Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Dodge
Model
Neon
Engine and year
L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alarm Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Alarm Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alarm Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 12
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Alarm Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 18
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Alarm Module: Component Locations
Fig.9 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) Location
Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 21
Alarm Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 22
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 23
Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 24
Alarm Module: Description and Operation
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE (SKIM)
Fig.13 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Fig.14 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Location
The Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) contains a Radio Frequency (RF) transceiver and a
microprocessor The SKIM retains in memory the ID numbers of any Sentry Key that is
programmed to it The maximum number of keys that may be programmed to each module is eight
(8). The SKIM also communicates over the PCI bus with the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), the
instrument cluster, and the DRB III scan tool. The SKIM transmits and receives RF signals through
a tuned antenna enclosed within a molded plastic ring formation that is integral to the SKIM
housing. When the SKIM is properly installed on the steering column, the antenna ring fits snugly
around the circumference of the ignition lock cylinder housing. If this ring is not mounted properly,
communication problems may arise in the form of transponder-related faults.
For added system security, each SKIM is programmed with a unique "Secret Key" code. This code
is stored in memory and is sent over the PCI bus to the PCM and to each key that is programmed
to work with the vehicle. The "Secret Key" code is therefore a common element found in all
components of the Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS). In the event that a SKIM replacement is
required, the "Secret Key" code can be restored from the PCM by following the SKIM replacement
procedure found in the DRB III scan tool. Proper completion of this task will allow the existing
ignition keys to be reprogrammed. Therefore, new keys will NOT be needed. In the event that the
original "Secret Key" code can not be recovered, new ignition keys will be required. The DRB III
scan tool will alert the technician if key replacement is necessary. Another security code, called a
PIN, is used to gain
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 25
secured access to the SKIM for service. The SKIM also stores in its memory the Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN), which it learns through a bus message from the PCM during
initialization. The SKIS scrambles the information that is communicated between its components in
order to reduce the possibility of unauthorized SKIM access and/or disabling.
When the ignition switch is moved to the RUN position, the SKIM transmits an RF signal to the
transponder in the ignition key. The SKIM then waits for a response RF signal from the transponder
in the key. If the response received identifies the key as valid, the SKIM sends a "valid key"
message to the PCM over the PCI bus. If the response received identifies the key as invalid or no
response is received from the transponder in the ignition key, the SKIM sends an "invalid key"
message to the PCM. The PCM will enable or disable engine operation based upon the status of
the SKIM messages. It is important to note that the default condition in the PCM is "invalid key."
Therefore, if no response is received by the PCM, the engine will be immobilized after two (2)
seconds of running.
The SKIM also sends indicator light status messages to the instrument cluster to tell that module
how to operate the light. This may consist of turning the light ON for a three (3) second bulb test
when the ignition switch is first turned to the ON position. It is also the method used to turn the light
ON solid or to flash it after the indicator light test is complete to signify a fault in the SKIS. If the
light comes ON and stays ON solid after the indicator light test, this signifies that the SKIM has
detected a system malfunction and/or that the SKIS has become inoperative. If the SKIM detects
an invalid key OR a key-related fault exists, the indicator light will flash following the indicator light
test. The SKIM may also request an audible chime if the customer key programming feature is
available and the procedure is being utilized.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Remove Lower Instrument Panel
Cover. Refer to Body, Instrument Panel, Lower Instrument Panel Cover, Removal. 3. Remove the
steering column upper and lower shrouds. Refer to Steering, Column, Column Shroud, Removal.
Fig.15 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) Remove/Install
4. Disengage the steering column wire harness from the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM). 5.
Remove the two screws securing the SKIM to the top of the steering column. 6. Rotate the SKIM
and its mounting bracket upwards and then to the side away from the steering column to slide the
SKIM antenna ring from
around the ignition switch lock cylinder housing.
7. Remove the SKIM from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If the SKIM is replaced with a new unit, a DRB III scan tool MUST be used to initialize the
new SKIM and to program at least two Sentry Key transponders (Refer to
ELECTRICAL/ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE).
1. Place the SKIM into position. 2. Rotate the SKIM and its mounting bracket downwards and then
to the side towards the steering column. 3. Install the two screws securing the SKIM to the top of
the steering column. 4. Engage the steering column wire harness to the Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module (SKIM). 5. Install the steering column upper and lower shrouds. Refer to Steering, Column,
Column Shroud, Installation. 6. Install the Lower Instrument Panel Cover. Refer to Body,
Instrument Panel, Lower Instrument Panel Cover, Installation. 7. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
> Page 28
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Programming the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
PROGRAMMING THE SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM,
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select SKIM MODULE REPLACEMENT (GASOLINE). 4.
Program the vehicle four-digit PIN into the SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct
country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select UPDATE VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to transfer the
VIN (the PCM will send the VIN to the SKIM). 8. The DRBIII will ask if you want to transfer the
secret key. Select ENTER to transfer secret key from the PCM. This will ensure the current vehicle
ignition keys will still operate the SKIS system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
> Page 29
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Programming Ignition Keys to the Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park / Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM, then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM AT ONE TIME. Once a key is
learned to a SKIM it (the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRBIII will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRBIII attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed in the SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed - (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle.
8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done - SKIM transponder ID memory is full. 1. Obtain
ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum) 2. Using the DRBIII, erase all
ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS 3. Program
all ignition keys.
Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
> Page 30
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Sentry Key Immobilizer System Initialization
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) initialization should be performed following a Sentry
Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) replacement. It can be summarized as follows:
1. Obtain the vehicle's unique four-digit PIN assigned to its original SKIM from the vehicle owner,
the vehicle's invoice, or from Chrysler's Customer
Center.
2. Using a DRB III scan tool, select "Theft Alarm," "SKIM," "Miscellaneous," and then "SKIM
Module Replaced."
a. Enter Secured Access Mode using the unique four-digit PIN. b. Program the vehicle's VIN
number into the SKIM's memory. c. Program the country code into the SKIM's memory (for North
America, choose US or domestic). d. The vehicle's unique Secret Key data will be retrieved from
the PCM automatically. If this data is corrupt or not present, you will be prompted
to cut new keys for this vehicle.
3. Program all customer keys into the SKIM's memory.
This process will require that the SKIM to be in the Secured Access Mode. The PIN must be
entered into the DRB III scan tool before the SKIM will enter the Secured Access Mode. Once
entered, Secured Access Mode shall be active until 60 seconds after the last command requiring
secured access was received and acknowledged.
Two exceptions to this rule are:
- When you have used the 'erase all keys' command OR
- When you have just programmed a new key. If either of these functions are performed
successfully while in the Secured Access Mode, this mode will be exited immediately following the
function.
NOTE: If a PCM is replaced, the unique 'Secret Key' data must be transferred from the SKIM to the
new PCM using the PCM replacement procedure. This procedure requires the Secured Access
Mode as well and can be found in the DRB III scan tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
> Page 31
Alarm Module: Service and Repair PCM/SKIM Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
> Page 32
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 41
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry
Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry
Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 47
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 50
Keyless Entry Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 51
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 52
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 53
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 54
Remote Keyless Entry Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 55
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
There are 2 Remote Keyless Entry Modules for the 2002 module year, premium and base. The
base module is for a vehicle with power door locks only. The base module performs the same
functions that the premium module does but has no provisions for Vehicle Theft Security System
(VTSS) or Remote Keyless Entry. Both modules communicate with other modules via the PCI bus
circuit.
The module monitors the Airbag Control Module messages for the purpose of monitoring the
deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message, along with the verification that the ignition
is on, it will provide the "enhanced accident response feature". This feature will cause the module
to unlock all doors and the instrument cluster to turn the courtesy lamps ON.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message and receive
body style information.
The Base module wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses
a signal from the driver or passenger (BUX) cylinder lock switch. The premium module wakes up
the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses a signal from the RKE
transmitter.
Two RKE transmitters are supplied with a premium equipped vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. Horn chirp on a premium equipped vehicle is customer programmable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 56
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
For procedures on diagnosing and testing the RKE Module's RKE functions, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr >
03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr >
03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 66
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 72
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 75
Keyless Entry Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 76
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 77
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 78
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 79
Remote Keyless Entry Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 80
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
There are 2 Remote Keyless Entry Modules for the 2002 module year, premium and base. The
base module is for a vehicle with power door locks only. The base module performs the same
functions that the premium module does but has no provisions for Vehicle Theft Security System
(VTSS) or Remote Keyless Entry. Both modules communicate with other modules via the PCI bus
circuit.
The module monitors the Airbag Control Module messages for the purpose of monitoring the
deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message, along with the verification that the ignition
is on, it will provide the "enhanced accident response feature". This feature will cause the module
to unlock all doors and the instrument cluster to turn the courtesy lamps ON.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message and receive
body style information.
The Base module wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses
a signal from the driver or passenger (BUX) cylinder lock switch. The premium module wakes up
the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses a signal from the RKE
transmitter.
Two RKE transmitters are supplied with a premium equipped vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. Horn chirp on a premium equipped vehicle is customer programmable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 81
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
For procedures on diagnosing and testing the RKE Module's RKE functions, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Service and Repair Sunroof Module
REMOVAL
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
1. Remove sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Disengage front
door weatherstrip from headliner, pull headliner
down to access control unit.
2. Disconnect wire connector from control unit. 3. Slide control unit up and forward and remove.
INSTALLATION
1. Place sunroof control unit into position. 2. Lock control unit into position. 3. Connect wire
connector to control unit. 4. Install sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper
B-pillar trim. Engage front door weatherstrip to headliner. 5. Cycle sunroof to the full open position.
6. Ensure sunroof adjustment. Refer to Sunroof Glass Adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module > Page 87
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Service and Repair Sunroof Module Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Close glass panel, if possible 2. Remove A-pillar trim. 3. Remove upper B-pillar and C-pillar trim.
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
4. Remove sunroof welt. 5. Remove the switch. 6. Detach fastener from headlinder bracket to the
front beam. 7. Remove all assist handles. 8. Remove sun visors. 9. Remove headlining and
disconnect the dome lamp connector.
10. Disconnect sunroof motor wiring connector. 11. Disconnect drain tubes. 12. Remove fasteners
attaching sunroof module to vehicle roof. 13. With the aid of a helper, remove sunroof module from
roof. 14. Remove sunroof module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. With the aid of a helper, position sunroof module in vehicle. 2. Install fasteners attaching sunroof
module to vehicle roof and support braces. Tighten all fasteners to 5 Nm (44 in. lbs.), starting from
the front and
working rearward and then the motor bracket.
3. Connect drain tubes. 4. Connect sunroof motor wiring connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module > Page 88
5. Headliner in position connect dome lamp wire connector. Install headlining. 6. Install the fastener
from the headliner bracket to front beam. 7. Install switch. 8. Install sunroof welt. 9. Install B-pillar
and C-pillar trim.
10. Install A-pillar trim. 11. Install sun visors. 12. Install all assist handles. 13. Install sunroof
sunshade. 14. Install sunroof glass panel. 15. Cycle glass panel open and close. 16. Ensure glass
adjustment, refer to Glass Adjustment procedure 17. Verify correct operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Fig.1 Integrated Control Unit (ICU)
The CAB is mounted to the ICU as part of the Integrated Control Unit (ICU).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 93
Controller Antilock Brake
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 94
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle.
Fig.3 CAB Mounting
3. Disconnect pump/motor connector from CAB. 4. Remove four screws securing CAB to HCU half
of ICU. Remove CAB from HCU. 5. Pull outward on CAB connector lock and disconnect 24-way
wiring connector. Remove CAB from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect 24-way wiring connector to CAB and push in connector lock. 2. Align CAB with HCU
half of ICU, then slide CAB up over HCU valves. Install four CAB mounting screws. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (17
in. lbs.) torque.
3. Connect pump/motor connector. 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Connect battery negative cable. 6. Connect
DRBIII to vehicle to initialize system. Check and clear any faults.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 99
Radiator Fan Relays
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 100
Radiator Fan High Relay (1.6L/2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 101
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
CHECKING RADIATOR FAN RELAY OUTPUT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radiator fan relay operation
- Ground circuit open
- Radiator fan motor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 102
- Fused B+ circuit
- Radiator fan relay output circuit
- Radiator fan relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 107
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 108
Compressor Clutch Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 109
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 110
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
Fig.6 A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
A/C COMPRESSOR CLUTCH RELAY
The A/C compressor clutch relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. The ISO micro-relay terminal functions are the same as a
conventional ISO relay. However, the ISO micro-relay terminal pattern (or footprint) is different, the
current capacity is lower, and the physical dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional
ISO relay. The A/C compressor clutch relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the
engine compartment. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the inside surface of the PDC
cover for A/C compressor clutch relay identification and location.
The black, molded plastic case is the most visible component of the A/C compressor clutch relay
Five male spade-type terminals extend from the bottom of the base to connect the relay to the
vehicle electrical system, and the ISO designation for each terminal is molded into the base
adjacent to each terminal.
The ISO terminal designations are as follows: 30 (Common Feed) - This terminal is connected to the movable contact point of the relay
- 85 (Coil Ground) - This terminal is connected to the ground feed side of the relay control coil.
- 86 (Coil Battery) - This terminal is connected to the battery feed side of the relay control coil.
- 87 (Normally Open) - This terminal is connected to the normally open fixed contact point of the
relay.
87A (Normally Closed) - This terminal is connected to the normally closed fixed contact point of the
relay.
The factory-installed A/C compressor clutch relay cannot be adjusted or repaired. If the relay is
damaged or faulty it must be replaced.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is an electromechanical switch that uses a low current input from
the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the high current output to the Compressor clutch
electromagnetic coil. The movable common feed contact point is held against the fixed normally
closed contact point by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field
is produced by the coil windings. This electromagnetic field draws the movable relay contact point
away from the fixed normally closed contact point, and holds it against the fixed normally open
contact point. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact
point back against the fixed normally closed contact point. The resistor or diode is connected in
parallel with the relay coil in the relay and helps to dissipate voltage spikes and electromagnetic
interference that can be generated as the electromagnetic field of the relay coil collapses.
The A/C compressor clutch relay terminals are connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
receptacle in the PDC. The inputs and outputs of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 111
the A/C compressor clutch relay include: The common feed terminal (30) receives a battery current input from a fuse in the PDC through a
fused B(+) circuit at all times.
- The coil ground terminal (85) receives a ground input from the PCM through the A/C compressor
clutch relay control circuit only when the PCM electronically pulls the control circuit to ground.
- The coil battery terminal (86) receives a battery current input from a fuse in the fuse block module
through a fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit only when the ignition switch is in the ON or
Start positions.
- The normally open terminal (87) provides a battery current output to the compressor clutch coil
through the A/C compressor clutch relay output circuit only when the A/C compressor clutch relay
coil is energized.
The normally closed terminal (87A) is not connected to any circuit in this application, but provides a
battery current output only when the A/C compressor clutch relay coil is de-energized.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 112
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
CHECKING THE A/C RELAY OUTPUT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- A/C clutch relay operation
- Ground circuit open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 113
- A/C clutch
- Fused B+ circuit
- A/C clutch output circuit
- A/C clutch relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 114
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.7 Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the cover from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 3. See the fuse and relay layout
label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for A/C compressor clutch relay identification and
location. 4. Remove the A/C compressor clutch relay from the PDC.
INSTALLATION
1. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for the proper A/C
compressor clutch relay location. 2. Position the A/C compressor clutch relay in the proper
receptacle in the PDC. 3. Align the A/C compressor clutch relay terminals with the terminal cavities
in the PDC receptacle. 4. Push down firmly on the A/C compressor clutch relay until the terminals
are fully seated in the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 5. Install the cover onto the PDC. 6.
Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Alignment
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams
Headlamp Alignment Control Module: Diagrams
Left Lavelier Module (Export)
Right Lavalier Module (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 122
Horn Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 123
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). 2. Using ohmmeter, test for continuity
between ground and circuit 65 of horn relay.
a. When the horn switch is not depressed, no continuity should be present. b. Continuity to ground
when horn switch is depressed. c. If continuity is not correct repair horn switch or wiring as
necessary.
3. Insert a jumper wire between circuit 63 and 66 of the Power Distribution Center.
a. If horn sounds replace relay b. If the horn does not sound, install horn relay and (Refer to
HORN/HORN - DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING).
4. Using voltmeter, test voltage at:
a. Circuit 62 and 66 test for battery voltage from fuse C to body ground. b. If voltage is incorrect
repair as necessary.
Fig. 2 Horn Relay
5. Click relay for 70 to 75 ohms resistance from terminal 85 to 86. If resistance not OK, replace
relay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 124
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the Power Distribution Center
cover and locate the horn relay. 3. Remove the horn relay.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the horn relay into the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 2. Install the PDC cover 3.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 130
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 131
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 132
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 133
Relay Box: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 134
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 137
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 138
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 139
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 140
Relay Box: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 141
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center
Relay Box: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center > Page 144
Relay Box: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 145
Relay Box: Service and Repair
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 152
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 153
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 154
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 155
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 156
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 157
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 158
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 159
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 160
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 161
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 162
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 163
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 164
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 165
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 166
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 167
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 168
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 169
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 170
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 171
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 172
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 173
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 174
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 175
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 176
Body Control Module: Electrical Diagrams
Airbag System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 177
Audio System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 178
CD Changer
Compass/Temperature Mirror
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 179
Exterior Lighting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 180
Instrument Cluster
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 181
Interior Lighting
Power Door Locks/RKE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 182
Vehicle Communication
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 183
Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information
Body Control Module: Technician Safety Information
SERVICING SUB-ASSEMBLIES
Some components of the body system are intended to be serviced as an assembly only.
Attempting to remove or repair certain system sub-components may result in personal injury and/or
improper system operation. Only those components with approved repair and installation
procedures should be serviced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 186
Body Control Module: Vehicle Damage Warnings
Electrical Testing Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "off". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation, this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion. Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent
accidental shorting of terminals Such mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second
code could be set, making diagnosis of the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description
Body Control Module: Description and Operation System Description
Identification Of System
The vehicle systems that are part of the "body" system are:
- Airbag System
- Audio
- Compass/Temperature Mirror
- Instrument Cluster
- Interior Lighting
- Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
- Vehicle Communications
- Vehicle Theft Security System
System Description
The body system on the 2003 PL consists of a combination of modules that communicate over the
PCI bus (Programmable Communication Interface multiplex system).
Through the PCI bus, information about the operation of vehicle components and circuits is relayed
quickly to the appropriate module(s). All modules receive all the information transmitted on the bus
even though a module may not require all information to perform it's function. It will only respond to
messages "addressed" to it through a binary coding process.
This method of data transmission significantly reduces the complexity of the wiring in the vehicle
and the size of wiring harnesses. All of the information about the functioning of all the systems is
organized, controlled, and communicated by the PCI bus, which is described in the Vehicle
Communication See: Functional Operation/Vehicle Communication of this general information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 189
Body Control Module: Description and Operation Functional Operation
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE
THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
DRIVER AIRBAG (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93 °C (200 °F).
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation, The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches on vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged. The clockspring cannot be repaired it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 190
PASSENGER AIRBAG (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and its
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON
GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG
MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING
INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93
degrees C (200 degrees F).
WARNING: REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN
THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR
INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT
PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE
AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY
DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY
SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT
FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG.
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
They are located on the left and right B-post. The SIACM perform self diagnostics and circuit tests
to determine if the system is functioning properly. If the test finds a problem the SIACM will set both
active and stored diagnostic trouble codes. If a DTC is active the SIACM will request that the airbag
warning lamp be turned on. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI Bus to the
ACM once each second or on change in lamp state. If the warning lamp status message from the
either SIACM contains a lamp on request the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the
DTC is set the ACM sends a PCI Bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC)
requesting the airbag warning lamp be turned on. Observe all ACM warning and caution
statements when servicing or handling the SIACM. SIACM are not repairable and must be replaced
if they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
SEAT AIRBAGS
The Left and Right seat airbag modules are located in the outboard end of the front seat backs.
The airbag module contains a bag, an inflator (a small canister of highly compressed argon gas)
and a mounting bracket. The seat airbag module cannot be repaired and must be replaced if
deployed or in any way damaged. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the inflator seals
the hole in the airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the
cushion. Upon deployment, the seat back trim cover will tear open and allow the seat airbag to fully
deploy between the seat and the door.
NOTE: It will be necessary to remove the seat back trim to gain access to the seat airbag module
connector when diagnosing the seat airbag system.
WARNING: THE SEAT AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI.
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR.
DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT
STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93 degrees C (200 degrees F). REPLACE AIRBAG
SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL
DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS,
SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE
SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY
MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS
NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE
PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Some airbag diagnostic tests use special tools, 8310 and 8443 airbag load tool, for testing squib
circuits. The load tools contain fixed resistive loads, jumpers and adapters. The fixed loads are
connected to cables and mounted in a storage case. The cables can be directly connected to some
airbag system connectors. Jumpers are used to convert the load tool cable connectors to the other
airbag system connectors. The adapters are connected to the module harness connector to open
shorting clips and protect the connector terminal during testing. When using the load tool follow all
of the safety procedures in the service information for disconnecting airbag system components.
Inspect the wiring, connector and terminals for damage or misalignment. Substitute the airbag load
tool in place of a Driver or Passenger Airbag, curtain airbag, clockspring, or seat belt tensioner (use
a jumper if needed). Then follow all of the safety procedures in the service information for
connecting airbag system components. Read the module active DTC's. If the module reports NO
ACTIVE DTC's the defective component has been removed from the system and should be
replaced. If the DTC is still active, continue this process until all components in the circuit have
been tested. Then disconnect the module connector and connect the matching adapter to the
module connector. With all airbags disconnected and the adapter installed the squib wiring can be
tested for open and shorted conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 191
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: *
Erase the stored codes
* Place the ignition in the Run position
* Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
* Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
* Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Audio System
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system on the 2003 PL consists of a radio that communicates over the PCI bus. The
speakers are located in the instrument panel, the front doors and the rear "D" pillars. The
instrument panel speakers are a tweeter type speaker for high frequency. The front door speakers
are a woofer/midrange type speaker. The rear "D" pillar speakers are a full range type speaker. If
one of the speaker circuits experiences a short, the other speakers on that output channel will also
shut down until the circuit is repaired. The radio will also set a trouble code, which the DRB III(R)
can display.
The in-dash CD-changer is designed to fit into the existing cubby bin in the center stack. This new
cartridge-less CD-changer is controlled by your radio, and allows you to individually load up to four
discs at one time. However, due to its compact design, the CD-changer can only carry out one
operation at a time. For example you can not load a new disc while playing another at the same
time. Each operation happens sequentially.
The radio unit installed with your system provides control over all features of the CD-changer with
the exception of the CD load and eject functions, which are controlled by buttons located on the
front of the CD-changer. The radio also supplies the power, ground, PCI Bus, left and right speaker
output through a single DIN cable. All features you would expect , such as Disc Up/Down, Track
Up/Down, Random and Scan are controlled by the radio, which also displays all relevant
CD-changer information on the radio display.
The CD-changer contains a Load/Eject button and an indicator light for each of the four disc
positions. The individual light indicates whether a CD is currently loaded in that particular chamber
of the CD-changer. Pressing the individual Load/Eject button for a particular chamber will eject a
disc currently present in the chamber. If the chamber is currently empty, actuating the Load/Eject
button will position that chamber to receive and load a new
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 192
disc in that chamber.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Compass/Temperature Mirror
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 193
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 194
magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may
appear to indicate false headings or appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may
need to be demagnetized. Refer to Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory, the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the
displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the
PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 195
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Exterior Lighting
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
The Headlamps are controlled by the Instrument Cluster.
The Instrument Cluster is also referred to as a "Smart Cluster". It receives and sends messages to
other modules through the PCI BUS circuit. The Headlamps are wired through the cluster and then
go to the Fuse Block to the lamps. Each Headlamp has an independent fuse located in the Fuse
Block.
For vehicles equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL Module is integrated with the
Instrument Cluster.
Interior Lighting
INTERIOR LIGHTING
The Courtesy Lamps are controlled by the instrument cluster.
Some of the features that it controls are the courtesy lamps, chime, and all instrument illumination.
It receives and sends messages to other modules via the PCI bus circuit.
The front turn signals are wired through the cluster and then go to the front lamps. For vehicles
equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL module is built into the cluster.
Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The Remote Keyless Entry module controls the Power Door Locks and the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). It also wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn on the illuminated entry when it
senses a signal from the RKE transmitter. The module communicates with other modules via the
PCI bus circuit.
The RKE module monitors the Occupant Restraint Controller messages for the purpose of
monitoring the deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message along with the verification
that the ignition is on and the vehicle speed is zero, it will provide the "enhanced accident response
feature". This feature will cause the module to unlock-all doors immediately and the instrument
cluster to turn the courtesy lamps on when the vehicle reaches 0 mph.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message, and receive
body style information. Two transmitters are supplied with the vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. The horn chirp on vehicle lock command is customer programmable.
To limit the amount of battery drain during storage, the IOD fuse may be removed.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM
When the VTSS is armed, it will monitor the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle
doors and decklid. Also monitored is a decklid security switch (knockout) for the cylinder lock. If the
alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 196
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, by
using the driver door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of an open decklid security switch sense circuit.
Disarming can be accomplished with a RKE unlock, turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key
or unlocking the vehicle with the driver door cylinder lock. All of the switches for the VTSS system
can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to determine the cause of a
customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM (Export Only)
When the VTSS is armed, it Will monitor the interior of the vehicle for movement via an intrusion
sensor (if equipped), the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle doors, decklid and
hood. Vehicles without an intrusion sensor will have a decklid security switch (knockout) which will
also be monitored. If the alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn or a battery backed siren
for vehicles equipped with the intrusion sensor, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, or
by using either door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of the hood ajar circuit being shorted (hood opened) or the decklid
security switch circuit being open (if equipped). Defeating the intrusion sensor feature for vehicles
so equipped can be done by three additional lock request to the RKE module within 5 seconds.
Disarming is done by either a RKE unlock or turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key. All of
the switches for the VTSS system can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to
determine the cause of a customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
Vehicle Communication
VEHICLE COMMUNICATION
The Programmable Communication Interface or PCI Bus is a single wire multiplexed network
capable of supporting binary encoded messages shared between multiple modules. The PCI bus
circuit is identified as D25. The modules are wired in parallel. Connections are made in the harness
using splices. The following modules are used on 2003 PL:
- Airbag Control Module
- Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Controller Antilock Brake
- Powertrain Control Module
- Radio (If equipped)
- CD Changer (If equipped)
- Compass/Temperature Mirror (If equipped)
- Remote Keyless Entry Module (If equipped)
- Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (If equipped)
- Mechanical Instrument Cluster
Each module provides its own bias and termination in order to transmit and receive messages. The
bus voltage is at zero volts when no modules are transmitting and is pulled up to about seven and
a half volts when modules are transmitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 197
The bus messages are transmitted at a rate averaging 10800 bits per second. Since there is only
voltage present when the modules transmit and the message length is only about 500 milliseconds,
it is ineffective to try and measure the bus activity with a conventional voltmeter. The preferred
method is to use the DRB III(R) lab scope. The 12 V square wave selection on the 20-volt scale
provides a good view of the bus activity. Voltage on the bus should pulse between zero and about
seven and a half volts. Refer to the diagram for some typical displays.
The PCI Bus failure modes are broken down into two categories. Complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure and individual module no response. Causes of a complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure include a short to ground or battery on the PCI circuit. Individual module no
response can be caused by an open circuit at the module, or an open battery or ground circuit to
the affected
Symptoms of a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure would include but are not limited to:
- All gauges on the EMIC stay at zero
- All telltales on EMIC illuminate
- EMIC backlighting at full intensity
- No response received from any module on the PCI bus (except PCM)
- No start (if equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer)
Symptoms of Individual module failure could include any one or more of the above. The difference
would be that at least one or more modules would respond to the DRB III(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 198
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III(R). If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III(R) may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III(R) and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only
an indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control
module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be
referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The Transmission Control Module is part of
the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller #8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Body Control Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Airbag Indicator On Without ACM Trouble Codes
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AIRBAG INDICATOR ON WITHOUT ACM TROUBLE CODES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Airbag indicator on without ACM trouble codes
- Instrument cluster problems
No Response From Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 201
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 202
Test 3 - 4
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM ACM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Checking for voltage at ACM
- Ground circuit open
- PCI bus circuit open
- Airbag control module
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 203
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Any Station Preset Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY STATION PRESET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Balance Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
BALANCE INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 204
CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Equalizer Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Fader Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FADER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 205
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
HOUR/MINUTE Switches Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HOUR/MINUTE SWITCHES INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
No Response From Radio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 206
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 207
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM RADIO
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response from radio
- Open fused ignition switch output circuit
- Open fused B+ circuit
- Radio ground circuit open
- Open PCI bus circuit
- Radio
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 208
SYMPTOM
PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
PWR Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Scan Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Seek Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 209
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Set Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 210
- Internal failure
Time Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tune Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Compass/Temperature Mirror Does Calibrate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 211
Test 1
Test 2
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR DOES CALIBRATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Calibration procedure
- Compass/temperature mirror
Compass/Temperature Mirror Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 212
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 213
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus - compass
- Fused B(+) circuit short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Ground circuit open
- Compass/temperature mirror
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 214
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to voltage
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Test 1 - 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 215
Test 5 - 7
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open fused B+
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to ground
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to ground
- Open fuse
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 216
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to voltage
- Fuse block
- Instrument cluster
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 217
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Fuse block
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Open fused B+ to fuse block
- Fused B+ circuit short to ground
- B+ circuit breaker 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 218
All Gauges Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 219
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus
- No response - PCI bus - powertrain control module
- No response - PCI bus - instrument cluster
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Instrument cluster ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
Any or All Gauge Pointer(s) On Wrong Side of Stop
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY OR ALL GAUGE POINTER(S) ON WRONG SIDE OF STOP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Any PCI Bus Indicator Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY PCI BUS INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 220
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- LED defective
- Instrument cluster
Brake Warning Indicator Always On
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 221
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit short to ground
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit short to ground
- Park brake switch
- Brake fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Brake Warning Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 222
Test 4 - 7
Test 8
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 223
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Brake fluid level switch
- Park brake switch
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit open
- Brake fluid level switch ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Front Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
FRONT FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Front fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Fuel Gauge Inaccurate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 224
Test 1 - 2
Test 3
SYMPTOM
FUEL GAUGE INACCURATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Fuel level sensor
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
High Beam Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 225
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- High beam indicator circuit open
- High beam indicator bulb
- Instrument cluster
Instrument Cluster Dimming Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 226
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DIMMING INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Headlamp switch output circuit open
- Illumination bulb
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Always on
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 227
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit short to ground
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 228
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit open
- Indicator led
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
One Gauge Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 229
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ONE GAUGE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Powertrain control module DTCs
- Instrument cluster
PRND or Autostick Indicator Display Inaccurate or Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 230
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
PRND OR AUTOSTICK INDICATOR DISPLAY INACCURATE OR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
Rear Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative - BUX Only
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
REAR FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE - BUX ONLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Rear fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Seat Belt Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 231
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
SEATBELT INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Indicator led
- Seat belt indicator circuit open
- Seat belt switch ground open
- Seat belt switch
- Instrument cluster
Temperature Display Inoperative or Wrong (2.0L Only)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 232
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG (2.0L ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present in PCM
- Ambient temperat1jre sensor
- Compass/temperature mirror
VF Display Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
VF DISPLAY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Courtesy Lamps Inoperative - All Lamps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 233
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS INOPERATIVE - ALL LAMPS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B+ circuit open
- Instrument cluster - courtesy lamp open
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit open
- Intermittent condition
Courtesy Lamps On At All Times
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 234
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 235
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 236
Test 8 - 10
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS ON AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Drivers door ajar switch
- Drivers door ajar switch sense wire short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster
- Panel lamps dimmer signal wire short to ground
- Multifunction switch
- Open door ajar switch
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense wire short to ground
- Instrument cluster
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit short to ground
- Instrument cluster
Illuminated Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 237
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ILLUMINATED ENTRY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Courtesy lamps operational
- Intermittent condition
- Illuminated entry not enabled
All Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 238
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 239
Test 8 - 13
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 240
Test 14 - 16
SYMPTOM
ALL DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid release relay output wire short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused B(+) wire short to ground
- Ground circuit open
- Door lock relay output circuit open
- Driver door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release solenoid-shorted
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Defective fuse #14
- RKE module - B(+) short to ground
- RKE module - relays open
- RKE module - shorted
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Lock and Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 241
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO LOCK AND UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open door unlock relay output
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Open motors
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 242
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door unlock relay output circuit short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module unlock relay
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Auto door locks not enabled
- Door ajar status
- PCM DTC's present
- RKE module defective - auto locks inoperable
Decklid Solenoid Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 243
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
DECKLID SOLENOID INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Solenoid ground open
- Decklid release solenoid open
- Decklid release relay output wire open
- RKE module - decklid relay open
Doors Lockable With Key In Ignition and Driver Door Open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 244
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 245
Test 4 - 10
SYMPTOM
DOORS LOCKABLE WITH KEY IN IGNITION & DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch - open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to RKE module
- Ignition switch open
- Key-in ignition switch sense wire open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to cluster
- Instrument cluster - key-in ignition open
- Instrument cluster defective-driver door ajar open
- RKE module defective-open driver door ajar
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 246
Driver Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open driver unlock circuit
- Driver door lock motor - open
- Driver door lock relay output wire open
- Driver door unlock relay output wire open
Driver Door Fails to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 247
Test 1
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- RKE module defective - driver unlock open
One Passenger Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 248
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ONE PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock motor open
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
Remote Keyless Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 249
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
RKE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Test transmitter with tester
- RKE transmitter not programmed
- Test RKE transmitter
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 250
- RKE transmitter - inoperative
- RKE module
- RKE module - receiver inoperable
Alarm Trips On Its Own
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALARM TRIPS ON ITS OWN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Last VTSS cause
- Attempt to trip alarm
- Intermittent condition
All Doors Fail to Lock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 251
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS FAIL TO LOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock relay output circuit short to ground
- Decklid release relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to driver door unlock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to door unlock relay output
- Remote keyless entry module - unlock ground open
All Locks Inoperative From A Door Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 252
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL LOCKS INOPERATIVE FROM A DOOR LOCK SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 253
- Door switch ground wire open
- Door switch MUX wire short to voltage
- Door switch MUX wire open
- Door lock switch open
- Remote keyless entry module - high voltage
- Remote keyless entry module - low voltage
Headlamps Fail to Flash When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HEADLAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Horn Fails to Sound When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HORN FAILS TO SOUND DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Horn relay control circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Cannot Be Disabled
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 254
Test 1
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR CANNOT BE DISABLED (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Fails to Trip VTSS
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 255
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR FAILS TO TRIP VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit open
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Repeatedly Triggers VTSS
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 256
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR REPEATEDLY TRIGGERS VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Driver Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
OPEN DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch
- Driver door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Driver door ajar switch sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Passenger Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 257
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 258
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 259
Test 7 - 8
SYMPTOM
OPEN PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Left rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
- RKE module - passenger door ajar sense
Park Lamps Fail to Flash During Alarm
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PARK LAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 260
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Park lamp switch output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
VTSS Fails to Arm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm From Passenger Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 261
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM PASSENGER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Passenger door switch MUX circuit open
- Passenger cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm/Disarm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM/DISARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 262
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR
CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY).
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Indicator Fails to Flash
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR FAILS TO FLASH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Remote keyless entry module
- Instrument cluster
- VTSS indicator driver circuit open
- VTSS led open
VTSS Indicator Stays On Steady During Arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 263
Test 1 - 5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 264
Test 6 - 8
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR STAYS ON STEADY DURING ARMING
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid security switch sense circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch ground circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch sense circuit shorted to ground (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch (if equipped)
- RKE module - VTSS indicator
- RKE module - hood ajar (if equipped)
- RKE module - decklid security (if equipped)
VTSS Siren Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 265
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
VTSS SIREN INOPERATIVE (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Siren functional test
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Faulty siren
- Siren control circuit open
- Siren control circuit shorted to ground
- Remote keyless entry module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 266
Body Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Six Step Troubleshooting Procedure
SIX-STEP TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
Diagnosis is done in six basic steps:
1. Verification of complaint 2. Verification of any related symptoms 3. Symptom analysis 4. Problem
isolation 5. Repair of isolated problem 6. Verification of proper operation
Road Testing
ROAD TEST WARNINGS
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure.
The purpose of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: Before road testing a vehicle, be sure that all components are reassembled. during the
test drive, do not try to read the DRB III screen while in motion. Do not hang the DRB III from the
rear view mirror or operate it yourself. Have an assistant available to operate the DRB III.
Vehicle Preparation For Testing
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR TESTING
Make sure the vehicle being tested has a fully charged battery. If it does not, false diagnostic codes
or error messages may occur.
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 267
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: Erase the stored codes
- Place the ignition in the Run position
- Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
- Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
- Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 268
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Glossary of Terms
ABS Antilock Brake System
ACM Airbag Control Module
AECM Airbag Electronic Control Module (ACM)
ASDM Airbag System Diagnostic Module (ACM)
BUX Built-Up Export
CAB Controller Antilock Brake
CTM Compass/Temperature Mirror
DAB Driver Airbag
DLC Data Link Connector
DTC Diagnostic Trouble Code
EMIC Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster
LSIACM
Left SIACM
NGC Next Generation Controller
PAB Passenger Airbag
PCI Programmable Communication Interface (Vehicle Communication Bus)
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PDC Power Distribution Center
PWM
Pulse Width Modulated
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RSIACM Right SIACM
SAB Side Airbag
SIACM Side Impact Airbag Control Module
SKIM Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
SKIS Sentry Key Immobilizer System
SQUIB Also Called Initiator (Located In Rear Of Airbag Module)
TCM Transmission Control Module
VFD Vacuum Fluorescent Display
VTSS Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 269
Body Control Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
DRB III Error Messages and Blank Screen
DRB III ERROR MESSAGES AND BLANK SCREEN
Under normal operation, the DRB III will display one of only two error messages:
User-Requested WARM Boot (Press MORE and NO at the same time)
User-Requested COLD Boot (Press MORE and YES at the same time)
If the DRB III should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the
S.T.A.R. Center for information and assistance.
DRB III DOES NOT POWER UP
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 16). A minimum of 11 volts
is required to adequately power the DRB III.
If all connections are proper between the DRB III and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, and inoperative DRB III may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
For a blank screen, refer to the appropriate body diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 270
DISPLAY IS NOT VISIBLE
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition
SOME DISPLAY ITEMS READ "---"
This is caused by scrolling the DRB III display a single line up or down. The line which was scrolled
onto the screen might read "---". Use the Page Down or Page Up function to display the
information.
DRB III Safety Information
DRB III (R) SAFETY INFORMATION
WARNING: EXCEEDING THE LIMITS OF THE DRB III (R) MULTIMETER IS DANGEROUS. IT
CAN EXPOSE YOU TO SERIOUS OR
POSSIBLE FATAL INJURY. CAREFULLY READ AND UNDERSTAND THE CAUTIONS AND THE
SPECIFICATION LIMITS.
Follow the vehicle manufacture's service specifications at all times.
Do not use the DRB Ill(R) if it has been damaged.
Do not use the test leads if the insulation is damaged or if metal is exposed.
To avoid electrical shock, do not touch the test leads, tips, or other circuit being tested.
Choose the proper range and function for the measurement. Do not try voltage or current
measurement that may exceed the rated capacity.
Do not exceed the limits shown in the table.
Voltage between any terminal and ground must not exceed 500v DC or 500v peak AC.
The circuit being tested must be protected by a 10A fuse or circuit breaker.
Use the low current shunt to measure circuits up to 10A. Use the higher current clamp to measure
circuits exceeding 10A.
When testing for the presence of voltage or current, make sure the meter is functioning correctly.
Take a reading of a known voltage or current before accepting a zero reading.
When measuring current, connect the meter in series with the load.
Disconnect the live test lead before disconnecting the common test lead.
When using the meter function, keep the DRB III (R) away from spark plug or coil wires to avoid
measuring error from outside interference.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 271
Body Control Module: Tools and Equipment
REQUIRED TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
DRB III (R) (diagnostic read out box) Jumper Wires Ohmmeter Voltmeter Test Light 8310 Airbag
Load Tool 8443 SRS Airbag System Load Tool
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 280
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 281
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 282
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 283
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 284
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 285
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 286
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 287
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 293
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 294
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 295
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 300
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 301
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 302
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 303
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 304
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 305
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 306
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 307
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 313
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 314
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 315
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 316
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Mounting Screws 4 Nm 35 In. Lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 319
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 320
Fig. 12 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 321
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 322
Fig. 43 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 325
Powertrain Control Module C2 (2.0L NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 326
Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 327
Powertrain Control Module C4 (EATX NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Important - Please Read
IMPORTANT (NGC)
New for the 2003 PL is a combined Powertrain Control Module and Transmission Control Module
in a single control module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller (NGC) for
DaimlerChrysler and will be referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 330
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
DATA BUS COMMUNICATION RECEIVE - PCM INPUT
The PCM uses the SCI communication bus to preform engine diagnostics and flash operations.
The transmission side of the PCM uses the SCI communication bus to flash new software.
However, diagnostics is performed via the vehicles J1850 bus for the transmission side of the
PCM.
IGNITION SENSE - PCM INPUT
The ignition sense input informs the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) that the ignition switch is in
the crank or run position.
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side relays, solenoids, ignition coil or injectors.
The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the ground side of
any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded separately from the
ground pins.
Fig.5 PCM
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine, transmission, and vehicle
operations through devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Controls
- Ambient Air temperature Sensor
- ASD Sense
- Baro/Tip (Turbo)
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 331
- Clutch Upstop Switch (1.6L)
- Clutch Interlock
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Cruise Control Switch
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor (Bus message)
- Ignition Switch
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- J1850
- Knock Sensor (1.6, 2.0, 2.4L only)
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection (NVLD)
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Oxygen Sensors
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receive
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 TPS Sensors)
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD)
- Transmission Range Sensor (TRS)
- Transmission Oil Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor (MTX-equipped models).
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp (Bus Message)
- SCI Transmit
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor (2.0/2.4L)
- Ignition Coils
- J1850
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp (Bus Message)
- Oxygen Sensors Heater Controls
- Radiator Fan Relays
- Speed Control Solenoids (2.0/2.4L)
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD)
- Transmission PRNDL Position (to Cluster)
- Transmission Torque Reduction Request (Internal to PCM)
- Transmission Temperature (Internal to PCM and a Bus Message)
- Vehicle Speed (Manual Transmission)
- 2 Electronic Throttle Control Outputs (1.6L) Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts fuel
injector pulse width, idle speed, ignition spark advance, ignition coil dwell and EVAP canister purge
operation. The PCM also determines the appropriate transmission shift schedule and shift points,
depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand. The PCM regulates the cooling
fan, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge rate by
adjusting the generator field. The PCM also performs diagnostics.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs. Battery voltage
- Coolant temperature
- Exhaust gas content (oxygen sensor)
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Intake air temperature
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 332
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs. -
Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Intake air temperature
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following
inputs. Air conditioning sense
- Battery voltage
- Battery temperature
- Brake switch
- Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Engine run time
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power steering pressure switch
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Vehicle distance (speed)
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are located in the Power Distribution Center
(PDC).
The camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor signals are sent to the PCM. If the
PCM does not receive the signal within approximately 1 second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the ASD relay and fuel pump relay. When these relays are deactivated, power is shut off from the
fuel injectors, ignition coils, oxygen sensor heating elements and fuel pump.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5 volts direct
current to power the camshaft position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, manifold absolute
pressure sensor, throttle position sensor, A/C pressure switch, A/C pressure transducer, and
vehicle speed sensor.
Powertrain Control Module Connectors
The PCM is an engine and transmission controller module all in one, if the vehicle is equipped with
an automatic transmission. The PCM uses four wiring harness connectors to receive and send
engine and transmission data. To ease assembly, the mating wiring harness connector is
color-coded. Each module connector cavity has its own unique color identification stripe located on
the outside of each connector cavity.
The PCM module utilizes four wiring harness connectors as described:
- Connector Cavity A is for Power & Ground (Black)
- Connector Cavity B is for Engine Side (Orange)
- Connector Cavity C is for Headlamp & Dash (White)
- Connector Cavity D is for Transmission (Green) If equipped.
NOTE: Connector Cavities A, B, C, And D must be connected prior to battery connection and
ignition key on to avoid setting erroneous controller fault codes. It is also recommended that cavity
A connector is made prior to any other connectors.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEX (CVI)
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Transmission Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs
represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 333
Fig.6 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRBIII Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
TRANSMISSION SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM is programmed to allow it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is
dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 334
- Software calibration level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
5 VOLT SUPPLY - PCM OUTPUT
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the following sensors:
- A/C pressure transducer
- Ambient Temperature sensor
- Battery temperature
- Camshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock sensor
- Linear EGR solenoid (if equipped)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L)
- Throttle position sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 335
Powertrain Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
CHECKING PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- (A14) PCM fused B+ circuit
- (A41) PCM fused ignition switch output circuit
- (Z12) PCM ground circuits
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 338
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 339
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 340
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 341
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 342
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 343
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 344
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 345
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 346
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 347
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 348
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 349
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 350
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Obtaining Diagnostic Trouble Codes
BULB CHECK
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 351
Key on: Bulb illuminated until vehicle starts, as long as all once per trip (readiness) monitors
completed. If monitors have not been completed, then:
Key on: bulb check for about 5 to 8 seconds, lamp then flashes if once per trip (readiness) monitors
have not been completed until vehicle is started, then MIL is extinguished.
OBTAINING DTC'S USING DRB SCAN TOOL
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "Read Fault" screen. 3. Record all the DTC's and
"freeze frame" information shown on the DRB scan tool. 4. To erase DTC's, use the "Erase Trouble
Code" data screen on the DRB scan tool. Do not erase any DTC's until problems have been
investigated
and repairs have been performed.
Pinion Factor Setting
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM/TCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an inoperative or improperly
calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM/TCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires)
available. Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain/ Transmission Control Module
initial setting so that the speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the
Pinion Factor, it is necessary to use a DRBIII scan tool.
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2.
Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then
follow the instructions on the DRBIII scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRBIII scan tool. This program allows the PCM/
TCM to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain/Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following
conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRBIII
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60° and below 200°
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRBIII to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 355
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 360
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 361
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel pump relay is located in the PDC. The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse location
The fuel pump relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel pump. A buss bar in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and contact side of the relay. The fuel pump
relay power circuit contains a fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the relay. The fuse is
located in the PDC. Refer to the Wiring Diagrams for circuit information.
The PCM controls the fuel pump relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the
relay ON and OFF. The PCM turns the ground path OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF
position. When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the PCM energizes the fuel pump. If the
crankshaft position sensor does not detect engine rotation, the PCM de-energizes the relay after
approximately one second.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 365
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 369
Manifold Tuning Valve Relay (RT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 375
Air Bag Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 376
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 377
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 378
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 379
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 380
Fig. 56 Body (Right) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 381
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
Airbag Control Module
Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 382
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH SIDE.
- DO NOT REMOVE SIACM FROM THE MOUNTING BRACKET. THIS IS SERVICED WITH THE
BRACKET AND A NEW ONE WILL COME WITH THE REPLACEMENT SIACM.
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 383
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
Airbag Control Module
AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, safing sensor, and
energy storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system
logic includes On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument
cluster circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn ON the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT. BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING
WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST
DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE. WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO
DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp ON for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns
OFF, it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible
malfunctions. If the lamp remains ON, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp
circuit may be internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer
than 6-8 seconds then goes OFF, there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 384
Fig.23 Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM)
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
Vehicles equipped with side impact airbags use two side impact airbag control modules. One is
located on each side of the vehicle within the body B-pillar.
Each Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM) serves as the impact sensor for its seat
mounted airbag. The right side SIACM controls the right seat airbag. The left side SIACM controls
the left seat air- bag. Each SIACM contains two accelerometers, both accelerometers must agree
in order to deploy the side airbag. In the event of a side impact, the appropriate SIACM will send a
electronic signal to its airbag, deploying the airbag. The SIACM communicates with the Airbag
Control Module (ACM) via the PCI bus circuit.
The SIACM perform self-diagnostics and circuit tests to determine if the system is functioning
properly. If the test finds a problem, the SIACM will set both active and stored Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTC's). If a DTC is active, the SIACM will request that the airbag warning lamp be turned
ON. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI bus to the ACM once each second or
on a change in lamp state (ON/OFF). If the warning lamp status message from either SIACM
contains a lamp ON request, the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the DTC is set,
the ACM sends a PCI bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC) requesting the
airbag warning lamp to be turned ON. Observe all ACM warning and caution statements when
servicing or handling the SIACM. The SIACM's are not serviceable and must be replaced even if
they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 385
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
If no obvious problems are found, erase stored codes, and with the ignition "ON" wiggle the wire
harness and connectors, rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop. Recheck for codes
periodically as you work through the system. This procedure may uncover a malfunction that is
difficult to locate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Airbag Control Module
REMOVAL
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove center console. Refer to Body
Interior, Floor Console, Removal.
Fig.4 Airbag Control Module (ACM) Remove/Install
3. Remove module mounting nuts and remove module. 4. Disconnect ACM 23-way connector. 5.
Remove ACM from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect ACM connector and ensure that the connector and all locking tabs are engaged.
CAUTION: USE SUPPLIED NUTS ONLY.
2. Position ACM (arrow pointing forward) in the console floor bracket, attach the nuts and tighten to
9.6 to 14 Nm (85 to 125 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Install center console assembly Refer to Body, Interior,
Floor Console Installation.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 388
TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 389
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Side Impact Airbag Control Module
REMOVAL
The removal and installation of the driver side and passenger side modules is identical. The
orientation of the modules is the only difference (which way they are tilted).
WARNING: THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH
SIDE.
1. Open hood.
Fig.18 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the lower seat trim. Locate the
connector for the seat airbag which is under the seat on the outboard side, attached to the seat
frame.
Disconnect the harness side of the connector. This is to engage the shorting Clips to disable the
side impact airbag system.
4. Remove the lower B-pillar trim from the appropriate side of the vehicle. Refer to Body, Interior,
B-Pillar Trim, Removal. 5. Remove the seat belt retractor. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Front Seat
Belt Retractor, Removal.
WARNING: DO NOT REMOVE SIACM FROM THE MOUNTING BRACKET. THIS IS SERVICED
WITH THE BRACKET AND A NEW ONE WILL COME WITH THE REPLACEMENT SIACM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 390
Fig.23 Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM)
6. Remove the SIACM retaining nuts and ground eyelet. 7. Pull SIACM out of B-pillar.
Fig.24 SIACM Connector
8. Disconnect the SIACM electrical connector. 9. Remove the SIACM from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
The installation of the driver side and passenger side modules is identical. The orientation of the
modules is the only difference (which way they are tilted).
WARNING: THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH
SIDE.
1. Connect the SIACM electrical connector. 2. Position the SIACM in the B-pillar and install the
retaining nuts. Torque the nuts to 41 Nm (360 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Place the ground eyelet over the TOP REAR (towards the rear of the vehicle) weld stud
when reattaching the SIACM. This location prevents the eyelet from spinning during tightening.
3. Install the seat belt retractor. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Front Seat Belt Retractor,
Installation. 4. Install the lower B-pillar trim. Refer to Body Interior, B-Pillar Trim, Installation. 5.
Connect the harness side of the connector. Install the lower seat trim.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
6. Close hood. 7. Verify vehicle and system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 395
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 396
Starter Motor Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 397
Starter Relay: Description and Operation
The Starter Relay is a micro relay located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), positioned in the
left front corner of the engine compartment.
As battery power is applied to the relay from the ignition switch, battery power is applied to the
starter motor through the relay to the starter solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 398
Starter Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer to the PDC cover for relay
location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 409
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 410
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 411
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 417
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 418
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 419
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 420
Control Module: Locations
Fig.11 TCM Location
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 421
Control Module: Description and Operation
Fig.11 TCM Location
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11). It mounts on a bracket that is fastened to the rail.
The TCM is the controlling unit for all electronic operations of the transaxle. The TCM receives
information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and selects the
operational mode of the transaxle. Direct inputs are hardwired to, and used specifically by the
TCM. Indirect inputs originate from other components/modules, and are shared with the TCM via
the J1850 communication bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are: -Battery (B+) voltage -Ignition "ON" voltage
-Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) -Throttle Position Sensor -Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) -Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) -Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD) -Transmission
Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS) -Input Shaft Speed Sensor -Output Shaft Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are: Engine/Body Identification
- Manifold Pressure
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Speed Control ON/OFF Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Brake Switch Status
- DRB Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are: Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD and UD)
- Vehicle Speed (to PCM)
- Torque Reduction Request (to PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 422
An example of a TCM indirect output is: Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions: Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indices (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with DRB scan tool)
Clutch Volume Index (CVI) An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index
(CVI). CVIs represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
Fig.12 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur (Fig. 12).
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRB Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 423
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Shift Schedules As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of
shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following: Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 424
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the chart
to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Control Module (TCM) is being replaced with a new or replacement unit,
the Pinion Factor and Quick Learn procedures must be performed. (Refer to ELECTRONIC
CONTROL MODULES/TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE - STANDARD PROCEDURE)
(Refer to ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/ TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE)
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially remove right front wheel
splash shield.
Fig.13 TCM 60-Way Connector
4. Disconnect TCM 60-way connector (Fig. 13).
Fig.14 TCM/Bracket Assembly
5. Remove three (3) TCM bracket-to-rail screws and remove TCM/bracket assembly from vehicle
(Fig. 14).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page
427
Fig.15 TCM Bracket
6. Remove four (4) bracket-to-TCM screws and remove bracket (Fig. 15).
INSTALLATION
1. Install TCM to mounting bracket and torque four (4) screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 15). 2.
Install TCM/bracket assembly to rail (Fig. 14). Install and torque three (3) bracket-to-rail screws to
12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Install TCM 60-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.) (Fig. 13). 4.
Install and secure right front wheel splash shield. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page
428
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the Transmission Control Module (TCM) has been
replaced with a NEW or replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an
inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The TCM
must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Transmission Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a DRB III scan tool. 1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector
located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous
menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the instructions on the DRB III scan tool screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page
429
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRB III scan tool. This program allows the
electronic transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle
operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met: The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRB III
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60 ° and below 200 °
1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRB III to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Control System Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 433
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 434
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 435
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION CONTROL RELAY - DESCRIPTION
The transmission control relay (Fig. 303) is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), which
is located on the left side of the engine compartment.
OPERATION
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TCM, and is used to supply power to the
solenoid pack when the transmission is in normal operating mode. When the relay is "off", no
power is supplied to the solenoid pack and the transmission is in "limp-in" mode.
After a controller reset (ignition key turned to the "run" position or after cranking engine), the TCM
energizes the relay. Prior to this, the TCM verifies that the contacts are open by checking for no
voltage at the switched battery terminals.
After this is verified, the voltage at the solenoid pack pressure switches is checked. After the relay
is energized, the TCM monitors the terminals to verify that the voltage is greater than 3 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Wiper Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.13 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove wiper arms. Refer to Electrical,
Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arm, Removal. 3. Remove the left side cowl cover. Refer to Body Exterior,
Cowl Cover, Removal. 4. Disconnect the motor posi-lock harness connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 440
Fig.14 Wiper Module Remove/Install
5. Remove the wiper module mounting screws and remove the module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the windshield wiper module into the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting screws and tighten to
7 - 9 Nm (60 - 80 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Connect the motor posi-lock harness connector. 4. Install the
left side cowl cover. Refer to Body, Exterior, Cowl Cover, Installation. 5. Install the wiper arms.
Refer to Electrical, Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arm, Installation. 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 446
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
HOOD AJAR SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Open hood.
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable - Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
hood ajar switch.
Fig.2 Hood Ajar Switch Location
4. Firmly press tangs on the bottom side of the switch together and push up through bracket. 5.
Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Firmly press hood ajar switch through bracket. 2. Connect wire harness connector to hood ajar
switch. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Close hood. 5. Verify vehicle and system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 451
Lock Cylinder Switch: Connector Locations
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 452
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 453
Lock Cylinder Switch: Diagrams
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Left Cylinder Lock Switch (Premium)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 454
Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. Refer to Body, Door - Front, Trim Panel, Removal. 2. Remove the
illuminated entry switch wiring clip and disconnect connector. 3. Remove door cylinder lock switch
from door handle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the door cylinder lock switch from door handle. 2. Install the illuminated entry switch wiring
clip and disconnect connector. 3. Install the door trim panel. Refer to Body, Door - Front, Trim
Panel, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Road
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Road Temperature Sensor: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Road
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 458
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 463
Fig. 48 Decklid - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 464
Decklid Security Switch (Knock Out)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 465
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
DECKLID SECURITY SWITCH
REMOVAL
The Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) Deck Lid Security Switch is mounted to the back of the
deck lid lock cylinder.
1. Open deck lid. 2. Disconnect wire connector to switch. 3. Remove the spring clip retainer. 4. Pull
switch off of deck lid lock cylinder and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Push switch onto the deck lid lock cylinder. 2. Install the spring clip retainer. 3. Connect the wire
connector to switch. 4. Close the deck lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Intrusion Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 470
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 471
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 472
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 473
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 474
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 475
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 476
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 477
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 478
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 479
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 480
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 481
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 482
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 483
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 484
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 485
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 486
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 487
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 488
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 489
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 490
Intrusion Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 491
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 492
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 493
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 494
Domelamp / Intrusion Sensor (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 495
Intrusion Sensor: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagram sheets may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
8w-39-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 496
8w-39-3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 497
8w-39-4 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 498
8w-39-5 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 499
8w-39-6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 500
8w-39-7 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 501
8w-39-8 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 502
8w-39-9
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 503
8w-39-10 (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 504
8w-39-11 (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 505
8w-39-12
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 506
8w-39-13 (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 507
8w-39-14 (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 508
8w-39-15 (Export)
NOTE: Other diagrams referred to by number (8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams can be found
at Diagrams by Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 509
Intrusion Sensor: Description and Operation
ULTRASONIC INTRUSION SENSOR
Fig.3 VTSS Intrusion Sensor
Some vehicles equipped with the premium Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) use a ultrasonic
intrusion sensor. This intrusion sensor is integrated into the dome lamp and detects any movement
in the cabin when the VTSS system and the intrusion sensor are armed The sensor cannot be
serviced separately and if found to be faulty the entire dome lamp assembly must be replaced
In the event the intrusion sensor detects movement inside the vehicle's interior (with system
armed), the ARKEM module will sound the siren.
DISARMING THE INTRUSION SENSOR
- Press the "LOCK" button on Remote Keyless Entry transmitter THREE times within five (5)
seconds This operation must be performed during the first 16 seconds of VTSS system arming
- Rotating the drivers door key cylinder THREE times within five (5) seconds This operation must
be performed during the first 16 seconds of VTSS system arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 510
Intrusion Sensor: Service and Repair
ULTRASONIC INTRUSION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable
Fig.4 Dome Lamp Unit With Intrusion Sensor Removal
2. Grasp the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor and rotate counterclockwise. 3. Pull straight
down on dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor. 4. Disconnect electrical connector. 5. Remove the
dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor from the vehicle
INSTALLATION
1. Connect electrical connector
Fig.5 Dome Lamp Unit With Intrusion Sensor Orientation To Headliner
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 511
2. Orient the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor in a way that the tabs align with the slots in the
headliner. 3. Push the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor straight up. 4. Rotate the dome lamp
unit with intrusion sensor clockwise. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 516
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 521
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
HOOD AJAR SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Open hood.
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable - Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
hood ajar switch.
Fig.2 Hood Ajar Switch Location
4. Firmly press tangs on the bottom side of the switch together and push up through bracket. 5.
Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Firmly press hood ajar switch through bracket. 2. Connect wire harness connector to hood ajar
switch. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Close hood. 5. Verify vehicle and system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Door (Passenger) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 525
Door (Passenger) - RHD
Fig. 61 Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 526
Fig. 62 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 527
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams
Left Door Lock Switch
Passenger Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Right Door Lock Switch
Right Rear Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 528
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the switch from its mounting location, and disconnect from vehicle wiring harness.
(Refer to POWER LOCKS/POWER LOCK SWITCH
- REMOVAL).
Door Lock Switch Resistance
2. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the DOOR LOCK SWITCH RESISTANCE table to determine if
switch resistance is correct in the Lock and Unlock
switch positions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 529
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel top cover.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove the two screws holding the RKE module to the instrument panel assembly. 4. Slide
locking tab of the wiring connector sideways to unlock tab, and remove connector from RKE
module. 5. Remove RKE module from vehicle.
NOTE: When replacing a faulty RKE Module, the replacement module must be configured with the
DRB III scan tool for proper operation. Additionally, all transmitters must be reprogrammed to the
new RKE module.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When replacing a faulty RKE Module, the replacement module must be configured with the
DRB III scan tool for proper operation. Additionally, all transmitters must be reprogrammed to the
new RKE module.
1. Install the RKE module into the vehicle. 2. Connect the RKE wiring connector. 3. Install the two
screws holding the RKE module to the instrument panel assembly. 4. Install the instrument panel
top cover. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Fig. 61 Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 533
Power Mirror Switch: Diagrams
Power Mirror Switch (LHD)
Power Mirror Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test
The following test is designed to be used only on vehicles equipped with power fold-away side view
mirrors.
1. Remove power mirror switch from mounting position (Refer to POWER MIRRORS/POWER
FOLDAWAY MIRROR SWITCH - REMOVAL).
Fig.2 Power Fold-Away Mirror Switch
2. Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
tables below.
NOTE: When testing using the chart below be certain to read the chart correctly. Example - When
testing left mirror "DOWN", pins 1, 9,10 will show continuity to each other, and pins 3, 4, 5 will show
continuity to each other.
3. If test results are not obtained as shown in the tables below, replace the switch.
Extended Mirror Switch Circuit Test
Extended Mirror Switch Circuit Test
NOTE: MIRROR POSITION SWITCH MUST BE IN THE "UNFOLD" POSITION TO USE CHART.
Retracted Mirror Switch Circuit Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 536
Retracted Mirror Switch Circuit Test
NOTE: MIRROR POSITION SWITCH MUST BE IN THE "FOLD" POSITION TO USE CHART.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 537
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Mirror Switch Test
1. Remove power mirror switch 2. Disconnect wiring harness connector from switch.
Power Mirror Switch Table ( Part 1 Of 2 )
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 538
Power Mirror Switch Table ( Part 2 Of 2 )
3. Using a ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch. 4. If results shown in
the table are not obtained, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 539
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or
equivalent, gently pry up on window switch bezel and remove from door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
wire connector from switch. 4. Remove two switch retaining screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the retaining screws. 2. Reconnect the wire connector to the switch. 3. Insert switch into
door trim panel 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Power Seat Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Limit
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Sunroof / Moonroof Limit Switch: Description and Operation
LIMIT SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The Sunroof Limit Switch is located in the drive motor assembly housing and is not serviceable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Sunroof Switch
Sunroof Vent Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 552
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 553
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 554
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 555
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 556
Fig. 35 Decklid - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 557
Decklid Release Switch (Power Release)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 558
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair
DECKLID RELEASE SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the glove box door. 3. Using a trim
stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry out on the deck lid release switch and pull out
of instrument panel. 4. Disconnect the wiring connector. 5. Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the wiring connector. 2. Align switch in hole and firmly snap into place. 3. Close the
glove box door. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 563
Fig. 37 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 564
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 565
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 566
Brake Fluid Level Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 567
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: An abnormal loss of brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir could be caused by
a leak in the hydraulic system. The entire brake hydraulic system should be checked for evidence
of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 568
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level switch is located in the left side of the brake fluid reservoir on the master
cylinder. It is clipped into the reservoir. It can be removed from the reservoir and replaced if
necessary.
OPERATION
The purpose of the brake fluid level switch is to provide the driver with an early warning that the
brake fluid level in the master cylinder reservoir has dropped below an acceptable level.
As the fluid drops below the designed level, the fluid level switch closes and grounds the red
BRAKE warning indicator circuit. This turns on the red BRAKE warning indicator. At this time, the
master cylinder brake fluid reservoir must be checked and filled to the full mark with DOT 3 brake
fluid. Check the entire brake hydraulic system for evidence of a leak.
CAUTION: An abnormal loss of brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir could be caused by
a leak in the hydraulic system. The entire brake hydraulic system should be checked for evidence
of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 569
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Remove the vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level switch in master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir.
2. Push together the retaining tabs holding the brake fluid level switch in place in the brake fluid
reservoir. 3. Pull the brake fluid level switch out the other side of the reservoir.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Align the brake fluid level switch with its mounting hole on the left side of the master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir. Push the switch into the fluid
reservoir until the switch retaining tabs are expanded on the other side of the reservoir, locking it in
place.
2. Connect the brake fluid level switch wiring connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 573
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
ABS Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Screw
...................................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (105
in. lbs.)
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR AIR GAP
Front Sensor ........................................................................................................................................
......................... 0.28 - 1.42 mm (0.011 - 0.056 in.) Rear Sensor ........................................................
.......................................................................................................... 0.45 - 1.12 mm (0.018 - 0.044
in.)
TONE WHEEL RUNOUT
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
................................................................. 0.009 in. Rear ....................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.009
in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
TONE WHEELS
FRONT
REAR
WHEEL SPEED SENSORS
FRONT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 579
REAR
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 580
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 581
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 582
Fig. 5 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 583
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 584
Fig. 37 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 585
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 586
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 587
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 588
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Tone Wheel
TONE WHEEL
DESCRIPTION
The tone wheel is used in conjunction with the wheel speed sensors.
OPERATION
The tone wheel is used in conjunction with the wheel speed sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 591
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor
Front
FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Mark 20e system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed sensors.
The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto resistive to help increase performance
and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A wheel speed sensor
is used at each wheel. The gear (tooth) type tone wheel serves as the trigger mechanism for each
sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one tone wheel.
The front wheel speed sensors are attached to bosses in the steering knuckle. The tone wheel is
an integral part of the outboard constant velocity joint located in the front axle shaft.
WSS air gaps are not adjustable. The initial factory WSS air gap specification can be found in
SPECIFICATIONS. Each WSS is serviced individually. The tone wheels are serviced as Dart of the
drive shaft.
OPERATION
The CAB sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the CAB. The
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 592
relationship of the tooth on the tone wheel to the permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to
enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output of the sensor, sent to the CAB, is a DC voltage
signal with changing voltage and current levels. The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit
is provided by the CAB.
When a valley of the tone wheel is aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8
volts and a constant 7 mA current is sent to the CAB. As the tone wheel rotates, the tooth shifts the
magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The CAB senses a voltage signal
of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The CAB measures the amperage of the digital signal for
each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABS CAB as the wheel speed.
Rear
REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Mark 20e system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed sensors.
The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto resistive to help increase performance
and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A wheel speed sensor
is used at each wheel. The gear (tooth) type tone wheel serves as the trigger mechanism for each
sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one tone wheel.
The rear wheel speed sensors are mounted through the disc brake adapter. The rear tone wheels
are mounted to and rotate with the hub and bearing assemblies.
The WSS air gaps are not adjustable. The initial factory WSS air gap specification can be found in
SPECIFICATIONS. Each WSS is serviced
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 593
individually. The tone wheels are serviced as an assembly with the hub and bearing assemblies.
OPERATION
The CAB sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the CAB. The relationship of the tooth on the tone wheel to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the CAB, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels. The
ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the CAB.
When a valley of the tone wheel is aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8
volts and a constant 7 mA current is sent to the CAB. As the tone wheel rotates, the tooth shifts the
magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The CAB senses a voltage signal
of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The CAB measures the amperage of the digital signal for
each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABS CAB as the wheel speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 594
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
TONE WHEEL
INSPECTION
Tone wheels can cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. Inspect tone wheels for the following
possible causes: missing, chipped, or broken teeth
- contact with the wheel speed sensor
- wheel speed sensor to tone wheel alignment
- wheel speed sensor to tone wheel clearance
- excessive tone wheel runout
- tone wheel loose on its mounting surface
If a front tone wheel is found to need replacement, the drive shaft must be replaced. No attempt
should be made to replace just the tone wheel. If a rear tone wheel is found to need replacement,
the rear hub and bearing must be replaced. No attempt should be made to replace just the tone
wheel. If wheel speed sensor to tone wheel contact is evident, determine the cause and correct it
before replacing the wheel speed sensor or tone wheel. Check the gap between the speed sensor
head and the tone wheel to ensure it is within specifications. Excessive tone wheel runout can
cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. If tone wheel runout is excessive, determine if it is
caused by a defect in the driveshaft assembly or hub and bearing. Replace as necessary. Tone
wheels are pressed onto their mounting surfaces and should not rotate independently from the
mounting surface. Replace the front driveshaft or rear hub and bearing as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector from the wiring harness on the inside of the
frame rail above the front suspension
crossmember. The connector has a locking tab which that must be pulled back before the
connector release tang can be depressed, releasing the connection.
3. If the sensor being removed is a left front, unclip the speed sensor cable from the brake tube on
the inside of and under the frame rail. 4. Remove the speed sensor cable grommet from the
retaining bracket attached to the brake hose on the outside of the frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 597
5. Remove the bolt mounting the wheel speed sensor head to the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When removing a wheel speed sensor from the knuckle, do not use pliers on the sensor
head. This may damage the sensor head. If the sensor has seized, use a hammer and a punch to
tap the edge of the sensor head ear, rocking the sensor side-to-side until free.
6. Carefully, remove the sensor head from the steering knuckle.
7. Remove the screw securing the wheel speed sensor to the rear of the strut. Remove the wheel
speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed,
and clipped properly.
1. Attach the wheel speed sensor to the strut using the its mounting screw. 2. Install the wheel
speed sensor head in the steering knuckle. Install the mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolt to a
torque of 12 Nm (105 inch
lbs.).
3. From the sensor bracket on the strut, loop the sensor cable upward, then downward at the
outside of the frame rail. Install the speed sensor cable
grommet onto the retaining bracket attached to the brake hose on the outside of the frame rail.
4. Loop the wheel speed sensor cable around the bottom of the frame rail and connect it to the
wiring harness connector on the inside of the frame
rail. Remember to push in the locking tab on the connector.
5. If the sensor being installed is the left front, clip the speed sensor cable to the brake tube on the
inside of and under the frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 598
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base brakes and ABS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 599
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector from the vehicle wiring harness. Remove
the clip attaching wheel speed sensor cable connector
to the vehicle's body.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket from under rear brake flex hose mounting
bracket. Then remove the speed sensor cable from
the routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube.
4. Remove the bolt attaching the wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket to rear strut.
CAUTION: When removing a wheel speed sensor from the rear disc brake adapter, do not use
pliers on the sensor head. This may damage the sensor head. If the sensor has seized, use a
hammer and a punch to tap the edge of the sensor head ear, rocking the sensor side-to-side until
free.
5. Remove the bolt attaching the wheel speed sensor to the rear disc brake adapter, then carefully
remove the sensor head from the rear disc brake
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 600
adapter and vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed,
and clipped properly.
1. Install the wheel speed sensor head into the disc brake adapter. 2. Install the wheel speed
sensor mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolt to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.). 3. Install the
wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket on the rear strut. 4. Install wheel speed sensor cable into
the routing clips on the rear brake hose and brake tube. 5. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable
connector into vehicle wiring harness. Install the clip attaching the wheel speed sensor cable
connector to
vehicle's body.
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base brakes and
ABS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Application and ID
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Climate Controls ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For
Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For
Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 609
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For
Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 610
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For
Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 611
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For
Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 612
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 623
Cruise Control Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: IF REMOVAL OF AIRBAG MODULE IS NECESSARY, REFER TO THE RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 624
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES
The speed control system has five separate resistive switches that provide a single multiplexed
(MUX) voltage inputs to the PCM The switch names are ON, OFF, SET, COAST, RESUME,
ACCEL, TAP-UP, COAST, and CANCEL Based on conditions when the buttons are pushed (and
released), the five voltages ranges provided to the PCM result in the following functions ON, OFF,
SET, COAST, RESUME, ACCEL, TAP-UP, TAP-DOWN, COAST, and CANCEL Refer to the
Speed Control Section for more information
Also the PCM receives an input from the brake switch to sense whether the brake pedal has been
depressed When the PCM receives the brake depressed input, it turns off power to the speed
control servo and disengages speed control Also the power to the servo is supplied through the
brake switch, which opens the circuit when the brake pedal is depressed
The individual switches cannot be repaired If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 625
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES
The speed control switch is mounted in the steering wheel and wired through the clock spring
device under the airbag module.
WARNING: IF REMOVAL OF AIRBAG MODULE IS NECESSARY, REFER TO THE RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS.
Fig.7 Speed Control Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the air cleaner lid, disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor and makeup air hose. 2.
Remove the negative battery cable. 3. Turn off ignition. 4. Remove air bag, refer to the Restraint
systems section.
Fig.8 Switch Top Mounting Screw
5. Remove the top mounting screw. 6. Rotate steering wheel so that the switch is in the 6 o'clock
position. Remove 2 screws from the back side of the speed control switch. 7. Disconnect the
electrical connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 626
Fig.9 Switch Removal
8. Remove switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install switch and tighten the screws to 1.6 Nm (15 in. lbs.).
Make sure rubber seal is in place around switch. 3. Install airbag, refer to the Restraint Systems
section. 4. Install the negative battery cable. 5. Install the air cleaner lid, connect the inlet air
temperature sensor and makeup air hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Sender: Description and Operation
OIL PRESSURE SENSOR/ SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The oil pressure switch is located on the right rear side of the engine block (Fig. 120). The oil
pressure switch is a pressure sensitive switch that is activated by the engine's oil pressure (in the
main oil gallery). The switch is a two terminal device (one terminal is provided to the wiring harness
and the other terminal is the switch's metal housing that screws into the engine block).
OPERATION
The oil pressure switch changes from an "Open" circuit to a "Closed" circuit, on decreasing
pressure, between 2 psig and 4 psig. The switch changes from a "Closed" circuit to an "Open"
circuit, on increasing pressure of 7 psig of the switch's "Closed" circuit pressure point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 631
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position oil collecting container under pressure switch location.
3. Disconnect oil pressure switch electrical connector and remove switch (Fig. 121).
INSTALLATION
1. Install oil pressure switch and connect electrical connector (Fig. 121). 2. Lower vehicle. 3. Start
engine and allow to run a minimum of 2 minutes. 4. Shut engine off and check engine oil level.
Adjust level as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 635
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
A/C Cycling Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 643
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 644
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the compass/temp module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 degrees C (140 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 degrees C (140
degrees F) to indicate a SHORT circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) to
indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the Sensor Test. If there are no codes
stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 645
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
0 degrees C (32 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 degrees C (50 degrees
F) Sensor Resistance = 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 degrees C (68 degrees F) Sensor Resistance =
11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 degrees C (77 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30
degrees C (86 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 degrees C (104 degrees F)
Sensor Resistance = 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 646
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Open hood, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Working under the front of the
vehicle, remove the necessary components to access the ambient temperature sensor. 3.
Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the ambient
temperature sensor retaining screw and remove the sensor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 2. Position the ambient
temperature sensor and install the retaining screw. 3. Install the removed components. 4. Connect
the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Coolant Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Application and ID
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Climate Controls ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig.22 Evaporator Probe Location - Typical
The evaporator probe is located in the A/C housing and placed in the evaporator fins.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 653
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the A/C housing from the vehicle.
The evaporator probe is located in the A/C housing and placed in the evaporator fins. The probe
prevents evaporator freeze-up. This is done by cycling the compressor clutch OFF when
evaporator temperature drops below the freeze point. It cycles ON when the evaporator
temperature rises above the freeze point. The evaporator probe uses a thermistor probe in a
capillary tube. The tube is inserted between the evaporator fins in the heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 654
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
The work area and vehicle must be between 16 °C (60 °F) and 32 °C (90 °F) when testing the
switch.
Fig.21 Evaporator Probe Harness Connector
1. Disconnect the three wire connector from the evaporator probe lead located behind the glove
box. 2. Start engine and set A/C to low blower motor speed, panel, full cool, and RECIRC. 3. Using
a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and 2. If no voltage is detected, there is no
power to the switch. Check wiring and
fuses.
4. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and Pin 3. If no voltage is detected,
there is no voltage from the Powertrain Control
Module. If voltage is OK, connect a jumper wire between Pin 1 and Pin 3. The compressor clutch
should engage. If the clutch engages, remove the jumper wire immediately and go to Step 5. If the
compressor clutch does not engage, check the operation of the clutch and repair as necessary.
5. If compressor clutch engages, connect the evaporator probe 3-way connector. The compressor
clutch should engage or cycle depending on
evaporator temperature. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, replace the clutch cycling switch.
6. The engine running and the A/C set to:
- Blower motor on Low speed
- Panel position
- Full cool
- RECIRC.
7. Close all doors and windows. Place a thermometer in the center discharge vent. 8. If the clutch
does not begin to cycle off between 2 - 7 °C (35 - 45 °F), verify that the evaporator probe is fully
installed and not loose in
evaporator. If it is not properly installed, install probe and retest outlet temperature. If the
evaporator probe is properly installed, replace the clutch cycling switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 655
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be removed without removing the A/C Housing from the vehicle.
1. Disconnect probe wiring connector from behind the glove box.
Fig.22 Evaporator Probe Location - Typical
2. Remove rubber grommet from evaporator/ blower module. 3. Note which of the three pilot holes
the evaporator probe is located in. 4. Pull probe out of evaporator fins.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be installed without removing the A/C Housing from the vehicle.
1. There are three pilot holes available for the probe. The top hole is for service. If top hole was not
used by previous probe, install probe in top hole. 2. If previous probe was removed from top hole,
use a small plastic stick of approximately 1/8 inch diameter, and make a new hole. Make the hole
1/4 inch above, or below the original hole in the evaporator core.
3. Insert the new probe into hole between evaporator fins. 4. Reinstall rubber grommet into
evaporator probe access hole.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 660
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 661
Fig. 4 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 662
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 663
Fig. 28 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 664
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 665
A/C High Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 666
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 High Pressure Cut Out Switch Location
A/C HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The high pressure cut out switch is located on the rear of the compressor. It turns off the
compressor if the system pressure exceeds 3240 kPa (470 psi). The high pressure cut out switch is
a factory calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and if faulty or damaged, it
must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 667
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE SYSTEM BEFORE
REMOVING THE HIGH PRESSURE CUT OUT SWITCH.
REMOVAL
1. Recover refrigerant from A/C system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle.
High Pressure Cut Out Switch
4. Disconnect the engine wire harness connector from the high pressure cut out switch on the
compressor back cover. 5. Using snap ring pliers, remove the internal snap ring that secures the
high pressure cut out switch to the switch port in the compressor back cover. 6. Pull the high
pressure cut out switch out of the compressor back cover. 7. Install a plug in or tape over the
opened switch port on the compressor back cover. 8. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the high
pressure cut out switch and discard.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean any foreign matter from the switch mounting bore 2. Install the high pressure cutout switch
with a new O-ring. Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the
R-134a
system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
3. Remove the tape or plug from the switch port on the compressor back cover. 4. Insert the high
pressure cut out switch into the switch port on the compressor back cover. 5. Reconnect the engine
wire harness connector to the high pressure cut out switch on the compressor back cover. 6. Lower
the vehicle. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 8. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 9.
Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 671
Fig. 4 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 672
Fig. 27 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 673
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
A/C Low Pressure Switch (LHD)
A/C Low Pressure Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 674
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C low pressure switch is a single pole, single throw, pressure actuated switch that is
installed in a threaded port into the suction passage of the accumulator. The switch is located on
the top of the accumulator in a fitting that contains a Schrader type valve, which allows the switch
to be serviced without discharging the refrigerant system. The accumulator fitting is equipped with
a O-ring to seal the switch plumbing connection.
The A/C low pressure switch is a factory calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or repaired
and if faulty or damaged it must be replaced.
The A/C low pressure switch monitors the pressure of the refrigerant leaving the accumulator to the
compressor. The switch is connected in series electrically with the heater-A/C control blower and
mode switches and the high pressure cut out switch between ground and the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). The switch contact open or close the path the ground, signaling the PCM to turn
the compressor clutch on and off. This regulates the refrigerant system pressure and controls
evaporator temperature. Controlling the evaporator temperature prevents con-densate water on the
evaporator fins from freezing and obstructing air conditioning system air flow.
The A/C low pressure switch contacts are open when the suction pressure is approximately 152
kPa (22 psi) or lower. The switch contacts will close when the suction pressure rises to
approximately 234 - 262 kPa (34 - 38 psi) or above. Lower temperatures, below approximately -1
°C (30 °F), will also cause the switch contacts to open. This is due to the pressure/ temperature
relationship of the refrigerant in the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 675
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
Before performing diagnosis of the A/C low pressure switch, be certain that the switch is properly
installed on the accumulator fitting. If the switch is too loose it may not open the Schrader-type
valve in the accumulator fitting, which will prevent the switch from correctly monitoring the
refrigerant system pressure.
Also verify that the refrigerant system had the correct refrigerant charge.
1. With gear selector in park or neutral and park brake set, start engine and allow to idle. 2. Raise
hood and disconnect low pressure cut off switch connector boot. 3. Using a suitable jumper wire,
jump across the terminals inside wire connector boot. 4. If the compressor clutch does not engage,
the A/C low pressure switch, wiring, relay, or fuse can be defective. 5. If clutch engages, connect
manifold gauge set. Read low pressure gauge. At pressure above 97 kPa (14 psi) and above, low
pressure out off switch
will complete the clutch circuit. If the low pressure gauge reads below 140 kPa (20 psi), the system
is low on refrigerant charge or empty due to a leak.
6. Install connector boot on switch and repeat Step 3. If the clutch does not engage, replace the
A/C low pressure switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 676
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the low pressure cycling
switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Disconnect the connector for the A/C low
pressure switch from the top connector on the accumulator. 3. Unscrew the A/C low pressure
switch from the fitting on the top of the accumulator. 4. Remove the O-ring seal from the
accumulator and discard.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replace the O-ring seal before installing the low pressure clutch cycling switch
1. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the accumulator fitting.
Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended
for the compressor in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the A/C low pressure cycling switch onto the accumulator fitting. The switch
should be hand-tightened onto the accumulator
fitting.
3. Reconnect the wiring harness connector to the A/C low pressure switch. 4. Reconnect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Door Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 681
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 682
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 683
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 684
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 685
Fig. 44 Body (Right Rear) - RHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 686
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 687
Door Switch: Diagrams
Driver Door Ajar Switch
Hood Ajar Switch (Export)
Left Rear Door Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 691
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The
sending unit consists of a float, an arm, and a variable resistor (track). The resistor track is used to
send electrical signals to the instrument cluster for fuel gauge operation and are then transmitted to
the engine controller for OBDII emission requirements.
For Fuel Gauge Operation: As fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This increases the
sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge to read full. As fuel level decreases, the float and
arm move down. This decreases the sending unit resistance causing the fuel gauge to read empty.
After this fuel level signal is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster will transmit the
data across the J1850 bus circuits to the PCM.
For OBD II Emission Requirements: The voltage signal is sent to the instrument cluster to indicate
fuel level. The cluster transmits the fuel level to the PCM where it is used to prevent a false setting
of misfire and fuel system monitor trouble codes. This occurs if the fuel level in the tank is less than
approximately 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 692
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
REMOVAL
Remove fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector (Fig. 4).
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge (Fig. 5).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 693
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector (Fig. 6). 4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector (Fig. 6).
Fig.7 Level Sensor
5. Slide level sensor wires through opening fuel pump module (Fig. 7). 6. Slide level sensor out of
installation channel in module.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert level sensor wires into bottom of opening in module. 2. Wrap wires into groove in back of
level sensor. 3. While feeding wires into guide grooves, slide level sensor up into channel until it
snaps into place (Fig. 7). Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in
place.
4. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
5. Install locking wedge on connector. 6. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector. 7. Install fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 697
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 702
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 703
Backup Lamp Switch (1.6/2.0L MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 704
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Lift vehicle on hoist.
Fig.1 Back-Up Lamp Switch
2. From bottom side of vehicle, disconnect back-up lamp switch connector. 3. Unscrew switch from
transaxle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install back-up lamp switch. Teflon tape or equivalent must be used on switch threads. Tighten
switch to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
CAUTION: Do not overtighten switch.
2. Connect back-up lamp switch connector. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Verify back-up lamp operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Light Switch: Component Locations
Fig.2 Brake Lamp Switch
The brake lamp switch is located under the instrument panel, at the brake pedal arm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 709
Brake Light Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 710
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 711
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 712
Brake Lamp Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 713
Brake Light Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If the switch
is not adjusted properly or has been removed for some service, a new switch must be installed and
adjusted.
- Never move the adjustment lever of the new brake lamp switch without it being properly installed
in the vehicle first. Such action will render the switch unusable and the switch must be discarded.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 714
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
Fig.2 Brake Lamp Switch
The brake lamp switch is located under the instrument panel, at the brake pedal arm. It has three
internal switches controlling various functions of the vehicle. It's main function is to control
operation of the vehicle's brake lamps. Other functions include speed control deactivation, brake
sense for the antilock brake system and brake sense for the brake transmission shift interlock.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If
the switch is not adjusted properly or has been removed for some service, a new switch must be
installed and adjusted.
When the brake pedal is pressed, the plunger on the outside of the brake lamp switch extends
outward. This action opens or closes the contacts of the three switches inside the brake lamp
switch.
With the brake pedal pressed down (plunger extended), the switch for terminals 1 and 2 is closed
completing the circuit. The switch for terminals 3 and 4 is open and so is the switch for terminals 5
and 6.
When the brake pedal is released (plunger pushed in), the three switches assume the opposite
positions. The switch for terminals 1 and 2 is now open while the other two switches are now
closed, completing their circuits.
A lever on the back of the switch is used to set the switch into the "adjusted" position. A
non-adjusted switch will have the lever set to the diagonal position in relation to the switch housing.
The plunger can be moved in and out, but the states of the internal switches will not change.
CAUTION: Never move the adjustment lever of the new brake lamp switch without it being properly
installed in the vehicle first. Such action will render the switch unusable and the switch must be
discarded.
Fig.5 Adjustment Lever Movement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 715
Once installed in the vehicle as described in the brake lamp switch installation procedure, the new
switch's adjustment lever is rotated to the adjusted position as indicated. This action locks the
plunger to the internal switches. Once in this position the switch is permanently adjusted (or locked)
and cannot be readjusted or released even if the lever is moved back.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 716
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH DIAGNOSIS
NOTE: Before proceeding with this diagnostic test, verify the adjustment lever on the back of the
switch is in the adjusted position. If the lever is in the non-adjusted (diagonal) position, it may have
never been adjusted.
If the electrical circuit has been tested and the brake lamp switch is suspected of being faulty, it can
be tested using the following method.
1. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
Fig.3 Switch Test - Released Position
2. With the switch in the released position (plunger extended), use an ohmmeter to test each of the
three internal switches as shown. You should
achieve the results as listed in the figure.
3. Gently push the plunger on the brake lamp switch in until it stops.
Fig.4 Switch Test - Depressed Position
4. With the switch in this depressed position (plunger pushed in), use an ohmmeter to test each of
the three internal switches as shown. You should
achieve the results as listed in the figure.
If you do not achieve the results as listed in both figures, the switch is faulty and must be replaced.
If the switch is found to be operating properly, it may be misadjusted. Do not reinstall the switch,
replace it.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If
the switch is not adjusted properly or has been removed for any reason, a new switch must be
installed and adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 717
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from its post on the battery. 2. Under the
instrument panel, remove the brake lamp switch by rotating the switch in a counterclockwise
direction approximately 30 degrees and
pulling it out of the bracket.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness from the connector on the switch. 4. Discard the brake lamp
switch. It must not be reused.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not reuse the original brake lamp switch. This switch can only be adjusted once.
That is during initial installation of the switch. If the switch is not adjusted properly or has been
removed for some service, a new switch must be installed and adjusted.
1. Obtain NEW brake lamp switch. The adjustment lever on the new switch should be at a 45°
angle from the wiring connector. If the adjustment
lever is parallel with the wiring connector, the switch has been preset and must be scrapped. DO
NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET (OR READJUST) THE BRAKE LAMP SWITCH.
2. Connect the wiring harness to the connector on the switch. 3. Mount and adjust the NEW brake
lamp switch using the following steps:
a. Install the switch in its bracket by aligning the index tab on the switch with the notch in the
mounting bracket. b. When the switch body is fully seated in its bracket, rotate the switch clockwise
approximately 30° to lock the switch into place.
Fig.5 Adjustment Lever Movement
c. With the brake pedal in the fully released position, move the adjustment lever on the brake lamp
switch from the 45° angled non-adjusted
position, clockwise as shown, until it is parallel with the wiring connector. The brake lamp switch is
now properly adjusted to the vehicle.
4. Reconnect the battery negative terminal. 5. Check the stop lamps to verify they are operating
properly and not staying on when the pedal is in the released position. 6. Road test the vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the brakes (including ABS if equipped) and speed control (if equipped).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Combination Switch: Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 721
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 722
Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 723
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
Turn Signal And Hazard Warning Flasher Diagnosis
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 724
Turn Signal And Hazard Warning Flasher Diagnosis
FLASHER DIAGNOSIS
Should any function of the multi-function switch fail, the entire switch assembly must be replaced.
SWITCH DIAGNOSIS
To test the switch:
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the upper and lower steering
column shrouds. 3. Disconnect the switch connector.
Fig.19 Combination Flasher Connector (A)
Fig.20 Multi-Function Switch Connector (B)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 725
Fig.21 Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch Connector (C)
Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test Part 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 726
Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test Part 2
Multi-Function Switch Dimmer Control Resistance
Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch as
shown in the Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test table for diagnosis.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 727
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
REMOVAL
Fig.22 Disconnect And Isolate Battery Negative Cable
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering
column shrouds.
Fig.23 Multi-Function Switch Mounting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 728
Fig.24 Multi-Function Switch - Remove/Install
3. Disconnect both posi-lock harness connectors at the rear of the multi-function switch. 4. Remove
multi-function switch mounting screws. 5. The combination flasher must be transferred to new
multi-function switch if replacing. 6. The windshield wiper/washer switch must be transferred to the
new multi-function switch.
INSTALLATION
1. The windshield wiper/washer switch must be transferred to the new multi-function switch. 2. The
combination flasher must be transferred to new multi-function switch if replacing. 3. Install the
multi-function switch mounting screws. Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to
3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect both posi-lock harness connectors at the rear of the
multi-function switch. 5. Instal both upper and lower steering column shrouds. 6. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Door Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 732
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 733
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 734
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 735
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 736
Fig. 44 Body (Right Rear) - RHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 737
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 738
Door Switch: Diagrams
Driver Door Ajar Switch
Hood Ajar Switch (Export)
Left Rear Door Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Fig. 6 Front Fog Lamps - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 742
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Diagrams
Left Front Fog Lamp
Right Front Fog Lamp (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 743
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation
REAR FOG LAMP SWITCH (EXPORT)
The Rear Fog Lamp Switch is located on the left stalk of the multi-function switch assembly. The
rear fog lamp switch is the primary controller of the rear fog lamps.
With the end of the left stalk pulled out, rotate it past the headlamp position to complete the rear fog
lamp switch circuit. This illuminates the rear fog lamp or lamps. Headlamps must be ON in order for
the rear fog lamp/s to function. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for a complete system schematic.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 744
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REAR FOG LAMP SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Refer to MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable 2. Open glove box door. 3. Pull downward on
lamp/switch assembly to disengage tabs from instrument panel. 4. Pull bulb from socket. 5.
Disconnect wire connector from lamp and remove glove box lamp/switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Place lamp/switch assembly into position. 3. Connect wire connector to
the lamp/switch. 4. Push lamp/switch assembly to lock tabs. 5. Check lamp operation, and close
glove box door. 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 751
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 752
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Multi-Function Switch
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel. The visible parts of the multi-function switch are the turn
signal control stalk that extends through a dedicated opening in the left side of the upper steering
column shrouds, the windshield wiper/washer, exterior lighting control stalk that extends through a
dedicated opening in the right upper steering column shrouds, the hazard warning switch push
button that protrudes through an opening in the upper steering column shroud on the top of the
steering column. The remainder of the switch, its mounting provisions, and its electrical
connections are all concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied
to it, which identify its many functions. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for
"Hazard Warning" is applied to the top of the hazard warning switch push button.
The switch housing and its controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A connector receptacle
with up to twenty terminals is located on the back of the switch housing and connects the switch to
the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
The multi-function switch supports the following functions and features: Continuous Wipe Modes - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides two continuous
wipe switch positions, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Wipe Mode - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides an intermittent
wipe mode with multiple delay interval positions.
- Washer Mode - A button on the end of the control stalk of the multi-function switch provides
washer system operation when the button is depressed towards the steering column.
- Hazard Warning Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
detent switching for activation and deactivation of the hazard warning system.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
for activation and deactivation of exterior lighting.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch
provide detent switching for selection of the headlamp high or low beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch includes
momentary switching of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature
(sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the
headlamp high beams as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide both
momentary non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left
and right turn signals.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is faulty, or if
the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Headlamp Switch: Component Locations
Fig.12 Headlamp Leveling Switch Location
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH
The Headlamp Leveling Switch is located on the center instrument panel area in the accessory
switch bezel and is the primary controller of the headlamp leveling system.
HEADLAMP SWITCH
The headlamp switch is integral to the left stalk of the multi-function switch located on the steering
column behind the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 757
Headlamp Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 12 Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 758
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 759
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Headlamp Leveling Switch Location
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH - EXPORT
The Headlamp Leveling Switch is located on the center instrument panel area in the accessory
switch bezel, and is the primary controller of the headlamp leveling system The leveling switch has
four settings 0-3, 0 being the lowest, and 3 being the highest headlamp beam vertical setting
With the rotation of the headlamp leveling switch control knob, voltage is adjusted at the headlamp
leveling switch (rheostat) This signals the headlamp leveling motors (headlamp module mounted)
to adjust the vertical headlamp beam pattern accordingly Headlamps must be "ON" in order for the
leveling system to function
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 760
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH - EXPORT
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable 2. Remove the headlamp leveling switch.
Headlamp Leveling Switch Resistance
3. Using an ohmmeter and the HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH RESISTANCE table, check the
resistance between switch connector pins 1&2. 4. If the test results are not as indicated in the table
below, replace the switch If test results are as indicated below, the switch is OK.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 761
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Leveling Switch Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Rotate the A/C outlet registers to the full down position Grip each outlet at its outboard end and
gently over-rotate to release from its pivot point
Swing outlet straight out and remove by hand
2. Remove the (4) HVAC control knobs by pulling straight off the switch shaft 3. Remove the (2)
screws from the center instrument bezel 4. Remove the center instrument bezel Pull it straight out
to unsnap the (4) retaining clips 5. Remove the (2) screws from the accessory switch bank 6. Pull
the accessory switch bank out and disconnect the electrical connector from the headlamp leveling
switch.
Fig.14 Leveling Switch Removal
7. Gently pry the headlamp leveling switch out of its mounting clips.
INSTALLATION
1. Snap the headlamp leveling switch into the accessory switch bank. 2. Install the headlamp
leveling switch electrical connector. 3. Verify switch operation. 4. Position the accessory switch
bank and install the (4) retaining screws. 5. Snap the center instrument bezel in position and install
the retaining screws. 6. Install the (4) HVAC control knobs. 7. Install the A/C outlet registers on the
center instrument bezel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Horn Switch: Locations
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 765
Horn Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 766
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module.
When the Driver Airbag is pressed, the horn switch makes contact to ground. The ground signal is
carried to the horn relay and the horn sounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 767
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Remove horn relay from the Power Distribution Center. 2. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to
ground and the other lead to cavity 65 of the power distribution center. 3. Depress horn switch,
should have continuity. If no continuity go to Step 4. 4. Test continuity at horn switch, remove the
Driver Airbag Module. (Refer to RESTRAINTS/DRIVER AIRBAG - REMOVAL). 5. Using
ohmmeter, connect one lead to the airbag module ground and the other lead to B+ wire. 6.
Depress horn switch, and the meter should show continuity If no continuity, replace the Driver
Airbag Module. If OK, repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 768
Horn Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the Driver Airbag Module. (Refer
to RESTRAINTS/DRIVER AIRBAG - REMOVAL). 3. Clip off strap tie holding the horn switch wire
to the airbag module. 4. Unclip horn switch wire connector from airbag module. 5. Remove four torx
screws from top side of airbag module. 6. Fold airbag module cover down to expose the horn
switch. 7. Lift the horn switch off indexing tabs and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Install horn switch to the indexing tabs on the airbag module. 2. Install screws to the top of
airbag module. 3. Reconnect horn switch connector to airbag module. 4. Install the airbag module.
5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Component Locations
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 773
Turn Signal Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 774
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 775
Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 776
Turn Signal Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Multi-Function Switch
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel. The visible parts of the multi-function switch are the turn
signal control stalk that extends through a dedicated opening in the left side of the upper steering
column shrouds, the windshield wiper/washer, exterior lighting control stalk that extends through a
dedicated opening in the right upper steering column shrouds, the hazard warning switch push
button that protrudes through an opening in the upper steering column shroud on the top of the
steering column. The remainder of the switch, its mounting provisions, and its electrical
connections are all concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied
to it, which identify its many functions. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for
"Hazard Warning" is applied to the top of the hazard warning switch push button.
The switch housing and its controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A connector receptacle
with up to twenty terminals is located on the back of the switch housing and connects the switch to
the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
The multi-function switch supports the following functions and features: Continuous Wipe Modes - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides two continuous
wipe switch positions, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Wipe Mode - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides an intermittent
wipe mode with multiple delay interval positions.
- Washer Mode - A button on the end of the control stalk of the multi-function switch provides
washer system operation when the button is depressed towards the steering column.
- Hazard Warning Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
detent switching for activation and deactivation of the hazard warning system.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
for activation and deactivation of exterior lighting.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch
provide detent switching for selection of the headlamp high or low beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch includes
momentary switching of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature
(sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the
headlamp high beams as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide both
momentary non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left
and right turn signals.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is faulty, or if
the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 783
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 784
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
785
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
786
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 790
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 794
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 795
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 796
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 797
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 802
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 803
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 804
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 805
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 806
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 807
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fig.11 Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 811
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 812
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 813
Fig.7 Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 818
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 819
Fig. 8 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 820
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 821
Fig. 48 Left Side Engine - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 822
Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 823
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct.
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery temperature sensor.
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values for the PCM to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery
temperature sensor.
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 824
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor 3. Remove
the air cleaner lid. 4. Disconnect the inlet air tube from the throttle body. 5. Remove inlet air tube
from air cleaner lid.
INSTALLATION
1. Install inlet air tube to air cleaner lid and tighten clamp. 2. Install inlet air tube to throttle body and
tighten clamp. 3. Install air cleaner lid to air cleaner box. 4. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor
electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 828
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Fig. 15 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 48 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 832
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 833
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 834
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.23 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
The MAP sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
The MAP sensor signal is provided from a single piezo-resistive element located in the center of a
diaphragm. The element and diaphragm are both made of silicone. As the pressures changes the
diaphragm moves causing the element to deflect which stresses the silicone. When silicone is
exposed to stress its resistance changes. As manifold vacuum increases, the MAP sensor input
voltage decreases proportionally. The sensor also contains electronics that condition the signal and
provide temperature compensation.
The MAP serves as a PCM input, using a silicon based sensing unit, to provide data on the
manifold vacuum that draws the air/fuel mixture into the combustion chamber. The PCM requires
this information to determine injector pulse width and spark advance. When MAP equals
Barometric pressure, the pulse width will be at maximum.
Also like the cam and crank sensors, a 5 volt reference is supplied from the PCM and returns a
voltage signal to the PCM that reflects manifold pressure. The zero pressure reading is 0.5V and
full scale is 4.5V. For a pressure swing of 0 - 15 psi the voltage changes 4.0V. The sensor is
supplied a regulated 4.8 to 5.1 volts to operate the sensor. Like the cam and crank sensors ground
is provided through the sensor return circuit.
The MAP sensor input is the number one contributor to pulse width. The most important function of
the MAP sensor is to determine barometric pressure. The PCM needs to know if the vehicle is at
sea level or is it in Denver at 5000 feet above sea level, because the air density changes with
altitude. It will also help to correct for varying weather conditions. If a hurricane was coming through
the pressure would be very, very low or there could be a real fair weather, high pressure area. This
is important because as air pressure changes the barometric pressure changes. Barometric
pressure and altitude have a direct inverse correlation, as altitude goes up barometric goes down.
The first thing that happens as the key is rolled on, before reaching the crank position, the PCM
powers up, comes around and looks at the MAP voltage, and based upon the voltage it sees, it
knows the current barometric pressure relative to altitude. Once the engine starts, the PCM looks
at the voltage again, continuously every 12 milliseconds, and compares the current voltage to what
it was at key ON. The difference between current and what it was at key ON is manifold vacuum.
During key ON (engine not running) the sensor reads (updates) barometric pressure. A normal
range can be obtained by monitoring known good sensor in you work area.
As the altitude increases the air becomes thinner (less oxygen). If a vehicle is started and driven to
a very different altitude than where it was at key ON the barometric pressure needs to be updated.
Any time the PCM sees Wide Open throttle, based upon TPS angle and RPM it will update
barometric pressure in the MAP memory cell. With periodic updates, the PCM can make its
calculations more effectively.
The PCM uses the MAP sensor to aid in calculating the following:
- Barometric pressure
- Engine load
- Manifold pressure
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance programs
- Shift-point strategies (F4AC1 transmissions only, via the PCI bus)
- Idle speed
- Decel fuel shutoff
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 835
The PCM recognizes a decrease in manifold pressure by monitoring a decrease in voltage from the
reading stored in the barometric pressure memory cell. The MAP sensor is a linear sensor; as
pressure changes, voltage changes proportionately. The range of voltage output from the sensor is
usually between 4.6 volts at sea level to as low as 0.3 volts at 26 in. of Hg. Barometric pressure is
the pressure exerted by the atmosphere upon an object. At sea level on a standard day, no storm,
barometric pressure is 29.92 in Hg. For every 100 feet of altitude barometric pressure drops 0.10
in. Hg. If a storm goes through it can either add, high pressure, or decrease, low pressure, from
what should be present for that altitude. You should make a habit of knowing what the average
pressure and corresponding barometric pressure is for your area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 836
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.24 MAP Sensor
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Disconnect the electrical connector
from the MAP sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting screws. 3. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while
making sure not to damage O-ring seal. 2. Tighten mounting screws to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque
for plastic manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 840
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Component Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 845
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 846
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 847
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 848
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 849
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 850
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor 1/1 Upstream
Oxygen Sensor 1/2 Downstream
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 851
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 852
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.30 Types Of O2 Sensors
Fig.27 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/1
O2 SENSOR
The upstream oxygen sensor threads into the outlet flange of the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 853
Fig.28 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/2
Fig.29 Heated Oxygen Sensor Systems
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the system depending on emission package.
Federal package the O2S is mounted after the catalytic convertor, LEV package the O2S is
mounted mid catalytic convertor, ULEV package is mounted between the catalytic convertor.
A single sensor ground is used for all O2 sensors (2 sensors on 4 cyl. vehicles and 4 sensors on 6
cyl. vehicles).
As vehicles accumulate mileage, the catalytic convertor deteriorates. The deterioration results in a
less efficient catalyst. To monitor catalytic convertor deterioration, the fuel injection system uses
two heated oxygen sensors. One sensor upstream of the catalytic convertor, one downstream of
the convertor. The PCM compares the reading from the sensors to calculate the catalytic convertor
oxygen storage capacity and converter efficiency. Also, the PCM uses the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input when adjusting injector pulse width.
When the catalytic converter efficiency drops below emission standards, the PCM stores a
diagnostic trouble code and illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL).
The O2S produce voltages from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air/fuel
mixture, can be caused by misfire and exhaust leaks), the sensors produces a low voltage. When
there is a lesser amount of oxygen present (caused by a rich air/fuel mixture, can be caused by
internal engine problems) it produces a higher voltage. By
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 854
monitoring the oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensors act as a rich-lean
switch.
The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element that keeps the sensors at proper
operating temperature during all operating modes. Maintaining correct sensor temperature at all
times allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop operation the PCM monitors the O2S input (along with other inputs) and adjusts the
injector pulse width accordingly. During Open Loop operation the PCM ignores the O2 sensor
input. The PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs
from other sensors.
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to both the upstream and
downstream heated oxygen sensors. The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element.
The heating elements reduce the time required for the sensors to reach operating temperature. The
PCM uses pulse width modulation to control the ground side of the heater to regulate the
temperature on 4 cyl. upstream O2 heater only. All other 4 cyl. and 6 cyl. O2 heaters do not use
pulse width modulation.
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
The input from the upstream heated oxygen sensor tells the PCM the oxygen content of the
exhaust gas. Based on this input, the PCM fine tunes the air-fuel ratio by adjusting injector pulse
width.
The sensor input switches from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air-fuel
mixture), the sensor produces voltage as low as 0.1 volt. When there is a lesser amount of oxygen
present (rich air-fuel mixture) the sensor produces a voltage as high as 1.0 volt. By monitoring the
oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensor acts as a rich-lean switch.
The heating element in the sensor provides heat to the sensor ceramic element. Heating the
sensor allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input along with other inputs. In Open Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on
preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs from other sensors.
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor input is used to detect catalytic convertor deterioration. As
the convertor deteriorates, the input from the downstream sensor begins to match the upstream
sensor input except for a slight time delay By comparing the downstream heated oxygen sensor
input to the input from the upstream sensor, the PCM calculates catalytic convertor efficiency. Also
used to establish the upstream O2 goal voltage (switching point).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
Fig.32 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust outlet pipe behind the catalytic
convertor.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from harness. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig.33 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 5. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Connect sensor electrical harness from clips along body
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor > Page 857
3. Connect electrical connector to harness. 4. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor > Page 858
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream (1/1) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector.
Fig.31 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
3. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 4. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Plug sensor connector. 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 859
Oxygen Sensor: Tools and Equipment
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - C-4907
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - 8439
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 864
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 865
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 866
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 867
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 872
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 873
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 874
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 875
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 876
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 882
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 883
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 884
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 885
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 886
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 887
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 888
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector
Views
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 899
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 900
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 901
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 902
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 903
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 908
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 913
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 914
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 915
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 916
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 917
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 918
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 926
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Fig. 28 Body (Left Front) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 931
Fig. 56 Body (Right) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 932
Seat Belt Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 938
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 939
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 940
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 941
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 946
Clutch Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 947
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 948
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 949
Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch (MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 950
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
DESCRIPTION - LHD The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two
switches: an engine starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 13). The
switch assembly is located in the clutch/brake pedal bracket assembly (Fig. 14), each switch being
fastened by four plastic wing tabs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 951
DESCRIPTION - RHD The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 15) consists of a single,
multi-function switch that is activated by hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod travel.
OPERATION - CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH The clutch interlock switch prevents engine starter
operation and inadvertent vehicle movement with the clutch pedal in the up position (not
depressed), or under normal conditions with the clutch engaged and the transaxle in gear.
WARNING: WHEN THERE IS A LOSS OF CLUTCH SYSTEM HYDRAULIC FLUID, OR THE
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
PUSHROD IS DISCONNECTED FROM THE PEDAL LEVER, THE ENGINE MAY START WITH
THE CLUTCH ENGAGED, CAUSING UNDESIRABLE VEHICLE MOVEMENT IF THE
TRANSAXLE IS IN ANY GEAR.
The switch is open while the clutch pedal is at rest or in the up position. When the clutch pedal is
fully depressed on LHD models, the clutch pedal lever closes the switch, completing the signal
circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter operation. When the
clutch pedal is fully depressed on RHD models, the master cylinder push rod closes the switch,
completing the signal circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter
operation. The interlock switch is not adjustable.
OPERATION - CLUTCH PEDAL UPSTOP SWITCH With the clutch pedal at rest, the clutch pedal
upstop switch is closed, allowing speed control operation. When the clutch pedal is depressed, the
upstop switch opens and signals the PCM to cancel speed control operation, and enter a modified
engine calibration schedule to improve driveability during gear-to-gear shifts. The upstop switch is
not adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Service Diagnosis
SERVICE DIAGNOSIS - CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two switches: an engine
starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 16).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 954
The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 17) consists of a single, multi-function switch that is
activated by the hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 955
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Clutch Interlock Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, turn the ignition key to the start position.
The engine starter should not crank with the
clutch pedal at rest (not depressed). If the starter cranks, proceed to the electrical test to determine
whether the switch is defective or the circuit is shorted. If the vehicle does not crank, proceed to the
next step.
2. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, fully depress the clutch pedal and turn
the ignition key to the start position. The engine
starter should crank. If the starter does not crank, visually inspect the clutch pedal for obstructions
(floor mat, etc.). Make sure the clutch pedal lever contacts and fully closes the switch on LHD
applications, and for proper installation of the master cylinder push rod/bushing on the pedal pin on
RHD applications.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 2 & 3 (Fig. 18) with the interlock
switch not depressed (clutch pedal at rest). There
should be no continuity between the terminals (open circuit).
5. LHD Models: Fully depress the clutch pedal to close the switch. The switch button should
compress at least 1.25 mm (0.050 inch) on LHD
applications. The ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms resistance). RHD Models: Disconnect
the push rod from the pedal pin and actuate the push rod by hand to close the switch. The
ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms). Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is
damaged (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced before reinstalling the push rod to the pedal.
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly, or the pedal bracket
assembly, is defective and should be replaced. If
the switch tests ok, wiring is defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 956
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Upstop Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
UPSTOP SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Start engine and operate speed control to maintain speed. 3. Depress
clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch). Speed control operation should terminate. If speed control
does not terminate, the upstop switch
is defective or the related wiring is shorted. Proceed to the upstop switch electrical test.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2 (Fig. 18) with the upstop switch
depressed (clutch pedal at rest). The ohmmeter
should show continuity (0 ohms).
5. Depress the clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch) check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2.
There should be no continuity between the
terminals (open circuit).
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly is defective and
should be replaced. If the switch tests ok, wiring is
defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - LHD
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable.
2. Remove left lower instrument panel bezel (Fig. 19). 3. Disconnect upstop switch and brake lamp
switch connectors. 4. Disconnect clutch master cylinder rod from clutch pedal pin. Inspect plastic
retainer upon removal. If retainer is damaged, it MUST be replaced.
5. Remove brake booster push rod retaining clip from brake pedal. Disengage rod from pedal (Fig.
20).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 959
6. Remove two pedal assembly bracket to instrument panel nuts (Fig. 21). 7. Remove four brake
booster/pedal bracket-to-cowl panel nuts (Fig. 21). 8. From under the hood, pull brake master
cylinder/booster far enough forward to obtain pedal to bracket stud clearance. 9. Remove the pedal
bracket assembly (Fig. 21).
10. Remove pedal pivot shaft and remove brake and clutch pedals.
11. Remove the interlock/upstop switch assembly (Fig. 22) from the brake/clutch pedal bracket
assembly by depressing the four plastic wing tabs on
each switch.
INSTALLATION - LHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 960
contacting pedals.
1. Install switches into the pedal bracket assembly as shown in (Fig. 22). Route harness as was
prior to removal. Secure switch connector retaining
push pin into the appropriate hole in the pedal bracket assembly.
2. Install clutch and brake pedals to pedal bracket, and install pivot shaft and nut. Torque pivot
shaft nut to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.). 3. Install brake/clutch pedal bracket assembly into position. Install
and tighten brake booster mounting nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). Install and tighten
pedal bracket-to-instrument panel nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
4. Install new stop lamp switch. 5. Connect brake booster rod to brake pedal. Install retainer clip
(Fig. 20).
6. Loosen adjustment screw (Fig. 24).
CAUTION: Inspect clutch master cylinder pushrod plastic retainer. If retainer is damaged in any
way (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced.
7. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod. Gently lift clutch pedal upwards until the clutch pedal
fully depresses the upstop switch. Torque
adjustment screw to 6 Nm (55 inch lbs.).
8. Connect interlock/upstop and stop lamp switch connectors. 9. Install left lower instrument panel
bezel (Fig. 19).
10. Connect battery negative cable. 11. Verify proper switch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 961
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - RHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - RHD
1. Disconnect the master cylinder push rod from the pedal pin (Fig. 23). Inspect push rod retainer
for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
must be replaced.
2. Squeeze together the tangs on the switch cover plate and slide the plate off the switch housing.
3. Disconnect the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector from the instrument panel wiring
harness. 4. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - RHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
contacting pedals.
1. Install the clutch interlock/upstop switch onto the master cylinder push rod, making sure that the
push rod is oriented with the push rod retainer
toward the wiring of the switch. The master cylinder push rod must be snapped into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch along the smaller diameter of the push rod between the snap ring and the
transition to the larger diameter.
CAUTION: Improper assembly of the larger diameter of the push rod into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch could cause damage to the switch or a
clutch system failure.
2. Install the switch cover plate.
CAUTION: Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
MUST be replaced.
3. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod to the clutch pedal pin. 4. Route the wiring harness as it
was prior to removal. 5. Secure the switch connector retaining push pin into the appropriate hole in
the pedal bracket assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
A power steering pressure switch is used to improve the vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch
improves vehicle idle quality by causing a readjustment of the engine idle speed as necessary
when increased fluid pressure is sensed in the power steering system. The pressure switch
functions by signaling the powertrain control module that an increase in pressure of the power
steering system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when the front
tires of the vehicle are turned while the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When
the powertrain control module receives the signal from the power steering pressure switch, it
directs the engine to increase its idle speed. This increase in engine idle speed compensates for
the additional load, thus maintaining the required engine idle speed and idle quality.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear.
OPERATION
The switch provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine RPM;
such as during parking maneuvers. When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2758 kPa (400
psi), the switch is open. The PCM increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine
stalling. The PCM sends 12 volts through a resister to the sensor circuit to ground. When pump
pressure is low, the switch is closed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 971
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Locate the power steering fluid pressure
switch on the back side of the power steering gear. 4. Remove the vehicle wiring harness
connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch.
NOTE: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, use a 7/8 inch deep well
socket. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic electrical connector area of the
power steering fluid pressure switch.
5. Unscrew and remove the power steering fluid pressure switch from the power steering gear.
INSTALLATION
1. By hand, screw the power steering pressure switch into the power steering gear until it is fully
seated. Tighten the power steering pressure switch
to a maximum torque of 8 Nm (70 inch lbs.). Over-torquing will result in stripping the threads out of
the power steering pressure switch port in the steering gear.
2. Install the vehicle wiring harness connector. Be sure the latch on the wiring harness connector is
fully engaged with the locking tab on the power
steering pressure switch.
3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Fill the power steering fluid reservoir to the correct fluid level. 5. Connect
the negative cable to the negative post of the battery. 6. Start the engine and turn the steering
wheel several times stop-to-stop to bleed any air from the fluid in the power steering system. Stop
the engine,
check the fluid level, and inspect the system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 976
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 977
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 978
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 979
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly-to-Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 12 Nm (110 in.
lbs.)
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Connector Screw
............................................................................................................................. 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 988
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 989
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
DESCRIPTION
The Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (Fig. 289) is external to the transaxle and mounted to the
transaxle case. The assembly consists of four solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the
LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is controlled by line pressure from
the manual valve in the valve body. The solenoids are contained within the Solenoid/Pressure
Switch Assembly, and can only be serviced by replacing the assembly. The solenoid assembly also
contains pressure switches that monitor and send hydraulic circuit information to the TCM.
Likewise, the pressure switches can only be service by replacing the assembly.
OPERATION SOLENOIDS
The solenoids receive electrical power from the Transmission Control Relay through a single wire.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid needed. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid passage is
opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The result is an
apply or release of a frictional element. The 2/4 and UD solenoids are normally applied, which by
design allow fluid to pass through in their relaxed or "off" state. This allows transaxle limp-in (P, R,
N, 2) in the event of an electrical failure. The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically
tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off depending on its current state. An inductive spike should
be detected by the TCM during this test. If no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify
the failure. In addition to the periodic testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or
pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on three pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2/4, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The range for the pressure switch closing and opening points is 11 23 psi. Typically the switch opening point will be approximately one psi lower than the closing point.
For example, a switch may close at 18 psi and open at 17 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 990
The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the correct states (open or closed) in
each gear as shown in the chart shown.
PRESSURE SWITCH STATES
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear. The TCM also tests the 2/4 and OD pressure switches when they are
normally off (OD and 2/4 are tested in 1st gear, OD in 2nd gear, and 2/4 in 3rd gear). The test
simply verifies that they are operational, by looking for a closed state when the corresponding
element is applied. Immediately after a shift into 1st, 2nd, or 3rd gear with the engine speed above
1000 rpm, the TCM momentarily turns on element pressure to the 2/4 and/or OD clutch circuits to
identify that the appropriate switch has closed. If it doesn't close, it is tested again. If the switch fails
to close the second time, the appropriate DTC will set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 991
Pressure Switch States
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 992
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY REMOVAL
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
solenoid/pressure switch assembly connector. 4. Disconnect input speed sensor connector.
5. Remove input speed sensor (Fig. 290).
6. Remove three (3) solenoid/pressure switch assembly-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 291).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 993
7. Remove solenoid/pressure switch assembly and gasket (Fig. 292). Use care to prevent gasket
material and foreign objects from become lodged in
the transaxle case ports.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install solenoid/pressure switch assembly and new gasket to transaxle (Fig. 292). 2. Install and
torque three (3) bolts (Fig. 291) to 13 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 3. Install input speed sensor (Fig. 290) and
torque to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect input speed sensor connector. 5. Install solenoid/pressure
switch 8-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 6. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 7. Connect battery negative cable. 8. If solenoid/pressure switch assembly was
replaced, perform TCM Quick Learn procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Switch: Locations
Interlock Mechanism
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 997
Shift Interlock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig. 39
1. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Fig. 40
2. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 40).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 998
Fig. 41
3. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/ RUN" position (Fig. 41).
Fig. 42
4. Grasp the interlock cable and connector firmly. Remove the interlock cable (Fig. 42).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 999
Fig. 43
5. Remove the two interlock mechanism-to-steering column attaching screws (Fig. 43). Remove
the interlock housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interlock housing at steering column. Install the two interlock mechanism-to-steering
column attaching screws. Torque screws to 3
Nm (21 inch lbs.).
2. Snap the interlock cable into the housing. 3. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds
(Fig. 40). 4. Install steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1003
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Mode Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1007
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1008
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1009
Autostick Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 1015
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 1016
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1017
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1018
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1019
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1020
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1021
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
1026
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
1027
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1028
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Input Speed Sensor (EATX)
Output Speed Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed
Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 293), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 294),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed
Sensor > Page 1031
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 295), an AC voltage is generated and sent to the
TCM. The TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input speed signal with output speed signal to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed
Sensor > Page 1032
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates an AC signal as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 298), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 299),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed
Sensor > Page 1033
OPERATION
The Output Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the output shaft is rotating. As the rear
planetary carrier park pawl lugs pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 300), an AC voltage is generated and
sent to the TCM. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following: Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed
Sensor > Page 1034
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Signal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
The vehicle speed signal is taken from the Output Speed Sensor. The TCM converts this signal
into a pulse per mile signal and sends it to the PCM.
The PCM, in turn, sends the vehicle speed message across the communication bus to the BCM.
The BCM sends this signal to the Instrument Cluster to display vehicle speed to the driver. The
vehicle speed signal pulse is roughly 8000 pulses per mile.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
input speed sensor connector.
4. Unscrew and remove input speed sensor (Fig. 296).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 297) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position. 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Install air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 5. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor >
Page 1037
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect output speed sensor
connector.
4. Unscrew and remove output speed sensor (Fig. 301).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 302) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position (Fig. 302). 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1042
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
T350 - Manual Transmission DESCRIPTION - VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1043
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect the speed sensor connector (Fig. 151).
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing to prevent dirt from entering the
transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt (Fig. 151). 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle
during sensor removal, drive gear must be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion gear to speed sensor (Fig. 151). 2. Using a NEW O-ring, install the speed sensor to
the transaxle (Fig. 151). 3. Install the bolt and torque to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.). 4. Connect speed
sensor connector (Fig. 151). 5. Lower vehicle and road test to verify proper speedometer operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Heated Glass Element Switch: Locations
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1048
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1049
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1050
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
The rear window defogger switch may be tested in the vehicle or out of the vehicle, on the bench.
IN-VEHICLE TESTING
1. Remove the switch from the instrument panel but leave the switch connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch ON.
Rear Window Defogger Switch Harness Connector
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage at Pin 1 and 2.
a. If OK, go to Step 4. b. If NOT OK, check fuse 7 in the fuse block and the 40 Amp cartridge fuse
in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). If fuses are OK, check
wiring circuit.
4. Check Pin 5, with switch in the ON position there should be battery voltage and no voltage in the
OFF position.
a. If OK, go to Step 5. b. If NOT OK, no voltage in the ON position or voltage in the OFF position.
Replace the switch.
5. Press switch to ON position. The indicator lamp should come ON and remain ON for
approximately 10 minutes. If the indicator lamp fails to light
or no voltage is present for approximately 10 minutes. Replace Rear Window Defogger Switch.
BENCH TESTING
1. First remove switch.
Rear Window Defogger Switch Connector
2. With switch removed from vehicle, use a jumper wire and connect a 12 volt supply to Pin 1 and
2. Using a third jumper wire, ground Pin 3. Refer
to and the Rear Window Defogger Switch and Harness Connector Pin Call-Outs table.
3. Follow the same procedures used for IN-VEHICLE TESTING, except for step Step 2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Power Window Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - RHD
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1054
Door (Passenger) - LHD
Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1055
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Driver Power Window Switch C1
Driver Power Window Switch C2
Passenger Power Window Switch (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1056
Passenger Power Window Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1057
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
Power Window Switch Continuity
Remove the switch from its mounting, (Refer to POWER WINDOWS/POWER WINDOW SWITCH REMOVAL). Using an ohmmeter, test the window switch for continuity in all positions Refer to
Power Window Switch Continuity table to determine if continuity is correct. If the correct results are
not obtained, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1058
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or
equivalent, gently pry up on window switch bezel and remove from door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
wire connector from switch. 4. Remove two switch retaining screws.
INSTALLATION
1. install the switch retaining screws. 2. Reconnect the wire connector to the switch. 3. Insert switch
into the door trim panel. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Wiper/Washer Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1063
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Wiper/Washer Switch Replacement
Fig.15 Wiper/Washer Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Removal. 2. Remove the two retaining screws to the Wiper/Washer Switch.
3. Separate the two switches.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the two switches. 2. Install the two retaining screws to the Wiper/ Washer Switch. 3.
Install the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle. Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1067
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1068
Wiper/Washer Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1069
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Fig.15 Wiper/Washer Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Removal. 2. Remove the two retaining screws to the Wiper/Washer Switch.
3. Separate the two switches.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the two switches. 2. Install the two retaining screws to the Wiper/ Washer Switch. 3.
Install the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle. Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Alignment Specifications
CURB HEIGHT FRONT REAR
All Neon 26.46 ± 0.32 in (672 ± 8 mm) 26.73 ± 0.32 in. (679 ± 8 mm)
SRT-4 26.97 ± 0.32 in. (685 ± 8 mm) 27.44 ± 0.32 in. (697 ± 8 mm)
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT ITEM PREFERRED SETTING ACCEPTABLE RANGE
Standard Neon Camber 0.00° -0.40° to +0.40°
Cross Camber (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 0.50°
Caster +2.60° +1.60° to +3.60°
Cross Caster (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 1.00°
Total Toe +0.20° 0.00° to +0.40°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
ACR Neon Camber 0.00° -2.4° to +0.40°
Cross Camber (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 0.50°
Caster +2.60° +1.60° to +3.60°
Cross Caster (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 1.00°
Total Toe +0.20° -0.70° to +0.30°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT ITEM PREFERRED SETTING ACCEPTABLE RANGE
Standard Neon Camber -0.25° -0.65° to +0.15°
Total Toe +0.30° +0.10° to +0.50°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
Thrust Angle 0.00° -0.10° to +0.10°
ACR Neon Camber -0.25° -1.00° to +0.20°
Total Toe +0.30° -0.70° to +0.30°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1074
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
Thrust Angle 0.00° -0.10° to +0.10°
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1075
Alignment: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Vehicle wheel alignment is the positioning of all interrelated front and rear suspension angles.
These angles affect the handling and steering of the vehicle when it is in motion. Proper wheel
alignment is essential for efficient steering, good directional stability, and proper tire wear.
The method of checking a vehicle's front and rear wheel alignment varies depending on the
manufacturer and type of equipment used. The manufacturer's instructions should always be
followed to ensure accuracy of the alignment, except when Daimler Chrysler Corporation's wheel
alignment specifications differ.
On this vehicle, the suspension angles that can be adjusted are as follows:
Front ^
Camber (when proper alignment package is used)
^ Toe
Rear ^
Camber (when proper alignment package is used)
^ Toe
Check the wheel alignment and make all wheel alignment adjustments with the vehicle standing at
its proper curb height specification. Curb height is the normal riding height of the vehicle. It is
measured from a certain point on the vehicle to the ground or a designated area while the vehicle
is sitting on a flat, level surface. Refer to Curb Height Measurement.
Typical wheel alignment angles and measurements are described in the following paragraphs.
CAMBER
Camber is the inward or outward tilt of the top of the tire and wheel assembly. Camber is measured
in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical line. Camber is a tire wearing angle. ^
Excessive negative camber will cause tread wear at the inside of the tire.
^ Excessive positive camber will cause tread wear on the outside of the tire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1076
CROSS CAMBER
Cross camber is the difference between left and right camber. To achieve the cross camber
reading, subtract the right side camber reading from the left. For example, if the left camber is +
0.3° and the right camber is 0.00°, the cross camber would be + 0.3°.
CASTER
Caster is the forward or rearward tilt of the steering knuckle in reference to the position of the upper
and lower ball joints. Caster is measured in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical center line.
This line is viewed from the side of the tire and wheel assembly. ^
Forward tilt (upper ball joint ahead of lower) results in a negative caster angle.
^ Rearward tilt (upper ball joint trailing lower) results in a positive caster angle.
Although caster does not affect tire wear, a caster imbalance between the two front wheels may
cause the vehicle to lead to the side with the least positive caster.
CROSS CASTER
Cross caster is the difference between left and right caster.
TOE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1077
Toe is the inward or outward angle of the wheels as viewed from above the vehicle. ^
Toe-in is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are closer together than
the rear edges.
^ Toe-out is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are farther apart than
the rear edges.
Toe-in and toe-out can occur at the front wheels and the rear wheels.
Toe is measured in degrees or inches. The measurement identifies the amount that the front of the
wheels point inward (toe-in) or outward (toe-out). Toe is measured at the spindle height. Zero toe
means the front and rear edges of the wheels on the same axle are equally distant.
TOE-OUT ON TURNS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1078
Toe-out on turns is the relative positioning of the front wheels while steering through a turn. This
compensates for each front wheel's turning radius. As the vehicle encounters a turn, the outboard
wheel must travel in a larger radius circle than the inboard wheel. The steering system is designed
to make each wheel follow its particular radius circle. To accomplish this, the front wheels must
progressively toe outward as the steering is turned from center. This eliminates tire scrubbing and
undue tire wear when steering a vehicle through a turn.
DYNAMIC TOE PATTERN
Dynamic toe pattern is the inward and outward toe movement of the front and rear tires through the
suspension's jounce and rebound travel. As the vehicle's suspension moves up and down, the toe
pattern varies. Toe pattern is critical in controlling the directional stability of the vehicle while in
motion. Front and rear dynamic toe pattern is preset by the factory at the time the vehicle is
assembled.
It is not necessary to check or adjust front or rear dynamic toe pattern when doing a normal wheel
alignment. The only time dynamic toe pattern needs to be checked or adjusted is if the frame of the
vehicle has been damaged.
STEERING AXIS INCLINATION (S. A. I.)
Steering axis inclination is the angle between a true vertical line starting at the center of the tire at
the road contact point and a line drawn through the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1079
center of the upper ball joint (or strut) and the lower ball joint. S.A.I. is built into the vehicle and is
not an adjustable angle. If S.A.I. is not within specifications, a bent or damaged suspension
component may be the cause.
INCLUDED ANGLE (I. A.)
Included angle is the sum of the S.A.I. angle plus or minus the camber angle, depending on
whether or not the wheel has positive or negative camber. If camber is positive, add the camber
angle to the S.A.I. angle. If camber is negative, subtract the camber angle from the S.A.I. angle.
Included angle is not adjustable, but can be used to diagnose a frame misalignment or bent
suspension component (spindle, strut).
THRUST ANGLE
Thrust angle is the averaged direction the rear wheels are pointing in relation to the vehicle's center
line. The presence of negative or positive thrust angle causes the rear tires to track improperly to
the left or right of the front tires (dog tracking). ^
Negative thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the left of the front tires.
^ Positive thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the right of the front tires.
Improper tracking can cause undue tire wear, a lead or pull and a crooked steering wheel.
Excessive thrust angle can usually be corrected by adjusting the rear wheel toe so that each wheel
has one-half of the total toe measurement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment
Alignment: Service and Repair Wheel Alignment
PRE-WHEEL ALIGNMENT VEHICLE INSPECTION
CAUTION: If during the inspection the front suspension crossmember shows any sign of impact
damage, the steering column lower coupling must be inspected.
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment, the following inspection and
necessary corrections must be made to the vehicle to ensure proper alignment. 1. Be sure the fuel
tank is full of fuel. If the fuel tank is not full, the reduction in weight will affect the curb height of the
vehicle and the alignment
specifications.
2. The passenger and luggage compartments of the vehicle should be free of any load that is not
factory equipment. 3. Check the tires on the vehicle. The tires are to be inflated to the
recommended air pressure. All tires must be the same size and in good condition
with approximately the same tread wear.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for excessive radial runout. 5. Inspect all suspension
component fasteners for looseness and torque. 6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all steering
linkage for looseness and any sign of wear or damage. 7. Inspect the rubber bushings on all the
suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any bushings show signs of wear or
deterioration, they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
WHEEL ALIGNMENT SETUP
1. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack. 2. Install all required alignment equipment on the
vehicle, per the alignment equipment manufacturer's instructions. On this vehicle, a four-wheel
alignment is recommended.
NOTE: Prior to reading the vehicle's alignment readouts, the front and rear of vehicle should be
jounced. Induce jounce (rear first, then front) by grasping the center of the bumper and jouncing
each end of vehicle an equal number of times. The bumper should always be released when
vehicle is at the bottom of the jounce cycle.
3. Read the vehicle's current front and rear alignment settings. Compare the vehicle's current
alignment settings to the vehicle specifications for
camber, caster and toe-in.
4. If the rear alignment is out of specification, adjust it first before proceeding to the front.
CAMBER AND CASTER
Front and rear camber and caster settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is
designed, by the location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is referred to as Net Build.
The result is no required adjustment of camber and caster after the vehicle is built or when
servicing the suspension components. Thus, when performing a wheel alignment, caster and
camber are not normally considered adjustable angles. Camber and caster should be checked to
ensure they meet vehicle specifications.
If either front or rear camber is found not to meet alignment specifications, it can be adjusted using
an available camber adjustment bolt package. Before installing a camber adjustment bolt package
on a vehicle found to be outside the specifications, inspect the suspension components for any
signs of damage or bending.
No adjustment can be made to the caster setting on this vehicle. If the vehicle's caster is not within
alignment specifications, check for damaged suspension components or body parts.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicles wheel alignment by heating or bending any of the
suspension components.
CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION (WITHOUT ACR PACKAGE)
NOTE: The following procedure should be used on vehicles WITHOUT the ACR competition
package or on the rear suspension of vehicles with the ACR competition package.
The camber adjustment bolt package contains new bolts and nuts for attaching the strut clevis
bracket to the steering knuckle. The bolts contained in the package are slightly undersize allowing
for movement between the strut clevis bracket and the steering knuckle. The movement allowed by
the undersize bolts provides approximately one degree of camber adjustment per side of the
vehicle. To install and adjust the camber adjustment bolt package, follow the procedure below.
CAUTION: There are separate camber adjustment bolt packages for the front and rear of the
vehicle. Be sure to use the correct package.
1. Raise the vehicle until its tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolt shanks are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove the nuts while holding the bolts stationary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1082
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly at the strut requiring modification.
3. Remove the original upper bolt attaching the strut clevis bracket to the knuckle. 4. Install a bolt
from the adjustment package into the hole where the original bolt was removed. Install the bolt from
the rear. 5. Install a nut provided in adjustment package on the replacement bolt. Tighten the nut
until it's snug, but still allowing the knuckle to slide in the
clevis bracket.
6. Remove the original lower bolt. 7. Install a bolt from the adjustment package into the bottom hole
of the strut clevis bracket. Install the bolt from the rear. 8. Install a nut provided in adjustment
package on the replacement bolt. Tighten the nut until it's snug. 9. Reinstall the tire and wheel
assembly.
10. Perform the above procedure to any of the remaining struts as required. 11. Lower the vehicle
and jounce the front and rear of the vehicle. 12. Adjust the front or rear camber to the preferred
setting by pushing or pulling on the top of the tire. When camber is set to specifications, tighten the
upper and lower strut clevis bracket bolts. Again jounce the front and rear of the vehicle, then verify
the camber settings.
13. Torque front strut clevis bracket-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts to 53 Nm (40 ft. lbs.), plus
an additional 1/4 turn after the torque is met.
Torque the rear strut clevis bracket-to-rear knuckle attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
14. Once camber is within specifications, adjust toe to meet the preferred specification setting.
Refer to TOE within this wheel alignment service
procedure.
CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION (WITH ACR PACKAGE)
NOTE: The following procedure should only be used on the front suspension of vehicles WITH the
ACR competition package. For installation of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1083
adjustment bolt package on the ACR rear suspension, refer to CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT
PACKAGE INSTALLATION (WITHOUT ACR PACKAGE) above.
The camber adjustment bolt package contains new bolts and nuts for attaching the strut clevis
bracket to the steering knuckle. The bolts contained in the package are slightly undersize allowing
for movement between the strut clevis bracket and the steering knuckle. The movement allowed by
the undersize bolts provides approximately one degree of camber adjustment per side of the
vehicle. Additional modification will also be necessary to gain a proper camber setting for ACR
competition. To modify the strut, install and adjust the camber adjustment bolt package, follow the
procedure below.
CAUTION: There are separate camber adjustment bolt packages for the front and rear of the
vehicle. Be sure to use the correct package for the front suspension.
1. Raise the vehicle until its tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolt shanks are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove the nuts while holding the bolts stationary.
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly at the strut requiring modification. 3. Remove the original
upper and lower bolts attaching the strut clevis bracket to the knuckle. 4. Separate the knuckle from
the strut clevis bracket.
NOTE: The following two steps must be performed to gain the necessary amount of negative
camber for ACR competition.
5. Draw an imaginary line from the center of the clevis bracket upper bolt hole down through the
center of the clevis bracket lower bolt hole.
Pivoting the line at the center of the lower hole, move the upper end of the line inward so as to
follow an arc past the inner edge of the upper bolt hole approximately 2.8 mm (0.11 inch). Mark the
bracket showing what area of the surface needs to be removed to form the elongated hole.
Remember, this elongation must follow the arc. Repeat this step on the opposite side of the clevis
bracket.
6. Using an appropriate grinding tool, elongate the upper hole as indicated by the markings until the
necessary material is removed. Repeat this step
on the opposite side of the clevis bracket.
7. Place the knuckle back in the clevis bracket. 8. Install bolts from the adjustment package into the
holes where the original bolts were removed. Install the bolts from the rear. 9. Install a nut provided
in adjustment package on each replacement bolt. Tighten the nuts until snug, but still allowing the
knuckle to slide in the
clevis bracket.
10. Reinstall the tire and wheel assembly. 11. Perform the above procedure to the remaining front
strut as required. 12. Lower the vehicle and jounce the front and rear of the vehicle. 13. Adjust the
front camber to the preferred setting by pushing or pulling on the top of the tire. When camber is
set to specifications, tighten the upper
and lower strut clevis bracket bolts. Again jounce the front and rear of the vehicle, then verify the
camber settings.
14. Torque front strut clevis bracket-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts to 53 Nm (40 ft. lbs.), plus
an additional 1/4 turn after the torque is met.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1084
Torque the rear strut clevis bracket-to-rear knuckle attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
15. Once camber is within specifications, adjust toe to meet the preferred specification setting.
Refer to TOE within this wheel alignment service
procedure.
TOE
1. Center the steering wheel and lock it in place using a steering wheel clamp.
NOTE: When performing the toe setting procedure, make sure the rear toe is set to the preferred
specification before setting the front toe to the preferred specification.
REAR TOE
1. Loosen the nuts on the left and right rear lateral link attaching bolts at the rear crossmember as
necessary to allow rotation of the rear toe
adjustment cams.
CAUTION: When adjusting rear toe, the notches on the toe adjustment cams are not to be facing
down. The notches in the adjustment cams are only to be facing up or toward one side.
2. Rotate each toe adjustment cam until the preferred rear toe specification is obtained. 3. While
holding the toe adjustment cams from turning, tighten the attaching bolt nuts. This will securely hold
the adjustment cams in position.
Tighten the attaching bolt nuts to a torque of 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs.).
4. Proceed to FRONT TOE to set the front toe.
FRONT TOE
CAUTION: Do not twist the inner tie rod-to-steering gear rubber boots while turning the inner tie rod
during the front toe adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1085
1. Loosen the tie rod adjusting jam nuts. Grasp each inner tie rod at its hex and rotate it one way or
the other until the front wheel toe is set to the
preferred specification.
2. Tighten tie rod adjusting jam nuts to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 3. Make sure the inner tie
rod-to-steering gear rubber boots are not twisted. If twisted, loosen the boot clamp at the inner tie
rod and move the boot as
necessary.
4. Remove steering wheel clamp. 5. Remove the alignment equipment. 6. Road test the vehicle to
verify the steering wheel is straight and the vehicle does not pull or wander.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Alignment >
Page 1086
Alignment: Service and Repair Curb Height Measurement
MEASUREMENT
The wheel alignment is to be checked and all alignment adjustments made with the vehicle at its
required curb height specification.
Vehicle height is to be checked with the vehicle on a flat, level surface, preferably a vehicle
alignment rack. The tires are to be inflated to the recommended pressure. All tires are to be the
same size as standard equipment. Vehicle height is checked with the fuel tank full of fuel, and no
passenger or luggage compartment load.
Vehicle height is not adjustable. If the measurement is not within specifications, inspect the vehicle
for bent or weak suspension components. Compare the parts tag on the suspect coil spring(s) to
the parts book and the vehicle sales code, checking for a match. Once removed from the vehicle,
compare the coil spring height to a correct new or known good coil spring. The heights should vary
if the suspect spring is weak.
NOTE: Prior to reading the curb height measurement, the front an rear of the vehicle should be
jounced. Induce jounce by grasping the center of the rear, then front bumper (or fascia) and
jouncing the vehicle an equal number of times. Release the bumper at the bottom of the jounce
cycle.
1. Measure from the inboard edge of the wheel opening fender lip directly above the wheel center
(spindle), to the floor or alignment rack surface. 2. When measuring, maximum left-to-right
differential is not to exceed 10 mm (0.39 inch). 3. Compare the measurements to specifications
listed in the CURB HEIGHT SPECIFICATIONS chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE ...............................................................................................................................
......................................... 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1091
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1092
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1093
Test 7 - 9
SYMPTOM
CHECKING FUEL DELIVERY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fuel pump relay
- Fuel pressure out of specs
- Restricted fuel supply line
- Fuel pump inlet strainer plugged
- Fuel pump module
- Fuel delivery system operation
- Fuel pump relay fused B+ circuit
- (A141) fuel pump relay output circuit open
- (Z1) fuel pump ground circuit open/high resistance
- Fuel pump module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove 5 screws from air cleaner element box lid. 2. Remove lid from air cleaner box. 3. Pull air
cleaner up and out of air cleaner box.
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element on to throttle body and push towards the throttle body and past lip in
air cleaner box bottom (Fig. 10). 2. Install lid and tighten screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1105
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
Ignition Coll Pack
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 1-3-4-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1109
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches directly to the valve cover.
The 2.0 Liter (122 cu. inch) in-line four cylinder engine is a single over head camshaft with
hydraulic lifters and four valves per cylinder design (Fig. 1). The engine does not have provisions
for a free wheeling valve train. The cylinders are numbered from front of the engine to the rear. The
firing order is 1-3-4-2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
CABLE .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................ RESISTANCE
# 1, # 4 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2970 - 8910 ohms
# 2, # 3 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2360 - 7070 ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1117
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
SPARK PLUG CABLE
Spark Plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer
electrical current from the ignition coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder. The resistive
spark plug cables are of nonmetallic construction. The cables provide suppression of radio
frequency emissions from the ignition system.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil, and spark plugs. Terminals
should be fully seated. The insulators should be in good condition and should fit tightly on the coil,
and spark plugs. Spark plug cables with insulators that are cracked or torn must be replaced.
Clean Spark Plug cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry. Check for brittle or cracked insulation. The spark plug cables and spark plug boots are made
from high temperature silicone materials. All spark plug cable leads are properly identified with
cylinder numbers. The inside of most the spark plug boot is coated with a special high temperature
silicone grease for greater sealing and to minimize boot bonding to the spark plug insulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1118
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of
the spark plug insulator, turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
INSTALLATION
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube, then connect the other end to coil pack.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUG TUBE
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Using locking pliers, remove the tube from the cylinder head. Discard old tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean area around spark plug with Mopar parts cleaner or equivalent. 2. Apply Mopar Stud and
Bearing Mount or equivalent to a new tube approximately 1 mm (0.039 inch) from the end in a 3
mm (0.118 inch) wide
area.
3. Install sealer end of tube into the cylinder head. Then carefully install the tube using a hardwood
block and mallet until the tube is seated into the
bottom of the bore.
4. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube
Seal - Valve Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The spark plug tube seals are located in the cylinder head cover. These seals are pressed into the
cylinder head cover to seal the outside perimeter of the spark plug tubes. If these seals show signs
of hardness and/or cracking, they should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube
Seal - Valve Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1126
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Using an appropriate tool, carefully remove spark plug tube
seals. Care should be taken not to damage cylinder head cover sealing surfaces.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean all sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Position seal with the concave side facing the installation tool.
2. Install seals using Special Tool MB-998306. Only hand pressure on tool is needed to install new
seals. 3. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure 170-225 psi
Max. Variation Between Cylinders 25 percent
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1130
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the PDC. 5. Be sure throttle blade is fully open
during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gauge adaptor Special Tool 8116 or the
equivalent, into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Connect the 0-500 psi (Blue)
pressure transducer (Special Tool CH7059) with cable adaptors to the DRB III.
7. Crank engine until maximum pressure is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder
pressure. 8. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 9. Compression should not be
less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder.
10. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression
test. 11. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second
compression test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates that this vehicle has hydraulic lifters or adjusters and therefore does
not require adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Specifications
Timing Belt: Specifications
Timing Belt Replacement Interval
On 2000-02 Neon models, replace every 105,000 miles or 84 months in normal service, or every
105,000 miles in severe service.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Installation
With Mechanical Tensioner
TIMING BELT (WITH MECHANICAL TENSIONER)
1. Set crankshaft sprocket to TDC by aligning the sprocket with the arrow on the oil pump housing,
then back off to 3 notches before TDC (Fig.
178).
2. Set camshaft to TDC by aligning mark on sprocket with the arrow on the rear timing belt cover
(Fig. 179).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1139
3. Move crankshaft to 1/2 mark before TDC (Fig. 180) for belt installation. 4. Install the timing belt.
Starting at the crankshaft, go around the water pump sprocket, then around the camshaft sprocket,
and finally route the back
side of the timing belt around the timing belt tensioner pulley
5. Move crankshaft sprocket to TDC to take up belt slack.
6. Insert a 6 mm Allen wrench into the hexagon opening located on the top plate of the belt
tensioner pulley Rotate the top plate
COUNTERCLOCKWISE. The tensioner pulley will move against the belt and the tensioner setting
notch will eventually start to move clockwise. Watching the movement of the setting notch, continue
rotating the top plate counterclockwise until the setting notch is aligned with the spring tang (Fig.
181). Using the allen wrench to prevent the top plate from moving, torque the tensioner lock nut to
30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.). Setting notch and spring tang should remain aligned after lock nut is torqued.
7. Remove allen wrench and torque wrench.
NOTE: Repositioning the crankshaft to the TDC position must be done only during the
CLOCKWISE rotation movement. If TDC is missed, rotate a further two revolutions until TDC is
achieved. DO NOT rotate crankshaft counterclockwise as this will make verification of proper
tensioner setting impossible.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1140
8. Rotate the crankshaft CLOCKWISE two complete revolutions manually for seating of the belt,
until the crankshaft is repositioned at the TDC
position. Verify that the camshaft and crankshaft timing marks are in proper position (Fig. 183).
9. Check if the spring tang is within the tolerance window (Fig. 182). If the spring tang is within the
tolerance window, the installation process is
complete and nothing further is required. If the spring tang is not within the tolerance window,
repeat Steps 6 through 8.
10. Install front timing belt cover. 11. Install spark plugs. 12. Perform camshaft and crankshaft
timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB 1116 scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located
in the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
With Hydraulic Tensioner
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1141
TIMING BELT (WITH HYDRAULIC TENSIONER)
1. Set crankshaft sprocket to TDC by aligning the sprocket with the arrow on the oil pump housing,
then back off to 3 notches before TDC (Fig.
173).
2. Set camshaft to TDC by aligning mark on sprocket with the arrow on the rear of timing belt cover
(Fig. 174).
3. Move crankshaft to 1/2 mark before TDC (Fig. 175) for belt installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1142
4. Install the timing belt. Starting at the crankshaft, go around the water pump sprocket, then
around the camshaft sprocket, and finally route the back
side of the timing belt around the timing belt tensioner pulley
5. Move crankshaft sprocket to TDC to take up belt slack.
6. Re-set the hydraulic tensioner by placing tensioner body in a vise equipped with soft jaws (Fig.
176). Slowly compress the plunger. 7. Compress the plunger until a 1.9 mm (5/64) Allen wrench or
pin can be inserted through the body and the plunger (Fig. 176). 8. Remove hydraulic tensioner
from vise and install on engine. Do not tighten attaching bolts at this time. 9. Using a torque wrench
on the tensioner pulley bolt, apply 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.) of torque against the timing belt.
10. With torque applied to the tensioner pulley/ timing belt, move the tensioner up against the
pulley pivot bracket and tighten tensioner bolts to 31
Nm (23 ft. lbs.). (Fig. 177).
11. Pull the tensioner plunger retaining pin. Pretension is correct when the pin can be removed and
installed into tensioner housing and plunger.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1143
12. Rotate crankshaft 2 revolutions and check the alignment of the timing marks (Fig. 175) and
(Fig. 174). 13. Check belt tension by installing pin into tensioner housing. If pin cannot be
re-installed, repeat belt tension procedure. 14. Install the front timing belt cover. 15. Lower vehicle
and perform camshaft and crankshaft timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB III scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1144
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Removal
With Mechanical Tensioner
TIMING BELT (WITH MECHANICAL TENSIONER)
1. Remove front timing belt cover (Fig. 168). 2. Remove spark plugs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1145
CAUTION: Align camshaft and crankshaft timing marks before removing the timing belt by rotating
the engine CLOCKWISE with the crankshaft (Fig. 183).
3. Loosen timing belt tensioner lock nut (Fig. 169). 4. Insert a 6 mm Allen wrench into the hexagon
opening located on the top plate of the belt tensioner pulley Rotate the top plate CLOCKWISE until
there is enough slack in timing belt to allow for removal (Fig. 169).
5. Remove timing belt.
CAUTION: Do not rotate the camshaft once the timing belt has been removed or damage to valve
components may occur.
With Hydraulic Tensioner
TIMING BELT (WITH HYDRAULIC TENSIONER)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1146
1. Remove front timing belt cover (Fig. 165).
CAUTION: Align camshaft and crankshaft timing marks before removing the timing belt by rotating
the engine with the crankshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Installation >
Page 1147
2. Rotate crankshaft until timing marks are aligned at both the camshaft and crankshaft (Fig. 166).
3. Loosen the timing belt tensioner fasteners (Fig. 166).
CAUTION: DO NOT loosen, tighten, or remove the tensioner pivot bolt (Fig. 167).
4. Remove the timing belt from sprockets.
CAUTION: Do not rotate the camshaft once the timing belt has been removed or damage to valve
components may occur.
5. For timing belt tensioner pulley assembly removal Refer to TIMING BELT TENSIONER &
PULLEY - REMOVAL.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications
Drive Belt: Specifications
Accessory drive belt Belt Tension
Power Steering Pump & A/C Compressor Dynamic Tension
Generator New 135 lbs.
Used 70 lbs.
A belt is considered used after 15 minutes of run-in time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1151
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The accessory drive consist of two Poly-V type drive belts (Fig. 1). One belt drives the generator,
the other drives the power steering pump and air conditioning compressor (if equipped). The power
steering/ air conditioning belt is tensioned by an automatically controlled belt tensioner. The
generator belt is manually tensioned using an adjusting bolt and a locking nut.
OPERATION
The accessory drive belts form the link between the engine crankshaft and the engine driven
accessories.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1152
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt
Drive Belt: Service and Repair A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt
REMOVAL
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
1. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be removed from
power steering pump pulley. Gently, release spring
tension on tensioner.
2. Remove the drive belt (Fig. 3).
CLEANING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1155
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required: ^
Excessive wear
^ Frayed cords
^ Severe glazing Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to
reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are
not (Fig. 6).
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When installing drive belt on the pulleys, make sure that belt is properly routed and all
V-grooves make proper contact with pulley grooves.
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1156
1. Install the drive belt (Fig. 3) over all the pulleys except for the power steering pump pulley
2. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be installed on the
power steering pulley Release spring tension onto
belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1157
3. After belt is installed, inspect belt length indicator marks (Fig. 7). The indicator mark should be
within the minimum belt length and maximum belt
length marks. On a new belt, the indicator mark should align approximately with the nominal belt
length mark.
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1158
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Alternator/Generator Belt
REMOVAL GENERATOR BELT
1. Remove power steering pump/air conditioning compressor drive belt.
2. Loosen generator locking nut (Fig. 4). 3. Raise vehicle on hoist.
4. Remove accessory drive belt splash shield (Fig. 5). 5. Loosen generator pivot bolt (Fig. 4). 6.
Loosen generator adjusting bolt until generator belt can be removed (Fig. 4). 7. Remove generator
belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1159
CLEANING
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required: ^
Excessive wear
^ Frayed cords
^ Severe glazing Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to
reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are
not (Fig. 6).
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When installing drive belt on the pulleys, make sure that belt is properly routed and all
V-grooves make proper contact with pulley grooves.
GENERATOR BELT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1160
1. Install belt around pulleys (Fig. 3).
2. Adjust belt tension by tightening adjusting bolt (Fig. 4). Adjust belt to specification shown in
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART. 3. Check belt tension using Special Tool 8371 Belt Tension
Gauge Adapter, and the DRB III using the following procedures:
WARNING: DO NOT CHECK BELT TENSION WITH ENGINE RUNNING.
a. Connect 8371 to the DRB III following the instructions provided with tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1161
b. Place end of microphone probe approximately 2.54 cm (1 inch) from belt at one of the belt center
span locations shown in (Fig. 8). c. Pluck the belt a minimum of 3 times. (Use your finger or other
suitable tool) d. The frequency of the belt in hertz (Hz) will display on DRB III screen. e. Adjust belt
to obtain proper frequency (tension).
4. Tighten generator pivot bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 4).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1162
5. Install accessory drive belt splash shield (Fig. 5). 6. Lower vehicle.
7. Tighten generator locking nut to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 4). 8. Install power steering pump/air
conditioning compressor drive belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1163
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1164
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Power Steering Belt
REMOVAL
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
1. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be removed from
power steering pump pulley. Gently, release spring
tension on tensioner.
2. Remove the drive belt (Fig. 3).
CLEANING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1165
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required: ^
Excessive wear
^ Frayed cords
^ Severe glazing Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to
reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are
not (Fig. 6).
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When installing drive belt on the pulleys, make sure that belt is properly routed and all
V-grooves make proper contact with pulley grooves.
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1166
1. Install the drive belt (Fig. 3) over all the pulleys except for the power steering pump pulley
2. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be installed on the
power steering pulley Release spring tension onto
belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor /
Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1167
3. After belt is installed, inspect belt length indicator marks (Fig. 7). The indicator mark should be
within the minimum belt length and maximum belt
length marks. On a new belt, the indicator mark should align approximately with the nominal belt
length mark.
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove 5 screws from air cleaner element box lid. 2. Remove lid from air cleaner box. 3. Pull air
cleaner up and out of air cleaner box.
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element on to throttle body and push towards the throttle body and past lip in
air cleaner box bottom (Fig. 10). 2. Install lid and tighten screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Application and ID
Cabin Air Filter: Application and ID
This vehicle is not equipped with a cabin air filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
should be used. A filter change should be made at
the time of the transmission oil change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be
cleaned with a clean, dry cloth. If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter
should be changed.
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED) 1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Place a drain container
with a large opening, under transaxle oil pan. 2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to
break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then remove the oil pan.
3. Install a new filter and O-ring on bottom of the valve body (Fig. 182). 4. Clean the oil pan and
magnet. Reinstall pan using new Mopar Silicone Adhesive sealant. Tighten oil pan bolts to 19 Nm
(165 in. lbs.). 5. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
through the dipstick opening. 6. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with
parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
7. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
8. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for the
proper fluid fill procedure.
9. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the dipstick
opening.
DIPSTICK TUBE FLUID SUCTION METHOD (ALTERNATIVE) 1. When performing the fluid
suction method, make sure the transaxle is at full operating temperature. 2. To perform the dipstick
tube fluid suction method, use a suitable fluid suction device (Vacula or equivalent).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1179
3. Insert the fluid suction line into the dipstick tube.
NOTE: Verify that the suction line is inserted to the lowest point of the transaxle oil pan. This will
ensure complete evacuation of the fluid in the pan.
4. Follow the manufacturers recommended procedure and evacuate the fluid from the transaxle. 5.
Remove the suction line from the dipstick tube. 6. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid) Type 9602 through the dipstick opening. 7. Start engine and allow to idle for at
least one minute. Then, with parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily
to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
8. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
9. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
10. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service
Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service
Precautions > Page 1184
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Pump Pickup Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Fuel Pump Pickup Filter: Service and Repair
INLET FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Fig.28
2. Using a thin straight blade screwdriver, pry back the locking tabs on fuel pump reservoir and
remove the strainer (Fig. 28). 3. Remove strainer O-ring from the fuel pump reservoir body. 4.
Remove any contaminants in the fuel tank by washing the inside of the fuel tank.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the strainer O-ring with clean engine oil. 2. Insert strainer O-ring into outlet of strainer
so that it sits evenly on the step inside the outlet. 3. Push strainer onto the inlet of the fuel pump
reservoir body. Make sure the locking tabs on the reservoir body lock over the locking tangs on the
strainer.
4. Install fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Filter: Specifications
Oil Filter 15 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1191
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
OIL FILTER
REMOVAL
CAUTION: When servicing the oil filter (Fig. 116), avoid deforming the filter. Use an appropriate oil
filter removing tool. Position filter wrench strap close the seam at the base of the filter. The oil filter
seam that joins the can to the base, is reinforced by the base plate.
1. Turn filter counterclockwise to remove (Fig. 116).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean and check the filter mounting surface. The surface must be smooth, flat and free of debris
or old pieces of rubber. 2. Lubricate new filter gasket. 3. Screw filter on until gasket contacts base
(Fig. 116). Tighten to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service Precautions
Refrigerant Filter: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THE OPERATION.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Page 1195
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the left side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
1. Evacuate and recover the refrigerant.
Fig.30 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Disconnect liquid line from filter/drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line on suction line assembly from
filter/drier. 4. Pull filter/drier out of rubber grommet. 5. Remove the filter/drier.
INSTALLATION
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the right side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
NOTE: Replace all A/C line seals from disassembled components. Failure to replace seals could
result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Install the filter/drier in the rubber grommet. 2. Connect the liquid line to the filter/drier.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Page 1196
3. Connect the liquid line on the suction line assembly to the filter/drier. 4. Evacuate the refrigerant
system. 5. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Line/Hose: Specifications
Water Pump Inlet Tube to Engine Block-Bolts 105 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1201
Coolant Line/Hose: Description and Operation
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
DESCRIPTION
The water pump inlet tube connects the water pump housing to the radiator lower hose and heater
return hose. This plastic tube is sealed by an O-ring and held in place by fasteners to the block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Supply/Return Tubes
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Heater Supply/Return Tubes
HEATER SUPPLY RETURN TUBES
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the intake manifold to replace heater supply/return tubes.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. Disconnect positive battery cable. Remove battery. 2. Raise
vehicle on hoist. 3. Drain cooling system.
4. Remove hose clamp from heater return tube located near starter. Disconnect hose from tube. 5.
Lower vehicle 6. Remove air cleaner housing and throttle body to intake manifold hose. 7.
Disconnect PCV vacuum hose at intake manifold. 8. Remove hose clamp from heater supply tube
located near thermostat housing. Disconnect hose from tube. 9. Remove two heater hose clamps
and disconnect heater hoses near battery.
10. Unclip wiring harness from heater tube assembly 11. Remove transmission dipstick tube and
place an appropriate plug into hole to prevent coolant from entering transmission. 12. Remove
fasteners attaching heater tube assembly to cylinder head and engine block. 13. Remove heater
tube assembly.
NOTE: After heater tube assembly is removed, the short hoses connecting the tubes to the
thermostat housing and water pump inlet tube can be replaced at this time.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect all hoses that connect to heater tubes. Replace if necessary. 2. Position heater tube
assembly near it's mounting location. 3. Connect hoses at water pump inlet tube and thermostat
housing. Ensure clamps are positioned properly to seal hoses and avoid contact with engine
components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Supply/Return Tubes > Page 1204
4. Install fasteners attaching heater tube assembly to cylinder head and engine block.
NOTE: Before installing transmission dipstick tube clean any residual coolant from around the area
where plug was placed.
5. Remove plug from transmission dipstick tube mounting hole. Install transmission dipstick tube. 6.
Reattach wiring harness to heater tube assembly. 7. Connect two heater hoses to heater tubes
near battery. Ensure clamps are positioned properly to seal hoses and avoid contact with engine
components.
8. Connect PCV vacuum hose to intake manifold. 9. Install air cleaner housing and throttle body to
intake manifold hose.
10. Raise vehicle on hoist. 11. Close radiator draincock. 12. Lower vehicle 13. Install battery.
Connect positive battery cable. Connect negative battery cable. 14. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Supply/Return Tubes > Page 1205
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Water Pump Inlet Tube
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
REMOVAL
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the radiator upper hose to access the hose connections at
the inlet tube. 3. Remove the intake manifold.
CAUTION: Do not use any sharp tools to remove hoses from inlet tube. This may cause the tube to
leak.
4. Remove the radiator lower hose and heater hose from the inlet tube. 5. Remove the lower intake
manifold support bracket. 6. Remove the inlet tube to the block fasteners. 7. Rotate tube while
removing the tube from the engine block.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring for damage before installing the tube into the cylinder block. Replace O-ring
as necessary. 2. Lubricate O-ring with Mopar Dielectric Grease and install inlet tube into the
cylinder block opening. 3. Install inlet tube fasteners and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Install
intake manifold lower support bracket fasteners and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 5. Connect the
radiator lower hose and heater hose to inlet tube. 6. Install the intake manifold. 7. Install the
radiator upper hose. 8. Fill the cooling system. 9. Pressure test cooling system and check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service Precautions
Heater Hose: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess pressure.
The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
- When installing hoses to heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive pressure.
The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Inlet Hose Replacement
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose Replacement
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement - LHD
HEATER INLET HOSE - LHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.54 Heater Hose Assembly - LHD 2.0L (Typical 2.4L)
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove clamps at end of heater hose to be
removed. 3. Carefully rotate hose back and forth while pulling away from connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Using spring tension clamp pliers, install the hose ends into position. 2. Refill the cooling system.
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement - RHD
HEATER INLET HOSE - RHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 1211
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.46 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove clamps at end of heater hose to be
removed 3. Carefully rotate hose back and forth while pulling away from connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Using spring tension clamp pliers, install the hose ends into position. 2. Refill the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 1212
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Return Hose Replacement
Heater Return Hose Replacement - LHD
HEATER RETURN HOSE - LHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from the heater core inlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.54 Heater Hose Assembly - LHD 2.0L (Typical 2.4L)
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove the clamps at the end of the heater
hoses to be removed. 3. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pulling away from the
connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When installing hoses to heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
1. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pushing the hose onto the connector nipple. 2.
Using spring tension pliers, install the clamps at the end of the heater hose being installed. 3. Refill
the cooling system.
Heater Return Hose Replacement - RHD
HEATER RETURN HOSE - RHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from the heater core inlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heater
Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 1213
leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.46 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove the clamps at the end of the heater
hoses to be removed. 3. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pulling away from the
connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pushing the hose onto the connector nipple. 2.
Using spring tension pliers, install the clamps at the end of the heater hose being installed. 3. Refill
the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Hose/Line HVAC: Specifications
A/C Line Retainer Bolt
..................................................................................................................................................... 23
Nm (16.9 ft. lbs) (203 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Technician Safety Information
Hose/Line HVAC: Technician Safety Information
WARNING:
- THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY EMPTY BEFORE PROCEEDING
WITH THE OPERATION.
- REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT BEFORE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING OPERATION.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Technician Safety Information > Page 1219
Hose/Line HVAC: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- The use of correct wrenches when making connections is very important. Improper wrenches or
improper use of wrenches can damage the fittings.
- The internal parts of the A/C system will remain stable as long as moisture-free refrigerant and
refrigerant oil is used. Abnormal amounts of dirt, moisture or air can upset the chemical stability.
This may cause operational troubles or even serious damage if present in more than very small
quantities.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Discharge Hose/Line
A/C Discharge Line - LHD
Fig.43 A/C Compressor Lines
The discharge line is the line that goes from the compressor to the condenser. It has no
serviceable parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must
be replaced as an assembly.
A/C Discharge Line - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1222
Fig.44 A/C Compressor Lines
The discharge line is the line that goes from the compressor to the condenser. It has no
serviceable parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must
be replaced as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1223
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Liquid Hose/Line
Liquid Line - LHD
The liquid line is the line that goes from the condenser to the receiver-drier. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced
as an assembly.
Liquid Line - RHD
The liquid line is the line that goes from the condenser to the receiver-drier. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced
as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1224
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Suction Hose/Line
Suction Line - LHD
The suction line is the large line that connects to the expansion valve and goes to the compressor.
It also has a small line that goes to the filter/drier. The suction line uses a gasket on the expansion
valve side and rubber O-rings on all other connections.
There are no serviceable parts on the suction line other than the rubber O-rings and expansion
valve gasket. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an assembly.
The refrigerant lines used for this vehicle are common between the two optional engines in order to
reduce complexity. The following refrigerant lines are available for service replacement on this
vehicle:
Fig.60 A/C Compressor Lines - LHD
- Discharge line - The discharge line is a flexible hose type line that is connected from the
discharge port of the compressor to the inlet (upper fitting) of the condenser. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber O-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the discharge
line is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
- Liquid line - The liquid line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the outlet (lower
fitting) of the condenser and the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly.
The liquid line also contains the variable orifice valve. It has no serviceable parts except the rubber
O-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the liquid line or the variable orifice valve
are damaged or faulty, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
- Suction line - The suction line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly and the suction port of the compressor. It
has no serviceable parts except the rubber O-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line.
If the suction line is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1225
Fig.61 A/C Service Ports - (Typical)
- Suction and liquid line assembly - The suction and liquid line assembly is a formed tubing type
line assembly that includes the mid-line connector block, a connector block for the evaporator, inlet
and outlet line fittings for the accumulator and both A/C service ports. The A/C service port caps,
the A/C service port valve cores, the gasket used to seal the connector block at the evaporator and
the rubber O-ring seals for the line fittings at the accumulator are all available for service
replacement. If any other part of the suction and liquid line assembly is damaged or faulty, the
assembly must be replaced.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant line
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
Suction Line - RHD
The suction line is the large line that connects to the expansion valve and goes to the compressor.
It also has a small line that goes to the filter/drier. The suction line uses a gasket on the expansion
valve side and rubber O-rings on all other connections.
There are no serviceable parts on the suction line other than the rubber O-rings and expansion
valve gasket. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an assembly.
The refrigerant lines used for this vehicle are common between the two optional engines in order to
reduce complexity. The following refrigerant lines are available for service replacement on this
vehicle:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1226
Fig.52 A/C Refrigerant Lines - Compressor
- Discharge line - The discharge line is a flexible hose type line that is connected from the
discharge port of the compressor to the inlet (upper fitting) of the condenser. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber 0-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the discharge line
is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
- Liquid line - The liquid line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the outlet (lower
fitting) of the condenser and the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly.
The liquid line also contains the variable orifice valve. It has no serviceable parts except the rubber
0-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the liquid line or the variable orifice valve
are damaged or faulty, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
- Suction line - The suction line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly and the suction port of the compressor. It
has no serviceable parts except the rubber 0-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line.
If the suction line is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1227
Fig.53 A/C Service Ports - LHD Shown (Typical RHD)
- Suction and liquid line assembly - The suction and liquid line assembly is a formed tubing type
line assembly that includes the mid-line connector block, a connector block for the evaporator, inlet
and outlet line fittings for the accumulator and both A/C service ports. The A/C service port caps,
the A/C service port valve cores, the gasket used to seal the connector block at the evaporator and
the rubber 0-ring seals for the line fittings at the accumulator are all available for service
replacement. If any other part of the suction and liquid line assembly is damaged or faulty, the
assembly must be replaced.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant line
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement
A/C Discharge Line Replacement - LHD
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY
PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system
Fig.44 Discharge Line
2. From the top side of the vehicle, remove line at compressor. 3. From the bottom side of the
vehicle, remove line at condenser.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY
PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Position the A/C discharge line in the vehicle and install the condenser end. Tighten the
connections to 12 Nm (108 in. lbs.) 2. Lower the vehicle and install the compressor end of the
discharge line. Tighten the connections to 12 Nm ( 108 in. lbs.) 3. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
4. Recharge the A/C system.
A/C Discharge Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY
PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1230
Fig.45 High Pressure Cut Out Switch Location
2. From the top side of the vehicle, remove line at compressor. 3. From the bottom side of the
vehicle, remove line at condenser.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the A/C discharge line in the vehicle and install the condenser end. Tighten the
connections to 12 Nm (108 in. lbs.) 2. Lower the vehicle and install the compressor end of the
discharge line. Tighten the connections to 12 Nm ( 108 in. lbs.) 3. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
4. Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1231
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Hose/Line Replacement
Liquid Line Replacement - LHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY EMPTY BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system 2.
Disconnect liquid line at drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line at condenser. 4. Remove the liquid line.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replacement of ale line seals is required anytime connections are opened. Failure to
replace seals could result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Connect the liquid line at the drier. 2. Connect the liquid line at the condenser. 3. Evacuate the
A/C system. 4. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Liquid Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY EMPTY BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system. 2.
Disconnect liquid line at drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line at condenser. 4. Remove the liquid line.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replacement of a/c line seals is required anytime connections are opened. Failure to
replace seals could result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Connect the liquid line at the drier. 2. Connect the liquid line at the condenser. 3. Evacuate the
A/C system. 4. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1232
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Suction and Liquid Hose/Line Replacement
Suction and Liquid Line Replacement - LHD
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT OF THIS GROUP
BEFORE PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. If the vehicle is so equipped, relocate the vehicle speed control servo as
necessary to access the accumulator. Refer to Vehicle Speed Control
System for the proper procedures.
Fig.64 A/C Accumulator And Low Pressure Switch
4. Remove the nut that secures the liquid line fitting (outboard fitting) to the mid-line connector
block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 5. Disconnect the liquid line fitting from the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 6. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line and discard. 7. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened
mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. 8. Remove
the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid
line assembly. 9. Disconnect the suction line fitting from the mid-line connector block of the suction
and liquid line assembly.
10. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the refrigerant line fitting of the suction line and discard.
11. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened mid-line connector block suction line port and the
refrigerant line fitting of the suction line. 12. Remove the two screws that secure the two refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector block inlet
and outlet ports.
13. Disconnect the two refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly from the
accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports. 14. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly and discard. 15. Install plugs in, or
tape over the opened accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the refrigerant line
fittings of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
16. Remove the two screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block to the evaporator. 17. Disconnect the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block from the evaporator. 18. Remove the gasket from the suction and liquid line assembly
evaporator connector block and discard. 19. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened suction and
liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the evaporator inlet and outlet
ports.
20. Remove the suction and liquid line assembly from the engine compartment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1233
INSTALLATION
1. Position the suction and liquid line assembly into the engine compartment. 2. Remove the tape
or plugs from the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the
evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 3. Align the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block and a new gasket to the evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 4. Install and tighten the two
screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block to the
evaporator. Tighten the upper
screw to 11.3 Nm (100 in. lbs.) first, then tighten the lower screw.
5. Remove the tape or plugs from the accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line
assembly.
6. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them on the refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly.
Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
7. Reconnect the refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator
connector block inlet and outlet ports. 8. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the two
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector
block inlet and outlet ports. Tighten the screws to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
9. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block suction line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the suction line.
10. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the refrigerant line
fitting of the suction line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
11. Reconnect the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block suction line port of the suction
and liquid line assembly. 12. Install and tighten the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the
mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the
nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
13. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the liquid line. 14. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and
install it on the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
15. Reconnect the liquid line fitting to the mid-line connector block liquid line port of the suction and
liquid line assembly. 16. Install and tighten the nut that secures the liquid line fitting to the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the nut
to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
17. If the vehicle is so equipped, reinstall the vehicle speed control servo. Refer to Vehicle Speed
Control System for the proper procedures. 18. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 19. Evacuate
the refrigerant system. Refer to Refrigerant System Evacuate in this group for the proper
procedures. 20. Charge the refrigerant system. Refer to Refrigerant System Charge in this group
for the proper procedures.
Suction and Liquid Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT OF THIS GROUP
BEFORE PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. If the vehicle is so equipped, relocate the vehicle speed control servo as
necessary to access the accumulator. Refer to Vehicle Speed Control
System for the proper procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1234
Fig.56 A/C Refrigerant Lines - Accumulator/Evaporator - LHD (Typical - RHD)
4. Remove the nut that secures the liquid line fitting (outboard fitting) to the mid-line connector
block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 5. Disconnect the liquid line fitting from the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 6. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line and discard. 7. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened
mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. 8. Remove
the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid
line assembly. 9. Disconnect the suction line fitting from the mid-line connector block of the suction
and liquid line assembly.
10. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the refrigerant line fitting of the suction line and discard.
11. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened mid-line connector block suction line port and the
refrigerant line fitting of the suction line. 12. Remove the two screws that secure the two refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector block inlet
and outlet ports.
13. Disconnect the two refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly from the
accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports. 14. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly and discard. 15. Install plugs in, or
tape over the opened accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the refrigerant line
fittings of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
16. Remove the two screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block to the evaporator. 17. Disconnect the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block from the evaporator. 18. Remove the gasket from the suction and liquid line assembly
evaporator connector block and discard. 19. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened suction and
liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the evaporator inlet and outlet
ports.
20. Remove the suction and liquid line assembly from the engine compartment.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the suction and liquid line assembly into the engine compartment. 2. Remove the tape
or plugs from the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the
evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 3. Align the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block and a new gasket to the evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 4. Install and tighten the two
screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block to the
evaporator. Tighten the upper
screw to 11.3 Nm (100 in. lbs.) first, then tighten the lower screw.
5. Remove the tape or plugs from the receiver-drier connector block inlet and outlet ports and the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
6. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them on the refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly.
Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
7. Reconnect the refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the receiver-drier
connector block inlet and outlet ports. 8. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the two
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the receiver-drier connector
block inlet and outlet ports. Tighten the screws to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
9. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block suction line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the suction line.
10. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the refrigerant line
fitting of the suction line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
11. Reconnect the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block suction line port of the suction
and liquid line assembly. 12. Install and tighten the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the
mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1235
nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
13. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the liquid line. 14. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and
install it on the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
15. Reconnect the liquid line fitting to the mid-line connector block liquid line port of the suction and
liquid line assembly. 16. Install and tighten the nut that secures the liquid line fitting to the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the nut
to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
17. If the vehicle is so equipped, reinstall the vehicle speed control servo. Refer to Vehicle Speed
Control System for the proper procedures. 18. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 19. Evacuate
the refrigerant system. 20. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1236
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Suction Hose/Line Replacement
Suction Line Replacement - LHD
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY PART OF
THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEMS.
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system.
Fig.62 A/C Compressor Lines - LHD
2. Remove line at the accumulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1237
Fig.63 A/C Compressor Lines - LHD
3. Remove line at the compressor.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY PART OF
THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEMS.
1. Install the suction line at the compressor. 2. Install the suction line at the expansion valve. 3.
Position the expansion valve and install the retaining bolt. 4. Evacuate the A/C system. 5.
Recharge the refrigerant system.
Suction Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY PART OF
THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEMS.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1238
Fig.54 Expansion Valve
2. Remove retaining bolt at expansion valve. 3. Remove line at the expansion valve.
Fig.55 Accumulator And Lines - LHD (Typical - RHD)
4. Remove line at the compressor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the suction line at the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1239
2. Install the suction line at the expansion valve. 3. Position the expansion valve and install the
retaining bolt. 4. Evacuate the A/C system. 5. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Hose Tube Nuts ...................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) Return Hose Bracket Bolt
.................................................................................................................................................. 28 Nm
(21 ft. lbs., 250 inch lbs.) Pressure Hose Bracket Bolt ........................................................................
.............................................................................................. 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hose - Pressure
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Hose - Pressure
HOSE POWER STEERING PRESSURE
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Service Precautions.
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Raise the vehicle.
Hoses And Cooler At LHD Gear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 1245
Hoses And Cooler At RHD Gear
3. Back out the tube nut securing the power steering fluid pressure hose to the gear. 4. LHD only Open the tube clamp on the right side of the gear and release the tube from the clamp. 5. Remove
the pressure hose tube from the gear.
RHD Pressure Hose At Engine
6. RHD only - Remove the bolt securing the pressure hose bracket to the engine. 7. Lower the
vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 1246
Power Steering Hoses At Pump
8. Remove the bolt securing the hose routing bracket to the engine mount dragon head. Remove
the hose from the bracket. 9. Un-thread the tube nut securing the power steering pressure hose to
the power steering pump.
10. Remove the power steering pressure hose.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the power steering pressure hose into the engine compartment from the top. First, guide
the pump end of the hose under the pump, then
route the rest of the hose along the right side of the engine. Guide the gear end of the hose down
behind the engine towards the power steering gear.
2. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering hose end and the power steering
pump port. Replace the used O-ring with new.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
3. Install the power steering pressure hose into the outlet fitting on the bottom of the power steering
pump. 4. Thread the tube nut into the pump outlet fitting and tighten it to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft.
lbs.). 5. Install the hose into the hose routing bracket aligning it as shown and attach the bracket to
the engine mount dragon head along with the ground
strap. Tighten the screw to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.).
6. Raise the vehicle.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid hoses must remain away from the exhaust system, vehicle
components, and unfriendly surfaces that can cause possible damage to the power steering hoses.
7. RHD only - Install the bolt attaching the power steering fluid pressure hose routing clamp to the
engine. Tighten the bolt to a torque of 61 Nm (45
ft. lbs.).
8. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering hose end and the power steering
gear port. Replace the used O-ring with new.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
9. Attach the power steering fluid pressure hose to the port on the power steering gear. Start the
tube nut threads into the gear. Do not completely
tighten at this time.
10. LHD only - Open the tube clamp on the right side of the gear and insert the pressure hose tube.
Close the clamp. 11. Tighten the pressure hose tube nut at the gear to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft.
lbs.). 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION
procedure. 14. Check for leaks at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 1247
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Hose - Return
HOSE POWER STEERING RETURN
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Service Precautions.
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Raise the vehicle.
Hoses And Cooler At LHD Gear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 1248
Hoses And Cooler At RHD Gear
3. Remove the hose clamp securing the return hose to the power steering cooler tube. Slide the
hose off the end of the cooler tube. 4. Lower the vehicle.
Power Steering Hoses At Pump
5. Remove the hose clamp securing the return hose to the power steering fluid reservoir. Slide the
hose off the end of the reservoir fitting. 6. Remove the bolt securing the hose routing bracket to the
engine mount dragon head. Remove the hose from the bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 1249
INSTALLATION
1. Slide a hose clamp onto the power steering pump end of the hose far enough to clear the fitting
on the power steering fluid reservoir once the hose
is installed.
2. Install the power steering return hose into the engine compartment from the top. First, guide the
pump end of the hose onto the fitting of the power
steering pump fluid reservoir, then route the rest of the hose along the right side of the engine.
Guide the remaining end of the hose down behind the engine towards the power steering gear.
3. Expand the hose clamp and slide it onto the fluid reservoir fitting. Secure the clamp once it is
past the bead formed into the fluid reservoir fitting. 4. Install the hose into the hose routing bracket
aligning it as shown and attach the bracket to the engine mount dragon head along with the ground
strap. Tighten the screw to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.).
5. Raise the vehicle.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid hoses must remain away from the exhaust system, vehicle
components, and unfriendly surfaces that can cause possible damage to the power steering hoses.
6. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering hose end and the power steering fluid
cooler tube. 7. Install a hose clamp onto the end of the hose far enough to clear the fitting on the
cooler once the hose is installed. 8. Slide the hose onto the end of the cooler tube. Install the hose
clamp past the bead formed into the cooler tube and secure in place. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION procedure. 11. Check for leaks
at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Brake Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Bring the fluid level up to the requirements described on the side of the brake reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1255
Brake Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Specification ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. DOT 3
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE J1703
NOTE: The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of
the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission
fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1256
Brake Fluid: Service Precautions
WARNING:
Use of a brake fluid that may have a lower initial boiling point, or is unidentified as to specification,
may result in sudden brake failure during hard prolonged braking. You could have an accident.
CAUTION:
DO not allow a petroleum-base fluid to contaminate the brake fluid. Seal damage may result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1257
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid including:
the master cylinder and reservoir; proportioning valves (non-ABS); caliper seals; wheel cylinder
seals; ABS hydraulic control unit; and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1258
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BRAKE FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
Brake fluid level should be checked a minimum of twice a year.
Master cylinder reservoirs are marked, FULL and MIN, indicating the allowable brake fluid level
range in the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications. Do not use petroleum-based fluid because seal damage in
the brake system will result.
Although there is a range, the preferred level is FULL. If necessary, adjust the brake fluid level to
the FULL mark on the side of the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Capacity Specifications
HYDRAULIC - FLUID
CAUTION: Never use any type of petroleum-based fluid (engine oil, transmission oil, power
steering fluid, etc.) in the clutch hydraulic system. Use of
such fluids will result in master/slave cylinder seal damage, and cause a failure of the hydraulic
clutch release system.
NOTE: The clutch hydraulic system and replacement components are pre-filled, and under normal
operating conditions, additional fluid is not required
for the life of the vehicle.
The fluid required for use in the clutch hydraulic system is brake fluid conforming to DOT 3
specifications and J1703 standards. No other type of fluid is recommended or approved for use in
the clutch hydraulic system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed
container.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1263
Clutch Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
HYDRAULIC - FLUID
CAUTION: Never use any type of petroleum-based fluid (engine oil, transmission oil, power
steering fluid, etc.) in the clutch hydraulic system. Use of
such fluids will result in master/slave cylinder seal damage, and cause a failure of the hydraulic
clutch release system.
NOTE: The clutch hydraulic system and replacement components are pre-filled, and under normal
operating conditions, additional fluid is not required
for the life of the vehicle.
The fluid required for use in the clutch hydraulic system is brake fluid conforming to DOT 3
specifications and J1703 standards. No other type of fluid is recommended or approved for use in
the clutch hydraulic system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed
container.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity
Coolant ................................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 6.2 Liters ( 6.5 qts )
Note: Includes heater and recover/reserve bottle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1268
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769), or the equivalent
ethylene glycol base coolant with hybrid organic corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid
Organic Additive Technology) is recommended.
This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50% Ethylene Glycol
and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F).
If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed
coolant solution.
IMPORTANT: The green coolant MUST NOT BE MIXED with the orange or magenta coolants.
When replacing coolant the complete system flush
must be performed before using the replacement coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1269
Coolant: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
Failure to use proper antifreeze could cause radiator plugging and engine overheating. Do not mix
antifreeze brands or use plain water or alcohol base antifreeze products. Do not use additional rust
inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not be compatible with the radiator coolant and may
plug the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1270
Coolant: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
CAUTION: Use of Propylene Glycol based coolants is not recommended, as they provide less
freeze protection and less corrosion protection. Do not mix coolant types. If coolant other than
Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula or equivalent is added, the mixed coolant
will have a reduced service schedule.
The use of aluminum cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion protection.
Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula or equivalent ethylene glycol based
coolant with corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) is
recommended. This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50%
Ethylene Glycol and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze point of -37 °C (-35 °F). If it loses color
or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed coolant solution.
Mixing of coolants other than specified (nonHOAT), will reduce the 5 year/100,000 mile corrosion
protection.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1271
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CONCENTRATION TESTING
Coolant concentration should be checked when any additional coolant was added to system or
after a coolant drain, flush and refill. The coolant mixture offers optimum engine cooling and
protection against corrosion when mixed to a freeze point of -37 °C (-34 °F) to -46 °C (-50 °F). The
use of a hydrometer or a refractometer can be used to test coolant concentration. A hydrometer will
test the amount of glycol in a mixture by measuring the specific gravity of the mixture. The higher
the concentration of ethylene glycol, the larger the number of balls that will float, and higher the
freeze protection (up to a maximum of 60% by volume glycol). A refractometer (Special Tool 8286)
will test the amount of glycol in a coolant mixture by measuring the amount a beam of light bends
as it passes through the fluid. Some coolant manufactures use other types of glycols into their
coolant formulations. Propylene glycol is the most common new coolant. However, propylene
glycol based coolants do not provide the same freezing protection and corrosion protection and is
not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix types of coolant-corrosion protection will be severely reduced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Differential Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
41TE - Automatic Transaxle
Refer to Transmission Fluid, A/T.
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1276
Differential Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
41TE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Recommended Fluid Type
........................................................................................................................................................
Mopar ATF +4, Type 9602
Recommended Sealer .........................................................................................................................
.......................................... Mopar RTV (MS-GF41)
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1277
Differential Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
41TE - Automatic Transaxle
Refer to Transmission Fluid, A/T.
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1278
Differential Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transaxle
Refer to Transmission Fluid, A/T.
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Differential Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Type ................................................................................................................................. Mopar ATF
+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES
NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard shifting effort, bearing,
gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used. The addition of any fluids to
the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended. An exception to this policy is
the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be
avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
NOTE: The 41TE Automatic and T350 Manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1283
Differential Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Type ................................................................................................................................. Mopar ATF
+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES
NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard shifting effort, bearing,
gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used. The addition of any fluids to
the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended. An exception to this policy is
the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be
avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
NOTE: The 41TE Automatic and T350 Manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 21-014-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-010-06, DATED APRIL 14,
2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES THE ADDITION OF THE ASIAN
WARNER (AW4) TRANSMISSION AND ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2008** (CS) Pacifica
1998-2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2008** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 - **2008** (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - **2008** (HB) Durango
**2008 (HG) Aspen**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1288
2007 - **2008** (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - **2008** (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
**2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro**
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
**2008 (KK) Liberty**
**2008 (L2) 300C (China)**
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - **2008** (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - **2008** (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**2008 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan/Grand Voyager (U.S. & International Markets)**
1997-2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2008** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2008** (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
**1989 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee**
**1989 - 1993 (MJ) Comanche**
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
**AWA (Asian Warner) transmission are now included in this Service Bulletin. ATF+4(R) is
recommended for AW-4 (Asian Warner) transmissions**
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire transmissions, MK/PM
vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1289
Transmission (CVT) and WG vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a
W5J400 or NAG1 transmission (sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE LISTED IN THE NOTE ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4(R) can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4® is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4®
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1290
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF+4 Fluid Usage/Applications
NUMBER: 21-010-06
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: April 14, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-004-04, DATED MARCH
16, 2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1291
2007 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - 2007 (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to AW-4 transmissions, Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire
transmissions, MK/PM vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) and WG
vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a W5J400 or NAG1 transmission
(sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE NOTED ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4 can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4(R) is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 1292
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Automatic Transaxle
Estimated Service Fill ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................. 4.0 Qt (3.8L) Overhaul Fill Capacity w/Torque Converter
Empty .......................................................................................................................................... 8.6
Qt (8.1L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1295
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
41TE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Automatic Transmission Fluid
....................................................................................................................................................
Mopar ATF +4, Type 9602
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1296
Fluid - A/T: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Using a transmission fluid other than ATF +4 may cause deterioration in transmission
shift quality and/or torque converter
shudder. Using a transmission fluid other than ATF +4 will result in more frequent fluid and filter
changes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Diagnosis and Testing
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection Diagnosis and Testing
Effects of Incorrect Fluid Level
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL A low fluid level allows
the pump to take in air along with the fluid.
Air in the fluid will cause fluid pressures to be low and develop slower than normal.
If the transmission is overfilled, the gears churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and
causing the same conditions occurring with a low level.
In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation and varnish build up which interferes
with valve and clutch operation.
Foaming also causes fluid expansion, which can result in fluid overflow from the transmission vent
or fill tube.
Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a leak if inspection is not careful.
Fluid Contamination
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of: *
adding incorrect fluid
* failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level
* engine coolant entering the fluid
* internal failure that generates debris
* overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown)
* failure to reverse flush cooler and lines after repair
* failure to replace contaminated converter after repair
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The transmission cooler and lines should be reverse flushed whenever a malfunction generates
sludge and/or debris. The torque converter should also be replaced at the same time.
Failure to flush the cooler and lines will result in recontamination. Flushing applies to auxiliary
coolers as well. The torque converter should also be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge
and debris. This is necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all
contaminants.
Causes of Burnt Fluid
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of
overheating which has three primary causes.
1. Internal clutch slippage, usually caused by low line pressure, inadequate clutch apply pressure,
or clutch seal failure.
2. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and/or auxiliary cooler. This condition is usually
the result of a faulty or improperly installed
drainback valve, a damaged main cooler, or severe restrictions in the coolers and lines caused by
debris or kinked lines.
3. Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer
towing or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Diagnosis and Testing > Page 1299
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection Fluid Level and Condition Check
41TE - Automatic Transaxle FLUID LEVEL AND CONDITION CHECK
NOTE: Only transmission fluid of the type labeled Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid Type 9602) should be used in this transaxle.
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
The transmission sump has a fluid level indicator (dipstick) to check oil similar to most automatic
transmissions. It is located on the left side of the engine. Be sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick
handle before removing.
The torque converter fills in both the P Park and N Neutral positions. Place the selector lever in P
Park to be sure that the fluid level check is accurate. The engine should be running at idle speed
for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground. At normal operating temperature 82 °C
(180 °F), the fluid level is correct if it is in the HOT region on the oil level indicator (Fig. 180). The
fluid level should be within the COLD region of the dipstick at 27 °C (80 °F) fluid temperature.
FLUID LEVEL CHECK USING DRB
NOTE: Engine and Transaxle should be at normal operating temperature before performing this
procedure.
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Hook up DRB scan tool and select transmission. 3.
Select sensors. 4. Read the transmission temperature value.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Diagnosis and Testing > Page 1300
5. Compare the fluid temperature value with the fluid temperature chart (Fig. 181). 6. Adjust
transmission fluid level shown on the indicator according to the chart. 7. Check transmission for
leaks.
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly. Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transaxle
has too much fluid, the gears churn up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low
fluid level. In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and/or fluid oxidation, and varnishing.
This can interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in
fluid escaping from the transaxle vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
FLUID CONDITION
Along with fluid level, it is important to check the condition of the fluid. When the fluid smells
burned, and is contaminated with metal or friction material particles, a complete transaxle
recondition is probably required. Be sure to examine the fluid on the dipstick closely. If there is any
doubt about its condition, drain out a sample for a double check.
Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid Type 9602) when new is red in color. The ATF is
dyed red so it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or
antifreeze. The red color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is
driven, the ATF will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. This is normal.
ATF +4 also has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be
used to indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fluid
Level and Condition Check
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Level and Condition Check
Procedure for Checking Fluid Level
Check the fluid level while the transmission is at normal operating temperature. this occurs after at
least 15 miles (25 km) of driving. At normal operating temperature, which is approximately 180 °F
(82 °C), the fluid cannot be held comfortably between the fingers.
To check the fluid level properly, the following procedure must be used:
1. The vehicle must be on level ground.
2. The engine should be running at curb idle speed for a minimum of 60 seconds.
3. Fully apply parking brake.
4. Place the gear selector momentarily in each gear position ending with the lever in P (PARK).
5. Remove the dipstick, wipe it clean and reinsert it until seated.
6. Remove the dipstick again and note the fluid level on both sides. The fluid level should be in the
crosshatch area at normal operating temperatures.
If the fluid is low, add as required into the dipstick tube. DO NOT OVERFILL.
Note: If it is necessary to check the transmission below the operating temperature, the fluid level
should be between the two cold (lower) holes on the dipstick with the fluid approximately 80 °F (27
°C) (room temperature). If the fluid level is correctly established at room temperature, it should be
between the HOT (upper) reference holes when the transmission reaches 180 °F (82 °C).
Remember, it is best to check the level at the normal operating temperature.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fluid
Level and Condition Check > Page 1303
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid and Filter Service
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
should be used. A filter change should be made at
the time of the transmission oil change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be
cleaned with a clean, dry cloth. If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter
should be changed.
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED) 1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Place a drain container
with a large opening, under transaxle oil pan. 2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to
break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then remove the oil pan.
3. Install a new filter and O-ring on bottom of the valve body (Fig. 182). 4. Clean the oil pan and
magnet. Reinstall pan using new Mopar Silicone Adhesive sealant. Tighten oil pan bolts to 19 Nm
(165 in. lbs.). 5. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
through the dipstick opening. 6. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with
parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
7. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
8. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for the
proper fluid fill procedure.
9. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the dipstick
opening.
DIPSTICK TUBE FLUID SUCTION METHOD (ALTERNATIVE) 1. When performing the fluid
suction method, make sure the transaxle is at full operating temperature.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fluid
Level and Condition Check > Page 1304
2. To perform the dipstick tube fluid suction method, use a suitable fluid suction device (Vacula or
equivalent). 3. Insert the fluid suction line into the dipstick tube.
NOTE: Verify that the suction line is inserted to the lowest point of the transaxle oil pan. This will
ensure complete evacuation of the fluid in the pan.
4. Follow the manufacturers recommended procedure and evacuate the fluid from the transaxle. 5.
Remove the suction line from the dipstick tube. 6. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid) Type 9602 through the dipstick opening. 7. Start engine and allow to idle for at
least one minute. Then, with parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily
to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
8. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
9. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
10. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
FLUID CAPACITY
NV T350 Manual Transaxle
...................................................................................................................................................... 2.4
- 2.7Liters (2.5 - 2.8 Qt)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1309
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
..................................... Mopar ATF +4 (Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission
Fluid - Type 9602). Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard
shifting effort, bearing, gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used.
The addition of any fluids to the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended.
An exception to this policy is the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of
transmission sealers should be avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Standard
Procedure - Fluid Drain and Fill
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Fluid Drain and Fill
T350 - Manual Transmission STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND FILL
NOTE: The fluid required in this transaxle is Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type
9602).
T350 - Manual Transmission
All T350 transaxles are equipped with a fill plug. The fill plug is located on the left side of the
transaxle differential area (Fig. 92). The fluid level should be within 3/16 inch from the bottom of the
transaxle fill hole (vehicle must be level when checking).
T350 - Manual Transmission
All T350 transaxles are equipped with a drain plug. The drain plug is located on the lower right side
of the transaxle differential housing (Fig. 93). Tighten drain plug to 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
Fill transaxle to capacity. Refer to chart shown. Wipe the outside of the transaxle if any lubricant
spills.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Standard
Procedure - Fluid Drain and Fill > Page 1312
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Fluid Level Check
Fluid Level Check
Check the fluid level by removing the fill plug. The fluid level should be between the bottom of the
fill hole and a point not more than 3/16" (4.76 mm) below the bottom of the hole.
Add fluid, if necessary, to maintain the proper level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 4.3Liters (4.5 Qt)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1317
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil Viscosity
Below 100°F (38°C) .............................................................................................................................
................................................... 5W-30 (Preferred)
Above 0°F (-18°C) ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 10W-30
The proper SAE viscosity grade of engine oil should be selected based on the following
recommendation and be within the operating temperature shown in the engine oil viscosity chart.
Synthetic Engine Oils
There are a growing number of engine oils being promoted as either synthetic or semi-synthetic. If
you choose to use such a product, use only those oils that meet the American Petroleum Institute
(API) and (SAE) viscosity standard. Follow the service schedule that describes your driving type.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1318
Engine Oil: Service Precautions
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil Identification Symbol
For best performance and maximum protection for all engines under all types of operation, select
only engine oils that meet American Petroleum Institute (API) certification and SAE viscosity
standards.
This symbol on the front of an oil container means that the oil has been certified by the American
Petroleum Institute (API) to meet all the lubrication requirements specified by DaimlerChrysler
Corporation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1319
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECK
The best time to check engine oil level is after it has sat overnight, or if the engine has been
running, allow the engine to be shut off for at least 5 minutes before checking oil level. Checking
the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil level reading.
Remove dipstick (Fig. 114) and observe oil level. Add oil only when the level is at or below the ADD
mark (Fig. 115).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1320
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE
Change engine oil at mileage and time intervals described.
WARNING: NEW OR USED ENGINE OIL CAN BE IRRITATING TO THE SKIN. AVOID
PROLONGED OR REPEATED SKIN CONTACT WITH ENGINE OIL. CONTAMINANTS IN USED
ENGINE OIL, CAUSED BY INTERNAL COMBUSTION, CAN BE HAZARDOUS TO YOUR
HEALTH. THOROUGHLY WASH EXPOSED SKIN WITH SOAP AND WATER. DO NOT WASH
SKIN WITH GASOLINE, DIESEL FUEL, THINNER, OR SOLVENTS, HEALTH PROBLEMS CAN
RESULT. DO NOT POLLUTE, DISPOSE OF USED ENGINE OIL PROPERLY. CONTACT YOUR
DEALER OR GOVERNMENT AGENCY FOR LOCATION OF COLLECTION CENTER IN YOUR
AREA.
Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 1. Position the vehicle on a level surface
and turn engine off.
2. Remove oil fill cap (Fig. 114). 3. Raise vehicle on hoist.
4. Place a suitable oil collecting container under oil pan drain plug (Fig. 116).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1321
5. Remove oil pan drain plug and allow oil to drain into collecting container. Inspect drain plug
threads for stretching or other damage. Replace drain
plug and gasket if damaged.
6. Remove oil filter. 7. Install and tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 8. Install new oil
filter. 9. Lower vehicle and fill crankcase with specified type and amount of engine oil.
10. Install oil fill cap. 11. Start engine and inspect for leaks. 12. Stop engine and inspect oil level.
NOTE: Care should be exercised when disposing used engine oil after it has been drained from a
vehicle engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 1326
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 1327
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 1328
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Capacity Specifications
The power steering pump has a dipstick. Fluid should be maintained at the proper level indicated
on the dipstick.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid should be checked on a level surface with the engine off.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1331
Power Steering Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications Automatic Transmission Fluid Type
Automatic Transmission Fluid Type
Mopar ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1332
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
STANDARD PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
WARNING: FLUID LEVEL SHOULD BE CHECKED WITH THE ENGINE OFF TO PREVENT
PERSONAL INJURY FROM MOVING PARTS.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid (MS-9602) in the power steering
system. Do not overfill the system.
The power steering fluid level can be viewed on the dipstick attached to the filler cap. Before
opening the power steering system, wipe the reservoir filler cap free of dirt and debris. Remove the
cap and check the fluid level on the dipstick. When the fluid is at normal ambient temperature,
approximately 21°C to 27°C (70°F to 80°F), the fluid level should register between the ADD and
FULL markings on the dipstick. The optimum level is at the FULL line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Refer to the refrigerant A/C Specification tag for system capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1337
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications A/C Refrigerant Type
A/C Refrigerant Type
R-134a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1338
Refrigerant: Service Precautions
R-134a - R-12
Because R-134a refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) which contains hydrogen atoms in place
of chlorine atoms, it will not cause damage to the ozone layer.
Ozone filters out harmful radiation from the sun. To assist in protecting the ozone layer, Chrysler
Corporation recommends an R-134a refrigerant recycling device.
The Clean Air Act Amendment of 1990 requires that Freon be recovered when accessing the air
conditioning circuit and that technicians hold a refrigerant recovery and handling certification.
The Ozone Layer A thin layer of ozone molecules, located 10 to 30 miles above the earth, form a
protective cover by absorbing a portion of the ultraviolet (UV) radiation emitted from the Sun.
Ozone Depletion Scientific research performed over the past 15 years links the release of
chlorofluorocarbons (CFC)s, also know by the trade name Freon) into the atmosphere to ozone
depletion. When CFCs are released into the atmosphere, they eventually reach the ozone layer
located in the stratosphere where they react with and destroy ozone molecules.
Harmful Effects Ozone depletion and the corresponding increase in UV radiation has been shown
to lead to higher incidents of cancer as well as global warming. When viewed from a global
perspective, ozone depletion holds an enormous potential for damage.
Upper Level vs. Ground Level Ozone Confusion often arises when we hear about the necessity of
the ozone layer and ground level ozone. The ozone layer existing high above the earth is beneficial
but the same compound, when located at ground level, is harmful to humans, animals, crops and
vegetation.
Ground level ozone is a component of smog and forms when hydrocarbons (HC) react with
nitrogen oxides (NOx) in the presence of sunlight and heat.
Montreal Protocol In response to the growing body of evidence demonstrating the detrimental
effects of (CFC)s, 24 countries and the European community met in Montreal, Canada, in 1987 to
establish standards for the control of (CFC)s. Since that time, a total of 132 countries have become
signatories to this agreement leading to an end of production of R12 in December, 1995, in all
developed countries.
As established by the Montreal Protocol, R12 production in developed countries has ceased.
Clean Air Act The United States Congress, acting in response to the Montreal Protocol, banned
production of (CFC)s by the year 2000. Congress also amended the Clean Air Act in an effort to
control both the production and use of (CFC)s for refrigerant applications including mobile vehicle
air conditioning systems.
Technician Certification Organizations providing technician refrigerant recovery and recycling
certification include:
National Institute for Automotive Service Excellence (ASE)
13505 Dulles Technology Drive, Suite 2 Herndon, VA 22071-3421 Phone: (703) 713-3800 Fax:
(703) 713-0727 http://www.asecert.org/
International Mobile Air Conditioning Association (IMACA)
P.O. Box 9000 Fort Worth, TX 76147-2000 Phone: (817) 338-1100 Fax: (817) 338-1451
Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) Worldwide
P.O. Box 100 East Greenville, PA 18041 Phone: 215-679-2220 Fax: 215-541-4635
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1339
http://www.macsw.org/
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1340
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT
The refrigerant used in this air conditioning system is a HydroFluoroCarbon (HFC), type R-134a.
Unlike R-12, which is a ChloroFluoroCarbon (CFC), R-134a refrigerant does not contain
ozone-depleting chlorine. R-134a refrigerant is a non-toxic, non-Hammable, clear, and colorless
liquefied gas.
Even though R-134a does not contain chlorine, it must be reclaimed and recycled just like
CFC-type refrigerants. This is because R-134a is a greenhouse gas and can contribute to global
warming.
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an air conditioning system. Even a
small amount of R-12 added to an R-134a refrigerant system will cause compressor failure,
refrigerant oil sludge or poor air conditioning system performance. In addition, the PolyAlkylene
Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oils used in an R-134a refrigerant system are not compatible
with the mineral-based refrigerant oils used in an R-12 refrigerant system.
R-134a refrigerant system service ports, service tool couplers and refrigerant dispensing bottles
have all been designed with unique fittings to ensure that an R-134a system is not accidentally
contaminated with the wrong refrigerant (R-12). There are also labels posted in the engine
compartment of the vehicle and on the compressor identifying to service technicians that the air
conditioning system is equipped with R-134a.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > R-134A
Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Service and Repair R-134A Refrigerant
STANDARD PROCEDURE - R-134A REFRIGERANT
This vehicle uses a refrigerant called R-134a. It is a non-toxic, non-flammable, clear colorless
liquefied gas.
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an air conditioning system. Even a
small amount of R-12 in a R-134a system could cause compressor failure, refrigerant oil to sludge
and/or poor performance. Never add any other type of refrigerant to a system designed to use
R-134a refrigerant. System failure will occur.
The high pressure service port is located on the filter/drier. The low pressure service port is located
on the suction line near the strut tower.
Fig. 31 Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling Station - Typical
When servicing a system, it is required that an air conditioning charging recovery/recycling
machine be used. Contact an automotive service equipment supplier for proper equipment. Refer
to the operating instructions provided with the equipment for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > R-134A
Refrigerant > Page 1343
Fig. 32 Manifold Gauge Set - Typical
A manifold gauge set might be required with the charging and/or recovery/recycling device. Only
use gauges that have not been used for R-12. The service hoses on the gauge set should have
manual (turn wheel) or automatic back flow valves at the service port connector ends. This will
prevent refrigerant R-134a from being released into the atmosphere.
R-134a refrigerant requires a special type of compressor oil. When adding oil, make sure to use the
oil that is specified on the under hood label and/or the compressor housing
The use of R 134a will have a positive environmental impact due to its zero ozone depletion and
low global warming impact.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > R-134A
Refrigerant > Page 1344
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant - Recovery
STANDARD PROCEDURE - REFRIGERANT RECOVERY
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT BEFORE
PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
A R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets SAE Standard J2210 must be
used to recover the refrigerant from an R-134a refrigerant system. See the operating instructions
supplied by the equipment manufacturer for the proper care and use of this equipment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL CAPACITIES
Total System ........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 180 ml (6.1 oz.)
Filter-Drier ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 30 ml (1 oz.)
Condenser ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 30 ml (1 oz.)
Evaporator ...........................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 59 ml (2 oz.)
Refrigerant Lines .................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 44 ml (1.5 oz.)
Compressor .........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... See Note
Note:
When replacing the A/C compressor, drain and measure the amount of oil from the old
compressor. Add the equivalent amount of fresh oil to the new compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1349
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Refrigerant Oil .....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. ND-8 PAG
PAG - PolyAlkylene Glycol
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1350
Refrigerant Oil: Service Precautions
CAUTION: The refrigerant oil used in a R-134a A/C system is unique. Use only oils which were
designed to work with R-134a refrigerant. The oil designated for this vehicle is ND8 PAG
(polyalkalene glycol).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1351
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation
The refrigerant oil used in R-134a refrigerant systems is a synthetic based PolyAlkylene Glycol
(PAG), wax-free lubricant Mineral-based R-12 refrigerant oils are not compatible with PAG oils, and
should never be introduced to an R-134a refrigerant system.
There are different PAG oils available, and each contains a different additive package. The 10S15
and 10S17 compressors used in this vehicle is designed to use an ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil. Use
only refrigerant oil of this same type to service the refrigerant system.
After performing any refrigerant recovery or recycling operation, always replenish the refrigerant
system with the same amount of the recommended refrigerant oil as was removed. Too little
refrigerant oil can cause compressor damage, and too much can reduce air conditioning system
performance.
PAG refrigerant oil is much more hygroscopic than mineral oil, and will absorb any moisture it
comes into contact with, even moisture in the air. The PAG oil container should always be kept
tightly capped until it is ready to be used. After use, recap the oil container immediately to prevent
moisture contamination.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Oil Level
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair Refrigerant Oil Level
STANDARD PROCEDURE - REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL CHECK
It is important to have the correct amount of oil in the A/C system to ensure proper lubrication of the
compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the compressor. Too much oil will reduce the
cooling capacity of the system and consequently result in higher discharge air temperatures.
NOTE: The oil used in the compressor is ND8 PAG R-134a refrigerant oil. Only refrigerant oil of the
same type should be used to service the system. Do not use any other oil. The oil container should
be kept tightly capped until it is ready for use. Tightly cap afterwards to prevent contamination from
dirt and moisture. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb any moisture it comes in contact with. Special
effort must be used to keep all R-134a system components moisture-free. Moisture in the oil is very
difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the compressor.
It will not be necessary to check oil level in the compressor or to add oil unless there has been an
oil loss. Oil loss at a leak point will be evident by the presence of a wet, shiny surface around the
leak.
Refrigerant Oil Capacities
When an air conditioning system is first assembled, all components (except the compressor) are
refrigerant oil free. After the system has been charged with R-134a refrigerant and operated, the oil
in the compressor is dispersed through the lines and components. The evaporator, condenser, and
filter- drier will retain a significant amount of oil, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart. When
a component is replaced, the specified amount of refrigerant oil must be added. When the
compressor is replaced, the amount of oil that is retained in the rest of the system must be drained
from the replacement compressor. When a line or component has ruptured and oil has escaped,
the compressor should be removed and drained. The filter-drier must be replaced along with the
ruptured part. The oil capacity of the system, minus the amount of oil still in the remaining
components, can be measured and poured into the suction port of the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant Oil Level > Page 1354
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair Servicing Refrigerant Oil Level
STANDARD PROCEDURE - SERVICING REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL
CAUTION: The refrigerant oil used in a R-134a A/C system is unique. Use only oils which were
designed to work with R-134a refrigerant. The oil designated for this vehicle is ND8 PAG
(polyalkalene glycol).
Recovery/recycling equipment will measure the lubricant being removed. This is the amount of
lubricant to be added back to the system. If a new compressor is being installed, drain lubricant
from the old compressor, measure the amount drained and discard old lubricant. Drain the lubricant
from the new compressor into a clean container. Return the amount of lubricant measured from the
old compressor, plus the amount reclaimed from the system back into the new compressor.
1. Discharge refrigerant system using recovery/recycling equipment if charge is present. 2.
Disconnect refrigerant lines from A/C compressor. Cap the open lines to prevent moisture from
entering system. 3. Remove compressor from vehicle. 4. From suction port on top of compressor,
drain lubricant from compressor. 5. Add system capacity minus the capacity of components that
have not been replaced. Add lubricant through the suction port on compressor. This is
not to exceed 180 ml (6.10 oz.) in total.
6. Install compressor and connect refrigerant lines. Then evacuate and charge refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Washer Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Washer Fluid: Specifications
Fill the reservoir with windshield washer solvent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bleeding
STANDARD PROCEDURE - MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
1. Clamp the master cylinder in a vise. 2. Refer to one of the following depending on whether the
master cylinder is a non-ABS unit Step a or an ABS unit Step b:
a. Attach four Master Cylinder Bleed Tubes, Special Tool 8358-1, to the four ports of the master
cylinder and tighten each in place. The bleed
tubes for the ports pertaining to the rear brakes are made to attach to the proportioning valves
screwed into the master cylinder. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder
reservoir so their outlets are below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
b. Attach Master Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-1, to the primary port of the master
cylinder and tighten in place. Attach Master
Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-2, to the secondary port of the master cylinder and tighten
in place. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder reservoir so their outlets are
below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
3. Fill the brake fluid reservoir with fresh Mopars brake fluid, or equivalent conforming to DOT 3
specifications. 4. Using a wooden dowel as a pushrod, press the pistons inward slowly applying
brake pressure, then release the pressure, allowing the pistons to
return to the released position. Repeat this several times until all air bubbles are expelled out of the
tubes and master cylinder bore.
5. Remove the bleed tubes from the master cylinder and plug the outlet ports. 6. Install the fill cap
on the reservoir. 7. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Bleeding > Page 1362
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Base Brake System
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BASE BRAKE BLEEDING
NOTE: For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Antilock Brake System Bleeding.
CAUTION: Before removing the master cylinder cap, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter from
dropping into the master cylinder reservoir.
- Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a fresh, tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications.
Do not pump the brake pedal at any time while a bleeder screw is open. This will only increase the
amount of air in the system and make additional bleeding necessary.
Do not allow the master cylinder reservoir to run out of brake fluid while bleeding the system. An
empty reservoir will allow additional air into the brake system. Check the fluid level frequently and
add fluid as needed.
The following wheel circuit sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic system should be used to
ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
- Left rear wheel - Right front wheel - Right rear wheel - Left front wheel
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Bleeding > Page 1363
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The base brake's hydraulic system must be bled anytime air enters the hydraulic system. The ABS
though, particularly the ICU (HCU), should only need to be bled when the HCU is replaced or
removed from the vehicle. The ABS must always be bled anytime it is suspected that the HCU has
ingested air. Under most circumstances that require the bleeding of the brakes hydraulic system,
only the base brake hydraulic system needs to be bled.
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence must be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding.
1. Make sure all hydraulic fluid lines are installed and properly torqued. 2. Connect the DRBIII scan
tool to the Data Link Connector. The connector is located under the lower steering column cover to
the left of the
steering column.
3. Using the DRBIII, check to make sure the CAB does not have any fault codes stored. If it does,
clear them using the DRBIII.
WARNING: WHEN BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM WEAR SAFETY GLASSES. A CLEAR
BLEED TUBE MUST BE ATTACHED TO THE BLEEDER SCREWS AND SUBMERGED IN A
CLEAR CONTAINER FILLED PART WAY WITH CLEAN BRAKE FLUID. DIRECT THE FLOW OF
BRAKE FLUID AWAY FROM YOURSELF AND THE PAINTED SURFACES OF THE VEHICLE.
BRAKE FLUID AT HIGH PRESSURE MAY COME OUT OF THE BLEEDER SCREWS WHEN
OPENED.
4. Bleed the base brake system using the standard pressure or manual bleeding procedure. 5.
Using the DRBIII, select ANTILOCK BRAKES, followed by MISCELLANEOUS, then BLEED
BRAKES. Follow the instructions displayed.
When the scan tool displays TEST COMPLETED, disconnect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically
to prevent emptying, causing air to enter the
hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder reservoir to the full level. 8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the brakes
are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel spongy.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Bleeding > Page 1364
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Manual Bleeding
MANUAL BLEEDING
NOTE: To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar containing
enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the
hose.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 3. With
the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least 1 full turn. 4. Once the brake pedal
has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake pedal.
5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually four or
five times). 6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from
the brake system. Monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check the brake pedal travel. If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air
may still be trapped in the system. Rebleed the brakes
as necessary.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder
Bleeding > Page 1365
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Pressure Bleeding
PRESSURE BLEEDING
NOTE: Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of pressure bleeding
equipment. Following the same wheel circuit sequence as prescribed for manual bleeding.
1. Attach Adapter, Special Tool 6921, to the master cylinder reservoir. 2. Attach Bleeder Tank,
Special Tool C-3496-B, or an equivalent, to the adapter on the master cylinder.
3. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar containing
enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the
hose.
4. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid. 5.
After approximately 4-8 ounces of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and an air-free
flow is maintained in the clear plastic hose and
jar, close the bleeder screw.
6. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws. 7. Check the brake pedal travel. If
pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air may still be trapped in the system.
Rebleed the brakes
as necessary.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
> Page 1369
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations
Circuit Breaker: Locations
8w-11-2 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1374
8w-11-3 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1375
Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breakers
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1376
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams
Circuit Breakers - LHD
Circuit Breakers - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block
Fuse: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block > Page 1381
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block > Page 1382
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block > Page 1383
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block > Page 1384
Fuse: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Block > Page 1385
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuse Block
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuse Block > Page 1388
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuse Block > Page 1389
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuse Block > Page 1390
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuse Block > Page 1391
Fuse: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuse Block > Page 1392
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1397
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1398
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1399
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1400
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1401
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1402
Fuse Block: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1403
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 1406
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1407
Fuse Block: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL, RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1410
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1411
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1412
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1413
Fuse Block: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1414
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Fuse Block > Page 1417
Fuse Block: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL, RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
The Fuse Block is serviced with the instrument panel wire harness. If service is required to the fuse
block, the entire instrument panel harness must be replaced.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the instrument panel. 2. With the instrument panel removed, disassemble the
instrument panel enough to gain access to all screws and connectors. 3. Remove instrument panel
wire harness with fuse block.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the instrument panel wire harness to the instrument panel. 2. Install all items removed
from the instrument panel to gain access to the wire harness. 3. Install the instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Fuse Block > Page 1420
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuse Block
Relay Box: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuse Block > Page 1425
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuse Block > Page 1426
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuse Block > Page 1427
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuse Block > Page 1428
Relay Box: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuse Block > Page 1429
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1432
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1433
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1434
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1435
Relay Box: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 1436
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center
Relay Box: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center > Page 1439
Relay Box: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 1440
Relay Box: Service and Repair
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Application and ID
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Malfunction Indicator Light ...................................................................................................................
............................................................... LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Application and ID > Page 1445
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
Refer to the Instrument Cluster for more information.
The PCM supplies the malfunction indicator (check engine) lamp ON/OFF signal to the instrument
panel through the PCI Bus. The PCI Bus is a communications port. Various modules use the PCI
Bus to exchange information.
The Check Engine lamp comes ON each time the ignition key is turned ON and stays on for 3
seconds as a bulb test.
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) stays ON continuously when the PCM has entered a Limp-In
mode or identified a failed emission component. During Limp-in Mode, the PCM attempts to keep
the system operational. The MIL signals the need for immediate service. In limp-in mode, the PCM
compensates for the failure of certain components that send incorrect signals. The PCM substitutes
for the incorrect signals with inputs from other sensors.
If the PCM detects active engine misfire severe enough to cause catalyst damage, it flashes the
MIL. At the same time the PCM also sets a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
For signals that can trigger the MIL (Check Engine Lamp) refer to the On-Board Diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Application and ID
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Application and ID
This vehicle did not have an Oil Change Reminder Light.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Vehicle Lifting: Technician Safety Information
STANDARD PROCEDURE - HOISTING RECOMMENDATIONS
Refer to the Owner's Manual for emergency vehicle lifting procedures.
WARNING: THE HOISTING AND JACK LIFTING POINTS PROVIDED ARE FOR A COMPLETE
VEHICLE. WHEN A CHASSIS OR DRIVETRAIN COMPONENT IS REMOVED FROM A
VEHICLE, THE CENTER OF GRAVITY IS ALTERED MAKING SOME HOISTING CONDITIONS
UNSTABLE. PROPERLY SUPPORT OR SECURE VEHICLE TO HOISTING DEVICE WHEN
THESE CONDITIONS EXIST.
Fig. 7 Correct Vehicle Lifting Locations
Floor Jack When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift a Ram Van or Wagon (Fig. 7).
Support the vehicle in the raised position with jack stands at the front and rear ends of the frame
rails.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a CNG Ram Van/Wagon with a floor jack positioned under:
- Body side sill
- Steering linkage component
- Drive shaft
- Engine or transmission oil pan
- Fuel cylinder
- Front suspension arm
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a vehicle with a floor jack positioned under: An axle tube.
- A body side sill.
- A steering linkage component.
- A drive shaft.
- The engine or transmission oil pan.
- The fuel tank.
- A front suspension arm.
Hoist A vehicle can be lifted with: A single-post, frame-contact hoist.
- A twin-post, chassis hoist.
- A ramp-type, drive-on hoist.
NOTE: When a frame-contact type hoist is used, verify that the lifting pads are positioned properly
(Fig. 7).
WARNING: WHEN A SERVICE PROCEDURE REQUIRES THE REMOVAL OF THE REAR AXLE,
FUEL CYLINDER OR SPARE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 1454
TIRE; EITHER:
- Place additional weight on the rear end of the vehicle
- Attach the vehicle to the hoist
- Place jack stands under the vehicle for support to prevent tipping when the center of balance
changes
A CNG Ram Van/Wagon can be lifted with: Twin post, chassis hoist
- Twin post, wheel lift hoist
- Ramp type, drive on hoist
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 1455
Vehicle Lifting: Vehicle Damage Warnings
STANDARD PROCEDURE - HOISTING RECOMMENDATIONS
Refer to the Owner's Manual for emergency vehicle lifting procedures.
WARNING: THE HOISTING AND JACK LIFTING POINTS PROVIDED ARE FOR A COMPLETE
VEHICLE. WHEN A CHASSIS OR DRIVETRAIN COMPONENT IS REMOVED FROM A
VEHICLE, THE CENTER OF GRAVITY IS ALTERED MAKING SOME HOISTING CONDITIONS
UNSTABLE. PROPERLY SUPPORT OR SECURE VEHICLE TO HOISTING DEVICE WHEN
THESE CONDITIONS EXIST.
Fig. 7 Correct Vehicle Lifting Locations
Floor Jack When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift a Ram Van or Wagon (Fig. 7).
Support the vehicle in the raised position with jack stands at the front and rear ends of the frame
rails.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a CNG Ram Van/Wagon with a floor jack positioned under:
- Body side sill
- Steering linkage component
- Drive shaft
- Engine or transmission oil pan
- Fuel cylinder
- Front suspension arm
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a vehicle with a floor jack positioned under: An axle tube.
- A body side sill.
- A steering linkage component.
- A drive shaft.
- The engine or transmission oil pan.
- The fuel tank.
- A front suspension arm.
Hoist A vehicle can be lifted with: A single-post, frame-contact hoist.
- A twin-post, chassis hoist.
- A ramp-type, drive-on hoist.
NOTE: When a frame-contact type hoist is used, verify that the lifting pads are positioned properly
(Fig. 7).
WARNING: WHEN A SERVICE PROCEDURE REQUIRES THE REMOVAL OF THE REAR AXLE,
FUEL CYLINDER OR SPARE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 1456
TIRE; EITHER:
- Place additional weight on the rear end of the vehicle
- Attach the vehicle to the hoist
- Place jack stands under the vehicle for support to prevent tipping when the center of balance
changes
A CNG Ram Van/Wagon can be lifted with: Twin post, chassis hoist
- Twin post, wheel lift hoist
- Ramp type, drive on hoist
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Tires: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - TIRE
Tires are designed and engineered for each specific vehicle. They provide the best overall
performance for normal operation. The ride and handling characteristics match the vehicle's
requirements. With proper care they will give excellent reliability, traction, skid resistance, and tread
life.
Driving habits have more effect on tire life than any other factor. Careful drivers will obtain, in most
cases, much greater mileage than severe use or careless drivers. A few of the driving habits which
will shorten the life of any tire are: -
Rapid acceleration
- Severe application of brakes
- High-speed driving
- Taking turns at excessive speeds
- Striking curbs and other obstacles
- Operating vehicle with over or under inflated tire pressures
Radial ply tires are more prone to irregular tread wear. It is important to follow the tire rotation
interval. This will help to achieve a greater tread-life potential.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Fig. 1
Tire type, size, aspect ratio and speed rating are encoded in the letters and numbers imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. Refer to the chart to decipher the tire identification code.
Performance tires will have a speed rating letter after the aspect ratio number. For example, the
letter "S" indicates that the tire is speed rated up to 112 mph (180 km/h). The speed rating is not
always printed on the tire sidewall. Q -up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
- S -up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
- T -up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
- U -up to 124 mph (200 km/h)
- H -up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
- V -up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
- Z -more than 149 mph (240 km/h) (consult the tire manufacturer for the specific speed rating)
An All Season type tire will have either M + S, M & S or M-S (indicating mud and snow traction)
imprinted on the sidewall.
TIRE CHAINS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1460
Refer to the owners manual supplied with the vehicle to determine whether the use of tire chains is
permitted on this vehicle.
DESCRIPTION - RADIAL-PLY TIRES
Radial-ply tires improve handling, tread life and ride quality, and decrease rolling resistance.
Radial-ply tires must always be used in sets of four. Under no circumstances should they be used
on the front only. They may be mixed with temporary spare tires when necessary. A maximum
speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) is recommended while a temporary spare is in use.
Radial-ply tires have the same load-carrying capacity as other types of tires of the same size. They
also use the same recommended inflation pressures.
The use of oversized tires, either in the front or rear of the vehicle, can cause vehicle drive train
failure. This could also cause inaccurate wheel speed signals when the vehicle is equipped with
Antilock Brakes.
The use of tires from different manufactures on the same vehicle is NOT recommended. The
proper tire pressure should be maintained on all four tires.
DESCRIPTION - REPLACEMENT TIRES
WARNING: FAILURE TO EQUIP THE VEHICLE WITH TIRES HAVING ADEQUATE SPEED
CAPABILITY CAN RESULT IN SUDDEN TIRE FAILURE.
It is recommended that tires equivalent to the original equipment tires be used when replacement is
needed. Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety and handling of
the vehicle.
The original equipment tires provide a proper combination of many characteristics such as: Ride
- Noise
- Handling
- Durability
- Tread life
- Traction
- Rolling resistance
- Speed capability
The use of oversize tires may cause interference with vehicle components. Under extremes of
suspension and steering travel, interference with vehicle components may cause tire damage.
DESCRIPTION - SPARE TIRE (TEMPORARY)
The compact temporary spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be
repaired or replaced at the first opportunity, then reinstalled. Do not exceed speeds of 80 km/h (50
mph) when using the temporary spare tire. Refer to Owner's Manual for complete details.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Tread Wear Indicators
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Indicators
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Tread wear indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. When tread depth is 1.6
mm (1/16 inch), the tread wear indicators will appear as a 13 mm (1/2 inch) band.
Tire replacement is necessary when indicators appear in two or more grooves or if localized
balding occurs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Tread Wear Indicators > Page 1463
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Patterns
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TIRE WEAR PATTERNS
Under inflation will cause wear on the shoulders of tire. Over inflation will cause wear at the center
of tire.
Fig. 2
Excessive camber causes the tire to run at an angle to the road. One side of tread is then worn
more than the other.
Excessive toe-in or toe-out causes wear on the tread edges and a feathered effect across the
tread.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Tread Wear Indicators > Page 1464
Tires: Testing and Inspection Vehicle Lead Diagnosis and Correction
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - VEHICLE LEAD DIAGNOSIS AND CORRECTION
Use the following chart to diagnose a vehicle that has a complaint of a drift or lead condition. The
use of this chart will help to determine if the lead condition is the result of a bad tire or is caused by
the wheel alignment.
VEHICLE LEAD DIAGNOSIS AND CORRECTION PROCEDURE
*NOTE: VERIFY THAT LEAD IS NOT RELATED TO STEERING WHEEL NOT CENTERED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Tires: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING - TIRES
Before delivery of a vehicle, remove the protective coating on the tires with white sidewalls or
raised white letters. To remove the protective coating, apply warm water and let it soak for a few
minutes. Afterwards, scrub the coating away with a soft bristle brush. Steam cleaning may also be
used to remove the coating.
CAUTION: DO NOT use gasoline, mineral oil, oil based solvent or a wire brush for cleaning.
Tire Inflation Pressures
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TIRE INFLATION PRESSURES The specified tire pressures have
been chosen to provide safe operation, vehicle stability, and a smooth ride. The proper tire
pressure specification can be found on the Tire Inflation Pressure Label provided with the vehicle
(usually on the rear face of the driver's door).
A quality air pressure gauge is recommended to check tire air pressure. Tire pressure should be
checked cold once per month. Check tire pressure more frequently when the weather temperature
varies widely. Tire pressure will decrease when the outdoor temperature drops. After checking the
air pressure, replace valve cap finger tight.
Inflation pressures specified on the Tire Inflation Pressure Label are always the cold inflation
pressure of the tire. Cold inflation pressure is obtained after the vehicle has not been operated for
at least 3 hours, or the vehicle is driven less than one mile after being inoperative for 3 hours. Tire
inflation pressures may increase from 2 to 6 pounds per square inch (psi) during operation. Do not
reduce this normal pressure buildup.
Improper inflation can cause:
- Uneven wear patterns
- Reduced tread life
- Reduced fuel economy
- Unsatisfactory ride
- The vehicle to drift.
WARNING: OVER OR UNDER INFLATED TIRES CAN AFFECT VEHICLE HANDLING. THE TIRE
CAN FAIL SUDDENLY, RESULTING IN LOSS OF VEHICLE CONTROL.
Fig. 4
Under inflation causes rapid shoulder wear, tire flexing, and can result in tire failure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1467
Fig. 5
Over inflation causes rapid center wear and loss of the tire's ability to cushion shocks.
Tire Pressure For High Speed Operation
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TIRE PRESSURE FOR HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Daimler Chrysler Corporation advocates driving at safe speeds within posted speed limits. Speed
capacity of a tire is a function of the tire speed rating, inflation pressure and vehicle axle weight.
Where speed limits allow the vehicle to be driven at high speeds, correct tire inflation pressure is
very important. Vehicles loaded to maximum capacity should not be driven at continuous speeds
over 120 km/h (75 mph). Never exceed the maximum speed capacity of the tire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1468
Tires: Removal and Replacement
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TIRE LEAK REPAIRING
Fig. 7
For proper repairing, a radial tire must be removed from the wheel. Repairs should only be made if
the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area. The tire should be replaced if the puncture is located in
the sidewall.
Deflate tire completely before attempting to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use a lubricant such
as a mild soap solution when dismounting or mounting tire. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges
which could damage the tire or wheel rim.
Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if
necessary.
Install wheel on vehicle, and progressively tighten the 5 wheel nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels - Caring for Chrome Wheels
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Caring for Chrome Wheels
NUMBER: 22-001-05
GROUP: Wheels and Tires
DATE: December 1, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 22-004-03, DATED
SEPTEMBER 26, 2003 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND MODEL
YEARS AND CLEANER SUGGESTIONS.
SUBJECT: Chrome Wheel Care
MODELS:
2000 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
2002 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
2000 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2006** (CS) Pacifica
2002 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2006 (DR/DH) Ram Truck**
2004 - **2006** (HB) Durango
2001 - **2006** (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 - **2006** (KJ) Liberty
1998 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M
2005 - **2006 (LX/LE) 300/Charger/Magnum**
**2005 - 2006 (ND) Dakota**
1998 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country
2002 - **2005** (PL) Neon
1999 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - **2006** (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - **2006** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan
2001 - **2005** (ST) Sebring/Stratus Coupe
2002 - **2006** (TJ) Wrangler
**2002 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter**
2001 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
**2005 - 2006 (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee**
**2006 (XK) Commander**
2003 - **2006 (ZB) Viper/Viper Coupe**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels - Caring for Chrome Wheels > Page 1473
2004 - **2006 (ZH) Crossfire/Crossfire Convertible/SRT6**
DISCUSSION:
Chrome wheels should be cleaned regularly with **good quality car wash such as MOPAR Car
Wash Concentrate p/n 04796236AB,** and water to maintain their luster and prevent corrosion.
Wash them with the same soap solution as the body of the vehicle.
Care must be taken in the selection of tire and wheel cleaning chemicals and equipment to prevent
damage to wheels. MOPAR Tire and Wheel Cleaner, p/n 05066247AB - 22 oz. or 05066248AB - 5
gal. **or MOPAR Wheel Cleaner, p/n 04796239AB,** is recommended to remove normal brake
dust, dirt, grease and grime.
NOTE:
To clean extremely dirty wheels, MOPAR Chrome Cleaner, pin 04318013, is recommended.
Any of the "DO NOT USE" items listed below can damage or stain wheels and wheel trim.
DO NOT USE:
^ Wheel cleaners that contain hydroflouric acid, biflouride compounds, sulfuric acid, or phosphoric
acid.
^ Any abrasive type cleaner
^ Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or abrasive brush
^ Any oven cleaner.
^ A car wash that has carbide tipped wheel-cleaning brushes.
CAUTION:
Many commercial wheel cleaners contain acids that may harm the wheel surface. Avoid all "wheel
acid" type cleaners.
CAUTION:
Any facility found using acid based wheel cleaners will void all wheel warranties, and all damage to
customer wheels will be the facility's responsibility.
Refer to Global Warranty Bulletin D-01-22 for further information.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1474
Wheels: Specifications
WHEEL SPECIFICATIONS
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut Hex Size ...................................................................................................
.................................................................. 19 mm Wheel Mounting Stud Size ...................................
...................................................................................................................................... M12 x 1.5 mm
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut Torque
.................................................................................................................................................. 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1475
Wheels: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION Original equipment wheels are designed for proper operation at all loads up to the
specified maximum vehicle capacity.
All models use steel or cast aluminum drop center wheels. Every wheel has raised sections
between the rim flanges and rim drop well called safety humps.
Initial inflation of the tires forces the bead over these raised sections. In case of air loss the raised
sections help hold the tire in position on the wheel until the vehicle can be brought to a safe stop.
Cast aluminum wheels require special balance weights to fit on the thicker flange of the rim and
special wheel clamps for the alignment equipment.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific wheel applications and must be replaced with
equivalent parts. Do not use replacement parts of lesser quality or of a substitute design. All
aluminum wheels use wheel nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is necessary to
ensure proper retention of the wheels.
Vehicles that are equipped with lock-on wheel covers use large nose wheel nuts. The wheel nuts
are externally threaded so that the wheel covers can be attached to the wheel nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1476
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WHEEL INSPECTION
Inspect wheels for: Excessive runout
- Dents, cracks or irregular bends
- Damaged wheel stud (lug) holes
- Air Leaks
NOTE: Do not attempt to repair a wheel by hammering, heating or welding.
If a wheel is damaged, an original equipment replacement wheel should be used. When obtaining
replacement wheels, they must be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The diameter, width, offset,
pilot hole and bolt circle of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: FAILURE TO USE EQUIVALENT REPLACEMENT WHEELS MAY ADVERSELY
AFFECT THE SAFETY AND HANDLING OF THE VEHICLE.
WARNING: REPLACEMENT WITH USED WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE SERVICE
HISTORY OF THE WHEEL MAY HAVE INCLUDED SEVERE TREATMENT OR VERY HIGH
MILEAGE. THE RIM COULD FAIL WITHOUT WARNING.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1477
Wheels: Service and Repair
CLEANING
WHEEL AND WHEEL TRIM CARE
All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and chrome plated, should be cleaned regularly
using mild soap and water to maintain their luster and to prevent corrosion. Wash them with the
same soap solution recommended for the body of the vehicle.
When cleaning extremely dirty wheels, care must be taken in the selection of tire and wheel
cleaning chemicals and equipment to prevent damage to the wheels. Mopar Wheel Treatment or
Mopar Chrome Cleaner is recommended. Any of the "DO NOT USE" items listed below can
damage wheels and wheel trim.
DO NOT USE: Any abrasive cleaner
- Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or abrasive brush
- Any cleaner that contains an acid which can react with and discolor the chrome surface. Many
wheel cleaners contain acids that can harm the wheel surface.
- Oven cleaner
- A car wash that uses carbide-tipped wheel cleaning brushes or acidic solutions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front
Bearing Retainer Plate Bolts
...........................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Rear
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
............................................ 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts
..........................................................................................................................................................
109-150 Nm (80-110 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle.
CAUTION: When removing the bolt-on wheel cover, do not attempt to pry the wheel cover off the
wheel.
2. Unthread and remove the 5 nuts attaching the wheel and wheel cover to the vehicle. 3. Remove
the wheel cover using care not to let the tire and wheel assembly fall off the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Installing the wheel mounting nuts without having good metal-to-mental contact
between the back of the wheel and the hub mounted brake disc or drum could cause the wheel to
bind and eventually cause loosening of the wheel mounting nuts.
CAUTION: Never use oil or grease on wheel studs or wheel mounting nuts.
1. With the tire and wheel assembly positioned on the wheel studs without the wheel mounting nuts
installed, align the valve notch in the wheel cover
with the valve stem on the wheel and install the wheel cover on the hub mounted studs.
2. Install and lightly tighten the wheel mounting nuts in the proper sequence. 3. Lower the vehicle.
4. Progressively tighten the 5 wheel mounting nuts in the proper sequence until tightened to half of
the specified torque. Finally, tighten the wheel
mounting nuts in the proper sequence to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Driveshaft Hub Nut ..............................................................................................................................
............................................ 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts ............................................
........................................................................................................................... 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut Hex Size
................................................................................................................................................... 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
For Tightening Sequence refer to Wheels and Tires, Service and Repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
WHEEL MOUNTING STUDS - FRONT
REMOVAL
Use the following procedure to remove and install one of five studs on one wheel hub. 1. Raise the
vehicle. 2. Remove the front tire and wheel assembly.
3. Remove the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle. 4.
Remove the disc brake caliper from the steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping
either the top (right side) or bottom (left side) of
the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's caliper slide
abutment (on the knuckle) and rotor.
5. Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not support the caliper by letting
it hang by the hydraulic hose. 6. Remove any retainer clips from the wheel mounting studs.
Remove the brake rotor from the front hub.
CAUTION: Do not hammer wheel mounting studs out of the hub. Damage to the wheel bearing will
occur, leading to premature bearing failure.
7. Install a wheel mounting nut on the wheel mounting stud being removed from the hub far enough
so the threads on the stud are even with end of
lug nut. Rotate the hub so the stud requiring removal is aligned with notch cast into front of the
steering knuckle. Install Remover, Special Tool C-4150A, on hub flange and wheel stud .
8. Tighten the remover, pushing the wheel mounting stud out the rear of the hub flange. When the
shoulder of the stud is past the flange, remove the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1493
remover from the hub. Remove the nut from the stud, then remove the stud from the flange.
INSTALLATION
Use the following procedure to remove and install one of five studs on one wheel hub.
Fig. 62
1. Install the wheel mounting stud in the flange of hub from the rear side. Install several washers
and a wheel mounting nut on the stud. The wheel
mounting nut must be installed with the flat side of the wheel mounting nut against the washers to
eliminate binding.
2. Tighten the wheel mounting nut. This will pull the wheel mounting stud into the flange of the hub.
When the head of the stud is fully seated against
the rear of the hub flange, remove the wheel mounting nut and washers from the stud.
3. Install the brake rotor on the hub.
4. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the caliper, then
pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side caliper is
installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower abutment on the steering
knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the caliper into place against
the steering knuckle.
5. Install the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle .
Tighten the guide pin bolts to a torque of 22 Nm (192
inch lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Install the wheel mounting nuts and tighten them to a torque
of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 7. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1494
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
WHEEL MOUNTING STUDS - REAR
REMOVAL
CAUTION: DO NOT hammer studs out of the hub flange. If a stud is removed by hammering it out
of the bearing flange, damage to the hub and bearing assembly will occur leading to premature
bearing failure.
1. Remove the hub and bearing from the vehicle.
CAUTION: Take care to keep hub and bearing assembly from falling during stud removal. Damage
to the hub and bearing could result.
2. Position the hub and bearing assembly under a hydraulic press ram, supported by a 21 mm
deep well impact socket under the stud to be replaced. 3. Press the stud out of the hub flange and
into the socket well. 4. Remove the hub and bearing assembly from the press. 5. Remove the stud
from the socket.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: DO NOT hammer studs into the hub flange. If a stud is installed in such a manner,
damage to the hub and bearing assembly may occur leading to premature bearing failure.
1. Install wheel stud into stud hole in hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 1495
2. Position the hub and bearing assembly face down with stud pointing down into the well of the 21
mm socket. The hydraulic press ram must line up
with the stud.
3. Press the stud into the hub flange until it bottoms. 4. Remove the hub and bearing assembly
from the press. 5. Install the hub and bearing on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety
Information
Jump Starting: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: DO NOT JUMP START A FROZEN BATTERY, PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
DO NOT JUMP START WHEN MAINTENANCE FREE BATTERY INDICATOR DOT IS YELLOW
OR BRIGHT COLOR. DO NOT JUMP START A VEHICLE WHEN THE BATTERY FLUID IS
BELOW THE TOP OF LEAD PLATES. DO NOT ALLOW JUMPER CABLE CLAMPS TO TOUCH
EACH OTHER WHEN CONNECTED TO A BOOSTER SOURCE. DO NOT USE OPEN FLAME
NEAR BATTERY. REMOVE METALLIC JEWELRY WORN ON HANDS OR WRISTS TO AVOID
INJURY BY ACCIDENTAL ARCING OF BATTERY CURRENT. WHEN USING A HIGH OUTPUT
BOOSTING DEVICE, DO NOT ALLOW BATTERY VOLTAGE TO EXCEED 16 VOLTS. REFER
TO INSTRUCTIONS PROVIDED WITH DEVICE BEING USED.
CAUTION: Do not crank starter motor on disabled vehicle for more than 15 seconds, starter will
overheat and could fail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety
Information > Page 1500
Jump Starting: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- When using another vehicle as a booster, do not allow vehicles to touch. Electrical systems can
be damaged on either vehicle.
- If the cause of starting problem on disabled vehicle is severe, damage to booster vehicle charging
system can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1501
Jump Starting: Service and Repair
STANDAD PROCEDURE - JUMP STARTING
WARNING: DO NOT JUMP START A FROZEN BATTERY, PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
DO NOT JUMP START WHEN MAINTENANCE FREE BATTERY INDICATOR DOT IS YELLOW
OR BRIGHT COLOR. DO NOT JUMP START A VEHICLE WHEN THE BATTERY FLUID IS
BELOW THE TOP OF LEAD PLATES. DO NOT ALLOW JUMPER CABLE CLAMPS TO TOUCH
EACH OTHER WHEN CONNECTED TO A BOOSTER SOURCE. DO NOT USE OPEN FLAME
NEAR BATTERY. REMOVE METALLIC JEWELRY WORN ON HANDS OR WRISTS TO AVOID
INJURY BY ACCIDENTAL ARCING OF BATTERY CURRENT. WHEN USING A HIGH OUTPUT
BOOSTING DEVICE, DO NOT ALLOW BATTERY VOLTAGE TO EXCEED 16 VOLTS. REFER
TO INSTRUCTIONS PROVIDED WITH DEVICE BEING USED.
CAUTION: When using another vehicle as a booster, do not allow vehicles to touch. Electrical
systems can be damaged on either vehicle.
TO JUMP START A DISABLED VEHICLE:
1. Raise hood on disabled vehicle and visually inspect engine compartment for:
- Battery cable clamp condition, clean if necessary
- Frozen battery.
- Yellow or bright color test indicator, if equipped.
- Low battery fluid level.
- Generator drive belt condition and tension.
- Fuel fumes or leakage, correct if necessary
CAUTION: If the cause of starting problem on disabled vehicle is severe, damage to booster
vehicle charging system can result.
2. When using another vehicle as a booster source, park the booster vehicle within cable reach.
Turn OFF all accessories, set the parking brake, place
the automatic transmission in PARK or the manual transmission in NEUTRAL and turn the ignition
OFF.
3. On disabled vehicle, place gear selector in park or neutral and set park brake. Turn OFF all
accessories. 4. Connect jumper cables to booster battery. RED clamp to positive terminal (+).
BLACK clamp to negative terminal (-). DO NOT allow clamps at
opposite end of cables to touch, electrical arc will result. Review all warnings in this procedure.
Fig. 6 Jumper Cable Clamp Connections
5. On disabled vehicle, connect RED jumper cable clamp to positive (+) terminal. Connect BLACK
jumper cable clamp to engine ground as close to
the ground cable attaching point as possible (Fig. 6).
6. Start the engine in the vehicle which has the booster battery, let the engine idle a few minutes,
then start the engine in the vehicle with the
discharged battery.
CAUTION: Do not crank starter motor on disabled vehicle for more than 15 seconds, starter will
overheat and could fail.
7. Allow battery in disabled vehicle to charge to at least 12.4 volts (75% charge) before attempting
to start engine. If engine does not start within 15
seconds, stop cranking engine and allow starter to cool (15 minutes), before cranking again.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1502
Disconnect Cable Clamps As Follows: Disconnect BLACK cable clamp from engine ground on disabled vehicle.
- When using a Booster vehicle, disconnect BLACK cable clamp from battery negative terminal.
Disconnect RED cable clamp from battery positive terminal
- Disconnect RED cable clamp from battery positive terminal on disabled vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information
Towing Information: Technician Safety Information
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TOWING RECOMMENDATIONS
CAUTION: Many vehicles are equipped with air dams, spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. To
avoid component damage, a wheel-lift towing vehicle or a flat-bed hauling vehicle is recommended.
Fig. 9 Tow Vehicles With Approved Equipment
A vehicle equipped with SAE approved sling-type towing equipment, a wheel-lift towing device or a
vehicle with a flat-bed device can be used to transport all RAM VAN or WAGON vehicles (Fig. 9). A
wooden crossbeam may be required for proper connection when using the sling-type, front-end
towing method.
Safety Precautions NOTE: The following safety precautions must be observed when towing a
vehicle.
- Secure loose and protruding parts.
- Always use a safety chain system that is independent of the lifting and towing equipment.
- Do not allow towing equipment to contact the disabled vehicle's fuel tank.
- Do not allow anyone under the disabled vehicle while it is lifted by the towing device.
- Do not allow passengers to ride in a vehicle being towed.
- Always observe state and local laws regarding towing regulations.
- Do not tow a vehicle in a manner that could jeopardize the safety of the operator, pedestrians or
other motorists.
- Do not attach tow chains, T-hooks, J-hooks, or a tow sling to a bumper, steering linkage, drive
shafts or a non-reinforced frame hole.
- Remove exhaust pipe tips that interfere with the tow sling and crossbar
- Padding should be placed between the tow sling/crossbar and any painted surfaces
- When placing tow hooks on the rear axle, position them so they do not damage the brake tubing
or hoses
- Do not tow the vehicle by connecting to the front or rear shock absorbers
- Do not tow a heavily loaded vehicle. Damage to the vehicle may result. Use a flatbed device to
transport a loaded vehicle.
Ground Clearance
CAUTION: If vehicle is towed with wheels removed, install lug nuts to retain brake drums.
A towed vehicle should be raised until lifted wheels are a minimum 100 mm (4 in) from the ground.
Be sure there is adequate ground clearance at the opposite end of the vehicle, especially when
towing over rough terrain, steep rises in the road or if the vehicle is equipped with air dams,
spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. If necessary, remove the wheels from the lifted end of the
vehicle and lower the vehicle closer to the ground, to increase the ground clearance at the opposite
end of the vehicle. Install lug nuts on wheel attaching studs to retain brake drums.
Ramp Angle If a vehicle with flat-bed towing equipment is used, the approach ramp angle should
not exceed 15 degrees.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1507
Towing-Rear End Lifted
CAUTION: Do not use steering column lock to secure steering wheel during towing operation.
Vehicles can be towed with the front wheels on the ground for extended distances at speeds not
exceeding 48 km/h (30 mph).
Fig. 10 Rear-End Lifted Towing
1. Attach the J-hooks around the axle shaft tubes outboard of the rear springs (Fig. 10). 2. Position
and center the sling under and forward of the rear bumper. 3. Attach safety chains (with pads) at
each end of the rear bumper. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position to unlock the steering
wheel. 5. Clamp the steering wheel with the front wheels in the straight ahead position. 6. Shift the
transmission to NEUTRAL.
Towing-Front End Lifted Provided the transmission is operable, tow only in NEUTRAL at speeds
not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h) and distances less than 15 miles (25km/h).
If the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 miles, the propeller shaft should be disconnected or
place tow dollies under rear wheels.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1508
Fig. 11 Front-End Lifted Towing - Typical
If a vehicle cannot be towed from the rear, the front-end raised towing method normally can be
used (Fig. 11).
1. Center the sling with the bumper and position it at the frame front crossmember.
CAUTION: Use tow chains with J-hooks for connecting to the disabled vehicle's lower suspension
arms. Never use T-hooks.
2. Route the J-hooks and tow chains over the steering linkage outboard of the coil spring. 3. Attach
the J-hooks to the outer end of the lower suspension arms. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Attach the
safety chains to the disabled vehicle at the frame rails.
Towing When Keys Are Not Available When the vehicle is locked and keys are not available, use a
flat bed hauler. A Wheel-lift or Sling-type device can be used provided all the wheels are lifted off
the ground using tow dollies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1509
Towing Information: Vehicle Damage Warnings
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TOWING RECOMMENDATIONS
CAUTION: Many vehicles are equipped with air dams, spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. To
avoid component damage, a wheel-lift towing vehicle or a flat-bed hauling vehicle is recommended.
Fig. 9 Tow Vehicles With Approved Equipment
A vehicle equipped with SAE approved sling-type towing equipment, a wheel-lift towing device or a
vehicle with a flat-bed device can be used to transport all RAM VAN or WAGON vehicles (Fig. 9). A
wooden crossbeam may be required for proper connection when using the sling-type, front-end
towing method.
Safety Precautions NOTE: The following safety precautions must be observed when towing a
vehicle.
- Secure loose and protruding parts.
- Always use a safety chain system that is independent of the lifting and towing equipment.
- Do not allow towing equipment to contact the disabled vehicle's fuel tank.
- Do not allow anyone under the disabled vehicle while it is lifted by the towing device.
- Do not allow passengers to ride in a vehicle being towed.
- Always observe state and local laws regarding towing regulations.
- Do not tow a vehicle in a manner that could jeopardize the safety of the operator, pedestrians or
other motorists.
- Do not attach tow chains, T-hooks, J-hooks, or a tow sling to a bumper, steering linkage, drive
shafts or a non-reinforced frame hole.
- Remove exhaust pipe tips that interfere with the tow sling and crossbar
- Padding should be placed between the tow sling/crossbar and any painted surfaces
- When placing tow hooks on the rear axle, position them so they do not damage the brake tubing
or hoses
- Do not tow the vehicle by connecting to the front or rear shock absorbers
- Do not tow a heavily loaded vehicle. Damage to the vehicle may result. Use a flatbed device to
transport a loaded vehicle.
Ground Clearance
CAUTION: If vehicle is towed with wheels removed, install lug nuts to retain brake drums.
A towed vehicle should be raised until lifted wheels are a minimum 100 mm (4 in) from the ground.
Be sure there is adequate ground clearance at the opposite end of the vehicle, especially when
towing over rough terrain, steep rises in the road or if the vehicle is equipped with air dams,
spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. If necessary, remove the wheels from the lifted end of the
vehicle and lower the vehicle closer to the ground, to increase the ground clearance at the opposite
end of the vehicle. Install lug nuts on wheel attaching studs to retain brake drums.
Ramp Angle If a vehicle with flat-bed towing equipment is used, the approach ramp angle should
not exceed 15 degrees.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1510
Towing-Rear End Lifted
CAUTION: Do not use steering column lock to secure steering wheel during towing operation.
Vehicles can be towed with the front wheels on the ground for extended distances at speeds not
exceeding 48 km/h (30 mph).
Fig. 10 Rear-End Lifted Towing
1. Attach the J-hooks around the axle shaft tubes outboard of the rear springs (Fig. 10). 2. Position
and center the sling under and forward of the rear bumper. 3. Attach safety chains (with pads) at
each end of the rear bumper. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position to unlock the steering
wheel. 5. Clamp the steering wheel with the front wheels in the straight ahead position. 6. Shift the
transmission to NEUTRAL.
Towing-Front End Lifted Provided the transmission is operable, tow only in NEUTRAL at speeds
not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h) and distances less than 15 miles (25km/h).
If the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 miles, the propeller shaft should be disconnected or
place tow dollies under rear wheels.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Towing Information > System Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1511
Fig. 11 Front-End Lifted Towing - Typical
If a vehicle cannot be towed from the rear, the front-end raised towing method normally can be
used (Fig. 11).
1. Center the sling with the bumper and position it at the frame front crossmember.
CAUTION: Use tow chains with J-hooks for connecting to the disabled vehicle's lower suspension
arms. Never use T-hooks.
2. Route the J-hooks and tow chains over the steering linkage outboard of the coil spring. 3. Attach
the J-hooks to the outer end of the lower suspension arms. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Attach the
safety chains to the disabled vehicle at the frame rails.
Towing When Keys Are Not Available When the vehicle is locked and keys are not available, use a
flat bed hauler. A Wheel-lift or Sling-type device can be used provided all the wheels are lifted off
the ground using tow dollies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information
Vehicle Lifting: Technician Safety Information
STANDARD PROCEDURE - HOISTING RECOMMENDATIONS
Refer to the Owner's Manual for emergency vehicle lifting procedures.
WARNING: THE HOISTING AND JACK LIFTING POINTS PROVIDED ARE FOR A COMPLETE
VEHICLE. WHEN A CHASSIS OR DRIVETRAIN COMPONENT IS REMOVED FROM A
VEHICLE, THE CENTER OF GRAVITY IS ALTERED MAKING SOME HOISTING CONDITIONS
UNSTABLE. PROPERLY SUPPORT OR SECURE VEHICLE TO HOISTING DEVICE WHEN
THESE CONDITIONS EXIST.
Fig. 7 Correct Vehicle Lifting Locations
Floor Jack When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift a Ram Van or Wagon (Fig. 7).
Support the vehicle in the raised position with jack stands at the front and rear ends of the frame
rails.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a CNG Ram Van/Wagon with a floor jack positioned under:
- Body side sill
- Steering linkage component
- Drive shaft
- Engine or transmission oil pan
- Fuel cylinder
- Front suspension arm
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a vehicle with a floor jack positioned under: An axle tube.
- A body side sill.
- A steering linkage component.
- A drive shaft.
- The engine or transmission oil pan.
- The fuel tank.
- A front suspension arm.
Hoist A vehicle can be lifted with: A single-post, frame-contact hoist.
- A twin-post, chassis hoist.
- A ramp-type, drive-on hoist.
NOTE: When a frame-contact type hoist is used, verify that the lifting pads are positioned properly
(Fig. 7).
WARNING: WHEN A SERVICE PROCEDURE REQUIRES THE REMOVAL OF THE REAR AXLE,
FUEL CYLINDER OR SPARE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1516
TIRE; EITHER:
- Place additional weight on the rear end of the vehicle
- Attach the vehicle to the hoist
- Place jack stands under the vehicle for support to prevent tipping when the center of balance
changes
A CNG Ram Van/Wagon can be lifted with: Twin post, chassis hoist
- Twin post, wheel lift hoist
- Ramp type, drive on hoist
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1517
Vehicle Lifting: Vehicle Damage Warnings
STANDARD PROCEDURE - HOISTING RECOMMENDATIONS
Refer to the Owner's Manual for emergency vehicle lifting procedures.
WARNING: THE HOISTING AND JACK LIFTING POINTS PROVIDED ARE FOR A COMPLETE
VEHICLE. WHEN A CHASSIS OR DRIVETRAIN COMPONENT IS REMOVED FROM A
VEHICLE, THE CENTER OF GRAVITY IS ALTERED MAKING SOME HOISTING CONDITIONS
UNSTABLE. PROPERLY SUPPORT OR SECURE VEHICLE TO HOISTING DEVICE WHEN
THESE CONDITIONS EXIST.
Fig. 7 Correct Vehicle Lifting Locations
Floor Jack When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift a Ram Van or Wagon (Fig. 7).
Support the vehicle in the raised position with jack stands at the front and rear ends of the frame
rails.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a CNG Ram Van/Wagon with a floor jack positioned under:
- Body side sill
- Steering linkage component
- Drive shaft
- Engine or transmission oil pan
- Fuel cylinder
- Front suspension arm
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a vehicle with a floor jack positioned under: An axle tube.
- A body side sill.
- A steering linkage component.
- A drive shaft.
- The engine or transmission oil pan.
- The fuel tank.
- A front suspension arm.
Hoist A vehicle can be lifted with: A single-post, frame-contact hoist.
- A twin-post, chassis hoist.
- A ramp-type, drive-on hoist.
NOTE: When a frame-contact type hoist is used, verify that the lifting pads are positioned properly
(Fig. 7).
WARNING: WHEN A SERVICE PROCEDURE REQUIRES THE REMOVAL OF THE REAR AXLE,
FUEL CYLINDER OR SPARE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 1518
TIRE; EITHER:
- Place additional weight on the rear end of the vehicle
- Attach the vehicle to the hoist
- Place jack stands under the vehicle for support to prevent tipping when the center of balance
changes
A CNG Ram Van/Wagon can be lifted with: Twin post, chassis hoist
- Twin post, wheel lift hoist
- Ramp type, drive on hoist
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure 170-225 psi
Max. Variation Between Cylinders 25 percent
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 1524
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the PDC. 5. Be sure throttle blade is fully open
during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gauge adaptor Special Tool 8116 or the
equivalent, into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Connect the 0-500 psi (Blue)
pressure transducer (Special Tool CH7059) with cable adaptors to the DRB III.
7. Crank engine until maximum pressure is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder
pressure. 8. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 9. Compression should not be
less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder.
10. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression
test. 11. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second
compression test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Bearing: > 09-007-04 >
Mar > 04 > Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound
Camshaft Bearing: Customer Interest Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound
NUMBER: 09-007-04
GROUP: Engine
DATE: March 2, 2004
SUBJECT: Irregular Engine Snapping Sound
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves chamfering the bore radius on cam bearing caps through L5 and
R2 through R5.
MODELS:
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2003 - 2004 (PL) Neon
2001 - 2004 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 2.0L, 2.4L DOHC or 2.4L Turbo engine (sales
code ECC, EDZ, ED1, EDV, ED2 or EDT).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The sound may be noticed when the engine is idling in park between idle rpm and 1400 rpm at
normal operating temperature. The sound is on the upper end of the engine (cylinder head)
towards the front of the engine or passenger side (right side). The sound is irregular, not periodic or
harmonious. The frequency of the sound will increase with RPM. The sound is more of a higher
pitch snapping noise not a low metallic knock.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition and the technician determines that the
sound is from the upper end of the engine (cylinder head) towards the front of the engine or
passenger side (right side), perform the Repair Procedure.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the cylinder head cover (Refer to information available in TechCONNECT 9 ENGINE/CYLINDER HEAD COVER - Removal)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Bearing: > 09-007-04 >
Mar > 04 > Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound > Page 1534
2. Remove L2 cam bearing cap (Fig. 1).
NOTE:
Do not remove the # L1/R1 or L6 cam bearing caps, or loosen the fasteners.
NOTE:
Only remove one cam bearing cap at a time.
3. Lightly chamfer the two bore radius edges with a small hand file, creating a 45° chamfer 1.0 to
1.5 mm in width along the edge of each bore radius (Fig. 2).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to scratch bore surface of cam bearing cap. Chamfer both bore radius.
4. Clean part to remove any aluminum filings prior to reinstalling.
5. Reinstall L2 cam bearing cap by loosely assembling fasteners. Prior to and during the torquing of
each fastener, twist the cam bearing cap by hand in a clockwise direction, as viewed from the top
of the engine. Torque M6 fasteners to 12 N.m (105 in. lbs.) while maintaining a clockwise twisting
force on the cam bearing cap.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 4 for cam bearing caps L3, L4, L51 R2, R3, R4, R5 and R6.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Bearing: > 09-007-04 >
Mar > 04 > Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound > Page 1535
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Bearing: >
09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound
Camshaft Bearing: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound
NUMBER: 09-007-04
GROUP: Engine
DATE: March 2, 2004
SUBJECT: Irregular Engine Snapping Sound
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves chamfering the bore radius on cam bearing caps through L5 and
R2 through R5.
MODELS:
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2003 - 2004 (PL) Neon
2001 - 2004 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 2.0L, 2.4L DOHC or 2.4L Turbo engine (sales
code ECC, EDZ, ED1, EDV, ED2 or EDT).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The sound may be noticed when the engine is idling in park between idle rpm and 1400 rpm at
normal operating temperature. The sound is on the upper end of the engine (cylinder head)
towards the front of the engine or passenger side (right side). The sound is irregular, not periodic or
harmonious. The frequency of the sound will increase with RPM. The sound is more of a higher
pitch snapping noise not a low metallic knock.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition and the technician determines that the
sound is from the upper end of the engine (cylinder head) towards the front of the engine or
passenger side (right side), perform the Repair Procedure.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove the cylinder head cover (Refer to information available in TechCONNECT 9 ENGINE/CYLINDER HEAD COVER - Removal)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Bearing: >
09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound > Page 1541
2. Remove L2 cam bearing cap (Fig. 1).
NOTE:
Do not remove the # L1/R1 or L6 cam bearing caps, or loosen the fasteners.
NOTE:
Only remove one cam bearing cap at a time.
3. Lightly chamfer the two bore radius edges with a small hand file, creating a 45° chamfer 1.0 to
1.5 mm in width along the edge of each bore radius (Fig. 2).
CAUTION:
Be careful not to scratch bore surface of cam bearing cap. Chamfer both bore radius.
4. Clean part to remove any aluminum filings prior to reinstalling.
5. Reinstall L2 cam bearing cap by loosely assembling fasteners. Prior to and during the torquing of
each fastener, twist the cam bearing cap by hand in a clockwise direction, as viewed from the top
of the engine. Torque M6 fasteners to 12 N.m (105 in. lbs.) while maintaining a clockwise twisting
force on the cam bearing cap.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 4 for cam bearing caps L3, L4, L51 R2, R3, R4, R5 and R6.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Bearing: >
09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Engine - Irregular Snapping Sound > Page 1542
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Bearing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1543
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications
Bearing Clearance- Diametrical 0.0021 - 0.0037 inch
Bearing Clearance (Max. Allowable) 0.0047 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Torque
Torque
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt 85 ft.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
REMOVAL - CAMSHAFT SPROCKET
1. Remove timing belt.
2. Hold camshaft sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and modified Adaptor C-4687-1 (Fig. 170),
while removing attaching bolt.
NOTE: For Special Tool Identification, Refer to SPECIAL TOOLS.
3. Remove camshaft sprocket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 1549
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Installation
CAMSHAFT SPROCKET
1. Install camshaft sprocket. While holding sprockets with Special Tools C-4687 and modified
Adaptor C-4687-1, tighten attaching bolt to 115 Nm
(85 ft. lbs.).
2. Install timing belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft: Specifications
Journal Diameter No.1 1.619-1.6199 in.
No.2 1.634 - 1.635 inch
No.3 1.650 - 1.651 inch
No.4 1.666 - 1.668 inch
No.5 1.682 - 1.6829 inch
Bearing Clearance- Diametrical 0.0021 - 0.0037 inch
Bearing Clearance (Max. Allowable) 0.0047 inch
End Play 0.002 - 0.015 inch
Lift (Zero Lash) Standard Engine Intake 0.283 inch
Exhaust 0.277 inch
Lift (Zero Lash)-High Output R/T Engine Intake 0.335 inch
Exhaust 0.315 inch
Exhaust Valve Timing" Standard Engine Closes (ATDC) 5.4°
*All readings in crankshaft degrees, at 0.5 mm (0.019 inch)
of valve lift.
Opens (BBDC) 43.7°
Duration 229.1°
Exhaust Valve Timing" High Output R/T Engine Closes (ATDC) 2.8°
*All readings in crankshaft degrees, at 0.5 mm (0.019 inch)
of valve lift.
Opens (BBDC) 45.7°
Duration 228.6°
Intake Valve Timing* Standard Engine Closes (ABDC) 41.1°
*All readings in crankshaft degrees, at 0.5 mm (0.019 inch)
of valve lift.
Opens (ATDC) 13.9°
Duration 207.2°
Valve Overlap None
Intake Valve Timing* High Output R/T Engine Closes (ABDC) 45.8°
*All readings in crankshaft degrees, at 0.5 mm (0.019 inch)
of valve lift.
Opens (ATDC) 12.6°
Duration 213.2°
Valve Overlap None
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1553
Camshaft: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The camshaft is made of nodular iron with five bearing journal surfaces and three cam lobes per
cylinder. Provision for a cam position sensor is provided on the rear of the camshaft. The camshaft
position sensor bolts to the rear of the cylinder head and also controls camshaft thrust. A
hydrodynamic oil seal is used for oil control at the front of the camshaft.
OPERATION
The camshaft is driven by the crankshaft via drive sprockets and belt. The camshaft has precisely
machined lobes to provide accurate valve timing and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1554
Camshaft: Testing and Inspection
CAMSHAFT END-PLAY
1. Measure camshaft end play using the following procedure:
a. Mount dial indicator C-3339 or equivalent, to a stationary point on cylinder head (Fig. 23). b.
Using a suitable tool, move camshaft to rear-ward limits of travel. c. Zero the dial indicator. d. Move
camshaft forward to limits of travel and read dial indicator. e. End play travel: 0.13 - 0.33 mm
(0.005 - 0.013 inch).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1555
Camshaft: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect positive battery cable. Remove the
battery. 3. Disconnect the IAT sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the following:
^ Air intake duct at throttle body
^ Throttle cables
^ TPS and JAC connectors
^ Make-up air hose at air cleaner housing
5. Remove the air cleaner housing assembly. 6. Remove the battery tray. 7. Remove the front
timing belt cover, timing belt, and tensioner. 8. Remove the camshaft sprocket and rear timing belt
cover. 9. Remove the cylinder head cover.
10. Mark rocker arm shaft assemblies so that they are installed in their original positions. 11.
Remove rocker arm and shafts assembly. 12. Drain cooling system below heater hose level. 13.
Disconnect the ECT sensor electrical connector. 14. Disconnect hoses from heater supply and
return tubes. 15. Remove heater tube support bracket bolts at rear of cylinder head.
16. Remove PDC attaching screws and reposition for camshaft removal clearance. 17. Remove
camshaft sensor and camshaft target magnet. 18. Carefully remove camshaft from the rear of
cylinder head. Reposition heater tubes and PDC for camshaft clearance (Fig. 24). 19. Remove the
camshaft seal.
CLEANING
Clean camshaft with a suitable solvent.
INSPECTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1556
1. Inspect camshaft bearing journals for damage and binding (Fig. 25). If journals are binding,
check the cylinder head for damage. Also check
cylinder head oil holes for clogging.
2. Check the cam lobe and bearing surfaces for abnormal wear and damage. Replace camshaft if
defective.
NOTE: If camshaft is replaced due to lobe wear or damage, always replace the rocker arms.
3. Measure the lobe actual wear (unworn area wear zone = actual wear) (Fig. 25) and replace
camshaft if out of limit. Standard value is 0.0254 mm
(0.001 inch), wear limit is 0.254 mm (0.010 inch).
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the camshaft journals with oil.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1557
2. Carefully install the camshaft into the cylinder head. Reposition the PDC and heater tubes for
clearance (Fig. 24). 3. Install camshaft target magnet into the end of the camshaft. Tighten
mounting screw to 3.4 Nm (30 in. lbs.). 4. Install camshaft position sensor. 5. Measure camshaft
end-play.
NOTE: Camshaft must be installed before installation of the camshaft seal.
6. Install camshaft seal. 7. Install rear timing belt cover. 8. Install the camshaft sprocket on the
camshaft.
CAUTION: DO NOT use an impact wrench (or any other air operated tool) for tightening the
camshaft sprocket bolt. Damage to the camshaft timing pin can result. ONLY use a hand wrench
while holding camshaft sprocket with Special Tool.
9. Install camshaft sprocket retaining bolt. While holding sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and
modified Adaptor C-4687-1, tighten attaching bolt
to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
10. Install timing belt and tensioner. 11. Install front timing belt cover.
12. Install rocker arm assemblies in correct order as removed. Tighten the rocker arm assemblies
in sequence shown in (Fig. 26) to 28 Nm (250 in.
lbs.).
13. Install the cylinder head cover. 14. Install ignition coil and spark plug cables. Tighten ignition
coil fasteners to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 15. Install the heater tube bracket attaching bolt. 16. Connect
the heater hoses to the heater tubes. 17. Connect the ECT electrical connector. 18. Install the PDC
attaching screws. 19. Install the battery tray. 20. Install the air cleaner housing assembly. 21.
Connect the following:
^ Air intake duct at throttle body
^ Throttle cables
^ TPS and JAC connectors
^ Make-up air hose at air cleaner housing
22. Connect the IAT sensor. 23. Install battery. Connect positive battery cable. 24. Connect
negative battery cable. 25. Refill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1558
26. Perform camshaft and crankshaft timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB 1116 scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located
in the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
"For information regarding this component please refer to Rocker Arm Testing and Inspection"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1562
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to Rocker Arm service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications
Rocker Arm Shaft-Bolts 250 in.lbs.
Rocker Arm Shaft Rocker Arm Shaft Diameter 0.7861 - 0.7868 inch
Rocker Arm Shaft Retainers Intake-Width 1.1193 - 1.1217 inch
Exhaust-Width 1 & 5 1.1477 - 1.1516 inch
Exhaust-Width 2,3, and 4 1.5906 - 1.5945 inch
Rocker Arm/Hydraulic Lash Adjuster Rocker Arm Inside Diameter 0.787 - 0.788 inch
Rocker Arm Shaft Clearance 0.0006 - 0.0021 inch
Body Diameter 0.9035 - 0.9040 inch
Plunger Travel Minimum (Dry) 0.087 inch
Dry Lash-Intake 0.039 inch
Dry Lash-Exhaust 0.055 inch
Rocker Arm Ratio 1.4 to 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1566
Rocker Arm Assembly: Testing and Inspection
HYDRAULIC LASH ADJUSTER NOISE DIAGNOSIS
A tappet-like noise may be produced from several items. Check the following items. 1. Engine oil
level too high or too low. This may cause aerated oil to enter the adjusters and cause them to be
spongy 2. Insufficient running time after rebuilding cylinder head. Low speed running up to 1 hour
may be required. 3. During this time, turn engine off and let set for a few minutes before restarting.
Repeat this several times after engine has reached normal operating
temperature.
4. Low oil pressure. 5. The oil restrictor (integral to the head gasket) in the vertical oil passage to
the cylinder head is plugged with debris. 6. Air ingested into oil due to broken or cracked oil pump
pick up. 7. Worn valve guides. 8. Rocker arm ears contacting valve spring retainer. 9. Rocker arm
loose, adjuster stuck or at maximum extension and still leaves lash in the system.
10. Faulty lash adjuster. e Check lash adjusters for sponginess while installed in cylinder head.
Depress part of rocker arm over adjuster. Normal
adjusters should feel very firm. Spongy adjusters can be bottomed out easily. ^
Remove suspected lash adjusters, and replace as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1567
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover. 2. Identify the rocker arm shaft assemblies before removal. 3.
Loosen the attaching fasteners. Remove rocker arm shaft assemblies from cylinder head.
4. Identify the rocker arms spacers and retainers for reassembly. Disassemble the rocker arm
assemblies by removing the attaching bolts from the
shaft (Fig. 37).
5. Slide the rocker arms and spacers off the shaft. Keep the spacers and rocker arms in the same
location for reassembly.
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the rocker arm for scoring, wear on the roller or damage to the rocker arm (Fig. 38).
Replace as necessary. 2. Check the location where the rocker arms mount to the shafts for wear or
damage. Replace if damaged or worn. 3. The rocker arm shaft is hollow and is used as a
lubrication oil duct. Check oil holes for clogging with small wire, clean as required.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Set crankshaft to 3 notches before TDC before installing rocker arm shafts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1568
1. Lubricate the rocker arms and spacers. Install onto shafts in their original position (Fig. 37). 2.
Install rocker arm/hydraulic lash adjuster assembly making sure that adjusters are at least partially
full of oil. This is indicated by little or no
plunger travel when the lash adjuster is depressed. If there is excessive plunger travel. Place the
rocker arm assembly into clean engine oil and pump the plunger until the lash adjuster travel is
taken up. If travel is not reduced, replace the assembly. Hydraulic lash adjuster and rocker arm are
serviced as an assembly
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1569
3. Install rocker arm and shaft assemblies with NOTCH in the rocker arm shafts pointing up and
toward the timing belt side of the engine (Fig. 39).
Install the retainers in their original positions on the exhaust and intake shafts (Fig. 37).
CAUTION: When installing the intake rocker arm shaft assembly be sure that the plastic spacers
do not interfere with the spark plug tubes. If the spacers do interfere rotate until they are at the
proper angle. To avoid damaging the spark plug tubes, do not attempt rotating the spacers by
forcing down the shaft assembly.
4. Tighten bolts to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.) in sequence shown in (Fig. 40). 5. Install the cylinder head
cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Bearing Clearance 0.001 - 0.0023 inch
Side Clearance 0.005 - 0.015 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1574
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
CONNECTING ROD AND BEARING - FITTING
1. Measure connecting rod bearing clearance using Plastigage (Fig. 54).
CAUTION: Do not rotate crankshaft or the Plastigage may be smeared.
NOTE: The rod bearing bolts should not be reused.
2. Before installing NEW bolts, lubricate the threads with clean engine oil. 3. Install each bolt finger
tight than alternately torque each bolt to assemble the cap properly. 4. Tighten the bolts to 27 Nm
PLUS 1/4 turn (20 ft. lbs. PLUS 1/4 turn) Do not use a torque wrench for last step. 5. Using a feeler
gauge, check connecting rod side clearance (Fig. 55).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Connecting Rod
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Bearing Clearance 0.001 - 0.0023 in
Wear Limit 0.003 in
Bore Diameter - Piston Pin 0.8252 - 0.8260 in
Bore Diameter - Crankshaft end 2.0075 - 2.0081 in
Side Clearance 0.005 - 0.015 in
Side Clearance Wear Limit 0.016 in
Weight - Total (Less Bearing) 1.20 lb (US)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Connecting Rod > Page 1579
Connecting Rod: Specifications Connecting Rod Bolt/Nut
Connecting Rod Cap Bolts
..................................................................................................................................................... 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.) + 1/4 turn
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1580
Connecting Rod: Description and Operation
"For information regarding this component please refer to Piston description and Operation"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1581
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair
CONNECTING ROD AND BEARING - FITTING
1. Measure connecting rod bearing clearance using Plastigage (Fig. 54).
CAUTION: Do not rotate crankshaft or the Plastigage may be smeared.
NOTE: The rod bearing bolts should not be reused.
2. Before installing NEW bolts, lubricate the threads with clean engine oil. 3. Install each bolt finger
tight than alternately torque each bolt to assemble the cap properly. 4. Tighten the bolts to 27 Nm
PLUS 1/4 turn (20 ft. lbs. PLUS 1/4 turn) Do not use a torque wrench for last step. 5. Using a feeler
gauge, check connecting rod side clearance (Fig. 55).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL - CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
1. Remove timing belt
2. Remove the crankshaft sprocket using Special Tool 6793 and insert C-4685-C2 (Fig. 171).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1586
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Installation
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
NOTE: Make sure the word "front" on the sprocket is facing outward.
CAUTION: Use of Special Tool 6792 is required to install the crankshaft sprocket to the proper
depth. Failure to use this tool will cause improper timing belt tracking.
1. Install the crankshaft sprocket (Fig. 172) using Special Tool 6792.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Service Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Main Bearing Diametrical Clearance 0.0008 - 0.0024 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Service Specifications > Page 1591
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications Torque Specifications
1. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts 11, 17 and 20 finger tight. Tighten these bolts
down together until the bedplate contacts the
cylinder block.
2. Tighten bolts 1 - 10 to 81 Nm (60 ft. lbs.). 3. Tighten bolts 11 - 20, with baffle studs in positions
12, 13 and 16, to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1592
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
Main Bearing Fitting
The crankshaft is supported in five main bearings. All upper and lower bearing shells in the
crankcase have oil grooves. The number three lower main thrust bearing is plain. Crankshaft end
play is controlled by a flanged bearing on the number three main bearing journal (Fig. 66). Upper
and lower Number 3 bearing halves are flanged to carry the crankshaft thrust loads and are NOT
interchangeable with any other bearing halves in the engine (Fig. 66). All bearing cap bolts
removed during service procedures are to be cleaned and oiled before installation. Bearing shells
are available in standard and the following undersized: 0.025 mm (0.001 inch) and 0.250 mm
(0.010 inch). Never install an undersize bearing that will reduce clearance below specifications.
MAIN BEARING INSTALLATION
1. Install the main bearing shells with the lubrication groove in the cylinder block (Fig. 67). 2. Make
certain oil holes in block line up with oil holes in bearings. Bearing tabs must seat in the block tab
slots.
CAUTION: Do not get oil on the bedplate mating surface. It will may effect the sealer ability to seal
the bedplate to cylinder block.
3. Oil the bearings and journals and install crankshaft.
CAUTION: Use only the specified anaerobic sealer on the bedplate or damage may occur to the
engine. Ensure that both cylinder block and bedplate surfaces are clean.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1593
4. Apply 1.5 to 2.0 mm (0.059 to 0.078 inch) bead of anaerobic sealer Mopar Bed Plate Sealant to
cylinder block as shown in (Fig. 68). 5. Install lower main bearings into main bearing cap/bedplate.
Make certain the bearing tabs are seated into the bedplate slots. 6. Position the main
bearing/bedplate onto the engine block. 7. Before installing bolts, lubricate the threads with clean
engine oil, wipe off any excess oil. 8. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts 11, 17 and
20 finger tight. Tighten these bolts down together until the bedplate contacts the
cylinder block.
9. To ensure correct thrust bearing alignment, perform the following steps: e Step 1: Rotate
crankshaft until number 4 piston is at TDC.
^ Step 2: Move crankshaft rearward to limits of travel.
^ Step 3: Then, move crankshaft forward to limits of travel.
^ Step 4: Wedge an appropriate tool between the rear of the cylinder block (NOT BED PLATE) and
the rear crankshaft counterweight. This will hold the crankshaft in it's furthest forward position.
^ Step 5: Install and tighten bolts (1-10) in sequence shown in (Fig. 69) to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
^ Step 6: Remove wedge tool used to hold crankshaft.
10. Tighten bolts (1-10) again to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) + 1/4 turn in sequence shown in (Fig. 69). 11.
Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts (11-20), and torque each bolt to 28 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.) in sequence shown in (Fig. 69). 12. After the main bearing bedplate is installed, check the
crankshaft turning torque. The turning torque should not exceed 5.6 Nm (50 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Connecting Rod Journal Diameter 1.8894 - 1.8900 ft
Main Bearing Journal Diameter 2.0469 - 2.0475 in
Journal Out of Round 0.0001 in
Journal Taper 0.0001 in
End Play 0.0035 - 0.0094 in
End Play Wear Limit 0.015 in
Main Bearing Diametrical Clearance 0.0008 - 0.0024 in
Crankshaft Main Bearing Cap/Bedplate M8 Bolts 25 ft.lb
Crankshaft Main Bearing Cap/Bedplate M11 Bolts 60 ft.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1597
Crankshaft: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft is made of nodular cast iron and includes five main bearing journals and four
connecting rod journals (Fig. 56). The number three journal is the location for the thrust bearing.
The mains and connecting rod journals have undercut fillet radiuses that are rolled for added
strength. To optimize bearing loading, eight counterweights are used.
OPERATION
The crankshaft transfers force generated by combustion within the cylinder to the flywheel or
flexplate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Crankshaft: Procedures
CRANKSHAFT END PLAY
1. Mount a dial indicator to front of engine, locating probe on nose of the crankshaft (Fig. 57). 2.
Move crankshaft all the way to the rear of its travel. 3. Zero the dial indicator. 4. Move crankshaft all
the way to the front of its travel and read the dial indicator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1600
Crankshaft: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove engine assembly. 2. Separate transaxle from engine. 3. Remove drive plate/flexplate. 4.
Remove crankshaft rear oil seal. 5. Mount engine on a suitable repair stand. 6. Remove crankshaft
vibration damper. 7. Remove engine mount bracket and front timing belt cover. 8. Remove the
timing belt. 9. Remove the timing belt tensioner.
10. Remove camshaft sprocket and rear timing belt cover. 11. Remove crankshaft sprocket.
12. Remove lower torque strut/air conditioning compressor mounting bracket from engine (Fig. 58).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1601
13. Remove oil filter and adapter (Fig. 59). 14. Remove oil pan. 15. Remove oil pump pick-up tube.
16. Remove oil pump. 17. Remove crankshaft position sensor (Fig. 59). 18. Using a permanent ink
or paint marker, identify cylinder number on each connecting rod cap.
CAUTION: DO NOT use a number stamp or a punch to mark connecting rods. Damage to
connecting rod could occur.
19. Remove all connecting rod bolts and caps. Care should be taken not to damage the fracture
rod and cap surfaces.
NOTE: Do not reuse connecting rod bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1602
20. Remove all main bearing cap and bedplate bolts from the engine block (Fig. 60). 21. Using a
mallet tap the bedplate loose from the engine block dowel pins.
CAUTION: Do not pry up on one side of the bedplate. Damage may occur to cylinder block and
bedplate alignment.
22. Bedplate should be removed evenly from the cylinder block dowel pins. 23. Lift out crankshaft
from cylinder block. Be sure not to damage the main bearings or journals when removing the
crankshaft.
CRANKSHAFT MAIN BEARINGS LOCATION
The crankshaft is supported in five main bearings. All upper bearing shells in the crankcase have
oil grooves. All lower bearing shells installed in the (bedplate) main bearing cap are plain.
Crankshaft end play is controlled by a flanged bearing on the number three main bearing journal
(Fig. 61).
NOTE: The upper and lower main Bearing shells are Not interchangeable. The lower shells have a
revised tab to prevent improper installation.
INSPECTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1603
The crankshaft journals should be checked for excessive wear, taper and scoring (Fig. 62). Limits
of taper or out of round on any crankshaft journals should be held to 0.025 mm (0.001 inch).
Journal grinding should not exceed 0.305 mm (0.012 inch) under the standard journal diameter.
DO NOT grind thrust faces of No. 3 main bearing. DO NOT nick crank pin or bearing fillets. After
grinding, remove rough edges from crankshaft oil holes and clean out all passages.
CAUTION: With the nodular cast iron crankshafts, it is important that the final paper or cloth polish
be in the same direction as normal rotation in the engine.
Upper and lower No. 3 bearing halves are flanged to carry the crankshaft thrust loads and are NOT
interchangeable with any other bearing halves in the engine (Fig. 61). All bearing cap bolts
removed during service procedures are to be cleaned and oiled before installation. Bearing shells
are available in standard and the following undersized: 0.016 mm (0.0006 inch), 0.032 mm (0.0012
inch), 0.250 mm (0.010 inch). Never install an undersize bearing that will reduce clearance below
specifications.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1604
1. Install the upper main bearing shells with the lubrication groove in the cylinder block. Install
O-ring into recess in the block (Fig. 63). 2. Make certain oil holes in block line up with oil hole in
bearings and bearing tabs seat in the block tab slots.
CAUTION: Do Not get oil on the bedplate mating surface. It will affect the sealer ability to seal the
bedplate to cylinder block.
3. Oil the bearings and journals and install crankshaft in cylinder block.
CAUTION: Use only the specified anaerobic sealer on the bedplate or damage may occur to the
engine.
4. Apply 1.5 - 2.0 mm (0.059 - 0.078 inch) bead of Mopar Bed Plate Sealant to cylinder block as
shown in (Fig. 64). 5. Install lower main bearings into main bearing cap/bedplate. Make certain the
bearing tabs are seated into the bedplate slots. Install the main
bearing/bedplate into engine block.
6. Before installing the bolts oil threads with clean engine oil, wipe off any excess oil.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1605
7. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts 11, 17 and 20 finger tight. Tighten these bolts
down together until the bedplate contacts the
cylinder block (Fig. 65).
8. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts (1-10) and torque each bolt to 81 Nm (60 ft.
lbs.) in sequence shown in (Fig. 65). 9. Install main bearing bedplate to engine block bolts (11-20),
with baffle studs in positions 12, 13 and 16 and torque each bolt to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
in sequence shown in (Fig. 65).
10. After the main bearing bedplate is installed, check the crankshaft turning torque. The turning
torque should not exceed 5.6 Nm (50 in. lbs.). 11. Check crankshaft end play. 12. Install connecting
rod bearings and caps. Install new connecting rod bolts and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) plus 1/4
turn. 13. Install oil pump and crankshaft front oil seal. 14. Install oil pick-up tube and oil pan. 15.
Install oil filter adapter and oil filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1606
16. Install lower torque strut/air conditioning compressor mounting bracket to engine (Fig. 58). 17.
Install timing belt rear cover and camshaft sprocket. 18. Install the crankshaft sprocket. 19. Install
the timing belt tensioner. 20. Install the timing belt. 21. Install front timing belt cover and engine
mount bracket. 22. Remove engine from repair stand and position on Special Tools 6135 and 6710
Engine Dolly and Cradle. Install safety straps around the engine to
cradle and tighten and lock them into position.
23. Install the crankshaft rear oil seal. 24. Install the flex plate. 25. Install the transaxle to engine.
26. Install the engine assembly. 27. Perform camshaft and crankshaft timing relearn procedure as
follows:
^ Connect the DRB 1116 scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located
in the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Engine Block Heater: Description and Operation
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER
DESCRIPTION
The heater is mounted in a core hole (in place of a core hole plug) in the engine block, with the
heating element immersed in coolant (Fig. 7). The engine block heater is available as an optional
accessory. The heater is operated by ordinary house current (110 Volt A.C.) through a power cord
and connector behind the radiator grille.
CAUTION: The power cord must be secured in its retainer clips, and not positioned so it could
contact linkages or exhaust manifolds and become damaged.
OPERATION
The block heater element is submerged in the cooling system's coolant. When electrical power
(110 volt A.C.) is applied to the element, it creates heat. This heat is transferred to the engine
coolant. This provides easier engine starting and faster warm-up when vehicle is operated in areas
having extremely low temperatures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1610
Engine Block Heater: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER TESTING
If unit does not operate, trouble can be in either the power cord or the heater element. Test power
cord for continuity with a 110-volt voltmeter or 110volt test light; test heater element continuity with
an ohmmeter or 12-volt test light.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1611
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain the cooling system.
2. Detach power cord plug from heater (Fig. 7). 3. Loosen screw in center of heater. Remove
heater assembly (Fig. 7).
INSTALLATION
1. Thoroughly clean core hole and heater seat.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1612
2. Insert heater assembly with element loop positioned upward (Fig. 7). 3. With heater seated,
tighten center screw securely to assure a positive seal. 4. Connect power cord to block heater (Fig.
7). 5. Fill the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications Torque
Torque
Crankshaft Damper Bolt 100 ft.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1616
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
VIBRATION DAMPER
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist and remove right inner splash shield. 2. Remove accessory drive belts.
3. Remove crankshaft vibration damper bolt. Remove damper using the large side of Special Tool
1026 and insert 6827-A (Fig. 93).
INSTALLATION
1. Install crankshaft vibration damper using M12-1.75 x 150 mm bolt, washer, thrust bearing and
nut from Special Tool 6792 (Fig. 94).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1617
2. Install vibration damper bolt. Using Special Tool 6847 and a torque wrench, tighten bolt to 136
Nm (100 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 95). 3. Install accessory drive belts. 4. Install the right inner splash shield and
lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Piston Diameter 3.4432 - 3.4439 in
Clearance at 0.42 in from bottom of skirt 0.0008 - 0.0020 in
Weight 11.29 - 11.60 oz (US)
Land Clearance Diametrical 0.0299 - 0.0312 in
Piston Length 2.197 inch
Piston Ring Groove Depth Number 1 0.157 - 0.156 in
Number 2 0.176 - 0.184 in
Number 3 0.151 - 0.163 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1621
Piston: Description and Operation
PISTON & CONNECTING ROD
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: The engine DOES NOT have provisions for a free wheeling valve train. Non free wheeling
valve train means, in the event of a broken timing belt, pistons will contact the valves. The pistons
are made of a cast aluminum alloy The pistons have pressed-in pins attached to forged powdered
metal connecting rods. The pistons pin is offset 1 mm (0.0394 inch) towards the thrust side of the
piston. The connecting rods are a cracked cap design and are not repairable. Hex head cap screws
are used to provide alignment and durability in the assembly. The pistons and connecting rods are
serviced as an assembly.
OPERATION
The piston and connecting rod is the link between the combustion force to the crankshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Piston: Procedures
CYLINDER BORE AND PISTON - FITTING
Piston and cylinder wall must be clean and dry. Piston diameter should be measured 90 degrees to
piston pin about 14 mm (9/16 inch.) from the bottom of the skirt as shown in (Fig. 81). Cylinder
bores should be measured halfway down the cylinder bore and transverse (measurement location
B) to the engine crankshaft center line shown in (Fig. 80). Correct piston to bore clearance must be
established in order to assure quiet and economical operation.
NOTE: Pistons and cylinder bores should be measured at normal room temperature, 70° F (21° C).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1624
Piston: Removal and Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head. 2. Remove the oil pan.
3. Remove top ridge of cylinder bores with a reliable ridge reamer before removing pistons from
cylinder block. Be sure to keep tops of pistons
covered during this operation. Mark piston with matching cylinder number (Fig. 82).
CAUTION: DO NOT use a number stamp or a punch to mark connecting rods. Damage to
connecting rod could occur.
4. Using a permanent ink marker or scribe tool mark the cylinder number on the side of the rod and
cap (Fig. 83) for identification. 5. Pistons will have a stamping in the approximate location shown in
(Fig. 82). These stamps will be either a directional arrow or a weight
identification for the assembly. L is for light and H is for heavy. These assemblies should all be the
same weight class. Service piston assemblies are marked with a S and can be used with either L
or H production assemblies. The weight designation stamps should face toward the timing belt side
of the engine.
6. Pistons and connecting rods must be removed from top of cylinder block. Rotate crankshaft so
that each connecting rod is centered in cylinder
bore.
7. Remove connecting rod cap bolts Do not use old bolts if reinstalling connecting rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1625
8. To protect crankshaft journal and fractured rod surfaces, install Special Tool 8189, connecting
rod guides onto connecting rod (Fig. 84). Carefully
push each piston and rod assembly out of cylinder bore.
CAUTION: Care must be taken not to damage the fractured rod and cap joint surfaces, as engine
damage many occur.
9. Remove Special Tool 8189, connecting rod guides and re-install bearing cap on the mating rod.
NOTE: Piston and rods are serviced as an assembly.
10. Remove piston rings.
INSTALLATION
1. Install piston rings on piston. 2. Before installing pistons and connecting rod assemblies into the
bore, ensure the compression ring gaps are staggered, and neither is in line with
the oil ring rail gap.
3. Before installing the ring compressor, ensure the oil ring expander ends are butted and the rail
gaps are located as shown in (Fig. 91).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1626
4. Immerse the piston head and rings in clean engine oil, slide the ring compressor, over the piston
(Fig. 85). Be sure position of rings does not
change during this operation.
5. The weight stamp designation L or H will be in the front half of the piston should face toward the
front of the engine (Fig. 82). 6. Rotate crankshaft so that the connecting rod journal is on the center
of the cylinder bore. Lubricate connecting rod journal with clean engine oil.
7. Position upper bearing half and install Special Tool 8189, connecting rod guides onto connecting
rod (Fig. 84). 8. Insert rod and piston assembly into cylinder bore and carefully guide rod over the
crankshaft journal. 9. Tap the piston down in cylinder bore, using a hammer handle. At the same
time, guide connecting rod into position on connecting rod journal.
10. Remove Special Tool 8189, connecting rod guides. 11. Install connecting rod lower bearing half
and cap. Install New bolts and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) plus 1/4 turn.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 1627
12. Install the cylinder head. 13. Install the oil pan.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Pin: Specifications
Clearance in Piston 0.0003 - 0.0006 inch
Clearance in Connecting Rod Interference
Diameter 0.8268 - 0.8269 inch
End Play None
Length 2.943 - 2.963 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Ring Gap Top Compression Ring 0.009 - 0.020 in
Wear Limit 0.031 in
Ring Gap Second Compression Ring 0.019 - 0.031 in
Wear Limit 0.039 in
Ring Gap Oil Control Steel Rails 0.009 - 0.026 in
Wear Limit 0.039 in
Ring Clearance Compression Rings 0.0010 - 0.0026 in
Wear Limit 0.004 in
Ring Clearance Oil Control Ring 0.0002 - 0.0070 in
Ring Width Compression Rings 0.046 - 0.047 in
Ring Width Oil Control Rings 0.1124 - 0.1184 in
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Piston Ring Fitting
Piston Ring: Service and Repair Piston Ring Fitting
PISTON RING FITTING
1. Wipe cylinder bore clean. Insert ring and push down with piston to ensure it is square in bore.
The ring gap measurement must be made with the
ring positioned below normal ring travel in the cylinder bore. Check gap with feeler gauge (Fig. 86).
2. Check piston ring to groove side clearance (Fig. 87).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Piston Ring Fitting > Page 1636
Piston Ring: Service and Repair Piston Ring - Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Using a suitable ring expander, remove upper and intermediate piston rings (Fig. 88). 2. Remove
the upper oil ring side rail, lower oil ring side rail and then oil ring expander from piston. 3. Clean
ring grooves of any carbon deposits.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The identification mark on face of upper and intermediate piston rings must point toward top
of piston. Install rings with manufacturers identification mark facing up, to the top of the piston (Fig.
89).
CAUTION: Install piston rings in the following order:
^ Oil ring expander.
^ Upper oil ring side rail.
^ Lower oil ring side rail.
^ No. 2 Intermediate piston ring.
^ No. 1 Upper piston ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Piston Ring Fitting > Page 1637
1. Install oil ring expander (Fig. 89).
2. Install upper side rail first and then the lower side rail. Install the side rails by placing one end
between the piston ring groove and the oil ring
expander. Hold end firmly and press down the portion to be installed until side rail is in position. Do
not use a piston ring expander (Fig. 90).
3. Install No. 2 piston ring and then No. 1 piston ring (Fig. 89).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Piston Ring Fitting > Page 1638
4. Position piston ring end gaps as shown in (Fig. 91). 5. Position oil ring expander gap at least 45°
from the side rail gaps but not on the piston pin center or on the thrust direction. Staggering ring
gap is
important for oil control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates that this vehicle has hydraulic lifters or adjusters and therefore does
not require adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1646
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications
Rocker Arm Assembly: Specifications
Rocker Arm Shaft-Bolts 250 in.lbs.
Rocker Arm Shaft Rocker Arm Shaft Diameter 0.7861 - 0.7868 inch
Rocker Arm Shaft Retainers Intake-Width 1.1193 - 1.1217 inch
Exhaust-Width 1 & 5 1.1477 - 1.1516 inch
Exhaust-Width 2,3, and 4 1.5906 - 1.5945 inch
Rocker Arm/Hydraulic Lash Adjuster Rocker Arm Inside Diameter 0.787 - 0.788 inch
Rocker Arm Shaft Clearance 0.0006 - 0.0021 inch
Body Diameter 0.9035 - 0.9040 inch
Plunger Travel Minimum (Dry) 0.087 inch
Dry Lash-Intake 0.039 inch
Dry Lash-Exhaust 0.055 inch
Rocker Arm Ratio 1.4 to 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1650
Rocker Arm Assembly: Testing and Inspection
HYDRAULIC LASH ADJUSTER NOISE DIAGNOSIS
A tappet-like noise may be produced from several items. Check the following items. 1. Engine oil
level too high or too low. This may cause aerated oil to enter the adjusters and cause them to be
spongy 2. Insufficient running time after rebuilding cylinder head. Low speed running up to 1 hour
may be required. 3. During this time, turn engine off and let set for a few minutes before restarting.
Repeat this several times after engine has reached normal operating
temperature.
4. Low oil pressure. 5. The oil restrictor (integral to the head gasket) in the vertical oil passage to
the cylinder head is plugged with debris. 6. Air ingested into oil due to broken or cracked oil pump
pick up. 7. Worn valve guides. 8. Rocker arm ears contacting valve spring retainer. 9. Rocker arm
loose, adjuster stuck or at maximum extension and still leaves lash in the system.
10. Faulty lash adjuster. e Check lash adjusters for sponginess while installed in cylinder head.
Depress part of rocker arm over adjuster. Normal
adjusters should feel very firm. Spongy adjusters can be bottomed out easily. ^
Remove suspected lash adjusters, and replace as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1651
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head cover. 2. Identify the rocker arm shaft assemblies before removal. 3.
Loosen the attaching fasteners. Remove rocker arm shaft assemblies from cylinder head.
4. Identify the rocker arms spacers and retainers for reassembly. Disassemble the rocker arm
assemblies by removing the attaching bolts from the
shaft (Fig. 37).
5. Slide the rocker arms and spacers off the shaft. Keep the spacers and rocker arms in the same
location for reassembly.
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the rocker arm for scoring, wear on the roller or damage to the rocker arm (Fig. 38).
Replace as necessary. 2. Check the location where the rocker arms mount to the shafts for wear or
damage. Replace if damaged or worn. 3. The rocker arm shaft is hollow and is used as a
lubrication oil duct. Check oil holes for clogging with small wire, clean as required.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Set crankshaft to 3 notches before TDC before installing rocker arm shafts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1652
1. Lubricate the rocker arms and spacers. Install onto shafts in their original position (Fig. 37). 2.
Install rocker arm/hydraulic lash adjuster assembly making sure that adjusters are at least partially
full of oil. This is indicated by little or no
plunger travel when the lash adjuster is depressed. If there is excessive plunger travel. Place the
rocker arm assembly into clean engine oil and pump the plunger until the lash adjuster travel is
taken up. If travel is not reduced, replace the assembly. Hydraulic lash adjuster and rocker arm are
serviced as an assembly
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1653
3. Install rocker arm and shaft assemblies with NOTCH in the rocker arm shafts pointing up and
toward the timing belt side of the engine (Fig. 39).
Install the retainers in their original positions on the exhaust and intake shafts (Fig. 37).
CAUTION: When installing the intake rocker arm shaft assembly be sure that the plastic spacers
do not interfere with the spark plug tubes. If the spacers do interfere rotate until they are at the
proper angle. To avoid damaging the spark plug tubes, do not attempt rotating the spacers by
forcing down the shaft assembly.
4. Tighten bolts to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.) in sequence shown in (Fig. 40). 5. Install the cylinder head
cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Cover: Specifications
Cylinder Head Cover- Bolts 105 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1657
Valve Cover: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect make-up air (Fig. 27) and PCV (Fig. 28) hoses from cylinder head cover.
2. Remove ignition coil and spark plug cables (Fig. 29). 3. Remove cylinder head cover bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1658
4. Remove cylinder head cover.
CLEANING
Clean cylinder head and cover mating surfaces using a suitable solvent.
INSPECTION
Inspect cover rails for flatness.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect gasket and seals (Fig. 30). Replace as necessary.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to loosen or remove baffle plate attaching screws. The screws are
self-tapping, and in the attempt to retighten, thread damage (stripping) will result.
2. Install cylinder head cover and gasket. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
3. Install ignition coil and spark plug cables (Fig. 29). Tighten ignition coil fasteners to 12 Nm (105
in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1659
4. Connect make-up air (Fig. 27) and PCV (Fig. 28) hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Guide: Specifications
Diameter I.D. 0.235 - 0.236 inch
Guide Bore Diameter 0.4330 - 0.4338 inch
Guide Height (spring seat to Guide Tip) 0.521 - 0.541 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications
Valve Seat: Specifications
Angle 45°
Seat Diameter-Intake 1.299 inch
Seat Diameter-Exhaust 1.102 inch
Runout (Max.) 0.002 inch
Valve Seat Width-Intake And Exhaust 0.035 - 0.051 inch
Service Limit-Intake 0.079 inch
Service Limit-Exhaust 0.098 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1666
Valve Seat: Description and Operation
"For information regarding this component please refer to valve intake/Exhaust description and
operation"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Spring: Specifications
Valve Springs - Standard Engine Free Length (Approx.) 1.84 inch
Nominal Force (Valve Closed) 70 lbs. @ 1.57 inch
Nominal Force (Valve Open) 160 lbs. @ 1.28 inch
Installed Heigh 1.580 inch
Valve Springs - High Output R/T Engine Free Length (Approx.) 2.13 inch
Nominal Force (Valve Closed) 72 lbs. @ 1.57 inch
Nominal Force (Valve Open) 167 lbs. @ 1.28 inch
Installed Height 1.580 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1670
Valve Spring: Description and Operation
VALVE SPRINGS
OPERATION
The valve spring returns the valve against its seat for a positive seal of the combustion chamber.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1671
Valve Spring: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - CYLINDER HEAD OFF
1. Using Special Tool C-3422-D (valve spring compressor) with Adapter 6526 compress valve
spring and remove valve retaining locks. 2. Slowly release valve spring compressor. Remove valve
spring retainer and valve spring. 3. Remove valve stem seal assembly.
REMOVAL - CYLINDER HEAD ON
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove rocker arm shafts assemblies. 3. Rotate crankshaft
until piston is at TDC on compression stroke. 4. With air hose attached to adapter tool installed in
spark plug hole, apply 90 - 120 psi air pressure.
5. Using Special Tool MD-998772A with adapter 6779 (Fig. 46)compress valve springs and remove
valve locks. 6. Remove the valve spring. 7. Remove the valve stem seal.
INSPECTION
When valves have been removed for inspection, reconditioning or replacement, valve springs
should be tested (Fig. 47). As an example; the compression length of the spring to be tested is
38.00 mm (1.496 inch). Turn table of Tool C-647 until surface is in line with the 38.00 mm (1.496
inches.) mark on the threaded stud and the zero mark on the front. Place spring over stud on the
table and lift compressing lever to set tone device. Pull on torque wrench until ping is heard. Take
reading on torque wrench at this instant. Multiply this reading by two. This will give the spring load
at test length. Fractional measurements are indicated on the table for finer adjustments. Replace
springs that do not meet specifications.
INSTALLATION - CYLINDER HEAD OFF
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil and insert in cylinder head. 2. Install new valve stem
seals.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1672
CAUTION: If oversize valves are used, there is only one oversize valve available. The same stem
seal is used on both the standard and oversize valve.
NOTE: On the high output R/T engine, the valve spring MUST be oriented properly when installed.
The closely spaced spring coils should be positioned toward the cylinder head (spring seat) (Fig.
50).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1673
3. Position valve spring and retainer on spring seat (Fig. 49) or (Fig. 50). 4. Compress valve
springs only enough to install locks, taking care not to misalign the direction of compression.
Nicked valve stems may result from
misalignment of the valve spring compressor.
CAUTION: When depressing the valve spring retainers with valve spring compressor the locks can
become dislocated. Check to make sure both locks are in their correct location after removing tool.
5. Check the valve spring installed height after refacing the valve and seat (measurement B) (Fig.
48). Make sure measurements are taken from top of
spring seat to the bottom surface of spring retainer. If height is greater than 40.18 mm (1.58 inch),
install a 0.762 mm (0.030 inch) spacer under the valve spring seat to bring spring height back
within specification.
6. Install rocker arms and shafts. 7. Checking dry lash. Dry lash is the amount of clearance that
exists between the base circle of an installed cam and the rocker arm roller when the
adjuster is drained of oil and completely collapsed. Specified dry lash is 1.17 mm (0.046 inch) for
intake and 1.28 mm (0.050 inch) for exhaust. After performing dry lash check, refill adjuster with oil
and allow 10 minutes for adjuster(s) to bleed down before rotating cam.
INSTALLATION - CYLINDER HEAD ON
1. Install valve stem seal assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1674
NOTE: On the high output R/T engine, the valve spring MUST be oriented properly when installed.
The closely spaced spring coils should be positioned toward the cylinder head (spring seat) (Fig.
50).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1675
2. Position valve spring and retainer on spring seat (Fig. 49) or (Fig. 50). 3. With air pressure
applied in cylinder and piston at TDC, use Special Tool MD-998772A to compress valve springs,
only enough to install the
locks. Correct alignment of tool is necessary to avoid nicking valve stems.
4. Install the rocker arm shaft assemblies. 5. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve: Specifications
Valves Face Angle Intake and Exhaust 45 - 45.5°
Head Diameter-Intake 1.303 - 1.313 inch
Head Diameter-Exhaust 1.124 - 1.135 inch
Valve Margin Intake 0.0452 - 0.0583 inch
Service Limit 0.0312 inch
Exhaust 0.058 - 0.071 inch
Service Limit 0.0469 inch
Valve Length (Overall) Intake 4.503 - 4.523 inch
Exhaust 4.603 - 4.623 inch
Valve Stem Tip Height Intake 1.76 - 1.80 inch
Exhaust 1.71 - 1.75 inch
Valve Stem Diameter Intake 0.2337 - 0.2344 inch
Exhaust 0.2326 - 0.2333 inch
Valve Stem to Guide Clearance Intake 0.0018 - 0.0025 inch
Max. Allowable 0.003 inch
Exhaust 0.0029 - 0.0037 inch
Max. Allowable 0.004 inch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1679
Valve: Description and Operation
INTAKE/EXHAUST VALVES & SEATS
DESCRIPTION
The four valves per cylinder are opened by using roller rocker arms with hydraulic lash adjusters
which pivot on the rocker shafts. The valves have chrome plated valve stems. Viton rubber valve
stem seals are integral with the spring seats. The valve springs, spring retainers, and locks are
3-bead design.
OPERATION
The intake valve allows the air/fuel mixture to enter the combustion chamber. The exhaust valve
allows the burned air/fuel mixture to exit the combustion chamber. Also, the intake and exhaust
valves seal the combustion chamber during the compression and power strokes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1680
Valve: Testing and Inspection
CLEANING
1. Clean all valves thoroughly and discard burned, warped and cracked valves.
INSPECTION
VALVES
1. Measure valve stems for wear (Fig. 34) approximately 60 mm (2.36 inch) below the valve lock
grooves.
NOTE: Valve stems are chrome plated and should not be polished (Fig. 34).
VALVE GUIDES
NOTE: Replace cylinder head if stem-to-guide clearance exceeds specifications, or if guide is loose
in cylinder head.
1. Measure valve stem-to-guide clearance as follows: 2. Install valve into cylinder head so it is 15
mm (0.590 inch) off the valve seat. A small piece of hose may be used to hold valve in place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1681
3. Attach dial indicator Tool C-3339 to cylinder head and set it at right angle of valve stem being
measured (Fig. 35). 4. Move valve to and from the indicator.
5. Check valve guide height (Fig. 36).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Valve: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve spring. 2. Before removing valve, remove any burrs from valve stem lock grooves
to prevent damage to the valve guides. Identify valves to insure
installation in original location.
3. Remove valve(s) from cylinder head.
INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with clean engine oil. 2. Install valve in cylinder head. 3. Install valve seal. 4.
Install valve springs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1684
Valve: Service and Repair Refacing Valves & Seats
VALVE AND VALVE SEAT REFACING
For all applicable valve and seat dimensions and angles, Refer to SPECIFICATIONS. 1. Reface
valves using a suitable valve refacing machine.
2. Inspect the remaining margin after the valves are refaced (Fig. 31). Intake valves with less than
0.79 mm (0.0312 inch) margin and exhaust valves
with less than 1.19 mm (0.0469 inch) margin should be replaced.
3. Valve seats which are worn or burned can be reworked, provided that correct angle and seat
width are maintained. The intake valve seat must be
serviced when the valve seat width is 2.0 mm (0.079 inch) or greater. The exhaust valve seat must
be serviced when the valve seat width is 2.5 mm (0.098 inch) or greater. Otherwise the cylinder
head must be replaced.
4. Reface valve seats using a suitable valve seat machine 5. When refacing valve seats, it is
important that the correct size valve guide pilot be used for reseating stones or cutter. A true and
complete surface
must be obtained.
6. Measure the concentricity of valve seat and valve guide using a valve seat runout dial indicator.
Total runout should not exceed. 0.051 mm (0.002
inch) (total indicator reading).
7. Inspect the valve seat with Prussian blue to determine where the valve contacts the seat. To do
this, coat valve seat LIGHTLY with Prussian blue
then set valve in place. Rotate the valve with light pressure. If the blue is transferred to the center
of valve face, contact is satisfactory. If the blue is transferred to top edge of the valve face, lower
valve seat with a 15 degrees stone/cutter. If the blue is transferred to the bottom edge of valve face
raise valve seat with a 65 degrees stone/cutter.
8. When seat is properly positioned the width of intake and exhaust seats should be 0.75 - 1.25
mm (0.030 - 0.049 inch) (Fig. 32).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 1685
9. Check valve tip to spring seat dimensions A after machining the valve seats or faces. Grind
valve tip until within specifications. Measure from
valve tip to spring seat when installed in the head (measurement A) (Fig. 33). The valve tip chamfer
is needed to be reground to prevent seal damage when the valve is installed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications
Drive Belt: Specifications
Accessory drive belt Belt Tension
Power Steering Pump & A/C Compressor Dynamic Tension
Generator New 135 lbs.
Used 70 lbs.
A belt is considered used after 15 minutes of run-in time.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1690
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The accessory drive consist of two Poly-V type drive belts (Fig. 1). One belt drives the generator,
the other drives the power steering pump and air conditioning compressor (if equipped). The power
steering/ air conditioning belt is tensioned by an automatically controlled belt tensioner. The
generator belt is manually tensioned using an adjusting bolt and a locking nut.
OPERATION
The accessory drive belts form the link between the engine crankshaft and the engine driven
accessories.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1691
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt
Drive Belt: Service and Repair A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt
REMOVAL
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
1. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be removed from
power steering pump pulley. Gently, release spring
tension on tensioner.
2. Remove the drive belt (Fig. 3).
CLEANING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1694
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required: ^
Excessive wear
^ Frayed cords
^ Severe glazing Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to
reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are
not (Fig. 6).
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When installing drive belt on the pulleys, make sure that belt is properly routed and all
V-grooves make proper contact with pulley grooves.
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1695
1. Install the drive belt (Fig. 3) over all the pulleys except for the power steering pump pulley
2. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be installed on the
power steering pulley Release spring tension onto
belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1696
3. After belt is installed, inspect belt length indicator marks (Fig. 7). The indicator mark should be
within the minimum belt length and maximum belt
length marks. On a new belt, the indicator mark should align approximately with the nominal belt
length mark.
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1697
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Alternator/Generator Belt
REMOVAL GENERATOR BELT
1. Remove power steering pump/air conditioning compressor drive belt.
2. Loosen generator locking nut (Fig. 4). 3. Raise vehicle on hoist.
4. Remove accessory drive belt splash shield (Fig. 5). 5. Loosen generator pivot bolt (Fig. 4). 6.
Loosen generator adjusting bolt until generator belt can be removed (Fig. 4). 7. Remove generator
belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1698
CLEANING
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required: ^
Excessive wear
^ Frayed cords
^ Severe glazing Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to
reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are
not (Fig. 6).
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When installing drive belt on the pulleys, make sure that belt is properly routed and all
V-grooves make proper contact with pulley grooves.
GENERATOR BELT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1699
1. Install belt around pulleys (Fig. 3).
2. Adjust belt tension by tightening adjusting bolt (Fig. 4). Adjust belt to specification shown in
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART. 3. Check belt tension using Special Tool 8371 Belt Tension
Gauge Adapter, and the DRB III using the following procedures:
WARNING: DO NOT CHECK BELT TENSION WITH ENGINE RUNNING.
a. Connect 8371 to the DRB III following the instructions provided with tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1700
b. Place end of microphone probe approximately 2.54 cm (1 inch) from belt at one of the belt center
span locations shown in (Fig. 8). c. Pluck the belt a minimum of 3 times. (Use your finger or other
suitable tool) d. The frequency of the belt in hertz (Hz) will display on DRB III screen. e. Adjust belt
to obtain proper frequency (tension).
4. Tighten generator pivot bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 4).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1701
5. Install accessory drive belt splash shield (Fig. 5). 6. Lower vehicle.
7. Tighten generator locking nut to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 4). 8. Install power steering pump/air
conditioning compressor drive belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1702
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1703
Drive Belt: Service and Repair Power Steering Belt
REMOVAL
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
1. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be removed from
power steering pump pulley. Gently, release spring
tension on tensioner.
2. Remove the drive belt (Fig. 3).
CLEANING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1704
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
INSPECTION
Belt replacement under any or all of the following conditions is required: ^
Excessive wear
^ Frayed cords
^ Severe glazing Poly-V Belt system may develop minor cracks across the ribbed side (due to
reverse bending). These minor cracks are considered normal and acceptable. Parallel cracks are
not (Fig. 6).
NOTE: Do not use any type of belt dressing or restorer on Poly-V Belts.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When installing drive belt on the pulleys, make sure that belt is properly routed and all
V-grooves make proper contact with pulley grooves.
POWER STEERING PUMP AND AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR BELT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1705
1. Install the drive belt (Fig. 3) over all the pulleys except for the power steering pump pulley
2. Using a 17 mm wrench, rotate belt tensioner clockwise (Fig. 2) until belt can be installed on the
power steering pulley Release spring tension onto
belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > A/C Compressor / Power Steering Pump Belt > Page 1706
3. After belt is installed, inspect belt length indicator marks (Fig. 7). The indicator mark should be
within the minimum belt length and maximum belt
length marks. On a new belt, the indicator mark should align approximately with the nominal belt
length mark.
DRIVE BELT TENSION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Specifications
Drive Belt Tensioner: Specifications
Automatic belt tensioner pulley-bolt 20 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1710
Drive Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The automatic belt tensioner (Fig. 9) maintains proper tension on the power steering and air
conditioning belt. The tensioner is serviced with the engine mount bracket assembly. The tensioner
pulley can be serviced separately.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1711
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Slight axial movement of the tensioner arm is normal. Tensioner arm should move freely
and maintain 50 - 70 lbs. tension on belt.
1. Remove engine mount bracket assembly. 2. Remove the tensioner pulley mounting bolt. 3.
Remove the pulley.
INSTALLATION
1. Install tensioner pulley, dust shield, and bolt. Tighten bolt to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 2. Install engine
mount bracket assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Torque Strut: Specifications
Engine Torque Strut Bracket To Engine-Bolts 45 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Strut
Engine Torque Strut: Service and Repair Torque Strut
TORQUE STRUT
REMOVAL
UPPER TORQUE STRUT
1. Remove bolts attaching strut to shock tower bracket and engine mount bracket (Fig. 106). 2.
Remove the upper torque strut.
LOWER TORQUE STRUT
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove accessory drive belt splash shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Strut > Page 1718
3. Remove pencil strut (Fig. 105).
4. Remove bolts attaching lower strut to crossmember and strut bracket (Fig. 106). 5. Remove
lower torque strut.
INSTALLATION
UPPER TORQUE STRUT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Strut > Page 1719
1. Position the upper torque strut into mounting locations (Fig. 106). 2. Install the mounting bolts
and perform the torque strut adjustment procedure.
LOWER TORQUE STRUT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Strut > Page 1720
1. Position lower torque strut into mounting locations (Fig. 106). 2. Install mounting bolts and
perform torque strut adjustment procedure.
3. Install pencil strut (Fig. 105). 4. Install accessory drive belt splash shield and lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Strut > Page 1721
Engine Torque Strut: Service and Repair Adjustments
ENGINE TORQUE STRUT ADJUSTMENT
The upper and lower torque struts need to be adjusted together to assure proper engine positioning
and engine mount loading. Whenever a torque strut bolt(s) is loosened, this procedure must be
performed. 1. Loosen the upper and lower torque strut attaching bolt at the suspension
crossmember and shock tower bracket.
2. The engine position may now be adjusted by positioning a suitable floor jack on the forward
edge of the transmission bell housing (Fig. 107).
NOTE: The floor jack must be positioned as shown in (Fig. 107) to prevent minimal upward lifting of
the engine.
3. With the engine supported, remove the upper and lower torque strut attachment bolt(s) at shock
tower bracket and suspension crossmember (Fig.
106). Verify that the torque struts are free to move within the shock tower bracket and
crossmember. Reinstall the torque strut bolt(s), but do not
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Engine Torque Strut > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Strut > Page 1722
tighten.
4. Carefully apply upward force, allowing the upper engine to rotate rearward until the distance
between the center of the rearmost attaching stud on
the engine mount bracket (point "A") and the center of the hole for the washer hose clip on the
shock tower bracket (point "B") is 119 mm (4.70 inch) (Fig. 108).
5. With the engine held at the proper position, tighten both the upper and lower torque strut bolts to
118 Nm (87 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 106). 6. Remove the floor jack.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
OIL PRESSURE @ Curb Idle Speed 4 psi
(at normal operating temperature) If oil pressure is ZERO at curb idle, DO NOT run engine at
3000 rpm.
@ 3000 rpm 25-80 psi
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1727
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
Check oil pressure using a gauge at oil pressure switch location. 1. Remove the oil pressure
switch. 2. Install oil pressure test gauge, Special Tool C-3292 with Adapter 8406.
CAUTION: If oil pressure is 0 at idle, Do Not Run engine at 3000 RPM.
3. Warm engine to normal operating temperature. 4. Monitor gauge readings at idle and 3000 rpm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Drain Plug >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Drain Plug: Specifications
Oil Pan Drain-Plug 20 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 4.3Liters (4.5 Qt)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 1735
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil Viscosity
Below 100°F (38°C) .............................................................................................................................
................................................... 5W-30 (Preferred)
Above 0°F (-18°C) ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 10W-30
The proper SAE viscosity grade of engine oil should be selected based on the following
recommendation and be within the operating temperature shown in the engine oil viscosity chart.
Synthetic Engine Oils
There are a growing number of engine oils being promoted as either synthetic or semi-synthetic. If
you choose to use such a product, use only those oils that meet the American Petroleum Institute
(API) and (SAE) viscosity standard. Follow the service schedule that describes your driving type.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1736
Engine Oil: Service Precautions
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil Identification Symbol
For best performance and maximum protection for all engines under all types of operation, select
only engine oils that meet American Petroleum Institute (API) certification and SAE viscosity
standards.
This symbol on the front of an oil container means that the oil has been certified by the American
Petroleum Institute (API) to meet all the lubrication requirements specified by DaimlerChrysler
Corporation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1737
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE OIL LEVEL CHECK
The best time to check engine oil level is after it has sat overnight, or if the engine has been
running, allow the engine to be shut off for at least 5 minutes before checking oil level. Checking
the oil while the vehicle is on level ground will improve the accuracy of the oil level reading.
Remove dipstick (Fig. 114) and observe oil level. Add oil only when the level is at or below the ADD
mark (Fig. 115).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1738
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ENGINE OIL AND FILTER CHANGE
Change engine oil at mileage and time intervals described.
WARNING: NEW OR USED ENGINE OIL CAN BE IRRITATING TO THE SKIN. AVOID
PROLONGED OR REPEATED SKIN CONTACT WITH ENGINE OIL. CONTAMINANTS IN USED
ENGINE OIL, CAUSED BY INTERNAL COMBUSTION, CAN BE HAZARDOUS TO YOUR
HEALTH. THOROUGHLY WASH EXPOSED SKIN WITH SOAP AND WATER. DO NOT WASH
SKIN WITH GASOLINE, DIESEL FUEL, THINNER, OR SOLVENTS, HEALTH PROBLEMS CAN
RESULT. DO NOT POLLUTE, DISPOSE OF USED ENGINE OIL PROPERLY. CONTACT YOUR
DEALER OR GOVERNMENT AGENCY FOR LOCATION OF COLLECTION CENTER IN YOUR
AREA.
Run engine until achieving normal operating temperature. 1. Position the vehicle on a level surface
and turn engine off.
2. Remove oil fill cap (Fig. 114). 3. Raise vehicle on hoist.
4. Place a suitable oil collecting container under oil pan drain plug (Fig. 116).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1739
5. Remove oil pan drain plug and allow oil to drain into collecting container. Inspect drain plug
threads for stretching or other damage. Replace drain
plug and gasket if damaged.
6. Remove oil filter. 7. Install and tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 8. Install new oil
filter. 9. Lower vehicle and fill crankcase with specified type and amount of engine oil.
10. Install oil fill cap. 11. Start engine and inspect for leaks. 12. Stop engine and inspect oil level.
NOTE: Care should be exercised when disposing used engine oil after it has been drained from a
vehicle engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Filter: Specifications
Oil Filter 15 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1743
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
OIL FILTER
REMOVAL
CAUTION: When servicing the oil filter (Fig. 116), avoid deforming the filter. Use an appropriate oil
filter removing tool. Position filter wrench strap close the seam at the base of the filter. The oil filter
seam that joins the can to the base, is reinforced by the base plate.
1. Turn filter counterclockwise to remove (Fig. 116).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean and check the filter mounting surface. The surface must be smooth, flat and free of debris
or old pieces of rubber. 2. Lubricate new filter gasket. 3. Screw filter on until gasket contacts base
(Fig. 116). Tighten to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Filter Adapter: Specifications
Oil Filter Adaptor 60 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1747
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
OIL FILTER ADAPTER
REMOVAL
REMOVE 1. Remove the oil filter.
2. Remove assembly by unscrewing adaptor fitting (Fig. 135). 3. Remove O-ring seal.
INSTALLATION
1. Position O-ring in the groove on adapter.
2. Align roll pin into engine block and tighten assembly to 80 Nm (60 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 135). 3. Install oil
filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Oil Pan-Bolts 105 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1751
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
OIL PAN
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Drain engine oil and
remove oil filter.
4. Remove oil filter adaptor from engine block (Fig. 117). 5. Remove structural collar.
6. Remove lateral bending brace attaching bolts (Fig. 118). 7. Remove lateral bending brace (Fig.
118). 8. Remove transaxle dust cover (Fig. 118). 9. Remove oil pan bolts.
10. Remove oil pan.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean oil pan and all sealing surfaces.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1752
2. Apply Mopar Silicone Rubber Adhesive Sealant at the oil pump to engine block parting line (Fig.
119). 3. Position a new oil pan gasket onto pan. 4. Install oil pan and tighten screws to 12 Nm (105
in. lbs.).
5. Install transaxle dust cover (Fig. 118). 6. Install lateral bending brace (Fig. 118). 7. Install
structural collar. 8. Install oil filter adaptor. 9. Install oil filter.
10. Lower vehicle and fill engine crankcase with proper oil to correct level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Sender: Description and Operation
OIL PRESSURE SENSOR/ SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The oil pressure switch is located on the right rear side of the engine block (Fig. 120). The oil
pressure switch is a pressure sensitive switch that is activated by the engine's oil pressure (in the
main oil gallery). The switch is a two terminal device (one terminal is provided to the wiring harness
and the other terminal is the switch's metal housing that screws into the engine block).
OPERATION
The oil pressure switch changes from an "Open" circuit to a "Closed" circuit, on decreasing
pressure, between 2 psig and 4 psig. The switch changes from a "Closed" circuit to an "Open"
circuit, on increasing pressure of 7 psig of the switch's "Closed" circuit pressure point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1756
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position oil collecting container under pressure switch location.
3. Disconnect oil pressure switch electrical connector and remove switch (Fig. 121).
INSTALLATION
1. Install oil pressure switch and connect electrical connector (Fig. 121). 2. Lower vehicle. 3. Start
engine and allow to run a minimum of 2 minutes. 4. Shut engine off and check engine oil level.
Adjust level as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1760
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Application and ID
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ..................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Application and ID > Page 1764
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
The low oil pressure indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position
without engine running. The lamp also illuminates if the engine oil pressure drops below a safe oil
pressure level.
Fig.2 Oil Pressure Switch
To test the system, turn the ignition switch to the ON position. If the lamp fails to light, inspect for a
broken or disconnected wire at the oil pressure switch, located at the front of the engine (Fig. 2). If
the wire at the connector checks good, pull the connector loose from the switch and with a jumper
wire, ground the connector to the engine. With the ignition switch turned to the ON position, check
the warning lamp. If the lamp still fails to light, inspect for a burned out lamp or disconnected socket
in the cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pump Cover: Specifications
Oil Pump Cover Plate-Bolts 105 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer >
Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Specifications
Oil Pump Pick-up Tube-Bolt 250 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
OIL PRESSURE @ Curb Idle Speed 4 psi
(at normal operating temperature) If oil pressure is ZERO at curb idle, DO NOT run engine at
3000 rpm.
@ 3000 rpm 25-80 psi
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1775
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
CHECKING ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
Check oil pressure using a gauge at oil pressure switch location. 1. Remove the oil pressure
switch. 2. Install oil pressure test gauge, Special Tool C-3292 with Adapter 8406.
CAUTION: If oil pressure is 0 at idle, Do Not Run engine at 3000 RPM.
3. Warm engine to normal operating temperature. 4. Monitor gauge readings at idle and 3000 rpm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Intake Manifold Torque Specifications
Intake Manifold: Specifications Intake Manifold Torque Specifications
1. Tighten lower intake manifold bolts in sequence shown. Torque to
2. Tighten upper intake manifold fasteners in sequence shown. Torque to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Intake Manifold Torque Specifications > Page 1780
Intake Manifold: Specifications Throttle Body Bolt Torque Specifications
Throttle Body Mounting Bolts
..............................................................................................................................................................
23 Nm (200 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1781
Intake Manifold: Description and Operation
INTAKE MANIFOLD - HIGH OUTPUT
DESCRIPTION
The intake manifold is a two piece cast aluminum design. The lower manifold section houses an
electronic controlled manifold tuning valve for increased engine performance.
OPERATION
The intake manifold meters and delivers air to the combustion chambers. This air allows the fuel
delivered by the fuel injectors to ignite; producing power. The Manifold Tuning Valve (MTV) allows
additional flow volumes under certain engine operating conditions for increase engine performance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1782
Intake Manifold: Testing and Inspection
INTAKE MANIFOLD LEAKS
An intake manifold air leak is characterized by lower than normal manifold vacuum. Also, one or
more cylinders may not be functioning.
WARNING: USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN THE ENGINE IS OPERATING. DO NOT STAND IN
A DIRECT LINE WITH THE FAN. DO NOT PUT YOUR HANDS NEAR THE PULLEYS, BELTS OR
THE FAN. DO NOT WEAR LOOSE CLOTHING.
1. Start the engine. 2. Spray a small stream of water (Spray Bottle) at the suspected leak area. 3. If
engine RPM'S change, the area of the suspected leak has been found. 4. Repair as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1783
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - HIGH OUTPUT ENGINE
WARNING: RELEASE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE BEFORE SERVICING FUEL SYSTEM
COMPONENTS. SERVICE VEHICLES IN WELL VENTILATED AREAS AND AVOID IGNITION
SOURCES. NEVER SMOKE WHILE SERVICING THE VEHICLE.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Perform fuel system pressure release procedure
before attempting any repairs.
WARNING: WRAP SHOP TOWELS AROUND FUEL HOSE TO CATCH ANY GASOLINE
SPILLAGE
3. Disconnect fuel supply line quick connect at the fuel tube assembly. 4. Disconnect fuel injector
connector and harness from injectors and fuel rail.
5. Disconnect PCV hose from manifold (Fig. 144). 6. Remove the inlet air duct from intake manifold
to throttle body
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1784
7. Remove bolt attaching lower intake manifold to support bracket (Fig. 143). 8. Remove engine oil
dipstick from housing. 9. Disconnect electrical connectors from MAP sensor and MTV actuator (Fig.
144).
10. Remove bolts attaching intake manifold to cylinder head.
11. Move manifold forward for access to wiring connections (Fig. 146).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1785
12. Disconnect the knock sensor (Fig. 145). 13. Disconnect brake booster hose (Fig. 146). 14.
Remove intake manifold.
INSTALLATION - HIGH OUTPUT ENGINE
1. Clean manifold sealing surfaces.
2. If separated, install lower to upper manifold gasket and tighten bolt in sequence shown in (Fig.
147) to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Position new manifold gasket on cylinder head mounting surface,
piloting on the 2 attaching studs. 4. Loosely position manifold in engine compartment. 5. Insert
engine wiring harness between middle intake runners.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1786
6. Connect the knock sensor (Fig. 145).
7. Connect brake booster hose (Fig. 146).
8. Position manifold to cylinder head and install fasteners. Tighten fasteners in sequence shown in
(Fig. 148) to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1787
9. Install bolt securing lower manifold to bracket (Fig. 143). Tighten bolt to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.).
10. Connect MAP sensor and MTV actuator electrical connection (Fig. 144). 11. Install engine oil
dipstick 12. Connect inlet air duct to manifold and throttle body 13. Connect PCV hose to manifold
(Fig. 144). 14. Connect fuel injector connectors and harness to fuel rail. 15. Connect fuel supply
line to fuel rail. 16. Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Application and ID
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ..................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Application and ID > Page 1792
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
The low oil pressure indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position
without engine running. The lamp also illuminates if the engine oil pressure drops below a safe oil
pressure level.
Fig.2 Oil Pressure Switch
To test the system, turn the ignition switch to the ON position. If the lamp fails to light, inspect for a
broken or disconnected wire at the oil pressure switch, located at the front of the engine (Fig. 2). If
the wire at the connector checks good, pull the connector loose from the switch and with a jumper
wire, ground the connector to the engine. With the ignition switch turned to the ON position, check
the warning lamp. If the lamp still fails to light, inspect for a burned out lamp or disconnected socket
in the cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Camshaft Oil Seal: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT OIL SEAL
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable. 2. Remove front timing belt cover. 3. Remove the
timing belt and tensioner assembly.
CAUTION: Do Not Rotate the camshaft or crankshaft when timing belt is removed damage to the
engine may occur.
4. Hold camshaft sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and modified C-4687-1 as shown in (Fig. 21),
while removing attaching bolt. 5. Remove sprocket from camshaft. 6. Remove the rear timing belt
cover. 7. Remove camshaft seal by carefully using a suitable pry tool. Be careful not to nick or
damage the camshaft seal surface or cylinder head seal
retaining bore.
CAUTION: Do not nick shaft seal surface or seal bore.
8. Shaft seal lip surface must be free of varnish, dirt or nicks. Polish with 400 grit paper, if
necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Install camshaft seal flush with cylinder head using Special Tool MD998306 (Fig. 22). 2. Install
the rear timing belt cover. 3. Install the camshaft sprocket on the camshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Camshaft Oil Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1797
CAUTION: DO NOT use an impact wrench (or any other air operated tool) for tightening the
camshaft sprocket bolt. Damage to the camshaft timing pin can result. ONLY use a hand wrench
while holding camshaft sprocket with Special Tool.
4. Install camshaft sprocket retaining bolt. Hold camshaft sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and
modified C-4687-1 (Fig. 21) and tighten bolt to
115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
5. Install timing belt and tensioner assembly. 6. Install front timing belt cover. 7. Connect negative
battery cable. 8. Perform camshaft and crankshaft timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB III scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the transaxle. 2. Remove the flex plate.
3. Insert a 3/16 flat bladed screwdriver between the dust lip and the metal case of the crankshaft
seal. Angle the screwdriver (Fig. 75) through the
dust lip against metal case of the seal. Pry out seal.
CAUTION: Do not permit the screwdriver blade to contact crankshaft seal surface. Contact of the
screwdriver blade against crankshaft edge (chamfer) is permitted.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If burr or scratch is present on the crankshaft edge (chamfer), cleanup with 400 grit
sand paper to prevent seal damage during installation of new seal.
NOTE: When installing seal, no lube on seal is needed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1801
1. Place Special Tool 6926-1 on crankshaft. This is a pilot tool with a magnetic base (Fig. 76). 2.
Position seal over pilot tool. Make sure you can read the words THIS SIDE OUT on seal (Fig. 76).
Pilot tool should remain on crankshaft during
installation of seal. Ensure that the lip of the seal is facing towards the crankcase during
installation.
CAUTION: If the seal is driven into the block past flush, this may cause an oil leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1802
3. Drive the seal into the block using Special Tool 6926-2 and handle C-4171 (Fig. 77) until the tool
bottoms out against the block (Fig. 78). 4. Install the flex plate. 5. Install the transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the accessory drive belts. 2. Remove the crankshaft vibration damper. 3. Remove the
timing belt.
4. Remove the crankshaft sprocket using Special Tool 6793 and insert C-4685-C2 (Fig. 70).
5. Remove the crankshaft sprocket key from crankshaft (Fig. 71).
CAUTION: Do not nick shaft seal surface or seal bore.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1806
6. Using Special Tool 6771, remove front crankshaft oil seal (Fig. 72). Do not damage the seal
contact area on the crankshaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Position seal into opening with seal spring towards the inside of engine. Using Special Tool
6780-1 (Fig. 73), install seal until flush with cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1807
2. Install the crankshaft sprocket key (Fig. 71).
3. Install the crankshaft sprocket (Fig. 74) using Special Tool 6792.
NOTE: Make sure the word "front" on the sprocket is facing outward.
CAUTION: Use of Special Tool 6792 is required to install the crankshaft sprocket to the proper
depth. Failure to use this tool will cause improper timing belt tracking.
4. Install the timing belt. 5. Install crankshaft vibration damper. 6. Install accessory drive belts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair
VALVE STEM SEALS
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve spring.
2. Remove valve stem seals by using a valve stem seal tool (Fig. 44).
INSTALLATION
1. The valve stem seal/valve spring seat should be pushed firmly and squarely over the valve guide
using the valve stem as guide. Do Not Force seal
against top of guide. When installing the valve retainer locks, compress the spring only enough to
install the locks.
CAUTION: Do not remove garter spring around the seal at the top of the valve stem seal (Fig. 45).
2. Install valve spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Sender: Description and Operation
OIL PRESSURE SENSOR/ SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The oil pressure switch is located on the right rear side of the engine block (Fig. 120). The oil
pressure switch is a pressure sensitive switch that is activated by the engine's oil pressure (in the
main oil gallery). The switch is a two terminal device (one terminal is provided to the wiring harness
and the other terminal is the switch's metal housing that screws into the engine block).
OPERATION
The oil pressure switch changes from an "Open" circuit to a "Closed" circuit, on decreasing
pressure, between 2 psig and 4 psig. The switch changes from a "Closed" circuit to an "Open"
circuit, on increasing pressure of 7 psig of the switch's "Closed" circuit pressure point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1815
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position oil collecting container under pressure switch location.
3. Disconnect oil pressure switch electrical connector and remove switch (Fig. 121).
INSTALLATION
1. Install oil pressure switch and connect electrical connector (Fig. 121). 2. Lower vehicle. 3. Start
engine and allow to run a minimum of 2 minutes. 4. Shut engine off and check engine oil level.
Adjust level as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1819
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Torque
Torque
Camshaft Sprocket Bolt 85 ft.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Removal
REMOVAL - CAMSHAFT SPROCKET
1. Remove timing belt.
2. Hold camshaft sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and modified Adaptor C-4687-1 (Fig. 170),
while removing attaching bolt.
NOTE: For Special Tool Identification, Refer to SPECIAL TOOLS.
3. Remove camshaft sprocket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Camshaft Sprockets - Removal > Page 1826
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Camshaft Sprockets - Installation
CAMSHAFT SPROCKET
1. Install camshaft sprocket. While holding sprockets with Special Tools C-4687 and modified
Adaptor C-4687-1, tighten attaching bolt to 115 Nm
(85 ft. lbs.).
2. Install timing belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL - CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
1. Remove timing belt
2. Remove the crankshaft sprocket using Special Tool 6793 and insert C-4685-C2 (Fig. 171).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1831
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair Installation
CRANKSHAFT SPROCKET
NOTE: Make sure the word "front" on the sprocket is facing outward.
CAUTION: Use of Special Tool 6792 is required to install the crankshaft sprocket to the proper
depth. Failure to use this tool will cause improper timing belt tracking.
1. Install the crankshaft sprocket (Fig. 172) using Special Tool 6792.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Belt: Specifications
Timing Belt Replacement Interval
On 2000-02 Neon models, replace every 105,000 miles or 84 months in normal service, or every
105,000 miles in severe service.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Installation
With Mechanical Tensioner
TIMING BELT (WITH MECHANICAL TENSIONER)
1. Set crankshaft sprocket to TDC by aligning the sprocket with the arrow on the oil pump housing,
then back off to 3 notches before TDC (Fig.
178).
2. Set camshaft to TDC by aligning mark on sprocket with the arrow on the rear timing belt cover
(Fig. 179).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1837
3. Move crankshaft to 1/2 mark before TDC (Fig. 180) for belt installation. 4. Install the timing belt.
Starting at the crankshaft, go around the water pump sprocket, then around the camshaft sprocket,
and finally route the back
side of the timing belt around the timing belt tensioner pulley
5. Move crankshaft sprocket to TDC to take up belt slack.
6. Insert a 6 mm Allen wrench into the hexagon opening located on the top plate of the belt
tensioner pulley Rotate the top plate
COUNTERCLOCKWISE. The tensioner pulley will move against the belt and the tensioner setting
notch will eventually start to move clockwise. Watching the movement of the setting notch, continue
rotating the top plate counterclockwise until the setting notch is aligned with the spring tang (Fig.
181). Using the allen wrench to prevent the top plate from moving, torque the tensioner lock nut to
30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.). Setting notch and spring tang should remain aligned after lock nut is torqued.
7. Remove allen wrench and torque wrench.
NOTE: Repositioning the crankshaft to the TDC position must be done only during the
CLOCKWISE rotation movement. If TDC is missed, rotate a further two revolutions until TDC is
achieved. DO NOT rotate crankshaft counterclockwise as this will make verification of proper
tensioner setting impossible.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1838
8. Rotate the crankshaft CLOCKWISE two complete revolutions manually for seating of the belt,
until the crankshaft is repositioned at the TDC
position. Verify that the camshaft and crankshaft timing marks are in proper position (Fig. 183).
9. Check if the spring tang is within the tolerance window (Fig. 182). If the spring tang is within the
tolerance window, the installation process is
complete and nothing further is required. If the spring tang is not within the tolerance window,
repeat Steps 6 through 8.
10. Install front timing belt cover. 11. Install spark plugs. 12. Perform camshaft and crankshaft
timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB 1116 scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located
in the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
With Hydraulic Tensioner
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1839
TIMING BELT (WITH HYDRAULIC TENSIONER)
1. Set crankshaft sprocket to TDC by aligning the sprocket with the arrow on the oil pump housing,
then back off to 3 notches before TDC (Fig.
173).
2. Set camshaft to TDC by aligning mark on sprocket with the arrow on the rear of timing belt cover
(Fig. 174).
3. Move crankshaft to 1/2 mark before TDC (Fig. 175) for belt installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1840
4. Install the timing belt. Starting at the crankshaft, go around the water pump sprocket, then
around the camshaft sprocket, and finally route the back
side of the timing belt around the timing belt tensioner pulley
5. Move crankshaft sprocket to TDC to take up belt slack.
6. Re-set the hydraulic tensioner by placing tensioner body in a vise equipped with soft jaws (Fig.
176). Slowly compress the plunger. 7. Compress the plunger until a 1.9 mm (5/64) Allen wrench or
pin can be inserted through the body and the plunger (Fig. 176). 8. Remove hydraulic tensioner
from vise and install on engine. Do not tighten attaching bolts at this time. 9. Using a torque wrench
on the tensioner pulley bolt, apply 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.) of torque against the timing belt.
10. With torque applied to the tensioner pulley/ timing belt, move the tensioner up against the
pulley pivot bracket and tighten tensioner bolts to 31
Nm (23 ft. lbs.). (Fig. 177).
11. Pull the tensioner plunger retaining pin. Pretension is correct when the pin can be removed and
installed into tensioner housing and plunger.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1841
12. Rotate crankshaft 2 revolutions and check the alignment of the timing marks (Fig. 175) and
(Fig. 174). 13. Check belt tension by installing pin into tensioner housing. If pin cannot be
re-installed, repeat belt tension procedure. 14. Install the front timing belt cover. 15. Lower vehicle
and perform camshaft and crankshaft timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB III scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1842
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Removal
With Mechanical Tensioner
TIMING BELT (WITH MECHANICAL TENSIONER)
1. Remove front timing belt cover (Fig. 168). 2. Remove spark plugs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1843
CAUTION: Align camshaft and crankshaft timing marks before removing the timing belt by rotating
the engine CLOCKWISE with the crankshaft (Fig. 183).
3. Loosen timing belt tensioner lock nut (Fig. 169). 4. Insert a 6 mm Allen wrench into the hexagon
opening located on the top plate of the belt tensioner pulley Rotate the top plate CLOCKWISE until
there is enough slack in timing belt to allow for removal (Fig. 169).
5. Remove timing belt.
CAUTION: Do not rotate the camshaft once the timing belt has been removed or damage to valve
components may occur.
With Hydraulic Tensioner
TIMING BELT (WITH HYDRAULIC TENSIONER)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1844
1. Remove front timing belt cover (Fig. 165).
CAUTION: Align camshaft and crankshaft timing marks before removing the timing belt by rotating
the engine with the crankshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Installation > Page 1845
2. Rotate crankshaft until timing marks are aligned at both the camshaft and crankshaft (Fig. 166).
3. Loosen the timing belt tensioner fasteners (Fig. 166).
CAUTION: DO NOT loosen, tighten, or remove the tensioner pivot bolt (Fig. 167).
4. Remove the timing belt from sprockets.
CAUTION: Do not rotate the camshaft once the timing belt has been removed or damage to valve
components may occur.
5. For timing belt tensioner pulley assembly removal Refer to TIMING BELT TENSIONER &
PULLEY - REMOVAL.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner: Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner Assembly Bolts 250 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Timing Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Removal
With Hydraulic Tensioner
WITH HYDRAULIC TENSIONER
1. Remove timing belt. 2. Remove bolts attaching the tensioner pulley assembly to engine.
3. Remove tensioner pulley assembly (Fig. 184).
With Mechanical Tensioner
WITH MECHANICAL TENSIONER
1. Remove timing belt. 2. Remove bolts attaching the timing belt tensioner assembly to engine.
3. Remove timing belt tensioner assembly (Fig. 185).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1851
Timing Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Installation
With Hydraulic Tensioner
WITH HYDRAULIC TENSIONER
1. Position timing belt tensioner assembly to the engine. To ensure proper alignment of tensioner to
engine block, temporarily install the engine
mount bracket bolts into the upper holes of the timing belt tensioner. Install timing belt tensioner
lower mounting bolts. Tighten lower mounting bolts to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.). Remove temporarily
installed engine mount bracket bolts.
2. Install timing belt.
With Mechanical Tensioner
WITH MECHANICAL TENSIONER
1. Position timing belt tensioner assembly to the engine. To ensure proper alignment of tensioner to
engine block, temporarily install the engine
mount bracket bolts into the upper holes of the timing belt tensioner. Install timing belt tensioner
lower mounting bolts. Tighten lower mounting bolts to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.). Remove temporarily
installed engine mount bracket bolts.
2. Install timing belt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Timing Belt Cover Bolts 105 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1855
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
Timing Belt CoversREMOVAL
FRONT COVER 1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Remove fastener securing ground strap
to engine mount bracket. 3. Remove upper torque strut. 4. Remove power steering/air conditioning
compressor drive belt. 5. Raise vehicle on hoist. 6. Remove accessory drive belt splash shield. 7.
Remove generator drive belt. 8. Remove crankshaft damper bolt. Remove crankshaft damper (Fig.
158). 9. Remove lower torque strut.
10. Lower vehicle. 11. Position a jack under engine. Raise jack enough to support engine weight.
12. Remove right engine mount to engine mount bracket through bolt (Fig. 159).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1856
13. Lower engine enough with jack to remove lower engine mount bracket bolt (Fig. 160). 14. Raise
engine with jack to allow engine-to-body clearance for engine mount bracket removal. 15. Remove
power steering pump assembly and set aside. Do Not disconnect lines from pump.
16. Remove the two remaining bolts securing engine mount bracket to engine. Remove engine
mount bracket (Fig. 160).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1857
17. Remove the front timing belt cover fasteners. Remove front timing belt cover (Fig. 161).
REAR COVER
1. Remove front timing belt cover. 2. Remove timing belt. 3. Remove timing belt tensioner
assembly.
4. Hold camshaft sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and modified Adaptor C-4687-1 (Fig. 162),
while removing attaching bolt.
NOTE: For Special Tool Identification, Refer to SPECIAL TOOLS.
5. Remove camshaft sprocket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1858
6. Remove rear cover attaching bolts (Fig. 163). 7. Remove rear cover (Fig. 163).
INSTALLATION
REAR COVER
1. Install rear cover and tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 163). 2. Install the camshaft
sprocket on the camshaft.
CAUTION: DO NOT use an impact wrench (or any other air operated tool) for tightening the
camshaft sprocket bolt. Damage to the camshaft timing pin can result. ONLY use a hand wrench
while holding camshaft sprocket with Special Tool.
3. Install camshaft sprocket retaining bolt. While holding sprocket with Special Tools C-4687 and
modified Adaptor C-4687-1, tighten attaching bolt
to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
4. Install timing belt tensioner assembly. 5. Install timing belt. 6. Install front timing belt cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1859
FRONT COVER
1. Install front cover and tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 161).
2. Position engine mount bracket to its mounting location. Hand start the upper two bolts of the
engine mount bracket (Fig. 160). 3. Lower engine with jack. 4. Install lower engine mount bracket
bolt. Tighten bolt to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 160). 5. Raise engine with jack. 6. Tighten upper
engine mount bracket bolts to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 160). 7. Install power steering pump
assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1860
8. Lower engine with jack.
9. Install right engine mount to engine mount bracket through bolt. Tighten bolt to 118 Nm (87 ft.
lbs.) (Fig. 159).
10. Remove jack from under engine. 11. Raise vehicle on hoist. 12. Install lower torque strut.
13. Install crankshaft damper (Fig. 164). Install crankshaft damper bolt. Torque bolt to 136 Nm (100
ft. lbs.). 14. Install accessory drive belts. 15. Install accessory drive belt splash shield. 16. Lower
vehicle. 17. Install upper torque strut. 18. Install fastener securing ground strap to engine mount
bracket. 19. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE ...............................................................................................................................
......................................... 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications > Page 1865
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications > Page 1866
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications > Page 1867
Test 7 - 9
SYMPTOM
CHECKING FUEL DELIVERY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fuel pump relay
- Fuel pressure out of specs
- Restricted fuel supply line
- Fuel pump inlet strainer plugged
- Fuel pump module
- Fuel delivery system operation
- Fuel pump relay fused B+ circuit
- (A141) fuel pump relay output circuit open
- (Z1) fuel pump ground circuit open/high resistance
- Fuel pump module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove 5 screws from air cleaner element box lid. 2. Remove lid from air cleaner box. 3. Pull air
cleaner up and out of air cleaner box.
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element on to throttle body and push towards the throttle body and past lip in
air cleaner box bottom (Fig. 10). 2. Install lid and tighten screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 1879
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
Ignition Coll Pack
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 1-3-4-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1883
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches directly to the valve cover.
The 2.0 Liter (122 cu. inch) in-line four cylinder engine is a single over head camshaft with
hydraulic lifters and four valves per cylinder design (Fig. 1). The engine does not have provisions
for a free wheeling valve train. The cylinders are numbered from front of the engine to the rear. The
firing order is 1-3-4-2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
CABLE .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................ RESISTANCE
# 1, # 4 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2970 - 8910 ohms
# 2, # 3 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2360 - 7070 ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1891
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
SPARK PLUG CABLE
Spark Plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer
electrical current from the ignition coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder. The resistive
spark plug cables are of nonmetallic construction. The cables provide suppression of radio
frequency emissions from the ignition system.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil, and spark plugs. Terminals
should be fully seated. The insulators should be in good condition and should fit tightly on the coil,
and spark plugs. Spark plug cables with insulators that are cracked or torn must be replaced.
Clean Spark Plug cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry. Check for brittle or cracked insulation. The spark plug cables and spark plug boots are made
from high temperature silicone materials. All spark plug cable leads are properly identified with
cylinder numbers. The inside of most the spark plug boot is coated with a special high temperature
silicone grease for greater sealing and to minimize boot bonding to the spark plug insulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1892
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of
the spark plug insulator, turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
INSTALLATION
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube, then connect the other end to coil pack.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Spark Plug Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUG TUBE
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Using locking pliers, remove the tube from the cylinder head. Discard old tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean area around spark plug with Mopar parts cleaner or equivalent. 2. Apply Mopar Stud and
Bearing Mount or equivalent to a new tube approximately 1 mm (0.039 inch) from the end in a 3
mm (0.118 inch) wide
area.
3. Install sealer end of tube into the cylinder head. Then carefully install the tube using a hardwood
block and mallet until the tube is seated into the
bottom of the bore.
4. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The spark plug tube seals are located in the cylinder head cover. These seals are pressed into the
cylinder head cover to seal the outside perimeter of the spark plug tubes. If these seals show signs
of hardness and/or cracking, they should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1900
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Using an appropriate tool, carefully remove spark plug tube
seals. Care should be taken not to damage cylinder head cover sealing surfaces.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean all sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Position seal with the concave side facing the installation tool.
2. Install seals using Special Tool MB-998306. Only hand pressure on tool is needed to install new
seals. 3. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure 170-225 psi
Max. Variation Between Cylinders 25 percent
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 1904
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the PDC. 5. Be sure throttle blade is fully open
during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gauge adaptor Special Tool 8116 or the
equivalent, into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Connect the 0-500 psi (Blue)
pressure transducer (Special Tool CH7059) with cable adaptors to the DRB III.
7. Crank engine until maximum pressure is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder
pressure. 8. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 9. Compression should not be
less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder.
10. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression
test. 11. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second
compression test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates that this vehicle has hydraulic lifters or adjusters and therefore does
not require adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Water Pump Inlet Tube to Engine Block-Bolt 105 in.lb
Water Pump to Engine Block-Bolts 105 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1911
Water Pump: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The water pump has a diecast aluminum body and housing with a stamped steel impeller. The
water pump bolts directly to the cylinder block and is driven by the timing belt. Cylinder block to
water pump sealing is provided by a rubber O-ring.
NOTE: The water pump on all models can be replaced without discharging the air conditioning
system.
OPERATION
The water pump is the heart of the cooling system. The coolant is pumped through the engine
block, cylinder head, heater core, and radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1912
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
WATER PUMP DIAGNOSIS
A quick flow test to determine water pump operation is check for proper heater operation. A
defective pump will not circulate heated coolant through the heater hoses. An additional flow test
can by performed by the following the procedures below:
WARNING: DO NOT remove radiator cap if the cooling system is hot or under pressure.
1. Remove cooling system pressure cap. 2. Remove a small amount of coolant from the system. 3.
Start the engine and warm up until thermostat opens. 4. With the thermostat open and coolant level
low, visually inspect for coolant flow. If flow is present, the water pump is pumping coolant through
the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1913
Water Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Remove right inner splash shield. 2. Remove accessory drive belts. 3.
Drain the cooling system. 4. Remove power steering pump attaching bolts and set pump and
assembly aside. Power steering lines do not need to be disconnected. 5. Remove upper and lower
torque isolator struts. 6. Support the engine from bottom and remove right engine mount attaching
bolt. 7. Remove right engine mount bracket. 8. Remove the timing belt. 9. Remove the timing belt
tensioner.
10. Remove camshaft sprocket and rear timing belt cover.
11. Remove water pump attaching screws to engine and remove pump.
INSPECTION
Replace water pump body assembly if it has any of these defects: 1. Cracks or damage on the
body 2. Coolant leaks from the shaft seal, evident by wet coolant traces on the pump body 3.
Loose or rough turning bearing. 4. Impeller rubs either the pump body or the engine block. 5.
Impeller loose or damaged. 6. Sprocket or sprocket flange loose or damaged.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar Dielectric Grease to O-ring before installation.
2. Install new O-ring gasket in water pump body O-ring groove.
CAUTION: Ensure O-ring gasket is properly seated in water pump groove before tightening
screws. An improperly located O-ring may cause damage to the O-ring, resulting in a coolant leak.
3. Assemble pump body to block and tighten screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). Pressurize cooling
system to 15 psi with pressure tester and check water
pump shaft seal and O-ring for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1914
4. Rotate pump by hand to check for freedom of movement. 5. Install timing belt rear cover and
camshaft sprocket. 6. Install timing belt tensioner. 7. Install the timing belt. 8. Install the engine right
mount bracket. 9. Install the upper and lower torque isolator struts.
10. Fill the cooling system. 11. Install the accessory drive belts. 12. Perform camshaft and
crankshaft timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB 1116 scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located
in the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity
Coolant ................................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 6.2 Liters ( 6.5 qts )
Note: Includes heater and recover/reserve bottle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 1920
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769), or the equivalent
ethylene glycol base coolant with hybrid organic corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid
Organic Additive Technology) is recommended.
This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50% Ethylene Glycol
and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F).
If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed
coolant solution.
IMPORTANT: The green coolant MUST NOT BE MIXED with the orange or magenta coolants.
When replacing coolant the complete system flush
must be performed before using the replacement coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1921
Coolant: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
Failure to use proper antifreeze could cause radiator plugging and engine overheating. Do not mix
antifreeze brands or use plain water or alcohol base antifreeze products. Do not use additional rust
inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not be compatible with the radiator coolant and may
plug the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1922
Coolant: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
CAUTION: Use of Propylene Glycol based coolants is not recommended, as they provide less
freeze protection and less corrosion protection. Do not mix coolant types. If coolant other than
Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula or equivalent is added, the mixed coolant
will have a reduced service schedule.
The use of aluminum cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion protection.
Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula or equivalent ethylene glycol based
coolant with corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) is
recommended. This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50%
Ethylene Glycol and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze point of -37 °C (-35 °F). If it loses color
or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh properly mixed coolant solution.
Mixing of coolants other than specified (nonHOAT), will reduce the 5 year/100,000 mile corrosion
protection.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1923
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CONCENTRATION TESTING
Coolant concentration should be checked when any additional coolant was added to system or
after a coolant drain, flush and refill. The coolant mixture offers optimum engine cooling and
protection against corrosion when mixed to a freeze point of -37 °C (-34 °F) to -46 °C (-50 °F). The
use of a hydrometer or a refractometer can be used to test coolant concentration. A hydrometer will
test the amount of glycol in a mixture by measuring the specific gravity of the mixture. The higher
the concentration of ethylene glycol, the larger the number of balls that will float, and higher the
freeze protection (up to a maximum of 60% by volume glycol). A refractometer (Special Tool 8286)
will test the amount of glycol in a coolant mixture by measuring the amount a beam of light bends
as it passes through the fluid. Some coolant manufactures use other types of glycols into their
coolant formulations. Propylene glycol is the most common new coolant. However, propylene
glycol based coolants do not provide the same freezing protection and corrosion protection and is
not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix types of coolant-corrosion protection will be severely reduced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Line/Hose: Specifications
Water Pump Inlet Tube to Engine Block-Bolts 105 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1927
Coolant Line/Hose: Description and Operation
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
DESCRIPTION
The water pump inlet tube connects the water pump housing to the radiator lower hose and heater
return hose. This plastic tube is sealed by an O-ring and held in place by fasteners to the block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heater Supply/Return Tubes
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Heater Supply/Return Tubes
HEATER SUPPLY RETURN TUBES
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the intake manifold to replace heater supply/return tubes.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. Disconnect positive battery cable. Remove battery. 2. Raise
vehicle on hoist. 3. Drain cooling system.
4. Remove hose clamp from heater return tube located near starter. Disconnect hose from tube. 5.
Lower vehicle 6. Remove air cleaner housing and throttle body to intake manifold hose. 7.
Disconnect PCV vacuum hose at intake manifold. 8. Remove hose clamp from heater supply tube
located near thermostat housing. Disconnect hose from tube. 9. Remove two heater hose clamps
and disconnect heater hoses near battery.
10. Unclip wiring harness from heater tube assembly 11. Remove transmission dipstick tube and
place an appropriate plug into hole to prevent coolant from entering transmission. 12. Remove
fasteners attaching heater tube assembly to cylinder head and engine block. 13. Remove heater
tube assembly.
NOTE: After heater tube assembly is removed, the short hoses connecting the tubes to the
thermostat housing and water pump inlet tube can be replaced at this time.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect all hoses that connect to heater tubes. Replace if necessary. 2. Position heater tube
assembly near it's mounting location. 3. Connect hoses at water pump inlet tube and thermostat
housing. Ensure clamps are positioned properly to seal hoses and avoid contact with engine
components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heater Supply/Return Tubes > Page 1930
4. Install fasteners attaching heater tube assembly to cylinder head and engine block.
NOTE: Before installing transmission dipstick tube clean any residual coolant from around the area
where plug was placed.
5. Remove plug from transmission dipstick tube mounting hole. Install transmission dipstick tube. 6.
Reattach wiring harness to heater tube assembly. 7. Connect two heater hoses to heater tubes
near battery. Ensure clamps are positioned properly to seal hoses and avoid contact with engine
components.
8. Connect PCV vacuum hose to intake manifold. 9. Install air cleaner housing and throttle body to
intake manifold hose.
10. Raise vehicle on hoist. 11. Close radiator draincock. 12. Lower vehicle 13. Install battery.
Connect positive battery cable. Connect negative battery cable. 14. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Line/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heater Supply/Return Tubes > Page 1931
Coolant Line/Hose: Service and Repair Water Pump Inlet Tube
WATER PUMP INLET TUBE
REMOVAL
1. Drain the cooling system. 2. Remove the radiator upper hose to access the hose connections at
the inlet tube. 3. Remove the intake manifold.
CAUTION: Do not use any sharp tools to remove hoses from inlet tube. This may cause the tube to
leak.
4. Remove the radiator lower hose and heater hose from the inlet tube. 5. Remove the lower intake
manifold support bracket. 6. Remove the inlet tube to the block fasteners. 7. Rotate tube while
removing the tube from the engine block.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring for damage before installing the tube into the cylinder block. Replace O-ring
as necessary. 2. Lubricate O-ring with Mopar Dielectric Grease and install inlet tube into the
cylinder block opening. 3. Install inlet tube fasteners and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Install
intake manifold lower support bracket fasteners and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 5. Connect the
radiator lower hose and heater hose to inlet tube. 6. Install the intake manifold. 7. Install the
radiator upper hose. 8. Fill the cooling system. 9. Pressure test cooling system and check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Specifications
Coolant Reservoir: Specifications
Coolant Recovery Container- Nut/Screw 35 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 1935
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair
COOLANT RECOVERY CONTAINER
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect recovery hose from water outlet connector/thermostat housing .
2. Remove container attaching fasteners. 3. Remove coolant recovery container.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 1936
1. Install coolant recovery container and tighten fasteners to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)).
2. Connect recovery hose to water outlet connector/thermostat housing. 3. Fill container to proper
level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Specifications
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Specifications
Radiator Fan to Radiator- Screws 65 in.lbs.
Radiator Fan Motor to Shroud- Screws 34 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagnostic Aids
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagnostic Aids > Page 1943
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagnostic Aids > Page 1944
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagnostic Aids > Page 1945
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagnostic Aids > Page 1946
Radiator Fan Motor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1947
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The radiator fan is a single speed electric motor driven fan. The radiator fan assembly components
includes an electric motor, a fan blade, and a support shroud that is attached to the radiator. Each
component of the fan assembly can be serviced separately. Depending on Engine/Transmission
combination, the vehicle may be equipped with a single fan or a dual fan.
NOTE: Vehicles equipped with dual fans, each fan blade is different from the other.
OPERATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1948
Radiator fan control operation is accomplished two ways. The fan will always run when the air
conditioning compressor clutch is engaged. In addition to this control, the fan is turned on by the
temperature of the coolant which is sensed by the coolant temperature sensor which sends the
message to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The PCM turns on the fan through a fan relay
by grounding the relay's coil. The fan relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer
to the label beneath the PDC cover for location of fan relay. The PCM will actuate the fan relay
whenever the A/C clutch is engaged regardless of coolant temperature and vehicle speed. If the
A/C clutch is not engaged, the PCM will actuate the fan relay when the coolant temperature
reaches approximately 97 °C (207 °F) and turns off the fan relay when the coolant temperature
drops to approximately 94 °C (201 °F). The fan relay is also turned off when the vehicle speed is
above approximately 100 km/h (62 mph). If the radiator fan is inoperative or a Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) related to fan control has been set, Refer to the Appropriate Diagnostic Information for
complete diagnostic procedures.
RADIATOR FAN OPERATION CHART
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1949
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: DO NOT REMOVE THE CYLINDER BLOCK PLUG OR THE RADIATOR
DRAINCOCK WITH THE SYSTEM HOT AND UNDER PRESSURE BECAUSE SERIOUS BURNS
FROM COOLANT CAN OCCUR.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Drain cooling system below the upper radiator hose
level.
3. Remove upper hose from radiator. 4. Remove fasteners that attach air cleaner housing to
vehicle. Reposition air cleaner housing. 5. Raise vehicle on hoist. 6. Disconnect and remove the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with bracket.
7. Disconnect radiator fan electrical connector. 8. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1950
9. Remove radiator upper support mounts.
10. Remove air conditioning line support bracket screw. 11. Remove radiator fan assembly screws
from radiator. 12. Carefully lift radiator fan assembly up and out of lower shroud attachment clips.
13. For radiator fan assembly sub-component removal procedures, Refer to RADIATOR FAN DISASSEMBLY.
DISASSEMBLY
The radiator fan assembly consist of the following three components: fan, fan motor, and shroud.
FAN
There are no repairs to be made to the fan. If the fan is warped, cracked, or otherwise damaged, it
must be replaced with only the recommended part for adequate strength, performance and safety.
1. Remove radiator fan assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1951
2. Remove fan hub retaining nut. 3. Remove fan from motor shaft.
FAN MOTOR
1. Remove radiator fan assembly. 2. Remove fan from motor shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1952
3. Remove screw attaching the in-rush current suppressor. 4. Remove screws attaching motor to
shroud . 5. Remove the fan motor.
SHROUD
1. Remove radiator fan assembly. 2. Remove the FAN. 3. Remove the FAN MOTOR.
ASSEMBLY
FAN There are no repairs to be made to the fan. If the fan is warped, cracked, or otherwise
damaged, it must be replaced with only the recommended part for adequate strength, performance
and safety. 1. Install fan on motor shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1953
2. Install fan retaining nut and tighten to 6.2 Nm (55 in. lbs.). 3. Install radiator fan assembly.
FAN MOTOR
1. Install the fan motor on shroud and tighten screws to 3.8 Nm (34 in. lbs.).
2. Install screw attaching the in-rush current suppressor and tighten to 2.6 Nm (23 in. lbs.). 3. Install
the fan on motor shaft. 4. Install the radiator fan assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1954
SHROUD
1. Install the FAN MOTOR 2. Install the FAN . 3. Install the radiator fan assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install radiator fan assembly by lowering into position on radiator. Ensure the fan assembly lower
mounts are engaged properly into slots on lower
radiator tank.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1955
2. Install the radiator fan assembly retaining screws and tighten to 7.5 Nm (65 in. lbs.) . 3. Install
radiator upper support mounts and tighten bolts to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
4. Install air conditioning line support bracket screw. 5. Raise vehicle on hoist.
6. Connect radiator fan electrical connector. 7. Install powertrain control module (PCM). 8. Lower
vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1956
9. Install air cleaner housing fasteners.
10. Install radiator upper hose to radiator. Align hose and position clamp to ensure proper
clearance with engine or hood. 11. Fill cooling system. 12. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1960
Radiator Fan Relays
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1961
Radiator Fan High Relay (1.6L/2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1962
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
CHECKING RADIATOR FAN RELAY OUTPUT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radiator fan relay operation
- Ground circuit open
- Radiator fan motor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1963
- Fused B+ circuit
- Radiator fan relay output circuit
- Radiator fan relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Specifications
Fan Blade: Specifications
Radiator Fan Blade to Motor Shaft-Nut 55 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Application and ID
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Climate Controls ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1974
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1975
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1976
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1977
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Locations
Heater Core: Locations
Fig.14 Heater Core
The heater core is located in the heater-A/C unit housing, under the instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1981
Heater Core: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO PASSIVE RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT
PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE PROPER
PRE-CAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
- DO NOT OPEN THE RADIATOR DRAIN-COCK OR DISCONNECT COOLANT HOSES WHEN
THE SYSTEM IS HOT AND UNDER PRESSURE. SERIOUS BURNS FROM COOLANT CAN
OCCUR.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1982
Heater Core: Description and Operation
Fig.51 Heater Core
HEATER CORE
The heater core is located in the heater-A/C unit housing, under the instrument panel. It is a heat
exchanger made of rows of tubes and fins. One end of the core is fitted with a molded plastic tank
that includes the integral heater core hose nipples.
Engine coolant is circulated through heater hoses to the heater core at all times. As the coolant
flows through the heater core, heat removed from the engine is transferred to the heater core fins
and tubes. Air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the heater core fins. The
blend air door allows control of the heater output air temperature by controlling how much of the air
flowing through the heater-A/C housing is directed through the heater core. The blower motor
speed controls the volume of air flowing through the heater-A/C housing.
The heater core cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced. Refer to Cooling
System for more information on the engine cooling system, the engine coolant and the heater
hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1983
Heater Core: Service and Repair
HEATER CORE
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS. FAILURE TO TAKE THE PROPER
PRE-CAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIR-BAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: DO NOT OPEN THE RADIATOR DRAIN-COCK OR DISCONNECT COOLANT
HOSES WHEN THE SYSTEM IS HOT AND UNDER PRESSURE. SERIOUS BURNS FROM
COOLANT CAN OCCUR.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Drain the cooling system. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling,
and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service and Repair" See: Service and Repair 3. Evacuate the
refrigerant system. Refer to: "Heating and Air Conditioning : Service and Repair" See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Service
and Repair
4. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Trim, Dashboard/Instrument
Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument
Panel Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Assembly Replacement, See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Assembly
5. Remove the refrigerant lines from the evaporator connections. 6. Remove the heater core
coolant supply hoses from the heater core.
INSTALLATION
Refer to HVAC Housing Assembly for heater core installation procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service Precautions
Heater Hose: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess pressure.
The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
- When installing hoses to heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive pressure.
The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose Replacement
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose Replacement
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement - LHD
HEATER INLET HOSE - LHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.54 Heater Hose Assembly - LHD 2.0L (Typical 2.4L)
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove clamps at end of heater hose to be
removed. 3. Carefully rotate hose back and forth while pulling away from connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Using spring tension clamp pliers, install the hose ends into position. 2. Refill the cooling system.
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement - RHD
HEATER INLET HOSE - RHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 1989
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.46 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove clamps at end of heater hose to be
removed 3. Carefully rotate hose back and forth while pulling away from connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Using spring tension clamp pliers, install the hose ends into position. 2. Refill the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 1990
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Return Hose Replacement
Heater Return Hose Replacement - LHD
HEATER RETURN HOSE - LHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from the heater core inlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.54 Heater Hose Assembly - LHD 2.0L (Typical 2.4L)
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove the clamps at the end of the heater
hoses to be removed. 3. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pulling away from the
connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When installing hoses to heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
1. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pushing the hose onto the connector nipple. 2.
Using spring tension pliers, install the clamps at the end of the heater hose being installed. 3. Refill
the cooling system.
Heater Return Hose Replacement - RHD
HEATER RETURN HOSE - RHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from the heater core inlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 1991
leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.46 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove the clamps at the end of the heater
hoses to be removed. 3. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pulling away from the
connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pushing the hose onto the connector nipple. 2.
Using spring tension pliers, install the clamps at the end of the heater hose being installed. 3. Refill
the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Radiator Drain Plug >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Radiator Drain Plug: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain the cooling system.
2. Turn the draincock stem counterclockwise to unscrew the stem. When the stem is unscrewed to
the end of the threads, pull the stem from the
radiator tank.
INSTALLATION
1. Push the draincock assembly body into the tank opening. 2. Tighten the draincock stem by
turning clockwise to 2.0 - 2.7 Nm (18 - 25 in. lbs.). 3. Fill the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Radiator Cap: Description and Operation
COOLING SYSTEM PRESSURE CAP
DESCRIPTION
The cooling system is equipped with a pressure cap that releases built up pressure, maintaining a
range of 97 - 124 kPa (14 - 18 psi). There is also a vent valve in the center of the cap. This valve
also opens when coolant is cooling and contracting, allowing coolant to return to radiator from
coolant reserve/recovery system container by vacuum through connecting hose. If valve is stuck
shut, the radiator hoses will be collapsed on cool down. Clean the vent valve to ensure proper
sealing when boiling point is reached.
OPERATION
The pressure cap allows the cooling system to operate at higher than atmospheric pressure. The
higher pressure raises the coolant boiling point; this allows increased radiator cooling capacity. The
gasket in the cap seals the filler neck, so that vacuum can be maintained, allowing coolant to be
drawn back into the radiator from the reserve container.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Radiator Cap: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION
Hold the cap in your hand, top side up. The vent valve at the bottom of the cap should open. If the
rubber gasket has swollen, preventing the valve from opening, replace the cap. Hold the cleaned
cap in your hand, upside down. If any light can be seen between vent valve and the rubber gasket,
replace the cap. Do not use a replacement cap that has a spring to hold the vent shut. A
replacement cap must be of the type designed for coolant reserve systems. This design ensures
coolant return to the radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2001
Radiator Cap: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Cooling System Pressure Relief Testing
COOLING SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF TESTING
WARNING: THE WARNING WORDS "DO NOT OPEN HOT" ON THE PRESSURE CAP IS A
SAFETY PRECAUTION. WHEN HOT, THE COOLING SYSTEM BUILDS UP PRESSURE. TO
PREVENT SCALDING OR OTHER INJURY, THE PRESSURE CAP SHOULD NOT BE
REMOVED WHILE THE SYSTEM IS HOT AND/OR UNDER PRESSURE.
The pressure cap upper gasket to filler neck seal can be checked by removing the overflow hose at
the filler neck overflow nipple. Attach the radiator pressure tester to the filler neck overflow nipple,
and pump air into the system. The pressure cap upper gasket should relieve pressure at 69 - 124
kPa (10 - 18 psi), and hold pressure at 55 kPa (8 psi) minimum. There is no need to remove the
pressure cap at any time except for the following purposes: ^
Check and adjust coolant freeze point
^ Refill system with new coolant
^ Conducting service procedures
^ Checking for leaks
WARNING: IF VEHICLE HAS BEEN RUN RECENTLY, WAIT 15 MINUTES BEFORE REMOVING
CAP. PLACE A SHOP TOWEL OVER THE CAP, AND WITHOUT PUSHING DOWN, ROTATE IT
COUNTERCLOCKWISE TO THE FIRST STOP. ALLOW FLUIDS TO ESCAPE THROUGH THE
OVERFLOW TUBE. WHEN THE SYSTEM STOPS PUSHING COOLANT AND STEAM INTO THE
CRS TANK AND PRESSURE DROPS, PUSH DOWN ON THE CAP AND REMOVE IT
COMPLETELY. SQUEEZING THE RADIATOR INLET HOSE WITH A SHOP TOWEL (TO CHECK
PRESSURE) BEFORE AND AFTER TURNING TO THE FIRST STOP IS RECOMMENDED.
Radiator Cap Testing
COOLING SYSTEM PRESSURE CAP TESTING
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2002
Dip the pressure cap in water. Clean any deposits off the vent valve or its seat and apply cap to
end of the Pressure Cap Test Adaptor that is included with the Cooling System Tester 7700.
Working the plunger, bring the pressure to 104 kPa (15 psi) on the gauge. If the pressure cap fails
to hold pressure of at least 97 kPa (14 psi), replace the pressure cap.
CAUTION: The Cooling System Tester Tool is very sensitive to small air leaks that will not cause
cooling system problems. A pressure cap that does not have a history of coolant loss should not be
replaced just because it leaks slowly when tested with this tool. Add water to the tool. Turn tool
upside down and recheck pressure cap to confirm that cap is bad. If the pressure cap tests
properly while positioned on Cooling System Tester, but will not hold pressure or vacuum when
positioned on the filler neck. Inspect the filler neck and cap top gasket for irregularities that may
prevent the cap from sealing properly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 2003
Radiator Cap: Service and Repair
CLEANING
Use only a mild soap to clean the pressure cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2008
Radiator Fan Relays
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2009
Radiator Fan High Relay (1.6L/2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2010
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
CHECKING RADIATOR FAN RELAY OUTPUT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radiator fan relay operation
- Ground circuit open
- Radiator fan motor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2011
- Fused B+ circuit
- Radiator fan relay output circuit
- Radiator fan relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information >
Application and ID
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Climate Controls ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2020
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2021
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2022
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2023
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Opening Temperature .........................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 195 °F Full Opening Temperature .................................
..................................................................................................................................................... 216
°F
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2027
Thermostat: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The engine thermostat is located on the left front side (radiator side) of the cylinder head in the
thermostat housing/engine outlet connector. The thermostat has an air bleed (vent) located in the
flange and a O-ring for sealing incorporate on it. A relief in the thermostat housing/outlet connector
is provided for the O-ring.
OPERATION
The engine thermostat is a wax pellet driven, reverse poppet choke type. It is designed to provide
the fastest warm up possible by preventing leakage through it and to guarantee a minimum engine
operating temperature of 88 to 93° C (192 to 199° F). Also, the thermostat will automatically reach
wide open, to accommodate unrestricted flow to the radiator as temperature of the coolant rises in
hot weather to around 104° C (220° F). Above this temperature the coolant temperature is
controlled by the radiator, fan, and ambient temperature-not the thermostat. A thermostats primary
purpose is to maintain engine temperature in a range that will provide satisfactory engine
performance and emission levels under all expected driving conditions. It also provides hot water
(coolant) for heater performance. It does this by transferring heat from engine metal and automatic
transmission oil cooler (if equipped) to coolant, moving this heated coolant to the heater core and
radiator, and then transferring this heat to the ambient air.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2028
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE THERMOSTAT TESTING
The thermostat that opens too soon type failure mode is included in the on-board diagnosis. The
check engine light will not be lit by an open too soon condition. If it has failed open, a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) will be set. Do not change a thermostat for lack of heater performance or
temperature gauge position, unless a DTC is present. Thermostat failing shut is the normal long
term mode of failure, and normally, only on high mileage vehicles. The temperature gauge will
indicate this.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2029
Thermostat: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain cooling system to the thermostat level or below. 2. Remove coolant recovery/reserve
system hose and radiator upper hose.
3. Remove thermostat/engine outlet connector bolts. 4. Remove thermostat and O-ring assembly
INSTALLATION
1. Clean all sealing surfaces. 2. Place the new thermostat assembly into the thermostat
housing/outlet connector. Align vent with notch in cylinder head. 3. Install thermostat housing/outlet
connector onto cylinder head and tighten bolts to 12.5 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 4. Install the radiator upper
hose. 5. Connect the coolant recovery/reserve system hose. 6. Fill the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications
Thermostat Housing: Specifications
Thermostat Housing/Water Outlet Connector-Screws 105 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Water Pump Inlet Tube to Engine Block-Bolt 105 in.lb
Water Pump to Engine Block-Bolts 105 in.lb
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2036
Water Pump: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The water pump has a diecast aluminum body and housing with a stamped steel impeller. The
water pump bolts directly to the cylinder block and is driven by the timing belt. Cylinder block to
water pump sealing is provided by a rubber O-ring.
NOTE: The water pump on all models can be replaced without discharging the air conditioning
system.
OPERATION
The water pump is the heart of the cooling system. The coolant is pumped through the engine
block, cylinder head, heater core, and radiator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2037
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
WATER PUMP DIAGNOSIS
A quick flow test to determine water pump operation is check for proper heater operation. A
defective pump will not circulate heated coolant through the heater hoses. An additional flow test
can by performed by the following the procedures below:
WARNING: DO NOT remove radiator cap if the cooling system is hot or under pressure.
1. Remove cooling system pressure cap. 2. Remove a small amount of coolant from the system. 3.
Start the engine and warm up until thermostat opens. 4. With the thermostat open and coolant level
low, visually inspect for coolant flow. If flow is present, the water pump is pumping coolant through
the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2038
Water Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Remove right inner splash shield. 2. Remove accessory drive belts. 3.
Drain the cooling system. 4. Remove power steering pump attaching bolts and set pump and
assembly aside. Power steering lines do not need to be disconnected. 5. Remove upper and lower
torque isolator struts. 6. Support the engine from bottom and remove right engine mount attaching
bolt. 7. Remove right engine mount bracket. 8. Remove the timing belt. 9. Remove the timing belt
tensioner.
10. Remove camshaft sprocket and rear timing belt cover.
11. Remove water pump attaching screws to engine and remove pump.
INSPECTION
Replace water pump body assembly if it has any of these defects: 1. Cracks or damage on the
body 2. Coolant leaks from the shaft seal, evident by wet coolant traces on the pump body 3.
Loose or rough turning bearing. 4. Impeller rubs either the pump body or the engine block. 5.
Impeller loose or damaged. 6. Sprocket or sprocket flange loose or damaged.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Mopar Dielectric Grease to O-ring before installation.
2. Install new O-ring gasket in water pump body O-ring groove.
CAUTION: Ensure O-ring gasket is properly seated in water pump groove before tightening
screws. An improperly located O-ring may cause damage to the O-ring, resulting in a coolant leak.
3. Assemble pump body to block and tighten screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). Pressurize cooling
system to 15 psi with pressure tester and check water
pump shaft seal and O-ring for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2039
4. Rotate pump by hand to check for freedom of movement. 5. Install timing belt rear cover and
camshaft sprocket. 6. Install timing belt tensioner. 7. Install the timing belt. 8. Install the engine right
mount bracket. 9. Install the upper and lower torque isolator struts.
10. Fill the cooling system. 11. Install the accessory drive belts. 12. Perform camshaft and
crankshaft timing relearn procedure as follows:
^ Connect the DRB 1116 scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located
in the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of instrument panel near the steering column.
^ Turn the ignition switch on.
^ Access "Engine" diagnostics.
^ Select "Miscellaneous" option.
^ Select "ReLearn Cam Crank" option and follow directions on DRB III screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications
Catalytic Converter: Specifications
Catalytic converter to exhaust manifold flange-fasteners 250 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2044
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2045
An under-floor catalytic converter is used on all three converter packages; EURO, Low Emission
Vehicle (LEV), and the High Output engine.
CAUTION: Due to exterior physical similarities of some catalytic converters with pipe assemblies,
extreme care should be taken with replacement parts.
An exhaust flex-joint coupling secures the catalytic converter to the exhaust manifold by using four
fasteners and a gasket for sealing. The flex-joint is serviced with the catalytic converter.
CAUTION: When servicing the catalytic converter, care must be exercised not to dent or bend the
flexjoint. Should this occur, the flex-joint will eventually fail and require the catalytic converter to be
replaced. Do not allow the exhaust system to hang unsupported. If the isolators are removed and
the catalytic converter is still attached to the exhaust manifold, failure to the flex joint will result.
OPERATION
The three-way catalytic converter simultaneously converts three exhaust emissions into harmless
gases. Specifically, HC and CO emissions are converted into water (H20) and Carbon Dioxide
(C02). Oxides of Nitrogen (NOx) are converted into elemental Nitrogen (N) and water. The
three-way catalyst is most efficient in converting HC, CO and NOx at the stoichiometric air fuel ratio
of 14.7:1. The oxygen content in a catalyst is important for efficient conversion of exhaust gases.
When a high oxygen content (lean) air/fuel ratio is present for an extended period, oxygen content
in a catalyst can reach a maximum. When a rich air/fuel ratio is present for an extended period, the
oxygen content in the catalyst can become totally depleted. When this occurs, the catalyst fails to
convert the gases. This is known as catalyst "punch through." Catalyst operation is dependent on
its ability to store and release the oxygen needed to complete the emissions-reducing chemical
reactions. As a catalyst deteriorates, its ability to store oxygen is reduced. Since the catalyst's
ability to store oxygen is somewhat related to proper operation, oxygen storage can be used as an
indicator of catalyst performance. Refer to the appropriate Diagnostic Information for diagnosis of a
catalyst related
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2046
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). The combustion reaction caused by the catalyst releases
additional heat in the exhaust system, causing temperature increases in the area of the reactor
under severe operating conditions. Such conditions can exist when the engine misfires or
otherwise does not operate at peak efficiency. Do not remove spark plug wires from plugs or by
any other means short out cylinders, if exhaust system is equipped with a catalytic converter.
Failure of the catalytic converter can occur due to temperature increases caused by unburned fuel
passing through the converter. This deterioration of the catalyst core can result in excessively high
emission levels, noise complaints, and exhaust restrictions. Unleaded gasoline must be used to
avoid ruining the catalyst core. Do not allow engine to operate above 1200 RPM in neutral for
extended periods over 5 minutes. This condition may result in excessive exhaust system/floor pan
temperatures because of no air movement under the vehicle. The flex joint allows flexing as the
engine moves, preventing breakage that could occur from the back-and-forth motion of a
transverse mounted engine.
CAUTION: Due to exterior physical similarities of some catalytic converters with pipe assemblies,
extreme care should be taken with replacement parts. There are internal converter differences
required in some parts of the country (particularly vehicles built for States with strict emission
requirements) and between model years.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2047
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM IS VERY
HIGH. THEREFORE, NEVER ATTEMPT TO SERVICE ANY PART OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM
UNTIL IT IS COOLED. SPECIAL CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN WHEN WORKING NEAR THE
CATALYTIC CONVERTER. THE TEMPERATURE OF THE CONVERTER RISES TO A HIGH
LEVEL AFTER A SHORT PERIOD OF ENGINE OPERATION TIME.
1. Remove muffler and exhaust pipe. 2. Disconnect the downstream oxygen sensor electrical
connector.
3. Remove the exhaust manifold support bracket (LEV only).
4. Remove catalytic converter to exhaust manifold attaching fasteners and remove converter from
vehicle. 5. Remove and discard the flange gasket.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, original equipment
parts (or equivalent) must be used.
INSPECTION
WARNING: THE NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM IS VERY
HIGH. THEREFORE, NEVER ATTEMPT TO SERVICE ANY PART OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM
UNTIL IT IS COOLED. SPECIAL CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN WHEN WORKING NEAR THE
CATALYTIC CONVERTER. THE TEMPERATURE OF THE CONVERTER RISES TO A HIGH
LEVEL AFTER A SHORT PERIOD OF ENGINE OPERATION TIME.
Check catalytic converter for a flow restriction. Visually inspect the catalytic converter element by
using a borescope or equivalent. Remove oxygen sensor(s) and insert borescope. If borescope is
not available, remove converter and inspect element using a flashlight. Inspect element for cracked
or melted substrate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2048
NOTE: Before replacing a catalytic converter, determine the root cause of failure. Most catalytic
converter failures are caused by air, fuel or ignition problems. Refer to the Appropriate Diagnostic
Information for test procedures.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until all components are aligned
and clearances are checked.
1. Assemble catalytic converter to exhaust manifold connection. Use a new flange gasket. 2. Install
exhaust manifold support bracket (LEV only). Tighten M10 bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.), M12 bolt to 95
Nm (70 ft. lbs.), and nut to 28 Nm
(250 in. lbs.).
3. Install bolt attaching manifold support bracket to the heat shield (NLEV only). Tighten bolt to 28
Nm (250 in. lbs.). 4. Assemble muffler and exhaust pipe to catalytic converter. Install muffler and
pipe support isolators to the underbody
5. Tighten the catalytic converter to exhaust manifold fasteners to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.). 6. Working
from the front of the system; align each component to maintain position and proper clearance with
under body components. Tighten all
slip joint band clamps to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Exhaust band clamps should never be tightened such that the two sides of the clamps
are bottomed out against the center hourglass shaped center block. Once this occurs, the clamp
has lost clamping force and must be replaced.
7. If removed, install downstream oxygen sensor. 8. Connect downstream oxygen sensor electrical
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Exhaust Manifold to Cylinder Head 200 in.lb
Exhaust Manifold Support Bracket M8 Bolts 250 in.lb
Fed and LEV
M10 Bolts 40 ft.lb
M12 Bolts 70 ft.lb
Exhaust Manifold Support Bracket 40 ft.lb
ULEV
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2052
Exhaust Manifold: Description and Operation
EXHAUST MANIFOLD - HIGH OUTPUT
DESCRIPTION
The exhaust manifold is a welded construction using lightweight tubular steel with stamped plate
steel mounting flanges. The manifold attaches to the cylinder head.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2053
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist.
3. Remove bolt attaching the wire harness heat shield to the exhaust manifold support bracket.
4. Remove exhaust manifold support bracket. 5. Remove fasteners attaching exhaust system flex
joint to exhaust manifold flange. Move exhaust system rearward to clear flange studs. 6. Lower
vehicle. 7. Disconnect make-up air hose from rear of cylinder head cover. 8. Disconnect oxygen
sensor connector and harness clip. 9. Remove heat shield attaching bolts.
10. Remove upper heat shield for access to manifold bolts. 11. Remove exhaust manifold bolts. 12.
Remove exhaust manifold from top of vehicle, between the cylinder head and cowl.
INSTALLATION
1. Position exhaust manifold and gasket in place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2054
2. Install exhaust manifold bolts and tighten in sequence shown to 23 Nm (200 in. lbs.). 3. Position
lower and upper heat shield on exhaust manifold. Install heat shield bolts and tighten to 11 Nm (95
in. lbs.). 4. Connect oxygen sensor electrical connector and harness clip. 5. Connect make-up air
hose on cylinder head cover port. 6. Raise vehicle. 7. Install new flex joint to manifold flange
gasket. 8. Attach exhaust system to manifold flange and tighten fasteners to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.).
9. Install exhaust manifold support bracket and tighten fasteners.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2055
10. Install bolt attaching wire harness heat shield to support bracket. 11. Lower vehicle. 12.
Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair
INTERMEDIATE PIPE
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM IS VERY
HIGH. THEREFORE, NEVER WORK AROUND OR ATTEMPT TO SERVICE ANY PART OF THE
EXHAUST SYSTEM UNTIL IT IS COOLED. SPECIAL CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN WHEN
WORKING NEAR THE CATALYTIC CONVERTER. THE TEMPERATURE OF THE CONVERTER
RISES TO A HIGH LEVEL AFTER A SHORT PERIOD OF ENGINE OPERATING TIME.
1. Raise vehicle on hoist and apply penetrating oil to band clamp fastener of component being
removed.
NOTE: Do not use petroleum-based lubricants when removing/installing muffler or exhaust pipe
isolators as it may compromise the life of the part. A suitable substitute is a mixture of liquid dish
soap and water.
2. Remove the muffler.
3. Loosen band clamp at the catalytic converter to intermediate pipe joint 4. Remove intermediate
pipe support isolator. Separate at slip joint and remove intermediate pipe. 5. Clean ends of pipes
and muffler to assure mating of all parts. Discard broken or worn isolators, rusted or overused
clamps, supports, and attaching
parts.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, you must use
original equipment parts (or their equivalent).
INSTALLATION
When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until components are aligned and
clearances are checked.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2059
1. Assemble intermediate pipe to catalytic converter and the isolator support to the underbody. 2.
Install the muffler to intermediate pipe and the isolator supports to the underbody 3. Working from
the front of system; align each component to maintain position and proper clearance with
underbody parts.
4. Tighten all band clamps to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Band clamps should never be tightened such that the two sides of the clamps are
bottomed out against the center hourglass shaped center block. Once this occurs, the clamp band
has been stretched and has lost its clamping force and must be replaced.*
NOTE: ^
*To replace the band clamp; remove the nut and peel back the ends of the clamp until spot weld
breaks.
^ Maintain proper clamp orientation when replacing with new clamp.
5. Connect the exhaust system ground strap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Heat Shield: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The heat shields,, and are needed to protect both the vehicle and the environment from the high
temperatures developed in the vicinity of the catalytic converter.
CAUTION: Avoid application of rust prevention compounds or undercoating materials to exhaust
system floor pan heat shield on cars if equipped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2063
Light over-spray near the edges is permitted. Application of coating will greatly reduce the
efficiency of the heat shields resulting in excessive floor pan temperatures and objectionable
fumes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2064
Heat Shield: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2065
2. Remove fasteners attaching heat shield to under body, or engine component. 3. Remove heat
shield(s).
INSTALLATION
1. Position heat shield to underbody, or engine component. 2. Install and tighten heat shield
fasteners,,, or 3. Inspect heat shield to exhaust system clearances and adjust as necessary. 4.
Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Muffler: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM IS VERY
HIGH. THEREFORE, NEVER WORK AROUND OR ATTEMPT TO SERVICE ANY PART OF THE
EXHAUST SYSTEM UNTIL IT IS COOLED. SPECIAL CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN WHEN
WORKING NEAR THE CATALYTIC CONVERTER. THE TEMPERATURE OF THE CONVERTER
RISES TO A HIGH LEVEL AFTER A SHORT PERIOD OF ENGINE OPERATING TIME.
1. Raise vehicle on hoist and apply penetrating oil to band clamp fastener of component being
removed.
NOTE: Do not use petroleum-based lubricants when removing/installing muffler or exhaust pipe
isolators as it may compromise the life of the part. A suitable substitute is a mixture of liquid dish
soap and water.
2. Remove exhaust system ground strap. 3. Loosen band clamp and remove support isolators at
muffler. Remove muffler from exhaust pipe. 4. Clean ends of pipes and muffler to assure mating of
all parts. Discard broken or worn isolators, rusted or overused clamps, supports, and attaching
parts.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, you must use
original equipment parts (or their equivalent).
INSTALLATION
When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until components are aligned and
clearances are checked. 1. Install the muffler to intermediate pipe and the isolator supports to the
underbody. 2. Working from the front of system; align each component to maintain position and
proper clearance with underbody parts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2069
3. Tighten all band clamps to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Band clamps should never be tightened such that the two sides of the clamps are
bottomed out against the center hourglass shaped center block. Once this occurs, the clamp band
has been stretched and has lost its clamping force and must be replaced.*
NOTE: ^
*To replace the band clamp; remove the nut and peel back the ends of the clamp until spot weld
breaks.
^ Maintain proper clamp orientation when replacing with new clamp.
4. Connect the exhaust system ground strap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2077
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2078
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2079
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2080
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2081
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2082
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2083
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2084
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2085
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2086
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2087
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2088
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2089
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2090
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2091
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2092
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2093
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2094
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2095
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2096
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2097
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2098
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2099
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2100
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2101
Body Control Module: Electrical Diagrams
Airbag System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2102
Audio System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2103
CD Changer
Compass/Temperature Mirror
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2104
Exterior Lighting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2105
Instrument Cluster
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2106
Interior Lighting
Power Door Locks/RKE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2107
Vehicle Communication
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2108
Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Technician Safety Information
Body Control Module: Technician Safety Information
SERVICING SUB-ASSEMBLIES
Some components of the body system are intended to be serviced as an assembly only.
Attempting to remove or repair certain system sub-components may result in personal injury and/or
improper system operation. Only those components with approved repair and installation
procedures should be serviced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Technician Safety Information > Page 2111
Body Control Module: Vehicle Damage Warnings
Electrical Testing Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "off". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation, this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion. Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent
accidental shorting of terminals Such mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second
code could be set, making diagnosis of the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description
Body Control Module: Description and Operation System Description
Identification Of System
The vehicle systems that are part of the "body" system are:
- Airbag System
- Audio
- Compass/Temperature Mirror
- Instrument Cluster
- Interior Lighting
- Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
- Vehicle Communications
- Vehicle Theft Security System
System Description
The body system on the 2003 PL consists of a combination of modules that communicate over the
PCI bus (Programmable Communication Interface multiplex system).
Through the PCI bus, information about the operation of vehicle components and circuits is relayed
quickly to the appropriate module(s). All modules receive all the information transmitted on the bus
even though a module may not require all information to perform it's function. It will only respond to
messages "addressed" to it through a binary coding process.
This method of data transmission significantly reduces the complexity of the wiring in the vehicle
and the size of wiring harnesses. All of the information about the functioning of all the systems is
organized, controlled, and communicated by the PCI bus, which is described in the Vehicle
Communication See: Functional Operation/Vehicle Communication of this general information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2114
Body Control Module: Description and Operation Functional Operation
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE
THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
DRIVER AIRBAG (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93 °C (200 °F).
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation, The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches on vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged. The clockspring cannot be repaired it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2115
PASSENGER AIRBAG (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and its
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON
GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG
MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING
INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93
degrees C (200 degrees F).
WARNING: REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN
THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR
INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT
PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE
AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY
DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY
SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT
FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG.
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
They are located on the left and right B-post. The SIACM perform self diagnostics and circuit tests
to determine if the system is functioning properly. If the test finds a problem the SIACM will set both
active and stored diagnostic trouble codes. If a DTC is active the SIACM will request that the airbag
warning lamp be turned on. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI Bus to the
ACM once each second or on change in lamp state. If the warning lamp status message from the
either SIACM contains a lamp on request the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the
DTC is set the ACM sends a PCI Bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC)
requesting the airbag warning lamp be turned on. Observe all ACM warning and caution
statements when servicing or handling the SIACM. SIACM are not repairable and must be replaced
if they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
SEAT AIRBAGS
The Left and Right seat airbag modules are located in the outboard end of the front seat backs.
The airbag module contains a bag, an inflator (a small canister of highly compressed argon gas)
and a mounting bracket. The seat airbag module cannot be repaired and must be replaced if
deployed or in any way damaged. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the inflator seals
the hole in the airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the
cushion. Upon deployment, the seat back trim cover will tear open and allow the seat airbag to fully
deploy between the seat and the door.
NOTE: It will be necessary to remove the seat back trim to gain access to the seat airbag module
connector when diagnosing the seat airbag system.
WARNING: THE SEAT AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI.
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR.
DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT
STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93 degrees C (200 degrees F). REPLACE AIRBAG
SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL
DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS,
SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE
SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY
MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS
NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE
PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Some airbag diagnostic tests use special tools, 8310 and 8443 airbag load tool, for testing squib
circuits. The load tools contain fixed resistive loads, jumpers and adapters. The fixed loads are
connected to cables and mounted in a storage case. The cables can be directly connected to some
airbag system connectors. Jumpers are used to convert the load tool cable connectors to the other
airbag system connectors. The adapters are connected to the module harness connector to open
shorting clips and protect the connector terminal during testing. When using the load tool follow all
of the safety procedures in the service information for disconnecting airbag system components.
Inspect the wiring, connector and terminals for damage or misalignment. Substitute the airbag load
tool in place of a Driver or Passenger Airbag, curtain airbag, clockspring, or seat belt tensioner (use
a jumper if needed). Then follow all of the safety procedures in the service information for
connecting airbag system components. Read the module active DTC's. If the module reports NO
ACTIVE DTC's the defective component has been removed from the system and should be
replaced. If the DTC is still active, continue this process until all components in the circuit have
been tested. Then disconnect the module connector and connect the matching adapter to the
module connector. With all airbags disconnected and the adapter installed the squib wiring can be
tested for open and shorted conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2116
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: *
Erase the stored codes
* Place the ignition in the Run position
* Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
* Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
* Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Audio System
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system on the 2003 PL consists of a radio that communicates over the PCI bus. The
speakers are located in the instrument panel, the front doors and the rear "D" pillars. The
instrument panel speakers are a tweeter type speaker for high frequency. The front door speakers
are a woofer/midrange type speaker. The rear "D" pillar speakers are a full range type speaker. If
one of the speaker circuits experiences a short, the other speakers on that output channel will also
shut down until the circuit is repaired. The radio will also set a trouble code, which the DRB III(R)
can display.
The in-dash CD-changer is designed to fit into the existing cubby bin in the center stack. This new
cartridge-less CD-changer is controlled by your radio, and allows you to individually load up to four
discs at one time. However, due to its compact design, the CD-changer can only carry out one
operation at a time. For example you can not load a new disc while playing another at the same
time. Each operation happens sequentially.
The radio unit installed with your system provides control over all features of the CD-changer with
the exception of the CD load and eject functions, which are controlled by buttons located on the
front of the CD-changer. The radio also supplies the power, ground, PCI Bus, left and right speaker
output through a single DIN cable. All features you would expect , such as Disc Up/Down, Track
Up/Down, Random and Scan are controlled by the radio, which also displays all relevant
CD-changer information on the radio display.
The CD-changer contains a Load/Eject button and an indicator light for each of the four disc
positions. The individual light indicates whether a CD is currently loaded in that particular chamber
of the CD-changer. Pressing the individual Load/Eject button for a particular chamber will eject a
disc currently present in the chamber. If the chamber is currently empty, actuating the Load/Eject
button will position that chamber to receive and load a new
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2117
disc in that chamber.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Compass/Temperature Mirror
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2118
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2119
magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may
appear to indicate false headings or appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may
need to be demagnetized. Refer to Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory, the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the
displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the
PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2120
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Exterior Lighting
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
The Headlamps are controlled by the Instrument Cluster.
The Instrument Cluster is also referred to as a "Smart Cluster". It receives and sends messages to
other modules through the PCI BUS circuit. The Headlamps are wired through the cluster and then
go to the Fuse Block to the lamps. Each Headlamp has an independent fuse located in the Fuse
Block.
For vehicles equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL Module is integrated with the
Instrument Cluster.
Interior Lighting
INTERIOR LIGHTING
The Courtesy Lamps are controlled by the instrument cluster.
Some of the features that it controls are the courtesy lamps, chime, and all instrument illumination.
It receives and sends messages to other modules via the PCI bus circuit.
The front turn signals are wired through the cluster and then go to the front lamps. For vehicles
equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL module is built into the cluster.
Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The Remote Keyless Entry module controls the Power Door Locks and the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). It also wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn on the illuminated entry when it
senses a signal from the RKE transmitter. The module communicates with other modules via the
PCI bus circuit.
The RKE module monitors the Occupant Restraint Controller messages for the purpose of
monitoring the deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message along with the verification
that the ignition is on and the vehicle speed is zero, it will provide the "enhanced accident response
feature". This feature will cause the module to unlock-all doors immediately and the instrument
cluster to turn the courtesy lamps on when the vehicle reaches 0 mph.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message, and receive
body style information. Two transmitters are supplied with the vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. The horn chirp on vehicle lock command is customer programmable.
To limit the amount of battery drain during storage, the IOD fuse may be removed.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM
When the VTSS is armed, it will monitor the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle
doors and decklid. Also monitored is a decklid security switch (knockout) for the cylinder lock. If the
alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2121
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, by
using the driver door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of an open decklid security switch sense circuit.
Disarming can be accomplished with a RKE unlock, turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key
or unlocking the vehicle with the driver door cylinder lock. All of the switches for the VTSS system
can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to determine the cause of a
customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM (Export Only)
When the VTSS is armed, it Will monitor the interior of the vehicle for movement via an intrusion
sensor (if equipped), the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle doors, decklid and
hood. Vehicles without an intrusion sensor will have a decklid security switch (knockout) which will
also be monitored. If the alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn or a battery backed siren
for vehicles equipped with the intrusion sensor, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, or
by using either door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of the hood ajar circuit being shorted (hood opened) or the decklid
security switch circuit being open (if equipped). Defeating the intrusion sensor feature for vehicles
so equipped can be done by three additional lock request to the RKE module within 5 seconds.
Disarming is done by either a RKE unlock or turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key. All of
the switches for the VTSS system can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to
determine the cause of a customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
Vehicle Communication
VEHICLE COMMUNICATION
The Programmable Communication Interface or PCI Bus is a single wire multiplexed network
capable of supporting binary encoded messages shared between multiple modules. The PCI bus
circuit is identified as D25. The modules are wired in parallel. Connections are made in the harness
using splices. The following modules are used on 2003 PL:
- Airbag Control Module
- Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Controller Antilock Brake
- Powertrain Control Module
- Radio (If equipped)
- CD Changer (If equipped)
- Compass/Temperature Mirror (If equipped)
- Remote Keyless Entry Module (If equipped)
- Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (If equipped)
- Mechanical Instrument Cluster
Each module provides its own bias and termination in order to transmit and receive messages. The
bus voltage is at zero volts when no modules are transmitting and is pulled up to about seven and
a half volts when modules are transmitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2122
The bus messages are transmitted at a rate averaging 10800 bits per second. Since there is only
voltage present when the modules transmit and the message length is only about 500 milliseconds,
it is ineffective to try and measure the bus activity with a conventional voltmeter. The preferred
method is to use the DRB III(R) lab scope. The 12 V square wave selection on the 20-volt scale
provides a good view of the bus activity. Voltage on the bus should pulse between zero and about
seven and a half volts. Refer to the diagram for some typical displays.
The PCI Bus failure modes are broken down into two categories. Complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure and individual module no response. Causes of a complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure include a short to ground or battery on the PCI circuit. Individual module no
response can be caused by an open circuit at the module, or an open battery or ground circuit to
the affected
Symptoms of a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure would include but are not limited to:
- All gauges on the EMIC stay at zero
- All telltales on EMIC illuminate
- EMIC backlighting at full intensity
- No response received from any module on the PCI bus (except PCM)
- No start (if equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer)
Symptoms of Individual module failure could include any one or more of the above. The difference
would be that at least one or more modules would respond to the DRB III(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
System Description > Page 2123
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III(R). If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III(R) may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III(R) and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only
an indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control
module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be
referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The Transmission Control Module is part of
the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller #8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Body Control Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Airbag Indicator On Without ACM Trouble Codes
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AIRBAG INDICATOR ON WITHOUT ACM TROUBLE CODES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Airbag indicator on without ACM trouble codes
- Instrument cluster problems
No Response From Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2126
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2127
Test 3 - 4
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM ACM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Checking for voltage at ACM
- Ground circuit open
- PCI bus circuit open
- Airbag control module
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2128
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Any Station Preset Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY STATION PRESET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Balance Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
BALANCE INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2129
CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Equalizer Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Fader Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FADER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2130
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
HOUR/MINUTE Switches Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HOUR/MINUTE SWITCHES INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
No Response From Radio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2131
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2132
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM RADIO
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response from radio
- Open fused ignition switch output circuit
- Open fused B+ circuit
- Radio ground circuit open
- Open PCI bus circuit
- Radio
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2133
SYMPTOM
PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
PWR Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Scan Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Seek Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2134
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Set Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2135
- Internal failure
Time Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tune Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Compass/Temperature Mirror Does Calibrate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2136
Test 1
Test 2
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR DOES CALIBRATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Calibration procedure
- Compass/temperature mirror
Compass/Temperature Mirror Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2137
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2138
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus - compass
- Fused B(+) circuit short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Ground circuit open
- Compass/temperature mirror
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2139
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to voltage
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Test 1 - 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2140
Test 5 - 7
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open fused B+
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to ground
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to ground
- Open fuse
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2141
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to voltage
- Fuse block
- Instrument cluster
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2142
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Fuse block
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Open fused B+ to fuse block
- Fused B+ circuit short to ground
- B+ circuit breaker 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2143
All Gauges Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2144
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus
- No response - PCI bus - powertrain control module
- No response - PCI bus - instrument cluster
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Instrument cluster ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
Any or All Gauge Pointer(s) On Wrong Side of Stop
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY OR ALL GAUGE POINTER(S) ON WRONG SIDE OF STOP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Any PCI Bus Indicator Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY PCI BUS INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2145
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- LED defective
- Instrument cluster
Brake Warning Indicator Always On
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2146
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit short to ground
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit short to ground
- Park brake switch
- Brake fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Brake Warning Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2147
Test 4 - 7
Test 8
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2148
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Brake fluid level switch
- Park brake switch
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit open
- Brake fluid level switch ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Front Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
FRONT FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Front fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Fuel Gauge Inaccurate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2149
Test 1 - 2
Test 3
SYMPTOM
FUEL GAUGE INACCURATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Fuel level sensor
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
High Beam Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2150
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- High beam indicator circuit open
- High beam indicator bulb
- Instrument cluster
Instrument Cluster Dimming Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2151
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DIMMING INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Headlamp switch output circuit open
- Illumination bulb
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Always on
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2152
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit short to ground
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2153
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit open
- Indicator led
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
One Gauge Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2154
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ONE GAUGE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Powertrain control module DTCs
- Instrument cluster
PRND or Autostick Indicator Display Inaccurate or Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2155
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
PRND OR AUTOSTICK INDICATOR DISPLAY INACCURATE OR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
Rear Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative - BUX Only
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
REAR FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE - BUX ONLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Rear fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Seat Belt Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2156
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
SEATBELT INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Indicator led
- Seat belt indicator circuit open
- Seat belt switch ground open
- Seat belt switch
- Instrument cluster
Temperature Display Inoperative or Wrong (2.0L Only)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2157
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG (2.0L ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present in PCM
- Ambient temperat1jre sensor
- Compass/temperature mirror
VF Display Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
VF DISPLAY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Courtesy Lamps Inoperative - All Lamps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2158
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS INOPERATIVE - ALL LAMPS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B+ circuit open
- Instrument cluster - courtesy lamp open
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit open
- Intermittent condition
Courtesy Lamps On At All Times
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2159
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2160
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2161
Test 8 - 10
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS ON AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Drivers door ajar switch
- Drivers door ajar switch sense wire short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster
- Panel lamps dimmer signal wire short to ground
- Multifunction switch
- Open door ajar switch
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense wire short to ground
- Instrument cluster
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit short to ground
- Instrument cluster
Illuminated Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2162
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ILLUMINATED ENTRY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Courtesy lamps operational
- Intermittent condition
- Illuminated entry not enabled
All Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2163
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2164
Test 8 - 13
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2165
Test 14 - 16
SYMPTOM
ALL DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid release relay output wire short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused B(+) wire short to ground
- Ground circuit open
- Door lock relay output circuit open
- Driver door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release solenoid-shorted
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Defective fuse #14
- RKE module - B(+) short to ground
- RKE module - relays open
- RKE module - shorted
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Lock and Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2166
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO LOCK AND UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open door unlock relay output
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Open motors
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2167
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door unlock relay output circuit short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module unlock relay
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Auto door locks not enabled
- Door ajar status
- PCM DTC's present
- RKE module defective - auto locks inoperable
Decklid Solenoid Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2168
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
DECKLID SOLENOID INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Solenoid ground open
- Decklid release solenoid open
- Decklid release relay output wire open
- RKE module - decklid relay open
Doors Lockable With Key In Ignition and Driver Door Open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2169
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2170
Test 4 - 10
SYMPTOM
DOORS LOCKABLE WITH KEY IN IGNITION & DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch - open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to RKE module
- Ignition switch open
- Key-in ignition switch sense wire open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to cluster
- Instrument cluster - key-in ignition open
- Instrument cluster defective-driver door ajar open
- RKE module defective-open driver door ajar
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2171
Driver Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open driver unlock circuit
- Driver door lock motor - open
- Driver door lock relay output wire open
- Driver door unlock relay output wire open
Driver Door Fails to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2172
Test 1
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- RKE module defective - driver unlock open
One Passenger Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2173
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ONE PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock motor open
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
Remote Keyless Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2174
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
RKE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Test transmitter with tester
- RKE transmitter not programmed
- Test RKE transmitter
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2175
- RKE transmitter - inoperative
- RKE module
- RKE module - receiver inoperable
Alarm Trips On Its Own
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALARM TRIPS ON ITS OWN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Last VTSS cause
- Attempt to trip alarm
- Intermittent condition
All Doors Fail to Lock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2176
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS FAIL TO LOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock relay output circuit short to ground
- Decklid release relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to driver door unlock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to door unlock relay output
- Remote keyless entry module - unlock ground open
All Locks Inoperative From A Door Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2177
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL LOCKS INOPERATIVE FROM A DOOR LOCK SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2178
- Door switch ground wire open
- Door switch MUX wire short to voltage
- Door switch MUX wire open
- Door lock switch open
- Remote keyless entry module - high voltage
- Remote keyless entry module - low voltage
Headlamps Fail to Flash When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HEADLAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Horn Fails to Sound When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HORN FAILS TO SOUND DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Horn relay control circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Cannot Be Disabled
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2179
Test 1
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR CANNOT BE DISABLED (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Fails to Trip VTSS
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2180
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR FAILS TO TRIP VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit open
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Repeatedly Triggers VTSS
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2181
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR REPEATEDLY TRIGGERS VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Driver Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
OPEN DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch
- Driver door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Driver door ajar switch sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Passenger Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2182
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2183
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2184
Test 7 - 8
SYMPTOM
OPEN PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Left rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
- RKE module - passenger door ajar sense
Park Lamps Fail to Flash During Alarm
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PARK LAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2185
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Park lamp switch output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
VTSS Fails to Arm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm From Passenger Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2186
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM PASSENGER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Passenger door switch MUX circuit open
- Passenger cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm/Disarm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM/DISARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2187
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR
CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY).
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Indicator Fails to Flash
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR FAILS TO FLASH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Remote keyless entry module
- Instrument cluster
- VTSS indicator driver circuit open
- VTSS led open
VTSS Indicator Stays On Steady During Arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2188
Test 1 - 5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2189
Test 6 - 8
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR STAYS ON STEADY DURING ARMING
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid security switch sense circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch ground circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch sense circuit shorted to ground (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch (if equipped)
- RKE module - VTSS indicator
- RKE module - hood ajar (if equipped)
- RKE module - decklid security (if equipped)
VTSS Siren Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2190
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
VTSS SIREN INOPERATIVE (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Siren functional test
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Faulty siren
- Siren control circuit open
- Siren control circuit shorted to ground
- Remote keyless entry module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2191
Body Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Six Step Troubleshooting Procedure
SIX-STEP TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
Diagnosis is done in six basic steps:
1. Verification of complaint 2. Verification of any related symptoms 3. Symptom analysis 4. Problem
isolation 5. Repair of isolated problem 6. Verification of proper operation
Road Testing
ROAD TEST WARNINGS
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure.
The purpose of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: Before road testing a vehicle, be sure that all components are reassembled. during the
test drive, do not try to read the DRB III screen while in motion. Do not hang the DRB III from the
rear view mirror or operate it yourself. Have an assistant available to operate the DRB III.
Vehicle Preparation For Testing
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR TESTING
Make sure the vehicle being tested has a fully charged battery. If it does not, false diagnostic codes
or error messages may occur.
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2192
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: Erase the stored codes
- Place the ignition in the Run position
- Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
- Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
- Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2193
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Glossary of Terms
ABS Antilock Brake System
ACM Airbag Control Module
AECM Airbag Electronic Control Module (ACM)
ASDM Airbag System Diagnostic Module (ACM)
BUX Built-Up Export
CAB Controller Antilock Brake
CTM Compass/Temperature Mirror
DAB Driver Airbag
DLC Data Link Connector
DTC Diagnostic Trouble Code
EMIC Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster
LSIACM
Left SIACM
NGC Next Generation Controller
PAB Passenger Airbag
PCI Programmable Communication Interface (Vehicle Communication Bus)
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PDC Power Distribution Center
PWM
Pulse Width Modulated
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RSIACM Right SIACM
SAB Side Airbag
SIACM Side Impact Airbag Control Module
SKIM Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
SKIS Sentry Key Immobilizer System
SQUIB Also Called Initiator (Located In Rear Of Airbag Module)
TCM Transmission Control Module
VFD Vacuum Fluorescent Display
VTSS Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2194
Body Control Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
DRB III Error Messages and Blank Screen
DRB III ERROR MESSAGES AND BLANK SCREEN
Under normal operation, the DRB III will display one of only two error messages:
User-Requested WARM Boot (Press MORE and NO at the same time)
User-Requested COLD Boot (Press MORE and YES at the same time)
If the DRB III should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the
S.T.A.R. Center for information and assistance.
DRB III DOES NOT POWER UP
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 16). A minimum of 11 volts
is required to adequately power the DRB III.
If all connections are proper between the DRB III and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, and inoperative DRB III may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
For a blank screen, refer to the appropriate body diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2195
DISPLAY IS NOT VISIBLE
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition
SOME DISPLAY ITEMS READ "---"
This is caused by scrolling the DRB III display a single line up or down. The line which was scrolled
onto the screen might read "---". Use the Page Down or Page Up function to display the
information.
DRB III Safety Information
DRB III (R) SAFETY INFORMATION
WARNING: EXCEEDING THE LIMITS OF THE DRB III (R) MULTIMETER IS DANGEROUS. IT
CAN EXPOSE YOU TO SERIOUS OR
POSSIBLE FATAL INJURY. CAREFULLY READ AND UNDERSTAND THE CAUTIONS AND THE
SPECIFICATION LIMITS.
Follow the vehicle manufacture's service specifications at all times.
Do not use the DRB Ill(R) if it has been damaged.
Do not use the test leads if the insulation is damaged or if metal is exposed.
To avoid electrical shock, do not touch the test leads, tips, or other circuit being tested.
Choose the proper range and function for the measurement. Do not try voltage or current
measurement that may exceed the rated capacity.
Do not exceed the limits shown in the table.
Voltage between any terminal and ground must not exceed 500v DC or 500v peak AC.
The circuit being tested must be protected by a 10A fuse or circuit breaker.
Use the low current shunt to measure circuits up to 10A. Use the higher current clamp to measure
circuits exceeding 10A.
When testing for the presence of voltage or current, make sure the meter is functioning correctly.
Take a reading of a known voltage or current before accepting a zero reading.
When measuring current, connect the meter in series with the load.
Disconnect the live test lead before disconnecting the common test lead.
When using the meter function, keep the DRB III (R) away from spark plug or coil wires to avoid
measuring error from outside interference.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2196
Body Control Module: Tools and Equipment
REQUIRED TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
DRB III (R) (diagnostic read out box) Jumper Wires Ohmmeter Voltmeter Test Light 8310 Airbag
Load Tool 8443 SRS Airbag System Load Tool
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2205
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2206
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2207
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2208
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2209
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2210
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2211
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module
Replacement > Page 2212
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A >
Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A >
Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2218
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A >
Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2219
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A >
Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2220
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2225
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2226
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2227
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2228
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2229
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2230
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2231
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03
> Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2232
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug >
06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug >
06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2238
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug >
06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2239
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug >
06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2240
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2241
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Mounting Screws 4 Nm 35 In. Lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2244
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2245
Fig. 12 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2246
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2247
Fig. 43 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 2250
Powertrain Control Module C2 (2.0L NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 2251
Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 2252
Powertrain Control Module C4 (EATX NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Important - Please Read
IMPORTANT (NGC)
New for the 2003 PL is a combined Powertrain Control Module and Transmission Control Module
in a single control module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller (NGC) for
DaimlerChrysler and will be referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2255
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
DATA BUS COMMUNICATION RECEIVE - PCM INPUT
The PCM uses the SCI communication bus to preform engine diagnostics and flash operations.
The transmission side of the PCM uses the SCI communication bus to flash new software.
However, diagnostics is performed via the vehicles J1850 bus for the transmission side of the
PCM.
IGNITION SENSE - PCM INPUT
The ignition sense input informs the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) that the ignition switch is in
the crank or run position.
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side relays, solenoids, ignition coil or injectors.
The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the ground side of
any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded separately from the
ground pins.
Fig.5 PCM
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine, transmission, and vehicle
operations through devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Controls
- Ambient Air temperature Sensor
- ASD Sense
- Baro/Tip (Turbo)
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2256
- Clutch Upstop Switch (1.6L)
- Clutch Interlock
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Cruise Control Switch
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor (Bus message)
- Ignition Switch
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- J1850
- Knock Sensor (1.6, 2.0, 2.4L only)
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection (NVLD)
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Oxygen Sensors
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receive
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 TPS Sensors)
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD)
- Transmission Range Sensor (TRS)
- Transmission Oil Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor (MTX-equipped models).
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp (Bus Message)
- SCI Transmit
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor (2.0/2.4L)
- Ignition Coils
- J1850
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp (Bus Message)
- Oxygen Sensors Heater Controls
- Radiator Fan Relays
- Speed Control Solenoids (2.0/2.4L)
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD)
- Transmission PRNDL Position (to Cluster)
- Transmission Torque Reduction Request (Internal to PCM)
- Transmission Temperature (Internal to PCM and a Bus Message)
- Vehicle Speed (Manual Transmission)
- 2 Electronic Throttle Control Outputs (1.6L) Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts fuel
injector pulse width, idle speed, ignition spark advance, ignition coil dwell and EVAP canister purge
operation. The PCM also determines the appropriate transmission shift schedule and shift points,
depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand. The PCM regulates the cooling
fan, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge rate by
adjusting the generator field. The PCM also performs diagnostics.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs. Battery voltage
- Coolant temperature
- Exhaust gas content (oxygen sensor)
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Intake air temperature
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2257
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs. -
Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Intake air temperature
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following
inputs. Air conditioning sense
- Battery voltage
- Battery temperature
- Brake switch
- Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Engine run time
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power steering pressure switch
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Vehicle distance (speed)
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are located in the Power Distribution Center
(PDC).
The camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor signals are sent to the PCM. If the
PCM does not receive the signal within approximately 1 second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the ASD relay and fuel pump relay. When these relays are deactivated, power is shut off from the
fuel injectors, ignition coils, oxygen sensor heating elements and fuel pump.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5 volts direct
current to power the camshaft position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, manifold absolute
pressure sensor, throttle position sensor, A/C pressure switch, A/C pressure transducer, and
vehicle speed sensor.
Powertrain Control Module Connectors
The PCM is an engine and transmission controller module all in one, if the vehicle is equipped with
an automatic transmission. The PCM uses four wiring harness connectors to receive and send
engine and transmission data. To ease assembly, the mating wiring harness connector is
color-coded. Each module connector cavity has its own unique color identification stripe located on
the outside of each connector cavity.
The PCM module utilizes four wiring harness connectors as described:
- Connector Cavity A is for Power & Ground (Black)
- Connector Cavity B is for Engine Side (Orange)
- Connector Cavity C is for Headlamp & Dash (White)
- Connector Cavity D is for Transmission (Green) If equipped.
NOTE: Connector Cavities A, B, C, And D must be connected prior to battery connection and
ignition key on to avoid setting erroneous controller fault codes. It is also recommended that cavity
A connector is made prior to any other connectors.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEX (CVI)
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Transmission Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs
represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2258
Fig.6 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRBIII Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
TRANSMISSION SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM is programmed to allow it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is
dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2259
- Software calibration level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
5 VOLT SUPPLY - PCM OUTPUT
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the following sensors:
- A/C pressure transducer
- Ambient Temperature sensor
- Battery temperature
- Camshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock sensor
- Linear EGR solenoid (if equipped)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L)
- Throttle position sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 2260
Powertrain Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
CHECKING PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- (A14) PCM fused B+ circuit
- (A41) PCM fused ignition switch output circuit
- (Z12) PCM ground circuits
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2263
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2264
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2265
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2266
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2267
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2268
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2269
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2270
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2271
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2272
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2273
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2274
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2275
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Obtaining Diagnostic Trouble Codes
BULB CHECK
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 2276
Key on: Bulb illuminated until vehicle starts, as long as all once per trip (readiness) monitors
completed. If monitors have not been completed, then:
Key on: bulb check for about 5 to 8 seconds, lamp then flashes if once per trip (readiness) monitors
have not been completed until vehicle is started, then MIL is extinguished.
OBTAINING DTC'S USING DRB SCAN TOOL
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "Read Fault" screen. 3. Record all the DTC's and
"freeze frame" information shown on the DRB scan tool. 4. To erase DTC's, use the "Erase Trouble
Code" data screen on the DRB scan tool. Do not erase any DTC's until problems have been
investigated
and repairs have been performed.
Pinion Factor Setting
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM/TCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an inoperative or improperly
calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM/TCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires)
available. Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain/ Transmission Control Module
initial setting so that the speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the
Pinion Factor, it is necessary to use a DRBIII scan tool.
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2.
Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then
follow the instructions on the DRBIII scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRBIII scan tool. This program allows the PCM/
TCM to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain/Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following
conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRBIII
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60° and below 200°
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRBIII to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2280
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2285
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2286
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel pump relay is located in the PDC. The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse location
The fuel pump relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel pump. A buss bar in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and contact side of the relay. The fuel pump
relay power circuit contains a fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the relay. The fuse is
located in the PDC. Refer to the Wiring Diagrams for circuit information.
The PCM controls the fuel pump relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the
relay ON and OFF. The PCM turns the ground path OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF
position. When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the PCM energizes the fuel pump. If the
crankshaft position sensor does not detect engine rotation, the PCM de-energizes the relay after
approximately one second.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2290
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page
2294
Manifold Tuning Valve Relay (RT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2301
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2302
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2303
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2304
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2308
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2312
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2313
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2314
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2315
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2320
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2321
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2322
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2323
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2324
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2325
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fig.11 Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2329
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2330
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2331
Fig.7 Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2336
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2337
Fig. 8 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2338
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2339
Fig. 48 Left Side Engine - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2340
Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2341
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct.
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery temperature sensor.
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values for the PCM to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery
temperature sensor.
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2342
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor 3. Remove
the air cleaner lid. 4. Disconnect the inlet air tube from the throttle body. 5. Remove inlet air tube
from air cleaner lid.
INSTALLATION
1. Install inlet air tube to air cleaner lid and tighten clamp. 2. Install inlet air tube to throttle body and
tighten clamp. 3. Install air cleaner lid to air cleaner box. 4. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor
electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2346
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Fig. 15 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 48 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2350
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2351
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2352
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.23 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
The MAP sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
The MAP sensor signal is provided from a single piezo-resistive element located in the center of a
diaphragm. The element and diaphragm are both made of silicone. As the pressures changes the
diaphragm moves causing the element to deflect which stresses the silicone. When silicone is
exposed to stress its resistance changes. As manifold vacuum increases, the MAP sensor input
voltage decreases proportionally. The sensor also contains electronics that condition the signal and
provide temperature compensation.
The MAP serves as a PCM input, using a silicon based sensing unit, to provide data on the
manifold vacuum that draws the air/fuel mixture into the combustion chamber. The PCM requires
this information to determine injector pulse width and spark advance. When MAP equals
Barometric pressure, the pulse width will be at maximum.
Also like the cam and crank sensors, a 5 volt reference is supplied from the PCM and returns a
voltage signal to the PCM that reflects manifold pressure. The zero pressure reading is 0.5V and
full scale is 4.5V. For a pressure swing of 0 - 15 psi the voltage changes 4.0V. The sensor is
supplied a regulated 4.8 to 5.1 volts to operate the sensor. Like the cam and crank sensors ground
is provided through the sensor return circuit.
The MAP sensor input is the number one contributor to pulse width. The most important function of
the MAP sensor is to determine barometric pressure. The PCM needs to know if the vehicle is at
sea level or is it in Denver at 5000 feet above sea level, because the air density changes with
altitude. It will also help to correct for varying weather conditions. If a hurricane was coming through
the pressure would be very, very low or there could be a real fair weather, high pressure area. This
is important because as air pressure changes the barometric pressure changes. Barometric
pressure and altitude have a direct inverse correlation, as altitude goes up barometric goes down.
The first thing that happens as the key is rolled on, before reaching the crank position, the PCM
powers up, comes around and looks at the MAP voltage, and based upon the voltage it sees, it
knows the current barometric pressure relative to altitude. Once the engine starts, the PCM looks
at the voltage again, continuously every 12 milliseconds, and compares the current voltage to what
it was at key ON. The difference between current and what it was at key ON is manifold vacuum.
During key ON (engine not running) the sensor reads (updates) barometric pressure. A normal
range can be obtained by monitoring known good sensor in you work area.
As the altitude increases the air becomes thinner (less oxygen). If a vehicle is started and driven to
a very different altitude than where it was at key ON the barometric pressure needs to be updated.
Any time the PCM sees Wide Open throttle, based upon TPS angle and RPM it will update
barometric pressure in the MAP memory cell. With periodic updates, the PCM can make its
calculations more effectively.
The PCM uses the MAP sensor to aid in calculating the following:
- Barometric pressure
- Engine load
- Manifold pressure
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance programs
- Shift-point strategies (F4AC1 transmissions only, via the PCI bus)
- Idle speed
- Decel fuel shutoff
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2353
The PCM recognizes a decrease in manifold pressure by monitoring a decrease in voltage from the
reading stored in the barometric pressure memory cell. The MAP sensor is a linear sensor; as
pressure changes, voltage changes proportionately. The range of voltage output from the sensor is
usually between 4.6 volts at sea level to as low as 0.3 volts at 26 in. of Hg. Barometric pressure is
the pressure exerted by the atmosphere upon an object. At sea level on a standard day, no storm,
barometric pressure is 29.92 in Hg. For every 100 feet of altitude barometric pressure drops 0.10
in. Hg. If a storm goes through it can either add, high pressure, or decrease, low pressure, from
what should be present for that altitude. You should make a habit of knowing what the average
pressure and corresponding barometric pressure is for your area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2354
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.24 MAP Sensor
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Disconnect the electrical connector
from the MAP sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting screws. 3. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while
making sure not to damage O-ring seal. 2. Tighten mounting screws to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque
for plastic manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2358
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Component Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2363
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2364
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2365
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2366
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2367
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2368
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor 1/1 Upstream
Oxygen Sensor 1/2 Downstream
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2369
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Ignition System/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2370
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.30 Types Of O2 Sensors
Fig.27 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/1
O2 SENSOR
The upstream oxygen sensor threads into the outlet flange of the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2371
Fig.28 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/2
Fig.29 Heated Oxygen Sensor Systems
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the system depending on emission package.
Federal package the O2S is mounted after the catalytic convertor, LEV package the O2S is
mounted mid catalytic convertor, ULEV package is mounted between the catalytic convertor.
A single sensor ground is used for all O2 sensors (2 sensors on 4 cyl. vehicles and 4 sensors on 6
cyl. vehicles).
As vehicles accumulate mileage, the catalytic convertor deteriorates. The deterioration results in a
less efficient catalyst. To monitor catalytic convertor deterioration, the fuel injection system uses
two heated oxygen sensors. One sensor upstream of the catalytic convertor, one downstream of
the convertor. The PCM compares the reading from the sensors to calculate the catalytic convertor
oxygen storage capacity and converter efficiency. Also, the PCM uses the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input when adjusting injector pulse width.
When the catalytic converter efficiency drops below emission standards, the PCM stores a
diagnostic trouble code and illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL).
The O2S produce voltages from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air/fuel
mixture, can be caused by misfire and exhaust leaks), the sensors produces a low voltage. When
there is a lesser amount of oxygen present (caused by a rich air/fuel mixture, can be caused by
internal engine problems) it produces a higher voltage. By
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2372
monitoring the oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensors act as a rich-lean
switch.
The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element that keeps the sensors at proper
operating temperature during all operating modes. Maintaining correct sensor temperature at all
times allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop operation the PCM monitors the O2S input (along with other inputs) and adjusts the
injector pulse width accordingly. During Open Loop operation the PCM ignores the O2 sensor
input. The PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs
from other sensors.
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to both the upstream and
downstream heated oxygen sensors. The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element.
The heating elements reduce the time required for the sensors to reach operating temperature. The
PCM uses pulse width modulation to control the ground side of the heater to regulate the
temperature on 4 cyl. upstream O2 heater only. All other 4 cyl. and 6 cyl. O2 heaters do not use
pulse width modulation.
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
The input from the upstream heated oxygen sensor tells the PCM the oxygen content of the
exhaust gas. Based on this input, the PCM fine tunes the air-fuel ratio by adjusting injector pulse
width.
The sensor input switches from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air-fuel
mixture), the sensor produces voltage as low as 0.1 volt. When there is a lesser amount of oxygen
present (rich air-fuel mixture) the sensor produces a voltage as high as 1.0 volt. By monitoring the
oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensor acts as a rich-lean switch.
The heating element in the sensor provides heat to the sensor ceramic element. Heating the
sensor allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input along with other inputs. In Open Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on
preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs from other sensors.
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor input is used to detect catalytic convertor deterioration. As
the convertor deteriorates, the input from the downstream sensor begins to match the upstream
sensor input except for a slight time delay By comparing the downstream heated oxygen sensor
input to the input from the upstream sensor, the PCM calculates catalytic convertor efficiency. Also
used to establish the upstream O2 goal voltage (switching point).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
Fig.32 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust outlet pipe behind the catalytic
convertor.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from harness. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig.33 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 5. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Connect sensor electrical harness from clips along body
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor > Page 2375
3. Connect electrical connector to harness. 4. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor > Page 2376
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream (1/1) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector.
Fig.31 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
3. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 4. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Plug sensor connector. 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2377
Oxygen Sensor: Tools and Equipment
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - C-4907
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - 8439
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2382
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2383
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2384
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2385
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2390
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2391
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2392
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2393
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2394
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 2400
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 2401
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2402
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2403
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2404
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2405
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2406
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector
Views
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2417
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2418
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2419
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2420
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2421
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2426
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 2431
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2432
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2433
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2434
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2435
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2436
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2444
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE ...............................................................................................................................
......................................... 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2449
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2450
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2451
Test 7 - 9
SYMPTOM
CHECKING FUEL DELIVERY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fuel pump relay
- Fuel pressure out of specs
- Restricted fuel supply line
- Fuel pump inlet strainer plugged
- Fuel pump module
- Fuel delivery system operation
- Fuel pump relay fused B+ circuit
- (A141) fuel pump relay output circuit open
- (Z1) fuel pump ground circuit open/high resistance
- Fuel pump module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove 5 screws from air cleaner element box lid. 2. Remove lid from air cleaner box. 3. Pull air
cleaner up and out of air cleaner box.
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element on to throttle body and push towards the throttle body and past lip in
air cleaner box bottom (Fig. 10). 2. Install lid and tighten screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 2463
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
Ignition Coll Pack
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 1-3-4-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2467
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches directly to the valve cover.
The 2.0 Liter (122 cu. inch) in-line four cylinder engine is a single over head camshaft with
hydraulic lifters and four valves per cylinder design (Fig. 1). The engine does not have provisions
for a free wheeling valve train. The cylinders are numbered from front of the engine to the rear. The
firing order is 1-3-4-2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
CABLE .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................ RESISTANCE
# 1, # 4 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2970 - 8910 ohms
# 2, # 3 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2360 - 7070 ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2475
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
SPARK PLUG CABLE
Spark Plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer
electrical current from the ignition coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder. The resistive
spark plug cables are of nonmetallic construction. The cables provide suppression of radio
frequency emissions from the ignition system.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil, and spark plugs. Terminals
should be fully seated. The insulators should be in good condition and should fit tightly on the coil,
and spark plugs. Spark plug cables with insulators that are cracked or torn must be replaced.
Clean Spark Plug cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry. Check for brittle or cracked insulation. The spark plug cables and spark plug boots are made
from high temperature silicone materials. All spark plug cable leads are properly identified with
cylinder numbers. The inside of most the spark plug boot is coated with a special high temperature
silicone grease for greater sealing and to minimize boot bonding to the spark plug insulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2476
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of
the spark plug insulator, turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
INSTALLATION
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube, then connect the other end to coil pack.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark
Plug Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUG TUBE
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Using locking pliers, remove the tube from the cylinder head. Discard old tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean area around spark plug with Mopar parts cleaner or equivalent. 2. Apply Mopar Stud and
Bearing Mount or equivalent to a new tube approximately 1 mm (0.039 inch) from the end in a 3
mm (0.118 inch) wide
area.
3. Install sealer end of tube into the cylinder head. Then carefully install the tube using a hardwood
block and mallet until the tube is seated into the
bottom of the bore.
4. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark
Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The spark plug tube seals are located in the cylinder head cover. These seals are pressed into the
cylinder head cover to seal the outside perimeter of the spark plug tubes. If these seals show signs
of hardness and/or cracking, they should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Spark
Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2484
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Using an appropriate tool, carefully remove spark plug tube
seals. Care should be taken not to damage cylinder head cover sealing surfaces.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean all sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Position seal with the concave side facing the installation tool.
2. Install seals using Special Tool MB-998306. Only hand pressure on tool is needed to install new
seals. 3. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure 170-225 psi
Max. Variation Between Cylinders 25 percent
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2488
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE TEST
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions. Ensure the battery is completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good
operating condition. Otherwise the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnosis
purposes. 1. Check engine oil level and add oil if necessary. 2. Drive the vehicle until engine
reaches normal operating temperature. Select a route free from traffic and other forms of
congestion, observe all
traffic laws, and accelerate through the gears several times briskly.
3. Remove all spark plugs from engine. As spark plugs are being removed, check electrodes for
abnormal firing indicators fouled, hot, oily, etc.
Record cylinder number of spark plug for future reference.
4. Remove the Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay from the PDC. 5. Be sure throttle blade is fully open
during the compression check. 6. Insert compression gauge adaptor Special Tool 8116 or the
equivalent, into the #1 spark plug hole in cylinder head. Connect the 0-500 psi (Blue)
pressure transducer (Special Tool CH7059) with cable adaptors to the DRB III.
7. Crank engine until maximum pressure is reached on gauge. Record this pressure as #1 cylinder
pressure. 8. Repeat the previous step for all remaining cylinders. 9. Compression should not be
less than 689 kPa (100 psi) and not vary more than 25 percent from cylinder to cylinder.
10. If one or more cylinders have abnormally low compression pressures, repeat the compression
test. 11. If the same cylinder or cylinders repeat an abnormally low reading on the second
compression test, it could indicate the existence of a problem in
the cylinder in question. The recommended compression pressures are to be used only as a guide
to diagnosing engine problems. An engine should not be disassembled to determine the cause of
low compression unless some malfunction is present.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
The manufacturer indicates that this vehicle has hydraulic lifters or adjusters and therefore does
not require adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2497
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2498
Fig. 8 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2499
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2500
Fig. 48 Left Side Engine - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2501
Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2502
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct.
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery temperature sensor.
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values for the PCM to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery
temperature sensor.
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT)
Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2503
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor 3. Remove
the air cleaner lid. 4. Disconnect the inlet air tube from the throttle body. 5. Remove inlet air tube
from air cleaner lid.
INSTALLATION
1. Install inlet air tube to air cleaner lid and tighten clamp. 2. Install inlet air tube to throttle body and
tighten clamp. 3. Install air cleaner lid to air cleaner box. 4. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor
electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2508
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2509
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2510
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2511
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2516
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2517
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2518
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2519
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2520
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2521
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2522
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2523
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2524
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2525
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2526
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2527
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2528
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2529
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2530
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2531
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2532
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2533
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2534
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2535
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2536
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2537
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2538
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2539
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2540
Body Control Module: Electrical Diagrams
Airbag System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2541
Audio System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2542
CD Changer
Compass/Temperature Mirror
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2543
Exterior Lighting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2544
Instrument Cluster
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2545
Interior Lighting
Power Door Locks/RKE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2546
Vehicle Communication
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2547
Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Body Control Module: Technician Safety Information
SERVICING SUB-ASSEMBLIES
Some components of the body system are intended to be serviced as an assembly only.
Attempting to remove or repair certain system sub-components may result in personal injury and/or
improper system operation. Only those components with approved repair and installation
procedures should be serviced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 2550
Body Control Module: Vehicle Damage Warnings
Electrical Testing Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "off". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation, this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion. Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent
accidental shorting of terminals Such mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second
code could be set, making diagnosis of the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description
Body Control Module: Description and Operation System Description
Identification Of System
The vehicle systems that are part of the "body" system are:
- Airbag System
- Audio
- Compass/Temperature Mirror
- Instrument Cluster
- Interior Lighting
- Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
- Vehicle Communications
- Vehicle Theft Security System
System Description
The body system on the 2003 PL consists of a combination of modules that communicate over the
PCI bus (Programmable Communication Interface multiplex system).
Through the PCI bus, information about the operation of vehicle components and circuits is relayed
quickly to the appropriate module(s). All modules receive all the information transmitted on the bus
even though a module may not require all information to perform it's function. It will only respond to
messages "addressed" to it through a binary coding process.
This method of data transmission significantly reduces the complexity of the wiring in the vehicle
and the size of wiring harnesses. All of the information about the functioning of all the systems is
organized, controlled, and communicated by the PCI bus, which is described in the Vehicle
Communication See: Functional Operation/Vehicle Communication of this general information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2553
Body Control Module: Description and Operation Functional Operation
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE
THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
DRIVER AIRBAG (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93 °C (200 °F).
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation, The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches on vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged. The clockspring cannot be repaired it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2554
PASSENGER AIRBAG (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and its
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON
GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG
MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING
INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93
degrees C (200 degrees F).
WARNING: REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN
THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR
INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT
PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE
AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY
DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY
SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT
FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG.
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
They are located on the left and right B-post. The SIACM perform self diagnostics and circuit tests
to determine if the system is functioning properly. If the test finds a problem the SIACM will set both
active and stored diagnostic trouble codes. If a DTC is active the SIACM will request that the airbag
warning lamp be turned on. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI Bus to the
ACM once each second or on change in lamp state. If the warning lamp status message from the
either SIACM contains a lamp on request the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the
DTC is set the ACM sends a PCI Bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC)
requesting the airbag warning lamp be turned on. Observe all ACM warning and caution
statements when servicing or handling the SIACM. SIACM are not repairable and must be replaced
if they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
SEAT AIRBAGS
The Left and Right seat airbag modules are located in the outboard end of the front seat backs.
The airbag module contains a bag, an inflator (a small canister of highly compressed argon gas)
and a mounting bracket. The seat airbag module cannot be repaired and must be replaced if
deployed or in any way damaged. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the inflator seals
the hole in the airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the
cushion. Upon deployment, the seat back trim cover will tear open and allow the seat airbag to fully
deploy between the seat and the door.
NOTE: It will be necessary to remove the seat back trim to gain access to the seat airbag module
connector when diagnosing the seat airbag system.
WARNING: THE SEAT AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI.
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR.
DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT
STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93 degrees C (200 degrees F). REPLACE AIRBAG
SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL
DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS,
SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE
SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY
MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS
NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE
PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Some airbag diagnostic tests use special tools, 8310 and 8443 airbag load tool, for testing squib
circuits. The load tools contain fixed resistive loads, jumpers and adapters. The fixed loads are
connected to cables and mounted in a storage case. The cables can be directly connected to some
airbag system connectors. Jumpers are used to convert the load tool cable connectors to the other
airbag system connectors. The adapters are connected to the module harness connector to open
shorting clips and protect the connector terminal during testing. When using the load tool follow all
of the safety procedures in the service information for disconnecting airbag system components.
Inspect the wiring, connector and terminals for damage or misalignment. Substitute the airbag load
tool in place of a Driver or Passenger Airbag, curtain airbag, clockspring, or seat belt tensioner (use
a jumper if needed). Then follow all of the safety procedures in the service information for
connecting airbag system components. Read the module active DTC's. If the module reports NO
ACTIVE DTC's the defective component has been removed from the system and should be
replaced. If the DTC is still active, continue this process until all components in the circuit have
been tested. Then disconnect the module connector and connect the matching adapter to the
module connector. With all airbags disconnected and the adapter installed the squib wiring can be
tested for open and shorted conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2555
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: *
Erase the stored codes
* Place the ignition in the Run position
* Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
* Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
* Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Audio System
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system on the 2003 PL consists of a radio that communicates over the PCI bus. The
speakers are located in the instrument panel, the front doors and the rear "D" pillars. The
instrument panel speakers are a tweeter type speaker for high frequency. The front door speakers
are a woofer/midrange type speaker. The rear "D" pillar speakers are a full range type speaker. If
one of the speaker circuits experiences a short, the other speakers on that output channel will also
shut down until the circuit is repaired. The radio will also set a trouble code, which the DRB III(R)
can display.
The in-dash CD-changer is designed to fit into the existing cubby bin in the center stack. This new
cartridge-less CD-changer is controlled by your radio, and allows you to individually load up to four
discs at one time. However, due to its compact design, the CD-changer can only carry out one
operation at a time. For example you can not load a new disc while playing another at the same
time. Each operation happens sequentially.
The radio unit installed with your system provides control over all features of the CD-changer with
the exception of the CD load and eject functions, which are controlled by buttons located on the
front of the CD-changer. The radio also supplies the power, ground, PCI Bus, left and right speaker
output through a single DIN cable. All features you would expect , such as Disc Up/Down, Track
Up/Down, Random and Scan are controlled by the radio, which also displays all relevant
CD-changer information on the radio display.
The CD-changer contains a Load/Eject button and an indicator light for each of the four disc
positions. The individual light indicates whether a CD is currently loaded in that particular chamber
of the CD-changer. Pressing the individual Load/Eject button for a particular chamber will eject a
disc currently present in the chamber. If the chamber is currently empty, actuating the Load/Eject
button will position that chamber to receive and load a new
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2556
disc in that chamber.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Compass/Temperature Mirror
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2557
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2558
magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may
appear to indicate false headings or appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may
need to be demagnetized. Refer to Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory, the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the
displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the
PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2559
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Exterior Lighting
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
The Headlamps are controlled by the Instrument Cluster.
The Instrument Cluster is also referred to as a "Smart Cluster". It receives and sends messages to
other modules through the PCI BUS circuit. The Headlamps are wired through the cluster and then
go to the Fuse Block to the lamps. Each Headlamp has an independent fuse located in the Fuse
Block.
For vehicles equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL Module is integrated with the
Instrument Cluster.
Interior Lighting
INTERIOR LIGHTING
The Courtesy Lamps are controlled by the instrument cluster.
Some of the features that it controls are the courtesy lamps, chime, and all instrument illumination.
It receives and sends messages to other modules via the PCI bus circuit.
The front turn signals are wired through the cluster and then go to the front lamps. For vehicles
equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL module is built into the cluster.
Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The Remote Keyless Entry module controls the Power Door Locks and the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). It also wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn on the illuminated entry when it
senses a signal from the RKE transmitter. The module communicates with other modules via the
PCI bus circuit.
The RKE module monitors the Occupant Restraint Controller messages for the purpose of
monitoring the deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message along with the verification
that the ignition is on and the vehicle speed is zero, it will provide the "enhanced accident response
feature". This feature will cause the module to unlock-all doors immediately and the instrument
cluster to turn the courtesy lamps on when the vehicle reaches 0 mph.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message, and receive
body style information. Two transmitters are supplied with the vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. The horn chirp on vehicle lock command is customer programmable.
To limit the amount of battery drain during storage, the IOD fuse may be removed.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM
When the VTSS is armed, it will monitor the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle
doors and decklid. Also monitored is a decklid security switch (knockout) for the cylinder lock. If the
alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2560
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, by
using the driver door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of an open decklid security switch sense circuit.
Disarming can be accomplished with a RKE unlock, turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key
or unlocking the vehicle with the driver door cylinder lock. All of the switches for the VTSS system
can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to determine the cause of a
customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM (Export Only)
When the VTSS is armed, it Will monitor the interior of the vehicle for movement via an intrusion
sensor (if equipped), the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle doors, decklid and
hood. Vehicles without an intrusion sensor will have a decklid security switch (knockout) which will
also be monitored. If the alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn or a battery backed siren
for vehicles equipped with the intrusion sensor, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, or
by using either door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of the hood ajar circuit being shorted (hood opened) or the decklid
security switch circuit being open (if equipped). Defeating the intrusion sensor feature for vehicles
so equipped can be done by three additional lock request to the RKE module within 5 seconds.
Disarming is done by either a RKE unlock or turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key. All of
the switches for the VTSS system can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to
determine the cause of a customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
Vehicle Communication
VEHICLE COMMUNICATION
The Programmable Communication Interface or PCI Bus is a single wire multiplexed network
capable of supporting binary encoded messages shared between multiple modules. The PCI bus
circuit is identified as D25. The modules are wired in parallel. Connections are made in the harness
using splices. The following modules are used on 2003 PL:
- Airbag Control Module
- Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Controller Antilock Brake
- Powertrain Control Module
- Radio (If equipped)
- CD Changer (If equipped)
- Compass/Temperature Mirror (If equipped)
- Remote Keyless Entry Module (If equipped)
- Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (If equipped)
- Mechanical Instrument Cluster
Each module provides its own bias and termination in order to transmit and receive messages. The
bus voltage is at zero volts when no modules are transmitting and is pulled up to about seven and
a half volts when modules are transmitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2561
The bus messages are transmitted at a rate averaging 10800 bits per second. Since there is only
voltage present when the modules transmit and the message length is only about 500 milliseconds,
it is ineffective to try and measure the bus activity with a conventional voltmeter. The preferred
method is to use the DRB III(R) lab scope. The 12 V square wave selection on the 20-volt scale
provides a good view of the bus activity. Voltage on the bus should pulse between zero and about
seven and a half volts. Refer to the diagram for some typical displays.
The PCI Bus failure modes are broken down into two categories. Complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure and individual module no response. Causes of a complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure include a short to ground or battery on the PCI circuit. Individual module no
response can be caused by an open circuit at the module, or an open battery or ground circuit to
the affected
Symptoms of a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure would include but are not limited to:
- All gauges on the EMIC stay at zero
- All telltales on EMIC illuminate
- EMIC backlighting at full intensity
- No response received from any module on the PCI bus (except PCM)
- No start (if equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer)
Symptoms of Individual module failure could include any one or more of the above. The difference
would be that at least one or more modules would respond to the DRB III(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > System Description > Page 2562
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III(R). If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III(R) may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III(R) and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only
an indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control
module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be
referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The Transmission Control Module is part of
the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller #8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Body Control Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Airbag Indicator On Without ACM Trouble Codes
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AIRBAG INDICATOR ON WITHOUT ACM TROUBLE CODES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Airbag indicator on without ACM trouble codes
- Instrument cluster problems
No Response From Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2565
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2566
Test 3 - 4
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM ACM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Checking for voltage at ACM
- Ground circuit open
- PCI bus circuit open
- Airbag control module
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2567
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Any Station Preset Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY STATION PRESET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Balance Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
BALANCE INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2568
CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Equalizer Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Fader Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FADER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2569
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
HOUR/MINUTE Switches Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HOUR/MINUTE SWITCHES INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
No Response From Radio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2570
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2571
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM RADIO
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response from radio
- Open fused ignition switch output circuit
- Open fused B+ circuit
- Radio ground circuit open
- Open PCI bus circuit
- Radio
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2572
SYMPTOM
PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
PWR Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Scan Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Seek Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2573
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Set Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2574
- Internal failure
Time Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tune Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Compass/Temperature Mirror Does Calibrate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2575
Test 1
Test 2
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR DOES CALIBRATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Calibration procedure
- Compass/temperature mirror
Compass/Temperature Mirror Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2576
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2577
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus - compass
- Fused B(+) circuit short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Ground circuit open
- Compass/temperature mirror
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2578
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to voltage
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Test 1 - 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2579
Test 5 - 7
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open fused B+
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to ground
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to ground
- Open fuse
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2580
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to voltage
- Fuse block
- Instrument cluster
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2581
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Fuse block
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Open fused B+ to fuse block
- Fused B+ circuit short to ground
- B+ circuit breaker 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2582
All Gauges Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2583
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus
- No response - PCI bus - powertrain control module
- No response - PCI bus - instrument cluster
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Instrument cluster ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
Any or All Gauge Pointer(s) On Wrong Side of Stop
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY OR ALL GAUGE POINTER(S) ON WRONG SIDE OF STOP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Any PCI Bus Indicator Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY PCI BUS INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2584
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- LED defective
- Instrument cluster
Brake Warning Indicator Always On
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2585
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit short to ground
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit short to ground
- Park brake switch
- Brake fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Brake Warning Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2586
Test 4 - 7
Test 8
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2587
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Brake fluid level switch
- Park brake switch
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit open
- Brake fluid level switch ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Front Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
FRONT FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Front fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Fuel Gauge Inaccurate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2588
Test 1 - 2
Test 3
SYMPTOM
FUEL GAUGE INACCURATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Fuel level sensor
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
High Beam Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2589
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- High beam indicator circuit open
- High beam indicator bulb
- Instrument cluster
Instrument Cluster Dimming Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2590
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DIMMING INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Headlamp switch output circuit open
- Illumination bulb
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Always on
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2591
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit short to ground
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2592
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit open
- Indicator led
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
One Gauge Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2593
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ONE GAUGE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Powertrain control module DTCs
- Instrument cluster
PRND or Autostick Indicator Display Inaccurate or Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2594
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
PRND OR AUTOSTICK INDICATOR DISPLAY INACCURATE OR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
Rear Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative - BUX Only
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
REAR FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE - BUX ONLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Rear fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Seat Belt Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2595
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
SEATBELT INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Indicator led
- Seat belt indicator circuit open
- Seat belt switch ground open
- Seat belt switch
- Instrument cluster
Temperature Display Inoperative or Wrong (2.0L Only)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2596
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG (2.0L ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present in PCM
- Ambient temperat1jre sensor
- Compass/temperature mirror
VF Display Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
VF DISPLAY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Courtesy Lamps Inoperative - All Lamps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2597
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS INOPERATIVE - ALL LAMPS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B+ circuit open
- Instrument cluster - courtesy lamp open
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit open
- Intermittent condition
Courtesy Lamps On At All Times
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2598
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2599
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2600
Test 8 - 10
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS ON AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Drivers door ajar switch
- Drivers door ajar switch sense wire short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster
- Panel lamps dimmer signal wire short to ground
- Multifunction switch
- Open door ajar switch
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense wire short to ground
- Instrument cluster
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit short to ground
- Instrument cluster
Illuminated Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2601
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ILLUMINATED ENTRY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Courtesy lamps operational
- Intermittent condition
- Illuminated entry not enabled
All Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2602
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2603
Test 8 - 13
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2604
Test 14 - 16
SYMPTOM
ALL DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid release relay output wire short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused B(+) wire short to ground
- Ground circuit open
- Door lock relay output circuit open
- Driver door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release solenoid-shorted
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Defective fuse #14
- RKE module - B(+) short to ground
- RKE module - relays open
- RKE module - shorted
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Lock and Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2605
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO LOCK AND UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open door unlock relay output
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Open motors
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2606
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door unlock relay output circuit short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module unlock relay
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Auto door locks not enabled
- Door ajar status
- PCM DTC's present
- RKE module defective - auto locks inoperable
Decklid Solenoid Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2607
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
DECKLID SOLENOID INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Solenoid ground open
- Decklid release solenoid open
- Decklid release relay output wire open
- RKE module - decklid relay open
Doors Lockable With Key In Ignition and Driver Door Open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2608
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2609
Test 4 - 10
SYMPTOM
DOORS LOCKABLE WITH KEY IN IGNITION & DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch - open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to RKE module
- Ignition switch open
- Key-in ignition switch sense wire open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to cluster
- Instrument cluster - key-in ignition open
- Instrument cluster defective-driver door ajar open
- RKE module defective-open driver door ajar
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2610
Driver Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open driver unlock circuit
- Driver door lock motor - open
- Driver door lock relay output wire open
- Driver door unlock relay output wire open
Driver Door Fails to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2611
Test 1
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- RKE module defective - driver unlock open
One Passenger Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2612
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ONE PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock motor open
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
Remote Keyless Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2613
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
RKE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Test transmitter with tester
- RKE transmitter not programmed
- Test RKE transmitter
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2614
- RKE transmitter - inoperative
- RKE module
- RKE module - receiver inoperable
Alarm Trips On Its Own
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALARM TRIPS ON ITS OWN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Last VTSS cause
- Attempt to trip alarm
- Intermittent condition
All Doors Fail to Lock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2615
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS FAIL TO LOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock relay output circuit short to ground
- Decklid release relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to driver door unlock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to door unlock relay output
- Remote keyless entry module - unlock ground open
All Locks Inoperative From A Door Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2616
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL LOCKS INOPERATIVE FROM A DOOR LOCK SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2617
- Door switch ground wire open
- Door switch MUX wire short to voltage
- Door switch MUX wire open
- Door lock switch open
- Remote keyless entry module - high voltage
- Remote keyless entry module - low voltage
Headlamps Fail to Flash When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HEADLAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Horn Fails to Sound When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HORN FAILS TO SOUND DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Horn relay control circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Cannot Be Disabled
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2618
Test 1
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR CANNOT BE DISABLED (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Fails to Trip VTSS
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2619
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR FAILS TO TRIP VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit open
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Repeatedly Triggers VTSS
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2620
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR REPEATEDLY TRIGGERS VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Driver Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
OPEN DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch
- Driver door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Driver door ajar switch sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Passenger Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2621
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2622
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2623
Test 7 - 8
SYMPTOM
OPEN PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Left rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
- RKE module - passenger door ajar sense
Park Lamps Fail to Flash During Alarm
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PARK LAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2624
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Park lamp switch output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
VTSS Fails to Arm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm From Passenger Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2625
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM PASSENGER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Passenger door switch MUX circuit open
- Passenger cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm/Disarm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM/DISARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2626
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR
CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY).
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Indicator Fails to Flash
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR FAILS TO FLASH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Remote keyless entry module
- Instrument cluster
- VTSS indicator driver circuit open
- VTSS led open
VTSS Indicator Stays On Steady During Arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2627
Test 1 - 5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2628
Test 6 - 8
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR STAYS ON STEADY DURING ARMING
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid security switch sense circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch ground circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch sense circuit shorted to ground (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch (if equipped)
- RKE module - VTSS indicator
- RKE module - hood ajar (if equipped)
- RKE module - decklid security (if equipped)
VTSS Siren Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2629
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
VTSS SIREN INOPERATIVE (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Siren functional test
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Faulty siren
- Siren control circuit open
- Siren control circuit shorted to ground
- Remote keyless entry module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2630
Body Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Six Step Troubleshooting Procedure
SIX-STEP TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
Diagnosis is done in six basic steps:
1. Verification of complaint 2. Verification of any related symptoms 3. Symptom analysis 4. Problem
isolation 5. Repair of isolated problem 6. Verification of proper operation
Road Testing
ROAD TEST WARNINGS
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure.
The purpose of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: Before road testing a vehicle, be sure that all components are reassembled. during the
test drive, do not try to read the DRB III screen while in motion. Do not hang the DRB III from the
rear view mirror or operate it yourself. Have an assistant available to operate the DRB III.
Vehicle Preparation For Testing
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR TESTING
Make sure the vehicle being tested has a fully charged battery. If it does not, false diagnostic codes
or error messages may occur.
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2631
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: Erase the stored codes
- Place the ignition in the Run position
- Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
- Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
- Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2632
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Glossary of Terms
ABS Antilock Brake System
ACM Airbag Control Module
AECM Airbag Electronic Control Module (ACM)
ASDM Airbag System Diagnostic Module (ACM)
BUX Built-Up Export
CAB Controller Antilock Brake
CTM Compass/Temperature Mirror
DAB Driver Airbag
DLC Data Link Connector
DTC Diagnostic Trouble Code
EMIC Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster
LSIACM
Left SIACM
NGC Next Generation Controller
PAB Passenger Airbag
PCI Programmable Communication Interface (Vehicle Communication Bus)
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PDC Power Distribution Center
PWM
Pulse Width Modulated
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RSIACM Right SIACM
SAB Side Airbag
SIACM Side Impact Airbag Control Module
SKIM Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
SKIS Sentry Key Immobilizer System
SQUIB Also Called Initiator (Located In Rear Of Airbag Module)
TCM Transmission Control Module
VFD Vacuum Fluorescent Display
VTSS Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2633
Body Control Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
DRB III Error Messages and Blank Screen
DRB III ERROR MESSAGES AND BLANK SCREEN
Under normal operation, the DRB III will display one of only two error messages:
User-Requested WARM Boot (Press MORE and NO at the same time)
User-Requested COLD Boot (Press MORE and YES at the same time)
If the DRB III should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the
S.T.A.R. Center for information and assistance.
DRB III DOES NOT POWER UP
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 16). A minimum of 11 volts
is required to adequately power the DRB III.
If all connections are proper between the DRB III and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, and inoperative DRB III may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
For a blank screen, refer to the appropriate body diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2634
DISPLAY IS NOT VISIBLE
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition
SOME DISPLAY ITEMS READ "---"
This is caused by scrolling the DRB III display a single line up or down. The line which was scrolled
onto the screen might read "---". Use the Page Down or Page Up function to display the
information.
DRB III Safety Information
DRB III (R) SAFETY INFORMATION
WARNING: EXCEEDING THE LIMITS OF THE DRB III (R) MULTIMETER IS DANGEROUS. IT
CAN EXPOSE YOU TO SERIOUS OR
POSSIBLE FATAL INJURY. CAREFULLY READ AND UNDERSTAND THE CAUTIONS AND THE
SPECIFICATION LIMITS.
Follow the vehicle manufacture's service specifications at all times.
Do not use the DRB Ill(R) if it has been damaged.
Do not use the test leads if the insulation is damaged or if metal is exposed.
To avoid electrical shock, do not touch the test leads, tips, or other circuit being tested.
Choose the proper range and function for the measurement. Do not try voltage or current
measurement that may exceed the rated capacity.
Do not exceed the limits shown in the table.
Voltage between any terminal and ground must not exceed 500v DC or 500v peak AC.
The circuit being tested must be protected by a 10A fuse or circuit breaker.
Use the low current shunt to measure circuits up to 10A. Use the higher current clamp to measure
circuits exceeding 10A.
When testing for the presence of voltage or current, make sure the meter is functioning correctly.
Take a reading of a known voltage or current before accepting a zero reading.
When measuring current, connect the meter in series with the load.
Disconnect the live test lead before disconnecting the common test lead.
When using the meter function, keep the DRB III (R) away from spark plug or coil wires to avoid
measuring error from outside interference.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2635
Body Control Module: Tools and Equipment
REQUIRED TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
DRB III (R) (diagnostic read out box) Jumper Wires Ohmmeter Voltmeter Test Light 8310 Airbag
Load Tool 8443 SRS Airbag System Load Tool
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2639
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2643
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2644
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2645
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature
(ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2646
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2651
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2652
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2653
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2654
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2655
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <-->
[Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2656
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Data Link Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2662
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation
Fig.4 Data Link Connector (DLC) Location
The data link connector is located inside the vehicle, under the instrument panel, left of the steering
column.
The data link connector (diagnostic connector) links the DRB scan tool with the powertrain control
module (PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Safety Systems - Inadvertent Damage/Disabling
Electronic Throttle Actuator: Technical Service Bulletins Safety Systems - Inadvertent
Damage/Disabling
NUMBER: 08-027-04
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: July 30, 2004
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-017-01, DATED
SEPTEMBER 21, 2001, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Safety Systems - Vehicle Modifications/Repair
MODELS:
2002 - **2003** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
2002 - **2004** (AN) Dakota
2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
**2004 - 2005 (CS) Pacifica**
2002 - **2003** (DN) Durango
**2003 - 2005 (DR/DH) Ram Pickup**
**2004 - 2005 (HB) Durange
2002 - **2005** (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
2002 - **2005** (KJ) Liberty
2002 - **2004** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/300M
**2005 (LX) 300/Magnum **
**2005 (ND) Dakota**
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2002 - **2005** (PL) Neon
2002 - **2003** (PR) Prowler
2002 - **2005** (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2002 - **2005** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2002 - **2005** (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2002 (SR) Viper
2002 - **2005** (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
2002 - **2005** (TJ) Wrangler
**2002 - 2005 (VA) Sprinter**
2002 - **2004** (WJ) Grand Cherokee
**2005 (WK) Grand Cherokee**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Safety Systems - Inadvertent Damage/Disabling > Page 2667
2002 - **2004** (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
**2005 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)**
**2003 - 2005 (ZB) Viper**
**2004 - 2005 (ZH) Crossfire**
DISCUSSION:
Current DaimlerChrysler vehicles may contain any or all of the following safety Systems: driver
airbags, passenger airbags, side curtain airbags, side seat airbags, seat belt pre-tensioners,
anti-lock brakes, electronic throttle control, or traction control. All these systems contain multiple
sophisticated sensitive electrical and mechanical components. The location and function of all
safety system components must be determined before performing repairs; including accident,
mechanical or electrical, or vehicle modifications such as adding an after-market sunroof.
WARNING:
ANY INADVERTENT SAFETY SYSTEM COMPONENT OR ASSOCIATED WIRING
DAMAGE/MODIFICATION OR COMPONENT LOCATION CHANGE MAY DISABLE ANY OF THE
SAFETY SYSTEMS.
Refer to the appropriate vehicle Service Information to determine location and function of all safety
systems before servicing vehicle. All systems should be checked for functionality after the vehicle
modifications/repairs are complete.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2676
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2677
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2678
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2679
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2680
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2681
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2682
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2683
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2689
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2690
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2691
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2696
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2697
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2698
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2699
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2700
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2701
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2702
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2703
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain
Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain
Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2709
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain
Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2710
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain
Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2711
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2712
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Mounting Screws 4 Nm 35 In. Lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2715
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2716
Fig. 12 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2717
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2718
Fig. 43 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 2721
Powertrain Control Module C2 (2.0L NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 2722
Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 2723
Powertrain Control Module C4 (EATX NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Important - Please Read
IMPORTANT (NGC)
New for the 2003 PL is a combined Powertrain Control Module and Transmission Control Module
in a single control module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller (NGC) for
DaimlerChrysler and will be referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2726
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
DATA BUS COMMUNICATION RECEIVE - PCM INPUT
The PCM uses the SCI communication bus to preform engine diagnostics and flash operations.
The transmission side of the PCM uses the SCI communication bus to flash new software.
However, diagnostics is performed via the vehicles J1850 bus for the transmission side of the
PCM.
IGNITION SENSE - PCM INPUT
The ignition sense input informs the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) that the ignition switch is in
the crank or run position.
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side relays, solenoids, ignition coil or injectors.
The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the ground side of
any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded separately from the
ground pins.
Fig.5 PCM
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine, transmission, and vehicle
operations through devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Controls
- Ambient Air temperature Sensor
- ASD Sense
- Baro/Tip (Turbo)
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2727
- Clutch Upstop Switch (1.6L)
- Clutch Interlock
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Cruise Control Switch
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor (Bus message)
- Ignition Switch
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- J1850
- Knock Sensor (1.6, 2.0, 2.4L only)
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection (NVLD)
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Oxygen Sensors
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receive
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 TPS Sensors)
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD)
- Transmission Range Sensor (TRS)
- Transmission Oil Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor (MTX-equipped models).
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp (Bus Message)
- SCI Transmit
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor (2.0/2.4L)
- Ignition Coils
- J1850
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp (Bus Message)
- Oxygen Sensors Heater Controls
- Radiator Fan Relays
- Speed Control Solenoids (2.0/2.4L)
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD)
- Transmission PRNDL Position (to Cluster)
- Transmission Torque Reduction Request (Internal to PCM)
- Transmission Temperature (Internal to PCM and a Bus Message)
- Vehicle Speed (Manual Transmission)
- 2 Electronic Throttle Control Outputs (1.6L) Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts fuel
injector pulse width, idle speed, ignition spark advance, ignition coil dwell and EVAP canister purge
operation. The PCM also determines the appropriate transmission shift schedule and shift points,
depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand. The PCM regulates the cooling
fan, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge rate by
adjusting the generator field. The PCM also performs diagnostics.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs. Battery voltage
- Coolant temperature
- Exhaust gas content (oxygen sensor)
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Intake air temperature
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2728
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs. Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Intake air temperature
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following
inputs. Air conditioning sense
- Battery voltage
- Battery temperature
- Brake switch
- Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Engine run time
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power steering pressure switch
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Vehicle distance (speed)
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are located in the Power Distribution Center
(PDC).
The camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor signals are sent to the PCM. If the
PCM does not receive the signal within approximately 1 second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the ASD relay and fuel pump relay. When these relays are deactivated, power is shut off from the
fuel injectors, ignition coils, oxygen sensor heating elements and fuel pump.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5 volts direct
current to power the camshaft position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, manifold absolute
pressure sensor, throttle position sensor, A/C pressure switch, A/C pressure transducer, and
vehicle speed sensor.
Powertrain Control Module Connectors
The PCM is an engine and transmission controller module all in one, if the vehicle is equipped with
an automatic transmission. The PCM uses four wiring harness connectors to receive and send
engine and transmission data. To ease assembly, the mating wiring harness connector is
color-coded. Each module connector cavity has its own unique color identification stripe located on
the outside of each connector cavity.
The PCM module utilizes four wiring harness connectors as described:
- Connector Cavity A is for Power & Ground (Black)
- Connector Cavity B is for Engine Side (Orange)
- Connector Cavity C is for Headlamp & Dash (White)
- Connector Cavity D is for Transmission (Green) If equipped.
NOTE: Connector Cavities A, B, C, And D must be connected prior to battery connection and
ignition key on to avoid setting erroneous controller fault codes. It is also recommended that cavity
A connector is made prior to any other connectors.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEX (CVI)
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Transmission Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs
represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2729
Fig.6 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRBIII Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
TRANSMISSION SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM is programmed to allow it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is
dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 2730
- Software calibration level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
5 VOLT SUPPLY - PCM OUTPUT
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the following sensors:
- A/C pressure transducer
- Ambient Temperature sensor
- Battery temperature
- Camshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock sensor
- Linear EGR solenoid (if equipped)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L)
- Throttle position sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2731
Powertrain Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
CHECKING PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- (A14) PCM fused B+ circuit
- (A41) PCM fused ignition switch output circuit
- (Z12) PCM ground circuits
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2734
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2735
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2736
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2737
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2738
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2739
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2740
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2741
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2742
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2743
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2744
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2745
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2746
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Obtaining Diagnostic Trouble Codes
BULB CHECK
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <-->
[Engine Control Module] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module >
Page 2747
Key on: Bulb illuminated until vehicle starts, as long as all once per trip (readiness) monitors
completed. If monitors have not been completed, then:
Key on: bulb check for about 5 to 8 seconds, lamp then flashes if once per trip (readiness) monitors
have not been completed until vehicle is started, then MIL is extinguished.
OBTAINING DTC'S USING DRB SCAN TOOL
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "Read Fault" screen. 3. Record all the DTC's and
"freeze frame" information shown on the DRB scan tool. 4. To erase DTC's, use the "Erase Trouble
Code" data screen on the DRB scan tool. Do not erase any DTC's until problems have been
investigated
and repairs have been performed.
Pinion Factor Setting
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM/TCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an inoperative or improperly
calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM/TCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires)
available. Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain/ Transmission Control Module
initial setting so that the speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the
Pinion Factor, it is necessary to use a DRBIII scan tool.
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2.
Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then
follow the instructions on the DRBIII scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRBIII scan tool. This program allows the PCM/
TCM to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain/Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following
conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRBIII
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60° and below 200°
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRBIII to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fig.11 Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2751
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2752
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2753
Fig.7 Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2757
Idle Air Control Motor (2.0L/2.4L Turbo)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2758
Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor: Description and Operation
Fig.16 Idle Air Control Solenoid - Typical
IDLE AIR CONTROL MOTOR
The Idle Air Control (IAC) solenoid is mounted on the throttle body. The PCM operates the idle air
control solenoid. It is an electric stepper solenoid.
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control solenoid to compensate for engine
load, coolant temperature or barometric pressure changes.
The throttle body has an air bypass passage that provides air for the engine during closed throttle
idle. The idle air control solenoid pintle protrudes into the air bypass passage and regulates air flow
through it.
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed by moving the IAC solenoid pintle in and out of the bypass
passage. The adjustments are based on inputs the PCM receives. The inputs are from the throttle
position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, coolant temperature sensor, MAP sensor, vehicle
speed sensor and various switch operations (brake, park/neutral, air conditioning and power
steering).
When engine rpm is above idle speed, the IAC is used for the following functions: Off-idle dashpot
- Deceleration air flow control
- A/C compressor load control and power steering (also opens the passage slightly before the
compressor is engaged so that the engine rpm does not dip down when the compressor engages)
Target Idle
Target idle is determined by the following inputs: Gear position
- ECT Sensor
- Battery voltage
- Ambient/Battery Temperature Sensor
- VSS
- TPS
- MAP Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2759
Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
When servicing throttle body components, always reassemble components with new O-rings and
seals where applicable. Never use lubricants on O-rings or seals, damage may result. If assembly
of component is difficult, use water to aid assembly Use care when removing hoses to prevent
damage to hose or hose nipple.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove electrical connector from idle air control
motor.
Fig.17 Servicing Idle Air Control Motor
3. Remove idle air control motor mounting screws. 4. Remove motor from throttle body. Ensure the
O-ring is removed with the motor.
INSTALLATION
1. The new idle air control motor has a new O-ring installed on it. If pintle measures more than 1
inch (25 mm) it must be retracted. Use the DRB III
Idle Air Control Motor Open/Close Test to retract the pintle (battery must be connected.)
2. Carefully place idle air control motor into throttle body. 3. Install mounting screws. Tighten
screws to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect electrical connector to idle air control motor. 5.
Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2764
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2765
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2766
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2767
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2768
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2769
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2770
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2771
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2772
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2773
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2774
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2775
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2776
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2777
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2778
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2779
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2780
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2781
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2782
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2783
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2784
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2785
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2786
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2787
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Communication
Information Bus: Description and Operation Vehicle Communication
COMMUNICATION
The Programmable Communication Interface (PCI) data bus system is a single wire multiplex
system used for vehicle communications on many DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles.
Multiplexing is a system that enables and supports the transmission of binary encoded messages
between multiple modules over a single channel or circuit. All DaimlerChrysler vehicles use this
principle for communication between various microprocessor-based electronic control modules.
The PCI data bus exceeds the Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE) J1850 Standard for Class B
Multiplexing.
The PCI bus circuit is identified as D25. The modules are wired in parallel. Connections are made
in the harness using splices.
The following modules are used on 2003 PL: Airbag Control Module
- Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Controller Antilock Brake
- Powertrain Control Module
- Radio (If equipped)
- CD Changer (If equipped)
- Compass/Temperature Mirror (If equipped)
- Remote Keyless Entry Module (If equipped)
- Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (If equipped)
- Mechanical Instrument Cluster
Many of the electronic control modules in a vehicle require information from the same sensing
device. In the past, if information from one sensing device was required by several controllers, a
wire from each controller needed to be connected in parallel to that sensor. In addition, each
controller utilizing analog sensors required an Analog/Digital (A/D) converter in order to "read"
these sensor inputs. Multiplexing reduces wire harness complexity, sensor current loads and
controller hardware because each sensing device is connected to only one controller, which reads
and distributes the sensor information to the other controllers over the data bus. Also, because
each controller on the data bus can access the controller sensor inputs to every other controller on
the data bus, more function and feature capabilities are possible.
In addition to reducing wire harness complexity, component sensor current loads and controller
hardware, multiplexing offers a diagnostic advantage. A multiplex system allows the information
flowing between controllers to be monitored using a diagnostic scan tool. The DaimlerChrysler
system allows an electronic control module to broadcast message data out onto the bus where all
other electronic control modules can "hear" the messages that are being sent. When a module
hears a message on the data bus that it requires, it relays that message to its microprocessor.
Each module ignores the messages on the data bus that are being sent to other electronic control
modules.
Data exchange between modules is achieved by serial transmission of encoded data over a single
wire broadcast network. The wire colors used for the PCI data bus circuits are yellow with a violet
tracer, or violet with a yellow tracer, depending upon the application. The PCI data bus messages
are carried over the bus in the form of Variable Pulse Width Modulated (VPWM) signals. The PCI
data bus speed is an average 10.8 Kilo-bits per second (Kbps). By comparison, the prior two-wire
Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus system is designed to run at 7.8125 Kbps.
The voltage network used to transmit messages requires biasing and termination. Each module on
the PCI data bus system provides its own biasing and termination in order to transmit and receive
messages. The bus voltage is at 0 volts when no modules are transmitting and is pulled up to
about 7-1/2 volts when modules are transmitting.
Each module (also referred to as a node) terminates the bus through a terminating resistor and a
terminating capacitor. There are two types of nodes on the bus. The dominant node terminates the
bus through a 1 KW resistor and a 3300 pF capacitor. The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is the
only dominant node for the PCI data bus system. A standard node terminates the bus through an
11 KW resistor and a 330 pF capacitor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Communication > Page 2790
The bus messages are transmitted at a rate averaging 10800 bits per second. Since there is only
voltage present when the modules transmit and the message length is only about 500 milliseconds,
it is ineffective to try and measure the bus activity with a conventional voltmeter. The preferred
method is to use the DRB III lab scope. The 12 V square wave selection on the 20-volt scale
provides a good view of the bus activity. Voltage on the bus should pulse between 0 volts and
about 7-1/2 volts. Refer to the diagram for some typical displays.
The modules bias the bus when transmitting a message. The PCI bus uses low and high voltage
levels to generate signals. Low voltage is around 0 volts and the high voltage is about 7-1/2 volts.
The low and high voltage levels are generated by means of variable-pulse width modulation to form
signals of varying length. The Variable Pulse Width Modulation (VPWM) used in PCI bus
messaging is a method in which both the state of the bus and the width of the pulse are used to
encode bit information. A "zero" bit is defined as a short low pulse or a long high pulse. A "one" bit
is defined as a long low pulse or a short high pulse. A low (passive) state on the bus does not
necessarily mean a zero bit. It also depends upon pulse width. If the width is short, it stands for a
zero bit. If the width is long, it stands for a one bit. Similarly, a high (active) state does not
necessarily mean a one bit. This too depends upon pulse width. If the width is short, it stands for a
one bit. If the width is long, it stands for a zero bit.
In the case where there are successive zero or one data bits, both the state of the bus and the
width of the pulse are changed alternately. This encoding scheme is used for two reasons. First,
this ensures that only one symbol per transition and one transition per symbol exists. On each
transition, every transmitting module must decode the symbol on the bus and begin timing of the
next symbol. Since timing of the next symbol begins with the last transition detected on the bus, all
of the modules are re-synchronized with each symbol. This ensures that there are no accumulated
timing errors during PCI data bus communication.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Communication > Page 2791
The second reason for this encoding scheme is to guarantee that the zero bit is the dominant bit on
the bus. When two modules are transmitting simultaneously on the bus, there must be some form
of arbitration to determine which module will gain control. A data collision occurs when two
modules are transmitting different messages at the same time. When a module is transmitting on
the bus, it is reading the bus at the same time to ensure message integrity. When a collision is
detected, the module that transmitted the one bit stops sending messages over the bus until the
bus becomes idle.
Each module is capable of transmitting and receiving data simultaneously. The typical PCI bus
message has the following four components: Message Header - One to three bytes in length. The header contains information identifying the
message type and length, message priority, target module(s) and sending module.
- Data Byte(s) - This is the actual message that is being sent.
- Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) Byte This byte is used to detect errors during a message
transmission.
- In-Frame Response (IFR) byte(s) - If a response is required from the target module (s), it can be
sent during this frame. This function is described in greater detail in the following paragraph.
The IFR consists of one or more bytes, which are transmitted during a message. If the sending
module requires information to be received immediately, the target module (s) can send data over
the bus during the original message. This allows the sending module to receive time-critical
information without having to wait for the target module to access the bus. After the IFR is received,
the sending module broadcasts an End of Frame (EOF) message and releases control of the bus.
The PCI data bus can be monitored using the DRB III scan tool. It is possible, however, for the bus
to pass all DRB III tests and still be faulty if the voltage parameters are all within the specified
range and false messages are being sent.
PCI Bus Failure Modes
The PCI Bus failure modes are broken down into two categories. Complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure and individual module no response. Causes of a complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure include a short to ground or battery on the PCI circuit. Individual module no
response can be caused by an open circuit at the module, or an open battery or ground circuit to
the affected
Symptoms of a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure would include but are not limited to: All gauges on the EMIC stay at zero
- All telltales on EMIC illuminate
- EMIC backlighting at full intensity
- No response received from any module on the PCI bus (except PCM)
- No start (if equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer)
Symptoms of Individual module failure could include any one or more of the above. The difference
would be that at least one or more modules would respond to the DRB III.
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III. If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only an
indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control module. This new module is the Next Generation
Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The Transmission Control Module is part of the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller # 8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Vehicle Communication > Page 2792
Information Bus: Description and Operation Programmable Communication Interface (PCI) Bus
PROGRAMMABLE COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE (PCI) BUS
The Programmable Communication Interface Multiplex system (PCI Bus) consist of a single wire.
The Body Control Module (BCM) acts as a splice to connect each module and the Data Link
Connector (DLC) together. Each module is wired in parallel to the data bus through its PCI chip set
and uses its ground as the bus reference. The wiring is a minimum 20 gage wire.
Various modules exchange information through a communications port called the PCI Bus. The
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) transmits the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check Engine)
ON/OFF signal and engine RPM on the PCI Bus. The PCM receives the Air Conditioning select
input, transaxle gear position inputs over the PCI Bus. The PCM also receives the air conditioning
evaporator temperature signal from the PCI Bus.
The following components access or send information on the PCI Bus. Instrument Panel
- Body Control Module
- Airbag System Diagnostic Module
- Full ATC Display Head (if equipped)
- ABS Module
- Transmission Control Module
- Powertrain Control Module
- Travel Module
- SKIM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Information Bus: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
VEHICLE COMMUNICATION
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III(R). If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III(R) may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III(R) and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only
an indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control
module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be
referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The Transmission Control Module is part of
the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller #8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Refer to Body Control System. See: Body Control Module
Refer to Computers and Control Systems. See:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2798
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay
<--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay
<--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2802
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Application and ID
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Malfunction Indicator Light ...................................................................................................................
............................................................... LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Application and ID > Page 2806
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
Refer to the Instrument Cluster for more information.
The PCM supplies the malfunction indicator (check engine) lamp ON/OFF signal to the instrument
panel through the PCI Bus. The PCI Bus is a communications port. Various modules use the PCI
Bus to exchange information.
The Check Engine lamp comes ON each time the ignition key is turned ON and stays on for 3
seconds as a bulb test.
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) stays ON continuously when the PCM has entered a Limp-In
mode or identified a failed emission component. During Limp-in Mode, the PCM attempts to keep
the system operational. The MIL signals the need for immediate service. In limp-in mode, the PCM
compensates for the failure of certain components that send incorrect signals. The PCM substitutes
for the incorrect signals with inputs from other sensors.
If the PCM detects active engine misfire severe enough to cause catalyst damage, it flashes the
MIL. At the same time the PCM also sets a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
For signals that can trigger the MIL (Check Engine Lamp) refer to the On-Board Diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Fig. 15 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 48 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2810
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2811
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2812
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.23 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
The MAP sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
The MAP sensor signal is provided from a single piezo-resistive element located in the center of a
diaphragm. The element and diaphragm are both made of silicone. As the pressures changes the
diaphragm moves causing the element to deflect which stresses the silicone. When silicone is
exposed to stress its resistance changes. As manifold vacuum increases, the MAP sensor input
voltage decreases proportionally. The sensor also contains electronics that condition the signal and
provide temperature compensation.
The MAP serves as a PCM input, using a silicon based sensing unit, to provide data on the
manifold vacuum that draws the air/fuel mixture into the combustion chamber. The PCM requires
this information to determine injector pulse width and spark advance. When MAP equals
Barometric pressure, the pulse width will be at maximum.
Also like the cam and crank sensors, a 5 volt reference is supplied from the PCM and returns a
voltage signal to the PCM that reflects manifold pressure. The zero pressure reading is 0.5V and
full scale is 4.5V. For a pressure swing of 0 - 15 psi the voltage changes 4.0V. The sensor is
supplied a regulated 4.8 to 5.1 volts to operate the sensor. Like the cam and crank sensors ground
is provided through the sensor return circuit.
The MAP sensor input is the number one contributor to pulse width. The most important function of
the MAP sensor is to determine barometric pressure. The PCM needs to know if the vehicle is at
sea level or is it in Denver at 5000 feet above sea level, because the air density changes with
altitude. It will also help to correct for varying weather conditions. If a hurricane was coming through
the pressure would be very, very low or there could be a real fair weather, high pressure area. This
is important because as air pressure changes the barometric pressure changes. Barometric
pressure and altitude have a direct inverse correlation, as altitude goes up barometric goes down.
The first thing that happens as the key is rolled on, before reaching the crank position, the PCM
powers up, comes around and looks at the MAP voltage, and based upon the voltage it sees, it
knows the current barometric pressure relative to altitude. Once the engine starts, the PCM looks
at the voltage again, continuously every 12 milliseconds, and compares the current voltage to what
it was at key ON. The difference between current and what it was at key ON is manifold vacuum.
During key ON (engine not running) the sensor reads (updates) barometric pressure. A normal
range can be obtained by monitoring known good sensor in you work area.
As the altitude increases the air becomes thinner (less oxygen). If a vehicle is started and driven to
a very different altitude than where it was at key ON the barometric pressure needs to be updated.
Any time the PCM sees Wide Open throttle, based upon TPS angle and RPM it will update
barometric pressure in the MAP memory cell. With periodic updates, the PCM can make its
calculations more effectively.
The PCM uses the MAP sensor to aid in calculating the following:
- Barometric pressure
- Engine load
- Manifold pressure
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance programs
- Shift-point strategies (F4AC1 transmissions only, via the PCI bus)
- Idle speed
- Decel fuel shutoff
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2813
The PCM recognizes a decrease in manifold pressure by monitoring a decrease in voltage from the
reading stored in the barometric pressure memory cell. The MAP sensor is a linear sensor; as
pressure changes, voltage changes proportionately. The range of voltage output from the sensor is
usually between 4.6 volts at sea level to as low as 0.3 volts at 26 in. of Hg. Barometric pressure is
the pressure exerted by the atmosphere upon an object. At sea level on a standard day, no storm,
barometric pressure is 29.92 in Hg. For every 100 feet of altitude barometric pressure drops 0.10
in. Hg. If a storm goes through it can either add, high pressure, or decrease, low pressure, from
what should be present for that altitude. You should make a habit of knowing what the average
pressure and corresponding barometric pressure is for your area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2814
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.24 MAP Sensor
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Disconnect the electrical connector
from the MAP sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting screws. 3. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while
making sure not to damage O-ring seal. 2. Tighten mounting screws to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque
for plastic manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2818
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Component Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2823
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2824
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2825
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2826
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2827
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2828
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor 1/1 Upstream
Oxygen Sensor 1/2 Downstream
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2829
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Ignition System/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2830
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.30 Types Of O2 Sensors
Fig.27 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/1
O2 SENSOR
The upstream oxygen sensor threads into the outlet flange of the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2831
Fig.28 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/2
Fig.29 Heated Oxygen Sensor Systems
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the system depending on emission package.
Federal package the O2S is mounted after the catalytic convertor, LEV package the O2S is
mounted mid catalytic convertor, ULEV package is mounted between the catalytic convertor.
A single sensor ground is used for all O2 sensors (2 sensors on 4 cyl. vehicles and 4 sensors on 6
cyl. vehicles).
As vehicles accumulate mileage, the catalytic convertor deteriorates. The deterioration results in a
less efficient catalyst. To monitor catalytic convertor deterioration, the fuel injection system uses
two heated oxygen sensors. One sensor upstream of the catalytic convertor, one downstream of
the convertor. The PCM compares the reading from the sensors to calculate the catalytic convertor
oxygen storage capacity and converter efficiency. Also, the PCM uses the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input when adjusting injector pulse width.
When the catalytic converter efficiency drops below emission standards, the PCM stores a
diagnostic trouble code and illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL).
The O2S produce voltages from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air/fuel
mixture, can be caused by misfire and exhaust leaks), the sensors produces a low voltage. When
there is a lesser amount of oxygen present (caused by a rich air/fuel mixture, can be caused by
internal engine problems) it produces a higher voltage. By
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2832
monitoring the oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensors act as a rich-lean
switch.
The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element that keeps the sensors at proper
operating temperature during all operating modes. Maintaining correct sensor temperature at all
times allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop operation the PCM monitors the O2S input (along with other inputs) and adjusts the
injector pulse width accordingly. During Open Loop operation the PCM ignores the O2 sensor
input. The PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs
from other sensors.
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to both the upstream and
downstream heated oxygen sensors. The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element.
The heating elements reduce the time required for the sensors to reach operating temperature. The
PCM uses pulse width modulation to control the ground side of the heater to regulate the
temperature on 4 cyl. upstream O2 heater only. All other 4 cyl. and 6 cyl. O2 heaters do not use
pulse width modulation.
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
The input from the upstream heated oxygen sensor tells the PCM the oxygen content of the
exhaust gas. Based on this input, the PCM fine tunes the air-fuel ratio by adjusting injector pulse
width.
The sensor input switches from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air-fuel
mixture), the sensor produces voltage as low as 0.1 volt. When there is a lesser amount of oxygen
present (rich air-fuel mixture) the sensor produces a voltage as high as 1.0 volt. By monitoring the
oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensor acts as a rich-lean switch.
The heating element in the sensor provides heat to the sensor ceramic element. Heating the
sensor allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input along with other inputs. In Open Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on
preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs from other sensors.
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor input is used to detect catalytic convertor deterioration. As
the convertor deteriorates, the input from the downstream sensor begins to match the upstream
sensor input except for a slight time delay By comparing the downstream heated oxygen sensor
input to the input from the upstream sensor, the PCM calculates catalytic convertor efficiency. Also
used to establish the upstream O2 goal voltage (switching point).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
Fig.32 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust outlet pipe behind the catalytic
convertor.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from harness. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig.33 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 5. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Connect sensor electrical harness from clips along body
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor > Page 2835
3. Connect electrical connector to harness. 4. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor > Page 2836
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream (1/1) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector.
Fig.31 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
3. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 4. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Plug sensor connector. 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2837
Oxygen Sensor: Tools and Equipment
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - C-4907
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - 8439
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2842
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2843
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2844
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2845
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2851
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2852
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2853
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2854
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2855
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2856
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2857
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2858
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2859
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2860
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2861
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2862
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2863
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2864
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2865
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2866
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2867
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2868
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2869
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2870
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2871
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2872
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2873
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2874
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2875
Body Control Module: Electrical Diagrams
Airbag System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2876
Audio System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2877
CD Changer
Compass/Temperature Mirror
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2878
Exterior Lighting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2879
Instrument Cluster
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2880
Interior Lighting
Power Door Locks/RKE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2881
Vehicle Communication
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2882
Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information
Body Control Module: Technician Safety Information
SERVICING SUB-ASSEMBLIES
Some components of the body system are intended to be serviced as an assembly only.
Attempting to remove or repair certain system sub-components may result in personal injury and/or
improper system operation. Only those components with approved repair and installation
procedures should be serviced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service Precautions > Technician
Safety Information > Page 2885
Body Control Module: Vehicle Damage Warnings
Electrical Testing Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "off". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation, this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion. Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent
accidental shorting of terminals Such mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second
code could be set, making diagnosis of the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description
Body Control Module: Description and Operation System Description
Identification Of System
The vehicle systems that are part of the "body" system are:
- Airbag System
- Audio
- Compass/Temperature Mirror
- Instrument Cluster
- Interior Lighting
- Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
- Vehicle Communications
- Vehicle Theft Security System
System Description
The body system on the 2003 PL consists of a combination of modules that communicate over the
PCI bus (Programmable Communication Interface multiplex system).
Through the PCI bus, information about the operation of vehicle components and circuits is relayed
quickly to the appropriate module(s). All modules receive all the information transmitted on the bus
even though a module may not require all information to perform it's function. It will only respond to
messages "addressed" to it through a binary coding process.
This method of data transmission significantly reduces the complexity of the wiring in the vehicle
and the size of wiring harnesses. All of the information about the functioning of all the systems is
organized, controlled, and communicated by the PCI bus, which is described in the Vehicle
Communication See: Functional Operation/Vehicle Communication of this general information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2888
Body Control Module: Description and Operation Functional Operation
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE
THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
DRIVER AIRBAG (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93 °C (200 °F).
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation, The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches on vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged. The clockspring cannot be repaired it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2889
PASSENGER AIRBAG (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and its
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON
GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG
MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING
INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93
degrees C (200 degrees F).
WARNING: REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN
THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR
INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT
PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE
AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY
DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY
SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT
FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG.
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
They are located on the left and right B-post. The SIACM perform self diagnostics and circuit tests
to determine if the system is functioning properly. If the test finds a problem the SIACM will set both
active and stored diagnostic trouble codes. If a DTC is active the SIACM will request that the airbag
warning lamp be turned on. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI Bus to the
ACM once each second or on change in lamp state. If the warning lamp status message from the
either SIACM contains a lamp on request the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the
DTC is set the ACM sends a PCI Bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC)
requesting the airbag warning lamp be turned on. Observe all ACM warning and caution
statements when servicing or handling the SIACM. SIACM are not repairable and must be replaced
if they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
SEAT AIRBAGS
The Left and Right seat airbag modules are located in the outboard end of the front seat backs.
The airbag module contains a bag, an inflator (a small canister of highly compressed argon gas)
and a mounting bracket. The seat airbag module cannot be repaired and must be replaced if
deployed or in any way damaged. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the inflator seals
the hole in the airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the
cushion. Upon deployment, the seat back trim cover will tear open and allow the seat airbag to fully
deploy between the seat and the door.
NOTE: It will be necessary to remove the seat back trim to gain access to the seat airbag module
connector when diagnosing the seat airbag system.
WARNING: THE SEAT AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI.
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR.
DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT
STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93 degrees C (200 degrees F). REPLACE AIRBAG
SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL
DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS,
SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE
SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY
MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS
NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE
PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Some airbag diagnostic tests use special tools, 8310 and 8443 airbag load tool, for testing squib
circuits. The load tools contain fixed resistive loads, jumpers and adapters. The fixed loads are
connected to cables and mounted in a storage case. The cables can be directly connected to some
airbag system connectors. Jumpers are used to convert the load tool cable connectors to the other
airbag system connectors. The adapters are connected to the module harness connector to open
shorting clips and protect the connector terminal during testing. When using the load tool follow all
of the safety procedures in the service information for disconnecting airbag system components.
Inspect the wiring, connector and terminals for damage or misalignment. Substitute the airbag load
tool in place of a Driver or Passenger Airbag, curtain airbag, clockspring, or seat belt tensioner (use
a jumper if needed). Then follow all of the safety procedures in the service information for
connecting airbag system components. Read the module active DTC's. If the module reports NO
ACTIVE DTC's the defective component has been removed from the system and should be
replaced. If the DTC is still active, continue this process until all components in the circuit have
been tested. Then disconnect the module connector and connect the matching adapter to the
module connector. With all airbags disconnected and the adapter installed the squib wiring can be
tested for open and shorted conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2890
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: *
Erase the stored codes
* Place the ignition in the Run position
* Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
* Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
* Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Audio System
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system on the 2003 PL consists of a radio that communicates over the PCI bus. The
speakers are located in the instrument panel, the front doors and the rear "D" pillars. The
instrument panel speakers are a tweeter type speaker for high frequency. The front door speakers
are a woofer/midrange type speaker. The rear "D" pillar speakers are a full range type speaker. If
one of the speaker circuits experiences a short, the other speakers on that output channel will also
shut down until the circuit is repaired. The radio will also set a trouble code, which the DRB III(R)
can display.
The in-dash CD-changer is designed to fit into the existing cubby bin in the center stack. This new
cartridge-less CD-changer is controlled by your radio, and allows you to individually load up to four
discs at one time. However, due to its compact design, the CD-changer can only carry out one
operation at a time. For example you can not load a new disc while playing another at the same
time. Each operation happens sequentially.
The radio unit installed with your system provides control over all features of the CD-changer with
the exception of the CD load and eject functions, which are controlled by buttons located on the
front of the CD-changer. The radio also supplies the power, ground, PCI Bus, left and right speaker
output through a single DIN cable. All features you would expect , such as Disc Up/Down, Track
Up/Down, Random and Scan are controlled by the radio, which also displays all relevant
CD-changer information on the radio display.
The CD-changer contains a Load/Eject button and an indicator light for each of the four disc
positions. The individual light indicates whether a CD is currently loaded in that particular chamber
of the CD-changer. Pressing the individual Load/Eject button for a particular chamber will eject a
disc currently present in the chamber. If the chamber is currently empty, actuating the Load/Eject
button will position that chamber to receive and load a new
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2891
disc in that chamber.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Compass/Temperature Mirror
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2892
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2893
magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may
appear to indicate false headings or appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may
need to be demagnetized. Refer to Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory, the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the
displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the
PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2894
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Exterior Lighting
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
The Headlamps are controlled by the Instrument Cluster.
The Instrument Cluster is also referred to as a "Smart Cluster". It receives and sends messages to
other modules through the PCI BUS circuit. The Headlamps are wired through the cluster and then
go to the Fuse Block to the lamps. Each Headlamp has an independent fuse located in the Fuse
Block.
For vehicles equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL Module is integrated with the
Instrument Cluster.
Interior Lighting
INTERIOR LIGHTING
The Courtesy Lamps are controlled by the instrument cluster.
Some of the features that it controls are the courtesy lamps, chime, and all instrument illumination.
It receives and sends messages to other modules via the PCI bus circuit.
The front turn signals are wired through the cluster and then go to the front lamps. For vehicles
equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL module is built into the cluster.
Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The Remote Keyless Entry module controls the Power Door Locks and the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). It also wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn on the illuminated entry when it
senses a signal from the RKE transmitter. The module communicates with other modules via the
PCI bus circuit.
The RKE module monitors the Occupant Restraint Controller messages for the purpose of
monitoring the deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message along with the verification
that the ignition is on and the vehicle speed is zero, it will provide the "enhanced accident response
feature". This feature will cause the module to unlock-all doors immediately and the instrument
cluster to turn the courtesy lamps on when the vehicle reaches 0 mph.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message, and receive
body style information. Two transmitters are supplied with the vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. The horn chirp on vehicle lock command is customer programmable.
To limit the amount of battery drain during storage, the IOD fuse may be removed.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM
When the VTSS is armed, it will monitor the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle
doors and decklid. Also monitored is a decklid security switch (knockout) for the cylinder lock. If the
alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2895
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, by
using the driver door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of an open decklid security switch sense circuit.
Disarming can be accomplished with a RKE unlock, turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key
or unlocking the vehicle with the driver door cylinder lock. All of the switches for the VTSS system
can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to determine the cause of a
customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM (Export Only)
When the VTSS is armed, it Will monitor the interior of the vehicle for movement via an intrusion
sensor (if equipped), the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle doors, decklid and
hood. Vehicles without an intrusion sensor will have a decklid security switch (knockout) which will
also be monitored. If the alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn or a battery backed siren
for vehicles equipped with the intrusion sensor, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, or
by using either door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of the hood ajar circuit being shorted (hood opened) or the decklid
security switch circuit being open (if equipped). Defeating the intrusion sensor feature for vehicles
so equipped can be done by three additional lock request to the RKE module within 5 seconds.
Disarming is done by either a RKE unlock or turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key. All of
the switches for the VTSS system can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to
determine the cause of a customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
Vehicle Communication
VEHICLE COMMUNICATION
The Programmable Communication Interface or PCI Bus is a single wire multiplexed network
capable of supporting binary encoded messages shared between multiple modules. The PCI bus
circuit is identified as D25. The modules are wired in parallel. Connections are made in the harness
using splices. The following modules are used on 2003 PL:
- Airbag Control Module
- Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Controller Antilock Brake
- Powertrain Control Module
- Radio (If equipped)
- CD Changer (If equipped)
- Compass/Temperature Mirror (If equipped)
- Remote Keyless Entry Module (If equipped)
- Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (If equipped)
- Mechanical Instrument Cluster
Each module provides its own bias and termination in order to transmit and receive messages. The
bus voltage is at zero volts when no modules are transmitting and is pulled up to about seven and
a half volts when modules are transmitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2896
The bus messages are transmitted at a rate averaging 10800 bits per second. Since there is only
voltage present when the modules transmit and the message length is only about 500 milliseconds,
it is ineffective to try and measure the bus activity with a conventional voltmeter. The preferred
method is to use the DRB III(R) lab scope. The 12 V square wave selection on the 20-volt scale
provides a good view of the bus activity. Voltage on the bus should pulse between zero and about
seven and a half volts. Refer to the diagram for some typical displays.
The PCI Bus failure modes are broken down into two categories. Complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure and individual module no response. Causes of a complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure include a short to ground or battery on the PCI circuit. Individual module no
response can be caused by an open circuit at the module, or an open battery or ground circuit to
the affected
Symptoms of a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure would include but are not limited to:
- All gauges on the EMIC stay at zero
- All telltales on EMIC illuminate
- EMIC backlighting at full intensity
- No response received from any module on the PCI bus (except PCM)
- No start (if equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer)
Symptoms of Individual module failure could include any one or more of the above. The difference
would be that at least one or more modules would respond to the DRB III(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > System
Description > Page 2897
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III(R). If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III(R) may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III(R) and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only
an indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control
module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be
referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The Transmission Control Module is part of
the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller #8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Body Control Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Airbag Indicator On Without ACM Trouble Codes
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AIRBAG INDICATOR ON WITHOUT ACM TROUBLE CODES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Airbag indicator on without ACM trouble codes
- Instrument cluster problems
No Response From Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2900
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2901
Test 3 - 4
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM ACM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Checking for voltage at ACM
- Ground circuit open
- PCI bus circuit open
- Airbag control module
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2902
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Any Station Preset Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY STATION PRESET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Balance Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
BALANCE INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2903
CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Equalizer Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Fader Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FADER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2904
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
HOUR/MINUTE Switches Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HOUR/MINUTE SWITCHES INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
No Response From Radio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2905
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2906
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM RADIO
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response from radio
- Open fused ignition switch output circuit
- Open fused B+ circuit
- Radio ground circuit open
- Open PCI bus circuit
- Radio
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2907
SYMPTOM
PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
PWR Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Scan Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Seek Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2908
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Set Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2909
- Internal failure
Time Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tune Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Compass/Temperature Mirror Does Calibrate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2910
Test 1
Test 2
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR DOES CALIBRATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Calibration procedure
- Compass/temperature mirror
Compass/Temperature Mirror Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2911
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2912
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus - compass
- Fused B(+) circuit short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Ground circuit open
- Compass/temperature mirror
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2913
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to voltage
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Test 1 - 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2914
Test 5 - 7
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open fused B+
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to ground
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to ground
- Open fuse
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2915
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to voltage
- Fuse block
- Instrument cluster
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2916
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Fuse block
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Open fused B+ to fuse block
- Fused B+ circuit short to ground
- B+ circuit breaker 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2917
All Gauges Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2918
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus
- No response - PCI bus - powertrain control module
- No response - PCI bus - instrument cluster
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Instrument cluster ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
Any or All Gauge Pointer(s) On Wrong Side of Stop
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY OR ALL GAUGE POINTER(S) ON WRONG SIDE OF STOP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Any PCI Bus Indicator Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY PCI BUS INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2919
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- LED defective
- Instrument cluster
Brake Warning Indicator Always On
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2920
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit short to ground
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit short to ground
- Park brake switch
- Brake fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Brake Warning Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2921
Test 4 - 7
Test 8
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2922
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Brake fluid level switch
- Park brake switch
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit open
- Brake fluid level switch ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Front Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
FRONT FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Front fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Fuel Gauge Inaccurate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2923
Test 1 - 2
Test 3
SYMPTOM
FUEL GAUGE INACCURATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Fuel level sensor
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
High Beam Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2924
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- High beam indicator circuit open
- High beam indicator bulb
- Instrument cluster
Instrument Cluster Dimming Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2925
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DIMMING INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Headlamp switch output circuit open
- Illumination bulb
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Always on
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2926
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit short to ground
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2927
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit open
- Indicator led
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
One Gauge Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2928
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ONE GAUGE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Powertrain control module DTCs
- Instrument cluster
PRND or Autostick Indicator Display Inaccurate or Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2929
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
PRND OR AUTOSTICK INDICATOR DISPLAY INACCURATE OR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
Rear Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative - BUX Only
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
REAR FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE - BUX ONLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Rear fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Seat Belt Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2930
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
SEATBELT INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Indicator led
- Seat belt indicator circuit open
- Seat belt switch ground open
- Seat belt switch
- Instrument cluster
Temperature Display Inoperative or Wrong (2.0L Only)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2931
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG (2.0L ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present in PCM
- Ambient temperat1jre sensor
- Compass/temperature mirror
VF Display Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
VF DISPLAY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Courtesy Lamps Inoperative - All Lamps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2932
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS INOPERATIVE - ALL LAMPS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B+ circuit open
- Instrument cluster - courtesy lamp open
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit open
- Intermittent condition
Courtesy Lamps On At All Times
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2933
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2934
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2935
Test 8 - 10
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS ON AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Drivers door ajar switch
- Drivers door ajar switch sense wire short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster
- Panel lamps dimmer signal wire short to ground
- Multifunction switch
- Open door ajar switch
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense wire short to ground
- Instrument cluster
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit short to ground
- Instrument cluster
Illuminated Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2936
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ILLUMINATED ENTRY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Courtesy lamps operational
- Intermittent condition
- Illuminated entry not enabled
All Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2937
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2938
Test 8 - 13
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2939
Test 14 - 16
SYMPTOM
ALL DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid release relay output wire short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused B(+) wire short to ground
- Ground circuit open
- Door lock relay output circuit open
- Driver door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release solenoid-shorted
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Defective fuse #14
- RKE module - B(+) short to ground
- RKE module - relays open
- RKE module - shorted
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Lock and Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2940
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO LOCK AND UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open door unlock relay output
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Open motors
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2941
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door unlock relay output circuit short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module unlock relay
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Auto door locks not enabled
- Door ajar status
- PCM DTC's present
- RKE module defective - auto locks inoperable
Decklid Solenoid Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2942
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
DECKLID SOLENOID INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Solenoid ground open
- Decklid release solenoid open
- Decklid release relay output wire open
- RKE module - decklid relay open
Doors Lockable With Key In Ignition and Driver Door Open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2943
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2944
Test 4 - 10
SYMPTOM
DOORS LOCKABLE WITH KEY IN IGNITION & DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch - open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to RKE module
- Ignition switch open
- Key-in ignition switch sense wire open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to cluster
- Instrument cluster - key-in ignition open
- Instrument cluster defective-driver door ajar open
- RKE module defective-open driver door ajar
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2945
Driver Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open driver unlock circuit
- Driver door lock motor - open
- Driver door lock relay output wire open
- Driver door unlock relay output wire open
Driver Door Fails to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2946
Test 1
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- RKE module defective - driver unlock open
One Passenger Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2947
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ONE PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock motor open
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
Remote Keyless Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2948
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
RKE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Test transmitter with tester
- RKE transmitter not programmed
- Test RKE transmitter
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2949
- RKE transmitter - inoperative
- RKE module
- RKE module - receiver inoperable
Alarm Trips On Its Own
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALARM TRIPS ON ITS OWN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Last VTSS cause
- Attempt to trip alarm
- Intermittent condition
All Doors Fail to Lock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2950
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS FAIL TO LOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock relay output circuit short to ground
- Decklid release relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to driver door unlock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to door unlock relay output
- Remote keyless entry module - unlock ground open
All Locks Inoperative From A Door Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2951
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL LOCKS INOPERATIVE FROM A DOOR LOCK SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2952
- Door switch ground wire open
- Door switch MUX wire short to voltage
- Door switch MUX wire open
- Door lock switch open
- Remote keyless entry module - high voltage
- Remote keyless entry module - low voltage
Headlamps Fail to Flash When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HEADLAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Horn Fails to Sound When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HORN FAILS TO SOUND DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Horn relay control circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Cannot Be Disabled
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2953
Test 1
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR CANNOT BE DISABLED (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Fails to Trip VTSS
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2954
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR FAILS TO TRIP VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit open
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Repeatedly Triggers VTSS
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2955
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR REPEATEDLY TRIGGERS VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Driver Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
OPEN DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch
- Driver door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Driver door ajar switch sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Passenger Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2956
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2957
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2958
Test 7 - 8
SYMPTOM
OPEN PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Left rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
- RKE module - passenger door ajar sense
Park Lamps Fail to Flash During Alarm
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PARK LAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2959
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Park lamp switch output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
VTSS Fails to Arm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm From Passenger Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2960
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM PASSENGER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Passenger door switch MUX circuit open
- Passenger cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm/Disarm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM/DISARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2961
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR
CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY).
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Indicator Fails to Flash
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR FAILS TO FLASH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Remote keyless entry module
- Instrument cluster
- VTSS indicator driver circuit open
- VTSS led open
VTSS Indicator Stays On Steady During Arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2962
Test 1 - 5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2963
Test 6 - 8
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR STAYS ON STEADY DURING ARMING
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid security switch sense circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch ground circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch sense circuit shorted to ground (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch (if equipped)
- RKE module - VTSS indicator
- RKE module - hood ajar (if equipped)
- RKE module - decklid security (if equipped)
VTSS Siren Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2964
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
VTSS SIREN INOPERATIVE (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Siren functional test
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Faulty siren
- Siren control circuit open
- Siren control circuit shorted to ground
- Remote keyless entry module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2965
Body Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Six Step Troubleshooting Procedure
SIX-STEP TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
Diagnosis is done in six basic steps:
1. Verification of complaint 2. Verification of any related symptoms 3. Symptom analysis 4. Problem
isolation 5. Repair of isolated problem 6. Verification of proper operation
Road Testing
ROAD TEST WARNINGS
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure.
The purpose of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: Before road testing a vehicle, be sure that all components are reassembled. during the
test drive, do not try to read the DRB III screen while in motion. Do not hang the DRB III from the
rear view mirror or operate it yourself. Have an assistant available to operate the DRB III.
Vehicle Preparation For Testing
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR TESTING
Make sure the vehicle being tested has a fully charged battery. If it does not, false diagnostic codes
or error messages may occur.
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2966
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: Erase the stored codes
- Place the ignition in the Run position
- Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
- Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
- Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2967
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Glossary of Terms
ABS Antilock Brake System
ACM Airbag Control Module
AECM Airbag Electronic Control Module (ACM)
ASDM Airbag System Diagnostic Module (ACM)
BUX Built-Up Export
CAB Controller Antilock Brake
CTM Compass/Temperature Mirror
DAB Driver Airbag
DLC Data Link Connector
DTC Diagnostic Trouble Code
EMIC Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster
LSIACM
Left SIACM
NGC Next Generation Controller
PAB Passenger Airbag
PCI Programmable Communication Interface (Vehicle Communication Bus)
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PDC Power Distribution Center
PWM
Pulse Width Modulated
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RSIACM Right SIACM
SAB Side Airbag
SIACM Side Impact Airbag Control Module
SKIM Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
SKIS Sentry Key Immobilizer System
SQUIB Also Called Initiator (Located In Rear Of Airbag Module)
TCM Transmission Control Module
VFD Vacuum Fluorescent Display
VTSS Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2968
Body Control Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
DRB III Error Messages and Blank Screen
DRB III ERROR MESSAGES AND BLANK SCREEN
Under normal operation, the DRB III will display one of only two error messages:
User-Requested WARM Boot (Press MORE and NO at the same time)
User-Requested COLD Boot (Press MORE and YES at the same time)
If the DRB III should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the
S.T.A.R. Center for information and assistance.
DRB III DOES NOT POWER UP
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 16). A minimum of 11 volts
is required to adequately power the DRB III.
If all connections are proper between the DRB III and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, and inoperative DRB III may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
For a blank screen, refer to the appropriate body diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2969
DISPLAY IS NOT VISIBLE
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition
SOME DISPLAY ITEMS READ "---"
This is caused by scrolling the DRB III display a single line up or down. The line which was scrolled
onto the screen might read "---". Use the Page Down or Page Up function to display the
information.
DRB III Safety Information
DRB III (R) SAFETY INFORMATION
WARNING: EXCEEDING THE LIMITS OF THE DRB III (R) MULTIMETER IS DANGEROUS. IT
CAN EXPOSE YOU TO SERIOUS OR
POSSIBLE FATAL INJURY. CAREFULLY READ AND UNDERSTAND THE CAUTIONS AND THE
SPECIFICATION LIMITS.
Follow the vehicle manufacture's service specifications at all times.
Do not use the DRB Ill(R) if it has been damaged.
Do not use the test leads if the insulation is damaged or if metal is exposed.
To avoid electrical shock, do not touch the test leads, tips, or other circuit being tested.
Choose the proper range and function for the measurement. Do not try voltage or current
measurement that may exceed the rated capacity.
Do not exceed the limits shown in the table.
Voltage between any terminal and ground must not exceed 500v DC or 500v peak AC.
The circuit being tested must be protected by a 10A fuse or circuit breaker.
Use the low current shunt to measure circuits up to 10A. Use the higher current clamp to measure
circuits exceeding 10A.
When testing for the presence of voltage or current, make sure the meter is functioning correctly.
Take a reading of a known voltage or current before accepting a zero reading.
When measuring current, connect the meter in series with the load.
Disconnect the live test lead before disconnecting the common test lead.
When using the meter function, keep the DRB III (R) away from spark plug or coil wires to avoid
measuring error from outside interference.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2970
Body Control Module: Tools and Equipment
REQUIRED TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
DRB III (R) (diagnostic read out box) Jumper Wires Ohmmeter Voltmeter Test Light 8310 Airbag
Load Tool 8443 SRS Airbag System Load Tool
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2979
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2980
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2981
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2982
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2983
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2984
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2985
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page
2986
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2992
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2993
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 >
Engine Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 2994
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # C08 Date: 030301
Campaign - Powertrain Control Module Replacement
March 2003
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Customer Satisfaction Notification No. C08 Replace Powertrain Control Module
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) # 02-025 is being cancelled. Those vehicles that
have already had this repair performed, as determined by our warranty records, have been
excluded from this notification.
Models
2003 (LH) Dodge Intrepid, Chrysler Concorde and 300M
(PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
(PL) Dodge Neon
(JR) Dodge Stratus Sedan
NOTE:
This notification applies only to certain vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission (Sales
Code DGB) built through October 4, 2002 (MDH 1004XX)
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
repair on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this repair on vehicles in
for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process
The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on about 550 of the above vehicles may contain a computer
driver chip that could fail. Driver chip failure may cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to
illuminate and cause the transmission to shift into 2nd gear (default limp-in mode)
The PCM must be replaced.
Parts Information
IMPORTANT:
Due to the small number of involved vehicles, no parts will be distributed to involved dealers. Parts
may be ordered as needed to support scheduled repairs.
Dealers should determine which PCM is required for each vehicle at the time appointments are
scheduled to assure that the correct part is available when the customer arrives. The PCM for the
vehicle to be serviced may be determined by:
> Using the part code in the third column of the VIN list along with the following table (involved
dealers);
> Using the VIN and part number list electronically transmitted to DIAL System Function 53
(involved dealers); or
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 2999
> Entering the VIN into the VIP System (sales code information) along with the table (all dealers):
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DIAL System. Claims
submitted will be used by DaimlerChrysler to record Customer Satisfaction Notification service
completions and provide dealer payments.
Use the labor operation number and time allowance shown.
Add the cost of the PCM plus applicable dealer allowance to your claim.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete claim
processing instructions.
Parts Return
Not required.
Dealer Notification and Vehicle List
All dealers will receive a copy of this Customer Satisfaction Notification letter by mail. Two
additional copies will be sent through the DCMMS, and DealerConnect/MDS2 will be updated to
include this notification in the near future. Each dealer to whom involved vehicles were invoiced will
receive a list of their involved vehicles. The vehicle list is arranged in Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) sequence. Owners known to DaimlerChrysler are also listed. The lists are for dealer
reference in arranging for service of involved vehicles.
DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3000
All involved vehicles have been entered to DIAL System Functions 53 and VIP for dealer inquiry as
needed.
Function 53 provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The
customer name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed
from Function 53 within several days of repair claim submission. To use this system, type "53" at
the "ENTER FUNCTION" prompt and then type "ORDC08".
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to DaimlerChrysler are being notified of the service requirement
by mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A copy of
the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification Form. The involved vehicle and
notification are identified on the form for owner or dealer reference as needed.
Vehicle Not Available
If a vehicle is not available for service, let us know by filling out the pre-addressed Owner
Notification Form or describe the reason on a postcard and mail to:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation CIMS 482-00-85 800 Chrysler Drive East Auburn Hills, Michigan
48326-2757
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations DaimlerChrysler Corporation
A. Replace PCM - LH Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the speed control servo and set it aside.
3. Remove the washer fluid bottle filler neck bolt and set the filler neck aside.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3001
4. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 1).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 1).
6. Install the new PCM. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m) (Figure 1).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 1).
8. Install the washer fluid bottle filler neck. Tighten the bolt securely.
9. Install the speed control servo. Tighten the servo bracket bolts securely.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
B. Replace PCM - PL Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Remove the air cleaner assembly and set it aside.
3. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3002
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bracket fasteners (Figure 2) and then remove the PCM and bracket
assembly.
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it (Figure 2).
6. Install the new PCM (Figure 2). Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8 Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly. Tighten the fasteners to 95 in-lbs (10.7 Nm).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors. Attach the wiring harness clip to the PCM
bracket.
9. Install the air cleaner assembly.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
C. Replace PCM - PT Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 3).
3. Disconnect the two (2) wiring harness clips from the PCM bracket
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3003
4. Remove the four (4) PCM mounting bracket screws and then remove the PCM and mounting
bracket assembly (Figure 3).
5. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
6. Install the new PCM onto the mounting bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 105 in-lbs (11.8
Nm).
7. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 3). Tighten the mounting bolts to 95 in-lbs (10.7
N.m).
8. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors (Figure 3).
9. Attach the wiring harness clips to the PCM bracket.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
11. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
D. Replace PCM - JR Vehicles
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Figure 4).
NOTE:
To enhance customer satisfaction, remember to reset the clock when you have completed the
service procedure.
2. Disconnect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors and set the wiring harness aside (Figure 4).
3. Remove the two (2) PCM bracket fasteners and then remove the PCM and bracket assembly
(Figure 4).
4. Remove the three (3) PCM bolts, then remove the PCM and discard it.
5. Install the new PCM on the bracket. Tighten the mounting bolts to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
6. Install the PCM and bracket assembly (Figure 4). Tighten the fasteners to 35 in-lbs (4 N.m).
7. Connect the four (4) PCM electrical connectors.
8. Connect the negative battery cable.
9. Continue with Section E - PCM/Vehicle Data Set-up.
E. PCM/Vehicle Data Set-Up
1. Connect the DRB III(R) to the data link connector located under the instrument panel. Turn the
ignition key to the "ON" position.
2. With the ignition switch in the "ON" position, determine if the vehicle is equipped with a SKIM
module by using the DRB III and selecting from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3004
the menu screen:
a. Select # 1 - "DRB III Standalone" from Main Menu screen.
b. Select # 1 - "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics" from Standalone Main Menu screen.
c. Select # 1 - "All (Except Below)" from 1998 - 2004 Diagnostics screen.
d. Select # 8 - "System Monitor" from Select System screen.
e. Select # 3 - "J1850 Module Scan" from Select Monitor screen and then press ENTER to
continue and note if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM.
> If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM obtain the vehicle PIN (Personal Identification Number)
before continuing with Step 3. This information is available from the original selling invoice, the Dial
VIP System, or by contacting the DaimlerChrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at
1-800-992-1997.
WARNING:
Failure to use the SKIM PIN number to transfer the secret key code data from the SKIM module will
cause a no-start condition.
> If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then continue with Step 3.
f. Press PAGE BACK.
3. Press PAGE BACK to return to the Select System screen.
4. Select # 1 - "Engine" from Select System screen.
5 Press ENTER to continue.
6. Press the RIGHT ARROW key to go to Page 2 of 2.
7. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous".
8 Select # 3 - "Check VIN".
9. Press ENTER to program the VIN.
If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM:
a. Press ENTER to continue.
b. Press ENTER to continue again.
c. Enter the vehicle 4-digit PIN.
d. Press ENTER to continue.
e. Press ENTER to continue again.
f. Press ENTER to continue again.
g. Press ENTER to update VIN.
h. Press ENTER to continue.
i. Press ENTER to transfer secret key data.
j. Press ENTER to continue.
k. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER.
l. Press any key to continue.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3005
If the vehicle is NOT equipped with SKIM:
a. Enter the 17-digit VIN.
b. Press ENTER to continue.
c. Press PAGEBACK.
10. Select # 1 - "Miscellaneous"
11. Select # 1 - "Check PCM Odometer"
12. Press YES if the vehicle has LESS than 50 miles on the odometer or press NO if the vehicle
has MORE than 50 miles on the odometer.
13. Enter current odometer reading and then press ENTER.
14. Cycle ignition key to "OFF" position and then back to "ON" position and then press ENTER
15. Press PAGE BACK.
16. Press PAGE BACK again.
17. Select # 2 - "Transmission"
18. Select # 1 - "Transmission Module".
19. Select # 9 - "Miscellaneous".
20. Select # 3 - "Pinion Factor".
21. Press any key to continue.
22. Select the correct tire size for the vehicle and then press ENTER.
23 Verify the selected tire size and then press PAGE BACK to exit.
24. Select # 6 - "Quicklearn" and then follow the instructions displayed on the DRB III screen.
25. Disconnect the DRB III.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > C08 > Mar > 03 > Campaign Powertrain Control Module Replacement > Page 3006
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - PCM Initialization
Procedure
NUMBER: 08-030-06 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: August 25, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETINS 08-030-06, DATED JULY 12, 2006,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED
WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES REVISED CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER INITIALIZATION
PROCEDURES.
SUBJECT: Powertrain Control Module Initialization
MODELS:
2001-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (DC) Ram Cab & Chassis
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
2007 (HG) Aspen
1999 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2007 (JS) Sebring
1998 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2007 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1999 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid/LHS
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Charger/Magnum
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2005-2007 (ND) Dakota
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2007 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2007 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser Convertible
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 3012
1998 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2004 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 -2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
1999 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
NOTE:
The model years and vehicles above must be equipped (optional) with Sentry Key Theft Deterrent
System (sales code GXX) for this bulletin to apply.
DISCUSSION:
ALL LISTED VEHICLES EXCEPT SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST), CROSSFIRE, AND
SPRINTER.
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) is replaced on vehicles equipped with the Sentry
Key(TM) Theft Deterrent System, it must be initialized to properly function with the anti-theft
module. This is accomplished at a Chrysler Group Dealer by using the DRBIII(R) or StarSCAN(TM)
Scan Tool to enter a PIN number.
When the PIN number is not available from the vehicle owner or a Chrysler Group Scan Tool(s) is
not available this can be accomplished by writing the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) into the
PCM using an after-market scan tool with a "VIN Write Function".
More information is available from the scan tool manufacturer or the Equipment & Tool Institute.
NOTE:
After performing this procedure with an after-market scan tool on vehicles equipped with Chrysler
Group's Next Generation Controller (NGC), Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) "P0633 - SKIM
SECRET KEY DATA NOT STORED IN PCM" will be set. This DTC will not effect vehicle or system
performance and cannot be erased.
SEBRING COUPE/STRATUS COUPE (ST)
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
J1962 MMC Cable (Special Tool CH7010), and the BLUE 5T22 PCMCIA
Diagnostic Card (Special Tool CH8425). This equipment is available for lease from
DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be required.
CROSSFIRE AND SPRINTER.
Initializing the PCM on these vehicles requires the use of a DaimlerChrysler scan tool (DRBIII(R)),
Multiplexer cable box (Special Tool CH 9043), and the ORANGE Crossfire PCMCIA card (Special
Tool CH9044) or the GREEN Sprinter PCMCIA card (Special Tool CH9087). This equipment is
available for lease from DaimlerChrysler for short periods of time. A credit card deposit will be
required.
The DRBIII(R) will be shipped within 24 hours to your location by an overnight delivery service.
When the DRBIII(R) is returned, your credit card will be charged the lease price.
2007 GRAND CHEROKEE W/ 3.0L TD/2005 - 2007 LIBERTY w/2.8L TD/2007 RAM TRUCK/RAM
CAB CHASSIS w 6.7L TD AND 2004-2006 SPRINTER w 2.7L TD ENGINES.
For the above models equipped with Turbo Diesel Engines, the fuel injector "Quantity Values" must
be physically read from each injector and the values written to the ECU with an appropriate scan
tool.
**PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE CROSSFIRE/SPRINTER**:
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 3013
Depending on the situation, there are two methods for initializing the PCM/ECM. Either Automatic
Replacement or Service Replacement must be performed. Automatic Replacement uploads the
data from the old controller and downloads data to the new controller when the part numbers are
identical between the replacement and replaced controller. Service Replacement is used when part
numbers are not identical or when the part number is not recognized by the DRBIII(R).
Automatic Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
NOTE:
For Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded. Under Miscellaneous Functions, select
"5. Injector Classification" then "2. Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the
information for all 5 cylinders.
7. "1. Module Auto Replacement"
8. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
Module Service Replacement
1. **Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
2. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
3. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
4. "1. System Select"
5. "1. Engine"
6. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
7. "7. Read PCM Coding for Crossfire" OR "6 Read ECM Coding for Sprinter" and record all data.
NOTE:
Record all information shown on the PCM/ECM screen for future use.
Additionally, for Sprinter only, injector classification must be recorded.
Under Miscellaneous Functions, select "5. Injector Classification" then "2.
Injector Modification" on the DRBIII(R) and record the information for all 5 cylinders.
8. Install new controller using the procedures found in TechCONNECT.
9. Using the DRBIII(R), repeat above steps 1 through 6 and select "2. Module Service
Replacement".
10. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until "Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
11. Was the message "Module Replacement Successful" received?
a. Yes >> No Further Action is Required, Module has been successfully replaced.
b. No >> proceed to the next Step # 12.
12. Open TechAUTHORITY. TechAUTHORITY is available on the internet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 08-030-06A > Aug > 06 > Engine
Control - PCM Initialization Procedure > Page 3014
13. At the "Home" page, open the "Powertrain Control Module Initialization" link.
14. Open the "Coding String Calculator for Sprinter & Crossfire Vehicles" link.
15. Open the "Select Module" pull down menu and select "PCM".
16. Select the appropriate "Transmission Type" button (Manual or Automatic).
17. Carefully enter the 17 character VIN.
18. Carefully enter the PCM pin located on the new PCM.
19. Select the "Calculate" button at the bottom of the window.
NOTE:
TechAUTHORITY will automatically populate the "Coding String", "SCN", and "CheckSum"
information.
20. Print the information from the technician's PC or accurately record the information.
21. Using the DRBIII(R) select: "1. DRBIII(R) Standalone"
22. "1.1998 - 2007 Diagnostics"
23. Make the appropriate selection: "5. 2004 - 2006 Crossfire" or "6. 2002 - 2006 Sprinter"
24. "1. System Select"
25. "1. Engine"
26. "9. Miscellaneous Functions"
27. "2. Module Service Replacement"
28. Follow the on screen instructions and carefully enter the "Coding String", "SCN" "CheckSum"
and VIN information into the DRBIII(R)**
NOTE:
If one or more errors were made entering the data in step 28, the DRBIII(R) will display an error
and ask that the data be checked and re-input as necessary.
29. Follow the DRBIII(R) "On Screen" prompts until 'Module Replacement Successful" message is
displayed.
PCM INITIALIZATION PROCEDURE SEBRING COUPE/STRAUS COUPE (ST):
1. Perform the "Registration Procedure" described in service bulletin 08-036-04. This service
bulletin, including the password, is available on the internet under the "Powertrain Control Module
Initialization" link.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3015
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Mounting Screws 4 Nm 35 In. Lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3018
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3019
Fig. 12 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3020
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3021
Fig. 43 Engine (Right Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Views
Powertrain Control Module C1 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 3024
Powertrain Control Module C2 (2.0L NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 3025
Powertrain Control Module C3 (NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 3026
Powertrain Control Module C4 (EATX NGC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Important - Please Read
IMPORTANT (NGC)
New for the 2003 PL is a combined Powertrain Control Module and Transmission Control Module
in a single control module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller (NGC) for
DaimlerChrysler and will be referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 3029
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation Powertrain Control Module
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE
SENSOR RETURN - PCM INPUT
The sensor return circuit provides a low electrical noise ground reference for all of the systems
sensors. The sensor return circuit connects to internal ground circuits within the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM).
DATA BUS COMMUNICATION RECEIVE - PCM INPUT
The PCM uses the SCI communication bus to preform engine diagnostics and flash operations.
The transmission side of the PCM uses the SCI communication bus to flash new software.
However, diagnostics is performed via the vehicles J1850 bus for the transmission side of the
PCM.
IGNITION SENSE - PCM INPUT
The ignition sense input informs the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) that the ignition switch is in
the crank or run position.
PCM GROUND
Ground is provided through multiple pins of the PCM connector. Depending on the vehicle there
may be as many as two different ground pins. There are power grounds and sensor grounds.
The power grounds are used to control the ground side relays, solenoids, ignition coil or injectors.
The signal ground is used for any input that uses sensor return for ground, and the ground side of
any internal processing component.
The PCM case is shielded to prevent RFI and EMI. The PCM case is grounded and must be firmly
attached to a good, clean body ground.
Internally all grounds are connected together, however there is noise suppression on the sensor
ground. For EMI and RFI protection the housing and cover are also grounded separately from the
ground pins.
Fig.5 PCM
The PCM receives input signals from various switches and sensors that are referred to as PCM
Inputs. Based on these inputs, the PCM adjusts various engine, transmission, and vehicle
operations through devices that are referred to as PCM Outputs.
NOTE: PCM Inputs:
- Air Conditioning Controls
- Ambient Air temperature Sensor
- ASD Sense
- Baro/Tip (Turbo)
- Battery Voltage
- Battery Temperature Sensor
- Brake Switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 3030
- Clutch Upstop Switch (1.6L)
- Clutch Interlock
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Cruise Control Switch
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
- Fuel Level Sensor (Bus message)
- Ignition Switch
- Intake Air Temperature Sensor
- J1850
- Knock Sensor (1.6, 2.0, 2.4L only)
- Natural Vacuum Leak Detection (NVLD)
- Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Oxygen Sensors
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power Steering Pressure Switch
- SCI Receive
- Speed Control Switches
- Throttle Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 TPS Sensors)
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+)
- Transmission Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Transmission Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD)
- Transmission Range Sensor (TRS)
- Transmission Oil Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS)
- Vehicle Speed Sensor (MTX-equipped models).
NOTE: PCM Outputs:
- Air Conditioning Clutch Relay
- Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay
- Charging Indicator Lamp (Bus Message)
- SCI Transmit
- Proportional Purge Solenoid
- EGR Solenoid
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L only)
- Fuel Injectors
- Fuel Pump Relay
- Generator Field
- Idle Air Control Motor (2.0/2.4L)
- Ignition Coils
- J1850
- Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) Lamp (Bus Message)
- Oxygen Sensors Heater Controls
- Radiator Fan Relays
- Speed Control Solenoids (2.0/2.4L)
- Transmission Control Relay
- Transmission Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD)
- Transmission PRNDL Position (to Cluster)
- Transmission Torque Reduction Request (Internal to PCM)
- Transmission Temperature (Internal to PCM and a Bus Message)
- Vehicle Speed (Manual Transmission)
- 2 Electronic Throttle Control Outputs (1.6L) Based on inputs it receives, the PCM adjusts fuel
injector pulse width, idle speed, ignition spark advance, ignition coil dwell and EVAP canister purge
operation. The PCM also determines the appropriate transmission shift schedule and shift points,
depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand. The PCM regulates the cooling
fan, air conditioning and speed control systems. The PCM changes generator charge rate by
adjusting the generator field. The PCM also performs diagnostics.
The PCM adjusts injector pulse width (air-fuel ratio) based on the following inputs. Battery voltage
- Coolant temperature
- Exhaust gas content (oxygen sensor)
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Intake air temperature
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 3031
The PCM adjusts ignition timing based on the following inputs. -
Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Knock sensor
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Intake air temperature
The PCM also adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control motor based on the following
inputs. Air conditioning sense
- Battery voltage
- Battery temperature
- Brake switch
- Coolant temperature
- Engine speed (crankshaft position sensor)
- Engine run time
- Manifold absolute pressure
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L has 2 sensors)
- Power steering pressure switch
- Throttle position
- Transmission gear selection (park/neutral switch)
- Vehicle distance (speed)
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) and fuel pump relays are located in the Power Distribution Center
(PDC).
The camshaft position sensor and crankshaft position sensor signals are sent to the PCM. If the
PCM does not receive the signal within approximately 1 second of engine cranking, it deactivates
the ASD relay and fuel pump relay. When these relays are deactivated, power is shut off from the
fuel injectors, ignition coils, oxygen sensor heating elements and fuel pump.
The PCM contains a voltage converter that changes battery voltage to a regulated 5 volts direct
current to power the camshaft position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, manifold absolute
pressure sensor, throttle position sensor, A/C pressure switch, A/C pressure transducer, and
vehicle speed sensor.
Powertrain Control Module Connectors
The PCM is an engine and transmission controller module all in one, if the vehicle is equipped with
an automatic transmission. The PCM uses four wiring harness connectors to receive and send
engine and transmission data. To ease assembly, the mating wiring harness connector is
color-coded. Each module connector cavity has its own unique color identification stripe located on
the outside of each connector cavity.
The PCM module utilizes four wiring harness connectors as described:
- Connector Cavity A is for Power & Ground (Black)
- Connector Cavity B is for Engine Side (Orange)
- Connector Cavity C is for Headlamp & Dash (White)
- Connector Cavity D is for Transmission (Green) If equipped.
NOTE: Connector Cavities A, B, C, And D must be connected prior to battery connection and
ignition key on to avoid setting erroneous controller fault codes. It is also recommended that cavity
A connector is made prior to any other connectors.
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEX (CVI)
An important function of the PCM is to monitor Transmission Clutch Volume Index (CVI). CVIs
represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The PCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the PCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the PCM with output shaft speed information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 3032
Fig.6 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the PCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the PCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRBIII Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the PCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the PCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly, etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
TRANSMISSION SHIFT SCHEDULES
The PCM is programmed to allow it to select a variety of shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is
dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Important - Please Read > Page 3033
- Software calibration level
As driving conditions change, the PCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
5 VOLT SUPPLY - PCM OUTPUT
The PCM supplies 5 volts to the following sensors:
- A/C pressure transducer
- Ambient Temperature sensor
- Battery temperature
- Camshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (NGC)
- Electronic Throttle Control (1.6L)
- Engine coolant temperature sensor
- Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
- Knock sensor
- Linear EGR solenoid (if equipped)
- Manifold absolute pressure sensor
- Oil Pressure Switch
- Pedal Position Sensor (1.6L)
- Throttle position sensor
- Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3034
Powertrain Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
CHECKING PCM POWER AND GROUND CIRCUITS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- (A14) PCM fused B+ circuit
- (A41) PCM fused ignition switch output circuit
- (Z12) PCM ground circuits
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3037
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3038
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3039
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3040
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3041
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3042
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3043
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3044
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair
Programming the Powertrain Control Module
IMPORTANT NOTE
Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to check the
related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the circuit. Most
PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal failure to components (i.e. 12-volt pull-ups,
drivers and ground sensors). These failures are difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred
and only one DTC has set.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
The SKIS Secret Key is an I.D. code that is unique to each SKIS. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, engine controller and transponder chip (ignition key). When replacing the PCM
it is necessary to program the secret key into the PCM.
NOTE: After replacing the PCM, you must program pinion factor.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park/Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM.
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED. 4. Enter secured access mode by
entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter the secure access mode using an incorrect PIN,
secured access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to
the run position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
5. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM).
Powertrain Control Module Replacement
REMOVAL - 2.0L
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
Fig.9 Air Box Relocated
2. Remove and relocate the air cleaner box, refer to the Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for
more information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3045
Fig.10 Connectors Installed
3. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connectors at the PCM.
Fig.11 Wiring Harness
4. Remove the wiring harness clip from the PCM bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3046
Fig.12 PCM And Bracket
5. Remove the mounting bolts from the bottom of the PCM bracket. 6. Remove the nut. 7. Remove
the assembly, PCM and bracket.
INSTALLATION - 2.0L
1. Install the assembly, PCM and bracket. 2. Loose install the mounting nut. 3. Install the mounting
bolts to the bottom of the PCM bracket. 4. Tighten the mounting nut, tighten to. 5. Install the wiring
harness clip to the PCM bracket.
NOTE: The electrical connector for the PCM are COLOR Coded.
6. Connect the electrical connectors and lock at the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
Engine/Air Intake/Air Cleaner Housing for more information. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
Fig.4 Battery Cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3047
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner
box.
Fig.5 Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
3. Remove the gray and black connector from the PCM.
Fig.6 PCM Wiring Bracket
4. Remove the harness clip bracket from PCM bracket. 5. Remove the nut from the upper bracket
mount. 6. Raise vehicle and support on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3048
Fig.7 Lower Mounting Bolts
7. Remove 2 lower bracket bolts.
Fig.8 PCM Bracket Screws
8. Remove 4 screws from bracket and remove bracket from PCM.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bracket to PCM and tighten screws. 2. Install PCM and bracket to body and tighten the 2
lower bolts. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Install upper bracket nut and tighten. 5. Clip in wiring harness
bracket. 6. Install gray and black connectors to the PCM. 7. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the
air cleaner box. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
PCM/Skim Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3049
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Obtaining Diagnostic Trouble Codes
BULB CHECK
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programming the Powertrain Control Module > Page 3050
Key on: Bulb illuminated until vehicle starts, as long as all once per trip (readiness) monitors
completed. If monitors have not been completed, then:
Key on: bulb check for about 5 to 8 seconds, lamp then flashes if once per trip (readiness) monitors
have not been completed until vehicle is started, then MIL is extinguished.
OBTAINING DTC'S USING DRB SCAN TOOL
1. Connect the DRB scan tool to the data link (diagnostic) connector. This connector is located in
the passenger compartment; at the lower edge of
instrument panel; near the steering column.
2. Turn the ignition switch on and access the "Read Fault" screen. 3. Record all the DTC's and
"freeze frame" information shown on the DRB scan tool. 4. To erase DTC's, use the "Erase Trouble
Code" data screen on the DRB scan tool. Do not erase any DTC's until problems have been
investigated
and repairs have been performed.
Pinion Factor Setting
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the PCM/TCM has been replaced with a NEW or
replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an inoperative or improperly
calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The
PCM/TCM must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires)
available. Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Powertrain/ Transmission Control Module
initial setting so that the speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the
Pinion Factor, it is necessary to use a DRBIII scan tool.
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector located under the instrument panel. 2.
Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then
follow the instructions on the DRBIII scan tool screen.
Quick Learn Procedure
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRBIII scan tool. This program allows the PCM/
TCM to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Powertrain/Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following
conditions must be met:
- The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRBIII
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60° and below 200°
1. Plug the DRBIII scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRBIII to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3054
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3060
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3061
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3062
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3063
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3067
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
(For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor 18 Nm 13.2 Ft. Lbs. 165 In. Lbs
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
(For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3071
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
(For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3072
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
(For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3073
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor threads into the rear of the cylinder head, next to
the camshaft position sensor. New sensors have sealant applied to the threads. The ECT Sensor is
a Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) Sensor. The resistance of the ECT Sensor changes as
coolant temperature changes. This results in different input voltages to the PCM. The PCM also
uses the ECT Sensor input to operate the radiator cooling fan(s), and send a message over the
PCI bus to the instrument cluster for temperature gauge operation.
OPERATION
The ECT sensor provides an input to the PCM. As temperature increases, resistance of the sensor
decreases. As coolant temperature varies, the ECT sensor resistance changes resulting in a
different voltage value at the PCM ECT sensor signal circuit. The ECT sensor provides input for
various PCM operations. The PCM uses the input to control air-fuel mixture, timing, and radiator
fan on/off times. The PCM uses ECT sensor input to send messages over the PCI bus for
temperature gauge operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor <--> [Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
(For Computer)] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3074
Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. With the engine cold, drain coolant until level drops below cylinder head.
2. Disconnect coolant sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove coolant sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install coolant sensor. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (165 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Attach electrical connector to sensor. 3. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 3079
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Page 3080
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Page 3081
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Page 3082
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Page 3083
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information
> Locations > Page 3084
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fig.11 Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3088
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3089
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3090
Fig.7 Level Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3095
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3096
Fig. 8 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3097
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3098
Fig. 48 Left Side Engine - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3099
Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3100
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct.
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery temperature sensor.
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor to
determine values for the PCM to use as an intake air temperature sensor and a battery
temperature sensor.
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor <--> [Intake Air Temperature Sensor] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3101
Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor 3. Remove
the air cleaner lid. 4. Disconnect the inlet air tube from the throttle body. 5. Remove inlet air tube
from air cleaner lid.
INSTALLATION
1. Install inlet air tube to air cleaner lid and tighten clamp. 2. Install inlet air tube to throttle body and
tighten clamp. 3. Install air cleaner lid to air cleaner box. 4. Connect the inlet air temperature sensor
electrical connector. 5. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3105
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Fig. 15 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 48 Engine (Top) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3109
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3110
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3111
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.23 Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor
The MAP sensor mounts to the intake manifold.
The MAP sensor signal is provided from a single piezo-resistive element located in the center of a
diaphragm. The element and diaphragm are both made of silicone. As the pressures changes the
diaphragm moves causing the element to deflect which stresses the silicone. When silicone is
exposed to stress its resistance changes. As manifold vacuum increases, the MAP sensor input
voltage decreases proportionally. The sensor also contains electronics that condition the signal and
provide temperature compensation.
The MAP serves as a PCM input, using a silicon based sensing unit, to provide data on the
manifold vacuum that draws the air/fuel mixture into the combustion chamber. The PCM requires
this information to determine injector pulse width and spark advance. When MAP equals
Barometric pressure, the pulse width will be at maximum.
Also like the cam and crank sensors, a 5 volt reference is supplied from the PCM and returns a
voltage signal to the PCM that reflects manifold pressure. The zero pressure reading is 0.5V and
full scale is 4.5V. For a pressure swing of 0 - 15 psi the voltage changes 4.0V. The sensor is
supplied a regulated 4.8 to 5.1 volts to operate the sensor. Like the cam and crank sensors ground
is provided through the sensor return circuit.
The MAP sensor input is the number one contributor to pulse width. The most important function of
the MAP sensor is to determine barometric pressure. The PCM needs to know if the vehicle is at
sea level or is it in Denver at 5000 feet above sea level, because the air density changes with
altitude. It will also help to correct for varying weather conditions. If a hurricane was coming through
the pressure would be very, very low or there could be a real fair weather, high pressure area. This
is important because as air pressure changes the barometric pressure changes. Barometric
pressure and altitude have a direct inverse correlation, as altitude goes up barometric goes down.
The first thing that happens as the key is rolled on, before reaching the crank position, the PCM
powers up, comes around and looks at the MAP voltage, and based upon the voltage it sees, it
knows the current barometric pressure relative to altitude. Once the engine starts, the PCM looks
at the voltage again, continuously every 12 milliseconds, and compares the current voltage to what
it was at key ON. The difference between current and what it was at key ON is manifold vacuum.
During key ON (engine not running) the sensor reads (updates) barometric pressure. A normal
range can be obtained by monitoring known good sensor in you work area.
As the altitude increases the air becomes thinner (less oxygen). If a vehicle is started and driven to
a very different altitude than where it was at key ON the barometric pressure needs to be updated.
Any time the PCM sees Wide Open throttle, based upon TPS angle and RPM it will update
barometric pressure in the MAP memory cell. With periodic updates, the PCM can make its
calculations more effectively.
The PCM uses the MAP sensor to aid in calculating the following:
- Barometric pressure
- Engine load
- Manifold pressure
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance programs
- Shift-point strategies (F4AC1 transmissions only, via the PCI bus)
- Idle speed
- Decel fuel shutoff
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3112
The PCM recognizes a decrease in manifold pressure by monitoring a decrease in voltage from the
reading stored in the barometric pressure memory cell. The MAP sensor is a linear sensor; as
pressure changes, voltage changes proportionately. The range of voltage output from the sensor is
usually between 4.6 volts at sea level to as low as 0.3 volts at 26 in. of Hg. Barometric pressure is
the pressure exerted by the atmosphere upon an object. At sea level on a standard day, no storm,
barometric pressure is 29.92 in Hg. For every 100 feet of altitude barometric pressure drops 0.10
in. Hg. If a storm goes through it can either add, high pressure, or decrease, low pressure, from
what should be present for that altitude. You should make a habit of knowing what the average
pressure and corresponding barometric pressure is for your area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3113
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.24 MAP Sensor
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Disconnect the electrical connector
from the MAP sensor. 2. Remove sensor mounting screws. 3. Remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
The MAP sensor attaches to the intake manifold plenum. 1. Insert sensor into intake manifold while
making sure not to damage O-ring seal. 2. Tighten mounting screws to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque
for plastic manifold. 3. Attach electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3117
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Oxygen Sensor: Component Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3122
Oxygen Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3123
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3124
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3125
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3126
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3127
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor 1/1 Upstream
Oxygen Sensor 1/2 Downstream
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3128
Oxygen Sensor: Application and ID
- Cylinder bank number one is the bank that contains number one cylinder.
See: Ignition System/Firing Order
Cylinder #1 on left side.
Cylinder #1 on right side.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/2.
- A third oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 1 would be numbered O2 Sensor 1/3.
- The first oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 2/1.
- The second oxygen sensor in cylinder bank # 2 is numbered O2 Sensor 1/1.
- If a V-6 or V-8 vehicle only uses one downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) it is numbered
O2 Sensor 1/2, even if it uses two upstream
HO2S.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3129
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.30 Types Of O2 Sensors
Fig.27 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/1
O2 SENSOR
The upstream oxygen sensor threads into the outlet flange of the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3130
Fig.28 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor 1/2
Fig.29 Heated Oxygen Sensor Systems
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the system depending on emission package.
Federal package the O2S is mounted after the catalytic convertor, LEV package the O2S is
mounted mid catalytic convertor, ULEV package is mounted between the catalytic convertor.
A single sensor ground is used for all O2 sensors (2 sensors on 4 cyl. vehicles and 4 sensors on 6
cyl. vehicles).
As vehicles accumulate mileage, the catalytic convertor deteriorates. The deterioration results in a
less efficient catalyst. To monitor catalytic convertor deterioration, the fuel injection system uses
two heated oxygen sensors. One sensor upstream of the catalytic convertor, one downstream of
the convertor. The PCM compares the reading from the sensors to calculate the catalytic convertor
oxygen storage capacity and converter efficiency. Also, the PCM uses the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input when adjusting injector pulse width.
When the catalytic converter efficiency drops below emission standards, the PCM stores a
diagnostic trouble code and illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL).
The O2S produce voltages from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air/fuel
mixture, can be caused by misfire and exhaust leaks), the sensors produces a low voltage. When
there is a lesser amount of oxygen present (caused by a rich air/fuel mixture, can be caused by
internal engine problems) it produces a higher voltage. By
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3131
monitoring the oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensors act as a rich-lean
switch.
The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element that keeps the sensors at proper
operating temperature during all operating modes. Maintaining correct sensor temperature at all
times allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop operation the PCM monitors the O2S input (along with other inputs) and adjusts the
injector pulse width accordingly. During Open Loop operation the PCM ignores the O2 sensor
input. The PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs
from other sensors.
The Automatic Shutdown (ASD) relay supplies battery voltage to both the upstream and
downstream heated oxygen sensors. The oxygen sensors are equipped with a heating element.
The heating elements reduce the time required for the sensors to reach operating temperature. The
PCM uses pulse width modulation to control the ground side of the heater to regulate the
temperature on 4 cyl. upstream O2 heater only. All other 4 cyl. and 6 cyl. O2 heaters do not use
pulse width modulation.
Upstream Oxygen Sensor
The input from the upstream heated oxygen sensor tells the PCM the oxygen content of the
exhaust gas. Based on this input, the PCM fine tunes the air-fuel ratio by adjusting injector pulse
width.
The sensor input switches from 0 to 1 volt, depending upon the oxygen content of the exhaust gas
in the exhaust manifold. When a large amount of oxygen is present (caused by a lean air-fuel
mixture), the sensor produces voltage as low as 0.1 volt. When there is a lesser amount of oxygen
present (rich air-fuel mixture) the sensor produces a voltage as high as 1.0 volt. By monitoring the
oxygen content and converting it to electrical voltage, the sensor acts as a rich-lean switch.
The heating element in the sensor provides heat to the sensor ceramic element. Heating the
sensor allows the system to enter into closed loop operation sooner. Also, it allows the system to
remain in closed loop operation during periods of extended idle.
In Closed Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on the upstream heated oxygen
sensor input along with other inputs. In Open Loop, the PCM adjusts injector pulse width based on
preprogrammed (fixed) values and inputs from other sensors.
Downstream Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor input is used to detect catalytic convertor deterioration. As
the convertor deteriorates, the input from the downstream sensor begins to match the upstream
sensor input except for a slight time delay By comparing the downstream heated oxygen sensor
input to the input from the upstream sensor, the PCM calculates catalytic convertor efficiency. Also
used to establish the upstream O2 goal voltage (switching point).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Downstream (1/2) O2
Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Downstream (1/2) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
Fig.32 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor
The downstream heated oxygen sensor threads into the exhaust outlet pipe behind the catalytic
convertor.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from harness. 3. Disconnect sensor electrical
harness from clips along body.
Fig.33 Downstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
4. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 5. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Connect sensor electrical harness from clips along body
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Downstream (1/2) O2
Sensor > Page 3134
3. Connect electrical connector to harness. 4. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Downstream (1/2) O2
Sensor > Page 3135
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Upstream (1/1) O2 Sensor
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Unplug sensor connector.
Fig.31 Upstream Heated Oxygen Sensor Removal/Installation
3. Remove sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. 4. After removing the sensor, the exhaust manifold threads must be cleaned with an 18
mm X 1.5 + 6E tap. If reusing the original sensor, coat the
sensor threads with an anti-seize compound such as Loctite 771-64 or equivalent.
INSTALLATION
New sensors have compound on the threads and do not require an additional coating.
1. Install sensor using an oxygen sensor crow foot wrench such as Snap-On tool YA8875 or
equivalent. Tighten the sensor to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
torque.
2. Plug sensor connector. 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3136
Oxygen Sensor: Tools and Equipment
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - C-4907
O2S (Oxygen Sensor) Remover/Installer - 8439
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3141
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3142
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3143
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3144
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
> Page 3149
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
> Page 3150
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3151
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3152
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3153
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3159
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3160
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3161
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3162
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3163
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3164
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3165
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3175
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3176
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3177
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3178
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3179
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3185
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3186
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3187
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3188
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3189
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3190
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3191
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications
Catalytic Converter: Specifications
Catalytic converter to exhaust manifold flange-fasteners 250 in.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3201
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3202
An under-floor catalytic converter is used on all three converter packages; EURO, Low Emission
Vehicle (LEV), and the High Output engine.
CAUTION: Due to exterior physical similarities of some catalytic converters with pipe assemblies,
extreme care should be taken with replacement parts.
An exhaust flex-joint coupling secures the catalytic converter to the exhaust manifold by using four
fasteners and a gasket for sealing. The flex-joint is serviced with the catalytic converter.
CAUTION: When servicing the catalytic converter, care must be exercised not to dent or bend the
flexjoint. Should this occur, the flex-joint will eventually fail and require the catalytic converter to be
replaced. Do not allow the exhaust system to hang unsupported. If the isolators are removed and
the catalytic converter is still attached to the exhaust manifold, failure to the flex joint will result.
OPERATION
The three-way catalytic converter simultaneously converts three exhaust emissions into harmless
gases. Specifically, HC and CO emissions are converted into water (H20) and Carbon Dioxide
(C02). Oxides of Nitrogen (NOx) are converted into elemental Nitrogen (N) and water. The
three-way catalyst is most efficient in converting HC, CO and NOx at the stoichiometric air fuel ratio
of 14.7:1. The oxygen content in a catalyst is important for efficient conversion of exhaust gases.
When a high oxygen content (lean) air/fuel ratio is present for an extended period, oxygen content
in a catalyst can reach a maximum. When a rich air/fuel ratio is present for an extended period, the
oxygen content in the catalyst can become totally depleted. When this occurs, the catalyst fails to
convert the gases. This is known as catalyst "punch through." Catalyst operation is dependent on
its ability to store and release the oxygen needed to complete the emissions-reducing chemical
reactions. As a catalyst deteriorates, its ability to store oxygen is reduced. Since the catalyst's
ability to store oxygen is somewhat related to proper operation, oxygen storage can be used as an
indicator of catalyst performance. Refer to the appropriate Diagnostic Information for diagnosis of a
catalyst related
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3203
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). The combustion reaction caused by the catalyst releases
additional heat in the exhaust system, causing temperature increases in the area of the reactor
under severe operating conditions. Such conditions can exist when the engine misfires or
otherwise does not operate at peak efficiency. Do not remove spark plug wires from plugs or by
any other means short out cylinders, if exhaust system is equipped with a catalytic converter.
Failure of the catalytic converter can occur due to temperature increases caused by unburned fuel
passing through the converter. This deterioration of the catalyst core can result in excessively high
emission levels, noise complaints, and exhaust restrictions. Unleaded gasoline must be used to
avoid ruining the catalyst core. Do not allow engine to operate above 1200 RPM in neutral for
extended periods over 5 minutes. This condition may result in excessive exhaust system/floor pan
temperatures because of no air movement under the vehicle. The flex joint allows flexing as the
engine moves, preventing breakage that could occur from the back-and-forth motion of a
transverse mounted engine.
CAUTION: Due to exterior physical similarities of some catalytic converters with pipe assemblies,
extreme care should be taken with replacement parts. There are internal converter differences
required in some parts of the country (particularly vehicles built for States with strict emission
requirements) and between model years.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3204
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM IS VERY
HIGH. THEREFORE, NEVER ATTEMPT TO SERVICE ANY PART OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM
UNTIL IT IS COOLED. SPECIAL CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN WHEN WORKING NEAR THE
CATALYTIC CONVERTER. THE TEMPERATURE OF THE CONVERTER RISES TO A HIGH
LEVEL AFTER A SHORT PERIOD OF ENGINE OPERATION TIME.
1. Remove muffler and exhaust pipe. 2. Disconnect the downstream oxygen sensor electrical
connector.
3. Remove the exhaust manifold support bracket (LEV only).
4. Remove catalytic converter to exhaust manifold attaching fasteners and remove converter from
vehicle. 5. Remove and discard the flange gasket.
NOTE: When replacement is required on any component of the exhaust system, original equipment
parts (or equivalent) must be used.
INSPECTION
WARNING: THE NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM IS VERY
HIGH. THEREFORE, NEVER ATTEMPT TO SERVICE ANY PART OF THE EXHAUST SYSTEM
UNTIL IT IS COOLED. SPECIAL CARE SHOULD BE TAKEN WHEN WORKING NEAR THE
CATALYTIC CONVERTER. THE TEMPERATURE OF THE CONVERTER RISES TO A HIGH
LEVEL AFTER A SHORT PERIOD OF ENGINE OPERATION TIME.
Check catalytic converter for a flow restriction. Visually inspect the catalytic converter element by
using a borescope or equivalent. Remove oxygen sensor(s) and insert borescope. If borescope is
not available, remove converter and inspect element using a flashlight. Inspect element for cracked
or melted substrate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3205
NOTE: Before replacing a catalytic converter, determine the root cause of failure. Most catalytic
converter failures are caused by air, fuel or ignition problems. Refer to the Appropriate Diagnostic
Information for test procedures.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When assembling exhaust system do not tighten clamps until all components are aligned
and clearances are checked.
1. Assemble catalytic converter to exhaust manifold connection. Use a new flange gasket. 2. Install
exhaust manifold support bracket (LEV only). Tighten M10 bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.), M12 bolt to 95
Nm (70 ft. lbs.), and nut to 28 Nm
(250 in. lbs.).
3. Install bolt attaching manifold support bracket to the heat shield (NLEV only). Tighten bolt to 28
Nm (250 in. lbs.). 4. Assemble muffler and exhaust pipe to catalytic converter. Install muffler and
pipe support isolators to the underbody
5. Tighten the catalytic converter to exhaust manifold fasteners to 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.). 6. Working
from the front of the system; align each component to maintain position and proper clearance with
under body components. Tighten all
slip joint band clamps to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: Exhaust band clamps should never be tightened such that the two sides of the clamps
are bottomed out against the center hourglass shaped center block. Once this occurs, the clamp
has lost clamping force and must be replaced.
7. If removed, install downstream oxygen sensor. 8. Connect downstream oxygen sensor electrical
connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3210
EVAP/Purge Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3211
Canister Purge Solenoid: Description and Operation
EVAP/PURGE SOLENOID
All vehicles use a proportional purge solenoid. The solenoid regulates the rate of vapor flow from
the EVAP canister to the throttle body. The PCM operates the solenoid.
During the cold start warm-up period and the hot start time delay, the PCM does not energize the
solenoid. When de-energized, no vapors are purged.
Fig.1 Proportional Purge Solenoid
The proportional purge solenoid operates at a frequency of 200 Hz and is controlled by an engine
controller circuit that senses the current being applied to the proportional purge solenoid and then
adjusts that current to achieve the desired purge flow. The proportional purge solenoid controls the
purge rate of fuel vapors from the vapor canister and fuel tank to the engine intake manifold.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3212
Canister Purge Solenoid: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.2 Proportional Purge Solenoid Valve
The solenoid attaches to a bracket near the steering gear . The solenoid will not operate unless it is
installed correctly. The top of the solenoid has TOP printed on it. The solenoid will not operate
unless it is installed correctly.
1. Raise vehicle and support. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from solenoid. 3. Disconnect
vacuum tubes from solenoid. 4. Remove solenoid from bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install solenoid on bracket. 2. Connect vacuum tube to solenoid. 3. Connect electrical connector
to solenoid. 4. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations > Page 3216
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Description and Operation
VAPOR CANISTER
Fig.16 EVAP Canister
The vacuum and vapor tubes connect to the top of the canister.
All vehicles use a maintenance free, evaporative (EVAP) canister. Fuel tank vapors vent into the
canister. The canister temporarily holds the fuel vapors until intake manifold vacuum draws them
into the combustion chamber. The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) purges the canister through
the proportional purge solenoid. The PCM purges the canister at predetermined intervals and
engine conditions.
Purge Free Cells
Purge-free memory cells are used to identify the fuel vapor content of the evaporative canister.
Since the evaporative canister is not purged 100% of the time, the PCM stores information about
the evaporative canister's vapor content in a memory cell.
The purge-free cells are constructed similar to certain purge-normal cells. The purge-free cells can
be monitored by the DRB III Scan Tool. The only difference between the purge-free cells and
normal adaptive cells is that in purge-free, the purge is completely turned OFF. This gives the PCM
the ability to compare purge and purge-free operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations > Page 3217
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support.
Fig.17 EVAP Canister
3. Disconnect the hoses from the EVAP canister.
Fig.18 EVAP
4. Remove 1 nut from the bracket of the EVAP canister. 5. Remove EVAP canister from bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install EVAP canister to Bracket 2. Install 2 nuts to EVAP canister and bracket and tighten nuts
to 6.7 Nm (60 in. lbs.). 3. Connect hoses. 4. Install EVAP canister and bracket to vehicle and
tighten nut 22.4 Nm (250 in. lbs.). 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3221
Natural Vacuum Leak Detection Assembly (2.0L Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
Leak Detection Pump (If Equipped)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3225
Natural Vacuum Leak Detection Assembly (2.0L Except Export/2.4L Turbo)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3226
Leak Detection Pump: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Natural Vacuum Leak Detection (NVLD) system is the next generation evaporative leak
detection system that will first be used on vehicles equipped with the Next Generation Controller
(NGC). This new system replaces the leak detection pump as the method of evaporative system
leak detection. This is to detect a leak equivalent to a 0.020" (0.5 mm) hole. This system has the
capability to detect holes of this size very dependably.
The basic leak detection theory employed with NVLD is the "Gas Law". This is to say that the
pressure in a sealed vessel will change if the temperature of the gas in the vessel changes. The
vessel will only see this effect if it is indeed sealed. Even small leaks will allow the pressure in the
vessel to come to equilibrium with the ambient pressure. In addition to the detection of very small
leaks, this system has the capability of detecting medium as well as large evaporative system
leaks.
A vent valve seals the canister vent during engine off conditions. If the vapor system has a leak of
less than the failure threshold, the evaporative system will be pulled into a vacuum, either due to
the cool down from operating temperature or diurnal ambient temperature cycling. The diurnal
effect is considered one of the primary contributors to the leak determination by this diagnostic.
When the vacuum in the system exceeds about 1" H2O (0.25 KPA), a vacuum switch closes. The
switch closure sends a signal to the NGC. The NGC, via appropriate logic strategies (described
below), utilizes the switch signal, or lack thereof, to make a determination of whether a leak is
present.
The NVLD device is designed with a normally open vacuum switch, a normally closed solenoid,
and a seal, which is actuated by both the solenoid and a diaphragm. The NVLD is located on the
atmospheric vent side of the canister. The NVLD assembly may be mounted on top of the canister
outlet, or in-line between the canister and atmospheric vent filter. The normally open vacuum
switch will close with about 1" H2O (0.25 KPA) vacuum in the evaporative system. The diaphragm
actuates the switch. This is above the opening point of the fuel inlet check valve in the fill tube so
cap off leaks can be detected. Submerged fill systems must have recirculation lines that do not
have the in-line normally closed check valve that protects the system from failed nozzle liquid
ingestion, in order to detect cap off conditions.
The normally closed valve in the NVLD is intended to maintain the seal on the evaporative system
during the engine off condition. If vacuum in the evaporative system exceeds 3" to 6" H2O (0.75 to
1.5 KPA), the valve will be pulled off the seat, opening the seal. This will protect the system from
excessive vacuum as well as allowing sufficient purge flow in the event that the solenoid was to
become inoperative.
The solenoid actuates the valve to unseal the canister vent while the engine is running. It also will
be used to close the vent during the medium and large leak tests and during the purge flow check.
This solenoid requires initial 1.5 amps of current to pull the valve open but after 100 ms. will be
duty cycled down to an average of about 150 mA for the remainder of the drive cycle.
Another feature in the device is a diaphragm that will open the seal in the NVLD with pressure in
the evaporative system. The device will "blow off" at about 0.5" H2O (0.12 KPA) pressure to permit
the venting of vapors during refueling. An added benefit to this is that it will also allow the tank to
"breathe" during increasing temperatures, thus limiting the pressure in the tank to this low level.
This is beneficial because the induced vacuum during a subsequent declining temperature will
achieve the switch closed (pass threshold) sooner than if the tank had to decay from a built up
pressure.
The device itself has 3 wires: Switch sense, solenoid driver and ground. The NGC utilizes a
high-side driver to energize and duty-cycle the solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Pump, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3227
Leak Detection Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle on a hoist. 2. Push locking tab on electrical connector to unlock and
remove connector. 3. loosen the sway bar bracket to remove the pump bracket. 4. Remove pump
and bracket as an assembly 5. Disconnect lines from LDP. 6. Remove filter. 7. Remove pump from
bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pump to bracket and tighten bolts to 1.2 Nm (10.6 in. lbs.). 2. Install filter and tighten to 2.8
Nm (25 in. lbs.).
NOTE: The LDP bracket must be between the rail and sway bar bracket.
3. Install pump and bracket assembly to body and tighten front bolt to 11.7 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4.
Install sway bar bracket bolt and tighten bolts to 33.8 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). 5. Before installing hoses to
LDP, make sure they are not cracked or split. If a hose leaks, it will cause the Check Engine Lamp
to illuminate.
Connect lines to the LDP.
6. Install electrical connector to pump and push locking tab to lock. 7. Lower vehicle 8. Use the
DRB III scan tool, verify proper operation of LDP.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Locations
Fig.10 PCV System - 2.0L
Fig. 6 Engine OFF Or Engine Backfire No Vapor Flow
This valve is screwed into the engine valve cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3232
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Description and Operation
Fig.10 PCV System - 2.0L
PCV Valve a plastic valve in the engine valve cover.
Fig.11 Engine OFF Or Engine Backfire No Vapor Flow
When the engine is not operating or during an engine backfire, the spring forces the plunger back
against the seat. This prevents vapors from flowing through the valve.
Fig.12 High Intake Manifold Vacuum Minimal Vapor Flow
When the engine is at idle or cruising, high manifold vacuum is present. At these times manifold
vacuum is able to completely compress the spring and pull the plunger to the top of the valve. In
this position there is minimal vapor flow through the valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3233
Fig.13 Moderate Intake Manifold Vacuum Maximum Vapor Flow
During periods of moderate intake manifold vacuum the plunger is only pulled part way back from
the inlet. This results in maximum vapor flow through the valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE ...............................................................................................................................
......................................... 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 3238
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 3239
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications > Page 3240
Test 7 - 9
SYMPTOM
CHECKING FUEL DELIVERY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fuel pump relay
- Fuel pressure out of specs
- Restricted fuel supply line
- Fuel pump inlet strainer plugged
- Fuel pump module
- Fuel delivery system operation
- Fuel pump relay fused B+ circuit
- (A141) fuel pump relay output circuit open
- (Z1) fuel pump ground circuit open/high resistance
- Fuel pump module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service Precautions > Page 3244
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
CAUTION: When servicing the accelerator pedal, throttle cable or speed control cable, do not
damage or kink the core wire inside the cable sheathing.
1. Remove throttle cable cover.
Fig.1 Throttle Cable
2. Hold the throttle body throttle lever in the wide open position. Remove the throttle cable from the
throttle body cam (Fig. 1).
Fig.2 Accelerator Pedal And Throttle Cable
3. From inside the vehicle, hold up the pedal and remove the cable retainer and throttle cable from
the upper end of the pedal shaft (Fig. 2). 4. Pull back the carpet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 3251
Fig.3 Accelerator Pedal
5. Working from inside the vehicle, remove nuts from accelerator pedal attaching studs (Fig. 3)
Remove assembly from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When servicing the accelerator pedal, throttle cable or speed control cable, do not
damage or kink the core wire inside the cable sheathing.
1. Position accelerator pedal assembly on dash panel. Install retaining nuts. Tighten retaining nuts
to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) torque. 2. From inside the vehicle, hold up the pedal and install the throttle
cable and cable retainer in the upper end of the pedal shaft. 3. From the engine compartment, hold
the throttle body lever in the wide open position and install the throttle cable. 4. Install the throttle
cable cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove 5 screws from air cleaner element box lid. 2. Remove lid from air cleaner box. 3. Pull air
cleaner up and out of air cleaner box.
INSTALLATION
1. Install air cleaner element on to throttle body and push towards the throttle body and past lip in
air cleaner box bottom (Fig. 10). 2. Install lid and tighten screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fuel: Capacity Specifications Fuel Capacity
Fuel Capacity
12.5 gal (47.5 L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3260
Fuel: Fluid Type Specifications Fuel Octane Rating
Fuel Octane Rating
91 Octane
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Filler Cap
Fuel Filler Cap: Description and Operation Fuel Filler Cap
The plastic fuel fill cap is threaded/quarter turn onto the end of the fuel filler tube. It's purpose is to
retain vapors and fuel in the fuel tank.
The fuel filler cap incorporates a two-way relief valve that is closed to atmosphere during normal
operating conditions. The relief valve is calibrated to open when a pressure of 17 kPa (2.5 psi) or
vacuum of 2 kPa (0.6 in.Hg) occurs in the fuel tank. When the pressure or vacuum is relieved, the
valve returns to the normally closed position.
CAUTION: Remove the fuel filler cap to release fuel tank pressure before disconnecting any fuel
system component.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Filler Cap > Page 3265
Fuel Filler Cap: Description and Operation Fuel Cap Lock Cylinder
Fig.32 Locking Fuel Cap
FUEL CAP LOCK CYLINDER
Some vehicles are equipped with a locking fuel filler neck cap tethered to the fuel tank filler neck
(Fig. 32). This limited factory installed locking fuel cap utilizes the standard vehicle key to lock and
unlock the fuel cap from the fuel tank filler tube.
A locking fuel filler neck cap is utilized to prevent refueling the vehicle with the ignition ON, theft or
contamination of the vehicle fuel supply The standard vehicle ignition key is used to lock or unlock
the fuel filler cap. By inserting and rotating the ignition key to the right, unlocks the cap. Rotating to
the left, locks the cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3266
Fuel Filler Cap: Service and Repair
FUEL CAP LOCK CYLINDER
REMOVAL
Fig.33 Removing Retaining Ring
1. Using a flat-bladed pry tool, pry fuel cap retaining ring free from cap assembly (Fig. 33).
Fig.34 Step 2
2. Remove threaded portion of cap assembly (Fig. 34).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3267
Fig.35 Removing Fuel Cap Tether
3. Remove lock cylinder engagement collar and tether (Fig. 35).
Fig.36 Depressing Lock Cylinder Retaining Clip
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3268
Fig.37 Lock Cylinder Removed
4. Depress the spring loaded lock cylinder retaining clip (Fig. 36) and remove the lock cylinder from
the cap (Fig. 37).
INSTALLATION
1. Install the keyed lock cylinder in cap. 2. Position lock cylinder engagement collar and tether (Fig.
35). 3. Position threaded portion of cap (Fig. 34). 4. Snap retaining ring in position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537 °C (1000 °F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- Over tightening the pump lock ring may result in a leak.
- The fuel reservoir of the fuel pump module does not empty out when the tank is drained. The fuel
in the reservoir may spill out when the module is removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 3273
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
1. Remove Fuel Pump relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). For location of relay, refer to
label on underside of PDC cover. 2. Start and run engine until it stalls. 3. Attempt restarting engine
until it will no longer run. 4. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 5. Return fuel pump relay to PDC. 6.
One or more Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) may have been stored in PCM memory due to fuel
pump relay removal. The DRB III scan tool
must be used to erase a DTC.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3278
Fuel Injector: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3279
Fuel Injector: Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3280
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
Fuel Injector No. 1
Fuel Injector No. 2
Fuel Injector No. 3
Fuel Injector No. 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3281
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
Fig.9 Fuel Injector Location - Typical
The injectors are positioned in the intake manifold with the nozzle ends directly above the intake
valve port (Fig. 9).
Fig.10 Fuel Injector - Typical
The fuel injectors are 12 volt electrical solenoids (Fig. 10). The injector contains a pintle that closes
off an orifice at the nozzle end. When electric current is supplied to the injector, the armature and
needle move a short distance against a spring, allowing fuel to flow out the orifice. Because the fuel
is under high pressure, a fine spray is developed in the shape of a hollow cone or two streams. The
spraying action atomizes the fuel, adding it to the air entering the combustion chamber. Fuel
injectors are not interchangeable between engines.
The PCM provides battery voltage to each injector through the ASD relay. Injector operation is
controlled by a ground path provided for each injector by the PCM. Injector on-time (pulse-width) is
variable, and is determined by the PCM processing all the data previously discussed to obtain the
optimum injector pulse width for each operating condition. The pulse width is controlled by the
duration of the ground path provided.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3282
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
Fig.11 Fuel Injectors
Fig.12 Remove/Install Injector Connector
REMOVAL - INJECTOR CONNECTOR
1. Disconnect electrical connectors at the fuel injectors (Fig. 11). To remove connector refer to (Fig.
12). Pull the red colored slider away from
injector (1). While pulling the slider, depress tab (2) and remove connector (3) from injector. The
factory fuel injection wiring harness is numerically tagged (INJ 1, INJ 2, etc.) for injector position
identification. If harness is not tagged, make note of wiring location before removal.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Release fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel System
Pressure Release procedure. 3. Disconnect fuel supply tube from rail. Refer to Quick-Connect
Fittings in the Fuel Delivery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3283
Fig.15 Crankshaft Sensor Location
4. Disconnect electrical connectors from fuel injectors (Fig. 13), refer to the fuel injector connector
section for electrical connector removal. 5. Remove fuel rail mounting screws. 6. Lift rail off of
intake manifold. Cover the fuel injector openings in the intake manifold.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a light coating of clean engine oil to the upper O-ring. 2. Install injector in cup on fuel rail.
3. Install retaining clip. 4. Apply a light coating of clean engine oil to the O-ring on the nozzle end of
each injector. 5
Insert fuel injector nozzles into openings in intake manifold. Seat the injectors in place. Tighten fuel
rail mounting screws to 22.5 ± 3 Nm (200 ± 30 in. lbs.).
6. Attach electrical connectors to fuel injectors, refer to the fuel injector connector section for
electrical connector installation. 7. Connect fuel supply tube to fuel rail. Refer to Quick Connect
Fittings in the Fuel Delivery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Standard Procedure - Quick-Connect Fittings
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Quick-Connect Fittings
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK-CONNECT FITTINGS
REMOVAL
When disconnecting a quick-connect fitting, the retainer will remain on the fuel tube nipple.
WARNING: RELEASE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE BEFORE DISCONNECTING A
QUICK-CONNECT FITTINGS. REFER TO THE FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE.
1. Perform Fuel Pressure Release Procedure. Refer to the Fuel Pressure Release Procedure. 2.
Disconnect negative cable from battery or auxiliary jumper terminal. 3. Squeeze retainer tabs
together and pull fuel tube/quick-connect fitting assembly off of fuel tube nipple. The retainer will
remain on fuel tube.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Never install a quick-connect fitting without the retainer being either on the fuel tube or
already in the quick-connect fitting. In either case, ensure the retainer locks securely into the quickconnect fitting by firmly pulling on fuel tube and fitting to ensure it is secured.
1. Using a clean lint free cloth, clean the fuel tube nipple and retainer. 2. Prior to connecting the
fitting to the fuel tube, coat the fuel tube nipple with clean 30 weight engine oil. 3. Push the
quick-connect fitting over the fuel tube until the retainer seats and a click is heard.
Fig.29 Plastic Quick-Connect Fitting/Fuel Tube Connection
4. The plastic quick-connect fitting has windows in the sides of the casing. When the fitting
completely attaches to the fuel tube, the retainer locking
ears and the fuel tube shoulder are visible in the windows. If they are not visible, the retainer was
not properly installed (Fig. 29). Do not rely upon the audible click to confirm a secure connection.
5. Connect negative cable to battery or auxiliary jumper terminal.
CAUTION: When using the ASD Fuel System Test, the Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay remains
energized for several minutes, until the test is stopped, or until the ignition switch is turned to the
OFF position.
6. Use the DRBIII scan tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system. Check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Standard Procedure - Quick-Connect Fittings > Page 3288
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Two-Tab Type Fitting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TWO-TAB TYPE FITTING
Fig.30 Typical Two-Tab Type Quick-Connect Fitting
This type of fitting is equipped with tabs located on both sides of the fitting (Fig. 30). These tabs are
supplied for disconnecting the quick-connect fitting from component being serviced.
CAUTION: The interior components (O-rings, spacers) of this type of quick-connect fitting are not
serviced separately, but new plastic retainers are available. Do not attempt to repair damaged
fittings or fuel lines/tubes. If repair is necessary, replace the complete fuel tube assembly.
WARNING: THE FUEL SYSTEM IS UNDER A CONSTANT PRESSURE (EVEN WITH THE
ENGINE OFF). BEFORE SERVICING ANY FUEL SYSTEM HOSES, FITTINGS OR LINES, THE
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE MUST BE RELEASED. REFER TO THE FUEL PRESSURE
RELEASE PROCEDURE IN THIS GROUP.
DISCONNECTION / CONNECTION
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Release Procedure in this
group. 2. Disconnect negative battery cable from battery or auxiliary jumper terminal. 3. Clean
fitting of any foreign material before disassembly 4. To disconnect quick-connect fitting, squeeze
plastic retainer tabs (Fig. 30) against sides of quick- connect fitting with your fingers. Tool use is not
required for removal and may damage plastic retainer. Pull fitting from fuel system component
being serviced. The plastic retainer will remain on component being serviced after fitting is
disconnected. The O-rings and spacer will remain in quick-connect fitting connector body.
5. Inspect quick-connect fitting body and component for damage. Replace as necessary.
CAUTION: When the quick-connect fitting was disconnected, the plastic retainer will remain on the
component being serviced. If this retainer must be removed, very carefully release the retainer from
the component with two small screwdrivers. After removal, inspect the retainer for cracks or any
damage.
6. Prior to connecting quick-connect fitting to component being serviced, check condition of fitting
and component. Clean parts with a lint-free cloth.
Lubricate with clean engine oil.
7. Insert quick-connect fitting to component being serviced and into plastic retainer. When a
connection is made, a click will be heard. 8. Verify a locked condition by firmly pulling on fuel tube
and fitting (15 - 30 lbs.). 9. Connect negative cable to battery or auxiliary jumper terminal.
10. Use the DRB III scan tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system. Check for
leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Standard Procedure - Quick-Connect Fittings > Page 3289
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Plastic Retainer Ring Type Fitting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PLASTIC RETAINER RING TYPE FITTING
Fig.31 Plastic Retainer Ring Type Fitting
This type of fitting can be identified by the use of a full-round plastic retainer ring (Fig. 31) usually
black in color.
CAUTION: The interior components (O-rings, spacers, retainers) of this type of quick-connect fitting
are not serviced separately. Do not attempt to repair damaged fittings or fuel lines/tubes. If repair is
necessary, replace the complete fuel tube assembly.
WARNING: THE FUEL SYSTEM IS UNDER A CONSTANT PRESSURE (EVEN WITH THE
ENGINE OFF). BEFORE SERVICING ANY FUEL SYSTEM HOSES, FITTINGS OR LINES, THE
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE MUST BE RELEASED. REFER TO THE FUEL SYSTEM
PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE IN THIS GROUP.
DISCONNECTION / CONNECTION
1. Perform fuel pressure release procedure. Refer to Fuel Pressure Release Procedure. 2.
Disconnect negative battery cable from battery or auxiliary jumper terminal. 3. Clean fitting of any
foreign material before disassembly. 4. To release fuel system component from quick-connect
fitting, firmly push fitting towards component being serviced while firmly pushing plastic
retainer ring into fitting (Fig. 31). With plastic ring depressed, pull fitting from component. The
plastic retainer ring must be pressed squarely into fitting body. If this retainer is cocked during
removal, it may be difficult to disconnect fitting. Use an open-end wrench on shoulder of plastic
retainer ring to aid in disconnection.
5. After disconnection, plastic retainer ring will remain with quick-connect fitting connector body. 6.
Inspect fitting connector body, plastic retainer ring and fuel system component for damage.
Replace as necessary. 7. Prior to connecting quick-connect fitting to component being serviced,
check condition of fitting and component. Clean parts with a lint-free cloth.
Lubricate with clean engine oil.
8. Insert quick-connect fitting into component being serviced until a click is felt. 9. Verify a locked
condition by firmly pulling on fuel tube and fitting (15 - 30 lbs.).
10. Connect negative battery cable to battery or auxiliary jumper terminal 11. Use the DRB III scan
tool ASD Fuel System Test to pressurize the fuel system Check for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pressure Regulator
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Description and Operation Fuel Pressure Regulator
FUEL FILTER/FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
A combination fuel filter and fuel pressure regulator is used on all gas powered engines. It is
located on the top of the fuel pump module.
Fig.1 Side View - Filter/Regulator
It contains a diaphragm, calibrated springs and a fuel return valve. The internal fuel filter is also
part of the assembly (Fig. 1)
Fuel Pressure Regulator Operation: The pressure regulator is a mechanical device that is
calibrated to maintain fuel system operating pressure of approximately 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi) at
the fuel injectors.
Fuel is supplied to the filter/regulator by the electric fuel pump through an opening tube at the
bottom of filter/regulator.
The fuel pump module contains a check valve to maintain some fuel pressure when the engine is
not operating. This will help to start the engine.
If fuel pressure at the pressure regulator exceeds approximately 58 psi, an internal diaphragm
closes and excess fuel pressure is routed back into the tank through the pressure regulator. A
separate fuel return line is not used with any gas powered engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Pressure Regulator > Page 3295
Fig.11 Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3296
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE FUEL SYSTEM IS UNDER A CONSTANT PRESSURE, EVEN WITH ENGINE
OFF. BEFORE SERVICING THE FUEL FILTER/FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR, THE FUEL
SYSTEM PRESSURE MUST BE RELEASED.
1. Refer to Fuel System Pressure Release in the Fuel Delivery System. The fuel filter/fuel pressure
regulator is located on the top of fuel pump
module. Fuel pump module removal is not necessary.
2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect fuel supply line at the Filter/Regulator nipple (refer to Quick
Connect Fittings).
Fig.9 Locking Spring Tab
4. Depress locking spring tab on side of Fuel/Regulator (Fig. 9) and rotate 90° counter-clockwise
and pull out.
NOTE: Make sure that the upper and lower O-rings are on the Filter/Regulator assembly.
INSTALLATION
Lightly lubricate the O-rings with engine oil. 1. Insert Filter/Regulator into the opening in the fuel
pump module, align the two hold down tabs with the flange.
Fig.10 Spring Tab In Locating Slot
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3297
2. While applying downward pressure, rotate the Filter/Regulator clockwise until the the spring tab
engages the locating slot (Fig. 10). 3. Connect the fuel line to the Filter/Regulator. 4. Lower vehicle
from hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURE ...............................................................................................................................
......................................... 400 ± 34 kPa (58 ± 5 psi)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3302
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3303
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3304
Test 7 - 9
SYMPTOM
CHECKING FUEL DELIVERY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fuel pump relay
- Fuel pressure out of specs
- Restricted fuel supply line
- Fuel pump inlet strainer plugged
- Fuel pump module
- Fuel delivery system operation
- Fuel pump relay fused B+ circuit
- (A141) fuel pump relay output circuit open
- (Z1) fuel pump ground circuit open/high resistance
- Fuel pump module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3308
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3309
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel pump relay is located in the PDC. The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse location
The fuel pump relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel pump. A buss bar in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and contact side of the relay. The fuel pump
relay power circuit contains a fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the relay. The fuse is
located in the PDC. Refer to the Wiring Diagrams for circuit information.
The PCM controls the fuel pump relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the
relay ON and OFF. The PCM turns the ground path OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF
position. When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the PCM energizes the fuel pump. If the
crankshaft position sensor does not detect engine rotation, the PCM de-energizes the relay after
approximately one second.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Pickup Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pump Pickup Filter: Service and Repair
INLET FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module Removal.
Fig.28
2. Using a thin straight blade screwdriver, pry back the locking tabs on fuel pump reservoir and
remove the strainer (Fig. 28). 3. Remove strainer O-ring from the fuel pump reservoir body. 4.
Remove any contaminants in the fuel tank by washing the inside of the fuel tank.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the strainer O-ring with clean engine oil. 2. Insert strainer O-ring into outlet of strainer
so that it sits evenly on the step inside the outlet. 3. Push strainer onto the inlet of the fuel pump
reservoir body. Make sure the locking tabs on the reservoir body lock over the locking tangs on the
strainer.
4. Install fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Rail: Description and Operation
Fig.15 Fuel Rail
The fuel rail supplies the necessary fuel to each individual fuel injector and is mounted to the intake
manifold (Fig. 15).
The fuel pressure regulator is no longer mounted to the fuel rail on any engine. It is now located on
the fuel tank mounted fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Filter/Fuel Pressure Regulator in the Fuel
Delivery System. The fuel rail is not repairable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3316
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Release fuel system pressure. Refer to Fuel System
Pressure Release procedure. 3. Disconnect fuel supply tube from rail. Refer to Quick-Connect
Fittings in the Fuel Delivery.
Fig.16 Fuel Rail And Injectors
4. Disconnect electrical connectors from fuel injectors (Fig. 16), refer to the fuel injector connector
section for electrical connector removal. 5. Remove fuel rail mounting screws. 6. Lift rail off of
intake manifold. Cover the fuel injector openings in the intake manifold.
Fig.17 Fuel Injector Retainer
7. Remove fuel injector retainer (Fig. 17).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3317
Fig.18 Fuel Injector O-Rings
8. Pull injector out of fuel rail. Replace fuel injector O-rings (Fig. 18).
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a light coating of clean engine oil to the upper O-ring. 2. Install injector in cup on fuel rail.
3. Install retaining clip. 4. Apply a light coating of clean engine oil to the O-ring on the nozzle end of
each injector. 5. Insert fuel injector nozzles into openings in intake manifold. Seat the injectors in
place. Tighten fuel rail mounting screws to 22.5 ± 3 Nm (200 ±
30 in. lbs.).
6. Attach electrical connectors to fuel injectors, refer to the fuel injector connector section for
electrical connector installation. 7. Connect fuel supply tube to fuel rail. Refer to Quick Connect
Fittings in the Fuel Delivery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Filler Neck: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Loosen fuel filler tube cap.
Fig.26 Fuel Filler Neck
2. Remove fuel filler neck screws (Fig. 26). 3. Raise and support vehicle. 4. Remove splash shield
from wheel well. 5. Disconnect fuel fill vapor tube. 6. Disconnect fuel filler tube from fuel tank. 7.
Remove groundstrap from body.
Fig.28 Remove Filler Neck
8. Remove filler neck (Fig. 27).
INSTALLATION
1. Install filler tube. 2. Install fuel filler neck screws and plastic filler cup. 3. Connect fuel fill vapor
tube. 4. Connect fuel filler tube to fuel tank. Tighten clamp. 5. Connect ground strap to body. 6.
Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3322
7. Install fuel filler tube cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3326
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The
sending unit consists of a float, an arm, and a variable resistor (track). The resistor track is used to
send electrical signals to the instrument cluster for fuel gauge operation and are then transmitted to
the engine controller for OBDII emission requirements.
For Fuel Gauge Operation: As fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This increases the
sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge to read full. As fuel level decreases, the float and
arm move down. This decreases the sending unit resistance causing the fuel gauge to read empty.
After this fuel level signal is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster will transmit the
data across the J1850 bus circuits to the PCM.
For OBD II Emission Requirements: The voltage signal is sent to the instrument cluster to indicate
fuel level. The cluster transmits the fuel level to the PCM where it is used to prevent a false setting
of misfire and fuel system monitor trouble codes. This occurs if the fuel level in the tank is less than
approximately 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3327
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
REMOVAL
Remove fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector (Fig. 4).
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge (Fig. 5).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3328
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector (Fig. 6). 4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector (Fig. 6).
Fig.7 Level Sensor
5. Slide level sensor wires through opening fuel pump module (Fig. 7). 6. Slide level sensor out of
installation channel in module.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert level sensor wires into bottom of opening in module. 2. Wrap wires into groove in back of
level sensor. 3. While feeding wires into guide grooves, slide level sensor up into channel until it
snaps into place (Fig. 7). Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in
place.
4. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
5. Install locking wedge on connector. 6. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector. 7. Install fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Module <--> [Fuel
Tank Unit] > Component Information > Diagrams
Fuel Pump Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3335
Idle Air Control Motor (2.0L/2.4L Turbo)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3336
Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor: Description and Operation
Fig.16 Idle Air Control Solenoid - Typical
IDLE AIR CONTROL MOTOR
The Idle Air Control (IAC) solenoid is mounted on the throttle body. The PCM operates the idle air
control solenoid. It is an electric stepper solenoid.
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed through the idle air control solenoid to compensate for engine
load, coolant temperature or barometric pressure changes.
The throttle body has an air bypass passage that provides air for the engine during closed throttle
idle. The idle air control solenoid pintle protrudes into the air bypass passage and regulates air flow
through it.
The PCM adjusts engine idle speed by moving the IAC solenoid pintle in and out of the bypass
passage. The adjustments are based on inputs the PCM receives. The inputs are from the throttle
position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, coolant temperature sensor, MAP sensor, vehicle
speed sensor and various switch operations (brake, park/neutral, air conditioning and power
steering).
When engine rpm is above idle speed, the IAC is used for the following functions: Off-idle dashpot
- Deceleration air flow control
- A/C compressor load control and power steering (also opens the passage slightly before the
compressor is engaged so that the engine rpm does not dip down when the compressor engages)
Target Idle
Target idle is determined by the following inputs: Gear position
- ECT Sensor
- Battery voltage
- Ambient/Battery Temperature Sensor
- VSS
- TPS
- MAP Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor <-->
[Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3337
Idle Air Control (IAC) Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
When servicing throttle body components, always reassemble components with new O-rings and
seals where applicable. Never use lubricants on O-rings or seals, damage may result. If assembly
of component is difficult, use water to aid assembly Use care when removing hoses to prevent
damage to hose or hose nipple.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove electrical connector from idle air control
motor.
Fig.17 Servicing Idle Air Control Motor
3. Remove idle air control motor mounting screws. 4. Remove motor from throttle body. Ensure the
O-ring is removed with the motor.
INSTALLATION
1. The new idle air control motor has a new O-ring installed on it. If pintle measures more than 1
inch (25 mm) it must be retracted. Use the DRB III
Idle Air Control Motor Open/Close Test to retract the pintle (battery must be connected.)
2. Carefully place idle air control motor into throttle body. 3. Install mounting screws. Tighten
screws to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect electrical connector to idle air control motor. 5.
Connect negative cable to battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <-->
[Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <-->
[Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3341
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3346
Fuel Pump Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3347
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel pump relay is located in the PDC. The inside top of the PDC cover has a label showing
relay and fuse location
The fuel pump relay supplies battery voltage to the fuel pump. A buss bar in the Power Distribution
Center (PDC) supplies voltage to the solenoid side and contact side of the relay. The fuel pump
relay power circuit contains a fuse between the buss bar in the PDC and the relay. The fuse is
located in the PDC. Refer to the Wiring Diagrams for circuit information.
The PCM controls the fuel pump relay by switching the ground path for the solenoid side of the
relay ON and OFF. The PCM turns the ground path OFF when the ignition switch is in the OFF
position. When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the PCM energizes the fuel pump. If the
crankshaft position sensor does not detect engine rotation, the PCM de-energizes the relay after
approximately one second.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Auto Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3351
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3355
Manifold Tuning Valve Relay (RT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3361
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3362
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3363
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3364
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3365
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3369
Throttle Body: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.34 Battery Negative Cable
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable (Fig. 34). 2. Remove the air cleaner box cover.
Fig.35 Air Cleaner Element
3. Remove the air cleaner element (Fig. 35). Pull up on element, past the lip in the box, to remove it
from the air cleaner box. 4
Disconnect the electrical connection at the throttle body.
5. Loosen the clamp on throttle body outlet hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3370
Fig.36 Throttle Body Bolts
6 Remove the bolts holding the throttle body to the air cleaner box (Fig. 36).
Fig.37 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3371
Fig.38 Transmission Kickdown Cable Connector
7. Remove cable s from throttle body cam (Fig. 37) and (Fig. 38).
INSTALLATION
1. Install cable s into throttle cam and clip cable s into throttle cable bracket. 2. Install throttle body
onto air cleaner box. Tighten mounting bolts. 3. Install and tighten the clamp on throttle body outlet
hose. 4. Connect the electrical connectors to the throttle body. 5
Install the air cleaner element, make sure that the element is past the lip on the air cleaner box.
6. Install the air cleaner box cover and tighten the screws. 7. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove throttle cable cover or engine cover, if equipped.
Fig.45 Throttle Body Cables Attachment In Throttle Body
Fig.46 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
2. Working from the engine compartment, remove throttle cable from throttle body cam (Fig. 45)
and (Fig. 46). 3. Lift the retaining tabs on the cable and slide cable out of bracket. 4. From inside
the vehicle, hold the throttle pedal up and remove the cable retainer and cable from upper end of
pedal shaft (Fig. 2).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3375
Fig.47 Retainer Clip
5. Remove retainer clip from throttle cable and grommet at the dashpanel (Fig. 47). 6. From the
engine compartment, pull the throttle cable and grommet out of the dash panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Install grommet into dashpanel. 2. From the engine compartment, push the housing end fitting
into the dashpanel grommet. 3. From the engine compartment, rotate the throttle lever forward to
the wide open position and install cable clasp (Fig. 46). 4. Install cable housing (throttle body end)
into the cable mounting bracket on the engine. 5. Install throttle cable cover. 6
From inside the vehicle, hold up pedal and feed throttle cable core wire through hole in upper end
of the pedal shaft. Install cable retainer (Fig. 47).
7 Install cable retainer clip (Fig. 47).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3380
Throttle Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3381
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3382
Throttle Position Senor (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3383
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.48 Throttle Position Sensor And Idle
DESCRIPTION The throttle position sensor mounts to the side of the throttle body.
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) connects to the throttle blade shaft. The TPS is a variable
resistor that provides the PCM with an input signal (voltage). The signal represents throttle blade
position. As the position of the throttle blade changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
OPERATION The signal represents throttle blade position. As the position of the throttle blade
changes, the resistance of the TPS changes.
The PCM supplies approximately 5 volts to the TPS. The TPS output voltage (input signal to the
powertrain control module) represents throttle blade position. The TPS output voltage to the PCM
varies from approximately 0.6 volt at minimum throttle opening (idle) to a maximum of 4.5 volts at
wide open throttle.
Along with inputs from other sensors, the PCM uses the TPS input to determine current engine
operating conditions. The PCM also adjusts fuel injector pulse width and ignition timing based on
these inputs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3384
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Loosen the clamp for the air duct at the throttle body.
3. Remove the mounting bolt and nut for the air cleaner box. 4. Pull the air cleaner box and throttle
body up to access the throttle position sensor. 5. Remove the throttle position sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the throttle position sensor. 2. Locate the air cleaner box and throttle body and tighten the
mounting bolt and nut. 3. Install the air duct hose and tighten the clamp. 4. Connect the negative
battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3389
Manifold Tuning Valve Relay (RT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams
Manifold Tuning Valve Solenoid (RT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
Manifold Tuning Valve Solenoid (RT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3396
Variable Induction Control Valve: Description and Operation
Fig.19 Manifold Turning Valve
The valve connects both passages of the intake manifold plenum (Fig. 19). It is an electric motor.
The PCM controls the MTV solenoid. The manifold tuning valve optimizes acoustical tuning of the
intake system during wide open throttle operation throughout the RPM range.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3397
Variable Induction Control Valve: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Tie the upper radiator hose back to gain access to the
Manifold Tuning Valve (MTV). 3. Remove the 3 bolts from the rear power steering bracket.
Fig.20 Power Steering Bracket
4 Remove the bracket (Fig. 20).
Fig.21 Manifold Tuning Valve (MTV)
5. Remove the 2 bolts from the MTV (Fig. 21).
NOTE: When removing the MTV do not loose the spring that is between the valve and intake
manifold.
6. Remove the MTV.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3398
Fig.22 Electrical Connector
7. Disconnect the electrical from the MTV and bracket (Fig. 32).
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the electrical connector to the MTV and bracket (Fig. 33).
NOTE: When removing the MTV do not loose the spring that is between the valve and intake
manifold.
2. Install the MTV. Align the slot in the valve with the tab on the intake manifold. Do not forget to
install the spring. 3. Install the 2 bolts to the MTV (Fig. 32). 4. Install the bracket (Fig. 31). 5. Install
the 3 bolts for the rear power steering bracket. 6. Untie the upper radiator hose. 7. Connect the
negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
Ignition Coll Pack
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 1-3-4-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3403
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches directly to the valve cover.
The 2.0 Liter (122 cu. inch) in-line four cylinder engine is a single over head camshaft with
hydraulic lifters and four valves per cylinder design (Fig. 1). The engine does not have provisions
for a free wheeling valve train. The cylinders are numbered from front of the engine to the rear. The
firing order is 1-3-4-2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3411
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3416
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3417
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3418
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3419
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3420
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft
Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3421
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
CABLE .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................ RESISTANCE
# 1, # 4 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2970 - 8910 ohms
# 2, # 3 .................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 2360 - 7070 ohms
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3425
Ignition Cable: Description and Operation
SPARK PLUG CABLE
Spark Plug cables are sometimes referred to as secondary ignition wires. The wires transfer
electrical current from the ignition coil pack to individual spark plugs at each cylinder. The resistive
spark plug cables are of nonmetallic construction. The cables provide suppression of radio
frequency emissions from the ignition system.
Check the spark plug cable connections for good contact at the coil, and spark plugs. Terminals
should be fully seated. The insulators should be in good condition and should fit tightly on the coil,
and spark plugs. Spark plug cables with insulators that are cracked or torn must be replaced.
Clean Spark Plug cables with a cloth moistened with a non-flammable solvent. Wipe the cables
dry. Check for brittle or cracked insulation. The spark plug cables and spark plug boots are made
from high temperature silicone materials. All spark plug cable leads are properly identified with
cylinder numbers. The inside of most the spark plug boot is coated with a special high temperature
silicone grease for greater sealing and to minimize boot bonding to the spark plug insulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3426
Ignition Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Remove spark plug cable from coil first. Always remove the spark plug cable by grasping the top of
the spark plug insulator, turning the boot 1/2 turn and pulling straight up in a steady motion.
INSTALLATION
Failure to route the cables properly could cause the radio to reproduce ignition noise, cross ignition
of the spark plugs or short circuit the cables to ground.
Install spark plug insulators over spark plugs. Ensure the top of the spark plug insulator covers the
upper end of the spark plug tube, then connect the other end to coil pack.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Ignition Coil: Electrical Specifications
Ignition Coil
Coil Polarity - Weastec Coil
Coil Polarity - Diamond Coil
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3431
Ignition Coil: Mechanical Specifications
Ignition Coil Mounting Bolts 11 Nm 8.1 Ft. Lbs. 95 In. Lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3432
Ignition Coil: Locations
Fig.11 Ignition Coil Pack
The coil pack consists of 2 coils molded together. The coil pack is mounted on the valve cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3433
Ignition Coil
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3434
Ignition Coil: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE DIRECT IGNITION SYSTEM GENERATES APPROXIMATELY 40,000 VOLTS.
PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM CONTACT WITH THIS SYSTEM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3435
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation
Fig.11 Ignition Coil Pack
The coil pack consists of 2 coils molded together. The coil pack is mounted on the valve cover.
WARNING: THE DIRECT IGNITION SYSTEM GENERATES APPROXIMATELY 40,000 VOLTS.
PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM CONTACT WITH THIS SYSTEM.
High tension leads route to each cylinder from the coil. The coil fires two spark plugs every power
stroke. One plug is the cylinder under compression, the other cylinder fires on the exhaust stroke.
Coil number one fires cylinders 1 and 4. Coil number two fires cylinders 2 and 3. The PCM
determines which of the coils to charge and fire at the correct time.
The Auto Shutdown (ASD) relay provides battery voltage to the ignition coil. The PCM provides a
ground contact (circuit) for energizing the coil. When the PCM breaks the contact, the energy in the
coil primary transfers to the secondary causing the spark. The PCM will de-energize the ASD relay
if it does not receive the crankshaft position sensor and camshaft position sensor inputs. Refer to
Auto Shutdown (ASD) Relay-PCM Output for relay operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3436
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.13 Electronic Ignition Coil Pack
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches directly to the valve cover.
Fig.12 Electronic Ignition Coil Connector
1. Disconnect electrical connector from coil pack. 2. Remove coil pack mounting bolts. 3. Remove
coil pack.
INSTALLATION
The electronic ignition coil pack attaches directly to the valve cover. 1. Install coil pack on valve
cover. 2. Transfer spark plug cables to new coil pack. The coil pack towers are numbered with the
cylinder identification. Be sure the ignition cables snap
onto the towers.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3440
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3445
Camshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
> Page 3450
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3451
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3452
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Crankshaft Position Sensor
The crankshaft position sensor mounts to the engine block behind the generator, just above the oil
filter.
The PCM uses the Crankshaft Position sensor to calculate the following:
- Engine RPM
- TDC number 1 and 4
- Ignition coil synchronization
- Injector synchronization
- Camshaft-to-crankshaft misalignment (Timing belt skipped 1 tooth or more diagnostic trouble
code).
The PCM sends approximately 5 volts to the Halleffect sensor. This voltage is required to operate
the Hall-effect chip and the electronics inside the sensor. A ground for the sensor is provided
through the sensor return circuit. The input to the PCM occurs on a 5 volt output reference circuit
that operates as follows: The Hall-effect sensor contains a powerful magnet. As the magnetic field
passes over the dense portion of the counterweight, the 5-volt signal is pulled to ground (.3 volts)
through a transistor in the sensor. When the magnetic field passes over the notches in the
crankshaft counterwieght, the magnetic field turns off the transistor in the sensor, causing the PCM
to register the 5-volt signal. The PCM identifies crankshaft position by registering the change from
5 to 0 volts, as signaled from the Crankshaft Position sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3453
Fig.14 Timing Reference Notches (NGC)
The PCM determines what cylinder to fire from the crankshaft position sensor input and the
camshaft position sensor input. The # 8 crankshaft counterweight has a target ring with 32 teeth
and notches, including one long referance tooth and notch. From the crankshaft position sensor
input the PCM determines engine speed and crankshaft angle (position).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3454
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L TURBO
Fig.1 Crankshaft Position Sensor Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor is in the front of the engine block just under the starter motor.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Raise vehicle and support. 3. On 2.4L SRT-4, remove
the lower inner cooler hose from the metal tube.
Fig.2 Structural Collar And Bending Strut - (Automatic Transaxle Equipped)
4. Remove the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar Removal and Installation
section. 5. Unlock and disconnect the electrical connector to the crankshaft position sensor. 6.
Remove the crankshaft position sensor bolt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor <--> [Crankshaft Position Sensor] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3455
Fig.3 Crankshaft Position Sensor - 2.4L Turbo
7. Remove the sensor.
INSTALLATION - 2.0, 2.4, 2.4L Turbo
1. Check O-ring for damage and lubricate the O-ring with engine oil before installing sensor. 2. Use
a twisting motion when installing the sensor. 3. Install and tighten the crankshaft position sensor
bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 ± 15 in. lbs.). 4. Connect and lock the electrical connector to the
crankshaft position sensor. 5. Install the Structural Collar, refer to the Engine, Structural Collar
Removal and Installation section. 6. On 2.4L SRT-4, install the lower inner cooler hose to metal
tube and tighten clamp. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Fig. 14 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 45 Engine (Left Front) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3463
Knock Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Spark Plug Tube: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUG TUBE
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Using locking pliers, remove the tube from the cylinder head. Discard old tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean area around spark plug with Mopar parts cleaner or equivalent. 2. Apply Mopar Stud and
Bearing Mount or equivalent to a new tube approximately 1 mm (0.039 inch) from the end in a 3
mm (0.118 inch) wide
area.
3. Install sealer end of tube into the cylinder head. Then carefully install the tube using a hardwood
block and mallet until the tube is seated into the
bottom of the bore.
4. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve
Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The spark plug tube seals are located in the cylinder head cover. These seals are pressed into the
cylinder head cover to seal the outside perimeter of the spark plug tubes. If these seals show signs
of hardness and/or cracking, they should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve
Cover > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3471
Spark Plug Tube Seal - Valve Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Using an appropriate tool, carefully remove spark plug tube
seals. Care should be taken not to damage cylinder head cover sealing surfaces.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean all sealing surfaces.
NOTE: Position seal with the concave side facing the installation tool.
2. Install seals using Special Tool MB-998306. Only hand pressure on tool is needed to install new
seals. 3. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3478
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3482
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3483
8w-80-61
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3484
Solenoid Application Chart
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams
Shift Indicator: Diagrams
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)(Autostick)
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Application and ID
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Console Gear Selector w/ Auto ...........................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC 194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 3503
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 3504
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 3505
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts > Page 3511
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts > Page 3512
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts > Page 3513
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 3514
Control Module: Locations
Fig.11 TCM Location
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 3515
Control Module: Description and Operation
Fig.11 TCM Location
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11). It mounts on a bracket that is fastened to the rail.
The TCM is the controlling unit for all electronic operations of the transaxle. The TCM receives
information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and selects the
operational mode of the transaxle. Direct inputs are hardwired to, and used specifically by the
TCM. Indirect inputs originate from other components/modules, and are shared with the TCM via
the J1850 communication bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are: -Battery (B+) voltage -Ignition "ON" voltage
-Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) -Throttle Position Sensor -Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) -Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) -Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD) -Transmission
Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS) -Input Shaft Speed Sensor -Output Shaft Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are: Engine/Body Identification
- Manifold Pressure
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Speed Control ON/OFF Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Brake Switch Status
- DRB Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are: Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD and UD)
- Vehicle Speed (to PCM)
- Torque Reduction Request (to PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 3516
An example of a TCM indirect output is: Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions: Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indices (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with DRB scan tool)
Clutch Volume Index (CVI) An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index
(CVI). CVIs represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
Fig.12 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur (Fig. 12).
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRB Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 3517
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Shift Schedules As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of
shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following: Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 3518
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the chart
to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Control Module (TCM) is being replaced with a new or replacement unit,
the Pinion Factor and Quick Learn procedures must be performed. (Refer to ELECTRONIC
CONTROL MODULES/TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE - STANDARD PROCEDURE)
(Refer to ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/ TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE)
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially remove right front wheel
splash shield.
Fig.13 TCM 60-Way Connector
4. Disconnect TCM 60-way connector (Fig. 13).
Fig.14 TCM/Bracket Assembly
5. Remove three (3) TCM bracket-to-rail screws and remove TCM/bracket assembly from vehicle
(Fig. 14).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3521
Fig.15 TCM Bracket
6. Remove four (4) bracket-to-TCM screws and remove bracket (Fig. 15).
INSTALLATION
1. Install TCM to mounting bracket and torque four (4) screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 15). 2.
Install TCM/bracket assembly to rail (Fig. 14). Install and torque three (3) bracket-to-rail screws to
12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Install TCM 60-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.) (Fig. 13). 4.
Install and secure right front wheel splash shield. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3522
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the Transmission Control Module (TCM) has been
replaced with a NEW or replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an
inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The TCM
must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Transmission Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a DRB III scan tool. 1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector
located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous
menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the instructions on the DRB III scan tool screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3523
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRB III scan tool. This program allows the
electronic transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle
operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met: The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRB III
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60 ° and below 200 °
1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRB III to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Transmission Control System Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3527
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3528
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3529
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION CONTROL RELAY - DESCRIPTION
The transmission control relay (Fig. 303) is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), which
is located on the left side of the engine compartment.
OPERATION
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TCM, and is used to supply power to the
solenoid pack when the transmission is in normal operating mode. When the relay is "off", no
power is supplied to the solenoid pack and the transmission is in "limp-in" mode.
After a controller reset (ignition key turned to the "run" position or after cranking engine), the TCM
energizes the relay. Prior to this, the TCM verifies that the contacts are open by checking for no
voltage at the switched battery terminals.
After this is verified, the voltage at the solenoid pack pressure switches is checked. After the relay
is energized, the TCM monitors the terminals to verify that the voltage is greater than 3 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly-to-Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 12 Nm (110 in.
lbs.)
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Connector Screw
............................................................................................................................. 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3538
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3539
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
DESCRIPTION
The Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (Fig. 289) is external to the transaxle and mounted to the
transaxle case. The assembly consists of four solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the
LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is controlled by line pressure from
the manual valve in the valve body. The solenoids are contained within the Solenoid/Pressure
Switch Assembly, and can only be serviced by replacing the assembly. The solenoid assembly also
contains pressure switches that monitor and send hydraulic circuit information to the TCM.
Likewise, the pressure switches can only be service by replacing the assembly.
OPERATION SOLENOIDS
The solenoids receive electrical power from the Transmission Control Relay through a single wire.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid needed. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid passage is
opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The result is an
apply or release of a frictional element. The 2/4 and UD solenoids are normally applied, which by
design allow fluid to pass through in their relaxed or "off" state. This allows transaxle limp-in (P, R,
N, 2) in the event of an electrical failure. The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically
tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off depending on its current state. An inductive spike should
be detected by the TCM during this test. If no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify
the failure. In addition to the periodic testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or
pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on three pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2/4, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The range for the pressure switch closing and opening points is 11 23 psi. Typically the switch opening point will be approximately one psi lower than the closing point.
For example, a switch may close at 18 psi and open at 17 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3540
The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the correct states (open or closed) in
each gear as shown in the chart shown.
PRESSURE SWITCH STATES
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear. The TCM also tests the 2/4 and OD pressure switches when they are
normally off (OD and 2/4 are tested in 1st gear, OD in 2nd gear, and 2/4 in 3rd gear). The test
simply verifies that they are operational, by looking for a closed state when the corresponding
element is applied. Immediately after a shift into 1st, 2nd, or 3rd gear with the engine speed above
1000 rpm, the TCM momentarily turns on element pressure to the 2/4 and/or OD clutch circuits to
identify that the appropriate switch has closed. If it doesn't close, it is tested again. If the switch fails
to close the second time, the appropriate DTC will set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3541
Pressure Switch States
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3542
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY REMOVAL
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
solenoid/pressure switch assembly connector. 4. Disconnect input speed sensor connector.
5. Remove input speed sensor (Fig. 290).
6. Remove three (3) solenoid/pressure switch assembly-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 291).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3543
7. Remove solenoid/pressure switch assembly and gasket (Fig. 292). Use care to prevent gasket
material and foreign objects from become lodged in
the transaxle case ports.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install solenoid/pressure switch assembly and new gasket to transaxle (Fig. 292). 2. Install and
torque three (3) bolts (Fig. 291) to 13 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 3. Install input speed sensor (Fig. 290) and
torque to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect input speed sensor connector. 5. Install solenoid/pressure
switch 8-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 6. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 7. Connect battery negative cable. 8. If solenoid/pressure switch assembly was
replaced, perform TCM Quick Learn procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Switch: Locations
Interlock Mechanism
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3547
Shift Interlock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig. 39
1. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Fig. 40
2. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 40).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3548
Fig. 41
3. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/ RUN" position (Fig. 41).
Fig. 42
4. Grasp the interlock cable and connector firmly. Remove the interlock cable (Fig. 42).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3549
Fig. 43
5. Remove the two interlock mechanism-to-steering column attaching screws (Fig. 43). Remove
the interlock housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interlock housing at steering column. Install the two interlock mechanism-to-steering
column attaching screws. Torque screws to 3
Nm (21 inch lbs.).
2. Snap the interlock cable into the housing. 3. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds
(Fig. 40). 4. Install steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3553
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Transmission Mode Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3557
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3558
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3559
Autostick Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3565
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3566
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3567
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3568
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3569
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3570
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3571
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3576
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3577
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3578
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Input Speed Sensor (EATX)
Output Speed Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 293), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 294),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 3581
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 295), an AC voltage is generated and sent to the
TCM. The TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input speed signal with output speed signal to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 3582
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates an AC signal as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 298), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 299),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 3583
OPERATION
The Output Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the output shaft is rotating. As the rear
planetary carrier park pawl lugs pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 300), an AC voltage is generated and
sent to the TCM. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following: Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 3584
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Signal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
The vehicle speed signal is taken from the Output Speed Sensor. The TCM converts this signal
into a pulse per mile signal and sends it to the PCM.
The PCM, in turn, sends the vehicle speed message across the communication bus to the BCM.
The BCM sends this signal to the Instrument Cluster to display vehicle speed to the driver. The
vehicle speed signal pulse is roughly 8000 pulses per mile.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
input speed sensor connector.
4. Unscrew and remove input speed sensor (Fig. 296).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 297) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position. 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Install air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 5. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor > Page 3587
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect output speed sensor
connector.
4. Unscrew and remove output speed sensor (Fig. 301).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 302) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position (Fig. 302). 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3592
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
T350 - Manual Transmission DESCRIPTION - VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3593
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect the speed sensor connector (Fig. 151).
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing to prevent dirt from entering the
transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt (Fig. 151). 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle
during sensor removal, drive gear must be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion gear to speed sensor (Fig. 151). 2. Using a NEW O-ring, install the speed sensor to
the transaxle (Fig. 151). 3. Install the bolt and torque to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.). 4. Connect speed
sensor connector (Fig. 151). 5. Lower vehicle and road test to verify proper speedometer operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle
Fluctuation/RPM Sag
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle
Fluctuation/RPM Sag
NUMBER: 18-024-05
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 17, 2005
THE DRBIII(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE ON DealerCONNECT.
FOR MARKETS OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA, THE FLASH FILES AND
REPROGRAMMING INSTRUCTIONS WILL BE AVAILABLE ON ITIL/ISIS DVD JULY, 2005.
SUBJECT: Flash: Driveability Improvements
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager
This bulletin applies to:
^ PL vehicles equipped with a 2.0L engine (sales code ECB or ECH).
^ PT vehicles equipped with a 2.0L or 2.4L engine (sales code ECC or EDZ).
^ RS vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code EDZ).
^ RG vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code EDZ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
All Vehicles
The vehicle operator may experience idle fluctuation.
PL Vehicles with a 2.0L Engine (sales codes ECH) or a 2.0L engine and manual transmission
(sales code ECB and DD5 or DDR)
The vehicle operator may experience one or more of the following:
^ Hard start at temperatures between 9° (48.2° F) and 65° C (149° F).
^ RPM bump while driving when the A/C is turned on.
^ RPM sag on throttle tip-in or tip-out.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate diagnostic procedures on TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the customer describes the Symptom/Condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle
Fluctuation/RPM Sag > Page 3602
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Whenever a controller is programmed, the software in the DRBIII(R); must be programmed with the
latest revision level available.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted and then follow the
directions on the DRBIII(R).
1. Before beginning the reprogramming procedure, remove any old flash reprogramming files from
the DRBIII(R) memory. To clear the memory from the MAIN MENU:
a. Simultaneously press the "MORE" and "YES" keys.
b. A screen will appear requesting a "COLD BOOT".
c. Follow the on screen instructions by selecting the "F4" key.
d. When the DRBIII(R) reboots to the MAIN MENU, proceed to Step # 2
2. With the ignition switch in the "RUN" position, determine the original part number of the PCM
currently in the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Module Display"
f. Record the "PCM part # " on the repair order for later reference.
3. Connect the DRBIII(R) to TechCONNECT. Open TechTOOLS and verify that the "DRBIII(R)
Status: Connected" message is in the upper right corner of the TechTOOLS screen.
4. Enter the "PCM part # " recorded in Step # 2 in the "Parts Criteria" area and select "Show
Updates". TechTOOLS will populate the appropriate calibration.
5. Select the calibration.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle
Fluctuation/RPM Sag > Page 3603
6. Select the "DRBIII" radio button which is next to the "Download/Update" button.
7. Select the "Download/Update" button.
8. Monitor the "Flash Download/Update Progress" window on the TechCONNECT and follow the
instructions on TechCONNECT. When the flash process is complete, proceed to Step # 9.
9. Disconnect the DRBIII(R) from TechCONNECT.
10. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts.
11. Connect the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle.
12. Download the flash from the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "Vehicle Flash"
b. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the flash process is complete, proceed to
Step # 13.
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. Check
all modules using "Module Scan", record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their
DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law.
13. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle
Fluctuation/RPM Sag > Page 3604
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T - Delayed Gear
Engagement/Possible DTC's
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Gear
Engagement/Possible DTC's
NUMBER: 21-004-05
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: January 22, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-007-04, DATED MAY 11,
2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES, ADDITIONAL MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Transmission Delayed Engagement
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the front pump assembly in the transmission and
checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) for the latest software revision level.
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
**2002** - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 (KJ) Liberty
2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
**2002** 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
**2002**2003 (PL) Neon
**2002** 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
**2002** 2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
**2002** 2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T - Delayed Gear
Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3609
NOTE:
Refer to the table for specific applications.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle operator may experience a delayed or temporary loss of transmission engagement after
initial start up. The condition follows an extended soak (several hours) and may be accompanied
by a harsh 4-3 downshift.
Technician may find Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P1791/P0944 - Loss of Prime.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBII I®) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine systems
are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition or the technician finds DTC P1791 or
P0944, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T - Delayed Gear
Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3610
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to Step # 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to Step # 3.
2. Replace the transmission oil pump. Refer to the service information available in TechCONNECT
Group-21, Transmission.
3. Verify the controller has the latest software revision level.
4. If the controller is at the latest revision level, no further action is necessary. If a flash update is
available reprogram the controller as instructed in Service Bulletin 21-006-03 Rev. A.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's
NUMBER: 18-026-03 REV A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 12, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-026-03, DATED JUNE 27,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL MODELS, ADDITIONAL
SYMPTOMS/CONDITIONS, ADDITIONAL TOOLS, UPDATED REPAIR PROCEDURE AND A
REVISED NOTE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Long Crank No Start/MIL Illumination
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software.
MODELS: 2003 (PL) Neon 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser 2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International
Markets) 2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager **2004 (CS) Pacifica**
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to RS and RG vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code EDZ) and
all CS, PL and PT vehicles built before date indicated below.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3615
Engine no start (engine will start immediately after cycling the ignition key), MIL illumination with
any or all of the false Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
NOTE:
Additional false DTC's may be set.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or the technician experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the
Repair Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3616
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Whenever a controller is programmed, the software in the DRBIII(R), must be programmed with the
latest revision level available.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted and then follow the
directions on the DRBIII(R).
1. With the ignition switch in the "RUN" position, determine the original part number of the PCM
currently in the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b."1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Module Display"
f. Record the first ten (10) characters of the "PCM part #" on the repair order for later reference.
NOTE:
If the PCM is not operational, the part number can be obtained from the label on the old controller.
If the label on the controller is not legible, proceed to next step.
2. Page back to the "Main Menu"
3. Determine if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "System Monitor"
e. "J1850 Module Scan"
f. Look for "SKIM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3617
4. If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then proceed to step 5. If the vehicle is equipped with
SKIM obtain the vehicle Personal Identification Number (PIN) before continuing with step 5. This
information is available from one of the following:
a. The original selling invoice.
b. The DealerCONNECT system under the "Sales" or "Parts" tabs - select "Key Codes".
c. By contacting the Daimlerchrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at 1-800-992-1997.
CAUTION:
Failure to install the SKIM pin number into the module after flashing the PCM will cause a start and
stall condition.
5. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify battery state is above 11.5 volts.
6. If the old "PCM part #" is known, proceed to step 12. If the old "PCM part #" is not known,
proceed to next step.
7. On DealerCONNECT select the "Service" tab.
8. Select "Vehicle Information Plus".
9. Manually enter the VIN and mileage and select "Enter".
10. Select the "Vehicle Option" tab.
11. Under the "Vehicle Option" window, identify and record:
a. Engine.
b. Emissions (Federal or California)
c. Transmission (Automatic, 5-speed manual, etc.).
12. Connect the DRBIII(R) to TechCONNECT and the vehicle. Open TechTOOLS and verify that
the "DRBIII(R) Status: Connected" message is in the upper right corner of the TechTOOLS screen.
13. TechTOOLS should automatically populate the VIN in the "Vehicle Criteria" area and the
available updates. If not, manually enter the VIN then TechTOOLS will populate the available
updates.
14. Determine the proper calibration:
a. If the old "PCM part #" is known, enter the part number of the old controller in the "Parts Criteria"
pin window. Proceed to step 15.
b. If the old "PCM part #" is not known, select the correct calibration based on the information that
was recorded from "Vehicle Options" in step 11.
15. Select the correct calibration.
16. Select the "Download/Update" button.
17. Monitor the "Flash Download/Update Progress" window on the TechCONNECT and follow the
instructions on TechCONNECT/DRBIII(R). When the flash process is completed, proceed to next
step.
18. Enter the VIN in the PCM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "Engine"
e. "Miscellaneous"
f. "Check VIN"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3618
g. If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM proceed to step 18h. If the vehicle is equipped with
SKIM follow the directions on the DRBIII(R). When the VIN and SKIM key has been programmed,
proceed to step 19.
h. Enter the VIN as requested by the DRBIII(R).
19. Update the PCM mileage. Using the DRBIII(R)select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Miscellaneous"
f. "Check PCM Odometer"
g. "NO"
h. Enter the current odometer mileage and then press "Enter".
I. Cycle the ignition key to the OFF position and back to the ON position and then press "Enter".
20. Proceed as follows:
a. If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, proceed to step 22.
b. If the vehicle is equipped with a non-turbo engine and manual transmission, it is not necessary to
set the pinion factor. Proceed to step 23.
c. If the vehicle is equipped with a Turbo engine and manual transmission, proceed to step 21.
21. On vehicles equipped with a Turbo engine and manual transmission, set the Pinion Factor.
Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Miscellaneous"
f. "Pinion Factor"
g. Select the correct tire size and then select "Page Back" to exit.
h. Proceed to step 24.
22. On vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission, set the Pinion Factor. Using the
DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Transmission"
e. "Transmission Module"
f. "Miscellaneous"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No
Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3619
g. "Pinion Factor"
h. Select the correct tire size and then select "Page Back" to exit.
I. Enter "Quick Learn" and then follow the instructions on the DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. Check
all modules using "Module Scan", record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their
DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law.
23. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 3624
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 3625
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 3626
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-018-03 > Apr > 03 > Engine Controls - Erroneous
MIL/DTC's
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - Erroneous
MIL/DTC's
NUMBER: 18-018-03
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. THE MDS2 MUST BE OPERATING WITH
CIS CD2132 OR HIGHER, AVAILABLE MAY 12, 2003. THE DRBIII(R) MUST BE OPERATING AT
LEVEL 55.7. ISIS MUST BE AT CD2132 (AVAILABLE JUNE 4, 2003) OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination, Erroneous Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PL) SRT-4
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO PL VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L ENGINE (SALES CODES
ECB OR ECH) OR A 2.4L ENGINE (SALES CODE EDV) BUILT ON OR BEFORE MARCH 31,
2003 (MDH 0331XX) AND PT VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L ENGINE (SALES CODE ECC)
OR A 2.41 ENGINE (SALES CODE EDZ OR EDV) BUILT ON OR BEFORE APRIL 28, 2003 (MDH
0428XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle operator may experience MIL illumination.
Technicians may find the following DTC(s):
P0071 - Ambient Temperature Sensor Performance.
P0111 - Intake Air Temperature Sensor Stuck.
P0116 - Engine Coolant Temperature Performance.
P0129 - Barometric Pressure Out of Range - Low (Turbo only).
P1115 - General Temperature Sensor Performance.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or the technician experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the
Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-018-03 > Apr > 03 > Engine Controls - Erroneous
MIL/DTC's > Page 3631
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
WHENEVER A CONTROLLER IS REPLACED OR REPROGRAMMED, THE SOFTWARE IN THE
CONTROLLER AND DRBIII(R) MUST BE VERIFIED AS HAVING THE LATEST REVISION
LEVEL.
1. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
2. Flash the PCM using the TechCONNECT/MDS2 and DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
DUE TO THE PCM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (TCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, ETC.) WITHIN THE VEHICLE, IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME
DTC'S MAY CAUSE THE MEL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
3. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the PCM as necessary and cover the label(s) with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-018-03 > Apr > 03 > Engine Controls - Erroneous
MIL/DTC's > Page 3632
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-003-03 > Feb > 03 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/False
DTC P0137 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/False
DTC P0137 Set
NUMBER: 18-003-03
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 21, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. THE TechCONNECT/MDS2 MUST BE
OPERATING WITH CIS CD2127 OR HIGHER, AVAILABLE MARCH 3, 2003.
SUBJECT: Flash: Erroneous Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0137
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) NEON/SX 2.0
NOTE:
THE BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE JANUARY 2, 2003 (MDH 0102XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
MIL illumination, DTC P0137, "02 SENSOR VOLTAGE LOW".
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRB III(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all
engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the Symptom/Condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
WHENEVER A PCM/TCM IS REPLACED OR REPROGRAMMED, THE SOFTWARE IN THE
CONTROLLER AND DRBIII(R) MUST BE VERIFIED AS HAVING THE LATEST REVISION
LEVEL.
1. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
2. Flash the PCM using the TechConnect (MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-003-03 > Feb > 03 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/False
DTC P0137 Set > Page 3637
DUE TO THE PCM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (TCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, ETC.) WITHIN THE VEHICLE, IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME
DTC'S MAY CAUSE THE MIL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
3. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the PCM and/or TCM as necessary and cover the label(s) with the clear
plastic overlay.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-003-03 > Feb > 03 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/False
DTC P0137 Set > Page 3638
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-037-05 Date: 051020
Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
NUMBER: 18-037-05
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 20, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-020-02, DATED JUNE 24, 2002 WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Flash Programming Failure Recovery Using DRBIII(R)
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin provides guidelines, to minimize flash reprogramming problems, and
information on recovery procedures for failed flash attempts.
MODELS:
1992 - 1994 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2003 (AB) Ramvan/Wagon
1992 - 1994 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1995 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1992 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1994 - 2002 (BRIBE) Ram Pickup
2004 - 2006 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2005 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2005 (KJ) Liberty/Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2003 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2005 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2006 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2006 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3644
1995 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
NOTE:
Many of the reasons a flash reprogramming procedure may not complete are documented in this
service bulletin, but if you are constantly having issues performing the flash reprogramming
procedure using a specific DRBIII(R), it is suggested you send the DRBIII(R) in question to
SPX/Miller Special Tools for service.
Occasionally a flash update procedure may not complete properly and/or the diagnostic equipment
may lock up or become disconnected during the procedure. Flash Reprogramming is a "CRITICAL
PROCESS"; an error may result in a no-start/failed control module. Most modules, encountering an
interruption or failure while reprogramming, are recoverable; a recoverable module is not covered
under the provisions of the warranty.
This service bulletin covers items that may cause this condition, a process to restart the flash
procedure, and miscellaneous information that will help prevent needless replacement of control
modules.
GENERAL: Flash Reprogramming is only authorized by a specific SERVICE BULLETIN, or
RECALL.
Review the entire Service Bulletin/Recall prior to performing a flash reprogramming update. Often
other parts may need to be serviced, replaced, or tested, prior to flash reprogramming, and ARE
REQUIRED as part of completing the Service Bulletin/Recall.
When flashing a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or Transmission Control Module (TCM) there
are other legal requirements with labeling issues that are included in those service bulletins.
Other non-emission related modules, such as instrument clusters and Body Control Modules
(BCMs) do not require labels.
FLASH REPROGRAMMING SEQUENCE OF EVENTS
The process of flash reprogramming is similar to flashing the BIOS on a Personal Computer.
Interruptions, voltage problems, and a variety of other outside interactions can potentially interfere
with the process. This document seeks to provide information to minimize problems associated
with vehicle control module flash reprogramming. The description that follows is for most PCMs
and some TCMs. Other modules use different initiation procedures.
The process starts by selecting an update from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS and then
"loading" that update into the DRBIII(R). Once the flash reprogramming update is loaded into the
DRBIII(R), and before the flash reprogramming begins, the DRBIII(R) verifies that the update
loaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS is the proper update for the module. This is done
using part number supersedence. This verification occurs only if an update is required, available
(on the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS) and has been selected for programming.
^ The module is then placed into "Boot Strap" programming mode by the DRBIII(R). This module
mode gives the DRBIII(R) permission and the ability to proceed with the flash reprogramming
session.
^ Next, the current part number, which resides in the module's flash memory, is stored in a "Safe
Memory" location within the module. This memory location is not affected by flash memory erasure
and reprogramming, which are to follow.
^ Once the part number is safely stored, the flash memory in the control module is erased. From
this point forward any interruption in the flash process,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3645
will result in a Non-Responsive module (NR). A NR module is a module that is either partially
erased or partially programmed.
^ After erasure, the actual reprogramming procedure starts, and the update software is
programmed into the flash memory within the module.
^ When reprogramming is completed, the flash memory is verified through an internal process in
the DRBIII(R) using a "Check Sum". This value is compared against another value that represents
what should be in memory and when matched, verifies successful reprogramming.
^ Next, a DRBIII(R) prompt is displayed instructing that the ignition switch be turned OFF. The
module exits the "Boot Strap" mode when the switch is turned off.
^ After a slight pause, the DRBIII(R) will prompt for the ignition switch to be turned ON. The
DRBIII(R) then reads the new part number in flash memory (along with a new computer program
the new part number is placed into the module's memory). If the new part number matches the
expected part number, the flash reprogramming session has completed successfully.
SOFTWARE VERSIONS MUST BE CURRENT
Before attempting a flash reprogramming session using the TechCONNECT Client, make sure you
have the most current DRBIII(R) software installed.
To verify whether your DRBIII(R) software is current, check the upper right-hand corner of the
TechCONNECT Client screen for DRBIII(R) Available Version, DRBIII(R) Current Version.
Often, because of multiple DRBIII(R)s in the shop, not all will get updated on a timely manner. The
installed DRBIII(R) software version can generally be found at the bottom center of most screens.
Alternately the version can be checked by pressing 6, 2, 5 from the DRBIII(R) Main Menu and
comparing it to what is available from a current TechCONNECT Client as described above.
If the TechCONNECT Client is current and the DRBIII(R) is not, it may be due to the fact that the
TechCONNECT Client does not force DRBIII(R) updates for "minor" revisions. Changes and new
support are added to the Vehicle Flash application on "minor" revisions on a regular basis. This is
why your TechCONNECT Client and DRBIII(R) must have the LATEST software revisions
installed.
DO NOT PASS on the option for updating to a "minor" revision!
Major updates require the DRBIII(R) to be updated prior to allowing any flash programming.
DRBIII(R) CABLES
A NEW DRBIII(R) cable was released as an Essential Service Tool! CH7000A - 8 ft.
Cable, DRBIII(R) to OBDII (J1962) DLC Connector.
CH7000A is the required cable for ALL flash reprogramming. The older CH7000 cable can be used
for diagnostics ONLY. One (1) cable was shipped to all dealerships. Easily identified, the correct
cable has a RED connector, which plugs into the DRBIII(R).
The cable modification enhances the DRBIII(R) communication capabilities when dealing with the
flash requirements of certain controllers/ECUs affected in part by the recent changes in DLC
connector configurations.
The new cable is required for ALL flash reprogramming sessions, and can be used wherever the
previous CH700017001 cables were used.
While not recommended for flash reprogramming usage, if you require a longer cable, there is also
a 12-foot cable released under pin CH7001A
The production of the previous CH700017001 cables has ceased. All orders placed will be
superseded to part number CH7000A/CH7001A.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3646
NOTE:
Consider all cables wear items. Always inspect for worn, damaged cables, connectors that are
damaged or do not lock securely, and all mating connections including checking for corrosion on
the pins. REPLACE ALL suspect cables. Do not use worn or damaged cables when flash
reprogramming.
Failure to use the new cable or to use a damaged cable often results in failed flash reprogramming
sessions.
The 2 door Sebring, Stratus, and Avenger coupes (supplied by MMC) generally use the CH7O1O
cable (Pre-OBDII MMC vehicles will use the CH7005 cable).
TechCONNECT CABLE (GPIB)
Replace any suspect GPIB cable.
The GPIB cable provides the connection between TechCONNECT Client and the DRBIII(R).
This cable is used by the TechCONNECT Client for vehicle part number reads and to send update
files to the DRBIII(R).
Inspect this cable for loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If
this cable becomes disconnected during a flash session, you may have to reload the update file
that you selected on the TechCONNECT Client.
TROUBLESHOOTING CONNECTIVITY OF THE DRBIII(R) UNIT TO THE TechCONNECT
APPLICATION.
1. Turn-on the power to the DRBIII(R) unit.
2. Select option 2 "Connect to TechCONNECT" and press Enter.
3. Attach the male mini D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable (part number
CH7035B) to the DRBIII(R) unit.
4. Insure that the larger female D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable is
properly attached to the male D-shell amphenol GPIB connector on the GPIB-USB-B protocol
converter, (part number CHGPIB-B).
5. Attach the USB cable from the GPIB-USB-B protocol converter to one of the USB ports on the
rear panel of the client CPU.
6. When the cable is attached to the USB port of the CPU for the first time, Windows 2000 will
detect the device and install software for it. Please wait for 25-30 seconds to complete the
installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3647
ISIS NULL MODEM CABLE
Replace any suspect null modem cables.
International (ISIS), a PC-based CD program similar to TechCONNECT Client uses a null modem
cable for vehicle part number reads and to send update files to the DRBIII(R). Inspect this cable for
loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If this cable becomes
disconnected during a flash download session, you will have to reload the update file or files.
GENERAL NOTES FOR CABLES AND VEHICLE CONNECTIONS
Consider ALL cables to be wear items.
Many successful dealers have dedicated cables devoted to "Flash ONLY".
Always have spare CH7000A, CH7010 and CH2002 GPIB or null modem cables available.
Inspect vehicle diagnostic connectors for potential problems that might cause communication
interruptions.
There are now clip repair kits available through teamPSE to replace the retaining clips for two of
these cables. To protect the DRBIII(R) from internal damage, the clips are designed to fail at above
25 lbs. of axial force. Kits are described in the table.
It is a good practice to discard cables that have damage to the pins, cuts, corrosion, or general
damage beyond the retaining clips.
ST22 SEBRING STRATUS 2 DOOR COUPES (2001-2005)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3648
These vehicles use MMC based modules. The CH8432 Supplemental Reprogramming Tool (SRT)
was shipped as a 2001 Essential Tool. The flash reprogramming update files will be downloaded
from TechCONNECT Client to the SRT for flash reprogramming sessions on these vehicles. Users
should closely follow the instructions that come with the tool. If the tool has not been initialized,
there is a known condition where it may take up to 5 or more attempts for it to fully initialize and
become functional.
NOTE:
Once it has successfully flashed, it is initialized and no further action is required.
PREPARING TO FLASH
It is highly recommended that a sign, or other process, be used that notifies other users that a
FLASH SESSION IS IN-PROGRESS and must NOT be interrupted. Interrupting some flash
reprogramming sessions at critical junctures can render a module inoperative. Another user may
not realize that a flash session is in-progress and may disturb or disconnect the DRBIII(R) or do
something on the vehicle that could interrupt the flash process.
Before starting the flash session, read, record and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle.
Also "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R) and download the flash since this will erase the flash file from the
DRBIII(R) memory. (To "Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the
same time. Then press "F4").
Be sure to arrange the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R) so that no cables are stretched across an
area where someone might trip over or kick a cable. When setting up your DRBIII(R), insure that it
rests on a surface where it will not fall or be bumped during reprogramming e.g.: DRBIII's have
been known to be swept off vehicle windshields by accident when a user bumps the wiper switch).
Check User settings on the DRBIII(R). From the DRBIII(R) Main menu, press 6,1 and check to
make sure item 1. Echo on PC is set to OFF. On occasion, when Echo on PC is set to ON, flash
reprogramming errors may occur.
VEHICLE BATTERY VOLTAGE
The flash programming procedure puts a load on the electrical system that may last from five to
twenty minutes depending on the particular flash reprogramming update. Connect a battery
charger to the vehicle. Set the charger to as close to 14 volts as possible. If the charger has a
timer, set it for 30 minutes BEFORE starting a flash reprogramming session. This will help to
prevent unwanted resets by either the DRBIII(R) and/or the vehicle module that are caused by
voltage fluctuations.
Alternately, as a bare minimum, use a "Battery Jump Box" when a battery charger is unavailable to
ensure adequate and stable system voltages on the module being flash reprogrammed.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Connected/Disconnected Flash Mode Using TechCONNECT
CONNECTED MODE FLASHING USING TechCONNECT
NOTE:
Capable but not recommended.
In this mode, the DRBIII(R) remains connected to the TechCONNECT Client and the vehicle
throughout the flash session. The DRBIII(R) is connected to the TechCONNECT Client using the
GPIB (CH7035) cable and to the vehicle using the vehicle I/O cable (the CH7000A for most
vehicles).
This mode is useful when the TechCONNECT Client is next to the vehicle being flashed.
Another advantage of this mode is that you are able to determine all available flash updates for the
vehicle you are connected to by clicking on the "Read Part Number(s) From Vehicle" button.
Again, it is important that other users do not attempt to reboot or move the TechCONNECT Client
while a flash update is in-progress.
The reprogramming procedure of this mode is initiated by selecting the controller option and
clicking "Download/Update" button on the TechCONNECT client.
DISCONNECTED FLASH MODE
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3649
This is the preferred method.
This mode allows a user to flash a vehicle without being connected to the TechCONNECT Client.
This is a popular mode for flashing in a remote area of the service garage or in a back lot.
Before you attempt to use this mode, you must configure the DRBIII(R) for the desired update(s).
To do this, you must connect the DRBIII(R) to the TechCONNECT Client using the GPIB cable and
the CH7025 cable. It is not necessary to be connected to a vehicle. The GPIB (CH7035) cable will
be used to communicate with the TechCONNECT Client (for update file downloading) while the
CH7025 cable is used to provide power to the DRBIII(R).
After making the above connections, you are able to select one or more updates that you want to
perform. These selections are made by highlighting the desired updates and then clicking on the
"Download/Update" button by selecting the DRBIII(R) option on the TechCONNECT client.
Obviously, the DRBIII(R) does not have unlimited memory. If the file size of the selected updates
exceeds 948 KB, the "DRB Space Used" indicator (at the bottom-center of the TechCONNECT
Client screen) will change color from GREEN to RED. At this point you must de-select entries until
the indicator changes color to GREEN again.
When the updates have finished downloading, you may disconnect from the TechCONNECT Client
and take the DRBIII(R) to wherever the vehicle is located. The updates will remain in DRBIII(R)
memory for 8 hours while the DRBIII(R) is without power. If the DRBIII(R) is powered up for several
minutes before the 8 hour time period has expired, the update files will remain on the DRBIII(R) for
another 8 hours without power.
To start the actual flash process, after connecting to the vehicle in Disconnected Mode, you must
press "7 - Vehicle Flash" from the Main Menu on the DRBIII(R). Step by step instruction will follow
on the DRBIII(R) display. As with Connected Flash Mode, take the necessary precautions to insure
that others are aware of the flash session and that nothing disturbs the vehicle, DRBIII(R), or
cabling while performing the flash. Remember to use a battery charger set to 14 volts or a "battery
jump box".
Pay Attention While Performing Flash Reprogram Procedures
PAY ATTENTION WHILE PERFORMING FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURES
Before downloading the flash files, double check to see if the files that you have selected are the
appropriate ones for that vehicle. Don't forget about the "Read Part Numbers From Vehicle" option
on TechCONNECT Client, this can be of great assistance when trying to flash a module. If the files
selected don't download on the first attempt, try again.
The technician should NOT leave the vehicle when flash reprogramming a module.
Again, check to make sure that all cable connections are secure and that the DRBIII(R) rests on a
stable surface. If you are using a battery charger, insure that the settings and charging times are
correct and that the battery post clamps are securely fastened.
Read, record, and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle. Read and record the module type and part
number from the module that is to be flash reprogrammed.
Some control modules are not "abort-recovery" capable. When this is true, the scan tool will
indicate so by displaying a WARNING message prior to the start of reprogramming. For these
modules it is especially important that all precautions and procedures, outlined here, are carefully
followed.
Pay special attention to DRBIII(R) screen directions relating to key cycles. Missing a "Key ON" or
"Key OFF" can cause the module to have to be reflashed again. Due to the variety of module types
and vehicle options, you can't always anticipate key prompts, so be alert and ready to respond to
DRBIII(R) instructions.
Some screens will also instruct that certain modules, connectors or fuses be disconnected or pulled
prior to the start of reprogramming and re-installed immediately after completion. Be careful not to
anticipate the steps or order of operations for reprogramming any vehicle modules. Because of the
many possible changes that occur with each new release of scan tool software, always allow the
TSB/Recall and scan tool instructions to be your guide while performing flash reprogramming.
Flash reprogramming sessions usually range from 5 to 20 minutes. If the flash session has not
completed within 25 minutes after starting a flash reprogramming update, an error has most likely
occurred (Record the message that appears on the screen when a failure occurs). If this is the
case, or if you know that the flash process was interrupted, cycle the ignition key (OFF to the
locked position, then back ON). Reset the DRBIII(R) (power down for 4 seconds and then power
up) before attempting to restart the flash process. If the module still won't respond, turn the ignition
key off, disconnect the module from the vehicle for 2 minutes, reconnect the module, turn the
ignition key to run and try to restart the flash process again.
Regardless of what mode that you are in (Connected Flash or Disconnected Flash), if you have
tried twice (2 times) unsuccessfully to do a flash recovery and ALL DRBIII(R) instructions were
followed, perform the following:
^ Cold boot the DRBIII(R). This resets memory and removes all update files from the DRBIII(R).
(Push MORE and YES buttons at the same time, then press F4).
^ Reload the flash update file from the TechCONNECT Client.
^ If it fails to complete in the connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before
re-attempting the flash download to the DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3650
^ Proceed to reflash the module.
On vehicles that have multiple flash updates available, always complete and verify each flash
update before attempting the next one.
After all flash reprogramming is completed, read and erase all DTCs in all modules on the vehicle.
A variety of DTCs may be set, which are usually related to a loss of communication with the
module(s) being reprogrammed.
Verify the update by reading the new part number using the DRBIII(R). A good double check is to
read the part number using DRBIII(R) stand alone.
At times, other modules, wired in parallel, to the DLC connector have prevented flash
reprogramming sessions to be successful. After the failed attempt, review the appropriate wiring
diagram for the vehicle you are flash reprogramming and, with the key "OFF"; disconnect the other
modules and retry the flash. Complete the flash, turn the key "OFF" and reconnect any modules
that were disconnected. Refer to the "Programmable Modules" section later in this document for
more information.
Error Messages
ERROR MESSAGES
Block Echo/Compare Errors
Block Echo and Block Compare errors are often caused by voltage fluctuations, faulty I/O cables
(CH7OOOA, CH7005, CH7010) or faulty communication connections at the diagnostic connector.
Inspect for these conditions and review the sections on Vehicle Battery Voltage and Cable
recommendations.
Checksum Errors
Checksum Errors are generally caused by corrupt flash update files, which can be caused by
DRBIII(R) memory problems. If the DRBIII(R) has been without power for more than 8 hours, the
update files and system memory could be in a corrupted state. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (To
"Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the same time. Then press
"F4"). Reload the flash update file(s) from the TechCONNECT CLIENT. If it fails to complete in the
connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before re-attempting the flash download to
the DRBIII(R). Then re-attempt the flash reprogramming process.
Enhanced and Original Abort Recovery
ENHANCED ABORT RECOVERY
Interruptions in the flash process are one of the main reasons for failed flash sessions and
non-responsive (NR) modules. Interrupting the flash process after the erase phase has started will
leave the control module in a non-functional state.
Generally, but not always, NR modules may be recovered successfully.
Briefly, abort recovery is the process used to get a NR module back to a fully functional state with
the latest software update. The technician should be familiar with the other sections in this
document and follow all DRBIII(R) user prompts carefully.
There are two methods for abort-recovery. The newer method is called "Enhanced Abort
Recovery". This is the preferred method since the original method takes several minutes longer
and requires the correct selection of module type from a list of possible PCM's or TCM's.
Starting with Release 60.1, a new useful feature was added to the flash reprogramming application
for Engine and Transmission control modules. The DRBIII(R) "writes" the YME and Controller Type
information to a "Safe Memory" location. This method allows for rapid recovery of the module part
number and minimizes errors that could otherwise be made by selecting the wrong controller type.
It also assumes that the user will attempt abort recovery for a failed flash attempt before moving to
another vehicle with the same DRBIII(R). If you need to move to another vehicle for flash
reprogramming you must erase the saved recovery information in order to successfully perform
flash reprogramming. Be careful to match the YME information displayed on the enhanced abort
recovery screen with the vehicle and module that you are attempting to recover. If you use the
recovery file on a different vehicle and module you could damage the module.
The recovery information will be displayed on your DRBIII(R), at the start of a flash session, only if
you previously encountered a problem that prevented a flash session from completing normally. If
your prior flash session was successful, the DRBIII(R) automatically erases the recovery file so that
the flash application will not show any recovery information at the start of your next flash session.
Enhanced abort recovery features:
^ Reduces the amount of time for the Module ID process.
^ Lowers the risk of possible user mistakes by presenting the user the Year, Model, Engine, and
Controller Type.
^ Currently only applicable to Engine and Transmission flash reprogramming.
^ The enhanced abort recovery file will only be erased upon a successful flash or manually by the
user.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3651
^ Cold booting (simultaneously pushing MORE & YES, then F4) the DRBIII(R) will not erase the
enhanced abort recovery file, but cold booting the DRBIII(R) will still erase the flash file so it can be
reloaded.
^ The user has a choice, at the start of a flash session, whether or not to use the enhanced abort
recovery feature. If the user chooses to erase the recovery file, then the DRBIII(R) will use the
original method of abort recovery.
^ Cycling the ignition key, when prompted by the DRBIII(R), is still necessary to put the controller
into bootstrap (reprogramming) mode.
ORIGINAL ABORT RECOVERY
If the choice is made to use the original method of abort recovery, a NR module is not always able
to provide the DRBIII with ID information. In this case the technician must enter this when prompted
by the DRBIII(R). Be patient when performing this process. If the module does not respond to
standard diagnostic requests, the DRBIII(R) may take several minutes before it determines that the
engine module is in a NR state. At this point, the DRBIII(R) displays the prompt "Could not
determine engine controller type. Please select from list" along with a list of possible controller
types (if the DRBIII(R) is attempting to identify a TCM, the prompt will say "trans" instead of
"engine" and list the possible trans controller types). Because of module variations, it is important
to correctly identify the PCM/TCM type so that the correct flash procedure is used. Failure to do
this will cause further problems and may damage the module. Tables are provided below to help
identify the proper module type to select. These tables correctly identify the modules that were on
the vehicles when they were built. However, some vehicles will have module types which were
superseded to a new type when a replacement part was installed (ie: EATX4 modules replaced
with an EATX4A). Correctly identify these modules using DRBIII(R) Standalone prior to attempting
flash reprogramming.
NOTE:
When instructed to turn the key to the LOCKED position, be sure that the key is not just turned to
the OFF position. The key must be rotated to the point at which it can be removed from the ignition
switch. On most vehicles the switch is on the steering column and at this position the steering
column is LOCKED. When instructed to turn the key to the RUN position, be careful not to turn the
key past this position which may engage the starter motor. This creates electrical noise which
interferes with the flash process.
General Steps for Abort Recovery
1. Review all Tips and Techniques before continuing. Pay special attention to the section on
Preparing to Flash a controller and to the Programmable Modules section.
2. Cycle the vehicle's ignition key to the LOCKED position and back to the RUN position.
3. Reset the DRBIII(R) by disconnecting the vehicle cable from the DRBIII(R) for 4 seconds and
then reconnecting the cable.
4. Depending on where the flash session was aborted, the DRBIII(R) may require that the
technician identify the control module type that was being flash reprogrammed. Use the PCM/TCM
configuration table below as a guide. This step is not necessary if using the enhanced abort
recovery method.
5. After selecting the proper control module type or choosing enhanced abort recovery, follow the
prompts that are displayed on the DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
If an error message is displayed at this point, an incorrect module type was most likely selected. If
this occurs, start the process over.
6. If the recovery process is unsuccessful, perform the following:
a. Review the TSB/Recall notice (authorizing the flash update) and all Tips and Techniques in this
document.
b. Reboot/Restart the TechCONNECT Client.
c. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (Press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R) at the same
time, then press F4).
d. Start this process over from item # 1. If using Disconnected Mode, the flash update will have to
be reloaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS DVD.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3652
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3653
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3654
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3655
Programmable Modules
The following pages list the various modules that have flash reprogramming capability. It does not
mean that a flash is currently available. What will be described are the module types and
variations, followed by items to note, and finally, abort recovery specifics if applicable.
Powertrain Modules - Engine and Transmission
ENGINE - POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3656
There are a variety of Engine (PCM) modules that are flash reprogrammable. Suggestions that are
somewhat unique to each type will have comments. Prior to reprogramming a PCM, retrieve the
module information and module type using your DRBII I®. PCM information is used by many
modules. Be sure to check DIG's before and after performing all flash reprogramming event.
The DTC's associated with flash reprogramming generally relate to "lack of communication" with
the other modules during the reprogramming session.
SBEC
Types:
SBEC, SBEC 2, SBEC 3, SBEC 3+, SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+, and SBEC 3B
NOTE:
During recovery, if the DRBIII® is not seeing the key off, you may need to remove power (B+) to
PCM by removing fuse(s) or disconnecting the PCM. When DRBIII® states to turn key ON,
reconnect fuse or harness connection.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow instructions on the DRBIII® for the module type. See table above.
^ Some SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+ AND SBEC 3B may be in a state where they can not correctly
identify a key cycle. In this case a Modified Key Cycle routine is required.
This state is present when the following message is displayed on the DRBIII(R): "Can not read Part
Number. Did not see Key On or PCM/TCM Controller may not be flashable". When this occurs
restart the flash session and when prompted to turn the ignition key to the LOCKED position, pull
the fuse(s) that supply battery power to the module instead. When prompted to turn the key to the
RUN position, replace the battery supply fuse(s) instead.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC, JTEC+
NOTE:
Viper ALL - Roll down windows especially Coupes before attempting a flash.
NOTE:
1999 WJ JTEC with Speed Proportional Steering module. Disconnect before and reconnect after
the PCM flash reprogramming session. Also see Transmission.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC
Types:
^ NGC 1, NGC 2, and NGC 3
NOTE:
There are derivatives of NGC 3 that will be significant when reprogramming and or testing. NGC
modules use one of the longest time spans for flash reprogramming (approximately 15 minutes).
The NGCI and NGC3 controllers incorporate both an engine as well as a transmission controller in
a common package. The NGC2 controller incorporates the engine controller and an Electronic
Throttle Control (ETC) module in place of the TCM. All NGC controllers can be visually identified by
noting its four (4) wiring connectors. On manual transmission applications and the NGC2, only 3
connectors may be populated with pins.
NOTE:
On certain vehicles, the ABS CAB module connector MUST be disconnected prior to performing
this Repair Procedure. The CAB module and the PCM are connected at the same diagnostic
connector pin (Pin # 9). Turn ignition switch to the OFF position, disconnect the CAB module
connector, and reprogram the PCM per the Repair Procedure. When reprogramming is complete
turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, connect the CAB module connector, and then check for
DTC's. If the PCM becomes "locked" during reprogramming because the ABS CAB module
connector was not disconnected, then the PCM may be recovered by following the procedure in
this NOTE.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3657
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ Power down the DRBIII(R) then cycle ignition before powering up the DRBIII(R) to attempt the
flash.
CUMMINS
Types:
^ CM551 and CM84x series
NOTE:
Cummins flash reprogrammable PCMs are used on 1998.5 and newer Dodge Trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. Model Year 2000 and earlier vehicles have one Engine
Control Fuse to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). Model Year 2001 and later have two Engine
Control Fuses (one 20 Amp and one 30 Amp) to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). The fuse(s)
are located in the PDC and need to be pulled/removed, when prompted, for at least 10 seconds.
SIEMENS
Types:
^ SIM-70
NOTE:
The SIM-70 is currently used on BUX PL and PG vehicles with a 1.6L ONLY. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
BOSCH
Types:
^ EDC15V, EDC15-C5, and EDC16
NOTE:
While there have been other Bosch modules, the EDC15V is not flash reprogrammable.
Transmission controllers are usually flashed on the vehicle (since 1996).
Technicians may set the pinion factor on "NEW" modules either before or after flash
reprogramming. Suggestions follow.
After flash reprogramming and before returning the vehicle to the customer, always perform a
"QuickLearn" to the TCM.
EATX
Types:
^ EATX, EATX 2, EATX 3, EATX 3A, EATX 3B, EATX 4, and EATX 4A
NOTE:
Table shows which TCM was installed "as-built". Often TCMs are superseded by parts and or a
service bulletin.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ 1999 - 2000 WJ and 2000 AN/DN using 4.7L engines the service replacement EATX4A part
numbers 56041814AD and 56028227AH currently display a P/N read failed error after the flash is
completed during PIN verification. This DOES NOT mean the flash failed. Check for the part
number using DRBIII(R) in standalone mode. This exists only for the service replacement modules
listed above. Flash reprogramming for OE modules flash and read the part number correctly.
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3658
^ NGC1, NGC2, NGC3
NOTE:
The NGC I1and NGC 3 have the EATX/XCORE and Engine modules combined. NGC 2 does not.
Vehicles with automatic transmissions using NGC2 will use an EATX4A.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ 2002 DR, 2002.5 DN, 2003 AN/DN and later with NGC have shown that in some instances the
CAB controller may need to be disconnected when attempting to flash the NGC controller. (This
should only be performed if an error occurs at the very beginning of the TCM flash portion.)
SIEMENS
Types:
^ EG552
NOTE:
EGS52 is used with the A580 automatic transmission WG Grand Cherokees with a 2.7L diesel
engine (BUX), ZH Crossfire and VA Sprinter.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC,JTEC+
NOTE:
Except for the 45RFE, 545RFE, and AW4 automatic transmissions, the JTEC controller also
provides transmission control functions on Dodge trucks and Jeep vehicles. Additionally, they are
used on some Cummins equipped Dodge trucks with manual and automatic transmissions.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
PRE 1996 EATX TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULES
Prior to 1996 there was not a vehicle SCI communication wire going to the FWD EATX controller
only to the PCM. Those vehicle TCMs only communicate to the DRBIII(R) using CCD
communications.
For these FWD vehicles, use the CH5500 kit and CH7025 DIN cable when connecting those
modules to the DRBIII(R) vehicle connector.
For 1992-1993 vehicles, the TCM modules were upgraded to MY1995 software. Because of this
you will need to use the Yellow SuperCard2, CH8361,to set pinion factor or when using a "new"
(superseded) TCM from parts as only the SuperCard2 properly sets the pinion factor on these
updated modules.
Additionally, when flashing or installing P/Ns 4796121, 4796122, 4796123, or 4796124.
The wire from cavity 49 must be removed from the TCM connector, refer to service bulletin
18-24-95.
Types:
^ TCCM
NOTE:
These modules are found on AN, DN, and DR trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3659
NON-POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULES
BODY CONTROL MODULE (BCM)
Types:
^ BCM
NOTE:
Body control modules are found on passenger vehicles.
NOTE:
The following vehicle BCMs support flash reprogramming: CS, JR, KJ, LH, RS, WJ, and ZB.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ BUX ONLY for 2001 JR - Compass/Mini Trip (BCM) Flash - Use special international release
software version 52.25
^ 2001 LH - there is NO abort recovery available for the BCM.
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE (CTM)
Types:
^ CTM
NOTE:
CTMs are found on: AB, AN, DN, BR, and BE trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER (EVIC)
Types:
^ EVIC
NOTE:
02-03 LH & WJ, and 03-04 KJ
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
FRONT CONTROL MODULE (FCM)
Types:
^ FCM
NOTE:
Front control modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (IPM)
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3660
^ 1PM
NOTE:
Integrated power modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
POWER LIFT GATE (PLG)
Types:
^ PLC
NOTE:
Power liftgate modules are found on CS and RS.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (PSDM)
Types:
^ PSDM
NOTE:
Passenger power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. DRIVER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (DSDM)
Types:
^ DSDM
NOTE:
Driver power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NOTE:
When flashing a vehicle that is equipped with both Passenger and Driver Power Sliding Doors, you
must Reboot the DRBIII(R) and cycle the ignition key before flashing the next door module.
DRIVER DOOR MODULE (DDM)
Types:
^ DDM
NOTE:
Driver Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER DOOR MODULE (PDM)
Types:
^ PDM
NOTE:
Passenger Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLUSTERS/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (MIC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3661
Types:
^ MICs, eMICs
NOTE:
MICs that have flash reprogramming are on the following vehicles: DR, JR, KJ, PL, PT, WJ, ZB
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. In certain cases, you will be asked to cycle the ignition key
and pull a specific fuse.
^ The DRBIII(R) may power down during the procedure with some modules. This is NORMAL and
is explained in the user prompts displayed during abort-recovery. Take the time to read and
understand the instructions before proceeding.
ALARM REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE (ARKEM)
Types:
^ ARKEM
NOTE:
Arkem modules are found on PL and PT vehicles. There are up to and after modules.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLIMATE CONTROL (ATC, HVAC)
Types:
^ HVAC, ATC, MTC
NOTE:
Generally, reprogramming for these modules is done using the standalone application rather than
the Vehicle Flash application.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
ADJUSTABLE PEDAL MODULE (APM)
Types:
^ APM
NOTE:
Found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
RAIN SENSOR MODULE (RSM)
Types:
^ RSM
NOTE:RSM modules are found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3662
INTRUSION TRANSCEIVER MODULE (ITM)
Types:
^ ITM
^ Updates for this module, to version 7.05 have involved a coordinated BCM flash update. See the
TSB for important instructions.
NOTE:
ITM modules are found on WJ (BUX) and KJ (BUX) vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEMS (SRS) - AIRBAGS, ETC.
Types:
^ SRS, ORC
NOTE:
While used on most vehicles, only CS, JR, LH, PT, RS, and WJ vehicles have the potential to
support flash updates.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle Fluctuation/RPM Sag
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Hard
Start/Idle Fluctuation/RPM Sag
NUMBER: 18-024-05
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 17, 2005
THE DRBIII(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE ON DealerCONNECT.
FOR MARKETS OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA, THE FLASH FILES AND
REPROGRAMMING INSTRUCTIONS WILL BE AVAILABLE ON ITIL/ISIS DVD JULY, 2005.
SUBJECT: Flash: Driveability Improvements
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager
This bulletin applies to:
^ PL vehicles equipped with a 2.0L engine (sales code ECB or ECH).
^ PT vehicles equipped with a 2.0L or 2.4L engine (sales code ECC or EDZ).
^ RS vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code EDZ).
^ RG vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code EDZ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
All Vehicles
The vehicle operator may experience idle fluctuation.
PL Vehicles with a 2.0L Engine (sales codes ECH) or a 2.0L engine and manual transmission
(sales code ECB and DD5 or DDR)
The vehicle operator may experience one or more of the following:
^ Hard start at temperatures between 9° (48.2° F) and 65° C (149° F).
^ RPM bump while driving when the A/C is turned on.
^ RPM sag on throttle tip-in or tip-out.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate diagnostic procedures on TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the customer describes the Symptom/Condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle Fluctuation/RPM Sag > Page 3667
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Whenever a controller is programmed, the software in the DRBIII(R); must be programmed with the
latest revision level available.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted and then follow the
directions on the DRBIII(R).
1. Before beginning the reprogramming procedure, remove any old flash reprogramming files from
the DRBIII(R) memory. To clear the memory from the MAIN MENU:
a. Simultaneously press the "MORE" and "YES" keys.
b. A screen will appear requesting a "COLD BOOT".
c. Follow the on screen instructions by selecting the "F4" key.
d. When the DRBIII(R) reboots to the MAIN MENU, proceed to Step # 2
2. With the ignition switch in the "RUN" position, determine the original part number of the PCM
currently in the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Module Display"
f. Record the "PCM part # " on the repair order for later reference.
3. Connect the DRBIII(R) to TechCONNECT. Open TechTOOLS and verify that the "DRBIII(R)
Status: Connected" message is in the upper right corner of the TechTOOLS screen.
4. Enter the "PCM part # " recorded in Step # 2 in the "Parts Criteria" area and select "Show
Updates". TechTOOLS will populate the appropriate calibration.
5. Select the calibration.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle Fluctuation/RPM Sag > Page 3668
6. Select the "DRBIII" radio button which is next to the "Download/Update" button.
7. Select the "Download/Update" button.
8. Monitor the "Flash Download/Update Progress" window on the TechCONNECT and follow the
instructions on TechCONNECT. When the flash process is complete, proceed to Step # 9.
9. Disconnect the DRBIII(R) from TechCONNECT.
10. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts.
11. Connect the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle.
12. Download the flash from the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "Vehicle Flash"
b. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the flash process is complete, proceed to
Step # 13.
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. Check
all modules using "Module Scan", record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their
DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law.
13. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-024-05 > May > 05 > Engine Controls - Hard Start/Idle Fluctuation/RPM Sag > Page 3669
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Gear
Engagement/Possible DTC's
NUMBER: 21-004-05
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: January 22, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-007-04, DATED MAY 11,
2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES, ADDITIONAL MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Transmission Delayed Engagement
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the front pump assembly in the transmission and
checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) for the latest software revision level.
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
**2002** - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 (KJ) Liberty
2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
**2002** 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
**2002**2003 (PL) Neon
**2002** 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
**2002** 2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
**2002** 2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3674
NOTE:
Refer to the table for specific applications.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle operator may experience a delayed or temporary loss of transmission engagement after
initial start up. The condition follows an extended soak (several hours) and may be accompanied
by a harsh 4-3 downshift.
Technician may find Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P1791/P0944 - Loss of Prime.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBII I®) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine systems
are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition or the technician finds DTC P1791 or
P0944, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3675
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to Step # 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to Step # 3.
2. Replace the transmission oil pump. Refer to the service information available in TechCONNECT
Group-21, Transmission.
3. Verify the controller has the latest software revision level.
4. If the controller is at the latest revision level, no further action is necessary. If a flash update is
available reprogram the controller as instructed in Service Bulletin 21-006-03 Rev. A.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Long
Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's
NUMBER: 18-026-03 REV A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 12, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-026-03, DATED JUNE 27,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL MODELS, ADDITIONAL
SYMPTOMS/CONDITIONS, ADDITIONAL TOOLS, UPDATED REPAIR PROCEDURE AND A
REVISED NOTE.
SUBJECT: Flash: Long Crank No Start/MIL Illumination
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
with new software.
MODELS: 2003 (PL) Neon 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser 2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International
Markets) 2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager **2004 (CS) Pacifica**
NOTE:
**This bulletin applies to RS and RG vehicles equipped with a 2.4L engine (sales code EDZ) and
all CS, PL and PT vehicles built before date indicated below.**
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3680
Engine no start (engine will start immediately after cycling the ignition key), MIL illumination with
any or all of the false Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
NOTE:
Additional false DTC's may be set.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or the technician experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the
Repair Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3681
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Whenever a controller is programmed, the software in the DRBIII(R), must be programmed with the
latest revision level available.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted and then follow the
directions on the DRBIII(R).
1. With the ignition switch in the "RUN" position, determine the original part number of the PCM
currently in the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b."1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Module Display"
f. Record the first ten (10) characters of the "PCM part #" on the repair order for later reference.
NOTE:
If the PCM is not operational, the part number can be obtained from the label on the old controller.
If the label on the controller is not legible, proceed to next step.
2. Page back to the "Main Menu"
3. Determine if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "System Monitor"
e. "J1850 Module Scan"
f. Look for "SKIM" in the list of modules.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3682
4. If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then proceed to step 5. If the vehicle is equipped with
SKIM obtain the vehicle Personal Identification Number (PIN) before continuing with step 5. This
information is available from one of the following:
a. The original selling invoice.
b. The DealerCONNECT system under the "Sales" or "Parts" tabs - select "Key Codes".
c. By contacting the Daimlerchrysler Customer Assistance Center (DCCAC) at 1-800-992-1997.
CAUTION:
Failure to install the SKIM pin number into the module after flashing the PCM will cause a start and
stall condition.
5. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify battery state is above 11.5 volts.
6. If the old "PCM part #" is known, proceed to step 12. If the old "PCM part #" is not known,
proceed to next step.
7. On DealerCONNECT select the "Service" tab.
8. Select "Vehicle Information Plus".
9. Manually enter the VIN and mileage and select "Enter".
10. Select the "Vehicle Option" tab.
11. Under the "Vehicle Option" window, identify and record:
a. Engine.
b. Emissions (Federal or California)
c. Transmission (Automatic, 5-speed manual, etc.).
12. Connect the DRBIII(R) to TechCONNECT and the vehicle. Open TechTOOLS and verify that
the "DRBIII(R) Status: Connected" message is in the upper right corner of the TechTOOLS screen.
13. TechTOOLS should automatically populate the VIN in the "Vehicle Criteria" area and the
available updates. If not, manually enter the VIN then TechTOOLS will populate the available
updates.
14. Determine the proper calibration:
a. If the old "PCM part #" is known, enter the part number of the old controller in the "Parts Criteria"
pin window. Proceed to step 15.
b. If the old "PCM part #" is not known, select the correct calibration based on the information that
was recorded from "Vehicle Options" in step 11.
15. Select the correct calibration.
16. Select the "Download/Update" button.
17. Monitor the "Flash Download/Update Progress" window on the TechCONNECT and follow the
instructions on TechCONNECT/DRBIII(R). When the flash process is completed, proceed to next
step.
18. Enter the VIN in the PCM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "Engine"
e. "Miscellaneous"
f. "Check VIN"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3683
g. If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM proceed to step 18h. If the vehicle is equipped with
SKIM follow the directions on the DRBIII(R). When the VIN and SKIM key has been programmed,
proceed to step 19.
h. Enter the VIN as requested by the DRBIII(R).
19. Update the PCM mileage. Using the DRBIII(R)select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Miscellaneous"
f. "Check PCM Odometer"
g. "NO"
h. Enter the current odometer mileage and then press "Enter".
I. Cycle the ignition key to the OFF position and back to the ON position and then press "Enter".
20. Proceed as follows:
a. If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, proceed to step 22.
b. If the vehicle is equipped with a non-turbo engine and manual transmission, it is not necessary to
set the pinion factor. Proceed to step 23.
c. If the vehicle is equipped with a Turbo engine and manual transmission, proceed to step 21.
21. On vehicles equipped with a Turbo engine and manual transmission, set the Pinion Factor.
Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. "Miscellaneous"
f. "Pinion Factor"
g. Select the correct tire size and then select "Page Back" to exit.
h. Proceed to step 24.
22. On vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission, set the Pinion Factor. Using the
DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2004 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Transmission"
e. "Transmission Module"
f. "Miscellaneous"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-026-03A > Sep > 03 > Engine Controls - Long Crank/No Start/MIL ON/DTC's > Page 3684
g. "Pinion Factor"
h. Select the correct tire size and then select "Page Back" to exit.
I. Enter "Quick Learn" and then follow the instructions on the DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. Check
all modules using "Module Scan", record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their
DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law.
23. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3689
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3690
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3691
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-018-03 > Apr > 03 > Engine Controls - Erroneous MIL/DTC's
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls Erroneous MIL/DTC's
NUMBER: 18-018-03
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. THE MDS2 MUST BE OPERATING WITH
CIS CD2132 OR HIGHER, AVAILABLE MAY 12, 2003. THE DRBIII(R) MUST BE OPERATING AT
LEVEL 55.7. ISIS MUST BE AT CD2132 (AVAILABLE JUNE 4, 2003) OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: Flash: MIL Illumination, Erroneous Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PL) SRT-4
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO PL VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L ENGINE (SALES CODES
ECB OR ECH) OR A 2.4L ENGINE (SALES CODE EDV) BUILT ON OR BEFORE MARCH 31,
2003 (MDH 0331XX) AND PT VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 2.0L ENGINE (SALES CODE ECC)
OR A 2.41 ENGINE (SALES CODE EDZ OR EDV) BUILT ON OR BEFORE APRIL 28, 2003 (MDH
0428XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle operator may experience MIL illumination.
Technicians may find the following DTC(s):
P0071 - Ambient Temperature Sensor Performance.
P0111 - Intake Air Temperature Sensor Stuck.
P0116 - Engine Coolant Temperature Performance.
P0129 - Barometric Pressure Out of Range - Low (Turbo only).
P1115 - General Temperature Sensor Performance.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or the technician experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the
Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-018-03 > Apr > 03 > Engine Controls - Erroneous MIL/DTC's > Page 3696
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
WHENEVER A CONTROLLER IS REPLACED OR REPROGRAMMED, THE SOFTWARE IN THE
CONTROLLER AND DRBIII(R) MUST BE VERIFIED AS HAVING THE LATEST REVISION
LEVEL.
1. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
2. Flash the PCM using the TechCONNECT/MDS2 and DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
DUE TO THE PCM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (TCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, ETC.) WITHIN THE VEHICLE, IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME
DTC'S MAY CAUSE THE MEL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
3. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the PCM as necessary and cover the label(s) with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-018-03 > Apr > 03 > Engine Controls - Erroneous MIL/DTC's > Page 3697
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-03 > Feb > 03 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/False DTC P0137 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/False DTC P0137 Set
NUMBER: 18-003-03
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 21, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. THE TechCONNECT/MDS2 MUST BE
OPERATING WITH CIS CD2127 OR HIGHER, AVAILABLE MARCH 3, 2003.
SUBJECT: Flash: Erroneous Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0137
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) NEON/SX 2.0
NOTE:
THE BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE JANUARY 2, 2003 (MDH 0102XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
MIL illumination, DTC P0137, "02 SENSOR VOLTAGE LOW".
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRB III(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all
engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the Symptom/Condition is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
WHENEVER A PCM/TCM IS REPLACED OR REPROGRAMMED, THE SOFTWARE IN THE
CONTROLLER AND DRBIII(R) MUST BE VERIFIED AS HAVING THE LATEST REVISION
LEVEL.
1. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
2. Flash the PCM using the TechConnect (MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-03 > Feb > 03 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/False DTC P0137 Set > Page 3702
DUE TO THE PCM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (TCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, ETC.) WITHIN THE VEHICLE, IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME
DTC'S MAY CAUSE THE MIL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
3. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the PCM and/or TCM as necessary and cover the label(s) with the clear
plastic overlay.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-003-03 > Feb > 03 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/False DTC P0137 Set > Page 3703
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-037-05 Date: 051020
Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery
NUMBER: 18-037-05
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: October 20, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-020-02, DATED JUNE 24, 2002 WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Flash Programming Failure Recovery Using DRBIII(R)
OVERVIEW: This Bulletin provides guidelines, to minimize flash reprogramming problems, and
information on recovery procedures for failed flash attempts.
MODELS:
1992 - 1994 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - 2003 (AB) Ramvan/Wagon
1992 - 1994 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1995 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1992 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1994 - 2002 (BRIBE) Ram Pickup
2004 - 2006 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2005 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2005 (KJ) Liberty/Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2003 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2005 (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - 2006 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2006 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3709
1995 - 2002 (SR) Viper
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2006 (ZB) Viper
1995 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2004 - 2006 (ZH) Crossfire Coupe/Crossfire Roadster
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
DISCUSSION:
NOTE:
Many of the reasons a flash reprogramming procedure may not complete are documented in this
service bulletin, but if you are constantly having issues performing the flash reprogramming
procedure using a specific DRBIII(R), it is suggested you send the DRBIII(R) in question to
SPX/Miller Special Tools for service.
Occasionally a flash update procedure may not complete properly and/or the diagnostic equipment
may lock up or become disconnected during the procedure. Flash Reprogramming is a "CRITICAL
PROCESS"; an error may result in a no-start/failed control module. Most modules, encountering an
interruption or failure while reprogramming, are recoverable; a recoverable module is not covered
under the provisions of the warranty.
This service bulletin covers items that may cause this condition, a process to restart the flash
procedure, and miscellaneous information that will help prevent needless replacement of control
modules.
GENERAL: Flash Reprogramming is only authorized by a specific SERVICE BULLETIN, or
RECALL.
Review the entire Service Bulletin/Recall prior to performing a flash reprogramming update. Often
other parts may need to be serviced, replaced, or tested, prior to flash reprogramming, and ARE
REQUIRED as part of completing the Service Bulletin/Recall.
When flashing a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or Transmission Control Module (TCM) there
are other legal requirements with labeling issues that are included in those service bulletins.
Other non-emission related modules, such as instrument clusters and Body Control Modules
(BCMs) do not require labels.
FLASH REPROGRAMMING SEQUENCE OF EVENTS
The process of flash reprogramming is similar to flashing the BIOS on a Personal Computer.
Interruptions, voltage problems, and a variety of other outside interactions can potentially interfere
with the process. This document seeks to provide information to minimize problems associated
with vehicle control module flash reprogramming. The description that follows is for most PCMs
and some TCMs. Other modules use different initiation procedures.
The process starts by selecting an update from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS and then
"loading" that update into the DRBIII(R). Once the flash reprogramming update is loaded into the
DRBIII(R), and before the flash reprogramming begins, the DRBIII(R) verifies that the update
loaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS is the proper update for the module. This is done
using part number supersedence. This verification occurs only if an update is required, available
(on the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS) and has been selected for programming.
^ The module is then placed into "Boot Strap" programming mode by the DRBIII(R). This module
mode gives the DRBIII(R) permission and the ability to proceed with the flash reprogramming
session.
^ Next, the current part number, which resides in the module's flash memory, is stored in a "Safe
Memory" location within the module. This memory location is not affected by flash memory erasure
and reprogramming, which are to follow.
^ Once the part number is safely stored, the flash memory in the control module is erased. From
this point forward any interruption in the flash process,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3710
will result in a Non-Responsive module (NR). A NR module is a module that is either partially
erased or partially programmed.
^ After erasure, the actual reprogramming procedure starts, and the update software is
programmed into the flash memory within the module.
^ When reprogramming is completed, the flash memory is verified through an internal process in
the DRBIII(R) using a "Check Sum". This value is compared against another value that represents
what should be in memory and when matched, verifies successful reprogramming.
^ Next, a DRBIII(R) prompt is displayed instructing that the ignition switch be turned OFF. The
module exits the "Boot Strap" mode when the switch is turned off.
^ After a slight pause, the DRBIII(R) will prompt for the ignition switch to be turned ON. The
DRBIII(R) then reads the new part number in flash memory (along with a new computer program
the new part number is placed into the module's memory). If the new part number matches the
expected part number, the flash reprogramming session has completed successfully.
SOFTWARE VERSIONS MUST BE CURRENT
Before attempting a flash reprogramming session using the TechCONNECT Client, make sure you
have the most current DRBIII(R) software installed.
To verify whether your DRBIII(R) software is current, check the upper right-hand corner of the
TechCONNECT Client screen for DRBIII(R) Available Version, DRBIII(R) Current Version.
Often, because of multiple DRBIII(R)s in the shop, not all will get updated on a timely manner. The
installed DRBIII(R) software version can generally be found at the bottom center of most screens.
Alternately the version can be checked by pressing 6, 2, 5 from the DRBIII(R) Main Menu and
comparing it to what is available from a current TechCONNECT Client as described above.
If the TechCONNECT Client is current and the DRBIII(R) is not, it may be due to the fact that the
TechCONNECT Client does not force DRBIII(R) updates for "minor" revisions. Changes and new
support are added to the Vehicle Flash application on "minor" revisions on a regular basis. This is
why your TechCONNECT Client and DRBIII(R) must have the LATEST software revisions
installed.
DO NOT PASS on the option for updating to a "minor" revision!
Major updates require the DRBIII(R) to be updated prior to allowing any flash programming.
DRBIII(R) CABLES
A NEW DRBIII(R) cable was released as an Essential Service Tool! CH7000A - 8 ft.
Cable, DRBIII(R) to OBDII (J1962) DLC Connector.
CH7000A is the required cable for ALL flash reprogramming. The older CH7000 cable can be used
for diagnostics ONLY. One (1) cable was shipped to all dealerships. Easily identified, the correct
cable has a RED connector, which plugs into the DRBIII(R).
The cable modification enhances the DRBIII(R) communication capabilities when dealing with the
flash requirements of certain controllers/ECUs affected in part by the recent changes in DLC
connector configurations.
The new cable is required for ALL flash reprogramming sessions, and can be used wherever the
previous CH700017001 cables were used.
While not recommended for flash reprogramming usage, if you require a longer cable, there is also
a 12-foot cable released under pin CH7001A
The production of the previous CH700017001 cables has ceased. All orders placed will be
superseded to part number CH7000A/CH7001A.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3711
NOTE:
Consider all cables wear items. Always inspect for worn, damaged cables, connectors that are
damaged or do not lock securely, and all mating connections including checking for corrosion on
the pins. REPLACE ALL suspect cables. Do not use worn or damaged cables when flash
reprogramming.
Failure to use the new cable or to use a damaged cable often results in failed flash reprogramming
sessions.
The 2 door Sebring, Stratus, and Avenger coupes (supplied by MMC) generally use the CH7O1O
cable (Pre-OBDII MMC vehicles will use the CH7005 cable).
TechCONNECT CABLE (GPIB)
Replace any suspect GPIB cable.
The GPIB cable provides the connection between TechCONNECT Client and the DRBIII(R).
This cable is used by the TechCONNECT Client for vehicle part number reads and to send update
files to the DRBIII(R).
Inspect this cable for loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If
this cable becomes disconnected during a flash session, you may have to reload the update file
that you selected on the TechCONNECT Client.
TROUBLESHOOTING CONNECTIVITY OF THE DRBIII(R) UNIT TO THE TechCONNECT
APPLICATION.
1. Turn-on the power to the DRBIII(R) unit.
2. Select option 2 "Connect to TechCONNECT" and press Enter.
3. Attach the male mini D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable (part number
CH7035B) to the DRBIII(R) unit.
4. Insure that the larger female D-shell amphenol GPIB connector of the new DRBIII(R) cable is
properly attached to the male D-shell amphenol GPIB connector on the GPIB-USB-B protocol
converter, (part number CHGPIB-B).
5. Attach the USB cable from the GPIB-USB-B protocol converter to one of the USB ports on the
rear panel of the client CPU.
6. When the cable is attached to the USB port of the CPU for the first time, Windows 2000 will
detect the device and install software for it. Please wait for 25-30 seconds to complete the
installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3712
ISIS NULL MODEM CABLE
Replace any suspect null modem cables.
International (ISIS), a PC-based CD program similar to TechCONNECT Client uses a null modem
cable for vehicle part number reads and to send update files to the DRBIII(R). Inspect this cable for
loose connections, damaged connectors or terminals, and wear and tear. If this cable becomes
disconnected during a flash download session, you will have to reload the update file or files.
GENERAL NOTES FOR CABLES AND VEHICLE CONNECTIONS
Consider ALL cables to be wear items.
Many successful dealers have dedicated cables devoted to "Flash ONLY".
Always have spare CH7000A, CH7010 and CH2002 GPIB or null modem cables available.
Inspect vehicle diagnostic connectors for potential problems that might cause communication
interruptions.
There are now clip repair kits available through teamPSE to replace the retaining clips for two of
these cables. To protect the DRBIII(R) from internal damage, the clips are designed to fail at above
25 lbs. of axial force. Kits are described in the table.
It is a good practice to discard cables that have damage to the pins, cuts, corrosion, or general
damage beyond the retaining clips.
ST22 SEBRING STRATUS 2 DOOR COUPES (2001-2005)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3713
These vehicles use MMC based modules. The CH8432 Supplemental Reprogramming Tool (SRT)
was shipped as a 2001 Essential Tool. The flash reprogramming update files will be downloaded
from TechCONNECT Client to the SRT for flash reprogramming sessions on these vehicles. Users
should closely follow the instructions that come with the tool. If the tool has not been initialized,
there is a known condition where it may take up to 5 or more attempts for it to fully initialize and
become functional.
NOTE:
Once it has successfully flashed, it is initialized and no further action is required.
PREPARING TO FLASH
It is highly recommended that a sign, or other process, be used that notifies other users that a
FLASH SESSION IS IN-PROGRESS and must NOT be interrupted. Interrupting some flash
reprogramming sessions at critical junctures can render a module inoperative. Another user may
not realize that a flash session is in-progress and may disturb or disconnect the DRBIII(R) or do
something on the vehicle that could interrupt the flash process.
Before starting the flash session, read, record and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle.
Also "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R) and download the flash since this will erase the flash file from the
DRBIII(R) memory. (To "Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the
same time. Then press "F4").
Be sure to arrange the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R) so that no cables are stretched across an
area where someone might trip over or kick a cable. When setting up your DRBIII(R), insure that it
rests on a surface where it will not fall or be bumped during reprogramming e.g.: DRBIII's have
been known to be swept off vehicle windshields by accident when a user bumps the wiper switch).
Check User settings on the DRBIII(R). From the DRBIII(R) Main menu, press 6,1 and check to
make sure item 1. Echo on PC is set to OFF. On occasion, when Echo on PC is set to ON, flash
reprogramming errors may occur.
VEHICLE BATTERY VOLTAGE
The flash programming procedure puts a load on the electrical system that may last from five to
twenty minutes depending on the particular flash reprogramming update. Connect a battery
charger to the vehicle. Set the charger to as close to 14 volts as possible. If the charger has a
timer, set it for 30 minutes BEFORE starting a flash reprogramming session. This will help to
prevent unwanted resets by either the DRBIII(R) and/or the vehicle module that are caused by
voltage fluctuations.
Alternately, as a bare minimum, use a "Battery Jump Box" when a battery charger is unavailable to
ensure adequate and stable system voltages on the module being flash reprogrammed.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Connected/Disconnected Flash Mode Using TechCONNECT
CONNECTED MODE FLASHING USING TechCONNECT
NOTE:
Capable but not recommended.
In this mode, the DRBIII(R) remains connected to the TechCONNECT Client and the vehicle
throughout the flash session. The DRBIII(R) is connected to the TechCONNECT Client using the
GPIB (CH7035) cable and to the vehicle using the vehicle I/O cable (the CH7000A for most
vehicles).
This mode is useful when the TechCONNECT Client is next to the vehicle being flashed.
Another advantage of this mode is that you are able to determine all available flash updates for the
vehicle you are connected to by clicking on the "Read Part Number(s) From Vehicle" button.
Again, it is important that other users do not attempt to reboot or move the TechCONNECT Client
while a flash update is in-progress.
The reprogramming procedure of this mode is initiated by selecting the controller option and
clicking "Download/Update" button on the TechCONNECT client.
DISCONNECTED FLASH MODE
NOTE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3714
This is the preferred method.
This mode allows a user to flash a vehicle without being connected to the TechCONNECT Client.
This is a popular mode for flashing in a remote area of the service garage or in a back lot.
Before you attempt to use this mode, you must configure the DRBIII(R) for the desired update(s).
To do this, you must connect the DRBIII(R) to the TechCONNECT Client using the GPIB cable and
the CH7025 cable. It is not necessary to be connected to a vehicle. The GPIB (CH7035) cable will
be used to communicate with the TechCONNECT Client (for update file downloading) while the
CH7025 cable is used to provide power to the DRBIII(R).
After making the above connections, you are able to select one or more updates that you want to
perform. These selections are made by highlighting the desired updates and then clicking on the
"Download/Update" button by selecting the DRBIII(R) option on the TechCONNECT client.
Obviously, the DRBIII(R) does not have unlimited memory. If the file size of the selected updates
exceeds 948 KB, the "DRB Space Used" indicator (at the bottom-center of the TechCONNECT
Client screen) will change color from GREEN to RED. At this point you must de-select entries until
the indicator changes color to GREEN again.
When the updates have finished downloading, you may disconnect from the TechCONNECT Client
and take the DRBIII(R) to wherever the vehicle is located. The updates will remain in DRBIII(R)
memory for 8 hours while the DRBIII(R) is without power. If the DRBIII(R) is powered up for several
minutes before the 8 hour time period has expired, the update files will remain on the DRBIII(R) for
another 8 hours without power.
To start the actual flash process, after connecting to the vehicle in Disconnected Mode, you must
press "7 - Vehicle Flash" from the Main Menu on the DRBIII(R). Step by step instruction will follow
on the DRBIII(R) display. As with Connected Flash Mode, take the necessary precautions to insure
that others are aware of the flash session and that nothing disturbs the vehicle, DRBIII(R), or
cabling while performing the flash. Remember to use a battery charger set to 14 volts or a "battery
jump box".
Pay Attention While Performing Flash Reprogram Procedures
PAY ATTENTION WHILE PERFORMING FLASH REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURES
Before downloading the flash files, double check to see if the files that you have selected are the
appropriate ones for that vehicle. Don't forget about the "Read Part Numbers From Vehicle" option
on TechCONNECT Client, this can be of great assistance when trying to flash a module. If the files
selected don't download on the first attempt, try again.
The technician should NOT leave the vehicle when flash reprogramming a module.
Again, check to make sure that all cable connections are secure and that the DRBIII(R) rests on a
stable surface. If you are using a battery charger, insure that the settings and charging times are
correct and that the battery post clamps are securely fastened.
Read, record, and erase all DTCs found on the vehicle. Read and record the module type and part
number from the module that is to be flash reprogrammed.
Some control modules are not "abort-recovery" capable. When this is true, the scan tool will
indicate so by displaying a WARNING message prior to the start of reprogramming. For these
modules it is especially important that all precautions and procedures, outlined here, are carefully
followed.
Pay special attention to DRBIII(R) screen directions relating to key cycles. Missing a "Key ON" or
"Key OFF" can cause the module to have to be reflashed again. Due to the variety of module types
and vehicle options, you can't always anticipate key prompts, so be alert and ready to respond to
DRBIII(R) instructions.
Some screens will also instruct that certain modules, connectors or fuses be disconnected or pulled
prior to the start of reprogramming and re-installed immediately after completion. Be careful not to
anticipate the steps or order of operations for reprogramming any vehicle modules. Because of the
many possible changes that occur with each new release of scan tool software, always allow the
TSB/Recall and scan tool instructions to be your guide while performing flash reprogramming.
Flash reprogramming sessions usually range from 5 to 20 minutes. If the flash session has not
completed within 25 minutes after starting a flash reprogramming update, an error has most likely
occurred (Record the message that appears on the screen when a failure occurs). If this is the
case, or if you know that the flash process was interrupted, cycle the ignition key (OFF to the
locked position, then back ON). Reset the DRBIII(R) (power down for 4 seconds and then power
up) before attempting to restart the flash process. If the module still won't respond, turn the ignition
key off, disconnect the module from the vehicle for 2 minutes, reconnect the module, turn the
ignition key to run and try to restart the flash process again.
Regardless of what mode that you are in (Connected Flash or Disconnected Flash), if you have
tried twice (2 times) unsuccessfully to do a flash recovery and ALL DRBIII(R) instructions were
followed, perform the following:
^ Cold boot the DRBIII(R). This resets memory and removes all update files from the DRBIII(R).
(Push MORE and YES buttons at the same time, then press F4).
^ Reload the flash update file from the TechCONNECT Client.
^ If it fails to complete in the connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before
re-attempting the flash download to the DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3715
^ Proceed to reflash the module.
On vehicles that have multiple flash updates available, always complete and verify each flash
update before attempting the next one.
After all flash reprogramming is completed, read and erase all DTCs in all modules on the vehicle.
A variety of DTCs may be set, which are usually related to a loss of communication with the
module(s) being reprogrammed.
Verify the update by reading the new part number using the DRBIII(R). A good double check is to
read the part number using DRBIII(R) stand alone.
At times, other modules, wired in parallel, to the DLC connector have prevented flash
reprogramming sessions to be successful. After the failed attempt, review the appropriate wiring
diagram for the vehicle you are flash reprogramming and, with the key "OFF"; disconnect the other
modules and retry the flash. Complete the flash, turn the key "OFF" and reconnect any modules
that were disconnected. Refer to the "Programmable Modules" section later in this document for
more information.
Error Messages
ERROR MESSAGES
Block Echo/Compare Errors
Block Echo and Block Compare errors are often caused by voltage fluctuations, faulty I/O cables
(CH7OOOA, CH7005, CH7010) or faulty communication connections at the diagnostic connector.
Inspect for these conditions and review the sections on Vehicle Battery Voltage and Cable
recommendations.
Checksum Errors
Checksum Errors are generally caused by corrupt flash update files, which can be caused by
DRBIII(R) memory problems. If the DRBIII(R) has been without power for more than 8 hours, the
update files and system memory could be in a corrupted state. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (To
"Cold Boot", press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R), at the same time. Then press
"F4"). Reload the flash update file(s) from the TechCONNECT CLIENT. If it fails to complete in the
connected mode, first reboot the TechCONNECT Client before re-attempting the flash download to
the DRBIII(R). Then re-attempt the flash reprogramming process.
Enhanced and Original Abort Recovery
ENHANCED ABORT RECOVERY
Interruptions in the flash process are one of the main reasons for failed flash sessions and
non-responsive (NR) modules. Interrupting the flash process after the erase phase has started will
leave the control module in a non-functional state.
Generally, but not always, NR modules may be recovered successfully.
Briefly, abort recovery is the process used to get a NR module back to a fully functional state with
the latest software update. The technician should be familiar with the other sections in this
document and follow all DRBIII(R) user prompts carefully.
There are two methods for abort-recovery. The newer method is called "Enhanced Abort
Recovery". This is the preferred method since the original method takes several minutes longer
and requires the correct selection of module type from a list of possible PCM's or TCM's.
Starting with Release 60.1, a new useful feature was added to the flash reprogramming application
for Engine and Transmission control modules. The DRBIII(R) "writes" the YME and Controller Type
information to a "Safe Memory" location. This method allows for rapid recovery of the module part
number and minimizes errors that could otherwise be made by selecting the wrong controller type.
It also assumes that the user will attempt abort recovery for a failed flash attempt before moving to
another vehicle with the same DRBIII(R). If you need to move to another vehicle for flash
reprogramming you must erase the saved recovery information in order to successfully perform
flash reprogramming. Be careful to match the YME information displayed on the enhanced abort
recovery screen with the vehicle and module that you are attempting to recover. If you use the
recovery file on a different vehicle and module you could damage the module.
The recovery information will be displayed on your DRBIII(R), at the start of a flash session, only if
you previously encountered a problem that prevented a flash session from completing normally. If
your prior flash session was successful, the DRBIII(R) automatically erases the recovery file so that
the flash application will not show any recovery information at the start of your next flash session.
Enhanced abort recovery features:
^ Reduces the amount of time for the Module ID process.
^ Lowers the risk of possible user mistakes by presenting the user the Year, Model, Engine, and
Controller Type.
^ Currently only applicable to Engine and Transmission flash reprogramming.
^ The enhanced abort recovery file will only be erased upon a successful flash or manually by the
user.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3716
^ Cold booting (simultaneously pushing MORE & YES, then F4) the DRBIII(R) will not erase the
enhanced abort recovery file, but cold booting the DRBIII(R) will still erase the flash file so it can be
reloaded.
^ The user has a choice, at the start of a flash session, whether or not to use the enhanced abort
recovery feature. If the user chooses to erase the recovery file, then the DRBIII(R) will use the
original method of abort recovery.
^ Cycling the ignition key, when prompted by the DRBIII(R), is still necessary to put the controller
into bootstrap (reprogramming) mode.
ORIGINAL ABORT RECOVERY
If the choice is made to use the original method of abort recovery, a NR module is not always able
to provide the DRBIII with ID information. In this case the technician must enter this when prompted
by the DRBIII(R). Be patient when performing this process. If the module does not respond to
standard diagnostic requests, the DRBIII(R) may take several minutes before it determines that the
engine module is in a NR state. At this point, the DRBIII(R) displays the prompt "Could not
determine engine controller type. Please select from list" along with a list of possible controller
types (if the DRBIII(R) is attempting to identify a TCM, the prompt will say "trans" instead of
"engine" and list the possible trans controller types). Because of module variations, it is important
to correctly identify the PCM/TCM type so that the correct flash procedure is used. Failure to do
this will cause further problems and may damage the module. Tables are provided below to help
identify the proper module type to select. These tables correctly identify the modules that were on
the vehicles when they were built. However, some vehicles will have module types which were
superseded to a new type when a replacement part was installed (ie: EATX4 modules replaced
with an EATX4A). Correctly identify these modules using DRBIII(R) Standalone prior to attempting
flash reprogramming.
NOTE:
When instructed to turn the key to the LOCKED position, be sure that the key is not just turned to
the OFF position. The key must be rotated to the point at which it can be removed from the ignition
switch. On most vehicles the switch is on the steering column and at this position the steering
column is LOCKED. When instructed to turn the key to the RUN position, be careful not to turn the
key past this position which may engage the starter motor. This creates electrical noise which
interferes with the flash process.
General Steps for Abort Recovery
1. Review all Tips and Techniques before continuing. Pay special attention to the section on
Preparing to Flash a controller and to the Programmable Modules section.
2. Cycle the vehicle's ignition key to the LOCKED position and back to the RUN position.
3. Reset the DRBIII(R) by disconnecting the vehicle cable from the DRBIII(R) for 4 seconds and
then reconnecting the cable.
4. Depending on where the flash session was aborted, the DRBIII(R) may require that the
technician identify the control module type that was being flash reprogrammed. Use the PCM/TCM
configuration table below as a guide. This step is not necessary if using the enhanced abort
recovery method.
5. After selecting the proper control module type or choosing enhanced abort recovery, follow the
prompts that are displayed on the DRBIII(R).
NOTE:
If an error message is displayed at this point, an incorrect module type was most likely selected. If
this occurs, start the process over.
6. If the recovery process is unsuccessful, perform the following:
a. Review the TSB/Recall notice (authorizing the flash update) and all Tips and Techniques in this
document.
b. Reboot/Restart the TechCONNECT Client.
c. "Cold Boot" the DRBIII(R). (Press the MORE and YES buttons on the DRBIII(R) at the same
time, then press F4).
d. Start this process over from item # 1. If using Disconnected Mode, the flash update will have to
be reloaded from the TechCONNECT Client or ISIS DVD.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3717
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3718
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3719
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3720
Programmable Modules
The following pages list the various modules that have flash reprogramming capability. It does not
mean that a flash is currently available. What will be described are the module types and
variations, followed by items to note, and finally, abort recovery specifics if applicable.
Powertrain Modules - Engine and Transmission
ENGINE - POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3721
There are a variety of Engine (PCM) modules that are flash reprogrammable. Suggestions that are
somewhat unique to each type will have comments. Prior to reprogramming a PCM, retrieve the
module information and module type using your DRBII I®. PCM information is used by many
modules. Be sure to check DIG's before and after performing all flash reprogramming event.
The DTC's associated with flash reprogramming generally relate to "lack of communication" with
the other modules during the reprogramming session.
SBEC
Types:
SBEC, SBEC 2, SBEC 3, SBEC 3+, SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+, and SBEC 3B
NOTE:
During recovery, if the DRBIII® is not seeing the key off, you may need to remove power (B+) to
PCM by removing fuse(s) or disconnecting the PCM. When DRBIII® states to turn key ON,
reconnect fuse or harness connection.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow instructions on the DRBIII® for the module type. See table above.
^ Some SBEC 3A, SBEC 3A+ AND SBEC 3B may be in a state where they can not correctly
identify a key cycle. In this case a Modified Key Cycle routine is required.
This state is present when the following message is displayed on the DRBIII(R): "Can not read Part
Number. Did not see Key On or PCM/TCM Controller may not be flashable". When this occurs
restart the flash session and when prompted to turn the ignition key to the LOCKED position, pull
the fuse(s) that supply battery power to the module instead. When prompted to turn the key to the
RUN position, replace the battery supply fuse(s) instead.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC, JTEC+
NOTE:
Viper ALL - Roll down windows especially Coupes before attempting a flash.
NOTE:
1999 WJ JTEC with Speed Proportional Steering module. Disconnect before and reconnect after
the PCM flash reprogramming session. Also see Transmission.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC
Types:
^ NGC 1, NGC 2, and NGC 3
NOTE:
There are derivatives of NGC 3 that will be significant when reprogramming and or testing. NGC
modules use one of the longest time spans for flash reprogramming (approximately 15 minutes).
The NGCI and NGC3 controllers incorporate both an engine as well as a transmission controller in
a common package. The NGC2 controller incorporates the engine controller and an Electronic
Throttle Control (ETC) module in place of the TCM. All NGC controllers can be visually identified by
noting its four (4) wiring connectors. On manual transmission applications and the NGC2, only 3
connectors may be populated with pins.
NOTE:
On certain vehicles, the ABS CAB module connector MUST be disconnected prior to performing
this Repair Procedure. The CAB module and the PCM are connected at the same diagnostic
connector pin (Pin # 9). Turn ignition switch to the OFF position, disconnect the CAB module
connector, and reprogram the PCM per the Repair Procedure. When reprogramming is complete
turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, connect the CAB module connector, and then check for
DTC's. If the PCM becomes "locked" during reprogramming because the ABS CAB module
connector was not disconnected, then the PCM may be recovered by following the procedure in
this NOTE.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3722
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ Power down the DRBIII(R) then cycle ignition before powering up the DRBIII(R) to attempt the
flash.
CUMMINS
Types:
^ CM551 and CM84x series
NOTE:
Cummins flash reprogrammable PCMs are used on 1998.5 and newer Dodge Trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. Model Year 2000 and earlier vehicles have one Engine
Control Fuse to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). Model Year 2001 and later have two Engine
Control Fuses (one 20 Amp and one 30 Amp) to pull when prompted by the DRBIII(R). The fuse(s)
are located in the PDC and need to be pulled/removed, when prompted, for at least 10 seconds.
SIEMENS
Types:
^ SIM-70
NOTE:
The SIM-70 is currently used on BUX PL and PG vehicles with a 1.6L ONLY. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
BOSCH
Types:
^ EDC15V, EDC15-C5, and EDC16
NOTE:
While there have been other Bosch modules, the EDC15V is not flash reprogrammable.
Transmission controllers are usually flashed on the vehicle (since 1996).
Technicians may set the pinion factor on "NEW" modules either before or after flash
reprogramming. Suggestions follow.
After flash reprogramming and before returning the vehicle to the customer, always perform a
"QuickLearn" to the TCM.
EATX
Types:
^ EATX, EATX 2, EATX 3, EATX 3A, EATX 3B, EATX 4, and EATX 4A
NOTE:
Table shows which TCM was installed "as-built". Often TCMs are superseded by parts and or a
service bulletin.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ 1999 - 2000 WJ and 2000 AN/DN using 4.7L engines the service replacement EATX4A part
numbers 56041814AD and 56028227AH currently display a P/N read failed error after the flash is
completed during PIN verification. This DOES NOT mean the flash failed. Check for the part
number using DRBIII(R) in standalone mode. This exists only for the service replacement modules
listed above. Flash reprogramming for OE modules flash and read the part number correctly.
Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NGC
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3723
^ NGC1, NGC2, NGC3
NOTE:
The NGC I1and NGC 3 have the EATX/XCORE and Engine modules combined. NGC 2 does not.
Vehicles with automatic transmissions using NGC2 will use an EATX4A.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ 2002 DR, 2002.5 DN, 2003 AN/DN and later with NGC have shown that in some instances the
CAB controller may need to be disconnected when attempting to flash the NGC controller. (This
should only be performed if an error occurs at the very beginning of the TCM flash portion.)
SIEMENS
Types:
^ EG552
NOTE:
EGS52 is used with the A580 automatic transmission WG Grand Cherokees with a 2.7L diesel
engine (BUX), ZH Crossfire and VA Sprinter.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
JTEC
Types:
^ JTEC,JTEC+
NOTE:
Except for the 45RFE, 545RFE, and AW4 automatic transmissions, the JTEC controller also
provides transmission control functions on Dodge trucks and Jeep vehicles. Additionally, they are
used on some Cummins equipped Dodge trucks with manual and automatic transmissions.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
PRE 1996 EATX TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULES
Prior to 1996 there was not a vehicle SCI communication wire going to the FWD EATX controller
only to the PCM. Those vehicle TCMs only communicate to the DRBIII(R) using CCD
communications.
For these FWD vehicles, use the CH5500 kit and CH7025 DIN cable when connecting those
modules to the DRBIII(R) vehicle connector.
For 1992-1993 vehicles, the TCM modules were upgraded to MY1995 software. Because of this
you will need to use the Yellow SuperCard2, CH8361,to set pinion factor or when using a "new"
(superseded) TCM from parts as only the SuperCard2 properly sets the pinion factor on these
updated modules.
Additionally, when flashing or installing P/Ns 4796121, 4796122, 4796123, or 4796124.
The wire from cavity 49 must be removed from the TCM connector, refer to service bulletin
18-24-95.
Types:
^ TCCM
NOTE:
These modules are found on AN, DN, and DR trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3724
NON-POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULES
BODY CONTROL MODULE (BCM)
Types:
^ BCM
NOTE:
Body control modules are found on passenger vehicles.
NOTE:
The following vehicle BCMs support flash reprogramming: CS, JR, KJ, LH, RS, WJ, and ZB.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
^ BUX ONLY for 2001 JR - Compass/Mini Trip (BCM) Flash - Use special international release
software version 52.25
^ 2001 LH - there is NO abort recovery available for the BCM.
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE (CTM)
Types:
^ CTM
NOTE:
CTMs are found on: AB, AN, DN, BR, and BE trucks.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER (EVIC)
Types:
^ EVIC
NOTE:
02-03 LH & WJ, and 03-04 KJ
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
FRONT CONTROL MODULE (FCM)
Types:
^ FCM
NOTE:
Front control modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
INTEGRATED POWER MODULE (IPM)
Types:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3725
^ 1PM
NOTE:
Integrated power modules are found on CS, DR, RG, and RS vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
POWER LIFT GATE (PLG)
Types:
^ PLC
NOTE:
Power liftgate modules are found on CS and RS.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (PSDM)
Types:
^ PSDM
NOTE:
Passenger power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery
Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. DRIVER SLIDING DOOR MODULE (DSDM)
Types:
^ DSDM
NOTE:
Driver power sliding door modules are found on RG and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
NOTE:
When flashing a vehicle that is equipped with both Passenger and Driver Power Sliding Doors, you
must Reboot the DRBIII(R) and cycle the ignition key before flashing the next door module.
DRIVER DOOR MODULE (DDM)
Types:
^ DDM
NOTE:
Driver Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. PASSENGER DOOR MODULE (PDM)
Types:
^ PDM
NOTE:
Passenger Door Module is found on the CS and RS vehicles. Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLUSTERS/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (MIC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3726
Types:
^ MICs, eMICs
NOTE:
MICs that have flash reprogramming are on the following vehicles: DR, JR, KJ, PL, PT, WJ, ZB
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully. In certain cases, you will be asked to cycle the ignition key
and pull a specific fuse.
^ The DRBIII(R) may power down during the procedure with some modules. This is NORMAL and
is explained in the user prompts displayed during abort-recovery. Take the time to read and
understand the instructions before proceeding.
ALARM REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE (ARKEM)
Types:
^ ARKEM
NOTE:
Arkem modules are found on PL and PT vehicles. There are up to and after modules.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
CLIMATE CONTROL (ATC, HVAC)
Types:
^ HVAC, ATC, MTC
NOTE:
Generally, reprogramming for these modules is done using the standalone application rather than
the Vehicle Flash application.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
ADJUSTABLE PEDAL MODULE (APM)
Types:
^ APM
NOTE:
Found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
RAIN SENSOR MODULE (RSM)
Types:
^ RSM
NOTE:RSM modules are found on CS, RS, and WJ vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-05 > Oct > 05 > Engine Controls - Flash Programming Failure Recovery > Page 3727
INTRUSION TRANSCEIVER MODULE (ITM)
Types:
^ ITM
^ Updates for this module, to version 7.05 have involved a coordinated BCM flash update. See the
TSB for important instructions.
NOTE:
ITM modules are found on WJ (BUX) and KJ (BUX) vehicles.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII® prompts carefully.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEMS (SRS) - AIRBAGS, ETC.
Types:
^ SRS, ORC
NOTE:
While used on most vehicles, only CS, JR, LH, PT, RS, and WJ vehicles have the potential to
support flash updates.
Abort Recovery Specifics:
^ Follow DRBIII(R) prompts carefully.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3734
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3738
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3739
8w-80-61
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3740
Solenoid Application Chart
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3746
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3750
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3751
8w-80-61
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3752
Solenoid Application Chart
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Accumulator: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transaxle ACCUMULATOR - DESCRIPTION
The 41te underdrive, overdrive, low/reverse, and 2/4 clutch hydraulic circuits each contain an
accumulator. An accumulator typically consists of a piston, seals, return spring(s), and a cover or
plug. The overdrive and underdrive accumulators are located within the transaxle case, and are
retained by the valve body (Fig. 157).
The low reverse accumulator (Fig. 158) is also located within the transaxle case, but the assembly
is retained by a cover and a snap-ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3756
The 2/4 accumulator is located in the valve body. It is retained by a cover and retaining screws
(Fig. 159).
OPERATION
The function of an accumulator is to cushion the application of a frictional clutch element. When
pressurized fluid is applied to a clutch circuit, the application force is dampened by fluid collecting
in the respective accumulator chamber against the piston and spring(s). The intended result is a
smooth, firm clutch application.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
CLUTCH CLEARANCES
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Driving Clutches
Clutch: Description and Operation Driving Clutches
41TE - Automatic Transaxle DRIVING CLUTCHES - DESCRIPTION
Three hydraulically applied input clutches are used to drive planetary components. The underdrive,
overdrive, and reverse clutches are considered input clutches and are contained within the input
clutch assembly (Fig. 160). The input clutch assembly also contains:
- Input shaft
- Input hub
- Clutch retainer
- Underdrive piston
- Overdrive/reverse piston
- Overdrive hub
- Underdrive hub
OPERATION
The three input clutches are responsible for driving different components of the planetary geartrain.
NOTE: Refer to the "Elements In Use" chart in Diagnosis and Testing for a collective view of which
clutch elements are applied at each position of the
selector lever.
UNDERDRIVE CLUTCH
The underdrive clutch is hydraulically applied in first, second, and third (direct) gears by
pressurized fluid against the underdrive piston. When the underdrive clutch is applied, the
underdrive hub drives the rear sun gear.
OVERDRIVE CLUTCH
The overdrive clutch is hydraulically applied in third (direct) and overdrive gears by pressurized
fluid against the overdrive/reverse piston. When the overdrive clutch is applied, the overdrive hub
drives the front planet carrier.
REVERSE CLUTCH
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Driving Clutches > Page 3765
The reverse clutch is hydraulically applied in reverse gear only by pressurized fluid against the
overdrive/reverse piston. When the reverse clutch is applied, the front sun gear assembly is driven.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Driving Clutches > Page 3766
Clutch: Description and Operation Holding Clutches
41TE - Automatic Transaxle HOLDING CLUTCHES - DESCRIPTION
Two hydraulically applied multi-disc clutches are used to hold planetary geartrain components
stationary while the input clutches drive others. The 2/4 and Low/Reverse clutches are considered
holding clutches and are contained at the rear of the transaxle case. (Fig. 196).
OPERATION
NOTE: Refer to the "Elements In Use" chart in Diagnosis and Testing for a collective view of which
clutch elements are applied at each position of the
selector lever.
2/4 CLUTCH
The 2/4 clutch is hydraulically applied in second and fourth gears by pressurized fluid against the
2/4 clutch piston. When the 2/4 clutch is applied, the front sun gear assembly is held or grounded
to the transaxle case.
LOW/REVERSE CLUTCH
The Low/Reverse clutch is hydraulically applied in park, reverse, neutral, and first gears by
pressurized fluid against the Low/Reverse clutch piston. When the Low/Reverse clutch is applied,
the front planet carrier/rear annulus assembly is held or grounded to the transaxle case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Clutch: Service and Repair Disassembly
41TE - Automatic Transaxle Input Clutch Assembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Mount input clutch assembly to Input Clutch Pressure Fixture (Tool 8391).
2. Tap down reverse clutch reaction plate to release pressure from snap ring (Fig. 197).
3. Remove reverse clutch snap ring (Fig. 198).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3769
4. Pry up and remove reverse clutch reaction plate (Fig. 199) (Fig. 200).
5. Remove the reverse clutch pack (two fibers/one steel) (Fig. 201).
NOTE: Tag reverse clutch pack for reassembly identification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3770
6. Remove the OD/Reverse pressure plate snap ring (Fig. 202).
7. Remove OD/Reverse pressure plate (Fig. 203).
8. Remove OD/Reverse pressure plate wave snap ring (Fig. 204).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3771
9. Remove OD shaft/hub and OD clutch pack (Fig. 205) (Fig. 206).
NOTE: Tag overdrive clutch pack for reassembly identification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3772
10. Remove and inspect # 3 & # 4 thrust washers (Fig. 207).
11. Remove the underdrive shaft assembly (Fig. 208).
12. Remove the # 2 needle bearing (Fig. 209).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3773
13. Remove the OD/UD reaction plate tapered snap ring (Fig. 210).
NOTE:
The OD/UD clutch reaction plate has a step on both sides. Install the OD/UD clutches reaction
plate tapered step side up.
14. Remove the OD/UD reaction plate (Fig. 211).
15. Remove the first UD clutch disc (Fig. 212).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3774
16. Remove the UD clutch flat snap ring (Fig. 213).
NOTE: Tag underdrive clutch pack for reassembly identification.
17. Remove the UD clutch pack (Fig. 214).
CAUTION: Compress return spring just enough to remove or install snap ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3775
18. Using Tool 5059A and an arbor press, compress UD clutch piston enough to remove snap ring
(Fig. 215) (Fig. 216). 19. Remove spring retainer (Fig. 216).
20. Remove UD clutch piston (Fig. 217).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3776
21. Remove input hub tapered snap ring (Fig. 218).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3777
22. Tap on input hub with soft faced hammer and separate input hub from OD/Reverse piston and
clutch retainer (Fig. 219) (Fig. 220).
23. Separate clutch retainer from OD/Reverse piston (Fig. 221).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3778
24. Using Tool 6057 and an arbor press, compress return OD/Reverse piston return spring just
enough to remove snap ring (Fig. 222) (Fig. 223).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3779
25. Remove input shaft to input clutch hub snap ring (Fig. 224).
26. Using a suitably sized socket and an arbor press, remove input shaft from input shaft hub (Fig.
225).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3780
Clutch: Service and Repair Assembly
41TE - Automatic Transaxle Input Clutch Assembly
ASSEMBLY
Use petroleum on all seals to ease assembly of components.
1. Using an arbor press, install input shaft to input shaft hub (Fig. 226).
2. Install input shaft snap ring (Fig. 227).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3781
3. Using an arbor press and Tool 6057, Install OD/Reverse piston return spring and snap ring (Fig.
228) (Fig. 229).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3782
4. Install the OD/Reverse piston assembly to the input clutch retainer as shown in (Fig. 230).
5. Install the input hub/shaft assy. to the OD/Reverse piston/clutch retainer assy. (Fig. 231).
6. Install input hub tapered snap ring (Fig. 232).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3783
7. Install UD clutch piston (Fig. 233).
8. Install UD piston return spring and Tool 5067 as shown in (Fig. 234).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3784
9. Using Tool 5059A and an arbor press, Install the UD spring retainer and snap ring. (Fig. 235)
(Fig. 236) Compress just enough to install snap ring.
CAUTION: Compress return spring just enough to install snap ring.
10. Install the UD clutch pack. Leave out upper disc, until snap ring is installed (Fig. 237).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3785
11. Install the UD clutch flat snap ring (Fig. 238).
12. Install the last UD clutch disc (Fig. 239).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3786
13. Install the OD/UD clutch reaction plate and snap ring (Fig. 240) (Fig. 241). The OD/UD clutches
reaction plate has a step on both sides. Install the
OD/UD clutches reaction plate tapered step side up.
NOTE: Snap ring ends must be located within one finger of the input clutch hub. Be sure that snap
ring is fully seated, by pushing with screwdriver, into snap ring groove all the way around.
14. Seat tapered snap ring to ensure proper installation (Fig. 242).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3787
15. Install input clutch assembly to the Input Clutch Pressure Fixture - Tool 8391 (Fig. 243).
16. Set up dial indicator on the UD clutch pack as shown in (Fig. 244).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3788
17. Using moderate pressure, press down and hold (near indicator) the UD clutch pack with
screwdriver or suitable tool and zero dial indicator (Fig.
245). When releasing pressure on clutch pack, indicator reading should advance 0.005 - 0.010.
CAUTION: Do not apply more than 30 psi (206 kPa) to the underdrive clutch pack.
18. Apply 30 psi (206 kPa) to the underdrive hose on Tool 8391 and measure UD clutch clearance.
Measure and record UD clutch pack measurement
in four (4) places, 90° apart.
19. Take average of four measurements and compare with UD clutch pack clearance specification.
Underdrive clutch pack clearance must be 0.94 1.50 mm (0.037 - 0.059 inch).
20. If necessary, select the proper reaction plate to achieve specifications.
21. Install the OD clutch pack (four frictions/three steels) (Fig. 246).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3789
22. Install OD pressure plate waved snap ring (Fig. 247).
23. Install the OD/Reverse pressure plate with large step down (towards OD clutch pack) (Fig.
248).
24. Install OD pressure plate flat snap ring (Fig. 249).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3790
25. Measure OD clutch pack clearance. Set up dial indicator on top of the OD/Reverse pressure
plate as shown in (Fig. 250). 26. Zero dial indicator and apply 30 psi (206 kPa) air pressure to the
overdrive clutch hose on Tool 8391. Measure and record OD clutch pack
measurement in four (4) places, 90° apart.
27. Take average of four measurements and compare with OD clutch pack clearance specification.
The overdrive (OD) clutch pack clearance is 1.07 3.25 mm (0.042 - 0.128 inch). If not within specifications, the clutch is not assembled properly.
There is no adjustment for the OD clutch clearance.
28. Install reverse clutch pack (two frictions/one steel) (Fig. 251).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3791
29. Install reverse clutch reaction plate with the flat side down towards reverse clutch (Fig. 252).
30. Tap reaction plate down to allow installation of the reverse clutch snap ring. Install reverse
clutch snap ring (Fig. 253).
31. Pry up reverse reaction plate to seat against snap ring (Fig. 254).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3792
32. Set up a dial indicator on the reverse clutch pack as shown in (Fig. 255).
33. Using moderate pressure, press down and hold (near indicator) reverse clutch disc with
screwdriver or suitable tool and zero dial indicator (Fig.
256). When releasing pressure, indicator should advance 0.005 - 0.010 as clutch pack relaxes.
34. Apply 30 psi (206 kPa) air pressure to the reverse clutch hose on Tool 8391. Measure and
record reverse clutch pack measurement in four (4)
places, 90° apart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3793
35. Take average of four measurements and compare with reverse clutch pack clearance
specification. The reverse clutch pack clearance is 0.89 - 1.37
mm (0.035 - 0.054 inch). Select the proper reverse clutch snap ring to achieve specifications.
36. To complete the assembly, reverse clutch and overdrive clutch must be removed.
37. Install the # 2 needle bearing (Fig. 257).
38. Install the underdrive shaft assembly (Fig. 258).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3794
39. Install the # 3 thrust washer to the underdrive shaft assembly. Be sure five tabs are seated
properly (Fig. 259).
40. Install the # 3 thrust plate to the bottom of the overdrive shaft assembly. Retain with petrolatum
or transmission assembly gel (Fig. 260).
41. Install the overdrive shaft assembly (Fig. 261). 42. Reinstall overdrive and reverse clutch as
shown. Rechecking these clutch clearances is not necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 >
A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 >
A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3803
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 >
A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3804
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 >
A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3805
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A >
Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A >
Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3811
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A >
Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3812
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A >
Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3813
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3814
Control Module: Locations
Fig.11 TCM Location
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3815
Control Module: Description and Operation
Fig.11 TCM Location
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11). It mounts on a bracket that is fastened to the rail.
The TCM is the controlling unit for all electronic operations of the transaxle. The TCM receives
information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and selects the
operational mode of the transaxle. Direct inputs are hardwired to, and used specifically by the
TCM. Indirect inputs originate from other components/modules, and are shared with the TCM via
the J1850 communication bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are: -Battery (B+) voltage -Ignition "ON" voltage
-Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) -Throttle Position Sensor -Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) -Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) -Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD) -Transmission
Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS) -Input Shaft Speed Sensor -Output Shaft Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are: Engine/Body Identification
- Manifold Pressure
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Speed Control ON/OFF Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Brake Switch Status
- DRB Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are: Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD and UD)
- Vehicle Speed (to PCM)
- Torque Reduction Request (to PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3816
An example of a TCM indirect output is: Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions: Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indices (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with DRB scan tool)
Clutch Volume Index (CVI) An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index
(CVI). CVIs represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
Fig.12 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur (Fig. 12).
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRB Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3817
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Shift Schedules As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of
shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following: Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3818
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the chart
to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Control Module (TCM) is being replaced with a new or replacement unit,
the Pinion Factor and Quick Learn procedures must be performed. (Refer to ELECTRONIC
CONTROL MODULES/TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE - STANDARD PROCEDURE)
(Refer to ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/ TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE)
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially remove right front wheel
splash shield.
Fig.13 TCM 60-Way Connector
4. Disconnect TCM 60-way connector (Fig. 13).
Fig.14 TCM/Bracket Assembly
5. Remove three (3) TCM bracket-to-rail screws and remove TCM/bracket assembly from vehicle
(Fig. 14).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3821
Fig.15 TCM Bracket
6. Remove four (4) bracket-to-TCM screws and remove bracket (Fig. 15).
INSTALLATION
1. Install TCM to mounting bracket and torque four (4) screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 15). 2.
Install TCM/bracket assembly to rail (Fig. 14). Install and torque three (3) bracket-to-rail screws to
12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Install TCM 60-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.) (Fig. 13). 4.
Install and secure right front wheel splash shield. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3822
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the Transmission Control Module (TCM) has been
replaced with a NEW or replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an
inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The TCM
must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Transmission Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a DRB III scan tool. 1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector
located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous
menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the instructions on the DRB III scan tool screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3823
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRB III scan tool. This program allows the
electronic transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle
operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met: The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRB III
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60 ° and below 200 °
1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRB III to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Differential Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
41TE - Automatic Transaxle
Refer to Transmission Fluid, A/T.
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3829
Differential Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
41TE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Recommended Fluid Type
........................................................................................................................................................
Mopar ATF +4, Type 9602
Recommended Sealer .........................................................................................................................
.......................................... Mopar RTV (MS-GF41)
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3830
Differential Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
41TE - Automatic Transaxle
Refer to Transmission Fluid, A/T.
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3831
Differential Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transaxle
Refer to Transmission Fluid, A/T.
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 21-014-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-010-06, DATED APRIL 14,
2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES THE ADDITION OF THE ASIAN
WARNER (AW4) TRANSMISSION AND ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2008** (CS) Pacifica
1998-2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2008** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 - **2008** (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - **2008** (HB) Durango
**2008 (HG) Aspen**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3836
2007 - **2008** (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - **2008** (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
**2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro**
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
**2008 (KK) Liberty**
**2008 (L2) 300C (China)**
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - **2008** (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - **2008** (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**2008 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan/Grand Voyager (U.S. & International Markets)**
1997-2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2008** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2008** (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
**1989 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee**
**1989 - 1993 (MJ) Comanche**
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
**AWA (Asian Warner) transmission are now included in this Service Bulletin. ATF+4(R) is
recommended for AW-4 (Asian Warner) transmissions**
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire transmissions, MK/PM
vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3837
Transmission (CVT) and WG vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a
W5J400 or NAG1 transmission (sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE LISTED IN THE NOTE ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4(R) can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4® is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4®
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3838
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF+4 Fluid Usage/Applications
NUMBER: 21-010-06
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: April 14, 2006
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-004-04, DATED MARCH
16, 2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (CS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - 2007 (HB) Durango
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2007 (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3839
2007 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - 2007 (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - 2007 (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to AW-4 transmissions, Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire
transmissions, MK/PM vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) and WG
vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a W5J400 or NAG1 transmission
(sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE NOTED ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4 can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4(R) is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage > Page 3840
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Automatic Transaxle
Estimated Service Fill ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................. 4.0 Qt (3.8L) Overhaul Fill Capacity w/Torque Converter
Empty .......................................................................................................................................... 8.6
Qt (8.1L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3843
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
41TE AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
Automatic Transmission Fluid
....................................................................................................................................................
Mopar ATF +4, Type 9602
NOTE: The 41TE automatic and T350 manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3844
Fluid - A/T: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Using a transmission fluid other than ATF +4 may cause deterioration in transmission
shift quality and/or torque converter
shudder. Using a transmission fluid other than ATF +4 will result in more frequent fluid and filter
changes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnosis and Testing
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection Diagnosis and Testing
Effects of Incorrect Fluid Level
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL A low fluid level allows
the pump to take in air along with the fluid.
Air in the fluid will cause fluid pressures to be low and develop slower than normal.
If the transmission is overfilled, the gears churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and
causing the same conditions occurring with a low level.
In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation and varnish build up which interferes
with valve and clutch operation.
Foaming also causes fluid expansion, which can result in fluid overflow from the transmission vent
or fill tube.
Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a leak if inspection is not careful.
Fluid Contamination
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of: *
adding incorrect fluid
* failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level
* engine coolant entering the fluid
* internal failure that generates debris
* overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown)
* failure to reverse flush cooler and lines after repair
* failure to replace contaminated converter after repair
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The transmission cooler and lines should be reverse flushed whenever a malfunction generates
sludge and/or debris. The torque converter should also be replaced at the same time.
Failure to flush the cooler and lines will result in recontamination. Flushing applies to auxiliary
coolers as well. The torque converter should also be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge
and debris. This is necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all
contaminants.
Causes of Burnt Fluid
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of
overheating which has three primary causes.
1. Internal clutch slippage, usually caused by low line pressure, inadequate clutch apply pressure,
or clutch seal failure.
2. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and/or auxiliary cooler. This condition is usually
the result of a faulty or improperly installed
drainback valve, a damaged main cooler, or severe restrictions in the coolers and lines caused by
debris or kinked lines.
3. Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer
towing or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnosis and Testing > Page 3847
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection Fluid Level and Condition Check
41TE - Automatic Transaxle FLUID LEVEL AND CONDITION CHECK
NOTE: Only transmission fluid of the type labeled Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid Type 9602) should be used in this transaxle.
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
The transmission sump has a fluid level indicator (dipstick) to check oil similar to most automatic
transmissions. It is located on the left side of the engine. Be sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick
handle before removing.
The torque converter fills in both the P Park and N Neutral positions. Place the selector lever in P
Park to be sure that the fluid level check is accurate. The engine should be running at idle speed
for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground. At normal operating temperature 82 °C
(180 °F), the fluid level is correct if it is in the HOT region on the oil level indicator (Fig. 180). The
fluid level should be within the COLD region of the dipstick at 27 °C (80 °F) fluid temperature.
FLUID LEVEL CHECK USING DRB
NOTE: Engine and Transaxle should be at normal operating temperature before performing this
procedure.
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Hook up DRB scan tool and select transmission. 3.
Select sensors. 4. Read the transmission temperature value.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnosis and Testing > Page 3848
5. Compare the fluid temperature value with the fluid temperature chart (Fig. 181). 6. Adjust
transmission fluid level shown on the indicator according to the chart. 7. Check transmission for
leaks.
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly. Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transaxle
has too much fluid, the gears churn up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low
fluid level. In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and/or fluid oxidation, and varnishing.
This can interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in
fluid escaping from the transaxle vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
FLUID CONDITION
Along with fluid level, it is important to check the condition of the fluid. When the fluid smells
burned, and is contaminated with metal or friction material particles, a complete transaxle
recondition is probably required. Be sure to examine the fluid on the dipstick closely. If there is any
doubt about its condition, drain out a sample for a double check.
Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid Type 9602) when new is red in color. The ATF is
dyed red so it can be identified from other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or
antifreeze. The red color is not permanent and is not an indicator of fluid condition. As the vehicle is
driven, the ATF will begin to look darker in color and may eventually become brown. This is normal.
ATF +4 also has a unique odor that may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be
used to indicate the fluid condition or the need for a fluid change.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fluid Level and Condition Check
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Level and Condition Check
Procedure for Checking Fluid Level
Check the fluid level while the transmission is at normal operating temperature. this occurs after at
least 15 miles (25 km) of driving. At normal operating temperature, which is approximately 180 °F
(82 °C), the fluid cannot be held comfortably between the fingers.
To check the fluid level properly, the following procedure must be used:
1. The vehicle must be on level ground.
2. The engine should be running at curb idle speed for a minimum of 60 seconds.
3. Fully apply parking brake.
4. Place the gear selector momentarily in each gear position ending with the lever in P (PARK).
5. Remove the dipstick, wipe it clean and reinsert it until seated.
6. Remove the dipstick again and note the fluid level on both sides. The fluid level should be in the
crosshatch area at normal operating temperatures.
If the fluid is low, add as required into the dipstick tube. DO NOT OVERFILL.
Note: If it is necessary to check the transmission below the operating temperature, the fluid level
should be between the two cold (lower) holes on the dipstick with the fluid approximately 80 °F (27
°C) (room temperature). If the fluid level is correctly established at room temperature, it should be
between the HOT (upper) reference holes when the transmission reaches 180 °F (82 °C).
Remember, it is best to check the level at the normal operating temperature.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fluid Level and Condition Check > Page 3851
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid and Filter Service
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
should be used. A filter change should be made at
the time of the transmission oil change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be
cleaned with a clean, dry cloth. If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter
should be changed.
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED) 1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Place a drain container
with a large opening, under transaxle oil pan. 2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to
break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then remove the oil pan.
3. Install a new filter and O-ring on bottom of the valve body (Fig. 182). 4. Clean the oil pan and
magnet. Reinstall pan using new Mopar Silicone Adhesive sealant. Tighten oil pan bolts to 19 Nm
(165 in. lbs.). 5. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
through the dipstick opening. 6. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with
parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
7. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
8. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for the
proper fluid fill procedure.
9. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the dipstick
opening.
DIPSTICK TUBE FLUID SUCTION METHOD (ALTERNATIVE) 1. When performing the fluid
suction method, make sure the transaxle is at full operating temperature.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fluid Level and Condition Check > Page 3852
2. To perform the dipstick tube fluid suction method, use a suitable fluid suction device (Vacula or
equivalent). 3. Insert the fluid suction line into the dipstick tube.
NOTE: Verify that the suction line is inserted to the lowest point of the transaxle oil pan. This will
ensure complete evacuation of the fluid in the pan.
4. Follow the manufacturers recommended procedure and evacuate the fluid from the transaxle. 5.
Remove the suction line from the dipstick tube. 6. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid) Type 9602 through the dipstick opening. 7. Start engine and allow to idle for at
least one minute. Then, with parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily
to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
8. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
9. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
10. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID AND FILTER SERVICE
NOTE: Only fluids of the type labeled Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
should be used. A filter change should be made at
the time of the transmission oil change. The magnet (on the inside of the oil pan) should also be
cleaned with a clean, dry cloth. If the transaxle is disassembled for any reason, the fluid and filter
should be changed.
FLUID/FILTER SERVICE (RECOMMENDED) 1. Raise vehicle on a hoist. Place a drain container
with a large opening, under transaxle oil pan. 2. Loosen pan bolts and tap the pan at one corner to
break it loose allowing fluid to drain, then remove the oil pan.
3. Install a new filter and O-ring on bottom of the valve body (Fig. 182). 4. Clean the oil pan and
magnet. Reinstall pan using new Mopar Silicone Adhesive sealant. Tighten oil pan bolts to 19 Nm
(165 in. lbs.). 5. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid) Type 9602
through the dipstick opening. 6. Start engine and allow to idle for at least one minute. Then, with
parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
7. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
8. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
Refer to Fluid Level and Condition Check for the
proper fluid fill procedure.
9. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the dipstick
opening.
DIPSTICK TUBE FLUID SUCTION METHOD (ALTERNATIVE) 1. When performing the fluid
suction method, make sure the transaxle is at full operating temperature. 2. To perform the dipstick
tube fluid suction method, use a suitable fluid suction device (Vacula or equivalent).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3856
3. Insert the fluid suction line into the dipstick tube.
NOTE: Verify that the suction line is inserted to the lowest point of the transaxle oil pan. This will
ensure complete evacuation of the fluid in the pan.
4. Follow the manufacturers recommended procedure and evacuate the fluid from the transaxle. 5.
Remove the suction line from the dipstick tube. 6. Pour four quarts of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid) Type 9602 through the dipstick opening. 7. Start engine and allow to idle for at
least one minute. Then, with parking and service brakes applied, move selector lever momentarily
to each
position, ending in the park or neutral position.
8. Check the transaxle fluid level and add an appropriate amount to bring the transaxle fluid level to
3 mm (1/8 inch) below the lowest mark on the
dipstick (Fig. 183).
9. Recheck the fluid level after the transaxle has reached normal operating temperature (180°F.).
10. To prevent dirt from entering transaxle, make certain that dipstick is fully seated into the
dipstick opening.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fluid Line/Hose: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION The transmission oil cooling circuit uses special aggressive fittings for the
transmission oil cooler hoses. Whenever a transmission oil cooler hose is removed from a
transmission fitting (at transmission), it must be cut off flush with the fitting, and a service splice kit
must be used upon reassembly Refer to instructions provided with splice kit. Whenever a
transmission oil cooler hose is removed from a transmission oil cooler fitting (at radiator), it must be
replaced with a new hose. Removing the hose from the aggressive fitting will scrape material from
inside the hose making the hose larger.
Failure to replace the hose or install a service splice kit will result in transmission oil leaks. When
hose clamp replacement is necessary, replace with constant tension spring type hose clamps.
Always use proper hose clamp pliers on clamps. Use of improper hose clamp pliers may bend
hose clamps out-of-round resulting in transmission oil leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Cooler Lines Removal and Installation
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair Transmission Cooler Lines Removal and Installation
41TE - Automatic Transmission
REMOVAL
1. While holding tension on hose clamps with pliers, move clamps off the fitting location of hose.
2. Disconnect hoses from cooler (Fig. 2). Disconnect hoses from transmission fittings (Fig. 3). 3.
Remove cooler hoses.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When the transaxle cooler lines are removed from the rolled-groove type fittings at the
cooler and transaxle, damage to the inner wall of hose will occur. To prevent potential leakage, the
cooler hoses must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Cooler Lines Removal and Installation > Page 3862
1. Connect hoses to cooler (Fig. 2) and transmission (Fig. 3) fittings. 2. Position and install hose
clamps. 3. Start engine and check transmission fluid level. Adjust level as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Cooler Lines Removal and Installation > Page 3863
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair Flushing Coolers and Tubes
41TE - Automatic Transmission
FLUSHING COOLERS AND TUBES The recommended procedure for cooler flushing is to use
Tool 6906 Cooler Flusher.
WARNING: WEAR PROTECTIVE EYEWEAR THAT MEETS THE REQUIREMENTS OF OSHA.
WEAR STANDARD INDUSTRIAL
RUBBER GLOVES. KEEP LIT CIGARETTES, SPARKS, FLAMES, AND OTHER IGNITION
SOURCES AWAY FROM THE AREA TO PREVENT THE IGNITION OF COMBUSTIBLE LIQUIDS
AND GASES. KEEP A CLASS (B) FIRE EXTINGUISHER IN THE AREA WHERE THE FLUSHER
WILL BE USED. KEEP THE AREA WELL VENTILATED. DO NOT LET FLUSHING SOLVENT
COME IN CONTACT WITH YOUR EYES OR SKIN: IF EYE CONTAMINATION OCCURS, FLUSH
EYES WITH WATER FOR 15 TO 20 SECONDS. REMOVE CONTAMINATED CLOTHING AND
WASH AFFECTED SKIN WITH SOAP AND WATER. SEEK MEDICAL ATTENTION.
1. Remove cover plate filler plug on Tool 6906. Fill reservoir 1/2 to 3/4 full of fresh flushing solution.
Use Mopar Transmission Cooler Flush
(MS-552) or equivalent solution conforming to MS-552. Flushing solvents are petroleum based
solutions generally used to clean automatic transmission components. DO NOT use solvents
containing acids, water, gasoline, or any other corrosive liquids.
2. Reinstall filler plug on Tool 6906. 3. Verify pump power switch is turned OFF. Connect red
alligator clip to positive (+) battery post. Connect black (-) alligator clip to a good ground.
NOTE: When flushing transmission cooler and lines, ALWAYS reverse flush.
4. Connect the BLUE pressure line to the OUTLET (From) cooler line. 5. Connect the CLEAR
return line to the INLET (To) cooler line 6. Turn pump ON for two to three minutes to flush cooler
and lines. 7. Turn pump OFF. 8. Disconnect CLEAR suction line from reservoir at cover plate.
Disconnect CLEAR return line at cover plate, and place it in a drain pan. 9. Turn pump ON for 30
seconds to purge flushing solution from cooler and lines. Turn pump OFF.
10. Place CLEAR suction line into a one quart container of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission
Fluid-Type 9602). 11. Turn pump ON until all transmission fluid is removed from the one quart
container and lines. This purges any residual cleaning solvent from the
transmission cooler and lines. Turn pump OFF.
12. Disconnect alligator clips from battery. Reconnect flusher lines to cover plate, and remove
flushing adapters from cooler lines.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Oil Pan-to-Case Bolt ............................................................................................................................
................................................. 19 Nm (165 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly-to-Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 12 Nm (110 in.
lbs.)
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Connector Screw
............................................................................................................................. 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3870
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3871
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
DESCRIPTION
The Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (Fig. 289) is external to the transaxle and mounted to the
transaxle case. The assembly consists of four solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the
LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is controlled by line pressure from
the manual valve in the valve body. The solenoids are contained within the Solenoid/Pressure
Switch Assembly, and can only be serviced by replacing the assembly. The solenoid assembly also
contains pressure switches that monitor and send hydraulic circuit information to the TCM.
Likewise, the pressure switches can only be service by replacing the assembly.
OPERATION SOLENOIDS
The solenoids receive electrical power from the Transmission Control Relay through a single wire.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid needed. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid passage is
opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The result is an
apply or release of a frictional element. The 2/4 and UD solenoids are normally applied, which by
design allow fluid to pass through in their relaxed or "off" state. This allows transaxle limp-in (P, R,
N, 2) in the event of an electrical failure. The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically
tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off depending on its current state. An inductive spike should
be detected by the TCM during this test. If no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify
the failure. In addition to the periodic testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or
pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on three pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2/4, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The range for the pressure switch closing and opening points is 11 23 psi. Typically the switch opening point will be approximately one psi lower than the closing point.
For example, a switch may close at 18 psi and open at 17 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3872
The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the correct states (open or closed) in
each gear as shown in the chart shown.
PRESSURE SWITCH STATES
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear. The TCM also tests the 2/4 and OD pressure switches when they are
normally off (OD and 2/4 are tested in 1st gear, OD in 2nd gear, and 2/4 in 3rd gear). The test
simply verifies that they are operational, by looking for a closed state when the corresponding
element is applied. Immediately after a shift into 1st, 2nd, or 3rd gear with the engine speed above
1000 rpm, the TCM momentarily turns on element pressure to the 2/4 and/or OD clutch circuits to
identify that the appropriate switch has closed. If it doesn't close, it is tested again. If the switch fails
to close the second time, the appropriate DTC will set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3873
Pressure Switch States
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3874
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY REMOVAL
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
solenoid/pressure switch assembly connector. 4. Disconnect input speed sensor connector.
5. Remove input speed sensor (Fig. 290).
6. Remove three (3) solenoid/pressure switch assembly-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 291).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3875
7. Remove solenoid/pressure switch assembly and gasket (Fig. 292). Use care to prevent gasket
material and foreign objects from become lodged in
the transaxle case ports.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install solenoid/pressure switch assembly and new gasket to transaxle (Fig. 292). 2. Install and
torque three (3) bolts (Fig. 291) to 13 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 3. Install input speed sensor (Fig. 290) and
torque to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect input speed sensor connector. 5. Install solenoid/pressure
switch 8-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 6. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 7. Connect battery negative cable. 8. If solenoid/pressure switch assembly was
replaced, perform TCM Quick Learn procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fluid Pump: > 21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's
Fluid Pump: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's
NUMBER: 21-004-05
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: January 22, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-007-04, DATED MAY 11,
2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES, ADDITIONAL MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Transmission Delayed Engagement
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the front pump assembly in the transmission and
checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) for the latest software revision level.
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
**2002** - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 (KJ) Liberty
2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
**2002** 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
**2002**2003 (PL) Neon
**2002** 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
**2002** 2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
**2002** 2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fluid Pump: > 21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3884
NOTE:
Refer to the table for specific applications.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle operator may experience a delayed or temporary loss of transmission engagement after
initial start up. The condition follows an extended soak (several hours) and may be accompanied
by a harsh 4-3 downshift.
Technician may find Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P1791/P0944 - Loss of Prime.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBII I®) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine systems
are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition or the technician finds DTC P1791 or
P0944, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fluid Pump: > 21-004-05 > Jan > 05 > A/T Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3885
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to Step # 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to Step # 3.
2. Replace the transmission oil pump. Refer to the service information available in TechCONNECT
Group-21, Transmission.
3. Verify the controller has the latest software revision level.
4. If the controller is at the latest revision level, no further action is necessary. If a flash update is
available reprogram the controller as instructed in Service Bulletin 21-006-03 Rev. A.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 21-004-05 > Jan >
05 > A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's
Fluid Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's
NUMBER: 21-004-05
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: January 22, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-007-04, DATED MAY 11,
2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES, ADDITIONAL MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Transmission Delayed Engagement
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing the front pump assembly in the transmission and
checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) for the latest software revision level.
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
**2002** - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 (KJ) Liberty
2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
**2002** 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
**2002**2003 (PL) Neon
**2002** 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
**2002** 2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
**2002** 2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 21-004-05 > Jan >
05 > A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3891
NOTE:
Refer to the table for specific applications.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle operator may experience a delayed or temporary loss of transmission engagement after
initial start up. The condition follows an extended soak (several hours) and may be accompanied
by a harsh 4-3 downshift.
Technician may find Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P1791/P0944 - Loss of Prime.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBII I®) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine systems
are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present, other than those listed above, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition or the technician finds DTC P1791 or
P0944, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 21-004-05 > Jan >
05 > A/T - Delayed Gear Engagement/Possible DTC's > Page 3892
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to Step # 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to Step # 3.
2. Replace the transmission oil pump. Refer to the service information available in TechCONNECT
Group-21, Transmission.
3. Verify the controller has the latest software revision level.
4. If the controller is at the latest revision level, no further action is necessary. If a flash update is
available reprogram the controller as instructed in Service Bulletin 21-006-03 Rev. A.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3893
Fluid Pump: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission OIL PUMP - DESCRIPTION
The oil pump is located in the pump housing inside the bell housing of the transaxle case (Fig.
262). The oil pump consists of an inner and outer gear, a housing, and a cover that also serves as
the reaction shaft support.
OPERATION
As the torque converter rotates, the converter hub rotates the inner and outer gears. As the gears
rotate, the clearance between the gear teeth increases in the crescent area, and creates a suction
at the inlet side of the pump.
This suction draws fluid through the pump inlet from the oil pan. As the clearance between the gear
teeth in the crescent area decreases, it forces pressurized fluid into the pump outlet and to the
valve body.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3894
Fluid Pump: Testing and Inspection
41TE - Automatic Transmission STANDARD PROCEDURE - OIL PUMP VOLUME CHECK
Measuring oil pump output volume will determine if sufficient flow to the transmission oil cooler
exists, and whether or not an internal transmission failure is present.
Verify that transmission fluid is at the proper level. If adding fluid is necessary, fill to the proper level
with Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602). The following procedure is to
check oil pump output volume:
1. Using hose cutters or a suitable blade, cut the "to cooler" (Fig. 263) line off flush with the cooler
inlet fitting and place a collection container under
the open line.
CAUTION: With the fluid set at the proper level, fluid collection should not exceed (1) quart or
internal damage to the transmission may occur.
2. Start engine and run at curb idle speed, with the shift selector in neutral. 3. If one quart of ATF is
collected in 20 seconds or less, flow is within acceptable limits. If fluid flow is intermittent or it takes
more than 20 seconds
to collect one quart of ATF, Refer to DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING.
4. Inspect the cooler hose for damage. Replace if necessary. 5. Re-connect the to cooler line to the
transmission using a service splice kit. Refer to instructions included with the kit. 6. Refill the
transaxle to proper level with Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Fluid Pump: Service and Repair Disassembly
41TE - Automatic Transmission DISASSEMBLY
When disassembling the transaxle it is necessary to inspect the oil pump for wear and damage.
1. Remove the reaction shaft support bolts.
2. Remove reaction shaft support from pump housing (Fig. 264).
3. Remove the pump gears (Fig. 265) and check for wear and damage on pump housing and
gears. 4. Re-install the gears and check clearances.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3897
5. Measure the clearance between the outer gear and the pump pocket (Fig. 266). Clearance
should be 0.089 - 0.202 mm (0.0035 - 0.0079 inch). 6. Measure clearance between outer gear and
crescent.
Clearance should be 0.060 - 0.298 mm (0.0023 - 0.0117 inch).
7. Measure clearance between inner gear and crescent.
Clearance should be 0.093 - 0.385 mm (0.0036 - 0.0151 inch).
8. Position an appropriate piece of Plastigage across both pump gears. 9. Align the Plastigage to a
flat area on the reaction shaft support housing.
10. Install the reaction shaft to the pump housing. Tighten the bolts to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 11.
Remove bolts and carefully separate the housings. Measure the Plastigage following the
instructions supplied. 12. Clearance between outer gear side and the reaction shaft support should
be 0.020 - 0.046 mm (0.0008 - 0.0018 inch).
Clearance between inner gear side and the reaction shaft support should be 0.020 - 0.046 mm
(0.0008 - 0.0018 inch).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 3898
Fluid Pump: Service and Repair Assembly
41TE - Automatic Transmission ASSEMBLY
1. Assemble oil pump as shown in (Fig. 267) 2. Install and torque reaction shaft support-to-oil pump
housing bolts to 28 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams
Shift Indicator: Diagrams
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)(Autostick)
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Application and ID
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Console Gear Selector w/ Auto ...........................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC 194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Planetary Gears, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Planetary Gears: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission PLANETARY GEARTRAIN - DESCRIPTION
The planetary geartrain is located between the input clutch assembly and the rear of the transaxle
case. The planetary geartrain consists of two sun gears, two planetary carriers, two annulus (ring)
gears, and one output shaft (Fig. 268).
OPERATION
The planetary geartrain utilizes two planetary gear sets that connect the transmission input shaft to
the output shaft. Input and holding clutches drive or lock different planetary members to change
output ratio or direction.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3918
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3919
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3920
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3926
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3927
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 3928
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3929
Control Module: Locations
Fig.11 TCM Location
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3930
Control Module: Description and Operation
Fig.11 TCM Location
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11). It mounts on a bracket that is fastened to the rail.
The TCM is the controlling unit for all electronic operations of the transaxle. The TCM receives
information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and selects the
operational mode of the transaxle. Direct inputs are hardwired to, and used specifically by the
TCM. Indirect inputs originate from other components/modules, and are shared with the TCM via
the J1850 communication bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are: -Battery (B+) voltage -Ignition "ON" voltage
-Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) -Throttle Position Sensor -Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) -Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) -Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD) -Transmission
Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS) -Input Shaft Speed Sensor -Output Shaft Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are: Engine/Body Identification
- Manifold Pressure
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Speed Control ON/OFF Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Brake Switch Status
- DRB Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are: Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD and UD)
- Vehicle Speed (to PCM)
- Torque Reduction Request (to PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3931
An example of a TCM indirect output is: Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions: Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indices (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with DRB scan tool)
Clutch Volume Index (CVI) An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index
(CVI). CVIs represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
Fig.12 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur (Fig. 12).
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRB Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3932
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Shift Schedules As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of
shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following: Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3933
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the chart
to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Control Module (TCM) is being replaced with a new or replacement unit,
the Pinion Factor and Quick Learn procedures must be performed. (Refer to ELECTRONIC
CONTROL MODULES/TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE - STANDARD PROCEDURE)
(Refer to ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/ TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE)
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially remove right front wheel
splash shield.
Fig.13 TCM 60-Way Connector
4. Disconnect TCM 60-way connector (Fig. 13).
Fig.14 TCM/Bracket Assembly
5. Remove three (3) TCM bracket-to-rail screws and remove TCM/bracket assembly from vehicle
(Fig. 14).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3936
Fig.15 TCM Bracket
6. Remove four (4) bracket-to-TCM screws and remove bracket (Fig. 15).
INSTALLATION
1. Install TCM to mounting bracket and torque four (4) screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 15). 2.
Install TCM/bracket assembly to rail (Fig. 14). Install and torque three (3) bracket-to-rail screws to
12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Install TCM 60-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.) (Fig. 13). 4.
Install and secure right front wheel splash shield. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3937
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the Transmission Control Module (TCM) has been
replaced with a NEW or replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an
inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The TCM
must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Transmission Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a DRB III scan tool. 1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector
located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous
menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the instructions on the DRB III scan tool screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 3938
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRB III scan tool. This program allows the
electronic transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle
operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met: The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRB III
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60 ° and below 200 °
1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRB III to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Control System Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3942
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3943
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3944
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION CONTROL RELAY - DESCRIPTION
The transmission control relay (Fig. 303) is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), which
is located on the left side of the engine compartment.
OPERATION
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TCM, and is used to supply power to the
solenoid pack when the transmission is in normal operating mode. When the relay is "off", no
power is supplied to the solenoid pack and the transmission is in "limp-in" mode.
After a controller reset (ignition key turned to the "run" position or after cranking engine), the TCM
energizes the relay. Prior to this, the TCM verifies that the contacts are open by checking for no
voltage at the switched battery terminals.
After this is verified, the voltage at the solenoid pack pressure switches is checked. After the relay
is energized, the TCM monitors the terminals to verify that the voltage is greater than 3 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SEAL, OIL PUMP
REMOVAL
1. Remove transaxle from vehicle.
2. Using Tool C-3981-B, remove oil pump seal (Fig. 269).
INSTALLATION
1. Using Tool C-4193, install oil pump seal (Fig. 270). 2. Install transaxle to vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly-to-Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 12 Nm (110 in.
lbs.)
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Connector Screw
............................................................................................................................. 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3955
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3956
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
DESCRIPTION
The Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (Fig. 289) is external to the transaxle and mounted to the
transaxle case. The assembly consists of four solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the
LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is controlled by line pressure from
the manual valve in the valve body. The solenoids are contained within the Solenoid/Pressure
Switch Assembly, and can only be serviced by replacing the assembly. The solenoid assembly also
contains pressure switches that monitor and send hydraulic circuit information to the TCM.
Likewise, the pressure switches can only be service by replacing the assembly.
OPERATION SOLENOIDS
The solenoids receive electrical power from the Transmission Control Relay through a single wire.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid needed. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid passage is
opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The result is an
apply or release of a frictional element. The 2/4 and UD solenoids are normally applied, which by
design allow fluid to pass through in their relaxed or "off" state. This allows transaxle limp-in (P, R,
N, 2) in the event of an electrical failure. The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically
tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off depending on its current state. An inductive spike should
be detected by the TCM during this test. If no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify
the failure. In addition to the periodic testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or
pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on three pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2/4, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The range for the pressure switch closing and opening points is 11 23 psi. Typically the switch opening point will be approximately one psi lower than the closing point.
For example, a switch may close at 18 psi and open at 17 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3957
The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the correct states (open or closed) in
each gear as shown in the chart shown.
PRESSURE SWITCH STATES
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear. The TCM also tests the 2/4 and OD pressure switches when they are
normally off (OD and 2/4 are tested in 1st gear, OD in 2nd gear, and 2/4 in 3rd gear). The test
simply verifies that they are operational, by looking for a closed state when the corresponding
element is applied. Immediately after a shift into 1st, 2nd, or 3rd gear with the engine speed above
1000 rpm, the TCM momentarily turns on element pressure to the 2/4 and/or OD clutch circuits to
identify that the appropriate switch has closed. If it doesn't close, it is tested again. If the switch fails
to close the second time, the appropriate DTC will set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3958
Pressure Switch States
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3959
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY REMOVAL
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
solenoid/pressure switch assembly connector. 4. Disconnect input speed sensor connector.
5. Remove input speed sensor (Fig. 290).
6. Remove three (3) solenoid/pressure switch assembly-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 291).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3960
7. Remove solenoid/pressure switch assembly and gasket (Fig. 292). Use care to prevent gasket
material and foreign objects from become lodged in
the transaxle case ports.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install solenoid/pressure switch assembly and new gasket to transaxle (Fig. 292). 2. Install and
torque three (3) bolts (Fig. 291) to 13 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 3. Install input speed sensor (Fig. 290) and
torque to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect input speed sensor connector. 5. Install solenoid/pressure
switch 8-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 6. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 7. Connect battery negative cable. 8. If solenoid/pressure switch assembly was
replaced, perform TCM Quick Learn procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Switch: Locations
Interlock Mechanism
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3964
Shift Interlock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig. 39
1. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Fig. 40
2. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 40).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3965
Fig. 41
3. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/ RUN" position (Fig. 41).
Fig. 42
4. Grasp the interlock cable and connector firmly. Remove the interlock cable (Fig. 42).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3966
Fig. 43
5. Remove the two interlock mechanism-to-steering column attaching screws (Fig. 43). Remove
the interlock housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interlock housing at steering column. Install the two interlock mechanism-to-steering
column attaching screws. Torque screws to 3
Nm (21 inch lbs.).
2. Snap the interlock cable into the housing. 3. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds
(Fig. 40). 4. Install steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3970
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Mode Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3974
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3975
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3976
Autostick Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3982
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3983
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3984
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3985
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3986
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3987
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3988
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3993
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3994
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3995
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Input Speed Sensor (EATX)
Output Speed Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 293), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 294),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor >
Page 3998
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 295), an AC voltage is generated and sent to the
TCM. The TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input speed signal with output speed signal to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor >
Page 3999
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates an AC signal as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 298), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 299),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor >
Page 4000
OPERATION
The Output Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the output shaft is rotating. As the rear
planetary carrier park pawl lugs pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 300), an AC voltage is generated and
sent to the TCM. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following: Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor >
Page 4001
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Signal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
The vehicle speed signal is taken from the Output Speed Sensor. The TCM converts this signal
into a pulse per mile signal and sends it to the PCM.
The PCM, in turn, sends the vehicle speed message across the communication bus to the BCM.
The BCM sends this signal to the Instrument Cluster to display vehicle speed to the driver. The
vehicle speed signal pulse is roughly 8000 pulses per mile.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
input speed sensor connector.
4. Unscrew and remove input speed sensor (Fig. 296).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 297) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position. 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Install air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 5. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4004
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect output speed sensor
connector.
4. Unscrew and remove output speed sensor (Fig. 301).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 302) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position (Fig. 302). 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments
Shift Interlock Cable: Adjustments
41TE - Automatic Transmission
BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK SYSTEM
VERIFICATION
The chart shown describes the normal operation of the Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI)
system. If the "expected response" differs from the vehicle's response, then system repair and/or
adjustment is necessary.
ADJUSTMENT
1. Loosen set screw and remove knob from shifter handle (Fig. 286).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4009
2. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 287).
3. Remove shifter bezel (Fig. 288). 4. Adjust interlock cable/system as follows: Pry up on cable
adjuster lock to release and allow cable to "self-adjust". Lock cable adjustment by
pressing down on the adjuster lock until bottomed at the cable housing.
5. Verify correct system operation. Refer to verification procedure. 6. Install shifter bezel (Fig. 288).
7. Install center console assembly (Fig. 287). 8. Install gearshift knob and tighten set screw to 2 Nm
(15 in. lbs.) torque (Fig. 286).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4010
Shift Interlock Cable: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SHIFT INTERLOCK CABLE - REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Loosen set screw and remove knob from shifter handle (Fig. 271).
3. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 272).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4011
4. Remove shifter bezel (Fig. 273).
5. Disconnect the shifter/ignition interlock cable from the shifter lever and bracket as shown in (Fig.
274). Remove the cable core end from the
plastic cam of the shifter mechanism and release cable from shifter bracket.
6. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 275).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4012
7. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 276).
8. Disconnect the Brake Transmission Shift Interlock (BTSI) solenoid connector from the interlock
cable (Fig. 277).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4013
9. Rotate the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/RUN" position (Fig. 278).
10. Squeeze the interlock cable locking tab. Remove the cable from the interlock housing (Fig.
279). 11. Release cable from retaining clips and remove through opening under steering column.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When installing interlock cable assembly, care must be taken not to bend exposed
cable wire and slug at shifter end of cable.
1. Route interlock cable through hole in instrument panel below steering column and around to
gear shifter assembly. 2. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/RUN" position (Fig. 278).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4014
3. Install the interlock cable into the interlock housing at the steering column (Fig. 280). Verify the
cable snaps into the housing and is fully seated. 4. Return the ignition key to the "LOCK" position
(Fig. 278). 5. Connect the BTSI solenoid connector (Fig. 277). 6. Install cable into retaining clips as
shown in (Fig. 277). 7. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 276). 8. Install
steering column lower cover (Fig. 275). 9. Verify that shifter is in gated "PARK".
10. Install the cable core end to the plastic cam of the shifter mechanism. Snap the shifter/ignition
interlock cable end fitting into the groove in the
gearshift mechanism as shown in (Fig. 274).
11. Adjust interlock cable/system as follows: If interlock cable is being replaced, it will come with an
adjustment pin. Remove the pin from the cable
and allow the cable to "self-adjust". Lock cable adjustment by pressing down on the adjuster lock
until bottomed at the cable housing. If interlock cable is being re-used, no pin will be provided. Pry
up on cable adjuster lock to release and allow cable to "self-adjust". Lock cable adjustment by
pressing down on the adjuster lock until bottomed at the cable housing.
12. Connect battery negative cable and verify interlock system operation as shown. 13. Install
shifter bezel (Fig. 273). 14. Install center console assembly (Fig. 272). 15. Install gearshift knob
and tighten set screw to 2 Nm (15 in. lbs.) torque (Fig. 271).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4018
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Switch: Locations
Interlock Mechanism
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4022
Shift Interlock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig. 39
1. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Fig. 40
2. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 40).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4023
Fig. 41
3. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/ RUN" position (Fig. 41).
Fig. 42
4. Grasp the interlock cable and connector firmly. Remove the interlock cable (Fig. 42).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4024
Fig. 43
5. Remove the two interlock mechanism-to-steering column attaching screws (Fig. 43). Remove
the interlock housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interlock housing at steering column. Install the two interlock mechanism-to-steering
column attaching screws. Torque screws to 3
Nm (21 inch lbs.).
2. Snap the interlock cable into the housing. 3. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds
(Fig. 40). 4. Install steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4028
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4029
8w-80-61
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4030
Solenoid Application Chart
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments
Shift Cable: Adjustments
41TE - Automatic Transmission GEARSHIFT CABLE
Normal operation of the Park/Neutral Position Switch provides a quick check to confirm proper
linkage adjustment. The engine starter should only operate when the transaxle shift lever is in the
PARK (P) or NEUTRAL (N) positions.
If the engine starts in any other gear position, or the vehicle rolls when the shifter is in gated PARK
(P), a gearshift cable adjustment is necessary.
ADJUSTMENT
1. Loosen set screw and remove knob from shifter handle (Fig. 193).
2. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 194). 3. Adjust gearshift cable as
follows:
a. Place gearshift lever in the PARK (P) position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4035
b. Loosen shift cable adjustment screw (Fig. 195). c. Move transaxle manual lever to the PARK.
Verify transaxle is in PARK by attempting to roll vehicle in either direction. d. Tighten shift cable
adjustment screw to 8 Nm (70 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Verify proper cable adjustment. Engine should start with the shifter lever in PARK (P) and
NEUTRAL (N) positions ONLY. 5. Install center console assembly (Fig. 194). 6. Install gearshift
knob and tighten set screw to 2 Nm (15 in. lbs.) torque (Fig. 193).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4036
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission GEARSHIFT CABLE - REMOVAL
1. Loosen set screw and remove knob from shifter handle (Fig. 184).
2. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 185).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4037
3. Remove shifter bezel (Fig. 186).
4. Disconnect shift cable from shifter assembly as shown in (Fig. 187). 5. Remove three grommet
plate to floor pan nuts as shown in (Fig. 187). 6. Disconnect both battery cables, remove battery
hold down clamp and bolt, and remove battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4038
7. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assy. (Fig. 188) as follows:
a. Disconnect Proportional Purge Solenoid (PPS) and crankcase vent hose from throttle body. b.
Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and Idle Air Control (IAC) connectors. c. Remove
mounting bolt and nut (Fig. 188) and partially remove air cleaner assembly. d. Disconnect
accelerator and speed control (if equipped) cables after the assy. is removed from position.
Remove air cleaner assembly from
vehicle.
8. Remove battery tray from bracket.
9. Disconnect shifter cable from shift lever and remove from bracket (Fig. 189).
10. Raise vehicle on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4039
11. Remove catalytic converter heat shield (Fig. 190). 12. Remove intermediate pipe heat shield
front bolts.
13. Remove remaining grommet plate screw and remove cable assembly from vehicle (Fig. 191).
INSTALLATION
1. Install cable assembly through floor pan opening and secure to floor pan with grommet plate and
one screw (Fig. 191). Make sure the three
grommet plate studs protrude through cable assembly and floor pan and tighten screw to 7 Nm (60
in. lbs.).
2. Route transaxle end of cable assembly into engine compartment and over transaxle assembly.
3. Install and tighten intermediate pipe heat shield front screws. 4. Install catalytic converter heat
shield (Fig. 190). 5. Install gear shift cable to bracket and connect to shift lever (Fig. 189). 6. Install
and tighten the three grommet plate-to-floor pan nuts. Tighten to 6 Nm (50 in. lbs.) torque. 7.
Connect gearshift cable to shifter assembly as shown in (Fig. 187). 8. Install shifter bezel (Fig.
186). 9. Adjust gearshift cable as follows:
a. Place gearshift lever in the PARK (P) position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 4040
b. Loosen shift cable adjustment screw (Fig. 192). c. Verify transaxle is in the PARK (P) position
and the shifter lever is in gated PARK. d. Tighten shift cable adjustment screw to 8 Nm (70 in. lbs.)
torque.
10. Install battery tray. 11. Install battery and hold down clamp. 12. Install the air cleaner/throttle
body assy. (Fig. 188) as follows:
a. Connect the accelerator and speed control (if equipped) cables to the air cleaner/throttle body
assy. b. Install assy. into position, making sure the air cleaner locating slot is engaged to the
battery bracket tab, and tighten fasteners to 14 Nm (120
in. lbs.) torque.
c. Verify throttle body duct is fully seated to intake manifold and tighten clamp to 5 Nm (40 in. lbs.)
torque. d. Connect the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and Idle Air Control (IAC) connectors. e.
Connect Proportional Purge Solenoid (PPS) and crankcase vent hose from throttle body.
13. Install center console assembly (Fig. 185). 14. Install gearshift knob and tighten set screw to 2
Nm (15 in. lbs.) torque (Fig. 184). 15. Connect battery cables. 16. Verify that engine starter
operates in both PARK (P) and NEUTRAL (N). Starter should not operate in any other gear
position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid Position
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid Position
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4044
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Specifications
Torque Converter: Specifications
Bolt, Torque Converter-to-Driveplate
...................................................................................................................................................... 75
Nm (55 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Control System Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4051
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4052
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4053
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION CONTROL RELAY - DESCRIPTION
The transmission control relay (Fig. 303) is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), which
is located on the left side of the engine compartment.
OPERATION
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TCM, and is used to supply power to the
solenoid pack when the transmission is in normal operating mode. When the relay is "off", no
power is supplied to the solenoid pack and the transmission is in "limp-in" mode.
After a controller reset (ignition key turned to the "run" position or after cranking engine), the TCM
energizes the relay. Prior to this, the TCM verifies that the contacts are open by checking for no
voltage at the switched battery terminals.
After this is verified, the voltage at the solenoid pack pressure switches is checked. After the relay
is energized, the TCM monitors the terminals to verify that the voltage is greater than 3 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission
DESCRIPTION The transmission oil cooler is an oil to coolant type, mounted in the radiator lower
tank (Fig. 1). Rubber hoses connect the oil cooler and the automatic transmission. Use only
approved transmission oil cooler hoses that are molded to fit the applicable vehicle. The
transmission cooler is serviced with the radiator.
OPERATION As oil flows through the cooler, heat from the oil is transferred to the coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Flushing Coolers and Tubes
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Flushing Coolers and Tubes
41TE - Automatic Transmission
FLUSHING COOLERS AND TUBES The recommended procedure for cooler flushing is to use
Tool 6906 Cooler Flusher.
WARNING: WEAR PROTECTIVE EYEWEAR THAT MEETS THE REQUIREMENTS OF OSHA.
WEAR STANDARD INDUSTRIAL
RUBBER GLOVES. KEEP LIT CIGARETTES, SPARKS, FLAMES, AND OTHER IGNITION
SOURCES AWAY FROM THE AREA TO PREVENT THE IGNITION OF COMBUSTIBLE LIQUIDS
AND GASES. KEEP A CLASS (B) FIRE EXTINGUISHER IN THE AREA WHERE THE FLUSHER
WILL BE USED. KEEP THE AREA WELL VENTILATED. DO NOT LET FLUSHING SOLVENT
COME IN CONTACT WITH YOUR EYES OR SKIN: IF EYE CONTAMINATION OCCURS, FLUSH
EYES WITH WATER FOR 15 TO 20 SECONDS. REMOVE CONTAMINATED CLOTHING AND
WASH AFFECTED SKIN WITH SOAP AND WATER. SEEK MEDICAL ATTENTION.
1. Remove cover plate filler plug on Tool 6906. Fill reservoir 1/2 to 3/4 full of fresh flushing solution.
Use Mopar Transmission Cooler Flush
(MS-552) or equivalent solution conforming to MS-552. Flushing solvents are petroleum based
solutions generally used to clean automatic transmission components. DO NOT use solvents
containing acids, water, gasoline, or any other corrosive liquids.
2. Reinstall filler plug on Tool 6906. 3. Verify pump power switch is turned OFF. Connect red
alligator clip to positive (+) battery post. Connect black (-) alligator clip to a good ground.
NOTE: When flushing transmission cooler and lines, ALWAYS reverse flush.
4. Connect the BLUE pressure line to the OUTLET (From) cooler line. 5. Connect the CLEAR
return line to the INLET (To) cooler line 6. Turn pump ON for two to three minutes to flush cooler
and lines. 7. Turn pump OFF. 8. Disconnect CLEAR suction line from reservoir at cover plate.
Disconnect CLEAR return line at cover plate, and place it in a drain pan. 9. Turn pump ON for 30
seconds to purge flushing solution from cooler and lines. Turn pump OFF.
10. Place CLEAR suction line into a one quart container of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission
Fluid-Type 9602). 11. Turn pump ON until all transmission fluid is removed from the one quart
container and lines. This purges any residual cleaning solvent from the
transmission cooler and lines. Turn pump OFF.
12. Disconnect alligator clips from battery. Reconnect flusher lines to cover plate, and remove
flushing adapters from cooler lines.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Flushing Coolers and Tubes > Page 4059
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Transmission Oil Cooler
41TE - Automatic Transmission REMOVAL The transmission cooler is serviced with the radiator
assembly.
CLEANING If internal cleaning is necessary Refer to FLUSHING COOLERS AND TUBES.
INSPECTION Inspect all hoses, tubes, clamps and connections for leaks, cracks, or damage.
Replace as necessary. Use only approved transmission oil cooler hoses that are molded to fit the
space available. Inspect external coolers for leaks, loose mounts, or damage. Replace as
necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Application and ID
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Console Gear Selector w/ Auto ...........................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC 194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Mode Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4066
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4067
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4068
Autostick Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4074
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4075
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4076
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4077
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4078
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4079
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4080
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure
Test Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4088
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4089
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4090
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Input Speed Sensor (EATX)
Output Speed Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 293), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 294),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4093
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 295), an AC voltage is generated and sent to the
TCM. The TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input speed signal with output speed signal to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4094
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates an AC signal as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 298), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 299),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4095
OPERATION
The Output Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the output shaft is rotating. As the rear
planetary carrier park pawl lugs pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 300), an AC voltage is generated and
sent to the TCM. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following: Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4096
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Signal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
The vehicle speed signal is taken from the Output Speed Sensor. The TCM converts this signal
into a pulse per mile signal and sends it to the PCM.
The PCM, in turn, sends the vehicle speed message across the communication bus to the BCM.
The BCM sends this signal to the Instrument Cluster to display vehicle speed to the driver. The
vehicle speed signal pulse is roughly 8000 pulses per mile.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
input speed sensor connector.
4. Unscrew and remove input speed sensor (Fig. 296).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 297) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position. 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Install air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 5. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4099
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect output speed sensor
connector.
4. Unscrew and remove output speed sensor (Fig. 301).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 302) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position (Fig. 302). 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-008-04A > Oct > 04 > A/T - MIL ON/DTC
P1776 Set
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - MIL ON/DTC P1776 Set
NUMBER: 21-008-04 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2004
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-008-04, DATED JUNE 1,
2004. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN
ADDITIONAL MODEL YEAR AND A UPDATED DISCUSSION.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination - DTC P1776 Solenoid Switch Valve Latched in LR Position
MODELS:
2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2005 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2003 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
**2002** - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003-2004 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2003 - 2005 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 - 2005 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2005 (RS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2003 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
NOTE:
Refer to the following table for specific applications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-008-04A > Oct > 04 > A/T - MIL ON/DTC
P1776 Set > Page 4108
DISCUSSION:
If the vehicle operator describes a MIL illumination and the technician finds DTC P1776 Solenoid
Switch Valve Latched in LR Position is set the DRBIII(R) can be used to access the event data
screen and look at the "TRS Code" reading.
NOTE:
The solenoid switch valve is not in the solenoid pack it is in the valve body.
TRS Code Reads TR2
If the TRS Code displays TR2 it is an indication that the manual valve was not fully in the OD
position at the time the DTC was set. Check the shifter cable adjustment and adjust if necessary.
Also check the shift control system for excessive friction and/or routing issues.
TRS Code Reads OD
If the "TRS Code displays "OD" then a sticky solenoid switch valve is the primary cause.
Perform the proper diagnosis for the valve body. Inspect for foreign material in the solenoid switch
valve and plugs.
**FOR 2002 - 2004 LH MODEL ONLY**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-008-04A > Oct > 04 > A/T - MIL ON/DTC
P1776 Set > Page 4109
**If replacing the valve body assembly for DTC P1776 Solenoid Switch Valve Latched in LR
Position first inspect the build date on the solenoid pack (Fig. 1) or (Fig. 2). If the build date range
falls in between 3001 and 0603 replace the solenoid pack not the valve body**
NOTE:
The first three characters are the day of the year, the fourth character is the year, ie. 3001 is the
300th day of 2001.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 21-008-04A > Oct > 04 > A/T - MIL
ON/DTC P1776 Set
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - MIL ON/DTC P1776 Set
NUMBER: 21-008-04 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2004
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-008-04, DATED JUNE 1,
2004. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN
ADDITIONAL MODEL YEAR AND A UPDATED DISCUSSION.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination - DTC P1776 Solenoid Switch Valve Latched in LR Position
MODELS:
2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - 2005 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2003 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
**2002** - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003-2004 (PL) Neon/SX2.0
2003 - 2005 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 - 2005 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 - 2005 (RS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2003 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
NOTE:
Refer to the following table for specific applications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 21-008-04A > Oct > 04 > A/T - MIL
ON/DTC P1776 Set > Page 4115
DISCUSSION:
If the vehicle operator describes a MIL illumination and the technician finds DTC P1776 Solenoid
Switch Valve Latched in LR Position is set the DRBIII(R) can be used to access the event data
screen and look at the "TRS Code" reading.
NOTE:
The solenoid switch valve is not in the solenoid pack it is in the valve body.
TRS Code Reads TR2
If the TRS Code displays TR2 it is an indication that the manual valve was not fully in the OD
position at the time the DTC was set. Check the shifter cable adjustment and adjust if necessary.
Also check the shift control system for excessive friction and/or routing issues.
TRS Code Reads OD
If the "TRS Code displays "OD" then a sticky solenoid switch valve is the primary cause.
Perform the proper diagnosis for the valve body. Inspect for foreign material in the solenoid switch
valve and plugs.
**FOR 2002 - 2004 LH MODEL ONLY**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 21-008-04A > Oct > 04 > A/T - MIL
ON/DTC P1776 Set > Page 4116
**If replacing the valve body assembly for DTC P1776 Solenoid Switch Valve Latched in LR
Position first inspect the build date on the solenoid pack (Fig. 1) or (Fig. 2). If the build date range
falls in between 3001 and 0603 replace the solenoid pack not the valve body**
NOTE:
The first three characters are the day of the year, the fourth character is the year, ie. 3001 is the
300th day of 2001.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 >
Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 >
Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 4122
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 >
Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 4128
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4129
Valve Body: Description and Operation
41/40TE - Automatic Transmission VALVE BODY - DESCRIPTION
The valve body assembly consists of a cast aluminum valve body, a separator plate, and transfer
plate. The valve body contains valves and check balls that control fluid delivery to the torque
converter clutch, solenoid/pressure switch assembly, and frictional clutches. The valve body
contains the following components (Fig. 307):
- Regulator valve
- Solenoid switch valve
- Manual valve
- Converter clutch switch valve
- Converter clutch control valve
- Torque converter regulator valve
- Low/Reverse switch valve
In addition, the valve body also contains the thermal valve, # 2, 3 & 4 check balls, the # 5
(overdrive) check valve and the 2/4 accumulator assembly.
OPERATION
NOTE: Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for a visual aid in determining valve location, operation
and design.
REGULATOR VALVE
The regulator valve controls hydraulic pressure in the transaxle. It receives unregulated pressure
from the pump, which works against spring tension to maintain oil at specific pressures. A system
of sleeves and ports allows the regulator valve to work at one of three predetermined pressure
levels. Regulated oil pressure is also referred to as "line pressure."
SOLENOID SWITCH VALVE
The solenoid switch valve controls line pressure from the LR/CC solenoid. In one position, it allows
the low/reverse clutch to be pressurized. In the other, it directs line pressure to the converter
control and converter clutch valves.
MANUAL VALVE The manual valve is operated by the mechanical shift linkage. Its primary
responsibility is to send line pressure to the appropriate hydraulic circuits and solenoids. The valve
has three operating ranges or positions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4130
CONVERTER CLUTCH SWITCH VALVE
The main responsibility of the converter clutch switch valve is to control hydraulic pressure applied
to the front (off) side of the converter clutch piston. Line pressure from the regulator valve is fed to
the torque converter regulator valve, where it passes through the valve, and is slightly regulated.
The pressure is then directed to the converter clutch switch valve and to the front side of the
converter clutch piston. This pressure pushes the piston back and disengages the converter clutch.
CONVERTER CLUTCH CONTROL VALVE
The converter clutch control valve controls the back (on) side of the torque converter clutch. When
the TCM energizes or modulates the LR/CC solenoid to apply the converter clutch piston, both the
converter clutch control valve and the converter control valve move, allowing pressure to be
applied to the back side of the clutch.
T/C REGULATOR VALVE
The torque converter regulator valve slightly regulates the flow of fluid to the torque converter.
LOW/REVERSE SWITCH VALVE
The low/reverse clutch is applied from different sources, depending on whether low (1st) gear or
reverse is selected. The low/reverse switch valve alternates positions depending on from which
direction fluid pressure is applied. By design, when the valve is shifted by fluid pressure from one
channel, the opposing channel is blocked. The switch valve alienates the possibility of a sticking
ball check, thus providing consistent application of the low/reverse clutch under all operating
conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Valve Body: Service and Repair Removal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VALVE BODY - REMOVAL
NOTE: If valve body is replaced or reconditioned, the TCM Quick Learn Procedure must be
performed.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
gearshift cable from manual valve lever. 4. Remove manual valve lever from manual shaft. 5.
Disconnect Transmission Range Sensor (TRS). 6. Raise vehicle on hoist.
7. Remove oil pan bolts (Fig. 308).
8. Remove oil pan (Fig. 309).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4133
9. Remove oil filter (Fig. 310).
10. Remove the valve body-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 311).
NOTE: To ease removal of the valve body, turn the manual valve lever fully clockwise to low or first
gear.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4134
11. Remove park rod rollers from guide bracket and remove valve body from transaxle (Fig. 312)
(Fig. 313).
CAUTION: The valve body manual shaft pilot may distort and bind the manual valve if the valve
body is mishandled or dropped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4135
Valve Body: Service and Repair Disassembly
41TE - Automatic Transmission DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: If valve body assembly is being reconditioned, the TCM Quick Learn Procedure must be
performed.
1. Remove manual shaft seal (Fig. 314).
2. Remove Transmission Range Sensor retaining screw (Fig. 315).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4136
3. Remove Manual Shaft/Rooster Comb and Transmission Range Sensor (Fig. 316).
4. Remove 2/4 Accumulator Retaining Plate (Fig. 317).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4137
5. Remove 2/4 Accumulator components as shown in (Fig. 318).
6. Remove Valve Body to Transfer Plate screws (Fig. 319).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4138
7. Invert assembly and remove Transfer Plate (Fig. 320). Beware of loose check balls.
8. Remove oil screen (Fig. 321).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4139
9. Remove the overdrive clutch (# 5) check valve (Fig. 322).
NOTE: Tag all valve/spring assemblies for reassembly identification.
10. Remove separator plate (Fig. 323).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4140
11. Remove thermal valve (Fig. 324).
12. Remove check balls (Fig. 325).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4141
13. Remove dual retainer plate using Tool 6301 (Fig. 326).
14. Remove regulator valve spring retainer (Fig. 327).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4142
15. Remove remaining retainers as shown in (Fig. 328).
16. Remove valves and springs as shown in (Fig. 329).
NOTE: Refer to Valve Body Cleaning and Inspection for cleaning procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4143
Valve Body: Service and Repair Assembly
41TE - Automatic Transmission
ASSEMBLY
NOTE: If valve body assembly is reconditioned, the TCM Quick Learn Procedure must be
performed.
1. Install valves and springs as shown in (Fig. 329).
2. Install regulator valve spring retainer (Fig. 330).
3. Install dual retainer plate using Tool 6301 (Fig. 331).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4144
4. Verify that all retainers are installed as shown in (Fig. 332). Retainers should be flush or below
valve body surface.
5. Install check balls into position as shown in (Fig. 333). If necessary, secure them with petrolatum
or transmission assembly gel for assembly ease.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4145
6. Install thermal valve into transfer plate (Fig. 334).
7. Install separator plate to valve body (Fig. 335).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4146
8. Install the overdrive clutch (# 5) check valve to separator plate (Fig. 336).
9. Install oil screen to separator plate (Fig. 337).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4147
10. Install transfer plate to valve body and separator plate. Make sure oil screen and # 5 check
valve do not bind (Fig. 338).
11. Install twenty-four transfer plate to valve body screws (Fig. 339) and torque to 5 Nm (45 in.
lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4148
12. Install 2/4 Accumulator components as shown in (Fig. 340).
13. Torque 2/4 Accumulator retainer to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.) (Fig. 341).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4149
14. Install Manual Shaft/Rooster Comb and Transmission Range Sensor (Fig. 342).
15. Make sure Manual Valve control pin is contained within the rooster comb slot (Fig. 343). Install
Transmission Range Sensor retaining screw (Fig.
343) and torque to 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4150
16. Install manual shaft seal (Fig. 344).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4151
Valve Body: Service and Repair Installation
41TE - Automatic Transmission
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If valve body assembly is being replaced or reconditioned, it is necessary to perform the
TCM Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install valve body assembly to transaxle (Fig. 345). Install and torque valve body-to-transaxle
case bolts (Fig. 346) to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4152
2. Install transaxle oil filter (Fig. 347). Inspect the O-ring and replace if necessary.
3. Ensure the transaxle oil pan and transaxle case sealing surfaces are clean and dry. Install an
1/8" bead of Mopar ATF RTV (MS-GF41) to the oil
pan and install (Fig. 348). Torque oil pan-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 349) to 19 Nm (165 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4153
4. Lower vehicle. 5. Connect transmission range sensor connector. 6. Install manual valve lever to
manual shaft. 7. Install gearshift cable to manual valve lever. 8. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 9. Connect battery negative cable.
10. Fill transaxle with Mopar ATF +4 Transmission fluid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Damper > Component Information >
Specifications
Clutch Damper: Specifications
Damper-to-Transaxle Nuts ..................................................................................................................
................................................ 24 Nm (215 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Clutch Disc: Specifications
Clutch Cover-to-Flywheel Bolts
..........................................................................................................................................................
29 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4161
Clutch Disc: Service and Repair
CLUTCH DISC
REMOVAL
1. Raise hood. 2. Disconnect and isolate both battery cables, remove battery hold down clamp and
bolt, and remove battery.
3. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assy. (Fig. 6) as follows:
a. Disconnect Proportional Purge Solenoid (PPS) and crankcase vent hose from throttle body. b.
Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and Idle Air Control (IAC) connectors. c. Disconnect
throttle body air duct at intake manifold. d. Remove mounting bolt and nut (Fig. 6) and partially
remove air cleaner assembly. e. Disconnect accelerator and speed control (if equipped) cables
after the assy. is removed from position. Remove air cleaner assembly from
vehicle.
4. Remove battery tray from bracket. 5. Disconnect ground cable at battery tray bracket. 6.
Disconnect back-up lamp switch connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4162
7. Using Tool 6638A, disconnect clutch hydraulic quick-connect (Fig. 7) (Fig. 8).
8. Remove shift cable-to-bracket clips (Fig. 9). 9. Disconnect shift selector and crossover cable
from levers (Fig. 9). Remove cables and secure out of the way.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4163
10. Disconnect the vehicle speed sensor connector (Fig. 10). 11. Raise vehicle on hoist. 12.
Remove transaxle oil drain plug and drain oil into a suitable container. 13. Remove both half shafts.
14. Remove starter motor (Fig. 11). 15. Support engine at oil pan with screw jack and wood block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4164
16. Remove transaxle upper mount thru-bolt. Gain access to this bolt through the driver's side
wheel house (Fig. 12). 17. Carefully lower engine and transaxle on screw jack until proper removal
clearance is obtained. 18. Obtain a helper to assist in holding transaxle while removing
transaxle-to-engine mounting bolts. 19. Remove transaxle from vehicle. 20. Remove bolts holding
the clutch pressure plate to the flywheel. 21. Remove the clutch pressure plate and disc from the
flywheel. 22. Remove the bolts holding the flywheel to the engine crankshaft. 23. Remove the
flywheel from the crankshaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect clutch release bearing and lever for excessive wear and replace as necessary. 2. Clean
the surfaces of the flywheel and pressure plate to make certain that all oil, grease, and rust have
been removed. 3. Inspect the clutch disc for the side marked "FLYWHEEL SIDE". 4. Apply a very
light coating of grease to the splines in the clutch disc hub. 5. Position the flywheel onto the engine
crankshaft. 6. Install the bolts to hold the flywheel to the crankshaft. Tighten the bolts to 95 Nm (70
ft. lbs.). 7. Position the clutch disc to the flywheel. 8. Install the clutch pressure plate to the flywheel.
Finger tighten the pressure plate bolts. 9. Use Clutch Alignment Tool 6724 to position the clutch
disc to the center of the flywheel.
10. Tighten the clutch pressure plate bolts in a criss-cross pattern to 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.). 11.
Install transaxle into position. Be sure to carefully guide the input shaft splines through the clutch
disc. It may be necessary to slightly rotate the
transaxle or flywheel to allow the splines to engage.
12. Install transaxle-to-engine mounting bolts and tighten to 108 Nm (80 ft. lbs.) torque. 13. Raise
engine and transaxle with screw jack until through hole in upper mount aligns with hole in mount
bracket. Install mount bolt and tighten to
108 Nm (70 ft. lbs.) torque (Fig. 12).
14. Remove screw jack. 15. Install starter motor and tighten bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque.
Make sure to fasten ground cable to upper starter bolt as shown in (Fig. 11). 16. Connect starter
electrical harness and tighten positive cable nut to 10 Nm (90 inch lbs.) torque. 17. Install both front
axle driveshafts. 18. Fill transaxle with suitable amount of Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission
Fluid - Type 9602). Fill height is 3/16" (4.76 mm) below bottom
of fill hole.
19. Lower vehicle. 20. Connect vehicle speed sensor connector (Fig. 10). 21. Connect shift
crossover and selector cables to shift lever. Install cables to bracket and install retaining clips (Fig.
9). 22. Connect the master cylinder hydraulic line to the slave cylinder hydraulic line. An audible
click should be heard. Verify the connection by pulling
outward on the master cylinder line.
23. Connect back-up lamp switch connector. 24. Connect ground strap to transaxle upper mount
bracket. 25. Install battery lower tray and battery, and tighten battery hold down clamp to secure
battery. 26. Install the air cleaner/throttle body assy. as follows:
a. Connect the accelerator and speed control (if equipped) cables to the air cleaner/throttle body
assy. b. Install assembly into position, making sure the air cleaner locating slot is engaged to the
battery bracket tab, and tighten fasteners to 14 Nm
(120 inch lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4165
c. Verify throttle body duct is fully seated to intake manifold and tighten clamp to 5 Nm (40 inch
lbs.) torque. d. Connect the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and Idle Air Control (IAC) connectors. e.
Connect Proportional Purge Solenoid (PPS) and crankcase vent hose from throttle body.
27. Connect the battery cables. 28. Road test vehicle and inspect for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Capacity Specifications
HYDRAULIC - FLUID
CAUTION: Never use any type of petroleum-based fluid (engine oil, transmission oil, power
steering fluid, etc.) in the clutch hydraulic system. Use of
such fluids will result in master/slave cylinder seal damage, and cause a failure of the hydraulic
clutch release system.
NOTE: The clutch hydraulic system and replacement components are pre-filled, and under normal
operating conditions, additional fluid is not required
for the life of the vehicle.
The fluid required for use in the clutch hydraulic system is brake fluid conforming to DOT 3
specifications and J1703 standards. No other type of fluid is recommended or approved for use in
the clutch hydraulic system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed
container.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4171
Clutch Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
HYDRAULIC - FLUID
CAUTION: Never use any type of petroleum-based fluid (engine oil, transmission oil, power
steering fluid, etc.) in the clutch hydraulic system. Use of
such fluids will result in master/slave cylinder seal damage, and cause a failure of the hydraulic
clutch release system.
NOTE: The clutch hydraulic system and replacement components are pre-filled, and under normal
operating conditions, additional fluid is not required
for the life of the vehicle.
The fluid required for use in the clutch hydraulic system is brake fluid conforming to DOT 3
specifications and J1703 standards. No other type of fluid is recommended or approved for use in
the clutch hydraulic system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or equivalent from a tightly sealed
container.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Master Cylinder: Specifications
Master Cylinder Pushrod Adj. Screw
..................................................................................................................................................... 6
Nm (55 inch lbs.)
Master Cylinder Mounting Nuts (LHD)
............................................................................................................................................. 15 Nm
(130 inch lbs.)
Master Cylinder Reservoir Mounting bolts (LHD)
............................................................................................................................ 11 Nm (100 inch
lbs.)
Master Cylinder Reservoir Mounting Screw (RHD)
.............................................................................................................................. 3 Nm (24 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4175
Clutch Master Cylinder: Description and Operation
MASTER CYLINDER - DESCRIPTION (LHD)
The LHD clutch master cylinder mounts to the dash panel (Fig. 26). The master cylinder consists of
an adjustable push rod, a piston and cylinder housing, a remote fluid reservoir, and an
interconnecting hydraulic tube (Fig. 27).
MASTER CYLINDER - DESCRIPTION (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4176
The RHD clutch master cylinder (Fig. 28) mounts through the dash panel and to the pedal bracket
assembly. The master cylinder consists of a push rod, a piston and cylinder housing, a remote fluid
reservoir, and an interconnecting hydraulic tube (Fig. 29).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4177
OPERATION The clutch master cylinder (Fig. 27) (Fig. 29) produces the hydraulic pressure
necessary to disengage the clutch. When the clutch pedal is depressed, the push rod moves the
piston to produce pressure in the cylinder. This pressure moves fluid through the system to the
slave cylinder, which in turn operates the clutch release lever and bearing, disengaging the clutch.
When the clutch pedal is released, pressure is relieved and the return spring returns the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4178
piston to its original position until the next pedal actuation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder - LDH
MASTER CYLINDER / REMOVAL - LHD
NOTE: Replacement master cylinder assemblies come pre-filled with fluid. No fluid service or
system bleeding should be required, unless the
hydraulic system has lost an excessive amount of fluid and has ingested air into the slave cylinder
assembly.
1. Remove air cleaner assembly (Fig. 30). 2. Disconnect battery negative cable. 3. Raise vehicle
on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH > Page 4181
4. Using Tool 6638A, disconnect clutch hydraulic quick-connect (Fig. 32) (Fig. 31).
5. Remove hydraulic hose from left rail retainers (Fig. 35). 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Remove PDC
bracket and position out of way.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH > Page 4182
8. Remove lower instrument panel bezel (Fig. 33).
9. Remove clip and disconnect the brake booster input rod from the brake pedal pin (Fig. 34).
10. Remove the brake booster mounting nuts (Fig. 34). 11. Slide brake booster forward enough to
gain access to and remove clutch master cylinder. 12. Remove clutch master cylinder reservoir
(Fig. 35). 13. Disconnect clutch master cylinder rod from clutch pedal. Inspect plastic retainer. If
retainer is broken or damaged in any way, it MUST be
replaced upon reassembly.
14. Remove two clutch master cylinder retaining nuts. 15. Remove the self-docking connector
bracket.
CAUTION: Use care when removing clutch master cylinder from engine compartment. Aggressive
handling can result in a damaged hydraulic tube and
improper clutch release operation upon reassembly.
16. Remove master cylinder from mounting position and carefully work hydraulic pipe from out of
engine compartment (Fig. 35). If necessary,
unfasten ABS module and purge solenoid assembly to gain necessary clearance.
INSTALLATION - LHD
1. Install the master cylinder into position on the dash panel. 2. Install the self-docking connector
bracket. 3. Install the master cylinder retaining nuts onto the master cylinder studs. Tighten the nuts
to 11 Nm (100 inch lbs.). 4. Route the hydraulic tube as noted upon removal. 5. Connect the
master cylinder hydraulic line to the slave cylinder hydraulic line. An audible click should be heard.
Verify the connection by pulling
outward on the master cylinder line.
6. Install the master cylinder remote reservoir onto the dash panel. 7. Install the reservoir retaining
screws. Tighten the screws to 11 Nm (103 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH > Page 4183
8. Install the brake booster.
CAUTION: Inspect the clutch master cylinder push rod plastic retainer for damage. If it is damaged
(broken/cracked), it MUST be replaced.
9. Loosen the push rod adjustment screw (Fig. 40).
10. Install the push rod onto the pedal pin. 11. Gently lift clutch pedal upwards until the clutch pedal
fully depresses the upstop switch. Torque adjustment screw to 6 Nm (55 inch lbs.). 12. Install the
ABS module/purge solenoid, PDC, and air cleaner. 13. Depress and release the clutch pedal a
minimum of ten (10) times to allow any residual air in the system to be vented to the reservoir. If
residual
air becomes trapped in the system, bleed the clutch hydraulic system.
14. Connect the negative battery cable. 15. Top off clutch master cylinder reservoir with DOT 3
brake fluid. 16. Verify correct clutch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH > Page 4184
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder - RDH
MASTER CYLINDER / REMOVAL - RHD
NOTE: Replacement master cylinder assemblies come pre-filled with fluid. No fluid service or
system bleeding should be required.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist.
3. Using Tool 6638A, disconnect clutch hydraulic quick-connect (Fig. 36) and (Fig. 37).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH > Page 4185
4. Remove hydraulic hose (Fig. 38) from the clips along the frame rail and the dash panel. 5. Lower
vehicle. 6. Remove the two screws holding the master cylinder remote reservoir to the dash panel.
7. Disconnect the master cylinder push rod from the pedal pin. Inspect plastic retainer. If retainer is
damaged in any way, it MUST be replaced.
8. Remove the clutch interlock/upstop switch cover plate and switch housing (Fig. 39) from the
master cylinder push rod. 9. From the engine compartment, grasp the master cylinder body and
rotate approximately 45° in a counter-clockwise direction.
10. Disengage the master cylinder from the pedal bracket assembly. 11. Remove the master
cylinder from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder - LDH > Page 4186
1. Install the master cylinder into position on the dash panel. (Fig. 41) 2. Seat the master cylinder in
the pedal bracket assembly. 3. Rotate the master cylinder approximately 45° in the clockwise
direction. 4. Route the hydraulic tube as noted upon removal. 5. Connect the master cylinder
hydraulic line to the slave cylinder hydraulic line. An audible click should be heard. Verify the
connection by pulling
outward on the master cylinder line.
6. Install the master cylinder remote reservoir onto the dash panel. 7. Install the reservoir retaining
screws. Tighten the screws to 3 Nm (24 inch lbs.).
8. Install the clutch interlock/upstop switch and cover plate. (Fig. 42)
CAUTION: Inspect the clutch master cylinder push rod plastic retainer for damage. If it is damaged
(broken/cracked), it MUST be replaced.
9. Install the push rod onto the pedal pin.
10. Depress and release the clutch pedal a minimum of ten (10) times to allow any residual air in
the system to be vented to the reservoir. If residual
air becomes trapped in the system, bleed the clutch hydraulic system.
11. Connect the negative battery cable. 12. Top off clutch master cylinder reservoir with DOT 3
brake fluid. 13. Verify proper clutch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Specifications
Slave Cylinder-to-Transaxle (2.0L)
......................................................................................................................................................... 19
Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
Slave Cylinder-to-Transaxle (1.6L)
.................................................................................................................................................... 12
Nm (105 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4190
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Description and Operation
SLAVE CYLINDER - DESCRIPTION
The clutch slave cylinder is fastened to transaxle bellhousing (Fig. 54), and consists of a hydraulic
piston and cylinder, seal, return spring, and integral fluid damper (if equipped) and line (Fig. 55).
OPERATION When the clutch pedal is depressed, fluid pressurized by the clutch master cylinder
pushes the slave cylinder piston, extending the push rod and operating the clutch release fork and
bearing. The integral damper (Fig. 55) absorbs vibration and noise generated in the clutch release
system, preventing it from being transmitted into the passenger compartment via the hydraulic
circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4191
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair
SLAVE CYLINDER - REMOVAL
NOTE: Replacement slave cylinder assemblies come pre-filled with fluid. No fluid service or system
bleeding should be required, unless excessive air
has been introduced to clutch hydraulic circuit.
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect clutch hydraulic quick connect using tool 6638A (Fig. 56). 3. 2.0L models: Remove
left lateral bending brace.
4. Remove damper bracket nuts (Fig. 57). 5. Remove slave cylinder mounting bolts (Fig. 57). 6.
Remove slave cylinder from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replacement slave cylinder assemblies come pre-filled with fluid. No fluid service or system
bleeding should be required, unless the hydraulic
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 4192
system has lost an excessive amount of fluid and has ingested air into the hydraulic circuit.
1. Install the slave cylinder assembly into position on transaxle (Fig. 57). Start damper and slave
cylinder fasteners by hand. 2. Tighten slave cylinder bolts-to-transaxle bolts to 19 Nm (168 inch
lbs.) on 2.0L applications, and 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.) torque on 1.6L
applications.
3. Tighten damper nuts to 24 Nm (215 inch lbs.) torque. 4. Connect clutch hydraulic supply tube
(Fig. 57). An audible click should be heard. Verify connection by pulling outward. 5. 2.0L models:
Install left lateral bending brace. 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Verify clutch master cylinder reservoir is full.
Top off with DOT 3 brake fluid if necessary. 8. Actuate clutch pedal a minimum of ten times to allow
any air ingested into the system to vent to the master cylinder reservoir. If excessive air is
ingested into system, bleed clutch hydraulic system.
9. Verify proper clutch release system operation.
10. If slave cylinder was replaced with a new unit, verify that the shipping strap has been broken. If
not, remove straps to prevent high pedal effort.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component Information
> Specifications
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Specifications
Brake/Clutch Pedal & Booster-to-Dash Nuts
...................................................................................................................................... 34 Nm (300
inch lbs.) Brake/Clutch Pedal Assembly-to-Instrument Panel
............................................................................................................................ 34 Nm (300 inch
lbs.) Clutch Pedal Pivot Shaft Nut .......................................................................................................
............................................................. 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4200
Clutch Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4201
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4202
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4203
Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch (MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4204
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
DESCRIPTION - LHD The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two
switches: an engine starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 13). The
switch assembly is located in the clutch/brake pedal bracket assembly (Fig. 14), each switch being
fastened by four plastic wing tabs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4205
DESCRIPTION - RHD The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 15) consists of a single,
multi-function switch that is activated by hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod travel.
OPERATION - CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH The clutch interlock switch prevents engine starter
operation and inadvertent vehicle movement with the clutch pedal in the up position (not
depressed), or under normal conditions with the clutch engaged and the transaxle in gear.
WARNING: WHEN THERE IS A LOSS OF CLUTCH SYSTEM HYDRAULIC FLUID, OR THE
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
PUSHROD IS DISCONNECTED FROM THE PEDAL LEVER, THE ENGINE MAY START WITH
THE CLUTCH ENGAGED, CAUSING UNDESIRABLE VEHICLE MOVEMENT IF THE
TRANSAXLE IS IN ANY GEAR.
The switch is open while the clutch pedal is at rest or in the up position. When the clutch pedal is
fully depressed on LHD models, the clutch pedal lever closes the switch, completing the signal
circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter operation. When the
clutch pedal is fully depressed on RHD models, the master cylinder push rod closes the switch,
completing the signal circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter
operation. The interlock switch is not adjustable.
OPERATION - CLUTCH PEDAL UPSTOP SWITCH With the clutch pedal at rest, the clutch pedal
upstop switch is closed, allowing speed control operation. When the clutch pedal is depressed, the
upstop switch opens and signals the PCM to cancel speed control operation, and enter a modified
engine calibration schedule to improve driveability during gear-to-gear shifts. The upstop switch is
not adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Service Diagnosis
SERVICE DIAGNOSIS - CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two switches: an engine
starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 16).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 4208
The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 17) consists of a single, multi-function switch that is
activated by the hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 4209
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Clutch Interlock Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, turn the ignition key to the start position.
The engine starter should not crank with the
clutch pedal at rest (not depressed). If the starter cranks, proceed to the electrical test to determine
whether the switch is defective or the circuit is shorted. If the vehicle does not crank, proceed to the
next step.
2. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, fully depress the clutch pedal and turn
the ignition key to the start position. The engine
starter should crank. If the starter does not crank, visually inspect the clutch pedal for obstructions
(floor mat, etc.). Make sure the clutch pedal lever contacts and fully closes the switch on LHD
applications, and for proper installation of the master cylinder push rod/bushing on the pedal pin on
RHD applications.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 2 & 3 (Fig. 18) with the interlock
switch not depressed (clutch pedal at rest). There
should be no continuity between the terminals (open circuit).
5. LHD Models: Fully depress the clutch pedal to close the switch. The switch button should
compress at least 1.25 mm (0.050 inch) on LHD
applications. The ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms resistance). RHD Models: Disconnect
the push rod from the pedal pin and actuate the push rod by hand to close the switch. The
ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms). Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is
damaged (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced before reinstalling the push rod to the pedal.
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly, or the pedal bracket
assembly, is defective and should be replaced. If
the switch tests ok, wiring is defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 4210
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Upstop Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
UPSTOP SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Start engine and operate speed control to maintain speed. 3. Depress
clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch). Speed control operation should terminate. If speed control
does not terminate, the upstop switch
is defective or the related wiring is shorted. Proceed to the upstop switch electrical test.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2 (Fig. 18) with the upstop switch
depressed (clutch pedal at rest). The ohmmeter
should show continuity (0 ohms).
5. Depress the clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch) check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2.
There should be no continuity between the
terminals (open circuit).
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly is defective and
should be replaced. If the switch tests ok, wiring is
defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - LHD
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable.
2. Remove left lower instrument panel bezel (Fig. 19). 3. Disconnect upstop switch and brake lamp
switch connectors. 4. Disconnect clutch master cylinder rod from clutch pedal pin. Inspect plastic
retainer upon removal. If retainer is damaged, it MUST be replaced.
5. Remove brake booster push rod retaining clip from brake pedal. Disengage rod from pedal (Fig.
20).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 4213
6. Remove two pedal assembly bracket to instrument panel nuts (Fig. 21). 7. Remove four brake
booster/pedal bracket-to-cowl panel nuts (Fig. 21). 8. From under the hood, pull brake master
cylinder/booster far enough forward to obtain pedal to bracket stud clearance. 9. Remove the pedal
bracket assembly (Fig. 21).
10. Remove pedal pivot shaft and remove brake and clutch pedals.
11. Remove the interlock/upstop switch assembly (Fig. 22) from the brake/clutch pedal bracket
assembly by depressing the four plastic wing tabs on
each switch.
INSTALLATION - LHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 4214
contacting pedals.
1. Install switches into the pedal bracket assembly as shown in (Fig. 22). Route harness as was
prior to removal. Secure switch connector retaining
push pin into the appropriate hole in the pedal bracket assembly.
2. Install clutch and brake pedals to pedal bracket, and install pivot shaft and nut. Torque pivot
shaft nut to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.). 3. Install brake/clutch pedal bracket assembly into position. Install
and tighten brake booster mounting nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). Install and tighten
pedal bracket-to-instrument panel nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
4. Install new stop lamp switch. 5. Connect brake booster rod to brake pedal. Install retainer clip
(Fig. 20).
6. Loosen adjustment screw (Fig. 24).
CAUTION: Inspect clutch master cylinder pushrod plastic retainer. If retainer is damaged in any
way (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced.
7. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod. Gently lift clutch pedal upwards until the clutch pedal
fully depresses the upstop switch. Torque
adjustment screw to 6 Nm (55 inch lbs.).
8. Connect interlock/upstop and stop lamp switch connectors. 9. Install left lower instrument panel
bezel (Fig. 19).
10. Connect battery negative cable. 11. Verify proper switch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 4215
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - RHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - RHD
1. Disconnect the master cylinder push rod from the pedal pin (Fig. 23). Inspect push rod retainer
for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
must be replaced.
2. Squeeze together the tangs on the switch cover plate and slide the plate off the switch housing.
3. Disconnect the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector from the instrument panel wiring
harness. 4. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - RHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
contacting pedals.
1. Install the clutch interlock/upstop switch onto the master cylinder push rod, making sure that the
push rod is oriented with the push rod retainer
toward the wiring of the switch. The master cylinder push rod must be snapped into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch along the smaller diameter of the push rod between the snap ring and the
transition to the larger diameter.
CAUTION: Improper assembly of the larger diameter of the push rod into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch could cause damage to the switch or a
clutch system failure.
2. Install the switch cover plate.
CAUTION: Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
MUST be replaced.
3. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod to the clutch pedal pin. 4. Route the wiring harness as it
was prior to removal. 5. Secure the switch connector retaining push pin into the appropriate hole in
the pedal bracket assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Bearing, M/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Release Bearing: Description and Operation
RELEASE BEARING AND LEVER - DESCRIPTION A conventional release bearing is used to
engage and disengage the clutch pressure plate. The clutch release bearing is mounted on the
transaxle front bearing retainer. The bearing is attached to and operated by the release lever (Fig.
25), which moves the bearing into contact with the clutch cover diaphragm spring.
OPERATION The release bearing is operated by the release lever. Slave cylinder force causes the
release lever to move the release bearing into contact with the diaphragm spring. As additional
force is applied, the bearing presses the diaphragm spring fingers inward on the fulcrums. This
action moves the pressure plate rearward, relieving clamping force on the clutch disc.
Releasing pedal pressure removes clutch hydraulic pressure. The release bearing then moves
away from the diaphragm spring which allows the pressure plate to exert clamping force on the
clutch disc.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Bearing, M/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4219
Clutch Release Bearing: Service and Repair
RELEASE BEARING AND LEVER
REMOVAL
1. Remove the transaxle from the vehicle. 2. Move the lever and bearing assembly to a vertical
in-line position. Grasp the release lever with two hands in the pivot stud socket area. Pull with
even pressure and the lever will pop off the pivot-stud. Do not use a screwdriver or pry bar to pop
off the lever. This may damage the spring clip on the lever.
3. As a unit, remove the lever from the bearing thrust plate. Be careful not to damage retention tabs
on bearing. 4. Examine the condition of the bearing. It is pre-lubricated and sealed and should not
be immersed in oil or solvent. 5. The bearing should turn smoothly when held in the hand under a
light thrust load. A light drag caused by the lubricant fill is normal. If the bearing
is noisy, rough, or dry, replace the complete bearing assembly with a new bearing.
6. Check the condition of the pivot stud spring clips on back side of clutch lever. If the clips are
broken or distorted, replace the clutch lever.
INSTALLATION
1. The pivot ball pocket in the lever, as well as the lever arms should be lubricated with grease prior
to installation. 2. Assemble the lever to the bearing. The small pegs on the bearing must go over
the lever arms. 3. Slide the bearing and lever assembly onto the input shaft bearing retainer, as a
unit. 4. Snap the clutch lever onto the pivot ball. 5. Reinstall transaxle assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pilot Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Pilot Bearing: Service and Repair
T350 Manual Transaxle INPUT BEARING AND SLEEVE - REMOVAL
The input bearing is a one-piece bearing and sleeve unit (Fig. 107). The sleeve is the slide point for
the clutch-release bearing and lever.
1. Install tool #6342 over input bearing on the gear case side of the transaxle clutch housing.
2. Press the input bearing out of the housing (Fig. 108).
INSTALLATION
1. Apply coating of Loctite sealant on bearing outer diameter. Position sleeve and bearing
assembly at input bearing bore.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pilot Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 4223
2. Install tool #C-4680-1 over input bearing (Fig. 109).
3. Using the spacer tool #4894 and shop press, install input bearing into bore until it is fully seated
(Fig. 110).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 > Sep > 04 >
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound
Technical Service Bulletin # 03-006-04 Date: 040915
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound
NUMBER: 03-006-04
GROUP: Axle and Propshaft
DATE: September 15, 2004
SUBJECT: Front Hub/Half Shaft Click/Pop Sound
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a rubber gasket to the face of the half shaft that
mounts to the hub bearing.
MODELS:
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2001 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to PT vehicles built prior to February 18, 2004, (MDH 0218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit a popping/clicking/snapping/ticking sound from the front hub/half shaft area
during acceleration after Drive to Reverse or Reverse to Drive shifts. The sound may also be
present while turning and accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
In order to determine if the popping/clicking/snapping/ticking sound is coming from the front
hub/half shaft interface, perform the following procedure:
1. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist and remove both front wheels.
2. Remove the cotter pin, nut lock, and wave washer from the end of both front half shafts.
3. With the vehicle's brakes applied to keep hub from turning, loosen both half shaft nuts to zero
torque.
4. With the service brake applied, shift the vehicle from Drive to Reverse and Reverse to Drive.
Once the transmission is engaged in gear, raise the engine speed to 1800 rpm.
5. If the sound is not present, perform the Repair Procedure. If the sound is still present, the source
of the sound is elsewhere. Further diagnosis is required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 > Sep > 04 >
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4234
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Repair Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Remove the half shaft nut.
3. Remove the wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the service information available
in TechCONNECT Section 22.
4. Remove the two front disc brake caliper adapter to steering knuckle attaching bolts (Fig. 1).
5. Remove the disc brake caliper assembly from the steering knuckle. The caliper assembly is
removed by first rotating the top of the caliper assembly away from the steering knuckle and then
removing the bottom of the assembly out from under the machined abutment on the steering
knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 > Sep > 04 >
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4235
6. Support the disc brake caliper assembly by using a wire hook and suspending it from the strut
assembly (Fig. 2).
NOTE:
Do not allow the brake caliper assembly to hang by the brake flex hose.
7. Remove the brake rotor from the hub and bearing assembly.
8. If the vehicle is equipped with eccentric bolts attaching the steering knuckle to the strut
assembly, proceed to next step. If not, proceed to step 10.
9. Mark the head of the eccentric bolt and the strut, so that the bolt can be installed in the same
position later.
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt.
11. Remove the steering knuckle-to-strut attachment bolts from the steering knuckle (Fig. 3).
12. Pull the steering knuckle from the strut clevis bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 > Sep > 04 >
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4236
NOTE:
Care must be taken not to separate the inner C/V joint during this operation. Do not allow half shaft
to hang by inner C/V joint after removing outer C/V joint from the hub/bearing assembly in steering
knuckle, the outboard end of the half shaft must be supported.
13. Pull the steering knuckle assembly down and away from the outer C/V joint while pulling the
C/V joint out of the hub bearing.
14. Support the outer end of the half shaft assembly.
NOTE:
The rubber gasket is to be installed as is (after removing the paper backing). The gasket should not
be cut in any way.
15. Peel paper backing off of the gasket. Slide the gasket over the C/V joint splines with the
adhesive side of the gasket facing the C/V joint surface, item 2, shown in (Fig. 4).
16. Grasp the inner tripod joint and interconnecting shaft. Forcefully push the tripod joint into side
gear of the transaxle, be sure the snap-ring is engaged with the transaxle side gear.
17. Clean all debris and moisture out of steering knuckle, in the area were outer CV joint will be
installed into steering knuckle.
18. Clean the C/V joint surface.
19. Ensure that the front of the outer CV joint which fits against the face of the hub and bearing is
free of debris and moisture before installing the outer CV joint into the hub and bearing assembly.
20. Slide the half shaft back into the front hub and bearing assembly.
21. Install the wheel speed sensor bolt and torque it to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
CAUTION:
The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Install nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 > Sep > 04 >
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4237
CAUTION:
If the vehicle being serviced is equipped with eccentric strut assembly attaching bolts, the eccentric
bolt must be installed in the bottom (slotted) hole on the strut clevis bracket (Fig. 5).
22. Install the steering knuckle in the clevis bracket of the strut assembly. Install the strut to
steering knuckle attaching bolts. If the eccentric bolt and strut was marked in step 9, align the
marks. Tighten both bolts to a torque of 88 Nm (65 ft.lbs.) plus an additional 1/4 turn.
23. Install the brake rotor on the hub and bearing assembly.
24. Install the disc brake caliper assembly on the steering knuckle. The caliper is installed by first
sliding the bottom of the caliper assembly under the abutment on the steering knuckle, and then
rotating the top of the caliper against the top abutment.
25. Install the disc brake caliper adapter to steering knuckle attaching bolts (Fig. 1). Tighten the
disc brake caliper adapter attaching bolts to a torque of 169 Nm (125 ft. lbs.).
26. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the outer CV joint. Install the washer and half shaft
nut on half shaft and securely tighten the nut (the nut will be torqued later).
27. Install the front wheel and tire assembly. Install and tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in
proper sequence until all the nuts are torqued to half the required specification. Then repeat the
tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.lbs.).
28. Repeat steps 2 through 27 on the other side of the vehicle. When steps 2 through 25 have
been completed on both sides of the vehicle, lower the vehicle.
29. With the vehicle's brakes applied to keep hub from turning, tighten the hub nut to a torque of
244 Nm (180 ft.lbs.)
30. Install the spring wave washer on the end of the half shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 > Sep > 04 >
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4238
31. Install the hub nut lock, and a new cotter pin. Wrap the cotter pin prongs tightly around the hub
nut lock as shown in (Fig. 6).
32. Repeat steps 29 through 31 on the other side of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 >
Sep > 04 > Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound
Technical Service Bulletin # 03-006-04 Date: 040915
Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound
NUMBER: 03-006-04
GROUP: Axle and Propshaft
DATE: September 15, 2004
SUBJECT: Front Hub/Half Shaft Click/Pop Sound
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a rubber gasket to the face of the half shaft that
mounts to the hub bearing.
MODELS:
2000 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2001 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to PT vehicles built prior to February 18, 2004, (MDH 0218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit a popping/clicking/snapping/ticking sound from the front hub/half shaft area
during acceleration after Drive to Reverse or Reverse to Drive shifts. The sound may also be
present while turning and accelerating from a stop.
DIAGNOSIS:
In order to determine if the popping/clicking/snapping/ticking sound is coming from the front
hub/half shaft interface, perform the following procedure:
1. Raise the vehicle on an appropriate hoist and remove both front wheels.
2. Remove the cotter pin, nut lock, and wave washer from the end of both front half shafts.
3. With the vehicle's brakes applied to keep hub from turning, loosen both half shaft nuts to zero
torque.
4. With the service brake applied, shift the vehicle from Drive to Reverse and Reverse to Drive.
Once the transmission is engaged in gear, raise the engine speed to 1800 rpm.
5. If the sound is not present, perform the Repair Procedure. If the sound is still present, the source
of the sound is elsewhere. Further diagnosis is required.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 >
Sep > 04 > Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4244
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Repair Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Remove the half shaft nut.
3. Remove the wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the service information available
in TechCONNECT Section 22.
4. Remove the two front disc brake caliper adapter to steering knuckle attaching bolts (Fig. 1).
5. Remove the disc brake caliper assembly from the steering knuckle. The caliper assembly is
removed by first rotating the top of the caliper assembly away from the steering knuckle and then
removing the bottom of the assembly out from under the machined abutment on the steering
knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 >
Sep > 04 > Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4245
6. Support the disc brake caliper assembly by using a wire hook and suspending it from the strut
assembly (Fig. 2).
NOTE:
Do not allow the brake caliper assembly to hang by the brake flex hose.
7. Remove the brake rotor from the hub and bearing assembly.
8. If the vehicle is equipped with eccentric bolts attaching the steering knuckle to the strut
assembly, proceed to next step. If not, proceed to step 10.
9. Mark the head of the eccentric bolt and the strut, so that the bolt can be installed in the same
position later.
10. Remove the wheel speed sensor bolt.
11. Remove the steering knuckle-to-strut attachment bolts from the steering knuckle (Fig. 3).
12. Pull the steering knuckle from the strut clevis bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 >
Sep > 04 > Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4246
NOTE:
Care must be taken not to separate the inner C/V joint during this operation. Do not allow half shaft
to hang by inner C/V joint after removing outer C/V joint from the hub/bearing assembly in steering
knuckle, the outboard end of the half shaft must be supported.
13. Pull the steering knuckle assembly down and away from the outer C/V joint while pulling the
C/V joint out of the hub bearing.
14. Support the outer end of the half shaft assembly.
NOTE:
The rubber gasket is to be installed as is (after removing the paper backing). The gasket should not
be cut in any way.
15. Peel paper backing off of the gasket. Slide the gasket over the C/V joint splines with the
adhesive side of the gasket facing the C/V joint surface, item 2, shown in (Fig. 4).
16. Grasp the inner tripod joint and interconnecting shaft. Forcefully push the tripod joint into side
gear of the transaxle, be sure the snap-ring is engaged with the transaxle side gear.
17. Clean all debris and moisture out of steering knuckle, in the area were outer CV joint will be
installed into steering knuckle.
18. Clean the C/V joint surface.
19. Ensure that the front of the outer CV joint which fits against the face of the hub and bearing is
free of debris and moisture before installing the outer CV joint into the hub and bearing assembly.
20. Slide the half shaft back into the front hub and bearing assembly.
21. Install the wheel speed sensor bolt and torque it to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
CAUTION:
The steering knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Install nuts while holding bolts stationary in the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 >
Sep > 04 > Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4247
CAUTION:
If the vehicle being serviced is equipped with eccentric strut assembly attaching bolts, the eccentric
bolt must be installed in the bottom (slotted) hole on the strut clevis bracket (Fig. 5).
22. Install the steering knuckle in the clevis bracket of the strut assembly. Install the strut to
steering knuckle attaching bolts. If the eccentric bolt and strut was marked in step 9, align the
marks. Tighten both bolts to a torque of 88 Nm (65 ft.lbs.) plus an additional 1/4 turn.
23. Install the brake rotor on the hub and bearing assembly.
24. Install the disc brake caliper assembly on the steering knuckle. The caliper is installed by first
sliding the bottom of the caliper assembly under the abutment on the steering knuckle, and then
rotating the top of the caliper against the top abutment.
25. Install the disc brake caliper adapter to steering knuckle attaching bolts (Fig. 1). Tighten the
disc brake caliper adapter attaching bolts to a torque of 169 Nm (125 ft. lbs.).
26. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the outer CV joint. Install the washer and half shaft
nut on half shaft and securely tighten the nut (the nut will be torqued later).
27. Install the front wheel and tire assembly. Install and tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in
proper sequence until all the nuts are torqued to half the required specification. Then repeat the
tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.lbs.).
28. Repeat steps 2 through 27 on the other side of the vehicle. When steps 2 through 25 have
been completed on both sides of the vehicle, lower the vehicle.
29. With the vehicle's brakes applied to keep hub from turning, tighten the hub nut to a torque of
244 Nm (180 ft.lbs.)
30. Install the spring wave washer on the end of the half shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Axle Shaft: > 03-006-04 >
Sep > 04 > Drivetrain - Front Hub/Half Shaft Pop/Click Sound > Page 4248
31. Install the hub nut lock, and a new cotter pin. Wrap the cotter pin prongs tightly around the hub
nut lock as shown in (Fig. 6).
32. Repeat steps 29 through 31 on the other side of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4249
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair
HALFSHAFT
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Boot sealing is vital to retain special lubricants and to prevent foreign contaminants
from entering the C/V joint. Mishandling, such as
allowing the assemblies to dangle unsupported, or pulling or pushing the ends can cut boots or
damage C/V joints. During removal and installation procedures, always support both ends of the
halfshaft to prevent damage. The halfshaft, when installed, acts as a bolt and secures the front
hub/bearing assembly. If vehicle is to be supported or moved on its wheels with a halfshaft
removed, install a PROPER-SIZED BOLT AND NUT through front hub. Tighten bolt and nut to 244
Nm (180 ft. lbs.). This will ensure that the hub bearing cannot loosen.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Place transaxle in gated park. 3. Raise vehicle on hoist.
4. Remove wheel and tire assembly (Fig. 1).
5. Remove the halfshaft to hub cotter pin, nut lock, wave washer and hub nut (Fig. 2). 6. If
equipped with ABS, disconnect the front wheel speed sensor and secure harness out of the way.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4250
7. Remove nut and bolt (Fig. 3) retaining ball joint stud into steering knuckle.
CAUTION: Use caution when separating ball joint stud from steering knuckle, so ball joint seal
does not get damaged.
8. Separate ball joint stud from steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm (Fig. 4).
CAUTION: Care must be taken not to separate the inner C/V joint during this operation. Do not
allow halfshaft to hang by inner C/V joint, halfshaft
must be supported.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4251
9. Remove halfshaft from steering knuckle by pulling outward on knuckle while pressing in on
halfshaft. Support outer end of halfshaft assembly. If
difficulty in separating halfshaft from steering knuckle is encountered, use Puller 1026 as shown in
(Fig. 5) to separate shaft. Do not strike shaft with hammer.
10. Support outer end of the halfshaft assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4252
11. Remove the inner tripod joints from the side gears of the transaxle using a punch to dislodge
the inner tripod joint retaining ring from the transaxle
side gear. If removing the right side inner tripod joint, position punch against the inner tripod joint
(Fig. 6). Strike the punch sharply with a hammer to dislodge the right inner joint from the side gear.
If removing the left side inner tripod joint, position the punch in the groove of the inner tripod joint
(Fig. 7). Strike the punch sharply with a hammer to dislodge the left inner tripod joint from the side
gear.
NOTE:
Removal of the inner tripod joints is made easier if you apply outward pressure on the joint as you
strike the punch with a hammer.
12. Hold inner tripod joint and interconnecting shaft of halfshaft assembly (Fig. 8). Remove inner
tripod joint from transaxle by pulling it straight out
of transaxle side gear and transaxle oil seal. When removing tripod joint, do not let spline or snap
ring drag across sealing lip of the transaxle to tripod joint oil seal. When tripod joint is removed from
transaxle, some fluid will leak out.
CAUTION: The halfshaft, when installed, acts as a bolt and secures the front hub/bearing
assembly. If vehicle is to be supported or moved on its
wheels with a halfshaft removed, install a PROPER-SIZED BOLT AND NUT through front hub.
Tighten bolt and nut to 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs.). This will ensure that the hub bearing cannot loosen.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Boot sealing is vital to retain special lubricants and to prevent foreign contaminants
from entering the C/V joint. Mishandling, such as
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4253
allowing the assemblies to dangle unsupported, or pulling or pushing the ends can cut boots or
damage C/V joints. During removal and installation procedures, always support both ends of the
halfshaft to prevent damage.
1. Thoroughly clean spline and oil seal sealing surface, on tripod joint. Lightly lubricate oil seal
sealing surface on tripod joint with fresh clean
transmission lubricant.
2. Holding halfshaft assembly by tripod joint and interconnecting shaft, install tripod joint into
transaxle side gear as far as possible by hand. 3. Carefully align tripod joint with transaxle side
gears. Then grasp halfshaft interconnecting shaft and push tripod joint into transaxle side gear until
fully seated. Test that snap ring is fully engaged with side gear by attempting to remove tripod joint
from transaxle by hand. If snap ring is fully engaged with side gear, tripod joint will not be
removable by hand.
4. Clean all debris and moisture out of steering knuckle (Fig. 9).
5. Ensure that front of outer C/V joint, which fits into steering knuckle (Fig. 10) is free of debris and
moisture before assembling into steering
knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4254
6. Slide halfshaft back into front hub. Install steering knuckle onto the ball joint stud (Fig. 11).
NOTE: At this point, the outer joint will not seat completely into the front hub. The outer joint will be
pulled into hub and seated when the hub nut is installed and torqued.
7. Install a NEW steering knuckle to ball joint stud bolt and nut (Fig. 11). Tighten the nut and bolt to
95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
8. Clean all foreign matter from threads of halfshaft outer stub axle. Install hub nut onto the threads
of the stub axle and tighten nut to 244 Nm (180
ft. lbs.) (Fig. 12).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4255
9. Install front wheel and tire assembly. Install front wheel lug nuts (Fig. 13) and tighten to 128 Nm
(95 ft. lbs.).
10. Check for correct fluid level in transaxle assembly. 11. Lower vehicle. 12. Connect battery
negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair CV Boot - Inner
CV BOOT - INNER / REMOVAL To remove sealing boot from halfshaft for replacement, the
halfshaft assembly must be removed from the vehicle.
The inner tripod joints use no internal retention in the tripod housing to keep the spider assembly in
the housing. Therefore, do not pull on the interconnecting shaft to disengage tripod housing from
transmission stub shaft. Removal in this manner will cause damage to the inboard joint sealing
boots.
1. Remove the halfshaft requiring boot replacement from the vehicle.
2. Remove large boot clamp that retains inner tripod joint sealing boot to tripod joint housing (Fig.
14) and discard. Then remove small clamp that
retains inner tripod joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft and discard. Remove the sealing boot
from the tripod housing and slide it down the interconnecting shaft.
CAUTION: When removing the spider joint from the tripod joint housing, hold the rollers in place on
the spider bunions to prevent the rollers and
needle bearings from falling away.
3. Slide the interconnecting shaft and spider assembly out of the tripod joint housing (Fig. 15).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4260
4. Remove snap ring that retains spider assembly to interconnecting shaft (Fig. 16). Remove the
spider assembly from interconnecting shaft. If spider
assembly will not come off interconnecting shaft by hand, it can be removed by tapping spider
assembly with a brass drift (Fig. 17). Do not hit the outer tripod bearings in an attempt to remove
spider assembly from interconnecting shaft.
5. Slide sealing boot off interconnecting shaft.
6. Thoroughly clean and inspect spider assembly, tripod joint housing, and interconnecting shaft for
any signs of excessive wear. If any parts show
signs of excessive wear, the halfshaft assembly will require replacement. Component parts of
these halfshaft assemblies are not serviceable.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The inner tripod joint sealing boots are made from two different types of material. High
temperature applications use silicone rubber whereas
standard temperature applications use Hytrel plastic. The silicone sealing boots are soft and
pliable. The Hytrel sealing boots are stiff and rigid. The replacement sealing boot MUST BE the
same type of material as the sealing boot that was removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4261
1. Slide inner tripod joint seal boot retaining clamp, onto interconnecting shaft. Then slide the
replacement inner tripod joint sealing boot onto
interconnecting shaft. Inner tripod joint seal boot MUST be positioned on interconnecting shaft, so
the raised bead on the inside of the seal boot is in groove on interconnecting shaft (Fig. 18).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4262
2. Install spider assembly onto interconnecting shaft with chamfer on spider assembly toward
interconnecting shaft (Fig. 19). Spider assembly must
be installed on interconnecting shaft far enough to fully install spider retaining snap ring. If spider
assembly will not fully install on interconnecting shaft by hand, it can be installed by tapping the
spider body with a brass drift (Fig. 20). Do not hit the outer tripod bearings in an attempt to install
spider assembly on interconnecting shaft.
3. Install the spider assembly to interconnecting shaft retaining snap ring into groove on end of
interconnecting shaft (Fig. 21). Be sure the snap ring
is fully seated into groove on interconnecting shaft.
4. Distribute 1/2 the amount of grease provided in the seal boot service package (DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER TYPE OF GREASE) into tripod
housing. Put the remaining amount into the sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4263
5. Align tripod housing with spider assembly and then slide tripod housing over spider assembly
and interconnecting shaft (Fig. 22).
6. Install inner tripod joint seal boot to interconnecting shaft clamp evenly on sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4264
7. Clamp sealing boot onto interconnecting shaft using crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A and the
following procedure. Place crimping tool C-4975-A
over bridge of clamp (Fig. 23). Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A until jaws on tool are closed
completely together, face to face (Fig. 24).
CAUTION: Seal must not be dimpled, stretched, or out-of-shape in any way. If seal is NOT shaped
correctly, equalize pressure in seal and shape it by
hand.
8. Position sealing boot into the tripod housing retaining groove. Install seal boot retaining clamp
evenly on sealing boot.
CAUTION: The following positioning procedure determines the correct air pressure inside the inner
tripod joint assembly prior to clamping the sealing
boot to inner tripod joint housing. If this procedure is not done prior to clamping sealing boot to
tripod joint housing, boot durability can be adversely affected. When venting the inner tripod joint
assembly, use care so inner tripod sealing boot does not get punctured or, in any other way,
damaged. If sealing boot is punctured or damaged while being vented, the sealing boot can not be
used.
9. Insert a trim stick between the tripod joint and the sealing boot to vent inner tripod joint assembly
(Fig. 25). When inserting trim stick between
tripod housing and sealing boot, ensure trim stick is held flat and firmly against the tripod housing.
If this is not done, damage to the sealing boot can occur. If inner tripod joint has a Hytrel (hard
plastic) sealing boot, be sure trim stick is inserted between soft rubber insert and tripod housing,
and not the hard plastic sealing boot and soft rubber insert.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4265
10. With trim stick inserted between sealing boot and tripod joint housing, position inner tripod joint
on halfshaft until correct sealing boot edge to
edge length is obtained for type of sealing boot material being used (Fig. 26) (Fig. 27). Then
remove the trim stick.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4266
11. Clamp tripod joint sealing boot to tripod joint using required procedure for type of boot clamp
application. If seal boot uses crimp type boot
clamp, clamp sealing boot onto tripod housing using crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A. Place
crimping tool C-4975-A over bridge of clamp (Fig. 28). Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A until
jaws on tool are closed completely together, face-to-face (Fig. 29).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4267
12. If seal boot uses low profile latching type boot clamp, clamp sealing boot onto tripod housing
using clamp locking tool, Snap-On YA3050 (or an
equivalent). Place prongs of clamp locking tool in the holes of the clamp (Fig. 30). Squeeze tool
together until top band of clamp is latched behind the two tabs on lower band of clamp (Fig. 31).
13. Install the halfshaft requiring boot replacement back on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4268
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair CV Boot - Outer
CV BOOT - OUTER / REMOVAL
1. Remove halfshaft assembly requiring boot replacement from vehicle.
2. Remove large boot clamp retaining C/V joint sealing boot to C/V joint housing (Fig. 32) and
discard. Remove small clamp that retains outer C/V
joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft and discard. Remove sealing boot from outer C/V joint
housing and slide it down interconnecting shaft.
3. Wipe away grease to expose outer C/V joint and interconnecting shaft.
4. Remove outer C/V joint from interconnecting shaft using the following procedure: Support
interconnecting shaft in a vise equipped with protective
caps on jaws of vise to prevent damage to interconnecting shaft. Then, using a soft-faced hammer,
sharply hit the end of the C/V joint housing to dislodge housing from internal circlip on
interconnecting shaft (Fig. 33). Then slide outer C/V joint off end of interconnecting shaft, joint may
have to be tapped off shaft using a soft-faced hammer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4269
5. Remove large circlip (Fig. 34) from the interconnecting shaft before attempting to remove outer
C/V joint sealing boot. 6. Slide sealing boot off interconnecting shaft. 7. Thoroughly clean and
inspect outer C/V joint assembly and interconnecting joint for any signs of excessive wear. If any
parts show signs of
excessive wear, the halfshaft assembly will require replacement. Component parts of these
halfshaft assemblies are not serviceable.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide new sealing boot to interconnecting shaft retaining clamp onto interconnecting shaft. Slide
the outer C/V joint assembly sealing boot onto the
interconnecting shaft (Fig. 35). Seal boot MUST be positioned on interconnecting shaft so the
raised bead on the inside of the seal boot is in groove on interconnecting shaft.
2. Align splines on interconnecting shaft with splines on cross of outer C/V joint assembly and start
outer C/V joint onto interconnecting shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4270
3. Install outer C/V joint assembly onto interconnecting shaft by using a soft-faced hammer and
tapping end of stub axle (with hub nut installed) until
outer C/V joint is fully seated on interconnecting shaft (Fig. 36).
4. Outer C/V joint assembly must be installed on interconnecting shaft until cross of outer C/V joint
assembly is seated against circlip on
interconnecting shaft (Fig. 37).
5. Distribute 1/2 the amount of grease provided in seal boot service package (DO NOT USE ANY
OTHER TYPE OF GREASE) into outer C/V joint
assembly housing. Put the remaining amount into the sealing boot.
6. Install outer C/V joint sealing boot to interconnecting shaft clamp evenly on sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4271
7. Clamp sealing boot onto interconnecting shaft using crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A and the
following procedure. Place crimping tool C-4975-A
over bridge of clamp (Fig. 38). Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A until jaws on tool are closed
completely together, face to face (Fig. 39).
CAUTION: Seal must not be dimpled, stretched, or out-of-shape in any way. If seal is NOT shaped
correctly, equalize pressure in seal and shape it by
hand.
8. Position outer C/V joint sealing boot into its retaining groove on outer C/V joint housing. Install
sealing boot to outer C/V joint retaining clamp
evenly on sealing boot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Boot - Inner > Page 4272
9. Clamp sealing boot onto outer C/V joint housing using Crimper, Special Tool C-4975-A and the
following procedure. Place crimping tool
C-4975-A over bridge of clamp (Fig. 40). Tighten nut on crimping tool C-4975-A until jaws on tool
are closed completely together, face to face (Fig. 41).
10. Install the halfshaft requiring boot replacement back on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front
Bearing Retainer Plate Bolts
...........................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Rear
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
............................................ 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts
..........................................................................................................................................................
109-150 Nm (80-110 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Driveshaft Hub Nut ..............................................................................................................................
............................................ 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts ............................................
........................................................................................................................... 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Flex Plate to Crankshaft 70 ft.lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
4283
Flex Plate: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the transaxle.
2. Remove the flex plate attaching bolts (Fig. 79). 3. Remove the flex plate (Fig. 79).
INSTALLATION
1. Position the drive plate on crankshaft (Fig. 79). 2. Apply Mopar Lock & Seal Adhesive to flex
plate bolt threads.
3. Install the flex plate bolts and tighten to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.) (Fig. 79). 4. Install the transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Specifications
Flywheel: Specifications
Flywheel-to-Crankshaft Bolts ...............................................................................................................
.................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams
Shift Indicator: Diagrams
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)(Autostick)
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Application and ID
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Console Gear Selector w/ Auto ...........................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC 194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Case: Specifications
Transaxle Case Bolts ..........................................................................................................................
...................................................... 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Differential Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Type ................................................................................................................................. Mopar ATF
+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES
NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard shifting effort, bearing,
gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used. The addition of any fluids to
the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended. An exception to this policy is
the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be
avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
NOTE: The 41TE Automatic and T350 Manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4304
Differential Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Type ................................................................................................................................. Mopar ATF
+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES
NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard shifting effort, bearing,
gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used. The addition of any fluids to
the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended. An exception to this policy is
the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be
avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
NOTE: The 41TE Automatic and T350 Manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Ring Gear, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
Differential Ring Gear Bolts .................................................................................................................
.................................................... 81 Nm (60 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
T350 - Manual Transmission
Drain Plug ............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4311
T350 - Manual Transmission
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fill Plug, M/T > Component
Information > Locations
T350 - Manual Transmission
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
FLUID CAPACITY
NV T350 Manual Transaxle
...................................................................................................................................................... 2.4
- 2.7Liters (2.5 - 2.8 Qt)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4319
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
..................................... Mopar ATF +4 (Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission
Fluid - Type 9602). Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard
shifting effort, bearing, gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used.
The addition of any fluids to the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended.
An exception to this policy is the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of
transmission sealers should be avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Standard Procedure - Fluid Drain and Fill
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Fluid Drain and Fill
T350 - Manual Transmission STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND FILL
NOTE: The fluid required in this transaxle is Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type
9602).
T350 - Manual Transmission
All T350 transaxles are equipped with a fill plug. The fill plug is located on the left side of the
transaxle differential area (Fig. 92). The fluid level should be within 3/16 inch from the bottom of the
transaxle fill hole (vehicle must be level when checking).
T350 - Manual Transmission
All T350 transaxles are equipped with a drain plug. The drain plug is located on the lower right side
of the transaxle differential housing (Fig. 93). Tighten drain plug to 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
Fill transaxle to capacity. Refer to chart shown. Wipe the outside of the transaxle if any lubricant
spills.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Standard Procedure - Fluid Drain and Fill > Page 4322
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Fluid Level Check
Fluid Level Check
Check the fluid level by removing the fill plug. The fluid level should be between the bottom of the
fill hole and a point not more than 3/16" (4.76 mm) below the bottom of the hole.
Add fluid, if necessary, to maintain the proper level.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Gear: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission SYNCHRONIZER
DISASSEMBLY
Place synchronizer in a clean shop towel and wrap. Press on inner hub. Carefully open up shop
towel and remove springs, balls, keys, hub, and sleeve.
CLEANING
Do not attempt to clean the blocking rings in solvent. The friction material will become
contaminated. Place synchronizer components in a suitable holder and clean with solvent. Air dry.
INSPECTION
Proper inspection of components involve:
- Teeth, for wear, scuffed, nicked, burred, or broken teeth
- Keys, for wear or distortion
- Balls and springs, for distortion, cracks, or wear
If any of these conditions exist in these components, replace as necessary.
ASSEMBLY
1. Position synchronizer hub onto a suitable holding fixture (input shaft). The synchronizer hubs are
directional. The hubs must be installed with the
U facing upward.
2. Install springs into hub slot (Fig. 147). 3. Insert key into hub and spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4326
4. Apply petroleum jelly to the hole in the key. Insert balls into each key (Fig. 148).
5. Slide sleeve over the hub and depress balls as you carefully slip the sleeve into position (Fig.
149).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4327
6. Line up stop ring tang over the keys in the hub (Fig. 150). Install stop rings. Center the keys and
balls by pushing on both stop rings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Input Shaft: Service and Repair Disassembly
T350 - Manual Transmission INPUT SHAFT DISASSEMBLY
Before disassembly of the input shaft, it is necessary to check the synchronizer stop ring gap. Use
a feeler gauge to measure the gaps between the stop rings and the speed gears. The correct gaps
are listed below: 1st .............................................................................................................................
............................................... 0.522 - 2.208 mm (0.021 - 0.087 inch). 2nd ........................................
.................................................................................................................................. 0.522 - 2.208
mm (0.021 - 0.087 inch). 3rd ...............................................................................................................
................................................................ 0.73 - 1.53 mm (0.029 - 0.060 inch). 4th ............................
................................................................................................................................................... 0.77 1.57 mm (0.030 - 0.062 inch). 5th .......................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.73 - 1.53 mm (0.029 - 0.060 inch).
If a stop ring gap does not fall within the specifications, it must be inspected for wear and replaced.
If the 1st or 2nd synchronizer stop ring is worn beyond specifications, the complete output shaft
assembly must be replaced.
The input shaft incorporates the 3rd, 4th, and 5th speed gears and synchronizers on the assembly
(Fig. 111).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4332
1. Install bearing splitter behind 5th speed gear. Remove snap ring at 5th synchronizer hub on
input shaft (Fig. 112).
2. Remove synchronizer and gear using shop press (Fig. 113).
3. Remove caged needle bearing (Fig. 114).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4333
4. Remove 4-5 gears split thrust washer ring (Fig. 115).
5. Remove split thrust washer (Fig. 116).
6. Remove split thrust washer separation pin (Fig. 117).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4334
7. Remove 4th sear (Fig. 118).
8. Remove 4th gear caged needle bearing (Fig. 119). Check the caged needle bearing for a broken
retention spring.
9. Remove blocking ring. Remove 3-4 synchronizer hub retaining snap ring (Fig. 120).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4335
10. Install input shaft in shop press. Using bearing splitter, remove 3-4 synchronizer and 3rd gear
(Fig. 121).
11. Remove 3rd gear caged needle bearing (Fig. 122). Inspect needle bearing for a broken
retention spring. 12. Inspect the input shaft for worn or damaged bearing races or chipped gear
teeth. Replace as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4336
Input Shaft: Service and Repair Assembly
T350 - Manual Transmission INPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
The snap rings that are used on the input shaft are available in select fit sizes. Use the thickest
snap ring that fits in each snap ring groove.
1. Place input shaft into shop press.
2. Install 3rd gear caged needle bearing (Fig. 123).
3. Install 3rd gear and 3-4 synchronizer onto input shaft. Install Tool #C-3717 over input shaft and
press on synchronizer hub and 3rd gear (Fig.
124). The synchronizer hub has the letter U stamped on the top face of the hub. This designates
that the hub must be installed with the U facing upward.
4. Install 3-4 synchronizer snap ring into slot on input shaft. 5. Install blocking ring into 3-4
synchronizer. Install 4th gear caged needle bearing. 6. Install 4th gear onto input shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4337
7. Install 4-5 split thrust washer separation pin (Fig. 125).
8. Install split thrust washer onto input shaft (Fig. 126).
9. Install split thrust washer retaining ring (Fig. 127).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4338
10. Install 5th gear caged needle bearing (Fig. 128).
11. Using special tool #C-3717, install 5th speed gear and synchronizer (Fig. 129). The 5th gear
synchronizer hub has the letter S stamped on the top
face of the hub. This designates that the hub must be installed with the S facing upward.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Input Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 4339
12. Install 5th gear synchronizer snap ring (Fig. 130).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Output Shaft: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission OUTPUT SHAFT DISASSEMBLY
CAUTION: The output shaft is serviced as an assembly. Do not try to repair any component on the
output shaft. If the 1-2 synchronizer or gear fails, it
is necessary to replace the output shaft assembly.
It is necessary to check the synchronizer stop ring gap. Use a feeler gauge to measure the gaps
between the stop rings and the speed gears. The correct gaps are listed below:
1st ........................................................................................................................................................
.......... 0.522 - 2.208 mm (0.021 - 0.087 inch) 2nd ..............................................................................
................................................................................... 0.522 - 2.208 mm (0.021 - 0.087 inch) 3rd ......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 0.73 - 1.53 mm (0.029 - 0.060 inch) 4th ...........................................................................................
........................................................................... 0.77 - 1.57 mm (0.030 - 0.062 inch) 5th ..................
.................................................................................................................................................... 0.73
- 1.53 mm (0.029 - 0.060 inch)
If a stop ring gap does not fall within the specifications it must be inspected for wear and replaced.
If the 1st or 2nd synchronizer stop ring is worn beyond specifications, the complete output shaft
assembly must be replaced.
The output shaft incorporates the 1st and 2nd gears and synchronizers on the assembly (Fig. 135).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft Bearing, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Output Shaft Bearing: Specifications
Output Bearing Race Ret. Strap
............................................................................................................................................................
11 Nm (96 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft Bearing, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4346
Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission OUTPUT BEARING AND RACE REMOVAL
CAUTION: The position of the output shaft bearing is critical. The bearing is not identical
end-to-end. Install bearing with larger diameter cage ring
facing out.
1. Remove caged roller bearing from output bearing race (Fig. 131).
2. Remove screws at output bearing retainer strap (Fig. 132).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft Bearing, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4347
3. Install tool #6787 and slide hammer (Fig. 133). Tighten tool to output bearing race. 4. Using slide
hammer, remove output bearing race.
INSTALLATION
1. Line up output bearing race to race bore.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft Bearing, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4348
2. Insert tool #4628 with C-4171 into output bearing race (Fig. 134). Tap race into bore. Install
output bearing into race. Verify that the larger
diameter cage is facing outward. Position bearing retaining strap. Tighten bolts to 11 Nm (96 inch
lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Reverse Idler Gear >
Component Information > Specifications
Reverse Idler Gear: Specifications
Reverse Idler Shaft Bolt .......................................................................................................................
.................................................... 29 Nm (19 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, M/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Shift Shaft Seals
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Shift Shaft Seals
T350 - Manual Transmission SHIFT SHAFT SEALS
REMOVAL
It is not necessary to remove the shift shafts from the transaxle to service the shift shaft seals.
1. Using a pick tool, pry up on the shift shaft seal, and remove seal from bore.
INSTALLATION
1. Position new shift shaft seal into bore. 2. Install shift shaft seal into bore using an appropriate
size deep-well socket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, M/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > Shift Shaft Seals > Page 4356
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Axle Seal
T350 - Manual Transmission AXLE SEAL REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft.
2. Insert a flat-blade pry tool at outer edge of axle shaft seal (Fig. 66) 3. Tap on the pry tool with a
small hammer and remove axle shaft seal.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean axle shaft seal bore of any excess sealant. 2. Align axle shaft seal with axle shaft seal
bore. 3. Install axle seal on tool #6709 and C-4171 and insert into axle shaft seal bore. 4. Tap seal
into position until seated against transaxle case. 5. Install axle shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - M/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - M/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4361
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
T350 - Manual Transmission DESCRIPTION - VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - M/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4362
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect the speed sensor connector (Fig. 151).
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing to prevent dirt from entering the
transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt (Fig. 151). 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle
during sensor removal, drive gear must be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion gear to speed sensor (Fig. 151). 2. Using a NEW O-ring, install the speed sensor to
the transaxle (Fig. 151). 3. Install the bolt and torque to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.). 4. Connect speed
sensor connector (Fig. 151). 5. Lower vehicle and road test to verify proper speedometer operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Shifter M/T: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission SHIFT MECHANISM REMOVAL
1. Lift up on gearshift boot to disengage retainer tabs from console.
2. Push down on knob and rotate clockwise to remove knob/boot assembly (Fig. 139).
3. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 140).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4366
4. Remove crossover cable retaining clip and disconnect from shift lever (Fig. 141).
5. Remove selector cable retaining clip and disconnect from shift lever (Fig. 142).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4367
6. Remove four shifter assy.-to-floor pan nuts and remove shifter from vehicle (Fig. 143).
INSTALLATION
1. Install shifter assy. to floor pan (Fig. 143). Install and tighten four nuts to 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.)
torque. 2. Install selector cable to shifter lever and secure cable to shifter bracket. Install clip (Fig.
142). 3. Install crossover cable to shifter lever and secure cable to shifter bracket. Install clip (Fig.
141). 4. Install center console assembly (Fig. 140). 5. Install knob/boot assembly to shifter lever,
align knob to three o'clock position, push knob down to engage spring and rotate counter
clockwise. 6. Locate boot to console at forward tab and secure to console with retaining tabs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Selector
Shaft, M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Shift Selector Shaft
Selector Shaft: Service and Repair Shift Selector Shaft
T350 - Manual Transmission SHIFT SELECTOR SHAFT REMOVAL
1. Disassemble transaxle. 2. With the transaxle disassembled, remove the selector shaft by
pushing on the shaft from the outside. Pull shaft out from the inside.
INSTALLATION
1. Pull selector shaft into position from the outside. 2. Assemble transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Selector
Shaft, M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Shift Selector Shaft > Page 4373
Selector Shaft: Service and Repair Shift Selector Shaft Bushing
T350 - Manual Transmission SHIFT SELECTOR SHAFT BUSHING REMOVAL
1. Remove selector shaft. 2. Thread tool #6786 into bushing.
3. Install slide hammer #3752 onto tool and remove bushing using slide hammer. (Fig. 145).
INSTALLATION
1. Position replacement bushing over selector shaft bore.
2. Using an appropriate size deep-well socket, install bushing in selector shaft bore (Fig. 146).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Boot, M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Boot: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission GEAR SHIFT KNOB/BOOT ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
1. Disengage boot from console by lifting up to free retaining tabs.
2. Push down on knob and rotate clockwise to remove (Fig. 106).
INSTALLATION
1. Install knob/boot assembly to shifter lever, align knob to three o'clock position, push knob down
to engage spring and rotate counter clockwise. 2. Locate boot to console at forward tab and secure
to console with retaining tabs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Cable: Specifications
Shift Cable Bracket to Transaxle
......................................................................................................................................................... 28
Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4380
Shift Cable: Adjustments
T350 - Manual Transmission GEAR SHIFT CABLE - ADJUSTMENTS
NOTE: Only the crossover cable is adjustable. The selector cable does not have adjustment
capabilities.
1. Disengage gearshift boot retaining tabs to free it from console.
2. Push down on knob and rotate clockwise to remove shifter boot/knob assembly (Fig. 103).
3. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 104)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4381
4. Loosen crossover adjustment screw at shifter assembly (Fig. 105). 5. The gearshift mechanism
and transaxle crossover lever are spring-loaded and self-centering. Alignment pins used in the past
are not required
anymore. Allow gearshift mechanism and transaxle crossover lever to relax in their neutral
positions. To ensure the gearshift lever is in the proper position, place the shifter in 3rd or 4th gear
if necessary. Torque adjustment screw to 8 Nm (70 inch lbs.). Care must be taken to avoid moving
the shift mechanism off-center during screw tightening.
6. Install center console assembly (Fig. 104). 7. Install knob/boot assembly to shifter lever, align
knob to three o'clock position, push knob down to engage spring and rotate counter clockwise. 8.
Secure boot retaining tabs to console.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4382
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission GEAR SHIFT CABLE REMOVAL
NOTE: The crossover and selector cables are manufactured as a cable "assembly" and cannot be
serviced individually.
1. Raise hood and disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Disengage gearshift boot from center
console.
3. Push down on knob and rotate clockwise to remove gearshift boot/knob assy. (Fig. 94).
4. Remove the center console assembly as shown in (Fig. 95).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4383
5. Remove crossover cable retaining clip and disconnect from shift lever (Fig. 96).
6. Remove selector cable retaining clip and disconnect from shift lever (Fig. 97). 7. Remove three
grommet plate-to-floor pan attaching nuts (Fig. 96).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4384
8. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assy. (Fig. 98) as follows:
a. Disconnect Proportional Purge Solenoid (PPS) and crankcase vent hose from throttle body. b.
Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and Idle Air Control (IAC) connectors. c. Disconnect
throttle body air duct from intake manifold. d. Remove mounting bolt and nut (Fig. 98) and partially
remove air cleaner assembly. e. Disconnect accelerator and speed control (if equipped) cables
after the assy. is removed from position. Remove air cleaner assembly from
vehicle.
9. Disconnect cables from the shift levers at the transaxle (Fig. 99).
CAUTION: Pry up with equal force on both sides of shifter cable isolator bushings to avoid
damaging cable isolator bushings.
Remove cable retaining clips and remove cables from bracket (Fig. 99).
10. Raise vehicle on hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4385
11. Remove converter heat shield (Fig. 100).
12. Remove remaining grommet plate-to-floor pan screw (Fig. 101). 13. Remove cable assembly
from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The crossover and selector cables are manufactured as a cable "assembly" and cannot be
serviced individually.
CAUTION: Gearshift cable bushings must not be lubricated or the bushings will swell and split.
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Install cable assembly through floor pan opening and secure to floor
pan with grommet plate and one screw (Fig. 101). Make sure the three
grommet plate studs protrude through cable assembly and floor pan and tighten screw to 7 Nm (60
inch lbs.).
3. Route transaxle end of cable assembly into engine compartment and over transaxle assembly.
4. Install converter heat shield (Fig. 100). 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Install gearshift cables to mounting
bracket and fasten with NEW clips (Fig. 99). Make sure clips are installed flush to bracket. 7.
Connect gearshift selector and crossover cable to shift levers at transaxle (Fig. 99). 8. Install and
tighten the three grommet plate-to-floor pan nuts to 6 Nm (50 inch lbs.) torque. 9. Install selector
cable to shifter lever and secure cable to shifter bracket. Install clip (Fig. 97).
10. Install crossover cable to shifter lever and secure cable to shifter bracket. Install clip (Fig. 96).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4386
NOTE: Only the crossover cable is adjustable. The selector cable does not have any adjustment
capabilities.
11. Adjust crossover cable as follows:
a. Loosen adjusting screw on crossover cable at shifter (Fig. 102). b. The gearshift mechanism and
transaxle crossover lever are spring-loaded and self-centering. Alignment pins used in the past are
not required
anymore. Allow gearshift mechanism and transaxle crossover lever to relax in their neutral
positions. To ensure the gearshift lever is in the proper position, place the shifter in 3rd or 4th gear
if necessary. Torque adjustment screw to 8 Nm (70 inch lbs.). Care must be taken to avoid moving
the shift mechanism off-center during screw tightening.
c. Perform functional check by shifting transaxle into all gears.
12. Install center console assembly (Fig. 95). Verify that boot is not pinched at console opening
before tightening. 13. Install knob/boot assembly to shifter lever, align knob to three o'clock
position, push knob down to engage spring and rotate counter clockwise to
secure (Fig. 94).
14. Locate boot to console at forward tab and secure with retaining tabs. 15. Return shifter boot to
its original position (seated around knob lip). 16. Install the air cleaner/throttle body assy. (Fig. 98)
as follows:
a. Connect the accelerator and speed control (if equipped) cables to the air cleaner/throttle body
assy. b. Install assy. into position, making sure the air cleaner locating slot is engaged to the
battery bracket tab, and tighten fasteners to 14 Nm (120
inch lbs.) torque.
c. Verify throttle body duct is fully seated to intake manifold and tighten clamp to 5 Nm (40 inch
lbs.) torque. d. Connect the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and Idle Air Control (IAC) connectors. e.
Connect Proportional Purge Solenoid (PPS) and crankcase vent hose from throttle body.
17. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Rail, M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Shift Rail: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission SHIFT RAIL BUSHINGS REMOVAL
1. Thread tool #6786 into shift rail bushing. 2. Install slide hammer #3752 onto tool.
3. Remove bushing using slide hammer and tool assembly (Fig. 144).
INSTALLATION
1. Line up replacement bushing in bore. 2. Using tool #MD998343, tap bushing into bore until flush
with the chamfer in the case.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Mount: Specifications
Front Engine Mount to Trans ...............................................................................................................
.................................................. 108 Nm (80 ft. lbs.) Front Mount Through Bolt .................................
...................................................................................................................................... 61 Nm (45 ft.
lbs.) Front Mount to Engine Bolt ..........................................................................................................
............................................................ 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) Left Mount Through Bolt ...........................
............................................................................................................................................ 108 Nm
(80 ft. lbs.) Left Mount to Transaxle .....................................................................................................
...................................................................... 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed Sensor,
M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed Sensor,
M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4396
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
T350 - Manual Transmission DESCRIPTION - VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed Sensor,
M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4397
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect the speed sensor connector (Fig. 151).
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing to prevent dirt from entering the
transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt (Fig. 151). 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle
during sensor removal, drive gear must be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion gear to speed sensor (Fig. 151). 2. Using a NEW O-ring, install the speed sensor to
the transaxle (Fig. 151). 3. Install the bolt and torque to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.). 4. Connect speed
sensor connector (Fig. 151). 5. Lower vehicle and road test to verify proper speedometer operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 4408
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 4409
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 4410
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 4416
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 4417
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts > Page 4418
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4419
Control Module: Locations
Fig.11 TCM Location
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4420
Control Module: Description and Operation
Fig.11 TCM Location
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11). It mounts on a bracket that is fastened to the rail.
The TCM is the controlling unit for all electronic operations of the transaxle. The TCM receives
information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and selects the
operational mode of the transaxle. Direct inputs are hardwired to, and used specifically by the
TCM. Indirect inputs originate from other components/modules, and are shared with the TCM via
the J1850 communication bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are: -Battery (B+) voltage -Ignition "ON" voltage
-Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) -Throttle Position Sensor -Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) -Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) -Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD) -Transmission
Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS) -Input Shaft Speed Sensor -Output Shaft Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are: Engine/Body Identification
- Manifold Pressure
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Speed Control ON/OFF Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Brake Switch Status
- DRB Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are: Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD and UD)
- Vehicle Speed (to PCM)
- Torque Reduction Request (to PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4421
An example of a TCM indirect output is: Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions: Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indices (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with DRB scan tool)
Clutch Volume Index (CVI) An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index
(CVI). CVIs represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
Fig.12 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur (Fig. 12).
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRB Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4422
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Shift Schedules As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of
shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following: Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4423
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the chart
to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Control Module (TCM) is being replaced with a new or replacement unit,
the Pinion Factor and Quick Learn procedures must be performed. (Refer to ELECTRONIC
CONTROL MODULES/TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE - STANDARD PROCEDURE)
(Refer to ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/ TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE)
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially remove right front wheel
splash shield.
Fig.13 TCM 60-Way Connector
4. Disconnect TCM 60-way connector (Fig. 13).
Fig.14 TCM/Bracket Assembly
5. Remove three (3) TCM bracket-to-rail screws and remove TCM/bracket assembly from vehicle
(Fig. 14).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation >
Page 4426
Fig.15 TCM Bracket
6. Remove four (4) bracket-to-TCM screws and remove bracket (Fig. 15).
INSTALLATION
1. Install TCM to mounting bracket and torque four (4) screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 15). 2.
Install TCM/bracket assembly to rail (Fig. 14). Install and torque three (3) bracket-to-rail screws to
12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Install TCM 60-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.) (Fig. 13). 4.
Install and secure right front wheel splash shield. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation >
Page 4427
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the Transmission Control Module (TCM) has been
replaced with a NEW or replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an
inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The TCM
must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Transmission Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a DRB III scan tool. 1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector
located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous
menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the instructions on the DRB III scan tool screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation >
Page 4428
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRB III scan tool. This program allows the
electronic transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle
operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met: The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRB III
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60 ° and below 200 °
1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRB III to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Control System Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4432
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4433
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4434
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION CONTROL RELAY - DESCRIPTION
The transmission control relay (Fig. 303) is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), which
is located on the left side of the engine compartment.
OPERATION
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TCM, and is used to supply power to the
solenoid pack when the transmission is in normal operating mode. When the relay is "off", no
power is supplied to the solenoid pack and the transmission is in "limp-in" mode.
After a controller reset (ignition key turned to the "run" position or after cranking engine), the TCM
energizes the relay. Prior to this, the TCM verifies that the contacts are open by checking for no
voltage at the switched battery terminals.
After this is verified, the voltage at the solenoid pack pressure switches is checked. After the relay
is energized, the TCM monitors the terminals to verify that the voltage is greater than 3 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly-to-Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 12 Nm (110 in.
lbs.)
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Connector Screw
............................................................................................................................. 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4443
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4444
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
DESCRIPTION
The Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (Fig. 289) is external to the transaxle and mounted to the
transaxle case. The assembly consists of four solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the
LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is controlled by line pressure from
the manual valve in the valve body. The solenoids are contained within the Solenoid/Pressure
Switch Assembly, and can only be serviced by replacing the assembly. The solenoid assembly also
contains pressure switches that monitor and send hydraulic circuit information to the TCM.
Likewise, the pressure switches can only be service by replacing the assembly.
OPERATION SOLENOIDS
The solenoids receive electrical power from the Transmission Control Relay through a single wire.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid needed. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid passage is
opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The result is an
apply or release of a frictional element. The 2/4 and UD solenoids are normally applied, which by
design allow fluid to pass through in their relaxed or "off" state. This allows transaxle limp-in (P, R,
N, 2) in the event of an electrical failure. The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically
tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off depending on its current state. An inductive spike should
be detected by the TCM during this test. If no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify
the failure. In addition to the periodic testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or
pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on three pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2/4, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The range for the pressure switch closing and opening points is 11 23 psi. Typically the switch opening point will be approximately one psi lower than the closing point.
For example, a switch may close at 18 psi and open at 17 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4445
The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the correct states (open or closed) in
each gear as shown in the chart shown.
PRESSURE SWITCH STATES
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear. The TCM also tests the 2/4 and OD pressure switches when they are
normally off (OD and 2/4 are tested in 1st gear, OD in 2nd gear, and 2/4 in 3rd gear). The test
simply verifies that they are operational, by looking for a closed state when the corresponding
element is applied. Immediately after a shift into 1st, 2nd, or 3rd gear with the engine speed above
1000 rpm, the TCM momentarily turns on element pressure to the 2/4 and/or OD clutch circuits to
identify that the appropriate switch has closed. If it doesn't close, it is tested again. If the switch fails
to close the second time, the appropriate DTC will set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4446
Pressure Switch States
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4447
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY REMOVAL
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
solenoid/pressure switch assembly connector. 4. Disconnect input speed sensor connector.
5. Remove input speed sensor (Fig. 290).
6. Remove three (3) solenoid/pressure switch assembly-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 291).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4448
7. Remove solenoid/pressure switch assembly and gasket (Fig. 292). Use care to prevent gasket
material and foreign objects from become lodged in
the transaxle case ports.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install solenoid/pressure switch assembly and new gasket to transaxle (Fig. 292). 2. Install and
torque three (3) bolts (Fig. 291) to 13 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 3. Install input speed sensor (Fig. 290) and
torque to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect input speed sensor connector. 5. Install solenoid/pressure
switch 8-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 6. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 7. Connect battery negative cable. 8. If solenoid/pressure switch assembly was
replaced, perform TCM Quick Learn procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Switch: Locations
Interlock Mechanism
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4452
Shift Interlock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig. 39
1. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Fig. 40
2. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 40).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4453
Fig. 41
3. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/ RUN" position (Fig. 41).
Fig. 42
4. Grasp the interlock cable and connector firmly. Remove the interlock cable (Fig. 42).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4454
Fig. 43
5. Remove the two interlock mechanism-to-steering column attaching screws (Fig. 43). Remove
the interlock housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interlock housing at steering column. Install the two interlock mechanism-to-steering
column attaching screws. Torque screws to 3
Nm (21 inch lbs.).
2. Snap the interlock cable into the housing. 3. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds
(Fig. 40). 4. Install steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4458
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Mode Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4462
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4463
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4464
Autostick Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 4470
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 4471
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4472
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4473
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4474
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4475
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4476
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 4481
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 4482
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4483
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Input Speed Sensor (EATX)
Output Speed Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input
Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 293), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 294),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input
Speed Sensor > Page 4486
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 295), an AC voltage is generated and sent to the
TCM. The TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input speed signal with output speed signal to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input
Speed Sensor > Page 4487
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates an AC signal as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 298), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 299),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input
Speed Sensor > Page 4488
OPERATION
The Output Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the output shaft is rotating. As the rear
planetary carrier park pawl lugs pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 300), an AC voltage is generated and
sent to the TCM. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following: Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Input
Speed Sensor > Page 4489
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Signal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
The vehicle speed signal is taken from the Output Speed Sensor. The TCM converts this signal
into a pulse per mile signal and sends it to the PCM.
The PCM, in turn, sends the vehicle speed message across the communication bus to the BCM.
The BCM sends this signal to the Instrument Cluster to display vehicle speed to the driver. The
vehicle speed signal pulse is roughly 8000 pulses per mile.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed
Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
input speed sensor connector.
4. Unscrew and remove input speed sensor (Fig. 296).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 297) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position. 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Install air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 5. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Input Speed
Sensor > Page 4492
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect output speed sensor
connector.
4. Unscrew and remove output speed sensor (Fig. 301).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 302) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position (Fig. 302). 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4497
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
T350 - Manual Transmission DESCRIPTION - VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4498
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect the speed sensor connector (Fig. 151).
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing to prevent dirt from entering the
transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt (Fig. 151). 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle
during sensor removal, drive gear must be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion gear to speed sensor (Fig. 151). 2. Using a NEW O-ring, install the speed sensor to
the transaxle (Fig. 151). 3. Install the bolt and torque to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.). 4. Connect speed
sensor connector (Fig. 151). 5. Lower vehicle and road test to verify proper speedometer operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4505
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Brake Transmission Shift Interlock Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4509
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4510
8w-80-61
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4511
Solenoid Application Chart
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams
Shift Indicator: Diagrams
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)(Autostick)
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Application and ID
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Console Gear Selector w/ Auto ...........................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC 194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 4530
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 4531
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear
Downshifts > Page 4532
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd Gear Downshifts
NUMBER: 21-006-03 REV. A
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: August 1, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-006-03, DATE JUNE 20,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITION OF KJ AND 2.4L RS
VEHICLES, REVISED NOTES, AND NEW APPLICATION TABLE.
**THE SOFTWARE IS CURRENTLY AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT FOR CS, JR, LH, PL, PT,
3.3L AND 3.8L RS/RG, AND TJ VEHICLES**.
**THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE FOR 2.4L RS/RG VEHICLES. THE
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER AUGUST 18, 2003. KJ
SOFTWARE WILL BE AVAILABLE ON TechCONNECT ON OR AFTER SEPTEMBER 3, 2003.**
SUBJECT: Transmission Harsh 4-3 Downshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves reprogramming the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
MODELS:
2004 (CS) Pacifica
2003 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
**2003 (KJ) Liberty**
**2003 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)**
2003 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/Intrepid
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
2003 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2003 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2003 (TJ) Wrangler
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts > Page 4538
NOTE:
**Refer to the following table for specific applications. **
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle may exhibit, after an extended soak (several hours), a harsh 4-3 downshift.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a Scan Tool (DRBIII(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures, verify all engine
systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin
If the vehicle operator describes the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
**An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being preformed.**
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Check the transmission fluid level. If fluid level is full proceed to step 2. If fluid level is low,
diagnose and repair fluid leak. Proceed to step 2.
NOTE:
Whenever a PCM/TCM is replaced or reprogrammed, the software in the controller and DRBIII(R)
must be verified as having the latest revision level. If a controller software update flash is available,
complete the flash and labeling requirement as directed in the appropriate service bulletin identified
on the TechCONNECT.
2. Connect a battery charger and set as close to 14 volts charge as possible.
3. Flash the controller using the TechCONNECT and DRBIII(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts > Page 4539
NOTE:
**Using the DRBIII(R) preform the proper Quick Learn procedure. Refer to the service information
available in TechCONNECT or the appropriate service manual in Section 8E - Electronic Control
Modules.**
NOTE:
Due to the PCM reprogramming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM, MIC,
SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. All
DTC's relate to a loss of communications with the module that is being reprogrammed. Check all
modules, record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following steps are required by law.
4. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020 (Fig.
1). Attach the label to the controller and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
5. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-006-03A > Aug > 03 > A/T - Harsh 4th to 3rd
Gear Downshifts > Page 4540
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4541
Control Module: Locations
Fig.11 TCM Location
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4542
Control Module: Description and Operation
Fig.11 TCM Location
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) is located behind the passenger fender and is fastened to
the frame rail forward of the suspension (Fig. 11). It mounts on a bracket that is fastened to the rail.
The TCM is the controlling unit for all electronic operations of the transaxle. The TCM receives
information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and selects the
operational mode of the transaxle. Direct inputs are hardwired to, and used specifically by the
TCM. Indirect inputs originate from other components/modules, and are shared with the TCM via
the J1850 communication bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are: -Battery (B+) voltage -Ignition "ON" voltage
-Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) -Throttle Position Sensor -Crankshaft Position Sensor
(CKP) -Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) -Pressure Switches (L/R, 2/4, OD) -Transmission
Temperature Sensor (Integral to TRS) -Input Shaft Speed Sensor -Output Shaft Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are: Engine/Body Identification
- Manifold Pressure
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Speed Control ON/OFF Switch
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Brake Switch Status
- DRB Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are: Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids (LR/CC, 2/4, OD and UD)
- Vehicle Speed (to PCM)
- Torque Reduction Request (to PCM)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4543
An example of a TCM indirect output is: Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions: Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indices (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with DRB scan tool)
Clutch Volume Index (CVI) An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Index
(CVI). CVIs represent the volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
Fig.12 Example Of CVI Calculation
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transaxle gear ratio. This is important to the
CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur (Fig. 12).
Gear ratios can be determined by using the DRB Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed
Sensor values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed
Sensor value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4544
Clutch Volumes
Certain mechanical problems within the clutch assemblies (broken return springs, out of position
snap rings, excessive clutch pack clearance, improper assembly etc.) can cause inadequate or
out-of-range clutch volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The chart identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Shift Schedules As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of
shift schedules. Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following: Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4545
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the chart
to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Module: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Control Module (TCM) is being replaced with a new or replacement unit,
the Pinion Factor and Quick Learn procedures must be performed. (Refer to ELECTRONIC
CONTROL MODULES/TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE - STANDARD PROCEDURE)
(Refer to ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/ TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE)
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially remove right front wheel
splash shield.
Fig.13 TCM 60-Way Connector
4. Disconnect TCM 60-way connector (Fig. 13).
Fig.14 TCM/Bracket Assembly
5. Remove three (3) TCM bracket-to-rail screws and remove TCM/bracket assembly from vehicle
(Fig. 14).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4548
Fig.15 TCM Bracket
6. Remove four (4) bracket-to-TCM screws and remove bracket (Fig. 15).
INSTALLATION
1. Install TCM to mounting bracket and torque four (4) screws to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) (Fig. 15). 2.
Install TCM/bracket assembly to rail (Fig. 14). Install and torque three (3) bracket-to-rail screws to
12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 3. Install TCM 60-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.) (Fig. 13). 4.
Install and secure right front wheel splash shield. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Connect battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4549
Control Module: Service and Repair Pinion Factor Setting
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PINION FACTOR SETTING
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the Transmission Control Module (TCM) has been
replaced with a NEW or replacement unit. Failure to perform this procedure will result in an
inoperative or improperly calibrated speedometer.
The vehicle speed readings for the speedometer are taken from the output speed sensor. The TCM
must be calibrated to the different combinations of equipment (final drive and tires) available.
Pinion Factor allows the technician to set the Transmission Control Module initial setting so that the
speedometer readings will be correct. To properly read and/or reset the Pinion Factor, it is
necessary to use a DRB III scan tool. 1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector
located under the instrument panel. 2. Select the Transmission menu. 3. Select the Miscellaneous
menu. 4. Select Pinion Factor. Then follow the instructions on the DRB III scan tool screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4550
Control Module: Service and Repair Quick Learn Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - QUICK LEARN PROCEDURE
The quick learn procedure requires the use of the DRB III scan tool. This program allows the
electronic transaxle system to recalibrate itself. This will provide the best possible transaxle
operation.
NOTE: The quick learn procedure should be performed if any of the following procedures are
performed:
- Transaxle Assembly Replacement
- Transmission Control Module Replacement
- Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Replacement
- Clutch Plate and/or Seal Replacement
- Valve Body Replacement or Recondition
To perform the Quick Learn Procedure, the following conditions must be met: The brakes must be applied
- The engine speed must be above 500 rpm
- The throttle angle (TPS) must be less than 3 degrees
- The shift lever position must stay until prompted to shift to overdrive
- The shift lever position must stay in overdrive after the Shift to Overdrive prompt until the DRB III
indicates the procedure is complete
- The calculated oil temperature must be above 60 ° and below 200 °
1. Plug the DRB III scan tool into the diagnostic connector. The connector is located under the
instrument panel. 2. Go to the Transmission screen. 3. Go to the Miscellaneous screen. 4. Select
Quick Learn Procedure. Follow the instructions of the DRB III to perform the Quick Learn
Procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Transmission Control System Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4554
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4555
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Automatic Shut Down Relay
Transmission Control Relay (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4556
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION CONTROL RELAY - DESCRIPTION
The transmission control relay (Fig. 303) is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), which
is located on the left side of the engine compartment.
OPERATION
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TCM, and is used to supply power to the
solenoid pack when the transmission is in normal operating mode. When the relay is "off", no
power is supplied to the solenoid pack and the transmission is in "limp-in" mode.
After a controller reset (ignition key turned to the "run" position or after cranking engine), the TCM
energizes the relay. Prior to this, the TCM verifies that the contacts are open by checking for no
voltage at the switched battery terminals.
After this is verified, the voltage at the solenoid pack pressure switches is checked. After the relay
is energized, the TCM monitors the terminals to verify that the voltage is greater than 3 volts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly-to-Case Bolt
................................................................................................................................ 12 Nm (110 in.
lbs.)
Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly Connector Screw
............................................................................................................................. 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4565
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4566
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY
DESCRIPTION
The Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (Fig. 289) is external to the transaxle and mounted to the
transaxle case. The assembly consists of four solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the
LR/CC, 2/4, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is controlled by line pressure from
the manual valve in the valve body. The solenoids are contained within the Solenoid/Pressure
Switch Assembly, and can only be serviced by replacing the assembly. The solenoid assembly also
contains pressure switches that monitor and send hydraulic circuit information to the TCM.
Likewise, the pressure switches can only be service by replacing the assembly.
OPERATION SOLENOIDS
The solenoids receive electrical power from the Transmission Control Relay through a single wire.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid needed. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid passage is
opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The result is an
apply or release of a frictional element. The 2/4 and UD solenoids are normally applied, which by
design allow fluid to pass through in their relaxed or "off" state. This allows transaxle limp-in (P, R,
N, 2) in the event of an electrical failure. The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically
tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off depending on its current state. An inductive spike should
be detected by the TCM during this test. If no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify
the failure. In addition to the periodic testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or
pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on three pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2/4, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The range for the pressure switch closing and opening points is 11 23 psi. Typically the switch opening point will be approximately one psi lower than the closing point.
For example, a switch may close at 18 psi and open at 17 psi.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4567
The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the correct states (open or closed) in
each gear as shown in the chart shown.
PRESSURE SWITCH STATES
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear. The TCM also tests the 2/4 and OD pressure switches when they are
normally off (OD and 2/4 are tested in 1st gear, OD in 2nd gear, and 2/4 in 3rd gear). The test
simply verifies that they are operational, by looking for a closed state when the corresponding
element is applied. Immediately after a shift into 1st, 2nd, or 3rd gear with the engine speed above
1000 rpm, the TCM momentarily turns on element pressure to the 2/4 and/or OD clutch circuits to
identify that the appropriate switch has closed. If it doesn't close, it is tested again. If the switch fails
to close the second time, the appropriate DTC will set.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4568
Pressure Switch States
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4569
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
41TE - Automatic Transmission SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH ASSY REMOVAL
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
solenoid/pressure switch assembly connector. 4. Disconnect input speed sensor connector.
5. Remove input speed sensor (Fig. 290).
6. Remove three (3) solenoid/pressure switch assembly-to-transaxle case bolts (Fig. 291).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4570
7. Remove solenoid/pressure switch assembly and gasket (Fig. 292). Use care to prevent gasket
material and foreign objects from become lodged in
the transaxle case ports.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If solenoid/pressure switch assembly is being replaced, it is necessary to perform the TCM
Quick Learn Procedure.
1. Install solenoid/pressure switch assembly and new gasket to transaxle (Fig. 292). 2. Install and
torque three (3) bolts (Fig. 291) to 13 Nm (110 in. lbs.). 3. Install input speed sensor (Fig. 290) and
torque to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect input speed sensor connector. 5. Install solenoid/pressure
switch 8-way connector and torque to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 6. Install air cleaner/throttle body
assembly. 7. Connect battery negative cable. 8. If solenoid/pressure switch assembly was
replaced, perform TCM Quick Learn procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Switch: Locations
Interlock Mechanism
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4574
Shift Interlock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig. 39
1. Remove the steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Fig. 40
2. Remove the steering column upper and lower shrouds (Fig. 40).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4575
Fig. 41
3. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" or "ON/ RUN" position (Fig. 41).
Fig. 42
4. Grasp the interlock cable and connector firmly. Remove the interlock cable (Fig. 42).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Interlock Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4576
Fig. 43
5. Remove the two interlock mechanism-to-steering column attaching screws (Fig. 43). Remove
the interlock housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the interlock housing at steering column. Install the two interlock mechanism-to-steering
column attaching screws. Torque screws to 3
Nm (21 inch lbs.).
2. Snap the interlock cable into the housing. 3. Install steering column upper and lower shrouds
(Fig. 40). 4. Install steering column lower cover (Fig. 39).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Shift Solenoid Position Sensor/Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4580
Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch Assembly (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Transmission Mode Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4584
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4585
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4586
Autostick Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Specifications
Transmission Range Sensor ...............................................................................................................
........................................................ 5 Nm (45 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4592
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4593
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4594
Transmission Range Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4595
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
41TE - Automatic Transmission TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is mounted to the top of the valve body inside the transaxle
and can only be serviced by removing the valve body. The electrical connector extends through the
transaxle case (Fig. 304). The TRS has four switch contacts that monitor shift lever position and
send the information to the TCM.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transaxle
temperature to the TCM and PCM (Fig. 305).
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) (Fig. 304) communicates Shift Lever Position (SLP) to the
TCM as a combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned
combination of switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The
TCM interprets this information and determines the appropriate transaxle gear position and shift
schedule.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4596
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR SWITCH STATES
Since there are four switches, there are 16 possible combinations of open and closed switches
(codes). Seven of these codes are related to gear position and three are recognized as "between
gear" codes. This results in six codes which should never occur. These are called "invalid" codes.
An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the shift lever position based
on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission operation with a TRS failure.
TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The TRS has an integrated thermistor (Fig. 305) that the TCM uses to monitor the transmission's
sump temperature. Since fluid temperature can affect transmission shift quality and convertor lock
up, the TCM requires this information to determine which shift schedule to operate in. The PCM
also monitors this temperature data so it can energize the vehicle cooling fan(s) when a
transmission "overheat" condition exists. If the thermistor circuit fails, the TCM will revert to
calculated oil temperature usage.
CALCULATED TEMPERATURE
A failure in the temperature sensor or circuit will result in calculated temperature being substituted
for actual temperature. Calculated temperature is a predicted fluid temperature which is calculated
from a combination of inputs:
- Battery (ambient) temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- In-gear run time since start-up
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4597
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4598
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Remove valve body assembly from transaxle.
2. Remove transmission range sensor retaining screw and remove sensor from valve body (Fig.
304). 3. Remove TRS from manual shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Install transmission range sensor (TRS) to the valve body and torque retaining screw (Fig. 304)
to 5 Nm (45 inch lbs.). 2. Install valve body to transaxle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4603
Transmission Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4604
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4605
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Input Speed Sensor (EATX)
Output Speed Sensor (EATX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT DESCRIPTION
The Input Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates AC signals as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 293), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 294),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4608
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 295), an AC voltage is generated and sent to the
TCM. The TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input speed signal with output speed signal to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4609
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT DESCRIPTION
The Output Speed Sensor is a two-wire magnetic pickup device that generates an AC signal as
rotation occurs. It is threaded into the transaxle case (Fig. 298), sealed with an O-ring (Fig. 299),
and is considered a primary input to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4610
OPERATION
The Output Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the output shaft is rotating. As the rear
planetary carrier park pawl lugs pass by the sensor coil (Fig. 300), an AC voltage is generated and
sent to the TCM. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following: Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4611
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Signal
41TE - Automatic Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL
The vehicle speed signal is taken from the Output Speed Sensor. The TCM converts this signal
into a pulse per mile signal and sends it to the PCM.
The PCM, in turn, sends the vehicle speed message across the communication bus to the BCM.
The BCM sends this signal to the Instrument Cluster to display vehicle speed to the driver. The
vehicle speed signal pulse is roughly 8000 pulses per mile.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Input Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - INPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Remove air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 3. Disconnect
input speed sensor connector.
4. Unscrew and remove input speed sensor (Fig. 296).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 297) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position. 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Install air cleaner/throttle body assembly. 5. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Input Speed Sensor > Page 4614
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Output Speed Sensor
41TE - Automatic Transmission SPEED SENSOR - OUTPUT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect output speed sensor
connector.
4. Unscrew and remove output speed sensor (Fig. 301).
5. Inspect speed sensor O-ring (Fig. 302) and replace if necessary.
INSTALLATION
1. Verify O-ring is installed into position (Fig. 302). 2. Install and tighten input speed sensor to 27
Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 3. Connect speed sensor connector. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Transmission Speed Sensor: Specifications
Vehicle Speed Sensor .........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4619
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
T350 - Manual Transmission DESCRIPTION - VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is a pulse generator mounted to an adapter near the
transmission output shaft. The sensor is driven through the adapter by a speedometer pinion gear.
The VSS pulse signal to the speedometer/odometer is monitored by the PCM speed control
circuitry to determine vehicle speed and to maintain speed control set speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, M/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4620
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
T350 - Manual Transmission VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. Disconnect the speed sensor connector (Fig. 151).
CAUTION: Clean area around speed sensor before removing to prevent dirt from entering the
transaxle during speed sensor removal.
3. Remove speed sensor retaining bolt (Fig. 151). 4. Remove speed sensor from transaxle.
CAUTION: Carefully remove vehicle speed sensor so that sensor drive gear does not fall into
transaxle. Should sensor drive gear fall into the transaxle
during sensor removal, drive gear must be reattached to sensor.
5. Remove speed sensor drive gear from speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install pinion gear to speed sensor (Fig. 151). 2. Using a NEW O-ring, install the speed sensor to
the transaxle (Fig. 151). 3. Install the bolt and torque to 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.). 4. Connect speed
sensor connector (Fig. 151). 5. Lower vehicle and road test to verify proper speedometer operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Locations
ABS Light: Locations
The amber ABS warning indicator lamp is located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4626
ABS Light: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
ABS Indicator .......................................................................................................................................
................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4627
ABS Light: Description and Operation
ABS WARNING INDICATOR
The amber ABS warning indicator is located in the instrument cluster. It is used to inform the driver
that the antilock function has been turned off due to a system malfunction. The CAB controls the
lamp indirectly. The CAB monitors its own functions. If the CAB determines that the ABS warning
indicator should be on, the CAB sends a message via the PCI BUS to the instrument cluster and
the cluster turns on the indicator. The indicator will remain lit during every key cycle until the circuit
or component fault is repaired and the CAB no longer detects the fault. After repair of a sensor
signal fault or a pump motor fault, the CAB must sense all four wheels at 25 km/h (15 mph) before
it will extinguish the ABS and TRAC OFF Indicators.
The Instrument Cluster will illuminate the ABS Warning Indicator if it loses communication with the
CAB.
When the ignition key is turned to the ON position, the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is lit until
the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) completes its self-tests and turns OFF the lamp (approximately
4 seconds). The amber ABS warning indicator lamp will illuminate when the CAB detects a
condition that results in the shutdown of ABS function. The CAB sends a message to the
Mechanical Instrument Cluster (MIC) instructing it to turn ON the amber ABS warning indicator
lamp.
Under most conditions, when the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is ON, only the ABS function
of the brake system is affected; The Electronic Brake Distribution (EBD), the base brake system
and the ability to stop the vehicle are not affected.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Fig.1 Integrated Control Unit (ICU)
The CAB is mounted to the ICU as part of the Integrated Control Unit (ICU).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4634
Controller Antilock Brake
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4635
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle.
Fig.3 CAB Mounting
3. Disconnect pump/motor connector from CAB. 4. Remove four screws securing CAB to HCU half
of ICU. Remove CAB from HCU. 5. Pull outward on CAB connector lock and disconnect 24-way
wiring connector. Remove CAB from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect 24-way wiring connector to CAB and push in connector lock. 2. Align CAB with HCU
half of ICU, then slide CAB up over HCU valves. Install four CAB mounting screws. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (17
in. lbs.) torque.
3. Connect pump/motor connector. 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Connect battery negative cable. 6. Connect
DRBIII to vehicle to initialize system. Check and clear any faults.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Specifications
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Specifications
ABS HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT
Hydraulic Tube Fitting Type
........................................................................................................................................................
SAE 45° Inverted Flare Inlet Port Threads ..........................................................................................
........................................................................................................ 7/16-24 Outlet Port Threads Left Front and Left Rear
......................................................................................................................................................
7/16-24 Outlet Port Threads - Right Front and Right Rear
...................................................................................................................................................
3/8-24
BRAKE FASTENER TORQUE
ABS ICU Mounting Bolts (To Bracket)
.............................................................................................................................................. 11 Nm
(97 in. lbs.) ABS ICU Mounting Bolts (To Frame)
............................................................................................................................................... 23 Nm
(200 in. lbs.) ABS CAB Mounting Screws (To HCU)
............................................................................................................................................. 2 Nm (17
in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4639
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Locations
Hydraulic Control Unit
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit)
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation HCU (Hydraulic Control
Unit)
DESCRIPTION - HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT (HCU)
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) is mounted to the CAB as part of the ICU. The HCU controls the
flow of brake fluid to the brakes using a series of valves and accumulators. A pump/motor is
mounted on the HCU to supply build pressure to the brakes during an ABS stop.
VALVES AND SOLENOIDS
The valve block contains four inlet valves and four outlet solenoid valves. The inlet valves are
spring loaded in the open position and the outlet valves are spring-loaded in the closed position
during normal braking. The fluid is allowed to flow from the master cylinder to the wheel brakes.
During an ABS stop, these valves cycle to maintain the proper slip ratio for each wheel. The inlet
valve closes preventing further pressure increase and the outlet valve opens to provide a path from
the wheel brake to the HCU accumulators and pump/motor. This releases (decays) pressure from
the wheel brake, thus releasing the wheel from excessive slippage. Once the wheel is no longer
slipping, the outlet valve is closed and the inlet valve is opened to reapply (build) pressure.
BRAKE FLUID ACCUMULATORS
There are two fluid accumulators in the HCU: one for the primary hydraulic circuit, and one for the
secondary hydraulic circuit. Each hydraulic circuit uses a 3 cc accumulator.
The fluid accumulators temporarily store brake fluid that is removed from the wheel brakes during
an ABS cycle. This stored fluid is used by the pump/ motor to provide build pressure for the brake
hydraulic system. When the antilock stop is complete, the accumulators are drained by the
pump/motor.
There are two noise dampening chambers in the HCU on this vehicle equipped with traction
control.
PUMP/MOTOR
There are two pump assemblies in the HCU: one for the primary hydraulic circuit, and one for the
secondary hydraulic circuit. Both pumps are driven by a common electric motor. This DC-type
motor is integral to the HCU and is controlled by the CAB.
The pump/motor provides the extra amount of brake fluid needed during antilock braking. Brake
fluid is released to the accumulators when the outlet valve is opened during an antilock stop. The
pump mechanism consists of two opposing pistons operated by an eccentric camshaft. In
operation, these pistons are used to purge fluid from the accumulators back into the master
cylinder circuits. When the antilock stop is complete, the pump/motor drains the accumulators.
The pump motor is also used to build pressure when the system goes into traction control mode.
The CAB may turn on the pump/motor when an antilock stop is detected. The pump/motor
continues to run during the antilock stop and is turned off after the stop is complete. Under some
conditions, the pump/motor runs to drain the accumulators during the next drive-off.
The pump/motor is not a serviceable item; if it requires replacement, the HCU must be replaced.
OPERATION - HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS AND VALVES
The hydraulic fluid control valves control the flow of pressurized brake fluid to the wheel brakes
during the different modes of ABS braking. The
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit) > Page
4642
following paragraphs explain how this works. For purposes of explanation only, it is assumed that
only the right front wheel is experiencing antilock braking; the following diagrams show only the
right front wheel in an antilock braking operation.
NORMAL BRAKING HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT AND SOLENOID VALVE FUNCTION
The hydraulic diagram shows the vehicle in the normal braking mode of the base brake hydraulic
system. The diagram shows no wheel spin or slip occurring relative to the speed of the vehicle. The
driver is applying the brake pedal; this builds pressure in the brake hydraulic system to engage the
brakes and stop the vehicle.
ABS HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT AND SOLENOID VALVE FUNCTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit) > Page
4643
The hydraulic diagram shows the vehicle in the ABS braking mode. The diagram shows one wheel
is slipping because the driver is attempting to stop the vehicle at a faster rate than is allowed by the
surface on which the tires are riding. ^
The normally open and normally closed valves modulate (build/decay) the brake hydraulic pressure
as required.
^ The pump/motor is switched on so that the brake fluid from the low pressure accumulators is
returned to the master cylinder circuits.
^ The brake fluid is routed to either the master cylinder or the wheel brake depending on the
position of the normally open valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit) > Page
4644
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation ICU (Integrated Control
Unit)
ICU (INTEGRATED CONTROL UNIT)
DESCRIPTION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) and the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) used with this antilock
brake system are combined (integrated) into one unit, which is called the Integrated Control Unit
(ICU). The ICU is located on the driver's side of the vehicle, below the master cylinder. The ABS
with traction control ICU consists of the following components: the CAB, eight (build/decay)
solenoid valves (four inlet valves and four outlet valves), two hydraulic shuttle valves, two traction
control valves, valve block, fluid accumulators, a pump, and an electric pump/motor. The
replaceable components of the ICU are the HCU and the CAB. No attempt should be made to
service any components of the HCU or CAB.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4645
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
INTEGRATED CONTROL UNIT (ICU)
NOTE: If servicing the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) only, the CAB can be serviced with the ICU
mounted in the vehicle.
REMOVAL- ICU
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
Brake Pedal Holding Tool Installed
1. Using a brake pedal holder, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of travel and hold it in
this position. This will isolate the master cylinder
from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the master cylinder
reservoir.
2. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable. 3. Disconnect the
positive cable from the battery, then remove the battery from the battery tray. There is one nut
securing the clamp on the backside
of the battery holding it in place.
4. Remove the one nut and one bolt securing the air cleaner box in place, then disconnect the
wiring harness connector at the air inlet sensor.
5. Lift the air cleaner box upward enough to clear its grommeted alignment post, then move the air
cleaner box forward just enough to access the
battery tray mounting bolts.
6. Remove the 2 bolts, then the 2 nuts mounting the battery tray to its bracket. Remove the battery
tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4646
7. Disconnect the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder. Install plugs in the
master cylinder outlet ports.
8. Disconnect the 24-way connector from the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) mounted on the
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) and move it out of the
way. The connector is disconnected by pulling outward on the connector lock. This will unlock and
raise the 24-way connector out of the socket on the CAB.
9. Tag the brake tubes coming from the master cylinder as primary and secondary. This is done to
avoid mix-up once the tubes are removed from the
vehicle.
10. Disconnect and remove the primary and secondary brake tubes coming from the master
cylinder at the ICU Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). 11. Disconnect the brake tubes going to each
individual brake at the HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4647
12. Remove the 3 bolts attaching the ICU to its mounting bracket. 13. Remove the ICU from the
vehicle. 14. If the CAB and HCU must be separated, Refer to ICU (INTEGRATED CONTROL
UNIT) - DISASSEMBLY.
DISASSEMBLY- ICU
NOTE: To replace the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) or the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) on this
vehicle, the entire Integrated Control Unit (ICU) needs to be removed from the vehicle. The CAB
can then be separated from the HCU.
1. Disconnect the pump/motor wiring harness from the CAB.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4648
2. Remove the 4 bolts attaching the CAB to the HCU3).
3. Remove the CAB from the HCU.
ASSEMBLY- ICU
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4649
1. Install the CAB on the HCU.
2. Install the 4 bolts mounting the CAB to the HCU). Tighten the CAB mounting bolts to a torque of
2 Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4650
3. Plug the pump/motor wiring harness into the CAB. 4. Install the ICU in the vehicle.
INSTALLATION- ICU
1. Install the ICU onto its mounting bracket.
2. Install the 3 bolts attaching the ICU to the mounting bracket. Tighten the 3 mounting bolts to a
torque of 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.)
Brake Pedal Holding Tool Installed
3. Install the four brake tubes going to the brakes into their respective outlet ports on the ICU HCU.
Using a crow foot on a torque wrench, tighten
the four brake tube nuts to a torque of 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.).
NOTE: When installing the brake tubes from the master cylinder on the HCU, the brake tube with
the small tube nut is to be installed in the forward-most port on the HCU with the small end going
toward the master cylinder secondary port.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4651
4. Install the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder onto the HCU. Do not
completely tighten the primary and secondary tubes
at this time.
5. Connect the primary and secondary brake tubes to the master cylinder ports. 6. Using a crow
foot on a torque wrench, tighten the primary and secondary brake tube nuts at both the master
cylinder and HCU to a torque of 17
Nm (145 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Before installing the 24-way connector in the CAB, be sure the seal is properly installed
in the connector.
7. Install the 24-way connector into the socket of the CAB as follows:
- Position the 24-way connector in the socket of the CAB and carefully push it down as far as
possible.
- When the connector is fully seated into the CAB socket, push the connector lock inward. This
pulls the connector into the socket of the CAB and locks it in the installed position.
8. Position the battery tray back in place. Install the two bolts, then the two nuts mounting the
battery tray to its bracket. Tighten the two bolts and
nuts to a torque of 15 Nm (135 in. lbs.).
9. Reinstall the air cleaner box onto its grommeted alignment post.
10. Install the one nut and one bolt securing the air cleaner box in place, then connect the wiring
harness connector at the air inlet sensor. 11. Install the battery and clamp it in place. Tighten the
hold-down clamp bolt to a torque of 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
12. Connect the positive, then the negative (ground) cable on the battery.
NOTE: The ICU may need to be initialized using the DRBIII scan tool after ICU installation. Refer to
Appropriate Diagnostic Information.
13. Bleed the base brakes and ABS hydraulic systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4652
14. Fill the master cylinder to the proper fill level. 15. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper
operation of the base and antilock brake systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID
Traction Control Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Trac OFF Indicator ..............................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
ABS Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Screw
...................................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (105
in. lbs.)
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR AIR GAP
Front Sensor ........................................................................................................................................
......................... 0.28 - 1.42 mm (0.011 - 0.056 in.) Rear Sensor ........................................................
.......................................................................................................... 0.45 - 1.12 mm (0.018 - 0.044
in.)
TONE WHEEL RUNOUT
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
................................................................. 0.009 in. Rear ....................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.009
in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
TONE WHEELS
FRONT
REAR
WHEEL SPEED SENSORS
FRONT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4661
REAR
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4662
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4663
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4664
Fig. 5 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4665
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4666
Fig. 37 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4667
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4668
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4669
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4670
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Tone Wheel
TONE WHEEL
DESCRIPTION
The tone wheel is used in conjunction with the wheel speed sensors.
OPERATION
The tone wheel is used in conjunction with the wheel speed sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 4673
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor
Front
FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Mark 20e system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed sensors.
The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto resistive to help increase performance
and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A wheel speed sensor
is used at each wheel. The gear (tooth) type tone wheel serves as the trigger mechanism for each
sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one tone wheel.
The front wheel speed sensors are attached to bosses in the steering knuckle. The tone wheel is
an integral part of the outboard constant velocity joint located in the front axle shaft.
WSS air gaps are not adjustable. The initial factory WSS air gap specification can be found in
SPECIFICATIONS. Each WSS is serviced individually. The tone wheels are serviced as Dart of the
drive shaft.
OPERATION
The CAB sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the CAB. The
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 4674
relationship of the tooth on the tone wheel to the permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to
enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output of the sensor, sent to the CAB, is a DC voltage
signal with changing voltage and current levels. The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit
is provided by the CAB.
When a valley of the tone wheel is aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8
volts and a constant 7 mA current is sent to the CAB. As the tone wheel rotates, the tooth shifts the
magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The CAB senses a voltage signal
of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The CAB measures the amperage of the digital signal for
each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABS CAB as the wheel speed.
Rear
REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Mark 20e system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed sensors.
The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto resistive to help increase performance
and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A wheel speed sensor
is used at each wheel. The gear (tooth) type tone wheel serves as the trigger mechanism for each
sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one tone wheel.
The rear wheel speed sensors are mounted through the disc brake adapter. The rear tone wheels
are mounted to and rotate with the hub and bearing assemblies.
The WSS air gaps are not adjustable. The initial factory WSS air gap specification can be found in
SPECIFICATIONS. Each WSS is serviced
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 4675
individually. The tone wheels are serviced as an assembly with the hub and bearing assemblies.
OPERATION
The CAB sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the CAB. The relationship of the tooth on the tone wheel to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the CAB, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels. The
ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the CAB.
When a valley of the tone wheel is aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8
volts and a constant 7 mA current is sent to the CAB. As the tone wheel rotates, the tooth shifts the
magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The CAB senses a voltage signal
of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The CAB measures the amperage of the digital signal for
each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABS CAB as the wheel speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4676
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
TONE WHEEL
INSPECTION
Tone wheels can cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. Inspect tone wheels for the following
possible causes: missing, chipped, or broken teeth
- contact with the wheel speed sensor
- wheel speed sensor to tone wheel alignment
- wheel speed sensor to tone wheel clearance
- excessive tone wheel runout
- tone wheel loose on its mounting surface
If a front tone wheel is found to need replacement, the drive shaft must be replaced. No attempt
should be made to replace just the tone wheel. If a rear tone wheel is found to need replacement,
the rear hub and bearing must be replaced. No attempt should be made to replace just the tone
wheel. If wheel speed sensor to tone wheel contact is evident, determine the cause and correct it
before replacing the wheel speed sensor or tone wheel. Check the gap between the speed sensor
head and the tone wheel to ensure it is within specifications. Excessive tone wheel runout can
cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. If tone wheel runout is excessive, determine if it is
caused by a defect in the driveshaft assembly or hub and bearing. Replace as necessary. Tone
wheels are pressed onto their mounting surfaces and should not rotate independently from the
mounting surface. Replace the front driveshaft or rear hub and bearing as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector from the wiring harness on the inside of the
frame rail above the front suspension
crossmember. The connector has a locking tab which that must be pulled back before the
connector release tang can be depressed, releasing the connection.
3. If the sensor being removed is a left front, unclip the speed sensor cable from the brake tube on
the inside of and under the frame rail. 4. Remove the speed sensor cable grommet from the
retaining bracket attached to the brake hose on the outside of the frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4679
5. Remove the bolt mounting the wheel speed sensor head to the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When removing a wheel speed sensor from the knuckle, do not use pliers on the sensor
head. This may damage the sensor head. If the sensor has seized, use a hammer and a punch to
tap the edge of the sensor head ear, rocking the sensor side-to-side until free.
6. Carefully, remove the sensor head from the steering knuckle.
7. Remove the screw securing the wheel speed sensor to the rear of the strut. Remove the wheel
speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed,
and clipped properly.
1. Attach the wheel speed sensor to the strut using the its mounting screw. 2. Install the wheel
speed sensor head in the steering knuckle. Install the mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolt to a
torque of 12 Nm (105 inch
lbs.).
3. From the sensor bracket on the strut, loop the sensor cable upward, then downward at the
outside of the frame rail. Install the speed sensor cable
grommet onto the retaining bracket attached to the brake hose on the outside of the frame rail.
4. Loop the wheel speed sensor cable around the bottom of the frame rail and connect it to the
wiring harness connector on the inside of the frame
rail. Remember to push in the locking tab on the connector.
5. If the sensor being installed is the left front, clip the speed sensor cable to the brake tube on the
inside of and under the frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4680
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base brakes and ABS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4681
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector from the vehicle wiring harness. Remove
the clip attaching wheel speed sensor cable connector
to the vehicle's body.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket from under rear brake flex hose mounting
bracket. Then remove the speed sensor cable from
the routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube.
4. Remove the bolt attaching the wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket to rear strut.
CAUTION: When removing a wheel speed sensor from the rear disc brake adapter, do not use
pliers on the sensor head. This may damage the sensor head. If the sensor has seized, use a
hammer and a punch to tap the edge of the sensor head ear, rocking the sensor side-to-side until
free.
5. Remove the bolt attaching the wheel speed sensor to the rear disc brake adapter, then carefully
remove the sensor head from the rear disc brake
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4682
adapter and vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed,
and clipped properly.
1. Install the wheel speed sensor head into the disc brake adapter. 2. Install the wheel speed
sensor mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolt to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.). 3. Install the
wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket on the rear strut. 4. Install wheel speed sensor cable into
the routing clips on the rear brake hose and brake tube. 5. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable
connector into vehicle wiring harness. Install the clip attaching the wheel speed sensor cable
connector to
vehicle's body.
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base brakes and
ABS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bleeding
STANDARD PROCEDURE - MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
1. Clamp the master cylinder in a vise. 2. Refer to one of the following depending on whether the
master cylinder is a non-ABS unit Step a or an ABS unit Step b:
a. Attach four Master Cylinder Bleed Tubes, Special Tool 8358-1, to the four ports of the master
cylinder and tighten each in place. The bleed
tubes for the ports pertaining to the rear brakes are made to attach to the proportioning valves
screwed into the master cylinder. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder
reservoir so their outlets are below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
b. Attach Master Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-1, to the primary port of the master
cylinder and tighten in place. Attach Master
Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-2, to the secondary port of the master cylinder and tighten
in place. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder reservoir so their outlets are
below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
3. Fill the brake fluid reservoir with fresh Mopars brake fluid, or equivalent conforming to DOT 3
specifications. 4. Using a wooden dowel as a pushrod, press the pistons inward slowly applying
brake pressure, then release the pressure, allowing the pistons to
return to the released position. Repeat this several times until all air bubbles are expelled out of the
tubes and master cylinder bore.
5. Remove the bleed tubes from the master cylinder and plug the outlet ports. 6. Install the fill cap
on the reservoir. 7. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4687
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Base Brake System
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BASE BRAKE BLEEDING
NOTE: For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Antilock Brake System Bleeding.
CAUTION: Before removing the master cylinder cap, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter from
dropping into the master cylinder reservoir.
- Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a fresh, tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications.
Do not pump the brake pedal at any time while a bleeder screw is open. This will only increase the
amount of air in the system and make additional bleeding necessary.
Do not allow the master cylinder reservoir to run out of brake fluid while bleeding the system. An
empty reservoir will allow additional air into the brake system. Check the fluid level frequently and
add fluid as needed.
The following wheel circuit sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic system should be used to
ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
- Left rear wheel - Right front wheel - Right rear wheel - Left front wheel
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4688
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The base brake's hydraulic system must be bled anytime air enters the hydraulic system. The ABS
though, particularly the ICU (HCU), should only need to be bled when the HCU is replaced or
removed from the vehicle. The ABS must always be bled anytime it is suspected that the HCU has
ingested air. Under most circumstances that require the bleeding of the brakes hydraulic system,
only the base brake hydraulic system needs to be bled.
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence must be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding.
1. Make sure all hydraulic fluid lines are installed and properly torqued. 2. Connect the DRBIII scan
tool to the Data Link Connector. The connector is located under the lower steering column cover to
the left of the
steering column.
3. Using the DRBIII, check to make sure the CAB does not have any fault codes stored. If it does,
clear them using the DRBIII.
WARNING: WHEN BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM WEAR SAFETY GLASSES. A CLEAR
BLEED TUBE MUST BE ATTACHED TO THE BLEEDER SCREWS AND SUBMERGED IN A
CLEAR CONTAINER FILLED PART WAY WITH CLEAN BRAKE FLUID. DIRECT THE FLOW OF
BRAKE FLUID AWAY FROM YOURSELF AND THE PAINTED SURFACES OF THE VEHICLE.
BRAKE FLUID AT HIGH PRESSURE MAY COME OUT OF THE BLEEDER SCREWS WHEN
OPENED.
4. Bleed the base brake system using the standard pressure or manual bleeding procedure. 5.
Using the DRBIII, select ANTILOCK BRAKES, followed by MISCELLANEOUS, then BLEED
BRAKES. Follow the instructions displayed.
When the scan tool displays TEST COMPLETED, disconnect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically
to prevent emptying, causing air to enter the
hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder reservoir to the full level. 8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the brakes
are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel spongy.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4689
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Manual Bleeding
MANUAL BLEEDING
NOTE: To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar containing
enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the
hose.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 3. With
the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least 1 full turn. 4. Once the brake pedal
has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake pedal.
5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually four or
five times). 6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from
the brake system. Monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check the brake pedal travel. If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air
may still be trapped in the system. Rebleed the brakes
as necessary.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4690
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Pressure Bleeding
PRESSURE BLEEDING
NOTE: Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of pressure bleeding
equipment. Following the same wheel circuit sequence as prescribed for manual bleeding.
1. Attach Adapter, Special Tool 6921, to the master cylinder reservoir. 2. Attach Bleeder Tank,
Special Tool C-3496-B, or an equivalent, to the adapter on the master cylinder.
3. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar containing
enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the
hose.
4. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid. 5.
After approximately 4-8 ounces of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and an air-free
flow is maintained in the clear plastic hose and
jar, close the bleeder screw.
6. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws. 7. Check the brake pedal travel. If
pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air may still be trapped in the system.
Rebleed the brakes
as necessary.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Pedal Assy: Specifications
Pedal Ratio 3.41
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair With Automatic Transaxle
PEDAL
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from its post on the battery.
2. Place the steering wheel and tires in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. Using a steering wheel
holder, lock the steering wheel in place to keep it
from rotating. This keeps the clockspring in the proper orientation.
3. Remove the steering column coupling retainer pin, back off the pinch bolt nut, and remove the
steering column coupling pinch bolt (the pinch bolt
nut is caged to the coupling and is not removable). Separate the upper and lower steering column
couplings.
4. Remove the brake lamp switch. 5. Remove the clip securing the power brake booster input rod
to the brake pedal. Remove the input rod from the brake pedal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle > Page 4696
6. Remove the two upper nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the power brake booster. 7.
Carefully pry the tie bar running between the two upper booster mounting studs from its plastic
retaining fasteners. 8. Remove the two remaining nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the
power brake booster. 9. If the vehicle is equipped with antilock brakes, carefully push the power
brake booster forward until the booster contacts the ABS ICU mounting
bracket.
10. If the vehicle does not have antilock brakes, carefully push the power brake booster forward
one to two inches being careful not to stretch the
brake lines from the master cylinder to the brakes.
11. Remove the two nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the instrument panel support. 12.
Carefully remove the brake pedal assembly by pulling the pedal bracket back toward the
instrument panel, releasing the bracket from the booster
studs. Next, tip the bracket down past the input rod, guiding the rod through the gap left by the
missing brace removed in Step (8). Remove the brake pedal assembly out from under the
instrument panel.
13. The pedal can be removed from it's bracket by grinding off the peened end of the shaft,
removing the shaft, pedal and bushings. A service parts
package is available to replace these items.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE
1. If the pedal has been removed from it's bracket, install the pedal, bushings and bolt-in-shaft on
the bracket using the available service parts
package.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle > Page 4697
2. Install the brake pedal assembly by tipping the pedal bracket and guiding the power brake
booster mounting portion up past the booster input rod.
Guide the top of the bracket onto the studs protruding from the instrument panel support, then
guide the booster mounting portion onto the power brake booster mounting studs.
3. Push the power brake booster back into mounting position from under the hood. 4. Install the two
nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the instrument panel support. Install the nuts all the way,
but do not tighten them at this
time.
5. Install the two lower power brake booster mounting nuts, but do not tighten them at this time. 6.
Place the tie bar running between the two upper booster mounting studs onto the studs with the
long flat side facing upward and the curved side
downward.
7. Install the two upper power brake booster mounting nuts on their studs. 8. Tighten all four nuts
fastening the brake pedal bracket to the power brake booster to a torque of 34 Nm (300 in. lbs.). 9.
Tighten the two nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the instrument panel support to a torque
of 34 Nm (300 in. lbs.).
10. Install the power brake booster input rod on the pin mounted on the side of the brake pedal.
Install a new retaining clip on the end of the pin. Do
not reuse the old clip.
11. Mount a new brake lamp switch into the bracket. 12. Install the dash-to-lower coupling seal in
place over the lower coupling's plastic collar and dash cover. 13. Verify the front tires are still in the
STRAIGHT-AHEAD position.
14. Reconnect the steering column lower coupling to the steering column upper coupling. Install the
coupling pinch bolt an tighten the pinch bolt nut
to a torque of 28 Nm (250 in. lbs.). Install the pinch bolt retainer pin.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle > Page 4698
15. Remove the steering wheel holder. 16. While looking under the instrument panel at the lower
coupling, rotate the steering wheel back and-forth to verify that the lower coupling does not
squeak against the dash-to-coupling seal.
17. Reconnect the battery negative terminal. 18. Check the stop lamps to verify they are operating
properly and not staying on when the pedal is in the released position. 19. Road test the vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle > Page 4699
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair With Manual Transaxle
PEDAL
REMOVAL WITH MANUAL TRANSAXLE
1. Remove the instrument panel. 2. Remove the brake lamp switch.
3. Disconnect the clutch cable from the clutch pedal spacer.
4. Disconnect the wiring harness connector going to the clutch pedal switches.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle > Page 4700
5. Remove the clip securing the power brake booster input rod to the brake pedal. Remove the
input rod from the brake pedal.
6. Remove the four nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the power brake booster. 7. Remove
the two nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the instrument panel support. 8. Remove the
brake pedal assembly. 9. The pedal can be removed from it's bracket by grinding off the peened
end of the shaft, removing the shaft, pedal and bushings. A service parts
package is available to replace these items.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
WITH MANUAL TRANSAXLE
1. If the pedal has been removed from it's bracket, install the pedal, bushings and bolt-in-shaft on
the bracket using the available service parts
package.
2. Install the brake pedal assembly onto the studs extending down from the instrument panel
support and power brake booster. 3. Install the two nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the
instrument panel support. Install the nuts all the way, but do not tighten them at this
time.
4. Install the power brake booster mounting nuts. Tighten the four nuts fastening the brake pedal
bracket to the power brake booster to a torque of 34
Nm (300 in. lbs.).
5. Tighten the two nuts fastening the brake pedal bracket to the instrument panel support to a
torque of 34 Nm (300 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Service and
Repair > With Automatic Transaxle > Page 4701
6. Connect the clutch cable to the clutch pedal spacer on the pedal.
7. Connect the wiring harness connector going to the clutch pedal switches. 8. Install the power
brake booster input rod on the pin mounted on the side of the brake pedal. Install a new retaining
clip on the end of the pin. Do
not reuse the old clip.
9. Mount a new brake lamp switch into the bracket.
10. Install the instrument panel. 11. Check the stop lamps to verify they are operating properly and
not staying on when the pedal is in the released position. 12. Road test the vehicle to ensure
proper operation of the brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Service
Precautions
Brake Warning Indicator: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Brake System Warning Indicator .........................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 4705
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE/PARK BRAKE INDICATOR
The brake warning lamp illuminates when the parking brake is applied with ignition switch turned to
the ON position. The same lamp will also illuminate if one of the two service brake systems fail the
when brake pedal is applied.
To Test The System: As the ignition switch is turned to the start position the lamp should light.
- Turn ignition switch to the ON position and apply the parking brake. The lamp should light.
If Lamp Fails To Light, Inspect For: A burned out lamp
- Loose, corroded or damaged socket
- A damaged circuit board
- A broken or disconnected wire at the switch
- Defective switch
To test the service brake warning system, refer to Brakes, Hydraulic System Control Valves.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Disc Brake Caliper Banjo Bolt .............................................................................................................
.................................................... 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.) Disc Brake Caliper Adapter (To Knuckle) Rear .................................................................................................................................... 75 Nm
(55 ft. lbs.) Disc Brake Caliper Guide Pin Bolts
...................................................................................................................................................... 22
Nm (192 in. lbs.) Disc Brake Caliper Bleeder Screw
......................................................................................................................................................... 15
Nm (125 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Front Disc Brake Caliper
REMOVAL- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (FRONT)
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of
travel and hold it in this position. This will isolate the
master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the
master cylinder reservoir when the lines are opened.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the front tire and wheel assembly.
4. Remove the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper. There are two washers
(one on each side of the flex hose fitting) that will
come off with the banjo bolt. Discard these washers. Replace them with new ones.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance between the shoes and the rotor to easily remove the
caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be accomplished before the guide pin bolts are removed,
by grasping the rear of the caliper and pulling outward working with the guide pins, thus retracting
the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may get damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4712
5. Remove the two brake caliper to steering knuckle guide pin bolts. 6. Remove the disc brake
caliper from the steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping either the top (right side
caliper) or bottom (left
side caliper) of the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's
caliper slide abutment (on the knuckle) and brake rotor.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
Removing Inner Sleeve From Bushing
1. With one hand, push the guide pin bushing sleeve towards the back of the caliper, and at the
same time, pull the sleeve out the back of the caliper
and bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4713
2. Using your fingers, collapse one side of the rubber guide pin bushing. Pull the guide pin bushing
out the other side of the brake caliper mounting
boss.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
CALIPER PISTON REMOVAL
WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD HIGH PRESSURE AIR EVER BE USED TO
REMOVE A PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM
SUCH A PRACTICE.
NOTE: The safest way to remove the piston from the caliper bore is to use the hydraulic pressure
of the vehicle's brake system.
1. Following the removal procedure, remove the caliper from the brake rotor and hang the
assembly on a wire hook away from rotor and body of the
vehicle so brake fluid cannot get on these components. Remove the brake shoes, and place a
small piece of wood between the piston and caliper fingers.
2. Carefully depress the brake pedal to hydraulically push piston out of its bore. Once completed,
apply and hold down the brake pedal to any
position beyond the first inch of pedal travel using a brake pedal holding tool. This will prevent the
fluid in the master cylinder reservoir from completely draining out.
3. Disconnect the brake fluid flex hose from the caliper assembly and remove it from the vehicle.
CALIPER SEAL REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion.
1. To disassemble the caliper, mount it in a vise equipped with protective jaws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4714
2. Remove the piston dust boot from the caliper and discard.
NOTE: Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can scratch
the bore or leave burrs on the seal groove edges.
3. Using a soft tool such as a plastic trim stick, work the piston seal out of its groove in caliper
piston bore. Discard the old seal. 4. Clean the piston bore and drilled passage ways using alcohol
or a suitable solvent. Wipe it dry using only a lint-free cloth.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4715
5. Inspect the piston bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can
usually be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion
using crocus cloth. Bores that have deep scratches or scoring should be honed. Use Caliper Hone,
Special Tool C-4095, or the equivalent to hone the bore. Do not overhone the bore. Don not
increase the diameter of the bore more than 0.0254 mm (0.001 inch). If the bore does not clean up
within this specification, a new caliper housing should be installed.
NOTE: During the honing procedure, coat the stones and bore with brake fluid. After honing the
bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff non-metallic rotary brush. Use extreme
care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing the caliper bore with
fresh clean brake fluid; wipe it dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean it a second time.
6. Inspect the caliper piston for pitting, scratches, or any physical damage. Replace the piston if
there is evidence of scratches, pitting or physical
damage.
CLEANING - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopars
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
INSPECTION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following: Brake fluid leaks in and around boot area and inboard lining
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
- Damaged, dry or brittle guide pin dust boots If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and
recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4716
Folded Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
1. Fold the guide pin bushing in half lengthwise at the solid middle section.
NOTE: To avoid damage to the bushing, do not use a sharp object to install the guide pin bushing.
2. Insert the folded bushing into the caliper mounting boss using your fingers.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4717
Bushing Correctly Installed In Caliper
3. Unfold the bushing using your fingers or a wooden dowel until the bushing is fully seated into the
caliper housing. The bushing flanges should be
seated evenly on both sides of the bushing hole.
4. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the bushing using Mopar Dielectric Grease or an equivalent.
5. Install the guide pin sleeve into one end of bushing until the seal area of bushing is past the seal
groove in the sleeve. 6. Holding the convoluted boot on the opposite end of the bushing, push the
steel sleeve through the bushing until the bushing boot is fully seated
into the seal groove on that end of sleeve . Install the other end bushing boot into the groove on
that end of the bushing sleeve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4718
7. Verify both ends of the bushing are seated in the sleeve groves. When the sleeve is seated
properly into the bushing, the sleeve/bushing can be held
between your fingers and easily slid back and forth without the bushing unseating from the sleeve
groove.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
NOTE: Never use an old piston seal.
Installing New Piston Seal In Caliper
1. Dip the new piston seal in clean brake fluid and install it in the groove of the caliper bore. The
seal should be started at one area of the groove and
gently worked around and into the groove using only your clean fingers to seat it.
2. Coat the new piston boot with clean brake fluid leaving a generous amount inside the boot. 3.
Position the dust boot over the piston after coating it with brake fluid.
CAUTION: Force applied to the piston to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly to avoid
cocking and binding of the piston.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4719
Installing Piston Into Caliper Bore
4. Install piston into caliper bore pushing it past the piston seal until it bottoms in the caliper bore. 5.
Position the dust boot into the counterbore of the caliper assembly piston bore.
6. Using a hammer and Installer, Special Tool C-4689, and Handle, Special Tool C-4171, drive the
boot into the counterbore of the caliper. 7. Install the brake shoes. 8. Reinstall the caliper on the
vehicle and bleed the brakes as necessary.
INSTALLATION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER (FRONT)
NOTE: Step 1 below is only required when installing a caliper after new brake shoes have been
installed.
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper. 2. Lubricate both steering
knuckle caliper slide abutments with a liberal amount of Mopars Multipurpose Lubricant, or an
equivalent.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on
the caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4720
3. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top caliper slide abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the
caliper, then pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side
caliper is installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower caliper slide
abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the
caliper into place against the steering knuckle.
4. Install the caliper guide pin bolts and tighten them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4721
5. Install the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper. Install NEW washers with
the banjo bolt. Place one NEW washer on each side
of the hose fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the
caliper and tighten it to a torque of 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100
ft. lbs.). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Remove the brake pedal holding tool. 9. Bleed the caliper as
necessary.
10. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake pads.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4722
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Rear Disc Brake Caliper
REMOVAL- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (REAR)
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of
travel and hold it in this position. This will isolate the
master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the
master cylinder reservoir while the lines are disconnected.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly.
4. Remove the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper. There are two washers
(one on each side of the flex hose fitting) that will
come off with the banjo bolt. Discard these washers. Replace them with new ones.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance between the shoes and the rotor to easily remove the
caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be accomplished before the guide pin bolts are removed,
by grasping the rear of the caliper and pulling outward working with the guide pins, thus retracting
the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may get damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4723
5. Remove the two caliper guide pin bolts.
Caliper Removal/Installation
6. Remove the caliper assembly from the brake adapter by first rotating the top of the caliper away
from the rotor, and then lifting the caliper
assembly off the machined abutment on the adapter.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4724
1. With one hand, push the guide pin bushing sleeve towards the back of the caliper, and at the
same time, pull the sleeve out the back of the caliper
and bushing.
2. Using your fingers, collapse one side of the rubber guide pin bushing. Pull the guide pin bushing
out the other side of the brake caliper mounting
boss.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
CALIPER PISTON REMOVAL
WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD HIGH PRESSURE AIR EVER BE USED TO
REMOVE A PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM
SUCH A PRACTICE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4725
NOTE: The safest way to remove the piston from the caliper bore is to use the hydraulic pressure
of the vehicle's brake system.
1. Following the removal procedure, remove the caliper from the brake rotor and hang the
assembly on a wire hook away from rotor and body of the
vehicle so brake fluid cannot get on these components. Remove the brake shoes, and place a
small piece of wood between the piston and caliper fingers.
2. Carefully depress the brake pedal to hydraulically push piston out of its bore. Once completed,
apply and hold down the brake pedal to any
position beyond the first inch of pedal travel using a brake pedal holding tool. This will prevent the
fluid in the master cylinder reservoir from completely draining out.
3. Disconnect the brake fluid flex hose from the caliper assembly and remove it from the vehicle.
CALIPER SEAL REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion.
1. To disassemble the caliper, mount it in a vise equipped with protective jaws.
Fig. 10 Dust Boot Removal
2. Remove the piston dust boot from the caliper and discard.
NOTE: Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can scratch
the bore or leave burrs on the seal groove edges.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4726
Removing Piston Seal From Caliper
3. Using a soft tool such as a plastic trim stick, work the piston seal out of its groove in caliper
piston bore. Discard the old seal. 4. Clean the piston bore and drilled passage ways using alcohol
or a suitable solvent. Wipe it dry using only a lint-free cloth.
5. Inspect the piston bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can
usually be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion
using crocus cloth. Bores that have deep scratches or scoring should be honed. Use Caliper Hone,
Special Tool C-4095, or the equivalent to hone the bore. Do not over-hone the bore. Don not
increase the diameter of the bore more than 0.0254 mm (0.001 inch). If the bore does not clean up
within this specification, a new caliper housing should be installed.
NOTE: During the honing procedure, coat the stones and bore with brake fluid. After honing the
bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff non-metallic rotary brush. Use extreme
care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing the caliper bore with
fresh clean brake fluid; wipe it dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean it a second time.
6. Inspect the caliper piston for pitting, scratches, or any physical damage. Replace the piston if
there is evidence of scratches, pitting or physical
damage.
CLEANING - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4727
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopars
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
INSPECTION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following: Brake fluid leaks in and around boot area and inboard lining
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
- Damaged, dry or brittle guide pin dust boots If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and
recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Folded Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
1. Fold the guide pin bushing in half lengthwise at the solid middle section.
NOTE: To avoid damage to the bushing, do not use a sharp object to install the guide pin bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4728
Installing Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
2. Insert the folded bushing into the caliper mounting boss using your fingers .
3. Unfold the bushing using your fingers or a wooden dowel until the bushing is fully seated into the
caliper housing. The bushing flanges should be
seated evenly on both sides of the bushing hole.
4. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the bushing using Mopar Dielectric Grease or an equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4729
Fig 7 Installing Caliper Sleeves
5. Install the guide pin sleeve into one end of bushing until the seal area of bushing is past the seal
groove in the sleeve. 6. Holding the convoluted boot on the opposite end of the bushing, push the
steel sleeve through the bushing until the bushing boot is fully seated
into the seal groove on that end of sleeve. Install the other end bushing boot into the groove on that
end of the bushing sleeve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4730
Fig 8 Installed Caliper Bushing Sleeve
7. Verify both ends of the bushing are seated in the sleeve groves. When the sleeve is seated
properly into the bushing, the sleeve/bushing can be held
between your fingers and easily slid back and forth without the bushing unseating from the sleeve
groove.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
NOTE: Never use an old piston seal.
1. Dip the new piston seal in clean brake fluid and install it in the groove of the caliper bore. The
seal should be started at one area of the groove and
gently worked around and into the groove using only your clean fingers to seat it.
Installing New Piston Seal In Caliper
2. Coat the new piston boot with clean brake fluid leaving a generous amount inside the boot. 3.
Position the dust boot over the piston after coating it with brake fluid.
CAUTION: Force applied to the piston to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly to avoid
cocking and binding of the piston.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4731
4. Install piston into caliper bore pushing it past the piston seal until it bottoms in the caliper bore. 5.
Position the dust boot into the counterbore of the caliper assembly piston bore.
Installing Piston Into Caliper Bore
6. Using a hammer and Installer, Special Tool C-4689, and Handle, Special Tool C-4171, drive the
boot into the counterbore of the caliper. 7. Install the brake shoes. 8. Reinstall the caliper on the
vehicle and bleed the brakes as necessary.
INSTALLATION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER (REAR)
NOTE: Step (1) below is only required when installing the disc brake caliper after new brake shoes
have been installed.
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into piston bore of the caliper. 2. Lubricate both
adapter caliper slide abutments with a liberal amount of Mopars Multipurpose Lubricant, or an
equivalent.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto adapter so the guide pin bushings
and sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4732
Caliper Removal/Installation
3. Starting with the lower end, carefully lower the caliper and brake shoes over the brake rotor and
catch the caliper's bottom edge behind the caliper
slide abutment. Rotate the top of the caliper into mounting position on the adapter.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
4. Carefully install the caliper guide pin bolts, then tighten them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.).
5. Install the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper . Install NEW washers with
the banjo bolt. Place one fitting washer on each
side of the hose fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the
caliper and tighten it to a torque of 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100
ft. lbs.). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Remove the brake pedal holding tool. 9. Bleed the caliper as
necessary.
10. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake shoes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Pad: Specifications
BRAKE PAD/SHOE THICKNESS SPECIFICATIONS
Front Brakes
Brake Shoe Thickness Measurement
The combined brake shoe and lining material thickness should be measured at the thinnest part of
the assembly.
When a set of brake shoes are worn to a total thickness of approximately 7.95 mm (5/16 inch) or
less, they should be replaced.
Rear Brakes
Brake Shoe Thickness Measurement
The combined brake shoe and lining material thickness should be measured at the thinnest part of
the assembly.
When a set of brake shoes are worn to a total thickness of approximately 7.0 mm (9/32 inch), they
should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL- DISC BRAKE SHOES (FRONT)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
- Some vehicles use a different lining material on the front disc brake shoes than other vehicles.
When new brake shoes are installed, be sure the brake shoes for the correct type of brake system
are used.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies from vehicle. 3. Begin on one
side of the vehicle.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance between the shoes and the rotor to easily remove the
caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be accomplished before the guide pin bolts are removed,
by grasping the rear of the caliper and pulling outward working with the guide pins, thus retracting
the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may get damaged.
4. Remove the two brake caliper guide pin bolts. 5. Remove the disc brake caliper from the
steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping either the top (right side caliper) or bottom
(left
side caliper) of the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's
caliper slide abutment (on the knuckle) and brake rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4738
6. Support the caliper using a wire or cord to prevent the weight of caliper from damaging the brake
hose. Do not let the caliper hang by the brake
hose.
7. Remove the outboard brake shoe from the caliper by prying the shoe retaining clip over the
raised area on the caliper. Slide the brake shoe down
and off of the caliper.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4739
8. Pull the inboard brake shoe away from the caliper piston until the retaining clip is out of the
cavity in the piston and remove the shoe. 9. Repeat the above procedure to the front brakes on the
other side of the vehicle.
CLEANING - DISC BRAKE SHOES
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
INSPECTION - DISC BRAKE SHOES
Visually inspect brake shoes (pads) for uneven lining wear. Also inspect for excessive lining
deterioration. Check the clearance between the tips of the wear indicators on the shoes (if
equipped) and the brake rotors. If a visual inspection does not adequately determine the condition
of the lining, a physical check will be necessary. To check the amount of lining wear, remove the
disc brake shoes from the calipers. Measure each brake shoe. The combined brake shoe and its
lining material thickness should be measured at its thinnest point. For front disc brake shoes, when a set of brake shoes are worn to a thickness of approximately
7.95 mm (5/16 inch), they should be replaced.
- For rear disc brake shoes, when a set of brake shoes are worn to a thickness of approximately
7.0 mm (9/32 inch), they should be replaced.
- Typically, if front shoes are worn out, both fronts and rears need to be replaced. Make sure to
check rears.
Replace both disc brake shoes (inboard and outboard) on each caliper. It is necessary to replace
the shoes on the opposite side of the vehicle as well as the shoes failing inspection. If the brake
shoe assemblies do not require replacement, be sure to reinstall the brake shoes in the original
position they were removed from.
INSTALLATION - DISC BRAKE SHOES (FRONT)
NOTE: Some vehicles use a different lining material on the front disc brake shoes than other
vehicles. When new brake shoes are installed, be sure the brake shoes for the correct type of
brake system are used.
1. Begin on one side of the vehicle. 2. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the
caliper. This is required to gain the necessary shoe-to-rotor clearance for the caliper
installation onto the steering knuckle.
3. Remove any protective paper from the noise suppression gasket on both the inner and outer
brake shoes (if equipped).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4740
Inboard Brake Shoe
4. Install the inboard brake shoe into the caliper piston by firmly pressing the shoe in with the
thumbs. Be sure the inboard brake shoe is positioned
squarely against the face of the caliper Piston.
Installing Outboard Brake Shoe
5. Slide the new outboard brake shoe onto the caliper. 6. Lubricate both steering knuckle caliper
slide abutments with a liberal amount of Mopars Multipurpose Lubricant, or an equivalent.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on
the caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4741
7. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top caliper slide abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the
caliper, then pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side
caliper is installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower caliper slide
abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the
caliper into place against the steering knuckle.
8. Install the caliper guide pin bolts and tighten them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.). 9. Install
the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat the above procedure to the front brakes on the other side of the vehicle. 11. Lower the
vehicle. 12. Pump the brake pedal to set the brake shoes to the brake rotors, then check brake fluid
level in master cylinder reservoir. Adjust brake fluid level
as necessary.
13. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake pads.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4742
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL- DISC BRAKE SHOES (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove both rear tire and wheel assemblies from vehicle. 3. Begin on one
side of the vehicle.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance between the shoes and the rotor to easily remove the
caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be accomplished before the guide pin bolts are removed,
by grasping the rear of the caliper and pulling outward working with the guide pins, thus retracting
the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may get damaged.
4. Remove the two caliper guide pin bolts.
Caliper Removal/Installation
5. Remove the caliper assembly from the brake adapter by first rotating the top of the caliper away
from the rotor, and then lifting the caliper
assembly off the machined abutment on the adapter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4743
6. Hang the brake caliper from rear strut using wire or cord to prevent the weight of the caliper from
damaging the brake hose.
7. Remove the outboard brake shoe from the caliper by prying the brake shoe retaining clip over
the raised area on the caliper. Then slide the brake
shoe down and off of the brake caliper.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4744
Removing Installing Inboard Brake Shoe
8. Pull the inboard brake shoe away from caliper piston until the retaining clip is free from the cavity
in the piston. 9. Repeat the above procedure to the rear brakes on the other side of the vehicle.
CLEANING - DISC BRAKE SHOES
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
INSPECTION - DISC BRAKE SHOES
Visually inspect brake shoes (pads) for uneven lining wear. Also inspect for excessive lining
deterioration. Check the clearance between the tips of the wear indicators on the shoes (if
equipped) and the brake rotors. If a visual inspection does not adequately determine the condition
of the lining, a physical check will be necessary. To check the amount of lining wear, remove the
disc brake shoes from the calipers. Measure each brake shoe. The combined brake shoe and its
lining material thickness should be measured at its thinnest point. For front disc brake shoes, when a set of brake shoes are worn to a thickness of approximately
7.95 mm (5/16 inch), they should be replaced.
- For rear disc brake shoes, when a set of brake shoes are worn to a thickness of approximately
7.0 mm (9/32 inch), they should be replaced.
- Typically, if front shoes are worn out, both fronts and rears need to be replaced. Make sure to
check rears. Replace both disc brake shoes (inboard and outboard) on each caliper. It is necessary
to replace the shoes on the opposite side of the vehicle as well as the shoes failing inspection. If
the brake shoe assemblies do not require replacement, be sure to reinstall the brake shoes in the
original position they were removed from.
INSTALLATION - DISC BRAKE SHOES (REAR)
1. Begin on one side of the vehicle. 2. Completely retract the caliper piston back into piston bore of
the caliper. This is required to gain the necessary shoe-to-rotor clearance for the
caliper installation onto the steering knuckle.
3. Remove any protective paper from the noise suppression gasket on both inner and outer brake
shoe assemblies (if equipped).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4745
Removing Installing Inboard Brake Shoe
4. Install the inboard brake shoe into the caliper piston by firmly pressing the shoe in with the
thumbs. Be sure the inboard brake shoe is positioned
squarely against the face of the caliper piston.
5. Slide the outboard brake shoe onto the caliper assembly. Be sure the retaining clip is squarely
seated in the depressed areas on the caliper. 6. Lubricate both adapter caliper slide abutments
with a liberal amount of Mopars Multipurpose Lubricant, or an equivalent.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto adapter so the guide pin bushings
and sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 4746
Caliper Removal/Installation
7. Starting with the lower end, carefully lower the caliper and brake shoes over the brake rotor and
catch the caliper's bottom edge behind the caliper
slide abutment. Rotate the top of the caliper into mounting position on the adapter.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
8. Carefully install the caliper guide pin bolts, then tighten them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.).
9. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100
ft. lbs.).
10. Repeat the above procedure to the rear brakes on the other side of the vehicle. 11. Lower the
vehicle. 12. Pump the brake pedal to set the brake shoes to the brake rotors, then check brake fluid
level in master cylinder reservoir. Adjust brake fluid level
as necessary.
13. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake shoes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Rotor Specifications
Rotor Specifications
BRAKE ROTOR Front Rotor Rear Rotor
ROTOR THICKNESS 21.87 - 22.13 mm (0.861 - 0.871 in.) 8.75 - 9.25 mm (0.344 - 0.364 in.)
MINIMUM ROTOR THICKNESS 20.4 mm (0.803 in.) 7.25 mm (0.285 in.)
ROTOR THICKNESS VARIATION 0.013 mm (0.0005 in.) 0.013 mm (0.0005 in.)
ROTOR RUNOUT * 0.13 mm (0.005 in.) 0.13 mm (0.005 in.)
* TIR - Total Indicator Reading (measured on vehicle)
ROTOR MICRO-FINISH 15 - 80 RMS 15 - 80 RMS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4750
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - BRAKE ROTOR
Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor within service tolerances to
ensure proper brake action.
Excessive runout or wobble in a rotor can increase pedal travel due to piston knock-back. This
increases guide pin sleeve wear due to the tendency of the caliper to follow the rotor wobble.
When diagnosing a brake noise or pulsation, the machined disc braking surface should be checked
and inspected.
BRAKING SURFACE INSPECTION
Light braking surface scoring and wear is acceptable. If heavy scoring or warping is evident, the
rotor must be refaced or replaced.
Excessive wear and scoring of the rotor can cause improper lining contact on the rotor's braking
surface. If the ridges on the rotor are not removed before new brake shoes are installed, improper
wear of the shoes will result.
If a vehicle has not been driven for a period of time, the rotor's braking surface will rust in the areas
not covered by the brake shoes at that time. Once the vehicle is driven, noise and chatter from the
disc brakes can result when the brakes are applied until the rust wears away.
Some discoloration or wear of the rotor surface is normal and does not require resurfacing when
linings are replaced. If cracks or burned spots are evident, the rotor must be replaced.
ROTOR MINIMUM THICKNESS
Measure rotor thickness at the center of the brake shoe contact surface. Replace the rotor if it is
worn below minimum thickness or if machining the rotor will cause its thickness to fall below
specifications.
CAUTION: Do not machine (turn) the rotor if it will cause the rotor to fall below minimum thickness.
Minimum thickness specifications are cast on the rotor's unmachined surface (or stamped into the
hat section). Limits can also be found in specifications
ROTOR THICKNESS VARIATION
Thickness variation in a rotor's braking surface can result in pedal pulsation, chatter and surge.
This can also be caused by excessive runout in the rotor or the hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4751
Rotor thickness variation measurements should be made in conjunction with measuring runout.
Measure thickness of the brake rotor at 12 equal points around the rotor braking surface with a
micrometer at a radius approximately 25 mm (1 inch) from edge of rotor. If thickness
measurements vary beyond the specification listed in specifications, the rotor should be refaced or
replaced.
ROTOR RUNOUT
On-vehicle rotor runout is the combination of the individual runout of the hub face and the runout of
the rotor. (The hub and rotor runouts are separable). To measure rotor runout on the vehicle, first
remove the tire and wheel assembly. Reinstall the wheel mounting nuts on the studs, tightening the
rotor to the hub. Mount the Dial Indicator, Special Tool C-3339, with Mounting Adaptor, Special
Tool SP-1910 on steering arm. The dial indicator plunger should contact braking surface of rotor
approximately 25 mm (1 inch) from edge of rotor. Check lateral runout on both sides of the rotor,
marking the low and high spots on both. Runout limits can be found in specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4752
If runout is in excess of the specification, check the lateral runout of the hub face. Before removing
the rotor from the hub, place a chalk mark across both the rotor and the one wheel stud closest to
where the high runout measurement was taken. This way, the original mounting spot of the rotor on
the hub is indexed.
Remove the rotor from the hub.
NOTE: Clean the hub face surface before checking runout. This provides a clean surface to get an
accurate indicator reading.
Mount Dial Indicator, Special Tool C-3339, and Mounting Adaptor, Special Tool SP-1910, to the
steering knuckle. Position the indicator stem so it contacts the hub face near the outer diameter.
Care must be taken to position stem outside of the stud circle, but inside of the chamfer on the hub
rim.
Hub runout should not exceed 0.08 mm (0.003 inch). If runout exceeds this specification, the hub
must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4753
If the hub runout does not exceed this specification, install the rotor back on the hub, aligning the
chalk marks on the rotor with a wheel mounting stud, two studs apart from the original stud. Tighten
nuts in the proper sequence and torque to specifications.
Recheck brake rotor runout to see if the runout is now within specifications. If runout is not within
specifications, reface or replace the brake rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor - Removal and Installation
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Brake Rotor - Removal and Installation
Front Brake Rotor
REMOVAL- BRAKE ROTOR (FRONT)
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the front tire and wheel assembly. 3. Remove the front disc brake
caliper assembly from the brake rotor and store it out of the way.
4. Remove the clips retaining the brake rotor. 5. Remove the brake rotor by pulling it straight off the
wheel mounting studs.
INSTALLATION - BRAKE ROTOR (FRONT)
1. Install the brake rotor over the wheel mounting studs and onto the hub. 2. Install the front disc
brake caliper. It may be necessary to retract the brake caliper piston back into the caliper to fit the
shoes onto the rotor. 3. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a
torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Pump the brake pedal before moving the
vehicle to set the brake shoes to the brake rotor.
Rear Brake Rotor
REMOVAL- BRAKE ROTOR (REAR)
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly. 3. Remove the rear disc brake
caliper assembly from the brake rotor and store it out of the way.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor - Removal and Installation > Page 4756
4. Remove any clips retaining the brake rotor. 5. Remove the brake rotor by pulling it straight off
the wheel mounting studs.
INSTALLATION - BRAKE ROTOR (REAR)
NOTE: Inspect the disc brake shoes and parking brake shoes before brake rotor installation.
1. Install the rear brake rotor over the wheel mounting studs and onto the hub. 2. Install rear disc
brake caliper. 3. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of
135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 4. Adjust the parking brake shoes as necessary. 5. Lower the vehicle. 6.
Pump the brake pedal before moving the vehicle to set the brake shoes to the brake rotor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor - Removal and Installation > Page 4757
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Brake Rotor Machining
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BRAKE ROTOR MACHINING
NOTE: Refacing the rotor is not required each time the brake pads are replaced, only when the
need is foreseen.
Any servicing of the rotor requires extreme care to maintain the rotor within service tolerances to
ensure proper brake action.
On-Car Brake Lathe
If the rotor surface is deeply scored or warped, or there is a complaint of brake roughness or brake
pedal pulsation, the rotor should be refaced using a hub-mounted on-car brake lathe, or replaced.
The use of a hub-mounted on-car brake lathe is highly recommended to eliminate the possibility of
excessive runout. It trues the brake rotor to the vehicle's hub and bearing.
Minimum Brake Rotor Thickness Markings (Typical)
NOTE: All rotors have markings for minimum allowable thickness cast on an unmachined surface
of the rotor or stamped into the hat section. Minimum thickness specifications can also be found in
the specifications.
Minimum allowable thickness is the minimum thickness which the brake rotor machined surface
may be cut to.
CAUTION: Do not machine the rotor if it will cause the rotor to fall below minimum thickness.
Before lathe installation, verify the brake rotor face and the hub adapters are free of any chips, rust,
or contamination.
When mounting and using the brake lathe, strict attention to the brake lathe manufacturer's
operating instructions is required.
Machine both sides of the brake rotor at the same time. Cutting both sides at the same time
minimizes the possibility of a tapered or uneven cut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Brake Rotor - Removal and Installation > Page 4758
When refacing a rotor, the required TIR (Total Indicator Reading) and thickness variation limits
MUST BE MAINTAINED. Extreme care in the operation of rotor turning equipment is required.
Specifications for brake rotor machining can be found in specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Specifications
Backing Plate: Specifications
DRUM BRAKE SHOE SUPPORT PLATE (REAR) Mounting Bolts 55 ft. lbs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4763
Backing Plate: Service and Repair
SUPPORT PLATE DRUM BRAKE
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of
travel and hold it in this position. This will isolate the
master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the
master cylinder reservoir.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle.
4. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose from the wheel cylinder. 5. Remove the rear brake drum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4764
6. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub and bearing.
7. Remove the nut holding the rear hub and bearing to the spindle. Remove the hub and bearing
from the spindle. 8. Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate. 9. Remove the
parking brake actuator lever from the parking brake cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4765
10. Position a to inch wrench over the retainer fingers on the end of the parking brake cable.
Compress the cable housing retaining fingers with the
wrench, then pull the cable housing out of the support plate. Remove the wrench as the parking
brake cable retainer is freed from the mounting hole in the brake support plate.
11. Remove the 4 brake support plate mounting bolts and washers. Separate brake support plate
from rear suspension knuckle. 12. Remove the brake wheel cylinder attaching bolts. 13. Remove
the brake wheel cylinder from the brake support plate.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Install a new O-ring at the mating surface of the wheel cylinder-to-brake support plate.
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake support plate.
2. Install the wheel cylinder onto brake support plate. Tighten the attaching bolts to a torque of 13
Nm (115 in. lbs.). 3. Install the brake support plate and gasket on rear suspension knuckle. Tighten
the support plate mounting bolts to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 4. Insert the parking brake cable
into its mounting hole in the brake support plate. Push the cable housing in until the retainer's
fingers lock into place. 5. Hand start the brake flex hose tube fitting to the wheel cylinder. Tighten
the tube nut to a torque of 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.). 6. Attach the parking brake cable to the parking
brake actuator. 7. Install the rear brake shoe assemblies on the brake support plate.
8. Install the rear hub and bearing assembly on the spindle. Install a new hub and bearing retaining
nut. Tighten the retaining nut to a torque of 217
Nm (160 ft. lbs.). Install dust cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4766
9. Install the brake drum.
10. Install the wheel and tire assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm
(100 ft. lbs.). 11. Adjust the rear brake shoes. 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Remove the brake pedal
holding tool. 14. Bleed the wheel cylinder as necessary. 15. Road test the vehicle to make sure the
brakes operate correctly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Adjuster > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection
Brake Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - DRUM BRAKE AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER
To properly test the drum brake automatic adjuster, the aide of a helper inside the vehicle to apply
the brakes will be necessary. 1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the access plug from the rear
adjustment slot in each brake support plate. 3. Insert a thin screwdriver in the adjustment slot and
push back the adjustment lever. With the lever in this position, back the star wheel adjustment
off approximately 10 notches. This will eliminate the possibility that the brake is at full adjustment,
and can be adjusted no further.
4. Remove the screwdriver from the adjustment slot. 5. Watch the star wheel through the
adjustment slot, while a helper applies the brake pedal. As the brake shoes apply, the adjustment
lever should
move downward, turning the star wheel. A definite rotation of the adjuster star wheel can be
observed if the automatic adjuster is working properly. If the star wheel does not move as
indicated, the brake drum needs to be removed and further inspection of the rear brakes is
necessary.
6. If the star wheel is operating properly, readjust the brakes. 7. Reinstall the adjustment slot
access plug. 8. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Drum: Specifications
Rear Drum Specifications
Nominal Diameter ................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 7.875"
Maximum Machine Limit ......................................................................................................................
............................................................ 7.904"
Discard Diameter .................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 7.921"
Runout Limit ........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... .006"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4773
Brake Drum: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - BRAKE DRUM
With the drum off the vehicle, measure the drum for diameter variation (oval shape). The diameter
variation of the drum braking surface must not exceed either 0.0635 mm (0.0025 inch) in 30° or
0.0889 mm (0.0035 inch) in 360°.
Measure brake drum runout. Brake drum runout should be checked with the drum mounted on a
brake lathe. Brake drum runout should not exceed 0.1524 mm (0.006 inch).
If either of these measurements are not within specification, reface or replace the drum.
Always replace the drum if machining will cause the diameter to exceed drum maximum diameter.
All brake drums are marked with the maximum allowable brake drum diameter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Brake Drum: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle.
3. Remove the brake drum retaining clips (if equipped). 4. Remove the brake drum.
NOTE: If the drum does not come off, further brake clearance can be obtained by backing off the
brake automatic adjuster screw. Remove the rubber plug from the top of brake support plate.
Rotate the automatic adjuster screw in an upward motion, using a screwdriver.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before installing the drum, inspect the brake shoe linings for wear, shoe alignment, and
contamination.
1. Install the rear brake drum on rear hub and bearing. 2. Install the tire and wheel assembly.
Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 3. Adjust the rear brake shoes
as necessary. 4. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 4776
Brake Drum: Service and Repair Brake Drum Machining
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BRAKE DRUM MACHINING
If a brake drum is deeply scored or warped, it can be machined on a brake lathe equipped to
machine brake drums. Follow the manufacturers instructions on the machining procedure.
Measure the brake drum diameter before machining. If machining the drum will cause the drum to
exceed maximum allowable diameter, do not machine the brake drum. It needs to be replaced.
CAUTION: Do not machine the brake drum if it will cause the drum to exceed maximum allowable
diameter.
All brake drums are marked with the maximum allowable brake drum diameter.
When machining, make sure the final finish feed cut is fine in order to avoid a screw effect on the
brake shoes when the brakes are applied. This final feed cut specification varies from lathe
manufacturer to lathe manufacturer.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Brake Shoe Thickness Specifications
Brake Shoe: Specifications Brake Shoe Thickness Specifications
As a general rule, riveted brake shoes should be replaced when worn to within 0.78 mm (1/32 inch)
of the rivet heads.
Bonded linings should be replaced when worn to a thickness of 1.6 mm (1/16 inch).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Brake Shoe Thickness Specifications > Page 4781
Brake Shoe: Specifications Torque Specifications
Drum Brake Shoe Support Plate Mounting Bolts
..................................................................................................................................... 75 Nm (55 ft.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4782
Brake Shoe: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT- DRUM BRAKE SHOES
1. Verify the parking brake lever is in the fully released position. 2. Raise the vehicle.
3. Remove the rear brake adjusting hole rubber clue from the rear brake shoe support plate. 4.
Insert a brake adjustment tool, or a screwdriver, through the adjusting hole in support plate and
against the star wheel of the adjuster screw. Move
the handle of tool downward to adjust the brake drag. Rotate the tire and wheel assembly while
adjusting the adjuster screw. Continue to adjust the shoes until a slight drag is noticed when the
tire and wheel assembly is rotated.
NOTE: In the event the brake shoes are over-adjusted, the adjuster can be backed off using the
following step. If not, proceed to step 6.
5. If the shoes are in the over-adjusted position, insert a thin screwdriver into brake adjusting hole
and push back the adjusting lever out of
engagement with star wheel. Take care not to bend the adjusting lever. While holding the adjusting
lever out of engagement with star wheel, back off the star wheel until the tire and wheel assembly
is free to turn without dragging. Repeat the adjustment procedure.
6. Install adjusting hole rubber plug. 7. Repeat the above adjustment procedure to the other side
brakes. 8. Apply and release the park brake lever one time after the adjustment process is
completed so the parking brakes can readjust themselves to the new
brake shoe adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4783
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
REMOVAL- DRUM BRAKE SHOES (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove both rear tire and wheel assemblies from the vehicle. 3. Begin on
one side of the vehicle.
4. Remove the brake drum retaining clips (if equipped). 5. Remove the brake drum.
6. Remove the automatic adjustment lever-to brake shoe spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4784
7. Remove the automatic adjustment lever from the brake shoe.
8. Remove the hold down clips and pins attaching the leading and trailing brake shoes to the brake
support plate .
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4785
9. Remove the lower brake shoe-to-anchor plate return spring.
10. Remove the parking brake lever pin-to-brake shoe retaining clip .
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4786
11. Remove the leading and trailing brake shoes, upper return spring and automatic adjuster screw
from the brake support plate as an assembly. 12. Disassemble the shoes completely once on the
bench. 13. Repeat the above procedure to the rear brakes on the other side of the vehicle.
CLEANING - DRUM BRAKE SHOES
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
INSPECTION - DRUM BRAKE SHOES
Rear brake shoe lining should show contact across the entire width of the lining and also from the
heel to the toe of the lining. Replace the shoes if noted otherwise. Brake shoes with lack of contact
at the toe or heel of the brake shoe lining may be improperly ground.
Clean and inspect the brake support plate and shoe adjuster screw. Apply a thin coat of Mopar
Multi-Purpose Lubricant or equivalent to the threads of the self-adjuster. Replace the adjuster
screw if it is corroded.
NOTE: Adjuster screws are different side-to-side. Left side adjuster screws have left-hand threads
and right side adjuster screws have right-handed threads.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4787
If the old brake shoe return or hold down springs have overheated or are damaged, replace them.
Overheating indications are paint discoloration or distorted end coils.
INSTALLATION - DRUM BRAKE SHOES (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Begin on one side of the vehicle.
2. Lubricate the eight shoe contact areas on the support plate and anchor using Mopar
Multi-Purpose Lubricant or equivalent. 3. Assemble the front and rear brake shoe assembly,
automatic adjuster screw, and upper return spring before installation on the vehicle.
4. Install the pre-assembled brake shoes, automatic adjuster screw and upper return spring on the
brake support plate. 5. Install the wave washer on the pin of park brake lever.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4788
6. Install the pin on the parking brake lever into hole in rear brake shoe assembly.
7. Install both brake shoe-to-brake support plate hold down pins and clips.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4789
8. Install the lower brake shoe-to-anchor plate return spring.
9. Install the automatic adjustment lever on the leading brake shoe.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4790
10. Install the automatic adjustment lever-to brake shoe spring. 11. Adjust the brake shoes out until
the drum lightly drags on the shoes when it is installed. Do not over-adjust the brakes.
12. Install the brake drum. 13. Repeat the above procedure to the rear brakes on the other side of
the vehicle. 14. Install the tire and wheel assemblies. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque
of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 15. Adjust the rear brake shoes. 16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Road test
vehicle stopping in both the forward and reverse directions. The automatic adjuster will continue to
adjust the brakes during the road test
of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Drum Brake Wheel Cylinder Mounting Bolts
........................................................................................................................................ 13 Nm (115
in. lbs.) Drum Brake Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Screw
........................................................................................................................................... 10 Nm (89
in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4794
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
WHEEL CYLINDERS DRUM BRAKE
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Using a brake pedal holder, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of travel and hold it in
this position . This will isolate the master cylinder
from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the master cylinder
reservoir.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly.
4. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose from the wheel cylinder. 5. Remove the rear brake drum. 6.
Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
NOTE: If the brake shoes are wet with grease or brake fluid, replace them.
7. Remove the brake wheel cylinder attaching bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4795
8. Remove the brake wheel cylinder from the brake support plate.
INSPECTION
With the brake drums removed, inspect the wheel cylinder boots for evidence of a brake fluid leak.
Visually check the boots for cuts, tears, or heat cracks. If any of these conditions exist, the wheel
cylinders should be completely cleaned, inspected and new parts installed.
If a wheel cylinder is leaking and the brake lining material is saturated with brake fluid, the brake
shoes must be replaced.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Install a new O-ring at the mating surface of the wheel cylinder-to-brake support plate.
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake assembly.
2. Install the wheel cylinder onto brake support plate. Tighten the attaching bolts to a torque of 13
Nm (115 in. lbs.). 3. Hand start the rear brake flex hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Tighten the
tube nut to a torque of 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.). 4. Install the rear brake shoes on the brake support
plate. Replace them as necessary. 5. Install the rear brake drum onto the rear hub. 6. Install the tire
and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 7.
Adjust the rear brakes. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Remove the brake pedal holder.
10. Bleed the wheel cylinder as necessary. 11. Road test the vehicle to make sure the brakes
operate correctly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bleeding
STANDARD PROCEDURE - MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
1. Clamp the master cylinder in a vise. 2. Refer to one of the following depending on whether the
master cylinder is a non-ABS unit Step a or an ABS unit Step b:
a. Attach four Master Cylinder Bleed Tubes, Special Tool 8358-1, to the four ports of the master
cylinder and tighten each in place. The bleed
tubes for the ports pertaining to the rear brakes are made to attach to the proportioning valves
screwed into the master cylinder. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder
reservoir so their outlets are below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
b. Attach Master Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-1, to the primary port of the master
cylinder and tighten in place. Attach Master
Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-2, to the secondary port of the master cylinder and tighten
in place. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder reservoir so their outlets are
below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
3. Fill the brake fluid reservoir with fresh Mopars brake fluid, or equivalent conforming to DOT 3
specifications. 4. Using a wooden dowel as a pushrod, press the pistons inward slowly applying
brake pressure, then release the pressure, allowing the pistons to
return to the released position. Repeat this several times until all air bubbles are expelled out of the
tubes and master cylinder bore.
5. Remove the bleed tubes from the master cylinder and plug the outlet ports. 6. Install the fill cap
on the reservoir. 7. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4801
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Base Brake System
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BASE BRAKE BLEEDING
NOTE: For bleeding the ABS hydraulic system, refer to Antilock Brake System Bleeding.
CAUTION: Before removing the master cylinder cap, wipe it clean to prevent dirt and other foreign matter from
dropping into the master cylinder reservoir.
- Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a fresh, tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications.
Do not pump the brake pedal at any time while a bleeder screw is open. This will only increase the
amount of air in the system and make additional bleeding necessary.
Do not allow the master cylinder reservoir to run out of brake fluid while bleeding the system. An
empty reservoir will allow additional air into the brake system. Check the fluid level frequently and
add fluid as needed.
The following wheel circuit sequence for bleeding the brake hydraulic system should be used to
ensure adequate removal of all trapped air from the hydraulic system.
- Left rear wheel - Right front wheel - Right rear wheel - Left front wheel
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4802
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Antilock Brake System
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ANTILOCK BRAKE SYSTEM BLEEDING
The base brake's hydraulic system must be bled anytime air enters the hydraulic system. The ABS
though, particularly the ICU (HCU), should only need to be bled when the HCU is replaced or
removed from the vehicle. The ABS must always be bled anytime it is suspected that the HCU has
ingested air. Under most circumstances that require the bleeding of the brakes hydraulic system,
only the base brake hydraulic system needs to be bled.
When bleeding the ABS system, the following bleeding sequence must be followed to insure
complete and adequate bleeding.
1. Make sure all hydraulic fluid lines are installed and properly torqued. 2. Connect the DRBIII scan
tool to the Data Link Connector. The connector is located under the lower steering column cover to
the left of the
steering column.
3. Using the DRBIII, check to make sure the CAB does not have any fault codes stored. If it does,
clear them using the DRBIII.
WARNING: WHEN BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM WEAR SAFETY GLASSES. A CLEAR
BLEED TUBE MUST BE ATTACHED TO THE BLEEDER SCREWS AND SUBMERGED IN A
CLEAR CONTAINER FILLED PART WAY WITH CLEAN BRAKE FLUID. DIRECT THE FLOW OF
BRAKE FLUID AWAY FROM YOURSELF AND THE PAINTED SURFACES OF THE VEHICLE.
BRAKE FLUID AT HIGH PRESSURE MAY COME OUT OF THE BLEEDER SCREWS WHEN
OPENED.
4. Bleed the base brake system using the standard pressure or manual bleeding procedure. 5.
Using the DRBIII, select ANTILOCK BRAKES, followed by MISCELLANEOUS, then BLEED
BRAKES. Follow the instructions displayed.
When the scan tool displays TEST COMPLETED, disconnect the scan tool and proceed.
6. Bleed the base brake system a second time. Check brake fluid level in the reservoir periodically
to prevent emptying, causing air to enter the
hydraulic system.
7. Fill the master cylinder reservoir to the full level. 8. Test drive the vehicle to be sure the brakes
are operating correctly and that the brake pedal does not feel spongy.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4803
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Manual Bleeding
MANUAL BLEEDING
NOTE: To bleed the brakes manually, the aid of a helper will be required.
1. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar containing
enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the
hose.
2. Have a helper pump the brake pedal three or four times and hold it in the down position. 3. With
the pedal in the down position, open the bleeder screw at least 1 full turn. 4. Once the brake pedal
has dropped, close the bleeder screw. After the bleeder screw is closed, release the brake pedal.
5. Repeat the above steps until all trapped air is removed from that wheel circuit (usually four or
five times). 6. Bleed the remaining wheel circuits in the same manner until all air is removed from
the brake system. Monitor the fluid level in the master cylinder
reservoir to make sure it does not go dry.
7. Check the brake pedal travel. If pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air
may still be trapped in the system. Rebleed the brakes
as necessary.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding > Page 4804
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Standard Procedure - Pressure Bleeding
PRESSURE BLEEDING
NOTE: Follow pressure bleeder manufacturer's instructions for use of pressure bleeding
equipment. Following the same wheel circuit sequence as prescribed for manual bleeding.
1. Attach Adapter, Special Tool 6921, to the master cylinder reservoir. 2. Attach Bleeder Tank,
Special Tool C-3496-B, or an equivalent, to the adapter on the master cylinder.
3. Attach a clear plastic hose to the bleeder screw and feed the hose into a clear jar containing
enough fresh brake fluid to submerge the end of the
hose.
4. Open the bleeder screw at least one full turn or more to obtain a steady stream of brake fluid. 5.
After approximately 4-8 ounces of fluid have been bled through the brake circuit and an air-free
flow is maintained in the clear plastic hose and
jar, close the bleeder screw.
6. Repeat this procedure at all the remaining bleeder screws. 7. Check the brake pedal travel. If
pedal travel is excessive or has not been improved, some air may still be trapped in the system.
Rebleed the brakes
as necessary.
8. Test drive the vehicle to verify the brakes are operating properly and pedal feel is correct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Disc Brake Caliper Banjo Bolt .............................................................................................................
.................................................... 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.) Disc Brake Caliper Adapter (To Knuckle) Rear .................................................................................................................................... 75 Nm
(55 ft. lbs.) Disc Brake Caliper Guide Pin Bolts
...................................................................................................................................................... 22
Nm (192 in. lbs.) Disc Brake Caliper Bleeder Screw
......................................................................................................................................................... 15
Nm (125 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Front Disc Brake Caliper
REMOVAL- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (FRONT)
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of
travel and hold it in this position. This will isolate the
master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the
master cylinder reservoir when the lines are opened.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the front tire and wheel assembly.
4. Remove the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper. There are two washers
(one on each side of the flex hose fitting) that will
come off with the banjo bolt. Discard these washers. Replace them with new ones.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance between the shoes and the rotor to easily remove the
caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be accomplished before the guide pin bolts are removed,
by grasping the rear of the caliper and pulling outward working with the guide pins, thus retracting
the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may get damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4810
5. Remove the two brake caliper to steering knuckle guide pin bolts. 6. Remove the disc brake
caliper from the steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping either the top (right side
caliper) or bottom (left
side caliper) of the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's
caliper slide abutment (on the knuckle) and brake rotor.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
Removing Inner Sleeve From Bushing
1. With one hand, push the guide pin bushing sleeve towards the back of the caliper, and at the
same time, pull the sleeve out the back of the caliper
and bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4811
2. Using your fingers, collapse one side of the rubber guide pin bushing. Pull the guide pin bushing
out the other side of the brake caliper mounting
boss.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
CALIPER PISTON REMOVAL
WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD HIGH PRESSURE AIR EVER BE USED TO
REMOVE A PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM
SUCH A PRACTICE.
NOTE: The safest way to remove the piston from the caliper bore is to use the hydraulic pressure
of the vehicle's brake system.
1. Following the removal procedure, remove the caliper from the brake rotor and hang the
assembly on a wire hook away from rotor and body of the
vehicle so brake fluid cannot get on these components. Remove the brake shoes, and place a
small piece of wood between the piston and caliper fingers.
2. Carefully depress the brake pedal to hydraulically push piston out of its bore. Once completed,
apply and hold down the brake pedal to any
position beyond the first inch of pedal travel using a brake pedal holding tool. This will prevent the
fluid in the master cylinder reservoir from completely draining out.
3. Disconnect the brake fluid flex hose from the caliper assembly and remove it from the vehicle.
CALIPER SEAL REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion.
1. To disassemble the caliper, mount it in a vise equipped with protective jaws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4812
2. Remove the piston dust boot from the caliper and discard.
NOTE: Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can scratch
the bore or leave burrs on the seal groove edges.
3. Using a soft tool such as a plastic trim stick, work the piston seal out of its groove in caliper
piston bore. Discard the old seal. 4. Clean the piston bore and drilled passage ways using alcohol
or a suitable solvent. Wipe it dry using only a lint-free cloth.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4813
5. Inspect the piston bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can
usually be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion
using crocus cloth. Bores that have deep scratches or scoring should be honed. Use Caliper Hone,
Special Tool C-4095, or the equivalent to hone the bore. Do not overhone the bore. Don not
increase the diameter of the bore more than 0.0254 mm (0.001 inch). If the bore does not clean up
within this specification, a new caliper housing should be installed.
NOTE: During the honing procedure, coat the stones and bore with brake fluid. After honing the
bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff non-metallic rotary brush. Use extreme
care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing the caliper bore with
fresh clean brake fluid; wipe it dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean it a second time.
6. Inspect the caliper piston for pitting, scratches, or any physical damage. Replace the piston if
there is evidence of scratches, pitting or physical
damage.
CLEANING - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopars
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
INSPECTION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following: Brake fluid leaks in and around boot area and inboard lining
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
- Damaged, dry or brittle guide pin dust boots If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and
recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4814
Folded Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
1. Fold the guide pin bushing in half lengthwise at the solid middle section.
NOTE: To avoid damage to the bushing, do not use a sharp object to install the guide pin bushing.
2. Insert the folded bushing into the caliper mounting boss using your fingers.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4815
Bushing Correctly Installed In Caliper
3. Unfold the bushing using your fingers or a wooden dowel until the bushing is fully seated into the
caliper housing. The bushing flanges should be
seated evenly on both sides of the bushing hole.
4. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the bushing using Mopar Dielectric Grease or an equivalent.
5. Install the guide pin sleeve into one end of bushing until the seal area of bushing is past the seal
groove in the sleeve. 6. Holding the convoluted boot on the opposite end of the bushing, push the
steel sleeve through the bushing until the bushing boot is fully seated
into the seal groove on that end of sleeve . Install the other end bushing boot into the groove on
that end of the bushing sleeve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4816
7. Verify both ends of the bushing are seated in the sleeve groves. When the sleeve is seated
properly into the bushing, the sleeve/bushing can be held
between your fingers and easily slid back and forth without the bushing unseating from the sleeve
groove.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
NOTE: Never use an old piston seal.
Installing New Piston Seal In Caliper
1. Dip the new piston seal in clean brake fluid and install it in the groove of the caliper bore. The
seal should be started at one area of the groove and
gently worked around and into the groove using only your clean fingers to seat it.
2. Coat the new piston boot with clean brake fluid leaving a generous amount inside the boot. 3.
Position the dust boot over the piston after coating it with brake fluid.
CAUTION: Force applied to the piston to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly to avoid
cocking and binding of the piston.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4817
Installing Piston Into Caliper Bore
4. Install piston into caliper bore pushing it past the piston seal until it bottoms in the caliper bore. 5.
Position the dust boot into the counterbore of the caliper assembly piston bore.
6. Using a hammer and Installer, Special Tool C-4689, and Handle, Special Tool C-4171, drive the
boot into the counterbore of the caliper. 7. Install the brake shoes. 8. Reinstall the caliper on the
vehicle and bleed the brakes as necessary.
INSTALLATION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER (FRONT)
NOTE: Step 1 below is only required when installing a caliper after new brake shoes have been
installed.
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into the bore of the caliper. 2. Lubricate both steering
knuckle caliper slide abutments with a liberal amount of Mopars Multipurpose Lubricant, or an
equivalent.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto the steering knuckle so the seals on
the caliper guide pin bushings do not get damaged by the steering knuckle bosses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4818
3. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top caliper slide abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the
caliper, then pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side
caliper is installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower caliper slide
abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the
caliper into place against the steering knuckle.
4. Install the caliper guide pin bolts and tighten them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4819
5. Install the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper. Install NEW washers with
the banjo bolt. Place one NEW washer on each side
of the hose fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the
caliper and tighten it to a torque of 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100
ft. lbs.). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Remove the brake pedal holding tool. 9. Bleed the caliper as
necessary.
10. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake pads.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4820
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Rear Disc Brake Caliper
REMOVAL- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (REAR)
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of
travel and hold it in this position. This will isolate the
master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the
master cylinder reservoir while the lines are disconnected.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly.
4. Remove the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper. There are two washers
(one on each side of the flex hose fitting) that will
come off with the banjo bolt. Discard these washers. Replace them with new ones.
NOTE: In some cases, it may be necessary to retract the caliper piston in its bore a small amount
in order to provide sufficient clearance between the shoes and the rotor to easily remove the
caliper from the knuckle. This can usually be accomplished before the guide pin bolts are removed,
by grasping the rear of the caliper and pulling outward working with the guide pins, thus retracting
the piston. Never push on the piston directly as it may get damaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4821
5. Remove the two caliper guide pin bolts.
Caliper Removal/Installation
6. Remove the caliper assembly from the brake adapter by first rotating the top of the caliper away
from the rotor, and then lifting the caliper
assembly off the machined abutment on the adapter.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4822
1. With one hand, push the guide pin bushing sleeve towards the back of the caliper, and at the
same time, pull the sleeve out the back of the caliper
and bushing.
2. Using your fingers, collapse one side of the rubber guide pin bushing. Pull the guide pin bushing
out the other side of the brake caliper mounting
boss.
DISASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
Before disassembling the brake caliper, clean and inspect it.
CALIPER PISTON REMOVAL
WARNING: UNDER NO CONDITION SHOULD HIGH PRESSURE AIR EVER BE USED TO
REMOVE A PISTON FROM A CALIPER BORE. PERSONAL INJURY COULD RESULT FROM
SUCH A PRACTICE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4823
NOTE: The safest way to remove the piston from the caliper bore is to use the hydraulic pressure
of the vehicle's brake system.
1. Following the removal procedure, remove the caliper from the brake rotor and hang the
assembly on a wire hook away from rotor and body of the
vehicle so brake fluid cannot get on these components. Remove the brake shoes, and place a
small piece of wood between the piston and caliper fingers.
2. Carefully depress the brake pedal to hydraulically push piston out of its bore. Once completed,
apply and hold down the brake pedal to any
position beyond the first inch of pedal travel using a brake pedal holding tool. This will prevent the
fluid in the master cylinder reservoir from completely draining out.
3. Disconnect the brake fluid flex hose from the caliper assembly and remove it from the vehicle.
CALIPER SEAL REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not use excessive force when clamping caliper in vise. Excessive vise pressure will
cause bore distortion.
1. To disassemble the caliper, mount it in a vise equipped with protective jaws.
Fig. 10 Dust Boot Removal
2. Remove the piston dust boot from the caliper and discard.
NOTE: Do not use a screw driver or other metal tool for seal removal. Using such tools can scratch
the bore or leave burrs on the seal groove edges.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4824
Removing Piston Seal From Caliper
3. Using a soft tool such as a plastic trim stick, work the piston seal out of its groove in caliper
piston bore. Discard the old seal. 4. Clean the piston bore and drilled passage ways using alcohol
or a suitable solvent. Wipe it dry using only a lint-free cloth.
5. Inspect the piston bore for scoring or pitting. Bores that show light scratches or corrosion can
usually be cleared of the light scratches or corrosion
using crocus cloth. Bores that have deep scratches or scoring should be honed. Use Caliper Hone,
Special Tool C-4095, or the equivalent to hone the bore. Do not over-hone the bore. Don not
increase the diameter of the bore more than 0.0254 mm (0.001 inch). If the bore does not clean up
within this specification, a new caliper housing should be installed.
NOTE: During the honing procedure, coat the stones and bore with brake fluid. After honing the
bore, carefully clean the seal and boot grooves with a stiff non-metallic rotary brush. Use extreme
care in cleaning the caliper after honing. Remove all dirt and grit by flushing the caliper bore with
fresh clean brake fluid; wipe it dry with a clean, lint free cloth and then clean it a second time.
6. Inspect the caliper piston for pitting, scratches, or any physical damage. Replace the piston if
there is evidence of scratches, pitting or physical
damage.
CLEANING - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4825
WARNING: DUST AND DIRT ACCUMULATING ON BRAKE PARTS DURING NORMAL USE
MAY CONTAIN ASBESTOS FIBERS FROM PRODUCTION OR AFTERMARKET BRAKE
LININGS. BREATHING EXCESSIVE CONCENTRATIONS OF ASBESTOS FIBERS CAN CAUSE
SERIOUS BODILY HARM. EXERCISE CARE WHEN SERVICING BRAKE PARTS. DO NOT
SAND OR GRIND BRAKE LINING UNLESS EQUIPMENT USED IS DESIGNED TO CONTAIN
THE DUST RESIDUE. DO NOT CLEAN BRAKE PARTS WITH COMPRESSED AIR OR BY DRY
BRUSHING. CLEANING SHOULD BE DONE BY DAMPENING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS
WITH A FINE MIST OF WATER, THEN WIPING THE BRAKE COMPONENTS CLEAN WITH A
DAMPENED CLOTH. DISPOSE OF CLOTH AND ALL RESIDUE CONTAINING ASBESTOS
FIBERS IN AN IMPERMEABLE CONTAINER WITH THE APPROPRIATE LABEL. FOLLOW
PRACTICES PRESCRIBED BY THE OCCUPATIONAL SAFETY AND HEALTH
ADMINISTRATION (OSHA) AND THE ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY (EPA) FOR
THE HANDLING, PROCESSING, AND DISPOSING OF DUST OR DEBRIS THAT MAY CONTAIN
ASBESTOS FIBERS.
To clean or flush the internal passages of the brake caliper, use fresh brake fluid or Mopars
Non-Chlorinated Brake Parts Cleaner. Never use gasoline, kerosene, alcohol, oil, transmission fluid
or any fluid containing mineral oil to clean the caliper. These fluids will damage rubber cups and
seals.
INSPECTION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER
Inspect the disc brake caliper for the following: Brake fluid leaks in and around boot area and inboard lining
- Ruptures, brittleness or damage to the piston dust boot
- Damaged, dry or brittle guide pin dust boots If caliper fails inspection, disassemble and
recondition caliper, replacing the seals and dust boots.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (GUIDE PIN BUSHINGS)
Folded Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
1. Fold the guide pin bushing in half lengthwise at the solid middle section.
NOTE: To avoid damage to the bushing, do not use a sharp object to install the guide pin bushing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4826
Installing Caliper Guide Pin Bushing
2. Insert the folded bushing into the caliper mounting boss using your fingers .
3. Unfold the bushing using your fingers or a wooden dowel until the bushing is fully seated into the
caliper housing. The bushing flanges should be
seated evenly on both sides of the bushing hole.
4. Lubricate the inside surfaces of the bushing using Mopar Dielectric Grease or an equivalent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4827
Fig 7 Installing Caliper Sleeves
5. Install the guide pin sleeve into one end of bushing until the seal area of bushing is past the seal
groove in the sleeve. 6. Holding the convoluted boot on the opposite end of the bushing, push the
steel sleeve through the bushing until the bushing boot is fully seated
into the seal groove on that end of sleeve. Install the other end bushing boot into the groove on that
end of the bushing sleeve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4828
Fig 8 Installed Caliper Bushing Sleeve
7. Verify both ends of the bushing are seated in the sleeve groves. When the sleeve is seated
properly into the bushing, the sleeve/bushing can be held
between your fingers and easily slid back and forth without the bushing unseating from the sleeve
groove.
ASSEMBLY- DISC BRAKE CALIPER (PISTON AND SEAL)
NOTE: Never use an old piston seal.
1. Dip the new piston seal in clean brake fluid and install it in the groove of the caliper bore. The
seal should be started at one area of the groove and
gently worked around and into the groove using only your clean fingers to seat it.
Installing New Piston Seal In Caliper
2. Coat the new piston boot with clean brake fluid leaving a generous amount inside the boot. 3.
Position the dust boot over the piston after coating it with brake fluid.
CAUTION: Force applied to the piston to seat it in the bore must be applied uniformly to avoid
cocking and binding of the piston.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4829
4. Install piston into caliper bore pushing it past the piston seal until it bottoms in the caliper bore. 5.
Position the dust boot into the counterbore of the caliper assembly piston bore.
Installing Piston Into Caliper Bore
6. Using a hammer and Installer, Special Tool C-4689, and Handle, Special Tool C-4171, drive the
boot into the counterbore of the caliper. 7. Install the brake shoes. 8. Reinstall the caliper on the
vehicle and bleed the brakes as necessary.
INSTALLATION - DISC BRAKE CALIPER (REAR)
NOTE: Step (1) below is only required when installing the disc brake caliper after new brake shoes
have been installed.
1. Completely retract the caliper piston back into piston bore of the caliper. 2. Lubricate both
adapter caliper slide abutments with a liberal amount of Mopars Multipurpose Lubricant, or an
equivalent.
CAUTION: Use care when installing the caliper assembly onto adapter so the guide pin bushings
and sleeves do not get damaged by the mounting bosses on adapter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Disc Brake Caliper > Page 4830
Caliper Removal/Installation
3. Starting with the lower end, carefully lower the caliper and brake shoes over the brake rotor and
catch the caliper's bottom edge behind the caliper
slide abutment. Rotate the top of the caliper into mounting position on the adapter.
CAUTION: Extreme caution should be taken not to cross thread the caliper guide pin bolts when
they are installed.
4. Carefully install the caliper guide pin bolts, then tighten them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.).
5. Install the banjo bolt connecting the brake hose to the brake caliper . Install NEW washers with
the banjo bolt. Place one fitting washer on each
side of the hose fitting as the banjo bolt is guided through the fitting. Thread the banjo bolt into the
caliper and tighten it to a torque of 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100
ft. lbs.). 7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Remove the brake pedal holding tool. 9. Bleed the caliper as
necessary.
10. Road test the vehicle and make several stops to wear off any foreign material on the brakes
and to seat the brake shoes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Brake Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Bring the fluid level up to the requirements described on the side of the brake reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4835
Brake Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Specification ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. DOT 3
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE J1703
NOTE: The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of
the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission
fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4836
Brake Fluid: Service Precautions
WARNING:
Use of a brake fluid that may have a lower initial boiling point, or is unidentified as to specification,
may result in sudden brake failure during hard prolonged braking. You could have an accident.
CAUTION:
DO not allow a petroleum-base fluid to contaminate the brake fluid. Seal damage may result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4837
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid including:
the master cylinder and reservoir; proportioning valves (non-ABS); caliper seals; wheel cylinder
seals; ABS hydraulic control unit; and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4838
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
STANDARD PROCEDURE - BRAKE FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
Brake fluid level should be checked a minimum of twice a year.
Master cylinder reservoirs are marked, FULL and MIN, indicating the allowable brake fluid level
range in the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container. Brake fluid
must conform to DOT 3 specifications. Do not use petroleum-based fluid because seal damage in
the brake system will result.
Although there is a range, the preferred level is FULL. If necessary, adjust the brake fluid level to
the FULL mark on the side of the master cylinder brake fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4842
Fig. 37 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4843
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4844
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4845
Brake Fluid Level Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4846
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: An abnormal loss of brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir could be caused by
a leak in the hydraulic system. The entire brake hydraulic system should be checked for evidence
of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4847
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level switch is located in the left side of the brake fluid reservoir on the master
cylinder. It is clipped into the reservoir. It can be removed from the reservoir and replaced if
necessary.
OPERATION
The purpose of the brake fluid level switch is to provide the driver with an early warning that the
brake fluid level in the master cylinder reservoir has dropped below an acceptable level.
As the fluid drops below the designed level, the fluid level switch closes and grounds the red
BRAKE warning indicator circuit. This turns on the red BRAKE warning indicator. At this time, the
master cylinder brake fluid reservoir must be checked and filled to the full mark with DOT 3 brake
fluid. Check the entire brake hydraulic system for evidence of a leak.
CAUTION: An abnormal loss of brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir could be caused by
a leak in the hydraulic system. The entire brake hydraulic system should be checked for evidence
of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4848
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Remove the vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level switch in master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir.
2. Push together the retaining tabs holding the brake fluid level switch in place in the brake fluid
reservoir. 3. Pull the brake fluid level switch out the other side of the reservoir.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Align the brake fluid level switch with its mounting hole on the left side of the master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir. Push the switch into the fluid
reservoir until the switch retaining tabs are expanded on the other side of the reservoir, locking it in
place.
2. Connect the brake fluid level switch wiring connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Hose/Line: Specifications
Brake Hose Banjo Bolt (To Caliper)
..................................................................................................................................................... 24
Nm (210 in. lbs.) Brake Tube Nuts ......................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4852
Brake Hose/Line: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - BRAKE TUBES AND HOSES
The brake tubes are steel with a corrosion-resistant nylon coating applied to the external surfaces.
The flex hoses are made of reinforced rubber with fittings at each end.
OPERATION - BRAKE TUBES AND HOSES
The purpose of the brake tubes and flex hoses is to transfer brake fluid pressure, developed by the
master cylinder to the brakes at each wheel of the vehicle. The flex hoses connect the chassis
brake tubes which are mounted to the vehicle's underbody to the brake at each wheel, allowing for
movement of the vehicle's suspension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4853
Brake Hose/Line: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION - BRAKE TUBES AND HOSES
Flexible rubber hose is used at both front and rear brakes. Inspection of brake hoses should be
performed whenever the brake system is serviced and every 7,500 miles or 12 months, whichever
comes first (every engine oil change). Inspect hydraulic brake hoses for severe surface cracking,
scuffing, worn spots or physical damage. If the fabric casing of the rubber hose becomes exposed
due to cracks or abrasions in the rubber hose cover, the hose should be replaced immediately.
Eventual deterioration of the hose can take place with possible burst failure. Faulty installation can
cause twisting, resulting in wheel, tire, or chassis interference.
The steel brake tubing should be inspected periodically for evidence of corrosion, physical damage
or contact with moving or hot components of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Specifications
PROPORTIONING VALVE: (non-ABS vehicles)
Material ................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Aluminum Function ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Fixed Pressure
Proportioning
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4857
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Description and Operation
PROPORTIONING VALVE
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Only vehicles without antilock brakes have proportioning valves. Vehicles with antilock
brakes have Electronic Variable Brake Proportioning (EVBP) that is built into the Integrated Control
Unit (ICU).
Proportioning valves balance front to rear braking by controlling the brake fluid hydraulic pressure
to the rear brakes. Under light pedal application, the proportioning valve allows normal fluid flow to
the rear brakes. Under higher pedal effort, the valve reduces fluid pressure to the rear brakes.
The non-antilock master cylinder is a four-outlet design with two screw-in proportioning valves
attached directly to the master cylinder housing. One proportioning valve controls each rear brake.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4858
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - PROPORTIONING VALVE
If premature rear wheel skid occurs on a hard brake application, it could be an indication that a
malfunction has occurred with one of the proportioning valves. One proportioning valve controls the
right rear brake, and the other proportioning valve controls the left rear brake.
Therefore, a road test to determine which rear brake skids first is essential. Before testing the
proportioning valve in question, inspect the rear brake linings for contamination or for replacement
shoes not meeting the OEM brake lining material specifications. The proportioning valve should
always be tested prior to being replaced.
The in-line proportioning valves used on this vehicle require special pressure fittings to test the
proportioning valves for proper proportioning valve function. The pressure fittings are installed
before and after the proportioning valve being tested to verify proportioning valve is maintaining the
required hydraulic pressure to the rear wheel brake which it controls.
PROPORTIONING VALVE TEST
The test procedure is the same for either rear proportioning valve. After road testing the vehicle to
determine which wheel skids first, follow the procedure below for testing the suspect proportioning
valve.
1. Using a brake pedal holding tool as shown, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of
travel and hold it in this position. This will isolate the
master cylinder from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the
master cylinder reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4859
2. Use the figure shown to determine which proportioning valve needs to be tested. 3. Remove the
hydraulic brake tube from the proportioning valve controlling the rear wheel of the vehicle that has
premature wheel skid. 4. Remove the proportioning valve from its outlet port on the master
cylinder.
CAUTION: Be sure the pressure test fittings being installed into master cylinder and proportioning
valve, have the correct thread sizes needed.
5. Install the Brake Pressure Adapters, Special Tool 8644 and 6805-3 onto the proportioning valve.
6. Install the proportioning valve (with tools) back into the outlet port on the master cylinder.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4860
7. Attach a Pressure Gauge, Special Tool C 4007-A, to each pressure adapter. 8. Remove the
brake pedal holding tool. Bleed any air out of the pressure gauge hoses at the pressure gauge. 9.
With the aid of a helper, apply pressure to the brake pedal until the reading on proportioning valve
inlet gauge is at the target inlet pressure shown
in the BRAKE PROPORTIONING VALVE APPLICATIONS AND PRESSURE SPECIFICATIONS
table following this procedure. If the inlet gauge pressure overshoots its target pressure when the
pedal is depressed, release the brake pedal, relieving the pressure in the system, before
reapplying the pedal to reach the target pressure at the inlet gauge. This is necessary to get an
accurate reading of the outlet pressure.
10. Once inlet pressure has been achieved, check the pressure reading on the proportioning valve
outlet gauge. If the proportioning valve outlet
pressure does not agree with value shown in the table, replace the proportioning valve. If
proportioning valve is within pressure specifications, the valve is good and does not require
replacement.
11. Reinstall the brake holding tool on the brake pedal and remove the test equipment from the
vehicle. 12. Remove the tools from the valve. 13. Install the proportioning valve in the master
cylinder and hand tighten until the proportioning valve is fully installed and its O-ring seal is seated
into the master cylinder. Torque the proportioning valve to 17.5 Nm (155 in. lbs.).
14. Install the brake tube on the proportioning valve. Torque the tube nut to 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.).
15. Bleed the affected brake line.
Brake Proportioning Valve Applications and Pressure Specifications
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4861
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
Brake Pedal Holding Tool
1. Using a brake pedal holder, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of travel and hold it in
this position . This will isolate the master cylinder
from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the master cylinder
reservoir.
2. Disconnect the brake tube from the proportioning valve requiring removal. 3. Unscrew the
Proportioning valve from the master cylinder.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Lubricate the O-ring on the proportioning valve. Make sure the O-ring on the proportioning valve
is new. 2. Install the proportioning valve in its master cylinder port. Tighten the proportioning valve
to a torque of 17.5 Nm (155 inch lbs.). 3. Connect the brake tube to the proportioning valve.
Tighten the tube nut to a torque of 17 Nm (145 inch lbs.). 4. Remove the brake pedal holder. 5.
Bleed the affected brake line. 6. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Specifications
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Specifications
ABS HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT
Hydraulic Tube Fitting Type
........................................................................................................................................................
SAE 45° Inverted Flare Inlet Port Threads ..........................................................................................
........................................................................................................ 7/16-24 Outlet Port Threads Left Front and Left Rear
......................................................................................................................................................
7/16-24 Outlet Port Threads - Right Front and Right Rear
...................................................................................................................................................
3/8-24
BRAKE FASTENER TORQUE
ABS ICU Mounting Bolts (To Bracket)
.............................................................................................................................................. 11 Nm
(97 in. lbs.) ABS ICU Mounting Bolts (To Frame)
............................................................................................................................................... 23 Nm
(200 in. lbs.) ABS CAB Mounting Screws (To HCU)
............................................................................................................................................. 2 Nm (17
in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4865
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Locations
Hydraulic Control Unit
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit)
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation HCU (Hydraulic Control
Unit)
DESCRIPTION - HYDRAULIC CONTROL UNIT (HCU)
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) is mounted to the CAB as part of the ICU. The HCU controls the
flow of brake fluid to the brakes using a series of valves and accumulators. A pump/motor is
mounted on the HCU to supply build pressure to the brakes during an ABS stop.
VALVES AND SOLENOIDS
The valve block contains four inlet valves and four outlet solenoid valves. The inlet valves are
spring loaded in the open position and the outlet valves are spring-loaded in the closed position
during normal braking. The fluid is allowed to flow from the master cylinder to the wheel brakes.
During an ABS stop, these valves cycle to maintain the proper slip ratio for each wheel. The inlet
valve closes preventing further pressure increase and the outlet valve opens to provide a path from
the wheel brake to the HCU accumulators and pump/motor. This releases (decays) pressure from
the wheel brake, thus releasing the wheel from excessive slippage. Once the wheel is no longer
slipping, the outlet valve is closed and the inlet valve is opened to reapply (build) pressure.
BRAKE FLUID ACCUMULATORS
There are two fluid accumulators in the HCU: one for the primary hydraulic circuit, and one for the
secondary hydraulic circuit. Each hydraulic circuit uses a 3 cc accumulator.
The fluid accumulators temporarily store brake fluid that is removed from the wheel brakes during
an ABS cycle. This stored fluid is used by the pump/ motor to provide build pressure for the brake
hydraulic system. When the antilock stop is complete, the accumulators are drained by the
pump/motor.
There are two noise dampening chambers in the HCU on this vehicle equipped with traction
control.
PUMP/MOTOR
There are two pump assemblies in the HCU: one for the primary hydraulic circuit, and one for the
secondary hydraulic circuit. Both pumps are driven by a common electric motor. This DC-type
motor is integral to the HCU and is controlled by the CAB.
The pump/motor provides the extra amount of brake fluid needed during antilock braking. Brake
fluid is released to the accumulators when the outlet valve is opened during an antilock stop. The
pump mechanism consists of two opposing pistons operated by an eccentric camshaft. In
operation, these pistons are used to purge fluid from the accumulators back into the master
cylinder circuits. When the antilock stop is complete, the pump/motor drains the accumulators.
The pump motor is also used to build pressure when the system goes into traction control mode.
The CAB may turn on the pump/motor when an antilock stop is detected. The pump/motor
continues to run during the antilock stop and is turned off after the stop is complete. Under some
conditions, the pump/motor runs to drain the accumulators during the next drive-off.
The pump/motor is not a serviceable item; if it requires replacement, the HCU must be replaced.
OPERATION - HYDRAULIC CIRCUITS AND VALVES
The hydraulic fluid control valves control the flow of pressurized brake fluid to the wheel brakes
during the different modes of ABS braking. The
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit) > Page 4868
following paragraphs explain how this works. For purposes of explanation only, it is assumed that
only the right front wheel is experiencing antilock braking; the following diagrams show only the
right front wheel in an antilock braking operation.
NORMAL BRAKING HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT AND SOLENOID VALVE FUNCTION
The hydraulic diagram shows the vehicle in the normal braking mode of the base brake hydraulic
system. The diagram shows no wheel spin or slip occurring relative to the speed of the vehicle. The
driver is applying the brake pedal; this builds pressure in the brake hydraulic system to engage the
brakes and stop the vehicle.
ABS HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT AND SOLENOID VALVE FUNCTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit) > Page 4869
The hydraulic diagram shows the vehicle in the ABS braking mode. The diagram shows one wheel
is slipping because the driver is attempting to stop the vehicle at a faster rate than is allowed by the
surface on which the tires are riding. ^
The normally open and normally closed valves modulate (build/decay) the brake hydraulic pressure
as required.
^ The pump/motor is switched on so that the brake fluid from the low pressure accumulators is
returned to the master cylinder circuits.
^ The brake fluid is routed to either the master cylinder or the wheel brake depending on the
position of the normally open valve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > HCU (Hydraulic Control Unit) > Page 4870
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Description and Operation ICU (Integrated Control
Unit)
ICU (INTEGRATED CONTROL UNIT)
DESCRIPTION
The Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) and the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) used with this antilock
brake system are combined (integrated) into one unit, which is called the Integrated Control Unit
(ICU). The ICU is located on the driver's side of the vehicle, below the master cylinder. The ABS
with traction control ICU consists of the following components: the CAB, eight (build/decay)
solenoid valves (four inlet valves and four outlet valves), two hydraulic shuttle valves, two traction
control valves, valve block, fluid accumulators, a pump, and an electric pump/motor. The
replaceable components of the ICU are the HCU and the CAB. No attempt should be made to
service any components of the HCU or CAB.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4871
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
INTEGRATED CONTROL UNIT (ICU)
NOTE: If servicing the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) only, the CAB can be serviced with the ICU
mounted in the vehicle.
REMOVAL- ICU
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
Brake Pedal Holding Tool Installed
1. Using a brake pedal holder, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of travel and hold it in
this position. This will isolate the master cylinder
from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the master cylinder
reservoir.
2. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable. 3. Disconnect the
positive cable from the battery, then remove the battery from the battery tray. There is one nut
securing the clamp on the backside
of the battery holding it in place.
4. Remove the one nut and one bolt securing the air cleaner box in place, then disconnect the
wiring harness connector at the air inlet sensor.
5. Lift the air cleaner box upward enough to clear its grommeted alignment post, then move the air
cleaner box forward just enough to access the
battery tray mounting bolts.
6. Remove the 2 bolts, then the 2 nuts mounting the battery tray to its bracket. Remove the battery
tray.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4872
7. Disconnect the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder. Install plugs in the
master cylinder outlet ports.
8. Disconnect the 24-way connector from the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) mounted on the
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) and move it out of the
way. The connector is disconnected by pulling outward on the connector lock. This will unlock and
raise the 24-way connector out of the socket on the CAB.
9. Tag the brake tubes coming from the master cylinder as primary and secondary. This is done to
avoid mix-up once the tubes are removed from the
vehicle.
10. Disconnect and remove the primary and secondary brake tubes coming from the master
cylinder at the ICU Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU). 11. Disconnect the brake tubes going to each
individual brake at the HCU.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4873
12. Remove the 3 bolts attaching the ICU to its mounting bracket. 13. Remove the ICU from the
vehicle. 14. If the CAB and HCU must be separated, Refer to ICU (INTEGRATED CONTROL
UNIT) - DISASSEMBLY.
DISASSEMBLY- ICU
NOTE: To replace the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) or the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) on this
vehicle, the entire Integrated Control Unit (ICU) needs to be removed from the vehicle. The CAB
can then be separated from the HCU.
1. Disconnect the pump/motor wiring harness from the CAB.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4874
2. Remove the 4 bolts attaching the CAB to the HCU3).
3. Remove the CAB from the HCU.
ASSEMBLY- ICU
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4875
1. Install the CAB on the HCU.
2. Install the 4 bolts mounting the CAB to the HCU). Tighten the CAB mounting bolts to a torque of
2 Nm (17 in. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4876
3. Plug the pump/motor wiring harness into the CAB. 4. Install the ICU in the vehicle.
INSTALLATION- ICU
1. Install the ICU onto its mounting bracket.
2. Install the 3 bolts attaching the ICU to the mounting bracket. Tighten the 3 mounting bolts to a
torque of 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.)
Brake Pedal Holding Tool Installed
3. Install the four brake tubes going to the brakes into their respective outlet ports on the ICU HCU.
Using a crow foot on a torque wrench, tighten
the four brake tube nuts to a torque of 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.).
NOTE: When installing the brake tubes from the master cylinder on the HCU, the brake tube with
the small tube nut is to be installed in the forward-most port on the HCU with the small end going
toward the master cylinder secondary port.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4877
4. Install the primary and secondary brake tubes from the master cylinder onto the HCU. Do not
completely tighten the primary and secondary tubes
at this time.
5. Connect the primary and secondary brake tubes to the master cylinder ports. 6. Using a crow
foot on a torque wrench, tighten the primary and secondary brake tube nuts at both the master
cylinder and HCU to a torque of 17
Nm (145 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Before installing the 24-way connector in the CAB, be sure the seal is properly installed
in the connector.
7. Install the 24-way connector into the socket of the CAB as follows:
- Position the 24-way connector in the socket of the CAB and carefully push it down as far as
possible.
- When the connector is fully seated into the CAB socket, push the connector lock inward. This
pulls the connector into the socket of the CAB and locks it in the installed position.
8. Position the battery tray back in place. Install the two bolts, then the two nuts mounting the
battery tray to its bracket. Tighten the two bolts and
nuts to a torque of 15 Nm (135 in. lbs.).
9. Reinstall the air cleaner box onto its grommeted alignment post.
10. Install the one nut and one bolt securing the air cleaner box in place, then connect the wiring
harness connector at the air inlet sensor. 11. Install the battery and clamp it in place. Tighten the
hold-down clamp bolt to a torque of 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.).
12. Connect the positive, then the negative (ground) cable on the battery.
NOTE: The ICU may need to be initialized using the DRBIII scan tool after ICU installation. Refer to
Appropriate Diagnostic Information.
13. Bleed the base brakes and ABS hydraulic systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4878
14. Fill the master cylinder to the proper fill level. 15. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper
operation of the base and antilock brake systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder: Specifications
MASTER CYLINDER
Mounting Studs ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. M8 x 1.25 Diaphragm Size/Type ..........................................
.................................................................................................................................... 205 mm
Tandem Type ......................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ Dual Tandem Body Material .......................................
........................................................................................................................................... Anodized
Aluminum Reservoir Material ..............................................................................................................
......................................................................... Polypropelene
MASTER CYLINDER BORE STROKE AND SPLIT
Non-ABS
........................................................................................................................................................
22.23 mm x 34.0 mm (0.875 in. x 1.34 in.) ABS ..................................................................................
.............................................................................. 23.82 mm x 34.0 mm (0.937 in. x 1.34 in.)
Displacement Split ...............................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 50/50
MASTER CYLINDER FLUID OUTLET PORTS
Tube Fitting Type .................................................................................................................................
........................................ SAE 45° Inverted Flare W/ABS - Primary Tube Nut Thread ......................
................................................................................................................................................ 7/16-24
W/ABS - Secondary Tube Nut Thread ................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3/8-24 W/O ABS - All Tube Nut Threads ........................
................................................................................................................................................ 7/16-24
BRAKE FASTENER TORQUE
Master Cylinder Mounting ....................................................................................................................
............................................. 18 Nm (160 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4882
Brake Master Cylinder: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Two different master cylinders are used on this vehicle. Vehicles without Antilock Brakes (ABS) use
a standard compensating-port master cylinder, while vehicles equipped with ABS use a
center-valve design master cylinder.
ABS vehicles, equipped with rear disc brakes, use a master cylinder with a 23.82 mm (0.937 inch)
bore diameter, while non-ABS vehicles, equipped with rear disc brakes, use a 22.23 mm (0.875
inch) bore diameter master cylinder.
The ABS master cylinder is a two-outlet design and the brake tubes from these primary and
secondary outlet ports lead directly to the Integrated Control Unit (ICU) before going to each wheel
brake.
The non-ABS master cylinder is a four-outlet design (one for each wheel brake) with two screw-in
proportioning valves (one for each rear wheel brake). One is attached directly to the inboard side of
the master cylinder housing while the other is attached to the bottom.
Both type master cylinders mount to the power brake booster using two nuts. They both have a
seal on the rear of the mounting flange to seal vacuum in the booster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4883
The master cylinder body is an anodized aluminum casting. It has a machined bore to accept the
master cylinder piston and also has threaded ports with seats for hydraulic brake line connections.
The master cylinder has the brake fluid reservoir mounted on top of it which gravity feeds brake
fluid to the master cylinder when it is required. The reservoir is made of see-through plastic and it
houses the brake fluid level switch. A removable brake fluid level switch is mounted in the left side.
OPERATION
When the brake pedal is pressed, the master cylinder primary and secondary pistons apply brake
pressure through the proportioning valves (on non-ABS vehicles) and chassis brake tubes to each
brake assembly. The brake fluid reservoir supplies the brake hydraulic system with the necessary
fluid to operate properly.
The non-ABS master cylinder's primary outlet ports supply hydraulic pressure to the right front and
left rear brakes while the secondary outlet ports supply hydraulic pressure to the left front and right
rear brakes. ABS equipped master cylinder outlet ports supply hydraulic pressure to the ABS
Integrated Control Unit (ICU) where it is distributed to the individual wheel brakes.
The master cylinder reservoir cap diaphragm is slit to allow atmospheric pressure to equalize on
both sides of the diaphragm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure
STANDARD PROCEDURE - MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
1. Clamp the master cylinder in a vise. 2. Refer to one of the following depending on whether the
master cylinder is a non-ABS unit Step a or an ABS unit Step b:
a. Attach four Master Cylinder Bleed Tubes, Special Tool 8358-1, to the four ports of the master
cylinder and tighten each in place. The bleed
tubes for the ports pertaining to the rear brakes are made to attach to the proportioning valves
screwed into the master cylinder. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder
reservoir so their outlets are below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
b. Attach Master Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-1, to the primary port of the master
cylinder and tighten in place. Attach Master
Cylinder Bleed Tube, Special Tool 8358-2, to the secondary port of the master cylinder and tighten
in place. Position the other end of the tubes into the master cylinder reservoir so their outlets are
below the surface of the brake fluid in the reservoir when filled.
3. Fill the brake fluid reservoir with fresh Mopars brake fluid, or equivalent conforming to DOT 3
specifications. 4. Using a wooden dowel as a pushrod, press the pistons inward slowly applying
brake pressure, then release the pressure, allowing the pistons to
return to the released position. Repeat this several times until all air bubbles are expelled out of the
tubes and master cylinder bore.
5. Remove the bleed tubes from the master cylinder and plug the outlet ports. 6. Install the fill cap
on the reservoir. 7. Remove the master cylinder from the vise.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4886
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Master Cylinder Removal and Installation
LHD With ABS
REMOVAL - LHD WITH ABS
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to WARNING.
CAUTION: The vacuum in the power brake booster must be pumped down before removing the
master cylinder to prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done by
pumping the brake pedal while the engine is not running until a firm brake pedal is achieved.
1. With the engine not running, pump the brake pedal 4-5 strokes until the pedal feel is firm. 2.
Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable. 3. Disconnect the
positive cable from the battery, then remove the battery from the battery tray. There is one nut
securing the clamp on the backside
of the battery holding it in place.
4. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the brake fluid level switch on the master cylinder
reservoir. 5. Disconnect the primary and secondary brake tubes from master cylinder. Install plugs
in the master cylinder outlet ports. 6. Clean the area around where the master cylinder attaches to
the power brake booster using a suitable brake cleaner such as Mopars Brake Parts
Cleaner or an equivalent.
7. Remove the 2 nuts attaching master cylinder to power brake booster. 8. Slide the master
cylinder straight out of the power brake booster.
INSTALLATION - LHD WITH ABS
NOTE: The master cylinder must be bled before installing it on the vehicle.
1. Bleed the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle. 2. Inspect and wipe clean the O-ring
vacuum seal on the master cylinder rear mounting flange to ensure a good vacuum seal once
installation is
complete. Replace as necessary.
3. Wipe the face of the power brake booster clean where the master cylinder seal comes in contact
when it's installed. Do not get any cleaner or
debris inside the booster.
4. Position the master cylinder on the studs of power brake vacuum booster aligning the booster
push rod with the master cylinder push rod.
Carefully push the master cylinder onto the studs until it contacts the face of the booster.
5. Install the two master cylinder mounting nuts. Tighten the mounting nuts to a torque of 18 Nm
(160 inch lbs.). 6. Connect the primary and secondary brake tubes to the master cylinder primary
and secondary ports. Tighten the nuts to a torque of 17 Nm (145
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4887
inch lbs.).
7. Install the wiring harness connector on the master cylinder reservoir fluid level switch. 8. Install
the battery and clamp in place. 9. Connect the positive, then the negative (ground) cable on the
battery.
10. Fill the master cylinder to the proper level. 11. Pump the brake pedal several times, then check
brake fluid level in master cylinder reservoir. Adjust brake fluid level as necessary.
CAUTION: It will be necessary to bleed the entire base hydraulic system if the brake system has
been open to air for an excessive amount of time or air is present in the lines.
12. Check for leaks. 13. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base and antilock
brake systems.
LHD Without ABS
REMOVAL - LHD WITHOUT ABS
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to WARNING.
CAUTION: The vacuum in the power brake booster must be pumped down before removing the
master cylinder to prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done by
pumping the brake pedal while the engine is not running until a firm brake pedal is achieved.
1. With the engine not running, pump the brake pedal 4-5 strokes until the pedal feel is firm. 2.
Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable. 3. Disconnect the
positive cable from the battery, then remove the battery from the battery tray. There is one nut
securing the clamp on the backside
of the battery holding it in place.
4. Remove the vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level switch in master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4888
5. Disconnect the two brake tubes from the master cylinder, and two brake tubes from the
proportioning valves. Install plugs at all of the open brake
tube outlets on the master cylinder.
6. Clean the area around where the master cylinder attaches to the power brake booster using a
suitable brake cleaner such as Mopar Brake Parts
Cleaner or an equivalent.
7. Remove the two nuts attaching the master cylinder to the power brake booster. 8. Slide the
master cylinder straight out of the power brake booster. 9. To remove the proportioning valves,
unthread each from the master cylinder.
INSTALLATION - LHD WITHOUT ABS
NOTE: The master cylinder must be bled before installing it on the vehicle.
1. If removed, install the proportioning valves in their master cylinder ports. The valves are
identical, so they can be installed in either master
cylinder port going to the rear brakes. Make sure the O-rings on the proportioning valves are new.
2. Bleed the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle. 3. Inspect and wipe clean the O-ring
vacuum seal on the master cylinder rear mounting flange to ensure a good vacuum seal once
installation is
complete. Replace as necessary.
4. Wipe the face of the power brake booster clean where the master cylinder seal comes in contact
when it's installed. Do not get any cleaner or
debris inside the booster.
5. Position the master cylinder on the studs of the power brake booster, aligning the push rod of the
power brake booster with master cylinder piston
push rod. Carefully push the master cylinder onto the studs until it contacts the face of the booster.
6. Install the two master cylinder mounting nuts and tighten each to a torque of 18 Nm (160 inch
lbs.). 7. Connect the four brake tubes to the master cylinder and proportioning valve ports. Tighten
all tube nuts to a torque of 17 Nm (145 inch lbs.). 8. Connect the brake fluid level switch wiring
connector. 9. Install the battery and clamp it in place.
10. Connect the positive, then the negative (ground) cable on the battery. 11. Fill the master
cylinder to the proper level. 12. Pump the brake pedal several times, then check brake fluid level in
master cylinder reservoir. Adjust brake fluid level as necessary.
CAUTION: It will be necessary to bleed the entire base hydraulic system if the brake system has
been open to air for an excessive amount of time or air is present in the lines.
13. Check for leaks. 14. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the brakes.
RHD
REMOVAL- RHD
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to WARNING.
CAUTION: The vacuum in the power brake booster must be pumped down before removing the
master cylinder to prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done by
pumping the brake pedal while the engine is not running until a firm brake pedal is achieved.
1. With the engine not running, pump the brake pedal 4-5 strokes until the pedal feel is firm. 2.
Disconnect the negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4889
3. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch wiring connector. 4. Remove the brake lines from the
master cylinder. 5. Remove the (2) master cylinder mounting nuts. 6. Slide the master cylinder
assembly straight out of the power brake booster.
INSTALLATION - RHD
NOTE: The master cylinder must be bled before installing it on the vehicle.
1. If removed, install the proportioning valves in their master cylinder ports. The valves are
identical, so they can be installed in either master
cylinder port going to the rear brakes. Make sure the O-rings on the proportioning valves are new.
2. Bleed the master cylinder before installing it on the vehicle. 3. Inspect and wipe clean the O-ring
vacuum seal on the master cylinder rear mounting flange to ensure a good vacuum seal once
installation is
complete. Replace as necessary.
4. Wipe the face of the power brake booster clean where the master cylinder seal comes in contact
when it's installed. Do not get any cleaner or
debris inside the booster.
5. Slide the master cylinder assembly straight in the power brake booster. 6. Install the (2) master
cylinder retaining nuts. Torque the nuts to 18 Nm (160 inch lbs.). 7. Install the brake lines on the
master cylinder. Torque the tube nuts to 17 Nm (145 inch lbs.). 8. Connect the brake fluid level
switch wiring connector. 9. Fill the master cylinder to the proper level.
10. Pump the brake pedal several times, then check brake fluid level in master cylinder reservoir.
Adjust brake fluid level as necessary.
CAUTION: It will be necessary to bleed the entire base hydraulic system if the brake system has
been open to air for an excessive amount of time or air is present in the lines.
11. Check for leaks. 12. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4890
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Fluid Reservoir Removal and Installation
FLUID RESERVOIR
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
- The master cylinder does not need to be removed from the power brake booster for removal and
installation of the brake fluid reservoir.
1. Clean the master cylinder housing and brake fluid reservoir exterior surfaces. 2. Remove the
brake fluid reservoir cap. Using a clean syringe or siphoning tool, empty as much brake fluid as
possible from the reservoir.
3. Remove the vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level switch in master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir.
4. Remove the two plastic pins holding the reservoir to the master cylinder. 5. Lift the reservoir from
the master cylinder casting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4891
6. Remove the grommets (O-rings) sealing the reservoir to the master cylinder housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Install NEW sealing grommets (O-rings) in the master cylinder housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder Bleeding Procedure > Page 4892
2. Lubricate the sealing grommets with fresh clean DOT 3 brake fluid. Place the reservoir in
position over the grommets making sure the filler hole is
towards the front of the vehicle. Seat the reservoir into the grommets. While holding the reservoir
firmly against the grommets, install new plastic pins through their mounting holes until they
protrude out the other side of the master cylinder reservoir.
3. Connect the brake fluid level switch wiring connector. 4. Fill the reservoir with fresh clean DOT 3
brake fluid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Drum Brake Wheel Cylinder Mounting Bolts
........................................................................................................................................ 13 Nm (115
in. lbs.) Drum Brake Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Screw
........................................................................................................................................... 10 Nm (89
in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4896
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
WHEEL CYLINDERS DRUM BRAKE
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Using a brake pedal holder, depress the brake pedal past its first one inch of travel and hold it in
this position . This will isolate the master cylinder
from the brake hydraulic system and will not allow the brake fluid to drain out of the master cylinder
reservoir.
2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly.
4. Disconnect the rear brake flex hose from the wheel cylinder. 5. Remove the rear brake drum. 6.
Remove the rear brake shoes from the brake support plate.
NOTE: If the brake shoes are wet with grease or brake fluid, replace them.
7. Remove the brake wheel cylinder attaching bolts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4897
8. Remove the brake wheel cylinder from the brake support plate.
INSPECTION
With the brake drums removed, inspect the wheel cylinder boots for evidence of a brake fluid leak.
Visually check the boots for cuts, tears, or heat cracks. If any of these conditions exist, the wheel
cylinders should be completely cleaned, inspected and new parts installed.
If a wheel cylinder is leaking and the brake lining material is saturated with brake fluid, the brake
shoes must be replaced.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Install a new O-ring at the mating surface of the wheel cylinder-to-brake support plate.
NOTE: When installing wheel cylinder on brake support plate, be sure it is positioned squarely
(horizontal) to the brake assembly.
2. Install the wheel cylinder onto brake support plate. Tighten the attaching bolts to a torque of 13
Nm (115 in. lbs.). 3. Hand start the rear brake flex hose tube fitting to wheel cylinder. Tighten the
tube nut to a torque of 17 Nm (145 in. lbs.). 4. Install the rear brake shoes on the brake support
plate. Replace them as necessary. 5. Install the rear brake drum onto the rear hub. 6. Install the tire
and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 7.
Adjust the rear brakes. 8. Lower the vehicle. 9. Remove the brake pedal holder.
10. Bleed the wheel cylinder as necessary. 11. Road test the vehicle to make sure the brakes
operate correctly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments
Parking Brake Cable: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
NOTE: The parking brake shoes used in the drum-in-hat park brake system do not automatically
adjust to compensate for brake shoe lining wear. Therefore, it is necessary to manually adjust the
parking brake shoes.
1. Verify the parking brake lever is in the released position. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the
rubber plug from the adjusting hole in the disc brake caliper adapter. 4. Adjust the parking brakes.
Use the first bullet point for the adjustment of the left side parking brake shoes. Use the second
bullet point for the
adjustment of the right side parking brake shoes. ^
Insert a medium size screwdriver through adjustment hole in the left backing plate. Position the
screwdriver against the star wheel on the parking brake shoe adjuster. Using the screwdriver,
rotate the star wheel downward until a slight drag is noticed when turning the rear tire and wheel
assembly. Then, using the screwdriver, slowly rotate the star wheel upward, backing off the
adjuster, just enough to allow the rear tire and wheel assembly to rotate without the parking brake
shoes dragging. Do not back off the adjuster star wheel more than two clicks past the point of no
drag. The parking brake shoe-to-drum clearance is now properly set.
^ Insert a medium size screwdriver through adjustment hole in the right backing plate. Position the
screwdriver against the star wheel on the parking brake shoe adjuster. Using the screwdriver,
rotate the star wheel upward until a slight drag is noticed when turning the rear tire and wheel
assembly. Then, using the screwdriver, slowly rotate the star wheel downward, backing off the
adjuster, just enough to allow the rear tire and wheel assembly to rotate without the parking brake
shoes dragging. Do not back off the adjuster star wheel more that two clicks past the point of no
drag. The parking brake shoe-to-drum clearance is now properly set.
5. Install the rubber plug in the adjusting holes of the disc brake caliper adapter. 6. Lower the
vehicle until the rear tires are just clearing the floor. 7. Reach inside the vehicle and fully apply and
release the park brakes two times after adjusting the parking brake shoes. 8. With the parking
brake lever in the fully applied position, attempt to hand rotate each rear tire and wheel assembly to
ensure that the parking brake
shoes are working.
9. With the parking brake lever in the released position, hand rotate each rear tire and wheel
assembly to ensure that the parking brake shoes are not
dragging.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4902
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair
PARKING BRAKE CABLES
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
The procedure below applies to either of the two rear parking brake cables. 1. Block the tire and
wheels so the vehicle does not move once the vehicle parking brake lever is released. 2. Fully
apply the parking brake lever, then shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Remove the screws
attaching the center console, then remove the center console. 4. Lower the parking brake lever
handle to the released position.
5. Grasp the parking brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward. Continue pulling on the
cable until a pin punch can be inserted through the
hole in the lever mechanism sector gear and the hole in the right side of its mounting bracket. This
will lock the parking brake automatic adjustment mechanism in place and take tension off the
parking brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4903
6. Remove both rear parking brake cables from the parking brake cable equalizer. 7. Remove the
rear seat cushion from the vehicle. 8. Fold the rear carpeting forward to expose the parking brake
cables at the end of the rear floor.
9. Install the box end of a to inch wrench over the parking brake cable retainer. Push the wrench
onto the retainer until the retainer fingers are
collapsed. From under the carpeting, grasp the parking brake cable housing and pull cable straight
out of the bracket attached to the floor.
10. Raise the vehicle. 11. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. 12. On
vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes, remove the brake drum. 13. On vehicles equipped with
rear disc brakes:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4904
- Remove the disc brake caliper guide pin bolts, then the caliper from disc brake adapter.
- Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord.
- Remove the brake rotor from the rear hub and bearing.
14. Remove the dust cap from the rear hub and bearing. 15. Remove the hub and bearing retaining
nut from the knuckle spindle, then remove the hub and bearing.
16. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, remove the upper return spring, both shoe
hold-down clips, then spread the rear parking brake shoes
apart at the top enough to clear the shoe anchor and remove the parking brake shoes as an
assembly from the disc brake adapter.
17. To remove the rear parking brake cable from the brake support plate on vehicles equipped with
rear drum brakes:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4905
- Remove the parking brake cable from the parking brake actuating lever.
- Remove the actuating spring between the brake shoe adjustment lever and the brake shoe.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4906
- Remove the parking brake cable from the rear brake support plate. The parking brake cable can
be removed from brake support plate using a to inch box wrench to compress the locking fingers
on the parking brake cable retainer.
18. To remove the rear parking brake cable from the disc brake adapter on vehicles equipped with
rear disc brakes:
- Remove the parking brake actuating lever from the parking brake cable.
- Remove the parking brake cable from the rear disc brake adapter. The parking brake cable can
be removed from the disc brake adapter using a to inch offset box wrench to compress the locking
fingers on the parking brake cable retainer.
19. Remove the nuts, then the parking brake cable routing bracket from the tension strut mounting
bolts. 20. Remove the parking brake cable and sealing grommet from floor pan of the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
The procedure below applies to either of the two rear parking brake cables. 1. From underneath
push the parking brake cable through the hole in the floor pan of the vehicle making sure the cable
sealing grommet is installed
in the floor pan as far as possible to insure a good seal.
2. Attach the parking brake cable routing bracket to the tension strut mounting bolts. Install and
tighten the mounting nuts to a torque of 28 Nm (250
in. lbs.).
3. Install the parking brake cable into the brake support plate or the rear disc brake adapter. Be
sure the locking fingers on the cable retainer are
expanded once the cable is pushed all the way into the support plate or brake adapter hole to
ensure the cable is securely held in place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4907
4. On vehicles equipped with rear drum brakes:
- Install the parking brake cable on the parking brake cable actuating lever.
- Install the actuating spring to the brake shoe and the brake adjustment lever.
5. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4908
- Install the parking brake shoes actuator lever on the parking brake cable.
- Install the parking brake shoe assemblies on the disc brake adapter.
6. Install the hub and bearing on the rear spindle. Install a new hub and bearing retaining nut.
Tighten the retaining nut to a torque of 217 Nm (160 ft.
lbs.).
7. Install the hub and bearing dust cap. 8. On drum brake equipped vehicles, install the rear brake
drum.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4909
9. On vehicles equipped with rear disc brakes, install the brake rotor, then the disc brake caliper.
Install the two caliper guide pin bolts, then tighten
them to a torque of 22 Nm (192 in. lbs.).
10. Install the rear tire and wheel assembly. Tighten all wheel nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.). 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Ensure that the seal grommet on the cable that was installed from
underneath is fully seated into the floor pan. 13. Route the parking brake cable under the carpeting,
up to parking brake cable retaining bracket on floor pan. Install the parking brake cable through
the retaining bracket. Push the cable in until the locking fingers on the cable retainer lock the cable
into place.
14. Install the rear parking brake cables into the equalizer on the parking brake lever output cable.
15. Ensure that the parking brake cables are correctly installed on the equalizer and aligned with
the cable track on the parking brake lever.
NOTE: The parking brake lever can be in any position when releasing the automatic adjuster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4910
16. Keeping your hands clear of the automatic adjuster sector and pawl area, firmly grasp the
parking brake lever pin punch (or locking pin if a new
mechanism has been installed), then quickly remove it from the parking brake lever mechanism.
This will allow the park brake lever mechanism to automatically adjust the parking brake cables.
17. Cycle the parking brake lever once to position the parking brake cables, then return the parking
brake lever its released position. 18. Check the rear wheels of the vehicle. They should rotate
freely without dragging with the lever in its released position. 19. Reposition the rear carpeting into
place. 20. Install the rear seat cushion. Be sure the seat cushion is fully installed in the retainers on
the floor pan of the vehicle. 21. Fully apply the parking brake lever. 22. Install the center console
and its mounting screws. 23. Remove the blocks from the tires and wheels.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Specifications
Parking Brake Lever: Specifications
Parking Brake Lever Mounting Nut And Screw
.................................................................................................................................... 28 Nm (250 in.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4914
Parking Brake Lever: Service and Repair
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
REMOVAL
WARNING: -
THE AUTOMATIC ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER CONTAINS A
CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 25 POUNDS. DO NOT RELEASE THE
AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE UNLESS THE REAR PARKING BRAKE CABLES
AND EQUALIZER ARE CONNECTED TO THE LEVER OUTPUT CABLE. KEEP HANDS OUT OF
AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA. FAILURE TO OBSERVE CAUTION IN
HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO SERIOUS INJURY.
- WHEN REPAIRS TO THE PARKING BRAKE LEVER OR CABLES ARE REQUIRED, THE
AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER MUST BE LOADED AND LOCKED OUT TO AVOID POSSIBLE
INJURY. THE LEVER ADJUSTMENT MECHANISM CAN BE LOADED AND LOCKED OUT AS
OUTLINED IN THIS PROCEDURE.
1. Block the tire and wheels so the vehicle does not move once the vehicle parking brake lever is
released. 2. Fully apply the parking brake lever, then shift the transmission into neutral. 3. Remove
the screws attaching the center console, then remove the center console. 4. Lower the parking
brake lever handle to the released position.
5. Grasp the parking brake lever output cable by hand and pull upward. Continue pulling on the
cable until a pin punch can be inserted through the
hole in the lever mechanism sector gear and the hole in the right side of its mounting bracket . This
will lock the parking brake automatic adjustment mechanism in place and take tension off the
parking brake cables.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4915
6. Remove both rear parking brake cables from the parking brake cable equalizer.
7. Remove the wiring harness electrical connector from the parking brake warning lamp switch on
the parking brake lever. 8. Remove the two nuts attaching the parking brake lever to the vehicle. 9.
Remove the parking brake lever from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE AUTOMATIC ADJUSTING FEATURE OF THIS PARKING BRAKE LEVER
CONTAINS A CLOCK SPRING LOADED TO APPROXIMATELY 25 POUNDS. DO NOT
RELEASE THE AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER LOCKOUT DEVICE UNLESS THE REAR PARKING
BRAKE CABLES AND EQUALIZER ARE CONNECTED TO THE LEVER OUTPUT CABLE. KEEP
HANDS OUT OF AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER SECTOR AND PAWL AREA. FAILURE TO OBSERVE
CAUTION IN HANDLING THIS MECHANISM COULD LEAD TO SERIOUS INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4916
1. Place the parking brake lever on the mounting studs on the vehicle floor. Install and tighten the
two mounting nuts to a torque of 28 Nm (250 in.
lbs.).
2. Connect the wiring harness electrical connector on the parking brake warning lamp switch.
3. Install both rear park brake cables into the equalizer on the parking brake lever output cable. 4.
Ensure that the parking brake cables are correctly installed on the equalizer and aligned with the
cable track on the parking brake lever.
NOTE: The parking brake lever can only be in the released position when releasing the automatic
adjuster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4917
5. Keeping your hands clear of the automatic adjuster sector and pawl area, firmly grasp the
parking brake lever pin punch (or locking pin if a new
mechanism has been installed), then quickly remove it from the parking brake lever mechanism.
This will allow the park brake lever mechanism to automatically adjust the parking brake cables.
6. Cycle the parking brake lever once to position the parking brake cables, then return the parking
brake lever its released position. 7. Check the rear wheels of the vehicle. They should rotate freely
without dragging with the lever in its released position. 8. Fully apply the parking brake lever. 9.
Install the center console and its mounting screws.
10. Remove the blocks from the tires and wheels.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments
Parking Brake Shoe: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
NOTE: The parking brake shoes used in the drum in-hat park brake system do not automatically
adjust to compensate for brake shoe lining wear. Therefore, it is necessary to manually adjust the
parking brake shoes.
1. Verify the parking brake lever is in the released position. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the
rubber plug from the adjusting hole in the disc brake caliper adapter. 4. Adjust the parking brakes.
Use the first bullet point for the adjustment of the left side parking brake shoes. Use the second
bullet point for the
adjustment of the right side parking brake shoes. Insert a medium size screwdriver through adjustment hole in the left backing plate. Position the
screwdriver against the star wheel on the parking brake shoe adjuster. Using the screwdriver,
rotate the star wheel downward until a slight drag is noticed when turning the rear tire and wheel
assembly. Then, using the screwdriver, slowly rotate the star wheel upward, backing off the
adjuster, just enough to allow the rear tire and wheel assembly to rotate without the parking brake
shoes dragging. Do not back off the adjuster star wheel more than two clicks past the point of no
drag. The parking brake shoe-to-drum clearance is now properly set.
- Insert a medium size screwdriver through adjustment hole in the right backing plate. Position the
screwdriver against the star wheel on the parking brake shoe adjuster. Using the screwdriver,
rotate the star wheel upward until a slight drag is noticed when turning the rear tire and wheel
assembly. Then, using the screwdriver, slowly rotate the star wheel downward, backing off the
adjuster, just enough to allow the rear tire and wheel assembly to rotate without the parking brake
shoes dragging. Do not back off the adjuster star wheel more that two clicks past the point of no
drag. The parking brake shoe-to-drum clearance is now properly set.
5. Install the rubber plug in the adjusting holes of the disc brake caliper adapter. 6. Lower the
vehicle until the rear tires are just clearing the floor. 7. Reach inside the vehicle and fully apply and
release the park brakes two times after adjusting the parking brake shoes. 8. With the parking
brake lever in the fully applied position, attempt to hand rotate each rear tire and wheel assembly to
ensure that the parking brake
shoes are working.
9. With the parking brake lever in the released position, hand rotate each rear tire and wheel
assembly to ensure that the parking brake shoes are not
dragging.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4921
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
NOTE: This procedure applies to vehicles with rear disc brakes only.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the rear tire and wheel assembly. 3. Remove the rear disc brake
caliper assembly from the brake rotor and store it out of the way. 4. Remove rear brake rotor. 5.
Remove the dust cap from the rear hub and bearing. 6. Remove the rear hub and bearing
assembly retaining nut and washer. 7. Remove the rear hub and bearing assembly from the rear
spindle.
8. Remove the rear brake shoe assembly hold down clip. 9. Turn the brake shoe adjuster wheel
until the adjuster is at shortest length.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4922
10. Remove the adjuster assembly from the parking brake shoe assemblies.
11. Remove the lower shoe-to-shoe spring.
12. Pull the rear brake shoe away from anchor. Remove the rear brake shoe and upper return
spring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4923
13. Remove the front brake shoe hold-down clip. Remove the front brake shoe assembly.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
NOTE: This procedure applies to vehicles with rear disc brakes only.
1. Install the front brake shoe and secure it in place with a hold-down clip . 2. Install the rear brake
shoe and the upper shoe return spring. Pull the rear brake shoe over the anchor block until it is
properly located on the
adapter.
3. Install the lower shoe-to-shoe return spring. 4. Install the brake shoe adjuster assembly with the
star wheel towards the rear. 5. Install the rear brake shoe hold down clip.
6. Adjust the parking brake shoes to a diameter to 171.72 - 171.50 mm (6.75 - 6.75 inch). 7. Install
the rear hub and bearing assembly on spindle. 8. Install a new hub and bearing assembly retaining
nut. Tighten the retaining nut to a torque of 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.). 9. Install the hub and bearing dust
cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4924
10. Install the rear brake rotor. 11. Install rear disc brake caliper. 12. Install the tire and wheel
assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 13. Repeat the
above procedure to the parking brake shoes on the other side of the vehicle. 14. Adjust the parking
brake shoes as necessary. 15. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4928
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Vacuum Brake Booster: Specifications
Power Brake Booster Mounting Nuts 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
Make/Type Bosch/Vacuum
Mounting Studs M8 x 1.25
Diaphragm Size/Type 205 mm Tandem
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4933
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
There are two different power brake booster designs, although externally they appear the same. All
vehicles use a 205 mm tandem diaphragm power brake booster. The two boosters are internally
tuned differently depending on whether the vehicle is equipped with the standard front disc/rear
drum brake combination or the optional front disc/rear disc (four-wheel disc) brake combination. If
the power brake booster requires replacement, be sure it is replaced with the correct part.
The power brake booster can be identified by the tag attached to the body of the booster assembly.
This tag contains the following information: The production part number of the power brake
booster, the date it was built and who manufactured it. The power brake booster reduces the
amount of force required by the driver to obtain the necessary hydraulic pressure to stop the
vehicle.
The power brake booster is vacuum-operated. The vacuum is supplied from the intake manifold on
the engine through the power brake booster check valve.
As the brake pedal is depressed, the power booster input rod moves forward. This opens and
closes valves in the power brake booster, allowing atmospheric pressure to enter on one side of a
diaphragm. Engine vacuum is always present on the other side. This difference in pressure forces
the output rod of the power booster out against the primary piston of the master cylinder. As the
pistons in the master cylinder move forward, hydraulic pressure is created in the brake system.
The power brake vacuum booster assembly mounts on the engine side of the dash panel. The
booster input push rod connects to the brake pedal. A vacuum line connects the power booster to
the intake manifold. The master cylinder is bolted to the front of the power brake booster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4934
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - POWER BRAKE BOOSTER
BASIC TEST
1. With engine off, depress and release the brake pedal several times to purge all vacuum from the
power brake booster. 2. Depress and hold the pedal with light effort (15 to 25 lbs. pressure), then
start the engine.
The pedal should fall slightly, then hold. Less effort should be needed to apply the pedal at this
time. If the pedal fell as indicated, perform the VACUUM LEAK TEST listed after the BASIC TEST.
If the pedal did not fall, continue on with this BASIC TEST.
3. Disconnect the vacuum hose on the side of the vacuum check valve that leads to the speed
control, then connect a vacuum gauge to the open
vacuum port on the valve.
4. Start the engine. 5. When the engine is at warm operating temperature, allow it to idle and check
the vacuum at the gauge.
If the vacuum supply is 12 inches Hg (40.5 kPa) or more, the power brake booster is defective and
must be replaced. If the vacuum supply is below 12 inches, continue on with this BASIC TEST.
6. Shut off the engine. 7. Connect the vacuum gauge to the vacuum reference port on the engine
intake manifold. 8. Start the engine and observe the vacuum gauge.
If the vacuum is still low, check the engine tune and repair as necessary. If the vacuum is above 12
inches, the hose or check to the booster has a restriction or leak. Once an adequate vacuum
supply is obtained, repeat the BASIC TEST.
VACUUM LEAK TEST
1. Disconnect the vacuum hose on the side of the power brake booster vacuum check valve that
leads to the speed control, then connect a vacuum
gauge to the open vacuum port on the valve.
2. Remove the remaining hose on the vacuum check valve that is not the vacuum supply hose
coming from the intake manifold. Cap off the open port
on the check valve.
3. Start the engine. 4. Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature and engine
idle. 5. Using vacuum line pliers, close off the vacuum supply hose near the booster and observe
the vacuum gauge.
If the vacuum drop exceeds 1.0 inch Hg (3.3 kPa) in one minute, repeat the above steps to confirm
the reading. The vacuum loss should be less than 1.0 inch Hg in one minute time span. If the loss
is more than 1.0 inch Hg, replace the power brake booster. If it is not, continue on with this test.
6. Remove the pliers from the hose temporarily. 7. Apply light effort (approximately 15 lbs. of force)
to the brake pedal and hold the pedal steady. Do not move the pedal once the pressure is applied
or the test results may vary.
8. Have an assistant reattach the pliers to the vacuum supply hose. 9. Allow 5 seconds for
stabilization, then observe the vacuum gauge.
If the vacuum drop exceeds 3.0 inches Hg (10 kPa) in 15 seconds, repeat the above steps to
confirm the reading. The vacuum loss should be less than 3.0 inches Hg in 15 seconds time span.
If the loss is more than 3.0 inches Hg, replace the power brake booster. If it is not, the booster is
not defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive)
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive)
REMOVAL - LHD
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Disconnect negative (ground) cable from the battery and isolate the cable. 2. Disconnect the
positive cable from the battery, then remove the battery from the battery tray. There is one nut
securing the clamp on the backside
of the battery holding it in place.
3. Remove the one nut and one bolt securing the air cleaner box in place, then disconnect the
wiring harness connector at the air inlet sensor.
4. Lift the air cleaner box upward enough to clear its grommeted alignment post, then move the air
cleaner box forward just enough to access the
battery tray mounting bolts.
5. Remove the 2 bolts, then the 2 nuts mounting the battery tray to its bracket. Remove the battery
tray.
CAUTION: The vacuum in the power brake booster must be pumped down before removing the
master cylinder to prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination. This can be done by
pumping the brake pedal 4-5 times while the engine is not running until a firm brake pedal is
achieved.
6. Remove the master cylinder. 7. If the vehicle is equipped with ABS, remove the Integrated
Control Unit (ICU). 8. If the vehicle is equipped with ABS, remove the three bolts securing the ICU
mounting bracket to the frame rail.
9. Disconnect the vacuum hoses from the check valve on the power brake booster, but do not
remove the check valve from Dower brake booster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive) > Page 4937
10. Locate the brake pedal-to-power brake booster input rod attachment under the instrument
panel. Position a small screwdriver under the center tang
of the retaining clip. Rotate the screwdriver enough to allow the retaining clip tang to pass over the
end of the brake pedal pin. Remove the clip.
CAUTION: Discard the used retaining clip, it is not to be reused. Replace the clip with a new one
on reassembly.
11. Remove the four nuts attaching the power brake booster to the instrument panel. The nuts are
accessible from under the instrument panel in the
area of the brake pedal bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive) > Page 4938
12. Slide the power brake booster forward until mounting studs clear the instrument panel. Turn the
booster sideways, then remove it from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - LHD
1. Turn the power brake booster sideways, then install it into the engine compartment down past
the heater hoses and the strut tower. Rotate the
booster so its four mounting studs and input rod are pointed straight toward the instrument panel.
Slide the input rod and studs through the instrument panel and into mounting position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive) > Page 4939
2. Under the instrument panel, install the four power brake booster mounting nuts. Tighten the nuts
to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). 3. Using lubriplate, or an equivalent, coat the surface of the brake
pedal pin where it contacts the brake booster input rod.
CAUTION: Use only a new brake booster input rod to-brake pedal retaining clip to ensure proper retainment.
- Install a new brake lamp switch anytime the old switch is removed, the brake booster or pedals
have been changed or removed.
4. Connect the power brake booster input rod-to brake pedal pin. Install a new retaining clip. Do not
use the old clip. 5. Install and adjust a new brake lamp switch.
6. Connect all previously removed vacuum hoses to the vacuum check valve. 7. If the vehicle is
equipped with ABS, install the ICU mounting bracket on the frame rail using its three bolts. Tighten
the nuts to a torque of 23 Nm
(200 in. lbs.).
8. If the vehicle is equipped with ABS, reinstall the ICU. 9. Install the master cylinder.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive) > Page 4940
10. Position the battery tray back in place. Install the two bolts, then the two nuts mounting the
battery tray to its bracket. Tighten the two bolts and
nuts to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.)
11. Reinstall the air cleaner box onto its grommeted alignment post. 12. Install the one nut and one
bolt securing the air cleaner box in place, then connect the wiring harness connector at the air inlet
sensor. 13. Install the battery and clamp it in place. 14. Connect the positive, then the negative
(ground) cable on the battery. 15. Bleed the base brake system. 16. Road test the vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the brakes.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive) > Page 4941
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair Removal and Installation (Right Hand Drive)
REMOVAL - RHD
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
CAUTION: Pump the brake pedal several times to relieve the vacuum in the power brake booster.
This will prevent the booster from sucking in any contamination when the master cylinder is
removed.
2. Remove the master cylinder from the vehicle. 3. Remove the air cleaner assembly. 4. Remove
the battery and battery tray from the vehicle. 5. Remove the heater core coolant supply tube
support bracket bolts. 6. Remove the (2) coolant reservoir retaining bolts from the dash panel.
Disconnect the coolant overflow hose from the thermostat housing and
remove the coolant reservoir from the dash panel.
7. Working from underneath the instrument panel, disconnect the brake pedal push rod. Remove
the retaining clip from the end of the brake pedal
mounted stud, then slide the push rod straight off the pin.
8. If equipped, disconnect the clutch pedal push rod. Depress the plastic retention clip on the end
of the clutch pedal mounted stud, while sliding the
push rod straight off the stud.
9. Rotate the clutch master cylinder to line up the square shaped retaining boss with the square
shaped opening in the brake pedal support bracket.
10. Remove the (4) brake booster retaining nuts. 11. Working from inside the engine compartment,
remove the (2) clutch fluid reservoir retaining bolts from the dash panel. 12. Remove the clutch
master cylinder from the dash panel by pulling it straight out. Position the reservoir and line
assembly out of the way. 13. Remove the brake booster from the dash panel by pulling it straight
out, then rotate the booster and slide it between the engine and the dash panel
towards the battery tray. Slide the booster under the heater core coolant supply hoses and out of
the engine bay.
INSTALLATION - RHD
1. Position the brake booster on the dash panel by reversing the path taken to remove the booster.
Slide the booster under the plenum on the battery
tray side of the engine compartment. Slide the booster between the engine and dash panel until it
can be installed on the right side of the dash panel.
2. Reinstall the vacuum supply hose on the booster check valve. Make sure the booster check
valve is firmly seated in the rubber grommet and did
not become dislodged during the booster installation.
3. If equipped, install the clutch master cylinder through the dash panel. 4. Install the clutch fluid
reservoir. Torque the retaining bolts to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.). 5. Working from underneath the
instrument panel, install the four brake booster retaining nuts. Torque the nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft.
lbs.). 6. Grease the brake pedal pin and slide the brake booster push rod onto the pedal pin. Install
the retaining clip. 7. If equipped, lock the clutch master cylinder in position. Rotate the clutch
master cylinder to line up the square shaped retaining boss with the
square shaped opening in the brake pedal support bracket. Once the cylinder is inserted through
the brake pedal support bracket rotate 90° to lock it in position.
8. Connect the clutch pedal push rod. Slide the push rod on the clutch pedal mounted stud until the
plastic retention clip locks it in place.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation (Left Hand Drive) > Page 4942
9. Install the coolant reservoir. Torque the retaining bolts to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.). Connect the coolant
overflow hose on the thermostat housing.
10. Install the heater core coolant supply tube support bracket bolts. Torque the bolts to 36 Nm (27
ft. lbs.). 11. Install the battery and battery tray in the vehicle. 12. Install the air cleaner assembly.
13. Install the master cylinder on the vehicle. 14. Fill the brake fluid reservoir to specification. 15.
Bleed the air from the brake hydraulic system.
WARNING: Be certain a firm brake pedal is achieved before attempting to move the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Fig.1 Integrated Control Unit (ICU)
The CAB is mounted to the ICU as part of the Integrated Control Unit (ICU).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4947
Controller Antilock Brake
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4948
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle.
Fig.3 CAB Mounting
3. Disconnect pump/motor connector from CAB. 4. Remove four screws securing CAB to HCU half
of ICU. Remove CAB from HCU. 5. Pull outward on CAB connector lock and disconnect 24-way
wiring connector. Remove CAB from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect 24-way wiring connector to CAB and push in connector lock. 2. Align CAB with HCU
half of ICU, then slide CAB up over HCU valves. Install four CAB mounting screws. Tighten
mounting screws to 2 Nm (17
in. lbs.) torque.
3. Connect pump/motor connector. 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Connect battery negative cable. 6. Connect
DRBIII to vehicle to initialize system. Check and clear any faults.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4953
Fig. 37 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4954
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4955
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4956
Brake Fluid Level Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4957
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: An abnormal loss of brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir could be caused by
a leak in the hydraulic system. The entire brake hydraulic system should be checked for evidence
of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4958
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The brake fluid level switch is located in the left side of the brake fluid reservoir on the master
cylinder. It is clipped into the reservoir. It can be removed from the reservoir and replaced if
necessary.
OPERATION
The purpose of the brake fluid level switch is to provide the driver with an early warning that the
brake fluid level in the master cylinder reservoir has dropped below an acceptable level.
As the fluid drops below the designed level, the fluid level switch closes and grounds the red
BRAKE warning indicator circuit. This turns on the red BRAKE warning indicator. At this time, the
master cylinder brake fluid reservoir must be checked and filled to the full mark with DOT 3 brake
fluid. Check the entire brake hydraulic system for evidence of a leak.
CAUTION: An abnormal loss of brake fluid in the master cylinder fluid reservoir could be caused by
a leak in the hydraulic system. The entire brake hydraulic system should be checked for evidence
of a leak.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4959
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Remove the vehicle wiring harness connector from brake fluid level switch in master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir.
2. Push together the retaining tabs holding the brake fluid level switch in place in the brake fluid
reservoir. 3. Pull the brake fluid level switch out the other side of the reservoir.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Align the brake fluid level switch with its mounting hole on the left side of the master cylinder
brake fluid reservoir. Push the switch into the fluid
reservoir until the switch retaining tabs are expanded on the other side of the reservoir, locking it in
place.
2. Connect the brake fluid level switch wiring connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4963
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
ABS Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Screw
...................................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (105
in. lbs.)
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR AIR GAP
Front Sensor ........................................................................................................................................
......................... 0.28 - 1.42 mm (0.011 - 0.056 in.) Rear Sensor ........................................................
.......................................................................................................... 0.45 - 1.12 mm (0.018 - 0.044
in.)
TONE WHEEL RUNOUT
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
................................................................. 0.009 in. Rear ....................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.009
in.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
TONE WHEELS
FRONT
REAR
WHEEL SPEED SENSORS
FRONT
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4969
REAR
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4970
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4971
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4972
Fig. 5 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4973
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4974
Fig. 37 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4975
Fig. 38 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4976
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4977
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4978
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor
Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Tone Wheel
TONE WHEEL
DESCRIPTION
The tone wheel is used in conjunction with the wheel speed sensors.
OPERATION
The tone wheel is used in conjunction with the wheel speed sensors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 4981
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Wheel Speed Sensor
Front
FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Mark 20e system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed sensors.
The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto resistive to help increase performance
and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A wheel speed sensor
is used at each wheel. The gear (tooth) type tone wheel serves as the trigger mechanism for each
sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one tone wheel.
The front wheel speed sensors are attached to bosses in the steering knuckle. The tone wheel is
an integral part of the outboard constant velocity joint located in the front axle shaft.
WSS air gaps are not adjustable. The initial factory WSS air gap specification can be found in
SPECIFICATIONS. Each WSS is serviced individually. The tone wheels are serviced as Dart of the
drive shaft.
OPERATION
The CAB sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the CAB. The
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 4982
relationship of the tooth on the tone wheel to the permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to
enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output of the sensor, sent to the CAB, is a DC voltage
signal with changing voltage and current levels. The ground for the IC and the current sense circuit
is provided by the CAB.
When a valley of the tone wheel is aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8
volts and a constant 7 mA current is sent to the CAB. As the tone wheel rotates, the tooth shifts the
magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The CAB senses a voltage signal
of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The CAB measures the amperage of the digital signal for
each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABS CAB as the wheel speed.
Rear
REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
DESCRIPTION
The Mark 20e system uses two-wire wheel speed sensors, known as active wheel speed sensors.
The sensors use an electronic principle known as magneto resistive to help increase performance
and durability. The sensors convert wheel speed into a small digital signal. A wheel speed sensor
is used at each wheel. The gear (tooth) type tone wheel serves as the trigger mechanism for each
sensor. At each wheel of the vehicle there is one wheel speed sensor and one tone wheel.
The rear wheel speed sensors are mounted through the disc brake adapter. The rear tone wheels
are mounted to and rotate with the hub and bearing assemblies.
The WSS air gaps are not adjustable. The initial factory WSS air gap specification can be found in
SPECIFICATIONS. Each WSS is serviced
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Tone Wheel > Page 4983
individually. The tone wheels are serviced as an assembly with the hub and bearing assemblies.
OPERATION
The CAB sends 12 volts to power an Integrated Circuit (IC) in the sensor. The IC supplies a
constant 7 mA power supply to the CAB. The relationship of the tooth on the tone wheel to the
permanent magnet in the sensor, signals the IC to enable a second 7 mA power supply. The output
of the sensor, sent to the CAB, is a DC voltage signal with changing voltage and current levels. The
ground for the IC and the current sense circuit is provided by the CAB.
When a valley of the tone wheel is aligned with the sensor, the voltage signal is approximately 0.8
volts and a constant 7 mA current is sent to the CAB. As the tone wheel rotates, the tooth shifts the
magnetic field and the IC enables a second 7 mA current source. The CAB senses a voltage signal
of approximately 1.6 volts and 14 mA. The CAB measures the amperage of the digital signal for
each wheel. The resulting signal is interpreted by the ABS CAB as the wheel speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4984
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
TONE WHEEL
INSPECTION
Tone wheels can cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. Inspect tone wheels for the following
possible causes: missing, chipped, or broken teeth
- contact with the wheel speed sensor
- wheel speed sensor to tone wheel alignment
- wheel speed sensor to tone wheel clearance
- excessive tone wheel runout
- tone wheel loose on its mounting surface
If a front tone wheel is found to need replacement, the drive shaft must be replaced. No attempt
should be made to replace just the tone wheel. If a rear tone wheel is found to need replacement,
the rear hub and bearing must be replaced. No attempt should be made to replace just the tone
wheel. If wheel speed sensor to tone wheel contact is evident, determine the cause and correct it
before replacing the wheel speed sensor or tone wheel. Check the gap between the speed sensor
head and the tone wheel to ensure it is within specifications. Excessive tone wheel runout can
cause erratic wheel speed sensor signals. If tone wheel runout is excessive, determine if it is
caused by a defect in the driveshaft assembly or hub and bearing. Replace as necessary. Tone
wheels are pressed onto their mounting surfaces and should not rotate independently from the
mounting surface. Replace the front driveshaft or rear hub and bearing as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector from the wiring harness on the inside of the
frame rail above the front suspension
crossmember. The connector has a locking tab which that must be pulled back before the
connector release tang can be depressed, releasing the connection.
3. If the sensor being removed is a left front, unclip the speed sensor cable from the brake tube on
the inside of and under the frame rail. 4. Remove the speed sensor cable grommet from the
retaining bracket attached to the brake hose on the outside of the frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4987
5. Remove the bolt mounting the wheel speed sensor head to the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: When removing a wheel speed sensor from the knuckle, do not use pliers on the sensor
head. This may damage the sensor head. If the sensor has seized, use a hammer and a punch to
tap the edge of the sensor head ear, rocking the sensor side-to-side until free.
6. Carefully, remove the sensor head from the steering knuckle.
7. Remove the screw securing the wheel speed sensor to the rear of the strut. Remove the wheel
speed sensor.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed,
and clipped properly.
1. Attach the wheel speed sensor to the strut using the its mounting screw. 2. Install the wheel
speed sensor head in the steering knuckle. Install the mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolt to a
torque of 12 Nm (105 inch
lbs.).
3. From the sensor bracket on the strut, loop the sensor cable upward, then downward at the
outside of the frame rail. Install the speed sensor cable
grommet onto the retaining bracket attached to the brake hose on the outside of the frame rail.
4. Loop the wheel speed sensor cable around the bottom of the frame rail and connect it to the
wiring harness connector on the inside of the frame
rail. Remember to push in the locking tab on the connector.
5. If the sensor being installed is the left front, clip the speed sensor cable to the brake tube on the
inside of and under the frame rail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4988
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Road test vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base brakes and ABS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4989
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable connector from the vehicle wiring harness. Remove
the clip attaching wheel speed sensor cable connector
to the vehicle's body.
3. Remove the wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket from under rear brake flex hose mounting
bracket. Then remove the speed sensor cable from
the routing clips on the rear brake flex hose and chassis brake tube.
4. Remove the bolt attaching the wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket to rear strut.
CAUTION: When removing a wheel speed sensor from the rear disc brake adapter, do not use
pliers on the sensor head. This may damage the sensor head. If the sensor has seized, use a
hammer and a punch to tap the edge of the sensor head ear, rocking the sensor side-to-side until
free.
5. Remove the bolt attaching the wheel speed sensor to the rear disc brake adapter, then carefully
remove the sensor head from the rear disc brake
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4990
adapter and vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to WARNING.
CAUTION: Failure to install speed sensor cables properly may result in contact with moving parts
or an over extension of cables causing an open circuit. Be sure that cables are installed, routed,
and clipped properly.
1. Install the wheel speed sensor head into the disc brake adapter. 2. Install the wheel speed
sensor mounting bolt. Tighten the mounting bolt to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.). 3. Install the
wheel speed sensor cable routing bracket on the rear strut. 4. Install wheel speed sensor cable into
the routing clips on the rear brake hose and brake tube. 5. Connect the wheel speed sensor cable
connector into vehicle wiring harness. Install the clip attaching the wheel speed sensor cable
connector to
vehicle's body.
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Road test the vehicle to ensure proper operation of the base brakes and
ABS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4997
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4998
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4999
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5000
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5005
Clutch Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5006
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5007
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5008
Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch (MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5009
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
DESCRIPTION - LHD The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two
switches: an engine starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 13). The
switch assembly is located in the clutch/brake pedal bracket assembly (Fig. 14), each switch being
fastened by four plastic wing tabs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5010
DESCRIPTION - RHD The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 15) consists of a single,
multi-function switch that is activated by hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod travel.
OPERATION - CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH The clutch interlock switch prevents engine starter
operation and inadvertent vehicle movement with the clutch pedal in the up position (not
depressed), or under normal conditions with the clutch engaged and the transaxle in gear.
WARNING: WHEN THERE IS A LOSS OF CLUTCH SYSTEM HYDRAULIC FLUID, OR THE
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
PUSHROD IS DISCONNECTED FROM THE PEDAL LEVER, THE ENGINE MAY START WITH
THE CLUTCH ENGAGED, CAUSING UNDESIRABLE VEHICLE MOVEMENT IF THE
TRANSAXLE IS IN ANY GEAR.
The switch is open while the clutch pedal is at rest or in the up position. When the clutch pedal is
fully depressed on LHD models, the clutch pedal lever closes the switch, completing the signal
circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter operation. When the
clutch pedal is fully depressed on RHD models, the master cylinder push rod closes the switch,
completing the signal circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter
operation. The interlock switch is not adjustable.
OPERATION - CLUTCH PEDAL UPSTOP SWITCH With the clutch pedal at rest, the clutch pedal
upstop switch is closed, allowing speed control operation. When the clutch pedal is depressed, the
upstop switch opens and signals the PCM to cancel speed control operation, and enter a modified
engine calibration schedule to improve driveability during gear-to-gear shifts. The upstop switch is
not adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Service Diagnosis
SERVICE DIAGNOSIS - CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two switches: an engine
starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 16).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 5013
The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 17) consists of a single, multi-function switch that is
activated by the hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 5014
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Clutch Interlock Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, turn the ignition key to the start position.
The engine starter should not crank with the
clutch pedal at rest (not depressed). If the starter cranks, proceed to the electrical test to determine
whether the switch is defective or the circuit is shorted. If the vehicle does not crank, proceed to the
next step.
2. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, fully depress the clutch pedal and turn
the ignition key to the start position. The engine
starter should crank. If the starter does not crank, visually inspect the clutch pedal for obstructions
(floor mat, etc.). Make sure the clutch pedal lever contacts and fully closes the switch on LHD
applications, and for proper installation of the master cylinder push rod/bushing on the pedal pin on
RHD applications.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 2 & 3 (Fig. 18) with the interlock
switch not depressed (clutch pedal at rest). There
should be no continuity between the terminals (open circuit).
5. LHD Models: Fully depress the clutch pedal to close the switch. The switch button should
compress at least 1.25 mm (0.050 inch) on LHD
applications. The ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms resistance). RHD Models: Disconnect
the push rod from the pedal pin and actuate the push rod by hand to close the switch. The
ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms). Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is
damaged (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced before reinstalling the push rod to the pedal.
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly, or the pedal bracket
assembly, is defective and should be replaced. If
the switch tests ok, wiring is defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 5015
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Upstop Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
UPSTOP SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Start engine and operate speed control to maintain speed. 3. Depress
clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch). Speed control operation should terminate. If speed control
does not terminate, the upstop switch
is defective or the related wiring is shorted. Proceed to the upstop switch electrical test.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2 (Fig. 18) with the upstop switch
depressed (clutch pedal at rest). The ohmmeter
should show continuity (0 ohms).
5. Depress the clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch) check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2.
There should be no continuity between the
terminals (open circuit).
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly is defective and
should be replaced. If the switch tests ok, wiring is
defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - LHD
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable.
2. Remove left lower instrument panel bezel (Fig. 19). 3. Disconnect upstop switch and brake lamp
switch connectors. 4. Disconnect clutch master cylinder rod from clutch pedal pin. Inspect plastic
retainer upon removal. If retainer is damaged, it MUST be replaced.
5. Remove brake booster push rod retaining clip from brake pedal. Disengage rod from pedal (Fig.
20).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 5018
6. Remove two pedal assembly bracket to instrument panel nuts (Fig. 21). 7. Remove four brake
booster/pedal bracket-to-cowl panel nuts (Fig. 21). 8. From under the hood, pull brake master
cylinder/booster far enough forward to obtain pedal to bracket stud clearance. 9. Remove the pedal
bracket assembly (Fig. 21).
10. Remove pedal pivot shaft and remove brake and clutch pedals.
11. Remove the interlock/upstop switch assembly (Fig. 22) from the brake/clutch pedal bracket
assembly by depressing the four plastic wing tabs on
each switch.
INSTALLATION - LHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 5019
contacting pedals.
1. Install switches into the pedal bracket assembly as shown in (Fig. 22). Route harness as was
prior to removal. Secure switch connector retaining
push pin into the appropriate hole in the pedal bracket assembly.
2. Install clutch and brake pedals to pedal bracket, and install pivot shaft and nut. Torque pivot
shaft nut to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.). 3. Install brake/clutch pedal bracket assembly into position. Install
and tighten brake booster mounting nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). Install and tighten
pedal bracket-to-instrument panel nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
4. Install new stop lamp switch. 5. Connect brake booster rod to brake pedal. Install retainer clip
(Fig. 20).
6. Loosen adjustment screw (Fig. 24).
CAUTION: Inspect clutch master cylinder pushrod plastic retainer. If retainer is damaged in any
way (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced.
7. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod. Gently lift clutch pedal upwards until the clutch pedal
fully depresses the upstop switch. Torque
adjustment screw to 6 Nm (55 inch lbs.).
8. Connect interlock/upstop and stop lamp switch connectors. 9. Install left lower instrument panel
bezel (Fig. 19).
10. Connect battery negative cable. 11. Verify proper switch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 5020
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - RHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - RHD
1. Disconnect the master cylinder push rod from the pedal pin (Fig. 23). Inspect push rod retainer
for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
must be replaced.
2. Squeeze together the tangs on the switch cover plate and slide the plate off the switch housing.
3. Disconnect the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector from the instrument panel wiring
harness. 4. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - RHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
contacting pedals.
1. Install the clutch interlock/upstop switch onto the master cylinder push rod, making sure that the
push rod is oriented with the push rod retainer
toward the wiring of the switch. The master cylinder push rod must be snapped into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch along the smaller diameter of the push rod between the snap ring and the
transition to the larger diameter.
CAUTION: Improper assembly of the larger diameter of the push rod into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch could cause damage to the switch or a
clutch system failure.
2. Install the switch cover plate.
CAUTION: Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
MUST be replaced.
3. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod to the clutch pedal pin. 4. Route the wiring harness as it
was prior to removal. 5. Secure the switch connector retaining push pin into the appropriate hole in
the pedal bracket assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5029
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5030
Starter Motor Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5031
Starter Relay: Description and Operation
The Starter Relay is a micro relay located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), positioned in the
left front corner of the engine compartment.
As battery power is applied to the relay from the ignition switch, battery power is applied to the
starter motor through the relay to the starter solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5032
Starter Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer to the PDC cover for relay
location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions
> Technician Safety Information
Jump Starting: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: DO NOT JUMP START A FROZEN BATTERY, PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
DO NOT JUMP START WHEN MAINTENANCE FREE BATTERY INDICATOR DOT IS YELLOW
OR BRIGHT COLOR. DO NOT JUMP START A VEHICLE WHEN THE BATTERY FLUID IS
BELOW THE TOP OF LEAD PLATES. DO NOT ALLOW JUMPER CABLE CLAMPS TO TOUCH
EACH OTHER WHEN CONNECTED TO A BOOSTER SOURCE. DO NOT USE OPEN FLAME
NEAR BATTERY. REMOVE METALLIC JEWELRY WORN ON HANDS OR WRISTS TO AVOID
INJURY BY ACCIDENTAL ARCING OF BATTERY CURRENT. WHEN USING A HIGH OUTPUT
BOOSTING DEVICE, DO NOT ALLOW BATTERY VOLTAGE TO EXCEED 16 VOLTS. REFER
TO INSTRUCTIONS PROVIDED WITH DEVICE BEING USED.
CAUTION: Do not crank starter motor on disabled vehicle for more than 15 seconds, starter will
overheat and could fail.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions
> Technician Safety Information > Page 5038
Jump Starting: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- When using another vehicle as a booster, do not allow vehicles to touch. Electrical systems can
be damaged on either vehicle.
- If the cause of starting problem on disabled vehicle is severe, damage to booster vehicle charging
system can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions
> Page 5039
Jump Starting: Service and Repair
STANDAD PROCEDURE - JUMP STARTING
WARNING: DO NOT JUMP START A FROZEN BATTERY, PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
DO NOT JUMP START WHEN MAINTENANCE FREE BATTERY INDICATOR DOT IS YELLOW
OR BRIGHT COLOR. DO NOT JUMP START A VEHICLE WHEN THE BATTERY FLUID IS
BELOW THE TOP OF LEAD PLATES. DO NOT ALLOW JUMPER CABLE CLAMPS TO TOUCH
EACH OTHER WHEN CONNECTED TO A BOOSTER SOURCE. DO NOT USE OPEN FLAME
NEAR BATTERY. REMOVE METALLIC JEWELRY WORN ON HANDS OR WRISTS TO AVOID
INJURY BY ACCIDENTAL ARCING OF BATTERY CURRENT. WHEN USING A HIGH OUTPUT
BOOSTING DEVICE, DO NOT ALLOW BATTERY VOLTAGE TO EXCEED 16 VOLTS. REFER
TO INSTRUCTIONS PROVIDED WITH DEVICE BEING USED.
CAUTION: When using another vehicle as a booster, do not allow vehicles to touch. Electrical
systems can be damaged on either vehicle.
TO JUMP START A DISABLED VEHICLE:
1. Raise hood on disabled vehicle and visually inspect engine compartment for:
- Battery cable clamp condition, clean if necessary
- Frozen battery.
- Yellow or bright color test indicator, if equipped.
- Low battery fluid level.
- Generator drive belt condition and tension.
- Fuel fumes or leakage, correct if necessary
CAUTION: If the cause of starting problem on disabled vehicle is severe, damage to booster
vehicle charging system can result.
2. When using another vehicle as a booster source, park the booster vehicle within cable reach.
Turn OFF all accessories, set the parking brake, place
the automatic transmission in PARK or the manual transmission in NEUTRAL and turn the ignition
OFF.
3. On disabled vehicle, place gear selector in park or neutral and set park brake. Turn OFF all
accessories. 4. Connect jumper cables to booster battery. RED clamp to positive terminal (+).
BLACK clamp to negative terminal (-). DO NOT allow clamps at
opposite end of cables to touch, electrical arc will result. Review all warnings in this procedure.
Fig. 6 Jumper Cable Clamp Connections
5. On disabled vehicle, connect RED jumper cable clamp to positive (+) terminal. Connect BLACK
jumper cable clamp to engine ground as close to
the ground cable attaching point as possible (Fig. 6).
6. Start the engine in the vehicle which has the booster battery, let the engine idle a few minutes,
then start the engine in the vehicle with the
discharged battery.
CAUTION: Do not crank starter motor on disabled vehicle for more than 15 seconds, starter will
overheat and could fail.
7. Allow battery in disabled vehicle to charge to at least 12.4 volts (75% charge) before attempting
to start engine. If engine does not start within 15
seconds, stop cranking engine and allow starter to cool (15 minutes), before cranking again.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Jump Starting > System Information > Service Precautions
> Page 5040
Disconnect Cable Clamps As Follows: Disconnect BLACK cable clamp from engine ground on disabled vehicle.
- When using a Booster vehicle, disconnect BLACK cable clamp from battery negative terminal.
Disconnect RED cable clamp from battery positive terminal
- Disconnect RED cable clamp from battery positive terminal on disabled vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Battery Cable: Description and Operation
The battery cables are large gauge, stranded copper wires sheathed within a heavy plastic or
synthetic rubber insulating jacket. The wire used in the battery cables combines excellent flexibility
and reliability with high electrical current carrying capacity. The battery cables feature a clamping
type female battery terminal made of soft lead that is die cast onto one end of the battery cable
wire. A square headed pinch-bolt and hex nut are installed at the open end of the female battery
terminal clamp. Large eyelet type terminals are crimped onto the opposite end of the battery cable
wire and then solder-dipped. The battery positive cable wires have a red insulating jacket to
provide visual identification and feature a larger female battery terminal clamp to allow connection
to the larger battery positive terminal post. The battery negative cable wires have a black insulating
jacket and a smaller female battery terminal clamp.
The battery cables cannot be repaired and, if damaged or faulty they must be replaced. Both the
battery positive and negative cables are available for service replacement only as a unit with the
battery wire harness, which may include portions of the wiring circuits for the generator and other
components on some models.
The battery cables connect the battery terminal posts to the vehicle electrical system. These cables
also provide a path back to the battery for electrical current generated by the charging system for
restoring the voltage potential of the battery. The female battery terminal clamps on the ends of the
battery cable wires provide a strong and reliable connection of the battery cable to the battery
terminal posts. The terminal pinch bolts allow the female terminal clamps to be tightened around
the male terminal posts on the top of the battery. The eyelet terminals secured to the opposite ends
of the battery cable wires from the female battery terminal clamps provide secure and reliable
connection of the battery cables to the vehicle electrical system.
The battery positive cable terminal clamp is die cast onto the ends of two wires. One wire has an
eyelet terminal that connects the battery positive cable to the B(+) terminal stud of the Power
Distribution Center (PDC), and the other wire has an eyelet terminal that connects the battery
positive cable to the B(+) terminal stud of the engine starter motor solenoid. The battery negative
cable terminal clamp is also die cast onto the ends of two wires. One wire has an eyelet terminal
that connects the battery negative cable to the vehicle powertrain through a stud on the right side
of the engine cylinder block. The other wire has an eyelet terminal that connects the battery
negative cable to the vehicle body through a ground screw on the right front fender inner shield,
near the battery.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5044
Battery Cable: Testing and Inspection
A voltage drop test will determine if there is excessive resistance in the battery cable terminal
connections or the battery cable. If excessive resistance is found in the battery cable connections,
the connection point should be disassembled, cleaned of all corrosion or foreign material, then
reassembled. Following reassembly, check the voltage drop for the battery cable connection and
the battery cable again to confirm repair.
When performing the voltage drop test, it is important to remember that the voltage drop is giving
an indication of the resistance between the two points at which the voltmeter probes are attached.
EXAMPLE: When testing the resistance of the battery positive cable, touch the voltmeter leads to
the battery positive cable terminal clamp and to the battery positive cable eyelet terminal at the
starter solenoid B(+) terminal stud. If you probe the battery positive terminal post and the battery
positive cable eyelet terminal at the starter solenoid B(+) terminal stud, you are reading the
combined voltage drop in the battery positive cable terminal clamp-to-terminal post connection and
the battery positive cable.
Voltage Drop Test
The following operation will require a voltmeter accurate to 1/10 (0.10) volt. Before performing this
test, be certain that the following procedures are accomplished: The battery is fully-charged and load tested. Refer to Standard Procedures for the proper battery
charging and load test procedures.
- Fully engage the parking brake.
- If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, place the gearshift selector lever in the
Park position. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, place the gearshift selector
lever in the Neutral position and block the clutch pedal in the fully depressed position.
- Verify that all lamps and accessories are turned OFF.
- To prevent the engine from starting, remove the Automatic Shut Down (ASD) relay. The ASD
relay is located in the Power Distribution Center ( PDC), in the engine compartment. See the fuse
and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for ASD relay identification and
location.
Fig.9 Test Battery Negative Connection Resistance - Typical
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the battery negative terminal post. Connect the
negative lead of the voltmeter to the battery negative
cable terminal clamp (Fig. 9). Rotate and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe the
voltmeter. If voltage is detected, correct the poor connection between the battery negative cable
terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal post.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5045
Fig.10 Test Battery Positive Connection Resistance - Typical
2. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the battery positive terminal post. Connect the
negative lead of the voltmeter to the battery positive
cable terminal clamp (Fig. 10). Rotate and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe the
voltmeter. If voltage is detected, correct the poor connection between the battery positive cable
terminal clamp and the battery positive terminal post.
Fig.11 Test Battery Positive Cable Resistance - Typical
3. Connect the voltmeter to measure between the battery positive cable terminal clamp and the
starter solenoid B(+) terminal stud (Fig. 11). Rotate
and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe the voltmeter. If the reading is above 0.2
volt, clean and tighten the battery positive cable eyelet terminal connection at the starter solenoid
B(+) terminal stud. Repeat the test. If the reading is still above 0.2 volt, replace the faulty battery
positive cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5046
Fig.12 Test Ground Circuit Resistance - Typical
4. Connect the voltmeter to measure between the battery negative cable terminal clamp and a
good clean ground on the engine block (Fig. 12). Rotate
and hold the ignition switch in the Start position. Observe the voltmeter. If the reading is above 0.2
volt, clean and tighten the battery negative cable eyelet terminal connection to the engine block.
Repeat the test. If the reading is still above 0.2 volt, replace the faulty battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5047
Battery Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. Be certain that all electrical accessories are turned
OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the remote battery negative cable terminal. 3. Remove the battery
from the vehicle. 4. One at a time, trace the battery cable retaining pushpins, fasteners and routing
clips until the cables are free from the vehicle. 5. Remove the battery cables from the engine
compartment.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the battery cables in the engine compartment. 2. One at a time, install the battery cable
retaining pushpins, fasteners and routing clips until the cables are installed exactly where they
were in the
vehicle.
3. Install the battery in the vehicle. 4. Connect the remote battery negative cable terminal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 5052
Battery Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 5053
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5054
Battery Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5055
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Inlet Air Temperature Sensor
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The IAT sensor attaches to the intake air duct (Fig. 1).
The IAT Sensor is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) Sensor that provides information to
the PCM regarding the temperature of the air entering the intake manifold. The PCM sends 5 volts
to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As temperature increases, resistance
in the sensor decreases.
Inlet/Intake Air Temperature
The inlet air temperature sensor replaces the intake air temperature sensor and the battery
temperature sensor. The PCM uses the information from the inlet air temperature sensor along with
other stored parameters to determine values to use as an intake air temperature and a battery
temperature. The IAT sensor value is used by the PCM to determine air density.
The PCM uses this information to calculate: Injector pulse width
- Adjustment of ignition timing (to prevent spark knock at high intake air temperatures)
Battery Temperature
The battery temperature information along with data from monitored line voltage (B+), is used by
the PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures
and is gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The battery temperature information is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II
monitors are either enabled or disabled depending upon the battery temperature sensor input
(example: disable purge, enable LDP). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20 °F.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Tray > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Holddown
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Holddown
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the single battery hold down
retaining bolt. 3. Remove the battery hold down from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the battery hold down in the vehicle. 2. Install the single battery hold down retaining bolt 3.
Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Tray > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Holddown > Page 5060
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Tray
REMOVAL
1. Remove the battery from the vehicle.
Fig.13 Battery Tray Removal
2. Remove two nuts to the rear and two bolts to the front of the battery tray (Fig. 13). 3. Remove
the tray retaining bolt under the center of the tray. 4. Slide battery tray out form under the air
cleaner assembly Do not remove the air cleaner assembly 5. Remove battery tray from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide battery tray in under the air cleaner assembly 2. Install two nuts at the rear and two bolts at
the front of the battery tray. 3. Install the bolt located under the tray. 4. Install the battery in the
vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Alternator: Electrical Specifications
TYPE ...................................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Mitsubishi
PART NUMBER ..................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 4794222AC
RATED SAE AMPS .............................................................................................................................
................................................................... 85 amps
MINIMUM TEST AMPS .......................................................................................................................
.................................................................
75 amps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5066
Alternator: Mechanical Specifications
Generator Mounting Bolt .....................................................................................................................
......................................................54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Generator Pivot Bolt ............................................................................................................................
......................................................54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5069
Generator
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Connector Views
Generator
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5072
Alternator: Description and Operation
The generator is belt-driven by the engine. It is serviced only as a complete assembly. If the
generator fails for any reason, the entire assembly must be replaced. The generator produces DC
voltage.
As the energized rotor begins to rotate within the generator, the spinning magnetic field induces a
current into the windings of the stator coil.
The Y type stator winding connections deliver the induced AC current to 3 positive and 3 negative
diodes for rectification. From the diodes, rectified DC current is delivered to the vehicles electrical
system through the generator, battery, and ground terminals.
Noise emitting from the generator may be caused by:
- Worn, loose or defective bearings
- Loose or defective drive pulley
- Incorrect, worn, damaged or misadjusted drive belt
- Loose mounting bolts
- Misaligned drive pulley
- Defective stator or diode
- Damaged internal fins
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5073
Alternator: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.2 Battery Cable
1. Disconnect battery negative cable (Fig. 2). 2. Loosen the jam nut and adjustment bolt. 3. Raise
vehicle and support.
Fig.3 Splash Shield And Belt
4. Remove accessary drive splash shield (Fig. 3). 5. Loosen the lower mounting bolt. 6. Remove
the generator drive belt. 7. Disconnect the generator field circuit wiring connector. Push the RED
locking tab to release. 8. Remove the B+ terminal nut and wire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5074
Fig.4 Lower Mounting Bolt
9. Remove the upper and lower mounting bolt (Fig. 4) and move generator off of pivot bracket.
10. Remove pivot bracket.
Fig.5 Generator
11. Remove Generator (Fig. 5) through wheel well.
INSTALLATION
1. Install generator (Fig. 5) through wheel well. 2. Install lower pivot bracket and tighten bolts to 54
Nm (40 ft. lbs.). 3. Loose install the upper and lower mounting bolts (Fig. 4). 4. Connect the
generator field circuit wiring connector. Push the RED locking tab to lock. 5. Install the B+ terminal
nut and wire. 6. Install the generator drive belt. 7. Lower vehicle. 8. Tension belt. Refer to the
Cooling System for belt tension specification. 9. Tighten adjustment bolt.
10. Tighten the jam nut. 11. Raise vehicle and support. 12. Tighten lower mounting bolt and tighten
bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.). 13. Install splash shield (Fig. 3). 14. Lower vehicle. 15. Connect battery
cable (Fig. 2).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Voltage Regulator > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Voltage Regulator: Description and Operation
The Electronic Voltage Regulator (EVR) is not a separate component It is actually a voltage
regulating circuit located within the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The EVR is not serviced
separately If replacement is necessary the PCM must be replaced.
The amount of DC current produced by the generator is controlled by EVR circuitry contained
within the PCM. This circuitry is connected in series with the generators second rotor field terminal
and its ground.
Voltage is regulated by cycling the ground path to control the strength of the rotor magnetic field.
The EVR circuitry monitors system line voltage (B+) and calculated battery temperature or inlet air
temperature sensor (refer to Battery Temperature Sensor or Inlet Air Temperature Sensor, if
equipped, for more information ). It then determines a target charging voltage. If sensed battery
voltage is lower than the target voltage, the PCM grounds the field winding until sensed battery
voltage is at the target voltage. A circuit in the PCM cycles the ground side of the generator field at
250 times per second (250Hz), but has the capability to ground the field control wire 100% of the
time (full field) to achieve the target voltage. If the charging rate cannot be monitored (limp-in), a
duty cycle of 25% is used by the PCM in order to have some generator output. Also refer to
Charging System Operation for additional information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 5083
Clutch Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 5084
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 5085
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5086
Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch (MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5087
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
DESCRIPTION - LHD The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two
switches: an engine starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 13). The
switch assembly is located in the clutch/brake pedal bracket assembly (Fig. 14), each switch being
fastened by four plastic wing tabs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5088
DESCRIPTION - RHD The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 15) consists of a single,
multi-function switch that is activated by hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod travel.
OPERATION - CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH The clutch interlock switch prevents engine starter
operation and inadvertent vehicle movement with the clutch pedal in the up position (not
depressed), or under normal conditions with the clutch engaged and the transaxle in gear.
WARNING: WHEN THERE IS A LOSS OF CLUTCH SYSTEM HYDRAULIC FLUID, OR THE
CLUTCH MASTER CYLINDER
PUSHROD IS DISCONNECTED FROM THE PEDAL LEVER, THE ENGINE MAY START WITH
THE CLUTCH ENGAGED, CAUSING UNDESIRABLE VEHICLE MOVEMENT IF THE
TRANSAXLE IS IN ANY GEAR.
The switch is open while the clutch pedal is at rest or in the up position. When the clutch pedal is
fully depressed on LHD models, the clutch pedal lever closes the switch, completing the signal
circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter operation. When the
clutch pedal is fully depressed on RHD models, the master cylinder push rod closes the switch,
completing the signal circuit from the PCM and closing the ground path, allowing engine starter
operation. The interlock switch is not adjustable.
OPERATION - CLUTCH PEDAL UPSTOP SWITCH With the clutch pedal at rest, the clutch pedal
upstop switch is closed, allowing speed control operation. When the clutch pedal is depressed, the
upstop switch opens and signals the PCM to cancel speed control operation, and enter a modified
engine calibration schedule to improve driveability during gear-to-gear shifts. The upstop switch is
not adjustable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Service Diagnosis
SERVICE DIAGNOSIS - CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
The LHD clutch interlock/upstop switch is an assembly consisting of two switches: an engine
starter inhibit switch (interlock) and a clutch pedal upstop switch (Fig. 16).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 5091
The RHD clutch interlock/upstop switch (Fig. 17) consists of a single, multi-function switch that is
activated by the hydraulic clutch master cylinder push rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 5092
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Clutch Interlock Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
CLUTCH INTERLOCK SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, turn the ignition key to the start position.
The engine starter should not crank with the
clutch pedal at rest (not depressed). If the starter cranks, proceed to the electrical test to determine
whether the switch is defective or the circuit is shorted. If the vehicle does not crank, proceed to the
next step.
2. With the park brake set and the transaxle IN NEUTRAL, fully depress the clutch pedal and turn
the ignition key to the start position. The engine
starter should crank. If the starter does not crank, visually inspect the clutch pedal for obstructions
(floor mat, etc.). Make sure the clutch pedal lever contacts and fully closes the switch on LHD
applications, and for proper installation of the master cylinder push rod/bushing on the pedal pin on
RHD applications.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 2 & 3 (Fig. 18) with the interlock
switch not depressed (clutch pedal at rest). There
should be no continuity between the terminals (open circuit).
5. LHD Models: Fully depress the clutch pedal to close the switch. The switch button should
compress at least 1.25 mm (0.050 inch) on LHD
applications. The ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms resistance). RHD Models: Disconnect
the push rod from the pedal pin and actuate the push rod by hand to close the switch. The
ohmmeter should show continuity (0 ohms). Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is
damaged (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced before reinstalling the push rod to the pedal.
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly, or the pedal bracket
assembly, is defective and should be replaced. If
the switch tests ok, wiring is defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Service Diagnosis > Page 5093
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection Upstop Switch / Mechanical-Electrical Tests
UPSTOP SWITCH
Mechanical Test
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Start engine and operate speed control to maintain speed. 3. Depress
clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch). Speed control operation should terminate. If speed control
does not terminate, the upstop switch
is defective or the related wiring is shorted. Proceed to the upstop switch electrical test.
Electrical Test
1. Move ignition key to the "OFF/LOCK" position and remove key. 2. Set park brake. 3. Disconnect
the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2 (Fig. 18) with the upstop switch
depressed (clutch pedal at rest). The ohmmeter
should show continuity (0 ohms).
5. Depress the clutch pedal at least 33 mm (1.30 inch) check for continuity between terminals 1 & 2.
There should be no continuity between the
terminals (open circuit).
6. If ohmmeter readings do not fall within these ranges, the switch assembly is defective and
should be replaced. If the switch tests ok, wiring is
defective.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - LHD
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable.
2. Remove left lower instrument panel bezel (Fig. 19). 3. Disconnect upstop switch and brake lamp
switch connectors. 4. Disconnect clutch master cylinder rod from clutch pedal pin. Inspect plastic
retainer upon removal. If retainer is damaged, it MUST be replaced.
5. Remove brake booster push rod retaining clip from brake pedal. Disengage rod from pedal (Fig.
20).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 5096
6. Remove two pedal assembly bracket to instrument panel nuts (Fig. 21). 7. Remove four brake
booster/pedal bracket-to-cowl panel nuts (Fig. 21). 8. From under the hood, pull brake master
cylinder/booster far enough forward to obtain pedal to bracket stud clearance. 9. Remove the pedal
bracket assembly (Fig. 21).
10. Remove pedal pivot shaft and remove brake and clutch pedals.
11. Remove the interlock/upstop switch assembly (Fig. 22) from the brake/clutch pedal bracket
assembly by depressing the four plastic wing tabs on
each switch.
INSTALLATION - LHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 5097
contacting pedals.
1. Install switches into the pedal bracket assembly as shown in (Fig. 22). Route harness as was
prior to removal. Secure switch connector retaining
push pin into the appropriate hole in the pedal bracket assembly.
2. Install clutch and brake pedals to pedal bracket, and install pivot shaft and nut. Torque pivot
shaft nut to 42 Nm (31 ft. lbs.). 3. Install brake/clutch pedal bracket assembly into position. Install
and tighten brake booster mounting nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.). Install and tighten
pedal bracket-to-instrument panel nuts to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
4. Install new stop lamp switch. 5. Connect brake booster rod to brake pedal. Install retainer clip
(Fig. 20).
6. Loosen adjustment screw (Fig. 24).
CAUTION: Inspect clutch master cylinder pushrod plastic retainer. If retainer is damaged in any
way (broken/cracked) it MUST be replaced.
7. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod. Gently lift clutch pedal upwards until the clutch pedal
fully depresses the upstop switch. Torque
adjustment screw to 6 Nm (55 inch lbs.).
8. Connect interlock/upstop and stop lamp switch connectors. 9. Install left lower instrument panel
bezel (Fig. 19).
10. Connect battery negative cable. 11. Verify proper switch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - LHD > Page 5098
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair Clutch Interlock/Upstop Switch - RHD
CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH
REMOVAL - RHD
1. Disconnect the master cylinder push rod from the pedal pin (Fig. 23). Inspect push rod retainer
for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
must be replaced.
2. Squeeze together the tangs on the switch cover plate and slide the plate off the switch housing.
3. Disconnect the clutch interlock/upstop switch connector from the instrument panel wiring
harness. 4. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - RHD
NOTE: Proper switch harness routing is critical to switch durability. Note the harness routing and
location of fasteners intended to keep wires from
contacting pedals.
1. Install the clutch interlock/upstop switch onto the master cylinder push rod, making sure that the
push rod is oriented with the push rod retainer
toward the wiring of the switch. The master cylinder push rod must be snapped into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch along the smaller diameter of the push rod between the snap ring and the
transition to the larger diameter.
CAUTION: Improper assembly of the larger diameter of the push rod into the clutch
interlock/upstop switch could cause damage to the switch or a
clutch system failure.
2. Install the switch cover plate.
CAUTION: Inspect the plastic push rod retainer for damage. If it is damaged (broken/cracked), it
MUST be replaced.
3. Connect clutch master cylinder pushrod to the clutch pedal pin. 4. Route the wiring harness as it
was prior to removal. 5. Secure the switch connector retaining push pin into the appropriate hole in
the pedal bracket assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information >
Application and ID
Ignition Lock: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Ignition Lock ........................................................................................................................................
................................................................... 161
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
"For information regarding this component please refer to steering column service and repair"
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Starter Motor: Electrical Specifications
Engine Application ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................ OHC - DOHC Power rating .....................................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
1.1 Kw
Voltage ................................................................................................................................................
................................................................. 12 VOLTS
Cranking Amperage Draw test ............................................................................................................
......................................................... 150 - 280 Amps.
NOTE: Engine should be up to operating temperature Extremely heavy oil or tight engine will
increase starter amperage draw.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5110
Starter Motor: Mechanical Specifications
Engine Application ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................ OHC - DOHC No. of Fields .....................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 6 No. of Poles ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................. 6 Brushes ..............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... 4 Drive ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................................ Planetary Gear Train
NOTE: Engine should be up to operating temperature Extremely heavy oil or tight engine will
increase starter amperage draw.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5111
Fig.9 Starter Mounting/Location
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5112
Starter Motor: Service Precautions
CAUTION: It is critical that the alternator output terminal be connected to the battery positive
terminal of the starter solenoid, for proper operation of the charging and cranking systems.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5113
Starter Motor: Description and Operation
The starter is a permanent magnet starter motor. The fields have six permanent magnets. A
planetary gear train transmits power between starter motor and pinion shaft. The starter provides
mechanical torque to rotate the crankshaft at an RPM (crank speed) necessary for self-sustained
spark/ignition.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output
Starter Motor: Service and Repair Starter Motor - High Output
REMOVAL
Fig.15 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable (Fig. 15).
Fig.16 Air Cleaner Box
2. Disconnect the inlet hose from intake manifold and reposition the air cleaner box (Fig. 16).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5116
Fig.17 Starter Location
3. Starter location (Fig. 17).
Fig.18 Starter Mounting/Location
4. Remove starter bolts (Fig. 18).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5117
Fig.19 Starter Electrical Connection
5. Remove starter assembly (Fig. 19). 6. Disengage latch and remove solenoid connector from
starter assembly.
Fig.20 Starter
7. Remove battery positive connector from starter assembly It is not necessary to remove the
alternator output lead from the connector (Fig. 20). 8. Remove starter from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean corrosion/dirt from the cable and wire terminals before installing wiring to the solenoid. 2.
Attach battery positive connector to starter. Ensure alternator output connector is snapped into the
battery positive connector. Tighten the captive
nut to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: It is critical that the alternator output terminal be connected to the battery positive
terminal of the starter solenoid, for proper operation of the charging and cranking systems.
3. Install solenoid connector to starter. Ensure that latch is fully engaged (Fig. 19).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5118
Fig.9 Starter Mounting/Location
4. Position the starter face into transmission housing. Start bottom mounting bolt and thread in until
bolt is snug (Fig. 9). 5. Attach ground cable to upper starter mounting bolt. 6. Ensure the proper
starter alignment before tightening the starter mounting bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 7.
Reposition the air cleaner box into position and connect the inlet hose from intake manifold (Fig.
16).
Fig.8 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
8. Connect negative battery cable (Fig. 8).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5119
Starter Motor: Service and Repair Starter Motor Replacement
REMOVAL
Fig.8 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable (Fig. 8). 2. Raise vehicle on hoist.
Fig.9 Starter Mounting/Location
3. Remove starter bolts (Fig. 9). 4. Remove starter assembly. 5. Disengage latch and remove
solenoid connector from starter assembly. 6. Remove battery positive connector from starter
assembly. It is not necessary to remove the alternator output lead from the connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5120
INSTALLATION
1. Clean corrosion/dirt from the cable and wire terminals before installing wiring to the solenoid. 2.
Attach battery positive connector to starter. Ensure alternator output connector is snapped into the
battery positive connector. Tighten the captive
nut to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: It is critical that the alternator output terminal be connected to the battery positive
terminal of the starter solenoid, for proper operation of the charging and cranking systems.
3. Install solenoid connector to starter. Ensure that latch is fully engaged. 4. Position the starter
face into transmission housing. Start bottom mounting bolt and thread in until bolt is snug. 5. Attach
ground cable to upper starter mounting bolt. 6. Ensure the proper starter alignment before
tightening the starter mounting bolts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 7. Lower vehicle 8. Connect
negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5121
Starter Motor: Service and Repair With Automatic Transmission
Starter Motor - 4 Speed Auto Replacement
REMOVAL
Automatic Transmission 1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner box,
refer to the air cleaner box removal/installation.
Fig.21 Intake Support Bracket
3. Remove the 2 upper bracket bolts for the intake support (Fig. 21). 4. Raise vehicle and support.
Fig.22 Oil Pan Bracket
5. Remove the oil pan support bracket (Fig. 22).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Starter Motor - High Output > Page 5122
Fig.23 Intake Support Bracket Lower Bolts
6. Remove the intake support bracket (Fig. 23). 7. Disconnect the battery cable and solenoid
connection from the starter. 8. Remove the starter bolts. 9. Remove starter.
INSTALLATION
Automatic Transmission 1. Install starter. 2. Install the starter bolts. 3. Connect the battery cable
and solenoid connection from the starter. 4. Install the intake support bracket (Fig. 23). 5. Install the
oil pan support bracket (Fig. 22). 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Install the 2 upper bracket bolts for the intake
support (Fig. 21). 8. Install the air cleaner box, refer to the air cleaner box removal/installation. 9.
Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 5126
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 5127
Starter Motor Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 5128
Starter Relay: Description and Operation
The Starter Relay is a micro relay located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), positioned in the
left front corner of the engine compartment.
As battery power is applied to the relay from the ignition switch, battery power is applied to the
starter motor through the relay to the starter solenoid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 5129
Starter Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer to the PDC cover for relay
location.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Specifications
Starter Solenoid: Specifications
Starter Solenoid Battery Nut ................................................................................................................
......................................................10 Nm (90 in. lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5133
Starter Solenoid: Locations
The Starter Solenoid is mounted directly to the Starter Motor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5134
Starter Solenoid: Description and Operation
The Starter Solenoid is mounted directly to the Starter Motor.
The Starter Solenoid is a switching device used to activate the high amperage starter motor circuit
from a low amperage control circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations
Fig. 12 Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5141
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5142
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5143
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5144
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5145
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5146
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5147
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5148
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5149
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5150
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5151
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5152
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5153
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5154
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5155
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5156
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5157
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5158
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5159
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5160
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5161
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5162
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5163
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5164
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5165
Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5166
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.1 Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet Base Removal
2. Look inside and note position of the retaining bosses (Fig. 1). 3. Using external snap ring pliers
with 90 degree tips. Insert pliers with tips against bosses and squeeze forcing bosses out of base.
Fig.2 Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet Base Removal
4. Pull out the base through mounting ring by gently rocking pliers. A tool can be made to do the
same (Fig. 2). 5. Disconnect the base wires. 6. Set base aside and remove base mount ring.
INSTALLATION
1. Position mount ring to the instrument panel and feed the wires through ring. Index the cap and
the mount ring with the index tab at 9 o'clock to the
key in the instrument panel. Install the ring.
2. Connect wires to base. Orient base alignment rib at 11 o'clock to mate the groove in mount ring
at the same location
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5167
3. Push base into the bezel till it locks. 4. Install cigar lighter cap and check operation of element. 5.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations
Circuit Breaker: Locations
8w-11-2 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5171
8w-11-3 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5172
Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breakers
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5173
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams
Circuit Breakers - LHD
Circuit Breakers - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag
DTC Set
Diode: Customer Interest Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set
NUMBER: 08-013-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 16, 2003
SUBJECT: Erroneous Airbag Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) - Loss of Ignition Run/Start
NOTE:
THE SYMPTOM/CONDITION ADDRESSED IN THIS BULLETIN HAS NO AFFECT ON AIRBAG
OPERATION.
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves adding a diode to the L4 circuit.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (DRL)
(SALES CODE LMN).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle sets DTC "Loss of Ignition Run/Start".
NOTE:
THE ABOVE MENTIONED DTC CAN BE GENERATED IF THE IGNITION SWITCH IS CYCLED
FROM THE RUN POSITION TO THE OFF POSITION WHILE THE HEADLAMPS REMAIN ON. A
VOLTAGE SPIKE FROM THE DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS COULD OCCUR SETTING THE
DTC.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRBIII(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual,
verify all systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present1 other than listed above,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the DTC listed above is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Open the driver's door. Remove the left instrument panel end cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag
DTC Set > Page 5182
3. Remove the 2 fuse block mounting screws holding the fuse block to the bracket (Fig. 1).
4. Pull the fuse block and wiring harness out the instrument panel end cap opening.
5. Unwrap the wiring harness covering up to the point that the harness exits the instrument panel.
6. Locate the L4 VT/WT wire in the wiring harness going toward the instrument panel. (Fig. 2).
7. Cut the wire approximately 101.6 mm (4 in.) from the fuse block terminal.
8. Slide the heat shrink tubing over the wire and slide the tubing up the wire out of the way until
needed in step 10.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag
DTC Set > Page 5183
9. Splice in the diode kit (p/n 05107069AA) following procedures outlined in the
TechCONNECT/MDS2 or 2003 Neon/SX 2.0 service manual (Publication No. 81-270-03028) page
8W-01-14 and 15 (Fig. 3).
NOTE:
THE DIODE IS TO BE INSTALLED WITH THE STRIPPED END AWAY FROM THE FUSE
BLOCK.
10. Once the diode is soldered in place, slide the heat shrink tubing over the diode and shrink the
tubing to seal the diode from the elements.
11. Install the covering on the wiring harness (Fig. 4). Apply electrical tape around the covering in a
couple of places to secure.
12. Install the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag
DTC Set > Page 5184
13. Install the 2 fuse block mounting screws.
14. Install instrument panel left end cap.
15. Install battery negative terminal.
16. Cycle the ignition switch from the RUN position to the OFF position while the headlamps are
on.
17. Check DTC's in the airbag control module.
18. If the DTC does not return proceed to step 19. If the "Loss of Ignition Run/Start" DTC returns,
check the installation of the diode. Be sure the stripped end of the diode is facing away from the
fuse block. Repeat steps 11 through 18.
NOTE:
IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION, RESET THE CLOCK TO THE CORRECT
TIME WHEN THE PROCEDURE IS COMPLETE.
19. Erase DTC's.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System Erroneous Airbag DTC Set
Diode: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set
NUMBER: 08-013-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 16, 2003
SUBJECT: Erroneous Airbag Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) - Loss of Ignition Run/Start
NOTE:
THE SYMPTOM/CONDITION ADDRESSED IN THIS BULLETIN HAS NO AFFECT ON AIRBAG
OPERATION.
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves adding a diode to the L4 circuit.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (DRL)
(SALES CODE LMN).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle sets DTC "Loss of Ignition Run/Start".
NOTE:
THE ABOVE MENTIONED DTC CAN BE GENERATED IF THE IGNITION SWITCH IS CYCLED
FROM THE RUN POSITION TO THE OFF POSITION WHILE THE HEADLAMPS REMAIN ON. A
VOLTAGE SPIKE FROM THE DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS COULD OCCUR SETTING THE
DTC.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRBIII(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual,
verify all systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present1 other than listed above,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the DTC listed above is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Open the driver's door. Remove the left instrument panel end cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System Erroneous Airbag DTC Set > Page 5190
3. Remove the 2 fuse block mounting screws holding the fuse block to the bracket (Fig. 1).
4. Pull the fuse block and wiring harness out the instrument panel end cap opening.
5. Unwrap the wiring harness covering up to the point that the harness exits the instrument panel.
6. Locate the L4 VT/WT wire in the wiring harness going toward the instrument panel. (Fig. 2).
7. Cut the wire approximately 101.6 mm (4 in.) from the fuse block terminal.
8. Slide the heat shrink tubing over the wire and slide the tubing up the wire out of the way until
needed in step 10.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System Erroneous Airbag DTC Set > Page 5191
9. Splice in the diode kit (p/n 05107069AA) following procedures outlined in the
TechCONNECT/MDS2 or 2003 Neon/SX 2.0 service manual (Publication No. 81-270-03028) page
8W-01-14 and 15 (Fig. 3).
NOTE:
THE DIODE IS TO BE INSTALLED WITH THE STRIPPED END AWAY FROM THE FUSE
BLOCK.
10. Once the diode is soldered in place, slide the heat shrink tubing over the diode and shrink the
tubing to seal the diode from the elements.
11. Install the covering on the wiring harness (Fig. 4). Apply electrical tape around the covering in a
couple of places to secure.
12. Install the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System Erroneous Airbag DTC Set > Page 5192
13. Install the 2 fuse block mounting screws.
14. Install instrument panel left end cap.
15. Install battery negative terminal.
16. Cycle the ignition switch from the RUN position to the OFF position while the headlamps are
on.
17. Check DTC's in the airbag control module.
18. If the DTC does not return proceed to step 19. If the "Loss of Ignition Run/Start" DTC returns,
check the installation of the diode. Be sure the stripped end of the diode is facing away from the
fuse block. Repeat steps 11 through 18.
NOTE:
IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION, RESET THE CLOCK TO THE CORRECT
TIME WHEN THE PROCEDURE IS COMPLETE.
19. Erase DTC's.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations
1.6L and 2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5196
Power Distribution Center (PDC): Application and ID
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5197
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5198
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5199
8w-10-5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5200
8w-10-6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5201
8w-10-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5202
Power Distribution Center (PDC): Description and Operation
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC)
<--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5203
Power Distribution Center (PDC): Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and headlamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the headlamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the headlamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the headlamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the headlamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and headlamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the headlamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers to
the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the headlamp and dash wire harness ground
eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis components. 7. Reconnect each of the headlamp and dash
wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in.
lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block
Fuse: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5208
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5209
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5210
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5211
Fuse: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5212
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5215
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5216
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5217
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5218
Fuse: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5219
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5224
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5225
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5226
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5227
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5228
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5229
Fuse Block: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5230
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Connector Views > Page 5233
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5234
Fuse Block: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL, RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5237
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5238
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5239
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5240
Fuse Block: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5241
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Fuse Block > Page 5244
Fuse Block: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL, RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
The Fuse Block is serviced with the instrument panel wire harness. If service is required to the fuse
block, the entire instrument panel harness must be replaced.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the instrument panel. 2. With the instrument panel removed, disassemble the
instrument panel enough to gain access to all screws and connectors. 3. Remove instrument panel
wire harness with fuse block.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the instrument panel wire harness to the instrument panel. 2. Install all items removed
from the instrument panel to gain access to the wire harness. 3. Install the instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuse Block > Page 5247
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse <-->
[Power Interrupt Connector/Switch] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse: Testing and Inspection
STANDARD PROCEDURE - IGNITION-OFF DRAW TEST
The term Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from
the battery with the ignition switch in the OFF position. A normal vehicle electrical system will draw
from 5 - 35 milliamperes (0.005 - 0.035 ampere) with the ignition switch in the OFF position, and all
non-ignition controlled circuits in proper working order. Up to 35 milliamperes are needed to enable
the memory functions for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), digital clock, electronically tuned
radio, and other modules which may vary with the vehicle equipment.
A vehicle that has not been operated for approximately twenty days, may discharge the battery to
an inadequate level. When a vehicle will not be used for twenty days or more (stored), remove the
IOD fuse from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). This will reduce battery discharging.
Excessive IOD can be caused by: Electrical items left ON.
- Faulty or improperly adjusted switches.
- Faulty or shorted electronic modules and components.
- An internally shorted generator.
- Intermittent shorts in the wiring.
If the IOD is over 35 milliamperes, the problem must be found and corrected before replacing a
battery. In most cases, the battery can be charged and returned to service after the excessive IOD
condition has been corrected. 1. Verify that all electrical accessories are OFF. Turn OFF all lamps,
remove the ignition key, and close all doors. If the vehicle is equipped with an
illuminated entry system or an electronically tuned radio, allow the electronic timer function of these
systems to automatically shut off (time out). This may take up to three minutes.
2. Determine that the underhood lamp is operating properly then disconnect the lamp wire harness
connector or remove the lamp bulb. 3. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 4. Set an electronic
digital multi-meter to its highest amperage scale. Connect the multi-meter between the
disconnected battery negative cable
terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal post. Make sure that the doors remain closed so
that the illuminated entry system is not activated. The multi-meter amperage reading may remain
high for up to three minutes, or may not give any reading at all while set in the highest amperage
scale, depending upon the electrical equipment in the vehicle. The multi-meter leads must be
securely clamped to the battery negative cable terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal
post. If continuity between the battery negative terminal post and the negative cable terminal clamp
is lost during any part of the IOD test, the electronic timer function will be activated and all of the
tests will have to be repeated.
5. After about three minutes, the high-amperage IOD reading on the multi-meter should become
very low or nonexistent, depending upon the
electrical equipment in the vehicle. If the amperage reading remains high, remove and replace
each fuse or circuit breaker in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and then in the Junction Block
(JB), one at a time until the amperage reading becomes very low, or nonexistent. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information for complete PDC and JB fuse, circuit breaker, and circuit
identification. This will isolate each circuit and identify the circuit that is the source of the
high-amperage IOD. If the amperage reading remains high after removing and replacing each fuse
and circuit breaker, disconnect the wire harness from the generator. If the amperage reading now
becomes very low or nonexistent, refer to Charging System for the proper charging system
diagnosis and testing procedures. After the high-amperage IOD has been corrected, switch the
multi-meter to progressively lower amperage scales and, if necessary repeat the fuse and circuit
breaker remove-and-replace process to identify and correct all sources of excessive IOD. It is now
safe to select the lowest milliampere scale of the multi-meter to check the low-amperage IOD.
CAUTION: Do not open any doors, or turn ON any electrical accessories with the lowest
milliampere scale selected, or the multi-meter may be damaged.
6. Observe the multi-meter reading. The low-amperage IOD should not exceed 35 milliamperes
(0.035 ampere). If the current draw exceeds 35
milliamperes, isolate each circuit using the fuse and circuit breaker remove-and-replace process in
Step 5. The multi-meter reading will drop to within the acceptable limit when the source of the
excessive current draw is disconnected. Repair this circuit as required; whether a wiring short,
incorrect switch adjustment, or a component failure is at fault.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5256
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5257
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5258
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5259
Relay Box: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5260
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5263
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5264
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5265
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5266
Relay Box: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5267
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center
Relay Box: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center > Page
5270
Relay Box: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5271
Relay Box: Service and Repair
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5276
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5277
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5278
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5279
Relay Box: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5280
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5283
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5284
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5285
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5286
Relay Box: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5287
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center
Relay Box: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center > Page 5290
Relay Box: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 5291
Relay Box: Service and Repair
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Sensors and Switches - Power and
Ground Distribution > Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse <--> [Power Interrupt Connector/Switch] > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse: Testing and Inspection
STANDARD PROCEDURE - IGNITION-OFF DRAW TEST
The term Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from
the battery with the ignition switch in the OFF position. A normal vehicle electrical system will draw
from 5 - 35 milliamperes (0.005 - 0.035 ampere) with the ignition switch in the OFF position, and all
non-ignition controlled circuits in proper working order. Up to 35 milliamperes are needed to enable
the memory functions for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), digital clock, electronically tuned
radio, and other modules which may vary with the vehicle equipment.
A vehicle that has not been operated for approximately twenty days, may discharge the battery to
an inadequate level. When a vehicle will not be used for twenty days or more (stored), remove the
IOD fuse from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). This will reduce battery discharging.
Excessive IOD can be caused by: Electrical items left ON.
- Faulty or improperly adjusted switches.
- Faulty or shorted electronic modules and components.
- An internally shorted generator.
- Intermittent shorts in the wiring.
If the IOD is over 35 milliamperes, the problem must be found and corrected before replacing a
battery. In most cases, the battery can be charged and returned to service after the excessive IOD
condition has been corrected. 1. Verify that all electrical accessories are OFF. Turn OFF all lamps,
remove the ignition key, and close all doors. If the vehicle is equipped with an
illuminated entry system or an electronically tuned radio, allow the electronic timer function of these
systems to automatically shut off (time out). This may take up to three minutes.
2. Determine that the underhood lamp is operating properly then disconnect the lamp wire harness
connector or remove the lamp bulb. 3. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 4. Set an electronic
digital multi-meter to its highest amperage scale. Connect the multi-meter between the
disconnected battery negative cable
terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal post. Make sure that the doors remain closed so
that the illuminated entry system is not activated. The multi-meter amperage reading may remain
high for up to three minutes, or may not give any reading at all while set in the highest amperage
scale, depending upon the electrical equipment in the vehicle. The multi-meter leads must be
securely clamped to the battery negative cable terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal
post. If continuity between the battery negative terminal post and the negative cable terminal clamp
is lost during any part of the IOD test, the electronic timer function will be activated and all of the
tests will have to be repeated.
5. After about three minutes, the high-amperage IOD reading on the multi-meter should become
very low or nonexistent, depending upon the
electrical equipment in the vehicle. If the amperage reading remains high, remove and replace
each fuse or circuit breaker in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and then in the Junction Block
(JB), one at a time until the amperage reading becomes very low, or nonexistent. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information for complete PDC and JB fuse, circuit breaker, and circuit
identification. This will isolate each circuit and identify the circuit that is the source of the
high-amperage IOD. If the amperage reading remains high after removing and replacing each fuse
and circuit breaker, disconnect the wire harness from the generator. If the amperage reading now
becomes very low or nonexistent, refer to Charging System for the proper charging system
diagnosis and testing procedures. After the high-amperage IOD has been corrected, switch the
multi-meter to progressively lower amperage scales and, if necessary repeat the fuse and circuit
breaker remove-and-replace process to identify and correct all sources of excessive IOD. It is now
safe to select the lowest milliampere scale of the multi-meter to check the low-amperage IOD.
CAUTION: Do not open any doors, or turn ON any electrical accessories with the lowest
milliampere scale selected, or the multi-meter may be damaged.
6. Observe the multi-meter reading. The low-amperage IOD should not exceed 35 milliamperes
(0.035 ampere). If the current draw exceeds 35
milliamperes, isolate each circuit using the fuse and circuit breaker remove-and-replace process in
Step 5. The multi-meter reading will drop to within the acceptable limit when the source of the
excessive current draw is disconnected. Repair this circuit as required; whether a wiring short,
incorrect switch adjustment, or a component failure is at fault.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
Fig. 12 Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5302
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5303
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5304
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5305
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5306
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5307
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5308
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5309
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5310
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5311
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5312
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5313
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5314
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5315
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5316
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5317
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5318
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5319
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5320
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5321
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5322
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5323
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5324
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5325
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5326
Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 5327
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.1 Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet Base Removal
2. Look inside and note position of the retaining bosses (Fig. 1). 3. Using external snap ring pliers
with 90 degree tips. Insert pliers with tips against bosses and squeeze forcing bosses out of base.
Fig.2 Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet Base Removal
4. Pull out the base through mounting ring by gently rocking pliers. A tool can be made to do the
same (Fig. 2). 5. Disconnect the base wires. 6. Set base aside and remove base mount ring.
INSTALLATION
1. Position mount ring to the instrument panel and feed the wires through ring. Index the cap and
the mount ring with the index tab at 9 o'clock to the
key in the instrument panel. Install the ring.
2. Connect wires to base. Orient base alignment rib at 11 o'clock to mate the groove in mount ring
at the same location
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 5328
3. Push base into the bezel till it locks. 4. Install cigar lighter cap and check operation of element. 5.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations
Circuit Breaker: Locations
8w-11-2 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations > Page
5332
8w-11-3 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations > Page
5333
Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breakers
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations > Page
5334
Circuit Breaker: Diagrams
Circuit Breakers - LHD
Circuit Breakers - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set
Diode: Customer Interest Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set
NUMBER: 08-013-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 16, 2003
SUBJECT: Erroneous Airbag Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) - Loss of Ignition Run/Start
NOTE:
THE SYMPTOM/CONDITION ADDRESSED IN THIS BULLETIN HAS NO AFFECT ON AIRBAG
OPERATION.
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves adding a diode to the L4 circuit.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (DRL)
(SALES CODE LMN).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle sets DTC "Loss of Ignition Run/Start".
NOTE:
THE ABOVE MENTIONED DTC CAN BE GENERATED IF THE IGNITION SWITCH IS CYCLED
FROM THE RUN POSITION TO THE OFF POSITION WHILE THE HEADLAMPS REMAIN ON. A
VOLTAGE SPIKE FROM THE DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS COULD OCCUR SETTING THE
DTC.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRBIII(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual,
verify all systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present1 other than listed above,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the DTC listed above is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Open the driver's door. Remove the left instrument panel end cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set > Page
5343
3. Remove the 2 fuse block mounting screws holding the fuse block to the bracket (Fig. 1).
4. Pull the fuse block and wiring harness out the instrument panel end cap opening.
5. Unwrap the wiring harness covering up to the point that the harness exits the instrument panel.
6. Locate the L4 VT/WT wire in the wiring harness going toward the instrument panel. (Fig. 2).
7. Cut the wire approximately 101.6 mm (4 in.) from the fuse block terminal.
8. Slide the heat shrink tubing over the wire and slide the tubing up the wire out of the way until
needed in step 10.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set > Page
5344
9. Splice in the diode kit (p/n 05107069AA) following procedures outlined in the
TechCONNECT/MDS2 or 2003 Neon/SX 2.0 service manual (Publication No. 81-270-03028) page
8W-01-14 and 15 (Fig. 3).
NOTE:
THE DIODE IS TO BE INSTALLED WITH THE STRIPPED END AWAY FROM THE FUSE
BLOCK.
10. Once the diode is soldered in place, slide the heat shrink tubing over the diode and shrink the
tubing to seal the diode from the elements.
11. Install the covering on the wiring harness (Fig. 4). Apply electrical tape around the covering in a
couple of places to secure.
12. Install the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set > Page
5345
13. Install the 2 fuse block mounting screws.
14. Install instrument panel left end cap.
15. Install battery negative terminal.
16. Cycle the ignition switch from the RUN position to the OFF position while the headlamps are
on.
17. Check DTC's in the airbag control module.
18. If the DTC does not return proceed to step 19. If the "Loss of Ignition Run/Start" DTC returns,
check the installation of the diode. Be sure the stripped end of the diode is facing away from the
fuse block. Repeat steps 11 through 18.
NOTE:
IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION, RESET THE CLOCK TO THE CORRECT
TIME WHEN THE PROCEDURE IS COMPLETE.
19. Erase DTC's.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC
Set
Diode: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC Set
NUMBER: 08-013-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 16, 2003
SUBJECT: Erroneous Airbag Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) - Loss of Ignition Run/Start
NOTE:
THE SYMPTOM/CONDITION ADDRESSED IN THIS BULLETIN HAS NO AFFECT ON AIRBAG
OPERATION.
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves adding a diode to the L4 circuit.
MODELS:
2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (DRL)
(SALES CODE LMN).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Vehicle sets DTC "Loss of Ignition Run/Start".
NOTE:
THE ABOVE MENTIONED DTC CAN BE GENERATED IF THE IGNITION SWITCH IS CYCLED
FROM THE RUN POSITION TO THE OFF POSITION WHILE THE HEADLAMPS REMAIN ON. A
VOLTAGE SPIKE FROM THE DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS COULD OCCUR SETTING THE
DTC.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRBIII(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual,
verify all systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's are present1 other than listed above,
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the DTC listed above is present, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Open the driver's door. Remove the left instrument panel end cap.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC
Set > Page 5351
3. Remove the 2 fuse block mounting screws holding the fuse block to the bracket (Fig. 1).
4. Pull the fuse block and wiring harness out the instrument panel end cap opening.
5. Unwrap the wiring harness covering up to the point that the harness exits the instrument panel.
6. Locate the L4 VT/WT wire in the wiring harness going toward the instrument panel. (Fig. 2).
7. Cut the wire approximately 101.6 mm (4 in.) from the fuse block terminal.
8. Slide the heat shrink tubing over the wire and slide the tubing up the wire out of the way until
needed in step 10.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC
Set > Page 5352
9. Splice in the diode kit (p/n 05107069AA) following procedures outlined in the
TechCONNECT/MDS2 or 2003 Neon/SX 2.0 service manual (Publication No. 81-270-03028) page
8W-01-14 and 15 (Fig. 3).
NOTE:
THE DIODE IS TO BE INSTALLED WITH THE STRIPPED END AWAY FROM THE FUSE
BLOCK.
10. Once the diode is soldered in place, slide the heat shrink tubing over the diode and shrink the
tubing to seal the diode from the elements.
11. Install the covering on the wiring harness (Fig. 4). Apply electrical tape around the covering in a
couple of places to secure.
12. Install the fuse block.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Diode > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diode: > 08-013-03 > May > 03 > Restraint System - Erroneous Airbag DTC
Set > Page 5353
13. Install the 2 fuse block mounting screws.
14. Install instrument panel left end cap.
15. Install battery negative terminal.
16. Cycle the ignition switch from the RUN position to the OFF position while the headlamps are
on.
17. Check DTC's in the airbag control module.
18. If the DTC does not return proceed to step 19. If the "Loss of Ignition Run/Start" DTC returns,
check the installation of the diode. Be sure the stripped end of the diode is facing away from the
fuse block. Repeat steps 11 through 18.
NOTE:
IN THE INTEREST OF CUSTOMER SATISFACTION, RESET THE CLOCK TO THE CORRECT
TIME WHEN THE PROCEDURE IS COMPLETE.
19. Erase DTC's.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations
1.6L and 2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5357
Power Distribution Center (PDC): Application and ID
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5358
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5359
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5360
8w-10-5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5361
8w-10-6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5362
8w-10-7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5363
Power Distribution Center (PDC): Description and Operation
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Center (PDC) <--> [Electrical Accessory
Panel] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5364
Power Distribution Center (PDC): Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and headlamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the headlamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the headlamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the headlamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the headlamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and headlamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the headlamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers to
the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the headlamp and dash wire harness ground
eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis components. 7. Reconnect each of the headlamp and dash
wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in.
lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block
Fuse: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block >
Page 5369
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block >
Page 5370
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block >
Page 5371
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block >
Page 5372
Fuse: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block >
Page 5373
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse
Block
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse
Block > Page 5376
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse
Block > Page 5377
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse
Block > Page 5378
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse
Block > Page 5379
Fuse: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse
Block > Page 5380
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5385
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5386
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5387
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5388
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5389
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5390
Fuse Block: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5391
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Connector Views
Fuse Block: Connector Views
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Connector Views > Page 5394
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5395
Fuse Block: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL, RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5398
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5399
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5400
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5401
Fuse Block: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5402
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuse Block > Page 5405
Fuse Block: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuse Block
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL, RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
The Fuse Block is serviced with the instrument panel wire harness. If service is required to the fuse
block, the entire instrument panel harness must be replaced.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the instrument panel. 2. With the instrument panel removed, disassemble the
instrument panel enough to gain access to all screws and connectors. 3. Remove instrument panel
wire harness with fuse block.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the instrument panel wire harness to the instrument panel. 2. Install all items removed
from the instrument panel to gain access to the wire harness. 3. Install the instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fuse Block > Page 5408
Fuse Block: Service and Repair Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse <--> [Power Interrupt
Connector/Switch] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse: Testing and Inspection
STANDARD PROCEDURE - IGNITION-OFF DRAW TEST
The term Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from
the battery with the ignition switch in the OFF position. A normal vehicle electrical system will draw
from 5 - 35 milliamperes (0.005 - 0.035 ampere) with the ignition switch in the OFF position, and all
non-ignition controlled circuits in proper working order. Up to 35 milliamperes are needed to enable
the memory functions for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), digital clock, electronically tuned
radio, and other modules which may vary with the vehicle equipment.
A vehicle that has not been operated for approximately twenty days, may discharge the battery to
an inadequate level. When a vehicle will not be used for twenty days or more (stored), remove the
IOD fuse from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). This will reduce battery discharging.
Excessive IOD can be caused by: Electrical items left ON.
- Faulty or improperly adjusted switches.
- Faulty or shorted electronic modules and components.
- An internally shorted generator.
- Intermittent shorts in the wiring.
If the IOD is over 35 milliamperes, the problem must be found and corrected before replacing a
battery. In most cases, the battery can be charged and returned to service after the excessive IOD
condition has been corrected. 1. Verify that all electrical accessories are OFF. Turn OFF all lamps,
remove the ignition key, and close all doors. If the vehicle is equipped with an
illuminated entry system or an electronically tuned radio, allow the electronic timer function of these
systems to automatically shut off (time out). This may take up to three minutes.
2. Determine that the underhood lamp is operating properly then disconnect the lamp wire harness
connector or remove the lamp bulb. 3. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 4. Set an electronic
digital multi-meter to its highest amperage scale. Connect the multi-meter between the
disconnected battery negative cable
terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal post. Make sure that the doors remain closed so
that the illuminated entry system is not activated. The multi-meter amperage reading may remain
high for up to three minutes, or may not give any reading at all while set in the highest amperage
scale, depending upon the electrical equipment in the vehicle. The multi-meter leads must be
securely clamped to the battery negative cable terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal
post. If continuity between the battery negative terminal post and the negative cable terminal clamp
is lost during any part of the IOD test, the electronic timer function will be activated and all of the
tests will have to be repeated.
5. After about three minutes, the high-amperage IOD reading on the multi-meter should become
very low or nonexistent, depending upon the
electrical equipment in the vehicle. If the amperage reading remains high, remove and replace
each fuse or circuit breaker in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and then in the Junction Block
(JB), one at a time until the amperage reading becomes very low, or nonexistent. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information for complete PDC and JB fuse, circuit breaker, and circuit
identification. This will isolate each circuit and identify the circuit that is the source of the
high-amperage IOD. If the amperage reading remains high after removing and replacing each fuse
and circuit breaker, disconnect the wire harness from the generator. If the amperage reading now
becomes very low or nonexistent, refer to Charging System for the proper charging system
diagnosis and testing procedures. After the high-amperage IOD has been corrected, switch the
multi-meter to progressively lower amperage scales and, if necessary repeat the fuse and circuit
breaker remove-and-replace process to identify and correct all sources of excessive IOD. It is now
safe to select the lowest milliampere scale of the multi-meter to check the low-amperage IOD.
CAUTION: Do not open any doors, or turn ON any electrical accessories with the lowest
milliampere scale selected, or the multi-meter may be damaged.
6. Observe the multi-meter reading. The low-amperage IOD should not exceed 35 milliamperes
(0.035 ampere). If the current draw exceeds 35
milliamperes, isolate each circuit using the fuse and circuit breaker remove-and-replace process in
Step 5. The multi-meter reading will drop to within the acceptable limit when the source of the
excessive current draw is disconnected. Repair this circuit as required; whether a wiring short,
incorrect switch adjustment, or a component failure is at fault.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5417
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5418
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5419
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5420
Relay Box: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Block > Page 5421
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5424
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5425
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5426
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5427
Relay Box: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Fuse Block > Page 5428
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center
Relay Box: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Distribution Center > Page 5431
Relay Box: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5432
Relay Box: Service and Repair
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse
Block
Relay Box: Locations Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse
Block > Page 5437
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse
Block > Page 5438
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse
Block > Page 5439
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse
Block > Page 5440
Relay Box: Locations Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Fuse
Block > Page 5441
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuse Block
Fuse Block - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5444
Fuse Block - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5445
Fuses (Fuse Block) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5446
Fuses (Fuse Block) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5447
Relay Box: Application and ID Power Distribution Center
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Fuse Block > Page 5448
Fuses (PDC)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Distribution Center
Relay Box: Description and Operation Power Distribution Center
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
The Power Distribution system for this vehicle provides a safe, reliable, centralized and convenient
means to access distribution of the electrical current required to operate all of the electrical
systems. At the same time, these systems were designed to provide centralized locations for
conducting diagnosis of faulty circuits, and for sourcing the additional current requirements of many
aftermarket vehicle accessory and convenience items.
The power distribution system for this vehicle consist of the following components: Fuses
- Fuse cartridges
- Fusible links
- Automatic resetting circuit breakers
- Relays
- Flashers
- Timers
- Circuit splice blocks
- Power Distribution Center (PDC)
All of the electrical current distributed throughout this vehicle is directed through the standard
equipment Power Distribution Center (PDC). The molded plastic PDC housing is located in the left
front corner of the engine compartment, just rearward of the air cleaner housing and left of the
battery. The PDC housing has a molded plastic cover. The PDC cover is easily removed for service
access and has a convenient fuse and relay layout label printed on the inside surface of the cover
to ensure proper component identification.
The PDC housing is secured to the left fender side extension with an indexing pin, one screw on
the rail and one screw on the fender side shield. All of the PDC outputs are through the integral
headlamp and dash wire harness.
All of the current from the generator cable connection goes to the battery through a 140 ampere
fusible link that is secured with a nut to the positive battery cable terminal. The PDC houses up to
ten cartridge fuses, which replace all in-line fusible links. The PDC also houses up to 12 mini fuses
(blade-type), up to three full International Standards Organization (ISO) relays, and up to eight mini
International Standards Organization (ISO) relays. Internal connection of all the PDC circuits is
accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and bus bars. For complete circuit diagrams,
refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
The fusible link, fuses and relays are available for service replacement. The PDC unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as a unit with the headlamp and dash wire harness. If the PDC is
faulty or damaged, the headlamp and dash wire harness assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Distribution Center > Page 5451
Relay Box: Description and Operation Fuse Block
FUSE BLOCK
An electrical Fuse Block is located in the left end of the instrument panel. It serves to simplify and
centralize numerous electrical components, as well as to distribute electrical current to many of the
accessory systems in the vehicle.
The Fuse Block is positioned on a mounting bracket up and under the left instrument panel. It is
secured by two screws. The fuse block is concealed behind the left instrument panel end cap. The
left end cap is a snap-fit access cover that conceals the fuse block fuses. A fuse layout placard is
on the back of the end cap to ensure proper fuse identification.
The fuse block houses blade-type fuses and automatic resetting circuit breakers. Internal
connection of all the fuse block circuits is accomplished by an intricate network of hard wiring and
bus bars.
The fuses and circuit breakers are available for service replacement. The fuse block unit cannot be
repaired and is only serviced as an assembly. If any circuit or the fuse block housing is faulty or
damaged, the entire fuse block and instrument panel wire harness assembly must be replaced.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5452
Relay Box: Service and Repair
POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER
REMOVAL
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
2. Disconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 3. Remove the fasteners
that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness ground eyelets to the vehicle body and
chassis components. 4. Disengage each of the retainers that secure the head lamp and dash wire
harness to the vehicle body and chassis components. 5. Disengage the grommet at the dash panel
and pull connectors through. 6. Remove the two screws and disengage the PDC housing from the
left inner fender well. 7. Remove the PDC and the head lamp and dash wire harness from the
engine compartment as a unit.
INSTALLATION
The Power Distribution Center (PDC) is serviced as a unit with the head lamp and dash wire
harness. If any internal circuit of the PDC or the PDC housing is faulty or damaged, the entire PDC
and head lamp and dash wire harness unit must be replaced.
1. Install the grommet at the dash panel. 2. Position the PDC in the engine compartment. 3. Align
the PDC mounting pin with the inner fender well hole. 4. Place PDC down in engine compartment
and install the two retaining screws. 5. Route the head lamp and dash wire harness from the PDC
through the engine and passenger compartment, engaging each of the harness retainers
to the mounting provisions in the vehicle body and chassis components.
6. Install and tighten the fasteners that secure each of the head lamp and dash wire harness
ground eyelets to the vehicle body and chassis
components.
7. Reconnect each of the head lamp and dash wire harness connectors. 8. Tighten nut retaining
positive battery cable at PDC to 14 Nm (123 in. lbs.). 9. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Sensors and Switches - Power and Ground Distribution >
Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse <--> [Power Interrupt Connector/Switch] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Ignition Off-Draw (IOD) Fuse: Testing and Inspection
STANDARD PROCEDURE - IGNITION-OFF DRAW TEST
The term Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from
the battery with the ignition switch in the OFF position. A normal vehicle electrical system will draw
from 5 - 35 milliamperes (0.005 - 0.035 ampere) with the ignition switch in the OFF position, and all
non-ignition controlled circuits in proper working order. Up to 35 milliamperes are needed to enable
the memory functions for the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), digital clock, electronically tuned
radio, and other modules which may vary with the vehicle equipment.
A vehicle that has not been operated for approximately twenty days, may discharge the battery to
an inadequate level. When a vehicle will not be used for twenty days or more (stored), remove the
IOD fuse from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). This will reduce battery discharging.
Excessive IOD can be caused by: Electrical items left ON.
- Faulty or improperly adjusted switches.
- Faulty or shorted electronic modules and components.
- An internally shorted generator.
- Intermittent shorts in the wiring.
If the IOD is over 35 milliamperes, the problem must be found and corrected before replacing a
battery. In most cases, the battery can be charged and returned to service after the excessive IOD
condition has been corrected. 1. Verify that all electrical accessories are OFF. Turn OFF all lamps,
remove the ignition key, and close all doors. If the vehicle is equipped with an
illuminated entry system or an electronically tuned radio, allow the electronic timer function of these
systems to automatically shut off (time out). This may take up to three minutes.
2. Determine that the underhood lamp is operating properly then disconnect the lamp wire harness
connector or remove the lamp bulb. 3. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 4. Set an electronic
digital multi-meter to its highest amperage scale. Connect the multi-meter between the
disconnected battery negative cable
terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal post. Make sure that the doors remain closed so
that the illuminated entry system is not activated. The multi-meter amperage reading may remain
high for up to three minutes, or may not give any reading at all while set in the highest amperage
scale, depending upon the electrical equipment in the vehicle. The multi-meter leads must be
securely clamped to the battery negative cable terminal clamp and the battery negative terminal
post. If continuity between the battery negative terminal post and the negative cable terminal clamp
is lost during any part of the IOD test, the electronic timer function will be activated and all of the
tests will have to be repeated.
5. After about three minutes, the high-amperage IOD reading on the multi-meter should become
very low or nonexistent, depending upon the
electrical equipment in the vehicle. If the amperage reading remains high, remove and replace
each fuse or circuit breaker in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and then in the Junction Block
(JB), one at a time until the amperage reading becomes very low, or nonexistent. Refer to the
appropriate wiring information for complete PDC and JB fuse, circuit breaker, and circuit
identification. This will isolate each circuit and identify the circuit that is the source of the
high-amperage IOD. If the amperage reading remains high after removing and replacing each fuse
and circuit breaker, disconnect the wire harness from the generator. If the amperage reading now
becomes very low or nonexistent, refer to Charging System for the proper charging system
diagnosis and testing procedures. After the high-amperage IOD has been corrected, switch the
multi-meter to progressively lower amperage scales and, if necessary repeat the fuse and circuit
breaker remove-and-replace process to identify and correct all sources of excessive IOD. It is now
safe to select the lowest milliampere scale of the multi-meter to check the low-amperage IOD.
CAUTION: Do not open any doors, or turn ON any electrical accessories with the lowest
milliampere scale selected, or the multi-meter may be damaged.
6. Observe the multi-meter reading. The low-amperage IOD should not exceed 35 milliamperes
(0.035 ampere). If the current draw exceeds 35
milliamperes, isolate each circuit using the fuse and circuit breaker remove-and-replace process in
Step 5. The multi-meter reading will drop to within the acceptable limit when the source of the
excessive current draw is disconnected. Repair this circuit as required; whether a wiring short,
incorrect switch adjustment, or a component failure is at fault.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Alignment Specifications
CURB HEIGHT FRONT REAR
All Neon 26.46 ± 0.32 in (672 ± 8 mm) 26.73 ± 0.32 in. (679 ± 8 mm)
SRT-4 26.97 ± 0.32 in. (685 ± 8 mm) 27.44 ± 0.32 in. (697 ± 8 mm)
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT ITEM PREFERRED SETTING ACCEPTABLE RANGE
Standard Neon Camber 0.00° -0.40° to +0.40°
Cross Camber (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 0.50°
Caster +2.60° +1.60° to +3.60°
Cross Caster (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 1.00°
Total Toe +0.20° 0.00° to +0.40°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
ACR Neon Camber 0.00° -2.4° to +0.40°
Cross Camber (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 0.50°
Caster +2.60° +1.60° to +3.60°
Cross Caster (Max Side-to-Side Difference) 0.00° 1.00°
Total Toe +0.20° -0.70° to +0.30°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT ITEM PREFERRED SETTING ACCEPTABLE RANGE
Standard Neon Camber -0.25° -0.65° to +0.15°
Total Toe +0.30° +0.10° to +0.50°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
Thrust Angle 0.00° -0.10° to +0.10°
ACR Neon Camber -0.25° -1.00° to +0.20°
Total Toe +0.30° -0.70° to +0.30°
Total Toe is the sum of both the left and right wheel toe
settings. Total Toe must be equally split between each
front wheel to ensure the steering wheel is centered after
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 5461
setting toe. Positive toe (+) is toe-in and negative toe
(-) is toe-out.
Thrust Angle 0.00° -0.10° to +0.10°
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 5462
Alignment: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Vehicle wheel alignment is the positioning of all interrelated front and rear suspension angles.
These angles affect the handling and steering of the vehicle when it is in motion. Proper wheel
alignment is essential for efficient steering, good directional stability, and proper tire wear.
The method of checking a vehicle's front and rear wheel alignment varies depending on the
manufacturer and type of equipment used. The manufacturer's instructions should always be
followed to ensure accuracy of the alignment, except when Daimler Chrysler Corporation's wheel
alignment specifications differ.
On this vehicle, the suspension angles that can be adjusted are as follows:
Front ^
Camber (when proper alignment package is used)
^ Toe
Rear ^
Camber (when proper alignment package is used)
^ Toe
Check the wheel alignment and make all wheel alignment adjustments with the vehicle standing at
its proper curb height specification. Curb height is the normal riding height of the vehicle. It is
measured from a certain point on the vehicle to the ground or a designated area while the vehicle
is sitting on a flat, level surface. Refer to Curb Height Measurement.
Typical wheel alignment angles and measurements are described in the following paragraphs.
CAMBER
Camber is the inward or outward tilt of the top of the tire and wheel assembly. Camber is measured
in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical line. Camber is a tire wearing angle. ^
Excessive negative camber will cause tread wear at the inside of the tire.
^ Excessive positive camber will cause tread wear on the outside of the tire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 5463
CROSS CAMBER
Cross camber is the difference between left and right camber. To achieve the cross camber
reading, subtract the right side camber reading from the left. For example, if the left camber is +
0.3° and the right camber is 0.00°, the cross camber would be + 0.3°.
CASTER
Caster is the forward or rearward tilt of the steering knuckle in reference to the position of the upper
and lower ball joints. Caster is measured in degrees of angle relative to a true vertical center line.
This line is viewed from the side of the tire and wheel assembly. ^
Forward tilt (upper ball joint ahead of lower) results in a negative caster angle.
^ Rearward tilt (upper ball joint trailing lower) results in a positive caster angle.
Although caster does not affect tire wear, a caster imbalance between the two front wheels may
cause the vehicle to lead to the side with the least positive caster.
CROSS CASTER
Cross caster is the difference between left and right caster.
TOE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 5464
Toe is the inward or outward angle of the wheels as viewed from above the vehicle. ^
Toe-in is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are closer together than
the rear edges.
^ Toe-out is produced when the front edges of the wheels on the same axle are farther apart than
the rear edges.
Toe-in and toe-out can occur at the front wheels and the rear wheels.
Toe is measured in degrees or inches. The measurement identifies the amount that the front of the
wheels point inward (toe-in) or outward (toe-out). Toe is measured at the spindle height. Zero toe
means the front and rear edges of the wheels on the same axle are equally distant.
TOE-OUT ON TURNS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 5465
Toe-out on turns is the relative positioning of the front wheels while steering through a turn. This
compensates for each front wheel's turning radius. As the vehicle encounters a turn, the outboard
wheel must travel in a larger radius circle than the inboard wheel. The steering system is designed
to make each wheel follow its particular radius circle. To accomplish this, the front wheels must
progressively toe outward as the steering is turned from center. This eliminates tire scrubbing and
undue tire wear when steering a vehicle through a turn.
DYNAMIC TOE PATTERN
Dynamic toe pattern is the inward and outward toe movement of the front and rear tires through the
suspension's jounce and rebound travel. As the vehicle's suspension moves up and down, the toe
pattern varies. Toe pattern is critical in controlling the directional stability of the vehicle while in
motion. Front and rear dynamic toe pattern is preset by the factory at the time the vehicle is
assembled.
It is not necessary to check or adjust front or rear dynamic toe pattern when doing a normal wheel
alignment. The only time dynamic toe pattern needs to be checked or adjusted is if the frame of the
vehicle has been damaged.
STEERING AXIS INCLINATION (S. A. I.)
Steering axis inclination is the angle between a true vertical line starting at the center of the tire at
the road contact point and a line drawn through the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 5466
center of the upper ball joint (or strut) and the lower ball joint. S.A.I. is built into the vehicle and is
not an adjustable angle. If S.A.I. is not within specifications, a bent or damaged suspension
component may be the cause.
INCLUDED ANGLE (I. A.)
Included angle is the sum of the S.A.I. angle plus or minus the camber angle, depending on
whether or not the wheel has positive or negative camber. If camber is positive, add the camber
angle to the S.A.I. angle. If camber is negative, subtract the camber angle from the S.A.I. angle.
Included angle is not adjustable, but can be used to diagnose a frame misalignment or bent
suspension component (spindle, strut).
THRUST ANGLE
Thrust angle is the averaged direction the rear wheels are pointing in relation to the vehicle's center
line. The presence of negative or positive thrust angle causes the rear tires to track improperly to
the left or right of the front tires (dog tracking). ^
Negative thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the left of the front tires.
^ Positive thrust angle means the rear tires are tracking to the right of the front tires.
Improper tracking can cause undue tire wear, a lead or pull and a crooked steering wheel.
Excessive thrust angle can usually be corrected by adjusting the rear wheel toe so that each wheel
has one-half of the total toe measurement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment
Alignment: Service and Repair Wheel Alignment
PRE-WHEEL ALIGNMENT VEHICLE INSPECTION
CAUTION: If during the inspection the front suspension crossmember shows any sign of impact
damage, the steering column lower coupling must be inspected.
Before any attempt is made to change or correct the wheel alignment, the following inspection and
necessary corrections must be made to the vehicle to ensure proper alignment. 1. Be sure the fuel
tank is full of fuel. If the fuel tank is not full, the reduction in weight will affect the curb height of the
vehicle and the alignment
specifications.
2. The passenger and luggage compartments of the vehicle should be free of any load that is not
factory equipment. 3. Check the tires on the vehicle. The tires are to be inflated to the
recommended air pressure. All tires must be the same size and in good condition
with approximately the same tread wear.
4. Check the front tire and wheel assemblies for excessive radial runout. 5. Inspect all suspension
component fasteners for looseness and torque. 6. Inspect the lower front ball joints and all steering
linkage for looseness and any sign of wear or damage. 7. Inspect the rubber bushings on all the
suspension components for signs of wear or deterioration. If any bushings show signs of wear or
deterioration, they should be replaced prior to aligning the vehicle.
WHEEL ALIGNMENT SETUP
1. Position the vehicle on an alignment rack. 2. Install all required alignment equipment on the
vehicle, per the alignment equipment manufacturer's instructions. On this vehicle, a four-wheel
alignment is recommended.
NOTE: Prior to reading the vehicle's alignment readouts, the front and rear of vehicle should be
jounced. Induce jounce (rear first, then front) by grasping the center of the bumper and jouncing
each end of vehicle an equal number of times. The bumper should always be released when
vehicle is at the bottom of the jounce cycle.
3. Read the vehicle's current front and rear alignment settings. Compare the vehicle's current
alignment settings to the vehicle specifications for
camber, caster and toe-in.
4. If the rear alignment is out of specification, adjust it first before proceeding to the front.
CAMBER AND CASTER
Front and rear camber and caster settings on this vehicle are determined at the time the vehicle is
designed, by the location of the vehicle's suspension components. This is referred to as Net Build.
The result is no required adjustment of camber and caster after the vehicle is built or when
servicing the suspension components. Thus, when performing a wheel alignment, caster and
camber are not normally considered adjustable angles. Camber and caster should be checked to
ensure they meet vehicle specifications.
If either front or rear camber is found not to meet alignment specifications, it can be adjusted using
an available camber adjustment bolt package. Before installing a camber adjustment bolt package
on a vehicle found to be outside the specifications, inspect the suspension components for any
signs of damage or bending.
No adjustment can be made to the caster setting on this vehicle. If the vehicle's caster is not within
alignment specifications, check for damaged suspension components or body parts.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to adjust the vehicles wheel alignment by heating or bending any of the
suspension components.
CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION (WITHOUT ACR PACKAGE)
NOTE: The following procedure should be used on vehicles WITHOUT the ACR competition
package or on the rear suspension of vehicles with the ACR competition package.
The camber adjustment bolt package contains new bolts and nuts for attaching the strut clevis
bracket to the steering knuckle. The bolts contained in the package are slightly undersize allowing
for movement between the strut clevis bracket and the steering knuckle. The movement allowed by
the undersize bolts provides approximately one degree of camber adjustment per side of the
vehicle. To install and adjust the camber adjustment bolt package, follow the procedure below.
CAUTION: There are separate camber adjustment bolt packages for the front and rear of the
vehicle. Be sure to use the correct package.
1. Raise the vehicle until its tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolt shanks are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove the nuts while holding the bolts stationary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 5469
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly at the strut requiring modification.
3. Remove the original upper bolt attaching the strut clevis bracket to the knuckle. 4. Install a bolt
from the adjustment package into the hole where the original bolt was removed. Install the bolt from
the rear. 5. Install a nut provided in adjustment package on the replacement bolt. Tighten the nut
until it's snug, but still allowing the knuckle to slide in the
clevis bracket.
6. Remove the original lower bolt. 7. Install a bolt from the adjustment package into the bottom hole
of the strut clevis bracket. Install the bolt from the rear. 8. Install a nut provided in adjustment
package on the replacement bolt. Tighten the nut until it's snug. 9. Reinstall the tire and wheel
assembly.
10. Perform the above procedure to any of the remaining struts as required. 11. Lower the vehicle
and jounce the front and rear of the vehicle. 12. Adjust the front or rear camber to the preferred
setting by pushing or pulling on the top of the tire. When camber is set to specifications, tighten the
upper and lower strut clevis bracket bolts. Again jounce the front and rear of the vehicle, then verify
the camber settings.
13. Torque front strut clevis bracket-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts to 53 Nm (40 ft. lbs.), plus
an additional 1/4 turn after the torque is met.
Torque the rear strut clevis bracket-to-rear knuckle attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
14. Once camber is within specifications, adjust toe to meet the preferred specification setting.
Refer to TOE within this wheel alignment service
procedure.
CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT PACKAGE INSTALLATION (WITH ACR PACKAGE)
NOTE: The following procedure should only be used on the front suspension of vehicles WITH the
ACR competition package. For installation of the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 5470
adjustment bolt package on the ACR rear suspension, refer to CAMBER ADJUSTMENT BOLT
PACKAGE INSTALLATION (WITHOUT ACR PACKAGE) above.
The camber adjustment bolt package contains new bolts and nuts for attaching the strut clevis
bracket to the steering knuckle. The bolts contained in the package are slightly undersize allowing
for movement between the strut clevis bracket and the steering knuckle. The movement allowed by
the undersize bolts provides approximately one degree of camber adjustment per side of the
vehicle. Additional modification will also be necessary to gain a proper camber setting for ACR
competition. To modify the strut, install and adjust the camber adjustment bolt package, follow the
procedure below.
CAUTION: There are separate camber adjustment bolt packages for the front and rear of the
vehicle. Be sure to use the correct package for the front suspension.
1. Raise the vehicle until its tires are not supporting the weight of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The knuckle to strut assembly attaching bolt shanks are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Remove the nuts while holding the bolts stationary.
2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly at the strut requiring modification. 3. Remove the original
upper and lower bolts attaching the strut clevis bracket to the knuckle. 4. Separate the knuckle from
the strut clevis bracket.
NOTE: The following two steps must be performed to gain the necessary amount of negative
camber for ACR competition.
5. Draw an imaginary line from the center of the clevis bracket upper bolt hole down through the
center of the clevis bracket lower bolt hole.
Pivoting the line at the center of the lower hole, move the upper end of the line inward so as to
follow an arc past the inner edge of the upper bolt hole approximately 2.8 mm (0.11 inch). Mark the
bracket showing what area of the surface needs to be removed to form the elongated hole.
Remember, this elongation must follow the arc. Repeat this step on the opposite side of the clevis
bracket.
6. Using an appropriate grinding tool, elongate the upper hole as indicated by the markings until the
necessary material is removed. Repeat this step
on the opposite side of the clevis bracket.
7. Place the knuckle back in the clevis bracket. 8. Install bolts from the adjustment package into the
holes where the original bolts were removed. Install the bolts from the rear. 9. Install a nut provided
in adjustment package on each replacement bolt. Tighten the nuts until snug, but still allowing the
knuckle to slide in the
clevis bracket.
10. Reinstall the tire and wheel assembly. 11. Perform the above procedure to the remaining front
strut as required. 12. Lower the vehicle and jounce the front and rear of the vehicle. 13. Adjust the
front camber to the preferred setting by pushing or pulling on the top of the tire. When camber is
set to specifications, tighten the upper
and lower strut clevis bracket bolts. Again jounce the front and rear of the vehicle, then verify the
camber settings.
14. Torque front strut clevis bracket-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts to 53 Nm (40 ft. lbs.), plus
an additional 1/4 turn after the torque is met.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 5471
Torque the rear strut clevis bracket-to-rear knuckle attaching bolts to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
15. Once camber is within specifications, adjust toe to meet the preferred specification setting.
Refer to TOE within this wheel alignment service
procedure.
TOE
1. Center the steering wheel and lock it in place using a steering wheel clamp.
NOTE: When performing the toe setting procedure, make sure the rear toe is set to the preferred
specification before setting the front toe to the preferred specification.
REAR TOE
1. Loosen the nuts on the left and right rear lateral link attaching bolts at the rear crossmember as
necessary to allow rotation of the rear toe
adjustment cams.
CAUTION: When adjusting rear toe, the notches on the toe adjustment cams are not to be facing
down. The notches in the adjustment cams are only to be facing up or toward one side.
2. Rotate each toe adjustment cam until the preferred rear toe specification is obtained. 3. While
holding the toe adjustment cams from turning, tighten the attaching bolt nuts. This will securely hold
the adjustment cams in position.
Tighten the attaching bolt nuts to a torque of 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs.).
4. Proceed to FRONT TOE to set the front toe.
FRONT TOE
CAUTION: Do not twist the inner tie rod-to-steering gear rubber boots while turning the inner tie rod
during the front toe adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 5472
1. Loosen the tie rod adjusting jam nuts. Grasp each inner tie rod at its hex and rotate it one way or
the other until the front wheel toe is set to the
preferred specification.
2. Tighten tie rod adjusting jam nuts to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 3. Make sure the inner tie
rod-to-steering gear rubber boots are not twisted. If twisted, loosen the boot clamp at the inner tie
rod and move the boot as
necessary.
4. Remove steering wheel clamp. 5. Remove the alignment equipment. 6. Road test the vehicle to
verify the steering wheel is straight and the vehicle does not pull or wander.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Wheel
Alignment > Page 5473
Alignment: Service and Repair Curb Height Measurement
MEASUREMENT
The wheel alignment is to be checked and all alignment adjustments made with the vehicle at its
required curb height specification.
Vehicle height is to be checked with the vehicle on a flat, level surface, preferably a vehicle
alignment rack. The tires are to be inflated to the recommended pressure. All tires are to be the
same size as standard equipment. Vehicle height is checked with the fuel tank full of fuel, and no
passenger or luggage compartment load.
Vehicle height is not adjustable. If the measurement is not within specifications, inspect the vehicle
for bent or weak suspension components. Compare the parts tag on the suspect coil spring(s) to
the parts book and the vehicle sales code, checking for a match. Once removed from the vehicle,
compare the coil spring height to a correct new or known good coil spring. The heights should vary
if the suspect spring is weak.
NOTE: Prior to reading the curb height measurement, the front an rear of the vehicle should be
jounced. Induce jounce by grasping the center of the rear, then front bumper (or fascia) and
jouncing the vehicle an equal number of times. Release the bumper at the bottom of the jounce
cycle.
1. Measure from the inboard edge of the wheel opening fender lip directly above the wheel center
(spindle), to the floor or alignment rack surface. 2. When measuring, maximum left-to-right
differential is not to exceed 10 mm (0.39 inch). 3. Compare the measurements to specifications
listed in the CURB HEIGHT SPECIFICATIONS chart.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
A power steering pressure switch is used to improve the vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch
improves vehicle idle quality by causing a readjustment of the engine idle speed as necessary
when increased fluid pressure is sensed in the power steering system. The pressure switch
functions by signaling the powertrain control module that an increase in pressure of the power
steering system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when the front
tires of the vehicle are turned while the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When
the powertrain control module receives the signal from the power steering pressure switch, it
directs the engine to increase its idle speed. This increase in engine idle speed compensates for
the additional load, thus maintaining the required engine idle speed and idle quality.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear.
OPERATION
The switch provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine RPM;
such as during parking maneuvers. When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2758 kPa (400
psi), the switch is open. The PCM increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine
stalling. The PCM sends 12 volts through a resister to the sensor circuit to ground. When pump
pressure is low, the switch is closed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 5479
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Locate the power steering fluid pressure
switch on the back side of the power steering gear. 4. Remove the vehicle wiring harness
connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch.
NOTE: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, use a 7/8 inch deep well
socket. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic electrical connector area of the
power steering fluid pressure switch.
5. Unscrew and remove the power steering fluid pressure switch from the power steering gear.
INSTALLATION
1. By hand, screw the power steering pressure switch into the power steering gear until it is fully
seated. Tighten the power steering pressure switch
to a maximum torque of 8 Nm (70 inch lbs.). Over-torquing will result in stripping the threads out of
the power steering pressure switch port in the steering gear.
2. Install the vehicle wiring harness connector. Be sure the latch on the wiring harness connector is
fully engaged with the locking tab on the power
steering pressure switch.
3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Fill the power steering fluid reservoir to the correct fluid level. 5. Connect
the negative cable to the negative post of the battery. 6. Start the engine and turn the steering
wheel several times stop-to-stop to bleed any air from the fluid in the power steering system. Stop
the engine,
check the fluid level, and inspect the system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 5484
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 5485
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 5486
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5487
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications
Front Steering Knuckle: Specifications
FRONT
STEERING KNUCKLE:
Disc Brake Caliper Guide Bolts
................................................................................................................................................ 22 Nm
(192 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5492
Front Steering Knuckle: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - STEERING KNUCKLE
The steering knuckle is a single casting with legs machined for attachment to the front strut
assembly on the top, lower control arm ball joint on the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5493
bottom, and steering linkage on the trailing end. The steering knuckle also has two machined
abutments (rails) on the leading end casting to support and align the front disc brake caliper.
The knuckle supports the wheel bearing and hub. The wheel hub is pressed into a sealed-for-life
wheel bearing that is pressed into the steering knuckle. A retainer plate also holds the bearing in
place. The hub supports the driveshaft outer constant velocity (C/V) joint. Each is splined and
meshes in the center of the hub. The outer C/V joint is retained to the hub using a nut. The nut is
locked to the outer C/V stub shaft using a nut retainer and cotter pin.
The wheel bearing is a Unit 1 type cartridge bearing that requires no maintenance. The wheel
bearing can be serviced separately from the hub.
The hub has five studs pressed into its flange.
OPERATION - STEERING KNUCKLE
The steering knuckle pivots with the strut assembly between the lower ball joint and the pivot
bearing in the strut assembly. The steering gear outer tie rod end connects to the trailing end of
each knuckle, allowing the vehicle to be steered.
The center of the knuckle supports the hub, wheel bearing and axle shaft.
The hub and wheel bearing work together. The wheel bearing has internal bearings that allow the
hub to rotate with the driveshaft and the tire and wheel assembly. The hub's five studs mount the
tire and wheel to the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5494
Front Steering Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - STEERING KNUCKLE
The front suspension steering knuckle is not a repairable component of the front suspension. It
must be replaced if found to be damaged in any way. If it is determined that the steering knuckle is
bent when servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made to straighten the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5495
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - STEERING KNUCKLE
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Apply the brakes and hold in place. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the front tire and wheel
assembly.
4. Remove the cotter pin, lock nut and spring washer from the hub nut. 5. While the brakes are
applied, loosen and remove the hub nut. 6. Release the brakes.
7. Remove the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle. 8.
Remove the disc brake caliper from the steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping
either the top (right side) or bottom (left side) of
the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's caliper slide (on
the knuckle) and rotor.
9. Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not support the caliper by letting
it hang by the hydraulic hose.
10. Remove any retainer clips from the wheel mounting studs. Remove the brake rotor from the
front hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5496
11. Remove the nut attaching the outer tie rod to the steering knuckle. To do this, hold the tie rod
end stud with a wrench while loosening and
removing the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench.
12. Remove the tie rod end from the steering knuckle using Remover, Special Tool MB991113. 13.
Remove the tie rod heat shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5497
14. Remove the nut and pinch bolt clamping the ball joint stud to the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckles while removing the nuts,
then tap the bolts out using a pin punch.
15. Remove the two bolts attaching the strut to the steering knuckle.
NOTE: Use caution when separating the ball joint stud from the steering knuckle, so the ball joint
seal does not get cut.
16. Separate the ball joint stud from the steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm and
up against the ball joint boss on the steering
knuckle.
NOTE: Do not allow the driveshaft to hang by the inner ON joint; it must be supported to keep the
joint from separating during this operation.
17. Pull the steering knuckle off the driveshaft outer C/V joint splines and remove the steering
knuckle.
NOTE: The cartridge type front wheel bearing used on this vehicle is not transferable to the
replacement steering knuckle. If the replacement steering knuckle does not come with a wheel
bearing, a new bearing must be installed in the steering knuckle. Installation of the new wheel
bearing and hub must be done before installing the steering knuckle on the vehicle.
18. If the steering knuckle is to be replaced, the hub and wheel bearing must be removed. Do not
reuse the wheel bearing.
DISASSEMBLY- STEERING KNUCKLE (WHEEL BEARING AND HUB)
NOTE: The removal and installation of the wheel bearing and hub from the steering knuckle is only
to be done with the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle. Removal of the wheel bearing from
the steering knuckle must be done using the following procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5498
1. Remove steering knuckle, hub, and wheel bearing as an assembly from the vehicle. 2. Using
Remover, Special Tool 41 50A, press one wheel mounting stud out of hub flange. Rotate the hub to
align the removed wheel mounting stud
with the notch in bearing retainer plate. Remove the wheel mounting stud from the hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5499
3. Rotate the hub so the hole in the hub that wheel mounting stud was removed from is facing
away from brake caliper lower rail on steering knuckle.
Install one half of the Bearing Splitter, Special Tool 1130, between the hub and the bearing retainer
plate.
NOTE: Align the threaded hole in this first half of the bearing splitter with the caliper rail on the
steering knuckle.
4. Install the remaining pieces of Bearing Splitter, Special Tool 1130, on the steering knuckle. Hand
tighten the nuts to hold bearing splitter in place
on steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5500
5. Once the bearing splitter in fully installed, be sure the three bolts attaching the bearing retainer
plate to steering knuckle are contacting the bearing
splitter. The bearing retainer plate should not support the steering knuckle or contact the bearing
splitter.
6. Place the steering knuckle in an arbor press supported by the bearing splitter as shown.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5501
7. Position Driver, Special Tool 6644-2, on the small end of the hub. Using the arbor press, remove
the hub from the wheel bearing. The outer
bearing race will normally come out of the wheel bearing when the hub is pressed out of the
bearing.
8. Remove the bearing splitter from the steering knuckle.
9. Remove the three bolts mounting the bearing retainer plate to the steering knuckle. Remove the
bearing retainer plate from the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5502
10. Place the steering knuckle back in the arbor press supported by press blocks as shown. The
press blocks must not obstruct the bore in the steering
knuckle so the wheel bearing can be pressed out of the steering knuckle. Place Bearing Driver,
Special Tool MB-990799 on the outer race of wheel bearing. Press the wheel bearing out of the
steering knuckle.
11. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool 1130, on the hub. The bearing splitter is to be installed on
the hub so it is between the flange of the hub and
the outer bearing race on the hub. Place the hub, bearing race and bearing splitter in an arbor
press as shown. Place Driver, Special Tool 6644-2 on end of hub. Press the hub out of the outer
bearing race.
ASSEMBLY - STEERING KNUCKLE (WHEEL BEARING AND HUB)
NOTE: The removal and installation of the wheel bearing and hub from the steering knuckle is only
to be done with the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle.
1. Wipe the empty bore of the steering knuckle clean of any grease or dirt with a clean, dry shop
towel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5503
2. Place the new wheel bearing into the bore of the steering knuckle. Be sure the wheel bearing is
placed squarely into the bore. Place the steering
knuckle in an arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool C-4698-2, supporting the steering knuckle.
Place Driver, Special Tool 5052, on the outer race of the wheel bearing. Press the wheel bearing
into the steering knuckle until it is fully bottomed in the bore of the steering knuckle. Remove the
knuckle from the press.
NOTE: Only the original or identical replacement bolts are to be used to mount the bearing retainer
plate to the steering knuckle.
3. Install the bearing retainer plate on the steering knuckle. Install the three bearing retainer
mounting bolts. Tighten the bearing retainer plate
mounting bolts to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5504
4. Place the previously removed wheel mounting stud back into the hub flange. Place the hub in
the arbor press supported by Special Tool C-4698-1.
Press wheel mounting stud into hub flange until it is fully seated against the back side on the hub
flange. Remove the hub from the press.
5. Place the steering knuckle with the wheel bearing installed back in the arbor press with
Receiver, Special Tool MB-990799 supporting the inner
race of the wheel bearing as shown. Place the hub in wheel bearing making sure it is square with
the bearing inner race. Press the hub into the wheel bearing until it is fully bottomed in the wheel
bearing. Remove the knuckle from the press.
6. Install the steering knuckle assembly on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - STEERING KNUCKLE
1. If the steering knuckle is being replaced and the wheel bearing and hub must be installed. Do
not reuse the old wheel bearing. 2. Slide the hub of the steering knuckle onto the splines on the
driveshaft C/V joint. 3. Install the steering knuckle onto the ball joint stud aligning the bolt hole in
the knuckle boss with the notch formed in the side of the ball joint stud. 4. Install a new ball joint
stud pinch bolt and nut. Tighten the nut to a torque of 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during installation. Install the nuts while holding the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle.
5. Position the lower end of the strut assembly in line with the upper end of the steering knuckle
and align the mounting holes. Install the two
attaching bolts. The bolts should be installed with so that the nuts face towards the front of the
vehicle once installed. Install the nuts. Holding the bolts in place tighten the nuts to a torque of 53
Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an additional 90° turn after the specified torque is met.
6. Place the tie rod heat shield on the steering knuckle arm so that the shield is positioned straight
away from the steering gear and tie rod end once
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5505
installed. Align the hole in the shield with the hole in the steering knuckle arm.
7. Install the outer tie rod ball stud into the hole in the steering knuckle arm. Start the tie rod
attaching nut onto the stud. Hold the tie rod end stud
with a wrench while tightening the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench. To fully tighten
the nut to specifications, use a crowfoot wrench on a torque wrench to turn the nut, and a wrench
on the stud. Tighten the nut to a torque of 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the brake rotor on the hub.
9. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the caliper, then
pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side caliper is
installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower abutment on the steering
knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the caliper into place against
the steering knuckle.
10. Install the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle.
Tighten the guide pin bolts to a torque of 22 Nm (192
inch lbs.).
11. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the driveshaft outer C/V joint. 12. Install the hub nut
in the end of the driveshaft and snug it. 13. Have a helper apply the brakes. With vehicle brakes
applied to keep brake rotor and hub from turning, tighten the hub nut to a torque of 244 Nm
(180 ft. lbs.).
14. Install the spring washer, lock nut and cotter pin on the hub nut. Wrap the cotter pin ends tightly
around the lock nut. 15. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Install the wheel mounting nuts and
tighten them to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Set front toe on the
vehicle to specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 5511
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 5512
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 5513
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Capacity Specifications
The power steering pump has a dipstick. Fluid should be maintained at the proper level indicated
on the dipstick.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid should be checked on a level surface with the engine off.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5516
Power Steering Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications Automatic Transmission Fluid Type
Automatic Transmission Fluid Type
Mopar ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5517
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
STANDARD PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
WARNING: FLUID LEVEL SHOULD BE CHECKED WITH THE ENGINE OFF TO PREVENT
PERSONAL INJURY FROM MOVING PARTS.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid (MS-9602) in the power steering
system. Do not overfill the system.
The power steering fluid level can be viewed on the dipstick attached to the filler cap. Before
opening the power steering system, wipe the reservoir filler cap free of dirt and debris. Remove the
cap and check the fluid level on the dipstick. When the fluid is at normal ambient temperature,
approximately 21°C to 27°C (70°F to 80°F), the fluid level should register between the ADD and
FULL markings on the dipstick. The optimum level is at the FULL line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
All models of this vehicle are equipped with a cooler for the power steering system fluid. The
purpose of the cooler is to keep the temperature of the power steering system fluid from rising to a
level that would affect the performance of the power steering system.
The power steering fluid cooler is located at the front of the front suspension crossmember. It is
mounted to the crossmember top surface using 2 fasteners.
The cooler is placed in series with the power steering fluid return hose, between the steering gear
fluid outlet port and the fluid return hose leading to the power steering fluid reservoir. The power
steering gear has a steel fitting attached to its outlet port that a short hose leading to the cooler is
pushed onto. This hose is secured to both the steering gear outlet fitting and the cooler using
standard adjustable clamps. The cooler is secured to the power steering fluid return hose using a
standard adjustable clamp.
OPERATION
The cooler used on this vehicle is referred to as a fluid-to-air type cooler. This means that the air
flow across the tubes of the cooler is used to extract the heat from the cooler which it has absorbed
from the power steering fluid flowing through it. Utilizing a small air dam mounted to its base to
redirect air across its coils, the cooler lowers the temperature of the power steering fluid prior to it
entering the power steering fluid reservoir where it is resupplied to the power steering pump.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5521
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Service Precautions.
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3.
Remove the hose clamp attaching the power steering fluid return hose to the power steering fluid
cooler. Remove the return hose from the cooler.
Power Steering Fluid Cooler Removal Part 1 Of 2
Power Steering Fluid Cooler Removal Part 2 Of 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5522
4. Remove the hose clamp attaching the power steering cooler fluid hose to the steel fitting in the
power steering gear outlet port. 5. Remove the two screws securing the cooler to the front
suspension crossmember. 6. On LHD vehicles, open the tube routing clamp on the right front of the
power steering gear housing and remove the cooler tube from it. 7. Remove the cooler from the
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide a hose clamp onto the end of the power steering cooler inlet hose (gear end) far enough to
clear the steel fitting on the power steering gear
once the hose is installed.
2. On LHD vehicles, align the cooler outlet tube with the open tube routing clamp on the right front
of the power steering gear housing, and snap it
into place. Close the clamp.
3. Slide the hose (with cooler attached) onto the steering gear outlet fitting. 4. Install the hose
clamp on the power steering cooler fluid hose past the bead formed into the steel fitting and secure
in place. 5. Install the two screws attaching the cooler to the front suspension crossmember.
Tighten the cooler attaching screws to a torque of 10 Nm (90 inch
lbs.).
6. Install the power steering fluid return hose on the power steering fluid cooler outlet tube. Install
the hose clamp on the power steering return hose
securing it to the power steering cooler. Be sure the hose clamp is installed on the return hose past
the bead on the end of the cooler tube.
7. Lower the vehicle. 8. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION procedure.
9. Check for leaks at all connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Level
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
A power steering pressure switch is used to improve the vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch
improves vehicle idle quality by causing a readjustment of the engine idle speed as necessary
when increased fluid pressure is sensed in the power steering system. The pressure switch
functions by signaling the powertrain control module that an increase in pressure of the power
steering system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when the front
tires of the vehicle are turned while the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When
the powertrain control module receives the signal from the power steering pressure switch, it
directs the engine to increase its idle speed. This increase in engine idle speed compensates for
the additional load, thus maintaining the required engine idle speed and idle quality.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear.
OPERATION
The switch provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine RPM;
such as during parking maneuvers. When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2758 kPa (400
psi), the switch is open. The PCM increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine
stalling. The PCM sends 12 volts through a resister to the sensor circuit to ground. When pump
pressure is low, the switch is closed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Level
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5526
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Locate the power steering fluid pressure
switch on the back side of the power steering gear. 4. Remove the vehicle wiring harness
connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch.
NOTE: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, use a 7/8 inch deep well
socket. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic electrical connector area of the
power steering fluid pressure switch.
5. Unscrew and remove the power steering fluid pressure switch from the power steering gear.
INSTALLATION
1. By hand, screw the power steering pressure switch into the power steering gear until it is fully
seated. Tighten the power steering pressure switch
to a maximum torque of 8 Nm (70 inch lbs.). Over-torquing will result in stripping the threads out of
the power steering pressure switch port in the steering gear.
2. Install the vehicle wiring harness connector. Be sure the latch on the wiring harness connector is
fully engaged with the locking tab on the power
steering pressure switch.
3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Fill the power steering fluid reservoir to the correct fluid level. 5. Connect
the negative cable to the negative post of the battery. 6. Start the engine and turn the steering
wheel several times stop-to-stop to bleed any air from the fluid in the power steering system. Stop
the engine,
check the fluid level, and inspect the system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Capacity Specifications
The power steering pump has a dipstick. Fluid should be maintained at the proper level indicated
on the dipstick.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid should be checked on a level surface with the engine off.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5531
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Fluid Type Specifications Automatic Transmission Fluid Type
Automatic Transmission Fluid Type
Mopar ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Hose Tube Nuts ...................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) Return Hose Bracket Bolt
.................................................................................................................................................. 28 Nm
(21 ft. lbs., 250 inch lbs.) Pressure Hose Bracket Bolt ........................................................................
.............................................................................................. 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hose - Pressure
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Hose - Pressure
HOSE POWER STEERING PRESSURE
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Service Precautions.
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Raise the vehicle.
Hoses And Cooler At LHD Gear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 5537
Hoses And Cooler At RHD Gear
3. Back out the tube nut securing the power steering fluid pressure hose to the gear. 4. LHD only Open the tube clamp on the right side of the gear and release the tube from the clamp. 5. Remove
the pressure hose tube from the gear.
RHD Pressure Hose At Engine
6. RHD only - Remove the bolt securing the pressure hose bracket to the engine. 7. Lower the
vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 5538
Power Steering Hoses At Pump
8. Remove the bolt securing the hose routing bracket to the engine mount dragon head. Remove
the hose from the bracket. 9. Un-thread the tube nut securing the power steering pressure hose to
the power steering pump.
10. Remove the power steering pressure hose.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the power steering pressure hose into the engine compartment from the top. First, guide
the pump end of the hose under the pump, then
route the rest of the hose along the right side of the engine. Guide the gear end of the hose down
behind the engine towards the power steering gear.
2. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering hose end and the power steering
pump port. Replace the used O-ring with new.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
3. Install the power steering pressure hose into the outlet fitting on the bottom of the power steering
pump. 4. Thread the tube nut into the pump outlet fitting and tighten it to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft.
lbs.). 5. Install the hose into the hose routing bracket aligning it as shown and attach the bracket to
the engine mount dragon head along with the ground
strap. Tighten the screw to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.).
6. Raise the vehicle.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid hoses must remain away from the exhaust system, vehicle
components, and unfriendly surfaces that can cause possible damage to the power steering hoses.
7. RHD only - Install the bolt attaching the power steering fluid pressure hose routing clamp to the
engine. Tighten the bolt to a torque of 61 Nm (45
ft. lbs.).
8. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering hose end and the power steering
gear port. Replace the used O-ring with new.
Lubricate the O-ring with clean power steering fluid.
9. Attach the power steering fluid pressure hose to the port on the power steering gear. Start the
tube nut threads into the gear. Do not completely
tighten at this time.
10. LHD only - Open the tube clamp on the right side of the gear and insert the pressure hose tube.
Close the clamp. 11. Tighten the pressure hose tube nut at the gear to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft.
lbs.). 12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION
procedure. 14. Check for leaks at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 5539
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Hose - Return
HOSE POWER STEERING RETURN
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Service Precautions.
1. Siphon as much fluid as possible from the power steering fluid reservoir. 2. Raise the vehicle.
Hoses And Cooler At LHD Gear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 5540
Hoses And Cooler At RHD Gear
3. Remove the hose clamp securing the return hose to the power steering cooler tube. Slide the
hose off the end of the cooler tube. 4. Lower the vehicle.
Power Steering Hoses At Pump
5. Remove the hose clamp securing the return hose to the power steering fluid reservoir. Slide the
hose off the end of the reservoir fitting. 6. Remove the bolt securing the hose routing bracket to the
engine mount dragon head. Remove the hose from the bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Hose - Pressure > Page 5541
INSTALLATION
1. Slide a hose clamp onto the power steering pump end of the hose far enough to clear the fitting
on the power steering fluid reservoir once the hose
is installed.
2. Install the power steering return hose into the engine compartment from the top. First, guide the
pump end of the hose onto the fitting of the power
steering pump fluid reservoir, then route the rest of the hose along the right side of the engine.
Guide the remaining end of the hose down behind the engine towards the power steering gear.
3. Expand the hose clamp and slide it onto the fluid reservoir fitting. Secure the clamp once it is
past the bead formed into the fluid reservoir fitting. 4. Install the hose into the hose routing bracket
aligning it as shown and attach the bracket to the engine mount dragon head along with the ground
strap. Tighten the screw to a torque of 12 Nm (105 inch lbs.).
5. Raise the vehicle.
CAUTION: The power steering fluid hoses must remain away from the exhaust system, vehicle
components, and unfriendly surfaces that can cause possible damage to the power steering hoses.
6. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the open power steering hose end and the power steering fluid
cooler tube. 7. Install a hose clamp onto the end of the hose far enough to clear the fitting on the
cooler once the hose is installed. 8. Slide the hose onto the end of the cooler tube. Install the hose
clamp past the bead formed into the cooler tube and secure in place. 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION procedure. 11. Check for leaks
at all hose connections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
Power Steering Pump: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 19-005-03
GROUP: Steering
DATE: Aug. 29, 2003
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-007-01, DATED AUG. 2, 2001, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO
ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Power Steering Fluid Usage
MODELS:
1993 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van
1994 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1994 - 2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2004 (CS) Pacifica
1998-2004 (DN) Durango
2002 - 2004 (DR) Ram Pickup
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Sedan, Stratus Sedan1 Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2004 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Voyager/Caravan
2002 (PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995-2004 (PL) Neon
1997 - 2003 (PR) Prowler
2002 - 2004 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2004 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2004 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1993 - 2002 (SR) Viper/Viper Coupe
2001 - 2004 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2004 (TJ) Wrangler
2003 - 2004 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 5546
1999-2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2003 - 2004 (ZB) Viper
2004 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
The factory fill power steering fluid for most 2004 model year Chrysler Group vehicles is ATF+4
(MS9602) and it provides superior performance at both low and high temperatures. WJ/WG and ZH
vehicles use unique power steering fluids. Refer to the table to identify factory fill and the approved
service power steering fluid by year and model. Note that MS9602 is Red in color and MS5931 and
MS9933 are Amber/Yellow in color. All three fluids will darken in color with usage and fluid color is
no longer an indication of fluid condition.
The part numbers for MS9602 are 05013457AA (quart) and 05013458AA (gallon). The part number
for MS5931 is 04883077 (quart). The part number for MB345 is 05127381AA.
MS9602 should not be mixed or used as a "topping off" fluid on systems requiring MS5931. On
some past models, MS9602 should be used as the replacement fluid. On these models, if a power
steering system is being serviced that results in a large fluid loss, such as a pump, hose or
gear/rack replacement, the complete system should be drained and filled with MS9602.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 5547
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Power Steering Fluid Usage > Page 5548
NOTE:
This bulletin supersedes owner's and service manuals for the vehicles listed above that may state
to use MS9933 in the power steering system, and that may state not to use automatic transmission
fluid in the power steering system.
POLICY: Information Only.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Power Steering Pump: Mechanical Specifications
Pump Pressure Fitting .........................................................................................................................
...................................................... 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs.) Pump Mounting Bolts
........................................................................................................................................................ 28
Nm (21 ft. lbs., 250 inch lbs.) Pump Rear Bracket-To-Engine Bolts
....................................................................................................................................................... 54
Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 5551
Power Steering Pump: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
POWER STEERING PUMP FLOW
Flow At 1500 RPM And Minimum Pressure
................................................................................................................................. 5.67 - 6.43
Liters/Min
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 1.5-1.7 GPM
Control Valve Relief Pressure .............................................................................................................
..................................................... 9308 - 9998 kPa
..............................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 1350- 1450 psi
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5552
Power Steering Pump: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - POWER STEERING PUMP (2.0L ENGINE)
The hydraulic pressure for operation of the power steering gear is provided by a belt driven power
steering pump. The constant flow rate and displacement vane-type power steering pump is located
on the front corner of the engine.
No repair procedures are to be done on the internal components of the power steering pump. The
only serviceable components of the power steering pump are the power steering pump pulley and
the pump itself. The power steering fluid reservoir is serviced with the pump.
Because of unique shaft bearings, flow control levels or pump displacements, power steering
pumps may be used only on specific vehicle applications. Be sure that all power steering pumps
are only replaced with a pump that is the correct replacement for that specific application.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump
Initial Operation
STANDARD PROCEDURE - POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION
WARNING: THE FLUID LEVEL SHOULD BE CHECKED AND ADJUSTED WITH THE ENGINE
OFF TO PREVENT INJURY FROM MOVING ENGINE COMPONENTS.
CAUTION: Use only Mopar ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid (MS-9602) in the power steering
system. Do not overfill.
1. Fill the power steering fluid reservoir to the proper level, then let the fluid settle for at least two
minutes. 2. Start the engine and let run for a few seconds, then turn the engine off. 3. Add fluid if
necessary. Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains constant after running the
engine. 4. Raise the front wheels off the ground. 5. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel
right and left, lightly contacting the wheel stops. 6. Add power steering fluid if necessary. 7. Lower
the vehicle and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock. 8. Stop the engine. Check the fluid
level and refill as required. 9. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few
minutes and repeat the above procedure.
Removal and Installation
REMOVAL - POWER STEERING PUMP
NOTE: Before proceeding, Description and Operation.
1. Remove battery cable from the negative post on the battery. 2. Siphon as much fluid as possible
from the power steering fluid reservoir. 3. Remove the power steering pump drive belt from the
power steering pump pulley.
4. Remove the hose clamp securing the return hose to the power steering fluid reservoir. Slide the
hose off the end of the reservoir fitting. 5. Back out the tube nut securing the power steering fluid
pressure hose to the power steering pump, then remove the hose from the pump.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5555
6. Remove the mounting bolt securing the support bracket to the rear of the power steering pump.
7. Loosen the two mounting bolts securing the support bracket to the engine block.
8. Remove the three mounting bolts holding the power steering pump to the cast bracket. Access
to the mounting bolts can be achieved through the
holes in the pump pulley.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5556
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the screw holding the A/C line routing clamp to the radiator
upper closure panel.
9. Remove the power steering pump with reservoir from the engine.
10. For transferal of the power steering pump pulley, Refer to PUMP - DISASSEMBLY.
INSTALLATION - POWER STEERING PUMP
1. Install the power steering pump with reservoir and pulley on the engine and install the three
mounting bolts securing the pump to the cast bracket.
Tighten the three bolts to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
2. Install the mounting bolt securing the support bracket to the rear of the power steering pump. Do
not completely tighten the bolt at this time. 3. Install the two mounting bolts securing the support
bracket to the engine block. Tighten the bolts to a torque of 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.). 4. Tighten the
mounting bolt securing the support bracket to the rear of the power steering pump to a torque of 28
Nm (250 inch lbs.). 5. Install the power steering pump drive belt on the power steering pump pulley.
6. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean all open power steering hose ends and power steering pump
fittings. 7. Install a new O-ring on the end of the power steering pressure hose. Lubricate the O-ring
using clean power steering fluid. 8. Attach the power steering fluid pressure hose to the pressure
fitting on the lower end of the power steering pump. Thread the tube nut securing the
power steering fluid pressure hose into the power steering pump pressure fitting. Tighten the tube
nut to at torque of 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
9. Slide the power steering fluid return hose onto the fluid reservoir fitting. Position the hose clamp
so it is installed on the hose past the bead formed
into the fluid reservoir fitting.
10. If previously disconnected, attach the A/C line routing clamp to the radiator upper closure
panel. 11. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION procedure. 12. Check for
leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5557
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley
DISASSEMBLY - POWER STEERING PUMP (PULLEY)
NOTE: The only serviceable part of the power steering pump is the pulley. Use the following
procedure for removal of the pulley from the pump.
NOTE: The power steering pump must be removed from the vehicle for power steering pump
pulley service.
CAUTION: Use care when removing and installing the power steering pump pulley. It is made of
plastic composite, except for the center shank. The special tools are to be used in the shank area
only as described in the following procedure.
CAUTION: Do not hammer on the power steering pump pulley or shaft to remove the power
steering pump pulley. Damage to the pulley and the power steering pump can occur.
1. Install Puller, Special Tool C-4333, or an equivalent, on the steering pump pulley as shown.
Tighten the puller screw drive and remove the pulley
from the power steering pump shaft.
NOTE: Replace the power steering pump pulley if it is cracked or loose.
2. Remove the puller from the power steering pump pulley.
NOTE: For installation of the pulley, Refer to PUMP - ASSEMBLY.
ASSEMBLY - POWER STEERING PUMP (PULLEY)
CAUTION: Use care when removing and installing the power steering pump pulley. It is made of
plastic composite, except for the center shank. The special tools are to be used in the shank area
only as described in the following procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 5558
1. Place the power steering pump pulley squarely on end of the power steering pump shaft. Mount
Installer, Special Tool C-4063, or an equivalent, in
the internal threads of the power steering pump shaft and against power steering pump pulley.
2. Ensuring that the installer and the pulley remain aligned with pump shaft, turn the installer outer
nut and force the pulley onto the power steering
pump shaft until it is flush with the end of the pump shaft. Once the pulley is flush with the end of
the shaft, the installer outer nut will no longer be able to turn.
3. Remove the installer from the power steering pump. 4. Install the power steering pump back on
the engine.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
POWER STEERING PRESSURE SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
A power steering pressure switch is used to improve the vehicle's idle quality. The pressure switch
improves vehicle idle quality by causing a readjustment of the engine idle speed as necessary
when increased fluid pressure is sensed in the power steering system. The pressure switch
functions by signaling the powertrain control module that an increase in pressure of the power
steering system is putting additional load on the engine. This type of condition exists when the front
tires of the vehicle are turned while the vehicle is stationary and the engine is at idle speed. When
the powertrain control module receives the signal from the power steering pressure switch, it
directs the engine to increase its idle speed. This increase in engine idle speed compensates for
the additional load, thus maintaining the required engine idle speed and idle quality.
The power steering pressure switch is mounted directly to the power steering gear.
OPERATION
The switch provides an input to the PCM during periods of high pump load and low engine RPM;
such as during parking maneuvers. When power steering pump pressure exceeds 2758 kPa (400
psi), the switch is open. The PCM increases idle air flow through the IAC motor to prevent engine
stalling. The PCM sends 12 volts through a resister to the sensor circuit to ground. When pump
pressure is low, the switch is closed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5563
Power Steering Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Disconnect negative battery cable from the negative post of the battery. Be sure cable is isolated
from negative post on battery. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Locate the power steering fluid pressure
switch on the back side of the power steering gear. 4. Remove the vehicle wiring harness
connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch.
NOTE: When removing and installing the power steering pressure switch, use a 7/8 inch deep well
socket. The deep well socket will prevent damage to the plastic electrical connector area of the
power steering fluid pressure switch.
5. Unscrew and remove the power steering fluid pressure switch from the power steering gear.
INSTALLATION
1. By hand, screw the power steering pressure switch into the power steering gear until it is fully
seated. Tighten the power steering pressure switch
to a maximum torque of 8 Nm (70 inch lbs.). Over-torquing will result in stripping the threads out of
the power steering pressure switch port in the steering gear.
2. Install the vehicle wiring harness connector. Be sure the latch on the wiring harness connector is
fully engaged with the locking tab on the power
steering pressure switch.
3. Lower the vehicle. 4. Fill the power steering fluid reservoir to the correct fluid level. 5. Connect
the negative cable to the negative post of the battery. 6. Start the engine and turn the steering
wheel several times stop-to-stop to bleed any air from the fluid in the power steering system. Stop
the engine,
check the fluid level, and inspect the system for leaks.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5568
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5569
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5570
Fig. 40 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5571
Power Steering Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service Precautions > Page 5576
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 19-002-04A >
Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
Steering Column Bearing: Customer Interest Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 19-002-04A >
Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5585
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 19-002-04A >
Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5586
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 19-002-04A >
Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5587
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 19-002-04A >
Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5588
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
Steering Column Bearing: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Steering Column Clicking
Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5594
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5595
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5596
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5597
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Cover: > 19-002-04A > Aug
> 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
Steering Column Cover: Customer Interest Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Cover: > 19-002-04A > Aug
> 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5606
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Cover: > 19-002-04A > Aug
> 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5607
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Cover: > 19-002-04A > Aug
> 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5608
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Cover: > 19-002-04A > Aug
> 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5609
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Cover: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
Steering Column Cover: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Cover: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5615
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Cover: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5616
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Cover: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5617
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Cover >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Cover: >
19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5618
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Steering Gear: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - POWER STEERING GEAR
The power steering gear is mounted on the front suspension crossmember. The outer ends of the
outer tie rods attach to the steering knuckles.
There are two different type power steering gears used on this vehicle, a standard, and an optional
which is used on the ACR and R/T vehicles. Externally the gears appear the same. Internally, the
standard has a 16:1 turning ratio while the ACR /R/T gear has an 18:1 turning ratio. The gear used
on ACR and R/T vehicles also has a restricted lateral (lock-to-lock) travel range to accommodate
the R/T wheel and tire combination. Sport feel valve coding provides ACR / R/T vehicles with more
firm feel steering to match the performance tire compounding and construction.
NOTE: The power steering gear should not be serviced or adjusted. If a malfunction or oil leak
occurs with the steering gear, the complete steering gear needs to be replaced.
OPERATION - POWER STEERING GEAR
Turning of the steering wheel is converted into lateral (side-to side) travel through the meshing of
the helical pinion teeth with the rack teeth located in the steering gear. This lateral travel pushes
and pulls the tie rods to change the direction of the vehicle's front wheels.
Power assist is provided by a pump and is controlled by an open-center, rotary type control valve. It
directs fluid to either side of the gear's integral steering rack piston. Depending on the rotation of
the steering wheel, more fluid pressure is directed to one side of the rack piston compared to the
other.
Road feel is controlled by the diameter of a torsion bar which initially steers the vehicle. As steering
effort increases, as in a turn, the torsion bar twists causing relative rotary motion between the
rotary valve body and valve spool. This movement restricts fluid flow to one side of the integral rack
piston and redirects fluid behind the other side of the integral rack piston, building up hydraulic
pressure, thus assisting in the turning effort.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5622
Steering Gear: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - POWER STEERING GEAR
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to STEERING - Service Precautions.
1. Place the steering wheel in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. Using a steering wheel holder, lock
the steering wheel in place to keep it from
rotating. This keeps the clockspring in the proper orientation.
2. Inside the passenger compartment, remove the steering column coupling retainer pin, back off
the pinch bolt nut, and remove the steering column
coupling pinch bolt (the pinch bolt nut is caged to the coupling and is not removable). Separate the
upper and lower steering column couplings.
3. Raise the vehicle. 4. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies from the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5623
5. Remove nuts attaching both outer tie rods to the steering knuckles. Remove each nut by holding
the tie rod stud stationary while loosening and
removing the nut with a wrench.
6. Remove the outer tie rod from the steering knuckles using Remover, Special Tool MB99 1113. 7.
Remove the tie rod heat shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5624
8. Release the locking tab on the wiring harness connector for the power steering fluid pressure
switch before connector removal. Remove the wiring
harness connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch.
9. Back out the tube nut securing the power steering fluid pressure hose to the gear.
10. Loosen the clamp, then disconnect the fluid cooler hose from the gear. 11. Open the routing
clips on the front of the power steering gear and remove the power steering fluid pressure hose
from the routing clips. At the
same time, remove the cooler tube from the right routing clip.
12. Remove the two screws securing the cooler to the front suspension crossmember. They are
located behind the cooler and can be accessed from
above. Allow the cooler to hang out of the way.
13. Remove the drive-belt splash shield fasteners. Remove the shield.
14. Remove the pencil strut from the right front corner of the crossmember and body of the vehicle.
Remove the washer behind the strut from the
torque strut bolt.
15. Remove the bolts mounting the engine torque strut in place, then remove the engine torque
strut from the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5625
NOTE: Before removing the front suspension crossmember from the vehicle, the location of the
crossmember must be scribed on the body of the vehicle. Do this so that the crossmember can be
relocated upon reinstallation against the body of vehicle in the same location as before removal. If
the front suspension crossmember is not reinstalled in exactly the same location as before
removal, the preset front wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
16. Using an awl, scribe a line marking the location of where the front suspension crossmember is
mounted against the body of the vehicle. 17. Position a transmission jack under the center of the
front suspension crossmember and raise it to support the bottom of the crossmember. 18. Loosen
and completely remove the two front bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front suspension
crossmember to the frame rails of vehicle.
The right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure. The left side bolt is located in the
same location on the other side of the vehicle.
19. Loosen the two rear bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front suspension crossmember
and lower control arms to the body of the vehicle
until they release from the threaded tapping plates in the body of the vehicle. Do not completely
remove the rear bolts because they are designed to disengage from the body threads yet stay
within the lower control arm rear isolator bushing. This allows the lower control arm to stay in place
on the crossmember. The right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure. The left side
bolt is located in the same location on the other side of the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5626
20. Lower the front suspension crossmember using the transmission jack enough to allow the
power steering gear to be removed from the rear of the
crossmember. When lowering front suspension crossmember, do not let crossmember hang from
lower control arms. The weight should be supported by the transmission jack.
21. Remove the roll pin securing the steering column lower coupling to the power steering gear
pinion shaft using a roll pin punch. Push the steering
column lower coupling up and off of the power steering gear pinion shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5627
22. Release the pinion shaft dash cover seal from the tabs cast into the power steering gear
housing and remove the seal from the power steering gear. 23. Loosen and remove the four bolts
attaching the power steering gear to the front suspension crossmember. Remove the power
steering gear from
the front suspension crossmember.
REMOVAL - RHD
Right-Hand-Drive power steering gear is typical of Left-Hand-Drive.
INSTALLATION - POWER STEERING GEAR
1. Install the steering gear on the front suspension crossmember. Install the four power steering
gear mounting bolts. Tighten the mounting bolts to a
torque of 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.).
2. Install the pinion shaft dash cover seal over the power steering pinion shaft and onto the power
steering gear housing. Align the holes on each side
of the seal with the tabs cast into the power steering gear housing.
3. With the steering column lower coupling pushed partway up through its hole in the dash panel,
match the flat on the inside of the steering column
lower coupling to the flat on the power steering gear pinion shaft and slide the coupling onto the top
of the pinion shaft. Align the roll pin hole in the coupling with the groove in the pinion shaft and
install the roll pin through the coupling until it is centered.
4. Center the power steering gear rack in its travel. 5. Using the transmission jack, raise the front
suspension crossmember and power steering gear until the crossmember contacts its mounting
spot
against the body and frame rails of the vehicle. As the crossmember is raised, carefully guide the
steering column lower coupling up through its hole in the dash panel.
6. Start the two rear crossmember mounting bolts into the tapping plates mounted in the body. The
right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt
figure. The left side bolt is located in the same location on the other side of the vehicle. Next, install
the two front mounting bolts attaching front suspension crossmember to frame rails of vehicle.
Lightly tighten all four mounting bolts to a approximately 2 Nm (20 inch lbs.) to hold the front
suspension crossmember in position.
NOTE: When reinstalling the front suspension crossmember back in the vehicle, it is very important
that the crossmember be attached to the body in exactly the same spot as when it was removed.
Otherwise, the vehicle's wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
7. Using a soft face hammer, tap the front suspension crossmember back-and-forth or side-to-side
until it is aligned with the previously scribed
positioning marks on the body of the vehicle. Once the front suspension crossmember is correctly
positioned, tighten the rear two crossmember (and rear lower control arm) mounting bolts to a
torque of 203 Nm (150 ft. lbs.), then tighten the front two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque
of 142 Nm (105 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the engine torque strut and mounting bolts. To properly align and tighten the torque strut,
Refer to TORQUE STRUT - ADJUSTMENTS. 9. Install the washer on the end of the stud
extending from the torque strut bolt.
10. Install the pencil strut to the right front corner of the crossmember and body of the vehicle.
Tighten the pencil strut nuts to a torque of 58 Nm (43
ft. lbs.).
11. Install the drive-belt splash shield and fasteners. 12. Using a lint free towel, wipe clean the
open power steering hose ends and the power steering gear ports. Replace the pressure hose
used O-ring
with new. Lubricate the O-ring with power steering fluid.
13. Attach the power steering fluid pressure hose to the pressure port on the power steering gear.
Start the tube nut threads into the gear, but do not
tighten them at this time. On vehicles equipped with a power steering fluid cooler, reconnect the
cooler line to the gear in place of the power steering fluid return hose.
14. Open the routing clips on the front of the steering gear housing and install the power steering
fluid pressure hose into the routing clips. 15. Place the cooler in mounting position and snap the
cooler tube going to the gear into the right routing clip. 16. Close both routing clips. 17. Tighten the
power steering fluid pressure hose tube nut at the gear to a torque of 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5628
18. Install the two screws securing the cooler to the front suspension crossmember. They are
located behind the cooler. 19. Place the hose clamp on the hose far enough from the end to clear
the steel fitting on the gear. Do the same for the fluid return hose on a vehicle
that is not equipped with a cooler.
20. Push either hose listed in the above step onto the steel fitting, then move and secure the clamp
on the hose past the bead on the steel fitting in the
steering gears outlet port.
21. Route the fluid return hose along the front of the steering gear, clipping it into place in the
C-clamps on the outside of the routing clips on the front
of the power steering gear housing.
22. Reconnect the wiring harness connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch. Be sure
the locking tab on the wiring harness connector is
securely latched.
23. Perform the following to each outer tie rod:
^ Place the tie rod heat shield on the knuckle's steering arm, aligning the hole in the shield with the
hole in the knuckle and the tangs on the outside of the shield with the outside configuration of the
steering arm. The shield should now be facing outboard, away from the power steering gear and tie
rod.
^ Attach the outer tie rod end to its steering knuckle.
^ Start the attaching nut onto the stud of the outer tie rod.
^ While holding the stud of the tie rod stationary with a wrench, tighten the attaching nut.
^ Using a crowfoot wrench attached to a torque wrench, tighten the attaching nut to 55 Nm (40 ft.
lbs.).
24. Install the tire and wheel assemblies back on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.) torque. 25. Lower the vehicle to ground level. 26. Install the dash-to-lower coupling
seal in place over the lower coupling's plastic collar.
NOTE: Verify that grease is present on the lip of the dash-to-coupling seal where it contacts the
coupling's plastic collar.
27. Inside the passenger compartment, place the steering column in the full tilt-up position and
secure the tilt lever, then reconnect the steering column
lower coupling to the steering column upper coupling. Install the coupling pinch bolt and tighten the
pinch bolt nut to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.). Install the pinch bolt retainer pin.
28. Remove the steering wheel holder. 29. While looking under the instrument panel at the lower
coupling, rotate the steering wheel back-and-forth to verify that the lower coupling does not
squeak against the dash-to-coupling seal.
30. Perform the POWER STEERING PUMP INITIAL OPERATION service procedure to properly fill
and bleed the power steering system. 31. Check for fluid leaks. 32. Adjust the front toe setting on
the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - RHD
Right-Hand-Drive power steering gear is typical of Left-Hand-Drive.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking
Sound
Steering Shaft: Customer Interest Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking
Sound > Page 5637
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking
Sound > Page 5638
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking
Sound > Page 5639
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering Column Clicking
Sound > Page 5640
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound
Steering Shaft: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5646
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5647
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5648
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5649
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound
Steering Shaft Coupler: Customer Interest Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5658
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5659
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5660
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 > Steering - Steering
Column Clicking Sound > Page 5661
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 >
Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
Steering Shaft Coupler: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound
NUMBER: 19-002-04 REV. A
GROUP: Steering
DATE: August 27, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL SEPT. 3, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 19-002-04 DATED APRIL 6, 2004, WHICH
SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH
**ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES AN ADDITIONAL PART AND CHANGE TO THE REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Steering Column Click Sound
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves aligning the steering column or removing the steering column and installing a
new steering column shaft, revised wedge, **revised spring** and seating the lower bearing.
MODELS: 2000 - 2004 (PL) Neon
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built prior to November 16, 2003 (MDH 1116XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
A click sound is heard when the steering wheel is turned.
PARTS REQUIRED
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED
DIAGNOSIS/REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Refer to the appropriate service manual or service information on TeChCONNECT for removal and
installation procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 >
Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5667
1. Turn the steering wheel and listen for a click sound. If the click sound is heard, remove the
steering column shrouds.
2. Turn the steering wheel, listen to hear if the click sound remains.
3. If the click sound is eliminated determine the source interference with the steering column
shrouds and correct, the repair is then complete.
WARNING:
When an undeployed airbag is to be removed from the steering wheel, disconnect and isolate the
battery ground cable. Allow the system capacitor to discharge for two minutes, then begin airbag
removal.
NOTE:
Be sure to center the steering wheel and have the front tires and wheels straight ahead before
removing the steering wheel and disconnecting the lower coupling. Access to the steering column
shaft coupler screw is easier if the steering wheel is turned so the screw head is pointing straight
down.
4. If a click sound is heard, remove the steering wheel and disconnect the intermediate shaft to
steering gear (lower) coupling.
NOTE:
Turn the steering shaft no more than one revolution in either direction from center. Keep track of
the centered position.
5. Turn the steering shaft, listen to see if the click sound remains.
6. If the click sound is eliminated reattach the lower coupling and install the steering wheel, being
sure the clock spring/steering wheel travel is centered. Torque the coupling pinch bolt to 29 Nm (21
ft. lbs.) and torque the steering wheel bolt to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
7. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains.
8. If the click sound returns, loosen the lower coupling pinch bolt and the four steering column
mounting bracket nuts.
9. Jiggle the steering column and then tighten lower coupling pinch bolt. Torque the coupling pinch
bolt to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) Tighten the 2 lower steering column assembly mounting nuts to hold the
steering column in place. Be sure both break-away capsules are still fully seated in the slots of the
upper steering column mounting bracket and the mounting studs are centered fore-and-aft in the
plastic capsules. Then equally tighten both steering column mounting nuts, until upper steering
column mounting bracket is seated against support bracket. Tighten the 4 steering column bracket
to support bracket nuts to 17 Nm (150 in. lbs.).
10. Turn the steering wheel; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the click sound is
eliminated, replace the lower coupling pinch bolt, p/n 06506112AA, torque the coupling pinch bolt
to 29 Nm (21 ft. lbs.), then the repair is complete.
11. If the click sound remains, remove the clock spring. To avoid damaging the clock spring:
a. The clock spring is positioned to the lock housing by two snap latch features at 12:00 and 6:00
o'clock positions. Lift the top latch up slightly while guiding it over the lock housing. This will prevent
the latch from being broken.
b. Care should be taken regarding centering of the steering wheel and clock spring with respect to
the front wheels; follow the service manual clock spring centering procedure. Turning the steering
wheel when the column is disconnected from the steering gear can damage the clock spring.
c. When using the steering wheel puller, hand tighten the puller bolts (no more than five
revolutions) and avoid contact between the bolts and the top of the clock spring.
d. When removing the airbag inflator connectors, squeeze the sides of the connector, to release it,
while pulling it out of the airbag.
12. Disconnect the lower coupling.
13. Turn the steering shaft; listen to hear if the click sound remains. If the sound is eliminated
determine the source interference with the clock spring and correct, the repair is then complete.
14. If the click sound remains, remove the steering column from the vehicle.
NOTE:
The ignition key must be turned to the run position to remove the shifter/ignition interlock cable
from the key lock housing.
15. Remove the two screws attaching the multifunction switch and separate the switch from the
steering column.
16. Remove the steering column intermediate shaft from the steering column shaft. Install
Remover/Installer, Special Tool 6831-A, through center of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 >
Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5668
roll pin in intermediate shaft's universal joint and install knurled nut. While holding hex on end
threaded rod, tighten the nut on threaded rod of Remover/Installer. This will pull the roll pin out of
the intermediate shaft's universal joint. Using a screwdriver inserted between the shaft's universal
joint and the steering column lower mounting bracket, gently pry intermediate shaft off steering
column shaft.
17. Remove the spring retainer by squeezing the outside diameter with pliers and sliding it off the
end of the steering column shaft, refer to (Fig. 1).
18. Remove the spring, wedge and steering column shaft.
19. Inspect the upper and lower steering column bearings, if damaged replace them/it as
necessary, p/n 04690507AB upper bearing, p/n 04690344AB lower bearing (with notch).
20. Stand the steering column on end so the outer race of the upper bearing is supported on a
1-1/16 in. socket. Using a 7/8" deep well socket or other suitable tool placed against the lower
bearing outer race tap the bearing downward several times with a brass hammer until the bearing
is fully seated. Use a 0.005" feeler gauge to make sure no clearance exists between the lower
casting and the outer race of the lower bearing. Refer to (Fig.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 >
Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5669
2)
21. Install the revised steering column shaft p/n 05057229AA, revised wedge, p/n 04690570, and
**revised preload spring, p/n 05057088AA**.
22. Thread the steering wheel bolt into the steering column shaft.
23. Stand the column assembly on the head of the steering wheel bolt, insure the surface is flat.
Refer to (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Shaft Coupler: > 19-002-04A > Aug > 04 >
Steering - Steering Column Clicking Sound > Page 5670
24. Install a new retainer, p/n 04664130, onto the steering column shaft by using a 7/8" deep well
socket and small hammer to tap the retainer into place so the installed distance between the lower
housing and the outside face of the retainer is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). If the retainer is
installed to distance less than 12 mm (15/32 in.) remove the retainer and install a new retainer,
repeat as necessary until the installed distance is 12-14 mm (15/32-17/32 in.). Refer to (Fig. 4).
NOTE:
If the installed dimension is less than l2mm a binding condition may result. If the installed
dimension is greater than l4mm a loose condition may result.
25. Verify the click sound has been corrected. If a sound is still present further diagnosis is
required.
26. Using the procedures outlined in the appropriate service information, install the steering column
and intermediate shaft assembly into the vehicle.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5671
Steering Shaft Coupler: Description and Operation
STEERING COUPLING LOWER
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle uses a corrugated design lower coupling to connect the steering column to the
steering gear.
This coupling has a hollow corrugated tube that allows the coupling to bend rather than collapse
when a vehicle is involved in a collision.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5672
Steering Shaft Coupler: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - STEERING COLUMN LOWER COUPLING
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to COLUMN - Service Precautions.
1. Place the steering wheel in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position. Using a steering wheel holder, lock
the steering wheel in place to keep it from
rotating. This keeps the clockspring in the proper orientation.
2. Inside the passenger compartment, remove the steering column coupling retainer pin, back off
the pinch bolt nut, and remove the steering column
coupling pinch bolt (the pinch bolt nut is caged to the coupling and is not removable). Separate the
upper and lower steering column couplings.
3. Raise the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5673
4. Release the locking tab on the wiring harness connector for the power steering fluid pressure
switch before connector removal. Remove the wiring
harness connector from the power steering fluid pressure switch.
5. Remove the drive-belt splash shield fasteners. Remove the shield.
6. Remove the pencil strut from the right front corner of the crossmember and body of the vehicle.
Remove the washer behind the strut from the
torque strut bolt.
7. Remove the bolts mounting the engine torque strut in place, then remove the engine torque strut
from the vehicle.
NOTE: Before removing the front suspension crossmember from the vehicle, the location of the
crossmember must be scribed on the body of the vehicle. Do this so that the crossmember can be
relocated upon reinstallation against the body of vehicle in the same location as before removal. If
the front suspension crossmember is not reinstalled in exactly the same location as before
removal, the preset front wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5674
8. Using an awl, scribe a line marking the location of where the front suspension crossmember is
mounted against the body of the vehicle. 9. Position a transmission jack under the center of the
front suspension crossmember and raise it to support the bottom of the crossmember.
10. Loosen and completely remove the two front bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front
suspension crossmember to the frame rails of vehicle.
The right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure. The left side bolt is located in the
same location on the other side of the vehicle.
11. Loosen the two rear bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front suspension crossmember
and lower control arms to the body of the vehicle
until they release from the threaded tapping plates in the body of the vehicle. Do not completely
remove the rear bolts because they are designed to disengage from the body threads yet stay
within the lower control arm rear isolator bushing. This allows the lower control arm to stay in place
on the crossmember. The right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure. The left side
bolt is located in the same location on the other side of the vehicle.
CAUTION: Lower the steering gear slowly, paying special attention to the power steering fluid
hoses coming down from the power steering pump. Do not strain or over extend the hoses coming
to the gear. Damage to the hoses or connecting hardware could occur.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5675
12. Lower the front suspension crossmember using the transmission jack enough to allow sufficient
access to the steering column lower coupling.
When lowering front suspension crossmember, do not let crossmember hang from lower control
arms or power steering hoses. The weight should be supported by the transmission jack.
13. Remove the roll pin securing the steering column lower coupling to the power steering gear
pinion shaft using a roll pin punch. Push the steering
column lower coupling up and off of the power steering gear pinion shaft.
INSTALLATION - STEERING COLUMN LOWER COUPLING
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Push the column end of the steering column lower coupling partway up through its hole in the
dash panel, then match the flat on the inside of the
steering column lower coupling to the flat on the power steering gear pinion shaft and slide the
coupling onto the top of the pinion shaft. Align the roll pin hole in the coupling with the groove in the
pinion shaft and install the roll pin through the coupling until it is centered.
2. Center the power steering gear rack in its travel. 3. Using the transmission jack, raise the front
suspension crossmember and power steering gear until the crossmember contacts its mounting
spot
against the body and frame rails of the vehicle. As the crossmember is raised, carefully guide the
steering column lower coupling up through its hole in the dash panel.
4. Start the two rear crossmember mounting bolts into the tapping plates mounted in the body. The
right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt
figure. The left side bolt is located in the same location on the other side of the vehicle. Next, install
the two front mounting bolts attaching front suspension crossmember to frame rails of vehicle.
Lightly tighten all four mounting bolts to a approximately 2 Nm (20 inch lbs.) to hold the front
suspension crossmember in position.
NOTE: When reinstalling the front suspension crossmember back in the vehicle, it is very important
that the crossmember be attached to the body in exactly the same spot as when it was removed.
Otherwise, the vehicle's wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft Coupler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5676
5. Using a soft face hammer, tap the front suspension crossmember back-and-forth or side-to-side
until it is aligned with the previously scribed
positioning marks on the body of the vehicle. Once the front suspension crossmember is correctly
positioned, tighten the rear two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque of 203 Nm (150 ft. lbs.),
then tighten the front two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque of 142 Nm (105 ft. lbs.).
6. Install the engine torque strut and mounting bolts. To properly align and tighten the torque strut,
Refer to TORQUE STRUT - ADJUSTMENTS. 7. Install the washer on the end of the stud
extending from the torque strut bolt. 8. Install the pencil strut to the right front corner of the
crossmember and body of the vehicle. Tighten the pencil strut nuts to a torque of 58 Nm (43
ft. lbs.).
9. Install the drive-belt splash shield and fasteners.
10. Reconnect the wiring harness connector to the power steering fluid pressure switch. Be sure
the locking tab on the wiring harness connector is
securely latched.
11. Lower the vehicle to ground level. 12. Install the dash-to-lower coupling seal in place over the
lower coupling's plastic collar.
NOTE: Verify that grease is present on the lip of the dash-to-coupling seal where it contacts the
coupling's plastic collar.
13. Inside the passenger compartment, position the steering column in the full tilt-up position and
secure the tilt lever, then reconnect the steering
column lower coupling to the steering column upper coupling. Install the coupling pinch bolt and
tighten the pinch bolt nut to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.). Install the pinch bolt retainer pin.
14. Remove the steering wheel holder. 15. While looking under the instrument panel at the lower
coupling, rotate the steering wheel back-and-forth to verify that the lower coupling does not
squeak against the dash-to-coupling seal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications
Steering Wheel: Specifications
Steering Wheel Retaining Screw
..............................................................................................................................................................
54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5680
Steering Wheel: Service Precautions
REMOVAL
WARNING: DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE
BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: ALLOW SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE FOR 2 MINUTES BEFORE
REMOVING ANY AIRBAG COMPONENTS.
1. Adjust the steering wheel so that the tires are in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position.
NOTE: The steering column on vehicles with an automatic transmission may not be equipped with
an internal locking shaft that allows the ignition key cylinder to be locked with the key. Alternative
methods of locking the steering wheel for service will have to be used.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
3. Remove the two mounting screws, one on each side of steering wheel, attaching the driver
airbag to the steering wheel. 4. Lay the driver airbag back away from the center of the steering
wheel. Disconnect the airbag squib and horn switch wiring connectors from the
rear of the airbag. Remove the driver airbag from the steering wheel.
5. If equipped with speed control, disconnect the wiring connector from the speed control switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5681
6. Holding the steering wheel firmly in place, remove the steering wheel retaining screw from the
steering column shaft.
CAUTION: When installing a wheel puller on the steering wheel, be sure the puller bolts are fully
seated in the threaded holes on the steering wheel. If the bolts are not fully seated in the threaded
holes, the threads may be stripped out of the steering wheel when attempting to remove the
steering wheel. Also, thread the retaining nut back on the end of the shaft until it is flush with the
shaft end to avoid damage to the shaft threads by the wheel puller.
7. Install a steering wheel puller on the steering wheel.
CAUTION: Do not bump or hammer on steering wheel or steering column shaft when removing
steering wheel from steering column.
8. While holding the steering wheel firmly in the STRAIGHT-AHEAD position, remove steering
wheel from the steering column shaft using the
puller. While removing the steering wheel, take care to feed the wires gently through the holes in
the steering wheel.
9. If equipped with speed control, remove the speed control switch.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE
BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR INSTALLATION
PROCEDURE. THIS WILL DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DISCONNECT
BATTERY COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Confirm that:
a. The front wheels are positioned straight ahead. b. The turn signal stalk is in the neutral position.
2. If equipped with speed control, install the speed control switch on the steering wheel.
CAUTION: Do not install the steering wheel onto the shaft of the steering column by driving it onto
the shaft.
3. Feed the clockspring wiring leads through the hole in the steering wheel. Align the steering
wheel's wide mounting spline with the steering column
shaft missing spline area and push the wheel onto the shaft. Make sure the clockspring squares up
with the back of the wheel and does not bind.
4. Install the steering wheel retaining screw and tighten it until the steering wheel is fully installed
on shaft. Tighten the retaining screw to a torque of
54.2 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
5. If equipped with speed control, connect the wiring lead from the clockspring to the speed control
switch on the steering wheel. 6. Position the driver airbag near the steering wheel. Connect the
horn switch wiring lead to the connector on the back of the airbag. 7. Install the airbag squib wiring
lead from the clockspring into the connector on the back of the driver airbag. Be sure the wiring
connector is
securely latched into the airbag connector.
CAUTION: The fasteners originally used for the airbag components are specifically designed for
the airbag system. They must never be replaced with any substitutes. Anytime a new fastener is
needed, replace it with only the correct fastener listed in the parts book.
8. Install the driver airbag into the center of the steering wheel. Align the airbag mounting holes
with the bolt holes in the steering wheel. Install only
the two original or identical replacement airbag module mounting screws. Tighten the two driver
airbag attaching bolts to a torque of 10 Nm (90 inch lbs.).
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE AT THIS TIME. REFER TO
RESTRAINTS - DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications
Tie Rod End: Specifications
Front
Tie Rod Adjusting Jam Nut ..................................................................................................................
................................................ 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.) Tie Rod End Steering Knuckle Nut
...................................................................................................................................................... 54
Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Steering
Tie Rod Steering Arm Nut ...................................................................................................................
................................................. 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) Tie Rod Jam Nut ..................................................
................................................................................................................................. 75 Nm (55 ft.
lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5686
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair
TIE ROD OUTER
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle.
3. Loosen tie rod jam nut. Thread the jam nut far enough up the inner tie rod to pull the collar away
from the outer tie rod end. Pull the collar off the
end of the outer tie rod.
4. Remove the nut attaching the outer tie rod end to steering knuckle. Remove the nut by holding
the tie rod stud stationary while loosening and
removing the nut with a wrench.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5687
5. Remove the outer tie rod from the steering knuckle using Remover, Special Tool MB991113. 6.
Remove the tie rod heat shield. 7. Remove the outer tie rod from the inner tie rod by unthreading it.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the jam nut on the inner tie rod threads if it is not already installed.
NOTE: Be sure the collar is installed on the inner tie rod with the flat end of the collar against jam
nut and the open end of the collar facing the outer tie rod end.
2. Install the collar on the inner tie rod. 3. Thread the outer tie rod onto the inner tie rod. 4. Position
the collar around the end of the outer tie rod. 5. Thread the jam nut down the inner tie rod far
enough to hold the collar in place on the outer tie rod. Do not tighten the jam nut. 6. Place the tie
rod heat shield on the knuckle's steering arm, aligning the hole in the shield with the hole in the
knuckle and the tangs on the outside
of the shield with the outside configuration of the steering arm. The shield should now be facing
outboard, away from the power steering gear and tie rod.
7. Attach the outer tie rod end to the steering knuckle. 8. Start the attaching nut onto the stud of the
outer tie rod. 9. While holding the stud of the tie rod stationary with a wrench, tighten the attaching
nut.
10. Using a crowfoot wrench attached to a torque wrench, tighten the attaching nut to 75 Nm (55 ft.
lbs.). 11. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten wheel nut to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
12. Lower the vehicle. 13. Adjust the front toe setting on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5688
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Front
Ball Joint Stud Pinch Bolt Nut
..............................................................................................................................................................
95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
For Ball Joint wear limit refer to Testing and Inspection, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - BALL
JOINT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 5693
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - BALL JOINT
With the weight of the vehicle resting on the road wheels, grasp the headless grease fitting as
shown. With no mechanical assistance or added force, attempt to move the grease fitting. If the ball
joint is worn, the grease fitting will move. If movement is noted, replace the ball joint.
CAUTION: No attempt should be made to service the headless grease fitting on the ball joint. It has
been purposely snapped off by the manufacturer to avoid over-greasing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Lower Ball Joint
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Lower Ball Joint
DISASSEMBLY - LOWER CONTROL ARM (BALL JOINT)
NOTE: The removal and installation of the lower ball joint from the lower control arm is to be done
with the lower control arm removed from the vehicle.
1. Using a screwdriver or other suitable tool, pry the seal boot off of the ball joint.
2. Position the Receiver, Special Tool 6908-2, on a hydraulic press to support the lower control
arm. Place the control arm on top of Tool 6908-2 so
that the bottom of the ball joint sets into the Receiver cup.
3. Place the larger end of the Adapter, Special Tool 6804, on top of the ball joint as shown. 4.
Using the hydraulic press, press the ball joint completely out of the lower control arm, into the
receiver. 5. Remove the tools, ball joint and arm from the hydraulic press.
ASSEMBLY - LOWER CONTROL ARM (BALL JOINT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 5696
CAUTION: When installing a ball joint in its mounting hole in the lower control arm, position the ball
joint so the notch in the ball joint stud is facing the lower control arm front isolator bushing. This will
ease assembly of the ball joint to the steering knuckle when the installation of the pinch bolt is
attempted.
1. By hand, position ball joint into it's bore on the lower control arm. To avoid binding upon
installation, be sure the ball joint is not cocked in the
bore.
2. Position the Installer, Special Tool 6758, on a hydraulic press to support the lower control arm.
Place the control arm on top of Tool 6758 in the
upside-down position, aligning the ball joint stud squarely with the Installer's cup.
3. Place the larger end of the Adapter, Special Tool 6804, on top of the ball joint as shown. 4.
Using the hydraulic press, press the ball joint into the lower control arm until the shoulder on the
ball joint bottoms against the lower control arm
ball joint bore. Do not apply excessive pressure against ball joint and lower control arm once the
ball joint bottoms.
5. Remove the tools and arm from the hydraulic press.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 5697
CAUTION: When installing the sealing boot on the ball joint, position the upward lip on the outside
perimeter of the seal boot outward, away from the control arm once installed. It is there to help
shield heat from the sealing boot.
6. Place a new ball joint seal boot over the ball joint stud. The upward lip located on the outside
perimeter of the seal boot must point outward away
from the control arm once installed. Start the sealing boot over the sides of the ball joint by hand.
7. Position the Installer, Special Tool 6758, over the sealing boot outer diameter as shown. By
hand, apply pressure to the top of the Installer until the
seal boot is pressed squarely down against the top surface of lower control arm.
8. Remove the tool. 9. If not already installed, install standard zirc-type grease fitting in ball joint.
CAUTION: It is important to lubricate the ball joint before installation of steering knuckle to allow
proper venting when the seal is filled. If the ball joint is lubricated after installation to knuckle,
damage to the seal can occur.
10. Using a hand-operated pump grease gun, fill the ball joint seal boot with Mopar Multi-Mileage
Lube or equivalent until grease pushes out past ball
joint stem. Wipe off overfill.
11. Remove standard zirc-type grease fitting and install headless grease fitting from original ball
joint to prevent future lubricating. See above Caution.
Be sure to properly clean headless grease fitting prior to installation.
12. Install the lower control arm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 5698
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Lower Ball Joint Seal Boot
REMOVAL
1. Remove steering knuckle from vehicle.
2. Using a screwdriver or other suitable tool, pry seal boot off of ball joint.
INSTALLATION
1. Wipe off used grease around ball joint stem.
CAUTION: When installing the sealing boot on the ball joint, position the upward lip on the seal
boot outside perimeter outward, away from the control arm once installed. It is there to help shield
heat from the sealing boot.
2. Place NEW ball joint seal boot over ball joint stem. Upward lip located on outside perimeter of
seal boot must point outward, away from control
arm once installed.
3. By hand, start sealing boot over sides of the ball joint. 4. Position Installer, Special Tool 6758,
over sealing boot outer diameter as shown. By hand, apply pressure to top of Installer until seal
boot is
pressed squarely down against top surface of lower control arm.
5. Remove tool. 6. Remove headless grease fitting on ball joint and replace it with standard
zirc-type grease fitting. Do not discard headless grease fitting.
CAUTION: It is important to lubricate the ball joint before installation of steering knuckle to allow
proper venting when the seal is filled. If the ball joint is lubricated after installation to knuckle,
damage to the seal can occur.
7. Using a hand operated pump grease gun, fill the ball joint seal boot with Mopar Multi-Mileage
Lube or equivalent until grease pushes out past ball
joint stem. Wipe off overfill.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Lower Ball Joint > Page 5699
8. Remove standard zirc-type grease fitting and reinstall headless grease fitting on ball joint to
prevent future lubricating. See above caution. 9. Install steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Control Arm Bushing: Service and Repair
DISASSEMBLY - LOWER CONTROL ARM (REAR ISOLATOR BUSHING)
NOTE: The removal and installation of the rear isolator bushing from the lower control arm is only
to be done with the lower control arm removed from the vehicle.
NOTE: The front isolator bushing is not serviceable.
1. Install the Remover Receiver, Special Tool 8373-1, into the cup of the Ball Joint Press, Special
Tool C-4212F, and tighten the set screw. Install
the Remover Driver, Special Tool 8373-2, on the tip of the Ball Joint Press screw-drive.
2. Place the lower control arm outer flange against the Receiver as shown. Tighten the screw-drive
until the Driver contacts the outer circumference
of the bushing evenly. Continue to tighten the screw-drive until the bushing is pressed completely
out of the lower control arm.
3. Back off the screw-drive and remove the lower control arm and isolator bushing from the
Receiver. 4. Remove the driver 8373-2 and receiver 8373-1 from the ball joint press C-4212F.
ASSEMBLY - LOWER CONTROL ARM (REAR ISOLATOR BUSHING)
1. Back the ball joint press C-4212F set screw outward so it does not extend out into the cup area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5704
2. Start the bushing in the lower control arm bushing bore by hand. Position the bushing so the
voids in the rubber are aligned in relationship to the
ball joint as shown.
3. Install the Receiver, Special Tool 6760, on the tip of the Ball Joint Press screw drive.
4. Place the lower control arm flange against the cup area of the ball joint press and tighten the
screwdriver until the Receiver contacts the outer
circumference of the bushing. Slowly tighten the screw-drive until the bushing bottoms in the lower
control arm bushing bore.
5. Back off the Ball Joint Press screw-drive and remove the power steering gear from the press. 6.
Install the lower control arm on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation
Front Cross-Member: Description and Operation
FRONT CROSSMEMBER
DESCRIPTION
The front suspension crossmember must be properly installed to achieve design camber, caster
settings and wheel stagger. The crossmember can be installed out of position on the frame rails
due to its design. Bolts and cage nuts hold the rear of the crossmember to the frame torque boxes.
Bolts and J-nuts hold the front of the crossmember to the frame rails. No designed in locating
device is used to position the crossmember in the vehicle. Before removing the crossmember mark
the frame torque box around the rear mounting location to aid installation. A crossmember that is
removed during service must be installed in the same position from which it was removed. To verify
that crossmember is in the proper position, refer to the dimensions provided. Front end dimensions
are gauged from the principal locating point (PLP) holes located under the frame torque boxes
rearward of the front wheels. After removal and installation of the crossmember is performed, verify
that front suspension alignment is within specifications. If camber, caster settings and thrust angle
are not within specifications, loosen and reposition crossmember to bring suspension within
specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5709
Front Cross-Member: Service and Repair
FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember is being replaced due to collision damage, inspect
the steering column lower coupling for damage.
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies from the vehicle.
Fig. 13
3. Remove both stabilizer bar links from the vehicle (Fig. 13). Remove each link by holding the
upper retainer/nut with a wrench and turning the link
bolt.
4. Remove the stabilizer bar cushion retainer bolts and retainers (Fig. 13), and remove the
stabilizer bar with cushions attached from the vehicle.
Fig. 14
5. Remove the nut and pinch bolt clamping each ball joint stud to the steering knuckle (Fig. 14).
CAUTION: After removing the steering knuckle from the ball joint stud, do not pull outward on the
knuckle. Pulling the steering knuckle outward at this point can separate the inner C/V joint on the
driveshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5710
NOTE: Use caution when separating the ball joint stud from the steering knuckle, so the ball joint
seal does not get cut.
Fig. 15
6. Separate each ball joint stud from the steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm and
up against the ball joint boss on the steering
knuckle (Fig. 15).
7. Remove the two screws securing the cooler to the front suspension crossmember. They are
located behind the cooler and can be accessed from
above. Allow the cooler to hang out of the way.
8. Using wire or cord, support and tie off the power steering gear to the underbody of the vehicle,
so when the crossmember is lowered, the gear does
not fall away being held to the vehicle by only the steering column coupler and the fluid hoses.
Fig. 16
9. Loosen and remove the four bolts attaching the power steering gear to the front suspension
cross-member (Fig. 16). Remove the power steering
gear from the front suspension crossmember.
10. Remove the drive-belt splash shield fasteners. Remove the shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5711
Fig. 17
11. Remove the pencil strut from the right front corner of the crossmember and body of the vehicle
(Fig. 17). Remove the washer behind the strut from
the torque strut bolt.
12. Remove the bolts mounting the engine torque strut in place (Fig. 17), then remove the engine
torque strut from the vehicle.
NOTE: Before removing the front suspension cross-member from the vehicle, the location of the
cross-member must be scribed on the body of the vehicle (Fig. 9). Do this so that the crossmember
can be relocated upon reinstallation against the body of vehicle in the same location as before
removal. If the front suspension crossmember is not reinstalled in exactly the same location as
before removal, the preset front wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
Fig. 18
13. Using an awl, scribe a line (Fig. 18) marking the location of where the front suspension
crossmember is mounted against the body of the vehicle. 14. Position a transmission jack under
the center of the front suspension crossmember and raise it to support the bottom of the
crossmember.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5712
Fig. 19
15. Loosen and completely remove the two front bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front
suspension crossmember to the frame rails of vehicle.
The right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure (Fig. 19). The left side bolt is located in
the same location on the other side of the vehicle.
16. Loosen the two rear bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front suspension crossmember
and lower control arms to the body of the vehicle
until they release from the threaded tapping plates in the body of the vehicle. Remove the rear
bolts from the body of the vehicle, but do not completely remove the rear bolts because they are
designed to disengage from the body threads yet stay within the lower control arm rear isolator
bushing. This allows the lower control arm to stay in place on the crossmember. The right side bolt
can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure (Fig. 19). The left side bolt is located in the same location
on the other side of the vehicle.
17. Lower the front suspension crossmember. 18. Remove each lower control arm from the
crossmember by removing the front pivot bolt.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember is being replaced due to collision damage, inspect
the steering column lower coupling for damage.
1. Install the lower control arms on the front suspension crossmember. Install the pivot bolts, but do
not completely tighten them at this time. 2. Using the transmission jack, raise the front suspension
crossmember and lower control arms until the crossmember contacts its mounting spot
against the body and frame rails of the vehicle. As the crossmember is raised, carefully guide the
power steering gear into mounting position.
3. Start the two rear crossmember mounting bolts into the tapping plates mounted in the body. The
right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt
figure (Fig. 19). The left side bolt is located in the same location on the other side of the vehicle.
Next, install the two front mounting bolts attaching front suspension crossmember to frame rails of
vehicle. Lightly tighten all four mounting bolts to a approximately 2 N.m (20 in.lbs.) to hold the front
suspension crossmember in position.
NOTE: When reinstalling the front suspension crossmember back in the vehicle, it is very important
that the crossmember be attached to the body in exactly the same spot as when it was removed.
Otherwise, the vehicle's wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
4. Using a soft face hammer, tap the front suspension crossmember back-and-forth or side-to-side
until it is aligned with the previously scribed
positioning marks on the body of the vehicle (Fig. 18). Once the front suspension crossmember is
correctly positioned, tighten the rear two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque of 203 N.m (150
ft.lbs.), then tighten the front two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque of 142 N.m (105 ft.lbs.).
5. Tighten the lower control arm front pivot bolts to a torque of 163 N.m (120 ft.lbs.). 6. Attach the
steering gear to the front suspension crossmember (Fig. 16). Install the four power steering gear
mounting bolts. Tighten the mounting
bolts to a torque of 61 N.m (45 ft.lbs.).
7. Remove the wire or cord suspending the power steering gear to the underbody. 8. Install the two
screws securing the cooler to the front suspension crossmember. They are located behind the
cooler. 9. Install each ball joint stud into the steering knuckle aligning the bolt hole in the knuckle
boss with the notch formed in the side of the ball joint
stud.
10. Install a new ball joint stud pinch bolt and nut (Fig. 14). Tighten the nut to a torque of 95 N.m
(70 ft.lbs.). 11. Install the engine torque strut and mounting bolts (Fig. 17). To properly align and
tighten the torque strut, Refer to Engine Mount. 12. Install the washer on the end of the stud
extending from the torque strut bolt (Fig. 17). 13. Install the pencil strut to the right front corner of
the crossmember and body of the vehicle (Fig. 17). Tighten the pencil strut nuts to a torque of 58
N.m (43 ft.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 5713
14. Install the drive-belt splash shield and fasteners.
Fig. 20
NOTE: Before installing the stabilizer bar, make sure the bar is not upside-down. The stabilizer bar
must be installed with the curve on the outboard ends of the bar facing downward to clear the
control arms once fully installed (Fig. 20).
15. First, place the stabilizer bar in position on the front suspension crossmember. The slits in each
cushion must point toward the front of the vehicle
and sit directly on top of the raised beads formed into the stamping on the crossmember. Next,
install the cushion retainers, matching the raised beads formed into the cushion retainers to the
grooves formed into the cushions. Install the cushion retainer bolts, but do not completely tighten
them at this time.
16. Install both stabilizer bar links back on vehicle (Fig. 13). Start each stabilizer bar link bolt with
bushing from the bottom, through the stabilizer bar
, inner link bushings, lower control arm, and into the upper retainer/nut and bushing. Do not fully
tighten the link assemblies at this time.
17. Install the tire and wheel assemblies back on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to 135
N.m (100 ft.lbs.) torque. 18. Lower the vehicle.
NOTE: It may be necessary to put the vehicle on a platform hoist or alignment rack to gain access
to the stabilizer bar mounting bolts with the vehicle at curb height.
19. Tighten each stabilizer bar link by holding the upper retainer/nut with a wrench and turning the
link bolt. Tighten each link bolt to a torque of 23
N.m (200 in.lbs.).
20. Tighten the stabilizer bar cushion retainer bolts to a torque of 34 N.m (300 in.lbs.). 21. Check
the front wheel alignment on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications
Front Steering Knuckle: Specifications
FRONT
STEERING KNUCKLE:
Disc Brake Caliper Guide Bolts
................................................................................................................................................ 22 Nm
(192 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5717
Front Steering Knuckle: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - STEERING KNUCKLE
The steering knuckle is a single casting with legs machined for attachment to the front strut
assembly on the top, lower control arm ball joint on the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5718
bottom, and steering linkage on the trailing end. The steering knuckle also has two machined
abutments (rails) on the leading end casting to support and align the front disc brake caliper.
The knuckle supports the wheel bearing and hub. The wheel hub is pressed into a sealed-for-life
wheel bearing that is pressed into the steering knuckle. A retainer plate also holds the bearing in
place. The hub supports the driveshaft outer constant velocity (C/V) joint. Each is splined and
meshes in the center of the hub. The outer C/V joint is retained to the hub using a nut. The nut is
locked to the outer C/V stub shaft using a nut retainer and cotter pin.
The wheel bearing is a Unit 1 type cartridge bearing that requires no maintenance. The wheel
bearing can be serviced separately from the hub.
The hub has five studs pressed into its flange.
OPERATION - STEERING KNUCKLE
The steering knuckle pivots with the strut assembly between the lower ball joint and the pivot
bearing in the strut assembly. The steering gear outer tie rod end connects to the trailing end of
each knuckle, allowing the vehicle to be steered.
The center of the knuckle supports the hub, wheel bearing and axle shaft.
The hub and wheel bearing work together. The wheel bearing has internal bearings that allow the
hub to rotate with the driveshaft and the tire and wheel assembly. The hub's five studs mount the
tire and wheel to the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5719
Front Steering Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - STEERING KNUCKLE
The front suspension steering knuckle is not a repairable component of the front suspension. It
must be replaced if found to be damaged in any way. If it is determined that the steering knuckle is
bent when servicing the vehicle, no attempt is to be made to straighten the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5720
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - STEERING KNUCKLE
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Apply the brakes and hold in place. 2. Raise the vehicle. 3. Remove the front tire and wheel
assembly.
4. Remove the cotter pin, lock nut and spring washer from the hub nut. 5. While the brakes are
applied, loosen and remove the hub nut. 6. Release the brakes.
7. Remove the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle. 8.
Remove the disc brake caliper from the steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping
either the top (right side) or bottom (left side) of
the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's caliper slide (on
the knuckle) and rotor.
9. Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not support the caliper by letting
it hang by the hydraulic hose.
10. Remove any retainer clips from the wheel mounting studs. Remove the brake rotor from the
front hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5721
11. Remove the nut attaching the outer tie rod to the steering knuckle. To do this, hold the tie rod
end stud with a wrench while loosening and
removing the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench.
12. Remove the tie rod end from the steering knuckle using Remover, Special Tool MB991113. 13.
Remove the tie rod heat shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5722
14. Remove the nut and pinch bolt clamping the ball joint stud to the steering knuckle.
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckles while removing the nuts,
then tap the bolts out using a pin punch.
15. Remove the two bolts attaching the strut to the steering knuckle.
NOTE: Use caution when separating the ball joint stud from the steering knuckle, so the ball joint
seal does not get cut.
16. Separate the ball joint stud from the steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm and
up against the ball joint boss on the steering
knuckle.
NOTE: Do not allow the driveshaft to hang by the inner ON joint; it must be supported to keep the
joint from separating during this operation.
17. Pull the steering knuckle off the driveshaft outer C/V joint splines and remove the steering
knuckle.
NOTE: The cartridge type front wheel bearing used on this vehicle is not transferable to the
replacement steering knuckle. If the replacement steering knuckle does not come with a wheel
bearing, a new bearing must be installed in the steering knuckle. Installation of the new wheel
bearing and hub must be done before installing the steering knuckle on the vehicle.
18. If the steering knuckle is to be replaced, the hub and wheel bearing must be removed. Do not
reuse the wheel bearing.
DISASSEMBLY- STEERING KNUCKLE (WHEEL BEARING AND HUB)
NOTE: The removal and installation of the wheel bearing and hub from the steering knuckle is only
to be done with the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle. Removal of the wheel bearing from
the steering knuckle must be done using the following procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5723
1. Remove steering knuckle, hub, and wheel bearing as an assembly from the vehicle. 2. Using
Remover, Special Tool 41 50A, press one wheel mounting stud out of hub flange. Rotate the hub to
align the removed wheel mounting stud
with the notch in bearing retainer plate. Remove the wheel mounting stud from the hub.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5724
3. Rotate the hub so the hole in the hub that wheel mounting stud was removed from is facing
away from brake caliper lower rail on steering knuckle.
Install one half of the Bearing Splitter, Special Tool 1130, between the hub and the bearing retainer
plate.
NOTE: Align the threaded hole in this first half of the bearing splitter with the caliper rail on the
steering knuckle.
4. Install the remaining pieces of Bearing Splitter, Special Tool 1130, on the steering knuckle. Hand
tighten the nuts to hold bearing splitter in place
on steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5725
5. Once the bearing splitter in fully installed, be sure the three bolts attaching the bearing retainer
plate to steering knuckle are contacting the bearing
splitter. The bearing retainer plate should not support the steering knuckle or contact the bearing
splitter.
6. Place the steering knuckle in an arbor press supported by the bearing splitter as shown.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5726
7. Position Driver, Special Tool 6644-2, on the small end of the hub. Using the arbor press, remove
the hub from the wheel bearing. The outer
bearing race will normally come out of the wheel bearing when the hub is pressed out of the
bearing.
8. Remove the bearing splitter from the steering knuckle.
9. Remove the three bolts mounting the bearing retainer plate to the steering knuckle. Remove the
bearing retainer plate from the steering knuckle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5727
10. Place the steering knuckle back in the arbor press supported by press blocks as shown. The
press blocks must not obstruct the bore in the steering
knuckle so the wheel bearing can be pressed out of the steering knuckle. Place Bearing Driver,
Special Tool MB-990799 on the outer race of wheel bearing. Press the wheel bearing out of the
steering knuckle.
11. Install Bearing Splitter, Special Tool 1130, on the hub. The bearing splitter is to be installed on
the hub so it is between the flange of the hub and
the outer bearing race on the hub. Place the hub, bearing race and bearing splitter in an arbor
press as shown. Place Driver, Special Tool 6644-2 on end of hub. Press the hub out of the outer
bearing race.
ASSEMBLY - STEERING KNUCKLE (WHEEL BEARING AND HUB)
NOTE: The removal and installation of the wheel bearing and hub from the steering knuckle is only
to be done with the steering knuckle removed from the vehicle.
1. Wipe the empty bore of the steering knuckle clean of any grease or dirt with a clean, dry shop
towel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5728
2. Place the new wheel bearing into the bore of the steering knuckle. Be sure the wheel bearing is
placed squarely into the bore. Place the steering
knuckle in an arbor press with Receiver, Special Tool C-4698-2, supporting the steering knuckle.
Place Driver, Special Tool 5052, on the outer race of the wheel bearing. Press the wheel bearing
into the steering knuckle until it is fully bottomed in the bore of the steering knuckle. Remove the
knuckle from the press.
NOTE: Only the original or identical replacement bolts are to be used to mount the bearing retainer
plate to the steering knuckle.
3. Install the bearing retainer plate on the steering knuckle. Install the three bearing retainer
mounting bolts. Tighten the bearing retainer plate
mounting bolts to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5729
4. Place the previously removed wheel mounting stud back into the hub flange. Place the hub in
the arbor press supported by Special Tool C-4698-1.
Press wheel mounting stud into hub flange until it is fully seated against the back side on the hub
flange. Remove the hub from the press.
5. Place the steering knuckle with the wheel bearing installed back in the arbor press with
Receiver, Special Tool MB-990799 supporting the inner
race of the wheel bearing as shown. Place the hub in wheel bearing making sure it is square with
the bearing inner race. Press the hub into the wheel bearing until it is fully bottomed in the wheel
bearing. Remove the knuckle from the press.
6. Install the steering knuckle assembly on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - STEERING KNUCKLE
1. If the steering knuckle is being replaced and the wheel bearing and hub must be installed. Do
not reuse the old wheel bearing. 2. Slide the hub of the steering knuckle onto the splines on the
driveshaft C/V joint. 3. Install the steering knuckle onto the ball joint stud aligning the bolt hole in
the knuckle boss with the notch formed in the side of the ball joint stud. 4. Install a new ball joint
stud pinch bolt and nut. Tighten the nut to a torque of 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during installation. Install the nuts while holding the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle.
5. Position the lower end of the strut assembly in line with the upper end of the steering knuckle
and align the mounting holes. Install the two
attaching bolts. The bolts should be installed with so that the nuts face towards the front of the
vehicle once installed. Install the nuts. Holding the bolts in place tighten the nuts to a torque of 53
Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an additional 90° turn after the specified torque is met.
6. Place the tie rod heat shield on the steering knuckle arm so that the shield is positioned straight
away from the steering gear and tie rod end once
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5730
installed. Align the hole in the shield with the hole in the steering knuckle arm.
7. Install the outer tie rod ball stud into the hole in the steering knuckle arm. Start the tie rod
attaching nut onto the stud. Hold the tie rod end stud
with a wrench while tightening the nut with a standard wrench or crowfoot wrench. To fully tighten
the nut to specifications, use a crowfoot wrench on a torque wrench to turn the nut, and a wrench
on the stud. Tighten the nut to a torque of 55 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the brake rotor on the hub.
9. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the caliper, then
pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side caliper is
installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower abutment on the steering
knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the caliper into place against
the steering knuckle.
10. Install the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle.
Tighten the guide pin bolts to a torque of 22 Nm (192
inch lbs.).
11. Clean all foreign matter from the threads of the driveshaft outer C/V joint. 12. Install the hub nut
in the end of the driveshaft and snug it. 13. Have a helper apply the brakes. With vehicle brakes
applied to keep brake rotor and hub from turning, tighten the hub nut to a torque of 244 Nm
(180 ft. lbs.).
14. Install the spring washer, lock nut and cotter pin on the hub nut. Wrap the cotter pin ends tightly
around the lock nut. 15. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Install the wheel mounting nuts and
tighten them to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 16. Lower the vehicle. 17. Set front toe on the
vehicle to specification.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Radius Arm > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Radius Arm: Testing and Inspection
TENSION STRUT
DESCRIPTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Radius Arm > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5734
The tension strut controls the fore-and-aft movement of the rear knuckle.
There is one tension strut per side of the rear suspension. The leading end of the tension strut
attaches to the frame rail while the trailing end of the strut attaches to the lower end of the rear
knuckle. The tension strut is isolated from the rest of the rear suspension through the use of rubber
bushings located at each end. The rear bushings (bayonet type) can be serviced separately, the
front bushings (spool type) cannot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Radius Arm > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5735
Radius Arm: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. Disconnect the tension strut from the knuckle. To do this, first hold the tension strut from turning
by using a wrench on the flat on the tension strut
and then remove the nut from the rear of the tension strut. Next, remove the tension strut retainer,
then the rear tension strut bayonet bushing from the tension strut.
4. Remove the nuts attaching the parking brake cable bracket to the studs on the tension strut
mounting bolt at the frame. Remove the parking brake
cable from the studs.
5. Remove the two mounting bolts holding the tension bolts to the frame, then remove the tension
strut from the vehicle. 6. Remove the forward bayonet bushing and retainer from the tension strut.
INSPECTION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Radius Arm > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5736
Inspect the tension strut. Look for signs of contact with any object that has bent or caused other
damage to the tension strut. If the tension strut is bent or damaged, the tension strut will require
replacement. Do not attempt to repair or straighten a tension strut.
Inspect the tension strut front (spool type) bushing, and rear (bayonet type) bushings and retainers
for signs of deterioration or damage. If the front
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Radius Arm > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5737
bushing is damaged or shows signs of deterioration, the tension strut must be replaced. The front
bushing cannot be replaced separately. If the rear bushings are deteriorated or damaged, or the
retainers are damaged, replacement is necessary. The bushings and retainers can be replaced
separately from the tension strut.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Install the forward retainer and a bayonet bushing on the tension strut trailing end. Be sure the
stepped area of the bushing is installed to face the
knuckle.
2. To install the knuckle on the tension, first stick the trailing end through the hole in the lower end
of the knuckle, seating the bayonet bushing
squarely against the hole. Next, raise the end of the tension strut with the spool bushing into its
mounting position on the frame. Install the mounting bolts securing the tension strut to the frame.
3. Tighten the two mounting bolts at the frame to a torque of 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.). 4. Place the
parking brake cable routing bracket on the studs of the tension strut mounting bolts and install the
nuts securing it in place. Tighten the
nuts to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
5. Install the rear bayonet bushing on the tension strut. Be sure the stepped area of the bushing is
squarely seated into the hole in the knuckle. 6. Install the rear tension strut retainer, then the nut.
To completely install the nut, place a wrench on the flat formed into the tension strut and tighten
the nut. Tighten the nut to a torque of 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
7. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts in proper sequence until all
nuts are torqued to half specification. Repeat the
tightening sequence, this time, to full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
8. Lower the vehicle to ground level. 9. Set the rear toe on the vehicle to specification as
necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications
Rear Knuckle: Specifications
REAR
KNUCKLE:
Brake Support Plate Mounting Bolts
.............................................................................................................................................. 75 Nm
(55 ft. lbs.) Disc Brake Adapter Mounting Bolts
.............................................................................................................................................. 75 Nm
(55 ft. lbs.)
LATERAL ARM:
Nut At Knuckle .....................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5741
Rear Knuckle: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
A forged rear knuckle bolts to each rear strut assembly. The rear knuckle's spindle supports the
rear hub and bearing. Together they support the rear
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5742
tire and wheel. The movement of the rear knuckle is controlled laterally using two lateral arms
attached to the knuckle. Fore and aft movement of the knuckle is controlled by using a tension
strut.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5743
Rear Knuckle: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - KNUCKLE (REAR)
The rear knuckle is not a repairable component of the rear suspension. Upon visual inspection, if it
is determined that the knuckle is cracked, bent or broken, no attempt is to be made to repair or to
straighten the knuckle. The knuckle must be replaced if found to be damaged in any way.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5744
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - KNUCKLE (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service PrecautionsService Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. If the vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, remove the screw securing the brake hose
bracket to the rear of the strut assembly.
4. If the vehicle is equipped with the antilock brake system (ABS), remove the screw securing the
ABS wheel speed sensor bracket to the rear of the
strut assembly.
5. If the vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, remove any retainer clips from the wheel
mounting studs, then pull the brake drum off the hub
and bearing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5745
6. If the vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, perform the following:
^ Remove the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle.
^ Remove the disc brake caliper from the knuckle and brake rotor.
^ Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not support the caliper by letting
it hang by the hydraulic hose.
^ Remove any retainer clips from the wheel mounting studs, then pull the brake rotor off the hub
and bearing.
7. Remove the dust cap from the hub and bearing assembly. 8. Remove the retaining nut, then the
hub and bearing from the knuckle's spindle.
9. If vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, remove the four bolts attaching the rear brake
support plate to the knuckle. Next, remove the brake
support plate, brake shoes and wheel cylinder as an assembly from the rear knuckle, then hang it
out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not overextend the brake hose when being hung. It
is not necessary to remove the brake hose from the wheel cylinder when removing the support
plate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5746
10. If the vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, remove the four bolts mounting the disc brake
adapter to the rear knuckle. Next, remove the
adapter, rotor shield, parking brake shoes and parking brake cable as an assembly from the
knuckle, then hang it out of the way using a wire hanger or cord.
CAUTION: The strut-to-knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned during
removal. Hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle while removing the nuts, then tap the
bolts out using a pin punch.
11. Loosen, but do not completely remove the two nuts and bolts attaching the rear knuckle to the
strut. 12. Remove the nuts and bolt attaching the rear knuckle to the lateral arms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5747
13. Disconnect the tension strut from the knuckle. To do this, first hold the tension strut from turning
by using a wrench on the flat on the tension strut
and then remove the nut from the rear of the tension strut. Next, remove the tension strut retainer,
then the rear tension strut bayonet bushing from the tension strut.
14. Remove the two nuts and bolts attaching the rear knuckle to the strut. Tap the bolts from the
knuckle using a pin punch. 15. Remove the knuckle.
INSTALLATION - KNUCKLE (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. To install the knuckle on the vehicle, first align the hole in the lower end of the rear knuckle with
the forward bayonet bushing on the tension strut.
Be sure the stepped area of the bushing is squarely seated into the hole in the knuckle. Next,
Rotate the knuckle until the upper mounting holes in the knuckle is aligned with the holes in the
strut's clevis bracket.
CAUTION: The strut-to-knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Once installed, hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle while installing and
tightening the nuts.
2. Install the two bolts attaching the strut to the rear knuckle from the front side. Install the nuts on
the bolts. Tighten the two nuts to a torque of 88
Nm (65 ft. lbs.).
3. Align the lateral arms with the hole in the center of the knuckle. Install the bolt attaching the arms
to the knuckle. When installing the bolt, start it
from the front side. Install the nut, but do not completely tighten it at this time. The nut will need to
be tightened when the vehicle is at curb height.
4. Install the rear bayonet bushing on the tension strut. Be sure the stepped area of the bushing is
squarely seated into the hole in the knuckle. 5. Install the rear tension strut retainer, then the nut.
To completely install the nut, place a wrench on the flat formed into the tension strut and tighten
the nut. Tighten the nut to a torque of 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.).
6. If vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, install the brake support plate on the knuckle and
attach it using it's four mounting bolts. Tighten the
mounting bolts to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
7. If the vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, install the disc brake adapter on the knuckle and
attach it using it's four mounting bolts. Tighten
the mounting bolts to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
8. Install the hub and bearing on the knuckle's spindle, then install a new retaining nut. Do not
reuse the original nut. Tighten the nut to a torque of
217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.).
9. Install the dust cap on the end of the hub and bearing.
10. If the vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, install the brake rotor and disc brake caliper on
the knuckle. Install the two guide pin bolts
securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle. Tighten the guide pin bolts to a torque
of 22 Nm (192 inch lbs.).
11. If the vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, install the screw securing the brake hose
bracket to the rear of the strut assembly. Tighten the
screw to a torque of 31 Nm (275 inch lbs.).
12. If the vehicle is equipped with the antilock brake system (ABS), install the screw securing the
ABS wheel speed sensor bracket to the rear of the
strut assembly. Tighten the mounting screw to a torque of 13 Nm (120 inch lbs.).
13. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts in proper sequence until
all nuts are torqued to half specification. Repeat the
tightening sequence, this time, to full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
14. Lower the vehicle to ground level. 15. Tighten the lateral arm-to-knuckle mounting bolt nut to a
torque of 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.). 16. Set the rear toe on the vehicle to specification if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Specifications
Stabilizer Bar: Specifications
Front
STABILIZER BAR:
Cushion Retainer Bolts
..............................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 inch lbs.) Link Nut ............................................................................................................
........................................................................ 31 Nm (275 inch lbs.)
Rear
STABILIZER BAR:
Cushion Retainer Bolts
..............................................................................................................................................................
34 Nm (300 inch lbs.) Link Bolt Nut .....................................................................................................
....................................................................... 23 Nm (200 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front
Stabilizer Bar: Description and Operation Front
DESCRIPTION
The stabilizer bar helps control vehicle body roll. Jounce and rebound movements affecting one
wheel are partially transmitted to the opposite wheel of the vehicle to stabilize body roll.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5753
The stabilizer bar interconnects both front lower control arms of the vehicle and is attached to the
front suspension crossmember.
Attachment of the stabilizer bar to the front suspension crossmember is through 2 rubber-isolator
cushion and retainers. The stabilizer bar attachment to the lower control arm is done by utilizing an
isolated stabilizer bar link at each arm. All components of the stabilizer bar are serviceable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5754
Stabilizer Bar: Description and Operation Rear
DESCRIPTION
Some versions of this vehicle are equipped with a rear stabilizer bar. The stabilizer bar
interconnects both rear strut assemblies and is attached to the rear frame rails of the vehicle.
The rear stabilizer bar allows jounce and rebound movements affecting one wheel to be partially
transmitted to the opposite wheel of the vehicle to stabilize body roll.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5755
Attachment of the stabilizer bar to the rear frame rails of the vehicle is through two rubber-isolator
cushions and retainers. The stabilizer bar attachment to each strut assembly is done utilizing a
rubber isolated stabilizer bar link. All parts of the stabilizer bar are serviceable, and the stabilizer
bar to frame rail isolator cushions are split for easy removal and installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front
Stabilizer Bar: Testing and Inspection Front
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - STABILIZER BAR (FRONT)
Inspect for broken, cracked or distorted stabilizer bar cushions and retainers. Inspect for worn or
damaged stabilizer bar links.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5758
Stabilizer Bar: Testing and Inspection Rear
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - STABILIZER BAR (REAR)
Inspect the stabilizer bar. Look for damage or bending. If damage is evident, the bar must be
replaced. Inspect for broken, cracked or distorted stabilizer bar cushions and cushion retainers.
The horizontal slit at the front of each cushion is supposed to be there. If damage is evident, the
cushions can be replaced separately from the stabilizer bar utilizing the horizontal slit. Inspect the
stabilizer bar links that attach the stabilizer bar to each rear strut. Look for damage or deterioration
of the bushings on the ends of each link. Inspect the stabilizer bar link to ensure it is not bent or
broken. If any of these conditions are present, the stabilizer bar link must be replaced. The links
can be replaced separately from the stabilizer bar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front
Stabilizer Bar: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Raise the vehicle.
2. Remove both stabilizer bar links from the vehicle. Remove each link by holding the upper
retainer/nut with a wrench and turning the link bolt. 3. Remove the stabilizer bar cushion retainer
bolts and retainers, and remove the stabilizer bar with cushions attached from the vehicle. 4. To
remove the cushions from the stabilizer bar, peel back each cushion at the slit and roll it off the bar.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions
NOTE: Before stabilizer bar installation, inspect the cushions and links for excessive wear, cracks,
damage and distortion. Replace any pieces failing inspection.
1. If removed, install the stabilizer bar cushions on the stabilizer bar utilizing the slit in each
cushion. Position the cushions at each end of the bar's
straight beam, just before it begins to curve.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5761
NOTE: Before installing the stabilizer bar, make sure the bar is not upside-down. The stabilizer bar
must be installed with the curve on the outboard ends of the bar facing downward to clear the
control arms once fully installed.
2. First, place the stabilizer bar in position on the front suspension crossmember. The slits in each
cushion must point toward the front of the vehicle
and sit directly on top of the raised beads formed into the stamping on the crossmember. Next,
install the cushion retainers, matching the raised beads formed into the cushion retainers to the
grooves formed into the cushions. Install the cushion retainer bolts, but do not completely tighten
them at this time.
3. Install both stabilizer bar links back on vehicle. Start each stabilizer bar link bolt with bushing
from the bottom, through the stabilizer bar, inner
link bushings, lower control arm, and into the upper retainer/nut and bushing. Do not fully tighten
the link assemblies at this time.
4. Lower the vehicle.
NOTE: It may be necessary to put the vehicle on a platform hoist or alignment rack to gain access
to the stabilizer bar mounting bolts with the vehicle at curb height.
5. Tighten each stabilizer bar link by holding the upper retainer/nut with a wrench and turning the
link bolt. Tighten each link bolt to a torque of 31
Nm (275 inch lbs.).
6. Tighten the stabilizer bar cushion retainer bolts to a torque of 28 Nm (250 inch lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5762
Stabilizer Bar: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove both rear wheel and tire assemblies from the vehicle.
3. Remove the nut from the end of each rear stabilizer bar link bolt. Pull the bolt out through the top
of the link and remove the link from each end of
the stabilizer bar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5763
4. Remove the two bolts securing each of the two cushion retainers to the frame rails, then remove
the cushion retainers, cushions and stabilizer bar
from the vehicle as an assembly.
5. Pull the cushion retainers off the cushions. 6. The cushions can be removed from the bar by
utilizing the pre-formed slit in each cushion and peeling it off the bar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5764
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions
.
1. Install the cushions on the stabilizer bar by opening the slit in the cushion and wrapping the
cushion around the bar. When installed properly, the
slit in the cushion should face in the same direction as the ends of the stabilizer bar, or toward the
front of the car once the bar is installed. The flat side of each cushion should face upward.
2. Install the retainers on the cushions, matching the contour of each retainer with its cushion. 3.
Install the stabilizer bar, cushions and retainers on the car as an assembly. The dipped area in the
center of the bar must face down to clear the well
in the luggage compartment.
4. Install two bolts in each cushion retainer and secure the stabilizer bar to the frame of the vehicle.
Do not completely install the bolts at this time. 5. Reinstall each stabilizer bar link:
a. Place the link center sleeve and bushings between the eye in the end of the stabilizer bar and
the link mounting bracket on the strut. b. Start the stabilizer bar link bolt with bushing from the top,
down through the stabilizer bar, inner link bushings and sleeve, and strut link
mounting bracket.
c. Install a lower bushing, then the nut. Do not tighten the nut at this time.
6. Install both tire and wheel assemblies on the vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in
proper sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Repeat the tightening sequence, this time, to full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
7. Lower the vehicle to ground level or curb height. 8. Tighten the rear stabilizer bar cushion
retainer bolts to a torque of 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.). 9. Tighten the stabilizer bar link nuts to a torque
of 23 Nm (200 inch lbs.).
10. Set the rear toe on the vehicle to specification if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Specifications
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Specifications
FRONT
STRUT ASSEMBLY:
Tower Nuts ..........................................................................................................................................
...................................... 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.) Steering Knuckle Nuts
...................................................................................................................................... 54 Nm (40 ft.
lbs.) + 90 degree Turn Strut Shaft Nut ................................................................................................
................................................................................ 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.)
REAR
STRUT ASSEMBLY:
Tower Attaching Nuts
..............................................................................................................................................................
34 Nm (300 inch lbs.) Knuckle Attaching Bolts ....................................................................................
............................................................................. 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs.) Strut Assembly Shaft Nut .........
...................................................................................................................................................... 75
Nm (55 ft. lbs.) Brake Hose Bracket Mounting Bolt
.......................................................................................................................................... 31 Nm (275
inch lbs.)
TENSION STRUT:
Rear Nut ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.) Frame Rail Bolts ........................................................
..................................................................................................................... 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Parking Brake Cable Nut
...........................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Front
DESCRIPTION - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT)
There are two different design struts available on this vehicle. A standard strut and an adjustable
strut which is used on vehicles equipped with the ACR performance package. Both struts share
common style components except that the ACR strut has no external jounce bumper. It is internal.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5770
A MacPherson type design strut assembly is used in place of the front suspension upper control
arm and upper ball joint. The bottom of the strut mounts directly to the steering knuckle using 2
attaching bolts and nuts going through the strut clevis bracket and steering knuckle. The top of the
strut mounts directly to the strut tower of the vehicle using the three threaded studs on the strut
assemblies upper mount. During steering maneuvers, the strut assembly (through a pivot bearing
in the upper strut mount) and steering knuckle (through the lower ball joint) turn as an assembly.
The strut assembly includes the following components: ^
Strut shaft retaining nut
^ Upper mount (rubber isolated)
^ Upper spring seat and bearing
^ Dust shield
^ Jounce bumper
^ Coil spring
^ Lower spring isolator
^ Strut (damper)
Each component is serviced by removing the strut assembly from the vehicle and disassembling it.
The strut and front suspension of the vehicle is supported by coil springs positioned around the
upper half of each strut. The springs are contained between the upper and the lower seats of the
strut assembly.
Coil springs are rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional
equipment and type of vehicle service. During service procedures of the strut assembly, if both
springs are removed, mark the springs to ensure installation in its original position.
NOTE: If a coil spring requires replacement, be sure that it is replaced with a spring meeting the
correct load rating for the vehicle and its specific options.
The adjustable ACR strut has a knob on the bottom. It is there to adjust the suspension firmness.
Although the strut shaft is much thicker on ACR struts, the same upper mount and retaining nut can
be used.
OPERATION - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT)
The strut assembly cushions the ride of the vehicle, controlling vibration, jounce and rebound of the
suspension.
The coil spring controls ride quality and maintains proper ride height.
The spring isolators isolate the coil spring at the top and bottom from coming into metal-to-metal
contact with the upper mounting seat and the strut.
The jounce bumper limits suspension travel and metal-to-metal contact under full jounce condition.
The strut dampens jounce and rebound motions of the coil spring and suspension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5771
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Description and Operation Rear
DESCRIPTION - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR)
There are two different design struts available on this vehicle. A standard strut and an adjustable
strut which is used on vehicles equipped with the ACR performance package. Both struts share
common style components except that the ACR strut has no external jounce bumper. It is internal.
The rear strut assemblies support the weight of the vehicle using coil springs positioned around
struts. The coil springs are contained between the upper mount of the strut assembly and a lower
spring seat on the body of the strut.
The top of each strut assembly is bolted to the top of the inner fender through a rubber isolated
mount. The bottom of the strut assembly attaches to the rear knuckle using 2 thru-bolts with
prevailing torque nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5772
The rear strut assembly includes the following components: ^
Strut shaft retaining nut
^ Upper mount (rubber isolated)
^ Dust shield
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Front > Page 5773
^ Jounce bumper
^ Coil spring
^ Lower spring isolator
^ Strut (damper)
Any component in need of service requires removal of the strut assembly from the vehicle and
disassembly of it.
Rear coil springs are rated separately for each corner or side of the vehicle depending on optional
equipment and type of vehicle service. If a coil spring requires replacement, be sure the spring
needing replacement is replaced with a spring meeting the correct load rating for the vehicle with
its specific options.
The adjustable ACR strut has a knob on the bottom. It is there to adjust the suspension firmness.
Although the strut shaft is much thicker on ACR struts, the same upper mount and retaining nut can
be used.
OPERATION - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR)
The strut assembly cushions the ride of the vehicle, controlling vibration, jounce and rebound of the
suspension.
The coil spring controls ride quality and maintains proper ride height.
The spring isolators isolate the coil spring at the top and bottom from coming into metal-to-metal
contact with the upper mounting seat and the strut.
The jounce bumper limits suspension travel and metal-to-metal contact under full jounce condition.
The strut dampens jounce and rebound motions of the coil spring and suspension.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Testing and Inspection Front
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT)
Inspect the strut assembly for the following conditions:
- Inspect for a damaged or broken coil spring.
- Inspect for a torn or damaged strut assembly dust shield.
- Lift the dust shield and inspect the strut assembly for evidence of fluid running from the upper end
of the strut fluid reservoir. (Actual leakage will be a stream of fluid running down the side and
dripping off lower end of unit). A slight amount of seepage between the strut shaft and strut shaft
seal is not unusual and does not affect performance of the strut assembly.
- Lift the dust shield and inspect the jounce bumper for signs of damage or deterioration (non ACR
vehicles only).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5776
- Inspect the clearance between the shock tower and the coil spring. Make sure no fasteners are
protruding through the shock tower possibly contacting the coil spring and strut. Because of the
minimum clearance in this area, installation of metal fasteners could damage the coil spring coating
and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring.
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle can a sheet metal screw, bolt or other metal
fastener be installed into the shock tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, do not
drill holes into the front shock tower for the installation of any metal fasteners into the shock tower
area indicated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5777
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Testing and Inspection Rear
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR)
Inspect the strut assembly for the following conditions: ^
Inspect for a damaged or broken coil spring.
^ Inspect for a torn or damaged strut assembly dust shield.
^ Lift the dust shield and inspect the strut assembly for evidence of fluid running from the upper end
of the strut fluid reservoir. (Actual leakage will be a stream of fluid running down the side and
dripping off lower end of unit). A slight amount of seepage between the strut shaft and strut shaft
seal is not unusual and does not affect performance of the strut assembly.
^ Lift the dust shield and inspect the jounce bumper for signs of damage or deterioration.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly from location on front of vehicle requiring
strut removal. 3. If both strut assemblies are to be removed, mark the strut assemblies right or left
according to which side of the vehicle they were removed from.
4. Remove the screw securing the ground strap to the rear of the strut. 5. If the vehicle is equipped
with Antilock brakes (ABS), remove the screw securing the ABS wheel speed sensor to the rear of
the strut.
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during removal. Hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle while removing the nuts,
then tap the bolts out using a pin punch.
6. Remove the two bolts attaching the strut to the steering knuckle. 7. Lower the vehicle just
enough to open the hood, but without letting the tires touch the floor.
8. Remove the three nuts attaching the upper mount of the strut assembly to the vehicle's strut
tower. 9. Remove the strut assembly from the vehicle.
10. For disassembly procedures, Refer to STRUT- DISASSEMBLY.
DISASSEMBLY - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5780
The Strut assembly must be removed from the vehicle for it to be disassembled and assembled.
For the disassembly and assembly of the strut assembly, use strut spring compressor, Pentastar
Service Equipment (PSE) tool W-7200, or the equivalent, to compress the coil spring. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions closely. 1. If both struts are being serviced at the same time, mark the
coil spring and strut assembly according to which side of the vehicle the strut was
removed from, and which strut the coil spring was removed from.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5781
2. Position the strut assembly in the strut coil spring compressor following the manufacturers
instructions. Set the lower hooks, then set the upper
hooks. Position the strut clevis bracket straight outward away from the compressor. Place a clamp
on the lower end of the coil spring, so the strut is held in place once the strut shaft nut is removed.
WARNING: DO NOT REMOVE THE STRUT SHAFT NUT BEFORE THE COIL SPRING IS
COMPRESSED. THE COIL SPRING IS HELD UNDER PRESSURE AND MUST BE
COMPRESSED, REMOVING SPRING TENSION FROM THE UPPER MOUNT AND PIVOT
BEARING, BEFORE THE SHAFT NUT IS REMOVED.
3. Compress the coil spring until all coil spring tension is removed from the upper mount.
4. Once the spring is sufficiently compressed, install Strut Nut Socket, Special Tool 6864, on the
strut shaft retaining nut. Next, install a socket on the
hex on the end of the strut shaft. While holding the strut shaft from turning, remove the nut from the
strut shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5782
5. Remove the upper mount from the strut shaft. 6. Remove the upper spring seat and bearing,
along with the upper spring isolator as an assembly from the top of the coil spring by pulling them
straight up. The upper spring isolator can be separated from the spring seat and bearing once
removed from vehicle.
7. Remove the dust shield, then the jounce bumper from the strut shaft by pulling each straight up.
8. Remove the clamp from the bottom of the coil spring and remove the strut out through the
bottom of the coil spring. 9. Remove the lower spring isolator from the lower spring seat on the
strut.
NOTE: If the coil spring needs to be serviced, proceed with the next step, otherwise, proceed with
step 11.
10. Release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor drive completely. Push
back the compressor hooks and remove the coil
spring.
11. Inspect the strut assembly components for the following and replace as necessary:
- Inspect the strut for any condition of shaft binding over the full stroke of the shaft.
- Inspect the jounce bumper for cracks and signs of deterioration (non-ACR vehicles only).
- Check the upper mount for cracks and distortion and its retaining studs for any sign of damage.
- Check the upper spring seat and bearing for cracks and distortion.
- Check for binding of the upper spring seat and bearing pivot bearing.
- Inspect the dust shield for rips and deterioration.
- Inspect the upper and lower spring isolators for material deterioration and distortion.
^ Inspect the coil spring for any sign of damage to the coating.
ASSEMBLY - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT) For the disassembly and assembly of the strut
assembly, use strut spring compressor, Pentastar Service Equipment (PSE) tool W-7200, or the
equivalent, to compress the coil spring. Follow the manufacturer's instructions closely.
NOTE: If the coil spring has been removed from the spring compressor, proceed with the next step,
otherwise, proceed with step 3.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5783
1. Place the coil spring in the compressor following the manufacturers instructions. Before
compressing the spring, rotate the spring so the end of the
top coil is directly in the back as shown.
2. Slowly compress the coil spring until enough room is available for strut assembly reassembly. 3.
Install the lower spring isolator on the lower spring seat of the strut. 4. Install the strut through the
bottom of the coil spring until the lower spring seat contacts the lower end of the coil spring. Rotate
the strut as
necessary until the clevis bracket is positioned straight outward away from the compressor. Install
the clamp on the lower end of the coil spring and strut, so the strut is held in place.
5. Install the jounce bumper on the strut shaft. The jounce bumper is to be installed with the smaller
end pointing downward toward the lower seat. 6. Install the dust shield on the strut shaft. The
bottom of the dust shield will snap past the retainer on top of the strut housing. 7. If disassembled,
reinstall the upper spring isolator on the upper spring seat and bearing. 8. Install the upper spring
seat and bearing on top of the coil spring. Position the notch formed into the edge of the upper seat
straight out away from
the compressor.
9. Install the strut upper mount over the strut shaft and onto the top of the upper spring seat and
bearing.
10. Loosely install the retaining nut on the strut shaft. Install Strut Nut Socket (on the end of a
torque wrench), Special Tool 6864, on the strut shaft
retaining nut. Next, install a socket on the hex on the end of the strut shaft. While holding the strut
shaft from turning, tighten the strut shaft retaining nut to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
11. Slowly release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor drive completely.
As the tension is relieved, make sure the upper
mount and seat and bearing align properly. Verify the upper mount does not bind.
12. Remove the clamp from the lower end of the coil spring and strut. Push back the spring
compressor upper and lower hooks, then remove the strut
assembly from the spring compressor.
13. Install the strut assembly on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - STRUT ASSEMBLY (FRONT)
1. Install the strut assembly into the strut tower, aligning the three studs on the strut upper mount
with the holes in strut tower. Install the three
mounting nuts on the studs. Tighten the three nuts to a torque of 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.).
2. Close the hood of the vehicle.
CAUTION: The strut assembly-to-steering knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be
turned during installation. Install the nuts while holding the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle.
3. Position the lower end of the strut assembly in line with the upper end of the steering knuckle
and align the mounting holes. Install the two
attaching bolts. The bolts should be installed with so that the nuts face towards the front of the
vehicle once installed. Install the nuts. Holding the bolts in place tighten the nuts to a torque of 53
Nm (40 ft. lbs.) plus an additional 90° turn after the specified torque is met.
4. If the vehicle is equipped with Antilock brakes (ABS), attach the ABS wheel speed sensor to the
rear of the strut (rearward ear) using its mounting
screw. Tighten the mounting screw to a torque of 13 Nm (120 inch lbs.).
5. Attach the ground strap to the rear of the strut (forward ear) using its mounting screw. Tighten
the mounting screw to a torque of 13 Nm (120 inch
lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Install and tighten the wheel mounting nuts in proper
sequence until all nuts are torqued to half specification.
Repeat the tightening sequence to the full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5784
7. Lower the vehicle.
ADJUSTMENT - ACR STRUT
Vehicles equipped with the optional ACR performance package have adjustable struts. A single
adjustment knob is located on the bottom of each front and rear strut. The one knob adjusts both
bump and rebound characteristics. It adjusts the strut up to 24 different positions (notches or
detents), six per revolution. Turn the knob clockwise to increase firmness and counterclockwise to
decrease firmness.
There is an internal stop at the "full firm" and "full soft" position.
New struts (and new vehicles equipped with them) come from the factory set at the "full soft"
position.
STRUT ADJUSTMENT KNOB (ACR)
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle.
2. Using a trim stick, carefully pry the knob off the bottom of the strut.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is no specific installed orientation for the adjustment knob. It can be installed in up to
6 different positions as long as the tabs on the knob are lined up with the flats on the internal nut.
1. Install knob center hex onto strut center hex screw, then line up tabs on knob with flats on strut
internal nut and push the knob upward, snapping it
into place.
2. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5785
3. Adjust the strut if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5786
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Rear
REMOVAL - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions.
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assembly from the vehicle.
3. If the vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, remove the screw securing the brake hose
bracket to the rear of the strut assembly.
4. If the vehicle is equipped with the antilock brake system (ABS), remove the screw securing the
ABS wheel speed sensor bracket to the rear of the
strut assembly.
5. If equipped with a rear stabilizer bar, remove the nut from the end of the rear stabilizer bar link
bolt. Pull the bolt out through the top of the link
and remove the link.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5787
6. If the vehicle is equipped with rear disc brakes, perform the following:
- Remove the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle.
- Remove the disc brake caliper from the knuckle and brake rotor.
- Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not support the caliper by letting it
hang by the hydraulic hose.
CAUTION: The strut-to-knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned during
removal. Hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle while removing the nuts, then tap the
bolts out using a pin punch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5788
7. Remove the two nuts and bolts attaching the strut to the rear knuckle. 8. Lower the vehicle just
enough to access the luggage compartment without letting the tires touch the floor. Access to rear
upper strut mount
attaching bolts is through the luggage compartment.
9. Open the deck lid.
10. If equipped, remove the carpet from the top of the strut tower.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5789
11. Loosen, but do not completely remove the 3 nuts securing the strut assembly to the strut tower.
Grasp the strut assembly to keep it from moving, then remove the 3 mounting nuts at the strut
tower.
12. Remove the strut assembly from the knuckle by sliding it away from the knuckle, lowering it
between the two lateral arms, then tipping the top
outward and removing it out through the well opening.
13. For disassembly procedures of the strut assembly, Refer to STRUT - DISASSEMBLY.
DISASSEMBLY - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR) The strut assembly must be removed from the
vehicle for it to be disassembled and assembled.
For the disassembly and assembly of the strut assembly, use strut spring compressor, Pentastar
Service Equipment (PSE) tool W-720O, or the equivalent, to compress the coil spring. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions closely.
1. If both struts are being serviced at the same time, mark the coil spring and strut assembly
according to which side of the vehicle the strut was
removed from, and which strut the coil spring was removed from.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5790
2. Position the strut assembly in the strut coil spring compressor following the manufacturers
instructions. Set the lower, then upper hooks on the coil
spring. Position the strut clevis bracket straight inward toward the compressor. Place a clamp on
the lower end of the coil spring, so the strut is held in place once the strut shaft nut is removed.
WARNING: DO NOT REMOVE THE STRUT SHAFT NUT BEFORE THE COIL SPRING IS
COMPRESSED. THE COIL SPRING IS HELD UNDER PRESSURE AND MUST BE
COMPRESSED, REMOVING SPRING TENSION FROM THE UPPER MOUNT AND PIVOT
BEARING, BEFORE THE SHAFT NUT IS REMOVED.
3. Compress the coil spring until all coil spring tension is removed from the upper mount.
4. Once the spring is sufficiently compressed, install Strut Nut Socket, Special Tool 6864, on the
strut shaft retaining nut. Next, install a socket on the
hex on the end of the strut shaft. While holding the strut shaft from turning, remove the nut from the
strut shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5791
5. Remove the upper mount from the strut shaft. 6. Remove the clamp from the bottom of the coil
spring and remove the strut out through the bottom of the coil spring. 7. Remove the dust shield,
then the jounce bumper from the strut shaft by pulling each straight up. 8. Remove the lower spring
isolator from the lower spring seat located on the strut.
NOTE: If the coil spring needs to be serviced, proceed with the next step, otherwise, proceed with
step 10.
NOTE: Before removing the coil spring from the compressor, make not of its position in the
compressor, for easy reassembly.
9. Release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor drive completely. Push
back the compressor hooks and remove the coil
spring.
10. Inspect the strut assembly components for the following and replace as necessary:
- Inspect the strut for any condition of shaft binding over the full stroke of the shaft.
- Inspect the jounce bumper for cracks and signs of deterioration.
- Check the upper mount for cracks and distortion and its retaining studs for any sign of damage.
- Inspect the dust shield for rips and deterioration.
- Inspect the upper and lower spring isolators for material deterioration and distortion.
- Inspect the coil spring for any sign of damage to the coating.
ASSEMBLY - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR) The strut assembly must be removed from the vehicle
for it to be disassembled and assembled.
For the disassembly and assembly of the strut assembly, use strut spring compressor, Pentastar
Service Equipment (PSE) tool W-720O, or the equivalent, to compress the coil spring. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions closely.
NOTE: If the coil spring has been removed from the spring compressor, proceed with the next step,
otherwise, proceed with step 3.
1. Place the coil spring in the compressor following the manufacturers instructions. Before
compressing the spring, rotate the spring to the position
determined in the note prior to step 9 in disassembly.
2. Slowly compress the coil spring until enough room is available for strut assembly reassembly. 3.
Install the lower spring isolator on the lower spring seat of the strut matching the step built into the
isolator with the step in the lower spring seat
on the strut.
4. Install the jounce bumper on the strut shaft. The jounce bumper is to be installed with the pointed
end pointing downward toward the lower seat. 5. Install the dust shield on the strut shaft. The
bottom of the dust shield will snap past the retainer on top of the strut housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5792
6. Install the strut through the bottom of the coil spring until the lower spring seat contacts the lower
end of the coil spring. Rotate the strut until the
end of the coil spring fits against the step in the lower spring seat. If done correctly, the clevis on
the bottom of the strut should face toward the compressor.
7. Install the clamp on the lower end of the coil spring and strut, so the strut is held in place with the
coil spring.
NOTE: Before installing the upper mount, check to make sure the correct side mount is being
installed. Left and right upper mounts are different. A left mount will be marked with the letter "L"
while a right mount will be marked with the letter "R".
8. Install the upper mount over the strut shaft and onto the top of the upper spring. Near the center
on the top of the mount is the word "OUT" and an
arrow. Point the arrow on the mount in the same direction that the clevis bracket on the lower end
of the strut is pointed in. This direction should be straight toward the compressor.
9. Loosely install the retaining nut on the strut shaft. Install Strut Nut Socket (on the end of a torque
wrench), Special Tool 6864, on the strut shaft
retaining nut. Next, install a socket on the hex on the end of the strut shaft. While holding the strut
shaft from turning, tighten the strut shaft retaining nut to a torque of 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.).
10. Slowly release the tension from the coil spring by backing off the compressor drive completely.
As the tension is relieved, make sure the upper
mount's seat aligns properly with the coil spring.
11. Verify the arrow on the upper mount is pointing in the same direction as the strut clevis bracket
as mentioned in step 9. 12. Remove the clamp from the lower end of the coil spring and strut. Push
back the spring compressor upper and lower hooks, then remove the strut
assembly from the spring compressor.
13. Install the strut assembly on the vehicle.
INSTALLATION - STRUT ASSEMBLY (REAR)
NOTE: Before proceeding with this procedure, Refer to Service Precautions .
1. To place the strut assembly into mounting position, start the lower end of the strut over the top of
the knuckle and down the back between the two
lateral arms. Next, lift the top of the strut assembly up into the strut tower aligning the studs on top
of the upper mount with the three mounting holes in the strut tower. While holding the strut
assembly in place, install the three mounting nuts on the upper mount studs inside the luggage
compartment. Tighten the 3 mounting nuts to a torque of 34 Nm (300 inch lbs.).
2. Install the carpeting back on top of the rear strut tower. 3. Close the deck lid. 4. Raise the
vehicle.
CAUTION: The strut-to-knuckle attaching bolts are serrated and must not be turned during
installation. Once installed, hold the bolts stationary in the steering knuckle while installing and
tightening the nuts.
5. Align the holes in the strut clevis bracket on the lower end of the strut with the mounting holes in
the knuckle. Install the two bolts attaching the
strut to the rear knuckle. Install the nuts. Tighten the two nuts to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs.).
6. If the vehicle is equipped with disc brakes, install the brake rotor and disc brake caliper on the
knuckle. Install the two guide pin bolts securing the
front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle. Tighten the guide pin bolts to a torque of 22 Nm
(192 inch lbs.).
7. If equipped with a rear stabilizer bar, reinstall the stabilizer bar link:
a. Place the link center sleeve and bushings between the eye in the end of the stabilizer bar and
the link mounting bracket on the strut. b. Start the stabilizer bar link bolt with bushing from the top,
down through the stabilizer bar, inner link bushings and sleeve, and strut link
mounting bracket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5793
c. Install a lower bushing, then the nut. Do not tighten the nut at this time.
8. If the vehicle is equipped with the antilock brake system (ABS), install the screw securing the
ABS wheel speed sensor bracket to the rear of the
strut assembly. Tighten the mounting screw to a torque of 13 Nm (120 inch lbs.).
9. If the vehicle is equipped with rear drum brakes, install the screw securing the brake hose
bracket to the rear of the strut assembly. Tighten the
screw to a torque of 31 Nm (275 inch lbs.).
10. Install the tire and wheel assembly on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting stud nuts in proper
sequence until all nuts are torqued to half
specification. Repeat the tightening sequence, this time, to full specified torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
11. Lower the vehicle to ground level. 12. Tighten the stabilizer bar link nut to a torque of 23 Nm
(200 inch lbs.). 13. Set the rear toe on the vehicle to the required specification if necessary.
ADJUSTMENTS ADJUSTMENT - ACR STRUT
Vehicles equipped with the optional ACR performance package have adjustable struts. A single
adjustment knob is located on the bottom of each front and rear strut. The one knob adjusts both
bump and rebound characteristics. It adjusts the strut up to 24 different positions (notches or
detents), six per revolution. Turn the knob clockwise to increase firmness and counterclockwise to
decrease firmness.
There is an internal stop at the "full firm" and "full soft" position.
New struts (and new vehicles equipped with them) come from the factory set at the "full soft"
position.
STRUT ADJUSTMENT KNOB (ACE) REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5794
2. Using a trim stick, carefully pry the knob off the bottom of the strut.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is no specific installed orientation for the adjustment knob. It can be installed in up to
6 different positions as long as the tabs on the knob are lined up with the flats on the internal nut.
1. Install knob center hex onto strut center hex screw, then line up tabs on knob with flats on strut
internal nut and push the knob upward, snapping it
into place.
2. Lower vehicle. 3. Adjust the strut if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front
Bearing Retainer Plate Bolts
...........................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Rear
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
............................................ 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts
..........................................................................................................................................................
109-150 Nm (80-110 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Driveshaft Hub Nut ..............................................................................................................................
............................................ 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts ............................................
........................................................................................................................... 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Vehicle Lifting: Technician Safety Information
STANDARD PROCEDURE - HOISTING RECOMMENDATIONS
Refer to the Owner's Manual for emergency vehicle lifting procedures.
WARNING: THE HOISTING AND JACK LIFTING POINTS PROVIDED ARE FOR A COMPLETE
VEHICLE. WHEN A CHASSIS OR DRIVETRAIN COMPONENT IS REMOVED FROM A
VEHICLE, THE CENTER OF GRAVITY IS ALTERED MAKING SOME HOISTING CONDITIONS
UNSTABLE. PROPERLY SUPPORT OR SECURE VEHICLE TO HOISTING DEVICE WHEN
THESE CONDITIONS EXIST.
Fig. 7 Correct Vehicle Lifting Locations
Floor Jack When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift a Ram Van or Wagon (Fig. 7).
Support the vehicle in the raised position with jack stands at the front and rear ends of the frame
rails.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a CNG Ram Van/Wagon with a floor jack positioned under:
- Body side sill
- Steering linkage component
- Drive shaft
- Engine or transmission oil pan
- Fuel cylinder
- Front suspension arm
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a vehicle with a floor jack positioned under: An axle tube.
- A body side sill.
- A steering linkage component.
- A drive shaft.
- The engine or transmission oil pan.
- The fuel tank.
- A front suspension arm.
Hoist A vehicle can be lifted with: A single-post, frame-contact hoist.
- A twin-post, chassis hoist.
- A ramp-type, drive-on hoist.
NOTE: When a frame-contact type hoist is used, verify that the lifting pads are positioned properly
(Fig. 7).
WARNING: WHEN A SERVICE PROCEDURE REQUIRES THE REMOVAL OF THE REAR AXLE,
FUEL CYLINDER OR SPARE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 5807
TIRE; EITHER:
- Place additional weight on the rear end of the vehicle
- Attach the vehicle to the hoist
- Place jack stands under the vehicle for support to prevent tipping when the center of balance
changes
A CNG Ram Van/Wagon can be lifted with: Twin post, chassis hoist
- Twin post, wheel lift hoist
- Ramp type, drive on hoist
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 5808
Vehicle Lifting: Vehicle Damage Warnings
STANDARD PROCEDURE - HOISTING RECOMMENDATIONS
Refer to the Owner's Manual for emergency vehicle lifting procedures.
WARNING: THE HOISTING AND JACK LIFTING POINTS PROVIDED ARE FOR A COMPLETE
VEHICLE. WHEN A CHASSIS OR DRIVETRAIN COMPONENT IS REMOVED FROM A
VEHICLE, THE CENTER OF GRAVITY IS ALTERED MAKING SOME HOISTING CONDITIONS
UNSTABLE. PROPERLY SUPPORT OR SECURE VEHICLE TO HOISTING DEVICE WHEN
THESE CONDITIONS EXIST.
Fig. 7 Correct Vehicle Lifting Locations
Floor Jack When properly positioned, a floor jack can be used to lift a Ram Van or Wagon (Fig. 7).
Support the vehicle in the raised position with jack stands at the front and rear ends of the frame
rails.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a CNG Ram Van/Wagon with a floor jack positioned under:
- Body side sill
- Steering linkage component
- Drive shaft
- Engine or transmission oil pan
- Fuel cylinder
- Front suspension arm
CAUTION: Do not attempt to lift a vehicle with a floor jack positioned under: An axle tube.
- A body side sill.
- A steering linkage component.
- A drive shaft.
- The engine or transmission oil pan.
- The fuel tank.
- A front suspension arm.
Hoist A vehicle can be lifted with: A single-post, frame-contact hoist.
- A twin-post, chassis hoist.
- A ramp-type, drive-on hoist.
NOTE: When a frame-contact type hoist is used, verify that the lifting pads are positioned properly
(Fig. 7).
WARNING: WHEN A SERVICE PROCEDURE REQUIRES THE REMOVAL OF THE REAR AXLE,
FUEL CYLINDER OR SPARE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 5809
TIRE; EITHER:
- Place additional weight on the rear end of the vehicle
- Attach the vehicle to the hoist
- Place jack stands under the vehicle for support to prevent tipping when the center of balance
changes
A CNG Ram Van/Wagon can be lifted with: Twin post, chassis hoist
- Twin post, wheel lift hoist
- Ramp type, drive on hoist
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Tires: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - TIRE
Tires are designed and engineered for each specific vehicle. They provide the best overall
performance for normal operation. The ride and handling characteristics match the vehicle's
requirements. With proper care they will give excellent reliability, traction, skid resistance, and tread
life.
Driving habits have more effect on tire life than any other factor. Careful drivers will obtain, in most
cases, much greater mileage than severe use or careless drivers. A few of the driving habits which
will shorten the life of any tire are: -
Rapid acceleration
- Severe application of brakes
- High-speed driving
- Taking turns at excessive speeds
- Striking curbs and other obstacles
- Operating vehicle with over or under inflated tire pressures
Radial ply tires are more prone to irregular tread wear. It is important to follow the tire rotation
interval. This will help to achieve a greater tread-life potential.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Fig. 1
Tire type, size, aspect ratio and speed rating are encoded in the letters and numbers imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. Refer to the chart to decipher the tire identification code.
Performance tires will have a speed rating letter after the aspect ratio number. For example, the
letter "S" indicates that the tire is speed rated up to 112 mph (180 km/h). The speed rating is not
always printed on the tire sidewall. Q -up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
- S -up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
- T -up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
- U -up to 124 mph (200 km/h)
- H -up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
- V -up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
- Z -more than 149 mph (240 km/h) (consult the tire manufacturer for the specific speed rating)
An All Season type tire will have either M + S, M & S or M-S (indicating mud and snow traction)
imprinted on the sidewall.
TIRE CHAINS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 5813
Refer to the owners manual supplied with the vehicle to determine whether the use of tire chains is
permitted on this vehicle.
DESCRIPTION - RADIAL-PLY TIRES
Radial-ply tires improve handling, tread life and ride quality, and decrease rolling resistance.
Radial-ply tires must always be used in sets of four. Under no circumstances should they be used
on the front only. They may be mixed with temporary spare tires when necessary. A maximum
speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) is recommended while a temporary spare is in use.
Radial-ply tires have the same load-carrying capacity as other types of tires of the same size. They
also use the same recommended inflation pressures.
The use of oversized tires, either in the front or rear of the vehicle, can cause vehicle drive train
failure. This could also cause inaccurate wheel speed signals when the vehicle is equipped with
Antilock Brakes.
The use of tires from different manufactures on the same vehicle is NOT recommended. The
proper tire pressure should be maintained on all four tires.
DESCRIPTION - REPLACEMENT TIRES
WARNING: FAILURE TO EQUIP THE VEHICLE WITH TIRES HAVING ADEQUATE SPEED
CAPABILITY CAN RESULT IN SUDDEN TIRE FAILURE.
It is recommended that tires equivalent to the original equipment tires be used when replacement is
needed. Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety and handling of
the vehicle.
The original equipment tires provide a proper combination of many characteristics such as: Ride
- Noise
- Handling
- Durability
- Tread life
- Traction
- Rolling resistance
- Speed capability
The use of oversize tires may cause interference with vehicle components. Under extremes of
suspension and steering travel, interference with vehicle components may cause tire damage.
DESCRIPTION - SPARE TIRE (TEMPORARY)
The compact temporary spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be
repaired or replaced at the first opportunity, then reinstalled. Do not exceed speeds of 80 km/h (50
mph) when using the temporary spare tire. Refer to Owner's Manual for complete details.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Tread Wear Indicators
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Indicators
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Tread wear indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. When tread depth is 1.6
mm (1/16 inch), the tread wear indicators will appear as a 13 mm (1/2 inch) band.
Tire replacement is necessary when indicators appear in two or more grooves or if localized
balding occurs.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Tread Wear Indicators > Page 5816
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Patterns
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TIRE WEAR PATTERNS
Under inflation will cause wear on the shoulders of tire. Over inflation will cause wear at the center
of tire.
Fig. 2
Excessive camber causes the tire to run at an angle to the road. One side of tread is then worn
more than the other.
Excessive toe-in or toe-out causes wear on the tread edges and a feathered effect across the
tread.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Tread Wear Indicators > Page 5817
Tires: Testing and Inspection Vehicle Lead Diagnosis and Correction
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - VEHICLE LEAD DIAGNOSIS AND CORRECTION
Use the following chart to diagnose a vehicle that has a complaint of a drift or lead condition. The
use of this chart will help to determine if the lead condition is the result of a bad tire or is caused by
the wheel alignment.
VEHICLE LEAD DIAGNOSIS AND CORRECTION PROCEDURE
*NOTE: VERIFY THAT LEAD IS NOT RELATED TO STEERING WHEEL NOT CENTERED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures
Tires: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING - TIRES
Before delivery of a vehicle, remove the protective coating on the tires with white sidewalls or
raised white letters. To remove the protective coating, apply warm water and let it soak for a few
minutes. Afterwards, scrub the coating away with a soft bristle brush. Steam cleaning may also be
used to remove the coating.
CAUTION: DO NOT use gasoline, mineral oil, oil based solvent or a wire brush for cleaning.
Tire Inflation Pressures
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TIRE INFLATION PRESSURES The specified tire pressures have
been chosen to provide safe operation, vehicle stability, and a smooth ride. The proper tire
pressure specification can be found on the Tire Inflation Pressure Label provided with the vehicle
(usually on the rear face of the driver's door).
A quality air pressure gauge is recommended to check tire air pressure. Tire pressure should be
checked cold once per month. Check tire pressure more frequently when the weather temperature
varies widely. Tire pressure will decrease when the outdoor temperature drops. After checking the
air pressure, replace valve cap finger tight.
Inflation pressures specified on the Tire Inflation Pressure Label are always the cold inflation
pressure of the tire. Cold inflation pressure is obtained after the vehicle has not been operated for
at least 3 hours, or the vehicle is driven less than one mile after being inoperative for 3 hours. Tire
inflation pressures may increase from 2 to 6 pounds per square inch (psi) during operation. Do not
reduce this normal pressure buildup.
Improper inflation can cause:
- Uneven wear patterns
- Reduced tread life
- Reduced fuel economy
- Unsatisfactory ride
- The vehicle to drift.
WARNING: OVER OR UNDER INFLATED TIRES CAN AFFECT VEHICLE HANDLING. THE TIRE
CAN FAIL SUDDENLY, RESULTING IN LOSS OF VEHICLE CONTROL.
Fig. 4
Under inflation causes rapid shoulder wear, tire flexing, and can result in tire failure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 5820
Fig. 5
Over inflation causes rapid center wear and loss of the tire's ability to cushion shocks.
Tire Pressure For High Speed Operation
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TIRE PRESSURE FOR HIGH SPEED OPERATION
Daimler Chrysler Corporation advocates driving at safe speeds within posted speed limits. Speed
capacity of a tire is a function of the tire speed rating, inflation pressure and vehicle axle weight.
Where speed limits allow the vehicle to be driven at high speeds, correct tire inflation pressure is
very important. Vehicles loaded to maximum capacity should not be driven at continuous speeds
over 120 km/h (75 mph). Never exceed the maximum speed capacity of the tire.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 5821
Tires: Removal and Replacement
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TIRE LEAK REPAIRING
Fig. 7
For proper repairing, a radial tire must be removed from the wheel. Repairs should only be made if
the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area. The tire should be replaced if the puncture is located in
the sidewall.
Deflate tire completely before attempting to dismount the tire from the wheel. Use a lubricant such
as a mild soap solution when dismounting or mounting tire. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges
which could damage the tire or wheel rim.
Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if
necessary.
Install wheel on vehicle, and progressively tighten the 5 wheel nuts to a torque of 135 Nm (100 ft.
lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels - Caring for Chrome Wheels
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Caring for Chrome Wheels
NUMBER: 22-001-05
GROUP: Wheels and Tires
DATE: December 1, 2005
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 22-004-03, DATED
SEPTEMBER 26, 2003 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS AND MODEL
YEARS AND CLEANER SUGGESTIONS.
SUBJECT: Chrome Wheel Care
MODELS:
2000 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
2002 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
2000 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2006** (CS) Pacifica
2002 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2006 (DR/DH) Ram Truck**
2004 - **2006** (HB) Durango
2001 - **2006** (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2003 - **2006** (KJ) Liberty
1998 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/LHS/300M
2005 - **2006 (LX/LE) 300/Charger/Magnum**
**2005 - 2006 (ND) Dakota**
1998 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country
2002 - **2005** (PL) Neon
1999 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - **2006** (PT) PT Cruiser
2001 - **2006** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan
2001 - **2005** (ST) Sebring/Stratus Coupe
2002 - **2006** (TJ) Wrangler
**2002 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter**
2001 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
**2005 - 2006 (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee**
**2006 (XK) Commander**
2003 - **2006 (ZB) Viper/Viper Coupe**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels - Caring for Chrome Wheels > Page 5826
2004 - **2006 (ZH) Crossfire/Crossfire Convertible/SRT6**
DISCUSSION:
Chrome wheels should be cleaned regularly with **good quality car wash such as MOPAR Car
Wash Concentrate p/n 04796236AB,** and water to maintain their luster and prevent corrosion.
Wash them with the same soap solution as the body of the vehicle.
Care must be taken in the selection of tire and wheel cleaning chemicals and equipment to prevent
damage to wheels. MOPAR Tire and Wheel Cleaner, p/n 05066247AB - 22 oz. or 05066248AB - 5
gal. **or MOPAR Wheel Cleaner, p/n 04796239AB,** is recommended to remove normal brake
dust, dirt, grease and grime.
NOTE:
To clean extremely dirty wheels, MOPAR Chrome Cleaner, pin 04318013, is recommended.
Any of the "DO NOT USE" items listed below can damage or stain wheels and wheel trim.
DO NOT USE:
^ Wheel cleaners that contain hydroflouric acid, biflouride compounds, sulfuric acid, or phosphoric
acid.
^ Any abrasive type cleaner
^ Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or abrasive brush
^ Any oven cleaner.
^ A car wash that has carbide tipped wheel-cleaning brushes.
CAUTION:
Many commercial wheel cleaners contain acids that may harm the wheel surface. Avoid all "wheel
acid" type cleaners.
CAUTION:
Any facility found using acid based wheel cleaners will void all wheel warranties, and all damage to
customer wheels will be the facility's responsibility.
Refer to Global Warranty Bulletin D-01-22 for further information.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5827
Wheels: Specifications
WHEEL SPECIFICATIONS
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut Hex Size ...................................................................................................
.................................................................. 19 mm Wheel Mounting Stud Size ...................................
...................................................................................................................................... M12 x 1.5 mm
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut Torque
.................................................................................................................................................. 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5828
Wheels: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION Original equipment wheels are designed for proper operation at all loads up to the
specified maximum vehicle capacity.
All models use steel or cast aluminum drop center wheels. Every wheel has raised sections
between the rim flanges and rim drop well called safety humps.
Initial inflation of the tires forces the bead over these raised sections. In case of air loss the raised
sections help hold the tire in position on the wheel until the vehicle can be brought to a safe stop.
Cast aluminum wheels require special balance weights to fit on the thicker flange of the rim and
special wheel clamps for the alignment equipment.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific wheel applications and must be replaced with
equivalent parts. Do not use replacement parts of lesser quality or of a substitute design. All
aluminum wheels use wheel nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is necessary to
ensure proper retention of the wheels.
Vehicles that are equipped with lock-on wheel covers use large nose wheel nuts. The wheel nuts
are externally threaded so that the wheel covers can be attached to the wheel nuts.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5829
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WHEEL INSPECTION
Inspect wheels for: Excessive runout
- Dents, cracks or irregular bends
- Damaged wheel stud (lug) holes
- Air Leaks
NOTE: Do not attempt to repair a wheel by hammering, heating or welding.
If a wheel is damaged, an original equipment replacement wheel should be used. When obtaining
replacement wheels, they must be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The diameter, width, offset,
pilot hole and bolt circle of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: FAILURE TO USE EQUIVALENT REPLACEMENT WHEELS MAY ADVERSELY
AFFECT THE SAFETY AND HANDLING OF THE VEHICLE.
WARNING: REPLACEMENT WITH USED WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE SERVICE
HISTORY OF THE WHEEL MAY HAVE INCLUDED SEVERE TREATMENT OR VERY HIGH
MILEAGE. THE RIM COULD FAIL WITHOUT WARNING.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5830
Wheels: Service and Repair
CLEANING
WHEEL AND WHEEL TRIM CARE
All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and chrome plated, should be cleaned regularly
using mild soap and water to maintain their luster and to prevent corrosion. Wash them with the
same soap solution recommended for the body of the vehicle.
When cleaning extremely dirty wheels, care must be taken in the selection of tire and wheel
cleaning chemicals and equipment to prevent damage to the wheels. Mopar Wheel Treatment or
Mopar Chrome Cleaner is recommended. Any of the "DO NOT USE" items listed below can
damage wheels and wheel trim.
DO NOT USE: Any abrasive cleaner
- Any abrasive cleaning pad (such as steel wool) or abrasive brush
- Any cleaner that contains an acid which can react with and discolor the chrome surface. Many
wheel cleaners contain acids that can harm the wheel surface.
- Oven cleaner
- A car wash that uses carbide-tipped wheel cleaning brushes or acidic solutions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front
Bearing Retainer Plate Bolts
...........................................................................................................................................................
28 Nm (250 inch lbs.)
Rear
To Knuckle Retaining Nut ....................................................................................................................
............................................ 217 Nm (160 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts
..........................................................................................................................................................
109-150 Nm (80-110 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle.
CAUTION: When removing the bolt-on wheel cover, do not attempt to pry the wheel cover off the
wheel.
2. Unthread and remove the 5 nuts attaching the wheel and wheel cover to the vehicle. 3. Remove
the wheel cover using care not to let the tire and wheel assembly fall off the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Installing the wheel mounting nuts without having good metal-to-mental contact
between the back of the wheel and the hub mounted brake disc or drum could cause the wheel to
bind and eventually cause loosening of the wheel mounting nuts.
CAUTION: Never use oil or grease on wheel studs or wheel mounting nuts.
1. With the tire and wheel assembly positioned on the wheel studs without the wheel mounting nuts
installed, align the valve notch in the wheel cover
with the valve stem on the wheel and install the wheel cover on the hub mounted studs.
2. Install and lightly tighten the wheel mounting nuts in the proper sequence. 3. Lower the vehicle.
4. Progressively tighten the 5 wheel mounting nuts in the proper sequence until tightened to half of
the specified torque. Finally, tighten the wheel
mounting nuts in the proper sequence to 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front
Driveshaft Hub Nut ..............................................................................................................................
............................................ 244 Nm (180 ft. lbs.) Wheel Mounting Nuts ............................................
........................................................................................................................... 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel Mounting (Lug) Nut Hex Size
................................................................................................................................................... 135
Nm (100 ft. lbs.)
For Tightening Sequence refer to Wheels and Tires, Service and Repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
WHEEL MOUNTING STUDS - FRONT
REMOVAL
Use the following procedure to remove and install one of five studs on one wheel hub. 1. Raise the
vehicle. 2. Remove the front tire and wheel assembly.
3. Remove the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle. 4.
Remove the disc brake caliper from the steering knuckle. The caliper is removed by first tipping
either the top (right side) or bottom (left side) of
the caliper away from the brake rotor, then pulling the caliper off the opposite end's caliper slide
abutment (on the knuckle) and rotor.
5. Hang the caliper out of the way using a wire hanger or cord. Do not support the caliper by letting
it hang by the hydraulic hose. 6. Remove any retainer clips from the wheel mounting studs.
Remove the brake rotor from the front hub.
CAUTION: Do not hammer wheel mounting studs out of the hub. Damage to the wheel bearing will
occur, leading to premature bearing failure.
7. Install a wheel mounting nut on the wheel mounting stud being removed from the hub far enough
so the threads on the stud are even with end of
lug nut. Rotate the hub so the stud requiring removal is aligned with notch cast into front of the
steering knuckle. Install Remover, Special Tool C-4150A, on hub flange and wheel stud .
8. Tighten the remover, pushing the wheel mounting stud out the rear of the hub flange. When the
shoulder of the stud is past the flange, remove the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5846
remover from the hub. Remove the nut from the stud, then remove the stud from the flange.
INSTALLATION
Use the following procedure to remove and install one of five studs on one wheel hub.
Fig. 62
1. Install the wheel mounting stud in the flange of hub from the rear side. Install several washers
and a wheel mounting nut on the stud. The wheel
mounting nut must be installed with the flat side of the wheel mounting nut against the washers to
eliminate binding.
2. Tighten the wheel mounting nut. This will pull the wheel mounting stud into the flange of the hub.
When the head of the stud is fully seated against
the rear of the hub flange, remove the wheel mounting nut and washers from the stud.
3. Install the brake rotor on the hub.
4. Install the disc brake caliper (with pads) on the brake rotor and steering knuckle. The left side
caliper is installed by first sliding the top of the
caliper past the top abutment on the steering knuckle to hook the top edge of the caliper, then
pushing the lower end of the caliper into place against the knuckle. The right side caliper is
installed by first sliding the bottom edge of the caliper past the lower abutment on the steering
knuckle to hook the lower edge of the caliper, then pushing the top of the caliper into place against
the steering knuckle.
5. Install the two guide pin bolts securing the front disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle .
Tighten the guide pin bolts to a torque of 22 Nm (192
inch lbs.).
6. Install the tire and wheel assembly. Install the wheel mounting nuts and tighten them to a torque
of 135 Nm (100 ft. lbs.). 7. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5847
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
WHEEL MOUNTING STUDS - REAR
REMOVAL
CAUTION: DO NOT hammer studs out of the hub flange. If a stud is removed by hammering it out
of the bearing flange, damage to the hub and bearing assembly will occur leading to premature
bearing failure.
1. Remove the hub and bearing from the vehicle.
CAUTION: Take care to keep hub and bearing assembly from falling during stud removal. Damage
to the hub and bearing could result.
2. Position the hub and bearing assembly under a hydraulic press ram, supported by a 21 mm
deep well impact socket under the stud to be replaced. 3. Press the stud out of the hub flange and
into the socket well. 4. Remove the hub and bearing assembly from the press. 5. Remove the stud
from the socket.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: DO NOT hammer studs into the hub flange. If a stud is installed in such a manner,
damage to the hub and bearing assembly may occur leading to premature bearing failure.
1. Install wheel stud into stud hole in hub and bearing assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5848
2. Position the hub and bearing assembly face down with stud pointing down into the well of the 21
mm socket. The hydraulic press ram must line up
with the stud.
3. Press the stud into the hub flange until it bottoms. 4. Remove the hub and bearing assembly
from the press. 5. Install the hub and bearing on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Accumulator HVAC: Locations
Fig.12 Accumulator - Typical
The accumulator is mounted in the engine compartment between the evaporator outlet and the
compressor suction port.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5853
Accumulator HVAC: Description and Operation
Fig.49 Accumulator - Typical
The accumulator is mounted in the engine compartment between the evaporator outlet and the
compressor suction port. An integral mounting bracket is used to secure the accumulator to the
right side rail with a screw. Two connectors of the suction and liquid line assembly are sealed to an
integral connector block on the top of the accumulator canister with rubber O-ring seals and
secured there with two screws. A threaded fitting on the top of the accumulator canister provides
the port through which the low pressure clutch cycling switch monitors the refrigerant system
pressures.
The accumulator cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced. The suction
and liquid line assembly, the rubber O-rings and the low pressure clutch cycling switch are
available for service replacement.
Refrigerant enters the accumulator canister as a low pressure vapor through the inlet tube. Any
liquid, oil-laden refrigerant falls to the bottom of the canister, which acts as a separator. A desiccant
bag located inside the accumulator canister absorbs any moisture which may have entered and
become trapped within the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5854
Accumulator HVAC: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT OF THIS GROUP
BEFORE PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
1. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. If the vehicle is so equipped, relocate the vehicle speed control servo as
necessary to access the accumulator. 4. Remove the low pressure clutch cycling switch from the
accumulator.
Fig.50 Accumulator Remove/Install
5. Remove the two screws that secure the two refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line
assembly to the accumulator connector block inlet
and outlet ports.
6. Disconnect the two refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly from the
accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports. 7. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly and discard. 8. Install plugs in, or tape
over the opened accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the refrigerant line fittings
of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
9. Remove the screw that secures the accumulator mounting bracket to the right side rail.
10. Remove the accumulator from the engine compartment.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT OF THIS GROUP
BEFORE PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
1. Position the accumulator into the engine compartment. 2. Install and tighten the screw that
secures the accumulator mounting bracket to the right side rail. Tighten the screw to 11.3 Nm (100
in. lbs.). 3. Remove the tape or plugs from the accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports
and the refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line
assembly.
4. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them on the refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly.
Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
5. Reconnect the refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator
connector block inlet and outlet ports. 6. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the two
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector
block inlet and outlet ports. Tighten the screws to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
7. Reinstall the low pressure clutch cycling switch onto the accumulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Accumulator HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5855
8. If the vehicle is so equipped, reinstall the vehicle speed control servo. 9. Reconnect the battery
negative cable.
10. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
NOTE: If the accumulator is replaced, add 89 milli-liters (3 fluid ounces) of refrigerant oil to the
refrigerant system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the
vehicle.
11. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Conditioning Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
A/C Cycling Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Description and Operation
Fig.25 A/C Vacuum Line
RECIRCULATION DOOR ACTUATOR - LHD
The vehicle uses vacuum to operate only the recirculation door All other controls are cable When
vacuum is supplied to the actuator, the door moves to the Recirculation position The actuator is
spring loaded so the door moves to the Outside-air position when there is no vacuum supplied The
operation of the door can be viewed by removing the blower motor and looking up into the unit inlet
Normally, vacuum is supplied to the actuator by placing the Circulation control knob in the
Recirculation position The Mode and the circulation control are mechanically interlocked so the
circulation control cannot be placed in the RECIRC position if the mode control is at or between the
mix and defrost positions Vacuum is supplied to the actuator only when circulation control is at the
RECIRC position If the circulation control is between the outside air position and RECIRC position
the system will be in outside air If the circulation control is in the RECIRC position and the mode
control is moved from the floor to the defrost positions, the circulation control will move from the
RECIRC position, to the outside air position beginning at the mix position This is to prevent window
fogging.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5863
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The recirculation door actuator is a vacuum controlled actuator used to control movement of the
recirculation door in air conditioner equipped vehicles.
The instrument panel must be removed from the vehicle to gain access to the recirculation door
actuator.
1. Remove the battery negative cable. 2. Remove instrument panel from vehicle. 3. Disconnect
vacuum line harness connector from the nipple on the recirculation door actuator. 4. Release the
latch that secures the recirculation door actuator mount to the stanchion on the Heater-A/C unit
housing, and disengage the
recirculation door actuator from the housing.
Fig.26 Recirculation Door Actuator And Linkage
5. Disconnect the recirculation door actuator linkage from the recirculation door lever. 6. Remove
the recirculation door actuator from the Heater-A/C unit housing.
INSTALLATION
The recirculation door actuator is a vacuum controlled actuator used to control movement of the
recirculation door in air conditioned equipped vehicles. 1. Position the recirculation door actuator to
the Heater-A/C unit housing. 2. Reconnect the recirculation door actuator linkage to the
recirculation door lever. 3. Align the recirculation door actuator mount to the stanchion on the
Heater-A/C unit housing, and press it onto the stanchion firmly and to engage
the latch.
4. Reconnect the vacuum harness connector to the nipple on the recirculation door actuator. 5.
Reinstall the Instrument Panel. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Adjustments > Temperature Control Cable Adjustment
Air Door Cable: Adjustments Temperature Control Cable Adjustment
1. Engage cable to actuator arm on temperature door and attach to housing. 2. Attach other end of
cable to instrument panel control. 3. Turn the temperature knob completely counterclockwise. 4.
While holding the knob in the counterclockwise position, pull on the gray casing of the temperature
cable. This will take up any free play in the
cable and index the temperature door to the temperature knob.
5. Then snap the cable hold down clip into position. 6. Remount control.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Adjustments > Temperature Control Cable Adjustment > Page 5868
Air Door Cable: Adjustments Mode Control Cable Adjustment
1. Engage cable to actuator arm lever on mode door and attach to housing. 2. Attach other end of
cable to instrument panel control. 3. Turn the mode knob completely counterclockwise. 4. While
holding the knob in the counterclockwise position, pull on the gray casing of the mode cable. This
will take up any free play in the cable and
index the mode door to the mode knob.
5. Then snap the cable hold down clip into position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Cable Replacement
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair Mode Door Cable Replacement
NOTE:The Mode Control Cable can be removed and installed without having to remove the
instrument panel from the vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.22 Instrument Panel Center Bezel & Knobs
2. Remove instrument panel center stack bezel.
Fig.23 HVAC Center Air Duct & Control Head
3. Remove center air duct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Cable Replacement > Page 5871
Fig.24 HVAC Control Head Cables
4. Remove heater-A/C control head and disconnect cable. 5. Disconnect the mode control cable
end from the mode door lever. 6. Remove the mode control cable through the instrument panel
heater-A/C control opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the mode control cable through the instrument panel heater-A/C control opening. 2.
Reach through the instrument panel center air duct opening to access and reconnect the mode
control cable end to the mode door lever. 3. Install and tighten the screw that secures the mode
control cable housing. Tighten the screw to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.). 4. Install the instrument panel
center stack bezel. 5. Reinstall the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Cable Replacement > Page 5872
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair Temperature Door Cable Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove instrument panel center stack
bezel. 3. Remove the center air duct from the instrument panel. 4. Remove heater-A/C control. 5.
Reach through the instrument panel center air duct opening to access and remove the screw that
secures the temperature control cable housing
retainer to the top of the heater-A/C unit housing.
6. Disconnect cable at control panel. Remove control from instrument panel.
Fig.27 HVAC Housing Cables - (Typical)
7. Disconnect the temperature control cable end from the blend-air door lever. 8. Remove the
temperature control cable through the instrument panel heater-A/C control opening.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the temperature control cable through the instrument panel heater-A/C control opening..
2. Reach through the instrument panel center air duct opening to access and reconnect the
temperature control cable end to the blend-air door lever. 3. Install and tighten the screw that
secures the temperature control cable housing retainer to the top of the heater-A/C unit housing.
Tighten the
screw to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
4. Reinstall the heater-A/C control into the instrument panel. 5. Install the instrument panel center
stack bezel. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Air Duct: Procedures
CENTER AIR OUTLET DUCT
REMOVAL
Fig.29 Dash Board - Front View
1. Remove the center bezel from the instrument panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Trim,
Dashboard/Instrument panel, Service and
Repair, Instrument Panel Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Center Bezel Replacement, See:
Body and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and
Repair/Instrument Panel Center Bezel
2. Remove the screws that secure the center air outlet duct to the instrument panel. 3. Disengage
the center air outlet duct from the air outlet distribution duct. 4. Remove the center air outlet duct
from the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the center air outlet duct to the instrument panel. 2. Engage the center air outlet duct to
the air outlet distribution duct. 3. Install the screws that secure the center air outlet duct to the
instrument panel. Tighten to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.). 4. Install the center bezel to the instrument panel.
Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Trim, Dashboard/Instrument panel, Service and Repair,
Instrument Panel Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Center Bezel Replacement, See: Body
and Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument
Panel Center Bezel
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 5877
Air Duct: Removal and Replacement
AIR EXHAUSTER
REMOVAL
1. Hoist rear end of vehicle and support on safety stands. 2. From behind rear bumper fascia below
quarter panel, disengage clips attaching body vent to trunk well.
Fig. 9
3. Remove body vent from vehicle (Fig. 9).
INSTALLATION
1. Place body vent in vehicle. 2. From behind rear bumper fascia below quarter panel, engage clips
attaching body vent to trunk well. 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Air Register: Description and Operation
AIR OUTLETS
The demisters direct air from the unit housing through the outlets located on the top corners of the
instrument panel. The demisters operate when the mode selector is anywhere between floor and
defrost settings. Some air may be noticeable from the demister outlets when the mode selector is
in the bi-level to floor positions.
AIR FLOW DISTRIBUTION
Fig.39 Dash Board - Front View
Based upon the system mode selected, conditioned air can exit the standard heater-only or
optional heater-A/C unit housing through one or a combination of the three main housing outlets:
defrost, panel or floor. The defrost outlet is located on the top of the housing, the panel outlet is
located on the face of the housing and the floor outlet is located on the bottom of the housing.
Once the conditioned air exits the unit housing, it is further directed through molded plastic ducts to
the various outlets in the vehicle interior. These outlets and their locations are as follows:
- Defroster Outlet - A single large defroster outlet is located in the center of the instrument panel
top cover, near the base of the windshield.
- Side Window Demister Outlets - There are two side window demister outlets, one is located at
each outboard end of the instrument panel top cover, near the belt line at the A-pillars.
- Panel Outlets - There are four panel outlets in the instrument panel, one located near each
outboard end of the instrument panel facing the rear of the vehicle and two located near the top of
the instrument panel center bezel.
- Front Floor Outlets - There are four front floor outlets, two located above each side of the floor
panel center tunnel near the dash panel.
- Rear Floor Outlets - There are two rear floor outlets, one located on each side of the floor panel
center tunnel near the front of each rear seat foot well.
The defroster outlet receives airflow from the unit housing through the molded plastic defroster
duct, which is snapped onto the unit housing defroster outlet and secured by two tabs to mounting
slots in the dash panel. The airflow from the defroster outlet is directed by fixed vanes in the
defroster outlet grille and cannot be adjusted. The defroster outlet grille is integral to the instrument
panel top cover.
The side window demister outlets receive airflow from the unit housing through the air outlet
distribution duct, two molded plastic demister hoses and, on the right side only, an intermediate
duct. The air outlet distribution duct is secured to the instrument panel with screws and receives
airflow through the panel outlet of the unit housing. The airflow from the side window demister
outlets is directed by fixed vanes in the demister outlet grilles and cannot be adjusted. The side
window demister outlet grilles are integral to the instrument panel top cover.
The panel outlets also receive airflow from the unit housing through the air outlet distribution duct.
Molded plastic panel outlet ducts and, on the left side only, an intermediate elbow direct airflow
from the distribution duct to the outboard panel outlets, while a center air outlet duct directs airflow
from the distribution duct to the two center panel outlets. The airflow from each of the panel outlets
is adjustable. A knob in the center of each panel outlet grille is used in a joystick fashion to adjust a
center diffuser that changes the airflow direction, and a knob on the outer edge of each panel outlet
grille opens or closes a shutter to turn airflow on or off through that outlet.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5881
The front and rear floor outlets receive airflow from the unit housing through the floor distribution
duct. The front floor outlets are integral to the molded plastic floor distribution duct, which is
secured to the bottom of the unit housing. A molded plastic rear seat duct elbow is fitted to the
bottom of the floor distribution duct and directs airflow through a molded plastic duct beneath the
carpet on the right side of the floor panel center tunnel to the right rear floor outlet. The right floor
duct also features a crossover fitting that joins the right floor duct to the left floor duct over the top
of the floor panel center tunnel to direct airflow to the left rear floor outlet. None of the floor outlets
can be adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5885
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5886
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the compass/temp module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 degrees C (140 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 degrees C (140
degrees F) to indicate a SHORT circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) to
indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the Sensor Test. If there are no codes
stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5887
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
0 degrees C (32 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 degrees C (50 degrees
F) Sensor Resistance = 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 degrees C (68 degrees F) Sensor Resistance =
11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 degrees C (77 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30
degrees C (86 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 degrees C (104 degrees F)
Sensor Resistance = 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5888
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Open hood, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Working under the front of the
vehicle, remove the necessary components to access the ambient temperature sensor. 3.
Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the ambient
temperature sensor retaining screw and remove the sensor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 2. Position the ambient
temperature sensor and install the retaining screw. 3. Install the removed components. 4. Connect
the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations
Blower Motor: Locations
The blower motor is located on the bottom right side of the unit housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Connector Views
A/C-Heater Blower Motor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5894
Blower Motor: Description and Operation
The blower motor wheel is only serviced with the blower motor. The wheel and the motor are
balanced as an assembly. If the blower motor wheel requires replacement, the blower motor must
also be replaced.
The blower motor will only operate when the ignition switch is in the On position, and the blower
control switch is in any position except Off. The blower motor circuit is protected by a fuse in the
instrument panel fuse block. The blower motor speed is controlled by regulating the battery feed
through the blower control switch and the blower motor resistor. The blower motor and wheel are
used to control the velocity of air moving through the heater-only or heater-A/C unit housing. The
blower motor controls the velocity of the air flowing through the heater-A/C housing by spinning the
blower wheel within the housing at the selected speed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5895
Blower Motor: Testing and Inspection
Fig.30 Blower Motor Electrical Diagnosis
For circuit descriptions and diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring
information includes wiring, diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, further details
on wire harness routing and retention, as well as pin-out and location views for the various wire
harness connectors, splices and grounds. The following chart will give you a basic check list on the
blower motor circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
With Air Conditioning
Blower Motor: Service and Repair With Air Conditioning
NOTE: The blower motor is located on the bottom right side of the unit housing. The blower motor
can be removed from the vehicle without having to remove the unit housing assembly.
REMOVAL
1. Remove left side scuff plate. 2. Pull back carpet. 3. Disconnect blower motor wiring connector.
Fig.31 Blower Motor Retaining Screws
4. Remove blower motor retaining screws, and lower blower motor assembly from unit housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the blower motor into the unit housing. 2. Install the blower motor retaining screws. 3.
Connect the wire harness to the blower motor. 4. Reposition the right side carpet. 5. Install the left
side scuff plate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
With Air Conditioning > Page 5898
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Without Air Conditioning
NOTE: The blower motor is located on the bottom right side of the unit housing. The blower motor
can be removed from the vehicle without having to remove the unit housing assembly.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect blower motor wiring connector.
Fig.32 Blower Motor Removal
2. Grasp the blower motor while pulling down tab. Turn approximately 1/8 turn counterclockwise
and remove blower motor assembly from unit
housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the blower motor in the unit housing. 2. Rotate the blower motor clockwise until tab
snaps into the locked position, approximately 1/8 turn.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Blower Motor Resistor: Component Locations
Fig.18 Blower Motor Resistor Block
The blower motor resistor is located in the cowl, at the base of the windshield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5903
Blower Motor Resistor: Connector Locations
Fig. 7 Rear Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5904
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5905
Blower Motor Resistor Block
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5906
Blower Motor Resistor: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Stay clear of the blower motor and resistor block (Hot). Do not operate the blower motor
with the resistor block removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5907
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation
Fig.19 Blower Motor Resistor Block
The blower motor resistor is located in the cowl, at the base of the windshield. There are two
different resistor blocks depending on whether the vehicle is equipped with A/C or not. The blower
motor resistors will get hot when in use. Do not touch resistor block if the blower motor has been
running.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 5908
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Stay clear of the blower motor and resistor block (Hot). Do not operate the blower motor
with the resistor block removed.
REMOVAL
1. Remove windshield wipers. 2. Remove cowl top screen.
Fig.20 Blower Motor Resistors
3. Disconnect the resistor block wiring connector. 4. Remove/unsnap resistor block from vehicle. 5.
Remove the resistor block from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
Fig.21 Blower Motor Resistor Block
1. Snap the new Blower Motor Resistor Block into place. 2. Connect the resistor block wiring
connector. 3. Install the cowl top screen. 4. Install the windshield wipers. 5. Reconnect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Application and ID
Cabin Air Filter: Application and ID
This vehicle is not equipped with a cabin air filter.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications
Compressor Clutch: Specifications
A/C Compressor Clutch Air Gap
.................................................................................................................................... 0.35 - 0.65 mm
(0.014 - 0.026 in.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5916
A/C Compressor Clutch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5917
Compressor Clutch: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use screwdrivers between the clutch plate assembly and pulley to remove front
plate as this may damage the front plate assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5918
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair
A/C COMPRESSOR CLUTCH
REMOVAL
Compressor assembly must be removed from mounting. Although, refrigerant discharge is not
necessary.
Fig.4 Compressor Shaft Bolt And Clutch Plate
1. Remove the compressor shaft bolt. A band type oil filter removal tool can be placed around the
clutch plate to aid in bolt removal.
Fig.5 Clutch Plate And Shim(s)
2. Tap the clutch plate with a plastic hammer and remove clutch plate and shim(s).
NOTE: Use care not to lose any of the shim(s).
CAUTION: Do not use screwdrivers between the clutch plate assembly and pulley to remove front
plate as this may damage the front plate assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5919
Fig.6 Removing Pulley Snap Ring
3. Remove pulley retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers, and slide pulley assembly off of
compressor. 4. Remove coil wire bracket/ground clip screw and wire harness.
Fig.7 Clutch Coil Snap Ring
5. Remove snap ring retaining field coil onto compressor housing. Slide field coil off of compressor
housing. 6. Examine frictional faces of the clutch pulley and front plate for wear. The pulley and
front plate should be replaced if there is excessive wear or
scoring. If the friction surfaces are oily, inspect the shaft nose area of the compressor for oil and
remove the felt from the front cover. If the compressor felt is saturated with oil, the shaft seal is
leaking and will have to be replaced.
7. Check bearing for roughness or excessive leakage of grease. Replace bearing as required.
INSTALLATION
1. Align pin in the back of the field coil with hole in compressor end housing, position the field coil
into place. Make sure that lead wires are properly
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5920
routed, and fasten the coil wire bracket/ground retaining screw.
NOTE: A new snap ring must be used. The bevel side of the snap ring must be outward.
2. Install field coil retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers. Press snap ring to make sure it is
properly seated in the groove.
CAUTION: If snap ring is not fully seated it will vibrate out, resulting in a clutch failure and severe
damage to the front face of the compressor. Do not mar the pulley frictional surface.
Fig.8 Installing Pulley Assembly
3. Install pulley assembly to compressor. If necessary, tap gently with a block of wood on the
friction surface. 4. Install pulley assembly retaining snap ring (bevel side outward) with Snap Ring
Pliers. Press the snap ring to make sure it is properly seated in the
groove.
5. If the original front plate assembly and pulley assembly are to be reused, the old shim(s) can be
used. If not, place a trial stack of shims, 2.54 mm
(0.10 in.) thick, on the shaft against the shoulder.
6. Install front plate assembly onto shaft. 7. If installing a new front plate and/or pulley assembly,
the gap between front plate and pulley face must be checked. Use the following procedure:
a. Attach a dial indicator to front plate so that movement of the plate can be measured. b. With the
dial indicator zeroed on the front plate, energize the clutch and record the amount of movement. c.
The readings should be 0.35 - 0.65 mm (0.014 - 0.026 in.). If proper reading is not obtained, add or
subtract shims until desired reading is
obtained.
8. Install compressor shaft bolt. Tighten to 17.5 ± 2 Nm (155 ± 20 in. lbs.) torque.
NOTE: Shims may compress after tightening shaft nut. Check air gap in four or more places to
verify if air gap is still correct. Spin pulley for final check.
CLUTCH BREAK-IN After new clutch installation, cycle the A/C clutch 20 times (5 seconds on and
5 seconds off). During this procedure, set the system to the A/C mode, engine speed at 1500 2000 rpm, and high blower speed. This procedure (burnishing) will seat the opposing friction
surfaces and provide a higher clutch torque capability.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service Precautions
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Do not use screwdrivers between the clutch plate assembly and pulley to remove front plate as
this may damage the front plate assembly.
- If snap ring is not fully seated it will vibrate out, resulting in a clutch failure and severe damage to
the front face of the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Page 5924
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair
A/C COMPRESSOR CLUTCH COIL
REMOVAL
Compressor assembly must be removed from mounting. Refrigerant discharge is not necessary.
Fig.13 Compressor Shaft Bolt And Clutch Plate
1. Remove the compressor shaft bolt. A band type oil filter removal tool can be placed around the
clutch plate to aid in bolt removal.
Fig.14 Clutch Plate And Shim(s)
2. Tap the clutch plate with a plastic hammer and remove clutch plate and shim(s).
NOTE: Use care not to lose any of the shim(s).
CAUTION: Do not use screwdrivers between the clutch plate assembly and pulley to remove front
plate as this may damage the front plate assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Page 5925
Fig.15 Removing Pulley Snap Ring
3. Remove pulley retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers, and slide pulley assembly off of
compressor. 4. Remove coil wire bracket/ground clip screw and wire harness.
Fig.16 Clutch Coil Snap Ring
5. Remove snap ring retaining field coil onto compressor housing. Slide field coil off of compressor
housing. 6. Examine frictional faces of the clutch pulley and front plate for wear. The pulley and
front plate should be replaced if there is excessive wear or
scoring. If the friction surfaces are oily, inspect the shaft nose area of the compressor for oil and
remove the felt from the front cover. If the compressor felt is saturated with oil, the shaft seal is
leaking and will have to be replaced.
7. Check bearing for roughness or excessive leakage of grease. Replace bearing as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Page 5926
INSTALLATION
1. Align pin in the back of the field coil with hole in compressor end housing, position the field coil
into place. Make sure that lead wires are properly
routed, and fasten the coil wire bracket/ground retaining screw.
NOTE: A new snap ring must be used. The bevel side of the snap ring must be outward.
2. Install field coil retaining snap ring with Snap Ring Pliers. Press snap ring to make sure it is
properly seated in the groove.
CAUTION: If snap ring is not fully seated it will vibrate out, resulting in a clutch failure and severe
damage to the front face of the compressor. Do not mar the pulley frictional surface.
Fig.17 Installing Pulley Assembly
3. Install pulley assembly to compressor. If necessary, tap gently with a block of wood on the
friction surface. 4. Install pulley assembly retaining snap ring (bevel side outward) with Snap Ring
Pliers. Press the snap ring to make sure it is properly seated in the
groove.
5. If the original front plate assembly and pulley assembly are to be reused, the old shim(s) can be
used. If not, place a trial stack of shims, 2.54 mm
(0.10 in.) thick, on the shaft against the shoulder.
6. Install front plate assembly onto shaft. 7. If installing a new front plate and/or pulley assembly,
the gap between front plate and pulley face must be checked. Use the following procedure:
a. Attach a dial indicator to front plate so that movement of the plate can be measured. b. With the
dial indicator zeroed on the front plate, energize the clutch and record the amount of movement. c.
The readings should be 0.35 to 0.65 mm (0.014 to 0.026 in.). If proper reading is not obtained, add
or subtract shims until desired reading is
obtained.
8. Install compressor shaft bolt. Tighten to 17.5 ± 2 Nm (155 ± 20 in. lbs.) torque.
NOTE: Shims may compress after tightening shaft nut. Check air gap in four or more places to
verify if air gap is still correct. Spin pulley for final check.
9. Install the compressor on the engine.
CLUTCH BREAK-IN
After new clutch installation, cycle the A/C clutch 20 times (5 seconds on and 5 seconds off).
During this procedure, set the system to the A/C mode, engine rpm at 1500 - 2000, and high
blower speed. This procedure (burnishing) will seat the opposing friction surfaces and provide a
higher clutch torque capability.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5930
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5931
Compressor Clutch Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5932
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5933
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
Fig.6 A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
A/C COMPRESSOR CLUTCH RELAY
The A/C compressor clutch relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. The ISO micro-relay terminal functions are the same as a
conventional ISO relay. However, the ISO micro-relay terminal pattern (or footprint) is different, the
current capacity is lower, and the physical dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional
ISO relay. The A/C compressor clutch relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the
engine compartment. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the inside surface of the PDC
cover for A/C compressor clutch relay identification and location.
The black, molded plastic case is the most visible component of the A/C compressor clutch relay
Five male spade-type terminals extend from the bottom of the base to connect the relay to the
vehicle electrical system, and the ISO designation for each terminal is molded into the base
adjacent to each terminal.
The ISO terminal designations are as follows: 30 (Common Feed) - This terminal is connected to the movable contact point of the relay
- 85 (Coil Ground) - This terminal is connected to the ground feed side of the relay control coil.
- 86 (Coil Battery) - This terminal is connected to the battery feed side of the relay control coil.
- 87 (Normally Open) - This terminal is connected to the normally open fixed contact point of the
relay.
87A (Normally Closed) - This terminal is connected to the normally closed fixed contact point of the
relay.
The factory-installed A/C compressor clutch relay cannot be adjusted or repaired. If the relay is
damaged or faulty it must be replaced.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is an electromechanical switch that uses a low current input from
the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the high current output to the Compressor clutch
electromagnetic coil. The movable common feed contact point is held against the fixed normally
closed contact point by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field
is produced by the coil windings. This electromagnetic field draws the movable relay contact point
away from the fixed normally closed contact point, and holds it against the fixed normally open
contact point. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact
point back against the fixed normally closed contact point. The resistor or diode is connected in
parallel with the relay coil in the relay and helps to dissipate voltage spikes and electromagnetic
interference that can be generated as the electromagnetic field of the relay coil collapses.
The A/C compressor clutch relay terminals are connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
receptacle in the PDC. The inputs and outputs of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5934
the A/C compressor clutch relay include: The common feed terminal (30) receives a battery current input from a fuse in the PDC through a
fused B(+) circuit at all times.
- The coil ground terminal (85) receives a ground input from the PCM through the A/C compressor
clutch relay control circuit only when the PCM electronically pulls the control circuit to ground.
- The coil battery terminal (86) receives a battery current input from a fuse in the fuse block module
through a fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit only when the ignition switch is in the ON or
Start positions.
- The normally open terminal (87) provides a battery current output to the compressor clutch coil
through the A/C compressor clutch relay output circuit only when the A/C compressor clutch relay
coil is energized.
The normally closed terminal (87A) is not connected to any circuit in this application, but provides a
battery current output only when the A/C compressor clutch relay coil is de-energized.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5935
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
CHECKING THE A/C RELAY OUTPUT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- A/C clutch relay operation
- Ground circuit open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5936
- A/C clutch
- Fused B+ circuit
- A/C clutch output circuit
- A/C clutch relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5937
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.7 Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the cover from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 3. See the fuse and relay layout
label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for A/C compressor clutch relay identification and
location. 4. Remove the A/C compressor clutch relay from the PDC.
INSTALLATION
1. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for the proper A/C
compressor clutch relay location. 2. Position the A/C compressor clutch relay in the proper
receptacle in the PDC. 3. Align the A/C compressor clutch relay terminals with the terminal cavities
in the PDC receptacle. 4. Push down firmly on the A/C compressor clutch relay until the terminals
are fully seated in the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 5. Install the cover onto the PDC. 6.
Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Condenser HVAC: Specifications
A/C Condenser Lines ..........................................................................................................................
....................................5 Nm (3.7 ft. lbs) (45 In. Lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 5941
Condenser HVAC: Locations
Fig.3 Condenser
The condenser is integral to a cooling module which includes the radiator, the electric cooling fan,
the fan shroud, air seals and an automatic transmission oil cooler on models so equipped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Condenser - LHD
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Condenser - LHD
The condenser is integral to a cooling module which includes the radiator, the electric cooling fan,
the fan shroud, air seals and an automatic transmission oil cooler on models so equipped. The
cooling module is located in the air flow in the front of the engine compartment behind the front
grille.
The condenser cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced. The
cooling module must be removed from the vehicle in order to access the condenser for service.
The condenser is a heat exchanger that allows the high-pressure refrigerant gas being discharged
by the compressor to give up its heat to the air passing over the condenser fins. When the
refrigerant gas gives up its heat, it condenses. When the refrigerant leaves the condenser, it has
become a high-pressure liquid refrigerant.
The volume of air flowing over the condenser fins is critical to the proper cooling performance of
the air conditioning system. Therefore, it is important that there are no objects placed in front of the
radiator grille openings in the front of the vehicle or foreign material on the condenser fins that
might obstruct proper air flow. Also, any factory-installed air seals or shrouds must be properly
reinstalled following radiator or condenser service.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Condenser - LHD > Page 5944
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Condenser - RHD
Fig.42 A/C Refrigerant Lines - Condenser
The condenser is integral to a cooling module which includes the radiator, the electric cooling fan,
the fan shroud, air seals and an automatic transmission oil cooler on models so equipped The
cooling module is located in the air flow in the front of the engine compartment behind the front
grille.
The condenser cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced The
cooling module must be removed from the vehicle in order to access the condenser for service
The condenser is a heat exchanger that allows the high-pressure refrigerant gas being discharged
by the compressor to give up its heat to the air passing over the condenser fins When the
refrigerant gas gives up its heat, it condenses When the refrigerant leaves the condenser, it has
become a high-pressure liquid refrigerant
The volume of air flowing over the condenser fins is critical to the proper cooling performance of
the air conditioning system Therefore, it is important that there are no objects placed in front of the
radiator grille openings in the front of the vehicle or foreign material on the condenser fins that
might obstruct proper air flow Also, any factory-installed air seals or shrouds must be properly
reinstalled following radiator or condenser service
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5945
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
A/C CONDENSER
The condenser is located in front of the engine radiator. It has no serviceable parts. If damaged or
leaking, the condenser assembly must be replaced.
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE SYSTEM BEFORE
REMOVING THE CONDENSER.
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system. 2.
Remove battery support strut.
Fig.42 Condenser Refrigerant Lines - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 5946
Fig.43 Condenser Refrigerant Lines - RHD
3. Remove refrigerant lines from condenser. 4. Remove upper radiator mounts. 5. Remove
condenser to radiator mounting screws. 6. Tilt radiator back and remove condenser.
INSTALLATION
1. Tilt the radiator back and position the condenser in the vehicle. 2. Install the condenser to
radiator mounting screws. 3. Install the upper radiator mounts. 4. Install the refrigerant lines to the
condenser. 5. Install the battery support strut. 6. Tighten the condenser refrigerant lines to 5 Nm
(45 in. lbs). 7. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 8. Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations
A/C Heater Control
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Connector Views
A/C-Heater Control
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5952
Control Assembly: Description and Operation
A/C-HEATER CONTROL
Both the heater-only and heater-A/C systems use a combination of, electrical, cable, and vacuum
controls. These controls provide the vehicle operator with a number of setting options to help
control the climate and comfort within the vehicle. Refer to the owner's manual in the vehicle glove
box for more information on the features, use, and suggested operation of these controls.
The heater-only or heater-A/C control panel is located to the right of the instrument cluster on the
instrument panel. The control panel contains rotary-type knobs. There is a blower motor speed
switch, mode control switch, temperature control, and airflow control.
The heater-only or heater-A/C control panel cannot be repaired. If faulty or damaged, the entire unit
must be replaced. The control knobs and the illumination lamps are available for service
replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5953
Control Assembly: Service and Repair
A/C-HEATER CONTROL
REMOVAL
Fig.10 Instrument Panel Center Bezel & Knobs
1. Remove the instrument panel center stack bezel.
Fig.11 HVAC Center Air Duct & Control Head
2. Remove the center air duct.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5954
Fig.12 HVAC Control Head Cables
3. Remove the heater-A/C control head and disconnect the cable.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the control head cable and install the heater-A/C control head to the dash. 2. Install the
center air duct. 3. Install the instrument panel center stack bezel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Application and ID
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Climate Controls ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
Technical Service Bulletin # 24-006-06 Date: 060810
A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
NUMBER: 24-006-06
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Approval Pending
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-013-05, DATED AUGUST
4, 2005, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL MODEL, YEAR AND
REVISED AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK REPAIR PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: A/C Cooling Coil Odor
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting for leaves and other foreign material, cleaning, and
treating the cooling coil and housing.
MODELS:
1995-2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1995-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - **2007** (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2007** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
2004 - **2007** (HB) Durango
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2002 - **2007** (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/LHS/New Yorker/Intrepid/Vision
2005 - **2007** (LX) 300/**Charger**/Magnum
2005 - **2007** (ND) Dakota
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2001 - **2007** (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - **2007** (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - **2007** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2002 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WJ/WG) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2007** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2007** (XK**/XH)** Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5966
Some vehicle operators may experience a musty odor from the A/C system, primarily at start up in
hot and humid climates. This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the cooling coil. During
normal A/C system operation, condensation forms in and around the NC cooling coil. When
airborne pollutants mix with this condensation, bacteria and fungi growth begins and odor results.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the operator describes, or the technician experiences a musty odor when operating the A/C
system, perform the appropriate Repair Procedure based on the vehicle model.
PARTS REQUIRED:
A/C COOLING COIL CLEANER REQUIREMENTS BY VEHICLE MODEL
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5967
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK Vehicle Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH (2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles skip to step 8) (AB/CS**
vehicles proceed to next step), raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
4. On **2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), fabricate the cooling coil
drain plug as follows (Fig. 1):
a. Gather a 457.2 mm (18 in.) long, 9.8 mm (3/8 in.) drive socket extension; a deep 12 mm, 9.8 mm
(3/8 in.) drive socket, and a 152.4 mm (6 in.) piece of 15.9 mm (5/8 in.) ID heater hose, p/n
HHR00058AA
b. Place the socket on the end of the extension. Slide approximately 25.4 mm (1 in.) of the heater
hose over the socket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5968
c. Slip the heater hose over the cooling coil drain tube, located above the right side of the
transmission using the socket and extension to reach up between the frame and the exhaust.
Leave the hose socket and extension in place (Fig. 2). Proceed to Step # 7.
5. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap/clamp.
6. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 12, other vehicles proceed to next step.
7. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
8. Remove passenger side floor mat.
9. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
10. On LX/RS/**WH/WK/XH**XK vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the glove
box to gain access to the blower motor resistor /power module. Refer to the detailed service
information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, Instrument Panel, Glove
Box
11. On LX/**WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles, remove the passenger side instrument panel silencer. Refer
to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body,
Instrument Panel, Instrument Panel Silencer. On 2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles remove the
blower motor and use a shop vacuum to clean the evaporator coil, reinstall the blower motor and
skip to step 18. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
12. Remove the 2 screws securing the blower motor resistor/power module in the NC housing and
remove the blower motor resistor/power module. Do not disconnect the electrical connector.
13. On LX/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), proceed to Step # 18
14. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C
air filter, remove the A/C air filter. Refer to the detailed service information available in
TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. If not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C air filter,
install the air filter door (do not install the air filter at this time).
18. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5969
19. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
20. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
21. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor/power module opening.
22. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
23. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
24. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 27. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
25. Remove the cap/clamp from the drain tube.
26. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
27. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
28. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
29. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening.
30. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
31. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
32. Start the engine.
33. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
34. Set the blower to HIGH.
35. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
36. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
37. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
38. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
39. Allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
41. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 44. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
42. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap.
43. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK/** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
44. Open all windows in the vehicle.
45. Remove the blower motor resistor/power module.
46. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5970
47. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
48. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
49. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
50. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 53. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
51. Remove the drain tube cap/clamp.
52. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
53. Start the engine.
54. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
55. Set the blower to HIGH.
56. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
57. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
58. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
59. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
60. Allow the engine to run for 20 minutes.
61. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
62. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
63. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 67. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
64. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
65. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 72, CS vehicles proceed to Step # 68, LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK**
vehicles proceed to Step # 66.
66. Lower the vehicle.
67. On **LX/WH/WK/XH/XK** vehicles (RS vehicles proceed to next step), install the right silencer
pad.
68. Install the glove box.
69. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to the next step. If equipped with an
A/C filter, remove the air filter door and install the A/C air filter. Replace with a new filter, if
necessary. See the parts table for the appropriate part number filter.
70. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
71. Install the floor mat.
72. Close the hood.
AN/DN/DR/HB/JR/KJ/LH/ND/PL/PT/TJ/WG/WJ Vehicles Procedure
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5971
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
3. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle on a suitable hoist.
4. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), remove the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
5. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
6. On AN/DN/DR/HB/KJ vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), cap off the drain tube using
a suitable cap. When the drain tube is capped off, proceed to Step # 9.
7. On ND vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), plug the cooling coil drain using a piece of
plastic or a shop towel. When the drain tube is plugged, proceed to Step #9.
8. Clamp off the drain tube.
9. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
10. Remove passenger side floor mat.
11. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
12. If applicable, remove the silencer pad from under the instrument panel on the right side to gain
access to the blower motor.
13. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the lower right under panel duct
and blower motor cover.
14. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, and protective clothing.
NOTE:
No occupants should be in the vehicle during material application.
18. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
19. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
20. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner
onto the cooling coil until the required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number
of bottles).
21. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
22. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
23. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
24. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
25. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
26. One at a time, screw each bottle of normal tap water onto the applicator tool.
27. Spray all of the normal tap water onto the cooling coil until each bottle is empty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5972
28. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
29. Connect the negative battery cable.
30. Start the engine.
31. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
32. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
33. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
34. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
35. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
36. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
37. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
38. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
39. Install the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
40. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
41. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
42. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
43. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
44. Shake an 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
45. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle on
the cooling coil being carefully to cover the entire surface of the cooling coil.
46. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
47. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
48. Connect the negative battery cable.
49. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
50. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap.
51. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower the
vehicle.
52. Start the engine.
53. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
54. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
55. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
56. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5973
57. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
58. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
59. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
60. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
61. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
62. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
63. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), install the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
64. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
65. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), install the blower motor cover and lower
right under panel duct.
66. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
67. If applicable, install the silencer pad under the right side of the instrument panel.
68. Install floor mat.
69. Close the hood.
ST Vehicle Procedure
1. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
2. Remove passenger side floor mat.
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
4. Remove the joint duct. Refer to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT,
under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Blower Assembly and Resistor, Joint Duct.
5. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
6. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
7. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
8. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
9. Insert the applicator tool into the opening created by the joint duct removal.
10. Spray the full contents of 2 bottles of cooling coil cleaner onto the evaporator, moving the tool
so that the evaporator is completely covered, until both bottles are empty (16 oz. total).
11. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
12. Fill both of the empty cooling coil cleaner bottles with normal tap water.
13. Screw one bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
14. Insert the applicator tool into the opening of the heater/cooler unit at the evaporator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5974
15. Spray the full contents of water until the bottle is empty.
16. Repeat Step #13 through Step #15 using the second bottle of water. When both bottles of
water are empty, proceed to the next step.
17. Install the joint duct.
18. Disconnect the A/C clutch electrical connector at the A/C compressor.
19. Start the engine.
20. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
21. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
22. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
23. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
24. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
25. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
26. Turn the engine off.
27. Turn the ignition switch ON, do not start the engine, to allow blower motor operation.
28. Fully open all windows.
29. Remove the outer glove box and the inner glove box. Refer to the detailed service information
available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, 23C Body Interior, Instrument Panel
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
30. Shake the 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
31. Insert the applicator tool into the recirculation inlet (behind glove box opening). Spray the full
contents of the bottle in the airstream until the bottle is empty.
32. Start the engine.
33. Set the blower to HIGH.
34. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
35. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
36. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
37. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
38. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
39. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the off position.
41. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
42. Connect the A/C compressor clutch electrical connector at the compressor.
43. Open the right side panel outlet vent.
44. Install inner glove box.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5975
45. Install outer glove box.
46. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
47. Install floor mat.
VA Vehicle Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
2. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
3. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Remove the HVAC filter cover and HVAC filter. Refer to the detailed service information available
in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
6. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
7. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
8. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
9. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (pin 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
10. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
11. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
12. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
13. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
14. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
15. Remove the clamp from the drain tube.
16. Lower the vehicle.
17. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
18. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
19. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
20. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
21. Install the HVAC filter cover (do not install the HVAC filter at this time).
22. Start the engine.
23. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
24. Set the blower to HIGH.
25. Set the A/C switch to NC OFF.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5976
26. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
27. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
28. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
29. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
30. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
31. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
32. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
33. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
34. Open all windows in the vehicle.
35. Remove the HVAC filter cover.
36. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
37. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
38. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
39. Install the HVAC filter. Replace with a new filter, p/n 05103600AA, if necessary.
40. Install the HVAC filter cover.
41. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
42. Remove the drain tube clamp.
43. Lower the vehicle.
44. Start the engine.
45. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
46. Set the blower to HIGH.
47. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
48. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
49. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
50. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
51. With the engine running, allow the blower motor to operate for 20 minutes.
52. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
53. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
54. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5977
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
55. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
56. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
Technical Service Bulletin # 24-006-06 Date: 060810
A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid
NUMBER: 24-006-06
GROUP: Heating & A/C
DATE: Approval Pending
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 24-013-05, DATED AUGUST
4, 2005, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE AN ADDITIONAL MODEL, YEAR AND
REVISED AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK REPAIR PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: A/C Cooling Coil Odor
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves inspecting for leaves and other foreign material, cleaning, and
treating the cooling coil and housing.
MODELS:
1995-2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1995-2004 (AN) Dakota
2004 - **2007** (CS) Pacifica
1998 - 2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2007** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Pickup
2004 - **2007** (HB) Durango
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
2002 - **2007** (KJ) Liberty
1993 - 2004 (LH) 300M/Concorde/LHS/New Yorker/Intrepid/Vision
2005 - **2007** (LX) 300/**Charger**/Magnum
2005 - **2007** (ND) Dakota
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2001 - **2007** (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - **2007** (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - **2007** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2001 - 2005 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe
1997 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2002 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
1999 - 2004 (WJ/WG) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2007** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2007** (XK**/XH)** Commander
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5987
Some vehicle operators may experience a musty odor from the A/C system, primarily at start up in
hot and humid climates. This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the cooling coil. During
normal A/C system operation, condensation forms in and around the NC cooling coil. When
airborne pollutants mix with this condensation, bacteria and fungi growth begins and odor results.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the operator describes, or the technician experiences a musty odor when operating the A/C
system, perform the appropriate Repair Procedure based on the vehicle model.
PARTS REQUIRED:
A/C COOLING COIL CLEANER REQUIREMENTS BY VEHICLE MODEL
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5988
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
AB/CS/LX/RS/WK/XK Vehicle Procedure
1. Open the hood.
2. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH (2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles skip to step 8) (AB/CS**
vehicles proceed to next step), raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
3. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
4. On **2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), fabricate the cooling coil
drain plug as follows (Fig. 1):
a. Gather a 457.2 mm (18 in.) long, 9.8 mm (3/8 in.) drive socket extension; a deep 12 mm, 9.8 mm
(3/8 in.) drive socket, and a 152.4 mm (6 in.) piece of 15.9 mm (5/8 in.) ID heater hose, p/n
HHR00058AA
b. Place the socket on the end of the extension. Slide approximately 25.4 mm (1 in.) of the heater
hose over the socket.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5989
c. Slip the heater hose over the cooling coil drain tube, located above the right side of the
transmission using the socket and extension to reach up between the frame and the exhaust.
Leave the hose socket and extension in place (Fig. 2). Proceed to Step # 7.
5. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap/clamp.
6. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 12, other vehicles proceed to next step.
7. On LX/RS/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
8. Remove passenger side floor mat.
9. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
10. On LX/RS/**WH/WK/XH**XK vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the glove
box to gain access to the blower motor resistor /power module. Refer to the detailed service
information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, Instrument Panel, Glove
Box
11. On LX/**WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles, remove the passenger side instrument panel silencer. Refer
to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body,
Instrument Panel, Instrument Panel Silencer. On 2006 - 2007 WH/WK/XH/XK vehicles remove the
blower motor and use a shop vacuum to clean the evaporator coil, reinstall the blower motor and
skip to step 18. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
12. Remove the 2 screws securing the blower motor resistor/power module in the NC housing and
remove the blower motor resistor/power module. Do not disconnect the electrical connector.
13. On LX/**2005 WK/WH** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), proceed to Step # 18
14. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C
air filter, remove the A/C air filter. Refer to the detailed service information available in
TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. If not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to next step. If equipped with an A/C air filter,
install the air filter door (do not install the air filter at this time).
18. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5990
19. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
20. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
21. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor/power module opening.
22. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
23. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
24. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 27. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
25. Remove the cap/clamp from the drain tube.
26. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
27. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
28. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
29. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening.
30. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
31. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
32. Start the engine.
33. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
34. Set the blower to HIGH.
35. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
36. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
37. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
38. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
39. Allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
41. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 44. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
42. Cap/clamp off the drain tube using a suitable cap.
43. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK/** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
44. Open all windows in the vehicle.
45. Remove the blower motor resistor/power module.
46. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5991
47. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
48. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
49. Install the blower motor resistor/power module.
50. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 53. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
51. Remove the drain tube cap/clamp.
52. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK** vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), lower the vehicle.
53. Start the engine.
54. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
55. Set the blower to HIGH.
56. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
57. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
58. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
59. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
60. Allow the engine to run for 20 minutes.
61. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
62. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
63. On LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK vehicles, raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. On 2006 - 2007
WH/WK/XH/XK skip to step 67. Other vehicles proceed to next step.**
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
64. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
65. AB vehicles proceed to Step # 72, CS vehicles proceed to Step # 68, LX/RS/**2005 WH/WK**
vehicles proceed to Step # 66.
66. Lower the vehicle.
67. On **LX/WH/WK/XH/XK** vehicles (RS vehicles proceed to next step), install the right silencer
pad.
68. Install the glove box.
69. If the vehicle is not equipped with an A/C air filter, proceed to the next step. If equipped with an
A/C filter, remove the air filter door and install the A/C air filter. Replace with a new filter, if
necessary. See the parts table for the appropriate part number filter.
70. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
71. Install the floor mat.
72. Close the hood.
AN/DN/DR/HB/JR/KJ/LH/ND/PL/PT/TJ/WG/WJ Vehicles Procedure
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5992
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
3. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle on a suitable hoist.
4. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), remove the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
5. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
6. On AN/DN/DR/HB/KJ vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), cap off the drain tube using
a suitable cap. When the drain tube is capped off, proceed to Step # 9.
7. On ND vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), plug the cooling coil drain using a piece of
plastic or a shop towel. When the drain tube is plugged, proceed to Step #9.
8. Clamp off the drain tube.
9. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
10. Remove passenger side floor mat.
11. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
12. If applicable, remove the silencer pad from under the instrument panel on the right side to gain
access to the blower motor.
13. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), remove the lower right under panel duct
and blower motor cover.
14. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
15. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
16. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
17. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, and protective clothing.
NOTE:
No occupants should be in the vehicle during material application.
18. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
19. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
20. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner
onto the cooling coil until the required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number
of bottles).
21. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
22. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise the
vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
23. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
24. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
25. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
26. One at a time, screw each bottle of normal tap water onto the applicator tool.
27. Spray all of the normal tap water onto the cooling coil until each bottle is empty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5993
28. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
29. Connect the negative battery cable.
30. Start the engine.
31. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
32. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
33. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
34. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
35. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
36. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
37. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
38. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
39. Install the drain tube clamp/cap/plug.
40. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
41. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
42. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
43. Disconnect the blower motor wire harness connector and remove the blower motor.
44. Shake an 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
45. Insert the applicator tool into the blower motor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle on
the cooling coil being carefully to cover the entire surface of the cooling coil.
46. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
47. Install the blower motor and connect the blower motor wire harness connector.
48. Connect the negative battery cable.
49. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
50. Remove the drain tube clamp/cap.
51. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower the
vehicle.
52. Start the engine.
53. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
54. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
55. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
56. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5994
57. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
58. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
59. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
60. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
61. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), raise
the vehicle.
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
62. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
63. On AN/DN/ND - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), install the exhaust heat
shield covering the cooling coil housing drain.
64. On AN/DN/HB/JR/LH/ND/PT/WG/WJ - vehicles (other vehicles proceed to the next step), lower
the vehicle.
65. On LH vehicles (other vehicles proceed to next step), install the blower motor cover and lower
right under panel duct.
66. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
67. If applicable, install the silencer pad under the right side of the instrument panel.
68. Install floor mat.
69. Close the hood.
ST Vehicle Procedure
1. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
2. Remove passenger side floor mat.
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet and the passenger front seat.
4. Remove the joint duct. Refer to the detailed service information available in TechCONNECT,
under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Blower Assembly and Resistor, Joint Duct.
5. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
6. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
NOTE:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
7. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (p/n 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
8. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
9. Insert the applicator tool into the opening created by the joint duct removal.
10. Spray the full contents of 2 bottles of cooling coil cleaner onto the evaporator, moving the tool
so that the evaporator is completely covered, until both bottles are empty (16 oz. total).
11. Allow the vehicle to sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
12. Fill both of the empty cooling coil cleaner bottles with normal tap water.
13. Screw one bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
14. Insert the applicator tool into the opening of the heater/cooler unit at the evaporator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5995
15. Spray the full contents of water until the bottle is empty.
16. Repeat Step #13 through Step #15 using the second bottle of water. When both bottles of
water are empty, proceed to the next step.
17. Install the joint duct.
18. Disconnect the A/C clutch electrical connector at the A/C compressor.
19. Start the engine.
20. Set the blower to HIGH - A/C OFF.
21. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
22. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
23. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
24. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
25. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
26. Turn the engine off.
27. Turn the ignition switch ON, do not start the engine, to allow blower motor operation.
28. Fully open all windows.
29. Remove the outer glove box and the inner glove box. Refer to the detailed service information
available in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 23 - Body, 23C Body Interior, Instrument Panel
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
30. Shake the 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
31. Insert the applicator tool into the recirculation inlet (behind glove box opening). Spray the full
contents of the bottle in the airstream until the bottle is empty.
32. Start the engine.
33. Set the blower to HIGH.
34. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
35. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
36. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
37. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
38. Open windows slightly (about 1/2 inch opening).
39. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
40. Turn the ignition switch to the off position.
41. Fill the 4 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
42. Connect the A/C compressor clutch electrical connector at the compressor.
43. Open the right side panel outlet vent.
44. Install inner glove box.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5996
45. Install outer glove box.
46. Remove the carpet and seat protector.
47. Install floor mat.
VA Vehicle Procedure
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
2. Inspect the cooling coil housing drain for leaves or other foreign material that may be blocking
the drain.
3. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
4. Lower the vehicle.
5. Remove the HVAC filter cover and HVAC filter. Refer to the detailed service information available
in TechCONNECT, under: Service Info, 24 - Heating & Air Conditioning, Distribution, Air Filter.
6. Inspect and remove any leaves and debris.
7. If necessary, use a shop vacuum to clean the cooling coil.
8. Open all the windows in the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
9. Screw the bottle of cooling coil cleaner (pin 05170022AA) onto the applicator tool.
10. Connect the assembled applicator tool to the shop compressed air supply line.
11. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
12. Spray all of the cooling coil cleaner onto the cooling coil continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered until the
required number of bottles are empty (See table for required number of bottles).
13. Allow the vehicle sit for a minimum of 30 minutes.
14. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
15. Remove the clamp from the drain tube.
16. Lower the vehicle.
17. Fill each empty cleaner bottle with normal tap water.
18. One at a time, screw each bottle of water onto the applicator tool.
19. Insert the applicator tool into the HVAC filter opening.
20. Spray the full contents of the water onto the evaporator continuously while moving the
applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the evaporator is evenly covered with water.
21. Install the HVAC filter cover (do not install the HVAC filter at this time).
22. Start the engine.
23. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
24. Set the blower to HIGH.
25. Set the A/C switch to NC OFF.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5997
26. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
27. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
28. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
29. With the engine running, allow the blower to operate for 20 minutes.
30. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
31. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
32. Clamp off the drain tube using a suitable clamp.
33. Lower the vehicle.
CAUTION:
Technician must use eye protection, rubber gloves, protective clothing, and avoid breathing vapors.
34. Open all windows in the vehicle.
35. Remove the HVAC filter cover.
36. Shake a 8 ounce bottle of Cooling Coil Coating (p/n 04728942AB), and screw the bottle onto
the applicator tool.
37. Insert the applicator tool into the blower resistor opening. Spray the full contents of the bottle
onto the evaporator while moving the applicator tool up and down and back and forth so that the
evaporator is evenly coated.
38. Allow the vehicle to sit for 30 minutes.
39. Install the HVAC filter. Replace with a new filter, p/n 05103600AA, if necessary.
40. Install the HVAC filter cover.
41. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
CAUTION:
The excess cooling coil coating will drain when the cap/clamp/plug is removed in the next step.
42. Remove the drain tube clamp.
43. Lower the vehicle.
44. Start the engine.
45. Raise all the windows to a slightly open position (about 1/2 inch opening).
46. Set the blower to HIGH.
47. Set the A/C switch to A/C OFF.
48. Set mode switch to PANEL OUTLETS.
49. Set temperature switch to FULL HEAT.
50. Set recirculation switch to RECIRCULATE.
51. With the engine running, allow the blower motor to operate for 20 minutes.
52. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
53. Fill an 8 ounce plastic bottle with warm water and screw onto applicator tool. Clean tool by
spraying warm water under pressure into the shop sink. Wipe the tool and store for next use.
54. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 09-007-04 > Mar > 04 > Customer Interest for Evaporator
Core: > 24-006-06 > Aug > 06 > A/C - Musty Odors When Hot/Humid > Page 5998
CAUTION:
In the following step be careful not to damage the A/C cooling coil.
55. Using a suitable object (a wire coat hanger for example), probe the drain tube 3.8 - 5.1 cm (1.5
- 2 in.) to ensure that the dried coil coating is not restricting the flow from the drain tube.
56. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > Page 5999
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Tray
REMOVAL
1. Remove the battery from the vehicle.
Fig.13 Battery Tray Removal
2. Remove two nuts to the rear and two bolts to the front of the battery tray (Fig. 13). 3. Remove
the tray retaining bolt under the center of the tray. 4. Slide battery tray out form under the air
cleaner assembly Do not remove the air cleaner assembly 5. Remove battery tray from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide battery tray in under the air cleaner assembly 2. Install two nuts at the rear and two bolts at
the front of the battery tray. 3. Install the bolt located under the tray. 4. Install the battery in the
vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Battery Holddown
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Holddown
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Remove the single battery hold down
retaining bolt. 3. Remove the battery hold down from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the battery hold down in the vehicle. 2. Install the single battery hold down retaining bolt 3.
Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Battery Holddown > Page 6003
Battery Tray: Service and Repair Battery Tray
REMOVAL
1. Remove the battery from the vehicle.
Fig.13 Battery Tray Removal
2. Remove two nuts to the rear and two bolts to the front of the battery tray (Fig. 13). 3. Remove
the tray retaining bolt under the center of the tray. 4. Slide battery tray out form under the air
cleaner assembly Do not remove the air cleaner assembly 5. Remove battery tray from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide battery tray in under the air cleaner assembly 2. Install two nuts at the rear and two bolts at
the front of the battery tray. 3. Install the bolt located under the tray. 4. Install the battery in the
vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Differential Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Type ................................................................................................................................. Mopar ATF
+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES
NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard shifting effort, bearing,
gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used. The addition of any fluids to
the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended. An exception to this policy is
the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be
avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
NOTE: The 41TE Automatic and T350 Manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 6007
Differential Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Type ................................................................................................................................. Mopar ATF
+4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602)
LUBRICANT/ADDITIVES
NV T350 (A-578) transaxles use Mopar ATF +4 (Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type 9602).
Hypoid gear lube or engine oil should not be used in this transaxle. Hard shifting effort, bearing,
gear, and/or synchronizer failure may occur if incorrect fluid is used. The addition of any fluids to
the transaxle, other than the fluid listed above, is not recommended. An exception to this policy is
the use of special dyes to aid in detecting fluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should be
avoided, since they may adversely affect seals.
NOTE: The 41TE Automatic and T350 Manual transaxles have a common transmission and
differential sump. Filling the transaxle accommodates the
differential as well.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Component
Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Fig. 13 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - LHD
Fig. 44 Engine (Left Rear) (2.0L) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6010
Engine Oil Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Evaporator Drain Tube: Description and Operation
CONDENSATION DRAIN TUBE
Condensation that accumulates in the evaporator housing is drained by a tube through the dash
and on to the ground. This tube must be kept open to prevent condensate water from collecting in
the bottom of the housing.
The tapered end of the drain tube is designed to keep contaminants from entering the heater A/C
unit housing. If the tube is pinched or blocked, condensate cannot drain, causing water to back up
and spill into the passenger compartment. It is normal to see condensate drainage below the
vehicle. If the tube is damaged, it should be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Condensation Drain Tube - LHD
Evaporator Drain Tube: Service and Repair Condensation Drain Tube - LHD
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a suitable lift.
Fig.65 Condensate Water Drain Tube - Typical
2. Locate rubber drain tube on right side of dash panel under the hood. 3. Squeeze clamp and
remove drain tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Squeeze the retaining tube over the nipple. 2. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Drain Tube > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Condensation Drain Tube - LHD > Page 6016
Evaporator Drain Tube: Service and Repair Condensation Drain Tube - RHD
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on a suitable lift
Fig.65 Condensate Water Drain Tube - Typical
2. Locate rubber drain tube on left side of dash panel under the hood. 3. Squeeze clamp and
remove drain tube
INSTALLATION
1. Squeeze the retaining clamp and install the tube over the nipple 2. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig.22 Evaporator Probe Location - Typical
The evaporator probe is located in the A/C housing and placed in the evaporator fins.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6020
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the A/C housing from the vehicle.
The evaporator probe is located in the A/C housing and placed in the evaporator fins. The probe
prevents evaporator freeze-up. This is done by cycling the compressor clutch OFF when
evaporator temperature drops below the freeze point. It cycles ON when the evaporator
temperature rises above the freeze point. The evaporator probe uses a thermistor probe in a
capillary tube. The tube is inserted between the evaporator fins in the heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6021
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
The work area and vehicle must be between 16 °C (60 °F) and 32 °C (90 °F) when testing the
switch.
Fig.21 Evaporator Probe Harness Connector
1. Disconnect the three wire connector from the evaporator probe lead located behind the glove
box. 2. Start engine and set A/C to low blower motor speed, panel, full cool, and RECIRC. 3. Using
a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and 2. If no voltage is detected, there is no
power to the switch. Check wiring and
fuses.
4. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and Pin 3. If no voltage is detected,
there is no voltage from the Powertrain Control
Module. If voltage is OK, connect a jumper wire between Pin 1 and Pin 3. The compressor clutch
should engage. If the clutch engages, remove the jumper wire immediately and go to Step 5. If the
compressor clutch does not engage, check the operation of the clutch and repair as necessary.
5. If compressor clutch engages, connect the evaporator probe 3-way connector. The compressor
clutch should engage or cycle depending on
evaporator temperature. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, replace the clutch cycling switch.
6. The engine running and the A/C set to:
- Blower motor on Low speed
- Panel position
- Full cool
- RECIRC.
7. Close all doors and windows. Place a thermometer in the center discharge vent. 8. If the clutch
does not begin to cycle off between 2 - 7 °C (35 - 45 °F), verify that the evaporator probe is fully
installed and not loose in
evaporator. If it is not properly installed, install probe and retest outlet temperature. If the
evaporator probe is properly installed, replace the clutch cycling switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6022
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be removed without removing the A/C Housing from the vehicle.
1. Disconnect probe wiring connector from behind the glove box.
Fig.22 Evaporator Probe Location - Typical
2. Remove rubber grommet from evaporator/ blower module. 3. Note which of the three pilot holes
the evaporator probe is located in. 4. Pull probe out of evaporator fins.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be installed without removing the A/C Housing from the vehicle.
1. There are three pilot holes available for the probe. The top hole is for service. If top hole was not
used by previous probe, install probe in top hole. 2. If previous probe was removed from top hole,
use a small plastic stick of approximately 1/8 inch diameter, and make a new hole. Make the hole
1/4 inch above, or below the original hole in the evaporator core.
3. Insert the new probe into hole between evaporator fins. 4. Reinstall rubber grommet into
evaporator probe access hole.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Locations
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Locations
A Variable Orifice Valve (VOV) is installed in the liquid line between the outlet of the condenser and
the inlet of the evaporator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6026
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Description and Operation
A/C VARIABLE ORIFICE TUBE
A Variable Orifice Valve (VOV) is installed in the liquid line between the outlet of the condenser and
the inlet of the evaporator. The inlet end of the Variable Orifice Valve has a nylon mesh filter
screen, which filters the refrigerant and helps to reduce the potential for blockage of the metering
orifices by refrigerant system contaminants. The outlet end of the tube has a nylon mesh diffuser
screen. The O-rings on the plastic body of the VOV seal the tube to the inside of the liquid line and
prevent refrigerant from bypassing the metering orifices.
The VOV is only serviced as an integral part of the liquid line. The VOV cannot be adjusted or
repaired and, if faulty or plugged, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
The VOV meters the flow of liquid refrigerant into the evaporator coil. The VOV contains two
orifices which work in parallel. The fixed orifice works along with the variable port to regulate
refrigerant expansion in the evaporator in a manner that is suitable for most operating conditions.
The high-pressure liquid refrigerant from the condenser expands into a low-pressure liquid/vapor
as it passes through the metering orifices and diffuser screen of the VOV
The VOV varies the flow of refrigerant in response to the temperature of the refrigerant exiting the
condenser. A thermostatic bimetal coil wrapped around the valve body is affected by the refrigerant
temperature changes, which opens or closes the variable port to regulate refrigerant flow. As the
refrigerant temperature increases, the variable port is progressively closed. A higher temperature
(while idling) produces more restriction. A lower temperature (at road speed) produces less
restriction.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6027
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Service and Repair
REMOVAL - INSTALLATION
The Variable Orifice Valve (VOV) is located in the liquid line near the condenser. If the VOV is
faulty or plugged, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Specifications
Expansion Valve: Specifications
Expansion Valve bolt ...........................................................................................................................
...................................11 Nm (8.1 ft. lbs) (97 in. lbs)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6031
Expansion Valve: Service Precautions
WARNING: PROTECT SKIN AND EYES FROM CONTACTING CO2. PERSONAL INJURY CAN
RESULT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6032
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation
A/C VARIABLE ORIFICE TUBE
A Variable Orifice Valve (VOV) is installed in the liquid line between the outlet of the condenser and
the inlet of the evaporator. The inlet end of the Variable Orifice Valve has a nylon mesh filter
screen, which filters the refrigerant and helps to reduce the potential for blockage of the metering
orifices by refrigerant system contaminants. The outlet end of the tube has a nylon mesh diffuser
screen. The O-rings on the plastic body of the VOV seal the tube to the inside of the liquid line and
prevent refrigerant from bypassing the metering orifices.
The VOV is only serviced as an integral part of the liquid line. The VOV cannot be adjusted or
repaired and, if faulty or plugged, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6033
Expansion Valve: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- Expansion valve tests should be performed after compressor tests.
- Liquid CO2 is required to test the expansion valve. It is available from most welding supply
facilities. CO2 is also available from companies which service and sell fire extinguishers.
Review Safety Precautions and Warnings in the General Information. The work area and vehicle
must be 21 to 27 °C (70 °C to 85 °F) when testing expansion valve. To test the expansion valve: 1.
Connect a charging station or manifold gauge set to the refrigerant system service ports. 2.
Disconnect wire connector at low pressure cutoff switch. Using a jumper wire, jump terminals inside
wire connector boot. 3. Close all doors, windows and vents to the passenger compartment. 4. Set
Heater-A/C control to A/C, full heat, floor, RECIRC. and high blower. 5. Start the engine and hold
the idle speed (1000 rpm). After the engine has reached running temperature, allow the passenger
compartment to heat
up. This will create the need for maximum refrigerant flow into the evaporator.
6. If the refrigerant charge is sufficient, discharge (high pressure) gauge should read 965 to 2620
kPa (140 to 380 psi). Suction (low pressure) gauge
should read 103 to 2417 kPa (15 to 35 psi). If system cannot achieve proper pressure readings,
replace the expansion valve. If pressure is correct, proceed with test.
WARNING: PROTECT SKIN AND EYES FROM CONTACTING CO2. PERSONAL INJURY CAN
RESULT.
7. If suction side low pressure is within specified range, freeze the expansion valve control head for
30 seconds. Use a super cold substance (liquid
CO). Do not spray refrigerant on the expansion valve for this test. Suction side low pressure should
drop to 34.5 kPa (5 psi) If not, replace expansion valve.
8. Allow expansion valve to thaw. The low pressure gauge reading should stabilize at 103 - 241
kPa (15 - 35 psi). If not, replace expansion valve. 9. When expansion valve test is complete, test
A/C overall performance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6034
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair
REMOVAL & INSTALLATION
The Variable Orifice Valve (VOV) is located in the liquid line near the condenser. If the VOV is
faulty or plugged, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Locations
Heater Core: Locations
Fig.14 Heater Core
The heater core is located in the heater-A/C unit housing, under the instrument panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Locations > Page
6038
Heater Core: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO PASSIVE RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT
PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE PROPER
PRE-CAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
- DO NOT OPEN THE RADIATOR DRAIN-COCK OR DISCONNECT COOLANT HOSES WHEN
THE SYSTEM IS HOT AND UNDER PRESSURE. SERIOUS BURNS FROM COOLANT CAN
OCCUR.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Locations > Page
6039
Heater Core: Description and Operation
Fig.51 Heater Core
HEATER CORE
The heater core is located in the heater-A/C unit housing, under the instrument panel. It is a heat
exchanger made of rows of tubes and fins. One end of the core is fitted with a molded plastic tank
that includes the integral heater core hose nipples.
Engine coolant is circulated through heater hoses to the heater core at all times. As the coolant
flows through the heater core, heat removed from the engine is transferred to the heater core fins
and tubes. Air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the heater core fins. The
blend air door allows control of the heater output air temperature by controlling how much of the air
flowing through the heater-A/C housing is directed through the heater core. The blower motor
speed controls the volume of air flowing through the heater-A/C housing.
The heater core cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced. Refer to Cooling
System for more information on the engine cooling system, the engine coolant and the heater
hoses.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Locations > Page
6040
Heater Core: Service and Repair
HEATER CORE
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS. FAILURE TO TAKE THE PROPER
PRE-CAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIR-BAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: DO NOT OPEN THE RADIATOR DRAIN-COCK OR DISCONNECT COOLANT
HOSES WHEN THE SYSTEM IS HOT AND UNDER PRESSURE. SERIOUS BURNS FROM
COOLANT CAN OCCUR.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable. 2. Drain the cooling system. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling,
and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service and Repair" See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair
3. Evacuate the refrigerant system. Refer to: "Heating and Air Conditioning : Service and Repair"
See: Service and Repair 4. Remove the instrument panel. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Trim,
Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument
Panel Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Assembly Replacement, See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Assembly
5. Remove the refrigerant lines from the evaporator connections. 6. Remove the heater core
coolant supply hoses from the heater core.
INSTALLATION
Refer to HVAC Housing Assembly for heater core installation procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service Precautions
Heater Hose: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess pressure.
The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
- When installing hoses to heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive pressure.
The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Inlet Hose Replacement
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement - LHD
HEATER INLET HOSE - LHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.54 Heater Hose Assembly - LHD 2.0L (Typical 2.4L)
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove clamps at end of heater hose to be
removed. 3. Carefully rotate hose back and forth while pulling away from connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Using spring tension clamp pliers, install the hose ends into position. 2. Refill the cooling system.
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement - RHD
HEATER INLET HOSE - RHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excess
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 6046
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.46 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove clamps at end of heater hose to be
removed 3. Carefully rotate hose back and forth while pulling away from connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Using spring tension clamp pliers, install the hose ends into position. 2. Refill the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 6047
Heater Hose: Service and Repair Heater Return Hose Replacement
Heater Return Hose Replacement - LHD
HEATER RETURN HOSE - LHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from the heater core inlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.54 Heater Hose Assembly - LHD 2.0L (Typical 2.4L)
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove the clamps at the end of the heater
hoses to be removed. 3. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pulling away from the
connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When installing hoses to heater core inlet or outlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and leak engine coolant.
1. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pushing the hose onto the connector nipple. 2.
Using spring tension pliers, install the clamps at the end of the heater hose being installed. 3. Refill
the cooling system.
Heater Return Hose Replacement - RHD
HEATER RETURN HOSE - RHD
CAUTION: When removing hoses from the heater core inlet nipples DO NOT exert excessive
pressure. The heater core may become damaged and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Inlet Hose Replacement > Page 6048
leak engine coolant.
NOTE: Review Cooling System Precautions before proceeding with this operation.
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine cooling system.
Fig.46 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Using spring tension clamp pliers (or equivalent), to remove the clamps at the end of the heater
hoses to be removed. 3. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pulling away from the
connector nipple.
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully rotate the hose back and forth while pushing the hose onto the connector nipple. 2.
Using spring tension pliers, install the clamps at the end of the heater hose being installed. 3. Refill
the cooling system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: AVOID BREATHING A/C REFRIGERANT AND LUBRICANT VAPOR OR MIST.
EXPOSURE MAY IRRITATE EYES, NOSE AND THROAT. USE ONLY APPROVED SERVICE
EQUIPMENT MEETING SAE REQUIREMENTS TO DISCHARGE R-134a SYSTEM. IF
ACCIDENTAL SYSTEM DISCHARGE OCCURS, VENTILATE WORK AREA BEFORE
RESUMING SERVICE. R-134a SERVICE EQUIPMENT OR VEHICLE A/C SYSTEM SHOULD
NOT BE PRESSURE TESTED OR LEAK TESTED WITH COMPRESSED AIR. MIXTURE OF AIR
and R-134a CAN BE COMBUSTIBLE AT ELEVATED PRESSURES. THESE MIXTURES ARE
POTENTIALLY DANGEROUS AND MAY RESULT IN FIRE OR EXPLOSION CAUSING INJURY
OR PROPERTY DAMAGE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6053
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Vehicle Damage Warnings
WARNING: AVOID BREATHING A/C REFRIGERANT AND LUBRICANT VAPOR OR MIST.
EXPOSURE MAY IRRITATE EYES, NOSE AND THROAT. USE ONLY APPROVED SERVICE
EQUIPMENT MEETING SAE REQUIREMENTS TO DISCHARGE R-134a SYSTEM. IF
ACCIDENTAL SYSTEM DISCHARGE OCCURS, VENTILATE WORK AREA BEFORE
RESUMING SERVICE. R-134a SERVICE EQUIPMENT OR VEHICLE A/C SYSTEM SHOULD
NOT BE PRESSURE TESTED OR LEAK TESTED WITH COMPRESSED AIR. MIXTURE OF AIR
and R-134a CAN BE COMBUSTIBLE AT ELEVATED PRESSURES. THESE MIXTURES ARE
POTENTIALLY DANGEROUS AND MAY RESULT IN FIRE OR EXPLOSION CAUSING INJURY
OR PROPERTY DAMAGE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Page 6054
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair
HIGH PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
WARNING: AVOID BREATHING A/C REFRIGERANT AND LUBRICANT VAPOR OR MIST. EXPOSURE MAY
IRRITATE EYES, NOSE AND THROAT. USE ONLY APPROVED SERVICE EQUIPMENT
MEETING SAE REQUIREMENTS TO DISCHARGE R-134a SYSTEM. IF ACCIDENTAL SYSTEM
DISCHARGE OCCURS, VENTILATE WORK AREA BEFORE RESUMING SERVICE.
- R-134a SERVICE EQUIPMENT OR VEHICLE A/C SYSTEM SHOULD NOT BE PRESSURE
TESTED OR LEAK TESTED WITH COMPRESSED AIR. MIXTURE OF AIR and R-134a CAN BE
COMBUSTIBLE AT ELEVATED PRESSURES. THESE MIXTURES ARE POTENTIALLY
DANGEROUS AND MAY RESULT IN FIRE OR EXPLOSION CAUSING INJURY OR PROPERTY
DAMAGE.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system. 2. Rotate
the high pressure relief valve counterclockwise and separate relief valve from the compressor
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O-ring. Lubricate the O-ring with refrigerant oil.
NOTE: Use only refrigerant oil specified for use in this A/C system.
2. Position and rotate the compressor high pressure relief valve clockwise to install. 3. Evacuate
the refrigerant system . 4. Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Hose/Line HVAC: Specifications
A/C Line Retainer Bolt
..................................................................................................................................................... 23
Nm (16.9 ft. lbs) (203 in. lbs.)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Hose/Line HVAC: Technician Safety Information
WARNING:
- THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY EMPTY BEFORE PROCEEDING
WITH THE OPERATION.
- REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT BEFORE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING OPERATION.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6060
Hose/Line HVAC: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- The use of correct wrenches when making connections is very important. Improper wrenches or
improper use of wrenches can damage the fittings.
- The internal parts of the A/C system will remain stable as long as moisture-free refrigerant and
refrigerant oil is used. Abnormal amounts of dirt, moisture or air can upset the chemical stability.
This may cause operational troubles or even serious damage if present in more than very small
quantities.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Discharge Hose/Line
A/C Discharge Line - LHD
Fig.43 A/C Compressor Lines
The discharge line is the line that goes from the compressor to the condenser. It has no
serviceable parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must
be replaced as an assembly.
A/C Discharge Line - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 6063
Fig.44 A/C Compressor Lines
The discharge line is the line that goes from the compressor to the condenser. It has no
serviceable parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must
be replaced as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 6064
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Liquid Hose/Line
Liquid Line - LHD
The liquid line is the line that goes from the condenser to the receiver-drier. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced
as an assembly.
Liquid Line - RHD
The liquid line is the line that goes from the condenser to the receiver-drier. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber O-rings. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced
as an assembly.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 6065
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Suction Hose/Line
Suction Line - LHD
The suction line is the large line that connects to the expansion valve and goes to the compressor.
It also has a small line that goes to the filter/drier. The suction line uses a gasket on the expansion
valve side and rubber O-rings on all other connections.
There are no serviceable parts on the suction line other than the rubber O-rings and expansion
valve gasket. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an assembly.
The refrigerant lines used for this vehicle are common between the two optional engines in order to
reduce complexity. The following refrigerant lines are available for service replacement on this
vehicle:
Fig.60 A/C Compressor Lines - LHD
- Discharge line - The discharge line is a flexible hose type line that is connected from the
discharge port of the compressor to the inlet (upper fitting) of the condenser. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber O-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the discharge
line is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
- Liquid line - The liquid line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the outlet (lower
fitting) of the condenser and the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly.
The liquid line also contains the variable orifice valve. It has no serviceable parts except the rubber
O-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the liquid line or the variable orifice valve
are damaged or faulty, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
- Suction line - The suction line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly and the suction port of the compressor. It
has no serviceable parts except the rubber O-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line.
If the suction line is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 6066
Fig.61 A/C Service Ports - (Typical)
- Suction and liquid line assembly - The suction and liquid line assembly is a formed tubing type
line assembly that includes the mid-line connector block, a connector block for the evaporator, inlet
and outlet line fittings for the accumulator and both A/C service ports. The A/C service port caps,
the A/C service port valve cores, the gasket used to seal the connector block at the evaporator and
the rubber O-ring seals for the line fittings at the accumulator are all available for service
replacement. If any other part of the suction and liquid line assembly is damaged or faulty, the
assembly must be replaced.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant line
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
Suction Line - RHD
The suction line is the large line that connects to the expansion valve and goes to the compressor.
It also has a small line that goes to the filter/drier. The suction line uses a gasket on the expansion
valve side and rubber O-rings on all other connections.
There are no serviceable parts on the suction line other than the rubber O-rings and expansion
valve gasket. If the line is found to be leaking or is damaged it must be replaced as an assembly.
The refrigerant lines used for this vehicle are common between the two optional engines in order to
reduce complexity. The following refrigerant lines are available for service replacement on this
vehicle:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 6067
Fig.52 A/C Refrigerant Lines - Compressor
- Discharge line - The discharge line is a flexible hose type line that is connected from the
discharge port of the compressor to the inlet (upper fitting) of the condenser. It has no serviceable
parts except the rubber 0-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the discharge line
is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
- Liquid line - The liquid line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the outlet (lower
fitting) of the condenser and the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly.
The liquid line also contains the variable orifice valve. It has no serviceable parts except the rubber
0-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line. If the liquid line or the variable orifice valve
are damaged or faulty, the liquid line unit must be replaced.
- Suction line - The suction line is a flexible hose type line that is connected between the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly and the suction port of the compressor. It
has no serviceable parts except the rubber 0-ring seals used on the fittings at each end of the line.
If the suction line is damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Hose/Line > Page 6068
Fig.53 A/C Service Ports - LHD Shown (Typical RHD)
- Suction and liquid line assembly - The suction and liquid line assembly is a formed tubing type
line assembly that includes the mid-line connector block, a connector block for the evaporator, inlet
and outlet line fittings for the accumulator and both A/C service ports. The A/C service port caps,
the A/C service port valve cores, the gasket used to seal the connector block at the evaporator and
the rubber 0-ring seals for the line fittings at the accumulator are all available for service
replacement. If any other part of the suction and liquid line assembly is damaged or faulty, the
assembly must be replaced.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant line
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement
A/C Discharge Line Replacement - LHD
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY
PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system
Fig.44 Discharge Line
2. From the top side of the vehicle, remove line at compressor. 3. From the bottom side of the
vehicle, remove line at condenser.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY
PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Position the A/C discharge line in the vehicle and install the condenser end. Tighten the
connections to 12 Nm (108 in. lbs.) 2. Lower the vehicle and install the compressor end of the
discharge line. Tighten the connections to 12 Nm ( 108 in. lbs.) 3. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
4. Recharge the A/C system.
A/C Discharge Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY
PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6071
Fig.45 High Pressure Cut Out Switch Location
2. From the top side of the vehicle, remove line at compressor. 3. From the bottom side of the
vehicle, remove line at condenser.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the A/C discharge line in the vehicle and install the condenser end. Tighten the
connections to 12 Nm (108 in. lbs.) 2. Lower the vehicle and install the compressor end of the
discharge line. Tighten the connections to 12 Nm ( 108 in. lbs.) 3. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
4. Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6072
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Hose/Line Replacement
Liquid Line Replacement - LHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY EMPTY BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system 2.
Disconnect liquid line at drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line at condenser. 4. Remove the liquid line.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replacement of ale line seals is required anytime connections are opened. Failure to
replace seals could result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Connect the liquid line at the drier. 2. Connect the liquid line at the condenser. 3. Evacuate the
A/C system. 4. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Liquid Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY EMPTY BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system. 2.
Disconnect liquid line at drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line at condenser. 4. Remove the liquid line.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replacement of a/c line seals is required anytime connections are opened. Failure to
replace seals could result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Connect the liquid line at the drier. 2. Connect the liquid line at the condenser. 3. Evacuate the
A/C system. 4. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6073
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Suction and Liquid Hose/Line Replacement
Suction and Liquid Line Replacement - LHD
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT OF THIS GROUP
BEFORE PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. If the vehicle is so equipped, relocate the vehicle speed control servo as
necessary to access the accumulator. Refer to Vehicle Speed Control
System for the proper procedures.
Fig.64 A/C Accumulator And Low Pressure Switch
4. Remove the nut that secures the liquid line fitting (outboard fitting) to the mid-line connector
block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 5. Disconnect the liquid line fitting from the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 6. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line and discard. 7. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened
mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. 8. Remove
the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid
line assembly. 9. Disconnect the suction line fitting from the mid-line connector block of the suction
and liquid line assembly.
10. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the refrigerant line fitting of the suction line and discard.
11. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened mid-line connector block suction line port and the
refrigerant line fitting of the suction line. 12. Remove the two screws that secure the two refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector block inlet
and outlet ports.
13. Disconnect the two refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly from the
accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports. 14. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly and discard. 15. Install plugs in, or
tape over the opened accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the refrigerant line
fittings of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
16. Remove the two screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block to the evaporator. 17. Disconnect the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block from the evaporator. 18. Remove the gasket from the suction and liquid line assembly
evaporator connector block and discard. 19. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened suction and
liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the evaporator inlet and outlet
ports.
20. Remove the suction and liquid line assembly from the engine compartment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6074
INSTALLATION
1. Position the suction and liquid line assembly into the engine compartment. 2. Remove the tape
or plugs from the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the
evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 3. Align the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block and a new gasket to the evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 4. Install and tighten the two
screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block to the
evaporator. Tighten the upper
screw to 11.3 Nm (100 in. lbs.) first, then tighten the lower screw.
5. Remove the tape or plugs from the accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line
assembly.
6. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them on the refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly.
Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
7. Reconnect the refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator
connector block inlet and outlet ports. 8. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the two
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector
block inlet and outlet ports. Tighten the screws to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
9. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block suction line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the suction line.
10. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the refrigerant line
fitting of the suction line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
11. Reconnect the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block suction line port of the suction
and liquid line assembly. 12. Install and tighten the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the
mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the
nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
13. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the liquid line. 14. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and
install it on the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
15. Reconnect the liquid line fitting to the mid-line connector block liquid line port of the suction and
liquid line assembly. 16. Install and tighten the nut that secures the liquid line fitting to the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the nut
to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
17. If the vehicle is so equipped, reinstall the vehicle speed control servo. Refer to Vehicle Speed
Control System for the proper procedures. 18. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 19. Evacuate
the refrigerant system. Refer to Refrigerant System Evacuate in this group for the proper
procedures. 20. Charge the refrigerant system. Refer to Refrigerant System Charge in this group
for the proper procedures.
Suction and Liquid Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT OF THIS GROUP
BEFORE PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL
1. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. 3. If the vehicle is so equipped, relocate the vehicle speed control servo as
necessary to access the accumulator. Refer to Vehicle Speed Control
System for the proper procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6075
Fig.56 A/C Refrigerant Lines - Accumulator/Evaporator - LHD (Typical - RHD)
4. Remove the nut that secures the liquid line fitting (outboard fitting) to the mid-line connector
block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 5. Disconnect the liquid line fitting from the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. 6. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line and discard. 7. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened
mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. 8. Remove
the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid
line assembly. 9. Disconnect the suction line fitting from the mid-line connector block of the suction
and liquid line assembly.
10. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the refrigerant line fitting of the suction line and discard.
11. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened mid-line connector block suction line port and the
refrigerant line fitting of the suction line. 12. Remove the two screws that secure the two refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the accumulator connector block inlet
and outlet ports.
13. Disconnect the two refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly from the
accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports. 14. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly and discard. 15. Install plugs in, or
tape over the opened accumulator connector block inlet and outlet ports and the refrigerant line
fittings of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
16. Remove the two screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block to the evaporator. 17. Disconnect the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block from the evaporator. 18. Remove the gasket from the suction and liquid line assembly
evaporator connector block and discard. 19. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened suction and
liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the evaporator inlet and outlet
ports.
20. Remove the suction and liquid line assembly from the engine compartment.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the suction and liquid line assembly into the engine compartment. 2. Remove the tape
or plugs from the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block ports and the
evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 3. Align the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector
block and a new gasket to the evaporator inlet and outlet ports. 4. Install and tighten the two
screws that secure the suction and liquid line assembly evaporator connector block to the
evaporator. Tighten the upper
screw to 11.3 Nm (100 in. lbs.) first, then tighten the lower screw.
5. Remove the tape or plugs from the receiver-drier connector block inlet and outlet ports and the
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid
line assembly.
6. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them on the refrigerant
line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly.
Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use
only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
7. Reconnect the refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the receiver-drier
connector block inlet and outlet ports. 8. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the two
refrigerant line fittings of the suction and liquid line assembly to the receiver-drier connector
block inlet and outlet ports. Tighten the screws to 2.3 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
9. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block suction line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the suction line.
10. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the refrigerant line
fitting of the suction line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
11. Reconnect the suction line fitting to the mid-line connector block suction line port of the suction
and liquid line assembly. 12. Install and tighten the nut that secures the suction line fitting to the
mid-line connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6076
nut to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
13. Remove the tape or plugs from the mid-line connector block liquid line port and the refrigerant
line fitting of the liquid line. 14. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and
install it on the refrigerant line fitting of the liquid line. Use only the specified
O-rings as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
15. Reconnect the liquid line fitting to the mid-line connector block liquid line port of the suction and
liquid line assembly. 16. Install and tighten the nut that secures the liquid line fitting to the mid-line
connector block of the suction and liquid line assembly. Tighten the nut
to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.).
17. If the vehicle is so equipped, reinstall the vehicle speed control servo. Refer to Vehicle Speed
Control System for the proper procedures. 18. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 19. Evacuate
the refrigerant system. 20. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6077
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Suction Hose/Line Replacement
Suction Line Replacement - LHD
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY PART OF
THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEMS.
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system.
Fig.62 A/C Compressor Lines - LHD
2. Remove line at the accumulator.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6078
Fig.63 A/C Compressor Lines - LHD
3. Remove line at the compressor.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY PART OF
THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEMS.
1. Install the suction line at the compressor. 2. Install the suction line at the expansion valve. 3.
Position the expansion valve and install the retaining bolt. 4. Evacuate the A/C system. 5.
Recharge the refrigerant system.
Suction Line Replacement - RHD
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE SERVICING ANY PART OF
THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEMS.
REMOVAL
1. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6079
Fig.54 Expansion Valve
2. Remove retaining bolt at expansion valve. 3. Remove line at the expansion valve.
Fig.55 Accumulator And Lines - LHD (Typical - RHD)
4. Remove line at the compressor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the suction line at the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 6080
2. Install the suction line at the expansion valve. 3. Position the expansion valve and install the
retaining bolt. 4. Evacuate the A/C system. 5. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Housing Assembly HVAC: Removal and Replacement
LHD
HVAC HOUSING - LHD
REMOVAL
The instrument panel must be removed in order to remove the heater-A/C Housing.
WARNING: THE R-134a REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE
SERVICING ANY PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Using a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system. Refer to:
"Heating and Air Conditioning : Service and
Repair" See: Service and Repair
2. Remove instrument panel from vehicle. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Trim,
Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair,
Instrument Panel Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Assembly Replacement, See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Assembly
3. Drain cooling system. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling, and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service and
Repair" See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair
4. Remove heater hoses at the dash panel. Place plugs in the heater core outlets to prevent
coolant spillage during unit housing removal. 5. Unfasten coolant recovery container and set aside.
6. Remove suction line at expansion valve. Cap open refrigerant lines to prevent moisture and/or
dirt from entering. 7. Remove expansion valve from evaporator, and cap fittings. 8. Remove rubber
drain tube extension from condensation drain tube.
Fig.33 A/C Vacuum Line
9. Disconnect the vacuum harness at the power brake booster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6085
Fig.34 HVAC Housing Defroster Duct - (RHD Shown)
10. Unsnap and remove the defroster duct.
Fig.35 Dash Panel Retaining Studs
11. Remove three retaining nuts located in the engine compartment, on the dash panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6086
Fig.36 Housing Screws - LHD
12. Remove the right side retaining screw. 13. Remove remaining nut located on dash panel stud.
14. Disconnect the wiring connectors. 15. Remove assembly from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE R-134a REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE
SERVICING ANY PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Position the housing in the vehicle. 2. Connect the wire harness connectors. 3. Install the nut on
the dash panel stud. 4. Install the three retaining nuts on the engine compartment studs. 5. Snap
the defrost duct in place. 6. Connect the vacuum harness at the brake booster. 7. Connect the
rubber drain tube to the extension. 8. Install the expansion valve to the evaporator. 9. Remove the
protective caps and connect the suction line to the expansion valve.
10. Position and install the coolant recovery container. 11. Install the instrument panel Refer to:
Body and Frame, Interior Trim, Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument Panel
Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Assembly Replacement, See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Assembly
12. Refill the cooling system. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling, and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service
and Repair" See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair
13. Evacuate the refrigerant system. Refer to: "Heating and Air Conditioning : Service and Repair"
See: Service and Repair 14. Recharge the refrigerant system.
RHD
REMOVAL
NOTE: The instrument panel must be removed in order to remove the heater-A/C Housing.
WARNING: THE R-134a REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE
SERVICING ANY PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Using a refrigerant recovery machine, remove the refrigerant from the A/C system. Refer to:
"Heating and Air Conditioning : Service and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6087
Repair" See: Service and Repair
2. Remove instrument panel from vehicle. Refer to: Body and Frame, Interior Trim,
Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair,
Instrument Panel Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Assembly Replacement, See: Body and
Frame/Interior Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel
Assembly
3. Drain cooling system. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling, and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service and
Repair" See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair
4. Remove heater hoses at the dash panel. Place plugs in the heater core outlets to prevent
coolant spillage during unit housing removal. 5. Unfasten coolant recovery container and set aside.
6. Remove suction line at expansion valve. Cap open refrigerant lines to prevent moisture and/or
dirt from entering. 7. Remove expansion valve from evaporator, and cap fittings. 8. Remove rubber
drain tube extension from condensation drain tube.
Fig.33 A/C Vacuum Line - LHD (Shown) Typical - RHD
9. Disconnect the vacuum harness at the power brake booster.
Fig.34 HVAC Housing Defroster Duct - (LHD Shown) Typical - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6088
10. Unsnap and remove the defroster duct.
Fig.35 Dash Panel Retaining Studs
11. Remove three retaining nuts located in the engine compartment, on the dash panel.
Fig.36 Housing Screws
12. Remove the right side retaining screw. 13. Remove remaining nut located on dash panel stud.
14. Disconnect the wiring connectors. 15. Remove assembly from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: THE R-134a REFRIGERANT SYSTEM MUST BE RECOVERED BEFORE
SERVICING ANY PART OF THE REFRIGERANT SYSTEM.
1. Position the housing in the vehicle. 2. Connect the wire harness connectors. 3. Install the nut on
the dash panel stud.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6089
4. Install the three retaining nuts on the engine compartment studs. 5. Snap the defrost duct in
place. 6. Connect the vacuum harness at the brake booster. 7. Connect the rubber drain tube to
the extension. 8. Install the expansion valve to the evaporator. 9. Remove the protective caps and
connect the suction line to the expansion valve.
10. Position and install the coolant recovery container. 11. Install the instrument panel. Refer to:
Body and Frame, Interior Trim, Dashboard/Instrument Panel, Service and Repair, Instrument Panel
Service Procedures, Instrument Panel Assembly Replacement, See: Body and Frame/Interior
Moulding / Trim/Dashboard / Instrument Panel/Service and Repair/Instrument Panel Assembly
12. Refill the cooling system. Refer to: "Engine, Cooling, and Exhaust : Cooling System : Service
and Repair" See: Engine, Cooling and
Exhaust/Cooling System/Service and Repair
13. Evacuate the refrigerant system. Refer to: "Heating and Air Conditioning : Service and Repair"
See: Service and Repair 14. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6090
Housing Assembly HVAC: Overhaul
LHD
DISASSEMBLY
Use this procedure if any or all of the following items require service:
- Heater core
- Evaporator
- HVAC housing
The HVAC housing must be removed from the vehicle before beginning with this procedure
Fig.37 HVAC Housing Air Distribution Foam Seals - LHD
1. Separate the air distribution outlet foam seals at the case parting line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6091
Fig.38 Common Blend-Air HVAC System
2. Remove the evaporator lines foam seal, and heater core tubes foam seal from the unit. 3.
Remove the retaining clips and screws that hold the upper and lower housings together. 4.
Separate the two halves of the housing. 5. Lift the heater core and evaporator out of the case.
ASSEMBLY
1. Install the heater and evaporator cores into the case. 2. Place the two halves of the heater-a/c
housing together.
3. Install the retaining clips and screws that hold the upper and lower case housings together. 4.
Install the evaporator lines form seals and heater core tube seals to the case housing. 5. Install the
air distribution outlet foam seals at the case parting line.
RHD
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: Use this procedure if any or all of the following items require service:
- Heater core
- Evaporator
- HVAC housing
The HVAC housing must be removed from the vehicle before beginning with this procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6092
Fig.37 HVAC Housing Air Distribution Form Seal - LHD Shown (Typical - RHD)
1. Separate the air distribution outlet foam seals at the case parting line.
Fig.38 Common Blend-Air HVAC System - LHD Shown (Typical - RHD)
2. Remove the evaporator lines foam seal, and heater core tubes foam seal from the unit. 3.
Remove the retaining clips and screws that hold the upper and lower housings together. 4.
Separate the two halves of the housing. 5. Lift the heater core and evaporator out of the case.
ASSEMBLY
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 6093
1. Install the heater and evaporator cores into the case. 2. Place the two halves of the heater-a/c
housing together. 3. Install the retaining clips and screws that hold the upper and lower case
housings together. 4. Install the evaporator lines form seals and heater core tube seals to the case
housing. 5. Install the air distribution outlet foam seals at the case parting line.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Locations
Receiver Dryer: Locations
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the left side of the engine compartment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Locations > Page
6097
Receiver Dryer: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THE OPERATION
.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Locations > Page
6098
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the left side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
1. Evacuate and recover the refrigerant.
Fig.30 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Disconnect liquid line from filter/drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line on suction line assembly from
filter/drier. 4. Pull filter/drier out of rubber grommet. 5. Remove the filter/drier.
INSTALLATION
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the right side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
NOTE: Replace all A/C line seals from disassembled components. Failure to replace seals could
result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Install the filter/drier in the rubber grommet. 2. Connect the liquid line to the filter/drier.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Locations > Page
6099
3. Connect the liquid line on the suction line assembly to the filter/drier. 4. Evacuate the refrigerant
system. 5. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Refer to the refrigerant A/C Specification tag for system capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 6104
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications A/C Refrigerant Type
A/C Refrigerant Type
R-134a
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6105
Refrigerant: Service Precautions
R-134a - R-12
Because R-134a refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) which contains hydrogen atoms in place
of chlorine atoms, it will not cause damage to the ozone layer.
Ozone filters out harmful radiation from the sun. To assist in protecting the ozone layer, Chrysler
Corporation recommends an R-134a refrigerant recycling device.
The Clean Air Act Amendment of 1990 requires that Freon be recovered when accessing the air
conditioning circuit and that technicians hold a refrigerant recovery and handling certification.
The Ozone Layer A thin layer of ozone molecules, located 10 to 30 miles above the earth, form a
protective cover by absorbing a portion of the ultraviolet (UV) radiation emitted from the Sun.
Ozone Depletion Scientific research performed over the past 15 years links the release of
chlorofluorocarbons (CFC)s, also know by the trade name Freon) into the atmosphere to ozone
depletion. When CFCs are released into the atmosphere, they eventually reach the ozone layer
located in the stratosphere where they react with and destroy ozone molecules.
Harmful Effects Ozone depletion and the corresponding increase in UV radiation has been shown
to lead to higher incidents of cancer as well as global warming. When viewed from a global
perspective, ozone depletion holds an enormous potential for damage.
Upper Level vs. Ground Level Ozone Confusion often arises when we hear about the necessity of
the ozone layer and ground level ozone. The ozone layer existing high above the earth is beneficial
but the same compound, when located at ground level, is harmful to humans, animals, crops and
vegetation.
Ground level ozone is a component of smog and forms when hydrocarbons (HC) react with
nitrogen oxides (NOx) in the presence of sunlight and heat.
Montreal Protocol In response to the growing body of evidence demonstrating the detrimental
effects of (CFC)s, 24 countries and the European community met in Montreal, Canada, in 1987 to
establish standards for the control of (CFC)s. Since that time, a total of 132 countries have become
signatories to this agreement leading to an end of production of R12 in December, 1995, in all
developed countries.
As established by the Montreal Protocol, R12 production in developed countries has ceased.
Clean Air Act The United States Congress, acting in response to the Montreal Protocol, banned
production of (CFC)s by the year 2000. Congress also amended the Clean Air Act in an effort to
control both the production and use of (CFC)s for refrigerant applications including mobile vehicle
air conditioning systems.
Technician Certification Organizations providing technician refrigerant recovery and recycling
certification include:
National Institute for Automotive Service Excellence (ASE)
13505 Dulles Technology Drive, Suite 2 Herndon, VA 22071-3421 Phone: (703) 713-3800 Fax:
(703) 713-0727 http://www.asecert.org/
International Mobile Air Conditioning Association (IMACA)
P.O. Box 9000 Fort Worth, TX 76147-2000 Phone: (817) 338-1100 Fax: (817) 338-1451
Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) Worldwide
P.O. Box 100 East Greenville, PA 18041 Phone: 215-679-2220 Fax: 215-541-4635
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6106
http://www.macsw.org/
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
6107
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT
The refrigerant used in this air conditioning system is a HydroFluoroCarbon (HFC), type R-134a.
Unlike R-12, which is a ChloroFluoroCarbon (CFC), R-134a refrigerant does not contain
ozone-depleting chlorine. R-134a refrigerant is a non-toxic, non-Hammable, clear, and colorless
liquefied gas.
Even though R-134a does not contain chlorine, it must be reclaimed and recycled just like
CFC-type refrigerants. This is because R-134a is a greenhouse gas and can contribute to global
warming.
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an air conditioning system. Even a
small amount of R-12 added to an R-134a refrigerant system will cause compressor failure,
refrigerant oil sludge or poor air conditioning system performance. In addition, the PolyAlkylene
Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oils used in an R-134a refrigerant system are not compatible
with the mineral-based refrigerant oils used in an R-12 refrigerant system.
R-134a refrigerant system service ports, service tool couplers and refrigerant dispensing bottles
have all been designed with unique fittings to ensure that an R-134a system is not accidentally
contaminated with the wrong refrigerant (R-12). There are also labels posted in the engine
compartment of the vehicle and on the compressor identifying to service technicians that the air
conditioning system is equipped with R-134a.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
R-134A Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Service and Repair R-134A Refrigerant
STANDARD PROCEDURE - R-134A REFRIGERANT
This vehicle uses a refrigerant called R-134a. It is a non-toxic, non-flammable, clear colorless
liquefied gas.
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an air conditioning system. Even a
small amount of R-12 in a R-134a system could cause compressor failure, refrigerant oil to sludge
and/or poor performance. Never add any other type of refrigerant to a system designed to use
R-134a refrigerant. System failure will occur.
The high pressure service port is located on the filter/drier. The low pressure service port is located
on the suction line near the strut tower.
Fig. 31 Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling Station - Typical
When servicing a system, it is required that an air conditioning charging recovery/recycling
machine be used. Contact an automotive service equipment supplier for proper equipment. Refer
to the operating instructions provided with the equipment for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
R-134A Refrigerant > Page 6110
Fig. 32 Manifold Gauge Set - Typical
A manifold gauge set might be required with the charging and/or recovery/recycling device. Only
use gauges that have not been used for R-12. The service hoses on the gauge set should have
manual (turn wheel) or automatic back flow valves at the service port connector ends. This will
prevent refrigerant R-134a from being released into the atmosphere.
R-134a refrigerant requires a special type of compressor oil. When adding oil, make sure to use the
oil that is specified on the under hood label and/or the compressor housing
The use of R 134a will have a positive environmental impact due to its zero ozone depletion and
low global warming impact.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
R-134A Refrigerant > Page 6111
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant - Recovery
STANDARD PROCEDURE - REFRIGERANT RECOVERY
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS IN THE FRONT BEFORE
PERFORMING THE FOLLOWING OPERATION.
A R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets SAE Standard J2210 must be
used to recover the refrigerant from an R-134a refrigerant system. See the operating instructions
supplied by the equipment manufacturer for the proper care and use of this equipment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service
Precautions
Refrigerant Filter: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THE OPERATION.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6115
Refrigerant Filter: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the left side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
1. Evacuate and recover the refrigerant.
Fig.30 Heater Hose Assembly - RHD 2.0L
2. Disconnect liquid line from filter/drier. 3. Disconnect liquid line on suction line assembly from
filter/drier. 4. Pull filter/drier out of rubber grommet. 5. Remove the filter/drier.
INSTALLATION
The filter/drier is mounted in a rubber grommet on the right side of the engine compartment. The
refrigerant must be recovered from the A/C system before replacing the filter/drier assembly.
WARNING: THE REFRIGERATION SYSTEM MUST BE COMPLETELY RECOVERED BEFORE
PROCEEDING WITH THIS OPERATION.
NOTE: Replace all A/C line seals from disassembled components. Failure to replace seals could
result in a refrigerant leak.
1. Install the filter/drier in the rubber grommet. 2. Connect the liquid line to the filter/drier.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6116
3. Connect the liquid line on the suction line assembly to the filter/drier. 4. Evacuate the refrigerant
system. 5. Recharge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL CAPACITIES
Total System ........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 180 ml (6.1 oz.)
Filter-Drier ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 30 ml (1 oz.)
Condenser ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 30 ml (1 oz.)
Evaporator ...........................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 59 ml (2 oz.)
Refrigerant Lines .................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 44 ml (1.5 oz.)
Compressor .........................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... See Note
Note:
When replacing the A/C compressor, drain and measure the amount of oil from the old
compressor. Add the equivalent amount of fresh oil to the new compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 6121
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Refrigerant Oil .....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. ND-8 PAG
PAG - PolyAlkylene Glycol
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6122
Refrigerant Oil: Service Precautions
CAUTION: The refrigerant oil used in a R-134a A/C system is unique. Use only oils which were
designed to work with R-134a refrigerant. The oil designated for this vehicle is ND8 PAG
(polyalkalene glycol).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 6123
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation
The refrigerant oil used in R-134a refrigerant systems is a synthetic based PolyAlkylene Glycol
(PAG), wax-free lubricant Mineral-based R-12 refrigerant oils are not compatible with PAG oils, and
should never be introduced to an R-134a refrigerant system.
There are different PAG oils available, and each contains a different additive package. The 10S15
and 10S17 compressors used in this vehicle is designed to use an ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil. Use
only refrigerant oil of this same type to service the refrigerant system.
After performing any refrigerant recovery or recycling operation, always replenish the refrigerant
system with the same amount of the recommended refrigerant oil as was removed. Too little
refrigerant oil can cause compressor damage, and too much can reduce air conditioning system
performance.
PAG refrigerant oil is much more hygroscopic than mineral oil, and will absorb any moisture it
comes into contact with, even moisture in the air. The PAG oil container should always be kept
tightly capped until it is ready to be used. After use, recap the oil container immediately to prevent
moisture contamination.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Refrigerant Oil Level
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair Refrigerant Oil Level
STANDARD PROCEDURE - REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL CHECK
It is important to have the correct amount of oil in the A/C system to ensure proper lubrication of the
compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the compressor. Too much oil will reduce the
cooling capacity of the system and consequently result in higher discharge air temperatures.
NOTE: The oil used in the compressor is ND8 PAG R-134a refrigerant oil. Only refrigerant oil of the
same type should be used to service the system. Do not use any other oil. The oil container should
be kept tightly capped until it is ready for use. Tightly cap afterwards to prevent contamination from
dirt and moisture. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb any moisture it comes in contact with. Special
effort must be used to keep all R-134a system components moisture-free. Moisture in the oil is very
difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the compressor.
It will not be necessary to check oil level in the compressor or to add oil unless there has been an
oil loss. Oil loss at a leak point will be evident by the presence of a wet, shiny surface around the
leak.
Refrigerant Oil Capacities
When an air conditioning system is first assembled, all components (except the compressor) are
refrigerant oil free. After the system has been charged with R-134a refrigerant and operated, the oil
in the compressor is dispersed through the lines and components. The evaporator, condenser, and
filter- drier will retain a significant amount of oil, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart. When
a component is replaced, the specified amount of refrigerant oil must be added. When the
compressor is replaced, the amount of oil that is retained in the rest of the system must be drained
from the replacement compressor. When a line or component has ruptured and oil has escaped,
the compressor should be removed and drained. The filter-drier must be replaced along with the
ruptured part. The oil capacity of the system, minus the amount of oil still in the remaining
components, can be measured and poured into the suction port of the compressor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Refrigerant Oil Level > Page 6126
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair Servicing Refrigerant Oil Level
STANDARD PROCEDURE - SERVICING REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL
CAUTION: The refrigerant oil used in a R-134a A/C system is unique. Use only oils which were
designed to work with R-134a refrigerant. The oil designated for this vehicle is ND8 PAG
(polyalkalene glycol).
Recovery/recycling equipment will measure the lubricant being removed. This is the amount of
lubricant to be added back to the system. If a new compressor is being installed, drain lubricant
from the old compressor, measure the amount drained and discard old lubricant. Drain the lubricant
from the new compressor into a clean container. Return the amount of lubricant measured from the
old compressor, plus the amount reclaimed from the system back into the new compressor.
1. Discharge refrigerant system using recovery/recycling equipment if charge is present. 2.
Disconnect refrigerant lines from A/C compressor. Cap the open lines to prevent moisture from
entering system. 3. Remove compressor from vehicle. 4. From suction port on top of compressor,
drain lubricant from compressor. 5. Add system capacity minus the capacity of components that
have not been replaced. Add lubricant through the suction port on compressor. This is
not to exceed 180 ml (6.10 oz.) in total.
6. Install compressor and connect refrigerant lines. Then evacuate and charge refrigerant system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6131
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6132
Fig. 4 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6133
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6134
Fig. 28 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6135
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6136
A/C High Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6137
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 High Pressure Cut Out Switch Location
A/C HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The high pressure cut out switch is located on the rear of the compressor. It turns off the
compressor if the system pressure exceeds 3240 kPa (470 psi). The high pressure cut out switch is
a factory calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and if faulty or damaged, it
must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > High Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6138
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE SYSTEM BEFORE
REMOVING THE HIGH PRESSURE CUT OUT SWITCH.
REMOVAL
1. Recover refrigerant from A/C system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle.
High Pressure Cut Out Switch
4. Disconnect the engine wire harness connector from the high pressure cut out switch on the
compressor back cover. 5. Using snap ring pliers, remove the internal snap ring that secures the
high pressure cut out switch to the switch port in the compressor back cover. 6. Pull the high
pressure cut out switch out of the compressor back cover. 7. Install a plug in or tape over the
opened switch port on the compressor back cover. 8. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the high
pressure cut out switch and discard.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean any foreign matter from the switch mounting bore 2. Install the high pressure cutout switch
with a new O-ring. Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the
R-134a
system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
3. Remove the tape or plug from the switch port on the compressor back cover. 4. Insert the high
pressure cut out switch into the switch port on the compressor back cover. 5. Reconnect the engine
wire harness connector to the high pressure cut out switch on the compressor back cover. 6. Lower
the vehicle. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 8. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 9.
Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6142
Fig. 4 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6143
Fig. 27 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6144
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
A/C Low Pressure Switch (LHD)
A/C Low Pressure Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6145
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C low pressure switch is a single pole, single throw, pressure actuated switch that is
installed in a threaded port into the suction passage of the accumulator. The switch is located on
the top of the accumulator in a fitting that contains a Schrader type valve, which allows the switch
to be serviced without discharging the refrigerant system. The accumulator fitting is equipped with
a O-ring to seal the switch plumbing connection.
The A/C low pressure switch is a factory calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or repaired
and if faulty or damaged it must be replaced.
The A/C low pressure switch monitors the pressure of the refrigerant leaving the accumulator to the
compressor. The switch is connected in series electrically with the heater-A/C control blower and
mode switches and the high pressure cut out switch between ground and the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). The switch contact open or close the path the ground, signaling the PCM to turn
the compressor clutch on and off. This regulates the refrigerant system pressure and controls
evaporator temperature. Controlling the evaporator temperature prevents con-densate water on the
evaporator fins from freezing and obstructing air conditioning system air flow.
The A/C low pressure switch contacts are open when the suction pressure is approximately 152
kPa (22 psi) or lower. The switch contacts will close when the suction pressure rises to
approximately 234 - 262 kPa (34 - 38 psi) or above. Lower temperatures, below approximately -1
°C (30 °F), will also cause the switch contacts to open. This is due to the pressure/ temperature
relationship of the refrigerant in the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6146
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
Before performing diagnosis of the A/C low pressure switch, be certain that the switch is properly
installed on the accumulator fitting. If the switch is too loose it may not open the Schrader-type
valve in the accumulator fitting, which will prevent the switch from correctly monitoring the
refrigerant system pressure.
Also verify that the refrigerant system had the correct refrigerant charge.
1. With gear selector in park or neutral and park brake set, start engine and allow to idle. 2. Raise
hood and disconnect low pressure cut off switch connector boot. 3. Using a suitable jumper wire,
jump across the terminals inside wire connector boot. 4. If the compressor clutch does not engage,
the A/C low pressure switch, wiring, relay, or fuse can be defective. 5. If clutch engages, connect
manifold gauge set. Read low pressure gauge. At pressure above 97 kPa (14 psi) and above, low
pressure out off switch
will complete the clutch circuit. If the low pressure gauge reads below 140 kPa (20 psi), the system
is low on refrigerant charge or empty due to a leak.
6. Install connector boot on switch and repeat Step 3. If the clutch does not engage, replace the
A/C low pressure switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6147
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the low pressure cycling
switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Disconnect the connector for the A/C low
pressure switch from the top connector on the accumulator. 3. Unscrew the A/C low pressure
switch from the fitting on the top of the accumulator. 4. Remove the O-ring seal from the
accumulator and discard.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replace the O-ring seal before installing the low pressure clutch cycling switch
1. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the accumulator fitting.
Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended
for the compressor in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the A/C low pressure cycling switch onto the accumulator fitting. The switch
should be hand-tightened onto the accumulator
fitting.
3. Reconnect the wiring harness connector to the A/C low pressure switch. 4. Reconnect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Locations
8w-10-2 Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6152
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6153
Compressor Clutch Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6154
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6155
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
Fig.6 A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
A/C COMPRESSOR CLUTCH RELAY
The A/C compressor clutch relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay.
Relays conforming to the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities,
terminal patterns, and terminal functions. The ISO micro-relay terminal functions are the same as a
conventional ISO relay. However, the ISO micro-relay terminal pattern (or footprint) is different, the
current capacity is lower, and the physical dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional
ISO relay. The A/C compressor clutch relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the
engine compartment. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the inside surface of the PDC
cover for A/C compressor clutch relay identification and location.
The black, molded plastic case is the most visible component of the A/C compressor clutch relay
Five male spade-type terminals extend from the bottom of the base to connect the relay to the
vehicle electrical system, and the ISO designation for each terminal is molded into the base
adjacent to each terminal.
The ISO terminal designations are as follows: 30 (Common Feed) - This terminal is connected to the movable contact point of the relay
- 85 (Coil Ground) - This terminal is connected to the ground feed side of the relay control coil.
- 86 (Coil Battery) - This terminal is connected to the battery feed side of the relay control coil.
- 87 (Normally Open) - This terminal is connected to the normally open fixed contact point of the
relay.
87A (Normally Closed) - This terminal is connected to the normally closed fixed contact point of the
relay.
The factory-installed A/C compressor clutch relay cannot be adjusted or repaired. If the relay is
damaged or faulty it must be replaced.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is an electromechanical switch that uses a low current input from
the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the high current output to the Compressor clutch
electromagnetic coil. The movable common feed contact point is held against the fixed normally
closed contact point by spring pressure. When the relay coil is energized, an electromagnetic field
is produced by the coil windings. This electromagnetic field draws the movable relay contact point
away from the fixed normally closed contact point, and holds it against the fixed normally open
contact point. When the relay coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact
point back against the fixed normally closed contact point. The resistor or diode is connected in
parallel with the relay coil in the relay and helps to dissipate voltage spikes and electromagnetic
interference that can be generated as the electromagnetic field of the relay coil collapses.
The A/C compressor clutch relay terminals are connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
receptacle in the PDC. The inputs and outputs of
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6156
the A/C compressor clutch relay include: The common feed terminal (30) receives a battery current input from a fuse in the PDC through a
fused B(+) circuit at all times.
- The coil ground terminal (85) receives a ground input from the PCM through the A/C compressor
clutch relay control circuit only when the PCM electronically pulls the control circuit to ground.
- The coil battery terminal (86) receives a battery current input from a fuse in the fuse block module
through a fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit only when the ignition switch is in the ON or
Start positions.
- The normally open terminal (87) provides a battery current output to the compressor clutch coil
through the A/C compressor clutch relay output circuit only when the A/C compressor clutch relay
coil is energized.
The normally closed terminal (87A) is not connected to any circuit in this application, but provides a
battery current output only when the A/C compressor clutch relay coil is de-energized.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6157
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
CHECKING THE A/C RELAY OUTPUT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- A/C clutch relay operation
- Ground circuit open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6158
- A/C clutch
- Fused B+ circuit
- A/C clutch output circuit
- A/C clutch relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6159
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.7 Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the cover from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 3. See the fuse and relay layout
label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for A/C compressor clutch relay identification and
location. 4. Remove the A/C compressor clutch relay from the PDC.
INSTALLATION
1. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for the proper A/C
compressor clutch relay location. 2. Position the A/C compressor clutch relay in the proper
receptacle in the PDC. 3. Align the A/C compressor clutch relay terminals with the terminal cavities
in the PDC receptacle. 4. Push down firmly on the A/C compressor clutch relay until the terminals
are fully seated in the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 5. Install the cover onto the PDC. 6.
Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
A/C Cycling Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6167
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6168
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the compass/temp module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 degrees C (140 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 degrees C (140
degrees F) to indicate a SHORT circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) to
indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the Sensor Test. If there are no codes
stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6169
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
0 degrees C (32 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 degrees C (50 degrees
F) Sensor Resistance = 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 degrees C (68 degrees F) Sensor Resistance =
11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 degrees C (77 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30
degrees C (86 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 degrees C (104 degrees F)
Sensor Resistance = 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6170
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Open hood, disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable. 2. Working under the front of the
vehicle, remove the necessary components to access the ambient temperature sensor. 3.
Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 4. Remove the ambient
temperature sensor retaining screw and remove the sensor from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector. 2. Position the ambient
temperature sensor and install the retaining screw. 3. Install the removed components. 4. Connect
the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Coolant Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Application and ID
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Climate Controls ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig.22 Evaporator Probe Location - Typical
The evaporator probe is located in the A/C housing and placed in the evaporator fins.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6177
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator probe can be replaced without having to remove the A/C housing from the vehicle.
The evaporator probe is located in the A/C housing and placed in the evaporator fins. The probe
prevents evaporator freeze-up. This is done by cycling the compressor clutch OFF when
evaporator temperature drops below the freeze point. It cycles ON when the evaporator
temperature rises above the freeze point. The evaporator probe uses a thermistor probe in a
capillary tube. The tube is inserted between the evaporator fins in the heater-A/C housing.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6178
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
The work area and vehicle must be between 16 °C (60 °F) and 32 °C (90 °F) when testing the
switch.
Fig.21 Evaporator Probe Harness Connector
1. Disconnect the three wire connector from the evaporator probe lead located behind the glove
box. 2. Start engine and set A/C to low blower motor speed, panel, full cool, and RECIRC. 3. Using
a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and 2. If no voltage is detected, there is no
power to the switch. Check wiring and
fuses.
4. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage between Pin 1 and Pin 3. If no voltage is detected,
there is no voltage from the Powertrain Control
Module. If voltage is OK, connect a jumper wire between Pin 1 and Pin 3. The compressor clutch
should engage. If the clutch engages, remove the jumper wire immediately and go to Step 5. If the
compressor clutch does not engage, check the operation of the clutch and repair as necessary.
5. If compressor clutch engages, connect the evaporator probe 3-way connector. The compressor
clutch should engage or cycle depending on
evaporator temperature. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, replace the clutch cycling switch.
6. The engine running and the A/C set to:
- Blower motor on Low speed
- Panel position
- Full cool
- RECIRC.
7. Close all doors and windows. Place a thermometer in the center discharge vent. 8. If the clutch
does not begin to cycle off between 2 - 7 °C (35 - 45 °F), verify that the evaporator probe is fully
installed and not loose in
evaporator. If it is not properly installed, install probe and retest outlet temperature. If the
evaporator probe is properly installed, replace the clutch cycling switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6179
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be removed without removing the A/C Housing from the vehicle.
1. Disconnect probe wiring connector from behind the glove box.
Fig.22 Evaporator Probe Location - Typical
2. Remove rubber grommet from evaporator/ blower module. 3. Note which of the three pilot holes
the evaporator probe is located in. 4. Pull probe out of evaporator fins.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The evaporator probe can be installed without removing the A/C Housing from the vehicle.
1. There are three pilot holes available for the probe. The top hole is for service. If top hole was not
used by previous probe, install probe in top hole. 2. If previous probe was removed from top hole,
use a small plastic stick of approximately 1/8 inch diameter, and make a new hole. Make the hole
1/4 inch above, or below the original hole in the evaporator core.
3. Insert the new probe into hole between evaporator fins. 4. Reinstall rubber grommet into
evaporator probe access hole.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6184
Fig. 2 Engine Compartment (Left) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6185
Fig. 4 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6186
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6187
Fig. 28 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6188
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6189
A/C High Pressure Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6190
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 High Pressure Cut Out Switch Location
A/C HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The high pressure cut out switch is located on the rear of the compressor. It turns off the
compressor if the system pressure exceeds 3240 kPa (470 psi). The high pressure cut out switch is
a factory calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and if faulty or damaged, it
must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6191
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: THE REFRIGERANT MUST BE REMOVED FROM THE SYSTEM BEFORE
REMOVING THE HIGH PRESSURE CUT OUT SWITCH.
REMOVAL
1. Recover refrigerant from A/C system. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle.
High Pressure Cut Out Switch
4. Disconnect the engine wire harness connector from the high pressure cut out switch on the
compressor back cover. 5. Using snap ring pliers, remove the internal snap ring that secures the
high pressure cut out switch to the switch port in the compressor back cover. 6. Pull the high
pressure cut out switch out of the compressor back cover. 7. Install a plug in or tape over the
opened switch port on the compressor back cover. 8. Remove the rubber O-ring seal from the high
pressure cut out switch and discard.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean any foreign matter from the switch mounting bore 2. Install the high pressure cutout switch
with a new O-ring. Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of a special material for the
R-134a
system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the compressor in the vehicle.
3. Remove the tape or plug from the switch port on the compressor back cover. 4. Insert the high
pressure cut out switch into the switch port on the compressor back cover. 5. Reconnect the engine
wire harness connector to the high pressure cut out switch on the compressor back cover. 6. Lower
the vehicle. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 8. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 9.
Recharge the A/C system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6195
Fig. 4 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6196
Fig. 27 Engine Compartment (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6197
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
A/C Low Pressure Switch (LHD)
A/C Low Pressure Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6198
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C low pressure switch is a single pole, single throw, pressure actuated switch that is
installed in a threaded port into the suction passage of the accumulator. The switch is located on
the top of the accumulator in a fitting that contains a Schrader type valve, which allows the switch
to be serviced without discharging the refrigerant system. The accumulator fitting is equipped with
a O-ring to seal the switch plumbing connection.
The A/C low pressure switch is a factory calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or repaired
and if faulty or damaged it must be replaced.
The A/C low pressure switch monitors the pressure of the refrigerant leaving the accumulator to the
compressor. The switch is connected in series electrically with the heater-A/C control blower and
mode switches and the high pressure cut out switch between ground and the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). The switch contact open or close the path the ground, signaling the PCM to turn
the compressor clutch on and off. This regulates the refrigerant system pressure and controls
evaporator temperature. Controlling the evaporator temperature prevents con-densate water on the
evaporator fins from freezing and obstructing air conditioning system air flow.
The A/C low pressure switch contacts are open when the suction pressure is approximately 152
kPa (22 psi) or lower. The switch contacts will close when the suction pressure rises to
approximately 234 - 262 kPa (34 - 38 psi) or above. Lower temperatures, below approximately -1
°C (30 °F), will also cause the switch contacts to open. This is due to the pressure/ temperature
relationship of the refrigerant in the system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6199
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
Before performing diagnosis of the A/C low pressure switch, be certain that the switch is properly
installed on the accumulator fitting. If the switch is too loose it may not open the Schrader-type
valve in the accumulator fitting, which will prevent the switch from correctly monitoring the
refrigerant system pressure.
Also verify that the refrigerant system had the correct refrigerant charge.
1. With gear selector in park or neutral and park brake set, start engine and allow to idle. 2. Raise
hood and disconnect low pressure cut off switch connector boot. 3. Using a suitable jumper wire,
jump across the terminals inside wire connector boot. 4. If the compressor clutch does not engage,
the A/C low pressure switch, wiring, relay, or fuse can be defective. 5. If clutch engages, connect
manifold gauge set. Read low pressure gauge. At pressure above 97 kPa (14 psi) and above, low
pressure out off switch
will complete the clutch circuit. If the low pressure gauge reads below 140 kPa (20 psi), the system
is low on refrigerant charge or empty due to a leak.
6. Install connector boot on switch and repeat Step 3. If the clutch does not engage, replace the
A/C low pressure switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 6200
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
A/C LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the low pressure cycling
switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Disconnect the connector for the A/C low
pressure switch from the top connector on the accumulator. 3. Unscrew the A/C low pressure
switch from the fitting on the top of the accumulator. 4. Remove the O-ring seal from the
accumulator and discard.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Replace the O-ring seal before installing the low pressure clutch cycling switch
1. Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the accumulator fitting.
Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended
for the compressor in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the A/C low pressure cycling switch onto the accumulator fitting. The switch
should be hand-tightened onto the accumulator
fitting.
3. Reconnect the wiring harness connector to the A/C low pressure switch. 4. Reconnect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Service
Precautions
Service Port HVAC: Service Precautions
CAUTION: A valve that is not fully seated can lead to damage to the valve during evacuation and
charge. This can result in system refrigerant discharge while uncoupling the charge adapters.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6204
Service Port HVAC: Description and Operation
Fig.39 A/C Service Port Valves
A/C SERVICE PORT VALVE CORES
The A/C service port valve cores are serviceable items. The high side valve is located on the
filter-drier, and the low side valve is situated on the suction line, near the washer fluid reservoir
filler.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6205
Service Port HVAC: Service and Repair
SERVICE PORT VALVE CORES
REMOVAL
1. Remove the valve caps. 2. Using a R-134a refrigerant recovery machine, Remove the refrigerant
from A/C system. 3. Using a standard valve core tool, remove the valve core. Be careful to prevent
any dirt/debris from entering the valve core opening or getting on
the replacement valve core.
INSTALLATION
1. When assembling the new valve core into the port, the core should be oiled with clean ND8 PAG
compressor oil.
CAUTION: A valve that is not fully seated can lead to damage to the valve during evacuation and
charge. This can result in system refrigerant discharge while uncoupling the charge adapters.
2. Install valve core into port and tighten. 3. Evacuate the refrigerant system. 4. Recharge the
refrigerant system. 5. Install the valve caps.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Check Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Vacuum Check Valve HVAC: Testing and Inspection
Fig.28 Adjust Vacuum Test Bleed Valve - Typical
Heater - A/C Vacuum System Diagnosis
Use an adjustable vacuum test set (Special Tool C-3707-B) and a suitable vacuum pump to test
the heater-A/C vacuum control system. With a finger placed over the end of the vacuum test hose
probe, adjust the bleed valve on the test set gauge to obtain a vacuum of exactly 27 kPa (8 in.
Hg.). Release and block the end of the probe several times to verify that the vacuum reading
returns to the exact 27 kPa (8 in. Hg.) setting. Otherwise, a false reading will be obtained during
testing.
One-way Check Valve
1. Disconnect the heater-A/C vacuum supply (Black) tube in the engine compartment. This tube
passes through an opening in the dash panel. 2. Remove the one-way vacuum check valve. The
valve is located on the (Black) vacuum supply hose at the brake power booster. 3. Connect the test
set vacuum supply hose to the heater side of the valve. When connected to this side of the check
valve, no vacuum should pass
and the test set gauge should return to the 27 kPa (8 in. Hg.) setting. If OK, go to step Step 4. If not
OK, replace the faulty valve.
4. Connect the test set vacuum supply hose to the engine vacuum side of the valve. When
connected to this side of the check valve, vacuum should
flow through the valve without restriction. If not OK, replace the faulty valve.
Heater-A/C Controls
The operation of the Circulation door can be viewed by removing the blower motor and looking up
into the unit inlet. 1. Connect the test set vacuum probe to the heater-A/C vacuum supply (Black)
hose in the engine compartment. Position the test set gauge so that it
can be viewed from the passenger compartment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Vacuum Check Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 6209
2. Start with the Mode control in the Panel position and the Circulation control in the Outside-air
position. 3. Move the Circulation control to the Recirculation position (the Circulation door should
move into the Recirculation position). After a short pause
move the Mode control to the Defrost position (the Circulation door should move to the Outside-air
position). The test gauge should return to the calibrated setting of 27 kPa (8 in. Hg.) after each
selection is made. If the gauge cannot achieve the calibrated setting, the vacuum circuit or a
component has a leak.
4. If the gauge achieves the calibrated setting but the door does not move, there is either a pinched
vacuum line or a failed actuator.
Locating Vacuum Leaks
1. Connect the test vacuum probe to the vehicles (Black) supply hose. Position the vacuum test
gauge so it can be viewed from the passenger
compartment.
2. Place the Mode in the Panel position and the Circulation control in the Recirculation position. 3.
Remove the center instrument panel bezel. 4. Remove the center vent duct. 5. Remove and block
the Supply (Black) vacuum line at the control. The test gauge should return to the calibrated setting
of 27 kPa (8 in. Hg). If
not, there is a leak in the Supply line.
6. If there is no leak in the Supply line, reconnect it to the Control and remove the Actuator Feed
(Red) line from the Control. Block the vacuum
connection on the Control from where the line was removed. The test gauge should return to the
calibrated setting of 27 kPa (8 in. Hg.). If not, there is a leak in the Control.
7. If there is no leak in the Supply line or the Control, reconnect the Actuator Feed (Red) line to the
control. Remove and block the Actuator Feed
(Red) line at the Actuator. The actuator vacuum port is accessible behind and above the Glove
Box. The test gauge should return to the calibrated setting of 27 kPa (8 in. Hg.). If not there is a
leak in the Actuator Feed line.
8. If there is no leak in the Supply line, Control, or the Actuator Feed line, the leak must be in the
Actuator itself. Connect the Vacuum hose from the
Vacuum Test Gauge directly to the Actuator to verify the leak.
Locating Pinched Vacuum Lines
The operation of the Circulation door can be viewed by removing the blower motor and looking up
into the unit inlet. See Blower Motor Wheel and Assembly removal and installation for service
procedures. 1. Connect the test vacuum probe to the vehicles (Black) supply hose. Position the
vacuum test gauge so it can be viewed from the passenger
compartment.
2. Place the Mode in the Panel position and the Circulation control in the Recirculation position. 3.
Remove the center instrument panel bezel. 4. Remove the center vent duct. 5. Remove the Supply
(Black) vacuum line at the control. The test gauge should drop indicating free flow through the
Supply line. If not, there is a
blockage in the Supply line.
6. If there is no blockage in the Supply line, reconnect it to the Control. Remove the Actuator Feed
(Red) line from the Control. The test gauge
should drop indicating free flow through the Supply line and Control. If not the vacuum switches on
the Control are not functioning.
7. If there is no blockage in the Supply line or the Control, reconnect the Actuator Feed (Red) line
to the control. Remove the Actuator Feed (Red)
line at the Actuator. The Actuator vacuum port is accessible behind and above the Glove Box. The
test gauge should drop indicating free flow through the supply line, Control, and the Actuator Feed
line. If not, there is a blockage in the Actuator Feed line.
8. If there is no blockage in the Supply line, Control, or the Actuator Feed line, the Actuator must
have failed. Connect the Vacuum hose from the
Vacuum Test Gauge directly to the Actuator to verify the Actuator has failed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag System
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Air Bag System
The OEM does not provide a list of restraint system components that should be inspected and/or
replaced following a collision.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information
> Service and Repair > Air Bag System > Page 6215
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Seat Belt System
REPAIRS AND INSPECTIONS REQUIRED AFTER A COLLISION
RESTRAINT SYSTEM
After a impact where an airbag has been deployed due to a collision, the following MUST be
replaced: 1. Front Seat Belts and Retractors (driver and passenger) with integral Tensioners. 2.
After an impact that deploys the airbag, the seat belt tensioner assembly must be replaced.
WARNING: WHEN THE FRONT AIRBAG IS DEPLOYED, THE TENSIONER WILL HAVE
DEPLOYED ALSO AND MUST BE REPLACED.
3. Do not reuse the bolts attaching the seat belt retractor to the seat frame. Failure to follow proper
installation procedure may result in the seat track
latch pins not being synchronized.
4. Inspect the condition of the shoulder/lap belt. replace the retractor if the belt is cut, frayed, torn,
or damaged in any way. The rear seat back
retaining nut also serves as the center seat belt anchor. Be certain to torque this nut.
5. All seat belts should be closely inspected for cuts, tears, fraying, or damage in any way following
any frontal impact or airbag deployment. The
seat belts are to be replaced when visible damage is incurred. Inspect the Lower Anchors and
Tether for Children (LATCH) child restraint anchors for damage after an impact event and replace
as needed.
6. During, and following, any child restraint anchor service, due to impact event or vehicle repair,
carefully inspect all mounting hardware, tether
straps and anchors for proper installation, operation, or damage. if a child restraint anchor is found
damaged in any way, the anchor must be replaced with the seat assembly. failure to do so could
result in occupant personal injury or death.
NOTE: Never attempt to repair a seat belt component. always replace damaged or faulty seat belt
components with the correct, new and unused replacement parts.
VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH THE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM (OCS)
If any of the Occupant Classification System (OCS) components of the passenger side front seat
cushion require replacement, they are serviced only as a factory-calibrated, assembled, and
tamper-evident service replacement package. This package includes the assembled frame,
springs, pad, seat weight bladder and pressure sensor, foam, wiring and a calibrated OCM. When
installing this package, always replace all of the existing components with the new components as
a unit. Do not attempt to separate or disconnect any of the new OCS components contained in the
service replacement package from each other, and do not attempt to reuse any of the replaced
components in this or any other vehicle.
CAUTION: Never replace both the Airbag Control Module (ACM) and the Occupant Classification
Module (OCM) at the same time. If both require replacement, replace one. Then perform the
supplemental restraint verification test before replacing the other. Both the ACM and the OCM
store OCS calibration data, which they transfer to one another when one of them is replaced. If
both are replaced at the same time, an irreversible fault will be set in both modules.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Page 6220
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Page
6224
Air Bag: Diagrams
Driver Airbag
Left Seat Airbag
Passenger Airbag
Right Seat Airbag
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Page
6225
Air Bag: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. FIRST (Refer to
RESTRAINTS/DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM).
- WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM RESERVE CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Page
6226
Air Bag: Description and Operation
Fig.11 Driver Airbag Location
DRIVER AIRBAG
The driver airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver airbag system. The
driver airbag is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the airbag trim cover are the
horn switch, the folded airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The
resistive membrane-type horn switch is secured within a plastic tray between the driver airbag
cover and the backer plate which is heat staked on to the driver airbag cover.
The driver airbag cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged.
The driver airbag trim cover and the horn switch are available for service replacement.
The driver airbag includes a stamped metal housing to which the cushion and an inflator unit are
attached and sealed. The conventional pyrotechnic-type inflator assembly is mounted to studs on
the back of the airbag module housing. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it can
discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. Following an airbag deployment, the airbag cushion quickly deflates by venting this gas
towards the instrument panel through the porous fabric material used on the steering wheel side of
the airbag cushion.
The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag and forms a decorative cover in the
center of the steering wheel. The inside of the trim cover has locking blocks molded into it that
engage a lip on the airbag metal housing. Two stamped metal retainers then fit over the inflator
mounting studs on the back of the airbag housing and are engaged in slots on the inside of the
cover, securely locking the trim cover into place. The trim cover will split at predetermined breakout
lines, then fold back out of the way along with the horn switch and tray unit upon airbag
deployment.
Fig.14 Passenger Airbag Location
PASSENGER AIRBAG
The passenger airbag is located behind the passenger airbag cover, between the glove box and
instrument panel top cover.
The passenger airbag includes an aluminum housing within which the cushion and inflator are
mounted and sealed. Two stamped metal brackets,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Page
6227
one on each end of the housing, enclose the cushion and inflator. The mounting scheme consists
of two weld studs and a bracket with two tabs off the bottom of the housing.
Following a passenger airbag deployment, the passenger airbag and the passenger airbag cover
must be replaced. If inspection reveals that the passenger airbag mounting points on the
instrument panel have been cracked or damaged, the instrument panel assembly must also be
replaced. The passenger airbag cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any
way damaged.
The hybrid-type inflator assembly includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The
inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it can discharge the gas it produces directly into the
cushion when supplied with the proper electrical signal. Following an airbag deployment, the airbag
cushion quickly deflates by venting this gas through the porous fabric material used on each end
panel of the airbag cushion.
The passenger airbag is secured with nuts to the instrument panel beneath the instrument panel
top pad and above the glove box opening.
Fig.17 Seat Airbag - Typical
Seat Airbags, SIACM
SEAT AIRBAG
The left and right seat airbags are located in the outboard edge of the front seat backs. The airbag
contains a bag, an inflator (small canister of highly compressed gas), and a mounting bracket. The
seat airbag cannot be repaired and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged.
When supplied with the proper electrical signal, the inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the compressed gas directly into the cushion. Upon deployment, the seat back trim
cover will tear open and allow the seat airbag to fully deploy between the seat and the door.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Airbag
REMOVAL
When removing a deployed airbag, rubber gloves, eye protection and long sleeved shirt should be
worn, as there may be deposits on the surface which could irritate the skin and eyes. 1. Disconnect
and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.12 Driver Airbag Remove/Install
2. Remove speed control switches or covers from steering wheel armature and disconnect the
wires. 3. Remove two bolts attaching Driver Airbag from the sides of steering wheel. 4. Lift airbag
and disconnect airbag squib wire connector and horn wire. 5. Remove Driver Airbag from vehicle.
NOTE: When replacing a deployed driver airbag, the clock spring must also be replaced. Refer to
Electrical, Restraints, Clock Spring, Removal.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the squib wire to the airbag. Make airbag connection by pressing straight in on the
connector. The connector should be fully seated. Feel
for positive snap to assure positive connection.
2. Connect the horn wire. 3. Install two bolts and tighten to 10 to 11 Nm (90 to 100 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Install covers to the steering wheel armature or connect the wire connectors to the speed control
switches and install switches. Tighten fastener to 2
Nm (20 in. lbs.) torque.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag > Page 6230
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Airbag Cover
REMOVAL
The horn switch is integral to the driver airbag trim cover. If either component is faulty or damaged,
the entire driver airbag trim cover and horn switch unit must be replaced.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
WARNING: WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM RESERVE CAPACITOR TO
DISCHARGE.
2. Remove the driver airbag from the steering wheel (Refer to RESTRAINTS/ DRIVER AIRBAG REMOVAL). 3. Remove the plastic wire retainer that captures the horn switch feed pigtail wire
between the upper left inflator stud and the inflator on the back of
the driver airbag housing.
4. Remove the four nuts that secure the upper and lower trim cover retainers to the studs on the
back of the driver airbag housing. 5. Remove the upper and lower trim cover retainers from the
airbag housing studs. 6. Remove the horn switch ground pigtail wire eyelet terminal from the upper
right airbag housing stud. 7. Disengage the six trim cover locking blocks from the lip around the
outside edge of the driver airbag housing and remove the housing from the
cover.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the housing into the cover. Engage the six trim cover locking blocks to the lip around the
outside edge of the driver airbag housing. 2. Install the horn switch ground pigtail wire eyelet
terminal to the upper right airbag housing stud. 3. Install the upper and lower trim cover retainers to
the airbag housing studs. 4. Install the four nuts that secure the upper and lower trim cover
retainers to the studs on the back of the driver airbag housing. 5. Install the plastic wire retainer
that captures the horn switch feed pigtail wire between the upper left inflator stud and the inflator on
the back of the
driver airbag housing.
6. Install the driver airbag onto the steering wheel (Refer to RESTRAINTS/ DRIVER AIRBAG INSTALLATION).
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. FIRST (Refer to
RESTRAINTS/DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag > Page 6231
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Airbag
REMOVAL
Non-deployed Module When removing an airbag for any reason other than DEPLOYMENT. 1.
Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Wait one minute for the reserve capacitor to
discharge before removing non-deployed module. 3. Remove instrument panel top cover. Refer to
Body Instrument Panel, Instrument panel Top Cover, Removal. 4. Remove three screws to glove
box door and remove door from instrument panel.
Fig.15 Passenger Airbag Remove/Install
5. Remove three passenger airbag cover screws attaching cover to top of instrument panel. 6.
Remove two passenger airbag cover screws attaching cover to front lower instrument panel. 7.
Remove three airbag attaching nuts from the support structure. 8. Lift the airbag up until the wire
connector is visible and disconnect the connector.
Deployed Module When removing a deployed airbag, rubber gloves, eye protection, and a
long-sleeved shirt should be worn, as there may be deposits on the surface which could irritate the
skin and eyes. 1. Roll/fold airbag towards instrument panel. 2. Close door over folded airbag and
tape door closed. 3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 4. Remove instrument panel
top cover. Refer to Body, Instrument Panel, Instrument panel Top Cover, Removal. 5. Remove
three screws to glove box door and remove door from instrument panel. 6. Remove three
passenger airbag cover screws attaching cover to top of instrument panel. 7. Remove two
passenger airbag cover screws attaching cover to front lower instrument panel. 8. Remove three
airbag attaching nuts from the support structure. 9. Lift the airbag up until the wire connector is
visible and disconnect the connector.
INSTALLATION
When installing a module for any reason other than DEPLOYMENT. 1. Connect the passenger
airbag wire connector to the airbag. Lower the airbag into the instrument panel in its mounting
position. 2. Install the three airbag attaching nuts to the support structure. Tighten the three airbag
retaining nuts to 22 to 34 Nm (200 to 300 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Install the two passenger airbag cover
screws attaching cover to the front lower instrument panel. Tighten screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.)
torque. 4. Install the three passenger airbag cover screws attaching cover to top of instrument
panel. Tighten screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.) torque. 5. Install the door onto the instrument panel and
install the three screws to the glove box door. Tighten screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.) torque. 6. Install
the instrument panel top cover. Refer to Body Instrument Panel, Instrument panel Top Cover,
Installation.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag > Page 6232
Air Bag: Service and Repair Seat Airbag
REMOVAL
1. Position the left front seat in the full forward position. 2. Open hood.
Fig.18 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 4. Remove front seat from vehicle. Refer to
Body, Seats, Front Seat, Removal.
Fig.19 Front Seat Back Panel - Typical
5. Remove plastic back panel from the seat back.
a. Grasp seat back panel at upper corners. b. Pull rearward on panel until panel disengages on
both sides of the upper portion. c. After both upper corners are disengaged from the seat frame,
remove the two lower portion attachment screws.
6. Disengage seat back trim cover J-strap from the upper, lower and airbag side of seat back.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag > Page 6233
Fig.20 Seat Airbag Electrical Connector
7. Disconnect the seat airbag electrical connector. Slide yellow locking tab down to unlock. Then
with two fingers, push two side retaining tabs in
and pull connector straight from module.
8. Remove the seat airbag retaining nuts. 9. Grasp the upper airbag side of the seat back trim
cover and pull trim cover and cushion over top of seat back frame. This will allow room to
remove seat airbag without damaging trim cover or cushion.
10. Working between seat back trim cover/cushion and frame carefully unhook seat airbag studs
from nylon sleeve and slide seat airbag out of sleeve.
Be careful not to tear nylon sleeve as this will affect function of airbag system.
CAUTION: Be certain not to tear the side impact airbag module nylon sleeve during removal.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The seat airbag connector must face down (toward seat cushion) after installation.
1. Carefully slide the seat airbag in nylon sleeve until mounting studs line up with holes provided in
nylon sleeve. Be careful not to tear nylon sleeve
as this will affect function of airbag system.
CAUTION: The seat airbag must be inside the nylon sleeve before installing retaining nuts. Failure
to do so will adversely affect the function of the side impact airbag system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag > Page 6234
Fig.21 Installing Seat Airbag
2. Pull seat airbag and nylon sleeve assembly up to line up mounting studs and mistake proofing
pin with holes provided in seat back frame mounting
bracket. Install the seat airbag retaining nuts. Torque to 10.7 Nm (94.7 in. lbs.).
3. Position the upper seat back trim cover and cushion over seat back frame. 4. Connect the seat
airbag electrical connector. After initial connector is installed be certain the yellow locking tab is in
the upper locked" position.
Check to be certain connector cannot be removed once yellow locking tab is positioned.
5. Position seat back trim cover and install seat back trim cover J-straps on the upper, lower and
airbag side of seat back frame. 6. Install the plastic back panel on the seat back.
a. Inspect seat back panel attachment clips (on upper portion on panel) for damage or excessive
deformation. Replace clips if necessary. b. Inspect seat frame back panel lower attachment bracket
(where attachment screws engage into frame) for damage or bending. c. If panel attachment lower
bracket is bent, bend seat back panel attachment lower bracket back to its original (flat) shape. If
bracket is damaged
or bent beyond repair, seat back frame must be replaced.
d. Inspect seat frame back panel upper attachment bracket (where attachment clips engage into
frame) for damage or bending. e. If frame panel upper attachment bracket is bent, bend seat back
panel attachment bracket back to its original (flat) shape. If bracket is damaged
or bent beyond repair, seat back frame must be replaced.
f. Secure back panel upper attachment clips to back panel.
g. Position back panel to seat back frame by placing locating feature posts to corresponding
locating holes in attachment brackets. h. Apply moderate force to push back panel until upper clips
engage into frame on both sides. i.
After both upper corners are engaged to seat frame, insert two lower portion attachment screws.
j. Torque screws to 2 Nm (8.9 in. lbs.).
7. Install the front seat back in vehicle. Refer to Body Seats, Front Seat, Installation.
CAUTION: Be certain plastic back panel is securely installed on the seat back. Failure to do so will
adversely affect the side impact airbag system.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
8. Close hood. 9. Verify vehicle and system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6239
Air Bag Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6240
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6241
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6242
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6243
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6244
Fig. 56 Body (Right) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6245
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
Airbag Control Module
Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6246
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH SIDE.
- DO NOT REMOVE SIACM FROM THE MOUNTING BRACKET. THIS IS SERVICED WITH THE
BRACKET AND A NEW ONE WILL COME WITH THE REPLACEMENT SIACM.
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6247
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
Airbag Control Module
AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, safing sensor, and
energy storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system
logic includes On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument
cluster circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn ON the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT. BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING
WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST
DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE. WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO
DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp ON for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns
OFF, it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible
malfunctions. If the lamp remains ON, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp
circuit may be internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer
than 6-8 seconds then goes OFF, there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6248
Fig.23 Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM)
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
Vehicles equipped with side impact airbags use two side impact airbag control modules. One is
located on each side of the vehicle within the body B-pillar.
Each Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM) serves as the impact sensor for its seat
mounted airbag. The right side SIACM controls the right seat airbag. The left side SIACM controls
the left seat air- bag. Each SIACM contains two accelerometers, both accelerometers must agree
in order to deploy the side airbag. In the event of a side impact, the appropriate SIACM will send a
electronic signal to its airbag, deploying the airbag. The SIACM communicates with the Airbag
Control Module (ACM) via the PCI bus circuit.
The SIACM perform self-diagnostics and circuit tests to determine if the system is functioning
properly. If the test finds a problem, the SIACM will set both active and stored Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTC's). If a DTC is active, the SIACM will request that the airbag warning lamp be turned
ON. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI bus to the ACM once each second or
on a change in lamp state (ON/OFF). If the warning lamp status message from either SIACM
contains a lamp ON request, the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the DTC is set,
the ACM sends a PCI bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC) requesting the
airbag warning lamp to be turned ON. Observe all ACM warning and caution statements when
servicing or handling the SIACM. The SIACM's are not serviceable and must be replaced even if
they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6249
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
If no obvious problems are found, erase stored codes, and with the ignition "ON" wiggle the wire
harness and connectors, rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop. Recheck for codes
periodically as you work through the system. This procedure may uncover a malfunction that is
difficult to locate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Airbag Control Module
REMOVAL
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove center console. Refer to Body
Interior, Floor Console, Removal.
Fig.4 Airbag Control Module (ACM) Remove/Install
3. Remove module mounting nuts and remove module. 4. Disconnect ACM 23-way connector. 5.
Remove ACM from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect ACM connector and ensure that the connector and all locking tabs are engaged.
CAUTION: USE SUPPLIED NUTS ONLY.
2. Position ACM (arrow pointing forward) in the console floor bracket, attach the nuts and tighten to
9.6 to 14 Nm (85 to 125 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Install center console assembly Refer to Body, Interior,
Floor Console Installation.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 6252
TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 6253
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Side Impact Airbag Control Module
REMOVAL
The removal and installation of the driver side and passenger side modules is identical. The
orientation of the modules is the only difference (which way they are tilted).
WARNING: THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH
SIDE.
1. Open hood.
Fig.18 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the lower seat trim. Locate the
connector for the seat airbag which is under the seat on the outboard side, attached to the seat
frame.
Disconnect the harness side of the connector. This is to engage the shorting Clips to disable the
side impact airbag system.
4. Remove the lower B-pillar trim from the appropriate side of the vehicle. Refer to Body, Interior,
B-Pillar Trim, Removal. 5. Remove the seat belt retractor. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Front Seat
Belt Retractor, Removal.
WARNING: DO NOT REMOVE SIACM FROM THE MOUNTING BRACKET. THIS IS SERVICED
WITH THE BRACKET AND A NEW ONE WILL COME WITH THE REPLACEMENT SIACM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 6254
Fig.23 Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM)
6. Remove the SIACM retaining nuts and ground eyelet. 7. Pull SIACM out of B-pillar.
Fig.24 SIACM Connector
8. Disconnect the SIACM electrical connector. 9. Remove the SIACM from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
The installation of the driver side and passenger side modules is identical. The orientation of the
modules is the only difference (which way they are tilted).
WARNING: THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH
SIDE.
1. Connect the SIACM electrical connector. 2. Position the SIACM in the B-pillar and install the
retaining nuts. Torque the nuts to 41 Nm (360 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Place the ground eyelet over the TOP REAR (towards the rear of the vehicle) weld stud
when reattaching the SIACM. This location prevents the eyelet from spinning during tightening.
3. Install the seat belt retractor. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Front Seat Belt Retractor,
Installation. 4. Install the lower B-pillar trim. Refer to Body Interior, B-Pillar Trim, Installation. 5.
Connect the harness side of the connector. Install the lower seat trim.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
6. Close hood. 7. Verify vehicle and system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6258
Clockspring
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6259
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service Precautions
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6260
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation
Fig.9 Clockspring Location
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation. The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches on vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged. The clockspring cannot be repaired it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6261
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Adjustments
STANDARD PROCEDURE - CLOCK SPRING CENTERING
If the rotating tape within the clock spring is not positioned properly with the steering wheel and the
front wheels, the clock spring may fail during use. The following procedure MUST BE USED to
center the clock spring if: The clock spring is not known to be properly positioned.
- The front wheels were moved.
- The steering wheel was moved from the half turn (180 degrees) to the right (clockwise) position.
1. Remove clock spring. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Clock Spring, Removal. 2. Rotate the clock
spring rotor in the CLOCKWISE DIRECTION to the end of travel. Do not apply excessive torque. 3.
From the end of travel, rotate the rotor three full turns in the counterclockwise direction. The horn
wire and the squib wire should end up at the
bottom. If not, rotate the rotor counter clockwise until the wires are properly orientated, but not
more than half turn (180 degrees). Engage clock spring locking mechanism.
4. Install the clock spring. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Clock Spring, Installation.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6262
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Place the front road wheels in the straight ahead position then:
- Rotate the steering wheel half turn (180 degrees) to the right (clockwise).
- Lock column with ignition lock cylinder.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Wait one minute for the reserve capacitor
to discharge before removing non-deployed module. 4. Remove steering wheel. Refer to Steering,
Column, Steering Wheel, Removal. 5. Remove upper and lower steering column shrouds to gain
access to clockspring wiring. Refer to Steering, Column, Upper Shroud Removal. 6. Remove
multi-function switch. Refer to Lamps/Lighting - Exterior, Multi-Function Switch, Removal. 7.
Disconnect the 7-way connector between the clock spring and the instrument panel wiring harness
at the base of the clock spring.
Fig.10 Clock Spring Latch Hooks
8. Remove clock spring by lifting the top latch tab up slightly to guide it over the lock housing. The
clock spring cannot be repaired, and must be
replaced if faulty.
9. Rotate clock spring rotor a half turn (180 degrees) to the left (counter clockwise).
10. Lock the clock spring rotor in the center position as follows: Insert a paper clip wire through the
hole in the rotor at the 10 O'clock position and
bend to prevent it from falling out.
INSTALLATION
1. Confirm that:
- The steering wheel position is a half turn (180 degrees) to the right (clockwise)
- The column is locked with the ignition cylinder lock.
- Check that the turn signal stalk is in the neutral position
- When reusing the clock spring, remove locking wire and rotate clock spring rotor one half turn
(180 degrees) to the right (clockwise). Locate the clock spring on the steering shaft and push down
on the rotor until the clock spring is fully seated on the steering column.
- When installing a new clock spring, position the front wheels straight a head. Remove grenade
pin. Rotate clock spring rotor one half turn (180 degrees) to the right (clockwise).
2. Connect the clock spring to the instrument panel harness, ensure wiring is properly routed. Then
check that the connectors, locking tabs are
properly engaged and the halo lamp wire is in position.
3. Install the multi-function switch. Refer to Lamps/Lighting - Exterior, Multi-Function Switch,
Installation. 4. Install steering column shrouds. Be sure all wires are inside of shrouds. 5. Install
steering wheel ensuring the flats on hub align with the clock spring. Pull the horn, airbag and speed
control leads through the larger slot.
Ensure leads do not get pinched under the steering wheel.
6. Route speed control wires under and behind the airbag module mounting tabs. 7. Connect the
horn lead wire and the airbag lead wire to the airbag module. 8. Install the airbag module and
tighten bolts to 12 to 14 Nm (105 to 125 in. lbs.) torque. 9. Connect the speed control wires to the
switches and install switches. Tighten screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.) torque.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Application and ID
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Airbag Indicator ...................................................................................................................................
................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6271
Air Bag Control Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6272
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6273
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6274
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6275
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6276
Fig. 56 Body (Right) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6277
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
Airbag Control Module
Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6278
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH SIDE.
- DO NOT REMOVE SIACM FROM THE MOUNTING BRACKET. THIS IS SERVICED WITH THE
BRACKET AND A NEW ONE WILL COME WITH THE REPLACEMENT SIACM.
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
- DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6279
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
Airbag Control Module
AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, safing sensor, and
energy storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system
logic includes On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument
cluster circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn ON the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT. BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING
WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST
DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE. WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO
DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp ON for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns
OFF, it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible
malfunctions. If the lamp remains ON, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp
circuit may be internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer
than 6-8 seconds then goes OFF, there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6280
Fig.23 Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM)
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
Vehicles equipped with side impact airbags use two side impact airbag control modules. One is
located on each side of the vehicle within the body B-pillar.
Each Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM) serves as the impact sensor for its seat
mounted airbag. The right side SIACM controls the right seat airbag. The left side SIACM controls
the left seat air- bag. Each SIACM contains two accelerometers, both accelerometers must agree
in order to deploy the side airbag. In the event of a side impact, the appropriate SIACM will send a
electronic signal to its airbag, deploying the airbag. The SIACM communicates with the Airbag
Control Module (ACM) via the PCI bus circuit.
The SIACM perform self-diagnostics and circuit tests to determine if the system is functioning
properly. If the test finds a problem, the SIACM will set both active and stored Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTC's). If a DTC is active, the SIACM will request that the airbag warning lamp be turned
ON. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI bus to the ACM once each second or
on a change in lamp state (ON/OFF). If the warning lamp status message from either SIACM
contains a lamp ON request, the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the DTC is set,
the ACM sends a PCI bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC) requesting the
airbag warning lamp to be turned ON. Observe all ACM warning and caution statements when
servicing or handling the SIACM. The SIACM's are not serviceable and must be replaced even if
they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6281
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
If no obvious problems are found, erase stored codes, and with the ignition "ON" wiggle the wire
harness and connectors, rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop. Recheck for codes
periodically as you work through the system. This procedure may uncover a malfunction that is
difficult to locate.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Airbag Control Module
REMOVAL
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove center console. Refer to Body
Interior, Floor Console, Removal.
Fig.4 Airbag Control Module (ACM) Remove/Install
3. Remove module mounting nuts and remove module. 4. Disconnect ACM 23-way connector. 5.
Remove ACM from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect ACM connector and ensure that the connector and all locking tabs are engaged.
CAUTION: USE SUPPLIED NUTS ONLY.
2. Position ACM (arrow pointing forward) in the console floor bracket, attach the nuts and tighten to
9.6 to 14 Nm (85 to 125 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Install center console assembly Refer to Body, Interior,
Floor Console Installation.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 6284
TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 6285
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Side Impact Airbag Control Module
REMOVAL
The removal and installation of the driver side and passenger side modules is identical. The
orientation of the modules is the only difference (which way they are tilted).
WARNING: THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH
SIDE.
1. Open hood.
Fig.18 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the lower seat trim. Locate the
connector for the seat airbag which is under the seat on the outboard side, attached to the seat
frame.
Disconnect the harness side of the connector. This is to engage the shorting Clips to disable the
side impact airbag system.
4. Remove the lower B-pillar trim from the appropriate side of the vehicle. Refer to Body, Interior,
B-Pillar Trim, Removal. 5. Remove the seat belt retractor. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Front Seat
Belt Retractor, Removal.
WARNING: DO NOT REMOVE SIACM FROM THE MOUNTING BRACKET. THIS IS SERVICED
WITH THE BRACKET AND A NEW ONE WILL COME WITH THE REPLACEMENT SIACM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Airbag Control Module > Page 6286
Fig.23 Side Impact Airbag Control Module (SIACM)
6. Remove the SIACM retaining nuts and ground eyelet. 7. Pull SIACM out of B-pillar.
Fig.24 SIACM Connector
8. Disconnect the SIACM electrical connector. 9. Remove the SIACM from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
The installation of the driver side and passenger side modules is identical. The orientation of the
modules is the only difference (which way they are tilted).
WARNING: THE MODULES CANNOT BE INTERCHANGED. THEY ARE UNIQUE TO EACH
SIDE.
1. Connect the SIACM electrical connector. 2. Position the SIACM in the B-pillar and install the
retaining nuts. Torque the nuts to 41 Nm (360 in. lbs.).
NOTE: Place the ground eyelet over the TOP REAR (towards the rear of the vehicle) weld stud
when reattaching the SIACM. This location prevents the eyelet from spinning during tightening.
3. Install the seat belt retractor. Refer to Electrical, Restraints, Front Seat Belt Retractor,
Installation. 4. Install the lower B-pillar trim. Refer to Body Interior, B-Pillar Trim, Installation. 5.
Connect the harness side of the connector. Install the lower seat trim.
WARNING: DO NOT CONNECT THE BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE. REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS, DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - AIRBAG SYSTEM FIRST.
6. Close hood. 7. Verify vehicle and system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Page 6291
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation
Fig.5 Child Tether Assembly
Fig.6 Child Tether Anchor
Fig.7 Child Tether Assembly Cap
CHILD TETHER
The Child Tether Assembly consists of the Child Tether Anchor and the Child Tether Assembly
Caps. The Child Tether Anchor is not serviceable. The anchor is located on the rear shelf panel.
The Child Tether Assembly Cap is not serviceable. The rear trim panel will have to be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6296
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Service and Repair
Fig.8 Child Tether Assembly Cap
REMOVAL
1. Open Child Tether Assembly Cap Cover to the full open position. 2. Pull cover upward until
cover detaches from cap.
INSTALLATION
1. Place Child Tether Assembly Cap Cover into position in the cap. 2. Push downward on Child
Tether Assembly Cap Cover till it locks into position (will hear part click into position)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service
Seat Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service
NUMBER: 08-010-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr.25, 2003
SUBJECT: Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service
MODELS:
2001 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon (Front Passenger Seat Belt Only)
1994 (BR) Ram Pickup
1996-2002 (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
2001 - 2003 (DN) Durango (Front Passenger Seat Belt Only)
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
2001 - 2004 (JR) Sebring Convertible/Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1995 - 2003 (PL) Neon/SX 2.0
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser
DISCUSSION:
Any time the seat belt cinch bar (Fig. 1) is loose, missing or damaged it is no longer necessary to
replace the seat belt assembly. Cinch bar repair kits are now available for the vehicles listed. If any
component of the seat belt assembly has been damaged due to collision, the entire assembly must
be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Seat Belt Cinch Bar Service > Page 6301
NOTE:
THE CINCH BAR, CINCH BAR COVER OR ANY OTHER COMPONENT OF THE SEAT BELT
ASSEMBLY MUST NEVER BE PAINTED.
NOTE:
INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS ARE INCLUDED WITH EACH KIT.
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
SELECT THE COLOR CLOSEST TO THE SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY COLOR.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6302
Seat Belt: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6303
Seat Belt: Testing and Inspection
FASTEN SEAT BELT
To test the fasten seat belts function, turn the ignition switch to the ON position with the driver's
seat belt unbuckled and fully retracted. The seat belt warning lamp should light for four to eight
seconds and the tone should sound three to five times.
If the lamp does not light, check the connection at the seat belt retractor. Replace as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat Belt and Retractor - Front Seat
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Seat Belt and Retractor - Front Seat
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
1. Remove B-pillar trim.
Fig.13 Front Seat Belt Retractor
2. Remove bolt attaching seat belt retractor to B-pillar. 3. Disconnect the wire connector to the
retractor. 4. Remove seat belt retractor from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
1. Connect the wire connector to the retractor. 2. Install seat belt retractor into vehicle. 3. Install bolt
attaching seat belt retractor to B-pillar. Tighten seat belt anchor bolt to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 4.
Install B-pillar trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Seat Belt and Retractor - Front Seat > Page 6306
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Seat Belt and Retractor - Rear Seat
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear seat cushion and back. 2. Remove seat belt bezel from parcel shelf cover. 3.
Remove rear seat closure panel silencer pad as necessary to gain access to retractor. 4. Remove
bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor.
Fig.16 Rear Seat Belt & Retractor
5. Remove bolt attaching retractor to rear seat closure panel. 6. Push seat belt bezel and buckle
stab through access hole in parcel shelf. 7. From in trunk compartment, remove rear seat belt
retractor from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position rear seat belt retractor in trunk compartment. 2. Push seat belt bezel and buckle stab
through access hole in rear shelf trim panel. 3. Install bolt attaching retractor to rear seat closure
panel. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Install bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor. Tighten the
seat belt bolt to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Install rear seat closure panel silencer pad. 6. Install
seat belt bezel to the rear shelf trim panel. 7. Install rear seat cushion and back.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
Precautions
Seat Belt Buckle: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Front Seat
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle - Front Seat
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
1. Remove bolt attaching seat belt buckle from seat anchor. 2. Remove seat belt buckle from seat.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
1. Place seat belt buckle in position on seat anchor 2. Install bolt and grommet attaching seat belt
buckle to seat anchor Tighten seat belt anchor bolt to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Seat Belt Buckle - Front Seat > Page 6312
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Seat Belt Buckle - Rear Seat
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear seat cushion 2. Remove rear seat belt buckle bolt 3. Remove rear seat belt buckle
from vehicle
INSTALLATION
1. Install rear seat belt buckle. Tighten the seat belt nut to 57 Nm (42 ft. lbs.) torque. 2. Install rear
seat cushion.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Fig. 28 Body (Left Front) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6316
Fig. 56 Body (Right) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6317
Seat Belt Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service Precautions
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
- Front seat belt adjuster must be in the lowest position when Installing adjuster knob.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service Precautions > Page 6321
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
Fig.13 Front Seat Belt Retractor
1. Remove B-pillar trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information
> Service Precautions > Page 6322
Fig.22 Front Shoulder Belt Adjuster
2. Remove the two bolts attaching shoulder belt adjuster to B-pillar. 3. Remove shoulder belt
adjuster from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
- Front seat belt adjuster must be in the lowest position when Installing adjuster knob.
1. Place into position the shoulder belt adjuster. 2. Install bolts attaching shoulder belt adjuster to
B-pillar. Tighten all seat belt bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Application and ID
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Seat Belt Indicator ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service Precautions
Seat Belt Retractor: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Front
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
1. Remove B-pillar trim.
Fig.13 Front Seat Belt Retractor
2. Remove bolt attaching seat belt retractor to B-pillar. 3. Disconnect the wire connector to the
retractor. 4. Remove seat belt retractor from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision.
1. Connect the wire connector to the retractor. 2. Install seat belt retractor into vehicle. 3. Install bolt
attaching seat belt retractor to B-pillar. Tighten seat belt anchor bolt to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 4.
Install B-pillar trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6331
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Rear
Rear Seat Belt and Retractor
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear seat cushion and back. 2. Remove seat belt bezel from parcel shelf cover. 3.
Remove rear seat closure panel silencer pad as necessary to gain access to retractor. 4. Remove
bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor.
Fig.16 Rear Seat Belt & Retractor
5. Remove bolt attaching retractor to rear seat closure panel. 6. Push seat belt bezel and buckle
stab through access hole in parcel shelf. 7. From in trunk compartment, remove rear seat belt
retractor from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position rear seat belt retractor in trunk compartment. 2. Push seat belt bezel and buckle stab
through access hole in rear shelf trim panel. 3. Install bolt attaching retractor to rear seat closure
panel. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Install bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor. Tighten the
seat belt bolt to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Install rear seat closure panel silencer pad. 6. Install
seat belt bezel to the rear shelf trim panel. 7. Install rear seat cushion and back.
Seat Belt and Retractor - Rear Center Three Point
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear seat cushion and back 2. Remove seat belt bezel from parcel shelf cover. 3.
Remove two push fasteners to NVH cover over retractor. 4. Remove bolt attaching retractor to
floor. 5. Remove bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor. 6. Push seat belt bezel and buckle
stab through access hole in parcel shelf. 7. From in trunk compartment, remove rear seat belt
retractor from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position rear seat belt retractor in trunk compartment. 2. Push seat belt bezel and buckle stab
through access hole in rear shelf trim panel. 3. Install bolt attaching retractor to rear floor. Tighten
to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Install the NVH cover and two push fasteners over the center
retractor. 5. Install bolt attaching seat belt lower anchor to floor. Tighten the seat belt bolt to 57 Nm
(42 ft. lbs.) torque. 6. Install seat belt bezel to the rear shelf trim panel. 7. Install rear seat cushion
and back.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Fig. 28 Body (Left Front) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6336
Fig. 56 Body (Right) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6337
Seat Belt Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service Precautions
Antenna Cable: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM
BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT
PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY
NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE, THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM
CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE PERFORMING FURTHER DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 6344
Antenna Cable: Description and Operation
ANTENNA BODY & CABLE
The antenna body and cable is secured below the fender panel by the antenna cap nut through a
mounting hole in the right front fender. The primary coaxial antenna cable is then routed beneath
the fender sheet metal and through a entry hole in the right cowl side panel into the interior of the
vehicle. Inside the vehicle, the primary coaxial cable is connected to a secondary instrument panel
antenna coaxial cable with an in-line connector that is located behind the right kick panel. The
secondary coaxial cable is then routed behind the instrument panel to the back of the radio.
The antenna body and cable connects the antenna mast to the radio. The radio antenna is an
electromagnetic circuit component used to capture radio frequency signals that are broadcast by
local commercial radio stations in both the Amplitude Modulating (AM) and Frequency Modulating
(FM) frequency ranges. These electromagnetic radio frequency signals induce small electrical
modulations into the antenna as they move past the mast. The antenna body transfers the weak
electromagnetic radio waves induced into the rigid antenna mast into the center conductor of the
flexible primary antenna coaxial cable. The braided outer shield of the antenna coaxial cable is
grounded through both the antenna body and the radio chassis, effectively shielding the radio
waves as they are conducted to the radio. The radio then tunes and amplifies the weak radio
signals into stronger electrical signals in order to operate the audio system speakers.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 6345
Antenna Cable: Testing and Inspection
ANTENNA BODY AND CABLE TESTING
The following four tests are used to diagnose the antenna with an ohmmeter: Test 1 - Mast to ground test
- Test 2 - Tip-of-mast to tip-of-conductor test
- Test 3 - Body ground to battery ground test
- Test 4 - Body ground to antenna coaxial cable shield test.
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR-BAGS, DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM
BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT
PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY
NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE, THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM
CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE PERFORMING FURTHER DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIR-BAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Fig.1 Antenna Tests - Typical
The ohmmeter test lead connections for each test are shown in the illustration.
NOTE: This model has a two-piece antenna coaxial cable. Tests 2 and 4 must be conducted in two
steps to isolate an antenna cable problem. First, test the primary antenna cable (integral to the
antenna body and cable) from the coaxial cable connector under the right end of the instrument
panel near the right cowl side inner panel to the antenna body. Then, test the secondary antenna
cable (instrument panel antenna cable) from the coaxial cable connector under the right end of the
instrument panel near the right cowl side inner panel to the coaxial cable connector at the radio.
TEST 1
Test 1 determines if the antenna mast is insulated from ground. Proceed as follows: 1. Disconnect
and isolate the antenna coaxial cable connector under the right end of the instrument panel near
the right cowl side inner panel. 2. Touch one ohmmeter test lead to the tip of the antenna mast.
Touch the other test lead to the antenna cap nut. Check the ohmmeter reading for
continuity.
3. There should be no continuity. If OK, go to Test 2. If not OK, replace the faulty antenna body and
cable.
TEST 2
Test 2 checks the antenna conductor components for an open circuit. This test should be
performed first on the entire antenna circuit, from the antenna mast to the center conductor of the
coaxial cable connector at the radio. If an open circuit is detected, each of the three antenna
conductor components (antenna mast, antenna body and primary cable unit, instrument panel
antenna secondary cable) should be isolated and tested individually to locate the exact component
that is the source of the open circuit.
To begin this test, proceed as follows: 1. Disconnect the instrument panel (secondary) antenna
cable coaxial connector from the back of the radio. 2. Touch one ohmmeter test lead to the tip of
the antenna mast. Touch the other test lead to the center conductor pin of the instrument panel
antenna
cable coaxial connector for the radio. Check the ohmmeter reading for continuity.
3. There should be continuity. The ohmmeter should register only a fraction of an ohm resistance.
High or infinite resistance indicates a damaged or
open antenna conductor. If OK, go to Test 3. If not OK, isolate and test each of the individual
antenna conductor components. Replace only the
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 6346
faulty antenna conductor component.
TEST 3
Test 3 checks the condition of the vehicle body ground connection. To begin this test, proceed as
follows: 1. This test must be performed with the battery positive cable disconnected from the
battery. Disconnect and isolate both battery cables, negative
cable first.
2. Reconnect the battery negative cable. 3. Touch one ohmmeter test lead to a good clean ground
point on the vehicle fender. Touch the other test lead to the battery negative terminal post.
Check the ohmmeter reading for continuity.
4. There should be continuity. The ohmmeter should register less than one ohm resistance. High or
infinite resistance indicates a loose, corroded, or
damaged connection between the battery negative terminal and the vehicle body. If OK, go to Test
4. If not OK, check the battery negative cable connection to the vehicle body and the radio noise
suppression ground strap connections to the engine and the vehicle body for being loose or
corroded. Clean or tighten these connections as required.
TEST 4
Test 4 checks the condition of between the antenna coaxial cable vehicle body ground as follows:
1. Disconnect and isolate the antenna coaxial cable connector under the right end of the instrument
panel near the right cowl side inner panel 2. Touch one ohmmeter test lead to a good clean ground
point on the vehicle fender Touch the other test lead to the outer crimp on the antenna
coaxial cable connector under the right end of the instrument panel near the right cowl side inner
panel Check the ohmmeter reading for continuity
3. There should be continuity The ohmmeter should register less than one ohm resistance High or
infinite resistance indicates a loose, corroded, or
damaged connection between the antenna body and the vehicle body or between the antenna
body and the antenna coaxial cable shield If not OK, clean the antenna body to fender mating
surfaces and tighten the antenna cap nut to specifications
4. Check the resistance again with an ohmmeter. If the resistance is still more then one ohm,
replace the faulty antenna body and cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 6347
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove antenna mast by unscrewing mast
from antenna body. 3. Locate the antenna lead disconnect in the instrument panel wire harness
above the passenger side cowl trim panel. Disconnect the antenna cable
from the instrument panel cable lead.
Mast And Antenna Assembly Mounting
4. Unfasten push pins from the rear of the plastic inner fender shield and move shield to gain
access to the base/cable assembly. 5. Remove cap nut and adapter. Remove base/cable
assembly from bottom of the load beam.
INSTALLATION
1. From under the fender, push the antenna base and cable assembly through the hole in the
fender. Seat grommet in the load beam. 2. From above the fender, place adapter, then the cap nut
on the base/cable assembly. Tighten the cap nut to 7 Nm (61 in. lbs.). 3. Seat the grommet in the
side panel and connect the cable to the instrument panel harness connector. 4. Install the plastic
inner fender shield. 5. Install passenger cowl side trim panel 6. Install antenna mast 7. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Horn >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Alarm Horn: Description and Operation
SIREN (EXPORT)
Fig.6 Vehicle Theft Security Siren
Some vehicles equipped with the premium Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) utilize a separate
siren. This siren is dedicated to the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) and is controlled by the
ARKEM module (Remote Keyless Entry). The siren can reach sound decibels as high as 110 dB. A
internal battery-backup power source and auto detect feature are also built into the siren. The
internal battery-backup provides sufficient power to sound the alarm even if the vehicle's electrical
system is depleted. The auto detect feature has the ability to sound the siren if any of the wires
(voltage supply, ground and signal) leading to the siren are cut while the system is armed.
In the event the vehicle theft security is triggered, the ARKEM module will sound the siren.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Horn >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6352
Alarm Horn: Service and Repair
SIREN (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the left rear wheel well splash
shield. 3. Remove the air blocker to see siren. 4. Disconnect the siren electrical connector.
Fig.7 Siren - Remove/Install
5. Remove the siren retaining screws and remove the siren from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position siren and install retaining screws. 2. Connect the siren electrical connector. 3. Install air
blocker in original position. 4. Install the left rear wheel well splash shield. 5. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr
> 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Alarm Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr
> 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6361
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alarm Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Alarm Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Alarm Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6367
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Alarm Module: Component Locations
Fig.9 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) Location
Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6370
Alarm Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6371
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6372
Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6373
Alarm Module: Description and Operation
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE (SKIM)
Fig.13 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Fig.14 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Location
The Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) contains a Radio Frequency (RF) transceiver and a
microprocessor The SKIM retains in memory the ID numbers of any Sentry Key that is
programmed to it The maximum number of keys that may be programmed to each module is eight
(8). The SKIM also communicates over the PCI bus with the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), the
instrument cluster, and the DRB III scan tool. The SKIM transmits and receives RF signals through
a tuned antenna enclosed within a molded plastic ring formation that is integral to the SKIM
housing. When the SKIM is properly installed on the steering column, the antenna ring fits snugly
around the circumference of the ignition lock cylinder housing. If this ring is not mounted properly,
communication problems may arise in the form of transponder-related faults.
For added system security, each SKIM is programmed with a unique "Secret Key" code. This code
is stored in memory and is sent over the PCI bus to the PCM and to each key that is programmed
to work with the vehicle. The "Secret Key" code is therefore a common element found in all
components of the Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS). In the event that a SKIM replacement is
required, the "Secret Key" code can be restored from the PCM by following the SKIM replacement
procedure found in the DRB III scan tool. Proper completion of this task will allow the existing
ignition keys to be reprogrammed. Therefore, new keys will NOT be needed. In the event that the
original "Secret Key" code can not be recovered, new ignition keys will be required. The DRB III
scan tool will alert the technician if key replacement is necessary. Another security code, called a
PIN, is used to gain
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6374
secured access to the SKIM for service. The SKIM also stores in its memory the Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN), which it learns through a bus message from the PCM during
initialization. The SKIS scrambles the information that is communicated between its components in
order to reduce the possibility of unauthorized SKIM access and/or disabling.
When the ignition switch is moved to the RUN position, the SKIM transmits an RF signal to the
transponder in the ignition key. The SKIM then waits for a response RF signal from the transponder
in the key. If the response received identifies the key as valid, the SKIM sends a "valid key"
message to the PCM over the PCI bus. If the response received identifies the key as invalid or no
response is received from the transponder in the ignition key, the SKIM sends an "invalid key"
message to the PCM. The PCM will enable or disable engine operation based upon the status of
the SKIM messages. It is important to note that the default condition in the PCM is "invalid key."
Therefore, if no response is received by the PCM, the engine will be immobilized after two (2)
seconds of running.
The SKIM also sends indicator light status messages to the instrument cluster to tell that module
how to operate the light. This may consist of turning the light ON for a three (3) second bulb test
when the ignition switch is first turned to the ON position. It is also the method used to turn the light
ON solid or to flash it after the indicator light test is complete to signify a fault in the SKIS. If the
light comes ON and stays ON solid after the indicator light test, this signifies that the SKIM has
detected a system malfunction and/or that the SKIS has become inoperative. If the SKIM detects
an invalid key OR a key-related fault exists, the indicator light will flash following the indicator light
test. The SKIM may also request an audible chime if the customer key programming feature is
available and the procedure is being utilized.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Remove Lower Instrument Panel
Cover. Refer to Body, Instrument Panel, Lower Instrument Panel Cover, Removal. 3. Remove the
steering column upper and lower shrouds. Refer to Steering, Column, Column Shroud, Removal.
Fig.15 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) Remove/Install
4. Disengage the steering column wire harness from the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM). 5.
Remove the two screws securing the SKIM to the top of the steering column. 6. Rotate the SKIM
and its mounting bracket upwards and then to the side away from the steering column to slide the
SKIM antenna ring from
around the ignition switch lock cylinder housing.
7. Remove the SKIM from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If the SKIM is replaced with a new unit, a DRB III scan tool MUST be used to initialize the
new SKIM and to program at least two Sentry Key transponders (Refer to
ELECTRICAL/ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE).
1. Place the SKIM into position. 2. Rotate the SKIM and its mounting bracket downwards and then
to the side towards the steering column. 3. Install the two screws securing the SKIM to the top of
the steering column. 4. Engage the steering column wire harness to the Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module (SKIM). 5. Install the steering column upper and lower shrouds. Refer to Steering, Column,
Column Shroud, Installation. 6. Install the Lower Instrument Panel Cover. Refer to Body,
Instrument Panel, Lower Instrument Panel Cover, Installation. 7. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement > Page 6377
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Programming the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
PROGRAMMING THE SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM,
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select SKIM MODULE REPLACEMENT (GASOLINE). 4.
Program the vehicle four-digit PIN into the SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct
country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select UPDATE VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to transfer the
VIN (the PCM will send the VIN to the SKIM). 8. The DRBIII will ask if you want to transfer the
secret key. Select ENTER to transfer secret key from the PCM. This will ensure the current vehicle
ignition keys will still operate the SKIS system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement > Page 6378
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Programming Ignition Keys to the Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park / Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM, then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM AT ONE TIME. Once a key is
learned to a SKIM it (the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRBIII will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRBIII attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed in the SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed - (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle.
8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done - SKIM transponder ID memory is full. 1. Obtain
ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum) 2. Using the DRBIII, erase all
ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS 3. Program
all ignition keys.
Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement > Page 6379
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Sentry Key Immobilizer System Initialization
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) initialization should be performed following a Sentry
Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) replacement. It can be summarized as follows:
1. Obtain the vehicle's unique four-digit PIN assigned to its original SKIM from the vehicle owner,
the vehicle's invoice, or from Chrysler's Customer
Center.
2. Using a DRB III scan tool, select "Theft Alarm," "SKIM," "Miscellaneous," and then "SKIM
Module Replaced."
a. Enter Secured Access Mode using the unique four-digit PIN. b. Program the vehicle's VIN
number into the SKIM's memory. c. Program the country code into the SKIM's memory (for North
America, choose US or domestic). d. The vehicle's unique Secret Key data will be retrieved from
the PCM automatically. If this data is corrupt or not present, you will be prompted
to cut new keys for this vehicle.
3. Program all customer keys into the SKIM's memory.
This process will require that the SKIM to be in the Secured Access Mode. The PIN must be
entered into the DRB III scan tool before the SKIM will enter the Secured Access Mode. Once
entered, Secured Access Mode shall be active until 60 seconds after the last command requiring
secured access was received and acknowledged.
Two exceptions to this rule are:
- When you have used the 'erase all keys' command OR
- When you have just programmed a new key. If either of these functions are performed
successfully while in the Secured Access Mode, this mode will be exited immediately following the
function.
NOTE: If a PCM is replaced, the unique 'Secret Key' data must be transferred from the SKIM to the
new PCM using the PCM replacement procedure. This procedure requires the Secured Access
Mode as well and can be found in the DRB III scan tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement > Page 6380
Alarm Module: Service and Repair PCM/SKIM Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement > Page 6381
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Description and Operation
Alarm System Transponder: Description and Operation
Sentry Key Immobilizer Transponder
TRANSPONDER KEY
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) uses a transponder chip that is integral to each ignition
key to communicate with the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM). Ignition keys are supplied
with the vehicle when it is shipped from the factory The transponder chip is undermolded within the
head of the key. This undermold is hidden beneath an overmolded rubber cap.
Each Sentry Key has a unique transponder identification code permanently programmed into it by
the manufacturer. Likewise, the SKIM has a unique "Secret Key" code programmed into it by the
manufacturer as well. When a Sentry Key is programmed into the memory of the SKIM, the SKIM
stores the transponder identification code from the Sentry Key, and the Sentry Key learns the
"Secret Key" code from the SKIM. Once the Sentry Key learns the "Secret Key" code of the SKIM,
it is also permanently programmed into the transponder's memory Therefore, blank keys for the
SKIS must be programmed by the SKIM in addition to being cut to match the mechanical coding of
the ignition lock cylinder. Refer to Electrical, Vehicle Theft Security Transponder Key, Standard
Procedure - Transponder Programming.
The Sentry Key's transponder is within the range of the SKIM's transceiver antenna ring when it is
inserted into the ignition lock cylinder. When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the
SKIM communicates with the Sentry Key via a radio frequency (RF) signal. The SKIM determines if
a valid key is present based on the information it receives from the Sentry Key. If a valid key is
detected, that fact is communicated to the PCM via the PCI bus and the vehicle is allowed to
continue running. If an invalid key is received by the PCM or no status at all is communicated, the
vehicle will stall after two (2) seconds of running. The indicator light will be flashing at this point.
The Sentry Key's transponder can not be repaired. If it is faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6385
Alarm System Transponder: Service and Repair
TRANSPONDER PROGRAMMING
Using a DRB III Scan Tool
All Sentry Keys included with the vehicle are preprogrammed to work with the Sentry Key
Immobilizer System (SKIS) when it is shipped from the factory. The Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
(SKIM) can be programmed to recognize up to a total of eight Sentry Keys. When programming a
blank Sentry Key transponder, the key must first be cut to match the ignition lock cylinder of the
vehicle for which it will be used. The vehicle's four digit PIN code will be required to complete this
task since you will need it to enter the Secured Access Mode in the SKIM. The following steps must
be completed using a DRB III scan tool:
1. Insert the blank key into the ignition and turn it to the RUN position. 2. Using a DRB III scan tool,
select "Theft Alarm," "SKIM," "Miscellaneous," and then "Program Ignition Key." 3. Enter the four
digit PIN code using the DRB III scan tool. When programming is completed, the SKIM will exit
Secured Access Mode and the
DRB III scan tool will display the results of your attempt to program the key. One of five distinct
results may be displayed. All five are listed below:
- "Programming Successful" is displayed if the Sentry Key programming is successful.
- "Learned Key in Ignition" is displayed if the key in the ignition has already been programmed into
that vehicle's SKIM.
- "Eight Keys Already Learned (At The Maximum) Programming Not Done" is displayed if eight
keys have already been programmed into the SKIM. In this case, if a new key needs to be added
due to a lost or defective key, the "Erase All Keys" command (which requires entering the Secured
Access Mode) has to be performed. Following the "Erase All Keys" command, all keys that will be
used to operate the vehicle MUST be reprogrammed to the SKIM.
- "Programming Not Attempted" is displayed after an "Erase All Keys" function is executed.
- "Programming Key Failed" is displayed if further diagnosis is required.
To learn additional keys, turn the ignition OFF, remove the learned key, insert the next new blank
key, and repeat the steps from the beginning.
"Customer Learn" Mode
This feature is only available on domestic vehicles or those which have a U.S. country code
designator. This procedure requires access to at least two valid Sentry Keys. If two valid Sentry
Keys are not available, Sentry Key programming will require the use of a DRB III scan tool.
The steps required to program Sentry Keys with two valid Sentry Keys follows: 1. Obtain the blank
Sentry Key(s) that need to be programmed. Cut the keys to match the ignition lock cylinder
mechanical key codes. 2. Insert one of the two valid Sentry Keys into the ignition switch and turn
the ignition switch to the ON position. 3. After the ignition switch has been in the ON position for
longer than three seconds, but no more than fifteen seconds, cycle the ignition switch
back to the OFF position. Replace the first valid Sentry Key in the ignition lock cylinder with the
second valid Sentry Key and turn the ignition switch back to the ON position. The second valid
Sentry Key must be inserted, and the ignition key to the ON position, within 15 seconds of
removing the first valid Sentry key.
4. About 10 seconds after the completion of Step 3, the indicator light will start to flash and a single
audible chime tone will sound to indicate that
the system has entered the "Customer Learn" programming mode.
5. Within 60 seconds of entering the "Customer Learn" programming mode, turn the ignition switch
to the OFF position, replace the valid Sentry
Key with a blank Sentry Key transponder, and turn the ignition switch back to the ON position.
6. About 10 seconds after the completion of Step 5, a single audible chime tone will sound and the
indicator light will stop flashing and stay on solid
for three (3) seconds and then turn off to indicate that the blank Sentry Key has been successfully
programmed. The SKIS will immediately exit the "Customer Learn" programming mode and the
vehicle may be started using the newly programmed Sentry Key.
These steps must be completed in their entirety for each additional Sentry Key to be programmed.
If any of the above steps are not completed in the given sequence, or within the allotted time, the
SKIS will exit the "Customer Learn" programming mode and the programming will be unsuccessful.
The SKIS will also automatically exit the "Customer Learn" programming mode if: It sees a non-blank Sentry Key when it should see a blank.
- If it has already programmed eight (8) valid Sentry Keys.
- If the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position for more than about 50 seconds.
NOTE: If you attempt to start the vehicle while in "Customer Learn" mode (LED flashing), the
vehicle will behave as though an invalid key is being used (i.e. the engine will stall after two (2)
seconds of running). No faults will be logged.
NOTE: Once a Sentry Key has been programmed to a particular vehicle, it cannot be used on any
other vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Hood Sensor/Switch
(For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6389
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
HOOD AJAR SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Open hood.
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable - Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
hood ajar switch.
Fig.2 Hood Ajar Switch Location
4. Firmly press tangs on the bottom side of the switch together and push up through bracket. 5.
Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Firmly press hood ajar switch through bracket. 2. Connect wire harness connector to hood ajar
switch. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Close hood. 5. Verify vehicle and system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Ignition Key In Signal,
Antitheft > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Ignition Key In Signal: Testing and Inspection
KEY LEFT IN IGNITION
To test the key left in ignition function, insert key into the ignition and open the driver's door. Chime
should sound until key is removed from ignition or driver's door is closed.
If these conditions are met and there is still a problem with the system, refer to Electrical,
Chime/Buzzer, Diagnosis and Testing - Chime System Conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry
Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry
Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6402
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6408
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6411
Keyless Entry Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6412
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6413
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6414
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6415
Remote Keyless Entry Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6416
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
There are 2 Remote Keyless Entry Modules for the 2002 module year, premium and base. The
base module is for a vehicle with power door locks only. The base module performs the same
functions that the premium module does but has no provisions for Vehicle Theft Security System
(VTSS) or Remote Keyless Entry. Both modules communicate with other modules via the PCI bus
circuit.
The module monitors the Airbag Control Module messages for the purpose of monitoring the
deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message, along with the verification that the ignition
is on, it will provide the "enhanced accident response feature". This feature will cause the module
to unlock all doors and the instrument cluster to turn the courtesy lamps ON.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message and receive
body style information.
The Base module wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses
a signal from the driver or passenger (BUX) cylinder lock switch. The premium module wakes up
the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses a signal from the RKE
transmitter.
Two RKE transmitters are supplied with a premium equipped vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. Horn chirp on a premium equipped vehicle is customer programmable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6417
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
For procedures on diagnosing and testing the RKE Module's RKE functions, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Description and Operation
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system Radio Frequency (RF) transmitter is equipped with four
buttons, labeled LOCK, UNLOCK, DECK LID RELEASE, and PANIC. It is also equipped with a key
ring and is designed to serve as a key fob. The operating range of the transmitter radio signal is up
to 10 meters (30 feet) from the RKE receiver.
Each RKE transmitter has a different vehicle access code, which must be programmed into the
memory of the RKE receiver in the vehicle in order to operate the RKE system. Two transmitters
are provided with the vehicle, but the RKE receiver can retain the access codes of up to four
transmitters in its memory.
The RKE transmitter operates on two Panasonic CR2016 (or equivalent) batteries. Typical battery
life is from one to two years. The RKE transmitter cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it
must be replaced.
The transmitter has four buttons for operation. They are LOCK, UNLOCK, DECK LID RELEASE,
and PANIC.
- The UNLOCK button will unlock the driver's door, flash the park lamps twice and enable
illuminated entry. Pushing and releasing the button once will unlock the driver's door. Pushing and
releasing the button two times, within a five second interval, will unlock all doors.
- Upon pressing the LOCK button, the horn will sound a short CHIRP (if enabled) and flash the park
lamps to notify that the all door lock signal was received and set. Illuminated entry is cancelled and
the interior lamps are faded to OFF.
- Pushing and releasing the DECK LID RELEASE button two times within a five second interval,
will slightly ajar the deck lid.
- Pushing and holding the PANIC button will cause the panic alarm to sound for three minutes, until
the panic button is pressed and held a second time, or the vehicle reaches a speed of 15 mph.
The receiver is capable of retaining a Vehicle Access Code (VAC) even when power is removed.
Each Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) module must have at least one and no more than four
transmitters.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmitter Programming
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Transmitter Programming
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
The Remote Keyless Entry transmitters can be programmed with the use of the DRB III scan tool
or by the customer.
DRB III Programming When Using The DRB III Scan Tool, SELECT: 1. "Theft Alarm" 2. "VTSS" 3.
"Miscellaneous" and then the desired function.
Customer Programming For a customer to be able to program RKE transmitters themselves, at
least one RKE transmitter must be programmed already This procedure is to add additional
transmitters. If all transmitters are lost, the DRB III scan tool must be used to program the new
transmitters. 1. Insert the key into the ignition switch, and turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position (without starting the vehicle). 2. Using the RKE transmitter programmed to the RKE
module, press and continuously hold down the UNLOCK button for 4 - 10 seconds. 3. Within the 4 10 second time range, continue to hold the UNLOCK button and press the PANIC button. Both
buttons may then be released. Upon
the PANIC button being depressed, the message for customer programming mode will be
transmitted to the RKE module.
4. A chime will be heard to verify that the customer programming mode has been entered. 5. Press
and release any button on each transmitter that is to be programmed to the RKE module, including
any transmitters which were previously
programmed to the RKE module (with a maximum of four possible). After each transmitter is
successfully programmed, a chime will be heard to verify that successful programming of the
transmitter has occurred.
6. After 30 seconds, or upon the ignition switch being turned OFF, a chime will indicate that the
RKE module has exited the programming mode.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmitter Programming > Page 6423
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Keyless Entry Transmitter Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove front door trim panel. 3.
Disconnect wire connector. 4. Remove two attaching screws. 5. Remove the switch from the door
panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch to the door panel. 2. Install the two attaching screws. 3. Connect the one wire
connector. 4. Install the front door trim panel. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6428
Lock Cylinder Switch: Connector Locations
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6429
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6430
Lock Cylinder Switch: Diagrams
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Left Cylinder Lock Switch (Premium)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6431
Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. Refer to Body, Door - Front, Trim Panel, Removal. 2. Remove the
illuminated entry switch wiring clip and disconnect connector. 3. Remove door cylinder lock switch
from door handle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the door cylinder lock switch from door handle. 2. Install the illuminated entry switch wiring
clip and disconnect connector. 3. Install the door trim panel. Refer to Body, Door - Front, Trim
Panel, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Security Lamp/Indicator
> Component Information > Application and ID
Security Lamp/Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Security Alarm Indicator ......................................................................................................................
................................................................. LED
All the interior bulbs are brass or glass wedge base. Aluminum base bulbs are not approved and
should not be used for replacement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Security Lamp/Indicator
> Component Information > Application and ID > Page 6435
Security Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
SKIS INDICATOR LAMP
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) uses the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS)
indicator LED to give an indication when the SKIS is faulty or when the vehicle has been
immobilized due to the use of an invalid ignition key. The LED is controlled by the instrument
cluster circuitry based upon messages received from the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM).
The SKIM sends messages to the instrument cluster, to turn the LED on for about three seconds
when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position as a bulb test. After completion of the bulb
test, the SKIM sends PCI bus messages to keep the LED off for a duration of about one second.
Then the SKIM sends messages to the instrument cluster circuitry to turn the LED on or off based
upon the results of the SKIS self-tests. If the VTSS indicator LED comes on and stays on after the
bulb test, it indicates that the SKIM has detected a system malfunction and/or that the SKIS has
become inoperative. If the SKIM detects an invalid key when the ignition switch is turned to the ON
position, it sends messages to the instrument cluster to flash the VTSS indicator LED.
The SKIM can also send messages to the instrument cluster to flash the LED and to generate a
single audible chime tone. These functions serve as an indication to the customer that the SKIS
has been placed in its "Customer Learn" programming mode. See Sentry Key Immobilizer System
Transponder Programming in this group for more information on the "Customer Learn"
programming mode.
The VTSS indicator LED uses a Light Emitting Diode (LED) on the instrument cluster electronic
circuit board. It is not serviceable separate from the instrument cluster assembly. If the VTSS
indicator LED comes on and stays on after the bulb test function, diagnosis of the SKIS should be
performed with a DRB III scan tool and the proper Powertrain Diagnostic Procedures manual.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Trunk/Liftgate
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Trunk/Liftgate
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6440
Fig. 48 Decklid - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Trunk/Liftgate
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6441
Decklid Security Switch (Knock Out)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Trunk/Liftgate
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6442
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
DECKLID SECURITY SWITCH
REMOVAL
The Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) Deck Lid Security Switch is mounted to the back of the
deck lid lock cylinder.
1. Open deck lid. 2. Disconnect wire connector to switch. 3. Remove the spring clip retainer. 4. Pull
switch off of deck lid lock cylinder and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Push switch onto the deck lid lock cylinder. 2. Install the spring clip retainer. 3. Connect the wire
connector to switch. 4. Close the deck lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Intrusion Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6447
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6448
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6449
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6450
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6451
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6452
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6453
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6454
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6455
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6456
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6457
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6458
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6459
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6460
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6461
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6462
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6463
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6464
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6465
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6466
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6467
Intrusion Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6468
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6469
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6470
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6471
Domelamp / Intrusion Sensor (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6472
Intrusion Sensor: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagram sheets may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
8w-39-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6473
8w-39-3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6474
8w-39-4 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6475
8w-39-5 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6476
8w-39-6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6477
8w-39-7 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6478
8w-39-8 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6479
8w-39-9
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6480
8w-39-10 (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6481
8w-39-11 (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6482
8w-39-12
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6483
8w-39-13 (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6484
8w-39-14 (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6485
8w-39-15 (Export)
NOTE: Other diagrams referred to by number (8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams can be found
at Diagrams by Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6486
Intrusion Sensor: Description and Operation
ULTRASONIC INTRUSION SENSOR
Fig.3 VTSS Intrusion Sensor
Some vehicles equipped with the premium Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) use a ultrasonic
intrusion sensor. This intrusion sensor is integrated into the dome lamp and detects any movement
in the cabin when the VTSS system and the intrusion sensor are armed The sensor cannot be
serviced separately and if found to be faulty the entire dome lamp assembly must be replaced
In the event the intrusion sensor detects movement inside the vehicle's interior (with system
armed), the ARKEM module will sound the siren.
DISARMING THE INTRUSION SENSOR
- Press the "LOCK" button on Remote Keyless Entry transmitter THREE times within five (5)
seconds This operation must be performed during the first 16 seconds of VTSS system arming
- Rotating the drivers door key cylinder THREE times within five (5) seconds This operation must
be performed during the first 16 seconds of VTSS system arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6487
Intrusion Sensor: Service and Repair
ULTRASONIC INTRUSION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable
Fig.4 Dome Lamp Unit With Intrusion Sensor Removal
2. Grasp the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor and rotate counterclockwise. 3. Pull straight
down on dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor. 4. Disconnect electrical connector. 5. Remove the
dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor from the vehicle
INSTALLATION
1. Connect electrical connector
Fig.5 Dome Lamp Unit With Intrusion Sensor Orientation To Headliner
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Intrusion Sensor <-->
[Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6488
2. Orient the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor in a way that the tabs align with the slots in the
headliner. 3. Push the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor straight up. 4. Rotate the dome lamp
unit with intrusion sensor clockwise. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > CD Changer > Component Information > Diagrams
Compact Disc Changer
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > CD Changer > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6494
CD Changer: Description and Operation
CD CHANGER
The In-Dash CD Changer (if equipped) is located in the instrument panel below the radio The
remote changer does not use a cartridge or magazine for the CD's Up to 6 CD's (4 in some export
markets) can be directly loaded into this unit, one at a time
Due to its compact design, the CD changer can carry out only one operation at a time For example,
you can not load a new disc while playing another at the same time Each operation happens
sequentially
The radio unit provides control over all features of the CD changer with the exception of the CD
load and eject functions, which are controlled by buttons located on the front of the CD changer All
features you would expect, such as Disc Up/Down, Track Up/Down, Random and Scan are
controlled by the radio, which also displays all relevant CD changer information on the radio
display.
The CD changer contains a Load/Eject button and an indicator LED for each of the disc positions
as well as an illuminated disc opening. The individual LED indicates whether a CD is currently
loaded or ready to load in that particular chamber of the CD changer. Pressing the individual
Load/Eject button for a particular chamber will eject a disc currently present in that chamber. If the
chamber is currently empty, actuating the Load/Eject button will position that chamber to receive
and load a new disc in that chamber.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > CD Changer > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6495
CD Changer: Service and Repair
CD CHANGER
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755),
gently pry out on CD changer bezel and remove.
Fig.3 CD Changer Remove/Install
3. Remove two retaining screws to CD changer. 4. Pull CD changer out of instrument panel and
disconnect harness connector from rear of changer. 5. Remove CD changer from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect harness connector to CD changer. 2. Install CD changer to vehicle. 3. Install retaining
screws. 4. Install CD changer bezel. 5. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter: Description and Operation
RADIO NOISE SUPPRESSION COMPONENTS
The vehicle has the following noise suppression components which, if disconnected, may interfere
with radio reception: Cylinder head to body ground strap (Y-strap).
- Battery tray to transmission ground strap (automatic transmission only).
- Hood hinge straps (left and right).
- Noise suppression capacitor.
- Strut to body ground straps (left and right). Resistive type spark plug cables in the high tension
circuit of the ignition system complete the interference suppression. Faulty or deteriorated spark
plug wires should be replaced.
There are two common strategies that can be used to suppress Radio Frequency Interference
(RFI) and Electro-Magnetic Interference (EMI) radio noise. The first suppression strategy involves
preventing the production of RFI and EMI electromagnetic signals at their sources. The second
suppression strategy involves preventing the reception of RFI and EMI electromagnetic signals by
the audio system components.
The use of braided ground straps in key locations is part of the RFI and EMI prevention strategy.
These ground straps ensure adequate ground paths, particularly for high current components such
as many of those found in the starting, charging, ignition, engine control and transmission control
systems. An insufficient ground path for any of these high current components may result in radio
noise caused by induced voltages created as the high current seeks alternative ground paths
through components or circuits intended for use by, or in close proximity to the audio system
components or circuits.
Preventing the reception of RFI and EMI is accomplished by ensuring that the audio system
components are correctly installed in the vehicle. Loose, corroded or improperly soldered wire
harness connections, improperly routed wiring and inadequate audio system component grounding
can all contribute to the reception of RFI and EMI. A properly grounded antenna body and radio
chassis, as well as a shielded antenna coaxial cable with clean and tight connections will each help
reduce the potential for reception of RFI and EMI.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams
Speaker: Diagrams
Left Front Door Speaker
Left Instrument Panel Speaker
Left Rear Speaker
Right Front Door Speaker
Right Instrument Panel Speaker
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6503
Right Rear Speaker
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6504
Speaker: Description and Operation
SPEAKERS
The standard equipment speaker system includes speakers in six locations. One 2.5 centimeter
(1.0 in.) diameter speaker is installed on each end of the instrument panel top pad. One 16.5
centimeter (6.5 in.) full-range speaker is located in each front door. There is also two full-range
15.2 X 22.8 centimeter (6 X 9 in.) diameter full-range speakers located in the rear shelf.
Two wires connected to each speaker, one feed circuit (+) and one return circuit (-), allow the audio
output signal electrical current to flow through the voice coil. For complete circuit diagrams, refer to
the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper wire
and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector pin-out
information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6505
Speaker: Testing and Inspection
SPEAKER DIAGNOSIS
Any diagnosis of the Audio system should begin with the use of the DRB III diagnostic tool.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information includes wiring diagrams, proper
wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness routing and retention, connector
pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness connectors, splices and
grounds.
WARNING: DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL,
STEERING COLUMN, SEAT BELT TENSIONER, SIDE AIRBAG, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL
COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY
NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE, THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM
CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE PERFORMING FURTHER DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
CAUTION: The speaker output of the radio is a "floating ground" system. Do not allow any speaker
lead to short to ground, as damage to the radio may result.
1. If all speakers are inoperative, check the fuses in the fuse block. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK,
repair the shorted circuit or component as required
and replace the faulty fuse.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Turn the radio receiver ON. Adjust the balance and
fader control controls to check the performance of
each individual speaker. Note the speaker locations that are not performing correctly. Go to Step 3.
3. Turn the radio receiver OFF. Turn the ignition OFF. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative
cable. Remove the radio receiver. 4. Check both the speaker feed (+) circuit and return (-) circuit
cavities for the inoperative speaker at the radio receiver wire harness connector for
continuity to ground. There should be no continuity. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the
shorted speaker feed (+) and/or return (-) circuits(s) to the speaker as required.
5. Disconnect wire harness connector at the inoperative speaker. Check for continuity between the
speaker feed (+) circuit cavities of the radio
receiver wire harness connector and the speaker wire harness connector. Repeat the check
between the speaker return (-) circuit cavities of the radio receiver wire harness connector and the
speaker wire harness connector. In each case, there should be continuity. If OK, replace the faulty
speaker. If not OK, repair the open speaker feed (+) and/or return (-) circuits(s) as required.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Door
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Front Door
FRONT DOOR
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove front door trim panel.
Fig.6 Front Door Speaker Remove/Install
3. Remove speaker retaining screws. 4. Remove speaker assembly and disconnect wire connector
from rear of speaker.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect wire connector to speaker and install speaker to vehicle. 2. Install speaker retaining
screws. 3. Install front door trim panel. 4. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Door > Page 6508
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Instrument Panel
INSTRUMENT PANEL
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove instrument panel top cover.
Fig.7 Instrument Panel Speakers Remove/Install
3. Remove speaker retaining screws. 4. Remove speaker and disconnect wire connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect wire harness to the speaker and install speaker to instrument panel. 2. Install speaker
retaining screws. 3. Install instrument panel top cover. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Speaker Replacement - Front Door > Page 6509
Speaker: Service and Repair Speaker Replacement - Rear
REAR
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove Rear Seat Cushion. 3. Remove
rear seat back. 4. Remove rear shelf panel.
Fig.8 Rear Shelf Speaker(s) Remove/Install
5. Remove four speaker retaining screws. 6. Remove speaker and disconnect wire connector. 7.
Remove speaker(s) from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect wire connector to the speaker. 2. Install speaker to the vehicle. 3. Install speaker
retaining screws. 4. Install rear shelf panel. 5. Install seat back. 6. Install rear seat cushion. 7.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Alarm Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6519
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Alarm Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alarm Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6525
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Alarm Module: Component Locations
Fig.9 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) Location
Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6528
Alarm Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6529
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6530
Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6531
Alarm Module: Description and Operation
SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE (SKIM)
Fig.13 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
Fig.14 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Location
The Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) contains a Radio Frequency (RF) transceiver and a
microprocessor The SKIM retains in memory the ID numbers of any Sentry Key that is
programmed to it The maximum number of keys that may be programmed to each module is eight
(8). The SKIM also communicates over the PCI bus with the Powertrain Control Module (PCM), the
instrument cluster, and the DRB III scan tool. The SKIM transmits and receives RF signals through
a tuned antenna enclosed within a molded plastic ring formation that is integral to the SKIM
housing. When the SKIM is properly installed on the steering column, the antenna ring fits snugly
around the circumference of the ignition lock cylinder housing. If this ring is not mounted properly,
communication problems may arise in the form of transponder-related faults.
For added system security, each SKIM is programmed with a unique "Secret Key" code. This code
is stored in memory and is sent over the PCI bus to the PCM and to each key that is programmed
to work with the vehicle. The "Secret Key" code is therefore a common element found in all
components of the Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS). In the event that a SKIM replacement is
required, the "Secret Key" code can be restored from the PCM by following the SKIM replacement
procedure found in the DRB III scan tool. Proper completion of this task will allow the existing
ignition keys to be reprogrammed. Therefore, new keys will NOT be needed. In the event that the
original "Secret Key" code can not be recovered, new ignition keys will be required. The DRB III
scan tool will alert the technician if key replacement is necessary. Another security code, called a
PIN, is used to gain
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6532
secured access to the SKIM for service. The SKIM also stores in its memory the Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN), which it learns through a bus message from the PCM during
initialization. The SKIS scrambles the information that is communicated between its components in
order to reduce the possibility of unauthorized SKIM access and/or disabling.
When the ignition switch is moved to the RUN position, the SKIM transmits an RF signal to the
transponder in the ignition key. The SKIM then waits for a response RF signal from the transponder
in the key. If the response received identifies the key as valid, the SKIM sends a "valid key"
message to the PCM over the PCI bus. If the response received identifies the key as invalid or no
response is received from the transponder in the ignition key, the SKIM sends an "invalid key"
message to the PCM. The PCM will enable or disable engine operation based upon the status of
the SKIM messages. It is important to note that the default condition in the PCM is "invalid key."
Therefore, if no response is received by the PCM, the engine will be immobilized after two (2)
seconds of running.
The SKIM also sends indicator light status messages to the instrument cluster to tell that module
how to operate the light. This may consist of turning the light ON for a three (3) second bulb test
when the ignition switch is first turned to the ON position. It is also the method used to turn the light
ON solid or to flash it after the indicator light test is complete to signify a fault in the SKIS. If the
light comes ON and stays ON solid after the indicator light test, this signifies that the SKIM has
detected a system malfunction and/or that the SKIS has become inoperative. If the SKIM detects
an invalid key OR a key-related fault exists, the indicator light will flash following the indicator light
test. The SKIM may also request an audible chime if the customer key programming feature is
available and the procedure is being utilized.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module Replacement
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Sentry Key Immobilizer Module Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative remote cable. 2. Remove Lower Instrument Panel
Cover. Refer to Body, Instrument Panel, Lower Instrument Panel Cover, Removal. 3. Remove the
steering column upper and lower shrouds. Refer to Steering, Column, Column Shroud, Removal.
Fig.15 Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) Remove/Install
4. Disengage the steering column wire harness from the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM). 5.
Remove the two screws securing the SKIM to the top of the steering column. 6. Rotate the SKIM
and its mounting bracket upwards and then to the side away from the steering column to slide the
SKIM antenna ring from
around the ignition switch lock cylinder housing.
7. Remove the SKIM from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If the SKIM is replaced with a new unit, a DRB III scan tool MUST be used to initialize the
new SKIM and to program at least two Sentry Key transponders (Refer to
ELECTRICAL/ELECTRONIC CONTROL MODULES/SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE STANDARD PROCEDURE).
1. Place the SKIM into position. 2. Rotate the SKIM and its mounting bracket downwards and then
to the side towards the steering column. 3. Install the two screws securing the SKIM to the top of
the steering column. 4. Engage the steering column wire harness to the Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module (SKIM). 5. Install the steering column upper and lower shrouds. Refer to Steering, Column,
Column Shroud, Installation. 6. Install the Lower Instrument Panel Cover. Refer to Body,
Instrument Panel, Lower Instrument Panel Cover, Installation. 7. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module Replacement > Page 6535
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Programming the Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
PROGRAMMING THE SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, program the VIN into the PCM
first. All vehicle keys will then need to be replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT ALARM,
SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select SKIM MODULE REPLACEMENT (GASOLINE). 4.
Program the vehicle four-digit PIN into the SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct
country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select UPDATE VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to transfer the
VIN (the PCM will send the VIN to the SKIM). 8. The DRBIII will ask if you want to transfer the
secret key. Select ENTER to transfer secret key from the PCM. This will ensure the current vehicle
ignition keys will still operate the SKIS system.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module Replacement > Page 6536
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Programming Ignition Keys to the Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER MODULE
1. Turn the ignition on (transmission in Park / Neutral). 2. Use the DRBIII and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM, then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM AT ONE TIME. Once a key is
learned to a SKIM it (the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRBIII will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRBIII attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed in the SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed - (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle.
8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done - SKIM transponder ID memory is full. 1. Obtain
ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum) 2. Using the DRBIII, erase all
ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS 3. Program
all ignition keys.
Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module Replacement > Page 6537
Alarm Module: Service and Repair Sentry Key Immobilizer System Initialization
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) initialization should be performed following a Sentry
Key Immobilizer Module (SKIM) replacement. It can be summarized as follows:
1. Obtain the vehicle's unique four-digit PIN assigned to its original SKIM from the vehicle owner,
the vehicle's invoice, or from Chrysler's Customer
Center.
2. Using a DRB III scan tool, select "Theft Alarm," "SKIM," "Miscellaneous," and then "SKIM
Module Replaced."
a. Enter Secured Access Mode using the unique four-digit PIN. b. Program the vehicle's VIN
number into the SKIM's memory. c. Program the country code into the SKIM's memory (for North
America, choose US or domestic). d. The vehicle's unique Secret Key data will be retrieved from
the PCM automatically. If this data is corrupt or not present, you will be prompted
to cut new keys for this vehicle.
3. Program all customer keys into the SKIM's memory.
This process will require that the SKIM to be in the Secured Access Mode. The PIN must be
entered into the DRB III scan tool before the SKIM will enter the Secured Access Mode. Once
entered, Secured Access Mode shall be active until 60 seconds after the last command requiring
secured access was received and acknowledged.
Two exceptions to this rule are:
- When you have used the 'erase all keys' command OR
- When you have just programmed a new key. If either of these functions are performed
successfully while in the Secured Access Mode, this mode will be exited immediately following the
function.
NOTE: If a PCM is replaced, the unique 'Secret Key' data must be transferred from the SKIM to the
new PCM using the PCM replacement procedure. This procedure requires the Secured Access
Mode as well and can be found in the DRB III scan tool.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module Replacement > Page 6538
Alarm Module: Service and Repair PCM/SKIM Programming
PCM/SKIM PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Before replacing the PCM for a failed driver, control circuit or ground circuit, be sure to
check the related component/circuit integrity for failures not detected due to a double fault in the
circuit. Most PCM driver/control circuit failures are caused by internal component failures (i.e. relay
and solenoids) and shorted circuits (i.e. pull-ups, drivers and switched circuits). These failures are
difficult to detect when a double fault has occurred and only one DTC has set.
When a PCM (SBEC) and the SKIM are replaced at the same time perform the following steps in
order: 1. Program the new PCM (SBEC) 2. Program the new SKIM 3. Replace all ignition keys and
program them to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING THE PCM (SBEC)
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKIM. This code is programmed and
stored in the SKIM, PCM and transponder chip (ignition keys). When replacing the PCM it is
necessary to program the secret key into the new PCM using the DRB III. Perform the following
steps to program the secret key into the PCM.
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Enter
secured access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN. 5. Select ENTER to update PCM VIN.
NOTE: If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an incorrect PIN, secured
access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn the ignition to the RUN
position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. (Ensure all accessories are turned off. Also
monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if necessary).
6. Press ENTER to transfer the secret key (the SKIM will send the secret key to the PCM). 7. Press
Page Back to get to the Select System menu and select ENGINE, MISCELLANEOUS, and SRI
MEMORY CHECK. 8. The DRB III will ask, Is odometer reading between XX and XX? Select the
YES or NO button on the DRB III. If NO is selected, the DRB III will
read, Enter odometer Reading . Enter the odometer reading from the Instrument Panel and press
ENTER.
PROGRAMMING THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PCM REPLACED (GAS ENGINE). 4. Program
the vehicle four-digit PIN into SKIM. 5. Select COUNTRY CODE and enter the correct country.
NOTE: Be sure to enter the correct country code. If the incorrect country code is programmed into
SKIM, the SKIM must be replaced.
6. Select YES to update VIN (the SKIM will learn the VIN from the PCM). 7. Press ENTER to
transfer the secret key (the PCM will send the secret key to the SKIM). 8. Program ignition keys to
SKIM.
NOTE: If the PCM and the SKIM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle keys will need to be
replaced and programmed to the new SKIM.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKIM
1. Turn the ignition switch on (transmission in park/neutral). 2. Use the DRB III and select THEFT
ALARM, SKIM then MISCELLANEOUS. 3. Select PROGRAM IGNITION KEY'S. 4. Enter secured
access mode by entering the vehicle four-digit PIN.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKIM. Once a key is learned to a SKIM it
(the key) cannot be transferred to another vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the DRB III will display one of the following messages:
Programming Not Attempted - The DRB III attempts to read the programmed key status and there
are no keys programmed into SKIM memory.
Programming Key Failed (Possible Used Key From Wrong Vehicle) - SKIM is unable to program
key due to one of the following: faulty ignition key transponder
- ignition key is programmed to another vehicle. 8 Keys Already Learned, Programming Not Done
-SKIM transponder ID memory is full.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sentry Key Immobilizer
Module Replacement > Page 6539
5. Obtain ignition keys to be programmed from customer (8 keys maximum). 6. Using the DRB III,
erase all ignition keys by selecting MISCELLANEOUS and ERASE ALL CURRENT IGN.KEYS. 7.
Program all ignition keys. Learned Key In Ignition - Ignition key transponder ID is currently
programmed in SKIM memory.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless
Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless
Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6548
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 6554
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6557
Keyless Entry Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6558
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6559
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6560
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6561
Remote Keyless Entry Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6562
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
There are 2 Remote Keyless Entry Modules for the 2002 module year, premium and base. The
base module is for a vehicle with power door locks only. The base module performs the same
functions that the premium module does but has no provisions for Vehicle Theft Security System
(VTSS) or Remote Keyless Entry. Both modules communicate with other modules via the PCI bus
circuit.
The module monitors the Airbag Control Module messages for the purpose of monitoring the
deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message, along with the verification that the ignition
is on, it will provide the "enhanced accident response feature". This feature will cause the module
to unlock all doors and the instrument cluster to turn the courtesy lamps ON.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message and receive
body style information.
The Base module wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses
a signal from the driver or passenger (BUX) cylinder lock switch. The premium module wakes up
the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses a signal from the RKE
transmitter.
Two RKE transmitters are supplied with a premium equipped vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. Horn chirp on a premium equipped vehicle is customer programmable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6563
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
For procedures on diagnosing and testing the RKE Module's RKE functions, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6568
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
HOOD AJAR SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Open hood.
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable - Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
hood ajar switch.
Fig.2 Hood Ajar Switch Location
4. Firmly press tangs on the bottom side of the switch together and push up through bracket. 5.
Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Firmly press hood ajar switch through bracket. 2. Connect wire harness connector to hood ajar
switch. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Close hood. 5. Verify vehicle and system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6573
Lock Cylinder Switch: Connector Locations
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6574
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6575
Lock Cylinder Switch: Diagrams
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Left Cylinder Lock Switch (Premium)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6576
Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Remove the door trim panel. Refer to Body, Door - Front, Trim Panel, Removal. 2. Remove the
illuminated entry switch wiring clip and disconnect connector. 3. Remove door cylinder lock switch
from door handle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the door cylinder lock switch from door handle. 2. Install the illuminated entry switch wiring
clip and disconnect connector. 3. Install the door trim panel. Refer to Body, Door - Front, Trim
Panel, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Road Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Road Temperature Sensor: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Road Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6580
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 6585
Fig. 48 Decklid - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6586
Decklid Security Switch (Knock Out)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6587
Trunk/Liftgate Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
DECKLID SECURITY SWITCH
REMOVAL
The Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) Deck Lid Security Switch is mounted to the back of the
deck lid lock cylinder.
1. Open deck lid. 2. Disconnect wire connector to switch. 3. Remove the spring clip retainer. 4. Pull
switch off of deck lid lock cylinder and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Push switch onto the deck lid lock cylinder. 2. Install the spring clip retainer. 3. Connect the wire
connector to switch. 4. Close the deck lid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Intrusion Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6592
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6593
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6594
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6595
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6596
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6597
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6598
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6599
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6600
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6601
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6602
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6603
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6604
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6605
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6606
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6607
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6608
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6609
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6610
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6611
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6612
Intrusion Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6613
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6614
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6615
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6616
Domelamp / Intrusion Sensor (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6617
Intrusion Sensor: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagram sheets may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
8w-39-2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6618
8w-39-3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6619
8w-39-4 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6620
8w-39-5 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6621
8w-39-6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6622
8w-39-7 (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6623
8w-39-8 (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6624
8w-39-9
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6625
8w-39-10 (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6626
8w-39-11 (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6627
8w-39-12
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6628
8w-39-13 (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6629
8w-39-14 (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6630
8w-39-15 (Export)
NOTE: Other diagrams referred to by number (8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams can be found
at Diagrams by Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6631
Intrusion Sensor: Description and Operation
ULTRASONIC INTRUSION SENSOR
Fig.3 VTSS Intrusion Sensor
Some vehicles equipped with the premium Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) use a ultrasonic
intrusion sensor. This intrusion sensor is integrated into the dome lamp and detects any movement
in the cabin when the VTSS system and the intrusion sensor are armed The sensor cannot be
serviced separately and if found to be faulty the entire dome lamp assembly must be replaced
In the event the intrusion sensor detects movement inside the vehicle's interior (with system
armed), the ARKEM module will sound the siren.
DISARMING THE INTRUSION SENSOR
- Press the "LOCK" button on Remote Keyless Entry transmitter THREE times within five (5)
seconds This operation must be performed during the first 16 seconds of VTSS system arming
- Rotating the drivers door key cylinder THREE times within five (5) seconds This operation must
be performed during the first 16 seconds of VTSS system arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6632
Intrusion Sensor: Service and Repair
ULTRASONIC INTRUSION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable
Fig.4 Dome Lamp Unit With Intrusion Sensor Removal
2. Grasp the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor and rotate counterclockwise. 3. Pull straight
down on dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor. 4. Disconnect electrical connector. 5. Remove the
dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor from the vehicle
INSTALLATION
1. Connect electrical connector
Fig.5 Dome Lamp Unit With Intrusion Sensor Orientation To Headliner
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Intrusion Sensor <--> [Ultrasonic Sensor, Antitheft] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6633
2. Orient the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor in a way that the tabs align with the slots in the
headliner. 3. Push the dome lamp unit with intrusion sensor straight up. 4. Rotate the dome lamp
unit with intrusion sensor clockwise. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Towing Information: Technician Safety Information
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TOWING RECOMMENDATIONS
CAUTION: Many vehicles are equipped with air dams, spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. To
avoid component damage, a wheel-lift towing vehicle or a flat-bed hauling vehicle is recommended.
Fig. 9 Tow Vehicles With Approved Equipment
A vehicle equipped with SAE approved sling-type towing equipment, a wheel-lift towing device or a
vehicle with a flat-bed device can be used to transport all RAM VAN or WAGON vehicles (Fig. 9). A
wooden crossbeam may be required for proper connection when using the sling-type, front-end
towing method.
Safety Precautions NOTE: The following safety precautions must be observed when towing a
vehicle.
- Secure loose and protruding parts.
- Always use a safety chain system that is independent of the lifting and towing equipment.
- Do not allow towing equipment to contact the disabled vehicle's fuel tank.
- Do not allow anyone under the disabled vehicle while it is lifted by the towing device.
- Do not allow passengers to ride in a vehicle being towed.
- Always observe state and local laws regarding towing regulations.
- Do not tow a vehicle in a manner that could jeopardize the safety of the operator, pedestrians or
other motorists.
- Do not attach tow chains, T-hooks, J-hooks, or a tow sling to a bumper, steering linkage, drive
shafts or a non-reinforced frame hole.
- Remove exhaust pipe tips that interfere with the tow sling and crossbar
- Padding should be placed between the tow sling/crossbar and any painted surfaces
- When placing tow hooks on the rear axle, position them so they do not damage the brake tubing
or hoses
- Do not tow the vehicle by connecting to the front or rear shock absorbers
- Do not tow a heavily loaded vehicle. Damage to the vehicle may result. Use a flatbed device to
transport a loaded vehicle.
Ground Clearance
CAUTION: If vehicle is towed with wheels removed, install lug nuts to retain brake drums.
A towed vehicle should be raised until lifted wheels are a minimum 100 mm (4 in) from the ground.
Be sure there is adequate ground clearance at the opposite end of the vehicle, especially when
towing over rough terrain, steep rises in the road or if the vehicle is equipped with air dams,
spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. If necessary, remove the wheels from the lifted end of the
vehicle and lower the vehicle closer to the ground, to increase the ground clearance at the opposite
end of the vehicle. Install lug nuts on wheel attaching studs to retain brake drums.
Ramp Angle If a vehicle with flat-bed towing equipment is used, the approach ramp angle should
not exceed 15 degrees.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6639
Towing-Rear End Lifted
CAUTION: Do not use steering column lock to secure steering wheel during towing operation.
Vehicles can be towed with the front wheels on the ground for extended distances at speeds not
exceeding 48 km/h (30 mph).
Fig. 10 Rear-End Lifted Towing
1. Attach the J-hooks around the axle shaft tubes outboard of the rear springs (Fig. 10). 2. Position
and center the sling under and forward of the rear bumper. 3. Attach safety chains (with pads) at
each end of the rear bumper. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position to unlock the steering
wheel. 5. Clamp the steering wheel with the front wheels in the straight ahead position. 6. Shift the
transmission to NEUTRAL.
Towing-Front End Lifted Provided the transmission is operable, tow only in NEUTRAL at speeds
not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h) and distances less than 15 miles (25km/h).
If the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 miles, the propeller shaft should be disconnected or
place tow dollies under rear wheels.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6640
Fig. 11 Front-End Lifted Towing - Typical
If a vehicle cannot be towed from the rear, the front-end raised towing method normally can be
used (Fig. 11).
1. Center the sling with the bumper and position it at the frame front crossmember.
CAUTION: Use tow chains with J-hooks for connecting to the disabled vehicle's lower suspension
arms. Never use T-hooks.
2. Route the J-hooks and tow chains over the steering linkage outboard of the coil spring. 3. Attach
the J-hooks to the outer end of the lower suspension arms. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Attach the
safety chains to the disabled vehicle at the frame rails.
Towing When Keys Are Not Available When the vehicle is locked and keys are not available, use a
flat bed hauler. A Wheel-lift or Sling-type device can be used provided all the wheels are lifted off
the ground using tow dollies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6641
Towing Information: Vehicle Damage Warnings
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TOWING RECOMMENDATIONS
CAUTION: Many vehicles are equipped with air dams, spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. To
avoid component damage, a wheel-lift towing vehicle or a flat-bed hauling vehicle is recommended.
Fig. 9 Tow Vehicles With Approved Equipment
A vehicle equipped with SAE approved sling-type towing equipment, a wheel-lift towing device or a
vehicle with a flat-bed device can be used to transport all RAM VAN or WAGON vehicles (Fig. 9). A
wooden crossbeam may be required for proper connection when using the sling-type, front-end
towing method.
Safety Precautions NOTE: The following safety precautions must be observed when towing a
vehicle.
- Secure loose and protruding parts.
- Always use a safety chain system that is independent of the lifting and towing equipment.
- Do not allow towing equipment to contact the disabled vehicle's fuel tank.
- Do not allow anyone under the disabled vehicle while it is lifted by the towing device.
- Do not allow passengers to ride in a vehicle being towed.
- Always observe state and local laws regarding towing regulations.
- Do not tow a vehicle in a manner that could jeopardize the safety of the operator, pedestrians or
other motorists.
- Do not attach tow chains, T-hooks, J-hooks, or a tow sling to a bumper, steering linkage, drive
shafts or a non-reinforced frame hole.
- Remove exhaust pipe tips that interfere with the tow sling and crossbar
- Padding should be placed between the tow sling/crossbar and any painted surfaces
- When placing tow hooks on the rear axle, position them so they do not damage the brake tubing
or hoses
- Do not tow the vehicle by connecting to the front or rear shock absorbers
- Do not tow a heavily loaded vehicle. Damage to the vehicle may result. Use a flatbed device to
transport a loaded vehicle.
Ground Clearance
CAUTION: If vehicle is towed with wheels removed, install lug nuts to retain brake drums.
A towed vehicle should be raised until lifted wheels are a minimum 100 mm (4 in) from the ground.
Be sure there is adequate ground clearance at the opposite end of the vehicle, especially when
towing over rough terrain, steep rises in the road or if the vehicle is equipped with air dams,
spoilers, and/or ground effect panels. If necessary, remove the wheels from the lifted end of the
vehicle and lower the vehicle closer to the ground, to increase the ground clearance at the opposite
end of the vehicle. Install lug nuts on wheel attaching studs to retain brake drums.
Ramp Angle If a vehicle with flat-bed towing equipment is used, the approach ramp angle should
not exceed 15 degrees.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6642
Towing-Rear End Lifted
CAUTION: Do not use steering column lock to secure steering wheel during towing operation.
Vehicles can be towed with the front wheels on the ground for extended distances at speeds not
exceeding 48 km/h (30 mph).
Fig. 10 Rear-End Lifted Towing
1. Attach the J-hooks around the axle shaft tubes outboard of the rear springs (Fig. 10). 2. Position
and center the sling under and forward of the rear bumper. 3. Attach safety chains (with pads) at
each end of the rear bumper. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position to unlock the steering
wheel. 5. Clamp the steering wheel with the front wheels in the straight ahead position. 6. Shift the
transmission to NEUTRAL.
Towing-Front End Lifted Provided the transmission is operable, tow only in NEUTRAL at speeds
not to exceed 30 mph (50 km/h) and distances less than 15 miles (25km/h).
If the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 miles, the propeller shaft should be disconnected or
place tow dollies under rear wheels.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Towing Information >
System Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6643
Fig. 11 Front-End Lifted Towing - Typical
If a vehicle cannot be towed from the rear, the front-end raised towing method normally can be
used (Fig. 11).
1. Center the sling with the bumper and position it at the frame front crossmember.
CAUTION: Use tow chains with J-hooks for connecting to the disabled vehicle's lower suspension
arms. Never use T-hooks.
2. Route the J-hooks and tow chains over the steering linkage outboard of the coil spring. 3. Attach
the J-hooks to the outer end of the lower suspension arms. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Attach the
safety chains to the disabled vehicle at the frame rails.
Towing When Keys Are Not Available When the vehicle is locked and keys are not available, use a
flat bed hauler. A Wheel-lift or Sling-type device can be used provided all the wheels are lifted off
the ground using tow dollies.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trip Computer > Road Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Road Temperature Sensor: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trip Computer > Road Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6648
Fig. 36 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6655
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6656
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6657
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6658
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6659
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6660
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6661
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6662
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6663
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6664
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6665
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6666
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6667
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6668
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6669
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6670
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6671
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6672
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6673
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6674
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6675
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6676
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6677
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6678
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6679
Body Control Module: Electrical Diagrams
Airbag System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6680
Audio System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6681
CD Changer
Compass/Temperature Mirror
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6682
Exterior Lighting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6683
Instrument Cluster
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6684
Interior Lighting
Power Door Locks/RKE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6685
Vehicle Communication
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6686
Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Body Control Module: Technician Safety Information
SERVICING SUB-ASSEMBLIES
Some components of the body system are intended to be serviced as an assembly only.
Attempting to remove or repair certain system sub-components may result in personal injury and/or
improper system operation. Only those components with approved repair and installation
procedures should be serviced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6689
Body Control Module: Vehicle Damage Warnings
Electrical Testing Precautions
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is "off". Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation, this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion. Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent
accidental shorting of terminals Such mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second
code could be set, making diagnosis of the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description
Body Control Module: Description and Operation System Description
Identification Of System
The vehicle systems that are part of the "body" system are:
- Airbag System
- Audio
- Compass/Temperature Mirror
- Instrument Cluster
- Interior Lighting
- Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
- Vehicle Communications
- Vehicle Theft Security System
System Description
The body system on the 2003 PL consists of a combination of modules that communicate over the
PCI bus (Programmable Communication Interface multiplex system).
Through the PCI bus, information about the operation of vehicle components and circuits is relayed
quickly to the appropriate module(s). All modules receive all the information transmitted on the bus
even though a module may not require all information to perform it's function. It will only respond to
messages "addressed" to it through a binary coding process.
This method of data transmission significantly reduces the complexity of the wiring in the vehicle
and the size of wiring harnesses. All of the information about the functioning of all the systems is
organized, controlled, and communicated by the PCI bus, which is described in the Vehicle
Communication See: Functional Operation/Vehicle Communication of this general information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6692
Body Control Module: Description and Operation Functional Operation
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
WARNING: NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE
THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
DRIVER AIRBAG (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93 °C (200 °F).
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation, The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches on vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged. The clockspring cannot be repaired it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6693
PASSENGER AIRBAG (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and its
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON
GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG
MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING
INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93
degrees C (200 degrees F).
WARNING: REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN
THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR
INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT
PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE
AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY
DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY
SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT
FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG.
SIDE IMPACT AIRBAG CONTROL MODULES (SIACM)
They are located on the left and right B-post. The SIACM perform self diagnostics and circuit tests
to determine if the system is functioning properly. If the test finds a problem the SIACM will set both
active and stored diagnostic trouble codes. If a DTC is active the SIACM will request that the airbag
warning lamp be turned on. The results of the system test are transmitted on the PCI Bus to the
ACM once each second or on change in lamp state. If the warning lamp status message from the
either SIACM contains a lamp on request the ACM will set an active DTC. At the same time as the
DTC is set the ACM sends a PCI Bus message to the mechanical instrument cluster (MIC)
requesting the airbag warning lamp be turned on. Observe all ACM warning and caution
statements when servicing or handling the SIACM. SIACM are not repairable and must be replaced
if they are dropped.
NOTE: When the Airbag Warning Indicator is illuminated, interrogate the ACM.
SEAT AIRBAGS
The Left and Right seat airbag modules are located in the outboard end of the front seat backs.
The airbag module contains a bag, an inflator (a small canister of highly compressed argon gas)
and a mounting bracket. The seat airbag module cannot be repaired and must be replaced if
deployed or in any way damaged. When supplied with the proper electrical signal the inflator seals
the hole in the airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the
cushion. Upon deployment, the seat back trim cover will tear open and allow the seat airbag to fully
deploy between the seat and the door.
NOTE: It will be necessary to remove the seat back trim to gain access to the seat airbag module
connector when diagnosing the seat airbag system.
WARNING: THE SEAT AIRBAG CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI.
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR.
DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT
STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93 degrees C (200 degrees F). REPLACE AIRBAG
SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL
DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS,
SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE
SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEY
MUST NEVER BE REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS
NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE
PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Some airbag diagnostic tests use special tools, 8310 and 8443 airbag load tool, for testing squib
circuits. The load tools contain fixed resistive loads, jumpers and adapters. The fixed loads are
connected to cables and mounted in a storage case. The cables can be directly connected to some
airbag system connectors. Jumpers are used to convert the load tool cable connectors to the other
airbag system connectors. The adapters are connected to the module harness connector to open
shorting clips and protect the connector terminal during testing. When using the load tool follow all
of the safety procedures in the service information for disconnecting airbag system components.
Inspect the wiring, connector and terminals for damage or misalignment. Substitute the airbag load
tool in place of a Driver or Passenger Airbag, curtain airbag, clockspring, or seat belt tensioner (use
a jumper if needed). Then follow all of the safety procedures in the service information for
connecting airbag system components. Read the module active DTC's. If the module reports NO
ACTIVE DTC's the defective component has been removed from the system and should be
replaced. If the DTC is still active, continue this process until all components in the circuit have
been tested. Then disconnect the module connector and connect the matching adapter to the
module connector. With all airbags disconnected and the adapter installed the squib wiring can be
tested for open and shorted conditions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6694
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: *
Erase the stored codes
* Place the ignition in the Run position
* Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
* Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
* Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Audio System
AUDIO SYSTEM
The audio system on the 2003 PL consists of a radio that communicates over the PCI bus. The
speakers are located in the instrument panel, the front doors and the rear "D" pillars. The
instrument panel speakers are a tweeter type speaker for high frequency. The front door speakers
are a woofer/midrange type speaker. The rear "D" pillar speakers are a full range type speaker. If
one of the speaker circuits experiences a short, the other speakers on that output channel will also
shut down until the circuit is repaired. The radio will also set a trouble code, which the DRB III(R)
can display.
The in-dash CD-changer is designed to fit into the existing cubby bin in the center stack. This new
cartridge-less CD-changer is controlled by your radio, and allows you to individually load up to four
discs at one time. However, due to its compact design, the CD-changer can only carry out one
operation at a time. For example you can not load a new disc while playing another at the same
time. Each operation happens sequentially.
The radio unit installed with your system provides control over all features of the CD-changer with
the exception of the CD load and eject functions, which are controlled by buttons located on the
front of the CD-changer. The radio also supplies the power, ground, PCI Bus, left and right speaker
output through a single DIN cable. All features you would expect , such as Disc Up/Down, Track
Up/Down, Random and Scan are controlled by the radio, which also displays all relevant
CD-changer information on the radio display.
The CD-changer contains a Load/Eject button and an indicator light for each of the four disc
positions. The individual light indicates whether a CD is currently loaded in that particular chamber
of the CD-changer. Pressing the individual Load/Eject button for a particular chamber will eject a
disc currently present in the chamber. If the chamber is currently empty, actuating the Load/Eject
button will position that chamber to receive and load a new
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6695
disc in that chamber.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Compass/Temperature Mirror
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6696
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6697
magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may
appear to indicate false headings or appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may
need to be demagnetized. Refer to Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory, the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the
displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the
PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6698
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Exterior Lighting
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
The Headlamps are controlled by the Instrument Cluster.
The Instrument Cluster is also referred to as a "Smart Cluster". It receives and sends messages to
other modules through the PCI BUS circuit. The Headlamps are wired through the cluster and then
go to the Fuse Block to the lamps. Each Headlamp has an independent fuse located in the Fuse
Block.
For vehicles equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL Module is integrated with the
Instrument Cluster.
Interior Lighting
INTERIOR LIGHTING
The Courtesy Lamps are controlled by the instrument cluster.
Some of the features that it controls are the courtesy lamps, chime, and all instrument illumination.
It receives and sends messages to other modules via the PCI bus circuit.
The front turn signals are wired through the cluster and then go to the front lamps. For vehicles
equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL module is built into the cluster.
Power Door Locks/Remote Keyless Entry
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The Remote Keyless Entry module controls the Power Door Locks and the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). It also wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn on the illuminated entry when it
senses a signal from the RKE transmitter. The module communicates with other modules via the
PCI bus circuit.
The RKE module monitors the Occupant Restraint Controller messages for the purpose of
monitoring the deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message along with the verification
that the ignition is on and the vehicle speed is zero, it will provide the "enhanced accident response
feature". This feature will cause the module to unlock-all doors immediately and the instrument
cluster to turn the courtesy lamps on when the vehicle reaches 0 mph.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message, and receive
body style information. Two transmitters are supplied with the vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. The horn chirp on vehicle lock command is customer programmable.
To limit the amount of battery drain during storage, the IOD fuse may be removed.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM
When the VTSS is armed, it will monitor the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle
doors and decklid. Also monitored is a decklid security switch (knockout) for the cylinder lock. If the
alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6699
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, by
using the driver door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of an open decklid security switch sense circuit.
Disarming can be accomplished with a RKE unlock, turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key
or unlocking the vehicle with the driver door cylinder lock. All of the switches for the VTSS system
can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to determine the cause of a
customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
VEHICLE THEFT SECURITY SYSTEM (Export Only)
When the VTSS is armed, it Will monitor the interior of the vehicle for movement via an intrusion
sensor (if equipped), the ignition switch status, ajar switches for the vehicle doors, decklid and
hood. Vehicles without an intrusion sensor will have a decklid security switch (knockout) which will
also be monitored. If the alarm is tripped, it will sound the vehicles horn or a battery backed siren
for vehicles equipped with the intrusion sensor, flash the exterior lamps and the VTSS indicator
located in the instrument cluster.
Arming the system is accomplished by locking the doors with the door lock switch following a
normal exit sequence of opening the door pressing the power lock button and closing the door, or
by using either door cylinder lock switch or by pressing the RKE lock button. After all the doors are
closed, the VTSS indicator will flash quickly for sixteen-seconds indicating the pre-arm process,
after which it will flash at a slower rate indicating the system is armed. If during the pre-arm process
a door is opened, the ignition is turned to the Run/Start position or if the RKE module receives an
unlock request the system will automatically be disarmed. If the VTSS indicator stays on steady
during prearm, it is an indication of the hood ajar circuit being shorted (hood opened) or the decklid
security switch circuit being open (if equipped). Defeating the intrusion sensor feature for vehicles
so equipped can be done by three additional lock request to the RKE module within 5 seconds.
Disarming is done by either a RKE unlock or turning the ignition on with a valid Sentry key. All of
the switches for the VTSS system can be monitored using the DRB III. The DRB III is also useful to
determine the cause of a customer complaint of the alarm going off with no apparent reason.
Vehicle Communication
VEHICLE COMMUNICATION
The Programmable Communication Interface or PCI Bus is a single wire multiplexed network
capable of supporting binary encoded messages shared between multiple modules. The PCI bus
circuit is identified as D25. The modules are wired in parallel. Connections are made in the harness
using splices. The following modules are used on 2003 PL:
- Airbag Control Module
- Left Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Right Side Impact Airbag Control Module
- Controller Antilock Brake
- Powertrain Control Module
- Radio (If equipped)
- CD Changer (If equipped)
- Compass/Temperature Mirror (If equipped)
- Remote Keyless Entry Module (If equipped)
- Sentry Key Immobilizer Module (If equipped)
- Mechanical Instrument Cluster
Each module provides its own bias and termination in order to transmit and receive messages. The
bus voltage is at zero volts when no modules are transmitting and is pulled up to about seven and
a half volts when modules are transmitting.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6700
The bus messages are transmitted at a rate averaging 10800 bits per second. Since there is only
voltage present when the modules transmit and the message length is only about 500 milliseconds,
it is ineffective to try and measure the bus activity with a conventional voltmeter. The preferred
method is to use the DRB III(R) lab scope. The 12 V square wave selection on the 20-volt scale
provides a good view of the bus activity. Voltage on the bus should pulse between zero and about
seven and a half volts. Refer to the diagram for some typical displays.
The PCI Bus failure modes are broken down into two categories. Complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure and individual module no response. Causes of a complete PCI Bus
Communication Failure include a short to ground or battery on the PCI circuit. Individual module no
response can be caused by an open circuit at the module, or an open battery or ground circuit to
the affected
Symptoms of a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure would include but are not limited to:
- All gauges on the EMIC stay at zero
- All telltales on EMIC illuminate
- EMIC backlighting at full intensity
- No response received from any module on the PCI bus (except PCM)
- No start (if equipped with Sentry Key Immobilizer)
Symptoms of Individual module failure could include any one or more of the above. The difference
would be that at least one or more modules would respond to the DRB III(R).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Description > Page 6701
Diagnosis starts with symptom identification. If a complete PCI Bus Communication Failure is
suspected, begin by identifying which modules the vehicle is equipped with and then attempt to get
a response from the modules with the DRB III(R). If any modules are responding, the failure is not
related to the total bus, but can be caused by one or more modules PCI circuit or power supply and
ground circuits. The DRB III(R) may display "BUS +A SIGNALS OPEN" OR "NO RESPONSE" to
indicate a communication problem. These same messages will be displayed if the vehicle is not
equipped with that particular module. The CCD error message is a default message used by the
DRB III(R) and in no way indicates whether or not the PCI bus is operational. The message is only
an indication that a module is either not responding or the vehicle is not equipped.
NOTE: For 2003 model year, some vehicles will integrate the Transmission Control Module and
Powertrain Control Module into a single control
module. This new module is the Next Generation Controller for Daimler/Chrysler and will be
referred to as the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The Transmission Control Module is part of
the Powertrain Control Module.
New Diagnostic procedures and New DTC numbers are some of the changes you will see which
reflect the new combined module technology. The PCM will have four color coded connectors C1
through C4, (C1-BLK, C2-GRAY, C3-WHITE, C4-GREEN), each PCM connector will have 38 pins
each. Two new tools are used for probing and repairing the New PCM connectors. A New tool to
release the pins from the PCM connectors Miller #3638 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool
#3638 to release the connector pins or harness and connector damage will occur. Also a New tool
for probing connectors Miller #8815 is introduced, you must use the Miller tool #8815 to probe the
PCM pins or harness and connector damage will occur. There is also a new Verification test and
module replacement procedure for the PCM.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Body Control Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Airbag Indicator On Without ACM Trouble Codes
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AIRBAG INDICATOR ON WITHOUT ACM TROUBLE CODES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Airbag indicator on without ACM trouble codes
- Instrument cluster problems
No Response From Airbag Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6704
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6705
Test 3 - 4
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM ACM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Checking for voltage at ACM
- Ground circuit open
- PCI bus circuit open
- Airbag control module
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6706
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Any Station Preset Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY STATION PRESET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Balance Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
BALANCE INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6707
CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Equalizer Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Fader Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FADER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6708
Test 1
SYMPTOM
FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
HOUR/MINUTE Switches Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HOUR/MINUTE SWITCHES INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
No Response From Radio
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6709
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6710
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
NO RESPONSE FROM RADIO
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response from radio
- Open fused ignition switch output circuit
- Open fused B+ circuit
- Radio ground circuit open
- Open PCI bus circuit
- Radio
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6711
SYMPTOM
PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
PWR Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Scan Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Seek Switch Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6712
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Set Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6713
- Internal failure
Time Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Tune Switch Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test CASSETTE PLAYER INOP.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Internal failure
Compass/Temperature Mirror Does Calibrate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6714
Test 1
Test 2
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR DOES CALIBRATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Calibration procedure
- Compass/temperature mirror
Compass/Temperature Mirror Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6715
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6716
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus - compass
- Fused B(+) circuit short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Ground circuit open
- Compass/temperature mirror
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6717
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to voltage
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
High Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Test 1 - 4
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6718
Test 5 - 7
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open fused B+
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to ground
- Dimmer switch high beam output circuit short to ground
- Open fuse
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Multifunction switch
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn Off
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6719
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN OFF
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit short to voltage
- Fuse block
- Instrument cluster
Low Beam Headlamps Will Not Turn On
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6720
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
LOW BEAM HEADLAMPS WILL NOT TURN ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Multifunction switch
- Fuse block
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Open fused B+ to fuse block
- Fused B+ circuit short to ground
- B+ circuit breaker 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6721
All Gauges Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
Test 5 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6722
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response - PCI bus
- No response - PCI bus - powertrain control module
- No response - PCI bus - instrument cluster
- Fused ignition switch output circuit short to ground
- Fused ignition switch output circuit open
- Instrument cluster ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
Any or All Gauge Pointer(s) On Wrong Side of Stop
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY OR ALL GAUGE POINTER(S) ON WRONG SIDE OF STOP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Any PCI Bus Indicator Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ANY PCI BUS INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6723
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- LED defective
- Instrument cluster
Brake Warning Indicator Always On
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6724
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit short to ground
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit short to ground
- Park brake switch
- Brake fluid level switch
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Brake Warning Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6725
Test 4 - 7
Test 8
SYMPTOM
BRAKE WARNING INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6726
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Brake warning indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Brake fluid level switch
- Park brake switch
- Red brake warning indicator driver circuit open
- Brake fluid level switch ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster
- Powertrain control module
Front Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
FRONT FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Front fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Fuel Gauge Inaccurate
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6727
Test 1 - 2
Test 3
SYMPTOM
FUEL GAUGE INACCURATE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Fuel level sensor
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
High Beam Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6728
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- High beam indicator circuit open
- High beam indicator bulb
- Instrument cluster
Instrument Cluster Dimming Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6729
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DIMMING INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Headlamp switch output circuit open
- Illumination bulb
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Always on
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6730
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR ALWAYS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit short to ground
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6731
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Engine oil pressure switch
- Engine oil pressure switch sense circuit open
- Indicator led
- Powertrain control module
- Instrument cluster
One Gauge Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6732
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ONE GAUGE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Powertrain control module DTCs
- Instrument cluster
PRND or Autostick Indicator Display Inaccurate or Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6733
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
PRND OR AUTOSTICK INDICATOR DISPLAY INACCURATE OR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
- Intermittent condition
- Instrument cluster
Rear Fog Lamp Indicator Inoperative - BUX Only
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
REAR FOG LAMP INDICATOR INOPERATIVE - BUX ONLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Rear fog lamp indicator circuit open
- Indicator led
- Instrument cluster
Seat Belt Indicator Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6734
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
SEATBELT INDICATOR INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Indicator led
- Seat belt indicator circuit open
- Seat belt switch ground open
- Seat belt switch
- Instrument cluster
Temperature Display Inoperative or Wrong (2.0L Only)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6735
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG (2.0L ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present in PCM
- Ambient temperat1jre sensor
- Compass/temperature mirror
VF Display Inoperative
Test 1
SYMPTOM
VF DISPLAY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Instrument cluster
Courtesy Lamps Inoperative - All Lamps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6736
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS INOPERATIVE - ALL LAMPS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B+ circuit open
- Instrument cluster - courtesy lamp open
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit open
- Intermittent condition
Courtesy Lamps On At All Times
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6737
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6738
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6739
Test 8 - 10
SYMPTOM
COURTESY LAMPS ON AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Drivers door ajar switch
- Drivers door ajar switch sense wire short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster
- Panel lamps dimmer signal wire short to ground
- Multifunction switch
- Open door ajar switch
- Remote keyless entry module - if equipped
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense wire short to ground
- Instrument cluster
- Courtesy lamp driver circuit short to ground
- Instrument cluster
Illuminated Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6740
Test 1 - 2
SYMPTOM
ILLUMINATED ENTRY INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Courtesy lamps operational
- Intermittent condition
- Illuminated entry not enabled
All Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6741
Test 3 - 7
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6742
Test 8 - 13
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6743
Test 14 - 16
SYMPTOM
ALL DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid release relay output wire short to ground
- Fused B(+) circuit open
- Fused B(+) wire short to ground
- Ground circuit open
- Door lock relay output circuit open
- Driver door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release solenoid-shorted
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Defective fuse #14
- RKE module - B(+) short to ground
- RKE module - relays open
- RKE module - shorted
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Lock and Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6744
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO LOCK AND UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open door unlock relay output
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Open motors
All Doors Except Driver Fail to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6745
Test 1
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS EXCEPT DRIVER FAIL TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door unlock relay output circuit short to ground
- Remote keyless entry module unlock relay
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Auto door locks not enabled
- Door ajar status
- PCM DTC's present
- RKE module defective - auto locks inoperable
Decklid Solenoid Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6746
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
DECKLID SOLENOID INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Solenoid ground open
- Decklid release solenoid open
- Decklid release relay output wire open
- RKE module - decklid relay open
Doors Lockable With Key In Ignition and Driver Door Open
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6747
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6748
Test 4 - 10
SYMPTOM
DOORS LOCKABLE WITH KEY IN IGNITION & DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch - open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to RKE module
- Ignition switch open
- Key-in ignition switch sense wire open
- Open driver door ajar switch sense to cluster
- Instrument cluster - key-in ignition open
- Instrument cluster defective-driver door ajar open
- RKE module defective-open driver door ajar
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6749
Driver Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Test 4
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RKE module - open driver unlock circuit
- Driver door lock motor - open
- Driver door lock relay output wire open
- Driver door unlock relay output wire open
Driver Door Fails to Unlock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6750
Test 1
SYMPTOM
DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- RKE module defective - driver unlock open
One Passenger Door Fails to Lock and Unlock
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6751
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ONE PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO LOCK & UNLOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock motor open
- Door unlock relay output wire open
- Door lock relay output wire open
- Door unlock relay output wire short to ground
- Door unlock relay output short to door lock relay output
- Door lock relay output wire short to ground
Remote Keyless Entry Inoperative
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6752
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 5
SYMPTOM
RKE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Test transmitter with tester
- RKE transmitter not programmed
- Test RKE transmitter
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6753
- RKE transmitter - inoperative
- RKE module
- RKE module - receiver inoperable
Alarm Trips On Its Own
Test 1 - 4
SYMPTOM
ALARM TRIPS ON ITS OWN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Last VTSS cause
- Attempt to trip alarm
- Intermittent condition
All Doors Fail to Lock
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6754
Test 1 - 4
Test 5
SYMPTOM
ALL DOORS FAIL TO LOCK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock relay output circuit short to ground
- Decklid release relay output short to door lock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to driver door unlock relay output
- Decklid release relay output short to door unlock relay output
- Remote keyless entry module - unlock ground open
All Locks Inoperative From A Door Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6755
Test 1 - 3
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
ALL LOCKS INOPERATIVE FROM A DOOR LOCK SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- DTC present
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6756
- Door switch ground wire open
- Door switch MUX wire short to voltage
- Door switch MUX wire open
- Door lock switch open
- Remote keyless entry module - high voltage
- Remote keyless entry module - low voltage
Headlamps Fail to Flash When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HEADLAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Dimmer switch low beam output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Horn Fails to Sound When Alarm Is Tripped
Test 1
SYMPTOM
HORN FAILS TO SOUND DURING ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Horn relay control circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Cannot Be Disabled
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6757
Test 1
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR CANNOT BE DISABLED (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Fails to Trip VTSS
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6758
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR FAILS TO TRIP VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit open
- Intrusion sensor signal circuit shorted to ground
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Intrusion Sensor Repeatedly Triggers VTSS
Test 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6759
SYMPTOM
INTRUSION SENSOR REPEATEDLY TRIGGERS VTSS (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Intrusion sensor
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Driver Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
OPEN DRIVER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Driver door ajar switch
- Driver door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Driver door ajar switch sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
Open Passenger Door Fails to Trip Alarm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6760
Test 1 - 2
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6761
Test 3 - 6
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6762
Test 7 - 8
SYMPTOM
OPEN PASSENGER DOOR FAILS TO TRIP ALARM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch ground circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Left rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Right rear door ajar switch
- Passenger door ajar/RKE circuit open
- Passenger door ajar/RKE sense circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
- RKE module - passenger door ajar sense
Park Lamps Fail to Flash During Alarm
Test 1
SYMPTOM
PARK LAMPS FAIL TO FLASH DURING ALARM
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6763
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Park lamp switch output circuit open
- Remote keyless entry module
VTSS Fails to Arm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm From Passenger Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6764
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM PASSENGER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Passenger door switch MUX circuit open
- Passenger cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Fails to Arm/Disarm From Driver Door Cylinder Lock Switch
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS FAILS TO ARM/DISARM FROM DRIVER DOOR CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6765
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test VTSS FAILS TO ARM FROM DRIVER DOOR
CYLINDER LOCK SWITCH (EXPORT ONLY).
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Door lock operation test
- Ground circuit open
- Driver door switch MUX circuit open
- Driver cylinder lock switch faulty
VTSS Indicator Fails to Flash
Test 1 - 3
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR FAILS TO FLASH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Remote keyless entry module
- Instrument cluster
- VTSS indicator driver circuit open
- VTSS led open
VTSS Indicator Stays On Steady During Arming
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6766
Test 1 - 5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6767
Test 6 - 8
SYMPTOM
VTSS INDICATOR STAYS ON STEADY DURING ARMING
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Decklid security switch sense circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch ground circuit open (if equipped)
- Decklid security switch (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch sense circuit shorted to ground (if equipped)
- Hood ajar switch (if equipped)
- RKE module - VTSS indicator
- RKE module - hood ajar (if equipped)
- RKE module - decklid security (if equipped)
VTSS Siren Inoperative
Test 1 - 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6768
Test 4 - 6
SYMPTOM
VTSS SIREN INOPERATIVE (EXPORT ONLY)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Siren functional test
- Open fused B(+) circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Faulty siren
- Siren control circuit open
- Siren control circuit shorted to ground
- Remote keyless entry module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6769
Body Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Six Step Troubleshooting Procedure
SIX-STEP TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE
Diagnosis is done in six basic steps:
1. Verification of complaint 2. Verification of any related symptoms 3. Symptom analysis 4. Problem
isolation 5. Repair of isolated problem 6. Verification of proper operation
Road Testing
ROAD TEST WARNINGS
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure.
The purpose of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: Before road testing a vehicle, be sure that all components are reassembled. during the
test drive, do not try to read the DRB III screen while in motion. Do not hang the DRB III from the
rear view mirror or operate it yourself. Have an assistant available to operate the DRB III.
Vehicle Preparation For Testing
VEHICLE PREPARATION FOR TESTING
Make sure the vehicle being tested has a fully charged battery. If it does not, false diagnostic codes
or error messages may occur.
Airbag System
AIRBAG SYSTEM
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is bolted to the floor panel transmission tunnel rearward from the
gear shift selector inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket is welded to the tunnel and is not
serviced with the ACM. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and energy
storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the airbag system logic. The ACM system logic
includes On Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument cluster
circuitry via the PCI data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the PCI data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. A
preprogrammed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag system
protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an electrical signal to deploy
the airbag system components.
The impact sensor is an accelerometer that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides
verification of the direction and severity of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the
specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide
airbag system protection in a severe secondary impact if the initial impact has damaged or
disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to deploy the airbags.
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER
SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM.
FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The airbag warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "run" or "start" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the airbag warning lamp on for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp turns off;
it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible malfunctions.
If the lamp remains on, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp circuit may be
internally shorted to ground. If the lamp comes on and stays on for a period longer than 6-8
seconds then goes off; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6770
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be given to the active codes.
Each diagnostic trouble code is diagnosed by following a specific testing procedure. The diagnostic
test procedures contain step-by-step instructions for determining the cause of the trouble codes. It
is not necessary to perform all of the tests in this book to diagnose an individual code.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reason for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble codes
are used as a diagnostic tool.
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-off, whichever occurs first.
An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the malfunction is
currently there every time the control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to erase
an active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a minimum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
An "Interrogate Right SIACM or Interrogate left SIACM" diagnostic trouble code indicates an active
trouble code in the respective module.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the
code currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 12 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 12 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected. The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually
present for less than one minute, Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes
13 seconds, for example, would be three minutes.
When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be initiated for that code. If
the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same malfunction, the diagnostic
trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If the malfunction reoccurs
before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter Will be reset and the diagnostic
trouble code Will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
WARNING: MAINTAIN A SAFE DISTANCE FROM ALL AIRBAGS WHILE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING INSPECTION:
If no obvious problems are found: Erase the stored codes
- Place the ignition in the Run position
- Wiggle the wire harness and connectors
- Rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop
- Recheck for active codes periodically as you work through the system.
Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC)
ELECTRO/MECHANICAL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER (EMIC)
There are 4 (four) different types of Instrument Clusters. Base, Premium, Luxury, and AutoStick.
The Premium cluster is equipped with a tachometer and a low fuel indicator. The Luxury has the
same features as the Premium with an additional black overlay and chrome rings. The AutoStick is
the Luxury cluster with the AutoStick function. The Transmission controller (TCM) controls the
vacuum fluorescent (VF) PRND or AutoStick display. The cluster will illuminate the appropriate
PRND or gear position based on PCI Bus data received from the TCM.
The Instrument Cluster Speedometer; Tachometer; and Engine Coolant Temperature gauges are
positioned using PCI Bus messages received from the PCM. The Fuel gauge is a hard wired input
from the Fuel Level Sensor in the Fuel Pump Module.
The Cluster also contains warning indicators that are illuminated by hard wired inputs or by
messages received from other modules on the PCI Bus.
The Trip/Total Odometer is a Vacuum Fluorescent (VF) display that is controlled by PCI Bus
messages received from the PCM. The VF display also displays the "Door", "Cruise", and "Trac"
messages. If the Instrument Cluster experiences a loss of PCI Bus communication with other
modules on the Bus, the Cluster will display "nobus" in the VF display.
The illumination lamps are hard wired in the Instrument Cluster. When the Park or Headlamps are
turned on, the Cluster receives a hard wire input from the Multi-Function Switch. The Cluster sends
a Panel Lamps Dimmer Signal to ground through the Multi-Function Switch. The varying voltage
drop is sensed by the Instrument Panel Drivers to create a corresponding amount of illumination
dimming. This dimming level is then sent out from the Cluster to other components.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6771
The Cluster will communicate with the DRB III(R) to display PCI Engine Info, PCI Bus info, and
certain inputs/outputs. The Cluster is also capable of performing a diagnostic Self-Test that is
actuated by depressing and holding the Odometer trip reset stalk while cycling the ignition from the
off to the on position. The Cluster will position all of the gauges at specified calibration points and
will illuminate all the PCI Bus controlled indicators. The Cluster will also illuminate each segment of
the VF display.
If the Cluster does not detect voltage on the Courtesy Lamp circuit, the message "FUSE" will
alternate with the odometer/trip odometer for 30 (thirty) seconds after the ignition is turned on and
for 15 (fifteen) seconds after the vehicle is first moved.
Glossary of Terms
ABS Antilock Brake System
ACM Airbag Control Module
AECM Airbag Electronic Control Module (ACM)
ASDM Airbag System Diagnostic Module (ACM)
BUX Built-Up Export
CAB Controller Antilock Brake
CTM Compass/Temperature Mirror
DAB Driver Airbag
DLC Data Link Connector
DTC Diagnostic Trouble Code
EMIC Electro/Mechanical Instrument Cluster
LSIACM
Left SIACM
NGC Next Generation Controller
PAB Passenger Airbag
PCI Programmable Communication Interface (Vehicle Communication Bus)
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PDC Power Distribution Center
PWM
Pulse Width Modulated
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
RSIACM Right SIACM
SAB Side Airbag
SIACM Side Impact Airbag Control Module
SKIM Sentry Key Immobilizer Module
SKIS Sentry Key Immobilizer System
SQUIB Also Called Initiator (Located In Rear Of Airbag Module)
TCM Transmission Control Module
VFD Vacuum Fluorescent Display
VTSS Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6772
Body Control Module: Scan Tool Testing and Procedures
DRB III Error Messages and Blank Screen
DRB III ERROR MESSAGES AND BLANK SCREEN
Under normal operation, the DRB III will display one of only two error messages:
User-Requested WARM Boot (Press MORE and NO at the same time)
User-Requested COLD Boot (Press MORE and YES at the same time)
If the DRB III should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the
S.T.A.R. Center for information and assistance.
DRB III DOES NOT POWER UP
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 16). A minimum of 11 volts
is required to adequately power the DRB III.
If all connections are proper between the DRB III and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, and inoperative DRB III may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
For a blank screen, refer to the appropriate body diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 6773
DISPLAY IS NOT VISIBLE
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition
SOME DISPLAY ITEMS READ "---"
This is caused by scrolling the DRB III display a single line up or down. The line which was scrolled
onto the screen might read "---". Use the Page Down or Page Up function to display the
information.
DRB III Safety Information
DRB III (R) SAFETY INFORMATION
WARNING: EXCEEDING THE LIMITS OF THE DRB III (R) MULTIMETER IS DANGEROUS. IT
CAN EXPOSE YOU TO SERIOUS OR
POSSIBLE FATAL INJURY. CAREFULLY READ AND UNDERSTAND THE CAUTIONS AND THE
SPECIFICATION LIMITS.
Follow the vehicle manufacture's service specifications at all times.
Do not use the DRB Ill(R) if it has been damaged.
Do not use the test leads if the insulation is damaged or if metal is exposed.
To avoid electrical shock, do not touch the test leads, tips, or other circuit being tested.
Choose the proper range and function for the measurement. Do not try voltage or current
measurement that may exceed the rated capacity.
Do not exceed the limits shown in the table.
Voltage between any terminal and ground must not exceed 500v DC or 500v peak AC.
The circuit being tested must be protected by a 10A fuse or circuit breaker.
Use the low current shunt to measure circuits up to 10A. Use the higher current clamp to measure
circuits exceeding 10A.
When testing for the presence of voltage or current, make sure the meter is functioning correctly.
Take a reading of a known voltage or current before accepting a zero reading.
When measuring current, connect the meter in series with the load.
Disconnect the live test lead before disconnecting the common test lead.
When using the meter function, keep the DRB III (R) away from spark plug or coil wires to avoid
measuring error from outside interference.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 6774
Body Control Module: Tools and Equipment
REQUIRED TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
DRB III (R) (diagnostic read out box) Jumper Wires Ohmmeter Voltmeter Test Light 8310 Airbag
Load Tool 8443 SRS Airbag System Load Tool
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
FRONT FASCIA
REMOVAL
1. Remove splash shield attaching screws.
Fig. 1
2. Remove fasteners attaching air dam to cross-member (Fig. 1).
Fig. 2
3. SRT-4 vehicle remove four attaching screws (Fig. 2). 4. Disconnect fog lamp wiring harness, if
equipped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6780
Fig. 3
Fig. 4
5. Remove nuts attaching front bumper fascia to bottom of fender flange. (Fig. 3), and (Fig. 4). 6.
Remove fascia from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6781
Fig. 5
7. SRT-4 vehicle remove the fascia to crossmember upper blockers from the fascia (Fig. 5).
INSTALLATION
1. SRT-4 vehicle place into position the fascia to crossmember upper blockers to the fascia (Fig. 5).
2. Position fascia on vehicle , (Fig. 3) and (Fig. 4). 3. Install nuts attaching front bumper fascia to
bottom of fender flange. 4. Attach fascia horns to radiator crossmember. 5. SRT-4 vehicle install air
dam four attaching screws (Fig. 2). 6. Install air dam to crossmember fasteners (Fig. 1). 7. Install
splash shield attaching screws. 8. Connect fog lamp wiring harness.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair
FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Remove front bumper fascia. Refer to Front Bumper. 2. Support bumper reinforcement on a
suitable lifting device.
Fig. 6
3. Remove nuts attaching reinforcement to the rail assembly (Fig. 6). 4. Remove bumper
reinforcement from vehicle. 5. Remove bolt attaching energy absorbers to beam, and peal energy
absorbers from beam, if equipped.
INSTALLATION
1. Install energy absorbers to beam and install attaching bolt. 2. Place bumper reinforcement in
position (Fig. 6). 3. Support bumper reinforcement on a suitable lifting device. 4. Install nuts
attaching reinforcement to rail assembly. 5. Install front fascia.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Service and Repair
REAR FASCIA
REMOVAL
1. Release decklid lock and open decklid.
Fig. 7
2. Remove screws and screw pin fasteners attaching fascia in the trunk (Fig. 7). 3. Raise vehicle
on hoist. 4. Disconnect license lamp. 5. Remove splash shield from fascia in the wheel opening
area. 6. From under license plate area, remove fasteners attaching lower fascia. 7. Remove nuts
attaching fascia to lower quarter panels. 8. Remove fascia from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position fascia on vehicle. 2. Install nuts attaching fascia to lower quarter panels (Fig. 7). 3. From
under license plate area, install fasteners attaching lower fascia. 4. Install splash shield in the
wheel opening area. 5. Connect license lamp. 6. Lower vehicle. 7. Install screws and screw pin
fasteners attaching fascia in the trunk. 8. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair
REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
REMOVAL
Fig. 8
1. Remove rear fascia (Fig. 8). 2. Support bumper reinforcement on a suitable lifting device. 3.
Remove screws attaching reinforcement to rear closure panel. 4. Remove bumper reinforcement
from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position bumper reinforcement to vehicle. 2. Install screws attaching reinforcement to rear
closure panel. 3. Install rear fascia.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL GRILLE SCREEN
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove windshield wiper arms.
Fig. 1
3. Remove the five screws attaching cowl screen cover to just below windshield flange. (Fig. 1). 4.
Remove cowl plenum to hood weatherstrip, at the leading edge of cowl cover. Pull weatherstrip
towards the front of the vehicle to remove. 5. Remove cowl screen windshield seal from upper
edge of the cowl screen cover. 6. Remove cowl screen cover from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair >
Page 6796
Fig. 2
1. Place cowl screen cover into position on vehicle (Fig. 2). 2. Start five screws attaching cowl
screen cover to cowl at base of windshield opening. 3. Install cowl screen windshield seal to upper
edge of the cowl screen. 4. Push cowl plenum to hood weatherstrip, into position on the leading
edge of cowl screen cover. 5. Install windshield wiper arms. 6. Tighten screws attaching cowl
screen cover to cowl at base of windshield opening. 7. Install windshield wiper arms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR HANDLE
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove the waterdam as necessary to gain access to the exterior
handle and door latch mechanisms. 3. Close door glass. 4. Disconnect lock and latch rods from
door latch.
Fig. 7
5. Remove screws attaching door handle retainer to outer door panel (Fig. 7). 6. Remove door
handle from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position door handle into door and install retainer at back of handle. 2. Install the screws
attaching door handle retainer to outer door panel. 3. Connect lock and latch rods to door latch. 4.
Place waterdam onto the door and pressurize at the butyl bead to seal completely. 5. Install door
trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Hinge: Service and Repair
FRONT DOOR HINGE
REMOVAL
1. Open and support door on a suitable lifting device. 2. Remove bolts attaching door check strap
to lower A-pillar for greater access, if necessary. 3. Mark position of hinge on both the door end
frame and lower A-pillar to ease installation.
Fig. 4
4. Remove bolts attaching hinge to door end frame (Fig. 4). 5. Remove bolts attaching hinge to
lower A-pillar. 6. Remove door hinge from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: When installing a new hinge, make sure that the head of each hinge pin is fully seated
into the door hinge. Also, remove the plastic shipping clip and replace it with the correct metal
retaining clip once the hinge pin is seated.
1. If necessary, paint new door hinge prior to installation. 2. Position door hinge on vehicle. 3.
Loosely install bolts attaching hinge to lower A-pillar. 4. Loosely install bolts attaching hinge to door
end frame. 5. Align hinge to marks made previously and tighten all bolts. 6. Install bolts attaching
door check strap to lower A-pillar, if removed previously. 7. Verify door fit and operation. Adjust
door hinge for proper door alignment, if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments
Front Door Latch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Insert a hex-wrench through the elongated hole in the door end frame near the latch striker
opening. 2. Loosen socket head screw on the side of the latch linkage. 3. Lift upward on outside
door handle and release it. 4. Tighten socket head screw on latch. 5. Verify latch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 6810
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair
LATCH
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water shield. 2. Close door glass.
Fig. 8
3. Disconnect lock and latch rods from door latch (Fig. 8). 4. Disengage wire connector from power
door lock motor, if equipped. 5. Remove screws holding latch to door end frame. 6. Remove door
latch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not close door before adjusting the door latch. Door may fail to open.
1. Position door latch inside door and install screws holding latch to door end frame. 2. Engage
wire connector into power door lock motor, if so equipped. 3. Connect latch and lock rods to door
latch. 4. Install door trim panel and water shield. 5. Adjust door latch using procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Limiter >
System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Limiter: Service and Repair
CHECK STRAP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove bolt attaching check strap to hinge pillar. 3.
Remove door speaker. 4. Remove glass run.
Fig. 3
5. Remove bolts attaching check strap to door end frame (Fig. 3). 6. Remove check strap from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Do not grease check strap.
1. Position door check on vehicle and install bolts attaching strap to door end frame. 2. Install glass
run. 3. Install door speaker, if so equipped. 4. Install bolt attaching door check strap to hinge pillar.
5. Install door trim panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Trim Panel
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Trim Panel
TRIM PANEL
REMOVAL
1. Release door latch and open door. 2. Lower door glass.
Fig. 13
3. Remove window regulator crank, if so equipped (Fig. 13).
Fig. 11
4. Remove screw from inside arm rest pull cup (Fig. 11). 5. Remove screw from behind inside latch
release handle. 6. Disengage push-in fasteners attaching trim to door panel around perimeter of
trim panel. 7. Tilt trim panel outward to clear locator pins on backside of trim panel. 8. Disconnect
trim panel from retainer channel in inner belt weatherstrip at top of door by lifting while gently
jiggling. 9. Move trim panel away from door and disengage clip attaching latch rod to handle.
10. Remove latch rod from handle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Trim Panel > Page 6818
CAUTION: Do not allow door trim panel to hang by the wire connector or wiring.
11. Disconnect wire connector from power door lock switch, mirror switch, and power window
switch if so equipped. 12. Remove trim panel from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Replace any damaged or missing push in fasteners from around perimeter of door trim panel. 2.
Place trim panel near door. 3. Connect wire connector into power door lock switch, mirror switch,
and power window switch , if so equipped. 4. Insert latch rod into handle and engage clip. 5. Install
trim panel into retainer channel at top of door and push down to seat. 6. Locate door trim panel to
inner door panel by aligning locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner door
panel. 7. Install push in fasteners to hold trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 8. Install
screw inside latch release handle. 9. Install screw inside arm rest pull cup.
10. With the window in the down position, orientate the window regulator crank handle
appropriately. Install the right handle at the 10 o'clock position
and the left handle at the 2 O'clock position, if so equipped.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Trim Panel > Page 6819
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair Waterdam
WATERDAM
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove door trim pull cup
mount bracket. 4. Disconnect clip attaching lock linkage to lock button bell-crank.
Fig. 12
5. Peel water dam away from adhesive around perimeter of inner door panel (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insure that enough adhesive remains to securely retain the water dam. Replace as necessary. 2.
Place the water dam into position and press securely to adhesive making sure to properly route
wiring and linkages. 3. Engage clip attaching lock linkage to lock button bell-crank. 4. Install door
trim pull cup mount bracket. 5. Install door speaker, if equipped. 6. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker >
System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Striker: Service and Repair
LATCH STRIKER
REMOVAL
1. Mark outline of door latch striker on B-pillar to aid installation.
Fig. 9
2. Remove screws attaching door latch striker to B-pillar (Fig. 9). 3. Remove door latch striker from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install door latch striker into the door. 2. Install screws attaching door latch striker to B-pillar
loosely. 3. Align door latch striker to outline marks on the B-pillar 4. Tighten screws attaching door
latch striker to B-pillar. 5. Check door alignment and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Front Vertical Guide Bar
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6828
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair B-Pillar Weatherstrip Channel
B-PILLAR WEATHERSTRIP CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove b-pillar applique. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 3. Pull
weatherstrip from b-pillar channels. 4. Remove screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 5. Remove
channels from b-pillar.
INSTALLATION
1. Install channels from b-pillar. 2. Install screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 3. Install
weatherstrip to b-pillar channels. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 5.
Install b-pillar applique.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6829
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair FDR Glass Run Weatherstrip
FDR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove flag cover, door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Loosen
side view mirror, as necessary. 4. Remove weatherstrip fasteners. 5. Pull weatherstrip from lower
front channel above door latch.
Fig. 1
6. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Tighten side view mirror. 8. Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, door trim panel and flag
trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6830
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Weatherstrip
OUTER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open door glass. 2. Pull upward at rear end of outer belt weatherstrip.
Fig. 2
3. Remove outer belt weatherstrip from vehicle (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Starting at leading edge of door, press weatherstrip onto door. 2. Operate window and check for
interference
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6831
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Front Vertical Guide Bar
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
B-Pillar Weatherstrip Channel
B-PILLAR WEATHERSTRIP CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove b-pillar applique. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 3. Pull
weatherstrip from b-pillar channels. 4. Remove screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 5. Remove
channels from b-pillar.
INSTALLATION
1. Install channels from b-pillar. 2. Install screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 3. Install
weatherstrip to b-pillar channels. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 5.
Install b-pillar applique.
FDR Glass Run Weatherstrip
FDR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove flag cover, door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Loosen
side view mirror, as necessary. 4. Remove weatherstrip fasteners. 5. Pull weatherstrip from lower
front channel above door latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6832
Fig. 1
6. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Tighten side view mirror. 8. Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, door trim panel and flag
trim.
Outer Belt Weatherstrip
OUTER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open door glass. 2. Pull upward at rear end of outer belt weatherstrip.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6833
Fig. 2
3. Remove outer belt weatherstrip from vehicle (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Starting at leading edge of door, press weatherstrip onto door. 2. Operate window and check for
interference
Door Upper Secondary Weatherstrip
DOOR UPPER SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool, disengage push in fasteners attaching door upper secondary
weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page
6834
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Move the window to the full-up position, if
possible. 3. Remove front door trim panel. 4. Remove front door water shield. 5. Remove three
screws to front door radio speaker so that motor has room to pivot. 6. Pivot window motor out of
door panel. 7. Remove three motor retaining screws to drive cable. 8. Remove motor from drive
cable assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install motor to the cable drive assembly. 2. Install motor retaining screws to drive cable. 3.
Install the screws to the front door radio speaker. 4. Install the front door water shield. 5. Install the
front door trim panel. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR HANDLE
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Close door glass. 3. Disengage clips attaching linkage rods to door
handle.
Fig. 5
4. Remove nuts attaching outside handle to door (Fig. 5). 5. Remove outside handle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position door outside handle in opening. 2. Tighten attaching nuts. 3. Connect linkage rods to
latch. 4. Connect lock and latch rods to door handle. 5. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Hinge: Service and Repair
HINGE
REMOVAL
NOTE: If both hinges on one door are to be replaced, remove and install one hinge completely
prior to beginning the second hinge.
1. Open and support door on a suitable lifting device. 2. Remove bolts attaching door check strap
to lower B-pillar for greater access, if necessary. 3. Mark position of hinge on both the door end
frame and lower B-pillar to ease installation.
Fig. 3
4. Remove bolts attaching hinge to door end frame (Fig. 3). 5. Remove bolts attaching hinge to
lower B-pillar. 6. Remove door hinge from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE:
- If both hinges on one door are to be replaced, remove and install one hinge completely prior to
beginning the second hinge.
- Do not grease door hinges.
1. If necessary, paint new door hinge prior to installation. 2. Position door hinge on vehicle. 3.
Loosely install bolts attaching hinge to lower B-pillar. 4. Loosely install bolts attaching hinge to door
end frame. 5. Align hinge to marks made previously and tighten all bolts. 6. Install bolts attaching
door check strap to lower B-pillar, if removed previously. 7. Verify door fit and operation. Adjust
door hinge for proper door alignment, if necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Latch: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENTS
1. Insert a hex-wrench through the elongated hole in the door end frame near the latch striker
opening. 2. Loosen socket head screw on the side of the latch linkage. 3. Lift upward on outside
door handle and release it. 4. Tighten socket head screw on latch. 5. Verify latch operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 6849
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair
LATCH
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Close door glass. 3. Loosen lower rear run channel. 4. Disconnect
clips attaching linkage rods to door latch.
Fig. 6
5. Remove linkage rods from latch (Fig. 6). 6. Remove screws attaching latch to door end frame. 7.
Remove door latch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not close door before adjusting the door latch. Door may fail to open.
1. Position door latch on vehicle and install screws attaching latch to door end frame. 2. Connect
linkage rods to latch. 3. Connect lock and latch rods to door latch. 4. Tighten lower rear run
channel. 5. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Limiter >
System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Limiter: Service and Repair
CHECK STRAP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove bolts attaching check strap to hinge pillar. 3. Remove check
strap seal from door end frame.
Fig. 2
4. Remove bolts attaching check strap to door end frame (Fig. 2). 5. Remove check strap from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not close door before adjusting the door latch. Door may fail to open.
1. Position door check strap on vehicle. 2. Install check strap attaching bolts to the door end frame.
3. Install check strap seal. If seal is damaged or worn replace seal. 4. Install check strap attaching
bolts to the hinge pillar. 5. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Trim Panel
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Trim Panel
TRIM PANEL
REMOVAL
1. Release door latch and open door. 2. Lower window glass. 3. Remove window regulator crank.
4. Remove screw from inside arm rest pull cup.
Fig. 7
5. Remove screw from behind inside latch release handle (Fig. 7). 6. Disengage push in fasteners
attaching trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 7. Disengage push-in metal spring clip
holding trim in sail flag area. 8. Lift trim panel up off belt weatherstrip. 9. Tilt top of trim panel away
from door and disengage clip attaching latch rod to handle.
10. Remove latch rod from handle. 11. Remove trim panel from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Replace any damaged or missing push in fasteners from around perimeter of door trim panel. 2.
Place trim panel in position on door. 3. Insert latch rod into handle and engage clip. 4. Engage trim
panel into retainer channel at top of door. 5. Locate door trim panel to inner door panel by aligning
locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner door panel. 6. Engage push in
fasteners attaching trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 7. Install screw behind inside
latch release handle. 8. Install screw inside arm rest pull cup. 9. Install window regulator crank.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Trim Panel > Page 6857
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair Waterdam
WATERDAM
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove door trim pull cup
mount bracket. 4. Disconnect clip attaching lock linkage to lock button bell-crank.
Fig. 8
5. Peel water dam away from adhesive around perimeter of inner door panel (Fig. 8).
INSTALLATION
1. Insure that enough adhesive remains to securely retain the water dam. Replace as necessary. 2.
Place the water dam into position and press securely to adhesive making sure to properly route
wiring and linkages. 3. Engage clip attaching lock linkage to lock button bell-crank. 4. Install door
trim pull cup mount bracket. 5. Install door speaker, if equipped. 6. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Striker > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Striker: Service and Repair
LATCH STRIKER
REMOVAL
1. Mark outline of door latch striker on B-pillar to aid installation.
Fig. 4
2. Remove screws attaching door latch striker to B-pillar (Fig. 4). 3. Remove door latch striker from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install door latch striker from vehicle. 2. Install screws attaching door latch striker to B-pillar. 3.
Align marked outline of door latch striker on B-pillar to aid installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6866
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Rear Door Glass Run Weatherstrip
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Remove
weatherstrip fasteners. 4. Pull weatherstrip from lower front channel above door latch.
Fig. 4
5. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 4).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, and door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6867
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair RDR Secondary Weatherstrip
RDR SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool C-4829 or equivalent, disengage push in fasteners attaching door
upper secondary weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6868
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Roof Rail Weatherstrip
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open front and rear doors. 2. Using a door trim removing tool, disengage the push-in fasteners
holding A-pillar and C-pillar weatherstrip molding. 3. Starting at the bottom of the A-pillar, pull the
roof rail weatherstrip from the windshield side molding.
Fig. 5
4. Pull roof rail weatherstrip from the roof rail pinch flange above the door opening (Fig. 5). 5.
Separate roof rail weatherstrip from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place weatherstrip in position on pinch flange. 2. Starting at the bottom of the C-pillar, install the
roof rail weatherstrip molding to the pinch rail. 3. Install push-in fasteners to hold weatherstrip to
A-pillar and C-pillar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6869
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Rear Door Glass Run Weatherstrip
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Remove
weatherstrip fasteners. 4. Pull weatherstrip from lower front channel above door latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6870
Fig. 4
5. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 4).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, and door trim panel.
RDR Secondary Weatherstrip
RDR SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool C-4829 or equivalent, disengage push in fasteners attaching door
upper secondary weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Roof Rail Weatherstrip
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open front and rear doors. 2. Using a door trim removing tool, disengage the push-in fasteners
holding A-pillar and C-pillar weatherstrip molding. 3. Starting at the bottom of the A-pillar, pull the
roof rail weatherstrip from the windshield side molding.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6871
Fig. 5
4. Pull roof rail weatherstrip from the roof rail pinch flange above the door opening (Fig. 5). 5.
Separate roof rail weatherstrip from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place weatherstrip in position on pinch flange. 2. Starting at the bottom of the C-pillar, install the
roof rail weatherstrip molding to the pinch rail. 3. Install push-in fasteners to hold weatherstrip to
A-pillar and C-pillar.
Roof Rail Weatherstrip Retainer Channel
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP RETAINER CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Open door(s). 2. Using trim stick disconnect the top and bottom push in fasteners from B-pillar
applique. Gently pull outward on the applique to remove from the
vehicle.
NOTE: The applique is attached to the vehicle with two sided tape between the push in fasteners,
ensure all of the old two sided tape is removed from the vehicle surface before installation of new
part.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6872
Fig. 6
3. Remove weatherstrip from the retainer channel (Fig. 6). 4. Remove retainer channel from the
body side aperture.
INSTALLATION
1. Install retainer channel to the body side aperture. 2. Remove weatherstrip from the retainer
channel. 3. Connect the top and bottom push in fasteners to B-pillar applique. Gently push on the
applique to install from the vehicle.
Secondary Sill Weatherstrip
SECONDARY SILL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
Fig. 7
1. Using a fork-type prying tool, disengage push in fasteners attaching sill secondary weatherstrip
to door (Fig. 7). 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip > Page 6873
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to door. 2. Press sill secondary weatherstrip fasteners into position.
Trunk Opening Weatherstrip
TRUNK OPENING WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open decklid.
Fig. 8
2. Pull decklid weatherstrip form decklid opening fence (Fig. 8). 3. Remove weatherstrip from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place decklid opening weatherstrip into position. 2. Press the weatherstrip onto the decklid
opening fence. 3. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove door glass from regulator channel.
Tie Strap Door Regulator Cable
3. Cut away the tie strap from the outboard regulator cable.
Rear Door Glass
4. Loosen screws attaching window regulator channel and crank housing to door panel. 5.
Disengage screw and bolt heads from keyhole slots in door panel. 6. Loosen bolts attaching
window regulator to door panel. 7. Disengage regulator from door panel, and crank housing. 8.
Slide regulator rearward and rotate forward end of roller channel through access hole in door
panel,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 6877
9. Remove window regulator from door through access hole in inner panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Position window regulator and crank housing on door panel through access hole in door panel.
2. Tighten bolts attaching window regulator to door panel. 3. Engage window regulator bolt heads
on channel to key hole slots in door panel. 4. Tighten screw attaching window regulator channel
and crank housing. 5. Install a new tie strap around the outboard regulator cable and door inner
sheet metal. 6. Position glass to regulator roller channel. 7. Tighten fasteners attaching door glass
to roller channel. 8. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Fuel Door: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Open the fuel filler door.
Fig. 5
2. Remove the screws attaching the door to the quarter panel (Fig. 5). 3. Remove the door from the
panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the fuel filler door on the quarter panel with the screw holes aligned. 2. Install the
screws attaching the fuel filler door to the quarter panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Hinge > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Hood Hinge: Service and Repair
HINGE
REMOVAL
1. Support hood on the side that requires hinge replacement. 2. Mark all bolt and hinge attachment
locations with a grease pencil or other suitable device to provide reference marks for installation.
When
installing hood hinge, align all marks and secure bolts. The hood should be aligned to 4 mm (0.160
in.) gap to the front fenders and flush across the top surfaces along fenders. Shims can be added
or removed under hood hinge to achieve proper hood height.
Fig. 1
3. Remove bolts holding hood to hinge (Fig. 1). 4. Remove bolts holding hood hinge to load beam
flange and separate hinge from vehicle. If necessary, paint new hinge before installation.
INSTALLATION
1. If necessary, paint new hinge before installation. 2. Place hinge in position on vehicle. 3. Install
bolts to hold hood hinge to front fender flange. 4. Install bolts to hold hood to hinge. 5. Align all
marks and secure bolts. The hood should be aligned to 4 mm (0.160 in.) gap to the front fenders
and flush across the top surfaces along
fenders. Shims can be added or removed under hood hinge to achieve proper hood height.
6. Remove support from under hood and verify hood operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Insulator / Pad > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Insulator / Pad: Service and Repair
SILENCER PAD
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood.
Fig. 8
2. Disconnect hood lamp wire connector and remove hood lamp (Fig. 8). 3. Remove fasteners
attaching hood silencer to hood. 4. Remove hood silencer from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place hood silencer in position on vehicle. 2. Install fastener attaching hood silencer to hood. 3.
Install hood lamp and connect wire connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Hood Latch: Service and Repair
LATCH
REMOVAL
Domestic
Fig. 4
1. Remove the upper fasteners securing the grille to the upper radiator closure panel. (Fig. 4)
Fig. 5
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 6891
2. Using a socket and extension, remove the nuts attaching hood latch to radiator closure panel.
(Fig. 5) 3. Carefully pull the grille out from the radiator closure and remove the hood latch
assembly. 4. Disengage remote release cable from latch.
International
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Support hood on prop rod. 3. Remove grille. 4. Remove
nuts attaching hood latch to radiator closure panel (Fig. 5). 5. Remove hood latch from closure
panel. 6. Disengage remote release cable from latch.
INSTALLATION
Domestic
1. Engage remote release cable into latch. 2. Carefully pull back the grille and place hood latch
onto radiator closure panel. 3. Install the nuts and tighten to 15 N.m (11 ft.lbs.). 4. Install the upper
fasteners securing the grille to the upper radiator closure panel.
International
1. Engage remote release cable into latch. 2. Place hood latch onto radiator closure panel. 3. Install
nuts attaching latch to closure panel and tighten to 15 N.m (11 ft.lbs.). 4. Install grille. 5. Close hood
and verify alignment of hood and that latch is securely engaged.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Latch Release Cable: Service and Repair
LATCH RELEASE CABLE
REMOVAL
1. Unlatch hood and open 2. Disconnect remote hood release cable from hood latch.
Fig. 6
3. Release any remote hood cable attachments and free cable (Fig. 6). 4. Remove left front cowl
trim panel, Refer to Trim Panel.
Fig. 7
5. Remove screws attaching hood release handle to cowl panel and release cable from clip (Fig.
7).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6895
6. Disconnect rubber grommet from dash panel behind instrument panel. 7. Pull release cable
through hole in dash panel. 8. Remove cable and handle from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. From inside of vehicle feed remote release cable through hole in dash panel (Fig. 7) 2. Connect
rubber grommet into dash panel. 3. Install screws attaching hood release handle to cowl panel. 4.
Install left front cowl trim panel. 5. Connect any remote cable attachments (Fig. 6). 6. Connect
remote hood release cable to hood latch. 7. Close hood and verify operation. 8. Check remote
hood release cable for proper operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Stop > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Hood Stop: Service and Repair
ADJUSTMENT BUMPER
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Rotate hood adjuster bumper counterclockwise. 3.
Remove hood adjuster bumper from headlamp reinforcement.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Striker > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Hood Striker: Service and Repair
LATCH STRIKER
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove bolts attaching striker to inside of hood. 3.
Remove hood latch striker from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position hood latch striker on vehicle. 2. Install bolts attaching hood latch striker to hood. Tighten
bolts to 13.5 N.m (10 ft.lbs.) torque. 3. Align hood latch striker to engage smoothly into hood latch.
4. Verify hood operation and alignment. Adjust as necessary. 5. Tighten attaching bolts to 13.5 N.m
(10 ft.lbs.) torque.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6906
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
HOOD AJAR SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Open hood.
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable - Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
hood ajar switch.
Fig.2 Hood Ajar Switch Location
4. Firmly press tangs on the bottom side of the switch together and push up through bracket. 5.
Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Firmly press hood ajar switch through bracket. 2. Connect wire harness connector to hood ajar
switch. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Close hood. 5. Verify vehicle and system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Cover > System
Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Cover: Service and Repair
COVER
REMOVAL
Fig. 1
1. Remove fasteners attaching decklid cover to vehicle (Fig. 1). 2. Remove decklid cover from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position cover on decklid over the striker. 2. Install push in fasteners. 3. Seat the lower edges of
the carpet and smooth out. 4. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair
LATCH
REMOVAL
1. Open decklid.
Fig. 3
2. Remove bolts attaching decklid latch to decklid (Fig. 3). 3. Remove attaching latch from decklid.
4. Disconnect remote decklid latch release cable form decklid latch. 5. Disconnect decklid ajar
switch connector from latch. 6. Remove latch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place decklid latch into position (Fig. 3). 2. Connect remote decklid latch wire connector to
decklid latch. 3. Connect decklid ajar and lamp switch connector to latch. 4. Install bolts attaching
decklid latch to decklid lid. 5. Check decklid latch for proper alignment. 6. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch Release
Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Latch Release Cable: Service and Repair
EMERGENCY RELEASE CABLE
REMOVAL
1. Remove the decklid cover. Refer to Trim Panel.
Fig. 6
2. Unclip cable and handle assembly (Fig. 6).
INSTALLATION
1. Attach emergency release cable clip to the latch stud. 2. Install the decklid cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
LOCK CYLINDER
REMOVAL
Fig. 2
1. Remove decklid latch. 2. Remove clip attaching decklid lock cylinder to decklid. 3. Pull lock
cylinder from decklid (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Place lock cylinder into position. 2. Install clip attaching decklid lock cylinder to decklid. 3. Install
decklid latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6924
Fig. 48 Decklid - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6925
Decklid Solenoid
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6926
Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
DECKLID SOLENOID TEST
1. Confirm operation of RKE transmitter(s) by actuating LOCK and UNLOCK functions. 2. Confirm
lead is connected to the deck lid release solenoid. 3. Unplug lead, and use an ohmmeter to verify
continuity of connection between pin 2 of the harness connector and ground. 4. Connect test light
to pin 1 of the harness connector and actuate deck lid release button on transmitter. 5. If test light
comes ON, the wiring circuit between the RKE module and the solenoid is functional, and the deck
lid solenoid should be replaced. 6. If test light does not come on, refer to the proper Body
Diagnostic Procedures for further troubleshooting information.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6927
Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid: Service and Repair
DECKLID SOLENOID
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Raise deck lid to the full up position. 3.
Unplug connector from solenoid. 4. Remove two solenoid mounting screws. 5. Remove solenoid
from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the solenoid into the vehicle. 2. Install the two solenoid mounting screws. 3. Plug the
connector into the solenoid. 4. Close the deck lid. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Adjust the deck lid latch and striker so that the deck lid latches with a moderate slam and so that
the deck lid releases properly whenever the power deck lid release is activated.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Spring: Service and Repair
LIFT SPRING
REMOVAL
WARNING: USE EYE AND HAND PROTECTION WHEN REMOVING SPRINGS, PERSONAL
INJURY MAY RESULT.
1. Release and open decklid. 2. Support decklid on a suitable prop device.
Fig. 5
3. Using a common pliers, disengage spring from rearward notch or hole under decklid opening
side trough (Fig. 5). 4. Disengage spring from decklid hinge.
INSTALLATION
1. Engage spring to decklid hinge. 2. Using a common pliers, connect spring to the rearward notch
or hole under decklid opening side trough (Fig. 5). Without spoiler connect the
spring into the hole. With spoiler connect spring to the notch.
3. Position spring with the damper at the of the spring with only 3 coils showing. 4. Remove decklid
support device. 5. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Striker >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Striker: Service and Repair
LATCH STRIKER
REMOVAL
1. Release decklid latch and open decklid. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching decklid lining to
tail panel. 3. Remove trunk lining from tail panel.
Fig. 4
4. Remove bolts attaching decklid latch striker to tail panel (Fig. 4). 5. Remove striker from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install striker in vehicle. 2. Install trunk lining from tail panel. 3. Install push in fasteners attaching
decklid lining to tail panel. 4. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6937
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6938
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6939
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6940
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6941
Fig. 35 Decklid - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6942
Decklid Release Switch (Power Release)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6943
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair
DECKLID RELEASE SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the glove box door. 3. Using a trim
stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry out on the deck lid release switch and pull out
of instrument panel. 4. Disconnect the wiring connector. 5. Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the wiring connector. 2. Align switch in hole and firmly snap into place. 3. Close the
glove box door. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Body Emblem: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR NAME PLATES
REMOVAL
1. Mark reference points before removing. 2. Using a heat gun gently apply heat in a circular
motion to loosen the adhesive bond. 3. Using a nonmetallic prying device, such as a plastic or
wood trim stick gently pry up at corners and remove. 4. Clean off all traces of adhesive or double
sided tape from the panel with a general purpose adhesive remover.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean panel surface with isopropyl alcohol. 2. Align badgeing to reference points. 3. Install and
press securely to full adhesive contact. 4. Clean away any reference points.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL GRILLE SCREEN
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove windshield wiper arms.
Fig. 1
3. Remove the five screws attaching cowl screen cover to just below windshield flange. (Fig. 1). 4.
Remove cowl plenum to hood weatherstrip, at the leading edge of cowl cover. Pull weatherstrip
towards the front of the vehicle to remove. 5. Remove cowl screen windshield seal from upper
edge of the cowl screen cover. 6. Remove cowl screen cover from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair > Page 6951
Fig. 2
1. Place cowl screen cover into position on vehicle (Fig. 2). 2. Start five screws attaching cowl
screen cover to cowl at base of windshield opening. 3. Install cowl screen windshield seal to upper
edge of the cowl screen. 4. Push cowl plenum to hood weatherstrip, into position on the leading
edge of cowl screen cover. 5. Install windshield wiper arms. 6. Tighten screws attaching cowl
screen cover to cowl at base of windshield opening. 7. Install windshield wiper arms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Service and Repair
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair
FRONT END SPLASH SHIELDS
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Remove front wheel.
Fig. 3
3. Remove push-in fasteners attaching splash shield to frame rail forward of suspension (Fig. 3). 4.
Remove push in fasteners attaching splash shield to frame rail rearward of suspension. 5. Remove
screws attaching wheelhouse splash shield to front fender. 6. Remove splash shield from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place splash shield in position on vehicle. 2. Install screws attaching wheelhouse splash shield
to front fender. 3. Install push in fasteners attaching splash shield to frame rail rearward of
suspension. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching splash shield to frame rail forward of suspension.
5. Install front wheel. 6. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Rear Fender > Rear Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair
Rear Fender Liner: Service and Repair
REAR WHEELHOUSE SPLASH SHIELD
REMOVAL
1. Remove the wheel.
Fig. 10
2. Remove the two screws and the three push-pin fasteners (Fig. 10).
INSTALLATION
1. Install the shield. 2. Install the three push-pin fasteners and two screws. 3. Install the wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation
Front Cross-Member: Description and Operation
FRONT CROSSMEMBER
DESCRIPTION
The front suspension crossmember must be properly installed to achieve design camber, caster
settings and wheel stagger. The crossmember can be installed out of position on the frame rails
due to its design. Bolts and cage nuts hold the rear of the crossmember to the frame torque boxes.
Bolts and J-nuts hold the front of the crossmember to the frame rails. No designed in locating
device is used to position the crossmember in the vehicle. Before removing the crossmember mark
the frame torque box around the rear mounting location to aid installation. A crossmember that is
removed during service must be installed in the same position from which it was removed. To verify
that crossmember is in the proper position, refer to the dimensions provided. Front end dimensions
are gauged from the principal locating point (PLP) holes located under the frame torque boxes
rearward of the front wheels. After removal and installation of the crossmember is performed, verify
that front suspension alignment is within specifications. If camber, caster settings and thrust angle
are not within specifications, loosen and reposition crossmember to bring suspension within
specifications.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6966
Front Cross-Member: Service and Repair
FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember is being replaced due to collision damage, inspect
the steering column lower coupling for damage.
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle. 2. Remove both front tire and wheel assemblies from the vehicle.
Fig. 13
3. Remove both stabilizer bar links from the vehicle (Fig. 13). Remove each link by holding the
upper retainer/nut with a wrench and turning the link
bolt.
4. Remove the stabilizer bar cushion retainer bolts and retainers (Fig. 13), and remove the
stabilizer bar with cushions attached from the vehicle.
Fig. 14
5. Remove the nut and pinch bolt clamping each ball joint stud to the steering knuckle (Fig. 14).
CAUTION: After removing the steering knuckle from the ball joint stud, do not pull outward on the
knuckle. Pulling the steering knuckle outward at this point can separate the inner C/V joint on the
driveshaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6967
NOTE: Use caution when separating the ball joint stud from the steering knuckle, so the ball joint
seal does not get cut.
Fig. 15
6. Separate each ball joint stud from the steering knuckle by prying down on lower control arm and
up against the ball joint boss on the steering
knuckle (Fig. 15).
7. Remove the two screws securing the cooler to the front suspension crossmember. They are
located behind the cooler and can be accessed from
above. Allow the cooler to hang out of the way.
8. Using wire or cord, support and tie off the power steering gear to the underbody of the vehicle,
so when the crossmember is lowered, the gear does
not fall away being held to the vehicle by only the steering column coupler and the fluid hoses.
Fig. 16
9. Loosen and remove the four bolts attaching the power steering gear to the front suspension
cross-member (Fig. 16). Remove the power steering
gear from the front suspension crossmember.
10. Remove the drive-belt splash shield fasteners. Remove the shield.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6968
Fig. 17
11. Remove the pencil strut from the right front corner of the crossmember and body of the vehicle
(Fig. 17). Remove the washer behind the strut from
the torque strut bolt.
12. Remove the bolts mounting the engine torque strut in place (Fig. 17), then remove the engine
torque strut from the vehicle.
NOTE: Before removing the front suspension cross-member from the vehicle, the location of the
cross-member must be scribed on the body of the vehicle (Fig. 9). Do this so that the crossmember
can be relocated upon reinstallation against the body of vehicle in the same location as before
removal. If the front suspension crossmember is not reinstalled in exactly the same location as
before removal, the preset front wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
Fig. 18
13. Using an awl, scribe a line (Fig. 18) marking the location of where the front suspension
crossmember is mounted against the body of the vehicle. 14. Position a transmission jack under
the center of the front suspension crossmember and raise it to support the bottom of the
crossmember.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6969
Fig. 19
15. Loosen and completely remove the two front bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front
suspension crossmember to the frame rails of vehicle.
The right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure (Fig. 19). The left side bolt is located in
the same location on the other side of the vehicle.
16. Loosen the two rear bolts (one right and one left) attaching the front suspension crossmember
and lower control arms to the body of the vehicle
until they release from the threaded tapping plates in the body of the vehicle. Remove the rear
bolts from the body of the vehicle, but do not completely remove the rear bolts because they are
designed to disengage from the body threads yet stay within the lower control arm rear isolator
bushing. This allows the lower control arm to stay in place on the crossmember. The right side bolt
can be viewed in the mounting bolt figure (Fig. 19). The left side bolt is located in the same location
on the other side of the vehicle.
17. Lower the front suspension crossmember. 18. Remove each lower control arm from the
crossmember by removing the front pivot bolt.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If the front suspension crossmember is being replaced due to collision damage, inspect
the steering column lower coupling for damage.
1. Install the lower control arms on the front suspension crossmember. Install the pivot bolts, but do
not completely tighten them at this time. 2. Using the transmission jack, raise the front suspension
crossmember and lower control arms until the crossmember contacts its mounting spot
against the body and frame rails of the vehicle. As the crossmember is raised, carefully guide the
power steering gear into mounting position.
3. Start the two rear crossmember mounting bolts into the tapping plates mounted in the body. The
right side bolt can be viewed in the mounting bolt
figure (Fig. 19). The left side bolt is located in the same location on the other side of the vehicle.
Next, install the two front mounting bolts attaching front suspension crossmember to frame rails of
vehicle. Lightly tighten all four mounting bolts to a approximately 2 N.m (20 in.lbs.) to hold the front
suspension crossmember in position.
NOTE: When reinstalling the front suspension crossmember back in the vehicle, it is very important
that the crossmember be attached to the body in exactly the same spot as when it was removed.
Otherwise, the vehicle's wheel alignment settings (caster and camber) will be lost.
4. Using a soft face hammer, tap the front suspension crossmember back-and-forth or side-to-side
until it is aligned with the previously scribed
positioning marks on the body of the vehicle (Fig. 18). Once the front suspension crossmember is
correctly positioned, tighten the rear two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque of 203 N.m (150
ft.lbs.), then tighten the front two crossmember mounting bolts to a torque of 142 N.m (105 ft.lbs.).
5. Tighten the lower control arm front pivot bolts to a torque of 163 N.m (120 ft.lbs.). 6. Attach the
steering gear to the front suspension crossmember (Fig. 16). Install the four power steering gear
mounting bolts. Tighten the mounting
bolts to a torque of 61 N.m (45 ft.lbs.).
7. Remove the wire or cord suspending the power steering gear to the underbody. 8. Install the two
screws securing the cooler to the front suspension crossmember. They are located behind the
cooler. 9. Install each ball joint stud into the steering knuckle aligning the bolt hole in the knuckle
boss with the notch formed in the side of the ball joint
stud.
10. Install a new ball joint stud pinch bolt and nut (Fig. 14). Tighten the nut to a torque of 95 N.m
(70 ft.lbs.). 11. Install the engine torque strut and mounting bolts (Fig. 17). To properly align and
tighten the torque strut, Refer to Engine Mount. 12. Install the washer on the end of the stud
extending from the torque strut bolt (Fig. 17). 13. Install the pencil strut to the right front corner of
the crossmember and body of the vehicle (Fig. 17). Tighten the pencil strut nuts to a torque of 58
N.m (43 ft.lbs.).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Front Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 6970
14. Install the drive-belt splash shield and fasteners.
Fig. 20
NOTE: Before installing the stabilizer bar, make sure the bar is not upside-down. The stabilizer bar
must be installed with the curve on the outboard ends of the bar facing downward to clear the
control arms once fully installed (Fig. 20).
15. First, place the stabilizer bar in position on the front suspension crossmember. The slits in each
cushion must point toward the front of the vehicle
and sit directly on top of the raised beads formed into the stamping on the crossmember. Next,
install the cushion retainers, matching the raised beads formed into the cushion retainers to the
grooves formed into the cushions. Install the cushion retainer bolts, but do not completely tighten
them at this time.
16. Install both stabilizer bar links back on vehicle (Fig. 13). Start each stabilizer bar link bolt with
bushing from the bottom, through the stabilizer bar
, inner link bushings, lower control arm, and into the upper retainer/nut and bushing. Do not fully
tighten the link assemblies at this time.
17. Install the tire and wheel assemblies back on vehicle. Tighten the wheel mounting nuts to 135
N.m (100 ft.lbs.) torque. 18. Lower the vehicle.
NOTE: It may be necessary to put the vehicle on a platform hoist or alignment rack to gain access
to the stabilizer bar mounting bolts with the vehicle at curb height.
19. Tighten each stabilizer bar link by holding the upper retainer/nut with a wrench and turning the
link bolt. Tighten each link bolt to a torque of 23
N.m (200 in.lbs.).
20. Tighten the stabilizer bar cushion retainer bolts to a torque of 34 N.m (300 in.lbs.). 21. Check
the front wheel alignment on the vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair
Grille: Service and Repair
GRILLE
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch, open and support hood on prop rod. 2. Remove the fascia. Refer to Front
Bumper.
Fig. 6
3. Remove the nut and remove the emblem. (Fig. 6) 4. Using a trim stick C-4755 or equivalent,
release the grille clips and remove the grille. 5. Using a trim stick C-4755 or equivalent, release the
grille surround clips and remove the grille surrounds.
IMPORT
1. Release hood latch, open and support hood on prop rod.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6974
Fig. 7
2. Remove screws attaching grille to fascia (Fig. 7). 3. Pull grille away from fascia, reach between
grille and fascia with pliers and compress lower grille clips. 4. Pull grille away from fascia and
remove grille from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the grille and install the grille surrounds (Fig. 6). 2. Seat the all the retaining clips fully. 3.
Install the emblem and install the nut. 4. Install the fascia.
IMPORT
1. Align lower grille clips and center grille tab into fascia slots (Fig. 7). 2. Push lower grille forward
until lower clips are seated into fascia slots. A click should be heard when clips are totally engaged
into fascia slots. 3. Seat top of grille to fascia and install screws attaching grille to fascia.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Carpets and Floor Mats
Carpet: Service and Repair Carpets and Floor Mats
CARPETS AND FLOOR MATS
REMOVAL
For removal of the carpet, the carpet will need to be cut under the instrument panel.
1. Remove front seats. 2. Remove rear seat cushion.
Fig. 4
3. Remove bolts attaching front seat belt lower anchors to floor (Fig. 4). 4. Remove door sill trim
covers. 5. Remove cowl trim covers. 6. Remove center floor console. 7. Remove decklid release
assist handle. 8. Remove lower fasteners from B-pillar trim panel. 9. Pull carpet from behind trim
panel.
10. Fold carpet in half toward rear seat. 11. Remove carpet through rear door opening.
INSTALLATION
The new carpet must be cut for installation. The area is mark on the reverse side of the carpet. The
location is in front of the tunnel area.
1. Install carpet through rear door opening. 2. Unfold carpet. 3. Tuck carpet behind trim panel. 4.
Install lower fasteners holding B-pillar trim panel. 5. Install decklid release assist handle. 6. Install
center floor console. 7. Install cowl trim covers. 8. Install door sill trim covers. 9. Install bolts
attaching front seat belt lower anchors to floor. Tighten all seat belts to 40 N.m (30 ft.lbs.) torque.
10. Install rear seat cushion. 11. Install front seats.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Carpets and Floor Mats > Page 6980
Carpet: Service and Repair Trunk Lining
TRUNK LINING
REMOVAL
Fig. 12
1. Remove fasteners (three per side) attaching carpet to shelf panel. Fasteners are accessed from
inside the vehicle (Fig. 12). 2. Pull out leading flaps of the carpet through the opening from the shelf
panel. 3. Pull carpet from under the springs. 4. Remove trunk carpet from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place carpet in truck and smooth out. 2. Tuck both sides of the carpet ends under springs. 3.
Position the leading flaps of the carpet through the opening onto the shelf panel. 4. Install fasteners
(three per side) to secure the carpet to shelf panel (install fasteners from inside the vehicle). 5.
Overlap the slits in the back of the carpet so the center section lays over the outer sections.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Console: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6985
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6986
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6987
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6988
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6989
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6990
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6991
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6992
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6993
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6994
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6995
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6996
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6997
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6998
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6999
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7000
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7001
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7002
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7003
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7004
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7005
Console: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7006
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7007
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7008
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures
Console: Procedures
REMOVAL
1. Fully apply parking brake.
2. Remove screw cover plugs over screws just rearward of cup holders.
3. Remove screws in cup holders attaching console to floor bracket.
4. Open console storage compartment lid, if so equipped.
5. Remove screws attaching console to floor bracket.
6. Remove shift lever knob, if vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission.
7. Lift console upward over gear selector and park brake handle.
8. Remove console from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place floor console into position in vehicle.
2. Install screws attaching console to floor brackets.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 7011
3. Install shift lever knob, if vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission.
4. Release parking brake.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 7012
Console: Removal and Replacement
FLOOR CONSOLE
REMOVAL
1. Fully apply parking brake. 2. Remove screw cover plugs over screws just rearward of cup
holders.
Fig. 7
3. Remove screws in cup holders attaching console to floor bracket (Fig. 7). 4. Open console
storage compartment lid, if so equipped. 5. Remove screws attaching console to floor bracket. 6.
Remove shift lever knob, if vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission. 7. Lift console upward
over gear selector and park brake handle. 8. Remove console from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place floor console into position in vehicle. 2. Install screws attaching console to floor brackets.
3. Install shift lever knob, if vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission. 4. Release parking
brake.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 7017
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Application and ID
Glove Compartment: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Glove Compartment ............................................................................................................................
.................................................................. T194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Glove Compartment: Removal and Replacement
GLOVE BOX
REMOVAL
1. Remove three glove box door hinge screws. 2. Open glove box and remove assembly from
vehicle. 3. Remove the latch by gently prying the retainer clip out of its slot. 4. Remove nine screws
retaining glove box door to bin assembly. 5. Remove glove box door from bin and remove. 6.
Remove dampers by gently stretching them over the end of their pins.
INSTALLATION
1. Assemble glove box door and bin. 2. Install the nine screws retaining glove box door to bin
assembly. 3. Install the latch using retainer clip. 4. Install glove box dampers over end of pins. 5.
Place glove box into instrument panel opening. 6. Close glove box door and install the three glove
box door hinge screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7023
Glove Compartment: Overhaul
REMOVAL
1. Remove three glove box door hinge screws. 2. Open glove box and remove assembly from
vehicle. 3. Remove the latch by gently prying the retainer clip out of its slot. 4. Remove eight
screws retaining glove box door to bin assembly. 5. Separate glove box door from bin and remove.
6. Remove dampers by gently stretching them over the end of their pins.
INSTALLATION
1. Assemble glove box door and bin. 2. Install the eight screws retaining glove box door to bin
assembly. 3. Install the latch using retainer clip. 4. Install glove box dampers over end of pins. 5.
Place glove box into instrument panel opening. 6. Close glove box door and install the three glove
box door hinge screws.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Headliner: Service and Repair
HEADLINER
REMOVAL
1. Remove screws attaching sun visors to roof header panel. 2. Disconnect wire connector from
lighted vanity mirror, if so equipped. 3. Remove sun visors from vehicle. 4. Remove A-pillar trim
covers. 5. Remove B-pillar trim panels. 6. Remove (upper) quarter panel trim panels. 7. Remove
assist handle, if so equipped. 8. Remove sun visor hooks. 9. Remove coat hooks, if so equipped.
10. Remove three push in fasteners at rear of headliner. 11. Disengage dome lamp wire connector,
at rear of headliner. 12. Remove push in fastener attaching wiring to C-pillar.
Fig. 8
13. Remove headliner through door opening (Fig. 8).
INSTALLATION
1. Position headliner in vehicle. 2. Install sun visor hooks, if so equipped. 3. Install coat hooks, if so
equipped. 4. Install three push in fastener at rear of headliner. 5. Install assist handles, if so
equipped. 6. Install push in fastener attaching headliner wiring to C-pillar. 7. Connect dome lamp
wire connector, at rear of headliner. 8. Install (upper) quarter panel trim panel. 9. Install B-pillar trim
panels.
10. Install A-pillar trim covers. 11. Install sun visors, lighted vanity mirror wire connector, if so
equipped, and screws attaching sun visors to roof header panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Rear Shelf > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Rear Shelf: Service and Repair
REAR SHELF TRIM PANEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove quarter trim panels as necessary, Refer to Trim Panel. 2. Remove rear seat cushion
and back. 3. Disengage seat belt bezels from rear shelf trim panel. 4. Remove rear seat shoulder
belt from the shelf by sliding belt through the slot.
Fig. 9
5. Remove rear shelf trim panel from vehicle (Fig. 9).
INSTALLATION
1. Place into position rear shelf trim panel. 2. Slide the rear seat shoulder belt through the slot in
the rear shelf trim panel. 3. Engage seat belt bezels to rear shelf trim panel. 4. Install rear seat
cushion and back. 5. Install quarter trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Sun Visor > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Sun Visor: Service and Repair
SUN VISOR
All vehicles with driver and passenger side airbags must have a colored coded five Bullet point
airbag warning label applied to the sun visor, verify label availability and ensure the label is
installed.
REMOVAL
1. Remove sun visor from center support. 2. Remove screws attaching sun visor to roof header. 3.
Remove sun visor from header. 4. If equipped, disconnect wire connector from body harness. 5.
Remove sun visor from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place sun visor in position. 2. If equipped, connect wire connector from body harness. 3. Install
screws attaching sun visor to header. 4. Install sun visor into center support.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures
Trim Panel: Procedures
HEAT STAKING
1. Remove trim panel. 2. Bend or move the trim panel components at the heat staked joints.
Observe the heat staked locations and/or component seams for looseness. 3. Heat stake the
components.
a. If the heat staked or component seam location is loose, hold the two components tightly together
and using a soldering gun with a flat tip, melt
the material securing the components together. Do not over heat the affected area, damage to the
exterior of the trim panel may occur.
b. If the heat staked material is broken or missing, use a hot glue gun to apply new material to the
area to be repaired. The panels that are being
heat staked must be held together while the applying the glue. Once the new material is in place, it
may be necessary to use a soldering gun to melt the newly applied material. Do not over heat the
affected area, damage to the exterior of the trim panel may occur.
4. Allow the repaired area to cool and verify the repair. 5. Install trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7037
Trim Panel: Removal and Replacement
Door Sill Trim Panel
DOOR SILL TRIM
REMOVAL
1. Open door to gain access to sill trim. 2. Disengage clips attaching sill trim to door sill and door
opening flange.
Fig. 5
Fig. 6
3. Remove door sill trim from vehicle (Fig. 5) and (Fig. 6).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7038
INSTALLATION
1. Position door sill trim on door sill. 2. Align locating pins on backside of trim panel to holes in door
sill. 3. Engage clips on trim panel into slots in door sill. 4. Engage clips on trim panel onto door
opening flange. 5. Press downward on trim panel to fully engage all clips.
Front Door Trim Panel
TRIM PANEL
REMOVAL
1. Release door latch and open door. 2. Lower door glass.
Fig. 13
3. Remove window regulator crank, if so equipped (Fig. 13).
Fig. 11
4. Remove screw from inside arm rest pull cup (Fig. 11). 5. Remove screw from behind inside latch
release handle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7039
6. Disengage push-in fasteners attaching trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 7. Tilt
trim panel outward to clear locator pins on backside of trim panel. 8. Disconnect trim panel from
retainer channel in inner belt weatherstrip at top of door by lifting while gently jiggling. 9. Move trim
panel away from door and disengage clip attaching latch rod to handle.
10. Remove latch rod from handle.
CAUTION: Do not allow door trim panel to hang by the wire connector or wiring.
11. Disconnect wire connector from power door lock switch, mirror switch, and power window
switch if so equipped. 12. Remove trim panel from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Replace any damaged or missing push in fasteners from around perimeter of door trim panel. 2.
Place trim panel near door. 3. Connect wire connector into power door lock switch, mirror switch,
and power window switch , if so equipped. 4. Insert latch rod into handle and engage clip. 5. Install
trim panel into retainer channel at top of door and push down to seat. 6. Locate door trim panel to
inner door panel by aligning locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner door
panel. 7. Install push in fasteners to hold trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 8. Install
screw inside latch release handle. 9. Install screw inside arm rest pull cup.
10. With the window in the down position, orientate the window regulator crank handle
appropriately. Install the right handle at the 10 o'clock position
and the left handle at the 2 O'clock position, if so equipped.
A-Pillar Trim
A-PILLAR TRIM
REMOVAL
1. Disengage clips holding trim to A-pillar.
Fig. 1
2. Separate A-pillar trim from vehicle (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Position A-pillar trim panel to A-pillar. 2. Align locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating
holes in A-pillar. 3. Push clips on trim panel into slots in A-pillar.
B-Pillar Trim
B-PILLAR TRIM
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7040
Fig. 2
1. Remove bolt attaching lower seat belt anchor to floor pan kick-up (Fig. 2). 2. Remove shoulder
belt height control knob. 3. Remove turning loop cover. 4. Remove bolt and remove the turning
loop.
Fig. 3
5. Remove bolt attaching turning loop to belt adjuster (Fig. 3). 6. Remove access cover from
B-pillar trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7041
7. Disengage clips attaching trim to B-pillar. 8. Feed seat belt turning loop and seat belt through
trim panel. 9. Remove B-pillar trim from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Tighten all seat belt bolts to 40 N.m (30 ft.lbs.) torque.
1. Position B-pillar trim panel near B-pillar. 2. Feed seat belt turning loop and seat belt through trim
panel. 3. Align locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in B-pillar. 4. Push clips on
trim panel into slots in B-pillar. 5. Install access cover to B-pillar trim. 6. Install bolt attaching turning
loop to belt adjuster. 7. Install the turning loop cover. 8. Move adjuster in to the lowest position. 9.
Install shoulder belt height control knob.
10. Install bolt attaching lower seat belt anchor to floor pan kick-up.
Lower Quarter Trim Panel
LOWER QUARTER TRIM
REMOVAL
1. Remove upper quarter trim panel. 2. Remove rear seat cushion and back. 3. Disengage clips
attaching trim to lower quarter panel. 4. Remove seat belt from slot in trim panel.
Fig. 13
5. Remove lower quarter trim from vehicle (Fig.13).
INSTALLATION
1. Position lower quarter trim panel to vehicle. 2. Install seat belt to slot in trim panel. 3. Align
locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner quarter panel. 4. Press clips on trim
panel into slots in inner quarter panel. 5. Install rear seat back and cushion. 6. Install upper quarter
trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7042
Upper Quarter Trim
UPPER QUARTER TRIM
REMOVAL
Fig. 13
1. Disengage clips attaching trim to upper quarter panel (Fig. 13). 2. Remove upper trim panel from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Check to ensure that electric rear window wiring is positioned correctly in the roof channel
provided. 2. Position trim panel in vehicle. 3. Align locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating
holes in upper quarter panel. 4. Push clips on trim panel into slots in upper quarter panel.
Rear Door Trim Panel
REMOVAL
1. Release door latch and open door. 2. Lower window glass 3. Remove window regulator crank. 4.
Remove screw from inside arm rest pull cup.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7043
Fig. 6 Rear Door Trim
5. Remove screw from behind inside latch release handle. 6. Disengage push in fasteners
attaching trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 7. Disengage push-in metal spring clip
holding trim in sail flag area. 8. Lift trim panel up off belt weatherstrip. 9. Tilt top of trim panel away
from door and disengage clip attaching latch rod to handle.
10. Remove latch rod from handle. 11. Remove trim panel from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Replace any damaged or missing push in fasteners from around perimeter of door trim panel. 2.
Place trim panel in position on door. 3. Insert latch rod into handle and engage clip. 4. Engage trim
panel into retainer channel at top of door. 5. Locate door trim panel to inner door panel by aligning
locating pins on backside of trim panel to mating holes in inner door panel. 6. Engage push in
fasteners attaching trim to door panel around perimeter of trim panel. 7. Install screw behind inside
latch release handle. 8. Install screw inside arm rest pull cup. 9. Install window regulator crank.
Rear Shelf Trim Panel
REAR SHELF TRIM PANEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove quarter trim panels as necessary, Refer to Trim Panel. 2. Remove rear seat cushion
and back. 3. Disengage seat belt bezels from rear shelf trim panel. 4. Remove rear seat shoulder
belt from the shelf by sliding belt through the slot.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 7044
Fig. 9
5. Remove rear shelf trim panel from vehicle (Fig. 9).
INSTALLATION
1. Place into position rear shelf trim panel. 2. Slide the rear seat shoulder belt through the slot in
the rear shelf trim panel. 3. Engage seat belt bezels to rear shelf trim panel. 4. Install rear seat
cushion and back. 5. Install quarter trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
LOCK CYLINDER
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Close door glass. 3. Disconnect door lock rod from
latch. 4. Remove clip attaching lock cylinder to door handle.
Fig. 10
5. Pull lock cylinder from door handle (Fig. 10).
INSTALLATION
1. Push lock cylinder into door handle. 2. Install clip attaching lock cylinder to door handle. 3.
Connect door lock rod from latch. 4. Install door trim panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information
> Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7053
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 7063
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm
System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm
System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 7069
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 7072
Keyless Entry Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 7073
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 7074
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 7075
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7076
Remote Keyless Entry Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7077
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
There are 2 Remote Keyless Entry Modules for the 2002 module year, premium and base. The
base module is for a vehicle with power door locks only. The base module performs the same
functions that the premium module does but has no provisions for Vehicle Theft Security System
(VTSS) or Remote Keyless Entry. Both modules communicate with other modules via the PCI bus
circuit.
The module monitors the Airbag Control Module messages for the purpose of monitoring the
deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message, along with the verification that the ignition
is on, it will provide the "enhanced accident response feature". This feature will cause the module
to unlock all doors and the instrument cluster to turn the courtesy lamps ON.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message and receive
body style information.
The Base module wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses
a signal from the driver or passenger (BUX) cylinder lock switch. The premium module wakes up
the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses a signal from the RKE
transmitter.
Two RKE transmitters are supplied with a premium equipped vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. Horn chirp on a premium equipped vehicle is customer programmable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7078
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
For procedures on diagnosing and testing the RKE Module's RKE functions, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Description and Operation
Fig.1 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system Radio Frequency (RF) transmitter is equipped with four
buttons, labeled LOCK, UNLOCK, DECK LID RELEASE, and PANIC. It is also equipped with a key
ring and is designed to serve as a key fob. The operating range of the transmitter radio signal is up
to 10 meters (30 feet) from the RKE receiver.
Each RKE transmitter has a different vehicle access code, which must be programmed into the
memory of the RKE receiver in the vehicle in order to operate the RKE system. Two transmitters
are provided with the vehicle, but the RKE receiver can retain the access codes of up to four
transmitters in its memory.
The RKE transmitter operates on two Panasonic CR2016 (or equivalent) batteries. Typical battery
life is from one to two years. The RKE transmitter cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it
must be replaced.
The transmitter has four buttons for operation. They are LOCK, UNLOCK, DECK LID RELEASE,
and PANIC.
- The UNLOCK button will unlock the driver's door, flash the park lamps twice and enable
illuminated entry. Pushing and releasing the button once will unlock the driver's door. Pushing and
releasing the button two times, within a five second interval, will unlock all doors.
- Upon pressing the LOCK button, the horn will sound a short CHIRP (if enabled) and flash the park
lamps to notify that the all door lock signal was received and set. Illuminated entry is cancelled and
the interior lamps are faded to OFF.
- Pushing and releasing the DECK LID RELEASE button two times within a five second interval,
will slightly ajar the deck lid.
- Pushing and holding the PANIC button will cause the panic alarm to sound for three minutes, until
the panic button is pressed and held a second time, or the vehicle reaches a speed of 15 mph.
The receiver is capable of retaining a Vehicle Access Code (VAC) even when power is removed.
Each Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) module must have at least one and no more than four
transmitters.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmitter Programming
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Transmitter Programming
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
The Remote Keyless Entry transmitters can be programmed with the use of the DRB III scan tool
or by the customer.
DRB III Programming When Using The DRB III Scan Tool, SELECT: 1. "Theft Alarm" 2. "VTSS" 3.
"Miscellaneous" and then the desired function.
Customer Programming For a customer to be able to program RKE transmitters themselves, at
least one RKE transmitter must be programmed already This procedure is to add additional
transmitters. If all transmitters are lost, the DRB III scan tool must be used to program the new
transmitters. 1. Insert the key into the ignition switch, and turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position (without starting the vehicle). 2. Using the RKE transmitter programmed to the RKE
module, press and continuously hold down the UNLOCK button for 4 - 10 seconds. 3. Within the 4 10 second time range, continue to hold the UNLOCK button and press the PANIC button. Both
buttons may then be released. Upon
the PANIC button being depressed, the message for customer programming mode will be
transmitted to the RKE module.
4. A chime will be heard to verify that the customer programming mode has been entered. 5. Press
and release any button on each transmitter that is to be programmed to the RKE module, including
any transmitters which were previously
programmed to the RKE module (with a maximum of four possible). After each transmitter is
successfully programmed, a chime will be heard to verify that successful programming of the
transmitter has occurred.
6. After 30 seconds, or upon the ignition switch being turned OFF, a chime will indicate that the
RKE module has exited the programming mode.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmitter Programming > Page 7084
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Keyless Entry Transmitter Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove front door trim panel. 3.
Disconnect wire connector. 4. Remove two attaching screws. 5. Remove the switch from the door
panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch to the door panel. 2. Install the two attaching screws. 3. Connect the one wire
connector. 4. Install the front door trim panel. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Door Lock Cylinder Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7089
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7094
Power Door Lock Actuator: Connector Locations
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7095
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7096
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7097
Power Door Lock Actuator: Diagrams
Driver Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Left Rear Door Loack Motor/Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7098
Power Door Lock Actuator: Testing and Inspection
1. Make certain battery is in normal condition and fuses powering the RKE module aren't blown
before circuits are tested. 2. To determine which motor is faulty, check each individual door for
electrical lock and unlock or disconnect the motor connectors one at a time,
while operating the door lock switch.
3. In the event that none of the motors work, the problem may be caused by a shorted motor, a bad
switch or a bad relay internal to the RKE module.
Disconnecting a defective motor will allow the others to work.
4. To test an individual door lock motor, disconnect the electrical connector from the motor. 5. To
lock the door, connect a 12 volt power source to one pin of the lock motor and a ground wire to the
other pin. 6. To unlock the door, reverse the wire connections at the motor pin terminals. 7. If these
results are NOT obtained, replace the motor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Door (Passenger) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7102
Door (Passenger) - RHD
Fig. 61 Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7103
Fig. 62 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7104
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams
Left Door Lock Switch
Passenger Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Right Door Lock Switch
Right Rear Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7105
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the switch from its mounting location, and disconnect from vehicle wiring harness.
(Refer to POWER LOCKS/POWER LOCK SWITCH
- REMOVAL).
Door Lock Switch Resistance
2. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the DOOR LOCK SWITCH RESISTANCE table to determine if
switch resistance is correct in the Lock and Unlock
switch positions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7106
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel top cover.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove the two screws holding the RKE module to the instrument panel assembly. 4. Slide
locking tab of the wiring connector sideways to unlock tab, and remove connector from RKE
module. 5. Remove RKE module from vehicle.
NOTE: When replacing a faulty RKE Module, the replacement module must be configured with the
DRB III scan tool for proper operation. Additionally, all transmitters must be reprogrammed to the
new RKE module.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When replacing a faulty RKE Module, the replacement module must be configured with the
DRB III scan tool for proper operation. Additionally, all transmitters must be reprogrammed to the
new RKE module.
1. Install the RKE module into the vehicle. 2. Connect the RKE wiring connector. 3. Install the two
screws holding the RKE module to the instrument panel assembly. 4. Install the instrument panel
top cover. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
LOCK CYLINDER
REMOVAL
Fig. 2
1. Remove decklid latch. 2. Remove clip attaching decklid lock cylinder to decklid. 3. Pull lock
cylinder from decklid (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Place lock cylinder into position. 2. Install clip attaching decklid lock cylinder to decklid. 3. Install
decklid latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Fig. 61 Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7114
Power Mirror Switch: Diagrams
Power Mirror Switch (LHD)
Power Mirror Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test
The following test is designed to be used only on vehicles equipped with power fold-away side view
mirrors.
1. Remove power mirror switch from mounting position (Refer to POWER MIRRORS/POWER
FOLDAWAY MIRROR SWITCH - REMOVAL).
Fig.2 Power Fold-Away Mirror Switch
2. Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
tables below.
NOTE: When testing using the chart below be certain to read the chart correctly. Example - When
testing left mirror "DOWN", pins 1, 9,10 will show continuity to each other, and pins 3, 4, 5 will show
continuity to each other.
3. If test results are not obtained as shown in the tables below, replace the switch.
Extended Mirror Switch Circuit Test
Extended Mirror Switch Circuit Test
NOTE: MIRROR POSITION SWITCH MUST BE IN THE "UNFOLD" POSITION TO USE CHART.
Retracted Mirror Switch Circuit Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 7117
Retracted Mirror Switch Circuit Test
NOTE: MIRROR POSITION SWITCH MUST BE IN THE "FOLD" POSITION TO USE CHART.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 7118
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Mirror Switch Test
1. Remove power mirror switch 2. Disconnect wiring harness connector from switch.
Power Mirror Switch Table ( Part 1 Of 2 )
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 7119
Power Mirror Switch Table ( Part 2 Of 2 )
3. Using a ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch. 4. If results shown in
the table are not obtained, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7120
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or
equivalent, gently pry up on window switch bezel and remove from door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
wire connector from switch. 4. Remove two switch retaining screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the retaining screws. 2. Reconnect the wire connector to the switch. 3. Insert switch into
door trim panel 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and
ID
Paint: Application and ID
Exterior Colors
Interior Colors
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and
ID > Page 7125
Paint: Description and Operation
BASE COAT/CLEAR COAT FINISH
DESCRIPTION
On most vehicles a two-part paint application (basecoat / clearcoat) is used. Color paint that is
applied to primer is called basecoat. The clearcoat protects the basecoat from ultraviolet light and
provides a durable high-gloss finish.
CAUTION: Do not use abrasive chemicals or compounds on painted surfaces. Damage to finish
can result.
Do not use harsh alkaline based cleaning solvents on painted surfaces. Damage to finish or color
can result.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > Paint Touch-Up
Paint: Service and Repair Paint Touch-Up
PAINT SURFACE TOUCH-UP
DESCRIPTION
When a painted metal surface has been scratched or chipped, it should be touched up as soon as
possible to avoid corrosion. For best results, use Mopar(R) Scratch Filler/Primer, Touch Up Paints
and Clear Top Coat. Refer to Information Labels.
WARNING: USE AN OSHA APPROVED RESPIRATOR AND SAFETY GLASSES WHEN
SPRAYING PAINT OR SOLVENTS IN A CONFINED AREA. PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
TOUCH UP PROCEDURE
1. Scrape loose paint and corrosion from inside scratch or chip. 2. Clean affected area with
Mopar(R) Tar/Road Oil Remover, and allow to dry. 3. Fill the inside of the scratch or chip with a
coat of filler/primer. Do not overlap primer onto good surface finish. The applicator brush should be
wet enough to puddle-fill the scratch or chip without running. Do not stroke brush applicator on
body surface. Allow the filler/primer to dry hard.
4. Cover the filler/primer with color touch up paint. Do not overlap touch up color onto the original
color coat around the scratch or chip. Butt the
new color to the original color, if possible. Do not stroke applicator brush on body surface. Allow
touch up paint to dry hard.
5. On vehicles without clearcoat, the touch up color can be lightly finesse sanded (1500 grit) and
polished with rubbing compound. 6. On vehicles with clearcoat, apply clear top coat to touch up
paint with the same technique as described in Step 4. Allow clear top coat to dry hard.
If desired, Step 5 can be performed on clear top coat.
WARNING: AVOID PROLONGED SKIN CONTACT WITH PETROLEUM OR ALCOHOL - BASED
CLEANING SOLVENTS. PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > Paint Touch-Up > Page 7128
Paint: Service and Repair Finesse Sanding, Buffing, And Polishing - Description
FINESSE SANDING/BUFFING & POLISHING
DESCRIPTION
Minor acid etching, orange peel, or smudging in clearcoat or single-stage finishes can be reduced
with light finesse sanding, hand buffing, and polishing. If the finish has been finesse sanded in the
past, it cannot be repeated. Finesse sanding operation should be performed by a trained
automotive paint technician.
CAUTION: Do not remove clearcoat finish, if equipped. Basecoat paint must retain clearcoat for
durability.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr >
03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: Customer Interest Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Keyless Entry Module: > 08-012-03 > Apr >
03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 7138
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
Keyless Entry Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation
NUMBER: 08-012-03
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Apr. 25, 2003
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS OR PERFORM
ANY ACTIONS RELATED TO THIS BULLETIN UNTIL MAY 9, 2003.
SUBJECT: Inadvertent Siren Activation
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacing and configuring an Alarm Remote Keyless Entry
Module (ARKEM).
MODELS:
2002 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2000 - 2003 (PL) NEON (International Markets)
2001 - 2003 (PT) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A THATCHAM ALARM, SALES
CODE LSC.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customer may describe inadvertent siren activation or security alarm activates for no apparent
reason, can happen at any time.
DIAGNOSIS:
If this condition can be duplicated or customer describes this condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
AFTER INSTALLING A NEW ARKEM (RKE) MODULE IT MUST BE CONFIGURED USING THE
DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL AS DESCRIBED BELOW. THE DRBIII(R) SCAN TOOL MUST BE
OPERATING AT LEVEL 56.0 OR HIGHER.
1. Replace the ARKEM (RKE) module as described in the appropriate service manual.
2. Hook up the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool to the Data Link Connector (DLC).
3. With the key in the ignition, turn the key to the RUN position.
4. After the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool initialization, perform the following:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Module: >
08-012-03 > Apr > 03 > Alarm System - Inadvertent Siren Activation > Page 7144
a. Select "Theft Alarm".
b. Select "VTSS".
c. Select "Miscellaneous".
d. Select "Configure Module".
e. Select "Yes" for Current Configuration Display.
f. Press Any key.
g. Select the number of the model year of the vehicle (new requirement).
h. Select the number of the body style of the vehicle.
i. Select the number for Left Hand Drive or Right Hand Drive.
j. Select the number of the Market.
k. Select the Desired VTA (module) Type.
l. The Current Configuration is displayed.
m. Reprogram the RKE (Key Fob) Transmitter(s).
5. The configuration is complete, disconnect the DRBIII(R) Scan Tool.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7147
Keyless Entry Module: Connector Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7148
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7149
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7150
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7151
Remote Keyless Entry Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7152
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
There are 2 Remote Keyless Entry Modules for the 2002 module year, premium and base. The
base module is for a vehicle with power door locks only. The base module performs the same
functions that the premium module does but has no provisions for Vehicle Theft Security System
(VTSS) or Remote Keyless Entry. Both modules communicate with other modules via the PCI bus
circuit.
The module monitors the Airbag Control Module messages for the purpose of monitoring the
deployment of the airbag. Upon receiving that message, along with the verification that the ignition
is on, it will provide the "enhanced accident response feature". This feature will cause the module
to unlock all doors and the instrument cluster to turn the courtesy lamps ON.
The RKE module communicates with the Powertrain Control Module to receive vehicle speed
information to activate the rolling door lock feature, receive the "okay to lock" message and receive
body style information.
The Base module wakes up the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses
a signal from the driver or passenger (BUX) cylinder lock switch. The premium module wakes up
the Instrument Cluster to turn ON the illuminated entry when it senses a signal from the RKE
transmitter.
Two RKE transmitters are supplied with a premium equipped vehicle but a total of 4 can be
programmed to the module. Horn chirp on a premium equipped vehicle is customer programmable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7153
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
For procedures on diagnosing and testing the RKE Module's RKE functions, refer to the proper
Body Diagnostic Procedures.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Service and Repair Sunroof Module
REMOVAL
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
1. Remove sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Disengage front
door weatherstrip from headliner, pull headliner
down to access control unit.
2. Disconnect wire connector from control unit. 3. Slide control unit up and forward and remove.
INSTALLATION
1. Place sunroof control unit into position. 2. Lock control unit into position. 3. Connect wire
connector to control unit. 4. Install sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper
B-pillar trim. Engage front door weatherstrip to headliner. 5. Cycle sunroof to the full open position.
6. Ensure sunroof adjustment. Refer to Sunroof Glass Adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module > Page 7159
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Service and Repair Sunroof Module Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Close glass panel, if possible 2. Remove A-pillar trim. 3. Remove upper B-pillar and C-pillar trim.
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
4. Remove sunroof welt. 5. Remove the switch. 6. Detach fastener from headlinder bracket to the
front beam. 7. Remove all assist handles. 8. Remove sun visors. 9. Remove headlining and
disconnect the dome lamp connector.
10. Disconnect sunroof motor wiring connector. 11. Disconnect drain tubes. 12. Remove fasteners
attaching sunroof module to vehicle roof. 13. With the aid of a helper, remove sunroof module from
roof. 14. Remove sunroof module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. With the aid of a helper, position sunroof module in vehicle. 2. Install fasteners attaching sunroof
module to vehicle roof and support braces. Tighten all fasteners to 5 Nm (44 in. lbs.), starting from
the front and
working rearward and then the motor bracket.
3. Connect drain tubes. 4. Connect sunroof motor wiring connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module > Page 7160
5. Headliner in position connect dome lamp wire connector. Install headlining. 6. Install the fastener
from the headliner bracket to front beam. 7. Install switch. 8. Install sunroof welt. 9. Install B-pillar
and C-pillar trim.
10. Install A-pillar trim. 11. Install sun visors. 12. Install all assist handles. 13. Install sunroof
sunshade. 14. Install sunroof glass panel. 15. Cycle glass panel open and close. 16. Ensure glass
adjustment, refer to Glass Adjustment procedure 17. Verify correct operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sun Shade >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Sun Shade: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Open sunroof glass panel to the vent position.
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
2. Through the glass panel opening, disengage the two rear slide blocks of sunshade from
sunshade guide. 3. Slide the sunshade rearward to have access to the two front slide blocks of
sunshade and disengage sunshade from sunshade guide. 4. Lift sunshade out of sunshade guide.
INSTALLATION
1. Place sunshade with cloth side down and install one side's slide blocks into the track on the
sunshade guide. 2. Slide the other side's slide blocks to fully inward position and insert them into
the sunshade guide. 3. Verify that all four slide blocks are fully engaged in the sunshade guide. 4.
Slide sunshade fully rearward and forward to verify operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Limit Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Sunroof / Moonroof Limit Switch: Description and Operation
LIMIT SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The Sunroof Limit Switch is located in the drive motor assembly housing and is not serviceable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof Motor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7172
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Testing and Inspection
ADJUSTMENTS
ADJUSTMENTS - SUNROOF VENT POSITION
PLACING SUNROOF GLASS IN VENT POSITION
1. Remove the drive motor. 2. Remove sunroof glass panel.
Fig. 2
3. Slide the mechanism forward till the mechanism slide is parallel with the front edge of the guide
(Fig. 2).
Fig. 3
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7173
Fig. 4
4. Using a rule, measure the rear end of the mechanism to the guide on each side of sun roof (Fig.
3) or (Fig. 4). 5. Initial height should be 44 to 48 mm. Adjust mechanism so that both sides are dia
1.0 mm of each other. 6. Install drive motor. 7. Install sunroof panel. 8. Ensure glass adjustment.
RE-POSITIONING DRIVE MOTOR
If the drive motor is not in the correct position it can be adjusted to the correct position when the
sunroof glass is in the vent position. Remove the drive motor from the sunroof module, reconnect
the wires to the motor and press the motor switch to the vent position. This should place the drive
motor into the vent position. The motor may now be installed if the sunroof glass panel is in the
vent position
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
SUNROOF DRIVE MOTOR
REMOVAL
NOTE: The Drive Motor is shipped in the VENT position. If the sunroof glass is not in the VENT
position, it must be moved to the VENT position. If the drive motor and/or the sunroof mechanism is
not in the VENT positions, the sunroof vent height will not be correct.
1. If the drive motor is to be reused, cycle the sunroof glass to the VENT position, if possible.
Fig. 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7176
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7177
2. Remove sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Disengage front
door weatherstrip from headliner, pull headliner
down to access sunroof drive motor (Fig. 1).
3. Disconnect wire harness connector from motor. 4. Remove the three screws attaching drive
motor to sunroof module bracket. 5. Remove drive motor from bracket from the front beam.
INSTALLATION
1. If the drive motor and/or sunroof glass is not in the VENT position. 2. Place drive motor into
position on the front beam. 3. If glass panel is mounted, with the aid of a helper, hold the sunroof
glass panel in the VENT position while installing the motor. 4. Install screws attaching drive motor
to motor bracket. 5. Connect wire harness to drive motor. 6. Install sun visors, front grab handles,
A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Engage front door weatherstrip to headliner. 7. Ensure
sunroof adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7178
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair Sunroof Drive Motor
SUNROOF DRIVE MOTOR
REMOVAL
NOTE: The Drive Motor is shipped in the VENT position. If the sunroof glass is not in the VENT
position, it must be moved to the VENT position. Refer to Placing The Sunroof Glass Into The
VENT Position. If the drive motor and/or the sunroof mechanism is not in the VENT positions, the
sunroof vent height will not be correct. Refer to Placing The Sunroof Glass Into The VENT Position
and/or Placing Drive Motor Into The VENT Position.
1. If the drive motor is to be reused, cycle the sunroof glass to the VENT position, if possible.
Fig. 1
2. Remove sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Disengage front
door weatherstrip from headliner, pull headliner
down to access sunroof drive motor (Fig. 1).
3. Disconnect wire harness connector from motor. 4. Remove the three screws attaching drive
motor to sunroof module bracket. 5. Remove drive motor from bracket from the front beam.
INSTALLATION
1. If the drive motor and/or sunroof glass is not in the VENT position, refer to Placing The Sunroof
Glass Into The VENT Position and/or Placing
Drive Motor Into The VENT Position.
2. Place drive motor into position on the front beam. 3. If glass panel is mounted, with the aid of a
helper, hold the sunroof glass panel in the VENT position while installing the motor. 4. Install
screws attaching drive motor to motor bracket. 5. Connect wire harness to drive motor. 6. Install
sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Engage front door
weatherstrip to headliner. 7. Ensure sunroof adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Sunroof Switch
Sunroof Vent Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close
NUMBER: 23-049-04 REV. A
GROUP: Body
DATE: December 15, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS RELATED TO
THIS BULLETIN UNTIL AFTER DECEMBER 31, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-049-04, DATED
NOVEMBER 22, 2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL MODEL YEARS,
REPAIR INFORMATION AND PARTS.
SUBJECT: Sunroof Vents But Will Not Open/Close
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves disassembling and reassembling the sunroof mechanism **and
possibly replacing the locker slide(s).**.
MODELS:
**2000** - 2005 (PL) Neon/SRT4
NOTE:
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The sunroof may go to vent and close but will not go to open or the sunroof goes to vent position
but will not close or open. These Symptoms occur after the sunroof has been operated at fast
highway speeds which applies force to the sunroof mechanism and causes it to go "over-center"
and bind usually on one side but could be both sides.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the above Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
**PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7190
1. Position the sunroof sunshade in the full rearward position.
2. Position the glass reinforcement panel in the CLOSED position before removing the six
mounting screws.
3. Remove the six sunroof glass panel screws.
4. Push the glass panel upward from the underside until the glass panel clears the roof panel.
5. Lift glass panel from the vehicle.
6. Put the sunroof mechanism in the vent position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7191
7. Using punch with diameter slightly smaller than the pin in mechanism (about 3 mm dia.), push
the pin out of the mechanism, (Fig. 2).
8. Pull up on mechanism bracket. **and remove the locker slide only if broken, if the locker slide is
not broken then skip to step 10).
9. Hold appropriate (right or left) replacement locker slide from kit p/n 05174865AA, and insert into
mechanism bracket.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7192
10. Make sure main lever is in the correct position, (Fig. 3). If the main lever is in the up position
before the pin/block, (Fig. 4), it means the module is mistimed (symptoms for this are that the
module will go to vent, but will not open).
11. If the sunroof is mistimed, move the sunroof to the closed position and carefully move the
mechanism into the vent position (by using the switch), guiding the main lever so the pin/block
goes into the slot/track of the main lever.
12. Push the locker slide all the way back in the mechanism bracket.
13. Align the main lever, bushing and locker slide, (Fig. 5), by pushing down on the bracket and
pulling forward on the main lever.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Track:
> 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7193
14. Gently install the pin from the inside of the opening. Push the pin in with punch until the pin is
flush with the face of the locker slide side of the mechanism bracket opening (outboard side). **If
the pin or bushing become lost or damaged replacements are available in kit p/n 05174865AA.
15. Repeat steps 6 - 14 for the other side if necessary.
16. Make sure the locker slides are engaged and cycle the sunroof to the close position,
17. Position the glass panel in the roof opening.
18. Start, but do not tighten, the glass attachment screws. **
19. Using a business card as a guide, slide the card around the edge of glass panel to ensure
panel is centered in the opening.
20. Position the front of the sunroof glass panel so that the corners are flush to 1.0 mm below the
top surface of the roof panel.
21. Position the rear of the sunroof glass panel so that the corners are flush to 1.0 mm over flush to
the top surface of the roof panel.
22. With the aid of a helper, hold the glass panel in position and tighten glass attaching screws.
23. Cycle the sunroof and verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open
or Close
NUMBER: 23-049-04 REV. A
GROUP: Body
DATE: December 15, 2004
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING PROVIDED IN ADVANCE. DO NOT ORDER PARTS RELATED TO
THIS BULLETIN UNTIL AFTER DECEMBER 31, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 23-049-04, DATED
NOVEMBER 22, 2004, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES ADDITIONAL MODEL YEARS,
REPAIR INFORMATION AND PARTS.
SUBJECT: Sunroof Vents But Will Not Open/Close
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves disassembling and reassembling the sunroof mechanism **and
possibly replacing the locker slide(s).**.
MODELS:
**2000** - 2005 (PL) Neon/SRT4
NOTE:
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The sunroof may go to vent and close but will not go to open or the sunroof goes to vent position
but will not close or open. These Symptoms occur after the sunroof has been operated at fast
highway speeds which applies force to the sunroof mechanism and causes it to go "over-center"
and bind usually on one side but could be both sides.
DIAGNOSIS:
If the vehicle operator describes the above Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair Procedure.
**PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7199
1. Position the sunroof sunshade in the full rearward position.
2. Position the glass reinforcement panel in the CLOSED position before removing the six
mounting screws.
3. Remove the six sunroof glass panel screws.
4. Push the glass panel upward from the underside until the glass panel clears the roof panel.
5. Lift glass panel from the vehicle.
6. Put the sunroof mechanism in the vent position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7200
7. Using punch with diameter slightly smaller than the pin in mechanism (about 3 mm dia.), push
the pin out of the mechanism, (Fig. 2).
8. Pull up on mechanism bracket. **and remove the locker slide only if broken, if the locker slide is
not broken then skip to step 10).
9. Hold appropriate (right or left) replacement locker slide from kit p/n 05174865AA, and insert into
mechanism bracket.**
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7201
10. Make sure main lever is in the correct position, (Fig. 3). If the main lever is in the up position
before the pin/block, (Fig. 4), it means the module is mistimed (symptoms for this are that the
module will go to vent, but will not open).
11. If the sunroof is mistimed, move the sunroof to the closed position and carefully move the
mechanism into the vent position (by using the switch), guiding the main lever so the pin/block
goes into the slot/track of the main lever.
12. Push the locker slide all the way back in the mechanism bracket.
13. Align the main lever, bushing and locker slide, (Fig. 5), by pushing down on the bracket and
pulling forward on the main lever.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof /
Moonroof Track: > 23-049-04A > Dec > 04 > Body - Sunroof Vents Only/Won't Open or Close > Page 7202
14. Gently install the pin from the inside of the opening. Push the pin in with punch until the pin is
flush with the face of the locker slide side of the mechanism bracket opening (outboard side). **If
the pin or bushing become lost or damaged replacements are available in kit p/n 05174865AA.
15. Repeat steps 6 - 14 for the other side if necessary.
16. Make sure the locker slides are engaged and cycle the sunroof to the close position,
17. Position the glass panel in the roof opening.
18. Start, but do not tighten, the glass attachment screws. **
19. Using a business card as a guide, slide the card around the edge of glass panel to ensure
panel is centered in the opening.
20. Position the front of the sunroof glass panel so that the corners are flush to 1.0 mm below the
top surface of the roof panel.
21. Position the rear of the sunroof glass panel so that the corners are flush to 1.0 mm over flush to
the top surface of the roof panel.
22. With the aid of a helper, hold the glass panel in position and tighten glass attaching screws.
23. Cycle the sunroof and verify proper operation.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Procedures
WIND DEFLECTOR
REMOVAL
1. Open sunroof to full open position.
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
2. Pull one end of wind deflector flap out of the wind deflector. 3. Release corner piece locking tab
and separate corner piece from wind deflector beam. 4. Rotate corner piece outboard to release
tab from roof flange. 5. Rotate corner piece to a vertical position and pull it up through hole in the
sunshade guide. 6. Repeat for other corner piece.
INSTALLATION
1. Hold corner piece vertically and push tab down through hole in the sunshade guide. 2. Rotate
corner piece inward and place tab under roof flange. 3. Connect corner piece to wind deflector. 4.
Install wind deflector flap into wind deflector. 5. Repeat for other corner piece.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7207
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Removal and Replacement
WIND DEFLECTOR
REMOVAL
1. Open sunroof to full open position.
Fig. 1
2. Pull one end of wind deflector flap out of the wind deflector (Fig. 1). 3. Release corner piece
locking tab and separate corner piece from wind deflector beam. 4. Rotate corner piece outboard to
release tab from roof flange. 5. Rotate corner piece to a vertical position and pull it up through hole
in the sunshade guide. 6. Repeat for other corner piece.
INSTALLATION
1. Hold corner piece vertically and push tab down through hole in the sunshade guide. 2. Rotate
corner piece inward and place tab under roof flange. 3. Connect corner piece to wind deflector. 4.
Install wind deflector flap into wind deflector. 5. Repeat for other corner piece.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Interior Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair
SUNSHADE
REMOVAL
1. Open sunroof glass panel to the vent position.
Fig. 1
2. Through the glass panel opening, disengage the two rear slide blocks of sunshade from
sunshade guide (Fig. 1). 3. Slide the sunshade rearward to have access to the two front slide
blocks of sunshade and disengage sunshade from sunshade guide. 4. Lift sunshade out of
sunshade guide.
INSTALLATION
1. Place sunshade with cloth side down and install one side's slide blocks into the track on the
sunshade guide. 2. Slide the other side's slide blocks to fully inward position and insert them into
the sunshade guide. 3. Verify that all four slide blocks are fully engaged in the sunshade guide. 4.
Slide sunshade fully rearward and forward to verify operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof Control Module
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Service and Repair Sunroof Module
REMOVAL
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
1. Remove sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper B-pillar trim. Disengage front
door weatherstrip from headliner, pull headliner
down to access control unit.
2. Disconnect wire connector from control unit. 3. Slide control unit up and forward and remove.
INSTALLATION
1. Place sunroof control unit into position. 2. Lock control unit into position. 3. Connect wire
connector to control unit. 4. Install sun visors, front grab handles, A-pillar screw, Right upper
B-pillar trim. Engage front door weatherstrip to headliner. 5. Cycle sunroof to the full open position.
6. Ensure sunroof adjustment. Refer to Sunroof Glass Adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module > Page 7216
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Service and Repair Sunroof Module Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Close glass panel, if possible 2. Remove A-pillar trim. 3. Remove upper B-pillar and C-pillar trim.
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
4. Remove sunroof welt. 5. Remove the switch. 6. Detach fastener from headlinder bracket to the
front beam. 7. Remove all assist handles. 8. Remove sun visors. 9. Remove headlining and
disconnect the dome lamp connector.
10. Disconnect sunroof motor wiring connector. 11. Disconnect drain tubes. 12. Remove fasteners
attaching sunroof module to vehicle roof. 13. With the aid of a helper, remove sunroof module from
roof. 14. Remove sunroof module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. With the aid of a helper, position sunroof module in vehicle. 2. Install fasteners attaching sunroof
module to vehicle roof and support braces. Tighten all fasteners to 5 Nm (44 in. lbs.), starting from
the front and
working rearward and then the motor bracket.
3. Connect drain tubes. 4. Connect sunroof motor wiring connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sunroof Module > Page 7217
5. Headliner in position connect dome lamp wire connector. Install headlining. 6. Install the fastener
from the headliner bracket to front beam. 7. Install switch. 8. Install sunroof welt. 9. Install B-pillar
and C-pillar trim.
10. Install A-pillar trim. 11. Install sun visors. 12. Install all assist handles. 13. Install sunroof
sunshade. 14. Install sunroof glass panel. 15. Cycle glass panel open and close. 16. Ensure glass
adjustment, refer to Glass Adjustment procedure 17. Verify correct operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Adjustments > Sunroof Glass
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Adjustments Sunroof Glass
ADJUSTMENTS - SUNROOF GLASS
FLUSHNESS
1. Position sunshade in full rearward position. Place the glass panel in the full closed position. 2. To
adjust front of glass;
a. Loosen front and middle glass attachment screws. b. Adjust front of sunroof glass panel so that
the corners are flush to 1.0 mm below the top surface of the roof panel. c. Tighten all glass
attachment screws.
3. To adjust rear of glass;
a. Loosen rear and middle glass attachment screws. b. Adjust rear of sunroof glass panel so that
the corners are flush to plus 1.0 mm off the top surface of the roof panel. c. Tighten all glass
attachment screws.
CENTERING SUNROOF GLASS ADJUSTMENT
Fig. 5
Using a business card, check sunroof glass for center in opening (Fig. 5). Move business card
around the glass seal, noting area where there is less pressure on the card. Loosen glass attaching
screws adjust as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Adjustments > Sunroof Glass > Page 7222
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Adjustments Sunroof Vent Position
PLACING SUNROOF GLASS IN VENT POSITION
1. Remove the drive motor. 2. Remove sunroof glass panel.
Fig. 2 Position Mechanism Slide
3. Slide the mechanism forward till the mechanism slide is parallel with the front edge of the guide.
Fig. 3 Measuring Height - Out Of Vehicle
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Adjustments > Sunroof Glass > Page 7223
Fig. 4 Measuring Height - In Vehicle
4. Using a rule, measure the rear end of the mechanism to the guide on each side of sun roof. 5.
Initial height should be 44 - 48 mm. Adjust mechanism so that both sides are ± 1.0 mm of each
other. 6. Install drive motor. 7. Install sunroof panel. 8. Ensure glass adjustment, refer to Glass
Adjustment procedure.
RE-POSITIONING DRIVE MOTOR
If the drive motor is not in the correct position it can be adjusted to the correct position when the
sunroof glass is in the vent position. Remove the drive motor from the sunroof module, reconnect
the wires to the motor and press the motor switch to the vent position. This should place the drive
motor into the vent position. The motor may now be installed if the sunroof glass panel is in the
vent position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Procedures
GLASS PANEL REMOVAL
Fig. 1 Sunroof Components
1. Position sunroof sunshade in full rearward position. 2. Position the glass reinforcement panel in
the CLOSED position before removing the six mounting screws. 3. Remove sunroof glass panel six
screws. 4. Push glass panel upward from underside until glass panel clears the roof panel. 5. Lift
glass panel from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position glass reinforcement panel in roof opening. 2. Start, but do not tighten, glass attachment
screws. Ensure glass is in the CLOSED position. 3. Cycle sunroof glass panel to the close position.
Using a business card as a guide, slide card around the edge of glass panel to ensure panel is
centered in opening.
4. With the aid of a helper, hold the glass panel in position and tighten glass attaching screws. 5.
Ensure glass adjustment, refer to Glass Adjustment procedure.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 7226
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Removal and Replacement
GLASS PANEL
REMOVAL
Fig. 1
1. Position sunroof sunshade in full rearward position (Fig. 1). 2. Position the glass reinforcement
panel in the CLOSED position before removing the six mounting screws. 3. Remove sunroof glass
panel six screws. 4. Push glass panel upward from underside until glass panel clears the roof
panel. 5. Lift glass panel from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Position glass reinforcement panel in roof opening. 2. Start, but do not tighten, glass attachment
screws. Ensure glass is in the CLOSED position. 3. Cycle sunroof glass panel to the close position.
Using a business card as a guide, slide card around the edge of glass panel to ensure panel is
centered in opening.
4. With the aid of a helper, hold the glass panel in position and tighten glass attaching screws. 5.
Ensure glass adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams
Power Seat Motor (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Power Seat Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Door Lock Cylinder Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7238
Right Cylinder Lock Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 7243
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
HOOD AJAR SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL
1. Open hood.
Fig.1 Battery Negative Cable - Remove/Install
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect wire harness connector from
hood ajar switch.
Fig.2 Hood Ajar Switch Location
4. Firmly press tangs on the bottom side of the switch together and push up through bracket. 5.
Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Firmly press hood ajar switch through bracket. 2. Connect wire harness connector to hood ajar
switch. 3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Close hood. 5. Verify vehicle and system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Door (Passenger) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7247
Door (Passenger) - RHD
Fig. 61 Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7248
Fig. 62 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7249
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams
Left Door Lock Switch
Passenger Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Right Door Lock Switch
Right Rear Door Lock Motor/Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7250
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the switch from its mounting location, and disconnect from vehicle wiring harness.
(Refer to POWER LOCKS/POWER LOCK SWITCH
- REMOVAL).
Door Lock Switch Resistance
2. Using an ohmmeter, refer to the DOOR LOCK SWITCH RESISTANCE table to determine if
switch resistance is correct in the Lock and Unlock
switch positions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7251
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the instrument panel top cover.
RKE Module Location
3. Remove the two screws holding the RKE module to the instrument panel assembly. 4. Slide
locking tab of the wiring connector sideways to unlock tab, and remove connector from RKE
module. 5. Remove RKE module from vehicle.
NOTE: When replacing a faulty RKE Module, the replacement module must be configured with the
DRB III scan tool for proper operation. Additionally, all transmitters must be reprogrammed to the
new RKE module.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: When replacing a faulty RKE Module, the replacement module must be configured with the
DRB III scan tool for proper operation. Additionally, all transmitters must be reprogrammed to the
new RKE module.
1. Install the RKE module into the vehicle. 2. Connect the RKE wiring connector. 3. Install the two
screws holding the RKE module to the instrument panel assembly. 4. Install the instrument panel
top cover. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - LHD
Fig. 61 Door (Driver) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7255
Power Mirror Switch: Diagrams
Power Mirror Switch (LHD)
Power Mirror Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test
The following test is designed to be used only on vehicles equipped with power fold-away side view
mirrors.
1. Remove power mirror switch from mounting position (Refer to POWER MIRRORS/POWER
FOLDAWAY MIRROR SWITCH - REMOVAL).
Fig.2 Power Fold-Away Mirror Switch
2. Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
tables below.
NOTE: When testing using the chart below be certain to read the chart correctly. Example - When
testing left mirror "DOWN", pins 1, 9,10 will show continuity to each other, and pins 3, 4, 5 will show
continuity to each other.
3. If test results are not obtained as shown in the tables below, replace the switch.
Extended Mirror Switch Circuit Test
Extended Mirror Switch Circuit Test
NOTE: MIRROR POSITION SWITCH MUST BE IN THE "UNFOLD" POSITION TO USE CHART.
Retracted Mirror Switch Circuit Test
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 7258
Retracted Mirror Switch Circuit Test
NOTE: MIRROR POSITION SWITCH MUST BE IN THE "FOLD" POSITION TO USE CHART.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 7259
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Mirror Switch Test
1. Remove power mirror switch 2. Disconnect wiring harness connector from switch.
Power Mirror Switch Table ( Part 1 Of 2 )
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Foldaway Mirror Switch Test > Page 7260
Power Mirror Switch Table ( Part 2 Of 2 )
3. Using a ohmmeter, test for continuity between the terminals of the switch. 4. If results shown in
the table are not obtained, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7261
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or
equivalent, gently pry up on window switch bezel and remove from door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
wire connector from switch. 4. Remove two switch retaining screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the retaining screws. 2. Reconnect the wire connector to the switch. 3. Insert switch into
door trim panel 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Power Seat Switch (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Limit
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Sunroof / Moonroof Limit Switch: Description and Operation
LIMIT SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The Sunroof Limit Switch is located in the drive motor assembly housing and is not serviceable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Sunroof Switch
Sunroof Vent Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7274
Fig. 22 Instrument Panel Splices (Bottom Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7275
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7276
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7277
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7278
Fig. 35 Decklid - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7279
Decklid Release Switch (Power Release)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7280
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Service and Repair
DECKLID RELEASE SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Open the glove box door. 3. Using a trim
stick (special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry out on the deck lid release switch and pull out
of instrument panel. 4. Disconnect the wiring connector. 5. Remove switch from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the wiring connector. 2. Align switch in hole and firmly snap into place. 3. Close the
glove box door. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Spoiler: Service and Repair
SPOILER
REMOVAL
1. Remove the decklid cover. Refer to trim panel.
Fig. 11
2. Remove the four nuts and remove the spoiler. (Fig. 11)
INSTALLATION
1. Install the spoiler and nuts (Fig. 11). 2. Tighten nuts to 3 N.m (30 in.lbs.) torque. 3. Install the
decklid cover.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL GRILLE SCREEN
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch and open hood. 2. Remove windshield wiper arms.
Fig. 1
3. Remove the five screws attaching cowl screen cover to just below windshield flange. (Fig. 1). 4.
Remove cowl plenum to hood weatherstrip, at the leading edge of cowl cover. Pull weatherstrip
towards the front of the vehicle to remove. 5. Remove cowl screen windshield seal from upper
edge of the cowl screen cover. 6. Remove cowl screen cover from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service
and Repair > Page 7290
Fig. 2
1. Place cowl screen cover into position on vehicle (Fig. 2). 2. Start five screws attaching cowl
screen cover to cowl at base of windshield opening. 3. Install cowl screen windshield seal to upper
edge of the cowl screen. 4. Push cowl plenum to hood weatherstrip, into position on the leading
edge of cowl screen cover. 5. Install windshield wiper arms. 6. Tighten screws attaching cowl
screen cover to cowl at base of windshield opening. 7. Install windshield wiper arms.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Front Vertical Guide Bar
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7296
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair B-Pillar Weatherstrip Channel
B-PILLAR WEATHERSTRIP CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove b-pillar applique. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 3. Pull
weatherstrip from b-pillar channels. 4. Remove screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 5. Remove
channels from b-pillar.
INSTALLATION
1. Install channels from b-pillar. 2. Install screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 3. Install
weatherstrip to b-pillar channels. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 5.
Install b-pillar applique.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7297
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair FDR Glass Run Weatherstrip
FDR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove flag cover, door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Loosen
side view mirror, as necessary. 4. Remove weatherstrip fasteners. 5. Pull weatherstrip from lower
front channel above door latch.
Fig. 1
6. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Tighten side view mirror. 8. Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, door trim panel and flag
trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7298
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Weatherstrip
OUTER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open door glass. 2. Pull upward at rear end of outer belt weatherstrip.
Fig. 2
3. Remove outer belt weatherstrip from vehicle (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Starting at leading edge of door, press weatherstrip onto door. 2. Operate window and check for
interference
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7299
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Front Vertical Guide Bar
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
B-Pillar Weatherstrip Channel
B-PILLAR WEATHERSTRIP CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove b-pillar applique. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 3. Pull
weatherstrip from b-pillar channels. 4. Remove screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 5. Remove
channels from b-pillar.
INSTALLATION
1. Install channels from b-pillar. 2. Install screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 3. Install
weatherstrip to b-pillar channels. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 5.
Install b-pillar applique.
FDR Glass Run Weatherstrip
FDR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove flag cover, door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Loosen
side view mirror, as necessary. 4. Remove weatherstrip fasteners. 5. Pull weatherstrip from lower
front channel above door latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7300
Fig. 1
6. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Tighten side view mirror. 8. Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, door trim panel and flag
trim.
Outer Belt Weatherstrip
OUTER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open door glass. 2. Pull upward at rear end of outer belt weatherstrip.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7301
Fig. 2
3. Remove outer belt weatherstrip from vehicle (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Starting at leading edge of door, press weatherstrip onto door. 2. Operate window and check for
interference
Door Upper Secondary Weatherstrip
DOOR UPPER SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool, disengage push in fasteners attaching door upper secondary
weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7302
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7307
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Rear Door Glass Run Weatherstrip
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Remove
weatherstrip fasteners. 4. Pull weatherstrip from lower front channel above door latch.
Fig. 4
5. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 4).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, and door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7308
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair RDR Secondary Weatherstrip
RDR SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool C-4829 or equivalent, disengage push in fasteners attaching door
upper secondary weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7309
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Roof Rail Weatherstrip
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open front and rear doors. 2. Using a door trim removing tool, disengage the push-in fasteners
holding A-pillar and C-pillar weatherstrip molding. 3. Starting at the bottom of the A-pillar, pull the
roof rail weatherstrip from the windshield side molding.
Fig. 5
4. Pull roof rail weatherstrip from the roof rail pinch flange above the door opening (Fig. 5). 5.
Separate roof rail weatherstrip from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place weatherstrip in position on pinch flange. 2. Starting at the bottom of the C-pillar, install the
roof rail weatherstrip molding to the pinch rail. 3. Install push-in fasteners to hold weatherstrip to
A-pillar and C-pillar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7310
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Rear Door Glass Run Weatherstrip
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Remove
weatherstrip fasteners. 4. Pull weatherstrip from lower front channel above door latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7311
Fig. 4
5. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 4).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, and door trim panel.
RDR Secondary Weatherstrip
RDR SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool C-4829 or equivalent, disengage push in fasteners attaching door
upper secondary weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Roof Rail Weatherstrip
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open front and rear doors. 2. Using a door trim removing tool, disengage the push-in fasteners
holding A-pillar and C-pillar weatherstrip molding. 3. Starting at the bottom of the A-pillar, pull the
roof rail weatherstrip from the windshield side molding.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7312
Fig. 5
4. Pull roof rail weatherstrip from the roof rail pinch flange above the door opening (Fig. 5). 5.
Separate roof rail weatherstrip from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place weatherstrip in position on pinch flange. 2. Starting at the bottom of the C-pillar, install the
roof rail weatherstrip molding to the pinch rail. 3. Install push-in fasteners to hold weatherstrip to
A-pillar and C-pillar.
Roof Rail Weatherstrip Retainer Channel
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP RETAINER CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Open door(s). 2. Using trim stick disconnect the top and bottom push in fasteners from B-pillar
applique. Gently pull outward on the applique to remove from the
vehicle.
NOTE: The applique is attached to the vehicle with two sided tape between the push in fasteners,
ensure all of the old two sided tape is removed from the vehicle surface before installation of new
part.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7313
Fig. 6
3. Remove weatherstrip from the retainer channel (Fig. 6). 4. Remove retainer channel from the
body side aperture.
INSTALLATION
1. Install retainer channel to the body side aperture. 2. Remove weatherstrip from the retainer
channel. 3. Connect the top and bottom push in fasteners to B-pillar applique. Gently push on the
applique to install from the vehicle.
Secondary Sill Weatherstrip
SECONDARY SILL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
Fig. 7
1. Using a fork-type prying tool, disengage push in fasteners attaching sill secondary weatherstrip
to door (Fig. 7). 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip > Page 7314
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to door. 2. Press sill secondary weatherstrip fasteners into position.
Trunk Opening Weatherstrip
TRUNK OPENING WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open decklid.
Fig. 8
2. Pull decklid weatherstrip form decklid opening fence (Fig. 8). 3. Remove weatherstrip from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place decklid opening weatherstrip into position. 2. Press the weatherstrip onto the decklid
opening fence. 3. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations
2.0L
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Page 7325
Speed Control Servo
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Page 7326
Cruise Control Servo: Description and Operation
SPEED CONTROL SERVO
The servo unit consists of a solenoid valve body, and a vacuum chamber The solenoid valve body
contains three solenoids Vacuum
- Vent
- Dump
The vacuum chamber contains a diaphragm with a cable attached to control the throttle linkage
The PCM controls the solenoid valve body The solenoid valve body controls the application and
release of vacuum to the diaphragm of the vacuum servo The servo unit cannot be repaired and is
serviced only as a complete assembly
Power is supplied to the servo by the PCM through the brake switch The PCM controls the ground
path for the vacuum and vent solenoids
The dump solenoid is energized anytime it receives power If power to the dump solenoid is
interrupted, the solenoid dumps vacuum in the servo This provides a safety backup to the vent and
vacuum solenoids
The vacuum and vent solenoids must be grounded by the PCM to operate When the PCM grounds
the vacuum servo solenoid, the solenoid allows vacuum to enter the servo and pull open the
throttle plate using the cable When the PCM breaks the ground, the solenoid closes and no more
vacuum is allowed to enter the servo The PCM also operates the vent solenoid via ground The
vent solenoid opens and closes a passage to bleed or hold vacuum in the servo as required
The PCM cycles the vacuum and vent solenoids to maintain the set speed, or to accelerate and
decelerate the vehicle To increase throttle opening, the PCM grounds the vacuum and vent
solenoids To decrease throttle opening, the PCM removes the grounds from the vacuum and vent
solenoids.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Page 7327
Cruise Control Servo: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SERVO
REMOVAL
Fig.6 Speed Control Servo
1. Disconnect electrical connector from servo. 2. Disconnect vacuum hose from servo. 3. Remove
2 nuts retaining bracket to servo. 4. Remove cable bell housing from servo mounting studs. 5.
Remove retaining clip pin holding cable to servo.
INSTALLATION
1. Install retaining clip to cable at servo 2. Install 2 nuts at cable to servo and servo bracket, tighten
to 7 Nm (60 in. lbs.). 3. Connect electrical connector to servo. 4. Connect vacuum hose to servo.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Locations
The speed control servo cable is connected between the speed control vacuum servo diaphragm
and the throttle body control linkage.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Locations > Page
7331
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Description and Operation
SPEED CONTROL SERVO CABLE
The speed control servo cable is connected between the speed control vacuum servo diaphragm
and the throttle body control linkage
This cable causes the throttle control linkage to open or close the throttle valve in response to
movement of the vacuum servo diaphragm
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Locations > Page
7332
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SERVO CABLE
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable 2. Remove the throttle cable cover
Fig.3 Disconnecting Throttle Cable
3. Remove speed control cable from throttle lever by sliding clasp out of the hole. 4. Lift the
retaining tab on the throttle cable and slide cable out of bracket Lift the retaining tab on the speed
control cable and slide cable out of
bracket
5. Disconnect electrical connector from servo 6. Disconnect vacuum hose from servo.
Fig.4 Speed Control Servo
7. Remove 2 nuts retaining bracket to servo. 8. Remove push nuts holding cable housing to Servo.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Locations > Page
7333
Fig.5 Speed Control Cable
9. Remove retaining clip holding cable to servo.
INSTALLATION
1. Install retaining clip to cable at servo 2. Slide cable bell housing over servo mounting studs 3.
Install servo mounting studs into bracket 4. Install 2 nuts at cable to servo and servo bracket,
tighten to 7 Nm (60 in. lbs.) 5. Connect electrical connector to servo 6. Connect vacuum hose to
servo 7. Rotate the throttle lever forward to the wide open position and install speed control cable
clasp. 8. Slide speed control cable into throttle cable bracket and engage retaining tab Slide throttle
cable into throttle cable bracket and engage retaining
tab.
9. Install the Throttle cable cover.
10. Connect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7337
Cruise Control Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: IF REMOVAL OF AIRBAG MODULE IS NECESSARY, REFER TO THE RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7338
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES
The speed control system has five separate resistive switches that provide a single multiplexed
(MUX) voltage inputs to the PCM The switch names are ON, OFF, SET, COAST, RESUME,
ACCEL, TAP-UP, COAST, and CANCEL Based on conditions when the buttons are pushed (and
released), the five voltages ranges provided to the PCM result in the following functions ON, OFF,
SET, COAST, RESUME, ACCEL, TAP-UP, TAP-DOWN, COAST, and CANCEL Refer to the
Speed Control Section for more information
Also the PCM receives an input from the brake switch to sense whether the brake pedal has been
depressed When the PCM receives the brake depressed input, it turns off power to the speed
control servo and disengages speed control Also the power to the servo is supplied through the
brake switch, which opens the circuit when the brake pedal is depressed
The individual switches cannot be repaired If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7339
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES
The speed control switch is mounted in the steering wheel and wired through the clock spring
device under the airbag module.
WARNING: IF REMOVAL OF AIRBAG MODULE IS NECESSARY, REFER TO THE RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS.
Fig.7 Speed Control Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the air cleaner lid, disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor and makeup air hose. 2.
Remove the negative battery cable. 3. Turn off ignition. 4. Remove air bag, refer to the Restraint
systems section.
Fig.8 Switch Top Mounting Screw
5. Remove the top mounting screw. 6. Rotate steering wheel so that the switch is in the 6 o'clock
position. Remove 2 screws from the back side of the speed control switch. 7. Disconnect the
electrical connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7340
Fig.9 Switch Removal
8. Remove switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install switch and tighten the screws to 1.6 Nm (15 in. lbs.).
Make sure rubber seal is in place around switch. 3. Install airbag, refer to the Restraint Systems
section. 4. Install the negative battery cable. 5. Install the air cleaner lid, connect the inlet air
temperature sensor and makeup air hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir > Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir: Locations
The vacuum reservoir is located in the engine compartment It is made of plastic.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7344
Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir: Description and Operation
VACUUM RESERVOIR
The vacuum reservoir is located in the engine compartment. It is made of plastic.
The reservoir stores engine vacuum. Manifold vacuum is supplied from the brake booster check
valve. The speed control vacuum supply hose has a check valve at the source (brake booster) to
maintain the highest available vacuum level in the servo, reservoir and vacuum hoses. When
engine vacuum drops, as in climbing a grade while driving, the reservoir supplies the vacuum
needed to maintain proper speed control operation. The vacuum reservoir cannot be repaired and
must be replaced if faulty.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7345
Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir: Service and Repair
VACUUM RESERVOIR
REMOVAL
1. Remove the passenger side cowl screen..
Fig.10 Vacuum Reservoir Mounting
2. Remove vacuum reservoir mounting nuts.
Fig.11 Vacuum Reservoir Connections
3. Remove vacuum hose and throttle cable tie strap push clip. 4. Remove vacuum reservoir.
INSTALLATION
1. Install vacuum reservoir, install nuts and tighten to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.). 2. Install vacuum hose. 3.
Install the throttle cable push clip onto reservoir.
NOTE: Throttle cable must be clipped to the reservoir to prevent contact with the exhaust manifold.
4. Install the passenger side cowl screen.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7356
Cruise Control Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: IF REMOVAL OF AIRBAG MODULE IS NECESSARY, REFER TO THE RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7357
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES
The speed control system has five separate resistive switches that provide a single multiplexed
(MUX) voltage inputs to the PCM The switch names are ON, OFF, SET, COAST, RESUME,
ACCEL, TAP-UP, COAST, and CANCEL Based on conditions when the buttons are pushed (and
released), the five voltages ranges provided to the PCM result in the following functions ON, OFF,
SET, COAST, RESUME, ACCEL, TAP-UP, TAP-DOWN, COAST, and CANCEL Refer to the
Speed Control Section for more information
Also the PCM receives an input from the brake switch to sense whether the brake pedal has been
depressed When the PCM receives the brake depressed input, it turns off power to the speed
control servo and disengages speed control Also the power to the servo is supplied through the
brake switch, which opens the circuit when the brake pedal is depressed
The individual switches cannot be repaired If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7358
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES
The speed control switch is mounted in the steering wheel and wired through the clock spring
device under the airbag module.
WARNING: IF REMOVAL OF AIRBAG MODULE IS NECESSARY, REFER TO THE RESTRAINT
SYSTEMS.
Fig.7 Speed Control Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the air cleaner lid, disconnect the inlet air temperature sensor and makeup air hose. 2.
Remove the negative battery cable. 3. Turn off ignition. 4. Remove air bag, refer to the Restraint
systems section.
Fig.8 Switch Top Mounting Screw
5. Remove the top mounting screw. 6. Rotate steering wheel so that the switch is in the 6 o'clock
position. Remove 2 screws from the back side of the speed control switch. 7. Disconnect the
electrical connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7359
Fig.9 Switch Removal
8. Remove switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the electrical connector. 2. Install switch and tighten the screws to 1.6 Nm (15 in. lbs.).
Make sure rubber seal is in place around switch. 3. Install airbag, refer to the Restraint Systems
section. 4. Install the negative battery cable. 5. Install the air cleaner lid, connect the inlet air
temperature sensor and makeup air hose.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Locations
ABS Light: Locations
The amber ABS warning indicator lamp is located in the instrument cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7364
ABS Light: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
ABS Indicator .......................................................................................................................................
................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7365
ABS Light: Description and Operation
ABS WARNING INDICATOR
The amber ABS warning indicator is located in the instrument cluster. It is used to inform the driver
that the antilock function has been turned off due to a system malfunction. The CAB controls the
lamp indirectly. The CAB monitors its own functions. If the CAB determines that the ABS warning
indicator should be on, the CAB sends a message via the PCI BUS to the instrument cluster and
the cluster turns on the indicator. The indicator will remain lit during every key cycle until the circuit
or component fault is repaired and the CAB no longer detects the fault. After repair of a sensor
signal fault or a pump motor fault, the CAB must sense all four wheels at 25 km/h (15 mph) before
it will extinguish the ABS and TRAC OFF Indicators.
The Instrument Cluster will illuminate the ABS Warning Indicator if it loses communication with the
CAB.
When the ignition key is turned to the ON position, the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is lit until
the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) completes its self-tests and turns OFF the lamp (approximately
4 seconds). The amber ABS warning indicator lamp will illuminate when the CAB detects a
condition that results in the shutdown of ABS function. The CAB sends a message to the
Mechanical Instrument Cluster (MIC) instructing it to turn ON the amber ABS warning indicator
lamp.
Under most conditions, when the amber ABS warning indicator lamp is ON, only the ABS function
of the brake system is affected; The Electronic Brake Distribution (EBD), the base brake system
and the ability to stop the vehicle are not affected.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Locations
Audible Warning Device: Locations
The Chime Module is located within the instrument cluster and is not serviceable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7369
Audible Warning Device: Description and Operation
CHIME/BUZZER
The Chime Module is located within the instrument cluster and is not serviceable. The
chime/buzzer system provides the driver with warning chimes for: Seat Belt
- Exterior Lamps ON
- Key-In Ignition
- Warning Lamp Announcement
- Turn Signal ON
- Park Brake
- Low Fuel
Fasten Seat Belt
The seat belt reminder system uses both visual and audible signals. A combined seat belt and key
reminder chime with a red light on the instrument panel.
The system will illuminate the seat belt reminder lamp for when the ignition switch is turned to the
ON position. The CHIME will sound 4 - 8 seconds if the driver's seat belt is not fastened.
Passenger belts are not connected to the system. The light will stay illuminated at all times when
the driver seat belt is not buckled.
Headlamps Reminder
These are the conditions that have to be met for the headlamps ON, chime function to work: Headlamps ON and
- Driver's door open and
- Key removed from the ignition switch.
Chime should sound until headlamps are turned OFF or the drivers door is closed.
Key In Ignition Reminder
The chime will activate if the drivers door is opened and the key is in the ignition switch, with the
ignition switch in either the OFF, LOCK, or the accessory (ACC) position.
Door Ajar Chime
The chime will sound once when: Door opened and
- Ignition in RUN position and
- Vehicle speed is present
Turn Signal ON
The cluster shall remind the driver that either turn signal has been left ON by continuously chiming
after: Left or Right turn signal left ON for 1.0 mile and
- Vehicle speed of 15 mph or greater.
Park Brake Reminder
The cluster shall chime 10 times and continuously flash the brake indicator when: Park brake is activated and
- Vehicle speed is present.
Low Fuel Reminder
When the fuel level drops to about 1/8 tank, the fuel symbol will light and a single chime will sound.
The light will remain ON until fuel is added. If the fuel level drops to about 1/16 of a tank, the fuel
symbol will flash several times and the chime will sound several times.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7370
Audible Warning Device: Testing and Inspection
CHIME SYSTEM CONDITIONS
No Tone When Ignition Switch Is Turned ON And Drivers Seat Belt Is Unbuckled 1. Using an
ohmmeter, with the seat belt fully retracted, check for continuity to ground at Pin 20 of the 26-way
cluster harness connector. If OK, go
to Step 2. If not OK, repair as necessary.
2. Using voltmeter, check for battery feed at Pin 4 of the 26-way cluster harness connector. Check
for ignition feed at Pin 14 of the 26-way cluster
harness connector. If not OK, repair as necessary.
No Fasten Seat Belt Lamp When Ignition Switch Is ON 1. Check for battery feed at cluster harness
connector Pin 4. 2. Check for ignition feed at cluster harness connector Pin 14. Repair as
necessary.
No Tone When Headlamps are ON And Drivers Door Is Open 1. Remove the key from the ignition.
2. Check left door jamb switch for good ground when drivers door is open. 3. Check for ground at
Pin 1 of the 26-way cluster harness connector. 4. Check for battery feed at cluster harness
connector Pin 4 of the 26-way cluster harness connector. 5. Check for NO voltage at Pin 14.
Ignition voltage must not be present for the chime to work. 6. Check headlamp switch.
No Tone When Key Is Left In Ignition And Drivers Door Is Open 1. Check for continuity to ground at
Pin 1 of the 26-way cluster harness connector. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair as necessary
2. Using voltmeter, check for battery feed at Pin 21 of the 26-way cluster harness connector. Check
for NO ignition feed at Pin 14 of the 26-way
cluster harness connector. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair as necessary.
3. Open driver's door and ensure the ignition key is in the OFF, LOCK, or ACC position. Check for
continuity to ground at Pin 9 of the 26-way
cluster harness connector. If ground OK, replace cluster printed circuit board. If no ground, check
key-in switch or door switch wiring and repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Service Precautions
Brake Warning Indicator: Service Precautions
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Brake System Warning Indicator .........................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Page 7374
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE/PARK BRAKE INDICATOR
The brake warning lamp illuminates when the parking brake is applied with ignition switch turned to
the ON position. The same lamp will also illuminate if one of the two service brake systems fail the
when brake pedal is applied.
To Test The System: As the ignition switch is turned to the start position the lamp should light.
- Turn ignition switch to the ON position and apply the parking brake. The lamp should light.
If Lamp Fails To Light, Inspect For: A burned out lamp
- Loose, corroded or damaged socket
- A damaged circuit board
- A broken or disconnected wire at the switch
- Defective switch
To test the service brake warning system, refer to Brakes, Hydraulic System Control Valves.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Locations
Fig. 12 Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY AND AVOID LOOSE
CLOTHING.
How to Find Wiring Diagrams
Diagrams are presented in three main categories:
^ Power Distribution Diagrams
Circuits feeding/protecting the system diagrams
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7380
^ System Diagrams
Component Circuits that work together as a system
^ Grounds Diagrams
Circuits grounding the system diagrams
Power Distribution Diagrams
The power distribution diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are especially useful for identifying potential suspects that could be causing any
"dead/unpowered" fuses and/or for identifying potential suspects that could be the causing any
"blown" fuses.
System Diagrams
These diagrams are useful for identifying a component's power source and its direct relationship to
the other components in the same system. These diagrams may also indicate a component's
indirect relationship with components in other systems.
Grounds Diagrams
The grounds diagrams are located at Power and Ground Distribution.
These diagrams are useful for determining the interconnections of the grounding circuits of different
systems.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagram sheets may appear
to be missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams
that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Navigate Between Wiring Diagrams
Circuits that go from one diagram sheet to another will be marked with references indicating which
diagram sheet the circuit went to/came from, i.e. "8W-16-4".
Theses references will be in the form of unique diagram identification numbers (i.e. 8W-16-4,
8W-25-2, etc). All diagram sheets are identified with this unique ID number in their captions.
Diagrams sheets being referred to that may reside outside of the set of diagrams you are viewing
can be accessed by clicking on the hyperlink for "Diagrams By Number" which is provided with all
sets of diagrams.
PLEASE NOTE: When locating diagrams by their ID numbers, some diagrams may appear to be
missing because of gaps in the number sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do
not apply to the vehicle model selected.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DIAGRAM LAYOUT
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7381
General Information (Part 1 of 2)
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page (Fig. 1).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7382
General Information (Part 2 of 2)
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition (Fig. 2).
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete. To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to
Vehicle/Diagrams/Electrical/Diagrams By Number.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7383
function only.
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sets at the applicable system level. If a component
is most likely found in a particular system, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and
pins) within that system's diagrams. It can, however, be shown partially in another system's
diagrams if it contains some associated wiring.
Wiring Diagram Symbols
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7384
Circuit Identification Code Chart
CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7385
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
...................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .....................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX
.............................................................................................................................................................
Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ..............................................................................
................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT .
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ..............................................................................
...................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
SOHC ..................................................................................................................................................
............................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ................................................................
............................................................................................................... Double Over Head Cam
Engine BUX .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.............................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................................... Vehicles Built
For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7386
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7387
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Views Information
Connector views show the connector and the circuits associated with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram sheets. A master list can be
found at Vehicle / Diagrams. See: Diagrams/Connector Views
Connector, Ground and Splice Identification and Location
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Identification
Connectors, grounds, and splices are identified as follows:
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7388
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers
- In-line connectors located in the Instrument Panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Locations
Vehicle/Locations contains the master connector/ground/splice location index charts with
hyperlinks to the applicable location illustrations. The illustrations contain the connector name (or
number)/ground number/splice number and component identification.
The abbreviation T/O is used in the location column to indicate a point in which the wiring harness
branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the illustrations.
PLEASE NOTE: The master location index charts contain numerous items that may not be
applicable to all vehicle models. If a link on the master location index chart to a figure is not
functional, that means that the chart item and/or figure in question does NOT apply to the vehicle
model selected.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7389
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7390
Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Take Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component.
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7391
RHD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX ..................................................................
............................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel
Drive MTX ............................................................................................................................................
......................... Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT ...........................................................
.......................................................................................................... Automatic Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................................................................................
..................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC ..........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Single
Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ Double Over Head Cam Engine BUX .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... Built-Up-Export Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Section Identification and Information
Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Connector Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery
Fig. 10 Removal Of Dress Cover
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7392
2. Release Connector Lock (Fig. 10). 3. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component. 4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (Fig. 10).
Fig. 11 Examples Of Connector Secondary Terminal Locks
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (Fig. 11).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7393
Fig. 12 Terminal Removal
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector (Fig. 12).
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector. 2. Repeat steps for each
terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the proper cavities. For
additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out. 4. Replace dress cover (if applicable). 5. Connect connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Diode Replacement
REMOVAL
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7394
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
Diode Identification
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction.
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode. 2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If
necessary, refer to the appropriate wiring diagram for current flow (Fig.
13).
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only Do not use acid core solder. 4.
Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed from
the elements. 5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in Connector Replacement. 2. Cut the wire 6
inches from the back of the connector.
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired. 2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation. 3.
Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure). 4. Insert the repaired wire
into the connector. 5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector
to its mating half/component. 6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the
connector and 2 inches past the repair. 7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced. 2. Place a
piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7395
Fig. 14 Splice Band
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (Fig. 14).
Fig. 15 Crimping Tool
4. Using crimping tool, Mopar P/N 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together (Fig. 15).
Fig. 16 Solder Splice
5. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only (Fig. 16).
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7396
Fig. 17 Heat Shrink Tube
6. Center the heat shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing (Fig. 17).
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Terminal Pick Tool Set 6680
Terminal Removing Tools 6932 And 8638
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7397
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Splice Diagrams
The splice diagram sheets (identified with an 8W-70 prefix) in Power and Ground Distribution
contain splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety elsewhere in the wiring diagrams.
These diagram sheets show the entire splice and provide references to other system diagrams the
splices serve.
To find any diagram sheets referred to by number only, go to Vehicle / Diagrams / Electrical /
Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Symbols
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7398
Fig.3 Wiring Diagram Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world (Fig. 3).
Terminology
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD .................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Right Hand Drive
Vehicles ATX .......................................................................................................................................
.......................... Automatic Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive MTX ...................................................
.................................................................................................................. Manual
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7399
AT ........................................................................................................................................................
............. Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive MT ...................................................................
..................................................................................................... Manual Transmissions-Rear
Wheel Drive SOHC ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................... Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC ........................................
........................................................................................................................................... Double
Over Head Cam Engine Built-Up-Export
.................................................................................................................. Vehicles Built For Sale In
Markets Other Than North America Except Built-Up-Export
........................................................................................................................................ Vehicles
Built For Sale In North America
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7400
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Intermittent and Poor Connections
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items. Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Fig.6 Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol (Fig. 6) is used to indicate this. When
handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the
possibility of electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the
component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7401
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part form
it's protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from it's
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fig.7 Testing For Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground (Fig. 7). 2. Connect the other
lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to
check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Fig.8 Testing For Continuity
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested (Fig. 8). 3. Connect the
other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7402
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
about 6 - 8 inches apart and watch the voltmeter/test lamp. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or
the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or
re-connecting the battery. 4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a
time. When the fuse blows the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Fig.9 Testing For Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery (Fig. 9).
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit. 3.
Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
Jumper Wire
This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass an open in a
circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
Voltmeter
Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good ground and
the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
Ohmmeter
Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in a circuit
means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 mega-ohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7403
Fig. 4 Probing Tool
Probing Tools
These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors (Fig. 4). Select the proper size tool from
Special Tool Package 6807, and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end of the
tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems, there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for nonfactory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem. 2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on
components that are in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams. 3. Analyze the symptoms.
Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the problem most likely is
occurring, and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area. 5. Repair the problem. 6. Verify proper operation. For this step, check
for proper operation of all items on the repaired circuit.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7404
Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 7405
Cigarette Lighter: Service and Repair
CIGAR LIGHTER OUTLET
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable
Fig. 1 Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet Base Removal
2. Look inside and note position of the retaining bosses (Fig. 1). 3. Using external snap ring pliers
with 90 degree tips. Insert pliers with tips against bosses and squeeze forcing bosses out of base.
Fig. 2 Cigar Lighter/Power Outlet Base Removal
4. Pull out the base through mounting ring by gently rocking pliers. A tool can be made to do the
same (Fig. 2). 5. Disconnect the base wires. 6. Set base aside and remove base mount ring.
INSTALLATION
1. Position mount ring to the instrument panel and feed the wires through ring. Index the cap and
the mount ring with the index tab at 9 o'clock to the
key in the instrument panel. Install the ring.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 7406
2. Connect wires to base. Orient base alignment rib at 11 o'clock to mate the groove in mount ring
at the same location 3. Push base into the bezel till it locks. 4. Install cigar lighter cap and check
operation of element. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations
Compass: Locations
The compass is located within the mirror module and can not be serviced separately.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7410
Compass/Temperature Mirror
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7411
Compass: Description and Operation
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7412
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is
subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may appear to indicate false headings or
appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may need to be demagnetized. Refer to
Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7413
the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and
engine temperature data received on the PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Compass/Mini-Trip Computer (CMTC) Self-Diagnostics
Compass: Testing and Inspection Compass/Mini-Trip Computer (CMTC) Self-Diagnostics
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR TEST
If the Compass/Temperature mirror lights up and functions, however the accuracy of the
information displayed is in question or certain displays are not working, refer to the self-diagnostic
test below. If the mirror doesn't light up or function, proceed with the following preliminary tests:
1. Disconnect the compass/temperature mirror electrical connector. Using a voltmeter, check for
12v on the fused B+ circuit cavity. Voltage should
be present. If OK go to Step 2, If NOT OK, repair the short or open circuit as required.
2. Using a voltmeter, check for 12v on the fused ignition run circuit cavity with the ignition switch in
the RUN position. Voltage should be present. If
OK go to Step 3, If NOT OK, repair the short or open circuit as required.
3. Key OFF. Using a ohmmeter, check for continuity to a good ground on the ground circuit cavities
of the compass/temperature mirror electrical
connector. Continuity should be present. If OK, replace the mirror assembly, If NOT OK, repair the
short or open circuits as required.
Compass/Temperature Mirror Self-Diagnostic Test
NOTE: If the ignition switch is turned OFF during any period of the self diagnostic procedure, the mirror will
exit the self diagnostic mode.
- Pressing and releasing the zone/calibration button will exit the self diagnostic mode and return to
the standard compass/temperature mode
To perform the Compass/Temperature Mirror Self-Diagnostic routine: 1. Turn the ignition to the ON
position. 2. Press and hold the zone/calibration (left reading lamp button) button for 20 - 25
seconds. 3. During testing, if any of the test fail, a "F" will appear. If more than one test fail, "FO"
will appear. If "F" or FO" appear, replace the compass
/temperature mirror.
4. If a "P" is displayed, that indicates that the compass/temperature mirror has passed the self
diagnostic procedure.
NOTE: If, after performing the self diagnostic procedure the compass still has an incorrect reading,
perform the compass calibration or compass variation adjustment.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Compass/Mini-Trip Computer (CMTC) Self-Diagnostics > Page 7416
Compass: Testing and Inspection Self-Check Diagnostics
SELF-CHECK DIAGNOSTICS
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20 - 25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display - Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as
follows:
- CAL
- ZONE
-N
- NE
-E
- SE
-S
- SW
-W
- NW
- 0 through 9
- degrees C
- degrees F
2. CTM memory - ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory - RAM 4. CTM memory - EEPROM 5.
Compass Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Compass/Mini-Trip Computer (CMTC) Self-Diagnostics > Page 7417
Compass: Testing and Inspection Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the Compass
/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Calibration
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15-20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature F degrees, or Compass/Temperature C degrees.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20-25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10-15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10-15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is
subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may appear to indicate false headings or
appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may need to be demagnetized. Refer to
Demagnetizing Procedure.
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory, the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the
displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the
PCI Bus.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Calibration > Page 7420
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 degrees F every 2 seconds, regardless if the
vehicle is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 degrees C (140 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 degrees C (140
degrees F) to indicate a short circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) to
indicate an open circuit condition.
Ambient Temperature Sensor
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the compass/temp module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 degrees C (140 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 degrees C (140
degrees F) to indicate a SHORT circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) to
indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
- 0 degrees C (32 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms
- 10 degrees C (50 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms
- 20 degrees C (68 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms
- 25 degrees C (77 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms
- 30 degrees C (86 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms
- 40 degrees C (104 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Calibration > Page 7421
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Variation Adjustment
STANDARD PROCEDURE - COMPASS VARIATION ADJUSTMENT
Compass variance, also known as magnetic declination, is the difference in angle between
magnetic north and true geographic north. In some geographic locations, the difference between
magnetic and geographic north is great enough to cause the compass to give false readings. If this
problem occurs, the compass variance must be set.
ZONE METHOD
Fig.2 Variance Settings
1. Using the Variance Settings map, find your geographic location and note the zone number (Fig.
2). 2. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. Press and hold the Zone/Calibration (left reading
lamp button) button for 5 - 10 seconds. The Zone
symbol should be illuminated.
3. Releasing the Zone /Calibration button while the ZONE symbol is illuminated will cause the
mirror to enter the zone display mode. 4. The current variance zone will now be displayed. To
change the zone, press the Zone/Calibration button until the correct zone is displayed. Wait
for 5 seconds.
5. After 5 seconds, the displayed zone will automatically be set in the mirror memory and normal
operation will resume. 6. Confirm that the correct directions are now indicated by the compass.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 7426
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Door Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7430
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7431
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7432
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7433
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7434
Fig. 44 Body (Right Rear) - RHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7435
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7436
Door Switch: Diagrams
Driver Door Ajar Switch
Hood Ajar Switch (Export)
Left Rear Door Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fog/Driving Lamp Indicator > Component
Information > Application and ID
Fog/Driving Lamp Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Front Fog Lamp Indicator ....................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7443
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The
sending unit consists of a float, an arm, and a variable resistor (track). The resistor track is used to
send electrical signals to the instrument cluster for fuel gauge operation and are then transmitted to
the engine controller for OBDII emission requirements.
For Fuel Gauge Operation: As fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This increases the
sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge to read full. As fuel level decreases, the float and
arm move down. This decreases the sending unit resistance causing the fuel gauge to read empty.
After this fuel level signal is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster will transmit the
data across the J1850 bus circuits to the PCM.
For OBD II Emission Requirements: The voltage signal is sent to the instrument cluster to indicate
fuel level. The cluster transmits the fuel level to the PCM where it is used to prevent a false setting
of misfire and fuel system monitor trouble codes. This occurs if the fuel level in the tank is less than
approximately 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7444
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
REMOVAL
Remove fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector (Fig. 4).
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge (Fig. 5).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7445
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector (Fig. 6). 4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector (Fig. 6).
Fig.7 Level Sensor
5. Slide level sensor wires through opening fuel pump module (Fig. 7). 6. Slide level sensor out of
installation channel in module.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert level sensor wires into bottom of opening in module. 2. Wrap wires into groove in back of
level sensor. 3. While feeding wires into guide grooves, slide level sensor up into channel until it
snaps into place (Fig. 7). Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in
place.
4. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
5. Install locking wedge on connector. 6. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector. 7. Install fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH
ENABLES THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY
THE AIRBAG.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS
COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL
INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Page 7450
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
AIRBAG ARMING AND DISARMING
WARNING: The airbag control module contains the impact sensor, which enables the system to
deploy the airbag. Before attempting to diagnose or service any airbag system or related steering
wheel, steering column, or instrument panel components, you must disable the airbag system.
PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative (ground) cable. 2. Wait at least two minutes for the
capacitor to discharge.
WARNING: This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system. Failure to do this could result in
accidental airbag deployment and possible personal injury.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Instrument
Panel Bulb > Map Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair
Map Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a small thin blade tool, pry at the
center of the lens nearest the mirror to remove lens. 3. Remove cartridge lamp.
INSTALLATION
1. Install lens by setting lens into position and applying pressure until it is locked into position. 2.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Application and ID
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Low Fuel Indicator ...............................................................................................................................
................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Application and ID
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Malfunction Indicator Light ...................................................................................................................
............................................................... LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Application and ID > Page 7461
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
Refer to the Instrument Cluster for more information.
The PCM supplies the malfunction indicator (check engine) lamp ON/OFF signal to the instrument
panel through the PCI Bus. The PCI Bus is a communications port. Various modules use the PCI
Bus to exchange information.
The Check Engine lamp comes ON each time the ignition key is turned ON and stays on for 3
seconds as a bulb test.
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) stays ON continuously when the PCM has entered a Limp-In
mode or identified a failed emission component. During Limp-in Mode, the PCM attempts to keep
the system operational. The MIL signals the need for immediate service. In limp-in mode, the PCM
compensates for the failure of certain components that send incorrect signals. The PCM substitutes
for the incorrect signals with inputs from other sensors.
If the PCM detects active engine misfire severe enough to cause catalyst damage, it flashes the
MIL. At the same time the PCM also sets a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
For signals that can trigger the MIL (Check Engine Lamp) refer to the On-Board Diagnostics.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp >
Component Information > Application and ID
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Application and ID
This vehicle did not have an Oil Change Reminder Light.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Sender: Description and Operation
OIL PRESSURE SENSOR/ SWITCH
DESCRIPTION
The oil pressure switch is located on the right rear side of the engine block (Fig. 120). The oil
pressure switch is a pressure sensitive switch that is activated by the engine's oil pressure (in the
main oil gallery). The switch is a two terminal device (one terminal is provided to the wiring harness
and the other terminal is the switch's metal housing that screws into the engine block).
OPERATION
The oil pressure switch changes from an "Open" circuit to a "Closed" circuit, on decreasing
pressure, between 2 psig and 4 psig. The switch changes from a "Closed" circuit to an "Open"
circuit, on increasing pressure of 7 psig of the switch's "Closed" circuit pressure point.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7468
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position oil collecting container under pressure switch location.
3. Disconnect oil pressure switch electrical connector and remove switch (Fig. 121).
INSTALLATION
1. Install oil pressure switch and connect electrical connector (Fig. 121). 2. Lower vehicle. 3. Start
engine and allow to run a minimum of 2 minutes. 4. Shut engine off and check engine oil level.
Adjust level as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Application and ID
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ..................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Application and ID > Page 7472
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
The low oil pressure indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position
without engine running. The lamp also illuminates if the engine oil pressure drops below a safe oil
pressure level.
Fig.2 Oil Pressure Switch
To test the system, turn the ignition switch to the ON position. If the lamp fails to light, inspect for a
broken or disconnected wire at the oil pressure switch, located at the front of the engine (Fig. 2). If
the wire at the connector checks good, pull the connector loose from the switch and with a jumper
wire, ground the connector to the engine. With the ignition switch turned to the ON position, check
the warning lamp. If the lamp still fails to light, inspect for a burned out lamp or disconnected socket
in the cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Outside Temperature Display: Description and Operation
COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MIRROR
The optional Compass/Temperature Mirror has a vacuum fluorescent (VF) display that is integrated
into the rear view mirror. The Compass/Temp Mirror includes the compass/temperature display and
two map/reading lamps. This display provides the outside temperature and one of eight compass
headings to indicate the direction the vehicle is facing. The Compass/Temp Mirror displays the
compass heading and the outside temperature at the same time. The Ambient Temperature
Sensor monitors the outside temperature and is hardwired to the Compass/Temp Mirror (1.6L
vehicles), or is hard-wired to the PCM (2.0L vehicles). The Compass/Temp Mirror also receives
and transmits data on the PCI Bus.
The Compass/Temp Mirror incorporates 2 reading lamp buttons with the STEP button and the
Zone/Calibration button features activated by holding a button for a specified time period. The
STEP button provides the selections between English and Metric. The Zone/Cal button provides
the selection to change the compass zone or to calibrate the compass. The reading lamp buttons
also cycle the reading lamps on or off.
The STEP button (right reading lamp button) operates a momentary contact switch which provides
input to the Compass/Temp Mirror in one of the following four modes:
- To toggle the right reading lamp on and off upon release of the button.
- To select degrees in F (Fahrenheit) for the temperature display.
- To select degrees in C (Celsius) for the temperature display.
- To turn off the compass/temperature display.
English/Metric/Off Mode
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the STEP button (right reading lamp
button) for 5-10 seconds will toggle the display between English and Metric. The Compass/Temp
Mirror stores the selected display mode in memory upon releasing the button during the 5-10
seconds.
Pressing and holding the STEP button for 10-15 seconds will turn the display OFF upon releasing
the button during the 10-15 seconds.
Each time the temperature mode is changed to F degrees or C degrees, the Compass/Temp Mirror
stores the new mode in memory. The selected English or Metric mode is recalled after the ignition
is cycled. The display OFF mode is not recalled after the ignition is cycled. The Compass/Temp
Mirror will power up and display the temperature mode (F degrees or C degrees) that was last
selected.
COMPASS
Calibration/Zone Mode
Refer to the Zone Variance Map. With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the
Zone/ Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds will illuminate ZONE in the display.
Releasing the button while ZONE is illuminated will enter the compass into the Zone Setting mode.
The Compass/Temp Mirror will illuminate the Zone Variance number 1 to 15 that is stored in
memory. While ZONE is displayed; momentarily pressing the Zone/Cal button advances the zone
to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal
button again. After 5 seconds, the Zone Variance number will be stored in the module memory.
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 10-15 seconds
will toggle the CAL (calibration) mode between on and off. Releasing the button while CAL is
displayed enters the compass into the calibration mode. See "First Time Calibration", "Manual
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7476
Calibration", and "Continuous Calibration."
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 15 - 20 seconds and then releasing will exit the CAL
mode and toggle the display to the current state of compass/temperature mirror use; OFF,
Compass/ Temperature °F, or Compass/Temperature °C.
Pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button for 20 - 25 seconds will enter the CTM into the self-check
diagnostic mode upon releasing the button.
Holding the Zone/Cal button for longer than 25 seconds will cause the display to return to its
current state with no changes.
Setting Compass Zone
The compass has a default zone of 8. Refer to the Zone Variance Map to determine the correct
zone number. The correct compass Zone selection is critical to proper compass operation. With the
ignition in the ON position, pressing the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 5-10 seconds
and then releasing while ZONE is illuminated enters the compass into the Zone display mode. In
the Zone display mode, ZONE will be illuminated instead of the temperature. The current Zone
number, 1 through 15 will be displayed. While ZONE is illuminated; momentarily pressing the
Zone/Cal button advances the zone to the next higher zone. When the desired zone number is
displayed, do not press the Zone/Cal button again. After 5 seconds , the Zone Variance number will
be stored in the module memory.
First Time Calibration
A new Compass/Temp Mirror is shipped in a first time calibration mode. CAL is illuminated when
the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up. The first time calibration mode can not be exited
until the first time calibration process is completed. The CAL icon will remain illuminated to alert the
driver that the Compass/Temp Mirror is operating in the CAL mode. Move the vehicle to an area
away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the display
the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h). The
compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Manual Calibration
With the ignition in the ON position, pressing and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp
button) for 10 - 15 seconds will toggle the display to CAL. Releasing the button within the 10 - 15
second duration will enter the compass into the calibration mode. CAL will remain illuminated until
the calibration is complete or is toggled off by pressing the Zone/Cal button. Move the vehicle to an
area away from large metallic objects or overhead power lines. While CAL is illuminated in the
display the vehicle must be driven in 3 complete 360 degree circles at less than 5 MPH (8 KPH).
The compass will calibrate; CAL will turn off, and then resume normal operation.
Continuous Calibration
During normal operation, the Compass/Temp Mirror will continuously update the compass
calibration to adjust for gradual changes in the vehicle's magnetic remnant field. If the vehicle is
subjected to high magnetic influences, the compass may appear to indicate false headings or
appear unable to be calibrated. If this occurs the vehicle may need to be demagnetized. Refer to
Demagnetizing Procedure.
Self-Check Diagnostics
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20-25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display-Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as follows:
CAL; ZONE; N; NE; E; SE; S; SW; W; NW; 0
through 9; C degrees; F degrees
2. CTM memory-ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory-RAM 4. CTM memory-EEPROM 5. Compass
Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
TEMPERATURE
Outside Temperature
The Compass/Temp Mirror utilizes vehicle speed and engine temperature data received on the PCI
Bus to accurately display the outside temperature to avoid "hot soak" condition readings. The
displayed outside temperature information is stored within the memory of the compass/temp mirror.
When the Compass/Temp Mirror is first powered up, it retrieves the temperature data from the
module memory. The memory temperature is compared with the temperature received from the
ambient temperature sensor. The colder of the two temperatures is displayed.
Temperature Update - Warm
On power up, when the outside temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is warmer
than the temperature stored in the module memory,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7477
the Compass/Temp Mirror will update the displayed temperature in relation to vehicle speed and
engine temperature data received on the PCI Bus.
Temperature Update - Cold
On power up, when the outside air temperature sensed by the ambient temperature sensor is
colder than the stored memory temperature, the Compass/ Temp Mirror will update the displayed
temperature to the outside temperature at a rate of -1 °F every 2 seconds, regardless if the vehicle
is moving or not.
Extreme temperature/Open or Short Condition
If the measured outside temperature is more than 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature
sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a short
circuit condition.
If the measured outside temperature is less than -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 ° C (-49 °F) to indicate an open circuit condition.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
On these equipped vehicles, the Ambient Temperature Sensor is hardwired to the PCM. The
ambient air temperature is monitored and displayed by the Compass/Temp Mirror.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
The resistance in the ambient temperature sensor changes as the outside temperature rises or
falls. The PCM senses the change in reference voltage through the ambient temperature sensor
resistor. Based on the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor, the PCM is programmed to
correspond to a specific temperature. The Compass/Temp Mirror then displays the proper ambient
temperature.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the Compass/Temp Module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 °C (140 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 °C (140 °F) to indicate a SHORT
circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 °C (-49 °F) or the ambient temperature sensor
sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 °C (-49 °F) to indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Test
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
TEMPERATURE
.............................................................................................................................................................
SENSOR RESISTANCE
0 °C (32 °F) .........................................................................................................................................
.................................... 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 °C (50 °F) ..............................................................
............................................................................................................. 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 °C
(68 °F) .................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 °C (77 °F) ........................................................................
..................................................................................................... 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30 °C (86 °F)
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 °C (104 °F) ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not
OK, replace the Sensor.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7478
Outside Temperature Display: Testing and Inspection
SELF-CHECK DIAGNOSTICS
With the ignition ON, the Compass/Temp Mirror can perform a diagnostic self-check by pressing
and holding the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) for 20 - 25 seconds. The internal
diagnostics will sequence the following five tests:
1. VF segment display - Illuminates the segment patterns one at a time for 1 second each as
follows:
- CAL
- ZONE
-N
- NE
-E
- SE
-S
- SW
-W
- NW
- 0 through 9
- degrees C
- degrees F
2. CTM memory - ROM Checksum 3. CTM memory - RAM 4. CTM memory - EEPROM 5.
Compass Test
During the self-check, if any of the internal tests fail, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display an "F"
and the number of the test that failed. If more than one test fails "FO" will be displayed. P- Pass or
F- Fail will be displayed until the Zone/Cal button (left reading lamp button) is pressed and released
or the ignition is cycled. If all of the tests pass, the Compass/Temp Mirror will display "P,'. A VF
segment that fails to illuminate will not cause the
Compass/Temp Mirror to display an "F". If any segment fails to illuminate or the Compass/Temp
Mirror displays "F", the Compass/Temp Mirror must be replaced.
To exit self-check diagnostics, press and release the Zone/Cal button or cycle the ignition to return
to normal compass/temp operation.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Diagnostics
The outside temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor; a signal and
ground circuit hardwired to the compass/temp module (1.6L vehicles) or to the PCM (2.0L
vehicles), and the Compass/Temp Mirror display.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates 60 degrees C (140 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is shorted to ground, the temp display will be 60 degrees C (140
degrees F) to indicate a SHORT circuit condition.
If the Compass/Temp Mirror display indicates -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) or the ambient
temperature sensor sense circuit is open, the temp display will be -45 degrees C (-49 degrees F) to
indicate an OPEN circuit condition.
If there is an OPEN or SHORT circuit condition, it must be repaired before the Compass/Temp
Mirror VF display can be tested.
The ambient temperature sensor can be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test. If there are no
codes stored in the PCM (2.0L vehicles) and the ambient temperature sensor and the circuits are
confirmed to be OK, but the temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, replace the
Compass/Temp Mirror.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition OFF. 2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 3. Disconnect the
ambient temperature sensor harness connector. 4. Measure the resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor using the following values:
0 degrees C (32 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 29.33 - 35.99 Kilohms 10 degrees C (50 degrees
F) Sensor Resistance = 17.99 - 21.81 Kilohms 20 degrees C (68 degrees F) Sensor Resistance =
11.37 - 13.61 Kilohms 25 degrees C (77 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 9.12 - 10.86 Kilohms 30
degrees C (86 degrees F) Sensor Resistance = 7.37 - 8.75 Kilohms 40 degrees C (104 degrees F)
Sensor Resistance = 4.90 - 5.75 Kilohms
The sensor resistance should read between these min/max values. If the resistance value is OK,
refer to the Wiring Diagrams to test the Signal and
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Outside Temperature Display >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7479
Ground circuits. If the resistance values are not OK, replace the Sensor.
Refer to Body Control System. See: Body and Frame/Body Control Systems/Body Control Module
Refer to The Programmable Communication Interface Multiplex System (PCI Bus). See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Information Bus
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7483
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Application and ID
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Seat Belt Indicator ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations
Door Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7491
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7492
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7493
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7494
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7495
Fig. 44 Body (Right Rear) - RHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7496
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7497
Door Switch: Diagrams
Driver Door Ajar Switch
Hood Ajar Switch (Export)
Left Rear Door Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 7501
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel pump module. The
sending unit consists of a float, an arm, and a variable resistor (track). The resistor track is used to
send electrical signals to the instrument cluster for fuel gauge operation and are then transmitted to
the engine controller for OBDII emission requirements.
For Fuel Gauge Operation: As fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This increases the
sending unit resistance, causing the fuel gauge to read full. As fuel level decreases, the float and
arm move down. This decreases the sending unit resistance causing the fuel gauge to read empty.
After this fuel level signal is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster will transmit the
data across the J1850 bus circuits to the PCM.
For OBD II Emission Requirements: The voltage signal is sent to the instrument cluster to indicate
fuel level. The cluster transmits the fuel level to the PCM where it is used to prevent a false setting
of misfire and fuel system monitor trouble codes. This occurs if the fuel level in the tank is less than
approximately 15 percent of its rated capacity.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 7502
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL LEVEL SENDING UNIT/SENSOR
REMOVAL
Remove fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Fig.4 Fuel Pump/Level Sensor Electrical Connector
1. Depress retaining tab and remove the fuel pump/level sensor connector from the bottom of the
fuel pump module electrical connector (Fig. 4).
Fig.5 Wire Terminal Locking Wedge
2. Pull off blue locking wedge (Fig. 5).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 7503
Fig.6 Removing Wires From Connector
3. Using a small screwdriver lift locking finger away from terminal and push terminal out of
connector (Fig. 6). 4. Push level sensor signal and ground terminals out of the connector (Fig. 6).
Fig.7 Level Sensor
5. Slide level sensor wires through opening fuel pump module (Fig. 7). 6. Slide level sensor out of
installation channel in module.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert level sensor wires into bottom of opening in module. 2. Wrap wires into groove in back of
level sensor. 3. While feeding wires into guide grooves, slide level sensor up into channel until it
snaps into place (Fig. 7). Ensure tab at bottom of sensor locks in
place.
4. Install level sensor wires in connector. Push the wires up through the connector and then pull
them down until they lock in place. Ensure signal and
ground wires are installed in the correct position.
5. Install locking wedge on connector. 6. Push connector up into bottom of fuel pump module
electrical connector. 7. Install fuel pump module. Refer to Fuel Pump Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7507
Fig. 27 Center Console - LHD
Fig. 55 Center Console - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams
Shift Indicator: Diagrams
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)(Autostick)
Trans Range Indicator Illumination (PRNDL)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Traction Control Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Application and ID
Traction Control Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Trac OFF Indicator ..............................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Application and ID
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Console Gear Selector w/ Auto ...........................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC 194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Shift Bezel (PRNDL) Lamp ..................................................................................................................
................................................................. T37
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID > Page 7520
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove floor console. 3. Remove wiring
and socket from shift bezel (PRNDL). 4. Remove bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb in socket and snap into place. 2. Install floor console. 3. Connect the battery negative
cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7526
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7527
Backup Lamp Switch (1.6/2.0L MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7528
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Lift vehicle on hoist.
Fig.1 Back-Up Lamp Switch
2. From bottom side of vehicle, disconnect back-up lamp switch connector. 3. Unscrew switch from
transaxle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install back-up lamp switch. Teflon tape or equivalent must be used on switch threads. Tighten
switch to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
CAUTION: Do not overtighten switch.
2. Connect back-up lamp switch connector. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Verify back-up lamp operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Brake Lamp: Connector Views
Left Tail/Stop Lamp (Export)
Left Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp (Except Export)
Right Tail/Stop Lamp (Export)
Right Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7533
Brake Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than the bulb listed in the table below. Damage to lamp can
result. Do not touch halogen bulbs with fingers or other oily surfaces. Bulb life will be reduced.
Bulb Application
Rear Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp
.........................................................................................................................................................
3157 - P27/7W
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Brake Light Switch: Component Locations
Fig.2 Brake Lamp Switch
The brake lamp switch is located under the instrument panel, at the brake pedal arm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 7538
Brake Light Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 7539
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 7540
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7541
Brake Lamp Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7542
Brake Light Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If the switch
is not adjusted properly or has been removed for some service, a new switch must be installed and
adjusted.
- Never move the adjustment lever of the new brake lamp switch without it being properly installed
in the vehicle first. Such action will render the switch unusable and the switch must be discarded.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7543
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
Fig.2 Brake Lamp Switch
The brake lamp switch is located under the instrument panel, at the brake pedal arm. It has three
internal switches controlling various functions of the vehicle. It's main function is to control
operation of the vehicle's brake lamps. Other functions include speed control deactivation, brake
sense for the antilock brake system and brake sense for the brake transmission shift interlock.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If
the switch is not adjusted properly or has been removed for some service, a new switch must be
installed and adjusted.
When the brake pedal is pressed, the plunger on the outside of the brake lamp switch extends
outward. This action opens or closes the contacts of the three switches inside the brake lamp
switch.
With the brake pedal pressed down (plunger extended), the switch for terminals 1 and 2 is closed
completing the circuit. The switch for terminals 3 and 4 is open and so is the switch for terminals 5
and 6.
When the brake pedal is released (plunger pushed in), the three switches assume the opposite
positions. The switch for terminals 1 and 2 is now open while the other two switches are now
closed, completing their circuits.
A lever on the back of the switch is used to set the switch into the "adjusted" position. A
non-adjusted switch will have the lever set to the diagonal position in relation to the switch housing.
The plunger can be moved in and out, but the states of the internal switches will not change.
CAUTION: Never move the adjustment lever of the new brake lamp switch without it being properly
installed in the vehicle first. Such action will render the switch unusable and the switch must be
discarded.
Fig.5 Adjustment Lever Movement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7544
Once installed in the vehicle as described in the brake lamp switch installation procedure, the new
switch's adjustment lever is rotated to the adjusted position as indicated. This action locks the
plunger to the internal switches. Once in this position the switch is permanently adjusted (or locked)
and cannot be readjusted or released even if the lever is moved back.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7545
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH DIAGNOSIS
NOTE: Before proceeding with this diagnostic test, verify the adjustment lever on the back of the
switch is in the adjusted position. If the lever is in the non-adjusted (diagonal) position, it may have
never been adjusted.
If the electrical circuit has been tested and the brake lamp switch is suspected of being faulty, it can
be tested using the following method.
1. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
Fig.3 Switch Test - Released Position
2. With the switch in the released position (plunger extended), use an ohmmeter to test each of the
three internal switches as shown. You should
achieve the results as listed in the figure.
3. Gently push the plunger on the brake lamp switch in until it stops.
Fig.4 Switch Test - Depressed Position
4. With the switch in this depressed position (plunger pushed in), use an ohmmeter to test each of
the three internal switches as shown. You should
achieve the results as listed in the figure.
If you do not achieve the results as listed in both figures, the switch is faulty and must be replaced.
If the switch is found to be operating properly, it may be misadjusted. Do not reinstall the switch,
replace it.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If
the switch is not adjusted properly or has been removed for any reason, a new switch must be
installed and adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7546
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from its post on the battery. 2. Under the
instrument panel, remove the brake lamp switch by rotating the switch in a counterclockwise
direction approximately 30 degrees and
pulling it out of the bracket.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness from the connector on the switch. 4. Discard the brake lamp
switch. It must not be reused.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not reuse the original brake lamp switch. This switch can only be adjusted once.
That is during initial installation of the switch. If the switch is not adjusted properly or has been
removed for some service, a new switch must be installed and adjusted.
1. Obtain NEW brake lamp switch. The adjustment lever on the new switch should be at a 45°
angle from the wiring connector. If the adjustment
lever is parallel with the wiring connector, the switch has been preset and must be scrapped. DO
NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET (OR READJUST) THE BRAKE LAMP SWITCH.
2. Connect the wiring harness to the connector on the switch. 3. Mount and adjust the NEW brake
lamp switch using the following steps:
a. Install the switch in its bracket by aligning the index tab on the switch with the notch in the
mounting bracket. b. When the switch body is fully seated in its bracket, rotate the switch clockwise
approximately 30° to lock the switch into place.
Fig.5 Adjustment Lever Movement
c. With the brake pedal in the fully released position, move the adjustment lever on the brake lamp
switch from the 45° angled non-adjusted
position, clockwise as shown, until it is parallel with the wiring connector. The brake lamp switch is
now properly adjusted to the vehicle.
4. Reconnect the battery negative terminal. 5. Check the stop lamps to verify they are operating
properly and not staying on when the pedal is in the released position. 6. Road test the vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the brakes (including ABS if equipped) and speed control (if equipped).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Cargo Lamp
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7550
Cargo Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Rear Cargo ..........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. T906
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7554
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than the bulb listed in the table below. Damage to lamp can
result. Do not touch halogen bulbs with fingers or other oily surfaces. Bulb life will be reduced.
Bulb Application
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
....................................................................................................................................................
W16W
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) Replacement
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove bulb socket from center high
mounted stop lamp. 3. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bulb into socket. 2. Install bulb socket into center high mounted stop lamp. 3. Connect
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL) Replacement > Page 7557
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair Center High Mounted Stop Lamp Unit (CHMSL)
Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove socket and bulb from lamp. 3.
Remove nuts attaching center high mounted stop lamp to deck lid. 4. Remove CHMSL from deck
lid.
INSTALLATION
1. Place CHMSL into position on deck lid. 2. Install nuts attaching CHMSL to deck lid. 3. Install
socket and bulb into lamp. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Glove Box Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable 2. Open glove box door. 3. Pull downward on
lamp/switch assembly to disengage tabs from instrument panel. 4. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Place lamp/switch assembly into position. 3. Push lamp/switch
assembly to lock tabs. 4. Check lamp operation, and close glove door. 5. Connect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable 2. Open glove box door. 3. Pull downward on
lamp/switch assembly to disengage tabs from instrument panel. 4. Pull bulb from socket. 5.
Disconnect wire connector from lamp and remove glove box lamp/switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Place lamp/switch assembly into position. 3. Connect wire connector to
the lamp/switch. 4. Push lamp/switch assembly to lock tabs. 5. Check lamp operation, and close
glove box door. 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Daytime Running Lamp: Description and Operation
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
The Headlamps are controlled by the Instrument Cluster.
The Instrument Cluster is also referred to as a "Smart Cluster". It receives and sends messages to
other modules through the PCI BUS circuit. The Headlamps are wired through the cluster and then
go to the Fuse Block to the lamps. Each Headlamp has an independent fuse located in the Fuse
Block.
For vehicles equipped with Daytime Running Lamps, the DRL Module is integrated with the
Instrument Cluster.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Dome Lamp: Diagrams
Dome Lamp (Except Export)
Dome Lamp/Intrusion Sensor (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7571
Dome Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Dome Lamp .........................................................................................................................................
................................................................. T579
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7572
Dome Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Lamp 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Insert a trim stick between the dome
lamp bezel and dome lamp lens. 3. Carefully pull down on lamp lens to remove lamp from
headliner. 4. Disconnect wire connector. 5. Remove lamp.
Bulb 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Insert a trim stick between the dome
lamp bezel and dome lamp lens. 3. Carefully swing down one side of the lamp lens. 4. Remove
bulb from lamp socket.
INSTALLATION
Lamp 1. Place lamp into position. 2. Connect wire connector. 3. Install dome lamp and lens. 4.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Bulb 1. Push bulb in socket and snap into place. 2. Position lens on lamp and snap into place. 3.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations
Door Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7576
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7577
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7578
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7579
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7580
Fig. 44 Body (Right Rear) - RHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7581
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7582
Door Switch: Diagrams
Driver Door Ajar Switch
Hood Ajar Switch (Export)
Left Rear Door Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Indicator > Component
Information > Application and ID
Fog/Driving Lamp Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Front Fog Lamp Indicator ....................................................................................................................
.................................................................. LED
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Locations
Fig. 6 Front Fog Lamps - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7590
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Diagrams
Left Front Fog Lamp
Right Front Fog Lamp (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7591
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation
REAR FOG LAMP SWITCH (EXPORT)
The Rear Fog Lamp Switch is located on the left stalk of the multi-function switch assembly. The
rear fog lamp switch is the primary controller of the rear fog lamps.
With the end of the left stalk pulled out, rotate it past the headlamp position to complete the rear fog
lamp switch circuit. This illuminates the rear fog lamp or lamps. Headlamps must be ON in order for
the rear fog lamp/s to function. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for a complete system schematic.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7592
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REAR FOG LAMP SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Refer to MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Flasher: Locations
Fig.6 Combination Flasher Location
The flasher is mounted to the back side of the multi-function switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7597
Hazard Warning Flasher: Description and Operation
COMBINATION FLASHER
The turn signal flasher and the hazard warning flasher are combined into one unit called a
Combination Flasher (combo-flasher). The combo-flasher is a smart relay located on the back of
the multi-function switch. The combo-flasher is black in color and has a dampener material
wrapped on it. Constant battery voltage is supplied to the flasher so that it can perform the hazard
warning function, and ignition switched battery voltage is supplied for the turn signal function.
However, when the flasher is idle no current is drawn through the module. The unit does not
become active until it is provided a signal ground from the turn signal switch or hazard warning
switch.
The combo-flasher controls the flashing of the hazard warning system and the turn signal system.
An inoperative bulb or incomplete turn signal circuit will cause the flasher rate to double. Typical
flash rate is about ninety flashes per minute. When a bulb is burnt out, or when a circuit for a lamp
is open, the turn signal flash rate will increase to a minimum of 180 flashes per minute. However,
an open lamp circuit or burnt out bulb does not change the hazard warning flash rate.
Turn signal inputs that actuate the combination flasher are low current grounds, each drawing a
maximum of 300 milliamperes. The turn signal inputs are provided to the flasher through the
multifunction switch on the steering column. The hazard warning signal input is a low current
ground drawing a maximum of 600 milliamperes. The hazard warning input can be provided
through the multifunction switch on the steering column.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7598
Hazard Warning Flasher: Service and Repair
COMBINATION FLASHER
REMOVAL
Fig.6 Combination Flasher Location
The flasher is mounted to the back side of the multi-function switch.
1. To gain access, the upper steering column shroud must be removed. 2. The flasher can be
removed by pulling it toward the instrument cluster (forward).
NOTE: The flasher is serviced separately from the multifunction switch.
INSTALLATION
The flasher is serviced separately from the multifunction switch.
1. The flasher can be installed by pushing it toward the back of the steering wheel. 2. Install the
upper steering column shroud.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7602
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7603
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Multi-Function Switch
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel. The visible parts of the multi-function switch are the turn
signal control stalk that extends through a dedicated opening in the left side of the upper steering
column shrouds, the windshield wiper/washer, exterior lighting control stalk that extends through a
dedicated opening in the right upper steering column shrouds, the hazard warning switch push
button that protrudes through an opening in the upper steering column shroud on the top of the
steering column. The remainder of the switch, its mounting provisions, and its electrical
connections are all concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied
to it, which identify its many functions. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for
"Hazard Warning" is applied to the top of the hazard warning switch push button.
The switch housing and its controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A connector receptacle
with up to twenty terminals is located on the back of the switch housing and connects the switch to
the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
The multi-function switch supports the following functions and features: Continuous Wipe Modes - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides two continuous
wipe switch positions, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Wipe Mode - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides an intermittent
wipe mode with multiple delay interval positions.
- Washer Mode - A button on the end of the control stalk of the multi-function switch provides
washer system operation when the button is depressed towards the steering column.
- Hazard Warning Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
detent switching for activation and deactivation of the hazard warning system.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
for activation and deactivation of exterior lighting.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch
provide detent switching for selection of the headlamp high or low beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch includes
momentary switching of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature
(sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the
headlamp high beams as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide both
momentary non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left
and right turn signals.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is faulty, or if
the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Alignment Control Module > Component
Information > Diagrams
Headlamp Alignment Control Module: Diagrams
Left Lavelier Module (Export)
Right Lavalier Module (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Motor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Headlamp Motor: Description and Operation
HEADLAMP LEVELING MOTOR - EXPORT
Two leveling motors are used per vehicle, one for each headlamp. These leveling motors are
attached to the rear of the headlamp mounting brackets. They can be described as a small
semi-square shaped module with a electrical connector attached to one side. Due to vehicle design
these motors can only be serviced or accessed from the under side of the vehicle.
The headlamp leveling motors move the headlamp and beam pattern according to the signal
received from the headlamp leveling switch. With the vehicles headlamps "ON," a signal voltage is
sent from the headlamp leveling switch and received at each of the headlamp leveling motors. This
signal voltage (typically 2-9 volts) tells the headlamp leveling motors were to position the
headlamps.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Motor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 7611
Headlamp Leveling Motor Diagnosis
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Motor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 7612
Headlamp Motor: Service and Repair
Headlamp Leveling Motor Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the appropriate headlamp unit.
Fig.12 Headlamp Leveling Motor
3. Disconnect the headlamp leveling motor electrical connector. Depress the steel retaining clip
while pulling the connector from the motor. 4. Rotate the headlamp leveling motor and pull it
straight out of the headlamp module.
NOTE: Significant force will be required to unsnap the ball and socket connection between the
headlamp leveling motor and the headlamp unit.
5. Separate the ball and socket from the motor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the headlamp leveling motor in the headlamp unit. Push the headlamp leveling motor
pushrod straight into its mating socket while holding
the headlamp unit in the fully retracted position.
2. Once the ball and socket connection is secured, push and rotate the headlamp leveling motor
into the headlamp unit to lock in place. 3. Connect the headlamp leveling motor electrical
connector. 4. Install the headlamp unit. 5. Connect the battery negative cable. 6. Verify system
operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Headlamp Switch: Component Locations
Fig.12 Headlamp Leveling Switch Location
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH
The Headlamp Leveling Switch is located on the center instrument panel area in the accessory
switch bezel and is the primary controller of the headlamp leveling system.
HEADLAMP SWITCH
The headlamp switch is integral to the left stalk of the multi-function switch located on the steering
column behind the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 7617
Headlamp Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 12 Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 7618
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7619
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Headlamp Leveling Switch Location
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH - EXPORT
The Headlamp Leveling Switch is located on the center instrument panel area in the accessory
switch bezel, and is the primary controller of the headlamp leveling system The leveling switch has
four settings 0-3, 0 being the lowest, and 3 being the highest headlamp beam vertical setting
With the rotation of the headlamp leveling switch control knob, voltage is adjusted at the headlamp
leveling switch (rheostat) This signals the headlamp leveling motors (headlamp module mounted)
to adjust the vertical headlamp beam pattern accordingly Headlamps must be "ON" in order for the
leveling system to function
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7620
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH - EXPORT
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable 2. Remove the headlamp leveling switch.
Headlamp Leveling Switch Resistance
3. Using an ohmmeter and the HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH RESISTANCE table, check the
resistance between switch connector pins 1&2. 4. If the test results are not as indicated in the table
below, replace the switch If test results are as indicated below, the switch is OK.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7621
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Leveling Switch Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Rotate the A/C outlet registers to the full down position Grip each outlet at its outboard end and
gently over-rotate to release from its pivot point
Swing outlet straight out and remove by hand
2. Remove the (4) HVAC control knobs by pulling straight off the switch shaft 3. Remove the (2)
screws from the center instrument bezel 4. Remove the center instrument bezel Pull it straight out
to unsnap the (4) retaining clips 5. Remove the (2) screws from the accessory switch bank 6. Pull
the accessory switch bank out and disconnect the electrical connector from the headlamp leveling
switch.
Fig.14 Leveling Switch Removal
7. Gently pry the headlamp leveling switch out of its mounting clips.
INSTALLATION
1. Snap the headlamp leveling switch into the accessory switch bank. 2. Install the headlamp
leveling switch electrical connector. 3. Verify switch operation. 4. Position the accessory switch
bank and install the (4) retaining screws. 5. Snap the center instrument bezel in position and install
the retaining screws. 6. Install the (4) HVAC control knobs. 7. Install the A/C outlet registers on the
center instrument bezel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID
Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
High Beam Lamp Indicator ..................................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7629
Horn Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7630
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). 2. Using ohmmeter, test for continuity
between ground and circuit 65 of horn relay.
a. When the horn switch is not depressed, no continuity should be present. b. Continuity to ground
when horn switch is depressed. c. If continuity is not correct repair horn switch or wiring as
necessary.
3. Insert a jumper wire between circuit 63 and 66 of the Power Distribution Center.
a. If horn sounds replace relay b. If the horn does not sound, install horn relay and (Refer to
HORN/HORN - DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING).
4. Using voltmeter, test voltage at:
a. Circuit 62 and 66 test for battery voltage from fuse C to body ground. b. If voltage is incorrect
repair as necessary.
Fig. 2 Horn Relay
5. Click relay for 70 to 75 ohms resistance from terminal 85 to 86. If resistance not OK, replace
relay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7631
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the Power Distribution Center
cover and locate the horn relay. 3. Remove the horn relay.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the horn relay into the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 2. Install the PDC cover 3.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations
Horn Switch: Locations
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7635
Horn Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7636
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module.
When the Driver Airbag is pressed, the horn switch makes contact to ground. The ground signal is
carried to the horn relay and the horn sounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7637
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Remove horn relay from the Power Distribution Center. 2. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to
ground and the other lead to cavity 65 of the power distribution center. 3. Depress horn switch,
should have continuity. If no continuity go to Step 4. 4. Test continuity at horn switch, remove the
Driver Airbag Module. (Refer to RESTRAINTS/DRIVER AIRBAG - REMOVAL). 5. Using
ohmmeter, connect one lead to the airbag module ground and the other lead to B+ wire. 6.
Depress horn switch, and the meter should show continuity If no continuity, replace the Driver
Airbag Module. If OK, repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7638
Horn Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the Driver Airbag Module. (Refer
to RESTRAINTS/DRIVER AIRBAG - REMOVAL). 3. Clip off strap tie holding the horn switch wire
to the airbag module. 4. Unclip horn switch wire connector from airbag module. 5. Remove four torx
screws from top side of airbag module. 6. Fold airbag module cover down to expose the horn
switch. 7. Lift the horn switch off indexing tabs and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Install horn switch to the indexing tabs on the airbag module. 2. Install screws to the top of
airbag module. 3. Reconnect horn switch connector to airbag module. 4. Install the airbag module.
5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector
Views
License Plate Lamp: Connector Views
Left License Lamp (Export)
License Lamp (Except Export)
Right License Lamp (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7643
License Plate Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than the bulb listed in the table below. Damage to lamp can
result. Do not touch halogen bulbs with fingers or other oily surfaces. Bulb life will be reduced.
Bulb Application
License Plate Lamp .............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 168
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair >
License Plate Lamp Replacement
License Plate Lamp: Service and Repair License Plate Lamp Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.17 License Plate Lamp
2. Remove screws attaching license plate lamp to rear bumper fascia. 3. Remove lamp from
bumper fascia. 4. Remove bulb socket from lamp. 5. Pull bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bulb into socket. 2. Install bulb socket into lamp. 3. Place lamp in position. 4. Install
screws attaching license plate lamp to rear bumper fascia. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair >
License Plate Lamp Replacement > Page 7646
License Plate Lamp: Service and Repair License Plate Lamp Unit Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.17 License Plate Lamp
2. Remove screws attaching license plate lamp to rear bumper fascia. 3. Remove lamp from rear
bumper fascia. 4. Remove bulb socket from lamp. 5. Remove lamp.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bulb socket into lamp. 2. Place lamp in position. 3. Install screws attaching license plate
lamp to rear bumper fascia. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Diagrams
Map Light: Diagrams
Center Stack Lamp (Light Package/Export)
Map/Reading Lamps
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Map Light > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7650
Map Light: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a small thin blade tool, pry at the
center of the lens nearest the mirror to remove lens. 3. Remove cartridge lamp.
INSTALLATION
1. Install lens by setting lens into position and applying pressure until it is locked into position. 2.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
Marker Lamp: Diagrams
Left Front Side Marker Lamp (Except Export)
Right Front Side Marker Lamp (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7654
Marker Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than the bulb listed in the table below. Damage to lamp can
result. Do not touch halogen bulbs with fingers or other oily surfaces. Bulb life will be reduced.
Bulb Application
Front Side Marker Lamp ......................................................................................................................
................................................................... 168
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Marker
Lamp Replacement
Marker Lamp: Service and Repair Marker Lamp Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.7 Fog Lamp/Fog Lamp Unit - Remove/Install
Fig.8 Fog Lamp - Canada/Export/RHD
2. Reach behind front bumper fascia forward of front wheel and remove attaching clip from the front
side marker lamp. 3. Remove lamp from front fascia. 4. Remove bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bulb into socket. 2. Install bulb socket into lamp unit 3. Install lamp unit into front fascia. 4.
Install attaching clip to the front side market lamp unit. 5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Marker
Lamp Replacement > Page 7657
Marker Lamp: Service and Repair Marker Lamp Unit Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Fig.7 Fog Lamp/Fog Lamp Unit - Remove/Install
Fig.8 Fog Lamp - Canada/Export/RHD
2. Reach behind front bumper fascia forward of front wheel and remove attaching clip from the front
side marker lamp. 3. Remove lamp. 4. Remove bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install bulb socket into lamp. 2. Place lamp into front fascia. 3. Install attaching clip to the front
side marker lamp. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Parking Lamp: Connector Views
Left Park/Turn Signal Lamp (Except Export)
Right Park/Turn Signal Lamp (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7662
Parking Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than the bulb listed in the table below. Damage to lamp can
result. Do not touch halogen bulbs with fingers or other oily surfaces. Bulb life will be reduced.
Bulb Application
Front Park/Turn Signal Lamp ..............................................................................................................
......................................................... 4157NAK
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7663
Parking Lamp: Description and Operation
FRONT POSITION LAMPS - EXPORT
Some vehicles are equipped with front position lamps. One front position lamp is incorporated into
each of the headlamps. These lamps utilize a clear lens and clear bulb and function in the same
way that Parking Lamps do on other market built vehicles (U.S., Canada). The front position lamp
is built in to the headlamp and therefore doesn't require its own lamp housing.
The front position lamps are turned on or off with the multi-function switch. These lamps function in
the same way that the parking lamps do on other market built vehicles.(U.S., Canada). Refer to
Wiring Diagrams for a complete schematic.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7664
Parking Lamp: Testing and Inspection
Front Position Lamps Test
The following test is designed to diagnosis a faulty front position lamp.
NOTE: Battery must be completely charged (12 volt) prior to testing. It may also be necessary to
install battery charger on the vehicles electrical system when performing this test. Refer to the
Battery for detailed information.
1. Remove the front position lamp bulb and check for burned out condition, replace bulb if
necessary. 2. If bulb appears OK, reinstall the bulb in its socket and rotate the left side
multi-function switch one detent position and check for lamp operation.
If lamp is still inoperative proceed to step # 3.
3. Remove lamp bulb and check for proper power (12 volt) and ground connections in lamp socket.
If power and I or ground connections are not
present, trace wire until open or short is found.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7665
Parking Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the 2 screws holding the headlamp bezel in place and remove the bezel. 2. Remove the
4 screws holding the headlamp and remove the headlamp. 3. Pull the front position lamp straight
from headlamp. 4. Remove the front position lamp bulb from its socket by rotating
counter-clockwise.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the front position lamp bulb into its socket by rotating clockwise. 2. Push the front position
lamp straight into the headlamp. 3. Install the headlamp and the 4 screws holding the headlamp. 4.
Install the headlamp bezel and the 2 screws holding the headlamp bezel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Alignment Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams
Headlamp Alignment Control Module: Diagrams
Left Lavelier Module (Export)
Right Lavalier Module (Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7673
Horn Relay
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7674
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove horn relay from Power Distribution Center (PDC). 2. Using ohmmeter, test for continuity
between ground and circuit 65 of horn relay.
a. When the horn switch is not depressed, no continuity should be present. b. Continuity to ground
when horn switch is depressed. c. If continuity is not correct repair horn switch or wiring as
necessary.
3. Insert a jumper wire between circuit 63 and 66 of the Power Distribution Center.
a. If horn sounds replace relay b. If the horn does not sound, install horn relay and (Refer to
HORN/HORN - DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING).
4. Using voltmeter, test voltage at:
a. Circuit 62 and 66 test for battery voltage from fuse C to body ground. b. If voltage is incorrect
repair as necessary.
Fig. 2 Horn Relay
5. Click relay for 70 to 75 ohms resistance from terminal 85 to 86. If resistance not OK, replace
relay.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7675
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the Power Distribution Center
cover and locate the horn relay. 3. Remove the horn relay.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the horn relay into the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 2. Install the PDC cover 3.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7680
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7681
Backup Lamp Switch (1.6/2.0L MTX)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7682
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Lift vehicle on hoist.
Fig.1 Back-Up Lamp Switch
2. From bottom side of vehicle, disconnect back-up lamp switch connector. 3. Unscrew switch from
transaxle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install back-up lamp switch. Teflon tape or equivalent must be used on switch threads. Tighten
switch to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
CAUTION: Do not overtighten switch.
2. Connect back-up lamp switch connector. 3. Lower vehicle. 4. Verify back-up lamp operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Light Switch: Component Locations
Fig.2 Brake Lamp Switch
The brake lamp switch is located under the instrument panel, at the brake pedal arm.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7687
Brake Light Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 3 Engine Compartment (Left Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7688
Fig. 39 Engine Compartment (Left Front) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7689
Fig. 49 Dash Panel/Plenum - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7690
Brake Lamp Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7691
Brake Light Switch: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If the switch
is not adjusted properly or has been removed for some service, a new switch must be installed and
adjusted.
- Never move the adjustment lever of the new brake lamp switch without it being properly installed
in the vehicle first. Such action will render the switch unusable and the switch must be discarded.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7692
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
Fig.2 Brake Lamp Switch
The brake lamp switch is located under the instrument panel, at the brake pedal arm. It has three
internal switches controlling various functions of the vehicle. It's main function is to control
operation of the vehicle's brake lamps. Other functions include speed control deactivation, brake
sense for the antilock brake system and brake sense for the brake transmission shift interlock.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If
the switch is not adjusted properly or has been removed for some service, a new switch must be
installed and adjusted.
When the brake pedal is pressed, the plunger on the outside of the brake lamp switch extends
outward. This action opens or closes the contacts of the three switches inside the brake lamp
switch.
With the brake pedal pressed down (plunger extended), the switch for terminals 1 and 2 is closed
completing the circuit. The switch for terminals 3 and 4 is open and so is the switch for terminals 5
and 6.
When the brake pedal is released (plunger pushed in), the three switches assume the opposite
positions. The switch for terminals 1 and 2 is now open while the other two switches are now
closed, completing their circuits.
A lever on the back of the switch is used to set the switch into the "adjusted" position. A
non-adjusted switch will have the lever set to the diagonal position in relation to the switch housing.
The plunger can be moved in and out, but the states of the internal switches will not change.
CAUTION: Never move the adjustment lever of the new brake lamp switch without it being properly
installed in the vehicle first. Such action will render the switch unusable and the switch must be
discarded.
Fig.5 Adjustment Lever Movement
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7693
Once installed in the vehicle as described in the brake lamp switch installation procedure, the new
switch's adjustment lever is rotated to the adjusted position as indicated. This action locks the
plunger to the internal switches. Once in this position the switch is permanently adjusted (or locked)
and cannot be readjusted or released even if the lever is moved back.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7694
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH DIAGNOSIS
NOTE: Before proceeding with this diagnostic test, verify the adjustment lever on the back of the
switch is in the adjusted position. If the lever is in the non-adjusted (diagonal) position, it may have
never been adjusted.
If the electrical circuit has been tested and the brake lamp switch is suspected of being faulty, it can
be tested using the following method.
1. Remove the switch from the vehicle.
Fig.3 Switch Test - Released Position
2. With the switch in the released position (plunger extended), use an ohmmeter to test each of the
three internal switches as shown. You should
achieve the results as listed in the figure.
3. Gently push the plunger on the brake lamp switch in until it stops.
Fig.4 Switch Test - Depressed Position
4. With the switch in this depressed position (plunger pushed in), use an ohmmeter to test each of
the three internal switches as shown. You should
achieve the results as listed in the figure.
If you do not achieve the results as listed in both figures, the switch is faulty and must be replaced.
If the switch is found to be operating properly, it may be misadjusted. Do not reinstall the switch,
replace it.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted once. That is during initial installation of the switch. If
the switch is not adjusted properly or has been removed for any reason, a new switch must be
installed and adjusted.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7695
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable from its post on the battery. 2. Under the
instrument panel, remove the brake lamp switch by rotating the switch in a counterclockwise
direction approximately 30 degrees and
pulling it out of the bracket.
3. Disconnect the wiring harness from the connector on the switch. 4. Discard the brake lamp
switch. It must not be reused.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not reuse the original brake lamp switch. This switch can only be adjusted once.
That is during initial installation of the switch. If the switch is not adjusted properly or has been
removed for some service, a new switch must be installed and adjusted.
1. Obtain NEW brake lamp switch. The adjustment lever on the new switch should be at a 45°
angle from the wiring connector. If the adjustment
lever is parallel with the wiring connector, the switch has been preset and must be scrapped. DO
NOT ATTEMPT TO RESET (OR READJUST) THE BRAKE LAMP SWITCH.
2. Connect the wiring harness to the connector on the switch. 3. Mount and adjust the NEW brake
lamp switch using the following steps:
a. Install the switch in its bracket by aligning the index tab on the switch with the notch in the
mounting bracket. b. When the switch body is fully seated in its bracket, rotate the switch clockwise
approximately 30° to lock the switch into place.
Fig.5 Adjustment Lever Movement
c. With the brake pedal in the fully released position, move the adjustment lever on the brake lamp
switch from the 45° angled non-adjusted
position, clockwise as shown, until it is parallel with the wiring connector. The brake lamp switch is
now properly adjusted to the vehicle.
4. Reconnect the battery negative terminal. 5. Check the stop lamps to verify they are operating
properly and not staying on when the pedal is in the released position. 6. Road test the vehicle to
ensure proper operation of the brakes (including ABS if equipped) and speed control (if equipped).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Combination Switch: Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7699
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7700
Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7701
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
Turn Signal And Hazard Warning Flasher Diagnosis
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7702
Turn Signal And Hazard Warning Flasher Diagnosis
FLASHER DIAGNOSIS
Should any function of the multi-function switch fail, the entire switch assembly must be replaced.
SWITCH DIAGNOSIS
To test the switch:
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the upper and lower steering
column shrouds. 3. Disconnect the switch connector.
Fig.19 Combination Flasher Connector (A)
Fig.20 Multi-Function Switch Connector (B)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7703
Fig.21 Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch Connector (C)
Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test Part 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7704
Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test Part 2
Multi-Function Switch Dimmer Control Resistance
Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch as
shown in the Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test table for diagnosis.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7705
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
REMOVAL
Fig.22 Disconnect And Isolate Battery Negative Cable
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering
column shrouds.
Fig.23 Multi-Function Switch Mounting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7706
Fig.24 Multi-Function Switch - Remove/Install
3. Disconnect both posi-lock harness connectors at the rear of the multi-function switch. 4. Remove
multi-function switch mounting screws. 5. The combination flasher must be transferred to new
multi-function switch if replacing. 6. The windshield wiper/washer switch must be transferred to the
new multi-function switch.
INSTALLATION
1. The windshield wiper/washer switch must be transferred to the new multi-function switch. 2. The
combination flasher must be transferred to new multi-function switch if replacing. 3. Install the
multi-function switch mounting screws. Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to
3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect both posi-lock harness connectors at the rear of the
multi-function switch. 5. Instal both upper and lower steering column shrouds. 6. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Door Switch: Locations
Fig. 1 Engine Compartment - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7710
Driver Door - LHD
Passenger Door - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7711
Fig. 23 Door (Rear) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7712
Fig. 25 Engine Compartment - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7713
Fig. 29 Engine Compartment (Right Side) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7714
Fig. 44 Body (Right Rear) - RHD
Fig. 45 Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7715
Door (Driver) - RHD
Fig. 47 Door (Rear) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7716
Door Switch: Diagrams
Driver Door Ajar Switch
Hood Ajar Switch (Export)
Left Rear Door Ajar Switch
Passenger Door Ajar Switch
Right Rear Door Ajar Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Fig. 6 Front Fog Lamps - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7720
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Diagrams
Left Front Fog Lamp
Right Front Fog Lamp (2.0L)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7721
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Description and Operation
REAR FOG LAMP SWITCH (EXPORT)
The Rear Fog Lamp Switch is located on the left stalk of the multi-function switch assembly. The
rear fog lamp switch is the primary controller of the rear fog lamps.
With the end of the left stalk pulled out, rotate it past the headlamp position to complete the rear fog
lamp switch circuit. This illuminates the rear fog lamp or lamps. Headlamps must be ON in order for
the rear fog lamp/s to function. Refer to Wiring Diagrams for a complete system schematic.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7722
Fog/Driving Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REAR FOG LAMP SWITCH (EXPORT)
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
Refer to MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable 2. Open glove box door. 3. Pull downward on
lamp/switch assembly to disengage tabs from instrument panel. 4. Pull bulb from socket. 5.
Disconnect wire connector from lamp and remove glove box lamp/switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Place lamp/switch assembly into position. 3. Connect wire connector to
the lamp/switch. 4. Push lamp/switch assembly to lock tabs. 5. Check lamp operation, and close
glove box door. 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7729
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7730
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Multi-Function Switch
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel. The visible parts of the multi-function switch are the turn
signal control stalk that extends through a dedicated opening in the left side of the upper steering
column shrouds, the windshield wiper/washer, exterior lighting control stalk that extends through a
dedicated opening in the right upper steering column shrouds, the hazard warning switch push
button that protrudes through an opening in the upper steering column shroud on the top of the
steering column. The remainder of the switch, its mounting provisions, and its electrical
connections are all concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied
to it, which identify its many functions. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for
"Hazard Warning" is applied to the top of the hazard warning switch push button.
The switch housing and its controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A connector receptacle
with up to twenty terminals is located on the back of the switch housing and connects the switch to
the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
The multi-function switch supports the following functions and features: Continuous Wipe Modes - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides two continuous
wipe switch positions, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Wipe Mode - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides an intermittent
wipe mode with multiple delay interval positions.
- Washer Mode - A button on the end of the control stalk of the multi-function switch provides
washer system operation when the button is depressed towards the steering column.
- Hazard Warning Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
detent switching for activation and deactivation of the hazard warning system.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
for activation and deactivation of exterior lighting.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch
provide detent switching for selection of the headlamp high or low beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch includes
momentary switching of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature
(sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the
headlamp high beams as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide both
momentary non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left
and right turn signals.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is faulty, or if
the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Headlamp Switch: Component Locations
Fig.12 Headlamp Leveling Switch Location
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH
The Headlamp Leveling Switch is located on the center instrument panel area in the accessory
switch bezel and is the primary controller of the headlamp leveling system.
HEADLAMP SWITCH
The headlamp switch is integral to the left stalk of the multi-function switch located on the steering
column behind the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7735
Headlamp Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 12 Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7736
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7737
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.13 Headlamp Leveling Switch Location
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH - EXPORT
The Headlamp Leveling Switch is located on the center instrument panel area in the accessory
switch bezel, and is the primary controller of the headlamp leveling system The leveling switch has
four settings 0-3, 0 being the lowest, and 3 being the highest headlamp beam vertical setting
With the rotation of the headlamp leveling switch control knob, voltage is adjusted at the headlamp
leveling switch (rheostat) This signals the headlamp leveling motors (headlamp module mounted)
to adjust the vertical headlamp beam pattern accordingly Headlamps must be "ON" in order for the
leveling system to function
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7738
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH - EXPORT
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable 2. Remove the headlamp leveling switch.
Headlamp Leveling Switch Resistance
3. Using an ohmmeter and the HEADLAMP LEVELING SWITCH RESISTANCE table, check the
resistance between switch connector pins 1&2. 4. If the test results are not as indicated in the table
below, replace the switch If test results are as indicated below, the switch is OK.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7739
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Leveling Switch Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Rotate the A/C outlet registers to the full down position Grip each outlet at its outboard end and
gently over-rotate to release from its pivot point
Swing outlet straight out and remove by hand
2. Remove the (4) HVAC control knobs by pulling straight off the switch shaft 3. Remove the (2)
screws from the center instrument bezel 4. Remove the center instrument bezel Pull it straight out
to unsnap the (4) retaining clips 5. Remove the (2) screws from the accessory switch bank 6. Pull
the accessory switch bank out and disconnect the electrical connector from the headlamp leveling
switch.
Fig.14 Leveling Switch Removal
7. Gently pry the headlamp leveling switch out of its mounting clips.
INSTALLATION
1. Snap the headlamp leveling switch into the accessory switch bank. 2. Install the headlamp
leveling switch electrical connector. 3. Verify switch operation. 4. Position the accessory switch
bank and install the (4) retaining screws. 5. Snap the center instrument bezel in position and install
the retaining screws. 6. Install the (4) HVAC control knobs. 7. Install the A/C outlet registers on the
center instrument bezel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Horn Switch: Locations
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7743
Horn Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7744
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
The horn switch is mounted between the outer and inner cover of the Driver Airbag Module.
When the Driver Airbag is pressed, the horn switch makes contact to ground. The ground signal is
carried to the horn relay and the horn sounds.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7745
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Remove horn relay from the Power Distribution Center. 2. Using ohmmeter, connect one lead to
ground and the other lead to cavity 65 of the power distribution center. 3. Depress horn switch,
should have continuity. If no continuity go to Step 4. 4. Test continuity at horn switch, remove the
Driver Airbag Module. (Refer to RESTRAINTS/DRIVER AIRBAG - REMOVAL). 5. Using
ohmmeter, connect one lead to the airbag module ground and the other lead to B+ wire. 6.
Depress horn switch, and the meter should show continuity If no continuity, replace the Driver
Airbag Module. If OK, repair as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7746
Horn Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the Driver Airbag Module. (Refer
to RESTRAINTS/DRIVER AIRBAG - REMOVAL). 3. Clip off strap tie holding the horn switch wire
to the airbag module. 4. Unclip horn switch wire connector from airbag module. 5. Remove four torx
screws from top side of airbag module. 6. Fold airbag module cover down to expose the horn
switch. 7. Lift the horn switch off indexing tabs and remove from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO ELECTRICAL,
RESTRAINTS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Install horn switch to the indexing tabs on the airbag module. 2. Install screws to the top of
airbag module. 3. Reconnect horn switch connector to airbag module. 4. Install the airbag module.
5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Component Locations
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7751
Turn Signal Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7752
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7753
Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7754
Turn Signal Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Multi-Function Switch
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel. The visible parts of the multi-function switch are the turn
signal control stalk that extends through a dedicated opening in the left side of the upper steering
column shrouds, the windshield wiper/washer, exterior lighting control stalk that extends through a
dedicated opening in the right upper steering column shrouds, the hazard warning switch push
button that protrudes through an opening in the upper steering column shroud on the top of the
steering column. The remainder of the switch, its mounting provisions, and its electrical
connections are all concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied
to it, which identify its many functions. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for
"Hazard Warning" is applied to the top of the hazard warning switch push button.
The switch housing and its controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A connector receptacle
with up to twenty terminals is located on the back of the switch housing and connects the switch to
the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
The multi-function switch supports the following functions and features: Continuous Wipe Modes - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides two continuous
wipe switch positions, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Wipe Mode - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides an intermittent
wipe mode with multiple delay interval positions.
- Washer Mode - A button on the end of the control stalk of the multi-function switch provides
washer system operation when the button is depressed towards the steering column.
- Hazard Warning Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
detent switching for activation and deactivation of the hazard warning system.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
for activation and deactivation of exterior lighting.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch
provide detent switching for selection of the headlamp high or low beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch includes
momentary switching of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature
(sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the
headlamp high beams as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide both
momentary non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left
and right turn signals.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is faulty, or if
the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Views
Tail Lamp: Connector Views
Left Tail/Stop Lamp (Export)
Left Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp (Except Export)
Right Tail/Stop Lamp (Export)
Right Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp (Except Export)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7759
Tail Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than the bulb listed in the table below. Damage to lamp can
result. Do not touch halogen bulbs with fingers or other oily surfaces. Bulb life will be reduced.
Bulb Application
Rear Tail/Stop/Turn Signal Lamp
.........................................................................................................................................................
3157 - P27/7W
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tail Lamp
Replacement
Tail Lamp: Service and Repair Tail Lamp Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Move trunk lining as necessary from rear
closure panel to gain access to back of tail lamp.
Fig.26 Tail And Stop Lamp Bulb
3. Remove bulb socket from tail lamp through openings in rear closure panel. 4. Pull bulb from
socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Push bulb into socket. 2. Install bulb socket into tail lamp through openings in rear closure panel.
3. Reposition trunk lining to rear closure panel. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tail Lamp
Replacement > Page 7762
Tail Lamp: Service and Repair Tail Lamp Unit Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Move trunk lining as necessary from rear
closure panel to gain access to back of tail lamp. 3. Remove nuts attaching tail lamp to the rear
closure panel. 4. Disconnect the wiring connectors and bulbs from unit by twisting bulb
counterclockwise. 5. Remove lamp housing from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place lamp housing into position. 2. Install the bulbs into bulb pockets and rotate clockwise. 3.
Install nuts attaching tail lamp to the rear closure panel. 4. Reposition trunk lining to rear closure
panel. 5. Connect the battery negative cable. 6. Verify vehicle and system operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk Lamp: Service and Repair
Trunk Lamp Unit Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Insert a trim stick or small flat blade
between the lamp lens and rear shelf reinforcement panel. 3. Pry the lamp lens downward. 4.
Disconnect wire connector. 5. Remove lamp from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place lamp into position. 2. Connect wire connector. 3. Install lamp lens. 4. Connect battery
negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Combination Switch: Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7770
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7771
Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7772
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
Turn Signal And Hazard Warning Flasher Diagnosis
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7773
Turn Signal And Hazard Warning Flasher Diagnosis
FLASHER DIAGNOSIS
Should any function of the multi-function switch fail, the entire switch assembly must be replaced.
SWITCH DIAGNOSIS
To test the switch:
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the upper and lower steering
column shrouds. 3. Disconnect the switch connector.
Fig.19 Combination Flasher Connector (A)
Fig.20 Multi-Function Switch Connector (B)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7774
Fig.21 Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch Connector (C)
Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test Part 1
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7775
Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test Part 2
Multi-Function Switch Dimmer Control Resistance
Using an ohmmeter, test for continuity (no resistance) between the terminals of the switch as
shown in the Multi-Function Switch Continuity Test table for diagnosis.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7776
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
REMOVAL
Fig.22 Disconnect And Isolate Battery Negative Cable
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove both upper and lower steering
column shrouds.
Fig.23 Multi-Function Switch Mounting
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7777
Fig.24 Multi-Function Switch - Remove/Install
3. Disconnect both posi-lock harness connectors at the rear of the multi-function switch. 4. Remove
multi-function switch mounting screws. 5. The combination flasher must be transferred to new
multi-function switch if replacing. 6. The windshield wiper/washer switch must be transferred to the
new multi-function switch.
INSTALLATION
1. The windshield wiper/washer switch must be transferred to the new multi-function switch. 2. The
combination flasher must be transferred to new multi-function switch if replacing. 3. Install the
multi-function switch mounting screws. Tighten multi-function switch to column retaining screws to
3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect both posi-lock harness connectors at the rear of the
multi-function switch. 5. Instal both upper and lower steering column shrouds. 6. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Locations
Turn Signal Flasher: Locations
Fig.6 Combination Flasher Location
The flasher is mounted to the back side of the multi-function switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7781
Turn Signal Flasher: Description and Operation
COMBINATION FLASHER
The turn signal flasher and the hazard warning flasher are combined into one unit called a
Combination Flasher (combo-flasher). The combo-flasher is a smart relay located on the back of
the multi-function switch. The combo-flasher is black in color and has a dampener material
wrapped on it. Constant battery voltage is supplied to the flasher so that it can perform the hazard
warning function, and ignition switched battery voltage is supplied for the turn signal function.
However, when the flasher is idle no current is drawn through the module. The unit does not
become active until it is provided a signal ground from the turn signal switch or hazard warning
switch.
The combo-flasher controls the flashing of the hazard warning system and the turn signal system.
An inoperative bulb or incomplete turn signal circuit will cause the flasher rate to double. Typical
flash rate is about ninety flashes per minute. When a bulb is burnt out, or when a circuit for a lamp
is open, the turn signal flash rate will increase to a minimum of 180 flashes per minute. However,
an open lamp circuit or burnt out bulb does not change the hazard warning flash rate.
Turn signal inputs that actuate the combination flasher are low current grounds, each drawing a
maximum of 300 milliamperes. The turn signal inputs are provided to the flasher through the
multifunction switch on the steering column. The hazard warning signal input is a low current
ground drawing a maximum of 600 milliamperes. The hazard warning input can be provided
through the multifunction switch on the steering column.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7782
Turn Signal Flasher: Service and Repair
COMBINATION FLASHER
REMOVAL
Fig.6 Combination Flasher Location
The flasher is mounted to the back side of the multi-function switch.
1. To gain access the upper steering column shroud must be removed. Refer to Steering, Column,
Column Shroud, Removal. 2. The flasher can be removed by pulling it toward the instrument
cluster (forward).
The flasher is serviced separately from the multifunction switch.
INSTALLATION
The flasher is serviced separately from the multifunction switch.
1. The flasher can be installed by pushing it toward the back of the steering wheel. 2. Install the
upper steering column shroud. Refer to Steering, Column, Column Shroud, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Indicator > Component Information >
Application and ID
Turn Signal Indicator: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Turn Signal Indicator ...........................................................................................................................
.............................................................. PC194
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Turn Signal Bulb: Service and Repair
Side Repeater Lamp Bulb
REMOVAL
1. Working in the appropriate front wheel well, remove the rear-most fasteners from the front
wheel-house liner. Refer to Body for detailed
instructions.
2. Reach up behind the side repeater lamp and depress the two lamp housing retaining tabs.
Remove the lamp housing from the fender opening. 3. Rotate the side repeater lamp housing
counterclockwise and remove the lamp socket from the lamp housing. 4. Pull the lamp bulb straight
from its socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the side repeater lamp bulb in the socket. 2. Verify lamp operation. 3. Install the side
repeater lamp socket into the lamp housing. 4. Install the side repeater lamp in the front fender. Be
certain lamp is secure in fender. 5. Install the front wheelhouse liner. Refer to Body for detailed
instructions.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Component Locations
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 7794
Turn Signal Switch: Connector Locations
Fig. 10 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 7795
Fig. 36 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7796
Multi-Function Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7797
Turn Signal Switch: Description and Operation
Fig.18 Multi-Function Switch
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
The multi-function switch is secured to the upper steering column housing at the top of the steering
column, just below the steering wheel. The visible parts of the multi-function switch are the turn
signal control stalk that extends through a dedicated opening in the left side of the upper steering
column shrouds, the windshield wiper/washer, exterior lighting control stalk that extends through a
dedicated opening in the right upper steering column shrouds, the hazard warning switch push
button that protrudes through an opening in the upper steering column shroud on the top of the
steering column. The remainder of the switch, its mounting provisions, and its electrical
connections are all concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied
to it, which identify its many functions. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for
"Hazard Warning" is applied to the top of the hazard warning switch push button.
The switch housing and its controls are constructed of molded black plastic. A connector receptacle
with up to twenty terminals is located on the back of the switch housing and connects the switch to
the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness.
The multi-function switch supports the following functions and features: Continuous Wipe Modes - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides two continuous
wipe switch positions, low speed or high speed.
- Intermittent Wipe Mode - The control knob of the multi-function switch provides an intermittent
wipe mode with multiple delay interval positions.
- Washer Mode - A button on the end of the control stalk of the multi-function switch provides
washer system operation when the button is depressed towards the steering column.
- Hazard Warning Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
detent switching for activation and deactivation of the hazard warning system.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide
for activation and deactivation of exterior lighting.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch
provide detent switching for selection of the headlamp high or low beams.
- Headlamp Optical Horn - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch includes
momentary switching of the headlamp high beam circuits to provide an optical horn feature
(sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass), which allows the vehicle operator to momentarily flash the
headlamp high beams as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The internal circuitry and hardware of the multi-function switch provide both
momentary non-detent switching and detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left
and right turn signals.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is faulty, or if
the switch is damaged, the entire switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Underhood Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID
Underhood Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Underhood ...........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 105
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID
Vanity Lamp: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs other than those listed in the chart below. Damage to lamp can result.
Bulb Application
Visor Vanity .........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 6501966
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Application and ID > Page 7804
Vanity Lamp: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Lower visor. 3. Insert a small flat bladed
tool between the lamp lens and lamp. 4. Carefully pry lens outward. 5. Remove bulb from socket.
INSTALLATION
1. Position bulb in socket and snap into place. 2. Position lens on lamp and snap into place. 3.
Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Heated Glass Element Switch: Locations
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7810
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7811
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7812
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
The rear window defogger switch may be tested in the vehicle or out of the vehicle, on the bench.
IN-VEHICLE TESTING
1. Remove the switch from the instrument panel but leave the switch connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch ON.
Rear Window Defogger Switch Harness Connector
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage at Pin 1 and 2.
a. If OK, go to Step 4. b. If NOT OK, check fuse 7 in the fuse block and the 40 Amp cartridge fuse
in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). If fuses are OK, check
wiring circuit.
4. Check Pin 5, with switch in the ON position there should be battery voltage and no voltage in the
OFF position.
a. If OK, go to Step 5. b. If NOT OK, no voltage in the ON position or voltage in the OFF position.
Replace the switch.
5. Press switch to ON position. The indicator lamp should come ON and remain ON for
approximately 10 minutes. If the indicator lamp fails to light
or no voltage is present for approximately 10 minutes. Replace Rear Window Defogger Switch.
BENCH TESTING
1. First remove switch.
Rear Window Defogger Switch Connector
2. With switch removed from vehicle, use a jumper wire and connect a 12 volt supply to Pin 1 and
2. Using a third jumper wire, ground Pin 3. Refer
to and the Rear Window Defogger Switch and Harness Connector Pin Call-Outs table.
3. Follow the same procedures used for IN-VEHICLE TESTING, except for step Step 2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Heated Glass Element Switch: Locations
Instrument Panel (Right Side) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7817
Instrument Panel (Left) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7818
Rear Window Defogger Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7819
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
The rear window defogger switch may be tested in the vehicle or out of the vehicle, on the bench.
IN-VEHICLE TESTING
1. Remove the switch from the instrument panel but leave the switch connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch ON.
Rear Window Defogger Switch Harness Connector
3. Using a voltmeter, check for battery voltage at Pin 1 and 2.
a. If OK, go to Step 4. b. If NOT OK, check fuse 7 in the fuse block and the 40 Amp cartridge fuse
in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). If fuses are OK, check
wiring circuit.
4. Check Pin 5, with switch in the ON position there should be battery voltage and no voltage in the
OFF position.
a. If OK, go to Step 5. b. If NOT OK, no voltage in the ON position or voltage in the OFF position.
Replace the switch.
5. Press switch to ON position. The indicator lamp should come ON and remain ON for
approximately 10 minutes. If the indicator lamp fails to light
or no voltage is present for approximately 10 minutes. Replace Rear Window Defogger Switch.
BENCH TESTING
1. First remove switch.
Rear Window Defogger Switch Connector
2. With switch removed from vehicle, use a jumper wire and connect a 12 volt supply to Pin 1 and
2. Using a third jumper wire, ground Pin 3. Refer
to and the Rear Window Defogger Switch and Harness Connector Pin Call-Outs table.
3. Follow the same procedures used for IN-VEHICLE TESTING, except for step Step 2.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Window Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - RHD
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7823
Door (Passenger) - LHD
Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7824
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Driver Power Window Switch C1
Driver Power Window Switch C2
Passenger Power Window Switch (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7825
Passenger Power Window Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7826
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
Power Window Switch Continuity
Remove the switch from its mounting, (Refer to POWER WINDOWS/POWER WINDOW SWITCH REMOVAL). Using an ohmmeter, test the window switch for continuity in all positions Refer to
Power Window Switch Continuity table to determine if continuity is correct. If the correct results are
not obtained, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7827
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or
equivalent, gently pry up on window switch bezel and remove from door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
wire connector from switch. 4. Remove two switch retaining screws.
INSTALLATION
1. install the switch retaining screws. 2. Reconnect the wire connector to the switch. 3. Insert switch
into the door trim panel. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Move the window to the full-up position, if
possible. 3. Remove front door trim panel. 4. Remove front door water shield. 5. Remove three
screws to front door radio speaker so that motor has room to pivot. 6. Pivot window motor out of
door panel. 7. Remove three motor retaining screws to drive cable. 8. Remove motor from drive
cable assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install motor to the cable drive assembly. 2. Install motor retaining screws to drive cable. 3.
Install the screws to the front door radio speaker. 4. Install the front door water shield. 5. Install the
front door trim panel. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Power Window Switch: Locations
Door (Driver) - RHD
Door (Driver) - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7836
Door (Passenger) - LHD
Door (Passenger) - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7837
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Driver Power Window Switch C1
Driver Power Window Switch C2
Passenger Power Window Switch (LHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7838
Passenger Power Window Switch (RHD)
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7839
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
Power Window Switch Continuity
Remove the switch from its mounting, (Refer to POWER WINDOWS/POWER WINDOW SWITCH REMOVAL). Using an ohmmeter, test the window switch for continuity in all positions Refer to
Power Window Switch Continuity table to determine if continuity is correct. If the correct results are
not obtained, replace the switch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7840
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a trim stick (special tool # C-4755) or
equivalent, gently pry up on window switch bezel and remove from door trim panel. 3. Disconnect
wire connector from switch. 4. Remove two switch retaining screws.
INSTALLATION
1. install the switch retaining screws. 2. Reconnect the wire connector to the switch. 3. Insert switch
into the door trim panel. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Back Window Glass: Service and Repair
BACKLITE
WARNING: DO NOT OPERATE THE VEHICLE WITHIN 24 HOURS OF WINDSHIELD
INSTALLATION. IT TAKES AT LEAST 24 HOURS FOR URETHANE ADHESIVE TO CURE. IF IT
IS NOT CURED, THE WINDSHIELD MAY NOT PERFORM PROPERLY IN AN ACCIDENT. BE
SURE TO DO NOT USE ADHESIVE AFTER ITS EXPIRATION DATE.
CAUTION: Open the left front door glass before installing the rear window to avoid pressurizing the
passenger compartment if a door is slammed before the urethane bonding is fully cured. Water
leaks can result.
Refer to the windshield paragraph for a description of tools and adhesive systems that are
recommended for use in this procedure.
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear window moldings. 2. Remove upper quarter trim panel. 3. Disconnect wire
connectors from rear window defogger.
WARNING: WEAR EYE AND HAND PROTECTION WHEN HANDLING SAFETY GLASS.
PERSONAL INJURY CAN RESULT.
CAUTION: Do not damage body or trim finish when cutting out glass or applying fence primer.
4. Cut the urethane around the perimeter of the rear window glass. 5. Remove the rear window
from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Prepare the work area, window fence, and glass the same way as described in the Windshield.
Fig. 1
2. Place fence spacers at the locations shown (Fig. 1). 3. Install the rear window molding on glass.
4. Apply a 10 mm (0.4 in.) bead of urethane around the perimeter of the glass. 5. Install the glass in
the same manner described in the Windshield (Fig. 1). 6. Connect rear window defogger wiring and
interior trim. 7. After urethane has cured, water test rear window to verify repair. Verify rear window
defogger operation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Front Vertical Guide Bar
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7850
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair B-Pillar Weatherstrip Channel
B-PILLAR WEATHERSTRIP CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove b-pillar applique. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 3. Pull
weatherstrip from b-pillar channels. 4. Remove screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 5. Remove
channels from b-pillar.
INSTALLATION
1. Install channels from b-pillar. 2. Install screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 3. Install
weatherstrip to b-pillar channels. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 5.
Install b-pillar applique.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7851
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair FDR Glass Run Weatherstrip
FDR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove flag cover, door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Loosen
side view mirror, as necessary. 4. Remove weatherstrip fasteners. 5. Pull weatherstrip from lower
front channel above door latch.
Fig. 1
6. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Tighten side view mirror. 8. Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, door trim panel and flag
trim.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7852
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Outer Belt Weatherstrip
OUTER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open door glass. 2. Pull upward at rear end of outer belt weatherstrip.
Fig. 2
3. Remove outer belt weatherstrip from vehicle (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Starting at leading edge of door, press weatherstrip onto door. 2. Operate window and check for
interference
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7853
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Front Vertical Guide Bar
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
B-Pillar Weatherstrip Channel
B-PILLAR WEATHERSTRIP CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Remove b-pillar applique. 2. Remove push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 3. Pull
weatherstrip from b-pillar channels. 4. Remove screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 5. Remove
channels from b-pillar.
INSTALLATION
1. Install channels from b-pillar. 2. Install screws attaching channels to b-pillar. 3. Install
weatherstrip to b-pillar channels. 4. Install push in fasteners attaching weatherstrip to b-pillar. 5.
Install b-pillar applique.
FDR Glass Run Weatherstrip
FDR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove flag cover, door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Loosen
side view mirror, as necessary. 4. Remove weatherstrip fasteners. 5. Pull weatherstrip from lower
front channel above door latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7854
Fig. 1
6. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 1).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Tighten side view mirror. 8. Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, door trim panel and flag
trim.
Outer Belt Weatherstrip
OUTER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open door glass. 2. Pull upward at rear end of outer belt weatherstrip.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7855
Fig. 2
3. Remove outer belt weatherstrip from vehicle (Fig. 2).
INSTALLATION
1. Starting at leading edge of door, press weatherstrip onto door. 2. Operate window and check for
interference
Door Upper Secondary Weatherstrip
DOOR UPPER SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool, disengage push in fasteners attaching door upper secondary
weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Vertical Guide Bar > Page 7856
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Front/Rear Door Inner Belt
Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7862
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Rear Door Glass Run Weatherstrip
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Remove
weatherstrip fasteners. 4. Pull weatherstrip from lower front channel above door latch.
Fig. 4
5. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 4).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, and door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7863
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair RDR Secondary Weatherstrip
RDR SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool C-4829 or equivalent, disengage push in fasteners attaching door
upper secondary weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7864
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair Roof Rail Weatherstrip
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open front and rear doors. 2. Using a door trim removing tool, disengage the push-in fasteners
holding A-pillar and C-pillar weatherstrip molding. 3. Starting at the bottom of the A-pillar, pull the
roof rail weatherstrip from the windshield side molding.
Fig. 5
4. Pull roof rail weatherstrip from the roof rail pinch flange above the door opening (Fig. 5). 5.
Separate roof rail weatherstrip from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place weatherstrip in position on pinch flange. 2. Starting at the bottom of the C-pillar, install the
roof rail weatherstrip molding to the pinch rail. 3. Install push-in fasteners to hold weatherstrip to
A-pillar and C-pillar.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7865
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip
FRONT/REAR DOOR INNER BELT WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel.
Fig. 3
2. Remove weatherstrip from door. Use a rubber mallet and a block of wood, tap upward at each
clip holding the molding to the door (Fig. 3).
INSTALLATION
1. Push down on weatherstrip to engage channel to door panel. 2. Install door trim panel.
Rear Door Glass Run Weatherstrip
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel, water dam as necessary. 2. Remove door glass. 3. Remove
weatherstrip fasteners. 4. Pull weatherstrip from lower front channel above door latch.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7866
Fig. 4
5. Pull run weatherstrip from window frame channel (Fig. 4).
INSTALLATION
1. Clean butyl material from door flange area. 2. Place door run weatherstrip in position on window
frame channel. 3. Push door run weatherstrip into window frame channel. 4. Push weatherstrip into
lower front channel above door latch. 5. Install weatherstrip fasteners. 6. Install door glass. 7.
Install pull cup support bracket, water shield, and door trim panel.
RDR Secondary Weatherstrip
RDR SECONDARY WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Using a fork-type prying tool C-4829 or equivalent, disengage push in fasteners attaching door
upper secondary weatherstrip to door opening. 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to opening door. 2. Press door upper secondary weatherstrip fasteners into
position.
Roof Rail Weatherstrip
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open front and rear doors. 2. Using a door trim removing tool, disengage the push-in fasteners
holding A-pillar and C-pillar weatherstrip molding. 3. Starting at the bottom of the A-pillar, pull the
roof rail weatherstrip from the windshield side molding.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7867
Fig. 5
4. Pull roof rail weatherstrip from the roof rail pinch flange above the door opening (Fig. 5). 5.
Separate roof rail weatherstrip from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place weatherstrip in position on pinch flange. 2. Starting at the bottom of the C-pillar, install the
roof rail weatherstrip molding to the pinch rail. 3. Install push-in fasteners to hold weatherstrip to
A-pillar and C-pillar.
Roof Rail Weatherstrip Retainer Channel
ROOF RAIL WEATHERSTRIP RETAINER CHANNEL
REMOVAL
1. Open door(s). 2. Using trim stick disconnect the top and bottom push in fasteners from B-pillar
applique. Gently pull outward on the applique to remove from the
vehicle.
NOTE: The applique is attached to the vehicle with two sided tape between the push in fasteners,
ensure all of the old two sided tape is removed from the vehicle surface before installation of new
part.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7868
Fig. 6
3. Remove weatherstrip from the retainer channel (Fig. 6). 4. Remove retainer channel from the
body side aperture.
INSTALLATION
1. Install retainer channel to the body side aperture. 2. Remove weatherstrip from the retainer
channel. 3. Connect the top and bottom push in fasteners to B-pillar applique. Gently push on the
applique to install from the vehicle.
Secondary Sill Weatherstrip
SECONDARY SILL WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
Fig. 7
1. Using a fork-type prying tool, disengage push in fasteners attaching sill secondary weatherstrip
to door (Fig. 7). 2. Remove weatherstrip from door.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front/Rear Door Inner Belt Weatherstrip >
Page 7869
INSTALLATION
1. Position weatherstrip to door. 2. Press sill secondary weatherstrip fasteners into position.
Trunk Opening Weatherstrip
TRUNK OPENING WEATHERSTRIP
REMOVAL
1. Open decklid.
Fig. 8
2. Pull decklid weatherstrip form decklid opening fence (Fig. 8). 3. Remove weatherstrip from
vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Place decklid opening weatherstrip into position. 2. Press the weatherstrip onto the decklid
opening fence. 3. Close decklid.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Handle > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Window Handle: Service and Repair
WINDOW CRANK
REMOVAL
1. Open door.
Fig. 13
2. Slide a window crank removal tool behind the window crank to release crank handle lock clip
(Fig. 13). 3. Remove handle from regulator shaft.
INSTALLATION
1. Place the lock clip on the window crank. 2. Place window crank on regulator shaft with the
window in the down position. 3. Orientate the window regulator crank handle appropriately at the
10 o'clock position and the left handle at the 2 o'clock position. 4. Push the handle in to the lock
position on the regulator shaft.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel. 2. Remove door glass from regulator channel.
Tie Strap Door Regulator Cable
3. Cut away the tie strap from the outboard regulator cable.
Rear Door Glass
4. Loosen screws attaching window regulator channel and crank housing to door panel. 5.
Disengage screw and bolt heads from keyhole slots in door panel. 6. Loosen bolts attaching
window regulator to door panel. 7. Disengage regulator from door panel, and crank housing. 8.
Slide regulator rearward and rotate forward end of roller channel through access hole in door
panel,
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 7877
9. Remove window regulator from door through access hole in inner panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Position window regulator and crank housing on door panel through access hole in door panel.
2. Tighten bolts attaching window regulator to door panel. 3. Engage window regulator bolt heads
on channel to key hole slots in door panel. 4. Tighten screw attaching window regulator channel
and crank housing. 5. Install a new tie strap around the outboard regulator cable and door inner
sheet metal. 6. Position glass to regulator roller channel. 7. Tighten fasteners attaching door glass
to roller channel. 8. Install door trim panel.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Track > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Window Track: Service and Repair
FRONT VERTICAL GUIDE BAR
REMOVAL
1. Remove door trim panel and water dam. 2. Remove door speaker, if equipped. 3. Remove front
lift guide. 4. Remove bolt attaching top of front guide bar to inner door panel. 5. Using a
Snap-on(R) flare-nut socket (FRXM10) and a hex wrench, remove nut attaching bottom of guide
bar to door panel while holding jack
screws.
INSTALLATION
1. Install nut attaching bottom of guide bar to door panel. 2. Install bolt attaching top of front guide
bar to inner door panel. 3. Install front lift guide. 4. Install door speaker, if equipped. 5. Verify door
glass alignment, adjust if necessary. 6. Install door trim panel and water dam.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions
Windshield: Service Precautions
STATIONARY GLASS
DESCRIPTION
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
WARNING: DO NOT OPERATE THE VEHICLE WITHIN 24 HOURS OF WINDSHIELD
INSTALLATION. IT TAKES AT LEAST 24 HOURS FOR URETHANE ADHESIVE TO CURE. IF IT
IS NOT CURED, THE WINDSHIELD MAY NOT PERFORM PROPERLY IN AN ACCIDENT.
URETHANE ADHESIVES ARE APPLIED AS A SYSTEM. USE GLASS CLEANER, GLASS PREP
SOLVENT, GLASS PRIMER, AND PINCH WELD (FENCE) PRIMER PROVIDED BY THE
ADHESIVE MANUFACTURER. IF NOT, STRUCTURAL INTEGRITY COULD BE
COMPROMISED.
CHRYSLER DOES NOT RECOMMEND GLASS ADHESIVE BY BRAND. TECHNICIANS
SHOULD REVIEW PRODUCT LABELS AND TECHNICAL DATA SHEETS, AND USE ONLY
ADHESIVES THAT THEIR MANUFACTURES WARRANT WILL RESTORE A VEHICLE TO THE
REQUIREMENTS OF FMVSS 212. TECHNICIANS SHOULD ALSO INSURE THAT PRIMERS
AND CLEANERS ARE COMPATIBLE WITH THE PARTICULAR ADHESIVE USED.
BE SURE TO DO NOT USE ADHESIVE AFTER ITS EXPIRATION DATE.
VAPORS THAT ARE EMITTED FROM THE URETHANE ADHESIVE OR PRIMER COULD
CAUSE PERSONAL INJURY. USE THEM IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
SKIN CONTACT WITH URETHANE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE AVOIDED. PERSONAL INJURY
MAY RESULT.
ALWAYS WEAR EYE AND HAND PROTECTION WHEN WORKING WITH GLASS.
CAUTION: Protect all painted and trimmed surfaces from coming in contact with urethane or
primers. Be careful not to damage painted surfaces when removing moldings or cutting urethane
around windshield.
It is difficult to salvage a windshield during the removal operation. The windshield is part of the
structural support for the roof. The urethane bonding used to secure the windshield to the fence is
difficult to cut or clean from any surface. If the moldings are set in urethane, it would also be
unlikely they could be salvaged. Before removing the windshield, check the availability of the
windshield and moldings from the parts supplier.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
7884
Windshield: Service and Repair
WINDSHIELD
DESCRIPTION
The urethane adhesive holding the windshield to the opening pinch weld (fence) can be cut using a
sharp cold knife from the exterior of the vehicle. Using the cold knife method is effective if the
windshield is already broken. If the glass must be salvaged, cutting the urethane adhesive from the
interior of the vehicle using a reciprocating or oscillating power knife is recommended.
POWER KNIFE
The urethane adhesive holding the windshield to the opening pinch weld (fence) can be cut using a
sharp cold knife from the exterior of the vehicle. Using the cold knife method is effective if the
windshield is already broken. If the glass must be salvaged, cutting the urethane adhesive from the
interior of the vehicle using a reciprocating or oscillating power knife is recommended.
RECOMMENDED TOOLS AND ADHESIVE
- Fein(R) Power Cutout Knife
- Equalizer(R) Magnum, Interior Auto Glass Cut Out Knife
ADHESIVE, PRIMER AND CLEANER
The urethane adhesive holding the windshield to the opening pinch weld (fence) can be cut using a
sharp cold knife from the exterior of the vehicle. Using the cold knife method is effective if the
windshield is already broken. If the glass must be salvaged, cutting the urethane adhesive from the
interior of the vehicle using a reciprocating or oscillating power knife is recommended.
RECOMMENDED TOOLS AND ADHESIVE
The following urethane adhesive systems are OEM certified and conform to the FMVSS 212
windshield retention standard and the FMVSS 216 roof crush standard.
REMOVAL
EXTERIOR METHOD
The urethane adhesive holding the windshield to the opening pinch weld (fence) can be cut using a
sharp cold knife from the exterior of the vehicle. Using the cold knife method is effective if the
windshield is already broken. If the glass must be salvaged, cutting the urethane adhesive from the
interior of the vehicle using a reciprocating or oscillating power knife is recommended.
1. Remove inside rear view mirror. 2. Remove windshield wiper arms. 3. Remove cowl cover. 4.
Place protective covers over instrument panel and hood.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
7885
Fig. 2
5. Remove the screws and remove the windshield A-pillar moldings. (Fig. 2)
Fig. 3
6. Using a sharp cold knife, cut urethane adhesive holding the windshield to the A-pillars, roof
header and cowl pinch weld fences (Fig. 3). A power
cutting device can be used if available.
7. Separate windshield from vehicle.
INTERIOR METHOD
The urethane adhesive holding the windshield to the opening pinch weld (fence) can be cut using a
sharp cold knife from the exterior of the vehicle. Using the cold knife method is effective if the
windshield is already broken. If the glass must be salvaged, cutting the urethane adhesive from the
interior of the vehicle using a reciprocating or oscillating power knife is recommended.
1. Remove inside rear view mirror. 2. Remove instrument panel top cover, refer to Instrument
Panel. 3. Remove A-pillar trim covers. 4. Place protective covers over instrument panel and hood.
5. Using a reciprocating or oscillating power knife, cut urethane adhesive holding the windshield to
the A-pillars, roof header and cowl pinch weld
fences. Refer to instructions provided with the equipment being used.
6. Remove windshield from vehicle.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
7886
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Open the left front door glass before installing windshield to avoid pressurizing the
passenger compartment. If a door is slammed before urethane bonding is cured, water leaks can
result. Allow the urethane at least 24 hours to cure before returning the vehicle to use.
To avoid stressing the replacement windshield, the urethane bonding material on the windshield
fence should be smooth and consistent to the shape of the replacement windshield. The support
spacers should be cleaned and properly installed on weld studs or repair screws at bottom of
windshield opening.
1. Place replacement windshield into windshield opening and position glass in the center of the
opening against the support spacers. 2. Verify the glass lays evenly against the pinch weld fence at
the sides, top and bottom of the replacement windshield. If not, the pinch weld fence
must be formed to the shape of the new glass.
3. Remove replacement windshield from windshield opening.
Fig. 4
4. Position the windshield inside up on a suitable work surface with two padded, wood 10 cm by 10
cm by 50 cm (4 in. by 4 in. by 20 in.) blocks,
placed parallel 75 cm (2.5 ft.) apart (Fig. 4).
WARNING: DO NOT USE SOLVENT BASED GLASS CLEANER TO CLEAN WINDSHIELD
BEFORE APPLYING GLASS PREP AND PRIMER. POOR ADHESION CAN RESULT.
5. Clean inside of windshield with ammonia based glass cleaner and lint-free cloth. 6. Apply
molding to Top of windshield. 7. Apply Glass Prep adhesion promoter 25 mm (1 in.) wide around
perimeter of windshield and wipe with clean/dry lint-free cloth until no streaks
are visible.
8. Apply Glass Primer 25 mm (1 in.) wide around perimeter of windshield. Allow at least three
minutes drying time. 9. Using a razor knife, remove as much original urethane as possible. Do not
damage paint on windshield fence.
10. Apply pinch weld primer 15 mm (.75 in.) wide around the windshield fence. Allow at least three
minutes drying time. 11. Apply a 10 mm (0.4 in.) bead of urethane on center line of windshield
fence. 12. With the aid of a helper, position the windshield over the windshield opening. Align the
reference marks at the bottom of the windshield to the
support spacers.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page
7887
Fig. 5
13. Slowly lower windshield glass to windshield opening fence. Guide the molding into proper
position as necessary. Push windshield inward molding
is flush to roof line and A-pillars (Fig. 5).
14. Clean access urethane from exterior with Mopar(R), Super Clean or equivalent. 15. Apply 150
mm (6 in.) lengths of 50 mm (2 in.) masking tape spaced 250 mm (10 in.) apart to hold molding in
place until urethane cures. 16. Install A-pillar moldings. 17. Install cowl cover and wipers. 18. Install
inside rear view mirror. 19. After urethane has cured, remove tape strips and water test windshield
to verify repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Wiper Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.13 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove wiper arms. Refer to Electrical,
Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arm, Removal. 3. Remove the left side cowl cover. Refer to Body Exterior,
Cowl Cover, Removal. 4. Disconnect the motor posi-lock harness connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7893
Fig.14 Wiper Module Remove/Install
5. Remove the wiper module mounting screws and remove the module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the windshield wiper module into the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting screws and tighten to
7 - 9 Nm (60 - 80 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Connect the motor posi-lock harness connector. 4. Install the
left side cowl cover. Refer to Body, Exterior, Cowl Cover, Installation. 5. Install the wiper arms.
Refer to Electrical, Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arm, Installation. 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Wiper/Washer Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7898
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Wiper/Washer Switch Replacement
Fig.15 Wiper/Washer Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Removal. 2. Remove the two retaining screws to the Wiper/Washer Switch.
3. Separate the two switches.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the two switches. 2. Install the two retaining screws to the Wiper/ Washer Switch. 3.
Install the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle. Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7902
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7903
Wiper/Washer Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7904
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Fig.15 Wiper/Washer Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Removal. 2. Remove the two retaining screws to the Wiper/Washer Switch.
3. Separate the two switches.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the two switches. 2. Install the two retaining screws to the Wiper/ Washer Switch. 3.
Install the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle. Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Washer Fluid: Specifications
Fill the reservoir with windshield washer solvent.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Hose: Service and Repair
Fig.6 Washer Hose
REMOVAL
For damaged or plugged washer hose, remove the effected piece of hose and replace, routing
hose the same way as removed.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect the
wire connector from the reservoir pump. 4. Disconnect the washer hose at the pump and drain the
reservoir. 5. Gently pry pump away from reservoir and out of grommet. Care must be taken not to
puncture reservoir. 6. Remove rubber grommet from reservoir. If replacing the pump, discard the
old washer pump grommet. If replacing the reservoir only, reuse the
old washer pump grommet.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure to use new grommet when installing new washer pump.
1. Install the rubber grommet into the reservoir. If replacing the pump, discard the old washer pump
grommet. If replacing the reservoir only, reuse
the old washer pump grommet.
2. Position pump in hole and firmly snap into the grommet. Care must be taken not to puncture
reservoir. 3. Connect the washer hose at the pump and fill the reservoir. 4. Connect the wire
connector to the reservoir pump 5. Lower vehicle from hoist 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Diagrams
Windshield Washer Pump
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7917
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Disconnect the
wire connector from the reservoir pump. 4. Disconnect the washer hose at the pump and drain the
reservoir. 5. Gently pry pump away from reservoir and out of grommet. Care must be taken not to
puncture reservoir. 6. Remove rubber grommet from reservoir. If replacing the pump, discard the
old washer pump grommet. If replacing the reservoir only, reuse the
old washer pump grommet.
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Make sure to use new grommet when installing new washer pump.
1. Install the rubber grommet into the reservoir. If replacing the pump, discard the old washer pump
grommet. If replacing the reservoir only, reuse
the old washer pump grommet.
2. Position pump in hole and firmly snap into the grommet. Care must be taken not to puncture
reservoir. 3. Connect the washer hose at the pump and fill the reservoir. 4. Connect the wire
connector to the reservoir pump 5. Lower vehicle from hoist 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable 2. Raise vehicle on hoist 3. Disconnect the
wire connector from the reservoir pump. 4. Disconnect the washer hose at the pump and drain the
reservoir. 5. Remove three fasteners from reservoir. 6. Remove the reservoir through fender
opening. 7. Remove the windshield washer pump from the reservoir (Refer to WIPERS/
WASHERS/WASHER PUMP MOTOR - REMOVAL).
INSTALLATION
1. Install the windshield washer pump into the reservoir (Refer to WIPERS/ WASHERS/WASHER
PUMP MOTOR - INSTALLATION). 2. Install the reservoir through fender opening. 3. Install the
fasteners to the reservoir. Tighten the reservoir screws to 6.8 - 8.5 Nm (60 - 75 in. lbs.) torque. 4.
Connect the washer hose at the pump and fill the reservoir. 5. Connect the wire connector to the
reservoir pump 6. Lower vehicle from hoist. 7. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Locations
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Locations
Fig.7 Windshield Washer Nozzle
There are two hood mounted washer nozzles
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7924
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Description and Operation
Fig.7 Windshield Washer Nozzle
There are two hood mounted washer nozzles. The right and left nozzles have different aims, but
can be installed in either hood hole and aimed appropriately.
Fig.8 Windshield Washer Pattern - Typical
Each nozzle emits two streams into the wiper pattern . If the nozzle performance is unsatisfactory
they can be adjusted.
To adjust front washer nozzle(s):
- Insert a pin into the nozzle ball and move so that it sprays into the proper pattern area.
NOTE: Aim the spray towards the top of the pattern area. When proceeding down the road at
speed, the spray will hit the windshield lower than when the vehicle is at rest.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7925
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Open hood. 2. Disconnect the washer hose from the underside of the washer nozzle. 3. Using a
plastic body filler spreader or equivalent (credit card), gently place it underneath the front of the
washer nozzle. Be careful not to damage
the hood seal underneath the nozzle.
4. Rock the nozzle back and forth slightly to release it from the hood panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Position nozzle over hole in hood panel and firmly snap into place. Make sure the seal is present
and not damaged. 2. Connect hose to nozzle on underside of hood. 3. After connecting hose,
check for proper system function and to assure leak free connections by actuating the washer
system switch from inside of
vehicle. Verify nozzle aim and adjust as necessary.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams
Wiper/Washer Switch
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7929
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Wiper/Washer Switch Replacement
Fig.15 Wiper/Washer Switch
REMOVAL
1. Remove the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Removal. 2. Remove the two retaining screws to the Wiper/Washer Switch.
3. Separate the two switches.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the two switches. 2. Install the two retaining screws to the Wiper/ Washer Switch. 3.
Install the Multi-Function Switch from the vehicle. Refer to Electrical, Lamps/Lighting - Exterior,
Multi-Function Switch, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments
Wiper Arm: Adjustments
1. Cycle the wiper motor into the PARK position. 2. Lift the wiper blade off the windshield and
release it.
Windshield Wiper Blade/Arm Park Lines
3. The wiper blade heel should be parked within 5 mm of the park line. The park line is mark on the
windshield. 4. In the event that the wiper blade tip excessively strikes the cowl screen due to long
term normal wear, reposition the wiper blade heel slightly
above the park line. Make sure that the wipers are in the PARK position.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Page
7933
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Place the wiper arm/blades in the PARK position and turn ignition OFF 2. Using a trim stick
(special tool # C-4755) or equivalent, gently pry up on arm cap and remove. 3. Remove the wiper
arm retaining nut. 4. Remove the arm from the pivot using a rocking motion while the arm is in an
over/centered position. 5. Clean metal splinters OFF the pivot shafts.
INSTALLATION
Ensure the wiper module is in the PARK position (cycle motor if necessary). Position wiper arms so
that the heel of the blade(s) is on the park line on the windshield. Refer to Electrical,
Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arms, Adjustments. for wiper arm adjustment. 1. Clean metal splinters
OFF the pivot shafts. 2. Install the arm onto the pivot using a rocking motion while the arm is in an
over/centered position. 3. Install the wiper arm retaining nut. Torque nut to 19.7 - 21.5 Nm (175 190 in. lbs.). 4. Install the arm nut cap. 5. Cycle the Place the wiper arm/blades, and verify that they
end up in the PARK position and turn ignition OFF.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Blade: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or Streak
Windshield
Wiper Blade: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or Streak Windshield
NUMBER: 23-014-06
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 8, 2006
SUBJECT: Windshield Wiper Blade/Element Maintenance
MODELS: All
All All Chrysler Group Vehicles
DISCUSSION:
Windshield wiper blades/elements are frequently replaced unnecessarily. Because of the
environmental conditions vehicles can be operated in, a film can build up on both the windshield
and the windshield wiper elements that will cause poor cleaning/streaking of the windshield, and in
some instances, a chattering condition as the wipers blades travel across the windshield.
Replacement of the wiper blades/elements is normally NOT required to correct streaking issues. A
simple NORMAL MAINTENANCE cleaning of the wiper blades/elements and windshield is all that
is required.
If the wipe pattern appears to be streaky or if there is chatter and no damage to the wiper
blades/elements is obvious, the following steps should be performed:
1. Use a soft cloth or sponge & squeegee and MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent (p/n
04318067AB, 16 Oz. bottle or p/n 04318068AB, 32 Oz. bottle), MOPAR Glass Cleaner (p/n
04897623AB, 16 Oz. bottle) or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water, to wash the windshield.
2. Raise the wiper blades off the glass and clean the wiper blade elements (rubber insert) with
MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water and a soft cloth,
paper towel or sponge.
3. Return the wiper blades to their normal operating position and function the washer system. If the
wiper blades/elements are not streaking the windshield or chattering, replacing the blade
assembly(ies) is not necessary. If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, repeat step 2 several times.
If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, replace the wiper blades/elements.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Blade: > 23-014-06 > Mar > 06 > Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or
Streak Windshield
Wiper Blade: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Wipers Smear or Streak Windshield
NUMBER: 23-014-06
GROUP: Body
DATE: March 8, 2006
SUBJECT: Windshield Wiper Blade/Element Maintenance
MODELS: All
All All Chrysler Group Vehicles
DISCUSSION:
Windshield wiper blades/elements are frequently replaced unnecessarily. Because of the
environmental conditions vehicles can be operated in, a film can build up on both the windshield
and the windshield wiper elements that will cause poor cleaning/streaking of the windshield, and in
some instances, a chattering condition as the wipers blades travel across the windshield.
Replacement of the wiper blades/elements is normally NOT required to correct streaking issues. A
simple NORMAL MAINTENANCE cleaning of the wiper blades/elements and windshield is all that
is required.
If the wipe pattern appears to be streaky or if there is chatter and no damage to the wiper
blades/elements is obvious, the following steps should be performed:
1. Use a soft cloth or sponge & squeegee and MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent (p/n
04318067AB, 16 Oz. bottle or p/n 04318068AB, 32 Oz. bottle), MOPAR Glass Cleaner (p/n
04897623AB, 16 Oz. bottle) or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water, to wash the windshield.
2. Raise the wiper blades off the glass and clean the wiper blade elements (rubber insert) with
MOPAR Windshield Washer Solvent or a solution of 50/50 alcohol and water and a soft cloth,
paper towel or sponge.
3. Return the wiper blades to their normal operating position and function the washer system. If the
wiper blades/elements are not streaking the windshield or chattering, replacing the blade
assembly(ies) is not necessary. If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, repeat step 2 several times.
If the wipe pattern is still objectionable, replace the wiper blades/elements.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 7947
Wiper Blade: Locations
The wiper blades are a rubber element with a steel vertebra that are mounted on the end of the
windshield wiper arm and sweep across the front windshield to clear it of water, snow, and debris.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 7948
Wiper Blade: Description and Operation
The wiper blades are a rubber element with a steel vertebra that are mounted on the end of the
windshield wiper arm and sweep across the front windshield to clear it of water, snow, and debris.
When the wiper blade rubber element is exposed to the weather for a long period of time, it tends
to lose wiping ability Periodic cleaning of the wiper blade element is suggested to remove the
accumulation of salt and road film. The wiper blades, arms, and windshield should be cleaned with
washer fluid , a sponge or cloth and a mild detergent, or non-abrasive cleaner. If the blades
continue to streak or smear, they should be replaced. The driver blade element is 550 mm in length
and the passenger blade element is 475 mm in length.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Blade Replacement
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Lift wiper arm to the over center position.
Wiper Blade And Element
2. Remove blade assembly from arm by pushing release tab under arm tip and slide blade away
from arm tip . 3. Gently place wiper arm tip on glass surface.
INSTALLATION
1. Gently lift wiper arm tip off glass surface and to the over center position.
Wiper Blade And Element
2. Install the blade assembly onto the arm by sliding blade towards arm tip. 3. Lower the wiper arm
to the glass surface and check the wiping pattern.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Blade Replacement > Page 7951
Wiper Blade: Service and Repair Wiper Blade Element Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Lift wiper arm to raise blade off glass.
Wiper Blade And Element
2. Remove blade assembly from arm by pushing release tab under arm tip and slide blade away
from arm tip. Gently place wiper arm tip on glass
surface.
Windshield Wiper Blade Element
3. Remove wiping element from blade assembly. Pull stopper of the rubber element out of the end
claw together with vertebrae (metal rails).
INSTALLATION
1. Install the wiping element onto the blade assembly. Push into the end of the blade assembly by
pressing the claw together with vertebrae (metal
rails) .
2. Install the blade assembly onto the arm by sliding onto the arm tip. Gently place wiper arm tip on
glass surface.
Check that the element and vertebrae are through all claws and the final claw is locked in the
stopper.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wiper Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Fig.13 Battery Negative Cable Remove/Install
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove wiper arms. Refer to Electrical,
Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arm, Removal. 3. Remove the left side cowl cover. Refer to Body Exterior,
Cowl Cover, Removal. 4. Disconnect the motor posi-lock harness connector.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7955
Fig.14 Wiper Module Remove/Install
5. Remove the wiper module mounting screws and remove the module from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the windshield wiper module into the vehicle. 2. Install the mounting screws and tighten to
7 - 9 Nm (60 - 80 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Connect the motor posi-lock harness connector. 4. Install the
left side cowl cover. Refer to Body, Exterior, Cowl Cover, Installation. 5. Install the wiper arms.
Refer to Electrical, Wipers/Washers, Wiper Arm, Installation. 6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector
Views
Wiper Motor
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7960
Wiper Motor: Testing and Inspection
Wiper Motor Diagnosis ( Part 1 Of 2 )
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7961
Wiper Motor Diagnosis ( Part 2 Of 2 )
Whenever a wiper motor malfunction occurs, verify that the wire harness is properly connected,
then start normal diagnosis and repair procedures. Refer to the WIPER MOTOR DIAGNOSIS
table.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7962
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove wiper module (Refer to WIPERS/WASHERS/WIPER MODULE - REMOVAL). 2.
Remove linkage from motor crank. Insert screwdriver or equivalent between crank and linkage then
twist and lift straight up on linkage. 3. Remove three motor mounting screws and separate motor
from linkage.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach motor to module. Install the three motor mounting screws and tighten the motor mounting
screws to 5 - 6 Nm (45 - 55 in. lbs.) torque.
NOTE:
- If motor crank was taken off for any reason, install and tighten drive link nut to 11 - 12 Nm (98 106 in. lbs.) torque.
- Make sure motor is parked before attaching the wiper arms.
2. Add unilube grease to the linkage socket and install the linkage onto the motor crank. 3. Install
the wiper module (Refer to WIPERS/WASHERS/WIPER MODULE - INSTALLATION).
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove wiper module Refer to Electrical, Wipers/Washers, Wiper Module Removal. 2. With the
wiper module on the bench, disconnect wiper arm linkage by inserting a screwdriver or equivalent
between ball cap and linkage. Twist
and lift straight up on linkage.
INSTALLATION
1. With the wiper module on the bench, connect wiper arm linkage by using pliers or your hand and
press the ball cap straight on to the ball stud. 2. Install the wiper module. Refer to Electrical,
Wipers/Washers, Wiper Module, Installation.
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Fig. 21 Instrument Panel - LHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7969
Fig. 51 Instrument Panel - RHD
Dodge Neon Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN F HO (2003))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7970
Wiper/Washer Switch